]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - doc/misc/calc.texi
(Embedded Mode, Algebraic-Style Calculations): Make Calc the subject
[gnu-emacs] / doc / misc / calc.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @comment %**start of header (This is for running Texinfo on a region.)
3 @c smallbook
4 @setfilename ../../info/calc
5 @c [title]
6 @settitle GNU Emacs Calc Manual
7 @setchapternewpage odd
8 @comment %**end of header (This is for running Texinfo on a region.)
9
10 @c The following macros are used for conditional output for single lines.
11 @c @texline foo
12 @c `foo' will appear only in TeX output
13 @c @infoline foo
14 @c `foo' will appear only in non-TeX output
15
16 @c @expr{expr} will typeset an expression;
17 @c $x$ in TeX, @samp{x} otherwise.
18
19 @iftex
20 @macro texline
21 @end macro
22 @alias infoline=comment
23 @alias expr=math
24 @alias tfn=code
25 @alias mathit=expr
26 @alias summarykey=key
27 @macro cpi{}
28 @math{@pi{}}
29 @end macro
30 @macro cpiover{den}
31 @math{@pi/\den\}
32 @end macro
33 @end iftex
34
35 @ifnottex
36 @alias texline=comment
37 @macro infoline{stuff}
38 \stuff\
39 @end macro
40 @alias expr=samp
41 @alias tfn=t
42 @alias mathit=i
43 @macro summarykey{ky}
44 \ky\
45 @end macro
46 @macro cpi{}
47 @expr{pi}
48 @end macro
49 @macro cpiover{den}
50 @expr{pi/\den\}
51 @end macro
52 @end ifnottex
53
54
55 @tex
56 % Suggested by Karl Berry <karl@@freefriends.org>
57 \gdef\!{\mskip-\thinmuskip}
58 @end tex
59
60 @c Fix some other things specifically for this manual.
61 @iftex
62 @finalout
63 @mathcode`@:=`@: @c Make Calc fractions come out right in math mode
64 @tex
65 \gdef\coloneq{\mathrel{\mathord:\mathord=}}
66
67 \gdef\beforedisplay{\vskip-10pt}
68 \gdef\afterdisplay{\vskip-5pt}
69 \gdef\beforedisplayh{\vskip-25pt}
70 \gdef\afterdisplayh{\vskip-10pt}
71 @end tex
72 @newdimen@kyvpos @kyvpos=0pt
73 @newdimen@kyhpos @kyhpos=0pt
74 @newcount@calcclubpenalty @calcclubpenalty=1000
75 @ignore
76 @newcount@calcpageno
77 @newtoks@calcoldeverypar @calcoldeverypar=@everypar
78 @everypar={@calceverypar@the@calcoldeverypar}
79 @ifx@turnoffactive@undefinedzzz@def@turnoffactive{}@fi
80 @ifx@ninett@undefinedzzz@font@ninett=cmtt9@fi
81 @catcode`@\=0 \catcode`\@=11
82 \r@ggedbottomtrue
83 \catcode`\@=0 @catcode`@\=@active
84 @end ignore
85 @end iftex
86
87 @copying
88 @ifinfo
89 This file documents Calc, the GNU Emacs calculator.
90 @end ifinfo
91 @ifnotinfo
92 This file documents Calc, the GNU Emacs calculator, included with GNU Emacs 23.1.
93 @end ifnotinfo
94
95 Copyright @copyright{} 1990, 1991, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004,
96 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
97
98 @quotation
99 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
100 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
101 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
102 Invariant Sections being just ``GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE'', with the
103 Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' and with the Back-Cover
104 Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license is included in the section
105 entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
106
107 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
108 modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
109 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
110 @end quotation
111 @end copying
112
113 @dircategory Emacs
114 @direntry
115 * Calc: (calc). Advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool.
116 @end direntry
117
118 @titlepage
119 @sp 6
120 @center @titlefont{Calc Manual}
121 @sp 4
122 @center GNU Emacs Calc
123 @c [volume]
124 @sp 5
125 @center Dave Gillespie
126 @center daveg@@synaptics.com
127 @page
128
129 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
130 Copyright @copyright{} 1990, 1991, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004,
131 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
132 @insertcopying
133 @end titlepage
134
135
136 @summarycontents
137
138 @c [end]
139
140 @contents
141
142 @c [begin]
143 @ifnottex
144 @node Top, Getting Started, (dir), (dir)
145 @chapter The GNU Emacs Calculator
146
147 @noindent
148 @dfn{Calc} is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool
149 written by Dave Gillespie that runs as part of the GNU Emacs environment.
150
151 This manual, also written (mostly) by Dave Gillespie, is divided into
152 three major parts: ``Getting Started,'' the ``Calc Tutorial,'' and the
153 ``Calc Reference.'' The Tutorial introduces all the major aspects of
154 Calculator use in an easy, hands-on way. The remainder of the manual is
155 a complete reference to the features of the Calculator.
156 @end ifnottex
157
158 @ifinfo
159 For help in the Emacs Info system (which you are using to read this
160 file), type @kbd{?}. (You can also type @kbd{h} to run through a
161 longer Info tutorial.)
162 @end ifinfo
163
164 @menu
165 * Getting Started:: General description and overview.
166 @ifinfo
167 * Interactive Tutorial::
168 @end ifinfo
169 * Tutorial:: A step-by-step introduction for beginners.
170
171 * Introduction:: Introduction to the Calc reference manual.
172 * Data Types:: Types of objects manipulated by Calc.
173 * Stack and Trail:: Manipulating the stack and trail buffers.
174 * Mode Settings:: Adjusting display format and other modes.
175 * Arithmetic:: Basic arithmetic functions.
176 * Scientific Functions:: Transcendentals and other scientific functions.
177 * Matrix Functions:: Operations on vectors and matrices.
178 * Algebra:: Manipulating expressions algebraically.
179 * Units:: Operations on numbers with units.
180 * Store and Recall:: Storing and recalling variables.
181 * Graphics:: Commands for making graphs of data.
182 * Kill and Yank:: Moving data into and out of Calc.
183 * Keypad Mode:: Operating Calc from a keypad.
184 * Embedded Mode:: Working with formulas embedded in a file.
185 * Programming:: Calc as a programmable calculator.
186
187 * Copying:: How you can copy and share Calc.
188 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation.
189 * Customizing Calc:: Customizing Calc.
190 * Reporting Bugs:: How to report bugs and make suggestions.
191
192 * Summary:: Summary of Calc commands and functions.
193
194 * Key Index:: The standard Calc key sequences.
195 * Command Index:: The interactive Calc commands.
196 * Function Index:: Functions (in algebraic formulas).
197 * Concept Index:: General concepts.
198 * Variable Index:: Variables used by Calc (both user and internal).
199 * Lisp Function Index:: Internal Lisp math functions.
200 @end menu
201
202 @ifinfo
203 @node Getting Started, Interactive Tutorial, Top, Top
204 @end ifinfo
205 @ifnotinfo
206 @node Getting Started, Tutorial, Top, Top
207 @end ifnotinfo
208 @chapter Getting Started
209 @noindent
210 This chapter provides a general overview of Calc, the GNU Emacs
211 Calculator: What it is, how to start it and how to exit from it,
212 and what are the various ways that it can be used.
213
214 @menu
215 * What is Calc::
216 * About This Manual::
217 * Notations Used in This Manual::
218 * Demonstration of Calc::
219 * Using Calc::
220 * History and Acknowledgements::
221 @end menu
222
223 @node What is Calc, About This Manual, Getting Started, Getting Started
224 @section What is Calc?
225
226 @noindent
227 @dfn{Calc} is an advanced calculator and mathematical tool that runs as
228 part of the GNU Emacs environment. Very roughly based on the HP-28/48
229 series of calculators, its many features include:
230
231 @itemize @bullet
232 @item
233 Choice of algebraic or RPN (stack-based) entry of calculations.
234
235 @item
236 Arbitrary precision integers and floating-point numbers.
237
238 @item
239 Arithmetic on rational numbers, complex numbers (rectangular and polar),
240 error forms with standard deviations, open and closed intervals, vectors
241 and matrices, dates and times, infinities, sets, quantities with units,
242 and algebraic formulas.
243
244 @item
245 Mathematical operations such as logarithms and trigonometric functions.
246
247 @item
248 Programmer's features (bitwise operations, non-decimal numbers).
249
250 @item
251 Financial functions such as future value and internal rate of return.
252
253 @item
254 Number theoretical features such as prime factorization and arithmetic
255 modulo @var{m} for any @var{m}.
256
257 @item
258 Algebraic manipulation features, including symbolic calculus.
259
260 @item
261 Moving data to and from regular editing buffers.
262
263 @item
264 Embedded mode for manipulating Calc formulas and data directly
265 inside any editing buffer.
266
267 @item
268 Graphics using GNUPLOT, a versatile (and free) plotting program.
269
270 @item
271 Easy programming using keyboard macros, algebraic formulas,
272 algebraic rewrite rules, or extended Emacs Lisp.
273 @end itemize
274
275 Calc tries to include a little something for everyone; as a result it is
276 large and might be intimidating to the first-time user. If you plan to
277 use Calc only as a traditional desk calculator, all you really need to
278 read is the ``Getting Started'' chapter of this manual and possibly the
279 first few sections of the tutorial. As you become more comfortable with
280 the program you can learn its additional features. Calc does not
281 have the scope and depth of a fully-functional symbolic math package,
282 but Calc has the advantages of convenience, portability, and freedom.
283
284 @node About This Manual, Notations Used in This Manual, What is Calc, Getting Started
285 @section About This Manual
286
287 @noindent
288 This document serves as a complete description of the GNU Emacs
289 Calculator. It works both as an introduction for novices and as
290 a reference for experienced users. While it helps to have some
291 experience with GNU Emacs in order to get the most out of Calc,
292 this manual ought to be readable even if you don't know or use Emacs
293 regularly.
294
295 This manual is divided into three major parts:@: the ``Getting
296 Started'' chapter you are reading now, the Calc tutorial (chapter 2),
297 and the Calc reference manual (the remaining chapters and appendices).
298 @c [when-split]
299 @c This manual has been printed in two volumes, the @dfn{Tutorial} and the
300 @c @dfn{Reference}. Both volumes include a copy of the ``Getting Started''
301 @c chapter.
302
303 If you are in a hurry to use Calc, there is a brief ``demonstration''
304 below which illustrates the major features of Calc in just a couple of
305 pages. If you don't have time to go through the full tutorial, this
306 will show you everything you need to know to begin.
307 @xref{Demonstration of Calc}.
308
309 The tutorial chapter walks you through the various parts of Calc
310 with lots of hands-on examples and explanations. If you are new
311 to Calc and you have some time, try going through at least the
312 beginning of the tutorial. The tutorial includes about 70 exercises
313 with answers. These exercises give you some guided practice with
314 Calc, as well as pointing out some interesting and unusual ways
315 to use its features.
316
317 The reference section discusses Calc in complete depth. You can read
318 the reference from start to finish if you want to learn every aspect
319 of Calc. Or, you can look in the table of contents or the Concept
320 Index to find the parts of the manual that discuss the things you
321 need to know.
322
323 @c @cindex Marginal notes
324 Every Calc keyboard command is listed in the Calc Summary, and also
325 in the Key Index. Algebraic functions, @kbd{M-x} commands, and
326 variables also have their own indices.
327 @c @texline Each
328 @c @infoline In the printed manual, each
329 @c paragraph that is referenced in the Key or Function Index is marked
330 @c in the margin with its index entry.
331
332 @c [fix-ref Help Commands]
333 You can access this manual on-line at any time within Calc by pressing
334 the @kbd{h i} key sequence. Outside of the Calc window, you can press
335 @kbd{C-x * i} to read the manual on-line. From within Calc the command
336 @kbd{h t} will jump directly to the Tutorial; from outside of Calc the
337 command @kbd{C-x * t} will jump to the Tutorial and start Calc if
338 necessary. Pressing @kbd{h s} or @kbd{C-x * s} will take you directly
339 to the Calc Summary. Within Calc, you can also go to the part of the
340 manual describing any Calc key, function, or variable using
341 @w{@kbd{h k}}, @kbd{h f}, or @kbd{h v}, respectively. @xref{Help Commands}.
342
343 @ifnottex
344 The Calc manual can be printed, but because the manual is so large, you
345 should only make a printed copy if you really need it. To print the
346 manual, you will need the @TeX{} typesetting program (this is a free
347 program by Donald Knuth at Stanford University) as well as the
348 @file{texindex} program and @file{texinfo.tex} file, both of which can
349 be obtained from the FSF as part of the @code{texinfo} package.
350 To print the Calc manual in one huge tome, you will need the
351 source code to this manual, @file{calc.texi}, available as part of the
352 Emacs source. Once you have this file, type @kbd{texi2dvi calc.texi}.
353 Alternatively, change to the @file{man} subdirectory of the Emacs
354 source distribution, and type @kbd{make calc.dvi}. (Don't worry if you
355 get some ``overfull box'' warnings while @TeX{} runs.)
356 The result will be a device-independent output file called
357 @file{calc.dvi}, which you must print in whatever way is right
358 for your system. On many systems, the command is
359
360 @example
361 lpr -d calc.dvi
362 @end example
363
364 @noindent
365 or
366
367 @example
368 dvips calc.dvi
369 @end example
370 @end ifnottex
371 @c Printed copies of this manual are also available from the Free Software
372 @c Foundation.
373
374 @node Notations Used in This Manual, Demonstration of Calc, About This Manual, Getting Started
375 @section Notations Used in This Manual
376
377 @noindent
378 This section describes the various notations that are used
379 throughout the Calc manual.
380
381 In keystroke sequences, uppercase letters mean you must hold down
382 the shift key while typing the letter. Keys pressed with Control
383 held down are shown as @kbd{C-x}. Keys pressed with Meta held down
384 are shown as @kbd{M-x}. Other notations are @key{RET} for the
385 Return key, @key{SPC} for the space bar, @key{TAB} for the Tab key,
386 @key{DEL} for the Delete key, and @key{LFD} for the Line-Feed key.
387 The @key{DEL} key is called Backspace on some keyboards, it is
388 whatever key you would use to correct a simple typing error when
389 regularly using Emacs.
390
391 (If you don't have the @key{LFD} or @key{TAB} keys on your keyboard,
392 the @kbd{C-j} and @kbd{C-i} keys are equivalent to them, respectively.
393 If you don't have a Meta key, look for Alt or Extend Char. You can
394 also press @key{ESC} or @kbd{C-[} first to get the same effect, so
395 that @kbd{M-x}, @kbd{@key{ESC} x}, and @kbd{C-[ x} are all equivalent.)
396
397 Sometimes the @key{RET} key is not shown when it is ``obvious''
398 that you must press @key{RET} to proceed. For example, the @key{RET}
399 is usually omitted in key sequences like @kbd{M-x calc-keypad @key{RET}}.
400
401 Commands are generally shown like this: @kbd{p} (@code{calc-precision})
402 or @kbd{C-x * k} (@code{calc-keypad}). This means that the command is
403 normally used by pressing the @kbd{p} key or @kbd{C-x * k} key sequence,
404 but it also has the full-name equivalent shown, e.g., @kbd{M-x calc-precision}.
405
406 Commands that correspond to functions in algebraic notation
407 are written: @kbd{C} (@code{calc-cos}) [@code{cos}]. This means
408 the @kbd{C} key is equivalent to @kbd{M-x calc-cos}, and that
409 the corresponding function in an algebraic-style formula would
410 be @samp{cos(@var{x})}.
411
412 A few commands don't have key equivalents: @code{calc-sincos}
413 [@code{sincos}].
414
415 @node Demonstration of Calc, Using Calc, Notations Used in This Manual, Getting Started
416 @section A Demonstration of Calc
417
418 @noindent
419 @cindex Demonstration of Calc
420 This section will show some typical small problems being solved with
421 Calc. The focus is more on demonstration than explanation, but
422 everything you see here will be covered more thoroughly in the
423 Tutorial.
424
425 To begin, start Emacs if necessary (usually the command @code{emacs}
426 does this), and type @kbd{C-x * c} to start the
427 Calculator. (You can also use @kbd{M-x calc} if this doesn't work.
428 @xref{Starting Calc}, for various ways of starting the Calculator.)
429
430 Be sure to type all the sample input exactly, especially noting the
431 difference between lower-case and upper-case letters. Remember,
432 @key{RET}, @key{TAB}, @key{DEL}, and @key{SPC} are the Return, Tab,
433 Delete, and Space keys.
434
435 @strong{RPN calculation.} In RPN, you type the input number(s) first,
436 then the command to operate on the numbers.
437
438 @noindent
439 Type @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 + Q} to compute
440 @texline @math{\sqrt{2+3} = 2.2360679775}.
441 @infoline the square root of 2+3, which is 2.2360679775.
442
443 @noindent
444 Type @kbd{P 2 ^} to compute
445 @texline @math{\pi^2 = 9.86960440109}.
446 @infoline the value of `pi' squared, 9.86960440109.
447
448 @noindent
449 Type @key{TAB} to exchange the order of these two results.
450
451 @noindent
452 Type @kbd{- I H S} to subtract these results and compute the Inverse
453 Hyperbolic sine of the difference, 2.72996136574.
454
455 @noindent
456 Type @key{DEL} to erase this result.
457
458 @strong{Algebraic calculation.} You can also enter calculations using
459 conventional ``algebraic'' notation. To enter an algebraic formula,
460 use the apostrophe key.
461
462 @noindent
463 Type @kbd{' sqrt(2+3) @key{RET}} to compute
464 @texline @math{\sqrt{2+3}}.
465 @infoline the square root of 2+3.
466
467 @noindent
468 Type @kbd{' pi^2 @key{RET}} to enter
469 @texline @math{\pi^2}.
470 @infoline `pi' squared.
471 To evaluate this symbolic formula as a number, type @kbd{=}.
472
473 @noindent
474 Type @kbd{' arcsinh($ - $$) @key{RET}} to subtract the second-most-recent
475 result from the most-recent and compute the Inverse Hyperbolic sine.
476
477 @strong{Keypad mode.} If you are using the X window system, press
478 @w{@kbd{C-x * k}} to get Keypad mode. (If you don't use X, skip to
479 the next section.)
480
481 @noindent
482 Click on the @key{2}, @key{ENTER}, @key{3}, @key{+}, and @key{SQRT}
483 ``buttons'' using your left mouse button.
484
485 @noindent
486 Click on @key{PI}, @key{2}, and @tfn{y^x}.
487
488 @noindent
489 Click on @key{INV}, then @key{ENTER} to swap the two results.
490
491 @noindent
492 Click on @key{-}, @key{INV}, @key{HYP}, and @key{SIN}.
493
494 @noindent
495 Click on @key{<-} to erase the result, then click @key{OFF} to turn
496 the Keypad Calculator off.
497
498 @strong{Grabbing data.} Type @kbd{C-x * x} if necessary to exit Calc.
499 Now select the following numbers as an Emacs region: ``Mark'' the
500 front of the list by typing @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} or @kbd{C-@@} there,
501 then move to the other end of the list. (Either get this list from
502 the on-line copy of this manual, accessed by @w{@kbd{C-x * i}}, or just
503 type these numbers into a scratch file.) Now type @kbd{C-x * g} to
504 ``grab'' these numbers into Calc.
505
506 @example
507 @group
508 1.23 1.97
509 1.6 2
510 1.19 1.08
511 @end group
512 @end example
513
514 @noindent
515 The result @samp{[1.23, 1.97, 1.6, 2, 1.19, 1.08]} is a Calc ``vector.''
516 Type @w{@kbd{V R +}} to compute the sum of these numbers.
517
518 @noindent
519 Type @kbd{U} to Undo this command, then type @kbd{V R *} to compute
520 the product of the numbers.
521
522 @noindent
523 You can also grab data as a rectangular matrix. Place the cursor on
524 the upper-leftmost @samp{1} and set the mark, then move to just after
525 the lower-right @samp{8} and press @kbd{C-x * r}.
526
527 @noindent
528 Type @kbd{v t} to transpose this
529 @texline @math{3\times2}
530 @infoline 3x2
531 matrix into a
532 @texline @math{2\times3}
533 @infoline 2x3
534 matrix. Type @w{@kbd{v u}} to unpack the rows into two separate
535 vectors. Now type @w{@kbd{V R + @key{TAB} V R +}} to compute the sums
536 of the two original columns. (There is also a special
537 grab-and-sum-columns command, @kbd{C-x * :}.)
538
539 @strong{Units conversion.} Units are entered algebraically.
540 Type @w{@kbd{' 43 mi/hr @key{RET}}} to enter the quantity 43 miles-per-hour.
541 Type @w{@kbd{u c km/hr @key{RET}}}. Type @w{@kbd{u c m/s @key{RET}}}.
542
543 @strong{Date arithmetic.} Type @kbd{t N} to get the current date and
544 time. Type @kbd{90 +} to find the date 90 days from now. Type
545 @kbd{' <25 dec 87> @key{RET}} to enter a date, then @kbd{- 7 /} to see how
546 many weeks have passed since then.
547
548 @strong{Algebra.} Algebraic entries can also include formulas
549 or equations involving variables. Type @kbd{@w{' [x + y} = a, x y = 1] @key{RET}}
550 to enter a pair of equations involving three variables.
551 (Note the leading apostrophe in this example; also, note that the space
552 in @samp{x y} is required.) Type @w{@kbd{a S x,y @key{RET}}} to solve
553 these equations for the variables @expr{x} and @expr{y}.
554
555 @noindent
556 Type @kbd{d B} to view the solutions in more readable notation.
557 Type @w{@kbd{d C}} to view them in C language notation, @kbd{d T}
558 to view them in the notation for the @TeX{} typesetting system,
559 and @kbd{d L} to view them in the notation for the La@TeX{} typesetting
560 system. Type @kbd{d N} to return to normal notation.
561
562 @noindent
563 Type @kbd{7.5}, then @kbd{s l a @key{RET}} to let @expr{a = 7.5} in these formulas.
564 (That's the letter @kbd{l}, not the numeral @kbd{1}.)
565
566 @ifnotinfo
567 @strong{Help functions.} You can read about any command in the on-line
568 manual. Type @kbd{C-x * c} to return to Calc after each of these
569 commands: @kbd{h k t N} to read about the @kbd{t N} command,
570 @kbd{h f sqrt @key{RET}} to read about the @code{sqrt} function, and
571 @kbd{h s} to read the Calc summary.
572 @end ifnotinfo
573 @ifinfo
574 @strong{Help functions.} You can read about any command in the on-line
575 manual. Remember to type the letter @kbd{l}, then @kbd{C-x * c}, to
576 return here after each of these commands: @w{@kbd{h k t N}} to read
577 about the @w{@kbd{t N}} command, @kbd{h f sqrt @key{RET}} to read about the
578 @code{sqrt} function, and @kbd{h s} to read the Calc summary.
579 @end ifinfo
580
581 Press @key{DEL} repeatedly to remove any leftover results from the stack.
582 To exit from Calc, press @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x * c} again.
583
584 @node Using Calc, History and Acknowledgements, Demonstration of Calc, Getting Started
585 @section Using Calc
586
587 @noindent
588 Calc has several user interfaces that are specialized for
589 different kinds of tasks. As well as Calc's standard interface,
590 there are Quick mode, Keypad mode, and Embedded mode.
591
592 @menu
593 * Starting Calc::
594 * The Standard Interface::
595 * Quick Mode Overview::
596 * Keypad Mode Overview::
597 * Standalone Operation::
598 * Embedded Mode Overview::
599 * Other C-x * Commands::
600 @end menu
601
602 @node Starting Calc, The Standard Interface, Using Calc, Using Calc
603 @subsection Starting Calc
604
605 @noindent
606 On most systems, you can type @kbd{C-x *} to start the Calculator.
607 The key sequence @kbd{C-x *} is bound to the command @code{calc-dispatch},
608 which can be rebound if convenient (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
609
610 When you press @kbd{C-x *}, Emacs waits for you to press a second key to
611 complete the command. In this case, you will follow @kbd{C-x *} with a
612 letter (upper- or lower-case, it doesn't matter for @kbd{C-x *}) that says
613 which Calc interface you want to use.
614
615 To get Calc's standard interface, type @kbd{C-x * c}. To get
616 Keypad mode, type @kbd{C-x * k}. Type @kbd{C-x * ?} to get a brief
617 list of the available options, and type a second @kbd{?} to get
618 a complete list.
619
620 To ease typing, @kbd{C-x * *} also works to start Calc. It starts the
621 same interface (either @kbd{C-x * c} or @w{@kbd{C-x * k}}) that you last
622 used, selecting the @kbd{C-x * c} interface by default.
623
624 If @kbd{C-x *} doesn't work for you, you can always type explicit
625 commands like @kbd{M-x calc} (for the standard user interface) or
626 @w{@kbd{M-x calc-keypad}} (for Keypad mode). First type @kbd{M-x}
627 (that's Meta with the letter @kbd{x}), then, at the prompt,
628 type the full command (like @kbd{calc-keypad}) and press Return.
629
630 The same commands (like @kbd{C-x * c} or @kbd{C-x * *}) that start
631 the Calculator also turn it off if it is already on.
632
633 @node The Standard Interface, Quick Mode Overview, Starting Calc, Using Calc
634 @subsection The Standard Calc Interface
635
636 @noindent
637 @cindex Standard user interface
638 Calc's standard interface acts like a traditional RPN calculator,
639 operated by the normal Emacs keyboard. When you type @kbd{C-x * c}
640 to start the Calculator, the Emacs screen splits into two windows
641 with the file you were editing on top and Calc on the bottom.
642
643 @smallexample
644 @group
645
646 ...
647 --**-Emacs: myfile (Fundamental)----All----------------------
648 --- Emacs Calculator Mode --- |Emacs Calculator Trail
649 2: 17.3 | 17.3
650 1: -5 | 3
651 . | 2
652 | 4
653 | * 8
654 | ->-5
655 |
656 --%*-Calc: 12 Deg (Calculator)----All----- --%*- *Calc Trail*
657 @end group
658 @end smallexample
659
660 In this figure, the mode-line for @file{myfile} has moved up and the
661 ``Calculator'' window has appeared below it. As you can see, Calc
662 actually makes two windows side-by-side. The lefthand one is
663 called the @dfn{stack window} and the righthand one is called the
664 @dfn{trail window.} The stack holds the numbers involved in the
665 calculation you are currently performing. The trail holds a complete
666 record of all calculations you have done. In a desk calculator with
667 a printer, the trail corresponds to the paper tape that records what
668 you do.
669
670 In this case, the trail shows that four numbers (17.3, 3, 2, and 4)
671 were first entered into the Calculator, then the 2 and 4 were
672 multiplied to get 8, then the 3 and 8 were subtracted to get @mathit{-5}.
673 (The @samp{>} symbol shows that this was the most recent calculation.)
674 The net result is the two numbers 17.3 and @mathit{-5} sitting on the stack.
675
676 Most Calculator commands deal explicitly with the stack only, but
677 there is a set of commands that allow you to search back through
678 the trail and retrieve any previous result.
679
680 Calc commands use the digits, letters, and punctuation keys.
681 Shifted (i.e., upper-case) letters are different from lowercase
682 letters. Some letters are @dfn{prefix} keys that begin two-letter
683 commands. For example, @kbd{e} means ``enter exponent'' and shifted
684 @kbd{E} means @expr{e^x}. With the @kbd{d} (``display modes'') prefix
685 the letter ``e'' takes on very different meanings: @kbd{d e} means
686 ``engineering notation'' and @kbd{d E} means ``@dfn{eqn} language mode.''
687
688 There is nothing stopping you from switching out of the Calc
689 window and back into your editing window, say by using the Emacs
690 @w{@kbd{C-x o}} (@code{other-window}) command. When the cursor is
691 inside a regular window, Emacs acts just like normal. When the
692 cursor is in the Calc stack or trail windows, keys are interpreted
693 as Calc commands.
694
695 When you quit by pressing @kbd{C-x * c} a second time, the Calculator
696 windows go away but the actual Stack and Trail are not gone, just
697 hidden. When you press @kbd{C-x * c} once again you will get the
698 same stack and trail contents you had when you last used the
699 Calculator.
700
701 The Calculator does not remember its state between Emacs sessions.
702 Thus if you quit Emacs and start it again, @kbd{C-x * c} will give you
703 a fresh stack and trail. There is a command (@kbd{m m}) that lets
704 you save your favorite mode settings between sessions, though.
705 One of the things it saves is which user interface (standard or
706 Keypad) you last used; otherwise, a freshly started Emacs will
707 always treat @kbd{C-x * *} the same as @kbd{C-x * c}.
708
709 The @kbd{q} key is another equivalent way to turn the Calculator off.
710
711 If you type @kbd{C-x * b} first and then @kbd{C-x * c}, you get a
712 full-screen version of Calc (@code{full-calc}) in which the stack and
713 trail windows are still side-by-side but are now as tall as the whole
714 Emacs screen. When you press @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x * c} again to quit,
715 the file you were editing before reappears. The @kbd{C-x * b} key
716 switches back and forth between ``big'' full-screen mode and the
717 normal partial-screen mode.
718
719 Finally, @kbd{C-x * o} (@code{calc-other-window}) is like @kbd{C-x * c}
720 except that the Calc window is not selected. The buffer you were
721 editing before remains selected instead. If you are in a Calc window,
722 then @kbd{C-x * o} will switch you out of it, being careful not to
723 switch you to the Calc Trail window. So @kbd{C-x * o} is a handy
724 way to switch out of Calc momentarily to edit your file; you can then
725 type @kbd{C-x * c} to switch back into Calc when you are done.
726
727 @node Quick Mode Overview, Keypad Mode Overview, The Standard Interface, Using Calc
728 @subsection Quick Mode (Overview)
729
730 @noindent
731 @dfn{Quick mode} is a quick way to use Calc when you don't need the
732 full complexity of the stack and trail. To use it, type @kbd{C-x * q}
733 (@code{quick-calc}) in any regular editing buffer.
734
735 Quick mode is very simple: It prompts you to type any formula in
736 standard algebraic notation (like @samp{4 - 2/3}) and then displays
737 the result at the bottom of the Emacs screen (@mathit{3.33333333333}
738 in this case). You are then back in the same editing buffer you
739 were in before, ready to continue editing or to type @kbd{C-x * q}
740 again to do another quick calculation. The result of the calculation
741 will also be in the Emacs ``kill ring'' so that a @kbd{C-y} command
742 at this point will yank the result into your editing buffer.
743
744 Calc mode settings affect Quick mode, too, though you will have to
745 go into regular Calc (with @kbd{C-x * c}) to change the mode settings.
746
747 @c [fix-ref Quick Calculator mode]
748 @xref{Quick Calculator}, for further information.
749
750 @node Keypad Mode Overview, Standalone Operation, Quick Mode Overview, Using Calc
751 @subsection Keypad Mode (Overview)
752
753 @noindent
754 @dfn{Keypad mode} is a mouse-based interface to the Calculator.
755 It is designed for use with terminals that support a mouse. If you
756 don't have a mouse, you will have to operate Keypad mode with your
757 arrow keys (which is probably more trouble than it's worth).
758
759 Type @kbd{C-x * k} to turn Keypad mode on or off. Once again you
760 get two new windows, this time on the righthand side of the screen
761 instead of at the bottom. The upper window is the familiar Calc
762 Stack; the lower window is a picture of a typical calculator keypad.
763
764 @tex
765 \dimen0=\pagetotal%
766 \advance \dimen0 by 24\baselineskip%
767 \ifdim \dimen0>\pagegoal \vfill\eject \fi%
768 \medskip
769 @end tex
770 @smallexample
771 @group
772 |--- Emacs Calculator Mode ---
773 |2: 17.3
774 |1: -5
775 | .
776 |--%*-Calc: 12 Deg (Calcul
777 |----+----+--Calc---+----+----1
778 |FLR |CEIL|RND |TRNC|CLN2|FLT |
779 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
780 | LN |EXP | |ABS |IDIV|MOD |
781 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
782 |SIN |COS |TAN |SQRT|y^x |1/x |
783 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
784 | ENTER |+/- |EEX |UNDO| <- |
785 |-----+---+-+--+--+-+---++----|
786 | INV | 7 | 8 | 9 | / |
787 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
788 | HYP | 4 | 5 | 6 | * |
789 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
790 |EXEC | 1 | 2 | 3 | - |
791 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
792 | OFF | 0 | . | PI | + |
793 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+
794 @end group
795 @end smallexample
796
797 Keypad mode is much easier for beginners to learn, because there
798 is no need to memorize lots of obscure key sequences. But not all
799 commands in regular Calc are available on the Keypad. You can
800 always switch the cursor into the Calc stack window to use
801 standard Calc commands if you need. Serious Calc users, though,
802 often find they prefer the standard interface over Keypad mode.
803
804 To operate the Calculator, just click on the ``buttons'' of the
805 keypad using your left mouse button. To enter the two numbers
806 shown here you would click @w{@kbd{1 7 .@: 3 ENTER 5 +/- ENTER}}; to
807 add them together you would then click @kbd{+} (to get 12.3 on
808 the stack).
809
810 If you click the right mouse button, the top three rows of the
811 keypad change to show other sets of commands, such as advanced
812 math functions, vector operations, and operations on binary
813 numbers.
814
815 Because Keypad mode doesn't use the regular keyboard, Calc leaves
816 the cursor in your original editing buffer. You can type in
817 this buffer in the usual way while also clicking on the Calculator
818 keypad. One advantage of Keypad mode is that you don't need an
819 explicit command to switch between editing and calculating.
820
821 If you press @kbd{C-x * b} first, you get a full-screen Keypad mode
822 (@code{full-calc-keypad}) with three windows: The keypad in the lower
823 left, the stack in the lower right, and the trail on top.
824
825 @c [fix-ref Keypad Mode]
826 @xref{Keypad Mode}, for further information.
827
828 @node Standalone Operation, Embedded Mode Overview, Keypad Mode Overview, Using Calc
829 @subsection Standalone Operation
830
831 @noindent
832 @cindex Standalone Operation
833 If you are not in Emacs at the moment but you wish to use Calc,
834 you must start Emacs first. If all you want is to run Calc, you
835 can give the commands:
836
837 @example
838 emacs -f full-calc
839 @end example
840
841 @noindent
842 or
843
844 @example
845 emacs -f full-calc-keypad
846 @end example
847
848 @noindent
849 which run a full-screen Calculator (as if by @kbd{C-x * b C-x * c}) or
850 a full-screen X-based Calculator (as if by @kbd{C-x * b C-x * k}).
851 In standalone operation, quitting the Calculator (by pressing
852 @kbd{q} or clicking on the keypad @key{EXIT} button) quits Emacs
853 itself.
854
855 @node Embedded Mode Overview, Other C-x * Commands, Standalone Operation, Using Calc
856 @subsection Embedded Mode (Overview)
857
858 @noindent
859 @dfn{Embedded mode} is a way to use Calc directly from inside an
860 editing buffer. Suppose you have a formula written as part of a
861 document like this:
862
863 @smallexample
864 @group
865 The derivative of
866
867 ln(ln(x))
868
869 is
870 @end group
871 @end smallexample
872
873 @noindent
874 and you wish to have Calc compute and format the derivative for
875 you and store this derivative in the buffer automatically. To
876 do this with Embedded mode, first copy the formula down to where
877 you want the result to be, leaving a blank line before and after the
878 formula:
879
880 @smallexample
881 @group
882 The derivative of
883
884 ln(ln(x))
885
886 is
887
888 ln(ln(x))
889 @end group
890 @end smallexample
891
892 Now, move the cursor onto this new formula and press @kbd{C-x * e}.
893 Calc will read the formula (using the surrounding blank lines to tell
894 how much text to read), then push this formula (invisibly) onto the Calc
895 stack. The cursor will stay on the formula in the editing buffer, but
896 the line with the formula will now appear as it would on the Calc stack
897 (in this case, it will be left-aligned) and the buffer's mode line will
898 change to look like the Calc mode line (with mode indicators like
899 @samp{12 Deg} and so on). Even though you are still in your editing
900 buffer, the keyboard now acts like the Calc keyboard, and any new result
901 you get is copied from the stack back into the buffer. To take the
902 derivative, you would type @kbd{a d x @key{RET}}.
903
904 @smallexample
905 @group
906 The derivative of
907
908 ln(ln(x))
909
910 is
911
912 1 / ln(x) x
913 @end group
914 @end smallexample
915
916 (Note that by default, Calc gives division lower precedence than multiplication,
917 so that @samp{1 / ln(x) x} is equivalent to @samp{1 / (ln(x) x)}.)
918
919 To make this look nicer, you might want to press @kbd{d =} to center
920 the formula, and even @kbd{d B} to use Big display mode.
921
922 @smallexample
923 @group
924 The derivative of
925
926 ln(ln(x))
927
928 is
929 % [calc-mode: justify: center]
930 % [calc-mode: language: big]
931
932 1
933 -------
934 ln(x) x
935 @end group
936 @end smallexample
937
938 Calc has added annotations to the file to help it remember the modes
939 that were used for this formula. They are formatted like comments
940 in the @TeX{} typesetting language, just in case you are using @TeX{} or
941 La@TeX{}. (In this example @TeX{} is not being used, so you might want
942 to move these comments up to the top of the file or otherwise put them
943 out of the way.)
944
945 As an extra flourish, we can add an equation number using a
946 righthand label: Type @kbd{d @} (1) @key{RET}}.
947
948 @smallexample
949 @group
950 % [calc-mode: justify: center]
951 % [calc-mode: language: big]
952 % [calc-mode: right-label: " (1)"]
953
954 1
955 ------- (1)
956 ln(x) x
957 @end group
958 @end smallexample
959
960 To leave Embedded mode, type @kbd{C-x * e} again. The mode line
961 and keyboard will revert to the way they were before.
962
963 The related command @kbd{C-x * w} operates on a single word, which
964 generally means a single number, inside text. It searches for an
965 expression which ``looks'' like a number containing the point.
966 Here's an example of its use:
967
968 @smallexample
969 A slope of one-third corresponds to an angle of 1 degrees.
970 @end smallexample
971
972 Place the cursor on the @samp{1}, then type @kbd{C-x * w} to enable
973 Embedded mode on that number. Now type @kbd{3 /} (to get one-third),
974 and @kbd{I T} (the Inverse Tangent converts a slope into an angle),
975 then @w{@kbd{C-x * w}} again to exit Embedded mode.
976
977 @smallexample
978 A slope of one-third corresponds to an angle of 18.4349488229 degrees.
979 @end smallexample
980
981 @c [fix-ref Embedded Mode]
982 @xref{Embedded Mode}, for full details.
983
984 @node Other C-x * Commands, , Embedded Mode Overview, Using Calc
985 @subsection Other @kbd{C-x *} Commands
986
987 @noindent
988 Two more Calc-related commands are @kbd{C-x * g} and @kbd{C-x * r},
989 which ``grab'' data from a selected region of a buffer into the
990 Calculator. The region is defined in the usual Emacs way, by
991 a ``mark'' placed at one end of the region, and the Emacs
992 cursor or ``point'' placed at the other.
993
994 The @kbd{C-x * g} command reads the region in the usual left-to-right,
995 top-to-bottom order. The result is packaged into a Calc vector
996 of numbers and placed on the stack. Calc (in its standard
997 user interface) is then started. Type @kbd{v u} if you want
998 to unpack this vector into separate numbers on the stack. Also,
999 @kbd{C-u C-x * g} interprets the region as a single number or
1000 formula.
1001
1002 The @kbd{C-x * r} command reads a rectangle, with the point and
1003 mark defining opposite corners of the rectangle. The result
1004 is a matrix of numbers on the Calculator stack.
1005
1006 Complementary to these is @kbd{C-x * y}, which ``yanks'' the
1007 value at the top of the Calc stack back into an editing buffer.
1008 If you type @w{@kbd{C-x * y}} while in such a buffer, the value is
1009 yanked at the current position. If you type @kbd{C-x * y} while
1010 in the Calc buffer, Calc makes an educated guess as to which
1011 editing buffer you want to use. The Calc window does not have
1012 to be visible in order to use this command, as long as there
1013 is something on the Calc stack.
1014
1015 Here, for reference, is the complete list of @kbd{C-x *} commands.
1016 The shift, control, and meta keys are ignored for the keystroke
1017 following @kbd{C-x *}.
1018
1019 @noindent
1020 Commands for turning Calc on and off:
1021
1022 @table @kbd
1023 @item *
1024 Turn Calc on or off, employing the same user interface as last time.
1025
1026 @item =, +, -, /, \, &, #
1027 Alternatives for @kbd{*}.
1028
1029 @item C
1030 Turn Calc on or off using its standard bottom-of-the-screen
1031 interface. If Calc is already turned on but the cursor is not
1032 in the Calc window, move the cursor into the window.
1033
1034 @item O
1035 Same as @kbd{C}, but don't select the new Calc window. If
1036 Calc is already turned on and the cursor is in the Calc window,
1037 move it out of that window.
1038
1039 @item B
1040 Control whether @kbd{C-x * c} and @kbd{C-x * k} use the full screen.
1041
1042 @item Q
1043 Use Quick mode for a single short calculation.
1044
1045 @item K
1046 Turn Calc Keypad mode on or off.
1047
1048 @item E
1049 Turn Calc Embedded mode on or off at the current formula.
1050
1051 @item J
1052 Turn Calc Embedded mode on or off, select the interesting part.
1053
1054 @item W
1055 Turn Calc Embedded mode on or off at the current word (number).
1056
1057 @item Z
1058 Turn Calc on in a user-defined way, as defined by a @kbd{Z I} command.
1059
1060 @item X
1061 Quit Calc; turn off standard, Keypad, or Embedded mode if on.
1062 (This is like @kbd{q} or @key{OFF} inside of Calc.)
1063 @end table
1064 @iftex
1065 @sp 2
1066 @end iftex
1067
1068 @noindent
1069 Commands for moving data into and out of the Calculator:
1070
1071 @table @kbd
1072 @item G
1073 Grab the region into the Calculator as a vector.
1074
1075 @item R
1076 Grab the rectangular region into the Calculator as a matrix.
1077
1078 @item :
1079 Grab the rectangular region and compute the sums of its columns.
1080
1081 @item _
1082 Grab the rectangular region and compute the sums of its rows.
1083
1084 @item Y
1085 Yank a value from the Calculator into the current editing buffer.
1086 @end table
1087 @iftex
1088 @sp 2
1089 @end iftex
1090
1091 @noindent
1092 Commands for use with Embedded mode:
1093
1094 @table @kbd
1095 @item A
1096 ``Activate'' the current buffer. Locate all formulas that
1097 contain @samp{:=} or @samp{=>} symbols and record their locations
1098 so that they can be updated automatically as variables are changed.
1099
1100 @item D
1101 Duplicate the current formula immediately below and select
1102 the duplicate.
1103
1104 @item F
1105 Insert a new formula at the current point.
1106
1107 @item N
1108 Move the cursor to the next active formula in the buffer.
1109
1110 @item P
1111 Move the cursor to the previous active formula in the buffer.
1112
1113 @item U
1114 Update (i.e., as if by the @kbd{=} key) the formula at the current point.
1115
1116 @item `
1117 Edit (as if by @code{calc-edit}) the formula at the current point.
1118 @end table
1119 @iftex
1120 @sp 2
1121 @end iftex
1122
1123 @noindent
1124 Miscellaneous commands:
1125
1126 @table @kbd
1127 @item I
1128 Run the Emacs Info system to read the Calc manual.
1129 (This is the same as @kbd{h i} inside of Calc.)
1130
1131 @item T
1132 Run the Emacs Info system to read the Calc Tutorial.
1133
1134 @item S
1135 Run the Emacs Info system to read the Calc Summary.
1136
1137 @item L
1138 Load Calc entirely into memory. (Normally the various parts
1139 are loaded only as they are needed.)
1140
1141 @item M
1142 Read a region of written keystroke names (like @kbd{C-n a b c @key{RET}})
1143 and record them as the current keyboard macro.
1144
1145 @item 0
1146 (This is the ``zero'' digit key.) Reset the Calculator to
1147 its initial state: Empty stack, and initial mode settings.
1148 @end table
1149
1150 @node History and Acknowledgements, , Using Calc, Getting Started
1151 @section History and Acknowledgements
1152
1153 @noindent
1154 Calc was originally started as a two-week project to occupy a lull
1155 in the author's schedule. Basically, a friend asked if I remembered
1156 the value of
1157 @texline @math{2^{32}}.
1158 @infoline @expr{2^32}.
1159 I didn't offhand, but I said, ``that's easy, just call up an
1160 @code{xcalc}.'' @code{Xcalc} duly reported that the answer to our
1161 question was @samp{4.294967e+09}---with no way to see the full ten
1162 digits even though we knew they were there in the program's memory! I
1163 was so annoyed, I vowed to write a calculator of my own, once and for
1164 all.
1165
1166 I chose Emacs Lisp, a) because I had always been curious about it
1167 and b) because, being only a text editor extension language after
1168 all, Emacs Lisp would surely reach its limits long before the project
1169 got too far out of hand.
1170
1171 To make a long story short, Emacs Lisp turned out to be a distressingly
1172 solid implementation of Lisp, and the humble task of calculating
1173 turned out to be more open-ended than one might have expected.
1174
1175 Emacs Lisp didn't have built-in floating point math (now it does), so
1176 this had to be simulated in software. In fact, Emacs integers would
1177 only comfortably fit six decimal digits or so---not enough for a decent
1178 calculator. So I had to write my own high-precision integer code as
1179 well, and once I had this I figured that arbitrary-size integers were
1180 just as easy as large integers. Arbitrary floating-point precision was
1181 the logical next step. Also, since the large integer arithmetic was
1182 there anyway it seemed only fair to give the user direct access to it,
1183 which in turn made it practical to support fractions as well as floats.
1184 All these features inspired me to look around for other data types that
1185 might be worth having.
1186
1187 Around this time, my friend Rick Koshi showed me his nifty new HP-28
1188 calculator. It allowed the user to manipulate formulas as well as
1189 numerical quantities, and it could also operate on matrices. I
1190 decided that these would be good for Calc to have, too. And once
1191 things had gone this far, I figured I might as well take a look at
1192 serious algebra systems for further ideas. Since these systems did
1193 far more than I could ever hope to implement, I decided to focus on
1194 rewrite rules and other programming features so that users could
1195 implement what they needed for themselves.
1196
1197 Rick complained that matrices were hard to read, so I put in code to
1198 format them in a 2D style. Once these routines were in place, Big mode
1199 was obligatory. Gee, what other language modes would be useful?
1200
1201 Scott Hemphill and Allen Knutson, two friends with a strong mathematical
1202 bent, contributed ideas and algorithms for a number of Calc features
1203 including modulo forms, primality testing, and float-to-fraction conversion.
1204
1205 Units were added at the eager insistence of Mass Sivilotti. Later,
1206 Ulrich Mueller at CERN and Przemek Klosowski at NIST provided invaluable
1207 expert assistance with the units table. As far as I can remember, the
1208 idea of using algebraic formulas and variables to represent units dates
1209 back to an ancient article in Byte magazine about muMath, an early
1210 algebra system for microcomputers.
1211
1212 Many people have contributed to Calc by reporting bugs and suggesting
1213 features, large and small. A few deserve special mention: Tim Peters,
1214 who helped develop the ideas that led to the selection commands, rewrite
1215 rules, and many other algebra features;
1216 @texline Fran\c{c}ois
1217 @infoline Francois
1218 Pinard, who contributed an early prototype of the Calc Summary appendix
1219 as well as providing valuable suggestions in many other areas of Calc;
1220 Carl Witty, whose eagle eyes discovered many typographical and factual
1221 errors in the Calc manual; Tim Kay, who drove the development of
1222 Embedded mode; Ove Ewerlid, who made many suggestions relating to the
1223 algebra commands and contributed some code for polynomial operations;
1224 Randal Schwartz, who suggested the @code{calc-eval} function; Juha
1225 Sarlin, who first worked out how to split Calc into quickly-loading
1226 parts; Bob Weiner, who helped immensely with the Lucid Emacs port; and
1227 Robert J. Chassell, who suggested the Calc Tutorial and exercises as
1228 well as many other things.
1229
1230 @cindex Bibliography
1231 @cindex Knuth, Art of Computer Programming
1232 @cindex Numerical Recipes
1233 @c Should these be expanded into more complete references?
1234 Among the books used in the development of Calc were Knuth's @emph{Art
1235 of Computer Programming} (especially volume II, @emph{Seminumerical
1236 Algorithms}); @emph{Numerical Recipes} by Press, Flannery, Teukolsky,
1237 and Vetterling; Bevington's @emph{Data Reduction and Error Analysis
1238 for the Physical Sciences}; @emph{Concrete Mathematics} by Graham,
1239 Knuth, and Patashnik; Steele's @emph{Common Lisp, the Language}; the
1240 @emph{CRC Standard Math Tables} (William H. Beyer, ed.); and
1241 Abramowitz and Stegun's venerable @emph{Handbook of Mathematical
1242 Functions}. Also, of course, Calc could not have been written without
1243 the excellent @emph{GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}, by Bil Lewis and
1244 Dan LaLiberte.
1245
1246 Final thanks go to Richard Stallman, without whose fine implementations
1247 of the Emacs editor, language, and environment, Calc would have been
1248 finished in two weeks.
1249
1250 @c [tutorial]
1251
1252 @ifinfo
1253 @c This node is accessed by the `C-x * t' command.
1254 @node Interactive Tutorial, Tutorial, Getting Started, Top
1255 @chapter Tutorial
1256
1257 @noindent
1258 Some brief instructions on using the Emacs Info system for this tutorial:
1259
1260 Press the space bar and Delete keys to go forward and backward in a
1261 section by screenfuls (or use the regular Emacs scrolling commands
1262 for this).
1263
1264 Press @kbd{n} or @kbd{p} to go to the Next or Previous section.
1265 If the section has a @dfn{menu}, press a digit key like @kbd{1}
1266 or @kbd{2} to go to a sub-section from the menu. Press @kbd{u} to
1267 go back up from a sub-section to the menu it is part of.
1268
1269 Exercises in the tutorial all have cross-references to the
1270 appropriate page of the ``answers'' section. Press @kbd{f}, then
1271 the exercise number, to see the answer to an exercise. After
1272 you have followed a cross-reference, you can press the letter
1273 @kbd{l} to return to where you were before.
1274
1275 You can press @kbd{?} at any time for a brief summary of Info commands.
1276
1277 Press the number @kbd{1} now to enter the first section of the Tutorial.
1278
1279 @menu
1280 * Tutorial::
1281 @end menu
1282
1283 @node Tutorial, Introduction, Interactive Tutorial, Top
1284 @end ifinfo
1285 @ifnotinfo
1286 @node Tutorial, Introduction, Getting Started, Top
1287 @end ifnotinfo
1288 @chapter Tutorial
1289
1290 @noindent
1291 This chapter explains how to use Calc and its many features, in
1292 a step-by-step, tutorial way. You are encouraged to run Calc and
1293 work along with the examples as you read (@pxref{Starting Calc}).
1294 If you are already familiar with advanced calculators, you may wish
1295 @c [not-split]
1296 to skip on to the rest of this manual.
1297 @c [when-split]
1298 @c to skip on to volume II of this manual, the @dfn{Calc Reference}.
1299
1300 @c [fix-ref Embedded Mode]
1301 This tutorial describes the standard user interface of Calc only.
1302 The Quick mode and Keypad mode interfaces are fairly
1303 self-explanatory. @xref{Embedded Mode}, for a description of
1304 the Embedded mode interface.
1305
1306 The easiest way to read this tutorial on-line is to have two windows on
1307 your Emacs screen, one with Calc and one with the Info system. Press
1308 @kbd{C-x * t} to set this up; the on-line tutorial will be opened in the
1309 current window and Calc will be started in another window. From the
1310 Info window, the command @kbd{C-x * c} can be used to switch to the Calc
1311 window and @kbd{C-x * o} can be used to switch back to the Info window.
1312 (If you have a printed copy of the manual you can use that instead; in
1313 that case you only need to press @kbd{C-x * c} to start Calc.)
1314
1315 This tutorial is designed to be done in sequence. But the rest of this
1316 manual does not assume you have gone through the tutorial. The tutorial
1317 does not cover everything in the Calculator, but it touches on most
1318 general areas.
1319
1320 @ifnottex
1321 You may wish to print out a copy of the Calc Summary and keep notes on
1322 it as you learn Calc. @xref{About This Manual}, to see how to make a
1323 printed summary. @xref{Summary}.
1324 @end ifnottex
1325 @iftex
1326 The Calc Summary at the end of the reference manual includes some blank
1327 space for your own use. You may wish to keep notes there as you learn
1328 Calc.
1329 @end iftex
1330
1331 @menu
1332 * Basic Tutorial::
1333 * Arithmetic Tutorial::
1334 * Vector/Matrix Tutorial::
1335 * Types Tutorial::
1336 * Algebra Tutorial::
1337 * Programming Tutorial::
1338
1339 * Answers to Exercises::
1340 @end menu
1341
1342 @node Basic Tutorial, Arithmetic Tutorial, Tutorial, Tutorial
1343 @section Basic Tutorial
1344
1345 @noindent
1346 In this section, we learn how RPN and algebraic-style calculations
1347 work, how to undo and redo an operation done by mistake, and how
1348 to control various modes of the Calculator.
1349
1350 @menu
1351 * RPN Tutorial:: Basic operations with the stack.
1352 * Algebraic Tutorial:: Algebraic entry; variables.
1353 * Undo Tutorial:: If you make a mistake: Undo and the trail.
1354 * Modes Tutorial:: Common mode-setting commands.
1355 @end menu
1356
1357 @node RPN Tutorial, Algebraic Tutorial, Basic Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
1358 @subsection RPN Calculations and the Stack
1359
1360 @cindex RPN notation
1361 @ifnottex
1362 @noindent
1363 Calc normally uses RPN notation. You may be familiar with the RPN
1364 system from Hewlett-Packard calculators, FORTH, or PostScript.
1365 (Reverse Polish Notation, RPN, is named after the Polish mathematician
1366 Jan Lukasiewicz.)
1367 @end ifnottex
1368 @tex
1369 \noindent
1370 Calc normally uses RPN notation. You may be familiar with the RPN
1371 system from Hewlett-Packard calculators, FORTH, or PostScript.
1372 (Reverse Polish Notation, RPN, is named after the Polish mathematician
1373 Jan \L ukasiewicz.)
1374 @end tex
1375
1376 The central component of an RPN calculator is the @dfn{stack}. A
1377 calculator stack is like a stack of dishes. New dishes (numbers) are
1378 added at the top of the stack, and numbers are normally only removed
1379 from the top of the stack.
1380
1381 @cindex Operators
1382 @cindex Operands
1383 In an operation like @expr{2+3}, the 2 and 3 are called the @dfn{operands}
1384 and the @expr{+} is the @dfn{operator}. In an RPN calculator you always
1385 enter the operands first, then the operator. Each time you type a
1386 number, Calc adds or @dfn{pushes} it onto the top of the Stack.
1387 When you press an operator key like @kbd{+}, Calc @dfn{pops} the appropriate
1388 number of operands from the stack and pushes back the result.
1389
1390 Thus we could add the numbers 2 and 3 in an RPN calculator by typing:
1391 @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} +}. (The @key{RET} key, Return, corresponds to
1392 the @key{ENTER} key on traditional RPN calculators.) Try this now if
1393 you wish; type @kbd{C-x * c} to switch into the Calc window (you can type
1394 @kbd{C-x * c} again or @kbd{C-x * o} to switch back to the Tutorial window).
1395 The first four keystrokes ``push'' the numbers 2 and 3 onto the stack.
1396 The @kbd{+} key ``pops'' the top two numbers from the stack, adds them,
1397 and pushes the result (5) back onto the stack. Here's how the stack
1398 will look at various points throughout the calculation:
1399
1400 @smallexample
1401 @group
1402 . 1: 2 2: 2 1: 5 .
1403 . 1: 3 .
1404 .
1405
1406 C-x * c 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} + @key{DEL}
1407 @end group
1408 @end smallexample
1409
1410 The @samp{.} symbol is a marker that represents the top of the stack.
1411 Note that the ``top'' of the stack is really shown at the bottom of
1412 the Stack window. This may seem backwards, but it turns out to be
1413 less distracting in regular use.
1414
1415 @cindex Stack levels
1416 @cindex Levels of stack
1417 The numbers @samp{1:} and @samp{2:} on the left are @dfn{stack level
1418 numbers}. Old RPN calculators always had four stack levels called
1419 @expr{x}, @expr{y}, @expr{z}, and @expr{t}. Calc's stack can grow
1420 as large as you like, so it uses numbers instead of letters. Some
1421 stack-manipulation commands accept a numeric argument that says
1422 which stack level to work on. Normal commands like @kbd{+} always
1423 work on the top few levels of the stack.
1424
1425 @c [fix-ref Truncating the Stack]
1426 The Stack buffer is just an Emacs buffer, and you can move around in
1427 it using the regular Emacs motion commands. But no matter where the
1428 cursor is, even if you have scrolled the @samp{.} marker out of
1429 view, most Calc commands always move the cursor back down to level 1
1430 before doing anything. It is possible to move the @samp{.} marker
1431 upwards through the stack, temporarily ``hiding'' some numbers from
1432 commands like @kbd{+}. This is called @dfn{stack truncation} and
1433 we will not cover it in this tutorial; @pxref{Truncating the Stack},
1434 if you are interested.
1435
1436 You don't really need the second @key{RET} in @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3
1437 @key{RET} +}. That's because if you type any operator name or
1438 other non-numeric key when you are entering a number, the Calculator
1439 automatically enters that number and then does the requested command.
1440 Thus @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 +} will work just as well.
1441
1442 Examples in this tutorial will often omit @key{RET} even when the
1443 stack displays shown would only happen if you did press @key{RET}:
1444
1445 @smallexample
1446 @group
1447 1: 2 2: 2 1: 5
1448 . 1: 3 .
1449 .
1450
1451 2 @key{RET} 3 +
1452 @end group
1453 @end smallexample
1454
1455 @noindent
1456 Here, after pressing @kbd{3} the stack would really show @samp{1: 2}
1457 with @samp{Calc:@: 3} in the minibuffer. In these situations, you can
1458 press the optional @key{RET} to see the stack as the figure shows.
1459
1460 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} (This tutorial will include exercises
1461 at various points. Try them if you wish. Answers to all the exercises
1462 are located at the end of the Tutorial chapter. Each exercise will
1463 include a cross-reference to its particular answer. If you are
1464 reading with the Emacs Info system, press @kbd{f} and the
1465 exercise number to go to the answer, then the letter @kbd{l} to
1466 return to where you were.)
1467
1468 @noindent
1469 Here's the first exercise: What will the keystrokes @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2
1470 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 + * -} compute? (@samp{*} is the symbol for
1471 multiplication.) Figure it out by hand, then try it with Calc to see
1472 if you're right. @xref{RPN Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
1473
1474 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Compute
1475 @texline @math{(2\times4) + (7\times9.4) + {5\over4}}
1476 @infoline @expr{2*4 + 7*9.5 + 5/4}
1477 using the stack. @xref{RPN Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
1478
1479 The @key{DEL} key is called Backspace on some keyboards. It is
1480 whatever key you would use to correct a simple typing error when
1481 regularly using Emacs. The @key{DEL} key pops and throws away the
1482 top value on the stack. (You can still get that value back from
1483 the Trail if you should need it later on.) There are many places
1484 in this tutorial where we assume you have used @key{DEL} to erase the
1485 results of the previous example at the beginning of a new example.
1486 In the few places where it is really important to use @key{DEL} to
1487 clear away old results, the text will remind you to do so.
1488
1489 (It won't hurt to let things accumulate on the stack, except that
1490 whenever you give a display-mode-changing command Calc will have to
1491 spend a long time reformatting such a large stack.)
1492
1493 Since the @kbd{-} key is also an operator (it subtracts the top two
1494 stack elements), how does one enter a negative number? Calc uses
1495 the @kbd{_} (underscore) key to act like the minus sign in a number.
1496 So, typing @kbd{-5 @key{RET}} won't work because the @kbd{-} key
1497 will try to do a subtraction, but @kbd{_5 @key{RET}} works just fine.
1498
1499 You can also press @kbd{n}, which means ``change sign.'' It changes
1500 the number at the top of the stack (or the number being entered)
1501 from positive to negative or vice-versa: @kbd{5 n @key{RET}}.
1502
1503 @cindex Duplicating a stack entry
1504 If you press @key{RET} when you're not entering a number, the effect
1505 is to duplicate the top number on the stack. Consider this calculation:
1506
1507 @smallexample
1508 @group
1509 1: 3 2: 3 1: 9 2: 9 1: 81
1510 . 1: 3 . 1: 9 .
1511 . .
1512
1513 3 @key{RET} @key{RET} * @key{RET} *
1514 @end group
1515 @end smallexample
1516
1517 @noindent
1518 (Of course, an easier way to do this would be @kbd{3 @key{RET} 4 ^},
1519 to raise 3 to the fourth power.)
1520
1521 The space-bar key (denoted @key{SPC} here) performs the same function
1522 as @key{RET}; you could replace all three occurrences of @key{RET} in
1523 the above example with @key{SPC} and the effect would be the same.
1524
1525 @cindex Exchanging stack entries
1526 Another stack manipulation key is @key{TAB}. This exchanges the top
1527 two stack entries. Suppose you have computed @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 +}
1528 to get 5, and then you realize what you really wanted to compute
1529 was @expr{20 / (2+3)}.
1530
1531 @smallexample
1532 @group
1533 1: 5 2: 5 2: 20 1: 4
1534 . 1: 20 1: 5 .
1535 . .
1536
1537 2 @key{RET} 3 + 20 @key{TAB} /
1538 @end group
1539 @end smallexample
1540
1541 @noindent
1542 Planning ahead, the calculation would have gone like this:
1543
1544 @smallexample
1545 @group
1546 1: 20 2: 20 3: 20 2: 20 1: 4
1547 . 1: 2 2: 2 1: 5 .
1548 . 1: 3 .
1549 .
1550
1551 20 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 + /
1552 @end group
1553 @end smallexample
1554
1555 A related stack command is @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} (hold @key{META} and type
1556 @key{TAB}). It rotates the top three elements of the stack upward,
1557 bringing the object in level 3 to the top.
1558
1559 @smallexample
1560 @group
1561 1: 10 2: 10 3: 10 3: 20 3: 30
1562 . 1: 20 2: 20 2: 30 2: 10
1563 . 1: 30 1: 10 1: 20
1564 . . .
1565
1566 10 @key{RET} 20 @key{RET} 30 @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB}
1567 @end group
1568 @end smallexample
1569
1570 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Suppose the numbers 10, 20, and 30 are
1571 on the stack. Figure out how to add one to the number in level 2
1572 without affecting the rest of the stack. Also figure out how to add
1573 one to the number in level 3. @xref{RPN Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
1574
1575 Operations like @kbd{+}, @kbd{-}, @kbd{*}, @kbd{/}, and @kbd{^} pop two
1576 arguments from the stack and push a result. Operations like @kbd{n} and
1577 @kbd{Q} (square root) pop a single number and push the result. You can
1578 think of them as simply operating on the top element of the stack.
1579
1580 @smallexample
1581 @group
1582 1: 3 1: 9 2: 9 1: 25 1: 5
1583 . . 1: 16 . .
1584 .
1585
1586 3 @key{RET} @key{RET} * 4 @key{RET} @key{RET} * + Q
1587 @end group
1588 @end smallexample
1589
1590 @noindent
1591 (Note that capital @kbd{Q} means to hold down the Shift key while
1592 typing @kbd{q}. Remember, plain unshifted @kbd{q} is the Quit command.)
1593
1594 @cindex Pythagorean Theorem
1595 Here we've used the Pythagorean Theorem to determine the hypotenuse of a
1596 right triangle. Calc actually has a built-in command for that called
1597 @kbd{f h}, but let's suppose we can't remember the necessary keystrokes.
1598 We can still enter it by its full name using @kbd{M-x} notation:
1599
1600 @smallexample
1601 @group
1602 1: 3 2: 3 1: 5
1603 . 1: 4 .
1604 .
1605
1606 3 @key{RET} 4 @key{RET} M-x calc-hypot
1607 @end group
1608 @end smallexample
1609
1610 All Calculator commands begin with the word @samp{calc-}. Since it
1611 gets tiring to type this, Calc provides an @kbd{x} key which is just
1612 like the regular Emacs @kbd{M-x} key except that it types the @samp{calc-}
1613 prefix for you:
1614
1615 @smallexample
1616 @group
1617 1: 3 2: 3 1: 5
1618 . 1: 4 .
1619 .
1620
1621 3 @key{RET} 4 @key{RET} x hypot
1622 @end group
1623 @end smallexample
1624
1625 What happens if you take the square root of a negative number?
1626
1627 @smallexample
1628 @group
1629 1: 4 1: -4 1: (0, 2)
1630 . . .
1631
1632 4 @key{RET} n Q
1633 @end group
1634 @end smallexample
1635
1636 @noindent
1637 The notation @expr{(a, b)} represents a complex number.
1638 Complex numbers are more traditionally written @expr{a + b i};
1639 Calc can display in this format, too, but for now we'll stick to the
1640 @expr{(a, b)} notation.
1641
1642 If you don't know how complex numbers work, you can safely ignore this
1643 feature. Complex numbers only arise from operations that would be
1644 errors in a calculator that didn't have complex numbers. (For example,
1645 taking the square root or logarithm of a negative number produces a
1646 complex result.)
1647
1648 Complex numbers are entered in the notation shown. The @kbd{(} and
1649 @kbd{,} and @kbd{)} keys manipulate ``incomplete complex numbers.''
1650
1651 @smallexample
1652 @group
1653 1: ( ... 2: ( ... 1: (2, ... 1: (2, ... 1: (2, 3)
1654 . 1: 2 . 3 .
1655 . .
1656
1657 ( 2 , 3 )
1658 @end group
1659 @end smallexample
1660
1661 You can perform calculations while entering parts of incomplete objects.
1662 However, an incomplete object cannot actually participate in a calculation:
1663
1664 @smallexample
1665 @group
1666 1: ( ... 2: ( ... 3: ( ... 1: ( ... 1: ( ...
1667 . 1: 2 2: 2 5 5
1668 . 1: 3 . .
1669 .
1670 (error)
1671 ( 2 @key{RET} 3 + +
1672 @end group
1673 @end smallexample
1674
1675 @noindent
1676 Adding 5 to an incomplete object makes no sense, so the last command
1677 produces an error message and leaves the stack the same.
1678
1679 Incomplete objects can't participate in arithmetic, but they can be
1680 moved around by the regular stack commands.
1681
1682 @smallexample
1683 @group
1684 2: 2 3: 2 3: 3 1: ( ... 1: (2, 3)
1685 1: 3 2: 3 2: ( ... 2 .
1686 . 1: ( ... 1: 2 3
1687 . . .
1688
1689 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} ( M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} )
1690 @end group
1691 @end smallexample
1692
1693 @noindent
1694 Note that the @kbd{,} (comma) key did not have to be used here.
1695 When you press @kbd{)} all the stack entries between the incomplete
1696 entry and the top are collected, so there's never really a reason
1697 to use the comma. It's up to you.
1698
1699 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} To enter the complex number @expr{(2, 3)},
1700 your friend Joe typed @kbd{( 2 , @key{SPC} 3 )}. What happened?
1701 (Joe thought of a clever way to correct his mistake in only two
1702 keystrokes, but it didn't quite work. Try it to find out why.)
1703 @xref{RPN Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
1704
1705 Vectors are entered the same way as complex numbers, but with square
1706 brackets in place of parentheses. We'll meet vectors again later in
1707 the tutorial.
1708
1709 Any Emacs command can be given a @dfn{numeric prefix argument} by
1710 typing a series of @key{META}-digits beforehand. If @key{META} is
1711 awkward for you, you can instead type @kbd{C-u} followed by the
1712 necessary digits. Numeric prefix arguments can be negative, as in
1713 @kbd{M-- M-3 M-5} or @w{@kbd{C-u - 3 5}}. Calc commands use numeric
1714 prefix arguments in a variety of ways. For example, a numeric prefix
1715 on the @kbd{+} operator adds any number of stack entries at once:
1716
1717 @smallexample
1718 @group
1719 1: 10 2: 10 3: 10 3: 10 1: 60
1720 . 1: 20 2: 20 2: 20 .
1721 . 1: 30 1: 30
1722 . .
1723
1724 10 @key{RET} 20 @key{RET} 30 @key{RET} C-u 3 +
1725 @end group
1726 @end smallexample
1727
1728 For stack manipulation commands like @key{RET}, a positive numeric
1729 prefix argument operates on the top @var{n} stack entries at once. A
1730 negative argument operates on the entry in level @var{n} only. An
1731 argument of zero operates on the entire stack. In this example, we copy
1732 the second-to-top element of the stack:
1733
1734 @smallexample
1735 @group
1736 1: 10 2: 10 3: 10 3: 10 4: 10
1737 . 1: 20 2: 20 2: 20 3: 20
1738 . 1: 30 1: 30 2: 30
1739 . . 1: 20
1740 .
1741
1742 10 @key{RET} 20 @key{RET} 30 @key{RET} C-u -2 @key{RET}
1743 @end group
1744 @end smallexample
1745
1746 @cindex Clearing the stack
1747 @cindex Emptying the stack
1748 Another common idiom is @kbd{M-0 @key{DEL}}, which clears the stack.
1749 (The @kbd{M-0} numeric prefix tells @key{DEL} to operate on the
1750 entire stack.)
1751
1752 @node Algebraic Tutorial, Undo Tutorial, RPN Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
1753 @subsection Algebraic-Style Calculations
1754
1755 @noindent
1756 If you are not used to RPN notation, you may prefer to operate the
1757 Calculator in Algebraic mode, which is closer to the way
1758 non-RPN calculators work. In Algebraic mode, you enter formulas
1759 in traditional @expr{2+3} notation.
1760
1761 @strong{Notice:} Calc gives @samp{/} lower precedence than @samp{*}, so
1762 that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}; this is not
1763 standard across all computer languages. See below for details.
1764
1765 You don't really need any special ``mode'' to enter algebraic formulas.
1766 You can enter a formula at any time by pressing the apostrophe (@kbd{'})
1767 key. Answer the prompt with the desired formula, then press @key{RET}.
1768 The formula is evaluated and the result is pushed onto the RPN stack.
1769 If you don't want to think in RPN at all, you can enter your whole
1770 computation as a formula, read the result from the stack, then press
1771 @key{DEL} to delete it from the stack.
1772
1773 Try pressing the apostrophe key, then @kbd{2+3+4}, then @key{RET}.
1774 The result should be the number 9.
1775
1776 Algebraic formulas use the operators @samp{+}, @samp{-}, @samp{*},
1777 @samp{/}, and @samp{^}. You can use parentheses to make the order
1778 of evaluation clear. In the absence of parentheses, @samp{^} is
1779 evaluated first, then @samp{*}, then @samp{/}, then finally
1780 @samp{+} and @samp{-}. For example, the expression
1781
1782 @example
1783 2 + 3*4*5 / 6*7^8 - 9
1784 @end example
1785
1786 @noindent
1787 is equivalent to
1788
1789 @example
1790 2 + ((3*4*5) / (6*(7^8)) - 9
1791 @end example
1792
1793 @noindent
1794 or, in large mathematical notation,
1795
1796 @ifnottex
1797 @example
1798 @group
1799 3 * 4 * 5
1800 2 + --------- - 9
1801 8
1802 6 * 7
1803 @end group
1804 @end example
1805 @end ifnottex
1806 @tex
1807 \turnoffactive
1808 \beforedisplay
1809 $$ 2 + { 3 \times 4 \times 5 \over 6 \times 7^8 } - 9 $$
1810 \afterdisplay
1811 @end tex
1812
1813 @noindent
1814 The result of this expression will be the number @mathit{-6.99999826533}.
1815
1816 Calc's order of evaluation is the same as for most computer languages,
1817 except that @samp{*} binds more strongly than @samp{/}, as the above
1818 example shows. As in normal mathematical notation, the @samp{*} symbol
1819 can often be omitted: @samp{2 a} is the same as @samp{2*a}.
1820
1821 Operators at the same level are evaluated from left to right, except
1822 that @samp{^} is evaluated from right to left. Thus, @samp{2-3-4} is
1823 equivalent to @samp{(2-3)-4} or @mathit{-5}, whereas @samp{2^3^4} is equivalent
1824 to @samp{2^(3^4)} (a very large integer; try it!).
1825
1826 If you tire of typing the apostrophe all the time, there is
1827 Algebraic mode, where Calc automatically senses
1828 when you are about to type an algebraic expression. To enter this
1829 mode, press the two letters @w{@kbd{m a}}. (An @samp{Alg} indicator
1830 should appear in the Calc window's mode line.)
1831
1832 Press @kbd{m a}, then @kbd{2+3+4} with no apostrophe, then @key{RET}.
1833
1834 In Algebraic mode, when you press any key that would normally begin
1835 entering a number (such as a digit, a decimal point, or the @kbd{_}
1836 key), or if you press @kbd{(} or @kbd{[}, Calc automatically begins
1837 an algebraic entry.
1838
1839 Functions which do not have operator symbols like @samp{+} and @samp{*}
1840 must be entered in formulas using function-call notation. For example,
1841 the function name corresponding to the square-root key @kbd{Q} is
1842 @code{sqrt}. To compute a square root in a formula, you would use
1843 the notation @samp{sqrt(@var{x})}.
1844
1845 Press the apostrophe, then type @kbd{sqrt(5*2) - 3}. The result should
1846 be @expr{0.16227766017}.
1847
1848 Note that if the formula begins with a function name, you need to use
1849 the apostrophe even if you are in Algebraic mode. If you type @kbd{arcsin}
1850 out of the blue, the @kbd{a r} will be taken as an Algebraic Rewrite
1851 command, and the @kbd{csin} will be taken as the name of the rewrite
1852 rule to use!
1853
1854 Some people prefer to enter complex numbers and vectors in algebraic
1855 form because they find RPN entry with incomplete objects to be too
1856 distracting, even though they otherwise use Calc as an RPN calculator.
1857
1858 Still in Algebraic mode, type:
1859
1860 @smallexample
1861 @group
1862 1: (2, 3) 2: (2, 3) 1: (8, -1) 2: (8, -1) 1: (9, -1)
1863 . 1: (1, -2) . 1: 1 .
1864 . .
1865
1866 (2,3) @key{RET} (1,-2) @key{RET} * 1 @key{RET} +
1867 @end group
1868 @end smallexample
1869
1870 Algebraic mode allows us to enter complex numbers without pressing
1871 an apostrophe first, but it also means we need to press @key{RET}
1872 after every entry, even for a simple number like @expr{1}.
1873
1874 (You can type @kbd{C-u m a} to enable a special Incomplete Algebraic
1875 mode in which the @kbd{(} and @kbd{[} keys use algebraic entry even
1876 though regular numeric keys still use RPN numeric entry. There is also
1877 Total Algebraic mode, started by typing @kbd{m t}, in which all
1878 normal keys begin algebraic entry. You must then use the @key{META} key
1879 to type Calc commands: @kbd{M-m t} to get back out of Total Algebraic
1880 mode, @kbd{M-q} to quit, etc.)
1881
1882 If you're still in Algebraic mode, press @kbd{m a} again to turn it off.
1883
1884 Actual non-RPN calculators use a mixture of algebraic and RPN styles.
1885 In general, operators of two numbers (like @kbd{+} and @kbd{*})
1886 use algebraic form, but operators of one number (like @kbd{n} and @kbd{Q})
1887 use RPN form. Also, a non-RPN calculator allows you to see the
1888 intermediate results of a calculation as you go along. You can
1889 accomplish this in Calc by performing your calculation as a series
1890 of algebraic entries, using the @kbd{$} sign to tie them together.
1891 In an algebraic formula, @kbd{$} represents the number on the top
1892 of the stack. Here, we perform the calculation
1893 @texline @math{\sqrt{2\times4+1}},
1894 @infoline @expr{sqrt(2*4+1)},
1895 which on a traditional calculator would be done by pressing
1896 @kbd{2 * 4 + 1 =} and then the square-root key.
1897
1898 @smallexample
1899 @group
1900 1: 8 1: 9 1: 3
1901 . . .
1902
1903 ' 2*4 @key{RET} $+1 @key{RET} Q
1904 @end group
1905 @end smallexample
1906
1907 @noindent
1908 Notice that we didn't need to press an apostrophe for the @kbd{$+1},
1909 because the dollar sign always begins an algebraic entry.
1910
1911 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} How could you get the same effect as
1912 pressing @kbd{Q} but using an algebraic entry instead? How about
1913 if the @kbd{Q} key on your keyboard were broken?
1914 @xref{Algebraic Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
1915
1916 The notations @kbd{$$}, @kbd{$$$}, and so on stand for higher stack
1917 entries. For example, @kbd{' $$+$ @key{RET}} is just like typing @kbd{+}.
1918
1919 Algebraic formulas can include @dfn{variables}. To store in a
1920 variable, press @kbd{s s}, then type the variable name, then press
1921 @key{RET}. (There are actually two flavors of store command:
1922 @kbd{s s} stores a number in a variable but also leaves the number
1923 on the stack, while @w{@kbd{s t}} removes a number from the stack and
1924 stores it in the variable.) A variable name should consist of one
1925 or more letters or digits, beginning with a letter.
1926
1927 @smallexample
1928 @group
1929 1: 17 . 1: a + a^2 1: 306
1930 . . .
1931
1932 17 s t a @key{RET} ' a+a^2 @key{RET} =
1933 @end group
1934 @end smallexample
1935
1936 @noindent
1937 The @kbd{=} key @dfn{evaluates} a formula by replacing all its
1938 variables by the values that were stored in them.
1939
1940 For RPN calculations, you can recall a variable's value on the
1941 stack either by entering its name as a formula and pressing @kbd{=},
1942 or by using the @kbd{s r} command.
1943
1944 @smallexample
1945 @group
1946 1: 17 2: 17 3: 17 2: 17 1: 306
1947 . 1: 17 2: 17 1: 289 .
1948 . 1: 2 .
1949 .
1950
1951 s r a @key{RET} ' a @key{RET} = 2 ^ +
1952 @end group
1953 @end smallexample
1954
1955 If you press a single digit for a variable name (as in @kbd{s t 3}, you
1956 get one of ten @dfn{quick variables} @code{q0} through @code{q9}.
1957 They are ``quick'' simply because you don't have to type the letter
1958 @code{q} or the @key{RET} after their names. In fact, you can type
1959 simply @kbd{s 3} as a shorthand for @kbd{s s 3}, and likewise for
1960 @kbd{t 3} and @w{@kbd{r 3}}.
1961
1962 Any variables in an algebraic formula for which you have not stored
1963 values are left alone, even when you evaluate the formula.
1964
1965 @smallexample
1966 @group
1967 1: 2 a + 2 b 1: 34 + 2 b
1968 . .
1969
1970 ' 2a+2b @key{RET} =
1971 @end group
1972 @end smallexample
1973
1974 Calls to function names which are undefined in Calc are also left
1975 alone, as are calls for which the value is undefined.
1976
1977 @smallexample
1978 @group
1979 1: 2 + log10(0) + log10(x) + log10(5, 6) + foo(3)
1980 .
1981
1982 ' log10(100) + log10(0) + log10(x) + log10(5,6) + foo(3) @key{RET}
1983 @end group
1984 @end smallexample
1985
1986 @noindent
1987 In this example, the first call to @code{log10} works, but the other
1988 calls are not evaluated. In the second call, the logarithm is
1989 undefined for that value of the argument; in the third, the argument
1990 is symbolic, and in the fourth, there are too many arguments. In the
1991 fifth case, there is no function called @code{foo}. You will see a
1992 ``Wrong number of arguments'' message referring to @samp{log10(5,6)}.
1993 Press the @kbd{w} (``why'') key to see any other messages that may
1994 have arisen from the last calculation. In this case you will get
1995 ``logarithm of zero,'' then ``number expected: @code{x}''. Calc
1996 automatically displays the first message only if the message is
1997 sufficiently important; for example, Calc considers ``wrong number
1998 of arguments'' and ``logarithm of zero'' to be important enough to
1999 report automatically, while a message like ``number expected: @code{x}''
2000 will only show up if you explicitly press the @kbd{w} key.
2001
2002 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Joe entered the formula @samp{2 x y},
2003 stored 5 in @code{x}, pressed @kbd{=}, and got the expected result,
2004 @samp{10 y}. He then tried the same for the formula @samp{2 x (1+y)},
2005 expecting @samp{10 (1+y)}, but it didn't work. Why not?
2006 @xref{Algebraic Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
2007
2008 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} What result would you expect
2009 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 0 /} to give? What if you then type @kbd{0 *}?
2010 @xref{Algebraic Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
2011
2012 One interesting way to work with variables is to use the
2013 @dfn{evaluates-to} (@samp{=>}) operator. It works like this:
2014 Enter a formula algebraically in the usual way, but follow
2015 the formula with an @samp{=>} symbol. (There is also an @kbd{s =}
2016 command which builds an @samp{=>} formula using the stack.) On
2017 the stack, you will see two copies of the formula with an @samp{=>}
2018 between them. The lefthand formula is exactly like you typed it;
2019 the righthand formula has been evaluated as if by typing @kbd{=}.
2020
2021 @smallexample
2022 @group
2023 2: 2 + 3 => 5 2: 2 + 3 => 5
2024 1: 2 a + 2 b => 34 + 2 b 1: 2 a + 2 b => 20 + 2 b
2025 . .
2026
2027 ' 2+3 => @key{RET} ' 2a+2b @key{RET} s = 10 s t a @key{RET}
2028 @end group
2029 @end smallexample
2030
2031 @noindent
2032 Notice that the instant we stored a new value in @code{a}, all
2033 @samp{=>} operators already on the stack that referred to @expr{a}
2034 were updated to use the new value. With @samp{=>}, you can push a
2035 set of formulas on the stack, then change the variables experimentally
2036 to see the effects on the formulas' values.
2037
2038 You can also ``unstore'' a variable when you are through with it:
2039
2040 @smallexample
2041 @group
2042 2: 2 + 5 => 5
2043 1: 2 a + 2 b => 2 a + 2 b
2044 .
2045
2046 s u a @key{RET}
2047 @end group
2048 @end smallexample
2049
2050 We will encounter formulas involving variables and functions again
2051 when we discuss the algebra and calculus features of the Calculator.
2052
2053 @node Undo Tutorial, Modes Tutorial, Algebraic Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
2054 @subsection Undo and Redo
2055
2056 @noindent
2057 If you make a mistake, you can usually correct it by pressing shift-@kbd{U},
2058 the ``undo'' command. First, clear the stack (@kbd{M-0 @key{DEL}}) and exit
2059 and restart Calc (@kbd{C-x * * C-x * *}) to make sure things start off
2060 with a clean slate. Now:
2061
2062 @smallexample
2063 @group
2064 1: 2 2: 2 1: 8 2: 2 1: 6
2065 . 1: 3 . 1: 3 .
2066 . .
2067
2068 2 @key{RET} 3 ^ U *
2069 @end group
2070 @end smallexample
2071
2072 You can undo any number of times. Calc keeps a complete record of
2073 all you have done since you last opened the Calc window. After the
2074 above example, you could type:
2075
2076 @smallexample
2077 @group
2078 1: 6 2: 2 1: 2 . .
2079 . 1: 3 .
2080 .
2081 (error)
2082 U U U U
2083 @end group
2084 @end smallexample
2085
2086 You can also type @kbd{D} to ``redo'' a command that you have undone
2087 mistakenly.
2088
2089 @smallexample
2090 @group
2091 . 1: 2 2: 2 1: 6 1: 6
2092 . 1: 3 . .
2093 .
2094 (error)
2095 D D D D
2096 @end group
2097 @end smallexample
2098
2099 @noindent
2100 It was not possible to redo past the @expr{6}, since that was placed there
2101 by something other than an undo command.
2102
2103 @cindex Time travel
2104 You can think of undo and redo as a sort of ``time machine.'' Press
2105 @kbd{U} to go backward in time, @kbd{D} to go forward. If you go
2106 backward and do something (like @kbd{*}) then, as any science fiction
2107 reader knows, you have changed your future and you cannot go forward
2108 again. Thus, the inability to redo past the @expr{6} even though there
2109 was an earlier undo command.
2110
2111 You can always recall an earlier result using the Trail. We've ignored
2112 the trail so far, but it has been faithfully recording everything we
2113 did since we loaded the Calculator. If the Trail is not displayed,
2114 press @kbd{t d} now to turn it on.
2115
2116 Let's try grabbing an earlier result. The @expr{8} we computed was
2117 undone by a @kbd{U} command, and was lost even to Redo when we pressed
2118 @kbd{*}, but it's still there in the trail. There should be a little
2119 @samp{>} arrow (the @dfn{trail pointer}) resting on the last trail
2120 entry. If there isn't, press @kbd{t ]} to reset the trail pointer.
2121 Now, press @w{@kbd{t p}} to move the arrow onto the line containing
2122 @expr{8}, and press @w{@kbd{t y}} to ``yank'' that number back onto the
2123 stack.
2124
2125 If you press @kbd{t ]} again, you will see that even our Yank command
2126 went into the trail.
2127
2128 Let's go further back in time. Earlier in the tutorial we computed
2129 a huge integer using the formula @samp{2^3^4}. We don't remember
2130 what it was, but the first digits were ``241''. Press @kbd{t r}
2131 (which stands for trail-search-reverse), then type @kbd{241}.
2132 The trail cursor will jump back to the next previous occurrence of
2133 the string ``241'' in the trail. This is just a regular Emacs
2134 incremental search; you can now press @kbd{C-s} or @kbd{C-r} to
2135 continue the search forwards or backwards as you like.
2136
2137 To finish the search, press @key{RET}. This halts the incremental
2138 search and leaves the trail pointer at the thing we found. Now we
2139 can type @kbd{t y} to yank that number onto the stack. If we hadn't
2140 remembered the ``241'', we could simply have searched for @kbd{2^3^4},
2141 then pressed @kbd{@key{RET} t n} to halt and then move to the next item.
2142
2143 You may have noticed that all the trail-related commands begin with
2144 the letter @kbd{t}. (The store-and-recall commands, on the other hand,
2145 all began with @kbd{s}.) Calc has so many commands that there aren't
2146 enough keys for all of them, so various commands are grouped into
2147 two-letter sequences where the first letter is called the @dfn{prefix}
2148 key. If you type a prefix key by accident, you can press @kbd{C-g}
2149 to cancel it. (In fact, you can press @kbd{C-g} to cancel almost
2150 anything in Emacs.) To get help on a prefix key, press that key
2151 followed by @kbd{?}. Some prefixes have several lines of help,
2152 so you need to press @kbd{?} repeatedly to see them all.
2153 You can also type @kbd{h h} to see all the help at once.
2154
2155 Try pressing @kbd{t ?} now. You will see a line of the form,
2156
2157 @smallexample
2158 trail/time: Display; Fwd, Back; Next, Prev, Here, [, ]; Yank: [MORE] t-
2159 @end smallexample
2160
2161 @noindent
2162 The word ``trail'' indicates that the @kbd{t} prefix key contains
2163 trail-related commands. Each entry on the line shows one command,
2164 with a single capital letter showing which letter you press to get
2165 that command. We have used @kbd{t n}, @kbd{t p}, @kbd{t ]}, and
2166 @kbd{t y} so far. The @samp{[MORE]} means you can press @kbd{?}
2167 again to see more @kbd{t}-prefix commands. Notice that the commands
2168 are roughly divided (by semicolons) into related groups.
2169
2170 When you are in the help display for a prefix key, the prefix is
2171 still active. If you press another key, like @kbd{y} for example,
2172 it will be interpreted as a @kbd{t y} command. If all you wanted
2173 was to look at the help messages, press @kbd{C-g} afterwards to cancel
2174 the prefix.
2175
2176 One more way to correct an error is by editing the stack entries.
2177 The actual Stack buffer is marked read-only and must not be edited
2178 directly, but you can press @kbd{`} (the backquote or accent grave)
2179 to edit a stack entry.
2180
2181 Try entering @samp{3.141439} now. If this is supposed to represent
2182 @cpi{}, it's got several errors. Press @kbd{`} to edit this number.
2183 Now use the normal Emacs cursor motion and editing keys to change
2184 the second 4 to a 5, and to transpose the 3 and the 9. When you
2185 press @key{RET}, the number on the stack will be replaced by your
2186 new number. This works for formulas, vectors, and all other types
2187 of values you can put on the stack. The @kbd{`} key also works
2188 during entry of a number or algebraic formula.
2189
2190 @node Modes Tutorial, , Undo Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
2191 @subsection Mode-Setting Commands
2192
2193 @noindent
2194 Calc has many types of @dfn{modes} that affect the way it interprets
2195 your commands or the way it displays data. We have already seen one
2196 mode, namely Algebraic mode. There are many others, too; we'll
2197 try some of the most common ones here.
2198
2199 Perhaps the most fundamental mode in Calc is the current @dfn{precision}.
2200 Notice the @samp{12} on the Calc window's mode line:
2201
2202 @smallexample
2203 --%*-Calc: 12 Deg (Calculator)----All------
2204 @end smallexample
2205
2206 @noindent
2207 Most of the symbols there are Emacs things you don't need to worry
2208 about, but the @samp{12} and the @samp{Deg} are mode indicators.
2209 The @samp{12} means that calculations should always be carried to
2210 12 significant figures. That is why, when we type @kbd{1 @key{RET} 7 /},
2211 we get @expr{0.142857142857} with exactly 12 digits, not counting
2212 leading and trailing zeros.
2213
2214 You can set the precision to anything you like by pressing @kbd{p},
2215 then entering a suitable number. Try pressing @kbd{p 30 @key{RET}},
2216 then doing @kbd{1 @key{RET} 7 /} again:
2217
2218 @smallexample
2219 @group
2220 1: 0.142857142857
2221 2: 0.142857142857142857142857142857
2222 .
2223 @end group
2224 @end smallexample
2225
2226 Although the precision can be set arbitrarily high, Calc always
2227 has to have @emph{some} value for the current precision. After
2228 all, the true value @expr{1/7} is an infinitely repeating decimal;
2229 Calc has to stop somewhere.
2230
2231 Of course, calculations are slower the more digits you request.
2232 Press @w{@kbd{p 12}} now to set the precision back down to the default.
2233
2234 Calculations always use the current precision. For example, even
2235 though we have a 30-digit value for @expr{1/7} on the stack, if
2236 we use it in a calculation in 12-digit mode it will be rounded
2237 down to 12 digits before it is used. Try it; press @key{RET} to
2238 duplicate the number, then @w{@kbd{1 +}}. Notice that the @key{RET}
2239 key didn't round the number, because it doesn't do any calculation.
2240 But the instant we pressed @kbd{+}, the number was rounded down.
2241
2242 @smallexample
2243 @group
2244 1: 0.142857142857
2245 2: 0.142857142857142857142857142857
2246 3: 1.14285714286
2247 .
2248 @end group
2249 @end smallexample
2250
2251 @noindent
2252 In fact, since we added a digit on the left, we had to lose one
2253 digit on the right from even the 12-digit value of @expr{1/7}.
2254
2255 How did we get more than 12 digits when we computed @samp{2^3^4}? The
2256 answer is that Calc makes a distinction between @dfn{integers} and
2257 @dfn{floating-point} numbers, or @dfn{floats}. An integer is a number
2258 that does not contain a decimal point. There is no such thing as an
2259 ``infinitely repeating fraction integer,'' so Calc doesn't have to limit
2260 itself. If you asked for @samp{2^10000} (don't try this!), you would
2261 have to wait a long time but you would eventually get an exact answer.
2262 If you ask for @samp{2.^10000}, you will quickly get an answer which is
2263 correct only to 12 places. The decimal point tells Calc that it should
2264 use floating-point arithmetic to get the answer, not exact integer
2265 arithmetic.
2266
2267 You can use the @kbd{F} (@code{calc-floor}) command to convert a
2268 floating-point value to an integer, and @kbd{c f} (@code{calc-float})
2269 to convert an integer to floating-point form.
2270
2271 Let's try entering that last calculation:
2272
2273 @smallexample
2274 @group
2275 1: 2. 2: 2. 1: 1.99506311689e3010
2276 . 1: 10000 .
2277 .
2278
2279 2.0 @key{RET} 10000 @key{RET} ^
2280 @end group
2281 @end smallexample
2282
2283 @noindent
2284 @cindex Scientific notation, entry of
2285 Notice the letter @samp{e} in there. It represents ``times ten to the
2286 power of,'' and is used by Calc automatically whenever writing the
2287 number out fully would introduce more extra zeros than you probably
2288 want to see. You can enter numbers in this notation, too.
2289
2290 @smallexample
2291 @group
2292 1: 2. 2: 2. 1: 1.99506311678e3010
2293 . 1: 10000. .
2294 .
2295
2296 2.0 @key{RET} 1e4 @key{RET} ^
2297 @end group
2298 @end smallexample
2299
2300 @cindex Round-off errors
2301 @noindent
2302 Hey, the answer is different! Look closely at the middle columns
2303 of the two examples. In the first, the stack contained the
2304 exact integer @expr{10000}, but in the second it contained
2305 a floating-point value with a decimal point. When you raise a
2306 number to an integer power, Calc uses repeated squaring and
2307 multiplication to get the answer. When you use a floating-point
2308 power, Calc uses logarithms and exponentials. As you can see,
2309 a slight error crept in during one of these methods. Which
2310 one should we trust? Let's raise the precision a bit and find
2311 out:
2312
2313 @smallexample
2314 @group
2315 . 1: 2. 2: 2. 1: 1.995063116880828e3010
2316 . 1: 10000. .
2317 .
2318
2319 p 16 @key{RET} 2. @key{RET} 1e4 ^ p 12 @key{RET}
2320 @end group
2321 @end smallexample
2322
2323 @noindent
2324 @cindex Guard digits
2325 Presumably, it doesn't matter whether we do this higher-precision
2326 calculation using an integer or floating-point power, since we
2327 have added enough ``guard digits'' to trust the first 12 digits
2328 no matter what. And the verdict is@dots{} Integer powers were more
2329 accurate; in fact, the result was only off by one unit in the
2330 last place.
2331
2332 @cindex Guard digits
2333 Calc does many of its internal calculations to a slightly higher
2334 precision, but it doesn't always bump the precision up enough.
2335 In each case, Calc added about two digits of precision during
2336 its calculation and then rounded back down to 12 digits
2337 afterward. In one case, it was enough; in the other, it
2338 wasn't. If you really need @var{x} digits of precision, it
2339 never hurts to do the calculation with a few extra guard digits.
2340
2341 What if we want guard digits but don't want to look at them?
2342 We can set the @dfn{float format}. Calc supports four major
2343 formats for floating-point numbers, called @dfn{normal},
2344 @dfn{fixed-point}, @dfn{scientific notation}, and @dfn{engineering
2345 notation}. You get them by pressing @w{@kbd{d n}}, @kbd{d f},
2346 @kbd{d s}, and @kbd{d e}, respectively. In each case, you can
2347 supply a numeric prefix argument which says how many digits
2348 should be displayed. As an example, let's put a few numbers
2349 onto the stack and try some different display modes. First,
2350 use @kbd{M-0 @key{DEL}} to clear the stack, then enter the four
2351 numbers shown here:
2352
2353 @smallexample
2354 @group
2355 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345
2356 3: 12345. 3: 12300. 3: 1.2345e4 3: 1.23e4 3: 12345.000
2357 2: 123.45 2: 123. 2: 1.2345e2 2: 1.23e2 2: 123.450
2358 1: 12.345 1: 12.3 1: 1.2345e1 1: 1.23e1 1: 12.345
2359 . . . . .
2360
2361 d n M-3 d n d s M-3 d s M-3 d f
2362 @end group
2363 @end smallexample
2364
2365 @noindent
2366 Notice that when we typed @kbd{M-3 d n}, the numbers were rounded down
2367 to three significant digits, but then when we typed @kbd{d s} all
2368 five significant figures reappeared. The float format does not
2369 affect how numbers are stored, it only affects how they are
2370 displayed. Only the current precision governs the actual rounding
2371 of numbers in the Calculator's memory.
2372
2373 Engineering notation, not shown here, is like scientific notation
2374 except the exponent (the power-of-ten part) is always adjusted to be
2375 a multiple of three (as in ``kilo,'' ``micro,'' etc.). As a result
2376 there will be one, two, or three digits before the decimal point.
2377
2378 Whenever you change a display-related mode, Calc redraws everything
2379 in the stack. This may be slow if there are many things on the stack,
2380 so Calc allows you to type shift-@kbd{H} before any mode command to
2381 prevent it from updating the stack. Anything Calc displays after the
2382 mode-changing command will appear in the new format.
2383
2384 @smallexample
2385 @group
2386 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345
2387 3: 12345.000 3: 12345.000 3: 12345.000 3: 1.2345e4 3: 12345.
2388 2: 123.450 2: 123.450 2: 1.2345e1 2: 1.2345e1 2: 123.45
2389 1: 12.345 1: 1.2345e1 1: 1.2345e2 1: 1.2345e2 1: 12.345
2390 . . . . .
2391
2392 H d s @key{DEL} U @key{TAB} d @key{SPC} d n
2393 @end group
2394 @end smallexample
2395
2396 @noindent
2397 Here the @kbd{H d s} command changes to scientific notation but without
2398 updating the screen. Deleting the top stack entry and undoing it back
2399 causes it to show up in the new format; swapping the top two stack
2400 entries reformats both entries. The @kbd{d @key{SPC}} command refreshes the
2401 whole stack. The @kbd{d n} command changes back to the normal float
2402 format; since it doesn't have an @kbd{H} prefix, it also updates all
2403 the stack entries to be in @kbd{d n} format.
2404
2405 Notice that the integer @expr{12345} was not affected by any
2406 of the float formats. Integers are integers, and are always
2407 displayed exactly.
2408
2409 @cindex Large numbers, readability
2410 Large integers have their own problems. Let's look back at
2411 the result of @kbd{2^3^4}.
2412
2413 @example
2414 2417851639229258349412352
2415 @end example
2416
2417 @noindent
2418 Quick---how many digits does this have? Try typing @kbd{d g}:
2419
2420 @example
2421 2,417,851,639,229,258,349,412,352
2422 @end example
2423
2424 @noindent
2425 Now how many digits does this have? It's much easier to tell!
2426 We can actually group digits into clumps of any size. Some
2427 people prefer @kbd{M-5 d g}:
2428
2429 @example
2430 24178,51639,22925,83494,12352
2431 @end example
2432
2433 Let's see what happens to floating-point numbers when they are grouped.
2434 First, type @kbd{p 25 @key{RET}} to make sure we have enough precision
2435 to get ourselves into trouble. Now, type @kbd{1e13 /}:
2436
2437 @example
2438 24,17851,63922.9258349412352
2439 @end example
2440
2441 @noindent
2442 The integer part is grouped but the fractional part isn't. Now try
2443 @kbd{M-- M-5 d g} (that's meta-minus-sign, meta-five):
2444
2445 @example
2446 24,17851,63922.92583,49412,352
2447 @end example
2448
2449 If you find it hard to tell the decimal point from the commas, try
2450 changing the grouping character to a space with @kbd{d , @key{SPC}}:
2451
2452 @example
2453 24 17851 63922.92583 49412 352
2454 @end example
2455
2456 Type @kbd{d , ,} to restore the normal grouping character, then
2457 @kbd{d g} again to turn grouping off. Also, press @kbd{p 12} to
2458 restore the default precision.
2459
2460 Press @kbd{U} enough times to get the original big integer back.
2461 (Notice that @kbd{U} does not undo each mode-setting command; if
2462 you want to undo a mode-setting command, you have to do it yourself.)
2463 Now, type @kbd{d r 16 @key{RET}}:
2464
2465 @example
2466 16#200000000000000000000
2467 @end example
2468
2469 @noindent
2470 The number is now displayed in @dfn{hexadecimal}, or ``base-16'' form.
2471 Suddenly it looks pretty simple; this should be no surprise, since we
2472 got this number by computing a power of two, and 16 is a power of 2.
2473 In fact, we can use @w{@kbd{d r 2 @key{RET}}} to see it in actual binary
2474 form:
2475
2476 @example
2477 2#1000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000 @dots{}
2478 @end example
2479
2480 @noindent
2481 We don't have enough space here to show all the zeros! They won't
2482 fit on a typical screen, either, so you will have to use horizontal
2483 scrolling to see them all. Press @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} to scroll the
2484 stack window left and right by half its width. Another way to view
2485 something large is to press @kbd{`} (back-quote) to edit the top of
2486 stack in a separate window. (Press @kbd{C-c C-c} when you are done.)
2487
2488 You can enter non-decimal numbers using the @kbd{#} symbol, too.
2489 Let's see what the hexadecimal number @samp{5FE} looks like in
2490 binary. Type @kbd{16#5FE} (the letters can be typed in upper or
2491 lower case; they will always appear in upper case). It will also
2492 help to turn grouping on with @kbd{d g}:
2493
2494 @example
2495 2#101,1111,1110
2496 @end example
2497
2498 Notice that @kbd{d g} groups by fours by default if the display radix
2499 is binary or hexadecimal, but by threes if it is decimal, octal, or any
2500 other radix.
2501
2502 Now let's see that number in decimal; type @kbd{d r 10}:
2503
2504 @example
2505 1,534
2506 @end example
2507
2508 Numbers are not @emph{stored} with any particular radix attached. They're
2509 just numbers; they can be entered in any radix, and are always displayed
2510 in whatever radix you've chosen with @kbd{d r}. The current radix applies
2511 to integers, fractions, and floats.
2512
2513 @cindex Roundoff errors, in non-decimal numbers
2514 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Your friend Joe tried to enter one-third
2515 as @samp{3#0.1} in @kbd{d r 3} mode with a precision of 12. He got
2516 @samp{3#0.0222222...} (with 25 2's) in the display. When he multiplied
2517 that by three, he got @samp{3#0.222222...} instead of the expected
2518 @samp{3#1}. Next, Joe entered @samp{3#0.2} and, to his great relief,
2519 saw @samp{3#0.2} on the screen. But when he typed @kbd{2 /}, he got
2520 @samp{3#0.10000001} (some zeros omitted). What's going on here?
2521 @xref{Modes Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
2522
2523 @cindex Scientific notation, in non-decimal numbers
2524 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Scientific notation works in non-decimal
2525 modes in the natural way (the exponent is a power of the radix instead of
2526 a power of ten, although the exponent itself is always written in decimal).
2527 Thus @samp{8#1.23e3 = 8#1230.0}. Suppose we have the hexadecimal number
2528 @samp{f.e8f} times 16 to the 15th power: We write @samp{16#f.e8fe15}.
2529 What is wrong with this picture? What could we write instead that would
2530 work better? @xref{Modes Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
2531
2532 The @kbd{m} prefix key has another set of modes, relating to the way
2533 Calc interprets your inputs and does computations. Whereas @kbd{d}-prefix
2534 modes generally affect the way things look, @kbd{m}-prefix modes affect
2535 the way they are actually computed.
2536
2537 The most popular @kbd{m}-prefix mode is the @dfn{angular mode}. Notice
2538 the @samp{Deg} indicator in the mode line. This means that if you use
2539 a command that interprets a number as an angle, it will assume the
2540 angle is measured in degrees. For example,
2541
2542 @smallexample
2543 @group
2544 1: 45 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.500000000001 1: 0.5
2545 . . . .
2546
2547 45 S 2 ^ c 1
2548 @end group
2549 @end smallexample
2550
2551 @noindent
2552 The shift-@kbd{S} command computes the sine of an angle. The sine
2553 of 45 degrees is
2554 @texline @math{\sqrt{2}/2};
2555 @infoline @expr{sqrt(2)/2};
2556 squaring this yields @expr{2/4 = 0.5}. However, there has been a slight
2557 roundoff error because the representation of
2558 @texline @math{\sqrt{2}/2}
2559 @infoline @expr{sqrt(2)/2}
2560 wasn't exact. The @kbd{c 1} command is a handy way to clean up numbers
2561 in this case; it temporarily reduces the precision by one digit while it
2562 re-rounds the number on the top of the stack.
2563
2564 @cindex Roundoff errors, examples
2565 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Your friend Joe computed the sine
2566 of 45 degrees as shown above, then, hoping to avoid an inexact
2567 result, he increased the precision to 16 digits before squaring.
2568 What happened? @xref{Modes Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
2569
2570 To do this calculation in radians, we would type @kbd{m r} first.
2571 (The indicator changes to @samp{Rad}.) 45 degrees corresponds to
2572 @cpiover{4} radians. To get @cpi{}, press the @kbd{P} key. (Once
2573 again, this is a shifted capital @kbd{P}. Remember, unshifted
2574 @kbd{p} sets the precision.)
2575
2576 @smallexample
2577 @group
2578 1: 3.14159265359 1: 0.785398163398 1: 0.707106781187
2579 . . .
2580
2581 P 4 / m r S
2582 @end group
2583 @end smallexample
2584
2585 Likewise, inverse trigonometric functions generate results in
2586 either radians or degrees, depending on the current angular mode.
2587
2588 @smallexample
2589 @group
2590 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.785398163398 1: 45.
2591 . . .
2592
2593 .5 Q m r I S m d U I S
2594 @end group
2595 @end smallexample
2596
2597 @noindent
2598 Here we compute the Inverse Sine of
2599 @texline @math{\sqrt{0.5}},
2600 @infoline @expr{sqrt(0.5)},
2601 first in radians, then in degrees.
2602
2603 Use @kbd{c d} and @kbd{c r} to convert a number from radians to degrees
2604 and vice-versa.
2605
2606 @smallexample
2607 @group
2608 1: 45 1: 0.785398163397 1: 45.
2609 . . .
2610
2611 45 c r c d
2612 @end group
2613 @end smallexample
2614
2615 Another interesting mode is @dfn{Fraction mode}. Normally,
2616 dividing two integers produces a floating-point result if the
2617 quotient can't be expressed as an exact integer. Fraction mode
2618 causes integer division to produce a fraction, i.e., a rational
2619 number, instead.
2620
2621 @smallexample
2622 @group
2623 2: 12 1: 1.33333333333 1: 4:3
2624 1: 9 . .
2625 .
2626
2627 12 @key{RET} 9 / m f U / m f
2628 @end group
2629 @end smallexample
2630
2631 @noindent
2632 In the first case, we get an approximate floating-point result.
2633 In the second case, we get an exact fractional result (four-thirds).
2634
2635 You can enter a fraction at any time using @kbd{:} notation.
2636 (Calc uses @kbd{:} instead of @kbd{/} as the fraction separator
2637 because @kbd{/} is already used to divide the top two stack
2638 elements.) Calculations involving fractions will always
2639 produce exact fractional results; Fraction mode only says
2640 what to do when dividing two integers.
2641
2642 @cindex Fractions vs. floats
2643 @cindex Floats vs. fractions
2644 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} If fractional arithmetic is exact,
2645 why would you ever use floating-point numbers instead?
2646 @xref{Modes Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
2647
2648 Typing @kbd{m f} doesn't change any existing values in the stack.
2649 In the above example, we had to Undo the division and do it over
2650 again when we changed to Fraction mode. But if you use the
2651 evaluates-to operator you can get commands like @kbd{m f} to
2652 recompute for you.
2653
2654 @smallexample
2655 @group
2656 1: 12 / 9 => 1.33333333333 1: 12 / 9 => 1.333 1: 12 / 9 => 4:3
2657 . . .
2658
2659 ' 12/9 => @key{RET} p 4 @key{RET} m f
2660 @end group
2661 @end smallexample
2662
2663 @noindent
2664 In this example, the righthand side of the @samp{=>} operator
2665 on the stack is recomputed when we change the precision, then
2666 again when we change to Fraction mode. All @samp{=>} expressions
2667 on the stack are recomputed every time you change any mode that
2668 might affect their values.
2669
2670 @node Arithmetic Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Basic Tutorial, Tutorial
2671 @section Arithmetic Tutorial
2672
2673 @noindent
2674 In this section, we explore the arithmetic and scientific functions
2675 available in the Calculator.
2676
2677 The standard arithmetic commands are @kbd{+}, @kbd{-}, @kbd{*}, @kbd{/},
2678 and @kbd{^}. Each normally takes two numbers from the top of the stack
2679 and pushes back a result. The @kbd{n} and @kbd{&} keys perform
2680 change-sign and reciprocal operations, respectively.
2681
2682 @smallexample
2683 @group
2684 1: 5 1: 0.2 1: 5. 1: -5. 1: 5.
2685 . . . . .
2686
2687 5 & & n n
2688 @end group
2689 @end smallexample
2690
2691 @cindex Binary operators
2692 You can apply a ``binary operator'' like @kbd{+} across any number of
2693 stack entries by giving it a numeric prefix. You can also apply it
2694 pairwise to several stack elements along with the top one if you use
2695 a negative prefix.
2696
2697 @smallexample
2698 @group
2699 3: 2 1: 9 3: 2 4: 2 3: 12
2700 2: 3 . 2: 3 3: 3 2: 13
2701 1: 4 1: 4 2: 4 1: 14
2702 . . 1: 10 .
2703 .
2704
2705 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 M-3 + U 10 M-- M-3 +
2706 @end group
2707 @end smallexample
2708
2709 @cindex Unary operators
2710 You can apply a ``unary operator'' like @kbd{&} to the top @var{n}
2711 stack entries with a numeric prefix, too.
2712
2713 @smallexample
2714 @group
2715 3: 2 3: 0.5 3: 0.5
2716 2: 3 2: 0.333333333333 2: 3.
2717 1: 4 1: 0.25 1: 4.
2718 . . .
2719
2720 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 M-3 & M-2 &
2721 @end group
2722 @end smallexample
2723
2724 Notice that the results here are left in floating-point form.
2725 We can convert them back to integers by pressing @kbd{F}, the
2726 ``floor'' function. This function rounds down to the next lower
2727 integer. There is also @kbd{R}, which rounds to the nearest
2728 integer.
2729
2730 @smallexample
2731 @group
2732 7: 2. 7: 2 7: 2
2733 6: 2.4 6: 2 6: 2
2734 5: 2.5 5: 2 5: 3
2735 4: 2.6 4: 2 4: 3
2736 3: -2. 3: -2 3: -2
2737 2: -2.4 2: -3 2: -2
2738 1: -2.6 1: -3 1: -3
2739 . . .
2740
2741 M-7 F U M-7 R
2742 @end group
2743 @end smallexample
2744
2745 Since dividing-and-flooring (i.e., ``integer quotient'') is such a
2746 common operation, Calc provides a special command for that purpose, the
2747 backslash @kbd{\}. Another common arithmetic operator is @kbd{%}, which
2748 computes the remainder that would arise from a @kbd{\} operation, i.e.,
2749 the ``modulo'' of two numbers. For example,
2750
2751 @smallexample
2752 @group
2753 2: 1234 1: 12 2: 1234 1: 34
2754 1: 100 . 1: 100 .
2755 . .
2756
2757 1234 @key{RET} 100 \ U %
2758 @end group
2759 @end smallexample
2760
2761 These commands actually work for any real numbers, not just integers.
2762
2763 @smallexample
2764 @group
2765 2: 3.1415 1: 3 2: 3.1415 1: 0.1415
2766 1: 1 . 1: 1 .
2767 . .
2768
2769 3.1415 @key{RET} 1 \ U %
2770 @end group
2771 @end smallexample
2772
2773 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} The @kbd{\} command would appear to be a
2774 frill, since you could always do the same thing with @kbd{/ F}. Think
2775 of a situation where this is not true---@kbd{/ F} would be inadequate.
2776 Now think of a way you could get around the problem if Calc didn't
2777 provide a @kbd{\} command. @xref{Arithmetic Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
2778
2779 We've already seen the @kbd{Q} (square root) and @kbd{S} (sine)
2780 commands. Other commands along those lines are @kbd{C} (cosine),
2781 @kbd{T} (tangent), @kbd{E} (@expr{e^x}) and @kbd{L} (natural
2782 logarithm). These can be modified by the @kbd{I} (inverse) and
2783 @kbd{H} (hyperbolic) prefix keys.
2784
2785 Let's compute the sine and cosine of an angle, and verify the
2786 identity
2787 @texline @math{\sin^2x + \cos^2x = 1}.
2788 @infoline @expr{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2 = 1}.
2789 We'll arbitrarily pick @mathit{-64} degrees as a good value for @expr{x}.
2790 With the angular mode set to degrees (type @w{@kbd{m d}}), do:
2791
2792 @smallexample
2793 @group
2794 2: -64 2: -64 2: -0.89879 2: -0.89879 1: 1.
2795 1: -64 1: -0.89879 1: -64 1: 0.43837 .
2796 . . . .
2797
2798 64 n @key{RET} @key{RET} S @key{TAB} C f h
2799 @end group
2800 @end smallexample
2801
2802 @noindent
2803 (For brevity, we're showing only five digits of the results here.
2804 You can of course do these calculations to any precision you like.)
2805
2806 Remember, @kbd{f h} is the @code{calc-hypot}, or square-root of sum
2807 of squares, command.
2808
2809 Another identity is
2810 @texline @math{\displaystyle\tan x = {\sin x \over \cos x}}.
2811 @infoline @expr{tan(x) = sin(x) / cos(x)}.
2812 @smallexample
2813 @group
2814
2815 2: -0.89879 1: -2.0503 1: -64.
2816 1: 0.43837 . .
2817 .
2818
2819 U / I T
2820 @end group
2821 @end smallexample
2822
2823 A physical interpretation of this calculation is that if you move
2824 @expr{0.89879} units downward and @expr{0.43837} units to the right,
2825 your direction of motion is @mathit{-64} degrees from horizontal. Suppose
2826 we move in the opposite direction, up and to the left:
2827
2828 @smallexample
2829 @group
2830 2: -0.89879 2: 0.89879 1: -2.0503 1: -64.
2831 1: 0.43837 1: -0.43837 . .
2832 . .
2833
2834 U U M-2 n / I T
2835 @end group
2836 @end smallexample
2837
2838 @noindent
2839 How can the angle be the same? The answer is that the @kbd{/} operation
2840 loses information about the signs of its inputs. Because the quotient
2841 is negative, we know exactly one of the inputs was negative, but we
2842 can't tell which one. There is an @kbd{f T} [@code{arctan2}] function which
2843 computes the inverse tangent of the quotient of a pair of numbers.
2844 Since you feed it the two original numbers, it has enough information
2845 to give you a full 360-degree answer.
2846
2847 @smallexample
2848 @group
2849 2: 0.89879 1: 116. 3: 116. 2: 116. 1: 180.
2850 1: -0.43837 . 2: -0.89879 1: -64. .
2851 . 1: 0.43837 .
2852 .
2853
2854 U U f T M-@key{RET} M-2 n f T -
2855 @end group
2856 @end smallexample
2857
2858 @noindent
2859 The resulting angles differ by 180 degrees; in other words, they
2860 point in opposite directions, just as we would expect.
2861
2862 The @key{META}-@key{RET} we used in the third step is the
2863 ``last-arguments'' command. It is sort of like Undo, except that it
2864 restores the arguments of the last command to the stack without removing
2865 the command's result. It is useful in situations like this one,
2866 where we need to do several operations on the same inputs. We could
2867 have accomplished the same thing by using @kbd{M-2 @key{RET}} to duplicate
2868 the top two stack elements right after the @kbd{U U}, then a pair of
2869 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} commands to cycle the 116 up around the duplicates.
2870
2871 A similar identity is supposed to hold for hyperbolic sines and cosines,
2872 except that it is the @emph{difference}
2873 @texline @math{\cosh^2x - \sinh^2x}
2874 @infoline @expr{cosh(x)^2 - sinh(x)^2}
2875 that always equals one. Let's try to verify this identity.
2876
2877 @smallexample
2878 @group
2879 2: -64 2: -64 2: -64 2: 9.7192e54 2: 9.7192e54
2880 1: -64 1: -3.1175e27 1: 9.7192e54 1: -64 1: 9.7192e54
2881 . . . . .
2882
2883 64 n @key{RET} @key{RET} H C 2 ^ @key{TAB} H S 2 ^
2884 @end group
2885 @end smallexample
2886
2887 @noindent
2888 @cindex Roundoff errors, examples
2889 Something's obviously wrong, because when we subtract these numbers
2890 the answer will clearly be zero! But if you think about it, if these
2891 numbers @emph{did} differ by one, it would be in the 55th decimal
2892 place. The difference we seek has been lost entirely to roundoff
2893 error.
2894
2895 We could verify this hypothesis by doing the actual calculation with,
2896 say, 60 decimal places of precision. This will be slow, but not
2897 enormously so. Try it if you wish; sure enough, the answer is
2898 0.99999, reasonably close to 1.
2899
2900 Of course, a more reasonable way to verify the identity is to use
2901 a more reasonable value for @expr{x}!
2902
2903 @cindex Common logarithm
2904 Some Calculator commands use the Hyperbolic prefix for other purposes.
2905 The logarithm and exponential functions, for example, work to the base
2906 @expr{e} normally but use base-10 instead if you use the Hyperbolic
2907 prefix.
2908
2909 @smallexample
2910 @group
2911 1: 1000 1: 6.9077 1: 1000 1: 3
2912 . . . .
2913
2914 1000 L U H L
2915 @end group
2916 @end smallexample
2917
2918 @noindent
2919 First, we mistakenly compute a natural logarithm. Then we undo
2920 and compute a common logarithm instead.
2921
2922 The @kbd{B} key computes a general base-@var{b} logarithm for any
2923 value of @var{b}.
2924
2925 @smallexample
2926 @group
2927 2: 1000 1: 3 1: 1000. 2: 1000. 1: 6.9077
2928 1: 10 . . 1: 2.71828 .
2929 . .
2930
2931 1000 @key{RET} 10 B H E H P B
2932 @end group
2933 @end smallexample
2934
2935 @noindent
2936 Here we first use @kbd{B} to compute the base-10 logarithm, then use
2937 the ``hyperbolic'' exponential as a cheap hack to recover the number
2938 1000, then use @kbd{B} again to compute the natural logarithm. Note
2939 that @kbd{P} with the hyperbolic prefix pushes the constant @expr{e}
2940 onto the stack.
2941
2942 You may have noticed that both times we took the base-10 logarithm
2943 of 1000, we got an exact integer result. Calc always tries to give
2944 an exact rational result for calculations involving rational numbers
2945 where possible. But when we used @kbd{H E}, the result was a
2946 floating-point number for no apparent reason. In fact, if we had
2947 computed @kbd{10 @key{RET} 3 ^} we @emph{would} have gotten an
2948 exact integer 1000. But the @kbd{H E} command is rigged to generate
2949 a floating-point result all of the time so that @kbd{1000 H E} will
2950 not waste time computing a thousand-digit integer when all you
2951 probably wanted was @samp{1e1000}.
2952
2953 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Find a pair of integer inputs to
2954 the @kbd{B} command for which Calc could find an exact rational
2955 result but doesn't. @xref{Arithmetic Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
2956
2957 The Calculator also has a set of functions relating to combinatorics
2958 and statistics. You may be familiar with the @dfn{factorial} function,
2959 which computes the product of all the integers up to a given number.
2960
2961 @smallexample
2962 @group
2963 1: 100 1: 93326215443... 1: 100. 1: 9.3326e157
2964 . . . .
2965
2966 100 ! U c f !
2967 @end group
2968 @end smallexample
2969
2970 @noindent
2971 Recall, the @kbd{c f} command converts the integer or fraction at the
2972 top of the stack to floating-point format. If you take the factorial
2973 of a floating-point number, you get a floating-point result
2974 accurate to the current precision. But if you give @kbd{!} an
2975 exact integer, you get an exact integer result (158 digits long
2976 in this case).
2977
2978 If you take the factorial of a non-integer, Calc uses a generalized
2979 factorial function defined in terms of Euler's Gamma function
2980 @texline @math{\Gamma(n)}
2981 @infoline @expr{gamma(n)}
2982 (which is itself available as the @kbd{f g} command).
2983
2984 @smallexample
2985 @group
2986 3: 4. 3: 24. 1: 5.5 1: 52.342777847
2987 2: 4.5 2: 52.3427777847 . .
2988 1: 5. 1: 120.
2989 . .
2990
2991 M-3 ! M-0 @key{DEL} 5.5 f g
2992 @end group
2993 @end smallexample
2994
2995 @noindent
2996 Here we verify the identity
2997 @texline @math{n! = \Gamma(n+1)}.
2998 @infoline @expr{@var{n}!@: = gamma(@var{n}+1)}.
2999
3000 The binomial coefficient @var{n}-choose-@var{m}
3001 @texline or @math{\displaystyle {n \choose m}}
3002 is defined by
3003 @texline @math{\displaystyle {n! \over m! \, (n-m)!}}
3004 @infoline @expr{n!@: / m!@: (n-m)!}
3005 for all reals @expr{n} and @expr{m}. The intermediate results in this
3006 formula can become quite large even if the final result is small; the
3007 @kbd{k c} command computes a binomial coefficient in a way that avoids
3008 large intermediate values.
3009
3010 The @kbd{k} prefix key defines several common functions out of
3011 combinatorics and number theory. Here we compute the binomial
3012 coefficient 30-choose-20, then determine its prime factorization.
3013
3014 @smallexample
3015 @group
3016 2: 30 1: 30045015 1: [3, 3, 5, 7, 11, 13, 23, 29]
3017 1: 20 . .
3018 .
3019
3020 30 @key{RET} 20 k c k f
3021 @end group
3022 @end smallexample
3023
3024 @noindent
3025 You can verify these prime factors by using @kbd{V R *} to multiply
3026 together the elements of this vector. The result is the original
3027 number, 30045015.
3028
3029 @cindex Hash tables
3030 Suppose a program you are writing needs a hash table with at least
3031 10000 entries. It's best to use a prime number as the actual size
3032 of a hash table. Calc can compute the next prime number after 10000:
3033
3034 @smallexample
3035 @group
3036 1: 10000 1: 10007 1: 9973
3037 . . .
3038
3039 10000 k n I k n
3040 @end group
3041 @end smallexample
3042
3043 @noindent
3044 Just for kicks we've also computed the next prime @emph{less} than
3045 10000.
3046
3047 @c [fix-ref Financial Functions]
3048 @xref{Financial Functions}, for a description of the Calculator
3049 commands that deal with business and financial calculations (functions
3050 like @code{pv}, @code{rate}, and @code{sln}).
3051
3052 @c [fix-ref Binary Number Functions]
3053 @xref{Binary Functions}, to read about the commands for operating
3054 on binary numbers (like @code{and}, @code{xor}, and @code{lsh}).
3055
3056 @node Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Types Tutorial, Arithmetic Tutorial, Tutorial
3057 @section Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3058
3059 @noindent
3060 A @dfn{vector} is a list of numbers or other Calc data objects.
3061 Calc provides a large set of commands that operate on vectors. Some
3062 are familiar operations from vector analysis. Others simply treat
3063 a vector as a list of objects.
3064
3065 @menu
3066 * Vector Analysis Tutorial::
3067 * Matrix Tutorial::
3068 * List Tutorial::
3069 @end menu
3070
3071 @node Vector Analysis Tutorial, Matrix Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3072 @subsection Vector Analysis
3073
3074 @noindent
3075 If you add two vectors, the result is a vector of the sums of the
3076 elements, taken pairwise.
3077
3078 @smallexample
3079 @group
3080 1: [1, 2, 3] 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: [8, 8, 3]
3081 . 1: [7, 6, 0] .
3082 .
3083
3084 [1,2,3] s 1 [7 6 0] s 2 +
3085 @end group
3086 @end smallexample
3087
3088 @noindent
3089 Note that we can separate the vector elements with either commas or
3090 spaces. This is true whether we are using incomplete vectors or
3091 algebraic entry. The @kbd{s 1} and @kbd{s 2} commands save these
3092 vectors so we can easily reuse them later.
3093
3094 If you multiply two vectors, the result is the sum of the products
3095 of the elements taken pairwise. This is called the @dfn{dot product}
3096 of the vectors.
3097
3098 @smallexample
3099 @group
3100 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: 19
3101 1: [7, 6, 0] .
3102 .
3103
3104 r 1 r 2 *
3105 @end group
3106 @end smallexample
3107
3108 @cindex Dot product
3109 The dot product of two vectors is equal to the product of their
3110 lengths times the cosine of the angle between them. (Here the vector
3111 is interpreted as a line from the origin @expr{(0,0,0)} to the
3112 specified point in three-dimensional space.) The @kbd{A}
3113 (absolute value) command can be used to compute the length of a
3114 vector.
3115
3116 @smallexample
3117 @group
3118 3: 19 3: 19 1: 0.550782 1: 56.579
3119 2: [1, 2, 3] 2: 3.741657 . .
3120 1: [7, 6, 0] 1: 9.219544
3121 . .
3122
3123 M-@key{RET} M-2 A * / I C
3124 @end group
3125 @end smallexample
3126
3127 @noindent
3128 First we recall the arguments to the dot product command, then
3129 we compute the absolute values of the top two stack entries to
3130 obtain the lengths of the vectors, then we divide the dot product
3131 by the product of the lengths to get the cosine of the angle.
3132 The inverse cosine finds that the angle between the vectors
3133 is about 56 degrees.
3134
3135 @cindex Cross product
3136 @cindex Perpendicular vectors
3137 The @dfn{cross product} of two vectors is a vector whose length
3138 is the product of the lengths of the inputs times the sine of the
3139 angle between them, and whose direction is perpendicular to both
3140 input vectors. Unlike the dot product, the cross product is
3141 defined only for three-dimensional vectors. Let's double-check
3142 our computation of the angle using the cross product.
3143
3144 @smallexample
3145 @group
3146 2: [1, 2, 3] 3: [-18, 21, -8] 1: [-0.52, 0.61, -0.23] 1: 56.579
3147 1: [7, 6, 0] 2: [1, 2, 3] . .
3148 . 1: [7, 6, 0]
3149 .
3150
3151 r 1 r 2 V C s 3 M-@key{RET} M-2 A * / A I S
3152 @end group
3153 @end smallexample
3154
3155 @noindent
3156 First we recall the original vectors and compute their cross product,
3157 which we also store for later reference. Now we divide the vector
3158 by the product of the lengths of the original vectors. The length of
3159 this vector should be the sine of the angle; sure enough, it is!
3160
3161 @c [fix-ref General Mode Commands]
3162 Vector-related commands generally begin with the @kbd{v} prefix key.
3163 Some are uppercase letters and some are lowercase. To make it easier
3164 to type these commands, the shift-@kbd{V} prefix key acts the same as
3165 the @kbd{v} key. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to make all
3166 prefix keys have this property.)
3167
3168 If we take the dot product of two perpendicular vectors we expect
3169 to get zero, since the cosine of 90 degrees is zero. Let's check
3170 that the cross product is indeed perpendicular to both inputs:
3171
3172 @smallexample
3173 @group
3174 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: 0 2: [7, 6, 0] 1: 0
3175 1: [-18, 21, -8] . 1: [-18, 21, -8] .
3176 . .
3177
3178 r 1 r 3 * @key{DEL} r 2 r 3 *
3179 @end group
3180 @end smallexample
3181
3182 @cindex Normalizing a vector
3183 @cindex Unit vectors
3184 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Given a vector on the top of the
3185 stack, what keystrokes would you use to @dfn{normalize} the
3186 vector, i.e., to reduce its length to one without changing its
3187 direction? @xref{Vector Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
3188
3189 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Suppose a certain particle can be
3190 at any of several positions along a ruler. You have a list of
3191 those positions in the form of a vector, and another list of the
3192 probabilities for the particle to be at the corresponding positions.
3193 Find the average position of the particle.
3194 @xref{Vector Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
3195
3196 @node Matrix Tutorial, List Tutorial, Vector Analysis Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3197 @subsection Matrices
3198
3199 @noindent
3200 A @dfn{matrix} is just a vector of vectors, all the same length.
3201 This means you can enter a matrix using nested brackets. You can
3202 also use the semicolon character to enter a matrix. We'll show
3203 both methods here:
3204
3205 @smallexample
3206 @group
3207 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ]
3208 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ]
3209 . .
3210
3211 [[1 2 3] [4 5 6]] ' [1 2 3; 4 5 6] @key{RET}
3212 @end group
3213 @end smallexample
3214
3215 @noindent
3216 We'll be using this matrix again, so type @kbd{s 4} to save it now.
3217
3218 Note that semicolons work with incomplete vectors, but they work
3219 better in algebraic entry. That's why we use the apostrophe in
3220 the second example.
3221
3222 When two matrices are multiplied, the lefthand matrix must have
3223 the same number of columns as the righthand matrix has rows.
3224 Row @expr{i}, column @expr{j} of the result is effectively the
3225 dot product of row @expr{i} of the left matrix by column @expr{j}
3226 of the right matrix.
3227
3228 If we try to duplicate this matrix and multiply it by itself,
3229 the dimensions are wrong and the multiplication cannot take place:
3230
3231 @smallexample
3232 @group
3233 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] * [ [ 1, 2, 3 ]
3234 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ]
3235 .
3236
3237 @key{RET} *
3238 @end group
3239 @end smallexample
3240
3241 @noindent
3242 Though rather hard to read, this is a formula which shows the product
3243 of two matrices. The @samp{*} function, having invalid arguments, has
3244 been left in symbolic form.
3245
3246 We can multiply the matrices if we @dfn{transpose} one of them first.
3247
3248 @smallexample
3249 @group
3250 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ 14, 32 ] 1: [ [ 17, 22, 27 ]
3251 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 32, 77 ] ] [ 22, 29, 36 ]
3252 1: [ [ 1, 4 ] . [ 27, 36, 45 ] ]
3253 [ 2, 5 ] .
3254 [ 3, 6 ] ]
3255 .
3256
3257 U v t * U @key{TAB} *
3258 @end group
3259 @end smallexample
3260
3261 Matrix multiplication is not commutative; indeed, switching the
3262 order of the operands can even change the dimensions of the result
3263 matrix, as happened here!
3264
3265 If you multiply a plain vector by a matrix, it is treated as a
3266 single row or column depending on which side of the matrix it is
3267 on. The result is a plain vector which should also be interpreted
3268 as a row or column as appropriate.
3269
3270 @smallexample
3271 @group
3272 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [14, 32]
3273 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] .
3274 1: [1, 2, 3]
3275 .
3276
3277 r 4 r 1 *
3278 @end group
3279 @end smallexample
3280
3281 Multiplying in the other order wouldn't work because the number of
3282 rows in the matrix is different from the number of elements in the
3283 vector.
3284
3285 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Use @samp{*} to sum along the rows
3286 of the above
3287 @texline @math{2\times3}
3288 @infoline 2x3
3289 matrix to get @expr{[6, 15]}. Now use @samp{*} to sum along the columns
3290 to get @expr{[5, 7, 9]}.
3291 @xref{Matrix Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
3292
3293 @cindex Identity matrix
3294 An @dfn{identity matrix} is a square matrix with ones along the
3295 diagonal and zeros elsewhere. It has the property that multiplication
3296 by an identity matrix, on the left or on the right, always produces
3297 the original matrix.
3298
3299 @smallexample
3300 @group
3301 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ]
3302 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ]
3303 . 1: [ [ 1, 0, 0 ] .
3304 [ 0, 1, 0 ]
3305 [ 0, 0, 1 ] ]
3306 .
3307
3308 r 4 v i 3 @key{RET} *
3309 @end group
3310 @end smallexample
3311
3312 If a matrix is square, it is often possible to find its @dfn{inverse},
3313 that is, a matrix which, when multiplied by the original matrix, yields
3314 an identity matrix. The @kbd{&} (reciprocal) key also computes the
3315 inverse of a matrix.
3316
3317 @smallexample
3318 @group
3319 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ -2.4, 1.2, -0.2 ]
3320 [ 4, 5, 6 ] [ 2.8, -1.4, 0.4 ]
3321 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ] [ -0.73333, 0.53333, -0.2 ] ]
3322 . .
3323
3324 r 4 r 2 | s 5 &
3325 @end group
3326 @end smallexample
3327
3328 @noindent
3329 The vertical bar @kbd{|} @dfn{concatenates} numbers, vectors, and
3330 matrices together. Here we have used it to add a new row onto
3331 our matrix to make it square.
3332
3333 We can multiply these two matrices in either order to get an identity.
3334
3335 @smallexample
3336 @group
3337 1: [ [ 1., 0., 0. ] 1: [ [ 1., 0., 0. ]
3338 [ 0., 1., 0. ] [ 0., 1., 0. ]
3339 [ 0., 0., 1. ] ] [ 0., 0., 1. ] ]
3340 . .
3341
3342 M-@key{RET} * U @key{TAB} *
3343 @end group
3344 @end smallexample
3345
3346 @cindex Systems of linear equations
3347 @cindex Linear equations, systems of
3348 Matrix inverses are related to systems of linear equations in algebra.
3349 Suppose we had the following set of equations:
3350
3351 @ifnottex
3352 @group
3353 @example
3354 a + 2b + 3c = 6
3355 4a + 5b + 6c = 2
3356 7a + 6b = 3
3357 @end example
3358 @end group
3359 @end ifnottex
3360 @tex
3361 \turnoffactive
3362 \beforedisplayh
3363 $$ \openup1\jot \tabskip=0pt plus1fil
3364 \halign to\displaywidth{\tabskip=0pt
3365 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3366 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3367 $\hfil#$&${}#\hfil$\tabskip=0pt plus1fil\cr
3368 a&+&2b&+&3c&=6 \cr
3369 4a&+&5b&+&6c&=2 \cr
3370 7a&+&6b& & &=3 \cr}
3371 $$
3372 \afterdisplayh
3373 @end tex
3374
3375 @noindent
3376 This can be cast into the matrix equation,
3377
3378 @ifnottex
3379 @group
3380 @example
3381 [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] [ [ a ] [ [ 6 ]
3382 [ 4, 5, 6 ] * [ b ] = [ 2 ]
3383 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ] [ c ] ] [ 3 ] ]
3384 @end example
3385 @end group
3386 @end ifnottex
3387 @tex
3388 \turnoffactive
3389 \beforedisplay
3390 $$ \pmatrix{ 1 & 2 & 3 \cr 4 & 5 & 6 \cr 7 & 6 & 0 }
3391 \times
3392 \pmatrix{ a \cr b \cr c } = \pmatrix{ 6 \cr 2 \cr 3 }
3393 $$
3394 \afterdisplay
3395 @end tex
3396
3397 We can solve this system of equations by multiplying both sides by the
3398 inverse of the matrix. Calc can do this all in one step:
3399
3400 @smallexample
3401 @group
3402 2: [6, 2, 3] 1: [-12.6, 15.2, -3.93333]
3403 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] .
3404 [ 4, 5, 6 ]
3405 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ]
3406 .
3407
3408 [6,2,3] r 5 /
3409 @end group
3410 @end smallexample
3411
3412 @noindent
3413 The result is the @expr{[a, b, c]} vector that solves the equations.
3414 (Dividing by a square matrix is equivalent to multiplying by its
3415 inverse.)
3416
3417 Let's verify this solution:
3418
3419 @smallexample
3420 @group
3421 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [6., 2., 3.]
3422 [ 4, 5, 6 ] .
3423 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ]
3424 1: [-12.6, 15.2, -3.93333]
3425 .
3426
3427 r 5 @key{TAB} *
3428 @end group
3429 @end smallexample
3430
3431 @noindent
3432 Note that we had to be careful about the order in which we multiplied
3433 the matrix and vector. If we multiplied in the other order, Calc would
3434 assume the vector was a row vector in order to make the dimensions
3435 come out right, and the answer would be incorrect. If you
3436 don't feel safe letting Calc take either interpretation of your
3437 vectors, use explicit
3438 @texline @math{N\times1}
3439 @infoline Nx1
3440 or
3441 @texline @math{1\times N}
3442 @infoline 1xN
3443 matrices instead. In this case, you would enter the original column
3444 vector as @samp{[[6], [2], [3]]} or @samp{[6; 2; 3]}.
3445
3446 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Algebraic entry allows you to make
3447 vectors and matrices that include variables. Solve the following
3448 system of equations to get expressions for @expr{x} and @expr{y}
3449 in terms of @expr{a} and @expr{b}.
3450
3451 @ifnottex
3452 @group
3453 @example
3454 x + a y = 6
3455 x + b y = 10
3456 @end example
3457 @end group
3458 @end ifnottex
3459 @tex
3460 \turnoffactive
3461 \beforedisplay
3462 $$ \eqalign{ x &+ a y = 6 \cr
3463 x &+ b y = 10}
3464 $$
3465 \afterdisplay
3466 @end tex
3467
3468 @noindent
3469 @xref{Matrix Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
3470
3471 @cindex Least-squares for over-determined systems
3472 @cindex Over-determined systems of equations
3473 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} A system of equations is ``over-determined''
3474 if it has more equations than variables. It is often the case that
3475 there are no values for the variables that will satisfy all the
3476 equations at once, but it is still useful to find a set of values
3477 which ``nearly'' satisfy all the equations. In terms of matrix equations,
3478 you can't solve @expr{A X = B} directly because the matrix @expr{A}
3479 is not square for an over-determined system. Matrix inversion works
3480 only for square matrices. One common trick is to multiply both sides
3481 on the left by the transpose of @expr{A}:
3482 @ifnottex
3483 @samp{trn(A)*A*X = trn(A)*B}.
3484 @end ifnottex
3485 @tex
3486 \turnoffactive
3487 $A^T A \, X = A^T B$, where $A^T$ is the transpose \samp{trn(A)}.
3488 @end tex
3489 Now
3490 @texline @math{A^T A}
3491 @infoline @expr{trn(A)*A}
3492 is a square matrix so a solution is possible. It turns out that the
3493 @expr{X} vector you compute in this way will be a ``least-squares''
3494 solution, which can be regarded as the ``closest'' solution to the set
3495 of equations. Use Calc to solve the following over-determined
3496 system:
3497
3498 @ifnottex
3499 @group
3500 @example
3501 a + 2b + 3c = 6
3502 4a + 5b + 6c = 2
3503 7a + 6b = 3
3504 2a + 4b + 6c = 11
3505 @end example
3506 @end group
3507 @end ifnottex
3508 @tex
3509 \turnoffactive
3510 \beforedisplayh
3511 $$ \openup1\jot \tabskip=0pt plus1fil
3512 \halign to\displaywidth{\tabskip=0pt
3513 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3514 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3515 $\hfil#$&${}#\hfil$\tabskip=0pt plus1fil\cr
3516 a&+&2b&+&3c&=6 \cr
3517 4a&+&5b&+&6c&=2 \cr
3518 7a&+&6b& & &=3 \cr
3519 2a&+&4b&+&6c&=11 \cr}
3520 $$
3521 \afterdisplayh
3522 @end tex
3523
3524 @noindent
3525 @xref{Matrix Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
3526
3527 @node List Tutorial, , Matrix Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3528 @subsection Vectors as Lists
3529
3530 @noindent
3531 @cindex Lists
3532 Although Calc has a number of features for manipulating vectors and
3533 matrices as mathematical objects, you can also treat vectors as
3534 simple lists of values. For example, we saw that the @kbd{k f}
3535 command returns a vector which is a list of the prime factors of a
3536 number.
3537
3538 You can pack and unpack stack entries into vectors:
3539
3540 @smallexample
3541 @group
3542 3: 10 1: [10, 20, 30] 3: 10
3543 2: 20 . 2: 20
3544 1: 30 1: 30
3545 . .
3546
3547 M-3 v p v u
3548 @end group
3549 @end smallexample
3550
3551 You can also build vectors out of consecutive integers, or out
3552 of many copies of a given value:
3553
3554 @smallexample
3555 @group
3556 1: [1, 2, 3, 4] 2: [1, 2, 3, 4] 2: [1, 2, 3, 4]
3557 . 1: 17 1: [17, 17, 17, 17]
3558 . .
3559
3560 v x 4 @key{RET} 17 v b 4 @key{RET}
3561 @end group
3562 @end smallexample
3563
3564 You can apply an operator to every element of a vector using the
3565 @dfn{map} command.
3566
3567 @smallexample
3568 @group
3569 1: [17, 34, 51, 68] 1: [289, 1156, 2601, 4624] 1: [17, 34, 51, 68]
3570 . . .
3571
3572 V M * 2 V M ^ V M Q
3573 @end group
3574 @end smallexample
3575
3576 @noindent
3577 In the first step, we multiply the vector of integers by the vector
3578 of 17's elementwise. In the second step, we raise each element to
3579 the power two. (The general rule is that both operands must be
3580 vectors of the same length, or else one must be a vector and the
3581 other a plain number.) In the final step, we take the square root
3582 of each element.
3583
3584 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Compute a vector of powers of two
3585 from
3586 @texline @math{2^{-4}}
3587 @infoline @expr{2^-4}
3588 to @expr{2^4}. @xref{List Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
3589
3590 You can also @dfn{reduce} a binary operator across a vector.
3591 For example, reducing @samp{*} computes the product of all the
3592 elements in the vector:
3593
3594 @smallexample
3595 @group
3596 1: 123123 1: [3, 7, 11, 13, 41] 1: 123123
3597 . . .
3598
3599 123123 k f V R *
3600 @end group
3601 @end smallexample
3602
3603 @noindent
3604 In this example, we decompose 123123 into its prime factors, then
3605 multiply those factors together again to yield the original number.
3606
3607 We could compute a dot product ``by hand'' using mapping and
3608 reduction:
3609
3610 @smallexample
3611 @group
3612 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: [7, 12, 0] 1: 19
3613 1: [7, 6, 0] . .
3614 .
3615
3616 r 1 r 2 V M * V R +
3617 @end group
3618 @end smallexample
3619
3620 @noindent
3621 Recalling two vectors from the previous section, we compute the
3622 sum of pairwise products of the elements to get the same answer
3623 for the dot product as before.
3624
3625 A slight variant of vector reduction is the @dfn{accumulate} operation,
3626 @kbd{V U}. This produces a vector of the intermediate results from
3627 a corresponding reduction. Here we compute a table of factorials:
3628
3629 @smallexample
3630 @group
3631 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6] 1: [1, 2, 6, 24, 120, 720]
3632 . .
3633
3634 v x 6 @key{RET} V U *
3635 @end group
3636 @end smallexample
3637
3638 Calc allows vectors to grow as large as you like, although it gets
3639 rather slow if vectors have more than about a hundred elements.
3640 Actually, most of the time is spent formatting these large vectors
3641 for display, not calculating on them. Try the following experiment
3642 (if your computer is very fast you may need to substitute a larger
3643 vector size).
3644
3645 @smallexample
3646 @group
3647 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, ... 1: [2, 3, 4, 5, ...
3648 . .
3649
3650 v x 500 @key{RET} 1 V M +
3651 @end group
3652 @end smallexample
3653
3654 Now press @kbd{v .} (the letter @kbd{v}, then a period) and try the
3655 experiment again. In @kbd{v .} mode, long vectors are displayed
3656 ``abbreviated'' like this:
3657
3658 @smallexample
3659 @group
3660 1: [1, 2, 3, ..., 500] 1: [2, 3, 4, ..., 501]
3661 . .
3662
3663 v x 500 @key{RET} 1 V M +
3664 @end group
3665 @end smallexample
3666
3667 @noindent
3668 (where now the @samp{...} is actually part of the Calc display).
3669 You will find both operations are now much faster. But notice that
3670 even in @w{@kbd{v .}} mode, the full vectors are still shown in the Trail.
3671 Type @w{@kbd{t .}} to cause the trail to abbreviate as well, and try the
3672 experiment one more time. Operations on long vectors are now quite
3673 fast! (But of course if you use @kbd{t .} you will lose the ability
3674 to get old vectors back using the @kbd{t y} command.)
3675
3676 An easy way to view a full vector when @kbd{v .} mode is active is
3677 to press @kbd{`} (back-quote) to edit the vector; editing always works
3678 with the full, unabbreviated value.
3679
3680 @cindex Least-squares for fitting a straight line
3681 @cindex Fitting data to a line
3682 @cindex Line, fitting data to
3683 @cindex Data, extracting from buffers
3684 @cindex Columns of data, extracting
3685 As a larger example, let's try to fit a straight line to some data,
3686 using the method of least squares. (Calc has a built-in command for
3687 least-squares curve fitting, but we'll do it by hand here just to
3688 practice working with vectors.) Suppose we have the following list
3689 of values in a file we have loaded into Emacs:
3690
3691 @smallexample
3692 x y
3693 --- ---
3694 1.34 0.234
3695 1.41 0.298
3696 1.49 0.402
3697 1.56 0.412
3698 1.64 0.466
3699 1.73 0.473
3700 1.82 0.601
3701 1.91 0.519
3702 2.01 0.603
3703 2.11 0.637
3704 2.22 0.645
3705 2.33 0.705
3706 2.45 0.917
3707 2.58 1.009
3708 2.71 0.971
3709 2.85 1.062
3710 3.00 1.148
3711 3.15 1.157
3712 3.32 1.354
3713 @end smallexample
3714
3715 @noindent
3716 If you are reading this tutorial in printed form, you will find it
3717 easiest to press @kbd{C-x * i} to enter the on-line Info version of
3718 the manual and find this table there. (Press @kbd{g}, then type
3719 @kbd{List Tutorial}, to jump straight to this section.)
3720
3721 Position the cursor at the upper-left corner of this table, just
3722 to the left of the @expr{1.34}. Press @kbd{C-@@} to set the mark.
3723 (On your system this may be @kbd{C-2}, @kbd{C-@key{SPC}}, or @kbd{NUL}.)
3724 Now position the cursor to the lower-right, just after the @expr{1.354}.
3725 You have now defined this region as an Emacs ``rectangle.'' Still
3726 in the Info buffer, type @kbd{C-x * r}. This command
3727 (@code{calc-grab-rectangle}) will pop you back into the Calculator, with
3728 the contents of the rectangle you specified in the form of a matrix.
3729
3730 @smallexample
3731 @group
3732 1: [ [ 1.34, 0.234 ]
3733 [ 1.41, 0.298 ]
3734 @dots{}
3735 @end group
3736 @end smallexample
3737
3738 @noindent
3739 (You may wish to use @kbd{v .} mode to abbreviate the display of this
3740 large matrix.)
3741
3742 We want to treat this as a pair of lists. The first step is to
3743 transpose this matrix into a pair of rows. Remember, a matrix is
3744 just a vector of vectors. So we can unpack the matrix into a pair
3745 of row vectors on the stack.
3746
3747 @smallexample
3748 @group
3749 1: [ [ 1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ] 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ]
3750 [ 0.234, 0.298, 0.402, ... ] ] 1: [0.234, 0.298, 0.402, ... ]
3751 . .
3752
3753 v t v u
3754 @end group
3755 @end smallexample
3756
3757 @noindent
3758 Let's store these in quick variables 1 and 2, respectively.
3759
3760 @smallexample
3761 @group
3762 1: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ] .
3763 .
3764
3765 t 2 t 1
3766 @end group
3767 @end smallexample
3768
3769 @noindent
3770 (Recall that @kbd{t 2} is a variant of @kbd{s 2} that removes the
3771 stored value from the stack.)
3772
3773 In a least squares fit, the slope @expr{m} is given by the formula
3774
3775 @ifnottex
3776 @example
3777 m = (N sum(x y) - sum(x) sum(y)) / (N sum(x^2) - sum(x)^2)
3778 @end example
3779 @end ifnottex
3780 @tex
3781 \turnoffactive
3782 \beforedisplay
3783 $$ m = {N \sum x y - \sum x \sum y \over
3784 N \sum x^2 - \left( \sum x \right)^2} $$
3785 \afterdisplay
3786 @end tex
3787
3788 @noindent
3789 where
3790 @texline @math{\sum x}
3791 @infoline @expr{sum(x)}
3792 represents the sum of all the values of @expr{x}. While there is an
3793 actual @code{sum} function in Calc, it's easier to sum a vector using a
3794 simple reduction. First, let's compute the four different sums that
3795 this formula uses.
3796
3797 @smallexample
3798 @group
3799 1: 41.63 1: 98.0003
3800 . .
3801
3802 r 1 V R + t 3 r 1 2 V M ^ V R + t 4
3803
3804 @end group
3805 @end smallexample
3806 @noindent
3807 @smallexample
3808 @group
3809 1: 13.613 1: 33.36554
3810 . .
3811
3812 r 2 V R + t 5 r 1 r 2 V M * V R + t 6
3813 @end group
3814 @end smallexample
3815
3816 @ifnottex
3817 @noindent
3818 These are @samp{sum(x)}, @samp{sum(x^2)}, @samp{sum(y)}, and @samp{sum(x y)},
3819 respectively. (We could have used @kbd{*} to compute @samp{sum(x^2)} and
3820 @samp{sum(x y)}.)
3821 @end ifnottex
3822 @tex
3823 \turnoffactive
3824 These are $\sum x$, $\sum x^2$, $\sum y$, and $\sum x y$,
3825 respectively. (We could have used \kbd{*} to compute $\sum x^2$ and
3826 $\sum x y$.)
3827 @end tex
3828
3829 Finally, we also need @expr{N}, the number of data points. This is just
3830 the length of either of our lists.
3831
3832 @smallexample
3833 @group
3834 1: 19
3835 .
3836
3837 r 1 v l t 7
3838 @end group
3839 @end smallexample
3840
3841 @noindent
3842 (That's @kbd{v} followed by a lower-case @kbd{l}.)
3843
3844 Now we grind through the formula:
3845
3846 @smallexample
3847 @group
3848 1: 633.94526 2: 633.94526 1: 67.23607
3849 . 1: 566.70919 .
3850 .
3851
3852 r 7 r 6 * r 3 r 5 * -
3853
3854 @end group
3855 @end smallexample
3856 @noindent
3857 @smallexample
3858 @group
3859 2: 67.23607 3: 67.23607 2: 67.23607 1: 0.52141679
3860 1: 1862.0057 2: 1862.0057 1: 128.9488 .
3861 . 1: 1733.0569 .
3862 .
3863
3864 r 7 r 4 * r 3 2 ^ - / t 8
3865 @end group
3866 @end smallexample
3867
3868 That gives us the slope @expr{m}. The y-intercept @expr{b} can now
3869 be found with the simple formula,
3870
3871 @ifnottex
3872 @example
3873 b = (sum(y) - m sum(x)) / N
3874 @end example
3875 @end ifnottex
3876 @tex
3877 \turnoffactive
3878 \beforedisplay
3879 $$ b = {\sum y - m \sum x \over N} $$
3880 \afterdisplay
3881 \vskip10pt
3882 @end tex
3883
3884 @smallexample
3885 @group
3886 1: 13.613 2: 13.613 1: -8.09358 1: -0.425978
3887 . 1: 21.70658 . .
3888 .
3889
3890 r 5 r 8 r 3 * - r 7 / t 9
3891 @end group
3892 @end smallexample
3893
3894 Let's ``plot'' this straight line approximation,
3895 @texline @math{y \approx m x + b},
3896 @infoline @expr{m x + b},
3897 and compare it with the original data.
3898
3899 @smallexample
3900 @group
3901 1: [0.699, 0.735, ... ] 1: [0.273, 0.309, ... ]
3902 . .
3903
3904 r 1 r 8 * r 9 + s 0
3905 @end group
3906 @end smallexample
3907
3908 @noindent
3909 Notice that multiplying a vector by a constant, and adding a constant
3910 to a vector, can be done without mapping commands since these are
3911 common operations from vector algebra. As far as Calc is concerned,
3912 we've just been doing geometry in 19-dimensional space!
3913
3914 We can subtract this vector from our original @expr{y} vector to get
3915 a feel for the error of our fit. Let's find the maximum error:
3916
3917 @smallexample
3918 @group
3919 1: [0.0387, 0.0112, ... ] 1: [0.0387, 0.0112, ... ] 1: 0.0897
3920 . . .
3921
3922 r 2 - V M A V R X
3923 @end group
3924 @end smallexample
3925
3926 @noindent
3927 First we compute a vector of differences, then we take the absolute
3928 values of these differences, then we reduce the @code{max} function
3929 across the vector. (The @code{max} function is on the two-key sequence
3930 @kbd{f x}; because it is so common to use @code{max} in a vector
3931 operation, the letters @kbd{X} and @kbd{N} are also accepted for
3932 @code{max} and @code{min} in this context. In general, you answer
3933 the @kbd{V M} or @kbd{V R} prompt with the actual key sequence that
3934 invokes the function you want. You could have typed @kbd{V R f x} or
3935 even @kbd{V R x max @key{RET}} if you had preferred.)
3936
3937 If your system has the GNUPLOT program, you can see graphs of your
3938 data and your straight line to see how well they match. (If you have
3939 GNUPLOT 3.0 or higher, the following instructions will work regardless
3940 of the kind of display you have. Some GNUPLOT 2.0, non-X-windows systems
3941 may require additional steps to view the graphs.)
3942
3943 Let's start by plotting the original data. Recall the ``@var{x}'' and ``@var{y}''
3944 vectors onto the stack and press @kbd{g f}. This ``fast'' graphing
3945 command does everything you need to do for simple, straightforward
3946 plotting of data.
3947
3948 @smallexample
3949 @group
3950 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ]
3951 1: [0.234, 0.298, 0.402, ... ]
3952 .
3953
3954 r 1 r 2 g f
3955 @end group
3956 @end smallexample
3957
3958 If all goes well, you will shortly get a new window containing a graph
3959 of the data. (If not, contact your GNUPLOT or Calc installer to find
3960 out what went wrong.) In the X window system, this will be a separate
3961 graphics window. For other kinds of displays, the default is to
3962 display the graph in Emacs itself using rough character graphics.
3963 Press @kbd{q} when you are done viewing the character graphics.
3964
3965 Next, let's add the line we got from our least-squares fit.
3966 @ifinfo
3967 (If you are reading this tutorial on-line while running Calc, typing
3968 @kbd{g a} may cause the tutorial to disappear from its window and be
3969 replaced by a buffer named @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}. The tutorial
3970 will reappear when you terminate GNUPLOT by typing @kbd{g q}.)
3971 @end ifinfo
3972
3973 @smallexample
3974 @group
3975 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ]
3976 1: [0.273, 0.309, 0.351, ... ]
3977 .
3978
3979 @key{DEL} r 0 g a g p
3980 @end group
3981 @end smallexample
3982
3983 It's not very useful to get symbols to mark the data points on this
3984 second curve; you can type @kbd{g S g p} to remove them. Type @kbd{g q}
3985 when you are done to remove the X graphics window and terminate GNUPLOT.
3986
3987 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} An earlier exercise showed how to do
3988 least squares fitting to a general system of equations. Our 19 data
3989 points are really 19 equations of the form @expr{y_i = m x_i + b} for
3990 different pairs of @expr{(x_i,y_i)}. Use the matrix-transpose method
3991 to solve for @expr{m} and @expr{b}, duplicating the above result.
3992 @xref{List Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
3993
3994 @cindex Geometric mean
3995 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} If the input data do not form a
3996 rectangle, you can use @w{@kbd{C-x * g}} (@code{calc-grab-region})
3997 to grab the data the way Emacs normally works with regions---it reads
3998 left-to-right, top-to-bottom, treating line breaks the same as spaces.
3999 Use this command to find the geometric mean of the following numbers.
4000 (The geometric mean is the @var{n}th root of the product of @var{n} numbers.)
4001
4002 @example
4003 2.3 6 22 15.1 7
4004 15 14 7.5
4005 2.5
4006 @end example
4007
4008 @noindent
4009 The @kbd{C-x * g} command accepts numbers separated by spaces or commas,
4010 with or without surrounding vector brackets.
4011 @xref{List Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
4012
4013 @ifnottex
4014 As another example, a theorem about binomial coefficients tells
4015 us that the alternating sum of binomial coefficients
4016 @var{n}-choose-0 minus @var{n}-choose-1 plus @var{n}-choose-2, and so
4017 on up to @var{n}-choose-@var{n},
4018 always comes out to zero. Let's verify this
4019 for @expr{n=6}.
4020 @end ifnottex
4021 @tex
4022 As another example, a theorem about binomial coefficients tells
4023 us that the alternating sum of binomial coefficients
4024 ${n \choose 0} - {n \choose 1} + {n \choose 2} - \cdots \pm {n \choose n}$
4025 always comes out to zero. Let's verify this
4026 for \cite{n=6}.
4027 @end tex
4028
4029 @smallexample
4030 @group
4031 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7] 1: [0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6]
4032 . .
4033
4034 v x 7 @key{RET} 1 -
4035
4036 @end group
4037 @end smallexample
4038 @noindent
4039 @smallexample
4040 @group
4041 1: [1, -6, 15, -20, 15, -6, 1] 1: 0
4042 . .
4043
4044 V M ' (-1)^$ choose(6,$) @key{RET} V R +
4045 @end group
4046 @end smallexample
4047
4048 The @kbd{V M '} command prompts you to enter any algebraic expression
4049 to define the function to map over the vector. The symbol @samp{$}
4050 inside this expression represents the argument to the function.
4051 The Calculator applies this formula to each element of the vector,
4052 substituting each element's value for the @samp{$} sign(s) in turn.
4053
4054 To define a two-argument function, use @samp{$$} for the first
4055 argument and @samp{$} for the second: @kbd{V M ' $$-$ @key{RET}} is
4056 equivalent to @kbd{V M -}. This is analogous to regular algebraic
4057 entry, where @samp{$$} would refer to the next-to-top stack entry
4058 and @samp{$} would refer to the top stack entry, and @kbd{' $$-$ @key{RET}}
4059 would act exactly like @kbd{-}.
4060
4061 Notice that the @kbd{V M '} command has recorded two things in the
4062 trail: The result, as usual, and also a funny-looking thing marked
4063 @samp{oper} that represents the operator function you typed in.
4064 The function is enclosed in @samp{< >} brackets, and the argument is
4065 denoted by a @samp{#} sign. If there were several arguments, they
4066 would be shown as @samp{#1}, @samp{#2}, and so on. (For example,
4067 @kbd{V M ' $$-$} will put the function @samp{<#1 - #2>} on the
4068 trail.) This object is a ``nameless function''; you can use nameless
4069 @w{@samp{< >}} notation to answer the @kbd{V M '} prompt if you like.
4070 Nameless function notation has the interesting, occasionally useful
4071 property that a nameless function is not actually evaluated until
4072 it is used. For example, @kbd{V M ' $+random(2.0)} evaluates
4073 @samp{random(2.0)} once and adds that random number to all elements
4074 of the vector, but @kbd{V M ' <#+random(2.0)>} evaluates the
4075 @samp{random(2.0)} separately for each vector element.
4076
4077 Another group of operators that are often useful with @kbd{V M} are
4078 the relational operators: @kbd{a =}, for example, compares two numbers
4079 and gives the result 1 if they are equal, or 0 if not. Similarly,
4080 @w{@kbd{a <}} checks for one number being less than another.
4081
4082 Other useful vector operations include @kbd{v v}, to reverse a
4083 vector end-for-end; @kbd{V S}, to sort the elements of a vector
4084 into increasing order; and @kbd{v r} and @w{@kbd{v c}}, to extract
4085 one row or column of a matrix, or (in both cases) to extract one
4086 element of a plain vector. With a negative argument, @kbd{v r}
4087 and @kbd{v c} instead delete one row, column, or vector element.
4088
4089 @cindex Divisor functions
4090 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} The @expr{k}th @dfn{divisor function}
4091 @tex
4092 $\sigma_k(n)$
4093 @end tex
4094 is the sum of the @expr{k}th powers of all the divisors of an
4095 integer @expr{n}. Figure out a method for computing the divisor
4096 function for reasonably small values of @expr{n}. As a test,
4097 the 0th and 1st divisor functions of 30 are 8 and 72, respectively.
4098 @xref{List Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
4099
4100 @cindex Square-free numbers
4101 @cindex Duplicate values in a list
4102 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} The @kbd{k f} command produces a
4103 list of prime factors for a number. Sometimes it is important to
4104 know that a number is @dfn{square-free}, i.e., that no prime occurs
4105 more than once in its list of prime factors. Find a sequence of
4106 keystrokes to tell if a number is square-free; your method should
4107 leave 1 on the stack if it is, or 0 if it isn't.
4108 @xref{List Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
4109
4110 @cindex Triangular lists
4111 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} Build a list of lists that looks
4112 like the following diagram. (You may wish to use the @kbd{v /}
4113 command to enable multi-line display of vectors.)
4114
4115 @smallexample
4116 @group
4117 1: [ [1],
4118 [1, 2],
4119 [1, 2, 3],
4120 [1, 2, 3, 4],
4121 [1, 2, 3, 4, 5],
4122 [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6] ]
4123 @end group
4124 @end smallexample
4125
4126 @noindent
4127 @xref{List Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
4128
4129 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 7.} Build the following list of lists.
4130
4131 @smallexample
4132 @group
4133 1: [ [0],
4134 [1, 2],
4135 [3, 4, 5],
4136 [6, 7, 8, 9],
4137 [10, 11, 12, 13, 14],
4138 [15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20] ]
4139 @end group
4140 @end smallexample
4141
4142 @noindent
4143 @xref{List Answer 7, 7}. (@bullet{})
4144
4145 @cindex Maximizing a function over a list of values
4146 @c [fix-ref Numerical Solutions]
4147 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 8.} Compute a list of values of Bessel's
4148 @texline @math{J_1(x)}
4149 @infoline @expr{J1}
4150 function @samp{besJ(1,x)} for @expr{x} from 0 to 5 in steps of 0.25.
4151 Find the value of @expr{x} (from among the above set of values) for
4152 which @samp{besJ(1,x)} is a maximum. Use an ``automatic'' method,
4153 i.e., just reading along the list by hand to find the largest value
4154 is not allowed! (There is an @kbd{a X} command which does this kind
4155 of thing automatically; @pxref{Numerical Solutions}.)
4156 @xref{List Answer 8, 8}. (@bullet{})
4157
4158 @cindex Digits, vectors of
4159 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 9.} You are given an integer in the range
4160 @texline @math{0 \le N < 10^m}
4161 @infoline @expr{0 <= N < 10^m}
4162 for @expr{m=12} (i.e., an integer of less than
4163 twelve digits). Convert this integer into a vector of @expr{m}
4164 digits, each in the range from 0 to 9. In vector-of-digits notation,
4165 add one to this integer to produce a vector of @expr{m+1} digits
4166 (since there could be a carry out of the most significant digit).
4167 Convert this vector back into a regular integer. A good integer
4168 to try is 25129925999. @xref{List Answer 9, 9}. (@bullet{})
4169
4170 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 10.} Your friend Joe tried to use
4171 @kbd{V R a =} to test if all numbers in a list were equal. What
4172 happened? How would you do this test? @xref{List Answer 10, 10}. (@bullet{})
4173
4174 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 11.} The area of a circle of radius one
4175 is @cpi{}. The area of the
4176 @texline @math{2\times2}
4177 @infoline 2x2
4178 square that encloses that circle is 4. So if we throw @var{n} darts at
4179 random points in the square, about @cpiover{4} of them will land inside
4180 the circle. This gives us an entertaining way to estimate the value of
4181 @cpi{}. The @w{@kbd{k r}}
4182 command picks a random number between zero and the value on the stack.
4183 We could get a random floating-point number between @mathit{-1} and 1 by typing
4184 @w{@kbd{2.0 k r 1 -}}. Build a vector of 100 random @expr{(x,y)} points in
4185 this square, then use vector mapping and reduction to count how many
4186 points lie inside the unit circle. Hint: Use the @kbd{v b} command.
4187 @xref{List Answer 11, 11}. (@bullet{})
4188
4189 @cindex Matchstick problem
4190 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 12.} The @dfn{matchstick problem} provides
4191 another way to calculate @cpi{}. Say you have an infinite field
4192 of vertical lines with a spacing of one inch. Toss a one-inch matchstick
4193 onto the field. The probability that the matchstick will land crossing
4194 a line turns out to be
4195 @texline @math{2/\pi}.
4196 @infoline @expr{2/pi}.
4197 Toss 100 matchsticks to estimate @cpi{}. (If you want still more fun,
4198 the probability that the GCD (@w{@kbd{k g}}) of two large integers is
4199 one turns out to be
4200 @texline @math{6/\pi^2}.
4201 @infoline @expr{6/pi^2}.
4202 That provides yet another way to estimate @cpi{}.)
4203 @xref{List Answer 12, 12}. (@bullet{})
4204
4205 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 13.} An algebraic entry of a string in
4206 double-quote marks, @samp{"hello"}, creates a vector of the numerical
4207 (ASCII) codes of the characters (here, @expr{[104, 101, 108, 108, 111]}).
4208 Sometimes it is convenient to compute a @dfn{hash code} of a string,
4209 which is just an integer that represents the value of that string.
4210 Two equal strings have the same hash code; two different strings
4211 @dfn{probably} have different hash codes. (For example, Calc has
4212 over 400 function names, but Emacs can quickly find the definition for
4213 any given name because it has sorted the functions into ``buckets'' by
4214 their hash codes. Sometimes a few names will hash into the same bucket,
4215 but it is easier to search among a few names than among all the names.)
4216 One popular hash function is computed as follows: First set @expr{h = 0}.
4217 Then, for each character from the string in turn, set @expr{h = 3h + c_i}
4218 where @expr{c_i} is the character's ASCII code. If we have 511 buckets,
4219 we then take the hash code modulo 511 to get the bucket number. Develop a
4220 simple command or commands for converting string vectors into hash codes.
4221 The hash code for @samp{"Testing, 1, 2, 3"} is 1960915098, which modulo
4222 511 is 121. @xref{List Answer 13, 13}. (@bullet{})
4223
4224 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 14.} The @kbd{H V R} and @kbd{H V U}
4225 commands do nested function evaluations. @kbd{H V U} takes a starting
4226 value and a number of steps @var{n} from the stack; it then applies the
4227 function you give to the starting value 0, 1, 2, up to @var{n} times
4228 and returns a vector of the results. Use this command to create a
4229 ``random walk'' of 50 steps. Start with the two-dimensional point
4230 @expr{(0,0)}; then take one step a random distance between @mathit{-1} and 1
4231 in both @expr{x} and @expr{y}; then take another step, and so on. Use the
4232 @kbd{g f} command to display this random walk. Now modify your random
4233 walk to walk a unit distance, but in a random direction, at each step.
4234 (Hint: The @code{sincos} function returns a vector of the cosine and
4235 sine of an angle.) @xref{List Answer 14, 14}. (@bullet{})
4236
4237 @node Types Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Tutorial
4238 @section Types Tutorial
4239
4240 @noindent
4241 Calc understands a variety of data types as well as simple numbers.
4242 In this section, we'll experiment with each of these types in turn.
4243
4244 The numbers we've been using so far have mainly been either @dfn{integers}
4245 or @dfn{floats}. We saw that floats are usually a good approximation to
4246 the mathematical concept of real numbers, but they are only approximations
4247 and are susceptible to roundoff error. Calc also supports @dfn{fractions},
4248 which can exactly represent any rational number.
4249
4250 @smallexample
4251 @group
4252 1: 3628800 2: 3628800 1: 518400:7 1: 518414:7 1: 7:518414
4253 . 1: 49 . . .
4254 .
4255
4256 10 ! 49 @key{RET} : 2 + &
4257 @end group
4258 @end smallexample
4259
4260 @noindent
4261 The @kbd{:} command divides two integers to get a fraction; @kbd{/}
4262 would normally divide integers to get a floating-point result.
4263 Notice we had to type @key{RET} between the @kbd{49} and the @kbd{:}
4264 since the @kbd{:} would otherwise be interpreted as part of a
4265 fraction beginning with 49.
4266
4267 You can convert between floating-point and fractional format using
4268 @kbd{c f} and @kbd{c F}:
4269
4270 @smallexample
4271 @group
4272 1: 1.35027217629e-5 1: 7:518414
4273 . .
4274
4275 c f c F
4276 @end group
4277 @end smallexample
4278
4279 The @kbd{c F} command replaces a floating-point number with the
4280 ``simplest'' fraction whose floating-point representation is the
4281 same, to within the current precision.
4282
4283 @smallexample
4284 @group
4285 1: 3.14159265359 1: 1146408:364913 1: 3.1416 1: 355:113
4286 . . . .
4287
4288 P c F @key{DEL} p 5 @key{RET} P c F
4289 @end group
4290 @end smallexample
4291
4292 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} A calculation has produced the
4293 result 1.26508260337. You suspect it is the square root of the
4294 product of @cpi{} and some rational number. Is it? (Be sure
4295 to allow for roundoff error!) @xref{Types Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
4296
4297 @dfn{Complex numbers} can be stored in both rectangular and polar form.
4298
4299 @smallexample
4300 @group
4301 1: -9 1: (0, 3) 1: (3; 90.) 1: (6; 90.) 1: (2.4495; 45.)
4302 . . . . .
4303
4304 9 n Q c p 2 * Q
4305 @end group
4306 @end smallexample
4307
4308 @noindent
4309 The square root of @mathit{-9} is by default rendered in rectangular form
4310 (@w{@expr{0 + 3i}}), but we can convert it to polar form (3 with a
4311 phase angle of 90 degrees). All the usual arithmetic and scientific
4312 operations are defined on both types of complex numbers.
4313
4314 Another generalized kind of number is @dfn{infinity}. Infinity
4315 isn't really a number, but it can sometimes be treated like one.
4316 Calc uses the symbol @code{inf} to represent positive infinity,
4317 i.e., a value greater than any real number. Naturally, you can
4318 also write @samp{-inf} for minus infinity, a value less than any
4319 real number. The word @code{inf} can only be input using
4320 algebraic entry.
4321
4322 @smallexample
4323 @group
4324 2: inf 2: -inf 2: -inf 2: -inf 1: nan
4325 1: -17 1: -inf 1: -inf 1: inf .
4326 . . . .
4327
4328 ' inf @key{RET} 17 n * @key{RET} 72 + A +
4329 @end group
4330 @end smallexample
4331
4332 @noindent
4333 Since infinity is infinitely large, multiplying it by any finite
4334 number (like @mathit{-17}) has no effect, except that since @mathit{-17}
4335 is negative, it changes a plus infinity to a minus infinity.
4336 (``A huge positive number, multiplied by @mathit{-17}, yields a huge
4337 negative number.'') Adding any finite number to infinity also
4338 leaves it unchanged. Taking an absolute value gives us plus
4339 infinity again. Finally, we add this plus infinity to the minus
4340 infinity we had earlier. If you work it out, you might expect
4341 the answer to be @mathit{-72} for this. But the 72 has been completely
4342 lost next to the infinities; by the time we compute @w{@samp{inf - inf}}
4343 the finite difference between them, if any, is undetectable.
4344 So we say the result is @dfn{indeterminate}, which Calc writes
4345 with the symbol @code{nan} (for Not A Number).
4346
4347 Dividing by zero is normally treated as an error, but you can get
4348 Calc to write an answer in terms of infinity by pressing @kbd{m i}
4349 to turn on Infinite mode.
4350
4351 @smallexample
4352 @group
4353 3: nan 2: nan 2: nan 2: nan 1: nan
4354 2: 1 1: 1 / 0 1: uinf 1: uinf .
4355 1: 0 . . .
4356 .
4357
4358 1 @key{RET} 0 / m i U / 17 n * +
4359 @end group
4360 @end smallexample
4361
4362 @noindent
4363 Dividing by zero normally is left unevaluated, but after @kbd{m i}
4364 it instead gives an infinite result. The answer is actually
4365 @code{uinf}, ``undirected infinity.'' If you look at a graph of
4366 @expr{1 / x} around @w{@expr{x = 0}}, you'll see that it goes toward
4367 plus infinity as you approach zero from above, but toward minus
4368 infinity as you approach from below. Since we said only @expr{1 / 0},
4369 Calc knows that the answer is infinite but not in which direction.
4370 That's what @code{uinf} means. Notice that multiplying @code{uinf}
4371 by a negative number still leaves plain @code{uinf}; there's no
4372 point in saying @samp{-uinf} because the sign of @code{uinf} is
4373 unknown anyway. Finally, we add @code{uinf} to our @code{nan},
4374 yielding @code{nan} again. It's easy to see that, because
4375 @code{nan} means ``totally unknown'' while @code{uinf} means
4376 ``unknown sign but known to be infinite,'' the more mysterious
4377 @code{nan} wins out when it is combined with @code{uinf}, or, for
4378 that matter, with anything else.
4379
4380 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Predict what Calc will answer
4381 for each of these formulas: @samp{inf / inf}, @samp{exp(inf)},
4382 @samp{exp(-inf)}, @samp{sqrt(-inf)}, @samp{sqrt(uinf)},
4383 @samp{abs(uinf)}, @samp{ln(0)}.
4384 @xref{Types Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
4385
4386 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} We saw that @samp{inf - inf = nan},
4387 which stands for an unknown value. Can @code{nan} stand for
4388 a complex number? Can it stand for infinity?
4389 @xref{Types Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
4390
4391 @dfn{HMS forms} represent a value in terms of hours, minutes, and
4392 seconds.
4393
4394 @smallexample
4395 @group
4396 1: 2@@ 30' 0" 1: 3@@ 30' 0" 2: 3@@ 30' 0" 1: 2.
4397 . . 1: 1@@ 45' 0." .
4398 .
4399
4400 2@@ 30' @key{RET} 1 + @key{RET} 2 / /
4401 @end group
4402 @end smallexample
4403
4404 HMS forms can also be used to hold angles in degrees, minutes, and
4405 seconds.
4406
4407 @smallexample
4408 @group
4409 1: 0.5 1: 26.56505 1: 26@@ 33' 54.18" 1: 0.44721
4410 . . . .
4411
4412 0.5 I T c h S
4413 @end group
4414 @end smallexample
4415
4416 @noindent
4417 First we convert the inverse tangent of 0.5 to degrees-minutes-seconds
4418 form, then we take the sine of that angle. Note that the trigonometric
4419 functions will accept HMS forms directly as input.
4420
4421 @cindex Beatles
4422 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} The Beatles' @emph{Abbey Road} is
4423 47 minutes and 26 seconds long, and contains 17 songs. What is the
4424 average length of a song on @emph{Abbey Road}? If the Extended Disco
4425 Version of @emph{Abbey Road} added 20 seconds to the length of each
4426 song, how long would the album be? @xref{Types Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
4427
4428 A @dfn{date form} represents a date, or a date and time. Dates must
4429 be entered using algebraic entry. Date forms are surrounded by
4430 @samp{< >} symbols; most standard formats for dates are recognized.
4431
4432 @smallexample
4433 @group
4434 2: <Sun Jan 13, 1991> 1: 2.25
4435 1: <6:00pm Thu Jan 10, 1991> .
4436 .
4437
4438 ' <13 Jan 1991>, <1/10/91, 6pm> @key{RET} -
4439 @end group
4440 @end smallexample
4441
4442 @noindent
4443 In this example, we enter two dates, then subtract to find the
4444 number of days between them. It is also possible to add an
4445 HMS form or a number (of days) to a date form to get another
4446 date form.
4447
4448 @smallexample
4449 @group
4450 1: <4:45:59pm Mon Jan 14, 1991> 1: <2:50:59am Thu Jan 17, 1991>
4451 . .
4452
4453 t N 2 + 10@@ 5' +
4454 @end group
4455 @end smallexample
4456
4457 @c [fix-ref Date Arithmetic]
4458 @noindent
4459 The @kbd{t N} (``now'') command pushes the current date and time on the
4460 stack; then we add two days, ten hours and five minutes to the date and
4461 time. Other date-and-time related commands include @kbd{t J}, which
4462 does Julian day conversions, @kbd{t W}, which finds the beginning of
4463 the week in which a date form lies, and @kbd{t I}, which increments a
4464 date by one or several months. @xref{Date Arithmetic}, for more.
4465
4466 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} How many days until the next
4467 Friday the 13th? @xref{Types Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
4468
4469 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} How many leap years will there be
4470 between now and the year 10001 A.D.? @xref{Types Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
4471
4472 @cindex Slope and angle of a line
4473 @cindex Angle and slope of a line
4474 An @dfn{error form} represents a mean value with an attached standard
4475 deviation, or error estimate. Suppose our measurements indicate that
4476 a certain telephone pole is about 30 meters away, with an estimated
4477 error of 1 meter, and 8 meters tall, with an estimated error of 0.2
4478 meters. What is the slope of a line from here to the top of the
4479 pole, and what is the equivalent angle in degrees?
4480
4481 @smallexample
4482 @group
4483 1: 8 +/- 0.2 2: 8 +/- 0.2 1: 0.266 +/- 0.011 1: 14.93 +/- 0.594
4484 . 1: 30 +/- 1 . .
4485 .
4486
4487 8 p .2 @key{RET} 30 p 1 / I T
4488 @end group
4489 @end smallexample
4490
4491 @noindent
4492 This means that the angle is about 15 degrees, and, assuming our
4493 original error estimates were valid standard deviations, there is about
4494 a 60% chance that the result is correct within 0.59 degrees.
4495
4496 @cindex Torus, volume of
4497 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 7.} The volume of a torus (a donut shape) is
4498 @texline @math{2 \pi^2 R r^2}
4499 @infoline @w{@expr{2 pi^2 R r^2}}
4500 where @expr{R} is the radius of the circle that
4501 defines the center of the tube and @expr{r} is the radius of the tube
4502 itself. Suppose @expr{R} is 20 cm and @expr{r} is 4 cm, each known to
4503 within 5 percent. What is the volume and the relative uncertainty of
4504 the volume? @xref{Types Answer 7, 7}. (@bullet{})
4505
4506 An @dfn{interval form} represents a range of values. While an
4507 error form is best for making statistical estimates, intervals give
4508 you exact bounds on an answer. Suppose we additionally know that
4509 our telephone pole is definitely between 28 and 31 meters away,
4510 and that it is between 7.7 and 8.1 meters tall.
4511
4512 @smallexample
4513 @group
4514 1: [7.7 .. 8.1] 2: [7.7 .. 8.1] 1: [0.24 .. 0.28] 1: [13.9 .. 16.1]
4515 . 1: [28 .. 31] . .
4516 .
4517
4518 [ 7.7 .. 8.1 ] [ 28 .. 31 ] / I T
4519 @end group
4520 @end smallexample
4521
4522 @noindent
4523 If our bounds were correct, then the angle to the top of the pole
4524 is sure to lie in the range shown.
4525
4526 The square brackets around these intervals indicate that the endpoints
4527 themselves are allowable values. In other words, the distance to the
4528 telephone pole is between 28 and 31, @emph{inclusive}. You can also
4529 make an interval that is exclusive of its endpoints by writing
4530 parentheses instead of square brackets. You can even make an interval
4531 which is inclusive (``closed'') on one end and exclusive (``open'') on
4532 the other.
4533
4534 @smallexample
4535 @group
4536 1: [1 .. 10) 1: (0.1 .. 1] 2: (0.1 .. 1] 1: (0.2 .. 3)
4537 . . 1: [2 .. 3) .
4538 .
4539
4540 [ 1 .. 10 ) & [ 2 .. 3 ) *
4541 @end group
4542 @end smallexample
4543
4544 @noindent
4545 The Calculator automatically keeps track of which end values should
4546 be open and which should be closed. You can also make infinite or
4547 semi-infinite intervals by using @samp{-inf} or @samp{inf} for one
4548 or both endpoints.
4549
4550 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 8.} What answer would you expect from
4551 @samp{@w{1 /} @w{(0 .. 10)}}? What about @samp{@w{1 /} @w{(-10 .. 0)}}? What
4552 about @samp{@w{1 /} @w{[0 .. 10]}} (where the interval actually includes
4553 zero)? What about @samp{@w{1 /} @w{(-10 .. 10)}}?
4554 @xref{Types Answer 8, 8}. (@bullet{})
4555
4556 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 9.} Two easy ways of squaring a number
4557 are @kbd{@key{RET} *} and @w{@kbd{2 ^}}. Normally these produce the same
4558 answer. Would you expect this still to hold true for interval forms?
4559 If not, which of these will result in a larger interval?
4560 @xref{Types Answer 9, 9}. (@bullet{})
4561
4562 A @dfn{modulo form} is used for performing arithmetic modulo @var{m}.
4563 For example, arithmetic involving time is generally done modulo 12
4564 or 24 hours.
4565
4566 @smallexample
4567 @group
4568 1: 17 mod 24 1: 3 mod 24 1: 21 mod 24 1: 9 mod 24
4569 . . . .
4570
4571 17 M 24 @key{RET} 10 + n 5 /
4572 @end group
4573 @end smallexample
4574
4575 @noindent
4576 In this last step, Calc has divided by 5 modulo 24; i.e., it has found a
4577 new number which, when multiplied by 5 modulo 24, produces the original
4578 number, 21. If @var{m} is prime and the divisor is not a multiple of
4579 @var{m}, it is always possible to find such a number. For non-prime
4580 @var{m} like 24, it is only sometimes possible.
4581
4582 @smallexample
4583 @group
4584 1: 10 mod 24 1: 16 mod 24 1: 1000000... 1: 16
4585 . . . .
4586
4587 10 M 24 @key{RET} 100 ^ 10 @key{RET} 100 ^ 24 %
4588 @end group
4589 @end smallexample
4590
4591 @noindent
4592 These two calculations get the same answer, but the first one is
4593 much more efficient because it avoids the huge intermediate value
4594 that arises in the second one.
4595
4596 @cindex Fermat, primality test of
4597 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 10.} A theorem of Pierre de Fermat
4598 says that
4599 @texline @w{@math{x^{n-1} \bmod n = 1}}
4600 @infoline @expr{x^(n-1) mod n = 1}
4601 if @expr{n} is a prime number and @expr{x} is an integer less than
4602 @expr{n}. If @expr{n} is @emph{not} a prime number, this will
4603 @emph{not} be true for most values of @expr{x}. Thus we can test
4604 informally if a number is prime by trying this formula for several
4605 values of @expr{x}. Use this test to tell whether the following numbers
4606 are prime: 811749613, 15485863. @xref{Types Answer 10, 10}. (@bullet{})
4607
4608 It is possible to use HMS forms as parts of error forms, intervals,
4609 modulo forms, or as the phase part of a polar complex number.
4610 For example, the @code{calc-time} command pushes the current time
4611 of day on the stack as an HMS/modulo form.
4612
4613 @smallexample
4614 @group
4615 1: 17@@ 34' 45" mod 24@@ 0' 0" 1: 6@@ 22' 15" mod 24@@ 0' 0"
4616 . .
4617
4618 x time @key{RET} n
4619 @end group
4620 @end smallexample
4621
4622 @noindent
4623 This calculation tells me it is six hours and 22 minutes until midnight.
4624
4625 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 11.} A rule of thumb is that one year
4626 is about
4627 @texline @math{\pi \times 10^7}
4628 @infoline @w{@expr{pi * 10^7}}
4629 seconds. What time will it be that many seconds from right now?
4630 @xref{Types Answer 11, 11}. (@bullet{})
4631
4632 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 12.} You are preparing to order packaging
4633 for the CD release of the Extended Disco Version of @emph{Abbey Road}.
4634 You are told that the songs will actually be anywhere from 20 to 60
4635 seconds longer than the originals. One CD can hold about 75 minutes
4636 of music. Should you order single or double packages?
4637 @xref{Types Answer 12, 12}. (@bullet{})
4638
4639 Another kind of data the Calculator can manipulate is numbers with
4640 @dfn{units}. This isn't strictly a new data type; it's simply an
4641 application of algebraic expressions, where we use variables with
4642 suggestive names like @samp{cm} and @samp{in} to represent units
4643 like centimeters and inches.
4644
4645 @smallexample
4646 @group
4647 1: 2 in 1: 5.08 cm 1: 0.027778 fath 1: 0.0508 m
4648 . . . .
4649
4650 ' 2in @key{RET} u c cm @key{RET} u c fath @key{RET} u b
4651 @end group
4652 @end smallexample
4653
4654 @noindent
4655 We enter the quantity ``2 inches'' (actually an algebraic expression
4656 which means two times the variable @samp{in}), then we convert it
4657 first to centimeters, then to fathoms, then finally to ``base'' units,
4658 which in this case means meters.
4659
4660 @smallexample
4661 @group
4662 1: 9 acre 1: 3 sqrt(acre) 1: 190.84 m 1: 190.84 m + 30 cm
4663 . . . .
4664
4665 ' 9 acre @key{RET} Q u s ' $+30 cm @key{RET}
4666
4667 @end group
4668 @end smallexample
4669 @noindent
4670 @smallexample
4671 @group
4672 1: 191.14 m 1: 36536.3046 m^2 1: 365363046 cm^2
4673 . . .
4674
4675 u s 2 ^ u c cgs
4676 @end group
4677 @end smallexample
4678
4679 @noindent
4680 Since units expressions are really just formulas, taking the square
4681 root of @samp{acre} is undefined. After all, @code{acre} might be an
4682 algebraic variable that you will someday assign a value. We use the
4683 ``units-simplify'' command to simplify the expression with variables
4684 being interpreted as unit names.
4685
4686 In the final step, we have converted not to a particular unit, but to a
4687 units system. The ``cgs'' system uses centimeters instead of meters
4688 as its standard unit of length.
4689
4690 There is a wide variety of units defined in the Calculator.
4691
4692 @smallexample
4693 @group
4694 1: 55 mph 1: 88.5139 kph 1: 88.5139 km / hr 1: 8.201407e-8 c
4695 . . . .
4696
4697 ' 55 mph @key{RET} u c kph @key{RET} u c km/hr @key{RET} u c c @key{RET}
4698 @end group
4699 @end smallexample
4700
4701 @noindent
4702 We express a speed first in miles per hour, then in kilometers per
4703 hour, then again using a slightly more explicit notation, then
4704 finally in terms of fractions of the speed of light.
4705
4706 Temperature conversions are a bit more tricky. There are two ways to
4707 interpret ``20 degrees Fahrenheit''---it could mean an actual
4708 temperature, or it could mean a change in temperature. For normal
4709 units there is no difference, but temperature units have an offset
4710 as well as a scale factor and so there must be two explicit commands
4711 for them.
4712
4713 @smallexample
4714 @group
4715 1: 20 degF 1: 11.1111 degC 1: -20:3 degC 1: -6.666 degC
4716 . . . .
4717
4718 ' 20 degF @key{RET} u c degC @key{RET} U u t degC @key{RET} c f
4719 @end group
4720 @end smallexample
4721
4722 @noindent
4723 First we convert a change of 20 degrees Fahrenheit into an equivalent
4724 change in degrees Celsius (or Centigrade). Then, we convert the
4725 absolute temperature 20 degrees Fahrenheit into Celsius. Since
4726 this comes out as an exact fraction, we then convert to floating-point
4727 for easier comparison with the other result.
4728
4729 For simple unit conversions, you can put a plain number on the stack.
4730 Then @kbd{u c} and @kbd{u t} will prompt for both old and new units.
4731 When you use this method, you're responsible for remembering which
4732 numbers are in which units:
4733
4734 @smallexample
4735 @group
4736 1: 55 1: 88.5139 1: 8.201407e-8
4737 . . .
4738
4739 55 u c mph @key{RET} kph @key{RET} u c km/hr @key{RET} c @key{RET}
4740 @end group
4741 @end smallexample
4742
4743 To see a complete list of built-in units, type @kbd{u v}. Press
4744 @w{@kbd{C-x * c}} again to re-enter the Calculator when you're done looking
4745 at the units table.
4746
4747 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 13.} How many seconds are there really
4748 in a year? @xref{Types Answer 13, 13}. (@bullet{})
4749
4750 @cindex Speed of light
4751 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 14.} Supercomputer designs are limited by
4752 the speed of light (and of electricity, which is nearly as fast).
4753 Suppose a computer has a 4.1 ns (nanosecond) clock cycle, and its
4754 cabinet is one meter across. Is speed of light going to be a
4755 significant factor in its design? @xref{Types Answer 14, 14}. (@bullet{})
4756
4757 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 15.} Sam the Slug normally travels about
4758 five yards in an hour. He has obtained a supply of Power Pills; each
4759 Power Pill he eats doubles his speed. How many Power Pills can he
4760 swallow and still travel legally on most US highways?
4761 @xref{Types Answer 15, 15}. (@bullet{})
4762
4763 @node Algebra Tutorial, Programming Tutorial, Types Tutorial, Tutorial
4764 @section Algebra and Calculus Tutorial
4765
4766 @noindent
4767 This section shows how to use Calc's algebra facilities to solve
4768 equations, do simple calculus problems, and manipulate algebraic
4769 formulas.
4770
4771 @menu
4772 * Basic Algebra Tutorial::
4773 * Rewrites Tutorial::
4774 @end menu
4775
4776 @node Basic Algebra Tutorial, Rewrites Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial
4777 @subsection Basic Algebra
4778
4779 @noindent
4780 If you enter a formula in Algebraic mode that refers to variables,
4781 the formula itself is pushed onto the stack. You can manipulate
4782 formulas as regular data objects.
4783
4784 @smallexample
4785 @group
4786 1: 2 x^2 - 6 1: 6 - 2 x^2 1: (6 - 2 x^2) (3 x^2 + y)
4787 . . .
4788
4789 ' 2x^2-6 @key{RET} n ' 3x^2+y @key{RET} *
4790 @end group
4791 @end smallexample
4792
4793 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Do @kbd{' x @key{RET} Q 2 ^} and
4794 @kbd{' x @key{RET} 2 ^ Q} both wind up with the same result (@samp{x})?
4795 Why or why not? @xref{Algebra Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
4796
4797 There are also commands for doing common algebraic operations on
4798 formulas. Continuing with the formula from the last example,
4799
4800 @smallexample
4801 @group
4802 1: 18 x^2 + 6 y - 6 x^4 - 2 x^2 y 1: (18 - 2 y) x^2 - 6 x^4 + 6 y
4803 . .
4804
4805 a x a c x @key{RET}
4806 @end group
4807 @end smallexample
4808
4809 @noindent
4810 First we ``expand'' using the distributive law, then we ``collect''
4811 terms involving like powers of @expr{x}.
4812
4813 Let's find the value of this expression when @expr{x} is 2 and @expr{y}
4814 is one-half.
4815
4816 @smallexample
4817 @group
4818 1: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: -25
4819 . .
4820
4821 1:2 s l y @key{RET} 2 s l x @key{RET}
4822 @end group
4823 @end smallexample
4824
4825 @noindent
4826 The @kbd{s l} command means ``let''; it takes a number from the top of
4827 the stack and temporarily assigns it as the value of the variable
4828 you specify. It then evaluates (as if by the @kbd{=} key) the
4829 next expression on the stack. After this command, the variable goes
4830 back to its original value, if any.
4831
4832 (An earlier exercise in this tutorial involved storing a value in the
4833 variable @code{x}; if this value is still there, you will have to
4834 unstore it with @kbd{s u x @key{RET}} before the above example will work
4835 properly.)
4836
4837 @cindex Maximum of a function using Calculus
4838 Let's find the maximum value of our original expression when @expr{y}
4839 is one-half and @expr{x} ranges over all possible values. We can
4840 do this by taking the derivative with respect to @expr{x} and examining
4841 values of @expr{x} for which the derivative is zero. If the second
4842 derivative of the function at that value of @expr{x} is negative,
4843 the function has a local maximum there.
4844
4845 @smallexample
4846 @group
4847 1: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: 34 x - 24 x^3
4848 . .
4849
4850 U @key{DEL} s 1 a d x @key{RET} s 2
4851 @end group
4852 @end smallexample
4853
4854 @noindent
4855 Well, the derivative is clearly zero when @expr{x} is zero. To find
4856 the other root(s), let's divide through by @expr{x} and then solve:
4857
4858 @smallexample
4859 @group
4860 1: (34 x - 24 x^3) / x 1: 34 x / x - 24 x^3 / x 1: 34 - 24 x^2
4861 . . .
4862
4863 ' x @key{RET} / a x a s
4864
4865 @end group
4866 @end smallexample
4867 @noindent
4868 @smallexample
4869 @group
4870 1: 34 - 24 x^2 = 0 1: x = 1.19023
4871 . .
4872
4873 0 a = s 3 a S x @key{RET}
4874 @end group
4875 @end smallexample
4876
4877 @noindent
4878 Notice the use of @kbd{a s} to ``simplify'' the formula. When the
4879 default algebraic simplifications don't do enough, you can use
4880 @kbd{a s} to tell Calc to spend more time on the job.
4881
4882 Now we compute the second derivative and plug in our values of @expr{x}:
4883
4884 @smallexample
4885 @group
4886 1: 1.19023 2: 1.19023 2: 1.19023
4887 . 1: 34 x - 24 x^3 1: 34 - 72 x^2
4888 . .
4889
4890 a . r 2 a d x @key{RET} s 4
4891 @end group
4892 @end smallexample
4893
4894 @noindent
4895 (The @kbd{a .} command extracts just the righthand side of an equation.
4896 Another method would have been to use @kbd{v u} to unpack the equation
4897 @w{@samp{x = 1.19}} to @samp{x} and @samp{1.19}, then use @kbd{M-- M-2 @key{DEL}}
4898 to delete the @samp{x}.)
4899
4900 @smallexample
4901 @group
4902 2: 34 - 72 x^2 1: -68. 2: 34 - 72 x^2 1: 34
4903 1: 1.19023 . 1: 0 .
4904 . .
4905
4906 @key{TAB} s l x @key{RET} U @key{DEL} 0 s l x @key{RET}
4907 @end group
4908 @end smallexample
4909
4910 @noindent
4911 The first of these second derivatives is negative, so we know the function
4912 has a maximum value at @expr{x = 1.19023}. (The function also has a
4913 local @emph{minimum} at @expr{x = 0}.)
4914
4915 When we solved for @expr{x}, we got only one value even though
4916 @expr{34 - 24 x^2 = 0} is a quadratic equation that ought to have
4917 two solutions. The reason is that @w{@kbd{a S}} normally returns a
4918 single ``principal'' solution. If it needs to come up with an
4919 arbitrary sign (as occurs in the quadratic formula) it picks @expr{+}.
4920 If it needs an arbitrary integer, it picks zero. We can get a full
4921 solution by pressing @kbd{H} (the Hyperbolic flag) before @kbd{a S}.
4922
4923 @smallexample
4924 @group
4925 1: 34 - 24 x^2 = 0 1: x = 1.19023 s1 1: x = -1.19023
4926 . . .
4927
4928 r 3 H a S x @key{RET} s 5 1 n s l s1 @key{RET}
4929 @end group
4930 @end smallexample
4931
4932 @noindent
4933 Calc has invented the variable @samp{s1} to represent an unknown sign;
4934 it is supposed to be either @mathit{+1} or @mathit{-1}. Here we have used
4935 the ``let'' command to evaluate the expression when the sign is negative.
4936 If we plugged this into our second derivative we would get the same,
4937 negative, answer, so @expr{x = -1.19023} is also a maximum.
4938
4939 To find the actual maximum value, we must plug our two values of @expr{x}
4940 into the original formula.
4941
4942 @smallexample
4943 @group
4944 2: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: 24.08333 s1^2 - 12.04166 s1^4 + 3
4945 1: x = 1.19023 s1 .
4946 .
4947
4948 r 1 r 5 s l @key{RET}
4949 @end group
4950 @end smallexample
4951
4952 @noindent
4953 (Here we see another way to use @kbd{s l}; if its input is an equation
4954 with a variable on the lefthand side, then @kbd{s l} treats the equation
4955 like an assignment to that variable if you don't give a variable name.)
4956
4957 It's clear that this will have the same value for either sign of
4958 @code{s1}, but let's work it out anyway, just for the exercise:
4959
4960 @smallexample
4961 @group
4962 2: [-1, 1] 1: [15.04166, 15.04166]
4963 1: 24.08333 s1^2 ... .
4964 .
4965
4966 [ 1 n , 1 ] @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET}
4967 @end group
4968 @end smallexample
4969
4970 @noindent
4971 Here we have used a vector mapping operation to evaluate the function
4972 at several values of @samp{s1} at once. @kbd{V M $} is like @kbd{V M '}
4973 except that it takes the formula from the top of the stack. The
4974 formula is interpreted as a function to apply across the vector at the
4975 next-to-top stack level. Since a formula on the stack can't contain
4976 @samp{$} signs, Calc assumes the variables in the formula stand for
4977 different arguments. It prompts you for an @dfn{argument list}, giving
4978 the list of all variables in the formula in alphabetical order as the
4979 default list. In this case the default is @samp{(s1)}, which is just
4980 what we want so we simply press @key{RET} at the prompt.
4981
4982 If there had been several different values, we could have used
4983 @w{@kbd{V R X}} to find the global maximum.
4984
4985 Calc has a built-in @kbd{a P} command that solves an equation using
4986 @w{@kbd{H a S}} and returns a vector of all the solutions. It simply
4987 automates the job we just did by hand. Applied to our original
4988 cubic polynomial, it would produce the vector of solutions
4989 @expr{[1.19023, -1.19023, 0]}. (There is also an @kbd{a X} command
4990 which finds a local maximum of a function. It uses a numerical search
4991 method rather than examining the derivatives, and thus requires you
4992 to provide some kind of initial guess to show it where to look.)
4993
4994 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Given a vector of the roots of a
4995 polynomial (such as the output of an @kbd{a P} command), what
4996 sequence of commands would you use to reconstruct the original
4997 polynomial? (The answer will be unique to within a constant
4998 multiple; choose the solution where the leading coefficient is one.)
4999 @xref{Algebra Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
5000
5001 The @kbd{m s} command enables Symbolic mode, in which formulas
5002 like @samp{sqrt(5)} that can't be evaluated exactly are left in
5003 symbolic form rather than giving a floating-point approximate answer.
5004 Fraction mode (@kbd{m f}) is also useful when doing algebra.
5005
5006 @smallexample
5007 @group
5008 2: 34 x - 24 x^3 2: 34 x - 24 x^3
5009 1: 34 x - 24 x^3 1: [sqrt(51) / 6, sqrt(51) / -6, 0]
5010 . .
5011
5012 r 2 @key{RET} m s m f a P x @key{RET}
5013 @end group
5014 @end smallexample
5015
5016 One more mode that makes reading formulas easier is Big mode.
5017
5018 @smallexample
5019 @group
5020 3
5021 2: 34 x - 24 x
5022
5023 ____ ____
5024 V 51 V 51
5025 1: [-----, -----, 0]
5026 6 -6
5027
5028 .
5029
5030 d B
5031 @end group
5032 @end smallexample
5033
5034 Here things like powers, square roots, and quotients and fractions
5035 are displayed in a two-dimensional pictorial form. Calc has other
5036 language modes as well, such as C mode, FORTRAN mode, @TeX{} mode
5037 and La@TeX{} mode.
5038
5039 @smallexample
5040 @group
5041 2: 34*x - 24*pow(x, 3) 2: 34*x - 24*x**3
5042 1: @{sqrt(51) / 6, sqrt(51) / -6, 0@} 1: /sqrt(51) / 6, sqrt(51) / -6, 0/
5043 . .
5044
5045 d C d F
5046
5047 @end group
5048 @end smallexample
5049 @noindent
5050 @smallexample
5051 @group
5052 3: 34 x - 24 x^3
5053 2: [@{\sqrt@{51@} \over 6@}, @{\sqrt@{51@} \over -6@}, 0]
5054 1: @{2 \over 3@} \sqrt@{5@}
5055 .
5056
5057 d T ' 2 \sqrt@{5@} \over 3 @key{RET}
5058 @end group
5059 @end smallexample
5060
5061 @noindent
5062 As you can see, language modes affect both entry and display of
5063 formulas. They affect such things as the names used for built-in
5064 functions, the set of arithmetic operators and their precedences,
5065 and notations for vectors and matrices.
5066
5067 Notice that @samp{sqrt(51)} may cause problems with older
5068 implementations of C and FORTRAN, which would require something more
5069 like @samp{sqrt(51.0)}. It is always wise to check over the formulas
5070 produced by the various language modes to make sure they are fully
5071 correct.
5072
5073 Type @kbd{m s}, @kbd{m f}, and @kbd{d N} to reset these modes. (You
5074 may prefer to remain in Big mode, but all the examples in the tutorial
5075 are shown in normal mode.)
5076
5077 @cindex Area under a curve
5078 What is the area under the portion of this curve from @expr{x = 1} to @expr{2}?
5079 This is simply the integral of the function:
5080
5081 @smallexample
5082 @group
5083 1: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: 5.6666 x^3 - 1.2 x^5 + 3 x
5084 . .
5085
5086 r 1 a i x
5087 @end group
5088 @end smallexample
5089
5090 @noindent
5091 We want to evaluate this at our two values for @expr{x} and subtract.
5092 One way to do it is again with vector mapping and reduction:
5093
5094 @smallexample
5095 @group
5096 2: [2, 1] 1: [12.93333, 7.46666] 1: 5.46666
5097 1: 5.6666 x^3 ... . .
5098
5099 [ 2 , 1 ] @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET} V R -
5100 @end group
5101 @end smallexample
5102
5103 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Find the integral from 1 to @expr{y}
5104 of
5105 @texline @math{x \sin \pi x}
5106 @infoline @w{@expr{x sin(pi x)}}
5107 (where the sine is calculated in radians). Find the values of the
5108 integral for integers @expr{y} from 1 to 5. @xref{Algebra Answer 3,
5109 3}. (@bullet{})
5110
5111 Calc's integrator can do many simple integrals symbolically, but many
5112 others are beyond its capabilities. Suppose we wish to find the area
5113 under the curve
5114 @texline @math{\sin x \ln x}
5115 @infoline @expr{sin(x) ln(x)}
5116 over the same range of @expr{x}. If you entered this formula and typed
5117 @kbd{a i x @key{RET}} (don't bother to try this), Calc would work for a
5118 long time but would be unable to find a solution. In fact, there is no
5119 closed-form solution to this integral. Now what do we do?
5120
5121 @cindex Integration, numerical
5122 @cindex Numerical integration
5123 One approach would be to do the integral numerically. It is not hard
5124 to do this by hand using vector mapping and reduction. It is rather
5125 slow, though, since the sine and logarithm functions take a long time.
5126 We can save some time by reducing the working precision.
5127
5128 @smallexample
5129 @group
5130 3: 10 1: [1, 1.1, 1.2, ... , 1.8, 1.9]
5131 2: 1 .
5132 1: 0.1
5133 .
5134
5135 10 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} .1 @key{RET} C-u v x
5136 @end group
5137 @end smallexample
5138
5139 @noindent
5140 (Note that we have used the extended version of @kbd{v x}; we could
5141 also have used plain @kbd{v x} as follows: @kbd{v x 10 @key{RET} 9 + .1 *}.)
5142
5143 @smallexample
5144 @group
5145 2: [1, 1.1, ... ] 1: [0., 0.084941, 0.16993, ... ]
5146 1: sin(x) ln(x) .
5147 .
5148
5149 ' sin(x) ln(x) @key{RET} s 1 m r p 5 @key{RET} V M $ @key{RET}
5150
5151 @end group
5152 @end smallexample
5153 @noindent
5154 @smallexample
5155 @group
5156 1: 3.4195 0.34195
5157 . .
5158
5159 V R + 0.1 *
5160 @end group
5161 @end smallexample
5162
5163 @noindent
5164 (If you got wildly different results, did you remember to switch
5165 to Radians mode?)
5166
5167 Here we have divided the curve into ten segments of equal width;
5168 approximating these segments as rectangular boxes (i.e., assuming
5169 the curve is nearly flat at that resolution), we compute the areas
5170 of the boxes (height times width), then sum the areas. (It is
5171 faster to sum first, then multiply by the width, since the width
5172 is the same for every box.)
5173
5174 The true value of this integral turns out to be about 0.374, so
5175 we're not doing too well. Let's try another approach.
5176
5177 @smallexample
5178 @group
5179 1: sin(x) ln(x) 1: 0.84147 x - 0.84147 + 0.11957 (x - 1)^2 - ...
5180 . .
5181
5182 r 1 a t x=1 @key{RET} 4 @key{RET}
5183 @end group
5184 @end smallexample
5185
5186 @noindent
5187 Here we have computed the Taylor series expansion of the function
5188 about the point @expr{x=1}. We can now integrate this polynomial
5189 approximation, since polynomials are easy to integrate.
5190
5191 @smallexample
5192 @group
5193 1: 0.42074 x^2 + ... 1: [-0.0446, -0.42073] 1: 0.3761
5194 . . .
5195
5196 a i x @key{RET} [ 2 , 1 ] @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET} V R -
5197 @end group
5198 @end smallexample
5199
5200 @noindent
5201 Better! By increasing the precision and/or asking for more terms
5202 in the Taylor series, we can get a result as accurate as we like.
5203 (Taylor series converge better away from singularities in the
5204 function such as the one at @code{ln(0)}, so it would also help to
5205 expand the series about the points @expr{x=2} or @expr{x=1.5} instead
5206 of @expr{x=1}.)
5207
5208 @cindex Simpson's rule
5209 @cindex Integration by Simpson's rule
5210 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} Our first method approximated the
5211 curve by stairsteps of width 0.1; the total area was then the sum
5212 of the areas of the rectangles under these stairsteps. Our second
5213 method approximated the function by a polynomial, which turned out
5214 to be a better approximation than stairsteps. A third method is
5215 @dfn{Simpson's rule}, which is like the stairstep method except
5216 that the steps are not required to be flat. Simpson's rule boils
5217 down to the formula,
5218
5219 @ifnottex
5220 @example
5221 (h/3) * (f(a) + 4 f(a+h) + 2 f(a+2h) + 4 f(a+3h) + ...
5222 + 2 f(a+(n-2)*h) + 4 f(a+(n-1)*h) + f(a+n*h))
5223 @end example
5224 @end ifnottex
5225 @tex
5226 \turnoffactive
5227 \beforedisplay
5228 $$ \displaylines{
5229 \qquad {h \over 3} (f(a) + 4 f(a+h) + 2 f(a+2h) + 4 f(a+3h) + \cdots
5230 \hfill \cr \hfill {} + 2 f(a+(n-2)h) + 4 f(a+(n-1)h) + f(a+n h)) \qquad
5231 } $$
5232 \afterdisplay
5233 @end tex
5234
5235 @noindent
5236 where @expr{n} (which must be even) is the number of slices and @expr{h}
5237 is the width of each slice. These are 10 and 0.1 in our example.
5238 For reference, here is the corresponding formula for the stairstep
5239 method:
5240
5241 @ifnottex
5242 @example
5243 h * (f(a) + f(a+h) + f(a+2h) + f(a+3h) + ...
5244 + f(a+(n-2)*h) + f(a+(n-1)*h))
5245 @end example
5246 @end ifnottex
5247 @tex
5248 \turnoffactive
5249 \beforedisplay
5250 $$ h (f(a) + f(a+h) + f(a+2h) + f(a+3h) + \cdots
5251 + f(a+(n-2)h) + f(a+(n-1)h)) $$
5252 \afterdisplay
5253 @end tex
5254
5255 Compute the integral from 1 to 2 of
5256 @texline @math{\sin x \ln x}
5257 @infoline @expr{sin(x) ln(x)}
5258 using Simpson's rule with 10 slices.
5259 @xref{Algebra Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
5260
5261 Calc has a built-in @kbd{a I} command for doing numerical integration.
5262 It uses @dfn{Romberg's method}, which is a more sophisticated cousin
5263 of Simpson's rule. In particular, it knows how to keep refining the
5264 result until the current precision is satisfied.
5265
5266 @c [fix-ref Selecting Sub-Formulas]
5267 Aside from the commands we've seen so far, Calc also provides a
5268 large set of commands for operating on parts of formulas. You
5269 indicate the desired sub-formula by placing the cursor on any part
5270 of the formula before giving a @dfn{selection} command. Selections won't
5271 be covered in the tutorial; @pxref{Selecting Subformulas}, for
5272 details and examples.
5273
5274 @c hard exercise: simplify (2^(n r) - 2^(r*(n - 1))) / (2^r - 1) 2^(n - 1)
5275 @c to 2^((n-1)*(r-1)).
5276
5277 @node Rewrites Tutorial, , Basic Algebra Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial
5278 @subsection Rewrite Rules
5279
5280 @noindent
5281 No matter how many built-in commands Calc provided for doing algebra,
5282 there would always be something you wanted to do that Calc didn't have
5283 in its repertoire. So Calc also provides a @dfn{rewrite rule} system
5284 that you can use to define your own algebraic manipulations.
5285
5286 Suppose we want to simplify this trigonometric formula:
5287
5288 @smallexample
5289 @group
5290 1: 1 / cos(x) - sin(x) tan(x)
5291 .
5292
5293 ' 1/cos(x) - sin(x) tan(x) @key{RET} s 1
5294 @end group
5295 @end smallexample
5296
5297 @noindent
5298 If we were simplifying this by hand, we'd probably replace the
5299 @samp{tan} with a @samp{sin/cos} first, then combine over a common
5300 denominator. There is no Calc command to do the former; the @kbd{a n}
5301 algebra command will do the latter but we'll do both with rewrite
5302 rules just for practice.
5303
5304 Rewrite rules are written with the @samp{:=} symbol.
5305
5306 @smallexample
5307 @group
5308 1: 1 / cos(x) - sin(x)^2 / cos(x)
5309 .
5310
5311 a r tan(a) := sin(a)/cos(a) @key{RET}
5312 @end group
5313 @end smallexample
5314
5315 @noindent
5316 (The ``assignment operator'' @samp{:=} has several uses in Calc. All
5317 by itself the formula @samp{tan(a) := sin(a)/cos(a)} doesn't do anything,
5318 but when it is given to the @kbd{a r} command, that command interprets
5319 it as a rewrite rule.)
5320
5321 The lefthand side, @samp{tan(a)}, is called the @dfn{pattern} of the
5322 rewrite rule. Calc searches the formula on the stack for parts that
5323 match the pattern. Variables in a rewrite pattern are called
5324 @dfn{meta-variables}, and when matching the pattern each meta-variable
5325 can match any sub-formula. Here, the meta-variable @samp{a} matched
5326 the actual variable @samp{x}.
5327
5328 When the pattern part of a rewrite rule matches a part of the formula,
5329 that part is replaced by the righthand side with all the meta-variables
5330 substituted with the things they matched. So the result is
5331 @samp{sin(x) / cos(x)}. Calc's normal algebraic simplifications then
5332 mix this in with the rest of the original formula.
5333
5334 To merge over a common denominator, we can use another simple rule:
5335
5336 @smallexample
5337 @group
5338 1: (1 - sin(x)^2) / cos(x)
5339 .
5340
5341 a r a/x + b/x := (a+b)/x @key{RET}
5342 @end group
5343 @end smallexample
5344
5345 This rule points out several interesting features of rewrite patterns.
5346 First, if a meta-variable appears several times in a pattern, it must
5347 match the same thing everywhere. This rule detects common denominators
5348 because the same meta-variable @samp{x} is used in both of the
5349 denominators.
5350
5351 Second, meta-variable names are independent from variables in the
5352 target formula. Notice that the meta-variable @samp{x} here matches
5353 the subformula @samp{cos(x)}; Calc never confuses the two meanings of
5354 @samp{x}.
5355
5356 And third, rewrite patterns know a little bit about the algebraic
5357 properties of formulas. The pattern called for a sum of two quotients;
5358 Calc was able to match a difference of two quotients by matching
5359 @samp{a = 1}, @samp{b = -sin(x)^2}, and @samp{x = cos(x)}.
5360
5361 @c [fix-ref Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules]
5362 We could just as easily have written @samp{a/x - b/x := (a-b)/x} for
5363 the rule. It would have worked just the same in all cases. (If we
5364 really wanted the rule to apply only to @samp{+} or only to @samp{-},
5365 we could have used the @code{plain} symbol. @xref{Algebraic Properties
5366 of Rewrite Rules}, for some examples of this.)
5367
5368 One more rewrite will complete the job. We want to use the identity
5369 @samp{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2 = 1}, but of course we must first rearrange
5370 the identity in a way that matches our formula. The obvious rule
5371 would be @samp{@w{1 - sin(x)^2} := cos(x)^2}, but a little thought shows
5372 that the rule @samp{sin(x)^2 := 1 - cos(x)^2} will also work. The
5373 latter rule has a more general pattern so it will work in many other
5374 situations, too.
5375
5376 @smallexample
5377 @group
5378 1: (1 + cos(x)^2 - 1) / cos(x) 1: cos(x)
5379 . .
5380
5381 a r sin(x)^2 := 1 - cos(x)^2 @key{RET} a s
5382 @end group
5383 @end smallexample
5384
5385 You may ask, what's the point of using the most general rule if you
5386 have to type it in every time anyway? The answer is that Calc allows
5387 you to store a rewrite rule in a variable, then give the variable
5388 name in the @kbd{a r} command. In fact, this is the preferred way to
5389 use rewrites. For one, if you need a rule once you'll most likely
5390 need it again later. Also, if the rule doesn't work quite right you
5391 can simply Undo, edit the variable, and run the rule again without
5392 having to retype it.
5393
5394 @smallexample
5395 @group
5396 ' tan(x) := sin(x)/cos(x) @key{RET} s t tsc @key{RET}
5397 ' a/x + b/x := (a+b)/x @key{RET} s t merge @key{RET}
5398 ' sin(x)^2 := 1 - cos(x)^2 @key{RET} s t sinsqr @key{RET}
5399
5400 1: 1 / cos(x) - sin(x) tan(x) 1: cos(x)
5401 . .
5402
5403 r 1 a r tsc @key{RET} a r merge @key{RET} a r sinsqr @key{RET} a s
5404 @end group
5405 @end smallexample
5406
5407 To edit a variable, type @kbd{s e} and the variable name, use regular
5408 Emacs editing commands as necessary, then type @kbd{C-c C-c} to store
5409 the edited value back into the variable.
5410 You can also use @w{@kbd{s e}} to create a new variable if you wish.
5411
5412 Notice that the first time you use each rule, Calc puts up a ``compiling''
5413 message briefly. The pattern matcher converts rules into a special
5414 optimized pattern-matching language rather than using them directly.
5415 This allows @kbd{a r} to apply even rather complicated rules very
5416 efficiently. If the rule is stored in a variable, Calc compiles it
5417 only once and stores the compiled form along with the variable. That's
5418 another good reason to store your rules in variables rather than
5419 entering them on the fly.
5420
5421 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Type @kbd{m s} to get Symbolic
5422 mode, then enter the formula @samp{@w{(2 + sqrt(2))} / @w{(1 + sqrt(2))}}.
5423 Using a rewrite rule, simplify this formula by multiplying the top and
5424 bottom by the conjugate @w{@samp{1 - sqrt(2)}}. The result will have
5425 to be expanded by the distributive law; do this with another
5426 rewrite. @xref{Rewrites Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
5427
5428 The @kbd{a r} command can also accept a vector of rewrite rules, or
5429 a variable containing a vector of rules.
5430
5431 @smallexample
5432 @group
5433 1: [tsc, merge, sinsqr] 1: [tan(x) := sin(x) / cos(x), ... ]
5434 . .
5435
5436 ' [tsc,merge,sinsqr] @key{RET} =
5437
5438 @end group
5439 @end smallexample
5440 @noindent
5441 @smallexample
5442 @group
5443 1: 1 / cos(x) - sin(x) tan(x) 1: cos(x)
5444 . .
5445
5446 s t trig @key{RET} r 1 a r trig @key{RET} a s
5447 @end group
5448 @end smallexample
5449
5450 @c [fix-ref Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules]
5451 Calc tries all the rules you give against all parts of the formula,
5452 repeating until no further change is possible. (The exact order in
5453 which things are tried is rather complex, but for simple rules like
5454 the ones we've used here the order doesn't really matter.
5455 @xref{Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules}.)
5456
5457 Calc actually repeats only up to 100 times, just in case your rule set
5458 has gotten into an infinite loop. You can give a numeric prefix argument
5459 to @kbd{a r} to specify any limit. In particular, @kbd{M-1 a r} does
5460 only one rewrite at a time.
5461
5462 @smallexample
5463 @group
5464 1: 1 / cos(x) - sin(x)^2 / cos(x) 1: (1 - sin(x)^2) / cos(x)
5465 . .
5466
5467 r 1 M-1 a r trig @key{RET} M-1 a r trig @key{RET}
5468 @end group
5469 @end smallexample
5470
5471 You can type @kbd{M-0 a r} if you want no limit at all on the number
5472 of rewrites that occur.
5473
5474 Rewrite rules can also be @dfn{conditional}. Simply follow the rule
5475 with a @samp{::} symbol and the desired condition. For example,
5476
5477 @smallexample
5478 @group
5479 1: exp(2 pi i) + exp(3 pi i) + exp(4 pi i)
5480 .
5481
5482 ' exp(2 pi i) + exp(3 pi i) + exp(4 pi i) @key{RET}
5483
5484 @end group
5485 @end smallexample
5486 @noindent
5487 @smallexample
5488 @group
5489 1: 1 + exp(3 pi i) + 1
5490 .
5491
5492 a r exp(k pi i) := 1 :: k % 2 = 0 @key{RET}
5493 @end group
5494 @end smallexample
5495
5496 @noindent
5497 (Recall, @samp{k % 2} is the remainder from dividing @samp{k} by 2,
5498 which will be zero only when @samp{k} is an even integer.)
5499
5500 An interesting point is that the variables @samp{pi} and @samp{i}
5501 were matched literally rather than acting as meta-variables.
5502 This is because they are special-constant variables. The special
5503 constants @samp{e}, @samp{phi}, and so on also match literally.
5504 A common error with rewrite
5505 rules is to write, say, @samp{f(a,b,c,d,e) := g(a+b+c+d+e)}, expecting
5506 to match any @samp{f} with five arguments but in fact matching
5507 only when the fifth argument is literally @samp{e}!
5508
5509 @cindex Fibonacci numbers
5510 @ignore
5511 @starindex
5512 @end ignore
5513 @tindex fib
5514 Rewrite rules provide an interesting way to define your own functions.
5515 Suppose we want to define @samp{fib(n)} to produce the @var{n}th
5516 Fibonacci number. The first two Fibonacci numbers are each 1;
5517 later numbers are formed by summing the two preceding numbers in
5518 the sequence. This is easy to express in a set of three rules:
5519
5520 @smallexample
5521 @group
5522 ' [fib(1) := 1, fib(2) := 1, fib(n) := fib(n-1) + fib(n-2)] @key{RET} s t fib
5523
5524 1: fib(7) 1: 13
5525 . .
5526
5527 ' fib(7) @key{RET} a r fib @key{RET}
5528 @end group
5529 @end smallexample
5530
5531 One thing that is guaranteed about the order that rewrites are tried
5532 is that, for any given subformula, earlier rules in the rule set will
5533 be tried for that subformula before later ones. So even though the
5534 first and third rules both match @samp{fib(1)}, we know the first will
5535 be used preferentially.
5536
5537 This rule set has one dangerous bug: Suppose we apply it to the
5538 formula @samp{fib(x)}? (Don't actually try this.) The third rule
5539 will match @samp{fib(x)} and replace it with @w{@samp{fib(x-1) + fib(x-2)}}.
5540 Each of these will then be replaced to get @samp{fib(x-2) + 2 fib(x-3) +
5541 fib(x-4)}, and so on, expanding forever. What we really want is to apply
5542 the third rule only when @samp{n} is an integer greater than two. Type
5543 @w{@kbd{s e fib @key{RET}}}, then edit the third rule to:
5544
5545 @smallexample
5546 fib(n) := fib(n-1) + fib(n-2) :: integer(n) :: n > 2
5547 @end smallexample
5548
5549 @noindent
5550 Now:
5551
5552 @smallexample
5553 @group
5554 1: fib(6) + fib(x) + fib(0) 1: 8 + fib(x) + fib(0)
5555 . .
5556
5557 ' fib(6)+fib(x)+fib(0) @key{RET} a r fib @key{RET}
5558 @end group
5559 @end smallexample
5560
5561 @noindent
5562 We've created a new function, @code{fib}, and a new command,
5563 @w{@kbd{a r fib @key{RET}}}, which means ``evaluate all @code{fib} calls in
5564 this formula.'' To make things easier still, we can tell Calc to
5565 apply these rules automatically by storing them in the special
5566 variable @code{EvalRules}.
5567
5568 @smallexample
5569 @group
5570 1: [fib(1) := ...] . 1: [8, 13]
5571 . .
5572
5573 s r fib @key{RET} s t EvalRules @key{RET} ' [fib(6), fib(7)] @key{RET}
5574 @end group
5575 @end smallexample
5576
5577 It turns out that this rule set has the problem that it does far
5578 more work than it needs to when @samp{n} is large. Consider the
5579 first few steps of the computation of @samp{fib(6)}:
5580
5581 @smallexample
5582 @group
5583 fib(6) =
5584 fib(5) + fib(4) =
5585 fib(4) + fib(3) + fib(3) + fib(2) =
5586 fib(3) + fib(2) + fib(2) + fib(1) + fib(2) + fib(1) + 1 = ...
5587 @end group
5588 @end smallexample
5589
5590 @noindent
5591 Note that @samp{fib(3)} appears three times here. Unless Calc's
5592 algebraic simplifier notices the multiple @samp{fib(3)}s and combines
5593 them (and, as it happens, it doesn't), this rule set does lots of
5594 needless recomputation. To cure the problem, type @code{s e EvalRules}
5595 to edit the rules (or just @kbd{s E}, a shorthand command for editing
5596 @code{EvalRules}) and add another condition:
5597
5598 @smallexample
5599 fib(n) := fib(n-1) + fib(n-2) :: integer(n) :: n > 2 :: remember
5600 @end smallexample
5601
5602 @noindent
5603 If a @samp{:: remember} condition appears anywhere in a rule, then if
5604 that rule succeeds Calc will add another rule that describes that match
5605 to the front of the rule set. (Remembering works in any rule set, but
5606 for technical reasons it is most effective in @code{EvalRules}.) For
5607 example, if the rule rewrites @samp{fib(7)} to something that evaluates
5608 to 13, then the rule @samp{fib(7) := 13} will be added to the rule set.
5609
5610 Type @kbd{' fib(8) @key{RET}} to compute the eighth Fibonacci number, then
5611 type @kbd{s E} again to see what has happened to the rule set.
5612
5613 With the @code{remember} feature, our rule set can now compute
5614 @samp{fib(@var{n})} in just @var{n} steps. In the process it builds
5615 up a table of all Fibonacci numbers up to @var{n}. After we have
5616 computed the result for a particular @var{n}, we can get it back
5617 (and the results for all smaller @var{n}) later in just one step.
5618
5619 All Calc operations will run somewhat slower whenever @code{EvalRules}
5620 contains any rules. You should type @kbd{s u EvalRules @key{RET}} now to
5621 un-store the variable.
5622
5623 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Sometimes it is possible to reformulate
5624 a problem to reduce the amount of recursion necessary to solve it.
5625 Create a rule that, in about @var{n} simple steps and without recourse
5626 to the @code{remember} option, replaces @samp{fib(@var{n}, 1, 1)} with
5627 @samp{fib(1, @var{x}, @var{y})} where @var{x} and @var{y} are the
5628 @var{n}th and @var{n+1}st Fibonacci numbers, respectively. This rule is
5629 rather clunky to use, so add a couple more rules to make the ``user
5630 interface'' the same as for our first version: enter @samp{fib(@var{n})},
5631 get back a plain number. @xref{Rewrites Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
5632
5633 There are many more things that rewrites can do. For example, there
5634 are @samp{&&&} and @samp{|||} pattern operators that create ``and''
5635 and ``or'' combinations of rules. As one really simple example, we
5636 could combine our first two Fibonacci rules thusly:
5637
5638 @example
5639 [fib(1 ||| 2) := 1, fib(n) := ... ]
5640 @end example
5641
5642 @noindent
5643 That means ``@code{fib} of something matching either 1 or 2 rewrites
5644 to 1.''
5645
5646 You can also make meta-variables optional by enclosing them in @code{opt}.
5647 For example, the pattern @samp{a + b x} matches @samp{2 + 3 x} but not
5648 @samp{2 + x} or @samp{3 x} or @samp{x}. The pattern @samp{opt(a) + opt(b) x}
5649 matches all of these forms, filling in a default of zero for @samp{a}
5650 and one for @samp{b}.
5651
5652 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Your friend Joe had @samp{2 + 3 x}
5653 on the stack and tried to use the rule
5654 @samp{opt(a) + opt(b) x := f(a, b, x)}. What happened?
5655 @xref{Rewrites Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
5656
5657 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} Starting with a positive integer @expr{a},
5658 divide @expr{a} by two if it is even, otherwise compute @expr{3 a + 1}.
5659 Now repeat this step over and over. A famous unproved conjecture
5660 is that for any starting @expr{a}, the sequence always eventually
5661 reaches 1. Given the formula @samp{seq(@var{a}, 0)}, write a set of
5662 rules that convert this into @samp{seq(1, @var{n})} where @var{n}
5663 is the number of steps it took the sequence to reach the value 1.
5664 Now enhance the rules to accept @samp{seq(@var{a})} as a starting
5665 configuration, and to stop with just the number @var{n} by itself.
5666 Now make the result be a vector of values in the sequence, from @var{a}
5667 to 1. (The formula @samp{@var{x}|@var{y}} appends the vectors @var{x}
5668 and @var{y}.) For example, rewriting @samp{seq(6)} should yield the
5669 vector @expr{[6, 3, 10, 5, 16, 8, 4, 2, 1]}.
5670 @xref{Rewrites Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
5671
5672 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} Define, using rewrite rules, a function
5673 @samp{nterms(@var{x})} that returns the number of terms in the sum
5674 @var{x}, or 1 if @var{x} is not a sum. (A @dfn{sum} for our purposes
5675 is one or more non-sum terms separated by @samp{+} or @samp{-} signs,
5676 so that @expr{2 - 3 (x + y) + x y} is a sum of three terms.)
5677 @xref{Rewrites Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
5678
5679 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} A Taylor series for a function is an
5680 infinite series that exactly equals the value of that function at
5681 values of @expr{x} near zero.
5682
5683 @ifnottex
5684 @example
5685 cos(x) = 1 - x^2 / 2! + x^4 / 4! - x^6 / 6! + ...
5686 @end example
5687 @end ifnottex
5688 @tex
5689 \turnoffactive
5690 \beforedisplay
5691 $$ \cos x = 1 - {x^2 \over 2!} + {x^4 \over 4!} - {x^6 \over 6!} + \cdots $$
5692 \afterdisplay
5693 @end tex
5694
5695 The @kbd{a t} command produces a @dfn{truncated Taylor series} which
5696 is obtained by dropping all the terms higher than, say, @expr{x^2}.
5697 Calc represents the truncated Taylor series as a polynomial in @expr{x}.
5698 Mathematicians often write a truncated series using a ``big-O'' notation
5699 that records what was the lowest term that was truncated.
5700
5701 @ifnottex
5702 @example
5703 cos(x) = 1 - x^2 / 2! + O(x^3)
5704 @end example
5705 @end ifnottex
5706 @tex
5707 \turnoffactive
5708 \beforedisplay
5709 $$ \cos x = 1 - {x^2 \over 2!} + O(x^3) $$
5710 \afterdisplay
5711 @end tex
5712
5713 @noindent
5714 The meaning of @expr{O(x^3)} is ``a quantity which is negligibly small
5715 if @expr{x^3} is considered negligibly small as @expr{x} goes to zero.''
5716
5717 The exercise is to create rewrite rules that simplify sums and products of
5718 power series represented as @samp{@var{polynomial} + O(@var{var}^@var{n})}.
5719 For example, given @samp{1 - x^2 / 2 + O(x^3)} and @samp{x - x^3 / 6 + O(x^4)}
5720 on the stack, we want to be able to type @kbd{*} and get the result
5721 @samp{x - 2:3 x^3 + O(x^4)}. Don't worry if the terms of the sum are
5722 rearranged or if @kbd{a s} needs to be typed after rewriting. (This one
5723 is rather tricky; the solution at the end of this chapter uses 6 rewrite
5724 rules. Hint: The @samp{constant(x)} condition tests whether @samp{x} is
5725 a number.) @xref{Rewrites Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
5726
5727 Just for kicks, try adding the rule @code{2+3 := 6} to @code{EvalRules}.
5728 What happens? (Be sure to remove this rule afterward, or you might get
5729 a nasty surprise when you use Calc to balance your checkbook!)
5730
5731 @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for the whole story on rewrite rules.
5732
5733 @node Programming Tutorial, Answers to Exercises, Algebra Tutorial, Tutorial
5734 @section Programming Tutorial
5735
5736 @noindent
5737 The Calculator is written entirely in Emacs Lisp, a highly extensible
5738 language. If you know Lisp, you can program the Calculator to do
5739 anything you like. Rewrite rules also work as a powerful programming
5740 system. But Lisp and rewrite rules take a while to master, and often
5741 all you want to do is define a new function or repeat a command a few
5742 times. Calc has features that allow you to do these things easily.
5743
5744 One very limited form of programming is defining your own functions.
5745 Calc's @kbd{Z F} command allows you to define a function name and
5746 key sequence to correspond to any formula. Programming commands use
5747 the shift-@kbd{Z} prefix; the user commands they create use the lower
5748 case @kbd{z} prefix.
5749
5750 @smallexample
5751 @group
5752 1: 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 1: 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6
5753 . .
5754
5755 ' 1 + x + x^2/2! + x^3/3! @key{RET} Z F e myexp @key{RET} @key{RET} @key{RET} y
5756 @end group
5757 @end smallexample
5758
5759 This polynomial is a Taylor series approximation to @samp{exp(x)}.
5760 The @kbd{Z F} command asks a number of questions. The above answers
5761 say that the key sequence for our function should be @kbd{z e}; the
5762 @kbd{M-x} equivalent should be @code{calc-myexp}; the name of the
5763 function in algebraic formulas should also be @code{myexp}; the
5764 default argument list @samp{(x)} is acceptable; and finally @kbd{y}
5765 answers the question ``leave it in symbolic form for non-constant
5766 arguments?''
5767
5768 @smallexample
5769 @group
5770 1: 1.3495 2: 1.3495 3: 1.3495
5771 . 1: 1.34986 2: 1.34986
5772 . 1: myexp(a + 1)
5773 .
5774
5775 .3 z e .3 E ' a+1 @key{RET} z e
5776 @end group
5777 @end smallexample
5778
5779 @noindent
5780 First we call our new @code{exp} approximation with 0.3 as an
5781 argument, and compare it with the true @code{exp} function. Then
5782 we note that, as requested, if we try to give @kbd{z e} an
5783 argument that isn't a plain number, it leaves the @code{myexp}
5784 function call in symbolic form. If we had answered @kbd{n} to the
5785 final question, @samp{myexp(a + 1)} would have evaluated by plugging
5786 in @samp{a + 1} for @samp{x} in the defining formula.
5787
5788 @cindex Sine integral Si(x)
5789 @ignore
5790 @starindex
5791 @end ignore
5792 @tindex Si
5793 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} The ``sine integral'' function
5794 @texline @math{{\rm Si}(x)}
5795 @infoline @expr{Si(x)}
5796 is defined as the integral of @samp{sin(t)/t} for
5797 @expr{t = 0} to @expr{x} in radians. (It was invented because this
5798 integral has no solution in terms of basic functions; if you give it
5799 to Calc's @kbd{a i} command, it will ponder it for a long time and then
5800 give up.) We can use the numerical integration command, however,
5801 which in algebraic notation is written like @samp{ninteg(f(t), t, 0, x)}
5802 with any integrand @samp{f(t)}. Define a @kbd{z s} command and
5803 @code{Si} function that implement this. You will need to edit the
5804 default argument list a bit. As a test, @samp{Si(1)} should return
5805 0.946083. (If you don't get this answer, you might want to check that
5806 Calc is in Radians mode. Also, @code{ninteg} will run a lot faster if
5807 you reduce the precision to, say, six digits beforehand.)
5808 @xref{Programming Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
5809
5810 The simplest way to do real ``programming'' of Emacs is to define a
5811 @dfn{keyboard macro}. A keyboard macro is simply a sequence of
5812 keystrokes which Emacs has stored away and can play back on demand.
5813 For example, if you find yourself typing @kbd{H a S x @key{RET}} often,
5814 you may wish to program a keyboard macro to type this for you.
5815
5816 @smallexample
5817 @group
5818 1: y = sqrt(x) 1: x = y^2
5819 . .
5820
5821 ' y=sqrt(x) @key{RET} C-x ( H a S x @key{RET} C-x )
5822
5823 1: y = cos(x) 1: x = s1 arccos(y) + 2 pi n1
5824 . .
5825
5826 ' y=cos(x) @key{RET} X
5827 @end group
5828 @end smallexample
5829
5830 @noindent
5831 When you type @kbd{C-x (}, Emacs begins recording. But it is also
5832 still ready to execute your keystrokes, so you're really ``training''
5833 Emacs by walking it through the procedure once. When you type
5834 @w{@kbd{C-x )}}, the macro is recorded. You can now type @kbd{X} to
5835 re-execute the same keystrokes.
5836
5837 You can give a name to your macro by typing @kbd{Z K}.
5838
5839 @smallexample
5840 @group
5841 1: . 1: y = x^4 1: x = s2 sqrt(s1 sqrt(y))
5842 . .
5843
5844 Z K x @key{RET} ' y=x^4 @key{RET} z x
5845 @end group
5846 @end smallexample
5847
5848 @noindent
5849 Notice that we use shift-@kbd{Z} to define the command, and lower-case
5850 @kbd{z} to call it up.
5851
5852 Keyboard macros can call other macros.
5853
5854 @smallexample
5855 @group
5856 1: abs(x) 1: x = s1 y 1: 2 / x 1: x = 2 / y
5857 . . . .
5858
5859 ' abs(x) @key{RET} C-x ( ' y @key{RET} a = z x C-x ) ' 2/x @key{RET} X
5860 @end group
5861 @end smallexample
5862
5863 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Define a keyboard macro to negate
5864 the item in level 3 of the stack, without disturbing the rest of
5865 the stack. @xref{Programming Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
5866
5867 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Define keyboard macros to compute
5868 the following functions:
5869
5870 @enumerate
5871 @item
5872 Compute
5873 @texline @math{\displaystyle{\sin x \over x}},
5874 @infoline @expr{sin(x) / x},
5875 where @expr{x} is the number on the top of the stack.
5876
5877 @item
5878 Compute the base-@expr{b} logarithm, just like the @kbd{B} key except
5879 the arguments are taken in the opposite order.
5880
5881 @item
5882 Produce a vector of integers from 1 to the integer on the top of
5883 the stack.
5884 @end enumerate
5885 @noindent
5886 @xref{Programming Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
5887
5888 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} Define a keyboard macro to compute
5889 the average (mean) value of a list of numbers.
5890 @xref{Programming Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
5891
5892 In many programs, some of the steps must execute several times.
5893 Calc has @dfn{looping} commands that allow this. Loops are useful
5894 inside keyboard macros, but actually work at any time.
5895
5896 @smallexample
5897 @group
5898 1: x^6 2: x^6 1: 360 x^2
5899 . 1: 4 .
5900 .
5901
5902 ' x^6 @key{RET} 4 Z < a d x @key{RET} Z >
5903 @end group
5904 @end smallexample
5905
5906 @noindent
5907 Here we have computed the fourth derivative of @expr{x^6} by
5908 enclosing a derivative command in a ``repeat loop'' structure.
5909 This structure pops a repeat count from the stack, then
5910 executes the body of the loop that many times.
5911
5912 If you make a mistake while entering the body of the loop,
5913 type @w{@kbd{Z C-g}} to cancel the loop command.
5914
5915 @cindex Fibonacci numbers
5916 Here's another example:
5917
5918 @smallexample
5919 @group
5920 3: 1 2: 10946
5921 2: 1 1: 17711
5922 1: 20 .
5923 .
5924
5925 1 @key{RET} @key{RET} 20 Z < @key{TAB} C-j + Z >
5926 @end group
5927 @end smallexample
5928
5929 @noindent
5930 The numbers in levels 2 and 1 should be the 21st and 22nd Fibonacci
5931 numbers, respectively. (To see what's going on, try a few repetitions
5932 of the loop body by hand; @kbd{C-j}, also on the Line-Feed or @key{LFD}
5933 key if you have one, makes a copy of the number in level 2.)
5934
5935 @cindex Golden ratio
5936 @cindex Phi, golden ratio
5937 A fascinating property of the Fibonacci numbers is that the @expr{n}th
5938 Fibonacci number can be found directly by computing
5939 @texline @math{\phi^n / \sqrt{5}}
5940 @infoline @expr{phi^n / sqrt(5)}
5941 and then rounding to the nearest integer, where
5942 @texline @math{\phi} (``phi''),
5943 @infoline @expr{phi},
5944 the ``golden ratio,'' is
5945 @texline @math{(1 + \sqrt{5}) / 2}.
5946 @infoline @expr{(1 + sqrt(5)) / 2}.
5947 (For convenience, this constant is available from the @code{phi}
5948 variable, or the @kbd{I H P} command.)
5949
5950 @smallexample
5951 @group
5952 1: 1.61803 1: 24476.0000409 1: 10945.9999817 1: 10946
5953 . . . .
5954
5955 I H P 21 ^ 5 Q / R
5956 @end group
5957 @end smallexample
5958
5959 @cindex Continued fractions
5960 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} The @dfn{continued fraction}
5961 representation of
5962 @texline @math{\phi}
5963 @infoline @expr{phi}
5964 is
5965 @texline @math{1 + 1/(1 + 1/(1 + 1/( \ldots )))}.
5966 @infoline @expr{1 + 1/(1 + 1/(1 + 1/( ...@: )))}.
5967 We can compute an approximate value by carrying this however far
5968 and then replacing the innermost
5969 @texline @math{1/( \ldots )}
5970 @infoline @expr{1/( ...@: )}
5971 by 1. Approximate
5972 @texline @math{\phi}
5973 @infoline @expr{phi}
5974 using a twenty-term continued fraction.
5975 @xref{Programming Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
5976
5977 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} Linear recurrences like the one for
5978 Fibonacci numbers can be expressed in terms of matrices. Given a
5979 vector @w{@expr{[a, b]}} determine a matrix which, when multiplied by this
5980 vector, produces the vector @expr{[b, c]}, where @expr{a}, @expr{b} and
5981 @expr{c} are three successive Fibonacci numbers. Now write a program
5982 that, given an integer @expr{n}, computes the @expr{n}th Fibonacci number
5983 using matrix arithmetic. @xref{Programming Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
5984
5985 @cindex Harmonic numbers
5986 A more sophisticated kind of loop is the @dfn{for} loop. Suppose
5987 we wish to compute the 20th ``harmonic'' number, which is equal to
5988 the sum of the reciprocals of the integers from 1 to 20.
5989
5990 @smallexample
5991 @group
5992 3: 0 1: 3.597739
5993 2: 1 .
5994 1: 20
5995 .
5996
5997 0 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} 20 Z ( & + 1 Z )
5998 @end group
5999 @end smallexample
6000
6001 @noindent
6002 The ``for'' loop pops two numbers, the lower and upper limits, then
6003 repeats the body of the loop as an internal counter increases from
6004 the lower limit to the upper one. Just before executing the loop
6005 body, it pushes the current loop counter. When the loop body
6006 finishes, it pops the ``step,'' i.e., the amount by which to
6007 increment the loop counter. As you can see, our loop always
6008 uses a step of one.
6009
6010 This harmonic number function uses the stack to hold the running
6011 total as well as for the various loop housekeeping functions. If
6012 you find this disorienting, you can sum in a variable instead:
6013
6014 @smallexample
6015 @group
6016 1: 0 2: 1 . 1: 3.597739
6017 . 1: 20 .
6018 .
6019
6020 0 t 7 1 @key{RET} 20 Z ( & s + 7 1 Z ) r 7
6021 @end group
6022 @end smallexample
6023
6024 @noindent
6025 The @kbd{s +} command adds the top-of-stack into the value in a
6026 variable (and removes that value from the stack).
6027
6028 It's worth noting that many jobs that call for a ``for'' loop can
6029 also be done more easily by Calc's high-level operations. Two
6030 other ways to compute harmonic numbers are to use vector mapping
6031 and reduction (@kbd{v x 20}, then @w{@kbd{V M &}}, then @kbd{V R +}),
6032 or to use the summation command @kbd{a +}. Both of these are
6033 probably easier than using loops. However, there are some
6034 situations where loops really are the way to go:
6035
6036 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 7.} Use a ``for'' loop to find the first
6037 harmonic number which is greater than 4.0.
6038 @xref{Programming Answer 7, 7}. (@bullet{})
6039
6040 Of course, if we're going to be using variables in our programs,
6041 we have to worry about the programs clobbering values that the
6042 caller was keeping in those same variables. This is easy to
6043 fix, though:
6044
6045 @smallexample
6046 @group
6047 . 1: 0.6667 1: 0.6667 3: 0.6667
6048 . . 2: 3.597739
6049 1: 0.6667
6050 .
6051
6052 Z ` p 4 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 / s 7 s s a @key{RET} Z ' r 7 s r a @key{RET}
6053 @end group
6054 @end smallexample
6055
6056 @noindent
6057 When we type @kbd{Z `} (that's a back-quote character), Calc saves
6058 its mode settings and the contents of the ten ``quick variables''
6059 for later reference. When we type @kbd{Z '} (that's an apostrophe
6060 now), Calc restores those saved values. Thus the @kbd{p 4} and
6061 @kbd{s 7} commands have no effect outside this sequence. Wrapping
6062 this around the body of a keyboard macro ensures that it doesn't
6063 interfere with what the user of the macro was doing. Notice that
6064 the contents of the stack, and the values of named variables,
6065 survive past the @kbd{Z '} command.
6066
6067 @cindex Bernoulli numbers, approximate
6068 The @dfn{Bernoulli numbers} are a sequence with the interesting
6069 property that all of the odd Bernoulli numbers are zero, and the
6070 even ones, while difficult to compute, can be roughly approximated
6071 by the formula
6072 @texline @math{\displaystyle{2 n! \over (2 \pi)^n}}.
6073 @infoline @expr{2 n!@: / (2 pi)^n}.
6074 Let's write a keyboard macro to compute (approximate) Bernoulli numbers.
6075 (Calc has a command, @kbd{k b}, to compute exact Bernoulli numbers, but
6076 this command is very slow for large @expr{n} since the higher Bernoulli
6077 numbers are very large fractions.)
6078
6079 @smallexample
6080 @group
6081 1: 10 1: 0.0756823
6082 . .
6083
6084 10 C-x ( @key{RET} 2 % Z [ @key{DEL} 0 Z : ' 2 $! / (2 pi)^$ @key{RET} = Z ] C-x )
6085 @end group
6086 @end smallexample
6087
6088 @noindent
6089 You can read @kbd{Z [} as ``then,'' @kbd{Z :} as ``else,'' and
6090 @kbd{Z ]} as ``end-if.'' There is no need for an explicit ``if''
6091 command. For the purposes of @w{@kbd{Z [}}, the condition is ``true''
6092 if the value it pops from the stack is a nonzero number, or ``false''
6093 if it pops zero or something that is not a number (like a formula).
6094 Here we take our integer argument modulo 2; this will be nonzero
6095 if we're asking for an odd Bernoulli number.
6096
6097 The actual tenth Bernoulli number is @expr{5/66}.
6098
6099 @smallexample
6100 @group
6101 3: 0.0756823 1: 0 1: 0.25305 1: 0 1: 1.16659
6102 2: 5:66 . . . .
6103 1: 0.0757575
6104 .
6105
6106 10 k b @key{RET} c f M-0 @key{DEL} 11 X @key{DEL} 12 X @key{DEL} 13 X @key{DEL} 14 X
6107 @end group
6108 @end smallexample
6109
6110 Just to exercise loops a bit more, let's compute a table of even
6111 Bernoulli numbers.
6112
6113 @smallexample
6114 @group
6115 3: [] 1: [0.10132, 0.03079, 0.02340, 0.033197, ...]
6116 2: 2 .
6117 1: 30
6118 .
6119
6120 [ ] 2 @key{RET} 30 Z ( X | 2 Z )
6121 @end group
6122 @end smallexample
6123
6124 @noindent
6125 The vertical-bar @kbd{|} is the vector-concatenation command. When
6126 we execute it, the list we are building will be in stack level 2
6127 (initially this is an empty list), and the next Bernoulli number
6128 will be in level 1. The effect is to append the Bernoulli number
6129 onto the end of the list. (To create a table of exact fractional
6130 Bernoulli numbers, just replace @kbd{X} with @kbd{k b} in the above
6131 sequence of keystrokes.)
6132
6133 With loops and conditionals, you can program essentially anything
6134 in Calc. One other command that makes looping easier is @kbd{Z /},
6135 which takes a condition from the stack and breaks out of the enclosing
6136 loop if the condition is true (non-zero). You can use this to make
6137 ``while'' and ``until'' style loops.
6138
6139 If you make a mistake when entering a keyboard macro, you can edit
6140 it using @kbd{Z E}. First, you must attach it to a key with @kbd{Z K}.
6141 One technique is to enter a throwaway dummy definition for the macro,
6142 then enter the real one in the edit command.
6143
6144 @smallexample
6145 @group
6146 1: 3 1: 3 Calc Macro Edit Mode.
6147 . . Original keys: 1 <return> 2 +
6148
6149 1 ;; calc digits
6150 RET ;; calc-enter
6151 2 ;; calc digits
6152 + ;; calc-plus
6153
6154 C-x ( 1 @key{RET} 2 + C-x ) Z K h @key{RET} Z E h
6155 @end group
6156 @end smallexample
6157
6158 @noindent
6159 A keyboard macro is stored as a pure keystroke sequence. The
6160 @file{edmacro} package (invoked by @kbd{Z E}) scans along the
6161 macro and tries to decode it back into human-readable steps.
6162 Descriptions of the keystrokes are given as comments, which begin with
6163 @samp{;;}, and which are ignored when the edited macro is saved.
6164 Spaces and line breaks are also ignored when the edited macro is saved.
6165 To enter a space into the macro, type @code{SPC}. All the special
6166 characters @code{RET}, @code{LFD}, @code{TAB}, @code{SPC}, @code{DEL},
6167 and @code{NUL} must be written in all uppercase, as must the prefixes
6168 @code{C-} and @code{M-}.
6169
6170 Let's edit in a new definition, for computing harmonic numbers.
6171 First, erase the four lines of the old definition. Then, type
6172 in the new definition (or use Emacs @kbd{M-w} and @kbd{C-y} commands
6173 to copy it from this page of the Info file; you can of course skip
6174 typing the comments, which begin with @samp{;;}).
6175
6176 @smallexample
6177 Z` ;; calc-kbd-push (Save local values)
6178 0 ;; calc digits (Push a zero onto the stack)
6179 st ;; calc-store-into (Store it in the following variable)
6180 1 ;; calc quick variable (Quick variable q1)
6181 1 ;; calc digits (Initial value for the loop)
6182 TAB ;; calc-roll-down (Swap initial and final)
6183 Z( ;; calc-kbd-for (Begin the "for" loop)
6184 & ;; calc-inv (Take the reciprocal)
6185 s+ ;; calc-store-plus (Add to the following variable)
6186 1 ;; calc quick variable (Quick variable q1)
6187 1 ;; calc digits (The loop step is 1)
6188 Z) ;; calc-kbd-end-for (End the "for" loop)
6189 sr ;; calc-recall (Recall the final accumulated value)
6190 1 ;; calc quick variable (Quick variable q1)
6191 Z' ;; calc-kbd-pop (Restore values)
6192 @end smallexample
6193
6194 @noindent
6195 Press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing and return to the Calculator.
6196
6197 @smallexample
6198 @group
6199 1: 20 1: 3.597739
6200 . .
6201
6202 20 z h
6203 @end group
6204 @end smallexample
6205
6206 The @file{edmacro} package defines a handy @code{read-kbd-macro} command
6207 which reads the current region of the current buffer as a sequence of
6208 keystroke names, and defines that sequence on the @kbd{X}
6209 (and @kbd{C-x e}) key. Because this is so useful, Calc puts this
6210 command on the @kbd{C-x * m} key. Try reading in this macro in the
6211 following form: Press @kbd{C-@@} (or @kbd{C-@key{SPC}}) at
6212 one end of the text below, then type @kbd{C-x * m} at the other.
6213
6214 @example
6215 @group
6216 Z ` 0 t 1
6217 1 TAB
6218 Z ( & s + 1 1 Z )
6219 r 1
6220 Z '
6221 @end group
6222 @end example
6223
6224 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 8.} A general algorithm for solving
6225 equations numerically is @dfn{Newton's Method}. Given the equation
6226 @expr{f(x) = 0} for any function @expr{f}, and an initial guess
6227 @expr{x_0} which is reasonably close to the desired solution, apply
6228 this formula over and over:
6229
6230 @ifnottex
6231 @example
6232 new_x = x - f(x)/f'(x)
6233 @end example
6234 @end ifnottex
6235 @tex
6236 \beforedisplay
6237 $$ x_{\rm new} = x - {f(x) \over f'(x)} $$
6238 \afterdisplay
6239 @end tex
6240
6241 @noindent
6242 where @expr{f'(x)} is the derivative of @expr{f}. The @expr{x}
6243 values will quickly converge to a solution, i.e., eventually
6244 @texline @math{x_{\rm new}}
6245 @infoline @expr{new_x}
6246 and @expr{x} will be equal to within the limits
6247 of the current precision. Write a program which takes a formula
6248 involving the variable @expr{x}, and an initial guess @expr{x_0},
6249 on the stack, and produces a value of @expr{x} for which the formula
6250 is zero. Use it to find a solution of
6251 @texline @math{\sin(\cos x) = 0.5}
6252 @infoline @expr{sin(cos(x)) = 0.5}
6253 near @expr{x = 4.5}. (Use angles measured in radians.) Note that
6254 the built-in @w{@kbd{a R}} (@code{calc-find-root}) command uses Newton's
6255 method when it is able. @xref{Programming Answer 8, 8}. (@bullet{})
6256
6257 @cindex Digamma function
6258 @cindex Gamma constant, Euler's
6259 @cindex Euler's gamma constant
6260 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 9.} The @dfn{digamma} function
6261 @texline @math{\psi(z) (``psi'')}
6262 @infoline @expr{psi(z)}
6263 is defined as the derivative of
6264 @texline @math{\ln \Gamma(z)}.
6265 @infoline @expr{ln(gamma(z))}.
6266 For large values of @expr{z}, it can be approximated by the infinite sum
6267
6268 @ifnottex
6269 @example
6270 psi(z) ~= ln(z) - 1/2z - sum(bern(2 n) / 2 n z^(2 n), n, 1, inf)
6271 @end example
6272 @end ifnottex
6273 @tex
6274 \beforedisplay
6275 $$ \psi(z) \approx \ln z - {1\over2z} -
6276 \sum_{n=1}^\infty {\code{bern}(2 n) \over 2 n z^{2n}}
6277 $$
6278 \afterdisplay
6279 @end tex
6280
6281 @noindent
6282 where
6283 @texline @math{\sum}
6284 @infoline @expr{sum}
6285 represents the sum over @expr{n} from 1 to infinity
6286 (or to some limit high enough to give the desired accuracy), and
6287 the @code{bern} function produces (exact) Bernoulli numbers.
6288 While this sum is not guaranteed to converge, in practice it is safe.
6289 An interesting mathematical constant is Euler's gamma, which is equal
6290 to about 0.5772. One way to compute it is by the formula,
6291 @texline @math{\gamma = -\psi(1)}.
6292 @infoline @expr{gamma = -psi(1)}.
6293 Unfortunately, 1 isn't a large enough argument
6294 for the above formula to work (5 is a much safer value for @expr{z}).
6295 Fortunately, we can compute
6296 @texline @math{\psi(1)}
6297 @infoline @expr{psi(1)}
6298 from
6299 @texline @math{\psi(5)}
6300 @infoline @expr{psi(5)}
6301 using the recurrence
6302 @texline @math{\psi(z+1) = \psi(z) + {1 \over z}}.
6303 @infoline @expr{psi(z+1) = psi(z) + 1/z}.
6304 Your task: Develop a program to compute
6305 @texline @math{\psi(z)};
6306 @infoline @expr{psi(z)};
6307 it should ``pump up'' @expr{z}
6308 if necessary to be greater than 5, then use the above summation
6309 formula. Use looping commands to compute the sum. Use your function
6310 to compute
6311 @texline @math{\gamma}
6312 @infoline @expr{gamma}
6313 to twelve decimal places. (Calc has a built-in command
6314 for Euler's constant, @kbd{I P}, which you can use to check your answer.)
6315 @xref{Programming Answer 9, 9}. (@bullet{})
6316
6317 @cindex Polynomial, list of coefficients
6318 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 10.} Given a polynomial in @expr{x} and
6319 a number @expr{m} on the stack, where the polynomial is of degree
6320 @expr{m} or less (i.e., does not have any terms higher than @expr{x^m}),
6321 write a program to convert the polynomial into a list-of-coefficients
6322 notation. For example, @expr{5 x^4 + (x + 1)^2} with @expr{m = 6}
6323 should produce the list @expr{[1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0]}. Also develop
6324 a way to convert from this form back to the standard algebraic form.
6325 @xref{Programming Answer 10, 10}. (@bullet{})
6326
6327 @cindex Recursion
6328 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 11.} The @dfn{Stirling numbers of the
6329 first kind} are defined by the recurrences,
6330
6331 @ifnottex
6332 @example
6333 s(n,n) = 1 for n >= 0,
6334 s(n,0) = 0 for n > 0,
6335 s(n+1,m) = s(n,m-1) - n s(n,m) for n >= m >= 1.
6336 @end example
6337 @end ifnottex
6338 @tex
6339 \turnoffactive
6340 \beforedisplay
6341 $$ \eqalign{ s(n,n) &= 1 \qquad \hbox{for } n \ge 0, \cr
6342 s(n,0) &= 0 \qquad \hbox{for } n > 0, \cr
6343 s(n+1,m) &= s(n,m-1) - n \, s(n,m) \qquad
6344 \hbox{for } n \ge m \ge 1.}
6345 $$
6346 \afterdisplay
6347 \vskip5pt
6348 (These numbers are also sometimes written $\displaystyle{n \brack m}$.)
6349 @end tex
6350
6351 This can be implemented using a @dfn{recursive} program in Calc; the
6352 program must invoke itself in order to calculate the two righthand
6353 terms in the general formula. Since it always invokes itself with
6354 ``simpler'' arguments, it's easy to see that it must eventually finish
6355 the computation. Recursion is a little difficult with Emacs keyboard
6356 macros since the macro is executed before its definition is complete.
6357 So here's the recommended strategy: Create a ``dummy macro'' and assign
6358 it to a key with, e.g., @kbd{Z K s}. Now enter the true definition,
6359 using the @kbd{z s} command to call itself recursively, then assign it
6360 to the same key with @kbd{Z K s}. Now the @kbd{z s} command will run
6361 the complete recursive program. (Another way is to use @w{@kbd{Z E}}
6362 or @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro}) to read the whole macro at once,
6363 thus avoiding the ``training'' phase.) The task: Write a program
6364 that computes Stirling numbers of the first kind, given @expr{n} and
6365 @expr{m} on the stack. Test it with @emph{small} inputs like
6366 @expr{s(4,2)}. (There is a built-in command for Stirling numbers,
6367 @kbd{k s}, which you can use to check your answers.)
6368 @xref{Programming Answer 11, 11}. (@bullet{})
6369
6370 The programming commands we've seen in this part of the tutorial
6371 are low-level, general-purpose operations. Often you will find
6372 that a higher-level function, such as vector mapping or rewrite
6373 rules, will do the job much more easily than a detailed, step-by-step
6374 program can:
6375
6376 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 12.} Write another program for
6377 computing Stirling numbers of the first kind, this time using
6378 rewrite rules. Once again, @expr{n} and @expr{m} should be taken
6379 from the stack. @xref{Programming Answer 12, 12}. (@bullet{})
6380
6381 @example
6382
6383 @end example
6384 This ends the tutorial section of the Calc manual. Now you know enough
6385 about Calc to use it effectively for many kinds of calculations. But
6386 Calc has many features that were not even touched upon in this tutorial.
6387 @c [not-split]
6388 The rest of this manual tells the whole story.
6389 @c [when-split]
6390 @c Volume II of this manual, the @dfn{Calc Reference}, tells the whole story.
6391
6392 @page
6393 @node Answers to Exercises, , Programming Tutorial, Tutorial
6394 @section Answers to Exercises
6395
6396 @noindent
6397 This section includes answers to all the exercises in the Calc tutorial.
6398
6399 @menu
6400 * RPN Answer 1:: 1 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 + * -
6401 * RPN Answer 2:: 2*4 + 7*9.5 + 5/4
6402 * RPN Answer 3:: Operating on levels 2 and 3
6403 * RPN Answer 4:: Joe's complex problems
6404 * Algebraic Answer 1:: Simulating Q command
6405 * Algebraic Answer 2:: Joe's algebraic woes
6406 * Algebraic Answer 3:: 1 / 0
6407 * Modes Answer 1:: 3#0.1 = 3#0.0222222?
6408 * Modes Answer 2:: 16#f.e8fe15
6409 * Modes Answer 3:: Joe's rounding bug
6410 * Modes Answer 4:: Why floating point?
6411 * Arithmetic Answer 1:: Why the \ command?
6412 * Arithmetic Answer 2:: Tripping up the B command
6413 * Vector Answer 1:: Normalizing a vector
6414 * Vector Answer 2:: Average position
6415 * Matrix Answer 1:: Row and column sums
6416 * Matrix Answer 2:: Symbolic system of equations
6417 * Matrix Answer 3:: Over-determined system
6418 * List Answer 1:: Powers of two
6419 * List Answer 2:: Least-squares fit with matrices
6420 * List Answer 3:: Geometric mean
6421 * List Answer 4:: Divisor function
6422 * List Answer 5:: Duplicate factors
6423 * List Answer 6:: Triangular list
6424 * List Answer 7:: Another triangular list
6425 * List Answer 8:: Maximum of Bessel function
6426 * List Answer 9:: Integers the hard way
6427 * List Answer 10:: All elements equal
6428 * List Answer 11:: Estimating pi with darts
6429 * List Answer 12:: Estimating pi with matchsticks
6430 * List Answer 13:: Hash codes
6431 * List Answer 14:: Random walk
6432 * Types Answer 1:: Square root of pi times rational
6433 * Types Answer 2:: Infinities
6434 * Types Answer 3:: What can "nan" be?
6435 * Types Answer 4:: Abbey Road
6436 * Types Answer 5:: Friday the 13th
6437 * Types Answer 6:: Leap years
6438 * Types Answer 7:: Erroneous donut
6439 * Types Answer 8:: Dividing intervals
6440 * Types Answer 9:: Squaring intervals
6441 * Types Answer 10:: Fermat's primality test
6442 * Types Answer 11:: pi * 10^7 seconds
6443 * Types Answer 12:: Abbey Road on CD
6444 * Types Answer 13:: Not quite pi * 10^7 seconds
6445 * Types Answer 14:: Supercomputers and c
6446 * Types Answer 15:: Sam the Slug
6447 * Algebra Answer 1:: Squares and square roots
6448 * Algebra Answer 2:: Building polynomial from roots
6449 * Algebra Answer 3:: Integral of x sin(pi x)
6450 * Algebra Answer 4:: Simpson's rule
6451 * Rewrites Answer 1:: Multiplying by conjugate
6452 * Rewrites Answer 2:: Alternative fib rule
6453 * Rewrites Answer 3:: Rewriting opt(a) + opt(b) x
6454 * Rewrites Answer 4:: Sequence of integers
6455 * Rewrites Answer 5:: Number of terms in sum
6456 * Rewrites Answer 6:: Truncated Taylor series
6457 * Programming Answer 1:: Fresnel's C(x)
6458 * Programming Answer 2:: Negate third stack element
6459 * Programming Answer 3:: Compute sin(x) / x, etc.
6460 * Programming Answer 4:: Average value of a list
6461 * Programming Answer 5:: Continued fraction phi
6462 * Programming Answer 6:: Matrix Fibonacci numbers
6463 * Programming Answer 7:: Harmonic number greater than 4
6464 * Programming Answer 8:: Newton's method
6465 * Programming Answer 9:: Digamma function
6466 * Programming Answer 10:: Unpacking a polynomial
6467 * Programming Answer 11:: Recursive Stirling numbers
6468 * Programming Answer 12:: Stirling numbers with rewrites
6469 @end menu
6470
6471 @c The following kludgery prevents the individual answers from
6472 @c being entered on the table of contents.
6473 @tex
6474 \global\let\oldwrite=\write
6475 \gdef\skipwrite#1#2{\let\write=\oldwrite}
6476 \global\let\oldchapternofonts=\chapternofonts
6477 \gdef\chapternofonts{\let\write=\skipwrite\oldchapternofonts}
6478 @end tex
6479
6480 @node RPN Answer 1, RPN Answer 2, Answers to Exercises, Answers to Exercises
6481 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 1
6482
6483 @noindent
6484 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 + * -}
6485
6486 The result is
6487 @texline @math{1 - (2 \times (3 + 4)) = -13}.
6488 @infoline @expr{1 - (2 * (3 + 4)) = -13}.
6489
6490 @node RPN Answer 2, RPN Answer 3, RPN Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6491 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 2
6492
6493 @noindent
6494 @texline @math{2\times4 + 7\times9.5 + {5\over4} = 75.75}
6495 @infoline @expr{2*4 + 7*9.5 + 5/4 = 75.75}
6496
6497 After computing the intermediate term
6498 @texline @math{2\times4 = 8},
6499 @infoline @expr{2*4 = 8},
6500 you can leave that result on the stack while you compute the second
6501 term. With both of these results waiting on the stack you can then
6502 compute the final term, then press @kbd{+ +} to add everything up.
6503
6504 @smallexample
6505 @group
6506 2: 2 1: 8 3: 8 2: 8
6507 1: 4 . 2: 7 1: 66.5
6508 . 1: 9.5 .
6509 .
6510
6511 2 @key{RET} 4 * 7 @key{RET} 9.5 *
6512
6513 @end group
6514 @end smallexample
6515 @noindent
6516 @smallexample
6517 @group
6518 4: 8 3: 8 2: 8 1: 75.75
6519 3: 66.5 2: 66.5 1: 67.75 .
6520 2: 5 1: 1.25 .
6521 1: 4 .
6522 .
6523
6524 5 @key{RET} 4 / + +
6525 @end group
6526 @end smallexample
6527
6528 Alternatively, you could add the first two terms before going on
6529 with the third term.
6530
6531 @smallexample
6532 @group
6533 2: 8 1: 74.5 3: 74.5 2: 74.5 1: 75.75
6534 1: 66.5 . 2: 5 1: 1.25 .
6535 . 1: 4 .
6536 .
6537
6538 ... + 5 @key{RET} 4 / +
6539 @end group
6540 @end smallexample
6541
6542 On an old-style RPN calculator this second method would have the
6543 advantage of using only three stack levels. But since Calc's stack
6544 can grow arbitrarily large this isn't really an issue. Which method
6545 you choose is purely a matter of taste.
6546
6547 @node RPN Answer 3, RPN Answer 4, RPN Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6548 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 3
6549
6550 @noindent
6551 The @key{TAB} key provides a way to operate on the number in level 2.
6552
6553 @smallexample
6554 @group
6555 3: 10 3: 10 4: 10 3: 10 3: 10
6556 2: 20 2: 30 3: 30 2: 30 2: 21
6557 1: 30 1: 20 2: 20 1: 21 1: 30
6558 . . 1: 1 . .
6559 .
6560
6561 @key{TAB} 1 + @key{TAB}
6562 @end group
6563 @end smallexample
6564
6565 Similarly, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} gives you access to the number in level 3.
6566
6567 @smallexample
6568 @group
6569 3: 10 3: 21 3: 21 3: 30 3: 11
6570 2: 21 2: 30 2: 30 2: 11 2: 21
6571 1: 30 1: 10 1: 11 1: 21 1: 30
6572 . . . . .
6573
6574 M-@key{TAB} 1 + M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB}
6575 @end group
6576 @end smallexample
6577
6578 @node RPN Answer 4, Algebraic Answer 1, RPN Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
6579 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 4
6580
6581 @noindent
6582 Either @kbd{( 2 , 3 )} or @kbd{( 2 @key{SPC} 3 )} would have worked,
6583 but using both the comma and the space at once yields:
6584
6585 @smallexample
6586 @group
6587 1: ( ... 2: ( ... 1: (2, ... 2: (2, ... 2: (2, ...
6588 . 1: 2 . 1: (2, ... 1: (2, 3)
6589 . . .
6590
6591 ( 2 , @key{SPC} 3 )
6592 @end group
6593 @end smallexample
6594
6595 Joe probably tried to type @kbd{@key{TAB} @key{DEL}} to swap the
6596 extra incomplete object to the top of the stack and delete it.
6597 But a feature of Calc is that @key{DEL} on an incomplete object
6598 deletes just one component out of that object, so he had to press
6599 @key{DEL} twice to finish the job.
6600
6601 @smallexample
6602 @group
6603 2: (2, ... 2: (2, 3) 2: (2, 3) 1: (2, 3)
6604 1: (2, 3) 1: (2, ... 1: ( ... .
6605 . . .
6606
6607 @key{TAB} @key{DEL} @key{DEL}
6608 @end group
6609 @end smallexample
6610
6611 (As it turns out, deleting the second-to-top stack entry happens often
6612 enough that Calc provides a special key, @kbd{M-@key{DEL}}, to do just that.
6613 @kbd{M-@key{DEL}} is just like @kbd{@key{TAB} @key{DEL}}, except that it doesn't exhibit
6614 the ``feature'' that tripped poor Joe.)
6615
6616 @node Algebraic Answer 1, Algebraic Answer 2, RPN Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
6617 @subsection Algebraic Entry Tutorial Exercise 1
6618
6619 @noindent
6620 Type @kbd{' sqrt($) @key{RET}}.
6621
6622 If the @kbd{Q} key is broken, you could use @kbd{' $^0.5 @key{RET}}.
6623 Or, RPN style, @kbd{0.5 ^}.
6624
6625 (Actually, @samp{$^1:2}, using the fraction one-half as the power, is
6626 a closer equivalent, since @samp{9^0.5} yields @expr{3.0} whereas
6627 @samp{sqrt(9)} and @samp{9^1:2} yield the exact integer @expr{3}.)
6628
6629 @node Algebraic Answer 2, Algebraic Answer 3, Algebraic Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6630 @subsection Algebraic Entry Tutorial Exercise 2
6631
6632 @noindent
6633 In the formula @samp{2 x (1+y)}, @samp{x} was interpreted as a function
6634 name with @samp{1+y} as its argument. Assigning a value to a variable
6635 has no relation to a function by the same name. Joe needed to use an
6636 explicit @samp{*} symbol here: @samp{2 x*(1+y)}.
6637
6638 @node Algebraic Answer 3, Modes Answer 1, Algebraic Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6639 @subsection Algebraic Entry Tutorial Exercise 3
6640
6641 @noindent
6642 The result from @kbd{1 @key{RET} 0 /} will be the formula @expr{1 / 0}.
6643 The ``function'' @samp{/} cannot be evaluated when its second argument
6644 is zero, so it is left in symbolic form. When you now type @kbd{0 *},
6645 the result will be zero because Calc uses the general rule that ``zero
6646 times anything is zero.''
6647
6648 @c [fix-ref Infinities]
6649 The @kbd{m i} command enables an @dfn{Infinite mode} in which @expr{1 / 0}
6650 results in a special symbol that represents ``infinity.'' If you
6651 multiply infinity by zero, Calc uses another special new symbol to
6652 show that the answer is ``indeterminate.'' @xref{Infinities}, for
6653 further discussion of infinite and indeterminate values.
6654
6655 @node Modes Answer 1, Modes Answer 2, Algebraic Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
6656 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 1
6657
6658 @noindent
6659 Calc always stores its numbers in decimal, so even though one-third has
6660 an exact base-3 representation (@samp{3#0.1}), it is still stored as
6661 0.3333333 (chopped off after 12 or however many decimal digits) inside
6662 the calculator's memory. When this inexact number is converted back
6663 to base 3 for display, it may still be slightly inexact. When we
6664 multiply this number by 3, we get 0.999999, also an inexact value.
6665
6666 When Calc displays a number in base 3, it has to decide how many digits
6667 to show. If the current precision is 12 (decimal) digits, that corresponds
6668 to @samp{12 / log10(3) = 25.15} base-3 digits. Because 25.15 is not an
6669 exact integer, Calc shows only 25 digits, with the result that stored
6670 numbers carry a little bit of extra information that may not show up on
6671 the screen. When Joe entered @samp{3#0.2}, the stored number 0.666666
6672 happened to round to a pleasing value when it lost that last 0.15 of a
6673 digit, but it was still inexact in Calc's memory. When he divided by 2,
6674 he still got the dreaded inexact value 0.333333. (Actually, he divided
6675 0.666667 by 2 to get 0.333334, which is why he got something a little
6676 higher than @code{3#0.1} instead of a little lower.)
6677
6678 If Joe didn't want to be bothered with all this, he could have typed
6679 @kbd{M-24 d n} to display with one less digit than the default. (If
6680 you give @kbd{d n} a negative argument, it uses default-minus-that,
6681 so @kbd{M-- d n} would be an easier way to get the same effect.) Those
6682 inexact results would still be lurking there, but they would now be
6683 rounded to nice, natural-looking values for display purposes. (Remember,
6684 @samp{0.022222} in base 3 is like @samp{0.099999} in base 10; rounding
6685 off one digit will round the number up to @samp{0.1}.) Depending on the
6686 nature of your work, this hiding of the inexactness may be a benefit or
6687 a danger. With the @kbd{d n} command, Calc gives you the choice.
6688
6689 Incidentally, another consequence of all this is that if you type
6690 @kbd{M-30 d n} to display more digits than are ``really there,''
6691 you'll see garbage digits at the end of the number. (In decimal
6692 display mode, with decimally-stored numbers, these garbage digits are
6693 always zero so they vanish and you don't notice them.) Because Calc
6694 rounds off that 0.15 digit, there is the danger that two numbers could
6695 be slightly different internally but still look the same. If you feel
6696 uneasy about this, set the @kbd{d n} precision to be a little higher
6697 than normal; you'll get ugly garbage digits, but you'll always be able
6698 to tell two distinct numbers apart.
6699
6700 An interesting side note is that most computers store their
6701 floating-point numbers in binary, and convert to decimal for display.
6702 Thus everyday programs have the same problem: Decimal 0.1 cannot be
6703 represented exactly in binary (try it: @kbd{0.1 d 2}), so @samp{0.1 * 10}
6704 comes out as an inexact approximation to 1 on some machines (though
6705 they generally arrange to hide it from you by rounding off one digit as
6706 we did above). Because Calc works in decimal instead of binary, you can
6707 be sure that numbers that look exact @emph{are} exact as long as you stay
6708 in decimal display mode.
6709
6710 It's not hard to show that any number that can be represented exactly
6711 in binary, octal, or hexadecimal is also exact in decimal, so the kinds
6712 of problems we saw in this exercise are likely to be severe only when
6713 you use a relatively unusual radix like 3.
6714
6715 @node Modes Answer 2, Modes Answer 3, Modes Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6716 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 2
6717
6718 If the radix is 15 or higher, we can't use the letter @samp{e} to mark
6719 the exponent because @samp{e} is interpreted as a digit. When Calc
6720 needs to display scientific notation in a high radix, it writes
6721 @samp{16#F.E8F*16.^15}. You can enter a number like this as an
6722 algebraic entry. Also, pressing @kbd{e} without any digits before it
6723 normally types @kbd{1e}, but in a high radix it types @kbd{16.^} and
6724 puts you in algebraic entry: @kbd{16#f.e8f @key{RET} e 15 @key{RET} *} is another
6725 way to enter this number.
6726
6727 The reason Calc puts a decimal point in the @samp{16.^} is to prevent
6728 huge integers from being generated if the exponent is large (consider
6729 @samp{16#1.23*16^1000}, where we compute @samp{16^1000} as a giant
6730 exact integer and then throw away most of the digits when we multiply
6731 it by the floating-point @samp{16#1.23}). While this wouldn't normally
6732 matter for display purposes, it could give you a nasty surprise if you
6733 copied that number into a file and later moved it back into Calc.
6734
6735 @node Modes Answer 3, Modes Answer 4, Modes Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6736 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 3
6737
6738 @noindent
6739 The answer he got was @expr{0.5000000000006399}.
6740
6741 The problem is not that the square operation is inexact, but that the
6742 sine of 45 that was already on the stack was accurate to only 12 places.
6743 Arbitrary-precision calculations still only give answers as good as
6744 their inputs.
6745
6746 The real problem is that there is no 12-digit number which, when
6747 squared, comes out to 0.5 exactly. The @kbd{f [} and @kbd{f ]}
6748 commands decrease or increase a number by one unit in the last
6749 place (according to the current precision). They are useful for
6750 determining facts like this.
6751
6752 @smallexample
6753 @group
6754 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.500000000001
6755 . .
6756
6757 45 S 2 ^
6758
6759 @end group
6760 @end smallexample
6761 @noindent
6762 @smallexample
6763 @group
6764 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.707106781186 1: 0.499999999999
6765 . . .
6766
6767 U @key{DEL} f [ 2 ^
6768 @end group
6769 @end smallexample
6770
6771 A high-precision calculation must be carried out in high precision
6772 all the way. The only number in the original problem which was known
6773 exactly was the quantity 45 degrees, so the precision must be raised
6774 before anything is done after the number 45 has been entered in order
6775 for the higher precision to be meaningful.
6776
6777 @node Modes Answer 4, Arithmetic Answer 1, Modes Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
6778 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 4
6779
6780 @noindent
6781 Many calculations involve real-world quantities, like the width and
6782 height of a piece of wood or the volume of a jar. Such quantities
6783 can't be measured exactly anyway, and if the data that is input to
6784 a calculation is inexact, doing exact arithmetic on it is a waste
6785 of time.
6786
6787 Fractions become unwieldy after too many calculations have been
6788 done with them. For example, the sum of the reciprocals of the
6789 integers from 1 to 10 is 7381:2520. The sum from 1 to 30 is
6790 9304682830147:2329089562800. After a point it will take a long
6791 time to add even one more term to this sum, but a floating-point
6792 calculation of the sum will not have this problem.
6793
6794 Also, rational numbers cannot express the results of all calculations.
6795 There is no fractional form for the square root of two, so if you type
6796 @w{@kbd{2 Q}}, Calc has no choice but to give you a floating-point answer.
6797
6798 @node Arithmetic Answer 1, Arithmetic Answer 2, Modes Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
6799 @subsection Arithmetic Tutorial Exercise 1
6800
6801 @noindent
6802 Dividing two integers that are larger than the current precision may
6803 give a floating-point result that is inaccurate even when rounded
6804 down to an integer. Consider @expr{123456789 / 2} when the current
6805 precision is 6 digits. The true answer is @expr{61728394.5}, but
6806 with a precision of 6 this will be rounded to
6807 @texline @math{12345700.0/2.0 = 61728500.0}.
6808 @infoline @expr{12345700.@: / 2.@: = 61728500.}.
6809 The result, when converted to an integer, will be off by 106.
6810
6811 Here are two solutions: Raise the precision enough that the
6812 floating-point round-off error is strictly to the right of the
6813 decimal point. Or, convert to Fraction mode so that @expr{123456789 / 2}
6814 produces the exact fraction @expr{123456789:2}, which can be rounded
6815 down by the @kbd{F} command without ever switching to floating-point
6816 format.
6817
6818 @node Arithmetic Answer 2, Vector Answer 1, Arithmetic Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6819 @subsection Arithmetic Tutorial Exercise 2
6820
6821 @noindent
6822 @kbd{27 @key{RET} 9 B} could give the exact result @expr{3:2}, but it
6823 does a floating-point calculation instead and produces @expr{1.5}.
6824
6825 Calc will find an exact result for a logarithm if the result is an integer
6826 or (when in Fraction mode) the reciprocal of an integer. But there is
6827 no efficient way to search the space of all possible rational numbers
6828 for an exact answer, so Calc doesn't try.
6829
6830 @node Vector Answer 1, Vector Answer 2, Arithmetic Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6831 @subsection Vector Tutorial Exercise 1
6832
6833 @noindent
6834 Duplicate the vector, compute its length, then divide the vector
6835 by its length: @kbd{@key{RET} A /}.
6836
6837 @smallexample
6838 @group
6839 1: [1, 2, 3] 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: [0.27, 0.53, 0.80] 1: 1.
6840 . 1: 3.74165738677 . .
6841 .
6842
6843 r 1 @key{RET} A / A
6844 @end group
6845 @end smallexample
6846
6847 The final @kbd{A} command shows that the normalized vector does
6848 indeed have unit length.
6849
6850 @node Vector Answer 2, Matrix Answer 1, Vector Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6851 @subsection Vector Tutorial Exercise 2
6852
6853 @noindent
6854 The average position is equal to the sum of the products of the
6855 positions times their corresponding probabilities. This is the
6856 definition of the dot product operation. So all you need to do
6857 is to put the two vectors on the stack and press @kbd{*}.
6858
6859 @node Matrix Answer 1, Matrix Answer 2, Vector Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6860 @subsection Matrix Tutorial Exercise 1
6861
6862 @noindent
6863 The trick is to multiply by a vector of ones. Use @kbd{r 4 [1 1 1] *} to
6864 get the row sum. Similarly, use @kbd{[1 1] r 4 *} to get the column sum.
6865
6866 @node Matrix Answer 2, Matrix Answer 3, Matrix Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6867 @subsection Matrix Tutorial Exercise 2
6868
6869 @ifnottex
6870 @example
6871 @group
6872 x + a y = 6
6873 x + b y = 10
6874 @end group
6875 @end example
6876 @end ifnottex
6877 @tex
6878 \turnoffactive
6879 \beforedisplay
6880 $$ \eqalign{ x &+ a y = 6 \cr
6881 x &+ b y = 10}
6882 $$
6883 \afterdisplay
6884 @end tex
6885
6886 Just enter the righthand side vector, then divide by the lefthand side
6887 matrix as usual.
6888
6889 @smallexample
6890 @group
6891 1: [6, 10] 2: [6, 10] 1: [6 - 4 a / (b - a), 4 / (b - a) ]
6892 . 1: [ [ 1, a ] .
6893 [ 1, b ] ]
6894 .
6895
6896 ' [6 10] @key{RET} ' [1 a; 1 b] @key{RET} /
6897 @end group
6898 @end smallexample
6899
6900 This can be made more readable using @kbd{d B} to enable Big display
6901 mode:
6902
6903 @smallexample
6904 @group
6905 4 a 4
6906 1: [6 - -----, -----]
6907 b - a b - a
6908 @end group
6909 @end smallexample
6910
6911 Type @kbd{d N} to return to Normal display mode afterwards.
6912
6913 @node Matrix Answer 3, List Answer 1, Matrix Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6914 @subsection Matrix Tutorial Exercise 3
6915
6916 @noindent
6917 To solve
6918 @texline @math{A^T A \, X = A^T B},
6919 @infoline @expr{trn(A) * A * X = trn(A) * B},
6920 first we compute
6921 @texline @math{A' = A^T A}
6922 @infoline @expr{A2 = trn(A) * A}
6923 and
6924 @texline @math{B' = A^T B};
6925 @infoline @expr{B2 = trn(A) * B};
6926 now, we have a system
6927 @texline @math{A' X = B'}
6928 @infoline @expr{A2 * X = B2}
6929 which we can solve using Calc's @samp{/} command.
6930
6931 @ifnottex
6932 @example
6933 @group
6934 a + 2b + 3c = 6
6935 4a + 5b + 6c = 2
6936 7a + 6b = 3
6937 2a + 4b + 6c = 11
6938 @end group
6939 @end example
6940 @end ifnottex
6941 @tex
6942 \turnoffactive
6943 \beforedisplayh
6944 $$ \openup1\jot \tabskip=0pt plus1fil
6945 \halign to\displaywidth{\tabskip=0pt
6946 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
6947 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
6948 $\hfil#$&${}#\hfil$\tabskip=0pt plus1fil\cr
6949 a&+&2b&+&3c&=6 \cr
6950 4a&+&5b&+&6c&=2 \cr
6951 7a&+&6b& & &=3 \cr
6952 2a&+&4b&+&6c&=11 \cr}
6953 $$
6954 \afterdisplayh
6955 @end tex
6956
6957 The first step is to enter the coefficient matrix. We'll store it in
6958 quick variable number 7 for later reference. Next, we compute the
6959 @texline @math{B'}
6960 @infoline @expr{B2}
6961 vector.
6962
6963 @smallexample
6964 @group
6965 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 2: [ [ 1, 4, 7, 2 ] 1: [57, 84, 96]
6966 [ 4, 5, 6 ] [ 2, 5, 6, 4 ] .
6967 [ 7, 6, 0 ] [ 3, 6, 0, 6 ] ]
6968 [ 2, 4, 6 ] ] 1: [6, 2, 3, 11]
6969 . .
6970
6971 ' [1 2 3; 4 5 6; 7 6 0; 2 4 6] @key{RET} s 7 v t [6 2 3 11] *
6972 @end group
6973 @end smallexample
6974
6975 @noindent
6976 Now we compute the matrix
6977 @texline @math{A'}
6978 @infoline @expr{A2}
6979 and divide.
6980
6981 @smallexample
6982 @group
6983 2: [57, 84, 96] 1: [-11.64, 14.08, -3.64]
6984 1: [ [ 70, 72, 39 ] .
6985 [ 72, 81, 60 ]
6986 [ 39, 60, 81 ] ]
6987 .
6988
6989 r 7 v t r 7 * /
6990 @end group
6991 @end smallexample
6992
6993 @noindent
6994 (The actual computed answer will be slightly inexact due to
6995 round-off error.)
6996
6997 Notice that the answers are similar to those for the
6998 @texline @math{3\times3}
6999 @infoline 3x3
7000 system solved in the text. That's because the fourth equation that was
7001 added to the system is almost identical to the first one multiplied
7002 by two. (If it were identical, we would have gotten the exact same
7003 answer since the
7004 @texline @math{4\times3}
7005 @infoline 4x3
7006 system would be equivalent to the original
7007 @texline @math{3\times3}
7008 @infoline 3x3
7009 system.)
7010
7011 Since the first and fourth equations aren't quite equivalent, they
7012 can't both be satisfied at once. Let's plug our answers back into
7013 the original system of equations to see how well they match.
7014
7015 @smallexample
7016 @group
7017 2: [-11.64, 14.08, -3.64] 1: [5.6, 2., 3., 11.2]
7018 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] .
7019 [ 4, 5, 6 ]
7020 [ 7, 6, 0 ]
7021 [ 2, 4, 6 ] ]
7022 .
7023
7024 r 7 @key{TAB} *
7025 @end group
7026 @end smallexample
7027
7028 @noindent
7029 This is reasonably close to our original @expr{B} vector,
7030 @expr{[6, 2, 3, 11]}.
7031
7032 @node List Answer 1, List Answer 2, Matrix Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
7033 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 1
7034
7035 @noindent
7036 We can use @kbd{v x} to build a vector of integers. This needs to be
7037 adjusted to get the range of integers we desire. Mapping @samp{-}
7038 across the vector will accomplish this, although it turns out the
7039 plain @samp{-} key will work just as well.
7040
7041 @smallexample
7042 @group
7043 2: 2 2: 2
7044 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9] 1: [-4, -3, -2, -1, 0, 1, 2, 3, 4]
7045 . .
7046
7047 2 v x 9 @key{RET} 5 V M - or 5 -
7048 @end group
7049 @end smallexample
7050
7051 @noindent
7052 Now we use @kbd{V M ^} to map the exponentiation operator across the
7053 vector.
7054
7055 @smallexample
7056 @group
7057 1: [0.0625, 0.125, 0.25, 0.5, 1, 2, 4, 8, 16]
7058 .
7059
7060 V M ^
7061 @end group
7062 @end smallexample
7063
7064 @node List Answer 2, List Answer 3, List Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
7065 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 2
7066
7067 @noindent
7068 Given @expr{x} and @expr{y} vectors in quick variables 1 and 2 as before,
7069 the first job is to form the matrix that describes the problem.
7070
7071 @ifnottex
7072 @example
7073 m*x + b*1 = y
7074 @end example
7075 @end ifnottex
7076 @tex
7077 \turnoffactive
7078 \beforedisplay
7079 $$ m \times x + b \times 1 = y $$
7080 \afterdisplay
7081 @end tex
7082
7083 Thus we want a
7084 @texline @math{19\times2}
7085 @infoline 19x2
7086 matrix with our @expr{x} vector as one column and
7087 ones as the other column. So, first we build the column of ones, then
7088 we combine the two columns to form our @expr{A} matrix.
7089
7090 @smallexample
7091 @group
7092 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ] 1: [ [ 1.34, 1 ]
7093 1: [1, 1, 1, ...] [ 1.41, 1 ]
7094 . [ 1.49, 1 ]
7095 @dots{}
7096
7097 r 1 1 v b 19 @key{RET} M-2 v p v t s 3
7098 @end group
7099 @end smallexample
7100
7101 @noindent
7102 Now we compute
7103 @texline @math{A^T y}
7104 @infoline @expr{trn(A) * y}
7105 and
7106 @texline @math{A^T A}
7107 @infoline @expr{trn(A) * A}
7108 and divide.
7109
7110 @smallexample
7111 @group
7112 1: [33.36554, 13.613] 2: [33.36554, 13.613]
7113 . 1: [ [ 98.0003, 41.63 ]
7114 [ 41.63, 19 ] ]
7115 .
7116
7117 v t r 2 * r 3 v t r 3 *
7118 @end group
7119 @end smallexample
7120
7121 @noindent
7122 (Hey, those numbers look familiar!)
7123
7124 @smallexample
7125 @group
7126 1: [0.52141679, -0.425978]
7127 .
7128
7129 /
7130 @end group
7131 @end smallexample
7132
7133 Since we were solving equations of the form
7134 @texline @math{m \times x + b \times 1 = y},
7135 @infoline @expr{m*x + b*1 = y},
7136 these numbers should be @expr{m} and @expr{b}, respectively. Sure
7137 enough, they agree exactly with the result computed using @kbd{V M} and
7138 @kbd{V R}!
7139
7140 The moral of this story: @kbd{V M} and @kbd{V R} will probably solve
7141 your problem, but there is often an easier way using the higher-level
7142 arithmetic functions!
7143
7144 @c [fix-ref Curve Fitting]
7145 In fact, there is a built-in @kbd{a F} command that does least-squares
7146 fits. @xref{Curve Fitting}.
7147
7148 @node List Answer 3, List Answer 4, List Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
7149 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 3
7150
7151 @noindent
7152 Move to one end of the list and press @kbd{C-@@} (or @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} or
7153 whatever) to set the mark, then move to the other end of the list
7154 and type @w{@kbd{C-x * g}}.
7155
7156 @smallexample
7157 @group
7158 1: [2.3, 6, 22, 15.1, 7, 15, 14, 7.5, 2.5]
7159 .
7160 @end group
7161 @end smallexample
7162
7163 To make things interesting, let's assume we don't know at a glance
7164 how many numbers are in this list. Then we could type:
7165
7166 @smallexample
7167 @group
7168 2: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ] 2: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ]
7169 1: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ] 1: 126356422.5
7170 . .
7171
7172 @key{RET} V R *
7173
7174 @end group
7175 @end smallexample
7176 @noindent
7177 @smallexample
7178 @group
7179 2: 126356422.5 2: 126356422.5 1: 7.94652913734
7180 1: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ] 1: 9 .
7181 . .
7182
7183 @key{TAB} v l I ^
7184 @end group
7185 @end smallexample
7186
7187 @noindent
7188 (The @kbd{I ^} command computes the @var{n}th root of a number.
7189 You could also type @kbd{& ^} to take the reciprocal of 9 and
7190 then raise the number to that power.)
7191
7192 @node List Answer 4, List Answer 5, List Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
7193 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 4
7194
7195 @noindent
7196 A number @expr{j} is a divisor of @expr{n} if
7197 @texline @math{n \mathbin{\hbox{\code{\%}}} j = 0}.
7198 @infoline @samp{n % j = 0}.
7199 The first step is to get a vector that identifies the divisors.
7200
7201 @smallexample
7202 @group
7203 2: 30 2: [0, 0, 0, 2, ...] 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, ...]
7204 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, ...] 1: 0 .
7205 . .
7206
7207 30 @key{RET} v x 30 @key{RET} s 1 V M % 0 V M a = s 2
7208 @end group
7209 @end smallexample
7210
7211 @noindent
7212 This vector has 1's marking divisors of 30 and 0's marking non-divisors.
7213
7214 The zeroth divisor function is just the total number of divisors.
7215 The first divisor function is the sum of the divisors.
7216
7217 @smallexample
7218 @group
7219 1: 8 3: 8 2: 8 2: 8
7220 2: [1, 2, 3, 4, ...] 1: [1, 2, 3, 0, ...] 1: 72
7221 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, ...] . .
7222 .
7223
7224 V R + r 1 r 2 V M * V R +
7225 @end group
7226 @end smallexample
7227
7228 @noindent
7229 Once again, the last two steps just compute a dot product for which
7230 a simple @kbd{*} would have worked equally well.
7231
7232 @node List Answer 5, List Answer 6, List Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
7233 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 5
7234
7235 @noindent
7236 The obvious first step is to obtain the list of factors with @kbd{k f}.
7237 This list will always be in sorted order, so if there are duplicates
7238 they will be right next to each other. A suitable method is to compare
7239 the list with a copy of itself shifted over by one.
7240
7241 @smallexample
7242 @group
7243 1: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19] 2: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19] 2: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19, 0]
7244 . 1: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19, 0] 1: [0, 3, 7, 7, 7, 19]
7245 . .
7246
7247 19551 k f @key{RET} 0 | @key{TAB} 0 @key{TAB} |
7248
7249 @end group
7250 @end smallexample
7251 @noindent
7252 @smallexample
7253 @group
7254 1: [0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0] 1: 2 1: 0
7255 . . .
7256
7257 V M a = V R + 0 a =
7258 @end group
7259 @end smallexample
7260
7261 @noindent
7262 Note that we have to arrange for both vectors to have the same length
7263 so that the mapping operation works; no prime factor will ever be
7264 zero, so adding zeros on the left and right is safe. From then on
7265 the job is pretty straightforward.
7266
7267 Incidentally, Calc provides the
7268 @texline @dfn{M@"obius} @math{\mu}
7269 @infoline @dfn{Moebius mu}
7270 function which is zero if and only if its argument is square-free. It
7271 would be a much more convenient way to do the above test in practice.
7272
7273 @node List Answer 6, List Answer 7, List Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
7274 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 6
7275
7276 @noindent
7277 First use @kbd{v x 6 @key{RET}} to get a list of integers, then @kbd{V M v x}
7278 to get a list of lists of integers!
7279
7280 @node List Answer 7, List Answer 8, List Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
7281 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 7
7282
7283 @noindent
7284 Here's one solution. First, compute the triangular list from the previous
7285 exercise and type @kbd{1 -} to subtract one from all the elements.
7286
7287 @smallexample
7288 @group
7289 1: [ [0],
7290 [0, 1],
7291 [0, 1, 2],
7292 @dots{}
7293
7294 1 -
7295 @end group
7296 @end smallexample
7297
7298 The numbers down the lefthand edge of the list we desire are called
7299 the ``triangular numbers'' (now you know why!). The @expr{n}th
7300 triangular number is the sum of the integers from 1 to @expr{n}, and
7301 can be computed directly by the formula
7302 @texline @math{n (n+1) \over 2}.
7303 @infoline @expr{n * (n+1) / 2}.
7304
7305 @smallexample
7306 @group
7307 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ] 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ]
7308 1: [0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5] 1: [0, 1, 3, 6, 10, 15]
7309 . .
7310
7311 v x 6 @key{RET} 1 - V M ' $ ($+1)/2 @key{RET}
7312 @end group
7313 @end smallexample
7314
7315 @noindent
7316 Adding this list to the above list of lists produces the desired
7317 result:
7318
7319 @smallexample
7320 @group
7321 1: [ [0],
7322 [1, 2],
7323 [3, 4, 5],
7324 [6, 7, 8, 9],
7325 [10, 11, 12, 13, 14],
7326 [15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20] ]
7327 .
7328
7329 V M +
7330 @end group
7331 @end smallexample
7332
7333 If we did not know the formula for triangular numbers, we could have
7334 computed them using a @kbd{V U +} command. We could also have
7335 gotten them the hard way by mapping a reduction across the original
7336 triangular list.
7337
7338 @smallexample
7339 @group
7340 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ] 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ]
7341 1: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ] 1: [0, 1, 3, 6, 10, 15]
7342 . .
7343
7344 @key{RET} V M V R +
7345 @end group
7346 @end smallexample
7347
7348 @noindent
7349 (This means ``map a @kbd{V R +} command across the vector,'' and
7350 since each element of the main vector is itself a small vector,
7351 @kbd{V R +} computes the sum of its elements.)
7352
7353 @node List Answer 8, List Answer 9, List Answer 7, Answers to Exercises
7354 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 8
7355
7356 @noindent
7357 The first step is to build a list of values of @expr{x}.
7358
7359 @smallexample
7360 @group
7361 1: [1, 2, 3, ..., 21] 1: [0, 1, 2, ..., 20] 1: [0, 0.25, 0.5, ..., 5]
7362 . . .
7363
7364 v x 21 @key{RET} 1 - 4 / s 1
7365 @end group
7366 @end smallexample
7367
7368 Next, we compute the Bessel function values.
7369
7370 @smallexample
7371 @group
7372 1: [0., 0.124, 0.242, ..., -0.328]
7373 .
7374
7375 V M ' besJ(1,$) @key{RET}
7376 @end group
7377 @end smallexample
7378
7379 @noindent
7380 (Another way to do this would be @kbd{1 @key{TAB} V M f j}.)
7381
7382 A way to isolate the maximum value is to compute the maximum using
7383 @kbd{V R X}, then compare all the Bessel values with that maximum.
7384
7385 @smallexample
7386 @group
7387 2: [0., 0.124, 0.242, ... ] 1: [0, 0, 0, ... ] 2: [0, 0, 0, ... ]
7388 1: 0.5801562 . 1: 1
7389 . .
7390
7391 @key{RET} V R X V M a = @key{RET} V R + @key{DEL}
7392 @end group
7393 @end smallexample
7394
7395 @noindent
7396 It's a good idea to verify, as in the last step above, that only
7397 one value is equal to the maximum. (After all, a plot of
7398 @texline @math{\sin x}
7399 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}
7400 might have many points all equal to the maximum value, 1.)
7401
7402 The vector we have now has a single 1 in the position that indicates
7403 the maximum value of @expr{x}. Now it is a simple matter to convert
7404 this back into the corresponding value itself.
7405
7406 @smallexample
7407 @group
7408 2: [0, 0, 0, ... ] 1: [0, 0., 0., ... ] 1: 1.75
7409 1: [0, 0.25, 0.5, ... ] . .
7410 .
7411
7412 r 1 V M * V R +
7413 @end group
7414 @end smallexample
7415
7416 If @kbd{a =} had produced more than one @expr{1} value, this method
7417 would have given the sum of all maximum @expr{x} values; not very
7418 useful! In this case we could have used @kbd{v m} (@code{calc-mask-vector})
7419 instead. This command deletes all elements of a ``data'' vector that
7420 correspond to zeros in a ``mask'' vector, leaving us with, in this
7421 example, a vector of maximum @expr{x} values.
7422
7423 The built-in @kbd{a X} command maximizes a function using more
7424 efficient methods. Just for illustration, let's use @kbd{a X}
7425 to maximize @samp{besJ(1,x)} over this same interval.
7426
7427 @smallexample
7428 @group
7429 2: besJ(1, x) 1: [1.84115, 0.581865]
7430 1: [0 .. 5] .
7431 .
7432
7433 ' besJ(1,x), [0..5] @key{RET} a X x @key{RET}
7434 @end group
7435 @end smallexample
7436
7437 @noindent
7438 The output from @kbd{a X} is a vector containing the value of @expr{x}
7439 that maximizes the function, and the function's value at that maximum.
7440 As you can see, our simple search got quite close to the right answer.
7441
7442 @node List Answer 9, List Answer 10, List Answer 8, Answers to Exercises
7443 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 9
7444
7445 @noindent
7446 Step one is to convert our integer into vector notation.
7447
7448 @smallexample
7449 @group
7450 1: 25129925999 3: 25129925999
7451 . 2: 10
7452 1: [11, 10, 9, ..., 1, 0]
7453 .
7454
7455 25129925999 @key{RET} 10 @key{RET} 12 @key{RET} v x 12 @key{RET} -
7456
7457 @end group
7458 @end smallexample
7459 @noindent
7460 @smallexample
7461 @group
7462 1: 25129925999 1: [0, 2, 25, 251, 2512, ... ]
7463 2: [100000000000, ... ] .
7464 .
7465
7466 V M ^ s 1 V M \
7467 @end group
7468 @end smallexample
7469
7470 @noindent
7471 (Recall, the @kbd{\} command computes an integer quotient.)
7472
7473 @smallexample
7474 @group
7475 1: [0, 2, 5, 1, 2, 9, 9, 2, 5, 9, 9, 9]
7476 .
7477
7478 10 V M % s 2
7479 @end group
7480 @end smallexample
7481
7482 Next we must increment this number. This involves adding one to
7483 the last digit, plus handling carries. There is a carry to the
7484 left out of a digit if that digit is a nine and all the digits to
7485 the right of it are nines.
7486
7487 @smallexample
7488 @group
7489 1: [0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1] 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, ... ]
7490 . .
7491
7492 9 V M a = v v
7493
7494 @end group
7495 @end smallexample
7496 @noindent
7497 @smallexample
7498 @group
7499 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, ... ] 1: [0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1]
7500 . .
7501
7502 V U * v v 1 |
7503 @end group
7504 @end smallexample
7505
7506 @noindent
7507 Accumulating @kbd{*} across a vector of ones and zeros will preserve
7508 only the initial run of ones. These are the carries into all digits
7509 except the rightmost digit. Concatenating a one on the right takes
7510 care of aligning the carries properly, and also adding one to the
7511 rightmost digit.
7512
7513 @smallexample
7514 @group
7515 2: [0, 0, 0, 0, ... ] 1: [0, 0, 2, 5, 1, 2, 9, 9, 2, 6, 0, 0, 0]
7516 1: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ] .
7517 .
7518
7519 0 r 2 | V M + 10 V M %
7520 @end group
7521 @end smallexample
7522
7523 @noindent
7524 Here we have concatenated 0 to the @emph{left} of the original number;
7525 this takes care of shifting the carries by one with respect to the
7526 digits that generated them.
7527
7528 Finally, we must convert this list back into an integer.
7529
7530 @smallexample
7531 @group
7532 3: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ] 2: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ]
7533 2: 1000000000000 1: [1000000000000, 100000000000, ... ]
7534 1: [100000000000, ... ] .
7535 .
7536
7537 10 @key{RET} 12 ^ r 1 |
7538
7539 @end group
7540 @end smallexample
7541 @noindent
7542 @smallexample
7543 @group
7544 1: [0, 0, 20000000000, 5000000000, ... ] 1: 25129926000
7545 . .
7546
7547 V M * V R +
7548 @end group
7549 @end smallexample
7550
7551 @noindent
7552 Another way to do this final step would be to reduce the formula
7553 @w{@samp{10 $$ + $}} across the vector of digits.
7554
7555 @smallexample
7556 @group
7557 1: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ] 1: 25129926000
7558 . .
7559
7560 V R ' 10 $$ + $ @key{RET}
7561 @end group
7562 @end smallexample
7563
7564 @node List Answer 10, List Answer 11, List Answer 9, Answers to Exercises
7565 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 10
7566
7567 @noindent
7568 For the list @expr{[a, b, c, d]}, the result is @expr{((a = b) = c) = d},
7569 which will compare @expr{a} and @expr{b} to produce a 1 or 0, which is
7570 then compared with @expr{c} to produce another 1 or 0, which is then
7571 compared with @expr{d}. This is not at all what Joe wanted.
7572
7573 Here's a more correct method:
7574
7575 @smallexample
7576 @group
7577 1: [7, 7, 7, 8, 7] 2: [7, 7, 7, 8, 7]
7578 . 1: 7
7579 .
7580
7581 ' [7,7,7,8,7] @key{RET} @key{RET} v r 1 @key{RET}
7582
7583 @end group
7584 @end smallexample
7585 @noindent
7586 @smallexample
7587 @group
7588 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, 1] 1: 0
7589 . .
7590
7591 V M a = V R *
7592 @end group
7593 @end smallexample
7594
7595 @node List Answer 11, List Answer 12, List Answer 10, Answers to Exercises
7596 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 11
7597
7598 @noindent
7599 The circle of unit radius consists of those points @expr{(x,y)} for which
7600 @expr{x^2 + y^2 < 1}. We start by generating a vector of @expr{x^2}
7601 and a vector of @expr{y^2}.
7602
7603 We can make this go a bit faster by using the @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .}
7604 commands.
7605
7606 @smallexample
7607 @group
7608 2: [2., 2., ..., 2.] 2: [2., 2., ..., 2.]
7609 1: [2., 2., ..., 2.] 1: [1.16, 1.98, ..., 0.81]
7610 . .
7611
7612 v . t . 2. v b 100 @key{RET} @key{RET} V M k r
7613
7614 @end group
7615 @end smallexample
7616 @noindent
7617 @smallexample
7618 @group
7619 2: [2., 2., ..., 2.] 1: [0.026, 0.96, ..., 0.036]
7620 1: [0.026, 0.96, ..., 0.036] 2: [0.53, 0.81, ..., 0.094]
7621 . .
7622
7623 1 - 2 V M ^ @key{TAB} V M k r 1 - 2 V M ^
7624 @end group
7625 @end smallexample
7626
7627 Now we sum the @expr{x^2} and @expr{y^2} values, compare with 1 to
7628 get a vector of 1/0 truth values, then sum the truth values.
7629
7630 @smallexample
7631 @group
7632 1: [0.56, 1.78, ..., 0.13] 1: [1, 0, ..., 1] 1: 84
7633 . . .
7634
7635 + 1 V M a < V R +
7636 @end group
7637 @end smallexample
7638
7639 @noindent
7640 The ratio @expr{84/100} should approximate the ratio @cpiover{4}.
7641
7642 @smallexample
7643 @group
7644 1: 0.84 1: 3.36 2: 3.36 1: 1.0695
7645 . . 1: 3.14159 .
7646
7647 100 / 4 * P /
7648 @end group
7649 @end smallexample
7650
7651 @noindent
7652 Our estimate, 3.36, is off by about 7%. We could get a better estimate
7653 by taking more points (say, 1000), but it's clear that this method is
7654 not very efficient!
7655
7656 (Naturally, since this example uses random numbers your own answer
7657 will be slightly different from the one shown here!)
7658
7659 If you typed @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .} before, type them again to
7660 return to full-sized display of vectors.
7661
7662 @node List Answer 12, List Answer 13, List Answer 11, Answers to Exercises
7663 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 12
7664
7665 @noindent
7666 This problem can be made a lot easier by taking advantage of some
7667 symmetries. First of all, after some thought it's clear that the
7668 @expr{y} axis can be ignored altogether. Just pick a random @expr{x}
7669 component for one end of the match, pick a random direction
7670 @texline @math{\theta},
7671 @infoline @expr{theta},
7672 and see if @expr{x} and
7673 @texline @math{x + \cos \theta}
7674 @infoline @expr{x + cos(theta)}
7675 (which is the @expr{x} coordinate of the other endpoint) cross a line.
7676 The lines are at integer coordinates, so this happens when the two
7677 numbers surround an integer.
7678
7679 Since the two endpoints are equivalent, we may as well choose the leftmost
7680 of the two endpoints as @expr{x}. Then @expr{theta} is an angle pointing
7681 to the right, in the range -90 to 90 degrees. (We could use radians, but
7682 it would feel like cheating to refer to @cpiover{2} radians while trying
7683 to estimate @cpi{}!)
7684
7685 In fact, since the field of lines is infinite we can choose the
7686 coordinates 0 and 1 for the lines on either side of the leftmost
7687 endpoint. The rightmost endpoint will be between 0 and 1 if the
7688 match does not cross a line, or between 1 and 2 if it does. So:
7689 Pick random @expr{x} and
7690 @texline @math{\theta},
7691 @infoline @expr{theta},
7692 compute
7693 @texline @math{x + \cos \theta},
7694 @infoline @expr{x + cos(theta)},
7695 and count how many of the results are greater than one. Simple!
7696
7697 We can make this go a bit faster by using the @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .}
7698 commands.
7699
7700 @smallexample
7701 @group
7702 1: [0.52, 0.71, ..., 0.72] 2: [0.52, 0.71, ..., 0.72]
7703 . 1: [78.4, 64.5, ..., -42.9]
7704 .
7705
7706 v . t . 1. v b 100 @key{RET} V M k r 180. v b 100 @key{RET} V M k r 90 -
7707 @end group
7708 @end smallexample
7709
7710 @noindent
7711 (The next step may be slow, depending on the speed of your computer.)
7712
7713 @smallexample
7714 @group
7715 2: [0.52, 0.71, ..., 0.72] 1: [0.72, 1.14, ..., 1.45]
7716 1: [0.20, 0.43, ..., 0.73] .
7717 .
7718
7719 m d V M C +
7720
7721 @end group
7722 @end smallexample
7723 @noindent
7724 @smallexample
7725 @group
7726 1: [0, 1, ..., 1] 1: 0.64 1: 3.125
7727 . . .
7728
7729 1 V M a > V R + 100 / 2 @key{TAB} /
7730 @end group
7731 @end smallexample
7732
7733 Let's try the third method, too. We'll use random integers up to
7734 one million. The @kbd{k r} command with an integer argument picks
7735 a random integer.
7736
7737 @smallexample
7738 @group
7739 2: [1000000, 1000000, ..., 1000000] 2: [78489, 527587, ..., 814975]
7740 1: [1000000, 1000000, ..., 1000000] 1: [324014, 358783, ..., 955450]
7741 . .
7742
7743 1000000 v b 100 @key{RET} @key{RET} V M k r @key{TAB} V M k r
7744
7745 @end group
7746 @end smallexample
7747 @noindent
7748 @smallexample
7749 @group
7750 1: [1, 1, ..., 25] 1: [1, 1, ..., 0] 1: 0.56
7751 . . .
7752
7753 V M k g 1 V M a = V R + 100 /
7754
7755 @end group
7756 @end smallexample
7757 @noindent
7758 @smallexample
7759 @group
7760 1: 10.714 1: 3.273
7761 . .
7762
7763 6 @key{TAB} / Q
7764 @end group
7765 @end smallexample
7766
7767 For a proof of this property of the GCD function, see section 4.5.2,
7768 exercise 10, of Knuth's @emph{Art of Computer Programming}, volume II.
7769
7770 If you typed @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .} before, type them again to
7771 return to full-sized display of vectors.
7772
7773 @node List Answer 13, List Answer 14, List Answer 12, Answers to Exercises
7774 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 13
7775
7776 @noindent
7777 First, we put the string on the stack as a vector of ASCII codes.
7778
7779 @smallexample
7780 @group
7781 1: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51]
7782 .
7783
7784 "Testing, 1, 2, 3 @key{RET}
7785 @end group
7786 @end smallexample
7787
7788 @noindent
7789 Note that the @kbd{"} key, like @kbd{$}, initiates algebraic entry so
7790 there was no need to type an apostrophe. Also, Calc didn't mind that
7791 we omitted the closing @kbd{"}. (The same goes for all closing delimiters
7792 like @kbd{)} and @kbd{]} at the end of a formula.
7793
7794 We'll show two different approaches here. In the first, we note that
7795 if the input vector is @expr{[a, b, c, d]}, then the hash code is
7796 @expr{3 (3 (3a + b) + c) + d = 27a + 9b + 3c + d}. In other words,
7797 it's a sum of descending powers of three times the ASCII codes.
7798
7799 @smallexample
7800 @group
7801 2: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 2: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51]
7802 1: 16 1: [15, 14, 13, ..., 0]
7803 . .
7804
7805 @key{RET} v l v x 16 @key{RET} -
7806
7807 @end group
7808 @end smallexample
7809 @noindent
7810 @smallexample
7811 @group
7812 2: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 1: 1960915098 1: 121
7813 1: [14348907, ..., 1] . .
7814 .
7815
7816 3 @key{TAB} V M ^ * 511 %
7817 @end group
7818 @end smallexample
7819
7820 @noindent
7821 Once again, @kbd{*} elegantly summarizes most of the computation.
7822 But there's an even more elegant approach: Reduce the formula
7823 @kbd{3 $$ + $} across the vector. Recall that this represents a
7824 function of two arguments that computes its first argument times three
7825 plus its second argument.
7826
7827 @smallexample
7828 @group
7829 1: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 1: 1960915098
7830 . .
7831
7832 "Testing, 1, 2, 3 @key{RET} V R ' 3$$+$ @key{RET}
7833 @end group
7834 @end smallexample
7835
7836 @noindent
7837 If you did the decimal arithmetic exercise, this will be familiar.
7838 Basically, we're turning a base-3 vector of digits into an integer,
7839 except that our ``digits'' are much larger than real digits.
7840
7841 Instead of typing @kbd{511 %} again to reduce the result, we can be
7842 cleverer still and notice that rather than computing a huge integer
7843 and taking the modulo at the end, we can take the modulo at each step
7844 without affecting the result. While this means there are more
7845 arithmetic operations, the numbers we operate on remain small so
7846 the operations are faster.
7847
7848 @smallexample
7849 @group
7850 1: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 1: 121
7851 . .
7852
7853 "Testing, 1, 2, 3 @key{RET} V R ' (3$$+$)%511 @key{RET}
7854 @end group
7855 @end smallexample
7856
7857 Why does this work? Think about a two-step computation:
7858 @w{@expr{3 (3a + b) + c}}. Taking a result modulo 511 basically means
7859 subtracting off enough 511's to put the result in the desired range.
7860 So the result when we take the modulo after every step is,
7861
7862 @ifnottex
7863 @example
7864 3 (3 a + b - 511 m) + c - 511 n
7865 @end example
7866 @end ifnottex
7867 @tex
7868 \turnoffactive
7869 \beforedisplay
7870 $$ 3 (3 a + b - 511 m) + c - 511 n $$
7871 \afterdisplay
7872 @end tex
7873
7874 @noindent
7875 for some suitable integers @expr{m} and @expr{n}. Expanding out by
7876 the distributive law yields
7877
7878 @ifnottex
7879 @example
7880 9 a + 3 b + c - 511*3 m - 511 n
7881 @end example
7882 @end ifnottex
7883 @tex
7884 \turnoffactive
7885 \beforedisplay
7886 $$ 9 a + 3 b + c - 511\times3 m - 511 n $$
7887 \afterdisplay
7888 @end tex
7889
7890 @noindent
7891 The @expr{m} term in the latter formula is redundant because any
7892 contribution it makes could just as easily be made by the @expr{n}
7893 term. So we can take it out to get an equivalent formula with
7894 @expr{n' = 3m + n},
7895
7896 @ifnottex
7897 @example
7898 9 a + 3 b + c - 511 n'
7899 @end example
7900 @end ifnottex
7901 @tex
7902 \turnoffactive
7903 \beforedisplay
7904 $$ 9 a + 3 b + c - 511 n' $$
7905 \afterdisplay
7906 @end tex
7907
7908 @noindent
7909 which is just the formula for taking the modulo only at the end of
7910 the calculation. Therefore the two methods are essentially the same.
7911
7912 Later in the tutorial we will encounter @dfn{modulo forms}, which
7913 basically automate the idea of reducing every intermediate result
7914 modulo some value @var{m}.
7915
7916 @node List Answer 14, Types Answer 1, List Answer 13, Answers to Exercises
7917 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 14
7918
7919 We want to use @kbd{H V U} to nest a function which adds a random
7920 step to an @expr{(x,y)} coordinate. The function is a bit long, but
7921 otherwise the problem is quite straightforward.
7922
7923 @smallexample
7924 @group
7925 2: [0, 0] 1: [ [ 0, 0 ]
7926 1: 50 [ 0.4288, -0.1695 ]
7927 . [ -0.4787, -0.9027 ]
7928 ...
7929
7930 [0,0] 50 H V U ' <# + [random(2.0)-1, random(2.0)-1]> @key{RET}
7931 @end group
7932 @end smallexample
7933
7934 Just as the text recommended, we used @samp{< >} nameless function
7935 notation to keep the two @code{random} calls from being evaluated
7936 before nesting even begins.
7937
7938 We now have a vector of @expr{[x, y]} sub-vectors, which by Calc's
7939 rules acts like a matrix. We can transpose this matrix and unpack
7940 to get a pair of vectors, @expr{x} and @expr{y}, suitable for graphing.
7941
7942 @smallexample
7943 @group
7944 2: [ 0, 0.4288, -0.4787, ... ]
7945 1: [ 0, -0.1696, -0.9027, ... ]
7946 .
7947
7948 v t v u g f
7949 @end group
7950 @end smallexample
7951
7952 Incidentally, because the @expr{x} and @expr{y} are completely
7953 independent in this case, we could have done two separate commands
7954 to create our @expr{x} and @expr{y} vectors of numbers directly.
7955
7956 To make a random walk of unit steps, we note that @code{sincos} of
7957 a random direction exactly gives us an @expr{[x, y]} step of unit
7958 length; in fact, the new nesting function is even briefer, though
7959 we might want to lower the precision a bit for it.
7960
7961 @smallexample
7962 @group
7963 2: [0, 0] 1: [ [ 0, 0 ]
7964 1: 50 [ 0.1318, 0.9912 ]
7965 . [ -0.5965, 0.3061 ]
7966 ...
7967
7968 [0,0] 50 m d p 6 @key{RET} H V U ' <# + sincos(random(360.0))> @key{RET}
7969 @end group
7970 @end smallexample
7971
7972 Another @kbd{v t v u g f} sequence will graph this new random walk.
7973
7974 An interesting twist on these random walk functions would be to use
7975 complex numbers instead of 2-vectors to represent points on the plane.
7976 In the first example, we'd use something like @samp{random + random*(0,1)},
7977 and in the second we could use polar complex numbers with random phase
7978 angles. (This exercise was first suggested in this form by Randal
7979 Schwartz.)
7980
7981 @node Types Answer 1, Types Answer 2, List Answer 14, Answers to Exercises
7982 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 1
7983
7984 @noindent
7985 If the number is the square root of @cpi{} times a rational number,
7986 then its square, divided by @cpi{}, should be a rational number.
7987
7988 @smallexample
7989 @group
7990 1: 1.26508260337 1: 0.509433962268 1: 2486645810:4881193627
7991 . . .
7992
7993 2 ^ P / c F
7994 @end group
7995 @end smallexample
7996
7997 @noindent
7998 Technically speaking this is a rational number, but not one that is
7999 likely to have arisen in the original problem. More likely, it just
8000 happens to be the fraction which most closely represents some
8001 irrational number to within 12 digits.
8002
8003 But perhaps our result was not quite exact. Let's reduce the
8004 precision slightly and try again:
8005
8006 @smallexample
8007 @group
8008 1: 0.509433962268 1: 27:53
8009 . .
8010
8011 U p 10 @key{RET} c F
8012 @end group
8013 @end smallexample
8014
8015 @noindent
8016 Aha! It's unlikely that an irrational number would equal a fraction
8017 this simple to within ten digits, so our original number was probably
8018 @texline @math{\sqrt{27 \pi / 53}}.
8019 @infoline @expr{sqrt(27 pi / 53)}.
8020
8021 Notice that we didn't need to re-round the number when we reduced the
8022 precision. Remember, arithmetic operations always round their inputs
8023 to the current precision before they begin.
8024
8025 @node Types Answer 2, Types Answer 3, Types Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8026 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 2
8027
8028 @noindent
8029 @samp{inf / inf = nan}. Perhaps @samp{1} is the ``obvious'' answer.
8030 But if @w{@samp{17 inf = inf}}, then @samp{17 inf / inf = inf / inf = 17}, too.
8031
8032 @samp{exp(inf) = inf}. It's tempting to say that the exponential
8033 of infinity must be ``bigger'' than ``regular'' infinity, but as
8034 far as Calc is concerned all infinities are as just as big.
8035 In other words, as @expr{x} goes to infinity, @expr{e^x} also goes
8036 to infinity, but the fact the @expr{e^x} grows much faster than
8037 @expr{x} is not relevant here.
8038
8039 @samp{exp(-inf) = 0}. Here we have a finite answer even though
8040 the input is infinite.
8041
8042 @samp{sqrt(-inf) = (0, 1) inf}. Remember that @expr{(0, 1)}
8043 represents the imaginary number @expr{i}. Here's a derivation:
8044 @samp{sqrt(-inf) = @w{sqrt((-1) * inf)} = sqrt(-1) * sqrt(inf)}.
8045 The first part is, by definition, @expr{i}; the second is @code{inf}
8046 because, once again, all infinities are the same size.
8047
8048 @samp{sqrt(uinf) = uinf}. In fact, we do know something about the
8049 direction because @code{sqrt} is defined to return a value in the
8050 right half of the complex plane. But Calc has no notation for this,
8051 so it settles for the conservative answer @code{uinf}.
8052
8053 @samp{abs(uinf) = inf}. No matter which direction @expr{x} points,
8054 @samp{abs(x)} always points along the positive real axis.
8055
8056 @samp{ln(0) = -inf}. Here we have an infinite answer to a finite
8057 input. As in the @expr{1 / 0} case, Calc will only use infinities
8058 here if you have turned on Infinite mode. Otherwise, it will
8059 treat @samp{ln(0)} as an error.
8060
8061 @node Types Answer 3, Types Answer 4, Types Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8062 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 3
8063
8064 @noindent
8065 We can make @samp{inf - inf} be any real number we like, say,
8066 @expr{a}, just by claiming that we added @expr{a} to the first
8067 infinity but not to the second. This is just as true for complex
8068 values of @expr{a}, so @code{nan} can stand for a complex number.
8069 (And, similarly, @code{uinf} can stand for an infinity that points
8070 in any direction in the complex plane, such as @samp{(0, 1) inf}).
8071
8072 In fact, we can multiply the first @code{inf} by two. Surely
8073 @w{@samp{2 inf - inf = inf}}, but also @samp{2 inf - inf = inf - inf = nan}.
8074 So @code{nan} can even stand for infinity. Obviously it's just
8075 as easy to make it stand for minus infinity as for plus infinity.
8076
8077 The moral of this story is that ``infinity'' is a slippery fish
8078 indeed, and Calc tries to handle it by having a very simple model
8079 for infinities (only the direction counts, not the ``size''); but
8080 Calc is careful to write @code{nan} any time this simple model is
8081 unable to tell what the true answer is.
8082
8083 @node Types Answer 4, Types Answer 5, Types Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
8084 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 4
8085
8086 @smallexample
8087 @group
8088 2: 0@@ 47' 26" 1: 0@@ 2' 47.411765"
8089 1: 17 .
8090 .
8091
8092 0@@ 47' 26" @key{RET} 17 /
8093 @end group
8094 @end smallexample
8095
8096 @noindent
8097 The average song length is two minutes and 47.4 seconds.
8098
8099 @smallexample
8100 @group
8101 2: 0@@ 2' 47.411765" 1: 0@@ 3' 7.411765" 1: 0@@ 53' 6.000005"
8102 1: 0@@ 0' 20" . .
8103 .
8104
8105 20" + 17 *
8106 @end group
8107 @end smallexample
8108
8109 @noindent
8110 The album would be 53 minutes and 6 seconds long.
8111
8112 @node Types Answer 5, Types Answer 6, Types Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
8113 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 5
8114
8115 @noindent
8116 Let's suppose it's January 14, 1991. The easiest thing to do is
8117 to keep trying 13ths of months until Calc reports a Friday.
8118 We can do this by manually entering dates, or by using @kbd{t I}:
8119
8120 @smallexample
8121 @group
8122 1: <Wed Feb 13, 1991> 1: <Wed Mar 13, 1991> 1: <Sat Apr 13, 1991>
8123 . . .
8124
8125 ' <2/13> @key{RET} @key{DEL} ' <3/13> @key{RET} t I
8126 @end group
8127 @end smallexample
8128
8129 @noindent
8130 (Calc assumes the current year if you don't say otherwise.)
8131
8132 This is getting tedious---we can keep advancing the date by typing
8133 @kbd{t I} over and over again, but let's automate the job by using
8134 vector mapping. The @kbd{t I} command actually takes a second
8135 ``how-many-months'' argument, which defaults to one. This
8136 argument is exactly what we want to map over:
8137
8138 @smallexample
8139 @group
8140 2: <Sat Apr 13, 1991> 1: [<Mon May 13, 1991>, <Thu Jun 13, 1991>,
8141 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6] <Sat Jul 13, 1991>, <Tue Aug 13, 1991>,
8142 . <Fri Sep 13, 1991>, <Sun Oct 13, 1991>]
8143 .
8144
8145 v x 6 @key{RET} V M t I
8146 @end group
8147 @end smallexample
8148
8149 @noindent
8150 Et voil@`a, September 13, 1991 is a Friday.
8151
8152 @smallexample
8153 @group
8154 1: 242
8155 .
8156
8157 ' <sep 13> - <jan 14> @key{RET}
8158 @end group
8159 @end smallexample
8160
8161 @noindent
8162 And the answer to our original question: 242 days to go.
8163
8164 @node Types Answer 6, Types Answer 7, Types Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
8165 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 6
8166
8167 @noindent
8168 The full rule for leap years is that they occur in every year divisible
8169 by four, except that they don't occur in years divisible by 100, except
8170 that they @emph{do} in years divisible by 400. We could work out the
8171 answer by carefully counting the years divisible by four and the
8172 exceptions, but there is a much simpler way that works even if we
8173 don't know the leap year rule.
8174
8175 Let's assume the present year is 1991. Years have 365 days, except
8176 that leap years (whenever they occur) have 366 days. So let's count
8177 the number of days between now and then, and compare that to the
8178 number of years times 365. The number of extra days we find must be
8179 equal to the number of leap years there were.
8180
8181 @smallexample
8182 @group
8183 1: <Mon Jan 1, 10001> 2: <Mon Jan 1, 10001> 1: 2925593
8184 . 1: <Tue Jan 1, 1991> .
8185 .
8186
8187 ' <jan 1 10001> @key{RET} ' <jan 1 1991> @key{RET} -
8188
8189 @end group
8190 @end smallexample
8191 @noindent
8192 @smallexample
8193 @group
8194 3: 2925593 2: 2925593 2: 2925593 1: 1943
8195 2: 10001 1: 8010 1: 2923650 .
8196 1: 1991 . .
8197 .
8198
8199 10001 @key{RET} 1991 - 365 * -
8200 @end group
8201 @end smallexample
8202
8203 @c [fix-ref Date Forms]
8204 @noindent
8205 There will be 1943 leap years before the year 10001. (Assuming,
8206 of course, that the algorithm for computing leap years remains
8207 unchanged for that long. @xref{Date Forms}, for some interesting
8208 background information in that regard.)
8209
8210 @node Types Answer 7, Types Answer 8, Types Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
8211 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 7
8212
8213 @noindent
8214 The relative errors must be converted to absolute errors so that
8215 @samp{+/-} notation may be used.
8216
8217 @smallexample
8218 @group
8219 1: 1. 2: 1.
8220 . 1: 0.2
8221 .
8222
8223 20 @key{RET} .05 * 4 @key{RET} .05 *
8224 @end group
8225 @end smallexample
8226
8227 Now we simply chug through the formula.
8228
8229 @smallexample
8230 @group
8231 1: 19.7392088022 1: 394.78 +/- 19.739 1: 6316.5 +/- 706.21
8232 . . .
8233
8234 2 P 2 ^ * 20 p 1 * 4 p .2 @key{RET} 2 ^ *
8235 @end group
8236 @end smallexample
8237
8238 It turns out the @kbd{v u} command will unpack an error form as
8239 well as a vector. This saves us some retyping of numbers.
8240
8241 @smallexample
8242 @group
8243 3: 6316.5 +/- 706.21 2: 6316.5 +/- 706.21
8244 2: 6316.5 1: 0.1118
8245 1: 706.21 .
8246 .
8247
8248 @key{RET} v u @key{TAB} /
8249 @end group
8250 @end smallexample
8251
8252 @noindent
8253 Thus the volume is 6316 cubic centimeters, within about 11 percent.
8254
8255 @node Types Answer 8, Types Answer 9, Types Answer 7, Answers to Exercises
8256 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 8
8257
8258 @noindent
8259 The first answer is pretty simple: @samp{1 / (0 .. 10) = (0.1 .. inf)}.
8260 Since a number in the interval @samp{(0 .. 10)} can get arbitrarily
8261 close to zero, its reciprocal can get arbitrarily large, so the answer
8262 is an interval that effectively means, ``any number greater than 0.1''
8263 but with no upper bound.
8264
8265 The second answer, similarly, is @samp{1 / (-10 .. 0) = (-inf .. -0.1)}.
8266
8267 Calc normally treats division by zero as an error, so that the formula
8268 @w{@samp{1 / 0}} is left unsimplified. Our third problem,
8269 @w{@samp{1 / [0 .. 10]}}, also (potentially) divides by zero because zero
8270 is now a member of the interval. So Calc leaves this one unevaluated, too.
8271
8272 If you turn on Infinite mode by pressing @kbd{m i}, you will
8273 instead get the answer @samp{[0.1 .. inf]}, which includes infinity
8274 as a possible value.
8275
8276 The fourth calculation, @samp{1 / (-10 .. 10)}, has the same problem.
8277 Zero is buried inside the interval, but it's still a possible value.
8278 It's not hard to see that the actual result of @samp{1 / (-10 .. 10)}
8279 will be either greater than @mathit{0.1}, or less than @mathit{-0.1}. Thus
8280 the interval goes from minus infinity to plus infinity, with a ``hole''
8281 in it from @mathit{-0.1} to @mathit{0.1}. Calc doesn't have any way to
8282 represent this, so it just reports @samp{[-inf .. inf]} as the answer.
8283 It may be disappointing to hear ``the answer lies somewhere between
8284 minus infinity and plus infinity, inclusive,'' but that's the best
8285 that interval arithmetic can do in this case.
8286
8287 @node Types Answer 9, Types Answer 10, Types Answer 8, Answers to Exercises
8288 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 9
8289
8290 @smallexample
8291 @group
8292 1: [-3 .. 3] 2: [-3 .. 3] 2: [0 .. 9]
8293 . 1: [0 .. 9] 1: [-9 .. 9]
8294 . .
8295
8296 [ 3 n .. 3 ] @key{RET} 2 ^ @key{TAB} @key{RET} *
8297 @end group
8298 @end smallexample
8299
8300 @noindent
8301 In the first case the result says, ``if a number is between @mathit{-3} and
8302 3, its square is between 0 and 9.'' The second case says, ``the product
8303 of two numbers each between @mathit{-3} and 3 is between @mathit{-9} and 9.''
8304
8305 An interval form is not a number; it is a symbol that can stand for
8306 many different numbers. Two identical-looking interval forms can stand
8307 for different numbers.
8308
8309 The same issue arises when you try to square an error form.
8310
8311 @node Types Answer 10, Types Answer 11, Types Answer 9, Answers to Exercises
8312 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 10
8313
8314 @noindent
8315 Testing the first number, we might arbitrarily choose 17 for @expr{x}.
8316
8317 @smallexample
8318 @group
8319 1: 17 mod 811749613 2: 17 mod 811749613 1: 533694123 mod 811749613
8320 . 811749612 .
8321 .
8322
8323 17 M 811749613 @key{RET} 811749612 ^
8324 @end group
8325 @end smallexample
8326
8327 @noindent
8328 Since 533694123 is (considerably) different from 1, the number 811749613
8329 must not be prime.
8330
8331 It's awkward to type the number in twice as we did above. There are
8332 various ways to avoid this, and algebraic entry is one. In fact, using
8333 a vector mapping operation we can perform several tests at once. Let's
8334 use this method to test the second number.
8335
8336 @smallexample
8337 @group
8338 2: [17, 42, 100000] 1: [1 mod 15485863, 1 mod ... ]
8339 1: 15485863 .
8340 .
8341
8342 [17 42 100000] 15485863 @key{RET} V M ' ($$ mod $)^($-1) @key{RET}
8343 @end group
8344 @end smallexample
8345
8346 @noindent
8347 The result is three ones (modulo @expr{n}), so it's very probable that
8348 15485863 is prime. (In fact, this number is the millionth prime.)
8349
8350 Note that the functions @samp{($$^($-1)) mod $} or @samp{$$^($-1) % $}
8351 would have been hopelessly inefficient, since they would have calculated
8352 the power using full integer arithmetic.
8353
8354 Calc has a @kbd{k p} command that does primality testing. For small
8355 numbers it does an exact test; for large numbers it uses a variant
8356 of the Fermat test we used here. You can use @kbd{k p} repeatedly
8357 to prove that a large integer is prime with any desired probability.
8358
8359 @node Types Answer 11, Types Answer 12, Types Answer 10, Answers to Exercises
8360 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 11
8361
8362 @noindent
8363 There are several ways to insert a calculated number into an HMS form.
8364 One way to convert a number of seconds to an HMS form is simply to
8365 multiply the number by an HMS form representing one second:
8366
8367 @smallexample
8368 @group
8369 1: 31415926.5359 2: 31415926.5359 1: 8726@@ 38' 46.5359"
8370 . 1: 0@@ 0' 1" .
8371 .
8372
8373 P 1e7 * 0@@ 0' 1" *
8374
8375 @end group
8376 @end smallexample
8377 @noindent
8378 @smallexample
8379 @group
8380 2: 8726@@ 38' 46.5359" 1: 6@@ 6' 2.5359" mod 24@@ 0' 0"
8381 1: 15@@ 27' 16" mod 24@@ 0' 0" .
8382 .
8383
8384 x time @key{RET} +
8385 @end group
8386 @end smallexample
8387
8388 @noindent
8389 It will be just after six in the morning.
8390
8391 The algebraic @code{hms} function can also be used to build an
8392 HMS form:
8393
8394 @smallexample
8395 @group
8396 1: hms(0, 0, 10000000. pi) 1: 8726@@ 38' 46.5359"
8397 . .
8398
8399 ' hms(0, 0, 1e7 pi) @key{RET} =
8400 @end group
8401 @end smallexample
8402
8403 @noindent
8404 The @kbd{=} key is necessary to evaluate the symbol @samp{pi} to
8405 the actual number 3.14159...
8406
8407 @node Types Answer 12, Types Answer 13, Types Answer 11, Answers to Exercises
8408 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 12
8409
8410 @noindent
8411 As we recall, there are 17 songs of about 2 minutes and 47 seconds
8412 each.
8413
8414 @smallexample
8415 @group
8416 2: 0@@ 2' 47" 1: [0@@ 3' 7" .. 0@@ 3' 47"]
8417 1: [0@@ 0' 20" .. 0@@ 1' 0"] .
8418 .
8419
8420 [ 0@@ 20" .. 0@@ 1' ] +
8421
8422 @end group
8423 @end smallexample
8424 @noindent
8425 @smallexample
8426 @group
8427 1: [0@@ 52' 59." .. 1@@ 4' 19."]
8428 .
8429
8430 17 *
8431 @end group
8432 @end smallexample
8433
8434 @noindent
8435 No matter how long it is, the album will fit nicely on one CD.
8436
8437 @node Types Answer 13, Types Answer 14, Types Answer 12, Answers to Exercises
8438 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 13
8439
8440 @noindent
8441 Type @kbd{' 1 yr @key{RET} u c s @key{RET}}. The answer is 31557600 seconds.
8442
8443 @node Types Answer 14, Types Answer 15, Types Answer 13, Answers to Exercises
8444 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 14
8445
8446 @noindent
8447 How long will it take for a signal to get from one end of the computer
8448 to the other?
8449
8450 @smallexample
8451 @group
8452 1: m / c 1: 3.3356 ns
8453 . .
8454
8455 ' 1 m / c @key{RET} u c ns @key{RET}
8456 @end group
8457 @end smallexample
8458
8459 @noindent
8460 (Recall, @samp{c} is a ``unit'' corresponding to the speed of light.)
8461
8462 @smallexample
8463 @group
8464 1: 3.3356 ns 1: 0.81356 ns / ns 1: 0.81356
8465 2: 4.1 ns . .
8466 .
8467
8468 ' 4.1 ns @key{RET} / u s
8469 @end group
8470 @end smallexample
8471
8472 @noindent
8473 Thus a signal could take up to 81 percent of a clock cycle just to
8474 go from one place to another inside the computer, assuming the signal
8475 could actually attain the full speed of light. Pretty tight!
8476
8477 @node Types Answer 15, Algebra Answer 1, Types Answer 14, Answers to Exercises
8478 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 15
8479
8480 @noindent
8481 The speed limit is 55 miles per hour on most highways. We want to
8482 find the ratio of Sam's speed to the US speed limit.
8483
8484 @smallexample
8485 @group
8486 1: 55 mph 2: 55 mph 3: 11 hr mph / yd
8487 . 1: 5 yd / hr .
8488 .
8489
8490 ' 55 mph @key{RET} ' 5 yd/hr @key{RET} /
8491 @end group
8492 @end smallexample
8493
8494 The @kbd{u s} command cancels out these units to get a plain
8495 number. Now we take the logarithm base two to find the final
8496 answer, assuming that each successive pill doubles his speed.
8497
8498 @smallexample
8499 @group
8500 1: 19360. 2: 19360. 1: 14.24
8501 . 1: 2 .
8502 .
8503
8504 u s 2 B
8505 @end group
8506 @end smallexample
8507
8508 @noindent
8509 Thus Sam can take up to 14 pills without a worry.
8510
8511 @node Algebra Answer 1, Algebra Answer 2, Types Answer 15, Answers to Exercises
8512 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 1
8513
8514 @noindent
8515 @c [fix-ref Declarations]
8516 The result @samp{sqrt(x)^2} is simplified back to @expr{x} by the
8517 Calculator, but @samp{sqrt(x^2)} is not. (Consider what happens
8518 if @w{@expr{x = -4}}.) If @expr{x} is real, this formula could be
8519 simplified to @samp{abs(x)}, but for general complex arguments even
8520 that is not safe. (@xref{Declarations}, for a way to tell Calc
8521 that @expr{x} is known to be real.)
8522
8523 @node Algebra Answer 2, Algebra Answer 3, Algebra Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8524 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 2
8525
8526 @noindent
8527 Suppose our roots are @expr{[a, b, c]}. We want a polynomial which
8528 is zero when @expr{x} is any of these values. The trivial polynomial
8529 @expr{x-a} is zero when @expr{x=a}, so the product @expr{(x-a)(x-b)(x-c)}
8530 will do the job. We can use @kbd{a c x} to write this in a more
8531 familiar form.
8532
8533 @smallexample
8534 @group
8535 1: 34 x - 24 x^3 1: [1.19023, -1.19023, 0]
8536 . .
8537
8538 r 2 a P x @key{RET}
8539
8540 @end group
8541 @end smallexample
8542 @noindent
8543 @smallexample
8544 @group
8545 1: [x - 1.19023, x + 1.19023, x] 1: (x - 1.19023) (x + 1.19023) x
8546 . .
8547
8548 V M ' x-$ @key{RET} V R *
8549
8550 @end group
8551 @end smallexample
8552 @noindent
8553 @smallexample
8554 @group
8555 1: x^3 - 1.41666 x 1: 34 x - 24 x^3
8556 . .
8557
8558 a c x @key{RET} 24 n * a x
8559 @end group
8560 @end smallexample
8561
8562 @noindent
8563 Sure enough, our answer (multiplied by a suitable constant) is the
8564 same as the original polynomial.
8565
8566 @node Algebra Answer 3, Algebra Answer 4, Algebra Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8567 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 3
8568
8569 @smallexample
8570 @group
8571 1: x sin(pi x) 1: (sin(pi x) - pi x cos(pi x)) / pi^2
8572 . .
8573
8574 ' x sin(pi x) @key{RET} m r a i x @key{RET}
8575
8576 @end group
8577 @end smallexample
8578 @noindent
8579 @smallexample
8580 @group
8581 1: [y, 1]
8582 2: (sin(pi x) - pi x cos(pi x)) / pi^2
8583 .
8584
8585 ' [y,1] @key{RET} @key{TAB}
8586
8587 @end group
8588 @end smallexample
8589 @noindent
8590 @smallexample
8591 @group
8592 1: [(sin(pi y) - pi y cos(pi y)) / pi^2, (sin(pi) - pi cos(pi)) / pi^2]
8593 .
8594
8595 V M $ @key{RET}
8596
8597 @end group
8598 @end smallexample
8599 @noindent
8600 @smallexample
8601 @group
8602 1: (sin(pi y) - pi y cos(pi y)) / pi^2 + (pi cos(pi) - sin(pi)) / pi^2
8603 .
8604
8605 V R -
8606
8607 @end group
8608 @end smallexample
8609 @noindent
8610 @smallexample
8611 @group
8612 1: (sin(3.14159 y) - 3.14159 y cos(3.14159 y)) / 9.8696 - 0.3183
8613 .
8614
8615 =
8616
8617 @end group
8618 @end smallexample
8619 @noindent
8620 @smallexample
8621 @group
8622 1: [0., -0.95493, 0.63662, -1.5915, 1.2732]
8623 .
8624
8625 v x 5 @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET}
8626 @end group
8627 @end smallexample
8628
8629 @node Algebra Answer 4, Rewrites Answer 1, Algebra Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
8630 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 4
8631
8632 @noindent
8633 The hard part is that @kbd{V R +} is no longer sufficient to add up all
8634 the contributions from the slices, since the slices have varying
8635 coefficients. So first we must come up with a vector of these
8636 coefficients. Here's one way:
8637
8638 @smallexample
8639 @group
8640 2: -1 2: 3 1: [4, 2, ..., 4]
8641 1: [1, 2, ..., 9] 1: [-1, 1, ..., -1] .
8642 . .
8643
8644 1 n v x 9 @key{RET} V M ^ 3 @key{TAB} -
8645
8646 @end group
8647 @end smallexample
8648 @noindent
8649 @smallexample
8650 @group
8651 1: [4, 2, ..., 4, 1] 1: [1, 4, 2, ..., 4, 1]
8652 . .
8653
8654 1 | 1 @key{TAB} |
8655 @end group
8656 @end smallexample
8657
8658 @noindent
8659 Now we compute the function values. Note that for this method we need
8660 eleven values, including both endpoints of the desired interval.
8661
8662 @smallexample
8663 @group
8664 2: [1, 4, 2, ..., 4, 1]
8665 1: [1, 1.1, 1.2, ... , 1.8, 1.9, 2.]
8666 .
8667
8668 11 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} .1 @key{RET} C-u v x
8669
8670 @end group
8671 @end smallexample
8672 @noindent
8673 @smallexample
8674 @group
8675 2: [1, 4, 2, ..., 4, 1]
8676 1: [0., 0.084941, 0.16993, ... ]
8677 .
8678
8679 ' sin(x) ln(x) @key{RET} m r p 5 @key{RET} V M $ @key{RET}
8680 @end group
8681 @end smallexample
8682
8683 @noindent
8684 Once again this calls for @kbd{V M * V R +}; a simple @kbd{*} does the
8685 same thing.
8686
8687 @smallexample
8688 @group
8689 1: 11.22 1: 1.122 1: 0.374
8690 . . .
8691
8692 * .1 * 3 /
8693 @end group
8694 @end smallexample
8695
8696 @noindent
8697 Wow! That's even better than the result from the Taylor series method.
8698
8699 @node Rewrites Answer 1, Rewrites Answer 2, Algebra Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
8700 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 1
8701
8702 @noindent
8703 We'll use Big mode to make the formulas more readable.
8704
8705 @smallexample
8706 @group
8707 ___
8708 2 + V 2
8709 1: (2 + sqrt(2)) / (1 + sqrt(2)) 1: --------
8710 . ___
8711 1 + V 2
8712
8713 .
8714
8715 ' (2+sqrt(2)) / (1+sqrt(2)) @key{RET} d B
8716 @end group
8717 @end smallexample
8718
8719 @noindent
8720 Multiplying by the conjugate helps because @expr{(a+b) (a-b) = a^2 - b^2}.
8721
8722 @smallexample
8723 @group
8724 ___ ___
8725 1: (2 + V 2 ) (V 2 - 1)
8726 .
8727
8728 a r a/(b+c) := a*(b-c) / (b^2-c^2) @key{RET}
8729
8730 @end group
8731 @end smallexample
8732 @noindent
8733 @smallexample
8734 @group
8735 ___ ___
8736 1: 2 + V 2 - 2 1: V 2
8737 . .
8738
8739 a r a*(b+c) := a*b + a*c a s
8740 @end group
8741 @end smallexample
8742
8743 @noindent
8744 (We could have used @kbd{a x} instead of a rewrite rule for the
8745 second step.)
8746
8747 The multiply-by-conjugate rule turns out to be useful in many
8748 different circumstances, such as when the denominator involves
8749 sines and cosines or the imaginary constant @code{i}.
8750
8751 @node Rewrites Answer 2, Rewrites Answer 3, Rewrites Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8752 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 2
8753
8754 @noindent
8755 Here is the rule set:
8756
8757 @smallexample
8758 @group
8759 [ fib(n) := fib(n, 1, 1) :: integer(n) :: n >= 1,
8760 fib(1, x, y) := x,
8761 fib(n, x, y) := fib(n-1, y, x+y) ]
8762 @end group
8763 @end smallexample
8764
8765 @noindent
8766 The first rule turns a one-argument @code{fib} that people like to write
8767 into a three-argument @code{fib} that makes computation easier. The
8768 second rule converts back from three-argument form once the computation
8769 is done. The third rule does the computation itself. It basically
8770 says that if @expr{x} and @expr{y} are two consecutive Fibonacci numbers,
8771 then @expr{y} and @expr{x+y} are the next (overlapping) pair of Fibonacci
8772 numbers.
8773
8774 Notice that because the number @expr{n} was ``validated'' by the
8775 conditions on the first rule, there is no need to put conditions on
8776 the other rules because the rule set would never get that far unless
8777 the input were valid. That further speeds computation, since no
8778 extra conditions need to be checked at every step.
8779
8780 Actually, a user with a nasty sense of humor could enter a bad
8781 three-argument @code{fib} call directly, say, @samp{fib(0, 1, 1)},
8782 which would get the rules into an infinite loop. One thing that would
8783 help keep this from happening by accident would be to use something like
8784 @samp{ZzFib} instead of @code{fib} as the name of the three-argument
8785 function.
8786
8787 @node Rewrites Answer 3, Rewrites Answer 4, Rewrites Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8788 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 3
8789
8790 @noindent
8791 He got an infinite loop. First, Calc did as expected and rewrote
8792 @w{@samp{2 + 3 x}} to @samp{f(2, 3, x)}. Then it looked for ways to
8793 apply the rule again, and found that @samp{f(2, 3, x)} looks like
8794 @samp{a + b x} with @w{@samp{a = 0}} and @samp{b = 1}, so it rewrote to
8795 @samp{f(0, 1, f(2, 3, x))}. It then wrapped another @samp{f(0, 1, ...)}
8796 around that, and so on, ad infinitum. Joe should have used @kbd{M-1 a r}
8797 to make sure the rule applied only once.
8798
8799 (Actually, even the first step didn't work as he expected. What Calc
8800 really gives for @kbd{M-1 a r} in this situation is @samp{f(3 x, 1, 2)},
8801 treating 2 as the ``variable,'' and @samp{3 x} as a constant being added
8802 to it. While this may seem odd, it's just as valid a solution as the
8803 ``obvious'' one. One way to fix this would be to add the condition
8804 @samp{:: variable(x)} to the rule, to make sure the thing that matches
8805 @samp{x} is indeed a variable, or to change @samp{x} to @samp{quote(x)}
8806 on the lefthand side, so that the rule matches the actual variable
8807 @samp{x} rather than letting @samp{x} stand for something else.)
8808
8809 @node Rewrites Answer 4, Rewrites Answer 5, Rewrites Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
8810 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 4
8811
8812 @noindent
8813 @ignore
8814 @starindex
8815 @end ignore
8816 @tindex seq
8817 Here is a suitable set of rules to solve the first part of the problem:
8818
8819 @smallexample
8820 @group
8821 [ seq(n, c) := seq(n/2, c+1) :: n%2 = 0,
8822 seq(n, c) := seq(3n+1, c+1) :: n%2 = 1 :: n > 1 ]
8823 @end group
8824 @end smallexample
8825
8826 Given the initial formula @samp{seq(6, 0)}, application of these
8827 rules produces the following sequence of formulas:
8828
8829 @example
8830 seq( 3, 1)
8831 seq(10, 2)
8832 seq( 5, 3)
8833 seq(16, 4)
8834 seq( 8, 5)
8835 seq( 4, 6)
8836 seq( 2, 7)
8837 seq( 1, 8)
8838 @end example
8839
8840 @noindent
8841 whereupon neither of the rules match, and rewriting stops.
8842
8843 We can pretty this up a bit with a couple more rules:
8844
8845 @smallexample
8846 @group
8847 [ seq(n) := seq(n, 0),
8848 seq(1, c) := c,
8849 ... ]
8850 @end group
8851 @end smallexample
8852
8853 @noindent
8854 Now, given @samp{seq(6)} as the starting configuration, we get 8
8855 as the result.
8856
8857 The change to return a vector is quite simple:
8858
8859 @smallexample
8860 @group
8861 [ seq(n) := seq(n, []) :: integer(n) :: n > 0,
8862 seq(1, v) := v | 1,
8863 seq(n, v) := seq(n/2, v | n) :: n%2 = 0,
8864 seq(n, v) := seq(3n+1, v | n) :: n%2 = 1 ]
8865 @end group
8866 @end smallexample
8867
8868 @noindent
8869 Given @samp{seq(6)}, the result is @samp{[6, 3, 10, 5, 16, 8, 4, 2, 1]}.
8870
8871 Notice that the @expr{n > 1} guard is no longer necessary on the last
8872 rule since the @expr{n = 1} case is now detected by another rule.
8873 But a guard has been added to the initial rule to make sure the
8874 initial value is suitable before the computation begins.
8875
8876 While still a good idea, this guard is not as vitally important as it
8877 was for the @code{fib} function, since calling, say, @samp{seq(x, [])}
8878 will not get into an infinite loop. Calc will not be able to prove
8879 the symbol @samp{x} is either even or odd, so none of the rules will
8880 apply and the rewrites will stop right away.
8881
8882 @node Rewrites Answer 5, Rewrites Answer 6, Rewrites Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
8883 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 5
8884
8885 @noindent
8886 @ignore
8887 @starindex
8888 @end ignore
8889 @tindex nterms
8890 If @expr{x} is the sum @expr{a + b}, then `@tfn{nterms(}@var{x}@tfn{)}' must
8891 be `@tfn{nterms(}@var{a}@tfn{)}' plus `@tfn{nterms(}@var{b}@tfn{)}'. If @expr{x}
8892 is not a sum, then `@tfn{nterms(}@var{x}@tfn{)}' = 1.
8893
8894 @smallexample
8895 @group
8896 [ nterms(a + b) := nterms(a) + nterms(b),
8897 nterms(x) := 1 ]
8898 @end group
8899 @end smallexample
8900
8901 @noindent
8902 Here we have taken advantage of the fact that earlier rules always
8903 match before later rules; @samp{nterms(x)} will only be tried if we
8904 already know that @samp{x} is not a sum.
8905
8906 @node Rewrites Answer 6, Programming Answer 1, Rewrites Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
8907 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 6
8908
8909 @noindent
8910 Here is a rule set that will do the job:
8911
8912 @smallexample
8913 @group
8914 [ a*(b + c) := a*b + a*c,
8915 opt(a) O(x^n) + opt(b) O(x^m) := O(x^n) :: n <= m
8916 :: constant(a) :: constant(b),
8917 opt(a) O(x^n) + opt(b) x^m := O(x^n) :: n <= m
8918 :: constant(a) :: constant(b),
8919 a O(x^n) := O(x^n) :: constant(a),
8920 x^opt(m) O(x^n) := O(x^(n+m)),
8921 O(x^n) O(x^m) := O(x^(n+m)) ]
8922 @end group
8923 @end smallexample
8924
8925 If we really want the @kbd{+} and @kbd{*} keys to operate naturally
8926 on power series, we should put these rules in @code{EvalRules}. For
8927 testing purposes, it is better to put them in a different variable,
8928 say, @code{O}, first.
8929
8930 The first rule just expands products of sums so that the rest of the
8931 rules can assume they have an expanded-out polynomial to work with.
8932 Note that this rule does not mention @samp{O} at all, so it will
8933 apply to any product-of-sum it encounters---this rule may surprise
8934 you if you put it into @code{EvalRules}!
8935
8936 In the second rule, the sum of two O's is changed to the smaller O.
8937 The optional constant coefficients are there mostly so that
8938 @samp{O(x^2) - O(x^3)} and @samp{O(x^3) - O(x^2)} are handled
8939 as well as @samp{O(x^2) + O(x^3)}.
8940
8941 The third rule absorbs higher powers of @samp{x} into O's.
8942
8943 The fourth rule says that a constant times a negligible quantity
8944 is still negligible. (This rule will also match @samp{O(x^3) / 4},
8945 with @samp{a = 1/4}.)
8946
8947 The fifth rule rewrites, for example, @samp{x^2 O(x^3)} to @samp{O(x^5)}.
8948 (It is easy to see that if one of these forms is negligible, the other
8949 is, too.) Notice the @samp{x^opt(m)} to pick up terms like
8950 @w{@samp{x O(x^3)}}. Optional powers will match @samp{x} as @samp{x^1}
8951 but not 1 as @samp{x^0}. This turns out to be exactly what we want here.
8952
8953 The sixth rule is the corresponding rule for products of two O's.
8954
8955 Another way to solve this problem would be to create a new ``data type''
8956 that represents truncated power series. We might represent these as
8957 function calls @samp{series(@var{coefs}, @var{x})} where @var{coefs} is
8958 a vector of coefficients for @expr{x^0}, @expr{x^1}, @expr{x^2}, and so
8959 on. Rules would exist for sums and products of such @code{series}
8960 objects, and as an optional convenience could also know how to combine a
8961 @code{series} object with a normal polynomial. (With this, and with a
8962 rule that rewrites @samp{O(x^n)} to the equivalent @code{series} form,
8963 you could still enter power series in exactly the same notation as
8964 before.) Operations on such objects would probably be more efficient,
8965 although the objects would be a bit harder to read.
8966
8967 @c [fix-ref Compositions]
8968 Some other symbolic math programs provide a power series data type
8969 similar to this. Mathematica, for example, has an object that looks
8970 like @samp{PowerSeries[@var{x}, @var{x0}, @var{coefs}, @var{nmin},
8971 @var{nmax}, @var{den}]}, where @var{x0} is the point about which the
8972 power series is taken (we've been assuming this was always zero),
8973 and @var{nmin}, @var{nmax}, and @var{den} allow pseudo-power-series
8974 with fractional or negative powers. Also, the @code{PowerSeries}
8975 objects have a special display format that makes them look like
8976 @samp{2 x^2 + O(x^4)} when they are printed out. (@xref{Compositions},
8977 for a way to do this in Calc, although for something as involved as
8978 this it would probably be better to write the formatting routine
8979 in Lisp.)
8980
8981 @node Programming Answer 1, Programming Answer 2, Rewrites Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
8982 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 1
8983
8984 @noindent
8985 Just enter the formula @samp{ninteg(sin(t)/t, t, 0, x)}, type
8986 @kbd{Z F}, and answer the questions. Since this formula contains two
8987 variables, the default argument list will be @samp{(t x)}. We want to
8988 change this to @samp{(x)} since @expr{t} is really a dummy variable
8989 to be used within @code{ninteg}.
8990
8991 The exact keystrokes are @kbd{Z F s Si @key{RET} @key{RET} C-b C-b @key{DEL} @key{DEL} @key{RET} y}.
8992 (The @kbd{C-b C-b @key{DEL} @key{DEL}} are what fix the argument list.)
8993
8994 @node Programming Answer 2, Programming Answer 3, Programming Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8995 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 2
8996
8997 @noindent
8998 One way is to move the number to the top of the stack, operate on
8999 it, then move it back: @kbd{C-x ( M-@key{TAB} n M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} C-x )}.
9000
9001 Another way is to negate the top three stack entries, then negate
9002 again the top two stack entries: @kbd{C-x ( M-3 n M-2 n C-x )}.
9003
9004 Finally, it turns out that a negative prefix argument causes a
9005 command like @kbd{n} to operate on the specified stack entry only,
9006 which is just what we want: @kbd{C-x ( M-- 3 n C-x )}.
9007
9008 Just for kicks, let's also do it algebraically:
9009 @w{@kbd{C-x ( ' -$$$, $$, $ @key{RET} C-x )}}.
9010
9011 @node Programming Answer 3, Programming Answer 4, Programming Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
9012 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 3
9013
9014 @noindent
9015 Each of these functions can be computed using the stack, or using
9016 algebraic entry, whichever way you prefer:
9017
9018 @noindent
9019 Computing
9020 @texline @math{\displaystyle{\sin x \over x}}:
9021 @infoline @expr{sin(x) / x}:
9022
9023 Using the stack: @kbd{C-x ( @key{RET} S @key{TAB} / C-x )}.
9024
9025 Using algebraic entry: @kbd{C-x ( ' sin($)/$ @key{RET} C-x )}.
9026
9027 @noindent
9028 Computing the logarithm:
9029
9030 Using the stack: @kbd{C-x ( @key{TAB} B C-x )}
9031
9032 Using algebraic entry: @kbd{C-x ( ' log($,$$) @key{RET} C-x )}.
9033
9034 @noindent
9035 Computing the vector of integers:
9036
9037 Using the stack: @kbd{C-x ( 1 @key{RET} 1 C-u v x C-x )}. (Recall that
9038 @kbd{C-u v x} takes the vector size, starting value, and increment
9039 from the stack.)
9040
9041 Alternatively: @kbd{C-x ( ~ v x C-x )}. (The @kbd{~} key pops a
9042 number from the stack and uses it as the prefix argument for the
9043 next command.)
9044
9045 Using algebraic entry: @kbd{C-x ( ' index($) @key{RET} C-x )}.
9046
9047 @node Programming Answer 4, Programming Answer 5, Programming Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
9048 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 4
9049
9050 @noindent
9051 Here's one way: @kbd{C-x ( @key{RET} V R + @key{TAB} v l / C-x )}.
9052
9053 @node Programming Answer 5, Programming Answer 6, Programming Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
9054 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 5
9055
9056 @smallexample
9057 @group
9058 2: 1 1: 1.61803398502 2: 1.61803398502
9059 1: 20 . 1: 1.61803398875
9060 . .
9061
9062 1 @key{RET} 20 Z < & 1 + Z > I H P
9063 @end group
9064 @end smallexample
9065
9066 @noindent
9067 This answer is quite accurate.
9068
9069 @node Programming Answer 6, Programming Answer 7, Programming Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
9070 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 6
9071
9072 @noindent
9073 Here is the matrix:
9074
9075 @example
9076 [ [ 0, 1 ] * [a, b] = [b, a + b]
9077 [ 1, 1 ] ]
9078 @end example
9079
9080 @noindent
9081 Thus @samp{[0, 1; 1, 1]^n * [1, 1]} computes Fibonacci numbers @expr{n+1}
9082 and @expr{n+2}. Here's one program that does the job:
9083
9084 @example
9085 C-x ( ' [0, 1; 1, 1] ^ ($-1) * [1, 1] @key{RET} v u @key{DEL} C-x )
9086 @end example
9087
9088 @noindent
9089 This program is quite efficient because Calc knows how to raise a
9090 matrix (or other value) to the power @expr{n} in only
9091 @texline @math{\log_2 n}
9092 @infoline @expr{log(n,2)}
9093 steps. For example, this program can compute the 1000th Fibonacci
9094 number (a 209-digit integer!) in about 10 steps; even though the
9095 @kbd{Z < ... Z >} solution had much simpler steps, it would have
9096 required so many steps that it would not have been practical.
9097
9098 @node Programming Answer 7, Programming Answer 8, Programming Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
9099 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 7
9100
9101 @noindent
9102 The trick here is to compute the harmonic numbers differently, so that
9103 the loop counter itself accumulates the sum of reciprocals. We use
9104 a separate variable to hold the integer counter.
9105
9106 @smallexample
9107 @group
9108 1: 1 2: 1 1: .
9109 . 1: 4
9110 .
9111
9112 1 t 1 1 @key{RET} 4 Z ( t 2 r 1 1 + s 1 & Z )
9113 @end group
9114 @end smallexample
9115
9116 @noindent
9117 The body of the loop goes as follows: First save the harmonic sum
9118 so far in variable 2. Then delete it from the stack; the for loop
9119 itself will take care of remembering it for us. Next, recall the
9120 count from variable 1, add one to it, and feed its reciprocal to
9121 the for loop to use as the step value. The for loop will increase
9122 the ``loop counter'' by that amount and keep going until the
9123 loop counter exceeds 4.
9124
9125 @smallexample
9126 @group
9127 2: 31 3: 31
9128 1: 3.99498713092 2: 3.99498713092
9129 . 1: 4.02724519544
9130 .
9131
9132 r 1 r 2 @key{RET} 31 & +
9133 @end group
9134 @end smallexample
9135
9136 Thus we find that the 30th harmonic number is 3.99, and the 31st
9137 harmonic number is 4.02.
9138
9139 @node Programming Answer 8, Programming Answer 9, Programming Answer 7, Answers to Exercises
9140 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 8
9141
9142 @noindent
9143 The first step is to compute the derivative @expr{f'(x)} and thus
9144 the formula
9145 @texline @math{\displaystyle{x - {f(x) \over f'(x)}}}.
9146 @infoline @expr{x - f(x)/f'(x)}.
9147
9148 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9149 below. You can use @w{@kbd{C-x * m}} to load it from there. While you are
9150 entering a @kbd{Z ` Z '} body in a macro, Calc simply collects
9151 keystrokes without executing them. In the following diagrams we'll
9152 pretend Calc actually executed the keystrokes as you typed them,
9153 just for purposes of illustration.)
9154
9155 @smallexample
9156 @group
9157 2: sin(cos(x)) - 0.5 3: 4.5
9158 1: 4.5 2: sin(cos(x)) - 0.5
9159 . 1: -(sin(x) cos(cos(x)))
9160 .
9161
9162 ' sin(cos(x))-0.5 @key{RET} 4.5 m r C-x ( Z ` @key{TAB} @key{RET} a d x @key{RET}
9163
9164 @end group
9165 @end smallexample
9166 @noindent
9167 @smallexample
9168 @group
9169 2: 4.5
9170 1: x + (sin(cos(x)) - 0.5) / sin(x) cos(cos(x))
9171 .
9172
9173 / ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} - t 1
9174 @end group
9175 @end smallexample
9176
9177 Now, we enter the loop. We'll use a repeat loop with a 20-repetition
9178 limit just in case the method fails to converge for some reason.
9179 (Normally, the @w{@kbd{Z /}} command will stop the loop before all 20
9180 repetitions are done.)
9181
9182 @smallexample
9183 @group
9184 1: 4.5 3: 4.5 2: 4.5
9185 . 2: x + (sin(cos(x)) ... 1: 5.24196456928
9186 1: 4.5 .
9187 .
9188
9189 20 Z < @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} s l x @key{RET}
9190 @end group
9191 @end smallexample
9192
9193 This is the new guess for @expr{x}. Now we compare it with the
9194 old one to see if we've converged.
9195
9196 @smallexample
9197 @group
9198 3: 5.24196 2: 5.24196 1: 5.24196 1: 5.26345856348
9199 2: 5.24196 1: 0 . .
9200 1: 4.5 .
9201 .
9202
9203 @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z / Z > Z ' C-x )
9204 @end group
9205 @end smallexample
9206
9207 The loop converges in just a few steps to this value. To check
9208 the result, we can simply substitute it back into the equation.
9209
9210 @smallexample
9211 @group
9212 2: 5.26345856348
9213 1: 0.499999999997
9214 .
9215
9216 @key{RET} ' sin(cos($)) @key{RET}
9217 @end group
9218 @end smallexample
9219
9220 Let's test the new definition again:
9221
9222 @smallexample
9223 @group
9224 2: x^2 - 9 1: 3.
9225 1: 1 .
9226 .
9227
9228 ' x^2-9 @key{RET} 1 X
9229 @end group
9230 @end smallexample
9231
9232 Once again, here's the full Newton's Method definition:
9233
9234 @example
9235 @group
9236 C-x ( Z ` @key{TAB} @key{RET} a d x @key{RET} / ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} - t 1
9237 20 Z < @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} s l x @key{RET}
9238 @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z /
9239 Z >
9240 Z '
9241 C-x )
9242 @end group
9243 @end example
9244
9245 @c [fix-ref Nesting and Fixed Points]
9246 It turns out that Calc has a built-in command for applying a formula
9247 repeatedly until it converges to a number. @xref{Nesting and Fixed Points},
9248 to see how to use it.
9249
9250 @c [fix-ref Root Finding]
9251 Also, of course, @kbd{a R} is a built-in command that uses Newton's
9252 method (among others) to look for numerical solutions to any equation.
9253 @xref{Root Finding}.
9254
9255 @node Programming Answer 9, Programming Answer 10, Programming Answer 8, Answers to Exercises
9256 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 9
9257
9258 @noindent
9259 The first step is to adjust @expr{z} to be greater than 5. A simple
9260 ``for'' loop will do the job here. If @expr{z} is less than 5, we
9261 reduce the problem using
9262 @texline @math{\psi(z) = \psi(z+1) - 1/z}.
9263 @infoline @expr{psi(z) = psi(z+1) - 1/z}. We go
9264 on to compute
9265 @texline @math{\psi(z+1)},
9266 @infoline @expr{psi(z+1)},
9267 and remember to add back a factor of @expr{-1/z} when we're done. This
9268 step is repeated until @expr{z > 5}.
9269
9270 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9271 below. You can use @w{@kbd{C-x * m}} to load it from there. While you are
9272 entering a @kbd{Z ` Z '} body in a macro, Calc simply collects
9273 keystrokes without executing them. In the following diagrams we'll
9274 pretend Calc actually executed the keystrokes as you typed them,
9275 just for purposes of illustration.)
9276
9277 @smallexample
9278 @group
9279 1: 1. 1: 1.
9280 . .
9281
9282 1.0 @key{RET} C-x ( Z ` s 1 0 t 2
9283 @end group
9284 @end smallexample
9285
9286 Here, variable 1 holds @expr{z} and variable 2 holds the adjustment
9287 factor. If @expr{z < 5}, we use a loop to increase it.
9288
9289 (By the way, we started with @samp{1.0} instead of the integer 1 because
9290 otherwise the calculation below will try to do exact fractional arithmetic,
9291 and will never converge because fractions compare equal only if they
9292 are exactly equal, not just equal to within the current precision.)
9293
9294 @smallexample
9295 @group
9296 3: 1. 2: 1. 1: 6.
9297 2: 1. 1: 1 .
9298 1: 5 .
9299 .
9300
9301 @key{RET} 5 a < Z [ 5 Z ( & s + 2 1 s + 1 1 Z ) r 1 Z ]
9302 @end group
9303 @end smallexample
9304
9305 Now we compute the initial part of the sum:
9306 @texline @math{\ln z - {1 \over 2z}}
9307 @infoline @expr{ln(z) - 1/2z}
9308 minus the adjustment factor.
9309
9310 @smallexample
9311 @group
9312 2: 1.79175946923 2: 1.7084261359 1: -0.57490719743
9313 1: 0.0833333333333 1: 2.28333333333 .
9314 . .
9315
9316 L r 1 2 * & - r 2 -
9317 @end group
9318 @end smallexample
9319
9320 Now we evaluate the series. We'll use another ``for'' loop counting
9321 up the value of @expr{2 n}. (Calc does have a summation command,
9322 @kbd{a +}, but we'll use loops just to get more practice with them.)
9323
9324 @smallexample
9325 @group
9326 3: -0.5749 3: -0.5749 4: -0.5749 2: -0.5749
9327 2: 2 2: 1:6 3: 1:6 1: 2.3148e-3
9328 1: 40 1: 2 2: 2 .
9329 . . 1: 36.
9330 .
9331
9332 2 @key{RET} 40 Z ( @key{RET} k b @key{TAB} @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} ^ * /
9333
9334 @end group
9335 @end smallexample
9336 @noindent
9337 @smallexample
9338 @group
9339 3: -0.5749 3: -0.5772 2: -0.5772 1: -0.577215664892
9340 2: -0.5749 2: -0.5772 1: 0 .
9341 1: 2.3148e-3 1: -0.5749 .
9342 . .
9343
9344 @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} - @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z / 2 Z ) Z ' C-x )
9345 @end group
9346 @end smallexample
9347
9348 This is the value of
9349 @texline @math{-\gamma},
9350 @infoline @expr{- gamma},
9351 with a slight bit of roundoff error. To get a full 12 digits, let's use
9352 a higher precision:
9353
9354 @smallexample
9355 @group
9356 2: -0.577215664892 2: -0.577215664892
9357 1: 1. 1: -0.577215664901532
9358
9359 1. @key{RET} p 16 @key{RET} X
9360 @end group
9361 @end smallexample
9362
9363 Here's the complete sequence of keystrokes:
9364
9365 @example
9366 @group
9367 C-x ( Z ` s 1 0 t 2
9368 @key{RET} 5 a < Z [ 5 Z ( & s + 2 1 s + 1 1 Z ) r 1 Z ]
9369 L r 1 2 * & - r 2 -
9370 2 @key{RET} 40 Z ( @key{RET} k b @key{TAB} @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} ^ * /
9371 @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} - @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z /
9372 2 Z )
9373 Z '
9374 C-x )
9375 @end group
9376 @end example
9377
9378 @node Programming Answer 10, Programming Answer 11, Programming Answer 9, Answers to Exercises
9379 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 10
9380
9381 @noindent
9382 Taking the derivative of a term of the form @expr{x^n} will produce
9383 a term like
9384 @texline @math{n x^{n-1}}.
9385 @infoline @expr{n x^(n-1)}.
9386 Taking the derivative of a constant
9387 produces zero. From this it is easy to see that the @expr{n}th
9388 derivative of a polynomial, evaluated at @expr{x = 0}, will equal the
9389 coefficient on the @expr{x^n} term times @expr{n!}.
9390
9391 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9392 below. You can use @w{@kbd{C-x * m}} to load it from there. While you are
9393 entering a @kbd{Z ` Z '} body in a macro, Calc simply collects
9394 keystrokes without executing them. In the following diagrams we'll
9395 pretend Calc actually executed the keystrokes as you typed them,
9396 just for purposes of illustration.)
9397
9398 @smallexample
9399 @group
9400 2: 5 x^4 + (x + 1)^2 3: 5 x^4 + (x + 1)^2
9401 1: 6 2: 0
9402 . 1: 6
9403 .
9404
9405 ' 5 x^4 + (x+1)^2 @key{RET} 6 C-x ( Z ` [ ] t 1 0 @key{TAB}
9406 @end group
9407 @end smallexample
9408
9409 @noindent
9410 Variable 1 will accumulate the vector of coefficients.
9411
9412 @smallexample
9413 @group
9414 2: 0 3: 0 2: 5 x^4 + ...
9415 1: 5 x^4 + ... 2: 5 x^4 + ... 1: 1
9416 . 1: 1 .
9417 .
9418
9419 Z ( @key{TAB} @key{RET} 0 s l x @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} ! / s | 1
9420 @end group
9421 @end smallexample
9422
9423 @noindent
9424 Note that @kbd{s | 1} appends the top-of-stack value to the vector
9425 in a variable; it is completely analogous to @kbd{s + 1}. We could
9426 have written instead, @kbd{r 1 @key{TAB} | t 1}.
9427
9428 @smallexample
9429 @group
9430 1: 20 x^3 + 2 x + 2 1: 0 1: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0]
9431 . . .
9432
9433 a d x @key{RET} 1 Z ) @key{DEL} r 1 Z ' C-x )
9434 @end group
9435 @end smallexample
9436
9437 To convert back, a simple method is just to map the coefficients
9438 against a table of powers of @expr{x}.
9439
9440 @smallexample
9441 @group
9442 2: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0] 2: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0]
9443 1: 6 1: [0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6]
9444 . .
9445
9446 6 @key{RET} 1 + 0 @key{RET} 1 C-u v x
9447
9448 @end group
9449 @end smallexample
9450 @noindent
9451 @smallexample
9452 @group
9453 2: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0] 2: 1 + 2 x + x^2 + 5 x^4
9454 1: [1, x, x^2, x^3, ... ] .
9455 .
9456
9457 ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M ^ *
9458 @end group
9459 @end smallexample
9460
9461 Once again, here are the whole polynomial to/from vector programs:
9462
9463 @example
9464 @group
9465 C-x ( Z ` [ ] t 1 0 @key{TAB}
9466 Z ( @key{TAB} @key{RET} 0 s l x @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} ! / s | 1
9467 a d x @key{RET}
9468 1 Z ) r 1
9469 Z '
9470 C-x )
9471
9472 C-x ( 1 + 0 @key{RET} 1 C-u v x ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M ^ * C-x )
9473 @end group
9474 @end example
9475
9476 @node Programming Answer 11, Programming Answer 12, Programming Answer 10, Answers to Exercises
9477 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 11
9478
9479 @noindent
9480 First we define a dummy program to go on the @kbd{z s} key. The true
9481 @w{@kbd{z s}} key is supposed to take two numbers from the stack and
9482 return one number, so @key{DEL} as a dummy definition will make
9483 sure the stack comes out right.
9484
9485 @smallexample
9486 @group
9487 2: 4 1: 4 2: 4
9488 1: 2 . 1: 2
9489 . .
9490
9491 4 @key{RET} 2 C-x ( @key{DEL} C-x ) Z K s @key{RET} 2
9492 @end group
9493 @end smallexample
9494
9495 The last step replaces the 2 that was eaten during the creation
9496 of the dummy @kbd{z s} command. Now we move on to the real
9497 definition. The recurrence needs to be rewritten slightly,
9498 to the form @expr{s(n,m) = s(n-1,m-1) - (n-1) s(n-1,m)}.
9499
9500 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9501 below. You can use @kbd{C-x * m} to load it from there.)
9502
9503 @smallexample
9504 @group
9505 2: 4 4: 4 3: 4 2: 4
9506 1: 2 3: 2 2: 2 1: 2
9507 . 2: 4 1: 0 .
9508 1: 2 .
9509 .
9510
9511 C-x ( M-2 @key{RET} a = Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 1 Z :
9512
9513 @end group
9514 @end smallexample
9515 @noindent
9516 @smallexample
9517 @group
9518 4: 4 2: 4 2: 3 4: 3 4: 3 3: 3
9519 3: 2 1: 2 1: 2 3: 2 3: 2 2: 2
9520 2: 2 . . 2: 3 2: 3 1: 3
9521 1: 0 1: 2 1: 1 .
9522 . . .
9523
9524 @key{RET} 0 a = Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 0 Z : @key{TAB} 1 - @key{TAB} M-2 @key{RET} 1 - z s
9525 @end group
9526 @end smallexample
9527
9528 @noindent
9529 (Note that the value 3 that our dummy @kbd{z s} produces is not correct;
9530 it is merely a placeholder that will do just as well for now.)
9531
9532 @smallexample
9533 @group
9534 3: 3 4: 3 3: 3 2: 3 1: -6
9535 2: 3 3: 3 2: 3 1: 9 .
9536 1: 2 2: 3 1: 3 .
9537 . 1: 2 .
9538 .
9539
9540 M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} z s * -
9541
9542 @end group
9543 @end smallexample
9544 @noindent
9545 @smallexample
9546 @group
9547 1: -6 2: 4 1: 11 2: 11
9548 . 1: 2 . 1: 11
9549 . .
9550
9551 Z ] Z ] C-x ) Z K s @key{RET} @key{DEL} 4 @key{RET} 2 z s M-@key{RET} k s
9552 @end group
9553 @end smallexample
9554
9555 Even though the result that we got during the definition was highly
9556 bogus, once the definition is complete the @kbd{z s} command gets
9557 the right answers.
9558
9559 Here's the full program once again:
9560
9561 @example
9562 @group
9563 C-x ( M-2 @key{RET} a =
9564 Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 1
9565 Z : @key{RET} 0 a =
9566 Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 0
9567 Z : @key{TAB} 1 - @key{TAB} M-2 @key{RET} 1 - z s
9568 M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} z s * -
9569 Z ]
9570 Z ]
9571 C-x )
9572 @end group
9573 @end example
9574
9575 You can read this definition using @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro})
9576 followed by @kbd{Z K s}, without having to make a dummy definition
9577 first, because @code{read-kbd-macro} doesn't need to execute the
9578 definition as it reads it in. For this reason, @code{C-x * m} is often
9579 the easiest way to create recursive programs in Calc.
9580
9581 @node Programming Answer 12, , Programming Answer 11, Answers to Exercises
9582 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 12
9583
9584 @noindent
9585 This turns out to be a much easier way to solve the problem. Let's
9586 denote Stirling numbers as calls of the function @samp{s}.
9587
9588 First, we store the rewrite rules corresponding to the definition of
9589 Stirling numbers in a convenient variable:
9590
9591 @smallexample
9592 s e StirlingRules @key{RET}
9593 [ s(n,n) := 1 :: n >= 0,
9594 s(n,0) := 0 :: n > 0,
9595 s(n,m) := s(n-1,m-1) - (n-1) s(n-1,m) :: n >= m :: m >= 1 ]
9596 C-c C-c
9597 @end smallexample
9598
9599 Now, it's just a matter of applying the rules:
9600
9601 @smallexample
9602 @group
9603 2: 4 1: s(4, 2) 1: 11
9604 1: 2 . .
9605 .
9606
9607 4 @key{RET} 2 C-x ( ' s($$,$) @key{RET} a r StirlingRules @key{RET} C-x )
9608 @end group
9609 @end smallexample
9610
9611 As in the case of the @code{fib} rules, it would be useful to put these
9612 rules in @code{EvalRules} and to add a @samp{:: remember} condition to
9613 the last rule.
9614
9615 @c This ends the table-of-contents kludge from above:
9616 @tex
9617 \global\let\chapternofonts=\oldchapternofonts
9618 @end tex
9619
9620 @c [reference]
9621
9622 @node Introduction, Data Types, Tutorial, Top
9623 @chapter Introduction
9624
9625 @noindent
9626 This chapter is the beginning of the Calc reference manual.
9627 It covers basic concepts such as the stack, algebraic and
9628 numeric entry, undo, numeric prefix arguments, etc.
9629
9630 @c [when-split]
9631 @c (Chapter 2, the Tutorial, has been printed in a separate volume.)
9632
9633 @menu
9634 * Basic Commands::
9635 * Help Commands::
9636 * Stack Basics::
9637 * Numeric Entry::
9638 * Algebraic Entry::
9639 * Quick Calculator::
9640 * Prefix Arguments::
9641 * Undo::
9642 * Error Messages::
9643 * Multiple Calculators::
9644 * Troubleshooting Commands::
9645 @end menu
9646
9647 @node Basic Commands, Help Commands, Introduction, Introduction
9648 @section Basic Commands
9649
9650 @noindent
9651 @pindex calc
9652 @pindex calc-mode
9653 @cindex Starting the Calculator
9654 @cindex Running the Calculator
9655 To start the Calculator in its standard interface, type @kbd{M-x calc}.
9656 By default this creates a pair of small windows, @samp{*Calculator*}
9657 and @samp{*Calc Trail*}. The former displays the contents of the
9658 Calculator stack and is manipulated exclusively through Calc commands.
9659 It is possible (though not usually necessary) to create several Calc
9660 mode buffers each of which has an independent stack, undo list, and
9661 mode settings. There is exactly one Calc Trail buffer; it records a
9662 list of the results of all calculations that have been done. The
9663 Calc Trail buffer uses a variant of Calc mode, so Calculator commands
9664 still work when the trail buffer's window is selected. It is possible
9665 to turn the trail window off, but the @samp{*Calc Trail*} buffer itself
9666 still exists and is updated silently. @xref{Trail Commands}.
9667
9668 @kindex C-x * c
9669 @kindex C-x * *
9670 @ignore
9671 @mindex @null
9672 @end ignore
9673 In most installations, the @kbd{C-x * c} key sequence is a more
9674 convenient way to start the Calculator. Also, @kbd{C-x * *}
9675 is a synonym for @kbd{C-x * c} unless you last used Calc
9676 in its Keypad mode.
9677
9678 @kindex x
9679 @kindex M-x
9680 @pindex calc-execute-extended-command
9681 Most Calc commands use one or two keystrokes. Lower- and upper-case
9682 letters are distinct. Commands may also be entered in full @kbd{M-x} form;
9683 for some commands this is the only form. As a convenience, the @kbd{x}
9684 key (@code{calc-execute-extended-command})
9685 is like @kbd{M-x} except that it enters the initial string @samp{calc-}
9686 for you. For example, the following key sequences are equivalent:
9687 @kbd{S}, @kbd{M-x calc-sin @key{RET}}, @kbd{x sin @key{RET}}.
9688
9689 Although Calc is designed to be used from the keyboard, some of
9690 Calc's more common commands are available from a menu. In the menu, the
9691 arguments to the functions are given by referring to their stack level
9692 numbers.
9693
9694 @cindex Extensions module
9695 @cindex @file{calc-ext} module
9696 The Calculator exists in many parts. When you type @kbd{C-x * c}, the
9697 Emacs ``auto-load'' mechanism will bring in only the first part, which
9698 contains the basic arithmetic functions. The other parts will be
9699 auto-loaded the first time you use the more advanced commands like trig
9700 functions or matrix operations. This is done to improve the response time
9701 of the Calculator in the common case when all you need to do is a
9702 little arithmetic. If for some reason the Calculator fails to load an
9703 extension module automatically, you can force it to load all the
9704 extensions by using the @kbd{C-x * L} (@code{calc-load-everything})
9705 command. @xref{Mode Settings}.
9706
9707 If you type @kbd{M-x calc} or @kbd{C-x * c} with any numeric prefix argument,
9708 the Calculator is loaded if necessary, but it is not actually started.
9709 If the argument is positive, the @file{calc-ext} extensions are also
9710 loaded if necessary. User-written Lisp code that wishes to make use
9711 of Calc's arithmetic routines can use @samp{(calc 0)} or @samp{(calc 1)}
9712 to auto-load the Calculator.
9713
9714 @kindex C-x * b
9715 @pindex full-calc
9716 If you type @kbd{C-x * b}, then next time you use @kbd{C-x * c} you
9717 will get a Calculator that uses the full height of the Emacs screen.
9718 When full-screen mode is on, @kbd{C-x * c} runs the @code{full-calc}
9719 command instead of @code{calc}. From the Unix shell you can type
9720 @samp{emacs -f full-calc} to start a new Emacs specifically for use
9721 as a calculator. When Calc is started from the Emacs command line
9722 like this, Calc's normal ``quit'' commands actually quit Emacs itself.
9723
9724 @kindex C-x * o
9725 @pindex calc-other-window
9726 The @kbd{C-x * o} command is like @kbd{C-x * c} except that the Calc
9727 window is not actually selected. If you are already in the Calc
9728 window, @kbd{C-x * o} switches you out of it. (The regular Emacs
9729 @kbd{C-x o} command would also work for this, but it has a
9730 tendency to drop you into the Calc Trail window instead, which
9731 @kbd{C-x * o} takes care not to do.)
9732
9733 @ignore
9734 @mindex C-x * q
9735 @end ignore
9736 For one quick calculation, you can type @kbd{C-x * q} (@code{quick-calc})
9737 which prompts you for a formula (like @samp{2+3/4}). The result is
9738 displayed at the bottom of the Emacs screen without ever creating
9739 any special Calculator windows. @xref{Quick Calculator}.
9740
9741 @ignore
9742 @mindex C-x * k
9743 @end ignore
9744 Finally, if you are using the X window system you may want to try
9745 @kbd{C-x * k} (@code{calc-keypad}) which runs Calc with a
9746 ``calculator keypad'' picture as well as a stack display. Click on
9747 the keys with the mouse to operate the calculator. @xref{Keypad Mode}.
9748
9749 @kindex q
9750 @pindex calc-quit
9751 @cindex Quitting the Calculator
9752 @cindex Exiting the Calculator
9753 The @kbd{q} key (@code{calc-quit}) exits Calc mode and closes the
9754 Calculator's window(s). It does not delete the Calculator buffers.
9755 If you type @kbd{M-x calc} again, the Calculator will reappear with the
9756 contents of the stack intact. Typing @kbd{C-x * c} or @kbd{C-x * *}
9757 again from inside the Calculator buffer is equivalent to executing
9758 @code{calc-quit}; you can think of @kbd{C-x * *} as toggling the
9759 Calculator on and off.
9760
9761 @kindex C-x * x
9762 The @kbd{C-x * x} command also turns the Calculator off, no matter which
9763 user interface (standard, Keypad, or Embedded) is currently active.
9764 It also cancels @code{calc-edit} mode if used from there.
9765
9766 @kindex d @key{SPC}
9767 @pindex calc-refresh
9768 @cindex Refreshing a garbled display
9769 @cindex Garbled displays, refreshing
9770 The @kbd{d @key{SPC}} key sequence (@code{calc-refresh}) redraws the contents
9771 of the Calculator buffer from memory. Use this if the contents of the
9772 buffer have been damaged somehow.
9773
9774 @ignore
9775 @mindex o
9776 @end ignore
9777 The @kbd{o} key (@code{calc-realign}) moves the cursor back to its
9778 ``home'' position at the bottom of the Calculator buffer.
9779
9780 @kindex <
9781 @kindex >
9782 @pindex calc-scroll-left
9783 @pindex calc-scroll-right
9784 @cindex Horizontal scrolling
9785 @cindex Scrolling
9786 @cindex Wide text, scrolling
9787 The @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} keys are bound to @code{calc-scroll-left} and
9788 @code{calc-scroll-right}. These are just like the normal horizontal
9789 scrolling commands except that they scroll one half-screen at a time by
9790 default. (Calc formats its output to fit within the bounds of the
9791 window whenever it can.)
9792
9793 @kindex @{
9794 @kindex @}
9795 @pindex calc-scroll-down
9796 @pindex calc-scroll-up
9797 @cindex Vertical scrolling
9798 The @kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}} keys are bound to @code{calc-scroll-down}
9799 and @code{calc-scroll-up}. They scroll up or down by one-half the
9800 height of the Calc window.
9801
9802 @kindex C-x * 0
9803 @pindex calc-reset
9804 The @kbd{C-x * 0} command (@code{calc-reset}; that's @kbd{C-x *} followed
9805 by a zero) resets the Calculator to its initial state. This clears
9806 the stack, resets all the modes to their initial values (the values
9807 that were saved with @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes})), clears the
9808 caches (@pxref{Caches}), and so on. (It does @emph{not} erase the
9809 values of any variables.) With an argument of 0, Calc will be reset to
9810 its default state; namely, the modes will be given their default values.
9811 With a positive prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * 0} preserves the contents of
9812 the stack but resets everything else to its initial state; with a
9813 negative prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * 0} preserves the contents of the
9814 stack but resets everything else to its default state.
9815
9816 @node Help Commands, Stack Basics, Basic Commands, Introduction
9817 @section Help Commands
9818
9819 @noindent
9820 @cindex Help commands
9821 @kindex ?
9822 @pindex calc-help
9823 The @kbd{?} key (@code{calc-help}) displays a series of brief help messages.
9824 Some keys (such as @kbd{b} and @kbd{d}) are prefix keys, like Emacs'
9825 @key{ESC} and @kbd{C-x} prefixes. You can type
9826 @kbd{?} after a prefix to see a list of commands beginning with that
9827 prefix. (If the message includes @samp{[MORE]}, press @kbd{?} again
9828 to see additional commands for that prefix.)
9829
9830 @kindex h h
9831 @pindex calc-full-help
9832 The @kbd{h h} (@code{calc-full-help}) command displays all the @kbd{?}
9833 responses at once. When printed, this makes a nice, compact (three pages)
9834 summary of Calc keystrokes.
9835
9836 In general, the @kbd{h} key prefix introduces various commands that
9837 provide help within Calc. Many of the @kbd{h} key functions are
9838 Calc-specific analogues to the @kbd{C-h} functions for Emacs help.
9839
9840 @kindex h i
9841 @kindex C-x * i
9842 @kindex i
9843 @pindex calc-info
9844 The @kbd{h i} (@code{calc-info}) command runs the Emacs Info system
9845 to read this manual on-line. This is basically the same as typing
9846 @kbd{C-h i} (the regular way to run the Info system), then, if Info
9847 is not already in the Calc manual, selecting the beginning of the
9848 manual. The @kbd{C-x * i} command is another way to read the Calc
9849 manual; it is different from @kbd{h i} in that it works any time,
9850 not just inside Calc. The plain @kbd{i} key is also equivalent to
9851 @kbd{h i}, though this key is obsolete and may be replaced with a
9852 different command in a future version of Calc.
9853
9854 @kindex h t
9855 @kindex C-x * t
9856 @pindex calc-tutorial
9857 The @kbd{h t} (@code{calc-tutorial}) command runs the Info system on
9858 the Tutorial section of the Calc manual. It is like @kbd{h i},
9859 except that it selects the starting node of the tutorial rather
9860 than the beginning of the whole manual. (It actually selects the
9861 node ``Interactive Tutorial'' which tells a few things about
9862 using the Info system before going on to the actual tutorial.)
9863 The @kbd{C-x * t} key is equivalent to @kbd{h t} (but it works at
9864 all times).
9865
9866 @kindex h s
9867 @kindex C-x * s
9868 @pindex calc-info-summary
9869 The @kbd{h s} (@code{calc-info-summary}) command runs the Info system
9870 on the Summary node of the Calc manual. @xref{Summary}. The @kbd{C-x * s}
9871 key is equivalent to @kbd{h s}.
9872
9873 @kindex h k
9874 @pindex calc-describe-key
9875 The @kbd{h k} (@code{calc-describe-key}) command looks up a key
9876 sequence in the Calc manual. For example, @kbd{h k H a S} looks
9877 up the documentation on the @kbd{H a S} (@code{calc-solve-for})
9878 command. This works by looking up the textual description of
9879 the key(s) in the Key Index of the manual, then jumping to the
9880 node indicated by the index.
9881
9882 Most Calc commands do not have traditional Emacs documentation
9883 strings, since the @kbd{h k} command is both more convenient and
9884 more instructive. This means the regular Emacs @kbd{C-h k}
9885 (@code{describe-key}) command will not be useful for Calc keystrokes.
9886
9887 @kindex h c
9888 @pindex calc-describe-key-briefly
9889 The @kbd{h c} (@code{calc-describe-key-briefly}) command reads a
9890 key sequence and displays a brief one-line description of it at
9891 the bottom of the screen. It looks for the key sequence in the
9892 Summary node of the Calc manual; if it doesn't find the sequence
9893 there, it acts just like its regular Emacs counterpart @kbd{C-h c}
9894 (@code{describe-key-briefly}). For example, @kbd{h c H a S}
9895 gives the description:
9896
9897 @smallexample
9898 H a S runs calc-solve-for: a `H a S' v => fsolve(a,v) (?=notes)
9899 @end smallexample
9900
9901 @noindent
9902 which means the command @kbd{H a S} or @kbd{H M-x calc-solve-for}
9903 takes a value @expr{a} from the stack, prompts for a value @expr{v},
9904 then applies the algebraic function @code{fsolve} to these values.
9905 The @samp{?=notes} message means you can now type @kbd{?} to see
9906 additional notes from the summary that apply to this command.
9907
9908 @kindex h f
9909 @pindex calc-describe-function
9910 The @kbd{h f} (@code{calc-describe-function}) command looks up an
9911 algebraic function or a command name in the Calc manual. Enter an
9912 algebraic function name to look up that function in the Function
9913 Index or enter a command name beginning with @samp{calc-} to look it
9914 up in the Command Index. This command will also look up operator
9915 symbols that can appear in algebraic formulas, like @samp{%} and
9916 @samp{=>}.
9917
9918 @kindex h v
9919 @pindex calc-describe-variable
9920 The @kbd{h v} (@code{calc-describe-variable}) command looks up a
9921 variable in the Calc manual. Enter a variable name like @code{pi} or
9922 @code{PlotRejects}.
9923
9924 @kindex h b
9925 @pindex describe-bindings
9926 The @kbd{h b} (@code{calc-describe-bindings}) command is just like
9927 @kbd{C-h b}, except that only local (Calc-related) key bindings are
9928 listed.
9929
9930 @kindex h n
9931 The @kbd{h n} or @kbd{h C-n} (@code{calc-view-news}) command displays
9932 the ``news'' or change history of Calc. This is kept in the file
9933 @file{README}, which Calc looks for in the same directory as the Calc
9934 source files.
9935
9936 @kindex h C-c
9937 @kindex h C-d
9938 @kindex h C-w
9939 The @kbd{h C-c}, @kbd{h C-d}, and @kbd{h C-w} keys display copying,
9940 distribution, and warranty information about Calc. These work by
9941 pulling up the appropriate parts of the ``Copying'' or ``Reporting
9942 Bugs'' sections of the manual.
9943
9944 @node Stack Basics, Numeric Entry, Help Commands, Introduction
9945 @section Stack Basics
9946
9947 @noindent
9948 @cindex Stack basics
9949 @c [fix-tut RPN Calculations and the Stack]
9950 Calc uses RPN notation. If you are not familiar with RPN, @pxref{RPN
9951 Tutorial}.
9952
9953 To add the numbers 1 and 2 in Calc you would type the keys:
9954 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2 +}.
9955 (@key{RET} corresponds to the @key{ENTER} key on most calculators.)
9956 The first three keystrokes ``push'' the numbers 1 and 2 onto the stack. The
9957 @kbd{+} key always ``pops'' the top two numbers from the stack, adds them,
9958 and pushes the result (3) back onto the stack. This number is ready for
9959 further calculations: @kbd{5 -} pushes 5 onto the stack, then pops the
9960 3 and 5, subtracts them, and pushes the result (@mathit{-2}).
9961
9962 Note that the ``top'' of the stack actually appears at the @emph{bottom}
9963 of the buffer. A line containing a single @samp{.} character signifies
9964 the end of the buffer; Calculator commands operate on the number(s)
9965 directly above this line. The @kbd{d t} (@code{calc-truncate-stack})
9966 command allows you to move the @samp{.} marker up and down in the stack;
9967 @pxref{Truncating the Stack}.
9968
9969 @kindex d l
9970 @pindex calc-line-numbering
9971 Stack elements are numbered consecutively, with number 1 being the top of
9972 the stack. These line numbers are ordinarily displayed on the lefthand side
9973 of the window. The @kbd{d l} (@code{calc-line-numbering}) command controls
9974 whether these numbers appear. (Line numbers may be turned off since they
9975 slow the Calculator down a bit and also clutter the display.)
9976
9977 @kindex o
9978 @pindex calc-realign
9979 The unshifted letter @kbd{o} (@code{calc-realign}) command repositions
9980 the cursor to its top-of-stack ``home'' position. It also undoes any
9981 horizontal scrolling in the window. If you give it a numeric prefix
9982 argument, it instead moves the cursor to the specified stack element.
9983
9984 The @key{RET} (or equivalent @key{SPC}) key is only required to separate
9985 two consecutive numbers.
9986 (After all, if you typed @kbd{1 2} by themselves the Calculator
9987 would enter the number 12.) If you press @key{RET} or @key{SPC} @emph{not}
9988 right after typing a number, the key duplicates the number on the top of
9989 the stack. @kbd{@key{RET} *} is thus a handy way to square a number.
9990
9991 The @key{DEL} key pops and throws away the top number on the stack.
9992 The @key{TAB} key swaps the top two objects on the stack.
9993 @xref{Stack and Trail}, for descriptions of these and other stack-related
9994 commands.
9995
9996 @node Numeric Entry, Algebraic Entry, Stack Basics, Introduction
9997 @section Numeric Entry
9998
9999 @noindent
10000 @kindex 0-9
10001 @kindex .
10002 @kindex e
10003 @cindex Numeric entry
10004 @cindex Entering numbers
10005 Pressing a digit or other numeric key begins numeric entry using the
10006 minibuffer. The number is pushed on the stack when you press the @key{RET}
10007 or @key{SPC} keys. If you press any other non-numeric key, the number is
10008 pushed onto the stack and the appropriate operation is performed. If
10009 you press a numeric key which is not valid, the key is ignored.
10010
10011 @cindex Minus signs
10012 @cindex Negative numbers, entering
10013 @kindex _
10014 There are three different concepts corresponding to the word ``minus,''
10015 typified by @expr{a-b} (subtraction), @expr{-x}
10016 (change-sign), and @expr{-5} (negative number). Calc uses three
10017 different keys for these operations, respectively:
10018 @kbd{-}, @kbd{n}, and @kbd{_} (the underscore). The @kbd{-} key subtracts
10019 the two numbers on the top of the stack. The @kbd{n} key changes the sign
10020 of the number on the top of the stack or the number currently being entered.
10021 The @kbd{_} key begins entry of a negative number or changes the sign of
10022 the number currently being entered. The following sequences all enter the
10023 number @mathit{-5} onto the stack: @kbd{0 @key{RET} 5 -}, @kbd{5 n @key{RET}},
10024 @kbd{5 @key{RET} n}, @kbd{_ 5 @key{RET}}, @kbd{5 _ @key{RET}}.
10025
10026 Some other keys are active during numeric entry, such as @kbd{#} for
10027 non-decimal numbers, @kbd{:} for fractions, and @kbd{@@} for HMS forms.
10028 These notations are described later in this manual with the corresponding
10029 data types. @xref{Data Types}.
10030
10031 During numeric entry, the only editing key available is @key{DEL}.
10032
10033 @node Algebraic Entry, Quick Calculator, Numeric Entry, Introduction
10034 @section Algebraic Entry
10035
10036 @noindent
10037 @kindex '
10038 @pindex calc-algebraic-entry
10039 @cindex Algebraic notation
10040 @cindex Formulas, entering
10041 The @kbd{'} (@code{calc-algebraic-entry}) command can be used to enter
10042 calculations in algebraic form. This is accomplished by typing the
10043 apostrophe key, ', followed by the expression in standard format:
10044
10045 @example
10046 ' 2+3*4 @key{RET}.
10047 @end example
10048
10049 @noindent
10050 This will compute
10051 @texline @math{2+(3\times4) = 14}
10052 @infoline @expr{2+(3*4) = 14}
10053 and push it on the stack. If you wish you can
10054 ignore the RPN aspect of Calc altogether and simply enter algebraic
10055 expressions in this way. You may want to use @key{DEL} every so often to
10056 clear previous results off the stack.
10057
10058 You can press the apostrophe key during normal numeric entry to switch
10059 the half-entered number into Algebraic entry mode. One reason to do
10060 this would be to fix a typo, as the full Emacs cursor motion and editing
10061 keys are available during algebraic entry but not during numeric entry.
10062
10063 In the same vein, during either numeric or algebraic entry you can
10064 press @kbd{`} (backquote) to switch to @code{calc-edit} mode, where
10065 you complete your half-finished entry in a separate buffer.
10066 @xref{Editing Stack Entries}.
10067
10068 @kindex m a
10069 @pindex calc-algebraic-mode
10070 @cindex Algebraic Mode
10071 If you prefer algebraic entry, you can use the command @kbd{m a}
10072 (@code{calc-algebraic-mode}) to set Algebraic mode. In this mode,
10073 digits and other keys that would normally start numeric entry instead
10074 start full algebraic entry; as long as your formula begins with a digit
10075 you can omit the apostrophe. Open parentheses and square brackets also
10076 begin algebraic entry. You can still do RPN calculations in this mode,
10077 but you will have to press @key{RET} to terminate every number:
10078 @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} * 4 @key{RET} +} would accomplish the same
10079 thing as @kbd{2*3+4 @key{RET}}.
10080
10081 @cindex Incomplete Algebraic Mode
10082 If you give a numeric prefix argument like @kbd{C-u} to the @kbd{m a}
10083 command, it enables Incomplete Algebraic mode; this is like regular
10084 Algebraic mode except that it applies to the @kbd{(} and @kbd{[} keys
10085 only. Numeric keys still begin a numeric entry in this mode.
10086
10087 @kindex m t
10088 @pindex calc-total-algebraic-mode
10089 @cindex Total Algebraic Mode
10090 The @kbd{m t} (@code{calc-total-algebraic-mode}) gives you an even
10091 stronger algebraic-entry mode, in which @emph{all} regular letter and
10092 punctuation keys begin algebraic entry. Use this if you prefer typing
10093 @w{@kbd{sqrt( )}} instead of @kbd{Q}, @w{@kbd{factor( )}} instead of
10094 @kbd{a f}, and so on. To type regular Calc commands when you are in
10095 Total Algebraic mode, hold down the @key{META} key. Thus @kbd{M-q}
10096 is the command to quit Calc, @kbd{M-p} sets the precision, and
10097 @kbd{M-m t} (or @kbd{M-m M-t}, if you prefer) turns Total Algebraic
10098 mode back off again. Meta keys also terminate algebraic entry, so
10099 that @kbd{2+3 M-S} is equivalent to @kbd{2+3 @key{RET} M-S}. The symbol
10100 @samp{Alg*} will appear in the mode line whenever you are in this mode.
10101
10102 Pressing @kbd{'} (the apostrophe) a second time re-enters the previous
10103 algebraic formula. You can then use the normal Emacs editing keys to
10104 modify this formula to your liking before pressing @key{RET}.
10105
10106 @kindex $
10107 @cindex Formulas, referring to stack
10108 Within a formula entered from the keyboard, the symbol @kbd{$}
10109 represents the number on the top of the stack. If an entered formula
10110 contains any @kbd{$} characters, the Calculator replaces the top of
10111 stack with that formula rather than simply pushing the formula onto the
10112 stack. Thus, @kbd{' 1+2 @key{RET}} pushes 3 on the stack, and @kbd{$*2
10113 @key{RET}} replaces it with 6. Note that the @kbd{$} key always
10114 initiates algebraic entry; the @kbd{'} is unnecessary if @kbd{$} is the
10115 first character in the new formula.
10116
10117 Higher stack elements can be accessed from an entered formula with the
10118 symbols @kbd{$$}, @kbd{$$$}, and so on. The number of stack elements
10119 removed (to be replaced by the entered values) equals the number of dollar
10120 signs in the longest such symbol in the formula. For example, @samp{$$+$$$}
10121 adds the second and third stack elements, replacing the top three elements
10122 with the answer. (All information about the top stack element is thus lost
10123 since no single @samp{$} appears in this formula.)
10124
10125 A slightly different way to refer to stack elements is with a dollar
10126 sign followed by a number: @samp{$1}, @samp{$2}, and so on are much
10127 like @samp{$}, @samp{$$}, etc., except that stack entries referred
10128 to numerically are not replaced by the algebraic entry. That is, while
10129 @samp{$+1} replaces 5 on the stack with 6, @samp{$1+1} leaves the 5
10130 on the stack and pushes an additional 6.
10131
10132 If a sequence of formulas are entered separated by commas, each formula
10133 is pushed onto the stack in turn. For example, @samp{1,2,3} pushes
10134 those three numbers onto the stack (leaving the 3 at the top), and
10135 @samp{$+1,$-1} replaces a 5 on the stack with 4 followed by 6. Also,
10136 @samp{$,$$} exchanges the top two elements of the stack, just like the
10137 @key{TAB} key.
10138
10139 You can finish an algebraic entry with @kbd{M-=} or @kbd{M-@key{RET}} instead
10140 of @key{RET}. This uses @kbd{=} to evaluate the variables in each
10141 formula that goes onto the stack. (Thus @kbd{' pi @key{RET}} pushes
10142 the variable @samp{pi}, but @kbd{' pi M-@key{RET}} pushes 3.1415.)
10143
10144 If you finish your algebraic entry by pressing @key{LFD} (or @kbd{C-j})
10145 instead of @key{RET}, Calc disables the default simplifications
10146 (as if by @kbd{m O}; @pxref{Simplification Modes}) while the entry
10147 is being pushed on the stack. Thus @kbd{' 1+2 @key{RET}} pushes 3
10148 on the stack, but @kbd{' 1+2 @key{LFD}} pushes the formula @expr{1+2};
10149 you might then press @kbd{=} when it is time to evaluate this formula.
10150
10151 @node Quick Calculator, Prefix Arguments, Algebraic Entry, Introduction
10152 @section ``Quick Calculator'' Mode
10153
10154 @noindent
10155 @kindex C-x * q
10156 @pindex quick-calc
10157 @cindex Quick Calculator
10158 There is another way to invoke the Calculator if all you need to do
10159 is make one or two quick calculations. Type @kbd{C-x * q} (or
10160 @kbd{M-x quick-calc}), then type any formula as an algebraic entry.
10161 The Calculator will compute the result and display it in the echo
10162 area, without ever actually putting up a Calc window.
10163
10164 You can use the @kbd{$} character in a Quick Calculator formula to
10165 refer to the previous Quick Calculator result. Older results are
10166 not retained; the Quick Calculator has no effect on the full
10167 Calculator's stack or trail. If you compute a result and then
10168 forget what it was, just run @code{C-x * q} again and enter
10169 @samp{$} as the formula.
10170
10171 If this is the first time you have used the Calculator in this Emacs
10172 session, the @kbd{C-x * q} command will create the @code{*Calculator*}
10173 buffer and perform all the usual initializations; it simply will
10174 refrain from putting that buffer up in a new window. The Quick
10175 Calculator refers to the @code{*Calculator*} buffer for all mode
10176 settings. Thus, for example, to set the precision that the Quick
10177 Calculator uses, simply run the full Calculator momentarily and use
10178 the regular @kbd{p} command.
10179
10180 If you use @code{C-x * q} from inside the Calculator buffer, the
10181 effect is the same as pressing the apostrophe key (algebraic entry).
10182
10183 The result of a Quick calculation is placed in the Emacs ``kill ring''
10184 as well as being displayed. A subsequent @kbd{C-y} command will
10185 yank the result into the editing buffer. You can also use this
10186 to yank the result into the next @kbd{C-x * q} input line as a more
10187 explicit alternative to @kbd{$} notation, or to yank the result
10188 into the Calculator stack after typing @kbd{C-x * c}.
10189
10190 If you finish your formula by typing @key{LFD} (or @kbd{C-j}) instead
10191 of @key{RET}, the result is inserted immediately into the current
10192 buffer rather than going into the kill ring.
10193
10194 Quick Calculator results are actually evaluated as if by the @kbd{=}
10195 key (which replaces variable names by their stored values, if any).
10196 If the formula you enter is an assignment to a variable using the
10197 @samp{:=} operator, say, @samp{foo := 2 + 3} or @samp{foo := foo + 1},
10198 then the result of the evaluation is stored in that Calc variable.
10199 @xref{Store and Recall}.
10200
10201 If the result is an integer and the current display radix is decimal,
10202 the number will also be displayed in hex, octal and binary formats. If
10203 the integer is in the range from 1 to 126, it will also be displayed as
10204 an ASCII character.
10205
10206 For example, the quoted character @samp{"x"} produces the vector
10207 result @samp{[120]} (because 120 is the ASCII code of the lower-case
10208 `x'; @pxref{Strings}). Since this is a vector, not an integer, it
10209 is displayed only according to the current mode settings. But
10210 running Quick Calc again and entering @samp{120} will produce the
10211 result @samp{120 (16#78, 8#170, x)} which shows the number in its
10212 decimal, hexadecimal, octal, and ASCII forms.
10213
10214 Please note that the Quick Calculator is not any faster at loading
10215 or computing the answer than the full Calculator; the name ``quick''
10216 merely refers to the fact that it's much less hassle to use for
10217 small calculations.
10218
10219 @node Prefix Arguments, Undo, Quick Calculator, Introduction
10220 @section Numeric Prefix Arguments
10221
10222 @noindent
10223 Many Calculator commands use numeric prefix arguments. Some, such as
10224 @kbd{d s} (@code{calc-sci-notation}), set a parameter to the value of
10225 the prefix argument or use a default if you don't use a prefix.
10226 Others (like @kbd{d f} (@code{calc-fix-notation})) require an argument
10227 and prompt for a number if you don't give one as a prefix.
10228
10229 As a rule, stack-manipulation commands accept a numeric prefix argument
10230 which is interpreted as an index into the stack. A positive argument
10231 operates on the top @var{n} stack entries; a negative argument operates
10232 on the @var{n}th stack entry in isolation; and a zero argument operates
10233 on the entire stack.
10234
10235 Most commands that perform computations (such as the arithmetic and
10236 scientific functions) accept a numeric prefix argument that allows the
10237 operation to be applied across many stack elements. For unary operations
10238 (that is, functions of one argument like absolute value or complex
10239 conjugate), a positive prefix argument applies that function to the top
10240 @var{n} stack entries simultaneously, and a negative argument applies it
10241 to the @var{n}th stack entry only. For binary operations (functions of
10242 two arguments like addition, GCD, and vector concatenation), a positive
10243 prefix argument ``reduces'' the function across the top @var{n}
10244 stack elements (for example, @kbd{C-u 5 +} sums the top 5 stack entries;
10245 @pxref{Reducing and Mapping}), and a negative argument maps the next-to-top
10246 @var{n} stack elements with the top stack element as a second argument
10247 (for example, @kbd{7 c-u -5 +} adds 7 to the top 5 stack elements).
10248 This feature is not available for operations which use the numeric prefix
10249 argument for some other purpose.
10250
10251 Numeric prefixes are specified the same way as always in Emacs: Press
10252 a sequence of @key{META}-digits, or press @key{ESC} followed by digits,
10253 or press @kbd{C-u} followed by digits. Some commands treat plain
10254 @kbd{C-u} (without any actual digits) specially.
10255
10256 @kindex ~
10257 @pindex calc-num-prefix
10258 You can type @kbd{~} (@code{calc-num-prefix}) to pop an integer from the
10259 top of the stack and enter it as the numeric prefix for the next command.
10260 For example, @kbd{C-u 16 p} sets the precision to 16 digits; an alternate
10261 (silly) way to do this would be @kbd{2 @key{RET} 4 ^ ~ p}, i.e., compute 2
10262 to the fourth power and set the precision to that value.
10263
10264 Conversely, if you have typed a numeric prefix argument the @kbd{~} key
10265 pushes it onto the stack in the form of an integer.
10266
10267 @node Undo, Error Messages, Prefix Arguments, Introduction
10268 @section Undoing Mistakes
10269
10270 @noindent
10271 @kindex U
10272 @kindex C-_
10273 @pindex calc-undo
10274 @cindex Mistakes, undoing
10275 @cindex Undoing mistakes
10276 @cindex Errors, undoing
10277 The shift-@kbd{U} key (@code{calc-undo}) undoes the most recent operation.
10278 If that operation added or dropped objects from the stack, those objects
10279 are removed or restored. If it was a ``store'' operation, you are
10280 queried whether or not to restore the variable to its original value.
10281 The @kbd{U} key may be pressed any number of times to undo successively
10282 farther back in time; with a numeric prefix argument it undoes a
10283 specified number of operations. The undo history is cleared only by the
10284 @kbd{q} (@code{calc-quit}) command. (Recall that @kbd{C-x * c} is
10285 synonymous with @code{calc-quit} while inside the Calculator; this
10286 also clears the undo history.)
10287
10288 Currently the mode-setting commands (like @code{calc-precision}) are not
10289 undoable. You can undo past a point where you changed a mode, but you
10290 will need to reset the mode yourself.
10291
10292 @kindex D
10293 @pindex calc-redo
10294 @cindex Redoing after an Undo
10295 The shift-@kbd{D} key (@code{calc-redo}) redoes an operation that was
10296 mistakenly undone. Pressing @kbd{U} with a negative prefix argument is
10297 equivalent to executing @code{calc-redo}. You can redo any number of
10298 times, up to the number of recent consecutive undo commands. Redo
10299 information is cleared whenever you give any command that adds new undo
10300 information, i.e., if you undo, then enter a number on the stack or make
10301 any other change, then it will be too late to redo.
10302
10303 @kindex M-@key{RET}
10304 @pindex calc-last-args
10305 @cindex Last-arguments feature
10306 @cindex Arguments, restoring
10307 The @kbd{M-@key{RET}} key (@code{calc-last-args}) is like undo in that
10308 it restores the arguments of the most recent command onto the stack;
10309 however, it does not remove the result of that command. Given a numeric
10310 prefix argument, this command applies to the @expr{n}th most recent
10311 command which removed items from the stack; it pushes those items back
10312 onto the stack.
10313
10314 The @kbd{K} (@code{calc-keep-args}) command provides a related function
10315 to @kbd{M-@key{RET}}. @xref{Stack and Trail}.
10316
10317 It is also possible to recall previous results or inputs using the trail.
10318 @xref{Trail Commands}.
10319
10320 The standard Emacs @kbd{C-_} undo key is recognized as a synonym for @kbd{U}.
10321
10322 @node Error Messages, Multiple Calculators, Undo, Introduction
10323 @section Error Messages
10324
10325 @noindent
10326 @kindex w
10327 @pindex calc-why
10328 @cindex Errors, messages
10329 @cindex Why did an error occur?
10330 Many situations that would produce an error message in other calculators
10331 simply create unsimplified formulas in the Emacs Calculator. For example,
10332 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 0 /} pushes the formula @expr{1 / 0}; @w{@kbd{0 L}} pushes
10333 the formula @samp{ln(0)}. Floating-point overflow and underflow are also
10334 reasons for this to happen.
10335
10336 When a function call must be left in symbolic form, Calc usually
10337 produces a message explaining why. Messages that are probably
10338 surprising or indicative of user errors are displayed automatically.
10339 Other messages are simply kept in Calc's memory and are displayed only
10340 if you type @kbd{w} (@code{calc-why}). You can also press @kbd{w} if
10341 the same computation results in several messages. (The first message
10342 will end with @samp{[w=more]} in this case.)
10343
10344 @kindex d w
10345 @pindex calc-auto-why
10346 The @kbd{d w} (@code{calc-auto-why}) command controls when error messages
10347 are displayed automatically. (Calc effectively presses @kbd{w} for you
10348 after your computation finishes.) By default, this occurs only for
10349 ``important'' messages. The other possible modes are to report
10350 @emph{all} messages automatically, or to report none automatically (so
10351 that you must always press @kbd{w} yourself to see the messages).
10352
10353 @node Multiple Calculators, Troubleshooting Commands, Error Messages, Introduction
10354 @section Multiple Calculators
10355
10356 @noindent
10357 @pindex another-calc
10358 It is possible to have any number of Calc mode buffers at once.
10359 Usually this is done by executing @kbd{M-x another-calc}, which
10360 is similar to @kbd{C-x * c} except that if a @samp{*Calculator*}
10361 buffer already exists, a new, independent one with a name of the
10362 form @samp{*Calculator*<@var{n}>} is created. You can also use the
10363 command @code{calc-mode} to put any buffer into Calculator mode, but
10364 this would ordinarily never be done.
10365
10366 The @kbd{q} (@code{calc-quit}) command does not destroy a Calculator buffer;
10367 it only closes its window. Use @kbd{M-x kill-buffer} to destroy a
10368 Calculator buffer.
10369
10370 Each Calculator buffer keeps its own stack, undo list, and mode settings
10371 such as precision, angular mode, and display formats. In Emacs terms,
10372 variables such as @code{calc-stack} are buffer-local variables. The
10373 global default values of these variables are used only when a new
10374 Calculator buffer is created. The @code{calc-quit} command saves
10375 the stack and mode settings of the buffer being quit as the new defaults.
10376
10377 There is only one trail buffer, @samp{*Calc Trail*}, used by all
10378 Calculator buffers.
10379
10380 @node Troubleshooting Commands, , Multiple Calculators, Introduction
10381 @section Troubleshooting Commands
10382
10383 @noindent
10384 This section describes commands you can use in case a computation
10385 incorrectly fails or gives the wrong answer.
10386
10387 @xref{Reporting Bugs}, if you find a problem that appears to be due
10388 to a bug or deficiency in Calc.
10389
10390 @menu
10391 * Autoloading Problems::
10392 * Recursion Depth::
10393 * Caches::
10394 * Debugging Calc::
10395 @end menu
10396
10397 @node Autoloading Problems, Recursion Depth, Troubleshooting Commands, Troubleshooting Commands
10398 @subsection Autoloading Problems
10399
10400 @noindent
10401 The Calc program is split into many component files; components are
10402 loaded automatically as you use various commands that require them.
10403 Occasionally Calc may lose track of when a certain component is
10404 necessary; typically this means you will type a command and it won't
10405 work because some function you've never heard of was undefined.
10406
10407 @kindex C-x * L
10408 @pindex calc-load-everything
10409 If this happens, the easiest workaround is to type @kbd{C-x * L}
10410 (@code{calc-load-everything}) to force all the parts of Calc to be
10411 loaded right away. This will cause Emacs to take up a lot more
10412 memory than it would otherwise, but it's guaranteed to fix the problem.
10413
10414 @node Recursion Depth, Caches, Autoloading Problems, Troubleshooting Commands
10415 @subsection Recursion Depth
10416
10417 @noindent
10418 @kindex M
10419 @kindex I M
10420 @pindex calc-more-recursion-depth
10421 @pindex calc-less-recursion-depth
10422 @cindex Recursion depth
10423 @cindex ``Computation got stuck'' message
10424 @cindex @code{max-lisp-eval-depth}
10425 @cindex @code{max-specpdl-size}
10426 Calc uses recursion in many of its calculations. Emacs Lisp keeps a
10427 variable @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} which limits the amount of recursion
10428 possible in an attempt to recover from program bugs. If a calculation
10429 ever halts incorrectly with the message ``Computation got stuck or
10430 ran too long,'' use the @kbd{M} command (@code{calc-more-recursion-depth})
10431 to increase this limit. (Of course, this will not help if the
10432 calculation really did get stuck due to some problem inside Calc.)
10433
10434 The limit is always increased (multiplied) by a factor of two. There
10435 is also an @kbd{I M} (@code{calc-less-recursion-depth}) command which
10436 decreases this limit by a factor of two, down to a minimum value of 200.
10437 The default value is 1000.
10438
10439 These commands also double or halve @code{max-specpdl-size}, another
10440 internal Lisp recursion limit. The minimum value for this limit is 600.
10441
10442 @node Caches, Debugging Calc, Recursion Depth, Troubleshooting Commands
10443 @subsection Caches
10444
10445 @noindent
10446 @cindex Caches
10447 @cindex Flushing caches
10448 Calc saves certain values after they have been computed once. For
10449 example, the @kbd{P} (@code{calc-pi}) command initially ``knows'' the
10450 constant @cpi{} to about 20 decimal places; if the current precision
10451 is greater than this, it will recompute @cpi{} using a series
10452 approximation. This value will not need to be recomputed ever again
10453 unless you raise the precision still further. Many operations such as
10454 logarithms and sines make use of similarly cached values such as
10455 @cpiover{4} and
10456 @texline @math{\ln 2}.
10457 @infoline @expr{ln(2)}.
10458 The visible effect of caching is that
10459 high-precision computations may seem to do extra work the first time.
10460 Other things cached include powers of two (for the binary arithmetic
10461 functions), matrix inverses and determinants, symbolic integrals, and
10462 data points computed by the graphing commands.
10463
10464 @pindex calc-flush-caches
10465 If you suspect a Calculator cache has become corrupt, you can use the
10466 @code{calc-flush-caches} command to reset all caches to the empty state.
10467 (This should only be necessary in the event of bugs in the Calculator.)
10468 The @kbd{C-x * 0} (with the zero key) command also resets caches along
10469 with all other aspects of the Calculator's state.
10470
10471 @node Debugging Calc, , Caches, Troubleshooting Commands
10472 @subsection Debugging Calc
10473
10474 @noindent
10475 A few commands exist to help in the debugging of Calc commands.
10476 @xref{Programming}, to see the various ways that you can write
10477 your own Calc commands.
10478
10479 @kindex Z T
10480 @pindex calc-timing
10481 The @kbd{Z T} (@code{calc-timing}) command turns on and off a mode
10482 in which the timing of slow commands is reported in the Trail.
10483 Any Calc command that takes two seconds or longer writes a line
10484 to the Trail showing how many seconds it took. This value is
10485 accurate only to within one second.
10486
10487 All steps of executing a command are included; in particular, time
10488 taken to format the result for display in the stack and trail is
10489 counted. Some prompts also count time taken waiting for them to
10490 be answered, while others do not; this depends on the exact
10491 implementation of the command. For best results, if you are timing
10492 a sequence that includes prompts or multiple commands, define a
10493 keyboard macro to run the whole sequence at once. Calc's @kbd{X}
10494 command (@pxref{Keyboard Macros}) will then report the time taken
10495 to execute the whole macro.
10496
10497 Another advantage of the @kbd{X} command is that while it is
10498 executing, the stack and trail are not updated from step to step.
10499 So if you expect the output of your test sequence to leave a result
10500 that may take a long time to format and you don't wish to count
10501 this formatting time, end your sequence with a @key{DEL} keystroke
10502 to clear the result from the stack. When you run the sequence with
10503 @kbd{X}, Calc will never bother to format the large result.
10504
10505 Another thing @kbd{Z T} does is to increase the Emacs variable
10506 @code{gc-cons-threshold} to a much higher value (two million; the
10507 usual default in Calc is 250,000) for the duration of each command.
10508 This generally prevents garbage collection during the timing of
10509 the command, though it may cause your Emacs process to grow
10510 abnormally large. (Garbage collection time is a major unpredictable
10511 factor in the timing of Emacs operations.)
10512
10513 Another command that is useful when debugging your own Lisp
10514 extensions to Calc is @kbd{M-x calc-pass-errors}, which disables
10515 the error handler that changes the ``@code{max-lisp-eval-depth}
10516 exceeded'' message to the much more friendly ``Computation got
10517 stuck or ran too long.'' This handler interferes with the Emacs
10518 Lisp debugger's @code{debug-on-error} mode. Errors are reported
10519 in the handler itself rather than at the true location of the
10520 error. After you have executed @code{calc-pass-errors}, Lisp
10521 errors will be reported correctly but the user-friendly message
10522 will be lost.
10523
10524 @node Data Types, Stack and Trail, Introduction, Top
10525 @chapter Data Types
10526
10527 @noindent
10528 This chapter discusses the various types of objects that can be placed
10529 on the Calculator stack, how they are displayed, and how they are
10530 entered. (@xref{Data Type Formats}, for information on how these data
10531 types are represented as underlying Lisp objects.)
10532
10533 Integers, fractions, and floats are various ways of describing real
10534 numbers. HMS forms also for many purposes act as real numbers. These
10535 types can be combined to form complex numbers, modulo forms, error forms,
10536 or interval forms. (But these last four types cannot be combined
10537 arbitrarily:@: error forms may not contain modulo forms, for example.)
10538 Finally, all these types of numbers may be combined into vectors,
10539 matrices, or algebraic formulas.
10540
10541 @menu
10542 * Integers:: The most basic data type.
10543 * Fractions:: This and above are called @dfn{rationals}.
10544 * Floats:: This and above are called @dfn{reals}.
10545 * Complex Numbers:: This and above are called @dfn{numbers}.
10546 * Infinities::
10547 * Vectors and Matrices::
10548 * Strings::
10549 * HMS Forms::
10550 * Date Forms::
10551 * Modulo Forms::
10552 * Error Forms::
10553 * Interval Forms::
10554 * Incomplete Objects::
10555 * Variables::
10556 * Formulas::
10557 @end menu
10558
10559 @node Integers, Fractions, Data Types, Data Types
10560 @section Integers
10561
10562 @noindent
10563 @cindex Integers
10564 The Calculator stores integers to arbitrary precision. Addition,
10565 subtraction, and multiplication of integers always yields an exact
10566 integer result. (If the result of a division or exponentiation of
10567 integers is not an integer, it is expressed in fractional or
10568 floating-point form according to the current Fraction mode.
10569 @xref{Fraction Mode}.)
10570
10571 A decimal integer is represented as an optional sign followed by a
10572 sequence of digits. Grouping (@pxref{Grouping Digits}) can be used to
10573 insert a comma at every third digit for display purposes, but you
10574 must not type commas during the entry of numbers.
10575
10576 @kindex #
10577 A non-decimal integer is represented as an optional sign, a radix
10578 between 2 and 36, a @samp{#} symbol, and one or more digits. For radix 11
10579 and above, the letters A through Z (upper- or lower-case) count as
10580 digits and do not terminate numeric entry mode. @xref{Radix Modes}, for how
10581 to set the default radix for display of integers. Numbers of any radix
10582 may be entered at any time. If you press @kbd{#} at the beginning of a
10583 number, the current display radix is used.
10584
10585 @node Fractions, Floats, Integers, Data Types
10586 @section Fractions
10587
10588 @noindent
10589 @cindex Fractions
10590 A @dfn{fraction} is a ratio of two integers. Fractions are traditionally
10591 written ``2/3'' but Calc uses the notation @samp{2:3}. (The @kbd{/} key
10592 performs RPN division; the following two sequences push the number
10593 @samp{2:3} on the stack: @kbd{2 :@: 3 @key{RET}}, or @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 /}
10594 assuming Fraction mode has been enabled.)
10595 When the Calculator produces a fractional result it always reduces it to
10596 simplest form, which may in fact be an integer.
10597
10598 Fractions may also be entered in a three-part form, where @samp{2:3:4}
10599 represents two-and-three-quarters. @xref{Fraction Formats}, for fraction
10600 display formats.
10601
10602 Non-decimal fractions are entered and displayed as
10603 @samp{@var{radix}#@var{num}:@var{denom}} (or in the analogous three-part
10604 form). The numerator and denominator always use the same radix.
10605
10606 @node Floats, Complex Numbers, Fractions, Data Types
10607 @section Floats
10608
10609 @noindent
10610 @cindex Floating-point numbers
10611 A floating-point number or @dfn{float} is a number stored in scientific
10612 notation. The number of significant digits in the fractional part is
10613 governed by the current floating precision (@pxref{Precision}). The
10614 range of acceptable values is from
10615 @texline @math{10^{-3999999}}
10616 @infoline @expr{10^-3999999}
10617 (inclusive) to
10618 @texline @math{10^{4000000}}
10619 @infoline @expr{10^4000000}
10620 (exclusive), plus the corresponding negative values and zero.
10621
10622 Calculations that would exceed the allowable range of values (such
10623 as @samp{exp(exp(20))}) are left in symbolic form by Calc. The
10624 messages ``floating-point overflow'' or ``floating-point underflow''
10625 indicate that during the calculation a number would have been produced
10626 that was too large or too close to zero, respectively, to be represented
10627 by Calc. This does not necessarily mean the final result would have
10628 overflowed, just that an overflow occurred while computing the result.
10629 (In fact, it could report an underflow even though the final result
10630 would have overflowed!)
10631
10632 If a rational number and a float are mixed in a calculation, the result
10633 will in general be expressed as a float. Commands that require an integer
10634 value (such as @kbd{k g} [@code{gcd}]) will also accept integer-valued
10635 floats, i.e., floating-point numbers with nothing after the decimal point.
10636
10637 Floats are identified by the presence of a decimal point and/or an
10638 exponent. In general a float consists of an optional sign, digits
10639 including an optional decimal point, and an optional exponent consisting
10640 of an @samp{e}, an optional sign, and up to seven exponent digits.
10641 For example, @samp{23.5e-2} is 23.5 times ten to the minus-second power,
10642 or 0.235.
10643
10644 Floating-point numbers are normally displayed in decimal notation with
10645 all significant figures shown. Exceedingly large or small numbers are
10646 displayed in scientific notation. Various other display options are
10647 available. @xref{Float Formats}.
10648
10649 @cindex Accuracy of calculations
10650 Floating-point numbers are stored in decimal, not binary. The result
10651 of each operation is rounded to the nearest value representable in the
10652 number of significant digits specified by the current precision,
10653 rounding away from zero in the case of a tie. Thus (in the default
10654 display mode) what you see is exactly what you get. Some operations such
10655 as square roots and transcendental functions are performed with several
10656 digits of extra precision and then rounded down, in an effort to make the
10657 final result accurate to the full requested precision. However,
10658 accuracy is not rigorously guaranteed. If you suspect the validity of a
10659 result, try doing the same calculation in a higher precision. The
10660 Calculator's arithmetic is not intended to be IEEE-conformant in any
10661 way.
10662
10663 While floats are always @emph{stored} in decimal, they can be entered
10664 and displayed in any radix just like integers and fractions. Since a
10665 float that is entered in a radix other that 10 will be converted to
10666 decimal, the number that Calc stores may not be exactly the number that
10667 was entered, it will be the closest decimal approximation given the
10668 current precison. The notation @samp{@var{radix}#@var{ddd}.@var{ddd}}
10669 is a floating-point number whose digits are in the specified radix.
10670 Note that the @samp{.} is more aptly referred to as a ``radix point''
10671 than as a decimal point in this case. The number @samp{8#123.4567} is
10672 defined as @samp{8#1234567 * 8^-4}. If the radix is 14 or less, you can
10673 use @samp{e} notation to write a non-decimal number in scientific
10674 notation. The exponent is written in decimal, and is considered to be a
10675 power of the radix: @samp{8#1234567e-4}. If the radix is 15 or above,
10676 the letter @samp{e} is a digit, so scientific notation must be written
10677 out, e.g., @samp{16#123.4567*16^2}. The first two exercises of the
10678 Modes Tutorial explore some of the properties of non-decimal floats.
10679
10680 @node Complex Numbers, Infinities, Floats, Data Types
10681 @section Complex Numbers
10682
10683 @noindent
10684 @cindex Complex numbers
10685 There are two supported formats for complex numbers: rectangular and
10686 polar. The default format is rectangular, displayed in the form
10687 @samp{(@var{real},@var{imag})} where @var{real} is the real part and
10688 @var{imag} is the imaginary part, each of which may be any real number.
10689 Rectangular complex numbers can also be displayed in @samp{@var{a}+@var{b}i}
10690 notation; @pxref{Complex Formats}.
10691
10692 Polar complex numbers are displayed in the form
10693 @texline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@math{\theta}@tfn{)}'
10694 @infoline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@var{theta}@tfn{)}'
10695 where @var{r} is the nonnegative magnitude and
10696 @texline @math{\theta}
10697 @infoline @var{theta}
10698 is the argument or phase angle. The range of
10699 @texline @math{\theta}
10700 @infoline @var{theta}
10701 depends on the current angular mode (@pxref{Angular Modes}); it is
10702 generally between @mathit{-180} and @mathit{+180} degrees or the equivalent range
10703 in radians.
10704
10705 Complex numbers are entered in stages using incomplete objects.
10706 @xref{Incomplete Objects}.
10707
10708 Operations on rectangular complex numbers yield rectangular complex
10709 results, and similarly for polar complex numbers. Where the two types
10710 are mixed, or where new complex numbers arise (as for the square root of
10711 a negative real), the current @dfn{Polar mode} is used to determine the
10712 type. @xref{Polar Mode}.
10713
10714 A complex result in which the imaginary part is zero (or the phase angle
10715 is 0 or 180 degrees or @cpi{} radians) is automatically converted to a real
10716 number.
10717
10718 @node Infinities, Vectors and Matrices, Complex Numbers, Data Types
10719 @section Infinities
10720
10721 @noindent
10722 @cindex Infinity
10723 @cindex @code{inf} variable
10724 @cindex @code{uinf} variable
10725 @cindex @code{nan} variable
10726 @vindex inf
10727 @vindex uinf
10728 @vindex nan
10729 The word @code{inf} represents the mathematical concept of @dfn{infinity}.
10730 Calc actually has three slightly different infinity-like values:
10731 @code{inf}, @code{uinf}, and @code{nan}. These are just regular
10732 variable names (@pxref{Variables}); you should avoid using these
10733 names for your own variables because Calc gives them special
10734 treatment. Infinities, like all variable names, are normally
10735 entered using algebraic entry.
10736
10737 Mathematically speaking, it is not rigorously correct to treat
10738 ``infinity'' as if it were a number, but mathematicians often do
10739 so informally. When they say that @samp{1 / inf = 0}, what they
10740 really mean is that @expr{1 / x}, as @expr{x} becomes larger and
10741 larger, becomes arbitrarily close to zero. So you can imagine
10742 that if @expr{x} got ``all the way to infinity,'' then @expr{1 / x}
10743 would go all the way to zero. Similarly, when they say that
10744 @samp{exp(inf) = inf}, they mean that
10745 @texline @math{e^x}
10746 @infoline @expr{exp(x)}
10747 grows without bound as @expr{x} grows. The symbol @samp{-inf} likewise
10748 stands for an infinitely negative real value; for example, we say that
10749 @samp{exp(-inf) = 0}. You can have an infinity pointing in any
10750 direction on the complex plane: @samp{sqrt(-inf) = i inf}.
10751
10752 The same concept of limits can be used to define @expr{1 / 0}. We
10753 really want the value that @expr{1 / x} approaches as @expr{x}
10754 approaches zero. But if all we have is @expr{1 / 0}, we can't
10755 tell which direction @expr{x} was coming from. If @expr{x} was
10756 positive and decreasing toward zero, then we should say that
10757 @samp{1 / 0 = inf}. But if @expr{x} was negative and increasing
10758 toward zero, the answer is @samp{1 / 0 = -inf}. In fact, @expr{x}
10759 could be an imaginary number, giving the answer @samp{i inf} or
10760 @samp{-i inf}. Calc uses the special symbol @samp{uinf} to mean
10761 @dfn{undirected infinity}, i.e., a value which is infinitely
10762 large but with an unknown sign (or direction on the complex plane).
10763
10764 Calc actually has three modes that say how infinities are handled.
10765 Normally, infinities never arise from calculations that didn't
10766 already have them. Thus, @expr{1 / 0} is treated simply as an
10767 error and left unevaluated. The @kbd{m i} (@code{calc-infinite-mode})
10768 command (@pxref{Infinite Mode}) enables a mode in which
10769 @expr{1 / 0} evaluates to @code{uinf} instead. There is also
10770 an alternative type of infinite mode which says to treat zeros
10771 as if they were positive, so that @samp{1 / 0 = inf}. While this
10772 is less mathematically correct, it may be the answer you want in
10773 some cases.
10774
10775 Since all infinities are ``as large'' as all others, Calc simplifies,
10776 e.g., @samp{5 inf} to @samp{inf}. Another example is
10777 @samp{5 - inf = -inf}, where the @samp{-inf} is so large that
10778 adding a finite number like five to it does not affect it.
10779 Note that @samp{a - inf} also results in @samp{-inf}; Calc assumes
10780 that variables like @code{a} always stand for finite quantities.
10781 Just to show that infinities really are all the same size,
10782 note that @samp{sqrt(inf) = inf^2 = exp(inf) = inf} in Calc's
10783 notation.
10784
10785 It's not so easy to define certain formulas like @samp{0 * inf} and
10786 @samp{inf / inf}. Depending on where these zeros and infinities
10787 came from, the answer could be literally anything. The latter
10788 formula could be the limit of @expr{x / x} (giving a result of one),
10789 or @expr{2 x / x} (giving two), or @expr{x^2 / x} (giving @code{inf}),
10790 or @expr{x / x^2} (giving zero). Calc uses the symbol @code{nan}
10791 to represent such an @dfn{indeterminate} value. (The name ``nan''
10792 comes from analogy with the ``NAN'' concept of IEEE standard
10793 arithmetic; it stands for ``Not A Number.'' This is somewhat of a
10794 misnomer, since @code{nan} @emph{does} stand for some number or
10795 infinity, it's just that @emph{which} number it stands for
10796 cannot be determined.) In Calc's notation, @samp{0 * inf = nan}
10797 and @samp{inf / inf = nan}. A few other common indeterminate
10798 expressions are @samp{inf - inf} and @samp{inf ^ 0}. Also,
10799 @samp{0 / 0 = nan} if you have turned on Infinite mode
10800 (as described above).
10801
10802 Infinities are especially useful as parts of @dfn{intervals}.
10803 @xref{Interval Forms}.
10804
10805 @node Vectors and Matrices, Strings, Infinities, Data Types
10806 @section Vectors and Matrices
10807
10808 @noindent
10809 @cindex Vectors
10810 @cindex Plain vectors
10811 @cindex Matrices
10812 The @dfn{vector} data type is flexible and general. A vector is simply a
10813 list of zero or more data objects. When these objects are numbers, the
10814 whole is a vector in the mathematical sense. When these objects are
10815 themselves vectors of equal (nonzero) length, the whole is a @dfn{matrix}.
10816 A vector which is not a matrix is referred to here as a @dfn{plain vector}.
10817
10818 A vector is displayed as a list of values separated by commas and enclosed
10819 in square brackets: @samp{[1, 2, 3]}. Thus the following is a 2 row by
10820 3 column matrix: @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5, 6]]}. Vectors, like complex
10821 numbers, are entered as incomplete objects. @xref{Incomplete Objects}.
10822 During algebraic entry, vectors are entered all at once in the usual
10823 brackets-and-commas form. Matrices may be entered algebraically as nested
10824 vectors, or using the shortcut notation @w{@samp{[1, 2, 3; 4, 5, 6]}},
10825 with rows separated by semicolons. The commas may usually be omitted
10826 when entering vectors: @samp{[1 2 3]}. Curly braces may be used in
10827 place of brackets: @samp{@{1, 2, 3@}}, but the commas are required in
10828 this case.
10829
10830 Traditional vector and matrix arithmetic is also supported;
10831 @pxref{Basic Arithmetic} and @pxref{Matrix Functions}.
10832 Many other operations are applied to vectors element-wise. For example,
10833 the complex conjugate of a vector is a vector of the complex conjugates
10834 of its elements.
10835
10836 @ignore
10837 @starindex
10838 @end ignore
10839 @tindex vec
10840 Algebraic functions for building vectors include @samp{vec(a, b, c)}
10841 to build @samp{[a, b, c]}, @samp{cvec(a, n, m)} to build an
10842 @texline @math{n\times m}
10843 @infoline @var{n}x@var{m}
10844 matrix of @samp{a}s, and @samp{index(n)} to build a vector of integers
10845 from 1 to @samp{n}.
10846
10847 @node Strings, HMS Forms, Vectors and Matrices, Data Types
10848 @section Strings
10849
10850 @noindent
10851 @kindex "
10852 @cindex Strings
10853 @cindex Character strings
10854 Character strings are not a special data type in the Calculator.
10855 Rather, a string is represented simply as a vector all of whose
10856 elements are integers in the range 0 to 255 (ASCII codes). You can
10857 enter a string at any time by pressing the @kbd{"} key. Quotation
10858 marks and backslashes are written @samp{\"} and @samp{\\}, respectively,
10859 inside strings. Other notations introduced by backslashes are:
10860
10861 @example
10862 @group
10863 \a 7 \^@@ 0
10864 \b 8 \^a-z 1-26
10865 \e 27 \^[ 27
10866 \f 12 \^\\ 28
10867 \n 10 \^] 29
10868 \r 13 \^^ 30
10869 \t 9 \^_ 31
10870 \^? 127
10871 @end group
10872 @end example
10873
10874 @noindent
10875 Finally, a backslash followed by three octal digits produces any
10876 character from its ASCII code.
10877
10878 @kindex d "
10879 @pindex calc-display-strings
10880 Strings are normally displayed in vector-of-integers form. The
10881 @w{@kbd{d "}} (@code{calc-display-strings}) command toggles a mode in
10882 which any vectors of small integers are displayed as quoted strings
10883 instead.
10884
10885 The backslash notations shown above are also used for displaying
10886 strings. Characters 128 and above are not translated by Calc; unless
10887 you have an Emacs modified for 8-bit fonts, these will show up in
10888 backslash-octal-digits notation. For characters below 32, and
10889 for character 127, Calc uses the backslash-letter combination if
10890 there is one, or otherwise uses a @samp{\^} sequence.
10891
10892 The only Calc feature that uses strings is @dfn{compositions};
10893 @pxref{Compositions}. Strings also provide a convenient
10894 way to do conversions between ASCII characters and integers.
10895
10896 @ignore
10897 @starindex
10898 @end ignore
10899 @tindex string
10900 There is a @code{string} function which provides a different display
10901 format for strings. Basically, @samp{string(@var{s})}, where @var{s}
10902 is a vector of integers in the proper range, is displayed as the
10903 corresponding string of characters with no surrounding quotation
10904 marks or other modifications. Thus @samp{string("ABC")} (or
10905 @samp{string([65 66 67])}) will look like @samp{ABC} on the stack.
10906 This happens regardless of whether @w{@kbd{d "}} has been used. The
10907 only way to turn it off is to use @kbd{d U} (unformatted language
10908 mode) which will display @samp{string("ABC")} instead.
10909
10910 Control characters are displayed somewhat differently by @code{string}.
10911 Characters below 32, and character 127, are shown using @samp{^} notation
10912 (same as shown above, but without the backslash). The quote and
10913 backslash characters are left alone, as are characters 128 and above.
10914
10915 @ignore
10916 @starindex
10917 @end ignore
10918 @tindex bstring
10919 The @code{bstring} function is just like @code{string} except that
10920 the resulting string is breakable across multiple lines if it doesn't
10921 fit all on one line. Potential break points occur at every space
10922 character in the string.
10923
10924 @node HMS Forms, Date Forms, Strings, Data Types
10925 @section HMS Forms
10926
10927 @noindent
10928 @cindex Hours-minutes-seconds forms
10929 @cindex Degrees-minutes-seconds forms
10930 @dfn{HMS} stands for Hours-Minutes-Seconds; when used as an angular
10931 argument, the interpretation is Degrees-Minutes-Seconds. All functions
10932 that operate on angles accept HMS forms. These are interpreted as
10933 degrees regardless of the current angular mode. It is also possible to
10934 use HMS as the angular mode so that calculated angles are expressed in
10935 degrees, minutes, and seconds.
10936
10937 @kindex @@
10938 @ignore
10939 @mindex @null
10940 @end ignore
10941 @kindex ' (HMS forms)
10942 @ignore
10943 @mindex @null
10944 @end ignore
10945 @kindex " (HMS forms)
10946 @ignore
10947 @mindex @null
10948 @end ignore
10949 @kindex h (HMS forms)
10950 @ignore
10951 @mindex @null
10952 @end ignore
10953 @kindex o (HMS forms)
10954 @ignore
10955 @mindex @null
10956 @end ignore
10957 @kindex m (HMS forms)
10958 @ignore
10959 @mindex @null
10960 @end ignore
10961 @kindex s (HMS forms)
10962 The default format for HMS values is
10963 @samp{@var{hours}@@ @var{mins}' @var{secs}"}. During entry, the letters
10964 @samp{h} (for ``hours'') or
10965 @samp{o} (approximating the ``degrees'' symbol) are accepted as well as
10966 @samp{@@}, @samp{m} is accepted in place of @samp{'}, and @samp{s} is
10967 accepted in place of @samp{"}.
10968 The @var{hours} value is an integer (or integer-valued float).
10969 The @var{mins} value is an integer or integer-valued float between 0 and 59.
10970 The @var{secs} value is a real number between 0 (inclusive) and 60
10971 (exclusive). A positive HMS form is interpreted as @var{hours} +
10972 @var{mins}/60 + @var{secs}/3600. A negative HMS form is interpreted
10973 as @mathit{- @var{hours}} @mathit{-} @var{mins}/60 @mathit{-} @var{secs}/3600.
10974 Display format for HMS forms is quite flexible. @xref{HMS Formats}.
10975
10976 HMS forms can be added and subtracted. When they are added to numbers,
10977 the numbers are interpreted according to the current angular mode. HMS
10978 forms can also be multiplied and divided by real numbers. Dividing
10979 two HMS forms produces a real-valued ratio of the two angles.
10980
10981 @pindex calc-time
10982 @cindex Time of day
10983 Just for kicks, @kbd{M-x calc-time} pushes the current time of day on
10984 the stack as an HMS form.
10985
10986 @node Date Forms, Modulo Forms, HMS Forms, Data Types
10987 @section Date Forms
10988
10989 @noindent
10990 @cindex Date forms
10991 A @dfn{date form} represents a date and possibly an associated time.
10992 Simple date arithmetic is supported: Adding a number to a date
10993 produces a new date shifted by that many days; adding an HMS form to
10994 a date shifts it by that many hours. Subtracting two date forms
10995 computes the number of days between them (represented as a simple
10996 number). Many other operations, such as multiplying two date forms,
10997 are nonsensical and are not allowed by Calc.
10998
10999 Date forms are entered and displayed enclosed in @samp{< >} brackets.
11000 The default format is, e.g., @samp{<Wed Jan 9, 1991>} for dates,
11001 or @samp{<3:32:20pm Wed Jan 9, 1991>} for dates with times.
11002 Input is flexible; date forms can be entered in any of the usual
11003 notations for dates and times. @xref{Date Formats}.
11004
11005 Date forms are stored internally as numbers, specifically the number
11006 of days since midnight on the morning of January 1 of the year 1 AD.
11007 If the internal number is an integer, the form represents a date only;
11008 if the internal number is a fraction or float, the form represents
11009 a date and time. For example, @samp{<6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991>}
11010 is represented by the number 726842.25. The standard precision of
11011 12 decimal digits is enough to ensure that a (reasonable) date and
11012 time can be stored without roundoff error.
11013
11014 If the current precision is greater than 12, date forms will keep
11015 additional digits in the seconds position. For example, if the
11016 precision is 15, the seconds will keep three digits after the
11017 decimal point. Decreasing the precision below 12 may cause the
11018 time part of a date form to become inaccurate. This can also happen
11019 if astronomically high years are used, though this will not be an
11020 issue in everyday (or even everymillennium) use. Note that date
11021 forms without times are stored as exact integers, so roundoff is
11022 never an issue for them.
11023
11024 You can use the @kbd{v p} (@code{calc-pack}) and @kbd{v u}
11025 (@code{calc-unpack}) commands to get at the numerical representation
11026 of a date form. @xref{Packing and Unpacking}.
11027
11028 Date forms can go arbitrarily far into the future or past. Negative
11029 year numbers represent years BC. Calc uses a combination of the
11030 Gregorian and Julian calendars, following the history of Great
11031 Britain and the British colonies. This is the same calendar that
11032 is used by the @code{cal} program in most Unix implementations.
11033
11034 @cindex Julian calendar
11035 @cindex Gregorian calendar
11036 Some historical background: The Julian calendar was created by
11037 Julius Caesar in the year 46 BC as an attempt to fix the gradual
11038 drift caused by the lack of leap years in the calendar used
11039 until that time. The Julian calendar introduced an extra day in
11040 all years divisible by four. After some initial confusion, the
11041 calendar was adopted around the year we call 8 AD. Some centuries
11042 later it became apparent that the Julian year of 365.25 days was
11043 itself not quite right. In 1582 Pope Gregory XIII introduced the
11044 Gregorian calendar, which added the new rule that years divisible
11045 by 100, but not by 400, were not to be considered leap years
11046 despite being divisible by four. Many countries delayed adoption
11047 of the Gregorian calendar because of religious differences;
11048 in Britain it was put off until the year 1752, by which time
11049 the Julian calendar had fallen eleven days behind the true
11050 seasons. So the switch to the Gregorian calendar in early
11051 September 1752 introduced a discontinuity: The day after
11052 Sep 2, 1752 is Sep 14, 1752. Calc follows this convention.
11053 To take another example, Russia waited until 1918 before
11054 adopting the new calendar, and thus needed to remove thirteen
11055 days (between Feb 1, 1918 and Feb 14, 1918). This means that
11056 Calc's reckoning will be inconsistent with Russian history between
11057 1752 and 1918, and similarly for various other countries.
11058
11059 Today's timekeepers introduce an occasional ``leap second'' as
11060 well, but Calc does not take these minor effects into account.
11061 (If it did, it would have to report a non-integer number of days
11062 between, say, @samp{<12:00am Mon Jan 1, 1900>} and
11063 @samp{<12:00am Sat Jan 1, 2000>}.)
11064
11065 Calc uses the Julian calendar for all dates before the year 1752,
11066 including dates BC when the Julian calendar technically had not
11067 yet been invented. Thus the claim that day number @mathit{-10000} is
11068 called ``August 16, 28 BC'' should be taken with a grain of salt.
11069
11070 Please note that there is no ``year 0''; the day before
11071 @samp{<Sat Jan 1, +1>} is @samp{<Fri Dec 31, -1>}. These are
11072 days 0 and @mathit{-1} respectively in Calc's internal numbering scheme.
11073
11074 @cindex Julian day counting
11075 Another day counting system in common use is, confusingly, also called
11076 ``Julian.'' The Julian day number is the numbers of days since
11077 12:00 noon (GMT) on Jan 1, 4713 BC, which in Calc's scheme (in GMT)
11078 is @mathit{-1721423.5} (recall that Calc starts at midnight instead
11079 of noon). Thus to convert a Calc date code obtained by unpacking a
11080 date form into a Julian day number, simply add 1721423.5 after
11081 compensating for the time zone difference. The built-in @kbd{t J}
11082 command performs this conversion for you.
11083
11084 The Julian day number is based on the Julian cycle, which was invented
11085 in 1583 by Joseph Justus Scaliger. Scaliger named it the Julian cycle
11086 since it is involves the Julian calendar, but some have suggested that
11087 Scaliger named it in honor of his father, Julius Caesar Scaliger. The
11088 Julian cycle is based it on three other cycles: the indiction cycle,
11089 the Metonic cycle, and the solar cycle. The indiction cycle is a 15
11090 year cycle originally used by the Romans for tax purposes but later
11091 used to date medieval documents. The Metonic cycle is a 19 year
11092 cycle; 19 years is close to being a common multiple of a solar year
11093 and a lunar month, and so every 19 years the phases of the moon will
11094 occur on the same days of the year. The solar cycle is a 28 year
11095 cycle; the Julian calendar repeats itself every 28 years. The
11096 smallest time period which contains multiples of all three cycles is
11097 the least common multiple of 15 years, 19 years and 28 years, which
11098 (since they're pairwise relatively prime) is
11099 @texline @math{15\times 19\times 28 = 7980} years.
11100 @infoline 15*19*28 = 7980 years.
11101 This is the length of a Julian cycle. Working backwards, the previous
11102 year in which all three cycles began was 4713 BC, and so Scalinger
11103 chose that year as the beginning of a Julian cycle. Since at the time
11104 there were no historical records from before 4713 BC, using this year
11105 as a starting point had the advantage of avoiding negative year
11106 numbers. In 1849, the astronomer John Herschel (son of William
11107 Herschel) suggested using the number of days since the beginning of
11108 the Julian cycle as an astronomical dating system; this idea was taken
11109 up by other astronomers. (At the time, noon was the start of the
11110 astronomical day. Herschel originally suggested counting the days
11111 since Jan 1, 4713 BC at noon Alexandria time; this was later amended to
11112 noon GMT.) Julian day numbering is largely used in astronomy.
11113
11114 @cindex Unix time format
11115 The Unix operating system measures time as an integer number of
11116 seconds since midnight, Jan 1, 1970. To convert a Calc date
11117 value into a Unix time stamp, first subtract 719164 (the code
11118 for @samp{<Jan 1, 1970>}), then multiply by 86400 (the number of
11119 seconds in a day) and press @kbd{R} to round to the nearest
11120 integer. If you have a date form, you can simply subtract the
11121 day @samp{<Jan 1, 1970>} instead of unpacking and subtracting
11122 719164. Likewise, divide by 86400 and add @samp{<Jan 1, 1970>}
11123 to convert from Unix time to a Calc date form. (Note that
11124 Unix normally maintains the time in the GMT time zone; you may
11125 need to subtract five hours to get New York time, or eight hours
11126 for California time. The same is usually true of Julian day
11127 counts.) The built-in @kbd{t U} command performs these
11128 conversions.
11129
11130 @node Modulo Forms, Error Forms, Date Forms, Data Types
11131 @section Modulo Forms
11132
11133 @noindent
11134 @cindex Modulo forms
11135 A @dfn{modulo form} is a real number which is taken modulo (i.e., within
11136 an integer multiple of) some value @var{M}. Arithmetic modulo @var{M}
11137 often arises in number theory. Modulo forms are written
11138 `@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}',
11139 where @var{a} and @var{M} are real numbers or HMS forms, and
11140 @texline @math{0 \le a < M}.
11141 @infoline @expr{0 <= a < @var{M}}.
11142 In many applications @expr{a} and @expr{M} will be
11143 integers but this is not required.
11144
11145 @ignore
11146 @mindex M
11147 @end ignore
11148 @kindex M (modulo forms)
11149 @ignore
11150 @mindex mod
11151 @end ignore
11152 @tindex mod (operator)
11153 To create a modulo form during numeric entry, press the shift-@kbd{M}
11154 key to enter the word @samp{mod}. As a special convenience, pressing
11155 shift-@kbd{M} a second time automatically enters the value of @expr{M}
11156 that was most recently used before. During algebraic entry, either
11157 type @samp{mod} by hand or press @kbd{M-m} (that's @kbd{@key{META}-m}).
11158 Once again, pressing this a second time enters the current modulo.
11159
11160 Modulo forms are not to be confused with the modulo operator @samp{%}.
11161 The expression @samp{27 % 10} means to compute 27 modulo 10 to produce
11162 the result 7. Further computations treat this 7 as just a regular integer.
11163 The expression @samp{27 mod 10} produces the result @samp{7 mod 10};
11164 further computations with this value are again reduced modulo 10 so that
11165 the result always lies in the desired range.
11166
11167 When two modulo forms with identical @expr{M}'s are added or multiplied,
11168 the Calculator simply adds or multiplies the values, then reduces modulo
11169 @expr{M}. If one argument is a modulo form and the other a plain number,
11170 the plain number is treated like a compatible modulo form. It is also
11171 possible to raise modulo forms to powers; the result is the value raised
11172 to the power, then reduced modulo @expr{M}. (When all values involved
11173 are integers, this calculation is done much more efficiently than
11174 actually computing the power and then reducing.)
11175
11176 @cindex Modulo division
11177 Two modulo forms `@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}' and `@var{b} @tfn{mod} @var{M}'
11178 can be divided if @expr{a}, @expr{b}, and @expr{M} are all
11179 integers. The result is the modulo form which, when multiplied by
11180 `@var{b} @tfn{mod} @var{M}', produces `@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}'. If
11181 there is no solution to this equation (which can happen only when
11182 @expr{M} is non-prime), or if any of the arguments are non-integers, the
11183 division is left in symbolic form. Other operations, such as square
11184 roots, are not yet supported for modulo forms. (Note that, although
11185 @w{`@tfn{(}@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}@tfn{)^.5}'} will compute a ``modulo square root''
11186 in the sense of reducing
11187 @texline @math{\sqrt a}
11188 @infoline @expr{sqrt(a)}
11189 modulo @expr{M}, this is not a useful definition from the
11190 number-theoretical point of view.)
11191
11192 It is possible to mix HMS forms and modulo forms. For example, an
11193 HMS form modulo 24 could be used to manipulate clock times; an HMS
11194 form modulo 360 would be suitable for angles. Making the modulo @expr{M}
11195 also be an HMS form eliminates troubles that would arise if the angular
11196 mode were inadvertently set to Radians, in which case
11197 @w{@samp{2@@ 0' 0" mod 24}} would be interpreted as two degrees modulo
11198 24 radians!
11199
11200 Modulo forms cannot have variables or formulas for components. If you
11201 enter the formula @samp{(x + 2) mod 5}, Calc propagates the modulus
11202 to each of the coefficients: @samp{(1 mod 5) x + (2 mod 5)}.
11203
11204 You can use @kbd{v p} and @kbd{%} to modify modulo forms.
11205 @xref{Packing and Unpacking}. @xref{Basic Arithmetic}.
11206
11207 @ignore
11208 @starindex
11209 @end ignore
11210 @tindex makemod
11211 The algebraic function @samp{makemod(a, m)} builds the modulo form
11212 @w{@samp{a mod m}}.
11213
11214 @node Error Forms, Interval Forms, Modulo Forms, Data Types
11215 @section Error Forms
11216
11217 @noindent
11218 @cindex Error forms
11219 @cindex Standard deviations
11220 An @dfn{error form} is a number with an associated standard
11221 deviation, as in @samp{2.3 +/- 0.12}. The notation
11222 @texline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @math{\sigma}'
11223 @infoline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} sigma'
11224 stands for an uncertain value which follows
11225 a normal or Gaussian distribution of mean @expr{x} and standard
11226 deviation or ``error''
11227 @texline @math{\sigma}.
11228 @infoline @expr{sigma}.
11229 Both the mean and the error can be either numbers or
11230 formulas. Generally these are real numbers but the mean may also be
11231 complex. If the error is negative or complex, it is changed to its
11232 absolute value. An error form with zero error is converted to a
11233 regular number by the Calculator.
11234
11235 All arithmetic and transcendental functions accept error forms as input.
11236 Operations on the mean-value part work just like operations on regular
11237 numbers. The error part for any function @expr{f(x)} (such as
11238 @texline @math{\sin x}
11239 @infoline @expr{sin(x)})
11240 is defined by the error of @expr{x} times the derivative of @expr{f}
11241 evaluated at the mean value of @expr{x}. For a two-argument function
11242 @expr{f(x,y)} (such as addition) the error is the square root of the sum
11243 of the squares of the errors due to @expr{x} and @expr{y}.
11244 @tex
11245 $$ \eqalign{
11246 f(x \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma)
11247 &= f(x) \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma \left| {df(x) \over dx} \right| \cr
11248 f(x \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma_x, y \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma_y)
11249 &= f(x,y) \hbox{\code{ +/- }}
11250 \sqrt{\left(\sigma_x \left| {\partial f(x,y) \over \partial x}
11251 \right| \right)^2
11252 +\left(\sigma_y \left| {\partial f(x,y) \over \partial y}
11253 \right| \right)^2 } \cr
11254 } $$
11255 @end tex
11256 Note that this
11257 definition assumes the errors in @expr{x} and @expr{y} are uncorrelated.
11258 A side effect of this definition is that @samp{(2 +/- 1) * (2 +/- 1)}
11259 is not the same as @samp{(2 +/- 1)^2}; the former represents the product
11260 of two independent values which happen to have the same probability
11261 distributions, and the latter is the product of one random value with itself.
11262 The former will produce an answer with less error, since on the average
11263 the two independent errors can be expected to cancel out.
11264
11265 Consult a good text on error analysis for a discussion of the proper use
11266 of standard deviations. Actual errors often are neither Gaussian-distributed
11267 nor uncorrelated, and the above formulas are valid only when errors
11268 are small. As an example, the error arising from
11269 @texline `@tfn{sin(}@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @math{\sigma}@tfn{)}'
11270 @infoline `@tfn{sin(}@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @var{sigma}@tfn{)}'
11271 is
11272 @texline `@math{\sigma} @tfn{abs(cos(}@var{x}@tfn{))}'.
11273 @infoline `@var{sigma} @tfn{abs(cos(}@var{x}@tfn{))}'.
11274 When @expr{x} is close to zero,
11275 @texline @math{\cos x}
11276 @infoline @expr{cos(x)}
11277 is close to one so the error in the sine is close to
11278 @texline @math{\sigma};
11279 @infoline @expr{sigma};
11280 this makes sense, since
11281 @texline @math{\sin x}
11282 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}
11283 is approximately @expr{x} near zero, so a given error in @expr{x} will
11284 produce about the same error in the sine. Likewise, near 90 degrees
11285 @texline @math{\cos x}
11286 @infoline @expr{cos(x)}
11287 is nearly zero and so the computed error is
11288 small: The sine curve is nearly flat in that region, so an error in @expr{x}
11289 has relatively little effect on the value of
11290 @texline @math{\sin x}.
11291 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}.
11292 However, consider @samp{sin(90 +/- 1000)}. The cosine of 90 is zero, so
11293 Calc will report zero error! We get an obviously wrong result because
11294 we have violated the small-error approximation underlying the error
11295 analysis. If the error in @expr{x} had been small, the error in
11296 @texline @math{\sin x}
11297 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}
11298 would indeed have been negligible.
11299
11300 @ignore
11301 @mindex p
11302 @end ignore
11303 @kindex p (error forms)
11304 @tindex +/-
11305 To enter an error form during regular numeric entry, use the @kbd{p}
11306 (``plus-or-minus'') key to type the @samp{+/-} symbol. (If you try actually
11307 typing @samp{+/-} the @kbd{+} key will be interpreted as the Calculator's
11308 @kbd{+} command!) Within an algebraic formula, you can press @kbd{M-+} to
11309 type the @samp{+/-} symbol, or type it out by hand.
11310
11311 Error forms and complex numbers can be mixed; the formulas shown above
11312 are used for complex numbers, too; note that if the error part evaluates
11313 to a complex number its absolute value (or the square root of the sum of
11314 the squares of the absolute values of the two error contributions) is
11315 used. Mathematically, this corresponds to a radially symmetric Gaussian
11316 distribution of numbers on the complex plane. However, note that Calc
11317 considers an error form with real components to represent a real number,
11318 not a complex distribution around a real mean.
11319
11320 Error forms may also be composed of HMS forms. For best results, both
11321 the mean and the error should be HMS forms if either one is.
11322
11323 @ignore
11324 @starindex
11325 @end ignore
11326 @tindex sdev
11327 The algebraic function @samp{sdev(a, b)} builds the error form @samp{a +/- b}.
11328
11329 @node Interval Forms, Incomplete Objects, Error Forms, Data Types
11330 @section Interval Forms
11331
11332 @noindent
11333 @cindex Interval forms
11334 An @dfn{interval} is a subset of consecutive real numbers. For example,
11335 the interval @samp{[2 ..@: 4]} represents all the numbers from 2 to 4,
11336 inclusive. If you multiply it by the interval @samp{[0.5 ..@: 2]} you
11337 obtain @samp{[1 ..@: 8]}. This calculation represents the fact that if
11338 you multiply some number in the range @samp{[2 ..@: 4]} by some other
11339 number in the range @samp{[0.5 ..@: 2]}, your result will lie in the range
11340 from 1 to 8. Interval arithmetic is used to get a worst-case estimate
11341 of the possible range of values a computation will produce, given the
11342 set of possible values of the input.
11343
11344 @ifnottex
11345 Calc supports several varieties of intervals, including @dfn{closed}
11346 intervals of the type shown above, @dfn{open} intervals such as
11347 @samp{(2 ..@: 4)}, which represents the range of numbers from 2 to 4
11348 @emph{exclusive}, and @dfn{semi-open} intervals in which one end
11349 uses a round parenthesis and the other a square bracket. In mathematical
11350 terms,
11351 @samp{[2 ..@: 4]} means @expr{2 <= x <= 4}, whereas
11352 @samp{[2 ..@: 4)} represents @expr{2 <= x < 4},
11353 @samp{(2 ..@: 4]} represents @expr{2 < x <= 4}, and
11354 @samp{(2 ..@: 4)} represents @expr{2 < x < 4}.
11355 @end ifnottex
11356 @tex
11357 Calc supports several varieties of intervals, including \dfn{closed}
11358 intervals of the type shown above, \dfn{open} intervals such as
11359 \samp{(2 ..\: 4)}, which represents the range of numbers from 2 to 4
11360 \emph{exclusive}, and \dfn{semi-open} intervals in which one end
11361 uses a round parenthesis and the other a square bracket. In mathematical
11362 terms,
11363 $$ \eqalign{
11364 [2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4] &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 \le x \le 4 \cr
11365 [2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4) &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 \le x < 4 \cr
11366 (2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4] &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 < x \le 4 \cr
11367 (2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4) &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 < x < 4 \cr
11368 } $$
11369 @end tex
11370
11371 The lower and upper limits of an interval must be either real numbers
11372 (or HMS or date forms), or symbolic expressions which are assumed to be
11373 real-valued, or @samp{-inf} and @samp{inf}. In general the lower limit
11374 must be less than the upper limit. A closed interval containing only
11375 one value, @samp{[3 ..@: 3]}, is converted to a plain number (3)
11376 automatically. An interval containing no values at all (such as
11377 @samp{[3 ..@: 2]} or @samp{[2 ..@: 2)}) can be represented but is not
11378 guaranteed to behave well when used in arithmetic. Note that the
11379 interval @samp{[3 .. inf)} represents all real numbers greater than
11380 or equal to 3, and @samp{(-inf .. inf)} represents all real numbers.
11381 In fact, @samp{[-inf .. inf]} represents all real numbers including
11382 the real infinities.
11383
11384 Intervals are entered in the notation shown here, either as algebraic
11385 formulas, or using incomplete forms. (@xref{Incomplete Objects}.)
11386 In algebraic formulas, multiple periods in a row are collected from
11387 left to right, so that @samp{1...1e2} is interpreted as @samp{1.0 ..@: 1e2}
11388 rather than @samp{1 ..@: 0.1e2}. Add spaces or zeros if you want to
11389 get the other interpretation. If you omit the lower or upper limit,
11390 a default of @samp{-inf} or @samp{inf} (respectively) is furnished.
11391
11392 Infinite mode also affects operations on intervals
11393 (@pxref{Infinities}). Calc will always introduce an open infinity,
11394 as in @samp{1 / (0 .. 2] = [0.5 .. inf)}. But closed infinities,
11395 @w{@samp{1 / [0 .. 2] = [0.5 .. inf]}}, arise only in Infinite mode;
11396 otherwise they are left unevaluated. Note that the ``direction'' of
11397 a zero is not an issue in this case since the zero is always assumed
11398 to be continuous with the rest of the interval. For intervals that
11399 contain zero inside them Calc is forced to give the result,
11400 @samp{1 / (-2 .. 2) = [-inf .. inf]}.
11401
11402 While it may seem that intervals and error forms are similar, they are
11403 based on entirely different concepts of inexact quantities. An error
11404 form
11405 @texline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @math{\sigma}'
11406 @infoline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @var{sigma}'
11407 means a variable is random, and its value could
11408 be anything but is ``probably'' within one
11409 @texline @math{\sigma}
11410 @infoline @var{sigma}
11411 of the mean value @expr{x}. An interval
11412 `@tfn{[}@var{a} @tfn{..@:} @var{b}@tfn{]}' means a
11413 variable's value is unknown, but guaranteed to lie in the specified
11414 range. Error forms are statistical or ``average case'' approximations;
11415 interval arithmetic tends to produce ``worst case'' bounds on an
11416 answer.
11417
11418 Intervals may not contain complex numbers, but they may contain
11419 HMS forms or date forms.
11420
11421 @xref{Set Operations}, for commands that interpret interval forms
11422 as subsets of the set of real numbers.
11423
11424 @ignore
11425 @starindex
11426 @end ignore
11427 @tindex intv
11428 The algebraic function @samp{intv(n, a, b)} builds an interval form
11429 from @samp{a} to @samp{b}; @samp{n} is an integer code which must
11430 be 0 for @samp{(..)}, 1 for @samp{(..]}, 2 for @samp{[..)}, or
11431 3 for @samp{[..]}.
11432
11433 Please note that in fully rigorous interval arithmetic, care would be
11434 taken to make sure that the computation of the lower bound rounds toward
11435 minus infinity, while upper bound computations round toward plus
11436 infinity. Calc's arithmetic always uses a round-to-nearest mode,
11437 which means that roundoff errors could creep into an interval
11438 calculation to produce intervals slightly smaller than they ought to
11439 be. For example, entering @samp{[1..2]} and pressing @kbd{Q 2 ^}
11440 should yield the interval @samp{[1..2]} again, but in fact it yields the
11441 (slightly too small) interval @samp{[1..1.9999999]} due to roundoff
11442 error.
11443
11444 @node Incomplete Objects, Variables, Interval Forms, Data Types
11445 @section Incomplete Objects
11446
11447 @noindent
11448 @ignore
11449 @mindex [ ]
11450 @end ignore
11451 @kindex [
11452 @ignore
11453 @mindex ( )
11454 @end ignore
11455 @kindex (
11456 @kindex ,
11457 @ignore
11458 @mindex @null
11459 @end ignore
11460 @kindex ]
11461 @ignore
11462 @mindex @null
11463 @end ignore
11464 @kindex )
11465 @cindex Incomplete vectors
11466 @cindex Incomplete complex numbers
11467 @cindex Incomplete interval forms
11468 When @kbd{(} or @kbd{[} is typed to begin entering a complex number or
11469 vector, respectively, the effect is to push an @dfn{incomplete} complex
11470 number or vector onto the stack. The @kbd{,} key adds the value(s) at
11471 the top of the stack onto the current incomplete object. The @kbd{)}
11472 and @kbd{]} keys ``close'' the incomplete object after adding any values
11473 on the top of the stack in front of the incomplete object.
11474
11475 As a result, the sequence of keystrokes @kbd{[ 2 , 3 @key{RET} 2 * , 9 ]}
11476 pushes the vector @samp{[2, 6, 9]} onto the stack. Likewise, @kbd{( 1 , 2 Q )}
11477 pushes the complex number @samp{(1, 1.414)} (approximately).
11478
11479 If several values lie on the stack in front of the incomplete object,
11480 all are collected and appended to the object. Thus the @kbd{,} key
11481 is redundant: @kbd{[ 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 2 * 9 ]}. Some people
11482 prefer the equivalent @key{SPC} key to @key{RET}.
11483
11484 As a special case, typing @kbd{,} immediately after @kbd{(}, @kbd{[}, or
11485 @kbd{,} adds a zero or duplicates the preceding value in the list being
11486 formed. Typing @key{DEL} during incomplete entry removes the last item
11487 from the list.
11488
11489 @kindex ;
11490 The @kbd{;} key is used in the same way as @kbd{,} to create polar complex
11491 numbers: @kbd{( 1 ; 2 )}. When entering a vector, @kbd{;} is useful for
11492 creating a matrix. In particular, @kbd{[ [ 1 , 2 ; 3 , 4 ; 5 , 6 ] ]} is
11493 equivalent to @kbd{[ [ 1 , 2 ] , [ 3 , 4 ] , [ 5 , 6 ] ]}.
11494
11495 @kindex ..
11496 @pindex calc-dots
11497 Incomplete entry is also used to enter intervals. For example,
11498 @kbd{[ 2 ..@: 4 )} enters a semi-open interval. Note that when you type
11499 the first period, it will be interpreted as a decimal point, but when
11500 you type a second period immediately afterward, it is re-interpreted as
11501 part of the interval symbol. Typing @kbd{..} corresponds to executing
11502 the @code{calc-dots} command.
11503
11504 If you find incomplete entry distracting, you may wish to enter vectors
11505 and complex numbers as algebraic formulas by pressing the apostrophe key.
11506
11507 @node Variables, Formulas, Incomplete Objects, Data Types
11508 @section Variables
11509
11510 @noindent
11511 @cindex Variables, in formulas
11512 A @dfn{variable} is somewhere between a storage register on a conventional
11513 calculator, and a variable in a programming language. (In fact, a Calc
11514 variable is really just an Emacs Lisp variable that contains a Calc number
11515 or formula.) A variable's name is normally composed of letters and digits.
11516 Calc also allows apostrophes and @code{#} signs in variable names.
11517 (The Calc variable @code{foo} corresponds to the Emacs Lisp variable
11518 @code{var-foo}, but unless you access the variable from within Emacs
11519 Lisp, you don't need to worry about it. Variable names in algebraic
11520 formulas implicitly have @samp{var-} prefixed to their names. The
11521 @samp{#} character in variable names used in algebraic formulas
11522 corresponds to a dash @samp{-} in the Lisp variable name. If the name
11523 contains any dashes, the prefix @samp{var-} is @emph{not} automatically
11524 added. Thus the two formulas @samp{foo + 1} and @samp{var#foo + 1} both
11525 refer to the same variable.)
11526
11527 In a command that takes a variable name, you can either type the full
11528 name of a variable, or type a single digit to use one of the special
11529 convenience variables @code{q0} through @code{q9}. For example,
11530 @kbd{3 s s 2} stores the number 3 in variable @code{q2}, and
11531 @w{@kbd{3 s s foo @key{RET}}} stores that number in variable
11532 @code{foo}.
11533
11534 To push a variable itself (as opposed to the variable's value) on the
11535 stack, enter its name as an algebraic expression using the apostrophe
11536 (@key{'}) key.
11537
11538 @kindex =
11539 @pindex calc-evaluate
11540 @cindex Evaluation of variables in a formula
11541 @cindex Variables, evaluation
11542 @cindex Formulas, evaluation
11543 The @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}) key ``evaluates'' a formula by
11544 replacing all variables in the formula which have been given values by a
11545 @code{calc-store} or @code{calc-let} command by their stored values.
11546 Other variables are left alone. Thus a variable that has not been
11547 stored acts like an abstract variable in algebra; a variable that has
11548 been stored acts more like a register in a traditional calculator.
11549 With a positive numeric prefix argument, @kbd{=} evaluates the top
11550 @var{n} stack entries; with a negative argument, @kbd{=} evaluates
11551 the @var{n}th stack entry.
11552
11553 @cindex @code{e} variable
11554 @cindex @code{pi} variable
11555 @cindex @code{i} variable
11556 @cindex @code{phi} variable
11557 @cindex @code{gamma} variable
11558 @vindex e
11559 @vindex pi
11560 @vindex i
11561 @vindex phi
11562 @vindex gamma
11563 A few variables are called @dfn{special constants}. Their names are
11564 @samp{e}, @samp{pi}, @samp{i}, @samp{phi}, and @samp{gamma}.
11565 (@xref{Scientific Functions}.) When they are evaluated with @kbd{=},
11566 their values are calculated if necessary according to the current precision
11567 or complex polar mode. If you wish to use these symbols for other purposes,
11568 simply undefine or redefine them using @code{calc-store}.
11569
11570 The variables @samp{inf}, @samp{uinf}, and @samp{nan} stand for
11571 infinite or indeterminate values. It's best not to use them as
11572 regular variables, since Calc uses special algebraic rules when
11573 it manipulates them. Calc displays a warning message if you store
11574 a value into any of these special variables.
11575
11576 @xref{Store and Recall}, for a discussion of commands dealing with variables.
11577
11578 @node Formulas, , Variables, Data Types
11579 @section Formulas
11580
11581 @noindent
11582 @cindex Formulas
11583 @cindex Expressions
11584 @cindex Operators in formulas
11585 @cindex Precedence of operators
11586 When you press the apostrophe key you may enter any expression or formula
11587 in algebraic form. (Calc uses the terms ``expression'' and ``formula''
11588 interchangeably.) An expression is built up of numbers, variable names,
11589 and function calls, combined with various arithmetic operators.
11590 Parentheses may
11591 be used to indicate grouping. Spaces are ignored within formulas, except
11592 that spaces are not permitted within variable names or numbers.
11593 Arithmetic operators, in order from highest to lowest precedence, and
11594 with their equivalent function names, are:
11595
11596 @samp{_} [@code{subscr}] (subscripts);
11597
11598 postfix @samp{%} [@code{percent}] (as in @samp{25% = 0.25});
11599
11600 prefix @samp{!} [@code{lnot}] (logical ``not,'' as in @samp{!x});
11601
11602 @samp{+/-} [@code{sdev}] (the standard deviation symbol) and
11603 @samp{mod} [@code{makemod}] (the symbol for modulo forms);
11604
11605 postfix @samp{!} [@code{fact}] (factorial, as in @samp{n!})
11606 and postfix @samp{!!} [@code{dfact}] (double factorial);
11607
11608 @samp{^} [@code{pow}] (raised-to-the-power-of);
11609
11610 prefix @samp{+} and @samp{-} [@code{neg}] (as in @samp{-x});
11611
11612 @samp{*} [@code{mul}];
11613
11614 @samp{/} [@code{div}], @samp{%} [@code{mod}] (modulo), and
11615 @samp{\} [@code{idiv}] (integer division);
11616
11617 infix @samp{+} [@code{add}] and @samp{-} [@code{sub}] (as in @samp{x-y});
11618
11619 @samp{|} [@code{vconcat}] (vector concatenation);
11620
11621 relations @samp{=} [@code{eq}], @samp{!=} [@code{neq}], @samp{<} [@code{lt}],
11622 @samp{>} [@code{gt}], @samp{<=} [@code{leq}], and @samp{>=} [@code{geq}];
11623
11624 @samp{&&} [@code{land}] (logical ``and'');
11625
11626 @samp{||} [@code{lor}] (logical ``or'');
11627
11628 the C-style ``if'' operator @samp{a?b:c} [@code{if}];
11629
11630 @samp{!!!} [@code{pnot}] (rewrite pattern ``not'');
11631
11632 @samp{&&&} [@code{pand}] (rewrite pattern ``and'');
11633
11634 @samp{|||} [@code{por}] (rewrite pattern ``or'');
11635
11636 @samp{:=} [@code{assign}] (for assignments and rewrite rules);
11637
11638 @samp{::} [@code{condition}] (rewrite pattern condition);
11639
11640 @samp{=>} [@code{evalto}].
11641
11642 Note that, unlike in usual computer notation, multiplication binds more
11643 strongly than division: @samp{a*b/c*d} is equivalent to
11644 @texline @math{a b \over c d}.
11645 @infoline @expr{(a*b)/(c*d)}.
11646
11647 @cindex Multiplication, implicit
11648 @cindex Implicit multiplication
11649 The multiplication sign @samp{*} may be omitted in many cases. In particular,
11650 if the righthand side is a number, variable name, or parenthesized
11651 expression, the @samp{*} may be omitted. Implicit multiplication has the
11652 same precedence as the explicit @samp{*} operator. The one exception to
11653 the rule is that a variable name followed by a parenthesized expression,
11654 as in @samp{f(x)},
11655 is interpreted as a function call, not an implicit @samp{*}. In many
11656 cases you must use a space if you omit the @samp{*}: @samp{2a} is the
11657 same as @samp{2*a}, and @samp{a b} is the same as @samp{a*b}, but @samp{ab}
11658 is a variable called @code{ab}, @emph{not} the product of @samp{a} and
11659 @samp{b}! Also note that @samp{f (x)} is still a function call.
11660
11661 @cindex Implicit comma in vectors
11662 The rules are slightly different for vectors written with square brackets.
11663 In vectors, the space character is interpreted (like the comma) as a
11664 separator of elements of the vector. Thus @w{@samp{[ 2a b+c d ]}} is
11665 equivalent to @samp{[2*a, b+c, d]}, whereas @samp{2a b+c d} is equivalent
11666 to @samp{2*a*b + c*d}.
11667 Note that spaces around the brackets, and around explicit commas, are
11668 ignored. To force spaces to be interpreted as multiplication you can
11669 enclose a formula in parentheses as in @samp{[(a b) 2(c d)]}, which is
11670 interpreted as @samp{[a*b, 2*c*d]}. An implicit comma is also inserted
11671 between @samp{][}, as in the matrix @samp{[[1 2][3 4]]}.
11672
11673 Vectors that contain commas (not embedded within nested parentheses or
11674 brackets) do not treat spaces specially: @samp{[a b, 2 c d]} is a vector
11675 of two elements. Also, if it would be an error to treat spaces as
11676 separators, but not otherwise, then Calc will ignore spaces:
11677 @w{@samp{[a - b]}} is a vector of one element, but @w{@samp{[a -b]}} is
11678 a vector of two elements. Finally, vectors entered with curly braces
11679 instead of square brackets do not give spaces any special treatment.
11680 When Calc displays a vector that does not contain any commas, it will
11681 insert parentheses if necessary to make the meaning clear:
11682 @w{@samp{[(a b)]}}.
11683
11684 The expression @samp{5%-2} is ambiguous; is this five-percent minus two,
11685 or five modulo minus-two? Calc always interprets the leftmost symbol as
11686 an infix operator preferentially (modulo, in this case), so you would
11687 need to write @samp{(5%)-2} to get the former interpretation.
11688
11689 @cindex Function call notation
11690 A function call is, e.g., @samp{sin(1+x)}. (The Calc algebraic function
11691 @code{foo} corresponds to the Emacs Lisp function @code{calcFunc-foo},
11692 but unless you access the function from within Emacs Lisp, you don't
11693 need to worry about it.) Most mathematical Calculator commands like
11694 @code{calc-sin} have function equivalents like @code{sin}.
11695 If no Lisp function is defined for a function called by a formula, the
11696 call is left as it is during algebraic manipulation: @samp{f(x+y)} is
11697 left alone. Beware that many innocent-looking short names like @code{in}
11698 and @code{re} have predefined meanings which could surprise you; however,
11699 single letters or single letters followed by digits are always safe to
11700 use for your own function names. @xref{Function Index}.
11701
11702 In the documentation for particular commands, the notation @kbd{H S}
11703 (@code{calc-sinh}) [@code{sinh}] means that the key sequence @kbd{H S}, the
11704 command @kbd{M-x calc-sinh}, and the algebraic function @code{sinh(x)} all
11705 represent the same operation.
11706
11707 Commands that interpret (``parse'') text as algebraic formulas include
11708 algebraic entry (@kbd{'}), editing commands like @kbd{`} which parse
11709 the contents of the editing buffer when you finish, the @kbd{C-x * g}
11710 and @w{@kbd{C-x * r}} commands, the @kbd{C-y} command, the X window system
11711 ``paste'' mouse operation, and Embedded mode. All of these operations
11712 use the same rules for parsing formulas; in particular, language modes
11713 (@pxref{Language Modes}) affect them all in the same way.
11714
11715 When you read a large amount of text into the Calculator (say a vector
11716 which represents a big set of rewrite rules; @pxref{Rewrite Rules}),
11717 you may wish to include comments in the text. Calc's formula parser
11718 ignores the symbol @samp{%%} and anything following it on a line:
11719
11720 @example
11721 [ a + b, %% the sum of "a" and "b"
11722 c + d,
11723 %% last line is coming up:
11724 e + f ]
11725 @end example
11726
11727 @noindent
11728 This is parsed exactly the same as @samp{[ a + b, c + d, e + f ]}.
11729
11730 @xref{Syntax Tables}, for a way to create your own operators and other
11731 input notations. @xref{Compositions}, for a way to create new display
11732 formats.
11733
11734 @xref{Algebra}, for commands for manipulating formulas symbolically.
11735
11736 @node Stack and Trail, Mode Settings, Data Types, Top
11737 @chapter Stack and Trail Commands
11738
11739 @noindent
11740 This chapter describes the Calc commands for manipulating objects on the
11741 stack and in the trail buffer. (These commands operate on objects of any
11742 type, such as numbers, vectors, formulas, and incomplete objects.)
11743
11744 @menu
11745 * Stack Manipulation::
11746 * Editing Stack Entries::
11747 * Trail Commands::
11748 * Keep Arguments::
11749 @end menu
11750
11751 @node Stack Manipulation, Editing Stack Entries, Stack and Trail, Stack and Trail
11752 @section Stack Manipulation Commands
11753
11754 @noindent
11755 @kindex @key{RET}
11756 @kindex @key{SPC}
11757 @pindex calc-enter
11758 @cindex Duplicating stack entries
11759 To duplicate the top object on the stack, press @key{RET} or @key{SPC}
11760 (two equivalent keys for the @code{calc-enter} command).
11761 Given a positive numeric prefix argument, these commands duplicate
11762 several elements at the top of the stack.
11763 Given a negative argument,
11764 these commands duplicate the specified element of the stack.
11765 Given an argument of zero, they duplicate the entire stack.
11766 For example, with @samp{10 20 30} on the stack,
11767 @key{RET} creates @samp{10 20 30 30},
11768 @kbd{C-u 2 @key{RET}} creates @samp{10 20 30 20 30},
11769 @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{RET}} creates @samp{10 20 30 20}, and
11770 @kbd{C-u 0 @key{RET}} creates @samp{10 20 30 10 20 30}.
11771
11772 @kindex @key{LFD}
11773 @pindex calc-over
11774 The @key{LFD} (@code{calc-over}) command (on a key marked Line-Feed if you
11775 have it, else on @kbd{C-j}) is like @code{calc-enter}
11776 except that the sign of the numeric prefix argument is interpreted
11777 oppositely. Also, with no prefix argument the default argument is 2.
11778 Thus with @samp{10 20 30} on the stack, @key{LFD} and @kbd{C-u 2 @key{LFD}}
11779 are both equivalent to @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{RET}}, producing
11780 @samp{10 20 30 20}.
11781
11782 @kindex @key{DEL}
11783 @kindex C-d
11784 @pindex calc-pop
11785 @cindex Removing stack entries
11786 @cindex Deleting stack entries
11787 To remove the top element from the stack, press @key{DEL} (@code{calc-pop}).
11788 The @kbd{C-d} key is a synonym for @key{DEL}.
11789 (If the top element is an incomplete object with at least one element, the
11790 last element is removed from it.) Given a positive numeric prefix argument,
11791 several elements are removed. Given a negative argument, the specified
11792 element of the stack is deleted. Given an argument of zero, the entire
11793 stack is emptied.
11794 For example, with @samp{10 20 30} on the stack,
11795 @key{DEL} leaves @samp{10 20},
11796 @kbd{C-u 2 @key{DEL}} leaves @samp{10},
11797 @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{DEL}} leaves @samp{10 30}, and
11798 @kbd{C-u 0 @key{DEL}} leaves an empty stack.
11799
11800 @kindex M-@key{DEL}
11801 @pindex calc-pop-above
11802 The @kbd{M-@key{DEL}} (@code{calc-pop-above}) command is to @key{DEL} what
11803 @key{LFD} is to @key{RET}: It interprets the sign of the numeric
11804 prefix argument in the opposite way, and the default argument is 2.
11805 Thus @kbd{M-@key{DEL}} by itself removes the second-from-top stack element,
11806 leaving the first, third, fourth, and so on; @kbd{M-3 M-@key{DEL}} deletes
11807 the third stack element.
11808
11809 @kindex @key{TAB}
11810 @pindex calc-roll-down
11811 To exchange the top two elements of the stack, press @key{TAB}
11812 (@code{calc-roll-down}). Given a positive numeric prefix argument, the
11813 specified number of elements at the top of the stack are rotated downward.
11814 Given a negative argument, the entire stack is rotated downward the specified
11815 number of times. Given an argument of zero, the entire stack is reversed
11816 top-for-bottom.
11817 For example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the stack,
11818 @key{TAB} creates @samp{10 20 30 50 40},
11819 @kbd{C-u 3 @key{TAB}} creates @samp{10 20 50 30 40},
11820 @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{TAB}} creates @samp{40 50 10 20 30}, and
11821 @kbd{C-u 0 @key{TAB}} creates @samp{50 40 30 20 10}.
11822
11823 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
11824 @pindex calc-roll-up
11825 The command @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} (@code{calc-roll-up}) is analogous to @key{TAB}
11826 except that it rotates upward instead of downward. Also, the default
11827 with no prefix argument is to rotate the top 3 elements.
11828 For example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the stack,
11829 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{10 20 40 50 30},
11830 @kbd{C-u 4 M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{10 30 40 50 20},
11831 @kbd{C-u - 2 M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{30 40 50 10 20}, and
11832 @kbd{C-u 0 M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{50 40 30 20 10}.
11833
11834 A good way to view the operation of @key{TAB} and @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} is in
11835 terms of moving a particular element to a new position in the stack.
11836 With a positive argument @var{n}, @key{TAB} moves the top stack
11837 element down to level @var{n}, making room for it by pulling all the
11838 intervening stack elements toward the top. @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} moves the
11839 element at level @var{n} up to the top. (Compare with @key{LFD},
11840 which copies instead of moving the element in level @var{n}.)
11841
11842 With a negative argument @mathit{-@var{n}}, @key{TAB} rotates the stack
11843 to move the object in level @var{n} to the deepest place in the
11844 stack, and the object in level @mathit{@var{n}+1} to the top. @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}
11845 rotates the deepest stack element to be in level @mathit{n}, also
11846 putting the top stack element in level @mathit{@var{n}+1}.
11847
11848 @xref{Selecting Subformulas}, for a way to apply these commands to
11849 any portion of a vector or formula on the stack.
11850
11851 @node Editing Stack Entries, Trail Commands, Stack Manipulation, Stack and Trail
11852 @section Editing Stack Entries
11853
11854 @noindent
11855 @kindex `
11856 @pindex calc-edit
11857 @pindex calc-edit-finish
11858 @cindex Editing the stack with Emacs
11859 The @kbd{`} (@code{calc-edit}) command creates a temporary buffer
11860 (@samp{*Calc Edit*}) for editing the top-of-stack value using regular
11861 Emacs commands. Note that @kbd{`} is a backquote, not a quote. With a
11862 numeric prefix argument, it edits the specified number of stack entries
11863 at once. (An argument of zero edits the entire stack; a negative
11864 argument edits one specific stack entry.)
11865
11866 When you are done editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish and return
11867 to Calc. The @key{RET} and @key{LFD} keys also work to finish most
11868 sorts of editing, though in some cases Calc leaves @key{RET} with its
11869 usual meaning (``insert a newline'') if it's a situation where you
11870 might want to insert new lines into the editing buffer.
11871
11872 When you finish editing, the Calculator parses the lines of text in
11873 the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer as numbers or formulas, replaces the
11874 original stack elements in the original buffer with these new values,
11875 then kills the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer. The original Calculator buffer
11876 continues to exist during editing, but for best results you should be
11877 careful not to change it until you have finished the edit. You can
11878 also cancel the edit by killing the buffer with @kbd{C-x k}.
11879
11880 The formula is normally reevaluated as it is put onto the stack.
11881 For example, editing @samp{a + 2} to @samp{3 + 2} and pressing
11882 @kbd{C-c C-c} will push 5 on the stack. If you use @key{LFD} to
11883 finish, Calc will put the result on the stack without evaluating it.
11884
11885 If you give a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-c},
11886 Calc will not kill the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer. You can switch
11887 back to that buffer and continue editing if you wish. However, you
11888 should understand that if you initiated the edit with @kbd{`}, the
11889 @kbd{C-c C-c} operation will be programmed to replace the top of the
11890 stack with the new edited value, and it will do this even if you have
11891 rearranged the stack in the meanwhile. This is not so much of a problem
11892 with other editing commands, though, such as @kbd{s e}
11893 (@code{calc-edit-variable}; @pxref{Operations on Variables}).
11894
11895 If the @code{calc-edit} command involves more than one stack entry,
11896 each line of the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer is interpreted as a
11897 separate formula. Otherwise, the entire buffer is interpreted as
11898 one formula, with line breaks ignored. (You can use @kbd{C-o} or
11899 @kbd{C-q C-j} to insert a newline in the buffer without pressing @key{RET}.)
11900
11901 The @kbd{`} key also works during numeric or algebraic entry. The
11902 text entered so far is moved to the @code{*Calc Edit*} buffer for
11903 more extensive editing than is convenient in the minibuffer.
11904
11905 @node Trail Commands, Keep Arguments, Editing Stack Entries, Stack and Trail
11906 @section Trail Commands
11907
11908 @noindent
11909 @cindex Trail buffer
11910 The commands for manipulating the Calc Trail buffer are two-key sequences
11911 beginning with the @kbd{t} prefix.
11912
11913 @kindex t d
11914 @pindex calc-trail-display
11915 The @kbd{t d} (@code{calc-trail-display}) command turns display of the
11916 trail on and off. Normally the trail display is toggled on if it was off,
11917 off if it was on. With a numeric prefix of zero, this command always
11918 turns the trail off; with a prefix of one, it always turns the trail on.
11919 The other trail-manipulation commands described here automatically turn
11920 the trail on. Note that when the trail is off values are still recorded
11921 there; they are simply not displayed. To set Emacs to turn the trail
11922 off by default, type @kbd{t d} and then save the mode settings with
11923 @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes}).
11924
11925 @kindex t i
11926 @pindex calc-trail-in
11927 @kindex t o
11928 @pindex calc-trail-out
11929 The @kbd{t i} (@code{calc-trail-in}) and @kbd{t o}
11930 (@code{calc-trail-out}) commands switch the cursor into and out of the
11931 Calc Trail window. In practice they are rarely used, since the commands
11932 shown below are a more convenient way to move around in the
11933 trail, and they work ``by remote control'' when the cursor is still
11934 in the Calculator window.
11935
11936 @cindex Trail pointer
11937 There is a @dfn{trail pointer} which selects some entry of the trail at
11938 any given time. The trail pointer looks like a @samp{>} symbol right
11939 before the selected number. The following commands operate on the
11940 trail pointer in various ways.
11941
11942 @kindex t y
11943 @pindex calc-trail-yank
11944 @cindex Retrieving previous results
11945 The @kbd{t y} (@code{calc-trail-yank}) command reads the selected value in
11946 the trail and pushes it onto the Calculator stack. It allows you to
11947 re-use any previously computed value without retyping. With a numeric
11948 prefix argument @var{n}, it yanks the value @var{n} lines above the current
11949 trail pointer.
11950
11951 @kindex t <
11952 @pindex calc-trail-scroll-left
11953 @kindex t >
11954 @pindex calc-trail-scroll-right
11955 The @kbd{t <} (@code{calc-trail-scroll-left}) and @kbd{t >}
11956 (@code{calc-trail-scroll-right}) commands horizontally scroll the trail
11957 window left or right by one half of its width.
11958
11959 @kindex t n
11960 @pindex calc-trail-next
11961 @kindex t p
11962 @pindex calc-trail-previous
11963 @kindex t f
11964 @pindex calc-trail-forward
11965 @kindex t b
11966 @pindex calc-trail-backward
11967 The @kbd{t n} (@code{calc-trail-next}) and @kbd{t p}
11968 (@code{calc-trail-previous)} commands move the trail pointer down or up
11969 one line. The @kbd{t f} (@code{calc-trail-forward}) and @kbd{t b}
11970 (@code{calc-trail-backward}) commands move the trail pointer down or up
11971 one screenful at a time. All of these commands accept numeric prefix
11972 arguments to move several lines or screenfuls at a time.
11973
11974 @kindex t [
11975 @pindex calc-trail-first
11976 @kindex t ]
11977 @pindex calc-trail-last
11978 @kindex t h
11979 @pindex calc-trail-here
11980 The @kbd{t [} (@code{calc-trail-first}) and @kbd{t ]}
11981 (@code{calc-trail-last}) commands move the trail pointer to the first or
11982 last line of the trail. The @kbd{t h} (@code{calc-trail-here}) command
11983 moves the trail pointer to the cursor position; unlike the other trail
11984 commands, @kbd{t h} works only when Calc Trail is the selected window.
11985
11986 @kindex t s
11987 @pindex calc-trail-isearch-forward
11988 @kindex t r
11989 @pindex calc-trail-isearch-backward
11990 @ifnottex
11991 The @kbd{t s} (@code{calc-trail-isearch-forward}) and @kbd{t r}
11992 (@code{calc-trail-isearch-backward}) commands perform an incremental
11993 search forward or backward through the trail. You can press @key{RET}
11994 to terminate the search; the trail pointer moves to the current line.
11995 If you cancel the search with @kbd{C-g}, the trail pointer stays where
11996 it was when the search began.
11997 @end ifnottex
11998 @tex
11999 The @kbd{t s} (@code{calc-trail-isearch-forward}) and @kbd{t r}
12000 (@code{calc-trail-isearch-backward}) com\-mands perform an incremental
12001 search forward or backward through the trail. You can press @key{RET}
12002 to terminate the search; the trail pointer moves to the current line.
12003 If you cancel the search with @kbd{C-g}, the trail pointer stays where
12004 it was when the search began.
12005 @end tex
12006
12007 @kindex t m
12008 @pindex calc-trail-marker
12009 The @kbd{t m} (@code{calc-trail-marker}) command allows you to enter a
12010 line of text of your own choosing into the trail. The text is inserted
12011 after the line containing the trail pointer; this usually means it is
12012 added to the end of the trail. Trail markers are useful mainly as the
12013 targets for later incremental searches in the trail.
12014
12015 @kindex t k
12016 @pindex calc-trail-kill
12017 The @kbd{t k} (@code{calc-trail-kill}) command removes the selected line
12018 from the trail. The line is saved in the Emacs kill ring suitable for
12019 yanking into another buffer, but it is not easy to yank the text back
12020 into the trail buffer. With a numeric prefix argument, this command
12021 kills the @var{n} lines below or above the selected one.
12022
12023 The @kbd{t .} (@code{calc-full-trail-vectors}) command is described
12024 elsewhere; @pxref{Vector and Matrix Formats}.
12025
12026 @node Keep Arguments, , Trail Commands, Stack and Trail
12027 @section Keep Arguments
12028
12029 @noindent
12030 @kindex K
12031 @pindex calc-keep-args
12032 The @kbd{K} (@code{calc-keep-args}) command acts like a prefix for
12033 the following command. It prevents that command from removing its
12034 arguments from the stack. For example, after @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 +},
12035 the stack contains the sole number 5, but after @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 K +},
12036 the stack contains the arguments and the result: @samp{2 3 5}.
12037
12038 With the exception of keyboard macros, this works for all commands that
12039 take arguments off the stack. (To avoid potentially unpleasant behavior,
12040 a @kbd{K} prefix before a keyboard macro will be ignored. A @kbd{K}
12041 prefix called @emph{within} the keyboard macro will still take effect.)
12042 As another example, @kbd{K a s} simplifies a formula, pushing the
12043 simplified version of the formula onto the stack after the original
12044 formula (rather than replacing the original formula). Note that you
12045 could get the same effect by typing @kbd{@key{RET} a s}, copying the
12046 formula and then simplifying the copy. One difference is that for a very
12047 large formula the time taken to format the intermediate copy in
12048 @kbd{@key{RET} a s} could be noticeable; @kbd{K a s} would avoid this
12049 extra work.
12050
12051 Even stack manipulation commands are affected. @key{TAB} works by
12052 popping two values and pushing them back in the opposite order,
12053 so @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 K @key{TAB}} produces @samp{2 3 3 2}.
12054
12055 A few Calc commands provide other ways of doing the same thing.
12056 For example, @kbd{' sin($)} replaces the number on the stack with
12057 its sine using algebraic entry; to push the sine and keep the
12058 original argument you could use either @kbd{' sin($1)} or
12059 @kbd{K ' sin($)}. @xref{Algebraic Entry}. Also, the @kbd{s s}
12060 command is effectively the same as @kbd{K s t}. @xref{Storing Variables}.
12061
12062 If you execute a command and then decide you really wanted to keep
12063 the argument, you can press @kbd{M-@key{RET}} (@code{calc-last-args}).
12064 This command pushes the last arguments that were popped by any command
12065 onto the stack. Note that the order of things on the stack will be
12066 different than with @kbd{K}: @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 + M-@key{RET}} leaves
12067 @samp{5 2 3} on the stack instead of @samp{2 3 5}. @xref{Undo}.
12068
12069 @node Mode Settings, Arithmetic, Stack and Trail, Top
12070 @chapter Mode Settings
12071
12072 @noindent
12073 This chapter describes commands that set modes in the Calculator.
12074 They do not affect the contents of the stack, although they may change
12075 the @emph{appearance} or @emph{interpretation} of the stack's contents.
12076
12077 @menu
12078 * General Mode Commands::
12079 * Precision::
12080 * Inverse and Hyperbolic::
12081 * Calculation Modes::
12082 * Simplification Modes::
12083 * Declarations::
12084 * Display Modes::
12085 * Language Modes::
12086 * Modes Variable::
12087 * Calc Mode Line::
12088 @end menu
12089
12090 @node General Mode Commands, Precision, Mode Settings, Mode Settings
12091 @section General Mode Commands
12092
12093 @noindent
12094 @kindex m m
12095 @pindex calc-save-modes
12096 @cindex Continuous memory
12097 @cindex Saving mode settings
12098 @cindex Permanent mode settings
12099 @cindex Calc init file, mode settings
12100 You can save all of the current mode settings in your Calc init file
12101 (the file given by the variable @code{calc-settings-file}, typically
12102 @file{~/.calc.el}) with the @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes}) command.
12103 This will cause Emacs to reestablish these modes each time it starts up.
12104 The modes saved in the file include everything controlled by the @kbd{m}
12105 and @kbd{d} prefix keys, the current precision and binary word size,
12106 whether or not the trail is displayed, the current height of the Calc
12107 window, and more. The current interface (used when you type @kbd{C-x * *})
12108 is also saved. If there were already saved mode settings in the
12109 file, they are replaced. Otherwise, the new mode information is
12110 appended to the end of the file.
12111
12112 @kindex m R
12113 @pindex calc-mode-record-mode
12114 The @kbd{m R} (@code{calc-mode-record-mode}) command tells Calc to
12115 record all the mode settings (as if by pressing @kbd{m m}) every
12116 time a mode setting changes. If the modes are saved this way, then this
12117 ``automatic mode recording'' mode is also saved.
12118 Type @kbd{m R} again to disable this method of recording the mode
12119 settings. To turn it off permanently, the @kbd{m m} command will also be
12120 necessary. (If Embedded mode is enabled, other options for recording
12121 the modes are available; @pxref{Mode Settings in Embedded Mode}.)
12122
12123 @kindex m F
12124 @pindex calc-settings-file-name
12125 The @kbd{m F} (@code{calc-settings-file-name}) command allows you to
12126 choose a different file than the current value of @code{calc-settings-file}
12127 for @kbd{m m}, @kbd{Z P}, and similar commands to save permanent information.
12128 You are prompted for a file name. All Calc modes are then reset to
12129 their default values, then settings from the file you named are loaded
12130 if this file exists, and this file becomes the one that Calc will
12131 use in the future for commands like @kbd{m m}. The default settings
12132 file name is @file{~/.calc.el}. You can see the current file name by
12133 giving a blank response to the @kbd{m F} prompt. See also the
12134 discussion of the @code{calc-settings-file} variable; @pxref{Customizing Calc}.
12135
12136 If the file name you give is your user init file (typically
12137 @file{~/.emacs}), @kbd{m F} will not automatically load the new file. This
12138 is because your user init file may contain other things you don't want
12139 to reread. You can give
12140 a numeric prefix argument of 1 to @kbd{m F} to force it to read the
12141 file no matter what. Conversely, an argument of @mathit{-1} tells
12142 @kbd{m F} @emph{not} to read the new file. An argument of 2 or @mathit{-2}
12143 tells @kbd{m F} not to reset the modes to their defaults beforehand,
12144 which is useful if you intend your new file to have a variant of the
12145 modes present in the file you were using before.
12146
12147 @kindex m x
12148 @pindex calc-always-load-extensions
12149 The @kbd{m x} (@code{calc-always-load-extensions}) command enables a mode
12150 in which the first use of Calc loads the entire program, including all
12151 extensions modules. Otherwise, the extensions modules will not be loaded
12152 until the various advanced Calc features are used. Since this mode only
12153 has effect when Calc is first loaded, @kbd{m x} is usually followed by
12154 @kbd{m m} to make the mode-setting permanent. To load all of Calc just
12155 once, rather than always in the future, you can press @kbd{C-x * L}.
12156
12157 @kindex m S
12158 @pindex calc-shift-prefix
12159 The @kbd{m S} (@code{calc-shift-prefix}) command enables a mode in which
12160 all of Calc's letter prefix keys may be typed shifted as well as unshifted.
12161 If you are typing, say, @kbd{a S} (@code{calc-solve-for}) quite often
12162 you might find it easier to turn this mode on so that you can type
12163 @kbd{A S} instead. When this mode is enabled, the commands that used to
12164 be on those single shifted letters (e.g., @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs})) can
12165 now be invoked by pressing the shifted letter twice: @kbd{A A}. Note
12166 that the @kbd{v} prefix key always works both shifted and unshifted, and
12167 the @kbd{z} and @kbd{Z} prefix keys are always distinct. Also, the @kbd{h}
12168 prefix is not affected by this mode. Press @kbd{m S} again to disable
12169 shifted-prefix mode.
12170
12171 @node Precision, Inverse and Hyperbolic, General Mode Commands, Mode Settings
12172 @section Precision
12173
12174 @noindent
12175 @kindex p
12176 @pindex calc-precision
12177 @cindex Precision of calculations
12178 The @kbd{p} (@code{calc-precision}) command controls the precision to
12179 which floating-point calculations are carried. The precision must be
12180 at least 3 digits and may be arbitrarily high, within the limits of
12181 memory and time. This affects only floats: Integer and rational
12182 calculations are always carried out with as many digits as necessary.
12183
12184 The @kbd{p} key prompts for the current precision. If you wish you
12185 can instead give the precision as a numeric prefix argument.
12186
12187 Many internal calculations are carried to one or two digits higher
12188 precision than normal. Results are rounded down afterward to the
12189 current precision. Unless a special display mode has been selected,
12190 floats are always displayed with their full stored precision, i.e.,
12191 what you see is what you get. Reducing the current precision does not
12192 round values already on the stack, but those values will be rounded
12193 down before being used in any calculation. The @kbd{c 0} through
12194 @kbd{c 9} commands (@pxref{Conversions}) can be used to round an
12195 existing value to a new precision.
12196
12197 @cindex Accuracy of calculations
12198 It is important to distinguish the concepts of @dfn{precision} and
12199 @dfn{accuracy}. In the normal usage of these words, the number
12200 123.4567 has a precision of 7 digits but an accuracy of 4 digits.
12201 The precision is the total number of digits not counting leading
12202 or trailing zeros (regardless of the position of the decimal point).
12203 The accuracy is simply the number of digits after the decimal point
12204 (again not counting trailing zeros). In Calc you control the precision,
12205 not the accuracy of computations. If you were to set the accuracy
12206 instead, then calculations like @samp{exp(100)} would generate many
12207 more digits than you would typically need, while @samp{exp(-100)} would
12208 probably round to zero! In Calc, both these computations give you
12209 exactly 12 (or the requested number of) significant digits.
12210
12211 The only Calc features that deal with accuracy instead of precision
12212 are fixed-point display mode for floats (@kbd{d f}; @pxref{Float Formats}),
12213 and the rounding functions like @code{floor} and @code{round}
12214 (@pxref{Integer Truncation}). Also, @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9}
12215 deal with both precision and accuracy depending on the magnitudes
12216 of the numbers involved.
12217
12218 If you need to work with a particular fixed accuracy (say, dollars and
12219 cents with two digits after the decimal point), one solution is to work
12220 with integers and an ``implied'' decimal point. For example, $8.99
12221 divided by 6 would be entered @kbd{899 @key{RET} 6 /}, yielding 149.833
12222 (actually $1.49833 with our implied decimal point); pressing @kbd{R}
12223 would round this to 150 cents, i.e., $1.50.
12224
12225 @xref{Floats}, for still more on floating-point precision and related
12226 issues.
12227
12228 @node Inverse and Hyperbolic, Calculation Modes, Precision, Mode Settings
12229 @section Inverse and Hyperbolic Flags
12230
12231 @noindent
12232 @kindex I
12233 @pindex calc-inverse
12234 There is no single-key equivalent to the @code{calc-arcsin} function.
12235 Instead, you must first press @kbd{I} (@code{calc-inverse}) to set
12236 the @dfn{Inverse Flag}, then press @kbd{S} (@code{calc-sin}).
12237 The @kbd{I} key actually toggles the Inverse Flag. When this flag
12238 is set, the word @samp{Inv} appears in the mode line.
12239
12240 @kindex H
12241 @pindex calc-hyperbolic
12242 Likewise, the @kbd{H} key (@code{calc-hyperbolic}) sets or clears the
12243 Hyperbolic Flag, which transforms @code{calc-sin} into @code{calc-sinh}.
12244 If both of these flags are set at once, the effect will be
12245 @code{calc-arcsinh}. (The Hyperbolic flag is also used by some
12246 non-trigonometric commands; for example @kbd{H L} computes a base-10,
12247 instead of base-@mathit{e}, logarithm.)
12248
12249 Command names like @code{calc-arcsin} are provided for completeness, and
12250 may be executed with @kbd{x} or @kbd{M-x}. Their effect is simply to
12251 toggle the Inverse and/or Hyperbolic flags and then execute the
12252 corresponding base command (@code{calc-sin} in this case).
12253
12254 The Inverse and Hyperbolic flags apply only to the next Calculator
12255 command, after which they are automatically cleared. (They are also
12256 cleared if the next keystroke is not a Calc command.) Digits you
12257 type after @kbd{I} or @kbd{H} (or @kbd{K}) are treated as prefix
12258 arguments for the next command, not as numeric entries. The same
12259 is true of @kbd{C-u}, but not of the minus sign (@kbd{K -} means to
12260 subtract and keep arguments).
12261
12262 The third Calc prefix flag, @kbd{K} (keep-arguments), is discussed
12263 elsewhere. @xref{Keep Arguments}.
12264
12265 @node Calculation Modes, Simplification Modes, Inverse and Hyperbolic, Mode Settings
12266 @section Calculation Modes
12267
12268 @noindent
12269 The commands in this section are two-key sequences beginning with
12270 the @kbd{m} prefix. (That's the letter @kbd{m}, not the @key{META} key.)
12271 The @samp{m a} (@code{calc-algebraic-mode}) command is described elsewhere
12272 (@pxref{Algebraic Entry}).
12273
12274 @menu
12275 * Angular Modes::
12276 * Polar Mode::
12277 * Fraction Mode::
12278 * Infinite Mode::
12279 * Symbolic Mode::
12280 * Matrix Mode::
12281 * Automatic Recomputation::
12282 * Working Message::
12283 @end menu
12284
12285 @node Angular Modes, Polar Mode, Calculation Modes, Calculation Modes
12286 @subsection Angular Modes
12287
12288 @noindent
12289 @cindex Angular mode
12290 The Calculator supports three notations for angles: radians, degrees,
12291 and degrees-minutes-seconds. When a number is presented to a function
12292 like @code{sin} that requires an angle, the current angular mode is
12293 used to interpret the number as either radians or degrees. If an HMS
12294 form is presented to @code{sin}, it is always interpreted as
12295 degrees-minutes-seconds.
12296
12297 Functions that compute angles produce a number in radians, a number in
12298 degrees, or an HMS form depending on the current angular mode. If the
12299 result is a complex number and the current mode is HMS, the number is
12300 instead expressed in degrees. (Complex-number calculations would
12301 normally be done in Radians mode, though. Complex numbers are converted
12302 to degrees by calculating the complex result in radians and then
12303 multiplying by 180 over @cpi{}.)
12304
12305 @kindex m r
12306 @pindex calc-radians-mode
12307 @kindex m d
12308 @pindex calc-degrees-mode
12309 @kindex m h
12310 @pindex calc-hms-mode
12311 The @kbd{m r} (@code{calc-radians-mode}), @kbd{m d} (@code{calc-degrees-mode}),
12312 and @kbd{m h} (@code{calc-hms-mode}) commands control the angular mode.
12313 The current angular mode is displayed on the Emacs mode line.
12314 The default angular mode is Degrees.
12315
12316 @node Polar Mode, Fraction Mode, Angular Modes, Calculation Modes
12317 @subsection Polar Mode
12318
12319 @noindent
12320 @cindex Polar mode
12321 The Calculator normally ``prefers'' rectangular complex numbers in the
12322 sense that rectangular form is used when the proper form can not be
12323 decided from the input. This might happen by multiplying a rectangular
12324 number by a polar one, by taking the square root of a negative real
12325 number, or by entering @kbd{( 2 @key{SPC} 3 )}.
12326
12327 @kindex m p
12328 @pindex calc-polar-mode
12329 The @kbd{m p} (@code{calc-polar-mode}) command toggles complex-number
12330 preference between rectangular and polar forms. In Polar mode, all
12331 of the above example situations would produce polar complex numbers.
12332
12333 @node Fraction Mode, Infinite Mode, Polar Mode, Calculation Modes
12334 @subsection Fraction Mode
12335
12336 @noindent
12337 @cindex Fraction mode
12338 @cindex Division of integers
12339 Division of two integers normally yields a floating-point number if the
12340 result cannot be expressed as an integer. In some cases you would
12341 rather get an exact fractional answer. One way to accomplish this is
12342 to use the @kbd{:} (@code{calc-fdiv}) [@code{fdiv}] command, which
12343 divides the two integers on the top of the stack to produce a fraction:
12344 @kbd{6 @key{RET} 4 :} produces @expr{3:2} even though
12345 @kbd{6 @key{RET} 4 /} produces @expr{1.5}.
12346
12347 @kindex m f
12348 @pindex calc-frac-mode
12349 To set the Calculator to produce fractional results for normal integer
12350 divisions, use the @kbd{m f} (@code{calc-frac-mode}) command.
12351 For example, @expr{8/4} produces @expr{2} in either mode,
12352 but @expr{6/4} produces @expr{3:2} in Fraction mode, @expr{1.5} in
12353 Float mode.
12354
12355 At any time you can use @kbd{c f} (@code{calc-float}) to convert a
12356 fraction to a float, or @kbd{c F} (@code{calc-fraction}) to convert a
12357 float to a fraction. @xref{Conversions}.
12358
12359 @node Infinite Mode, Symbolic Mode, Fraction Mode, Calculation Modes
12360 @subsection Infinite Mode
12361
12362 @noindent
12363 @cindex Infinite mode
12364 The Calculator normally treats results like @expr{1 / 0} as errors;
12365 formulas like this are left in unsimplified form. But Calc can be
12366 put into a mode where such calculations instead produce ``infinite''
12367 results.
12368
12369 @kindex m i
12370 @pindex calc-infinite-mode
12371 The @kbd{m i} (@code{calc-infinite-mode}) command turns this mode
12372 on and off. When the mode is off, infinities do not arise except
12373 in calculations that already had infinities as inputs. (One exception
12374 is that infinite open intervals like @samp{[0 .. inf)} can be
12375 generated; however, intervals closed at infinity (@samp{[0 .. inf]})
12376 will not be generated when Infinite mode is off.)
12377
12378 With Infinite mode turned on, @samp{1 / 0} will generate @code{uinf},
12379 an undirected infinity. @xref{Infinities}, for a discussion of the
12380 difference between @code{inf} and @code{uinf}. Also, @expr{0 / 0}
12381 evaluates to @code{nan}, the ``indeterminate'' symbol. Various other
12382 functions can also return infinities in this mode; for example,
12383 @samp{ln(0) = -inf}, and @samp{gamma(-7) = uinf}. Once again,
12384 note that @samp{exp(inf) = inf} regardless of Infinite mode because
12385 this calculation has infinity as an input.
12386
12387 @cindex Positive Infinite mode
12388 The @kbd{m i} command with a numeric prefix argument of zero,
12389 i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 m i}, turns on a Positive Infinite mode in
12390 which zero is treated as positive instead of being directionless.
12391 Thus, @samp{1 / 0 = inf} and @samp{-1 / 0 = -inf} in this mode.
12392 Note that zero never actually has a sign in Calc; there are no
12393 separate representations for @mathit{+0} and @mathit{-0}. Positive
12394 Infinite mode merely changes the interpretation given to the
12395 single symbol, @samp{0}. One consequence of this is that, while
12396 you might expect @samp{1 / -0 = -inf}, actually @samp{1 / -0}
12397 is equivalent to @samp{1 / 0}, which is equal to positive @code{inf}.
12398
12399 @node Symbolic Mode, Matrix Mode, Infinite Mode, Calculation Modes
12400 @subsection Symbolic Mode
12401
12402 @noindent
12403 @cindex Symbolic mode
12404 @cindex Inexact results
12405 Calculations are normally performed numerically wherever possible.
12406 For example, the @code{calc-sqrt} command, or @code{sqrt} function in an
12407 algebraic expression, produces a numeric answer if the argument is a
12408 number or a symbolic expression if the argument is an expression:
12409 @kbd{2 Q} pushes 1.4142 but @kbd{@key{'} x+1 @key{RET} Q} pushes @samp{sqrt(x+1)}.
12410
12411 @kindex m s
12412 @pindex calc-symbolic-mode
12413 In @dfn{Symbolic mode}, controlled by the @kbd{m s} (@code{calc-symbolic-mode})
12414 command, functions which would produce inexact, irrational results are
12415 left in symbolic form. Thus @kbd{16 Q} pushes 4, but @kbd{2 Q} pushes
12416 @samp{sqrt(2)}.
12417
12418 @kindex N
12419 @pindex calc-eval-num
12420 The shift-@kbd{N} (@code{calc-eval-num}) command evaluates numerically
12421 the expression at the top of the stack, by temporarily disabling
12422 @code{calc-symbolic-mode} and executing @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}).
12423 Given a numeric prefix argument, it also
12424 sets the floating-point precision to the specified value for the duration
12425 of the command.
12426
12427 To evaluate a formula numerically without expanding the variables it
12428 contains, you can use the key sequence @kbd{m s a v m s} (this uses
12429 @code{calc-alg-evaluate}, which resimplifies but doesn't evaluate
12430 variables.)
12431
12432 @node Matrix Mode, Automatic Recomputation, Symbolic Mode, Calculation Modes
12433 @subsection Matrix and Scalar Modes
12434
12435 @noindent
12436 @cindex Matrix mode
12437 @cindex Scalar mode
12438 Calc sometimes makes assumptions during algebraic manipulation that
12439 are awkward or incorrect when vectors and matrices are involved.
12440 Calc has two modes, @dfn{Matrix mode} and @dfn{Scalar mode}, which
12441 modify its behavior around vectors in useful ways.
12442
12443 @kindex m v
12444 @pindex calc-matrix-mode
12445 Press @kbd{m v} (@code{calc-matrix-mode}) once to enter Matrix mode.
12446 In this mode, all objects are assumed to be matrices unless provably
12447 otherwise. One major effect is that Calc will no longer consider
12448 multiplication to be commutative. (Recall that in matrix arithmetic,
12449 @samp{A*B} is not the same as @samp{B*A}.) This assumption affects
12450 rewrite rules and algebraic simplification. Another effect of this
12451 mode is that calculations that would normally produce constants like
12452 0 and 1 (e.g., @expr{a - a} and @expr{a / a}, respectively) will now
12453 produce function calls that represent ``generic'' zero or identity
12454 matrices: @samp{idn(0)}, @samp{idn(1)}. The @code{idn} function
12455 @samp{idn(@var{a},@var{n})} returns @var{a} times an @var{n}x@var{n}
12456 identity matrix; if @var{n} is omitted, it doesn't know what
12457 dimension to use and so the @code{idn} call remains in symbolic
12458 form. However, if this generic identity matrix is later combined
12459 with a matrix whose size is known, it will be converted into
12460 a true identity matrix of the appropriate size. On the other hand,
12461 if it is combined with a scalar (as in @samp{idn(1) + 2}), Calc
12462 will assume it really was a scalar after all and produce, e.g., 3.
12463
12464 Press @kbd{m v} a second time to get Scalar mode. Here, objects are
12465 assumed @emph{not} to be vectors or matrices unless provably so.
12466 For example, normally adding a variable to a vector, as in
12467 @samp{[x, y, z] + a}, will leave the sum in symbolic form because
12468 as far as Calc knows, @samp{a} could represent either a number or
12469 another 3-vector. In Scalar mode, @samp{a} is assumed to be a
12470 non-vector, and the addition is evaluated to @samp{[x+a, y+a, z+a]}.
12471
12472 Press @kbd{m v} a third time to return to the normal mode of operation.
12473
12474 If you press @kbd{m v} with a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, you
12475 get a special ``dimensioned'' Matrix mode in which matrices of
12476 unknown size are assumed to be @var{n}x@var{n} square matrices.
12477 Then, the function call @samp{idn(1)} will expand into an actual
12478 matrix rather than representing a ``generic'' matrix. Simply typing
12479 @kbd{C-u m v} will get you a square Matrix mode, in which matrices of
12480 unknown size are assumed to be square matrices of unspecified size.
12481
12482 @cindex Declaring scalar variables
12483 Of course these modes are approximations to the true state of
12484 affairs, which is probably that some quantities will be matrices
12485 and others will be scalars. One solution is to ``declare''
12486 certain variables or functions to be scalar-valued.
12487 @xref{Declarations}, to see how to make declarations in Calc.
12488
12489 There is nothing stopping you from declaring a variable to be
12490 scalar and then storing a matrix in it; however, if you do, the
12491 results you get from Calc may not be valid. Suppose you let Calc
12492 get the result @samp{[x+a, y+a, z+a]} shown above, and then stored
12493 @samp{[1, 2, 3]} in @samp{a}. The result would not be the same as
12494 for @samp{[x, y, z] + [1, 2, 3]}, but that's because you have broken
12495 your earlier promise to Calc that @samp{a} would be scalar.
12496
12497 Another way to mix scalars and matrices is to use selections
12498 (@pxref{Selecting Subformulas}). Use Matrix mode when operating on
12499 your formula normally; then, to apply Scalar mode to a certain part
12500 of the formula without affecting the rest just select that part,
12501 change into Scalar mode and press @kbd{=} to resimplify the part
12502 under this mode, then change back to Matrix mode before deselecting.
12503
12504 @node Automatic Recomputation, Working Message, Matrix Mode, Calculation Modes
12505 @subsection Automatic Recomputation
12506
12507 @noindent
12508 The @dfn{evaluates-to} operator, @samp{=>}, has the special
12509 property that any @samp{=>} formulas on the stack are recomputed
12510 whenever variable values or mode settings that might affect them
12511 are changed. @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}.
12512
12513 @kindex m C
12514 @pindex calc-auto-recompute
12515 The @kbd{m C} (@code{calc-auto-recompute}) command turns this
12516 automatic recomputation on and off. If you turn it off, Calc will
12517 not update @samp{=>} operators on the stack (nor those in the
12518 attached Embedded mode buffer, if there is one). They will not
12519 be updated unless you explicitly do so by pressing @kbd{=} or until
12520 you press @kbd{m C} to turn recomputation back on. (While automatic
12521 recomputation is off, you can think of @kbd{m C m C} as a command
12522 to update all @samp{=>} operators while leaving recomputation off.)
12523
12524 To update @samp{=>} operators in an Embedded buffer while
12525 automatic recomputation is off, use @w{@kbd{C-x * u}}.
12526 @xref{Embedded Mode}.
12527
12528 @node Working Message, , Automatic Recomputation, Calculation Modes
12529 @subsection Working Messages
12530
12531 @noindent
12532 @cindex Performance
12533 @cindex Working messages
12534 Since the Calculator is written entirely in Emacs Lisp, which is not
12535 designed for heavy numerical work, many operations are quite slow.
12536 The Calculator normally displays the message @samp{Working...} in the
12537 echo area during any command that may be slow. In addition, iterative
12538 operations such as square roots and trigonometric functions display the
12539 intermediate result at each step. Both of these types of messages can
12540 be disabled if you find them distracting.
12541
12542 @kindex m w
12543 @pindex calc-working
12544 Type @kbd{m w} (@code{calc-working}) with a numeric prefix of 0 to
12545 disable all ``working'' messages. Use a numeric prefix of 1 to enable
12546 only the plain @samp{Working...} message. Use a numeric prefix of 2 to
12547 see intermediate results as well. With no numeric prefix this displays
12548 the current mode.
12549
12550 While it may seem that the ``working'' messages will slow Calc down
12551 considerably, experiments have shown that their impact is actually
12552 quite small. But if your terminal is slow you may find that it helps
12553 to turn the messages off.
12554
12555 @node Simplification Modes, Declarations, Calculation Modes, Mode Settings
12556 @section Simplification Modes
12557
12558 @noindent
12559 The current @dfn{simplification mode} controls how numbers and formulas
12560 are ``normalized'' when being taken from or pushed onto the stack.
12561 Some normalizations are unavoidable, such as rounding floating-point
12562 results to the current precision, and reducing fractions to simplest
12563 form. Others, such as simplifying a formula like @expr{a+a} (or @expr{2+3}),
12564 are done by default but can be turned off when necessary.
12565
12566 When you press a key like @kbd{+} when @expr{2} and @expr{3} are on the
12567 stack, Calc pops these numbers, normalizes them, creates the formula
12568 @expr{2+3}, normalizes it, and pushes the result. Of course the standard
12569 rules for normalizing @expr{2+3} will produce the result @expr{5}.
12570
12571 Simplification mode commands consist of the lower-case @kbd{m} prefix key
12572 followed by a shifted letter.
12573
12574 @kindex m O
12575 @pindex calc-no-simplify-mode
12576 The @kbd{m O} (@code{calc-no-simplify-mode}) command turns off all optional
12577 simplifications. These would leave a formula like @expr{2+3} alone. In
12578 fact, nothing except simple numbers are ever affected by normalization
12579 in this mode.
12580
12581 @kindex m N
12582 @pindex calc-num-simplify-mode
12583 The @kbd{m N} (@code{calc-num-simplify-mode}) command turns off simplification
12584 of any formulas except those for which all arguments are constants. For
12585 example, @expr{1+2} is simplified to @expr{3}, and @expr{a+(2-2)} is
12586 simplified to @expr{a+0} but no further, since one argument of the sum
12587 is not a constant. Unfortunately, @expr{(a+2)-2} is @emph{not} simplified
12588 because the top-level @samp{-} operator's arguments are not both
12589 constant numbers (one of them is the formula @expr{a+2}).
12590 A constant is a number or other numeric object (such as a constant
12591 error form or modulo form), or a vector all of whose
12592 elements are constant.
12593
12594 @kindex m D
12595 @pindex calc-default-simplify-mode
12596 The @kbd{m D} (@code{calc-default-simplify-mode}) command restores the
12597 default simplifications for all formulas. This includes many easy and
12598 fast algebraic simplifications such as @expr{a+0} to @expr{a}, and
12599 @expr{a + 2 a} to @expr{3 a}, as well as evaluating functions like
12600 @expr{@tfn{deriv}(x^2, x)} to @expr{2 x}.
12601
12602 @kindex m B
12603 @pindex calc-bin-simplify-mode
12604 The @kbd{m B} (@code{calc-bin-simplify-mode}) mode applies the default
12605 simplifications to a result and then, if the result is an integer,
12606 uses the @kbd{b c} (@code{calc-clip}) command to clip the integer according
12607 to the current binary word size. @xref{Binary Functions}. Real numbers
12608 are rounded to the nearest integer and then clipped; other kinds of
12609 results (after the default simplifications) are left alone.
12610
12611 @kindex m A
12612 @pindex calc-alg-simplify-mode
12613 The @kbd{m A} (@code{calc-alg-simplify-mode}) mode does algebraic
12614 simplification; it applies all the default simplifications, and also
12615 the more powerful (and slower) simplifications made by @kbd{a s}
12616 (@code{calc-simplify}). @xref{Algebraic Simplifications}.
12617
12618 @kindex m E
12619 @pindex calc-ext-simplify-mode
12620 The @kbd{m E} (@code{calc-ext-simplify-mode}) mode does ``extended''
12621 algebraic simplification, as by the @kbd{a e} (@code{calc-simplify-extended})
12622 command. @xref{Unsafe Simplifications}.
12623
12624 @kindex m U
12625 @pindex calc-units-simplify-mode
12626 The @kbd{m U} (@code{calc-units-simplify-mode}) mode does units
12627 simplification; it applies the command @kbd{u s}
12628 (@code{calc-simplify-units}), which in turn
12629 is a superset of @kbd{a s}. In this mode, variable names which
12630 are identifiable as unit names (like @samp{mm} for ``millimeters'')
12631 are simplified with their unit definitions in mind.
12632
12633 A common technique is to set the simplification mode down to the lowest
12634 amount of simplification you will allow to be applied automatically, then
12635 use manual commands like @kbd{a s} and @kbd{c c} (@code{calc-clean}) to
12636 perform higher types of simplifications on demand. @xref{Algebraic
12637 Definitions}, for another sample use of No-Simplification mode.
12638
12639 @node Declarations, Display Modes, Simplification Modes, Mode Settings
12640 @section Declarations
12641
12642 @noindent
12643 A @dfn{declaration} is a statement you make that promises you will
12644 use a certain variable or function in a restricted way. This may
12645 give Calc the freedom to do things that it couldn't do if it had to
12646 take the fully general situation into account.
12647
12648 @menu
12649 * Declaration Basics::
12650 * Kinds of Declarations::
12651 * Functions for Declarations::
12652 @end menu
12653
12654 @node Declaration Basics, Kinds of Declarations, Declarations, Declarations
12655 @subsection Declaration Basics
12656
12657 @noindent
12658 @kindex s d
12659 @pindex calc-declare-variable
12660 The @kbd{s d} (@code{calc-declare-variable}) command is the easiest
12661 way to make a declaration for a variable. This command prompts for
12662 the variable name, then prompts for the declaration. The default
12663 at the declaration prompt is the previous declaration, if any.
12664 You can edit this declaration, or press @kbd{C-k} to erase it and
12665 type a new declaration. (Or, erase it and press @key{RET} to clear
12666 the declaration, effectively ``undeclaring'' the variable.)
12667
12668 A declaration is in general a vector of @dfn{type symbols} and
12669 @dfn{range} values. If there is only one type symbol or range value,
12670 you can write it directly rather than enclosing it in a vector.
12671 For example, @kbd{s d foo @key{RET} real @key{RET}} declares @code{foo} to
12672 be a real number, and @kbd{s d bar @key{RET} [int, const, [1..6]] @key{RET}}
12673 declares @code{bar} to be a constant integer between 1 and 6.
12674 (Actually, you can omit the outermost brackets and Calc will
12675 provide them for you: @kbd{s d bar @key{RET} int, const, [1..6] @key{RET}}.)
12676
12677 @cindex @code{Decls} variable
12678 @vindex Decls
12679 Declarations in Calc are kept in a special variable called @code{Decls}.
12680 This variable encodes the set of all outstanding declarations in
12681 the form of a matrix. Each row has two elements: A variable or
12682 vector of variables declared by that row, and the declaration
12683 specifier as described above. You can use the @kbd{s D} command to
12684 edit this variable if you wish to see all the declarations at once.
12685 @xref{Operations on Variables}, for a description of this command
12686 and the @kbd{s p} command that allows you to save your declarations
12687 permanently if you wish.
12688
12689 Items being declared can also be function calls. The arguments in
12690 the call are ignored; the effect is to say that this function returns
12691 values of the declared type for any valid arguments. The @kbd{s d}
12692 command declares only variables, so if you wish to make a function
12693 declaration you will have to edit the @code{Decls} matrix yourself.
12694
12695 For example, the declaration matrix
12696
12697 @smallexample
12698 @group
12699 [ [ foo, real ]
12700 [ [j, k, n], int ]
12701 [ f(1,2,3), [0 .. inf) ] ]
12702 @end group
12703 @end smallexample
12704
12705 @noindent
12706 declares that @code{foo} represents a real number, @code{j}, @code{k}
12707 and @code{n} represent integers, and the function @code{f} always
12708 returns a real number in the interval shown.
12709
12710 @vindex All
12711 If there is a declaration for the variable @code{All}, then that
12712 declaration applies to all variables that are not otherwise declared.
12713 It does not apply to function names. For example, using the row
12714 @samp{[All, real]} says that all your variables are real unless they
12715 are explicitly declared without @code{real} in some other row.
12716 The @kbd{s d} command declares @code{All} if you give a blank
12717 response to the variable-name prompt.
12718
12719 @node Kinds of Declarations, Functions for Declarations, Declaration Basics, Declarations
12720 @subsection Kinds of Declarations
12721
12722 @noindent
12723 The type-specifier part of a declaration (that is, the second prompt
12724 in the @kbd{s d} command) can be a type symbol, an interval, or a
12725 vector consisting of zero or more type symbols followed by zero or
12726 more intervals or numbers that represent the set of possible values
12727 for the variable.
12728
12729 @smallexample
12730 @group
12731 [ [ a, [1, 2, 3, 4, 5] ]
12732 [ b, [1 .. 5] ]
12733 [ c, [int, 1 .. 5] ] ]
12734 @end group
12735 @end smallexample
12736
12737 Here @code{a} is declared to contain one of the five integers shown;
12738 @code{b} is any number in the interval from 1 to 5 (any real number
12739 since we haven't specified), and @code{c} is any integer in that
12740 interval. Thus the declarations for @code{a} and @code{c} are
12741 nearly equivalent (see below).
12742
12743 The type-specifier can be the empty vector @samp{[]} to say that
12744 nothing is known about a given variable's value. This is the same
12745 as not declaring the variable at all except that it overrides any
12746 @code{All} declaration which would otherwise apply.
12747
12748 The initial value of @code{Decls} is the empty vector @samp{[]}.
12749 If @code{Decls} has no stored value or if the value stored in it
12750 is not valid, it is ignored and there are no declarations as far
12751 as Calc is concerned. (The @kbd{s d} command will replace such a
12752 malformed value with a fresh empty matrix, @samp{[]}, before recording
12753 the new declaration.) Unrecognized type symbols are ignored.
12754
12755 The following type symbols describe what sorts of numbers will be
12756 stored in a variable:
12757
12758 @table @code
12759 @item int
12760 Integers.
12761 @item numint
12762 Numerical integers. (Integers or integer-valued floats.)
12763 @item frac
12764 Fractions. (Rational numbers which are not integers.)
12765 @item rat
12766 Rational numbers. (Either integers or fractions.)
12767 @item float
12768 Floating-point numbers.
12769 @item real
12770 Real numbers. (Integers, fractions, or floats. Actually,
12771 intervals and error forms with real components also count as
12772 reals here.)
12773 @item pos
12774 Positive real numbers. (Strictly greater than zero.)
12775 @item nonneg
12776 Nonnegative real numbers. (Greater than or equal to zero.)
12777 @item number
12778 Numbers. (Real or complex.)
12779 @end table
12780
12781 Calc uses this information to determine when certain simplifications
12782 of formulas are safe. For example, @samp{(x^y)^z} cannot be
12783 simplified to @samp{x^(y z)} in general; for example,
12784 @samp{((-3)^2)^1:2} is 3, but @samp{(-3)^(2*1:2) = (-3)^1} is @mathit{-3}.
12785 However, this simplification @emph{is} safe if @code{z} is known
12786 to be an integer, or if @code{x} is known to be a nonnegative
12787 real number. If you have given declarations that allow Calc to
12788 deduce either of these facts, Calc will perform this simplification
12789 of the formula.
12790
12791 Calc can apply a certain amount of logic when using declarations.
12792 For example, @samp{(x^y)^(2n+1)} will be simplified if @code{n}
12793 has been declared @code{int}; Calc knows that an integer times an
12794 integer, plus an integer, must always be an integer. (In fact,
12795 Calc would simplify @samp{(-x)^(2n+1)} to @samp{-(x^(2n+1))} since
12796 it is able to determine that @samp{2n+1} must be an odd integer.)
12797
12798 Similarly, @samp{(abs(x)^y)^z} will be simplified to @samp{abs(x)^(y z)}
12799 because Calc knows that the @code{abs} function always returns a
12800 nonnegative real. If you had a @code{myabs} function that also had
12801 this property, you could get Calc to recognize it by adding the row
12802 @samp{[myabs(), nonneg]} to the @code{Decls} matrix.
12803
12804 One instance of this simplification is @samp{sqrt(x^2)} (since the
12805 @code{sqrt} function is effectively a one-half power). Normally
12806 Calc leaves this formula alone. After the command
12807 @kbd{s d x @key{RET} real @key{RET}}, however, it can simplify the formula to
12808 @samp{abs(x)}. And after @kbd{s d x @key{RET} nonneg @key{RET}}, Calc can
12809 simplify this formula all the way to @samp{x}.
12810
12811 If there are any intervals or real numbers in the type specifier,
12812 they comprise the set of possible values that the variable or
12813 function being declared can have. In particular, the type symbol
12814 @code{real} is effectively the same as the range @samp{[-inf .. inf]}
12815 (note that infinity is included in the range of possible values);
12816 @code{pos} is the same as @samp{(0 .. inf]}, and @code{nonneg} is
12817 the same as @samp{[0 .. inf]}. Saying @samp{[real, [-5 .. 5]]} is
12818 redundant because the fact that the variable is real can be
12819 deduced just from the interval, but @samp{[int, [-5 .. 5]]} and
12820 @samp{[rat, [-5 .. 5]]} are useful combinations.
12821
12822 Note that the vector of intervals or numbers is in the same format
12823 used by Calc's set-manipulation commands. @xref{Set Operations}.
12824
12825 The type specifier @samp{[1, 2, 3]} is equivalent to
12826 @samp{[numint, 1, 2, 3]}, @emph{not} to @samp{[int, 1, 2, 3]}.
12827 In other words, the range of possible values means only that
12828 the variable's value must be numerically equal to a number in
12829 that range, but not that it must be equal in type as well.
12830 Calc's set operations act the same way; @samp{in(2, [1., 2., 3.])}
12831 and @samp{in(1.5, [1:2, 3:2, 5:2])} both report ``true.''
12832
12833 If you use a conflicting combination of type specifiers, the
12834 results are unpredictable. An example is @samp{[pos, [0 .. 5]]},
12835 where the interval does not lie in the range described by the
12836 type symbol.
12837
12838 ``Real'' declarations mostly affect simplifications involving powers
12839 like the one described above. Another case where they are used
12840 is in the @kbd{a P} command which returns a list of all roots of a
12841 polynomial; if the variable has been declared real, only the real
12842 roots (if any) will be included in the list.
12843
12844 ``Integer'' declarations are used for simplifications which are valid
12845 only when certain values are integers (such as @samp{(x^y)^z}
12846 shown above).
12847
12848 Another command that makes use of declarations is @kbd{a s}, when
12849 simplifying equations and inequalities. It will cancel @code{x}
12850 from both sides of @samp{a x = b x} only if it is sure @code{x}
12851 is non-zero, say, because it has a @code{pos} declaration.
12852 To declare specifically that @code{x} is real and non-zero,
12853 use @samp{[[-inf .. 0), (0 .. inf]]}. (There is no way in the
12854 current notation to say that @code{x} is nonzero but not necessarily
12855 real.) The @kbd{a e} command does ``unsafe'' simplifications,
12856 including cancelling @samp{x} from the equation when @samp{x} is
12857 not known to be nonzero.
12858
12859 Another set of type symbols distinguish between scalars and vectors.
12860
12861 @table @code
12862 @item scalar
12863 The value is not a vector.
12864 @item vector
12865 The value is a vector.
12866 @item matrix
12867 The value is a matrix (a rectangular vector of vectors).
12868 @item sqmatrix
12869 The value is a square matrix.
12870 @end table
12871
12872 These type symbols can be combined with the other type symbols
12873 described above; @samp{[int, matrix]} describes an object which
12874 is a matrix of integers.
12875
12876 Scalar/vector declarations are used to determine whether certain
12877 algebraic operations are safe. For example, @samp{[a, b, c] + x}
12878 is normally not simplified to @samp{[a + x, b + x, c + x]}, but
12879 it will be if @code{x} has been declared @code{scalar}. On the
12880 other hand, multiplication is usually assumed to be commutative,
12881 but the terms in @samp{x y} will never be exchanged if both @code{x}
12882 and @code{y} are known to be vectors or matrices. (Calc currently
12883 never distinguishes between @code{vector} and @code{matrix}
12884 declarations.)
12885
12886 @xref{Matrix Mode}, for a discussion of Matrix mode and
12887 Scalar mode, which are similar to declaring @samp{[All, matrix]}
12888 or @samp{[All, scalar]} but much more convenient.
12889
12890 One more type symbol that is recognized is used with the @kbd{H a d}
12891 command for taking total derivatives of a formula. @xref{Calculus}.
12892
12893 @table @code
12894 @item const
12895 The value is a constant with respect to other variables.
12896 @end table
12897
12898 Calc does not check the declarations for a variable when you store
12899 a value in it. However, storing @mathit{-3.5} in a variable that has
12900 been declared @code{pos}, @code{int}, or @code{matrix} may have
12901 unexpected effects; Calc may evaluate @samp{sqrt(x^2)} to @expr{3.5}
12902 if it substitutes the value first, or to @expr{-3.5} if @code{x}
12903 was declared @code{pos} and the formula @samp{sqrt(x^2)} is
12904 simplified to @samp{x} before the value is substituted. Before
12905 using a variable for a new purpose, it is best to use @kbd{s d}
12906 or @kbd{s D} to check to make sure you don't still have an old
12907 declaration for the variable that will conflict with its new meaning.
12908
12909 @node Functions for Declarations, , Kinds of Declarations, Declarations
12910 @subsection Functions for Declarations
12911
12912 @noindent
12913 Calc has a set of functions for accessing the current declarations
12914 in a convenient manner. These functions return 1 if the argument
12915 can be shown to have the specified property, or 0 if the argument
12916 can be shown @emph{not} to have that property; otherwise they are
12917 left unevaluated. These functions are suitable for use with rewrite
12918 rules (@pxref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}) or programming constructs
12919 (@pxref{Conditionals in Macros}). They can be entered only using
12920 algebraic notation. @xref{Logical Operations}, for functions
12921 that perform other tests not related to declarations.
12922
12923 For example, @samp{dint(17)} returns 1 because 17 is an integer, as
12924 do @samp{dint(n)} and @samp{dint(2 n - 3)} if @code{n} has been declared
12925 @code{int}, but @samp{dint(2.5)} and @samp{dint(n + 0.5)} return 0.
12926 Calc consults knowledge of its own built-in functions as well as your
12927 own declarations: @samp{dint(floor(x))} returns 1.
12928
12929 @ignore
12930 @starindex
12931 @end ignore
12932 @tindex dint
12933 @ignore
12934 @starindex
12935 @end ignore
12936 @tindex dnumint
12937 @ignore
12938 @starindex
12939 @end ignore
12940 @tindex dnatnum
12941 The @code{dint} function checks if its argument is an integer.
12942 The @code{dnatnum} function checks if its argument is a natural
12943 number, i.e., a nonnegative integer. The @code{dnumint} function
12944 checks if its argument is numerically an integer, i.e., either an
12945 integer or an integer-valued float. Note that these and the other
12946 data type functions also accept vectors or matrices composed of
12947 suitable elements, and that real infinities @samp{inf} and @samp{-inf}
12948 are considered to be integers for the purposes of these functions.
12949
12950 @ignore
12951 @starindex
12952 @end ignore
12953 @tindex drat
12954 The @code{drat} function checks if its argument is rational, i.e.,
12955 an integer or fraction. Infinities count as rational, but intervals
12956 and error forms do not.
12957
12958 @ignore
12959 @starindex
12960 @end ignore
12961 @tindex dreal
12962 The @code{dreal} function checks if its argument is real. This
12963 includes integers, fractions, floats, real error forms, and intervals.
12964
12965 @ignore
12966 @starindex
12967 @end ignore
12968 @tindex dimag
12969 The @code{dimag} function checks if its argument is imaginary,
12970 i.e., is mathematically equal to a real number times @expr{i}.
12971
12972 @ignore
12973 @starindex
12974 @end ignore
12975 @tindex dpos
12976 @ignore
12977 @starindex
12978 @end ignore
12979 @tindex dneg
12980 @ignore
12981 @starindex
12982 @end ignore
12983 @tindex dnonneg
12984 The @code{dpos} function checks for positive (but nonzero) reals.
12985 The @code{dneg} function checks for negative reals. The @code{dnonneg}
12986 function checks for nonnegative reals, i.e., reals greater than or
12987 equal to zero. Note that the @kbd{a s} command can simplify an
12988 expression like @expr{x > 0} to 1 or 0 using @code{dpos}, and that
12989 @kbd{a s} is effectively applied to all conditions in rewrite rules,
12990 so the actual functions @code{dpos}, @code{dneg}, and @code{dnonneg}
12991 are rarely necessary.
12992
12993 @ignore
12994 @starindex
12995 @end ignore
12996 @tindex dnonzero
12997 The @code{dnonzero} function checks that its argument is nonzero.
12998 This includes all nonzero real or complex numbers, all intervals that
12999 do not include zero, all nonzero modulo forms, vectors all of whose
13000 elements are nonzero, and variables or formulas whose values can be
13001 deduced to be nonzero. It does not include error forms, since they
13002 represent values which could be anything including zero. (This is
13003 also the set of objects considered ``true'' in conditional contexts.)
13004
13005 @ignore
13006 @starindex
13007 @end ignore
13008 @tindex deven
13009 @ignore
13010 @starindex
13011 @end ignore
13012 @tindex dodd
13013 The @code{deven} function returns 1 if its argument is known to be
13014 an even integer (or integer-valued float); it returns 0 if its argument
13015 is known not to be even (because it is known to be odd or a non-integer).
13016 The @kbd{a s} command uses this to simplify a test of the form
13017 @samp{x % 2 = 0}. There is also an analogous @code{dodd} function.
13018
13019 @ignore
13020 @starindex
13021 @end ignore
13022 @tindex drange
13023 The @code{drange} function returns a set (an interval or a vector
13024 of intervals and/or numbers; @pxref{Set Operations}) that describes
13025 the set of possible values of its argument. If the argument is
13026 a variable or a function with a declaration, the range is copied
13027 from the declaration. Otherwise, the possible signs of the
13028 expression are determined using a method similar to @code{dpos},
13029 etc., and a suitable set like @samp{[0 .. inf]} is returned. If
13030 the expression is not provably real, the @code{drange} function
13031 remains unevaluated.
13032
13033 @ignore
13034 @starindex
13035 @end ignore
13036 @tindex dscalar
13037 The @code{dscalar} function returns 1 if its argument is provably
13038 scalar, or 0 if its argument is provably non-scalar. It is left
13039 unevaluated if this cannot be determined. (If Matrix mode or Scalar
13040 mode is in effect, this function returns 1 or 0, respectively,
13041 if it has no other information.) When Calc interprets a condition
13042 (say, in a rewrite rule) it considers an unevaluated formula to be
13043 ``false.'' Thus, @samp{dscalar(a)} is ``true'' only if @code{a} is
13044 provably scalar, and @samp{!dscalar(a)} is ``true'' only if @code{a}
13045 is provably non-scalar; both are ``false'' if there is insufficient
13046 information to tell.
13047
13048 @node Display Modes, Language Modes, Declarations, Mode Settings
13049 @section Display Modes
13050
13051 @noindent
13052 The commands in this section are two-key sequences beginning with the
13053 @kbd{d} prefix. The @kbd{d l} (@code{calc-line-numbering}) and @kbd{d b}
13054 (@code{calc-line-breaking}) commands are described elsewhere;
13055 @pxref{Stack Basics} and @pxref{Normal Language Modes}, respectively.
13056 Display formats for vectors and matrices are also covered elsewhere;
13057 @pxref{Vector and Matrix Formats}.
13058
13059 One thing all display modes have in common is their treatment of the
13060 @kbd{H} prefix. This prefix causes any mode command that would normally
13061 refresh the stack to leave the stack display alone. The word ``Dirty''
13062 will appear in the mode line when Calc thinks the stack display may not
13063 reflect the latest mode settings.
13064
13065 @kindex d @key{RET}
13066 @pindex calc-refresh-top
13067 The @kbd{d @key{RET}} (@code{calc-refresh-top}) command reformats the
13068 top stack entry according to all the current modes. Positive prefix
13069 arguments reformat the top @var{n} entries; negative prefix arguments
13070 reformat the specified entry, and a prefix of zero is equivalent to
13071 @kbd{d @key{SPC}} (@code{calc-refresh}), which reformats the entire stack.
13072 For example, @kbd{H d s M-2 d @key{RET}} changes to scientific notation
13073 but reformats only the top two stack entries in the new mode.
13074
13075 The @kbd{I} prefix has another effect on the display modes. The mode
13076 is set only temporarily; the top stack entry is reformatted according
13077 to that mode, then the original mode setting is restored. In other
13078 words, @kbd{I d s} is equivalent to @kbd{H d s d @key{RET} H d (@var{old mode})}.
13079
13080 @menu
13081 * Radix Modes::
13082 * Grouping Digits::
13083 * Float Formats::
13084 * Complex Formats::
13085 * Fraction Formats::
13086 * HMS Formats::
13087 * Date Formats::
13088 * Truncating the Stack::
13089 * Justification::
13090 * Labels::
13091 @end menu
13092
13093 @node Radix Modes, Grouping Digits, Display Modes, Display Modes
13094 @subsection Radix Modes
13095
13096 @noindent
13097 @cindex Radix display
13098 @cindex Non-decimal numbers
13099 @cindex Decimal and non-decimal numbers
13100 Calc normally displays numbers in decimal (@dfn{base-10} or @dfn{radix-10})
13101 notation. Calc can actually display in any radix from two (binary) to 36.
13102 When the radix is above 10, the letters @code{A} to @code{Z} are used as
13103 digits. When entering such a number, letter keys are interpreted as
13104 potential digits rather than terminating numeric entry mode.
13105
13106 @kindex d 2
13107 @kindex d 8
13108 @kindex d 6
13109 @kindex d 0
13110 @cindex Hexadecimal integers
13111 @cindex Octal integers
13112 The key sequences @kbd{d 2}, @kbd{d 8}, @kbd{d 6}, and @kbd{d 0} select
13113 binary, octal, hexadecimal, and decimal as the current display radix,
13114 respectively. Numbers can always be entered in any radix, though the
13115 current radix is used as a default if you press @kbd{#} without any initial
13116 digits. A number entered without a @kbd{#} is @emph{always} interpreted
13117 as decimal.
13118
13119 @kindex d r
13120 @pindex calc-radix
13121 To set the radix generally, use @kbd{d r} (@code{calc-radix}) and enter
13122 an integer from 2 to 36. You can specify the radix as a numeric prefix
13123 argument; otherwise you will be prompted for it.
13124
13125 @kindex d z
13126 @pindex calc-leading-zeros
13127 @cindex Leading zeros
13128 Integers normally are displayed with however many digits are necessary to
13129 represent the integer and no more. The @kbd{d z} (@code{calc-leading-zeros})
13130 command causes integers to be padded out with leading zeros according to the
13131 current binary word size. (@xref{Binary Functions}, for a discussion of
13132 word size.) If the absolute value of the word size is @expr{w}, all integers
13133 are displayed with at least enough digits to represent
13134 @texline @math{2^w-1}
13135 @infoline @expr{(2^w)-1}
13136 in the current radix. (Larger integers will still be displayed in their
13137 entirety.)
13138
13139 @node Grouping Digits, Float Formats, Radix Modes, Display Modes
13140 @subsection Grouping Digits
13141
13142 @noindent
13143 @kindex d g
13144 @pindex calc-group-digits
13145 @cindex Grouping digits
13146 @cindex Digit grouping
13147 Long numbers can be hard to read if they have too many digits. For
13148 example, the factorial of 30 is 33 digits long! Press @kbd{d g}
13149 (@code{calc-group-digits}) to enable @dfn{Grouping} mode, in which digits
13150 are displayed in clumps of 3 or 4 (depending on the current radix)
13151 separated by commas.
13152
13153 The @kbd{d g} command toggles grouping on and off.
13154 With a numeric prefix of 0, this command displays the current state of
13155 the grouping flag; with an argument of minus one it disables grouping;
13156 with a positive argument @expr{N} it enables grouping on every @expr{N}
13157 digits. For floating-point numbers, grouping normally occurs only
13158 before the decimal point. A negative prefix argument @expr{-N} enables
13159 grouping every @expr{N} digits both before and after the decimal point.
13160
13161 @kindex d ,
13162 @pindex calc-group-char
13163 The @kbd{d ,} (@code{calc-group-char}) command allows you to choose any
13164 character as the grouping separator. The default is the comma character.
13165 If you find it difficult to read vectors of large integers grouped with
13166 commas, you may wish to use spaces or some other character instead.
13167 This command takes the next character you type, whatever it is, and
13168 uses it as the digit separator. As a special case, @kbd{d , \} selects
13169 @samp{\,} (@TeX{}'s thin-space symbol) as the digit separator.
13170
13171 Please note that grouped numbers will not generally be parsed correctly
13172 if re-read in textual form, say by the use of @kbd{C-x * y} and @kbd{C-x * g}.
13173 (@xref{Kill and Yank}, for details on these commands.) One exception is
13174 the @samp{\,} separator, which doesn't interfere with parsing because it
13175 is ignored by @TeX{} language mode.
13176
13177 @node Float Formats, Complex Formats, Grouping Digits, Display Modes
13178 @subsection Float Formats
13179
13180 @noindent
13181 Floating-point quantities are normally displayed in standard decimal
13182 form, with scientific notation used if the exponent is especially high
13183 or low. All significant digits are normally displayed. The commands
13184 in this section allow you to choose among several alternative display
13185 formats for floats.
13186
13187 @kindex d n
13188 @pindex calc-normal-notation
13189 The @kbd{d n} (@code{calc-normal-notation}) command selects the normal
13190 display format. All significant figures in a number are displayed.
13191 With a positive numeric prefix, numbers are rounded if necessary to
13192 that number of significant digits. With a negative numerix prefix,
13193 the specified number of significant digits less than the current
13194 precision is used. (Thus @kbd{C-u -2 d n} displays 10 digits if the
13195 current precision is 12.)
13196
13197 @kindex d f
13198 @pindex calc-fix-notation
13199 The @kbd{d f} (@code{calc-fix-notation}) command selects fixed-point
13200 notation. The numeric argument is the number of digits after the
13201 decimal point, zero or more. This format will relax into scientific
13202 notation if a nonzero number would otherwise have been rounded all the
13203 way to zero. Specifying a negative number of digits is the same as
13204 for a positive number, except that small nonzero numbers will be rounded
13205 to zero rather than switching to scientific notation.
13206
13207 @kindex d s
13208 @pindex calc-sci-notation
13209 @cindex Scientific notation, display of
13210 The @kbd{d s} (@code{calc-sci-notation}) command selects scientific
13211 notation. A positive argument sets the number of significant figures
13212 displayed, of which one will be before and the rest after the decimal
13213 point. A negative argument works the same as for @kbd{d n} format.
13214 The default is to display all significant digits.
13215
13216 @kindex d e
13217 @pindex calc-eng-notation
13218 @cindex Engineering notation, display of
13219 The @kbd{d e} (@code{calc-eng-notation}) command selects engineering
13220 notation. This is similar to scientific notation except that the
13221 exponent is rounded down to a multiple of three, with from one to three
13222 digits before the decimal point. An optional numeric prefix sets the
13223 number of significant digits to display, as for @kbd{d s}.
13224
13225 It is important to distinguish between the current @emph{precision} and
13226 the current @emph{display format}. After the commands @kbd{C-u 10 p}
13227 and @kbd{C-u 6 d n} the Calculator computes all results to ten
13228 significant figures but displays only six. (In fact, intermediate
13229 calculations are often carried to one or two more significant figures,
13230 but values placed on the stack will be rounded down to ten figures.)
13231 Numbers are never actually rounded to the display precision for storage,
13232 except by commands like @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-x * y} which operate on the
13233 actual displayed text in the Calculator buffer.
13234
13235 @kindex d .
13236 @pindex calc-point-char
13237 The @kbd{d .} (@code{calc-point-char}) command selects the character used
13238 as a decimal point. Normally this is a period; users in some countries
13239 may wish to change this to a comma. Note that this is only a display
13240 style; on entry, periods must always be used to denote floating-point
13241 numbers, and commas to separate elements in a list.
13242
13243 @node Complex Formats, Fraction Formats, Float Formats, Display Modes
13244 @subsection Complex Formats
13245
13246 @noindent
13247 @kindex d c
13248 @pindex calc-complex-notation
13249 There are three supported notations for complex numbers in rectangular
13250 form. The default is as a pair of real numbers enclosed in parentheses
13251 and separated by a comma: @samp{(a,b)}. The @kbd{d c}
13252 (@code{calc-complex-notation}) command selects this style.
13253
13254 @kindex d i
13255 @pindex calc-i-notation
13256 @kindex d j
13257 @pindex calc-j-notation
13258 The other notations are @kbd{d i} (@code{calc-i-notation}), in which
13259 numbers are displayed in @samp{a+bi} form, and @kbd{d j}
13260 (@code{calc-j-notation}) which displays the form @samp{a+bj} preferred
13261 in some disciplines.
13262
13263 @cindex @code{i} variable
13264 @vindex i
13265 Complex numbers are normally entered in @samp{(a,b)} format.
13266 If you enter @samp{2+3i} as an algebraic formula, it will be stored as
13267 the formula @samp{2 + 3 * i}. However, if you use @kbd{=} to evaluate
13268 this formula and you have not changed the variable @samp{i}, the @samp{i}
13269 will be interpreted as @samp{(0,1)} and the formula will be simplified
13270 to @samp{(2,3)}. Other commands (like @code{calc-sin}) will @emph{not}
13271 interpret the formula @samp{2 + 3 * i} as a complex number.
13272 @xref{Variables}, under ``special constants.''
13273
13274 @node Fraction Formats, HMS Formats, Complex Formats, Display Modes
13275 @subsection Fraction Formats
13276
13277 @noindent
13278 @kindex d o
13279 @pindex calc-over-notation
13280 Display of fractional numbers is controlled by the @kbd{d o}
13281 (@code{calc-over-notation}) command. By default, a number like
13282 eight thirds is displayed in the form @samp{8:3}. The @kbd{d o} command
13283 prompts for a one- or two-character format. If you give one character,
13284 that character is used as the fraction separator. Common separators are
13285 @samp{:} and @samp{/}. (During input of numbers, the @kbd{:} key must be
13286 used regardless of the display format; in particular, the @kbd{/} is used
13287 for RPN-style division, @emph{not} for entering fractions.)
13288
13289 If you give two characters, fractions use ``integer-plus-fractional-part''
13290 notation. For example, the format @samp{+/} would display eight thirds
13291 as @samp{2+2/3}. If two colons are present in a number being entered,
13292 the number is interpreted in this form (so that the entries @kbd{2:2:3}
13293 and @kbd{8:3} are equivalent).
13294
13295 It is also possible to follow the one- or two-character format with
13296 a number. For example: @samp{:10} or @samp{+/3}. In this case,
13297 Calc adjusts all fractions that are displayed to have the specified
13298 denominator, if possible. Otherwise it adjusts the denominator to
13299 be a multiple of the specified value. For example, in @samp{:6} mode
13300 the fraction @expr{1:6} will be unaffected, but @expr{2:3} will be
13301 displayed as @expr{4:6}, @expr{1:2} will be displayed as @expr{3:6},
13302 and @expr{1:8} will be displayed as @expr{3:24}. Integers are also
13303 affected by this mode: 3 is displayed as @expr{18:6}. Note that the
13304 format @samp{:1} writes fractions the same as @samp{:}, but it writes
13305 integers as @expr{n:1}.
13306
13307 The fraction format does not affect the way fractions or integers are
13308 stored, only the way they appear on the screen. The fraction format
13309 never affects floats.
13310
13311 @node HMS Formats, Date Formats, Fraction Formats, Display Modes
13312 @subsection HMS Formats
13313
13314 @noindent
13315 @kindex d h
13316 @pindex calc-hms-notation
13317 The @kbd{d h} (@code{calc-hms-notation}) command controls the display of
13318 HMS (hours-minutes-seconds) forms. It prompts for a string which
13319 consists basically of an ``hours'' marker, optional punctuation, a
13320 ``minutes'' marker, more optional punctuation, and a ``seconds'' marker.
13321 Punctuation is zero or more spaces, commas, or semicolons. The hours
13322 marker is one or more non-punctuation characters. The minutes and
13323 seconds markers must be single non-punctuation characters.
13324
13325 The default HMS format is @samp{@@ ' "}, producing HMS values of the form
13326 @samp{23@@ 30' 15.75"}. The format @samp{deg, ms} would display this same
13327 value as @samp{23deg, 30m15.75s}. During numeric entry, the @kbd{h} or @kbd{o}
13328 keys are recognized as synonyms for @kbd{@@} regardless of display format.
13329 The @kbd{m} and @kbd{s} keys are recognized as synonyms for @kbd{'} and
13330 @kbd{"}, respectively, but only if an @kbd{@@} (or @kbd{h} or @kbd{o}) has
13331 already been typed; otherwise, they have their usual meanings
13332 (@kbd{m-} prefix and @kbd{s-} prefix). Thus, @kbd{5 "}, @kbd{0 @@ 5 "}, and
13333 @kbd{0 h 5 s} are some of the ways to enter the quantity ``five seconds.''
13334 The @kbd{'} key is recognized as ``minutes'' only if @kbd{@@} (or @kbd{h} or
13335 @kbd{o}) has already been pressed; otherwise it means to switch to algebraic
13336 entry.
13337
13338 @node Date Formats, Truncating the Stack, HMS Formats, Display Modes
13339 @subsection Date Formats
13340
13341 @noindent
13342 @kindex d d
13343 @pindex calc-date-notation
13344 The @kbd{d d} (@code{calc-date-notation}) command controls the display
13345 of date forms (@pxref{Date Forms}). It prompts for a string which
13346 contains letters that represent the various parts of a date and time.
13347 To show which parts should be omitted when the form represents a pure
13348 date with no time, parts of the string can be enclosed in @samp{< >}
13349 marks. If you don't include @samp{< >} markers in the format, Calc
13350 guesses at which parts, if any, should be omitted when formatting
13351 pure dates.
13352
13353 The default format is: @samp{<H:mm:SSpp >Www Mmm D, YYYY}.
13354 An example string in this format is @samp{3:32pm Wed Jan 9, 1991}.
13355 If you enter a blank format string, this default format is
13356 reestablished.
13357
13358 Calc uses @samp{< >} notation for nameless functions as well as for
13359 dates. @xref{Specifying Operators}. To avoid confusion with nameless
13360 functions, your date formats should avoid using the @samp{#} character.
13361
13362 @menu
13363 * Date Formatting Codes::
13364 * Free-Form Dates::
13365 * Standard Date Formats::
13366 @end menu
13367
13368 @node Date Formatting Codes, Free-Form Dates, Date Formats, Date Formats
13369 @subsubsection Date Formatting Codes
13370
13371 @noindent
13372 When displaying a date, the current date format is used. All
13373 characters except for letters and @samp{<} and @samp{>} are
13374 copied literally when dates are formatted. The portion between
13375 @samp{< >} markers is omitted for pure dates, or included for
13376 date/time forms. Letters are interpreted according to the table
13377 below.
13378
13379 When dates are read in during algebraic entry, Calc first tries to
13380 match the input string to the current format either with or without
13381 the time part. The punctuation characters (including spaces) must
13382 match exactly; letter fields must correspond to suitable text in
13383 the input. If this doesn't work, Calc checks if the input is a
13384 simple number; if so, the number is interpreted as a number of days
13385 since Jan 1, 1 AD. Otherwise, Calc tries a much more relaxed and
13386 flexible algorithm which is described in the next section.
13387
13388 Weekday names are ignored during reading.
13389
13390 Two-digit year numbers are interpreted as lying in the range
13391 from 1941 to 2039. Years outside that range are always
13392 entered and displayed in full. Year numbers with a leading
13393 @samp{+} sign are always interpreted exactly, allowing the
13394 entry and display of the years 1 through 99 AD.
13395
13396 Here is a complete list of the formatting codes for dates:
13397
13398 @table @asis
13399 @item Y
13400 Year: ``91'' for 1991, ``7'' for 2007, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13401 @item YY
13402 Year: ``91'' for 1991, ``07'' for 2007, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13403 @item BY
13404 Year: ``91'' for 1991, `` 7'' for 2007, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13405 @item YYY
13406 Year: ``1991'' for 1991, ``23'' for 23 AD.
13407 @item YYYY
13408 Year: ``1991'' for 1991, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13409 @item aa
13410 Year: ``ad'' or blank.
13411 @item AA
13412 Year: ``AD'' or blank.
13413 @item aaa
13414 Year: ``ad '' or blank. (Note trailing space.)
13415 @item AAA
13416 Year: ``AD '' or blank.
13417 @item aaaa
13418 Year: ``a.d.'' or blank.
13419 @item AAAA
13420 Year: ``A.D.'' or blank.
13421 @item bb
13422 Year: ``bc'' or blank.
13423 @item BB
13424 Year: ``BC'' or blank.
13425 @item bbb
13426 Year: `` bc'' or blank. (Note leading space.)
13427 @item BBB
13428 Year: `` BC'' or blank.
13429 @item bbbb
13430 Year: ``b.c.'' or blank.
13431 @item BBBB
13432 Year: ``B.C.'' or blank.
13433 @item M
13434 Month: ``8'' for August.
13435 @item MM
13436 Month: ``08'' for August.
13437 @item BM
13438 Month: `` 8'' for August.
13439 @item MMM
13440 Month: ``AUG'' for August.
13441 @item Mmm
13442 Month: ``Aug'' for August.
13443 @item mmm
13444 Month: ``aug'' for August.
13445 @item MMMM
13446 Month: ``AUGUST'' for August.
13447 @item Mmmm
13448 Month: ``August'' for August.
13449 @item D
13450 Day: ``7'' for 7th day of month.
13451 @item DD
13452 Day: ``07'' for 7th day of month.
13453 @item BD
13454 Day: `` 7'' for 7th day of month.
13455 @item W
13456 Weekday: ``0'' for Sunday, ``6'' for Saturday.
13457 @item WWW
13458 Weekday: ``SUN'' for Sunday.
13459 @item Www
13460 Weekday: ``Sun'' for Sunday.
13461 @item www
13462 Weekday: ``sun'' for Sunday.
13463 @item WWWW
13464 Weekday: ``SUNDAY'' for Sunday.
13465 @item Wwww
13466 Weekday: ``Sunday'' for Sunday.
13467 @item d
13468 Day of year: ``34'' for Feb. 3.
13469 @item ddd
13470 Day of year: ``034'' for Feb. 3.
13471 @item bdd
13472 Day of year: `` 34'' for Feb. 3.
13473 @item h
13474 Hour: ``5'' for 5 AM; ``17'' for 5 PM.
13475 @item hh
13476 Hour: ``05'' for 5 AM; ``17'' for 5 PM.
13477 @item bh
13478 Hour: `` 5'' for 5 AM; ``17'' for 5 PM.
13479 @item H
13480 Hour: ``5'' for 5 AM and 5 PM.
13481 @item HH
13482 Hour: ``05'' for 5 AM and 5 PM.
13483 @item BH
13484 Hour: `` 5'' for 5 AM and 5 PM.
13485 @item p
13486 AM/PM: ``a'' or ``p''.
13487 @item P
13488 AM/PM: ``A'' or ``P''.
13489 @item pp
13490 AM/PM: ``am'' or ``pm''.
13491 @item PP
13492 AM/PM: ``AM'' or ``PM''.
13493 @item pppp
13494 AM/PM: ``a.m.'' or ``p.m.''.
13495 @item PPPP
13496 AM/PM: ``A.M.'' or ``P.M.''.
13497 @item m
13498 Minutes: ``7'' for 7.
13499 @item mm
13500 Minutes: ``07'' for 7.
13501 @item bm
13502 Minutes: `` 7'' for 7.
13503 @item s
13504 Seconds: ``7'' for 7; ``7.23'' for 7.23.
13505 @item ss
13506 Seconds: ``07'' for 7; ``07.23'' for 7.23.
13507 @item bs
13508 Seconds: `` 7'' for 7; `` 7.23'' for 7.23.
13509 @item SS
13510 Optional seconds: ``07'' for 7; blank for 0.
13511 @item BS
13512 Optional seconds: `` 7'' for 7; blank for 0.
13513 @item N
13514 Numeric date/time: ``726842.25'' for 6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13515 @item n
13516 Numeric date: ``726842'' for any time on Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13517 @item J
13518 Julian date/time: ``2448265.75'' for 6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13519 @item j
13520 Julian date: ``2448266'' for any time on Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13521 @item U
13522 Unix time: ``663400800'' for 6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13523 @item X
13524 Brackets suppression. An ``X'' at the front of the format
13525 causes the surrounding @w{@samp{< >}} delimiters to be omitted
13526 when formatting dates. Note that the brackets are still
13527 required for algebraic entry.
13528 @end table
13529
13530 If ``SS'' or ``BS'' (optional seconds) is preceded by a colon, the
13531 colon is also omitted if the seconds part is zero.
13532
13533 If ``bb,'' ``bbb'' or ``bbbb'' or their upper-case equivalents
13534 appear in the format, then negative year numbers are displayed
13535 without a minus sign. Note that ``aa'' and ``bb'' are mutually
13536 exclusive. Some typical usages would be @samp{YYYY AABB};
13537 @samp{AAAYYYYBBB}; @samp{YYYYBBB}.
13538
13539 The formats ``YY,'' ``YYYY,'' ``MM,'' ``DD,'' ``ddd,'' ``hh,'' ``HH,''
13540 ``mm,'' ``ss,'' and ``SS'' actually match any number of digits during
13541 reading unless several of these codes are strung together with no
13542 punctuation in between, in which case the input must have exactly as
13543 many digits as there are letters in the format.
13544
13545 The ``j,'' ``J,'' and ``U'' formats do not make any time zone
13546 adjustment. They effectively use @samp{julian(x,0)} and
13547 @samp{unixtime(x,0)} to make the conversion; @pxref{Date Arithmetic}.
13548
13549 @node Free-Form Dates, Standard Date Formats, Date Formatting Codes, Date Formats
13550 @subsubsection Free-Form Dates
13551
13552 @noindent
13553 When reading a date form during algebraic entry, Calc falls back
13554 on the algorithm described here if the input does not exactly
13555 match the current date format. This algorithm generally
13556 ``does the right thing'' and you don't have to worry about it,
13557 but it is described here in full detail for the curious.
13558
13559 Calc does not distinguish between upper- and lower-case letters
13560 while interpreting dates.
13561
13562 First, the time portion, if present, is located somewhere in the
13563 text and then removed. The remaining text is then interpreted as
13564 the date.
13565
13566 A time is of the form @samp{hh:mm:ss}, possibly with the seconds
13567 part omitted and possibly with an AM/PM indicator added to indicate
13568 12-hour time. If the AM/PM is present, the minutes may also be
13569 omitted. The AM/PM part may be any of the words @samp{am},
13570 @samp{pm}, @samp{noon}, or @samp{midnight}; each of these may be
13571 abbreviated to one letter, and the alternate forms @samp{a.m.},
13572 @samp{p.m.}, and @samp{mid} are also understood. Obviously
13573 @samp{noon} and @samp{midnight} are allowed only on 12:00:00.
13574 The words @samp{noon}, @samp{mid}, and @samp{midnight} are also
13575 recognized with no number attached.
13576
13577 If there is no AM/PM indicator, the time is interpreted in 24-hour
13578 format.
13579
13580 To read the date portion, all words and numbers are isolated
13581 from the string; other characters are ignored. All words must
13582 be either month names or day-of-week names (the latter of which
13583 are ignored). Names can be written in full or as three-letter
13584 abbreviations.
13585
13586 Large numbers, or numbers with @samp{+} or @samp{-} signs,
13587 are interpreted as years. If one of the other numbers is
13588 greater than 12, then that must be the day and the remaining
13589 number in the input is therefore the month. Otherwise, Calc
13590 assumes the month, day and year are in the same order that they
13591 appear in the current date format. If the year is omitted, the
13592 current year is taken from the system clock.
13593
13594 If there are too many or too few numbers, or any unrecognizable
13595 words, then the input is rejected.
13596
13597 If there are any large numbers (of five digits or more) other than
13598 the year, they are ignored on the assumption that they are something
13599 like Julian dates that were included along with the traditional
13600 date components when the date was formatted.
13601
13602 One of the words @samp{ad}, @samp{a.d.}, @samp{bc}, or @samp{b.c.}
13603 may optionally be used; the latter two are equivalent to a
13604 minus sign on the year value.
13605
13606 If you always enter a four-digit year, and use a name instead
13607 of a number for the month, there is no danger of ambiguity.
13608
13609 @node Standard Date Formats, , Free-Form Dates, Date Formats
13610 @subsubsection Standard Date Formats
13611
13612 @noindent
13613 There are actually ten standard date formats, numbered 0 through 9.
13614 Entering a blank line at the @kbd{d d} command's prompt gives
13615 you format number 1, Calc's usual format. You can enter any digit
13616 to select the other formats.
13617
13618 To create your own standard date formats, give a numeric prefix
13619 argument from 0 to 9 to the @w{@kbd{d d}} command. The format you
13620 enter will be recorded as the new standard format of that
13621 number, as well as becoming the new current date format.
13622 You can save your formats permanently with the @w{@kbd{m m}}
13623 command (@pxref{Mode Settings}).
13624
13625 @table @asis
13626 @item 0
13627 @samp{N} (Numerical format)
13628 @item 1
13629 @samp{<H:mm:SSpp >Www Mmm D, YYYY} (American format)
13630 @item 2
13631 @samp{D Mmm YYYY<, h:mm:SS>} (European format)
13632 @item 3
13633 @samp{Www Mmm BD< hh:mm:ss> YYYY} (Unix written date format)
13634 @item 4
13635 @samp{M/D/Y< H:mm:SSpp>} (American slashed format)
13636 @item 5
13637 @samp{D.M.Y< h:mm:SS>} (European dotted format)
13638 @item 6
13639 @samp{M-D-Y< H:mm:SSpp>} (American dashed format)
13640 @item 7
13641 @samp{D-M-Y< h:mm:SS>} (European dashed format)
13642 @item 8
13643 @samp{j<, h:mm:ss>} (Julian day plus time)
13644 @item 9
13645 @samp{YYddd< hh:mm:ss>} (Year-day format)
13646 @end table
13647
13648 @node Truncating the Stack, Justification, Date Formats, Display Modes
13649 @subsection Truncating the Stack
13650
13651 @noindent
13652 @kindex d t
13653 @pindex calc-truncate-stack
13654 @cindex Truncating the stack
13655 @cindex Narrowing the stack
13656 The @kbd{d t} (@code{calc-truncate-stack}) command moves the @samp{.}@:
13657 line that marks the top-of-stack up or down in the Calculator buffer.
13658 The number right above that line is considered to the be at the top of
13659 the stack. Any numbers below that line are ``hidden'' from all stack
13660 operations (although still visible to the user). This is similar to the
13661 Emacs ``narrowing'' feature, except that the values below the @samp{.}
13662 are @emph{visible}, just temporarily frozen. This feature allows you to
13663 keep several independent calculations running at once in different parts
13664 of the stack, or to apply a certain command to an element buried deep in
13665 the stack.
13666
13667 Pressing @kbd{d t} by itself moves the @samp{.} to the line the cursor
13668 is on. Thus, this line and all those below it become hidden. To un-hide
13669 these lines, move down to the end of the buffer and press @w{@kbd{d t}}.
13670 With a positive numeric prefix argument @expr{n}, @kbd{d t} hides the
13671 bottom @expr{n} values in the buffer. With a negative argument, it hides
13672 all but the top @expr{n} values. With an argument of zero, it hides zero
13673 values, i.e., moves the @samp{.} all the way down to the bottom.
13674
13675 @kindex d [
13676 @pindex calc-truncate-up
13677 @kindex d ]
13678 @pindex calc-truncate-down
13679 The @kbd{d [} (@code{calc-truncate-up}) and @kbd{d ]}
13680 (@code{calc-truncate-down}) commands move the @samp{.} up or down one
13681 line at a time (or several lines with a prefix argument).
13682
13683 @node Justification, Labels, Truncating the Stack, Display Modes
13684 @subsection Justification
13685
13686 @noindent
13687 @kindex d <
13688 @pindex calc-left-justify
13689 @kindex d =
13690 @pindex calc-center-justify
13691 @kindex d >
13692 @pindex calc-right-justify
13693 Values on the stack are normally left-justified in the window. You can
13694 control this arrangement by typing @kbd{d <} (@code{calc-left-justify}),
13695 @kbd{d >} (@code{calc-right-justify}), or @kbd{d =}
13696 (@code{calc-center-justify}). For example, in Right-Justification mode,
13697 stack entries are displayed flush-right against the right edge of the
13698 window.
13699
13700 If you change the width of the Calculator window you may have to type
13701 @kbd{d @key{SPC}} (@code{calc-refresh}) to re-align right-justified or centered
13702 text.
13703
13704 Right-justification is especially useful together with fixed-point
13705 notation (see @code{d f}; @code{calc-fix-notation}). With these modes
13706 together, the decimal points on numbers will always line up.
13707
13708 With a numeric prefix argument, the justification commands give you
13709 a little extra control over the display. The argument specifies the
13710 horizontal ``origin'' of a display line. It is also possible to
13711 specify a maximum line width using the @kbd{d b} command (@pxref{Normal
13712 Language Modes}). For reference, the precise rules for formatting and
13713 breaking lines are given below. Notice that the interaction between
13714 origin and line width is slightly different in each justification
13715 mode.
13716
13717 In Left-Justified mode, the line is indented by a number of spaces
13718 given by the origin (default zero). If the result is longer than the
13719 maximum line width, if given, or too wide to fit in the Calc window
13720 otherwise, then it is broken into lines which will fit; each broken
13721 line is indented to the origin.
13722
13723 In Right-Justified mode, lines are shifted right so that the rightmost
13724 character is just before the origin, or just before the current
13725 window width if no origin was specified. If the line is too long
13726 for this, then it is broken; the current line width is used, if
13727 specified, or else the origin is used as a width if that is
13728 specified, or else the line is broken to fit in the window.
13729
13730 In Centering mode, the origin is the column number of the center of
13731 each stack entry. If a line width is specified, lines will not be
13732 allowed to go past that width; Calc will either indent less or
13733 break the lines if necessary. If no origin is specified, half the
13734 line width or Calc window width is used.
13735
13736 Note that, in each case, if line numbering is enabled the display
13737 is indented an additional four spaces to make room for the line
13738 number. The width of the line number is taken into account when
13739 positioning according to the current Calc window width, but not
13740 when positioning by explicit origins and widths. In the latter
13741 case, the display is formatted as specified, and then uniformly
13742 shifted over four spaces to fit the line numbers.
13743
13744 @node Labels, , Justification, Display Modes
13745 @subsection Labels
13746
13747 @noindent
13748 @kindex d @{
13749 @pindex calc-left-label
13750 The @kbd{d @{} (@code{calc-left-label}) command prompts for a string,
13751 then displays that string to the left of every stack entry. If the
13752 entries are left-justified (@pxref{Justification}), then they will
13753 appear immediately after the label (unless you specified an origin
13754 greater than the length of the label). If the entries are centered
13755 or right-justified, the label appears on the far left and does not
13756 affect the horizontal position of the stack entry.
13757
13758 Give a blank string (with @kbd{d @{ @key{RET}}) to turn the label off.
13759
13760 @kindex d @}
13761 @pindex calc-right-label
13762 The @kbd{d @}} (@code{calc-right-label}) command similarly adds a
13763 label on the righthand side. It does not affect positioning of
13764 the stack entries unless they are right-justified. Also, if both
13765 a line width and an origin are given in Right-Justified mode, the
13766 stack entry is justified to the origin and the righthand label is
13767 justified to the line width.
13768
13769 One application of labels would be to add equation numbers to
13770 formulas you are manipulating in Calc and then copying into a
13771 document (possibly using Embedded mode). The equations would
13772 typically be centered, and the equation numbers would be on the
13773 left or right as you prefer.
13774
13775 @node Language Modes, Modes Variable, Display Modes, Mode Settings
13776 @section Language Modes
13777
13778 @noindent
13779 The commands in this section change Calc to use a different notation for
13780 entry and display of formulas, corresponding to the conventions of some
13781 other common language such as Pascal or La@TeX{}. Objects displayed on the
13782 stack or yanked from the Calculator to an editing buffer will be formatted
13783 in the current language; objects entered in algebraic entry or yanked from
13784 another buffer will be interpreted according to the current language.
13785
13786 The current language has no effect on things written to or read from the
13787 trail buffer, nor does it affect numeric entry. Only algebraic entry is
13788 affected. You can make even algebraic entry ignore the current language
13789 and use the standard notation by giving a numeric prefix, e.g., @kbd{C-u '}.
13790
13791 For example, suppose the formula @samp{2*a[1] + atan(a[2])} occurs in a C
13792 program; elsewhere in the program you need the derivatives of this formula
13793 with respect to @samp{a[1]} and @samp{a[2]}. First, type @kbd{d C}
13794 to switch to C notation. Now use @code{C-u C-x * g} to grab the formula
13795 into the Calculator, @kbd{a d a[1] @key{RET}} to differentiate with respect
13796 to the first variable, and @kbd{C-x * y} to yank the formula for the derivative
13797 back into your C program. Press @kbd{U} to undo the differentiation and
13798 repeat with @kbd{a d a[2] @key{RET}} for the other derivative.
13799
13800 Without being switched into C mode first, Calc would have misinterpreted
13801 the brackets in @samp{a[1]} and @samp{a[2]}, would not have known that
13802 @code{atan} was equivalent to Calc's built-in @code{arctan} function,
13803 and would have written the formula back with notations (like implicit
13804 multiplication) which would not have been valid for a C program.
13805
13806 As another example, suppose you are maintaining a C program and a La@TeX{}
13807 document, each of which needs a copy of the same formula. You can grab the
13808 formula from the program in C mode, switch to La@TeX{} mode, and yank the
13809 formula into the document in La@TeX{} math-mode format.
13810
13811 Language modes are selected by typing the letter @kbd{d} followed by a
13812 shifted letter key.
13813
13814 @menu
13815 * Normal Language Modes::
13816 * C FORTRAN Pascal::
13817 * TeX and LaTeX Language Modes::
13818 * Eqn Language Mode::
13819 * Yacas Language Mode::
13820 * Maxima Language Mode::
13821 * Giac Language Mode::
13822 * Mathematica Language Mode::
13823 * Maple Language Mode::
13824 * Compositions::
13825 * Syntax Tables::
13826 @end menu
13827
13828 @node Normal Language Modes, C FORTRAN Pascal, Language Modes, Language Modes
13829 @subsection Normal Language Modes
13830
13831 @noindent
13832 @kindex d N
13833 @pindex calc-normal-language
13834 The @kbd{d N} (@code{calc-normal-language}) command selects the usual
13835 notation for Calc formulas, as described in the rest of this manual.
13836 Matrices are displayed in a multi-line tabular format, but all other
13837 objects are written in linear form, as they would be typed from the
13838 keyboard.
13839
13840 @kindex d O
13841 @pindex calc-flat-language
13842 @cindex Matrix display
13843 The @kbd{d O} (@code{calc-flat-language}) command selects a language
13844 identical with the normal one, except that matrices are written in
13845 one-line form along with everything else. In some applications this
13846 form may be more suitable for yanking data into other buffers.
13847
13848 @kindex d b
13849 @pindex calc-line-breaking
13850 @cindex Line breaking
13851 @cindex Breaking up long lines
13852 Even in one-line mode, long formulas or vectors will still be split
13853 across multiple lines if they exceed the width of the Calculator window.
13854 The @kbd{d b} (@code{calc-line-breaking}) command turns this line-breaking
13855 feature on and off. (It works independently of the current language.)
13856 If you give a numeric prefix argument of five or greater to the @kbd{d b}
13857 command, that argument will specify the line width used when breaking
13858 long lines.
13859
13860 @kindex d B
13861 @pindex calc-big-language
13862 The @kbd{d B} (@code{calc-big-language}) command selects a language
13863 which uses textual approximations to various mathematical notations,
13864 such as powers, quotients, and square roots:
13865
13866 @example
13867 ____________
13868 | a + 1 2
13869 | ----- + c
13870 \| b
13871 @end example
13872
13873 @noindent
13874 in place of @samp{sqrt((a+1)/b + c^2)}.
13875
13876 Subscripts like @samp{a_i} are displayed as actual subscripts in Big
13877 mode. Double subscripts, @samp{a_i_j} (@samp{subscr(subscr(a, i), j)})
13878 are displayed as @samp{a} with subscripts separated by commas:
13879 @samp{i, j}. They must still be entered in the usual underscore
13880 notation.
13881
13882 One slight ambiguity of Big notation is that
13883
13884 @example
13885 3
13886 - -
13887 4
13888 @end example
13889
13890 @noindent
13891 can represent either the negative rational number @expr{-3:4}, or the
13892 actual expression @samp{-(3/4)}; but the latter formula would normally
13893 never be displayed because it would immediately be evaluated to
13894 @expr{-3:4} or @expr{-0.75}, so this ambiguity is not a problem in
13895 typical use.
13896
13897 Non-decimal numbers are displayed with subscripts. Thus there is no
13898 way to tell the difference between @samp{16#C2} and @samp{C2_16},
13899 though generally you will know which interpretation is correct.
13900 Logarithms @samp{log(x,b)} and @samp{log10(x)} also use subscripts
13901 in Big mode.
13902
13903 In Big mode, stack entries often take up several lines. To aid
13904 readability, stack entries are separated by a blank line in this mode.
13905 You may find it useful to expand the Calc window's height using
13906 @kbd{C-x ^} (@code{enlarge-window}) or to make the Calc window the only
13907 one on the screen with @kbd{C-x 1} (@code{delete-other-windows}).
13908
13909 Long lines are currently not rearranged to fit the window width in
13910 Big mode, so you may need to use the @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} keys
13911 to scroll across a wide formula. For really big formulas, you may
13912 even need to use @kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}} to scroll up and down.
13913
13914 @kindex d U
13915 @pindex calc-unformatted-language
13916 The @kbd{d U} (@code{calc-unformatted-language}) command altogether disables
13917 the use of operator notation in formulas. In this mode, the formula
13918 shown above would be displayed:
13919
13920 @example
13921 sqrt(add(div(add(a, 1), b), pow(c, 2)))
13922 @end example
13923
13924 These four modes differ only in display format, not in the format
13925 expected for algebraic entry. The standard Calc operators work in
13926 all four modes, and unformatted notation works in any language mode
13927 (except that Mathematica mode expects square brackets instead of
13928 parentheses).
13929
13930 @node C FORTRAN Pascal, TeX and LaTeX Language Modes, Normal Language Modes, Language Modes
13931 @subsection C, FORTRAN, and Pascal Modes
13932
13933 @noindent
13934 @kindex d C
13935 @pindex calc-c-language
13936 @cindex C language
13937 The @kbd{d C} (@code{calc-c-language}) command selects the conventions
13938 of the C language for display and entry of formulas. This differs from
13939 the normal language mode in a variety of (mostly minor) ways. In
13940 particular, C language operators and operator precedences are used in
13941 place of Calc's usual ones. For example, @samp{a^b} means @samp{xor(a,b)}
13942 in C mode; a value raised to a power is written as a function call,
13943 @samp{pow(a,b)}.
13944
13945 In C mode, vectors and matrices use curly braces instead of brackets.
13946 Octal and hexadecimal values are written with leading @samp{0} or @samp{0x}
13947 rather than using the @samp{#} symbol. Array subscripting is
13948 translated into @code{subscr} calls, so that @samp{a[i]} in C
13949 mode is the same as @samp{a_i} in Normal mode. Assignments
13950 turn into the @code{assign} function, which Calc normally displays
13951 using the @samp{:=} symbol.
13952
13953 The variables @code{pi} and @code{e} would be displayed @samp{pi}
13954 and @samp{e} in Normal mode, but in C mode they are displayed as
13955 @samp{M_PI} and @samp{M_E}, corresponding to the names of constants
13956 typically provided in the @file{<math.h>} header. Functions whose
13957 names are different in C are translated automatically for entry and
13958 display purposes. For example, entering @samp{asin(x)} will push the
13959 formula @samp{arcsin(x)} onto the stack; this formula will be displayed
13960 as @samp{asin(x)} as long as C mode is in effect.
13961
13962 @kindex d P
13963 @pindex calc-pascal-language
13964 @cindex Pascal language
13965 The @kbd{d P} (@code{calc-pascal-language}) command selects Pascal
13966 conventions. Like C mode, Pascal mode interprets array brackets and uses
13967 a different table of operators. Hexadecimal numbers are entered and
13968 displayed with a preceding dollar sign. (Thus the regular meaning of
13969 @kbd{$2} during algebraic entry does not work in Pascal mode, though
13970 @kbd{$} (and @kbd{$$}, etc.) not followed by digits works the same as
13971 always.) No special provisions are made for other non-decimal numbers,
13972 vectors, and so on, since there is no universally accepted standard way
13973 of handling these in Pascal.
13974
13975 @kindex d F
13976 @pindex calc-fortran-language
13977 @cindex FORTRAN language
13978 The @kbd{d F} (@code{calc-fortran-language}) command selects FORTRAN
13979 conventions. Various function names are transformed into FORTRAN
13980 equivalents. Vectors are written as @samp{/1, 2, 3/}, and may be
13981 entered this way or using square brackets. Since FORTRAN uses round
13982 parentheses for both function calls and array subscripts, Calc displays
13983 both in the same way; @samp{a(i)} is interpreted as a function call
13984 upon reading, and subscripts must be entered as @samp{subscr(a, i)}.
13985 If the variable @code{a} has been declared to have type
13986 @code{vector} or @code{matrix}, however, then @samp{a(i)} will be
13987 parsed as a subscript. (@xref{Declarations}.) Usually it doesn't
13988 matter, though; if you enter the subscript expression @samp{a(i)} and
13989 Calc interprets it as a function call, you'll never know the difference
13990 unless you switch to another language mode or replace @code{a} with an
13991 actual vector (or unless @code{a} happens to be the name of a built-in
13992 function!).
13993
13994 Underscores are allowed in variable and function names in all of these
13995 language modes. The underscore here is equivalent to the @samp{#} in
13996 Normal mode, or to hyphens in the underlying Emacs Lisp variable names.
13997
13998 FORTRAN and Pascal modes normally do not adjust the case of letters in
13999 formulas. Most built-in Calc names use lower-case letters. If you use a
14000 positive numeric prefix argument with @kbd{d P} or @kbd{d F}, these
14001 modes will use upper-case letters exclusively for display, and will
14002 convert to lower-case on input. With a negative prefix, these modes
14003 convert to lower-case for display and input.
14004
14005 @node TeX and LaTeX Language Modes, Eqn Language Mode, C FORTRAN Pascal, Language Modes
14006 @subsection @TeX{} and La@TeX{} Language Modes
14007
14008 @noindent
14009 @kindex d T
14010 @pindex calc-tex-language
14011 @cindex TeX language
14012 @kindex d L
14013 @pindex calc-latex-language
14014 @cindex LaTeX language
14015 The @kbd{d T} (@code{calc-tex-language}) command selects the conventions
14016 of ``math mode'' in Donald Knuth's @TeX{} typesetting language,
14017 and the @kbd{d L} (@code{calc-latex-language}) command selects the
14018 conventions of ``math mode'' in La@TeX{}, a typesetting language that
14019 uses @TeX{} as its formatting engine. Calc's La@TeX{} language mode can
14020 read any formula that the @TeX{} language mode can, although La@TeX{}
14021 mode may display it differently.
14022
14023 Formulas are entered and displayed in the appropriate notation;
14024 @texline @math{\sin(a/b)}
14025 @infoline @expr{sin(a/b)}
14026 will appear as @samp{\sin\left( @{a \over b@} \right)} in @TeX{} mode and
14027 @samp{\sin\left(\frac@{a@}@{b@}\right)} in La@TeX{} mode.
14028 Math formulas are often enclosed by @samp{$ $} signs in @TeX{} and
14029 La@TeX{}; these should be omitted when interfacing with Calc. To Calc,
14030 the @samp{$} sign has the same meaning it always does in algebraic
14031 formulas (a reference to an existing entry on the stack).
14032
14033 Complex numbers are displayed as in @samp{3 + 4i}. Fractions and
14034 quotients are written using @code{\over} in @TeX{} mode (as in
14035 @code{@{a \over b@}}) and @code{\frac} in La@TeX{} mode (as in
14036 @code{\frac@{a@}@{b@}}); binomial coefficients are written with
14037 @code{\choose} in @TeX{} mode (as in @code{@{a \choose b@}}) and
14038 @code{\binom} in La@TeX{} mode (as in @code{\binom@{a@}@{b@}}).
14039 Interval forms are written with @code{\ldots}, and error forms are
14040 written with @code{\pm}. Absolute values are written as in
14041 @samp{|x + 1|}, and the floor and ceiling functions are written with
14042 @code{\lfloor}, @code{\rfloor}, etc. The words @code{\left} and
14043 @code{\right} are ignored when reading formulas in @TeX{} and La@TeX{}
14044 modes. Both @code{inf} and @code{uinf} are written as @code{\infty};
14045 when read, @code{\infty} always translates to @code{inf}.
14046
14047 Function calls are written the usual way, with the function name followed
14048 by the arguments in parentheses. However, functions for which @TeX{}
14049 and La@TeX{} have special names (like @code{\sin}) will use curly braces
14050 instead of parentheses for very simple arguments. During input, curly
14051 braces and parentheses work equally well for grouping, but when the
14052 document is formatted the curly braces will be invisible. Thus the
14053 printed result is
14054 @texline @math{\sin{2 x}}
14055 @infoline @expr{sin 2x}
14056 but
14057 @texline @math{\sin(2 + x)}.
14058 @infoline @expr{sin(2 + x)}.
14059
14060 Function and variable names not treated specially by @TeX{} and La@TeX{}
14061 are simply written out as-is, which will cause them to come out in
14062 italic letters in the printed document. If you invoke @kbd{d T} or
14063 @kbd{d L} with a positive numeric prefix argument, names of more than
14064 one character will instead be enclosed in a protective commands that
14065 will prevent them from being typeset in the math italics; they will be
14066 written @samp{\hbox@{@var{name}@}} in @TeX{} mode and
14067 @samp{\text@{@var{name}@}} in La@TeX{} mode. The
14068 @samp{\hbox@{ @}} and @samp{\text@{ @}} notations are ignored during
14069 reading. If you use a negative prefix argument, such function names are
14070 written @samp{\@var{name}}, and function names that begin with @code{\} during
14071 reading have the @code{\} removed. (Note that in this mode, long
14072 variable names are still written with @code{\hbox} or @code{\text}.
14073 However, you can always make an actual variable name like @code{\bar} in
14074 any @TeX{} mode.)
14075
14076 During reading, text of the form @samp{\matrix@{ ...@: @}} is replaced
14077 by @samp{[ ...@: ]}. The same also applies to @code{\pmatrix} and
14078 @code{\bmatrix}. In La@TeX{} mode this also applies to
14079 @samp{\begin@{matrix@} ... \end@{matrix@}},
14080 @samp{\begin@{bmatrix@} ... \end@{bmatrix@}},
14081 @samp{\begin@{pmatrix@} ... \end@{pmatrix@}}, as well as
14082 @samp{\begin@{smallmatrix@} ... \end@{smallmatrix@}}.
14083 The symbol @samp{&} is interpreted as a comma,
14084 and the symbols @samp{\cr} and @samp{\\} are interpreted as semicolons.
14085 During output, matrices are displayed in @samp{\matrix@{ a & b \\ c & d@}}
14086 format in @TeX{} mode and in
14087 @samp{\begin@{pmatrix@} a & b \\ c & d \end@{pmatrix@}} format in
14088 La@TeX{} mode; you may need to edit this afterwards to change to your
14089 preferred matrix form. If you invoke @kbd{d T} or @kbd{d L} with an
14090 argument of 2 or -2, then matrices will be displayed in two-dimensional
14091 form, such as
14092
14093 @example
14094 \begin@{pmatrix@}
14095 a & b \\
14096 c & d
14097 \end@{pmatrix@}
14098 @end example
14099
14100 @noindent
14101 This may be convenient for isolated matrices, but could lead to
14102 expressions being displayed like
14103
14104 @example
14105 \begin@{pmatrix@} \times x
14106 a & b \\
14107 c & d
14108 \end@{pmatrix@}
14109 @end example
14110
14111 @noindent
14112 While this wouldn't bother Calc, it is incorrect La@TeX{}.
14113 (Similarly for @TeX{}.)
14114
14115 Accents like @code{\tilde} and @code{\bar} translate into function
14116 calls internally (@samp{tilde(x)}, @samp{bar(x)}). The @code{\underline}
14117 sequence is treated as an accent. The @code{\vec} accent corresponds
14118 to the function name @code{Vec}, because @code{vec} is the name of
14119 a built-in Calc function. The following table shows the accents
14120 in Calc, @TeX{}, La@TeX{} and @dfn{eqn} (described in the next section):
14121
14122 @ignore
14123 @iftex
14124 @begingroup
14125 @let@calcindexershow=@calcindexernoshow @c Suppress marginal notes
14126 @let@calcindexersh=@calcindexernoshow
14127 @end iftex
14128 @starindex
14129 @end ignore
14130 @tindex acute
14131 @ignore
14132 @starindex
14133 @end ignore
14134 @tindex Acute
14135 @ignore
14136 @starindex
14137 @end ignore
14138 @tindex bar
14139 @ignore
14140 @starindex
14141 @end ignore
14142 @tindex Bar
14143 @ignore
14144 @starindex
14145 @end ignore
14146 @tindex breve
14147 @ignore
14148 @starindex
14149 @end ignore
14150 @tindex Breve
14151 @ignore
14152 @starindex
14153 @end ignore
14154 @tindex check
14155 @ignore
14156 @starindex
14157 @end ignore
14158 @tindex Check
14159 @ignore
14160 @starindex
14161 @end ignore
14162 @tindex dddot
14163 @ignore
14164 @starindex
14165 @end ignore
14166 @tindex ddddot
14167 @ignore
14168 @starindex
14169 @end ignore
14170 @tindex dot
14171 @ignore
14172 @starindex
14173 @end ignore
14174 @tindex Dot
14175 @ignore
14176 @starindex
14177 @end ignore
14178 @tindex dotdot
14179 @ignore
14180 @starindex
14181 @end ignore
14182 @tindex DotDot
14183 @ignore
14184 @starindex
14185 @end ignore
14186 @tindex dyad
14187 @ignore
14188 @starindex
14189 @end ignore
14190 @tindex grave
14191 @ignore
14192 @starindex
14193 @end ignore
14194 @tindex Grave
14195 @ignore
14196 @starindex
14197 @end ignore
14198 @tindex hat
14199 @ignore
14200 @starindex
14201 @end ignore
14202 @tindex Hat
14203 @ignore
14204 @starindex
14205 @end ignore
14206 @tindex Prime
14207 @ignore
14208 @starindex
14209 @end ignore
14210 @tindex tilde
14211 @ignore
14212 @starindex
14213 @end ignore
14214 @tindex Tilde
14215 @ignore
14216 @starindex
14217 @end ignore
14218 @tindex under
14219 @ignore
14220 @starindex
14221 @end ignore
14222 @tindex Vec
14223 @ignore
14224 @starindex
14225 @end ignore
14226 @tindex VEC
14227 @ignore
14228 @iftex
14229 @endgroup
14230 @end iftex
14231 @end ignore
14232 @example
14233 Calc TeX LaTeX eqn
14234 ---- --- ----- ---
14235 acute \acute \acute
14236 Acute \Acute
14237 bar \bar \bar bar
14238 Bar \Bar
14239 breve \breve \breve
14240 Breve \Breve
14241 check \check \check
14242 Check \Check
14243 dddot \dddot
14244 ddddot \ddddot
14245 dot \dot \dot dot
14246 Dot \Dot
14247 dotdot \ddot \ddot dotdot
14248 DotDot \Ddot
14249 dyad dyad
14250 grave \grave \grave
14251 Grave \Grave
14252 hat \hat \hat hat
14253 Hat \Hat
14254 Prime prime
14255 tilde \tilde \tilde tilde
14256 Tilde \Tilde
14257 under \underline \underline under
14258 Vec \vec \vec vec
14259 VEC \Vec
14260 @end example
14261
14262 The @samp{=>} (evaluates-to) operator appears as a @code{\to} symbol:
14263 @samp{@{@var{a} \to @var{b}@}}. @TeX{} defines @code{\to} as an
14264 alias for @code{\rightarrow}. However, if the @samp{=>} is the
14265 top-level expression being formatted, a slightly different notation
14266 is used: @samp{\evalto @var{a} \to @var{b}}. The @code{\evalto}
14267 word is ignored by Calc's input routines, and is undefined in @TeX{}.
14268 You will typically want to include one of the following definitions
14269 at the top of a @TeX{} file that uses @code{\evalto}:
14270
14271 @example
14272 \def\evalto@{@}
14273 \def\evalto#1\to@{@}
14274 @end example
14275
14276 The first definition formats evaluates-to operators in the usual
14277 way. The second causes only the @var{b} part to appear in the
14278 printed document; the @var{a} part and the arrow are hidden.
14279 Another definition you may wish to use is @samp{\let\to=\Rightarrow}
14280 which causes @code{\to} to appear more like Calc's @samp{=>} symbol.
14281 @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}, for a discussion of @code{evalto}.
14282
14283 The complete set of @TeX{} control sequences that are ignored during
14284 reading is:
14285
14286 @example
14287 \hbox \mbox \text \left \right
14288 \, \> \: \; \! \quad \qquad \hfil \hfill
14289 \displaystyle \textstyle \dsize \tsize
14290 \scriptstyle \scriptscriptstyle \ssize \ssize
14291 \rm \bf \it \sl \roman \bold \italic \slanted
14292 \cal \mit \Cal \Bbb \frak \goth
14293 \evalto
14294 @end example
14295
14296 Note that, because these symbols are ignored, reading a @TeX{} or
14297 La@TeX{} formula into Calc and writing it back out may lose spacing and
14298 font information.
14299
14300 Also, the ``discretionary multiplication sign'' @samp{\*} is read
14301 the same as @samp{*}.
14302
14303 @ifnottex
14304 The @TeX{} version of this manual includes some printed examples at the
14305 end of this section.
14306 @end ifnottex
14307 @iftex
14308 Here are some examples of how various Calc formulas are formatted in @TeX{}:
14309
14310 @example
14311 @group
14312 sin(a^2 / b_i)
14313 \sin\left( {a^2 \over b_i} \right)
14314 @end group
14315 @end example
14316 @tex
14317 $$ \sin\left( a^2 \over b_i \right) $$
14318 @end tex
14319 @sp 1
14320
14321 @example
14322 @group
14323 [(3, 4), 3:4, 3 +/- 4, [3 .. inf)]
14324 [3 + 4i, @{3 \over 4@}, 3 \pm 4, [3 \ldots \infty)]
14325 @end group
14326 @end example
14327 @tex
14328 \turnoffactive
14329 $$ [3 + 4i, {3 \over 4}, 3 \pm 4, [ 3 \ldots \infty)] $$
14330 @end tex
14331 @sp 1
14332
14333 @example
14334 @group
14335 [abs(a), abs(a / b), floor(a), ceil(a / b)]
14336 [|a|, \left| a \over b \right|,
14337 \lfloor a \rfloor, \left\lceil a \over b \right\rceil]
14338 @end group
14339 @end example
14340 @tex
14341 $$ [|a|, \left| a \over b \right|,
14342 \lfloor a \rfloor, \left\lceil a \over b \right\rceil] $$
14343 @end tex
14344 @sp 1
14345
14346 @example
14347 @group
14348 [sin(a), sin(2 a), sin(2 + a), sin(a / b)]
14349 [\sin@{a@}, \sin@{2 a@}, \sin(2 + a),
14350 \sin\left( @{a \over b@} \right)]
14351 @end group
14352 @end example
14353 @tex
14354 \turnoffactive
14355 $$ [\sin{a}, \sin{2 a}, \sin(2 + a), \sin\left( {a \over b} \right)] $$
14356 @end tex
14357 @sp 2
14358
14359 First with plain @kbd{d T}, then with @kbd{C-u d T}, then finally with
14360 @kbd{C-u - d T} (using the example definition
14361 @samp{\def\foo#1@{\tilde F(#1)@}}:
14362
14363 @example
14364 @group
14365 [f(a), foo(bar), sin(pi)]
14366 [f(a), foo(bar), \sin{\pi}]
14367 [f(a), \hbox@{foo@}(\hbox@{bar@}), \sin@{\pi@}]
14368 [f(a), \foo@{\hbox@{bar@}@}, \sin@{\pi@}]
14369 @end group
14370 @end example
14371 @tex
14372 $$ [f(a), foo(bar), \sin{\pi}] $$
14373 $$ [f(a), \hbox{foo}(\hbox{bar}), \sin{\pi}] $$
14374 $$ [f(a), \tilde F(\hbox{bar}), \sin{\pi}] $$
14375 @end tex
14376 @sp 2
14377
14378 First with @samp{\def\evalto@{@}}, then with @samp{\def\evalto#1\to@{@}}:
14379
14380 @example
14381 @group
14382 2 + 3 => 5
14383 \evalto 2 + 3 \to 5
14384 @end group
14385 @end example
14386 @tex
14387 \turnoffactive
14388 $$ 2 + 3 \to 5 $$
14389 $$ 5 $$
14390 @end tex
14391 @sp 2
14392
14393 First with standard @code{\to}, then with @samp{\let\to\Rightarrow}:
14394
14395 @example
14396 @group
14397 [2 + 3 => 5, a / 2 => (b + c) / 2]
14398 [@{2 + 3 \to 5@}, @{@{a \over 2@} \to @{b + c \over 2@}@}]
14399 @end group
14400 @end example
14401 @tex
14402 \turnoffactive
14403 $$ [{2 + 3 \to 5}, {{a \over 2} \to {b + c \over 2}}] $$
14404 {\let\to\Rightarrow
14405 $$ [{2 + 3 \to 5}, {{a \over 2} \to {b + c \over 2}}] $$}
14406 @end tex
14407 @sp 2
14408
14409 Matrices normally, then changing @code{\matrix} to @code{\pmatrix}:
14410
14411 @example
14412 @group
14413 [ [ a / b, 0 ], [ 0, 2^(x + 1) ] ]
14414 \matrix@{ @{a \over b@} & 0 \\ 0 & 2^@{(x + 1)@} @}
14415 \pmatrix@{ @{a \over b@} & 0 \\ 0 & 2^@{(x + 1)@} @}
14416 @end group
14417 @end example
14418 @tex
14419 \turnoffactive
14420 $$ \matrix{ {a \over b} & 0 \cr 0 & 2^{(x + 1)} } $$
14421 $$ \pmatrix{ {a \over b} & 0 \cr 0 & 2^{(x + 1)} } $$
14422 @end tex
14423 @sp 2
14424 @end iftex
14425
14426 @node Eqn Language Mode, Yacas Language Mode, TeX and LaTeX Language Modes, Language Modes
14427 @subsection Eqn Language Mode
14428
14429 @noindent
14430 @kindex d E
14431 @pindex calc-eqn-language
14432 @dfn{Eqn} is another popular formatter for math formulas. It is
14433 designed for use with the TROFF text formatter, and comes standard
14434 with many versions of Unix. The @kbd{d E} (@code{calc-eqn-language})
14435 command selects @dfn{eqn} notation.
14436
14437 The @dfn{eqn} language's main idiosyncrasy is that whitespace plays
14438 a significant part in the parsing of the language. For example,
14439 @samp{sqrt x+1 + y} treats @samp{x+1} as the argument of the
14440 @code{sqrt} operator. @dfn{Eqn} also understands more conventional
14441 grouping using curly braces: @samp{sqrt@{x+1@} + y}. Braces are
14442 required only when the argument contains spaces.
14443
14444 In Calc's @dfn{eqn} mode, however, curly braces are required to
14445 delimit arguments of operators like @code{sqrt}. The first of the
14446 above examples would treat only the @samp{x} as the argument of
14447 @code{sqrt}, and in fact @samp{sin x+1} would be interpreted as
14448 @samp{sin * x + 1}, because @code{sin} is not a special operator
14449 in the @dfn{eqn} language. If you always surround the argument
14450 with curly braces, Calc will never misunderstand.
14451
14452 Calc also understands parentheses as grouping characters. Another
14453 peculiarity of @dfn{eqn}'s syntax makes it advisable to separate
14454 words with spaces from any surrounding characters that aren't curly
14455 braces, so Calc writes @samp{sin ( x + y )} in @dfn{eqn} mode.
14456 (The spaces around @code{sin} are important to make @dfn{eqn}
14457 recognize that @code{sin} should be typeset in a roman font, and
14458 the spaces around @code{x} and @code{y} are a good idea just in
14459 case the @dfn{eqn} document has defined special meanings for these
14460 names, too.)
14461
14462 Powers and subscripts are written with the @code{sub} and @code{sup}
14463 operators, respectively. Note that the caret symbol @samp{^} is
14464 treated the same as a space in @dfn{eqn} mode, as is the @samp{~}
14465 symbol (these are used to introduce spaces of various widths into
14466 the typeset output of @dfn{eqn}).
14467
14468 As in La@TeX{} mode, Calc's formatter omits parentheses around the
14469 arguments of functions like @code{ln} and @code{sin} if they are
14470 ``simple-looking''; in this case Calc surrounds the argument with
14471 braces, separated by a @samp{~} from the function name: @samp{sin~@{x@}}.
14472
14473 Font change codes (like @samp{roman @var{x}}) and positioning codes
14474 (like @samp{~} and @samp{down @var{n} @var{x}}) are ignored by the
14475 @dfn{eqn} reader. Also ignored are the words @code{left}, @code{right},
14476 @code{mark}, and @code{lineup}. Quotation marks in @dfn{eqn} mode input
14477 are treated the same as curly braces: @samp{sqrt "1+x"} is equivalent to
14478 @samp{sqrt @{1+x@}}; this is only an approximation to the true meaning
14479 of quotes in @dfn{eqn}, but it is good enough for most uses.
14480
14481 Accent codes (@samp{@var{x} dot}) are handled by treating them as
14482 function calls (@samp{dot(@var{x})}) internally.
14483 @xref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}, for a table of these accent
14484 functions. The @code{prime} accent is treated specially if it occurs on
14485 a variable or function name: @samp{f prime prime @w{( x prime )}} is
14486 stored internally as @samp{f'@w{'}(x')}. For example, taking the
14487 derivative of @samp{f(2 x)} with @kbd{a d x} will produce @samp{2 f'(2
14488 x)}, which @dfn{eqn} mode will display as @samp{2 f prime ( 2 x )}.
14489
14490 Assignments are written with the @samp{<-} (left-arrow) symbol,
14491 and @code{evalto} operators are written with @samp{->} or
14492 @samp{evalto ... ->} (@pxref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}, for a discussion
14493 of this). The regular Calc symbols @samp{:=} and @samp{=>} are also
14494 recognized for these operators during reading.
14495
14496 Vectors in @dfn{eqn} mode use regular Calc square brackets, but
14497 matrices are formatted as @samp{matrix @{ ccol @{ a above b @} ... @}}.
14498 The words @code{lcol} and @code{rcol} are recognized as synonyms
14499 for @code{ccol} during input, and are generated instead of @code{ccol}
14500 if the matrix justification mode so specifies.
14501
14502 @node Yacas Language Mode, Maxima Language Mode, Eqn Language Mode, Language Modes
14503 @subsection Yacas Language Mode
14504
14505 @noindent
14506 @kindex d Y
14507 @pindex calc-yacas-language
14508 @cindex Yacas language
14509 The @kbd{d Y} (@code{calc-yacas-language}) command selects the
14510 conventions of Yacas, a free computer algebra system. While the
14511 operators and functions in Yacas are similar to those of Calc, the names
14512 of built-in functions in Yacas are capitalized. The Calc formula
14513 @samp{sin(2 x)}, for example, is entered and displayed @samp{Sin(2 x)}
14514 in Yacas mode, and `@samp{arcsin(x^2)} is @samp{ArcSin(x^2)} in Yacas
14515 mode. Complex numbers are written are written @samp{3 + 4 I}.
14516 The standard special constants are written @code{Pi}, @code{E},
14517 @code{I}, @code{GoldenRatio} and @code{Gamma}. @code{Infinity}
14518 represents both @code{inf} and @code{uinf}, and @code{Undefined}
14519 represents @code{nan}.
14520
14521 Certain operators on functions, such as @code{D} for differentiation
14522 and @code{Integrate} for integration, take a prefix form in Yacas. For
14523 example, the derivative of @w{@samp{e^x sin(x)}} can be computed with
14524 @w{@samp{D(x) Exp(x)*Sin(x)}}.
14525
14526 Other notable differences between Yacas and standard Calc expressions
14527 are that vectors and matrices use curly braces in Yacas, and subscripts
14528 use square brackets. If, for example, @samp{A} represents the list
14529 @samp{@{a,2,c,4@}}, then @samp{A[3]} would equal @samp{c}.
14530
14531
14532 @node Maxima Language Mode, Giac Language Mode, Yacas Language Mode, Language Modes
14533 @subsection Maxima Language Mode
14534
14535 @noindent
14536 @kindex d X
14537 @pindex calc-maxima-language
14538 @cindex Maxima language
14539 The @kbd{d X} (@code{calc-maxima-language}) command selects the
14540 conventions of Maxima, another free computer algebra system. The
14541 function names in Maxima are similar, but not always identical, to Calc.
14542 For example, instead of @samp{arcsin(x)}, Maxima will use
14543 @samp{asin(x)}. Complex numbers are written @samp{3 + 4 %i}. The
14544 standard special constants are written @code{%pi}, @code{%e},
14545 @code{%i}, @code{%phi} and @code{%gamma}. In Maxima, @code{inf} means
14546 the same as in Calc, but @code{infinity} represents Calc's @code{uinf}.
14547
14548 Underscores as well as percent signs are allowed in function and
14549 variable names in Maxima mode. The underscore again is equivalent to
14550 the @samp{#} in Normal mode, and the percent sign is equivalent to
14551 @samp{o'o}.
14552
14553 Maxima uses square brackets for lists and vectors, and matrices are
14554 written as calls to the function @code{matrix}, given the row vectors of
14555 the matrix as arguments. Square brackets are also used as subscripts.
14556
14557 @node Giac Language Mode, Mathematica Language Mode, Maxima Language Mode, Language Modes
14558 @subsection Giac Language Mode
14559
14560 @noindent
14561 @kindex d A
14562 @pindex calc-giac-language
14563 @cindex Giac language
14564 The @kbd{d A} (@code{calc-giac-language}) command selects the
14565 conventions of Giac, another free computer algebra system. The function
14566 names in Giac are similar to Maxima. Complex numbers are written
14567 @samp{3 + 4 i}. The standard special constants in Giac are the same as
14568 in Calc, except that @code{infinity} represents both Calc's @code{inf}
14569 and @code{uinf}.
14570
14571 Underscores are allowed in function and variable names in Giac mode.
14572 Brackets are used for subscripts. In Giac, indexing of lists begins at
14573 0, instead of 1 as in Calc. So if @samp{A} represents the list
14574 @samp{[a,2,c,4]}, then @samp{A[2]} would equal @samp{c}. In general,
14575 @samp{A[n]} in Giac mode corresponds to @samp{A_(n+1)} in Normal mode.
14576
14577 The Giac interval notation @samp{2 .. 3} has no surrounding brackets;
14578 Calc reads @samp{2 .. 3} as the closed interval @samp{[2 .. 3]} and
14579 writes any kind of interval as @samp{2 .. 3}. This means you cannot see
14580 the difference between an open and a closed interval while in Giac mode.
14581
14582 @node Mathematica Language Mode, Maple Language Mode, Giac Language Mode, Language Modes
14583 @subsection Mathematica Language Mode
14584
14585 @noindent
14586 @kindex d M
14587 @pindex calc-mathematica-language
14588 @cindex Mathematica language
14589 The @kbd{d M} (@code{calc-mathematica-language}) command selects the
14590 conventions of Mathematica. Notable differences in Mathematica mode
14591 are that the names of built-in functions are capitalized, and function
14592 calls use square brackets instead of parentheses. Thus the Calc
14593 formula @samp{sin(2 x)} is entered and displayed @w{@samp{Sin[2 x]}} in
14594 Mathematica mode.
14595
14596 Vectors and matrices use curly braces in Mathematica. Complex numbers
14597 are written @samp{3 + 4 I}. The standard special constants in Calc are
14598 written @code{Pi}, @code{E}, @code{I}, @code{GoldenRatio}, @code{EulerGamma},
14599 @code{Infinity}, @code{ComplexInfinity}, and @code{Indeterminate} in
14600 Mathematica mode.
14601 Non-decimal numbers are written, e.g., @samp{16^^7fff}. Floating-point
14602 numbers in scientific notation are written @samp{1.23*10.^3}.
14603 Subscripts use double square brackets: @samp{a[[i]]}.
14604
14605 @node Maple Language Mode, Compositions, Mathematica Language Mode, Language Modes
14606 @subsection Maple Language Mode
14607
14608 @noindent
14609 @kindex d W
14610 @pindex calc-maple-language
14611 @cindex Maple language
14612 The @kbd{d W} (@code{calc-maple-language}) command selects the
14613 conventions of Maple.
14614
14615 Maple's language is much like C. Underscores are allowed in symbol
14616 names; square brackets are used for subscripts; explicit @samp{*}s for
14617 multiplications are required. Use either @samp{^} or @samp{**} to
14618 denote powers.
14619
14620 Maple uses square brackets for lists and curly braces for sets. Calc
14621 interprets both notations as vectors, and displays vectors with square
14622 brackets. This means Maple sets will be converted to lists when they
14623 pass through Calc. As a special case, matrices are written as calls
14624 to the function @code{matrix}, given a list of lists as the argument,
14625 and can be read in this form or with all-capitals @code{MATRIX}.
14626
14627 The Maple interval notation @samp{2 .. 3} is like Giac's interval
14628 notation, and is handled the same by Calc.
14629
14630 Maple writes complex numbers as @samp{3 + 4*I}. Its special constants
14631 are @code{Pi}, @code{E}, @code{I}, and @code{infinity} (all three of
14632 @code{inf}, @code{uinf}, and @code{nan} display as @code{infinity}).
14633 Floating-point numbers are written @samp{1.23*10.^3}.
14634
14635 Among things not currently handled by Calc's Maple mode are the
14636 various quote symbols, procedures and functional operators, and
14637 inert (@samp{&}) operators.
14638
14639 @node Compositions, Syntax Tables, Maple Language Mode, Language Modes
14640 @subsection Compositions
14641
14642 @noindent
14643 @cindex Compositions
14644 There are several @dfn{composition functions} which allow you to get
14645 displays in a variety of formats similar to those in Big language
14646 mode. Most of these functions do not evaluate to anything; they are
14647 placeholders which are left in symbolic form by Calc's evaluator but
14648 are recognized by Calc's display formatting routines.
14649
14650 Two of these, @code{string} and @code{bstring}, are described elsewhere.
14651 @xref{Strings}. For example, @samp{string("ABC")} is displayed as
14652 @samp{ABC}. When viewed on the stack it will be indistinguishable from
14653 the variable @code{ABC}, but internally it will be stored as
14654 @samp{string([65, 66, 67])} and can still be manipulated this way; for
14655 example, the selection and vector commands @kbd{j 1 v v j u} would
14656 select the vector portion of this object and reverse the elements, then
14657 deselect to reveal a string whose characters had been reversed.
14658
14659 The composition functions do the same thing in all language modes
14660 (although their components will of course be formatted in the current
14661 language mode). The one exception is Unformatted mode (@kbd{d U}),
14662 which does not give the composition functions any special treatment.
14663 The functions are discussed here because of their relationship to
14664 the language modes.
14665
14666 @menu
14667 * Composition Basics::
14668 * Horizontal Compositions::
14669 * Vertical Compositions::
14670 * Other Compositions::
14671 * Information about Compositions::
14672 * User-Defined Compositions::
14673 @end menu
14674
14675 @node Composition Basics, Horizontal Compositions, Compositions, Compositions
14676 @subsubsection Composition Basics
14677
14678 @noindent
14679 Compositions are generally formed by stacking formulas together
14680 horizontally or vertically in various ways. Those formulas are
14681 themselves compositions. @TeX{} users will find this analogous
14682 to @TeX{}'s ``boxes.'' Each multi-line composition has a
14683 @dfn{baseline}; horizontal compositions use the baselines to
14684 decide how formulas should be positioned relative to one another.
14685 For example, in the Big mode formula
14686
14687 @example
14688 @group
14689 2
14690 a + b
14691 17 + ------
14692 c
14693 @end group
14694 @end example
14695
14696 @noindent
14697 the second term of the sum is four lines tall and has line three as
14698 its baseline. Thus when the term is combined with 17, line three
14699 is placed on the same level as the baseline of 17.
14700
14701 @tex
14702 \bigskip
14703 @end tex
14704
14705 Another important composition concept is @dfn{precedence}. This is
14706 an integer that represents the binding strength of various operators.
14707 For example, @samp{*} has higher precedence (195) than @samp{+} (180),
14708 which means that @samp{(a * b) + c} will be formatted without the
14709 parentheses, but @samp{a * (b + c)} will keep the parentheses.
14710
14711 The operator table used by normal and Big language modes has the
14712 following precedences:
14713
14714 @example
14715 _ 1200 @r{(subscripts)}
14716 % 1100 @r{(as in n}%@r{)}
14717 ! 1000 @r{(as in }!@r{n)}
14718 mod 400
14719 +/- 300
14720 !! 210 @r{(as in n}!!@r{)}
14721 ! 210 @r{(as in n}!@r{)}
14722 ^ 200
14723 - 197 @r{(as in }-@r{n)}
14724 * 195 @r{(or implicit multiplication)}
14725 / % \ 190
14726 + - 180 @r{(as in a}+@r{b)}
14727 | 170
14728 < = 160 @r{(and other relations)}
14729 && 110
14730 || 100
14731 ? : 90
14732 !!! 85
14733 &&& 80
14734 ||| 75
14735 := 50
14736 :: 45
14737 => 40
14738 @end example
14739
14740 The general rule is that if an operator with precedence @expr{n}
14741 occurs as an argument to an operator with precedence @expr{m}, then
14742 the argument is enclosed in parentheses if @expr{n < m}. Top-level
14743 expressions and expressions which are function arguments, vector
14744 components, etc., are formatted with precedence zero (so that they
14745 normally never get additional parentheses).
14746
14747 For binary left-associative operators like @samp{+}, the righthand
14748 argument is actually formatted with one-higher precedence than shown
14749 in the table. This makes sure @samp{(a + b) + c} omits the parentheses,
14750 but the unnatural form @samp{a + (b + c)} keeps its parentheses.
14751 Right-associative operators like @samp{^} format the lefthand argument
14752 with one-higher precedence.
14753
14754 @ignore
14755 @starindex
14756 @end ignore
14757 @tindex cprec
14758 The @code{cprec} function formats an expression with an arbitrary
14759 precedence. For example, @samp{cprec(abc, 185)} will combine into
14760 sums and products as follows: @samp{7 + abc}, @samp{7 (abc)} (because
14761 this @code{cprec} form has higher precedence than addition, but lower
14762 precedence than multiplication).
14763
14764 @tex
14765 \bigskip
14766 @end tex
14767
14768 A final composition issue is @dfn{line breaking}. Calc uses two
14769 different strategies for ``flat'' and ``non-flat'' compositions.
14770 A non-flat composition is anything that appears on multiple lines
14771 (not counting line breaking). Examples would be matrices and Big
14772 mode powers and quotients. Non-flat compositions are displayed
14773 exactly as specified. If they come out wider than the current
14774 window, you must use horizontal scrolling (@kbd{<} and @kbd{>}) to
14775 view them.
14776
14777 Flat compositions, on the other hand, will be broken across several
14778 lines if they are too wide to fit the window. Certain points in a
14779 composition are noted internally as @dfn{break points}. Calc's
14780 general strategy is to fill each line as much as possible, then to
14781 move down to the next line starting at the first break point that
14782 didn't fit. However, the line breaker understands the hierarchical
14783 structure of formulas. It will not break an ``inner'' formula if
14784 it can use an earlier break point from an ``outer'' formula instead.
14785 For example, a vector of sums might be formatted as:
14786
14787 @example
14788 @group
14789 [ a + b + c, d + e + f,
14790 g + h + i, j + k + l, m ]
14791 @end group
14792 @end example
14793
14794 @noindent
14795 If the @samp{m} can fit, then so, it seems, could the @samp{g}.
14796 But Calc prefers to break at the comma since the comma is part
14797 of a ``more outer'' formula. Calc would break at a plus sign
14798 only if it had to, say, if the very first sum in the vector had
14799 itself been too large to fit.
14800
14801 Of the composition functions described below, only @code{choriz}
14802 generates break points. The @code{bstring} function (@pxref{Strings})
14803 also generates breakable items: A break point is added after every
14804 space (or group of spaces) except for spaces at the very beginning or
14805 end of the string.
14806
14807 Composition functions themselves count as levels in the formula
14808 hierarchy, so a @code{choriz} that is a component of a larger
14809 @code{choriz} will be less likely to be broken. As a special case,
14810 if a @code{bstring} occurs as a component of a @code{choriz} or
14811 @code{choriz}-like object (such as a vector or a list of arguments
14812 in a function call), then the break points in that @code{bstring}
14813 will be on the same level as the break points of the surrounding
14814 object.
14815
14816 @node Horizontal Compositions, Vertical Compositions, Composition Basics, Compositions
14817 @subsubsection Horizontal Compositions
14818
14819 @noindent
14820 @ignore
14821 @starindex
14822 @end ignore
14823 @tindex choriz
14824 The @code{choriz} function takes a vector of objects and composes
14825 them horizontally. For example, @samp{choriz([17, a b/c, d])} formats
14826 as @w{@samp{17a b / cd}} in Normal language mode, or as
14827
14828 @example
14829 @group
14830 a b
14831 17---d
14832 c
14833 @end group
14834 @end example
14835
14836 @noindent
14837 in Big language mode. This is actually one case of the general
14838 function @samp{choriz(@var{vec}, @var{sep}, @var{prec})}, where
14839 either or both of @var{sep} and @var{prec} may be omitted.
14840 @var{Prec} gives the @dfn{precedence} to use when formatting
14841 each of the components of @var{vec}. The default precedence is
14842 the precedence from the surrounding environment.
14843
14844 @var{Sep} is a string (i.e., a vector of character codes as might
14845 be entered with @code{" "} notation) which should separate components
14846 of the composition. Also, if @var{sep} is given, the line breaker
14847 will allow lines to be broken after each occurrence of @var{sep}.
14848 If @var{sep} is omitted, the composition will not be breakable
14849 (unless any of its component compositions are breakable).
14850
14851 For example, @samp{2 choriz([a, b c, d = e], " + ", 180)} is
14852 formatted as @samp{2 a + b c + (d = e)}. To get the @code{choriz}
14853 to have precedence 180 ``outwards'' as well as ``inwards,''
14854 enclose it in a @code{cprec} form: @samp{2 cprec(choriz(...), 180)}
14855 formats as @samp{2 (a + b c + (d = e))}.
14856
14857 The baseline of a horizontal composition is the same as the
14858 baselines of the component compositions, which are all aligned.
14859
14860 @node Vertical Compositions, Other Compositions, Horizontal Compositions, Compositions
14861 @subsubsection Vertical Compositions
14862
14863 @noindent
14864 @ignore
14865 @starindex
14866 @end ignore
14867 @tindex cvert
14868 The @code{cvert} function makes a vertical composition. Each
14869 component of the vector is centered in a column. The baseline of
14870 the result is by default the top line of the resulting composition.
14871 For example, @samp{f(cvert([a, bb, ccc]), cvert([a^2 + 1, b^2]))}
14872 formats in Big mode as
14873
14874 @example
14875 @group
14876 f( a , 2 )
14877 bb a + 1
14878 ccc 2
14879 b
14880 @end group
14881 @end example
14882
14883 @ignore
14884 @starindex
14885 @end ignore
14886 @tindex cbase
14887 There are several special composition functions that work only as
14888 components of a vertical composition. The @code{cbase} function
14889 controls the baseline of the vertical composition; the baseline
14890 will be the same as the baseline of whatever component is enclosed
14891 in @code{cbase}. Thus @samp{f(cvert([a, cbase(bb), ccc]),
14892 cvert([a^2 + 1, cbase(b^2)]))} displays as
14893
14894 @example
14895 @group
14896 2
14897 a + 1
14898 a 2
14899 f(bb , b )
14900 ccc
14901 @end group
14902 @end example
14903
14904 @ignore
14905 @starindex
14906 @end ignore
14907 @tindex ctbase
14908 @ignore
14909 @starindex
14910 @end ignore
14911 @tindex cbbase
14912 There are also @code{ctbase} and @code{cbbase} functions which
14913 make the baseline of the vertical composition equal to the top
14914 or bottom line (rather than the baseline) of that component.
14915 Thus @samp{cvert([cbase(a / b)]) + cvert([ctbase(a / b)]) +
14916 cvert([cbbase(a / b)])} gives
14917
14918 @example
14919 @group
14920 a
14921 a -
14922 - + a + b
14923 b -
14924 b
14925 @end group
14926 @end example
14927
14928 There should be only one @code{cbase}, @code{ctbase}, or @code{cbbase}
14929 function in a given vertical composition. These functions can also
14930 be written with no arguments: @samp{ctbase()} is a zero-height object
14931 which means the baseline is the top line of the following item, and
14932 @samp{cbbase()} means the baseline is the bottom line of the preceding
14933 item.
14934
14935 @ignore
14936 @starindex
14937 @end ignore
14938 @tindex crule
14939 The @code{crule} function builds a ``rule,'' or horizontal line,
14940 across a vertical composition. By itself @samp{crule()} uses @samp{-}
14941 characters to build the rule. You can specify any other character,
14942 e.g., @samp{crule("=")}. The argument must be a character code or
14943 vector of exactly one character code. It is repeated to match the
14944 width of the widest item in the stack. For example, a quotient
14945 with a thick line is @samp{cvert([a + 1, cbase(crule("=")), b^2])}:
14946
14947 @example
14948 @group
14949 a + 1
14950 =====
14951 2
14952 b
14953 @end group
14954 @end example
14955
14956 @ignore
14957 @starindex
14958 @end ignore
14959 @tindex clvert
14960 @ignore
14961 @starindex
14962 @end ignore
14963 @tindex crvert
14964 Finally, the functions @code{clvert} and @code{crvert} act exactly
14965 like @code{cvert} except that the items are left- or right-justified
14966 in the stack. Thus @samp{clvert([a, bb, ccc]) + crvert([a, bb, ccc])}
14967 gives:
14968
14969 @example
14970 @group
14971 a + a
14972 bb bb
14973 ccc ccc
14974 @end group
14975 @end example
14976
14977 Like @code{choriz}, the vertical compositions accept a second argument
14978 which gives the precedence to use when formatting the components.
14979 Vertical compositions do not support separator strings.
14980
14981 @node Other Compositions, Information about Compositions, Vertical Compositions, Compositions
14982 @subsubsection Other Compositions
14983
14984 @noindent
14985 @ignore
14986 @starindex
14987 @end ignore
14988 @tindex csup
14989 The @code{csup} function builds a superscripted expression. For
14990 example, @samp{csup(a, b)} looks the same as @samp{a^b} does in Big
14991 language mode. This is essentially a horizontal composition of
14992 @samp{a} and @samp{b}, where @samp{b} is shifted up so that its
14993 bottom line is one above the baseline.
14994
14995 @ignore
14996 @starindex
14997 @end ignore
14998 @tindex csub
14999 Likewise, the @code{csub} function builds a subscripted expression.
15000 This shifts @samp{b} down so that its top line is one below the
15001 bottom line of @samp{a} (note that this is not quite analogous to
15002 @code{csup}). Other arrangements can be obtained by using
15003 @code{choriz} and @code{cvert} directly.
15004
15005 @ignore
15006 @starindex
15007 @end ignore
15008 @tindex cflat
15009 The @code{cflat} function formats its argument in ``flat'' mode,
15010 as obtained by @samp{d O}, if the current language mode is normal
15011 or Big. It has no effect in other language modes. For example,
15012 @samp{a^(b/c)} is formatted by Big mode like @samp{csup(a, cflat(b/c))}
15013 to improve its readability.
15014
15015 @ignore
15016 @starindex
15017 @end ignore
15018 @tindex cspace
15019 The @code{cspace} function creates horizontal space. For example,
15020 @samp{cspace(4)} is effectively the same as @samp{string(" ")}.
15021 A second string (i.e., vector of characters) argument is repeated
15022 instead of the space character. For example, @samp{cspace(4, "ab")}
15023 looks like @samp{abababab}. If the second argument is not a string,
15024 it is formatted in the normal way and then several copies of that
15025 are composed together: @samp{cspace(4, a^2)} yields
15026
15027 @example
15028 @group
15029 2 2 2 2
15030 a a a a
15031 @end group
15032 @end example
15033
15034 @noindent
15035 If the number argument is zero, this is a zero-width object.
15036
15037 @ignore
15038 @starindex
15039 @end ignore
15040 @tindex cvspace
15041 The @code{cvspace} function creates vertical space, or a vertical
15042 stack of copies of a certain string or formatted object. The
15043 baseline is the center line of the resulting stack. A numerical
15044 argument of zero will produce an object which contributes zero
15045 height if used in a vertical composition.
15046
15047 @ignore
15048 @starindex
15049 @end ignore
15050 @tindex ctspace
15051 @ignore
15052 @starindex
15053 @end ignore
15054 @tindex cbspace
15055 There are also @code{ctspace} and @code{cbspace} functions which
15056 create vertical space with the baseline the same as the baseline
15057 of the top or bottom copy, respectively, of the second argument.
15058 Thus @samp{cvspace(2, a/b) + ctspace(2, a/b) + cbspace(2, a/b)}
15059 displays as:
15060
15061 @example
15062 @group
15063 a
15064 -
15065 a b
15066 - a a
15067 b + - + -
15068 a b b
15069 - a
15070 b -
15071 b
15072 @end group
15073 @end example
15074
15075 @node Information about Compositions, User-Defined Compositions, Other Compositions, Compositions
15076 @subsubsection Information about Compositions
15077
15078 @noindent
15079 The functions in this section are actual functions; they compose their
15080 arguments according to the current language and other display modes,
15081 then return a certain measurement of the composition as an integer.
15082
15083 @ignore
15084 @starindex
15085 @end ignore
15086 @tindex cwidth
15087 The @code{cwidth} function measures the width, in characters, of a
15088 composition. For example, @samp{cwidth(a + b)} is 5, and
15089 @samp{cwidth(a / b)} is 5 in Normal mode, 1 in Big mode, and 11 in
15090 @TeX{} mode (for @samp{@{a \over b@}}). The argument may involve
15091 the composition functions described in this section.
15092
15093 @ignore
15094 @starindex
15095 @end ignore
15096 @tindex cheight
15097 The @code{cheight} function measures the height of a composition.
15098 This is the total number of lines in the argument's printed form.
15099
15100 @ignore
15101 @starindex
15102 @end ignore
15103 @tindex cascent
15104 @ignore
15105 @starindex
15106 @end ignore
15107 @tindex cdescent
15108 The functions @code{cascent} and @code{cdescent} measure the amount
15109 of the height that is above (and including) the baseline, or below
15110 the baseline, respectively. Thus @samp{cascent(@var{x}) + cdescent(@var{x})}
15111 always equals @samp{cheight(@var{x})}. For a one-line formula like
15112 @samp{a + b}, @code{cascent} returns 1 and @code{cdescent} returns 0.
15113 For @samp{a / b} in Big mode, @code{cascent} returns 2 and @code{cdescent}
15114 returns 1. The only formula for which @code{cascent} will return zero
15115 is @samp{cvspace(0)} or equivalents.
15116
15117 @node User-Defined Compositions, , Information about Compositions, Compositions
15118 @subsubsection User-Defined Compositions
15119
15120 @noindent
15121 @kindex Z C
15122 @pindex calc-user-define-composition
15123 The @kbd{Z C} (@code{calc-user-define-composition}) command lets you
15124 define the display format for any algebraic function. You provide a
15125 formula containing a certain number of argument variables on the stack.
15126 Any time Calc formats a call to the specified function in the current
15127 language mode and with that number of arguments, Calc effectively
15128 replaces the function call with that formula with the arguments
15129 replaced.
15130
15131 Calc builds the default argument list by sorting all the variable names
15132 that appear in the formula into alphabetical order. You can edit this
15133 argument list before pressing @key{RET} if you wish. Any variables in
15134 the formula that do not appear in the argument list will be displayed
15135 literally; any arguments that do not appear in the formula will not
15136 affect the display at all.
15137
15138 You can define formats for built-in functions, for functions you have
15139 defined with @kbd{Z F} (@pxref{Algebraic Definitions}), or for functions
15140 which have no definitions but are being used as purely syntactic objects.
15141 You can define different formats for each language mode, and for each
15142 number of arguments, using a succession of @kbd{Z C} commands. When
15143 Calc formats a function call, it first searches for a format defined
15144 for the current language mode (and number of arguments); if there is
15145 none, it uses the format defined for the Normal language mode. If
15146 neither format exists, Calc uses its built-in standard format for that
15147 function (usually just @samp{@var{func}(@var{args})}).
15148
15149 If you execute @kbd{Z C} with the number 0 on the stack instead of a
15150 formula, any defined formats for the function in the current language
15151 mode will be removed. The function will revert to its standard format.
15152
15153 For example, the default format for the binomial coefficient function
15154 @samp{choose(n, m)} in the Big language mode is
15155
15156 @example
15157 @group
15158 n
15159 ( )
15160 m
15161 @end group
15162 @end example
15163
15164 @noindent
15165 You might prefer the notation,
15166
15167 @example
15168 @group
15169 C
15170 n m
15171 @end group
15172 @end example
15173
15174 @noindent
15175 To define this notation, first make sure you are in Big mode,
15176 then put the formula
15177
15178 @smallexample
15179 choriz([cvert([cvspace(1), n]), C, cvert([cvspace(1), m])])
15180 @end smallexample
15181
15182 @noindent
15183 on the stack and type @kbd{Z C}. Answer the first prompt with
15184 @code{choose}. The second prompt will be the default argument list
15185 of @samp{(C m n)}. Edit this list to be @samp{(n m)} and press
15186 @key{RET}. Now, try it out: For example, turn simplification
15187 off with @kbd{m O} and enter @samp{choose(a,b) + choose(7,3)}
15188 as an algebraic entry.
15189
15190 @example
15191 @group
15192 C + C
15193 a b 7 3
15194 @end group
15195 @end example
15196
15197 As another example, let's define the usual notation for Stirling
15198 numbers of the first kind, @samp{stir1(n, m)}. This is just like
15199 the regular format for binomial coefficients but with square brackets
15200 instead of parentheses.
15201
15202 @smallexample
15203 choriz([string("["), cvert([n, cbase(cvspace(1)), m]), string("]")])
15204 @end smallexample
15205
15206 Now type @kbd{Z C stir1 @key{RET}}, edit the argument list to
15207 @samp{(n m)}, and type @key{RET}.
15208
15209 The formula provided to @kbd{Z C} usually will involve composition
15210 functions, but it doesn't have to. Putting the formula @samp{a + b + c}
15211 onto the stack and typing @kbd{Z C foo @key{RET} @key{RET}} would define
15212 the function @samp{foo(x,y,z)} to display like @samp{x + y + z}.
15213 This ``sum'' will act exactly like a real sum for all formatting
15214 purposes (it will be parenthesized the same, and so on). However
15215 it will be computationally unrelated to a sum. For example, the
15216 formula @samp{2 * foo(1, 2, 3)} will display as @samp{2 (1 + 2 + 3)}.
15217 Operator precedences have caused the ``sum'' to be written in
15218 parentheses, but the arguments have not actually been summed.
15219 (Generally a display format like this would be undesirable, since
15220 it can easily be confused with a real sum.)
15221
15222 The special function @code{eval} can be used inside a @kbd{Z C}
15223 composition formula to cause all or part of the formula to be
15224 evaluated at display time. For example, if the formula is
15225 @samp{a + eval(b + c)}, then @samp{foo(1, 2, 3)} will be displayed
15226 as @samp{1 + 5}. Evaluation will use the default simplifications,
15227 regardless of the current simplification mode. There are also
15228 @code{evalsimp} and @code{evalextsimp} which simplify as if by
15229 @kbd{a s} and @kbd{a e} (respectively). Note that these ``functions''
15230 operate only in the context of composition formulas (and also in
15231 rewrite rules, where they serve a similar purpose; @pxref{Rewrite
15232 Rules}). On the stack, a call to @code{eval} will be left in
15233 symbolic form.
15234
15235 It is not a good idea to use @code{eval} except as a last resort.
15236 It can cause the display of formulas to be extremely slow. For
15237 example, while @samp{eval(a + b)} might seem quite fast and simple,
15238 there are several situations where it could be slow. For example,
15239 @samp{a} and/or @samp{b} could be polar complex numbers, in which
15240 case doing the sum requires trigonometry. Or, @samp{a} could be
15241 the factorial @samp{fact(100)} which is unevaluated because you
15242 have typed @kbd{m O}; @code{eval} will evaluate it anyway to
15243 produce a large, unwieldy integer.
15244
15245 You can save your display formats permanently using the @kbd{Z P}
15246 command (@pxref{Creating User Keys}).
15247
15248 @node Syntax Tables, , Compositions, Language Modes
15249 @subsection Syntax Tables
15250
15251 @noindent
15252 @cindex Syntax tables
15253 @cindex Parsing formulas, customized
15254 Syntax tables do for input what compositions do for output: They
15255 allow you to teach custom notations to Calc's formula parser.
15256 Calc keeps a separate syntax table for each language mode.
15257
15258 (Note that the Calc ``syntax tables'' discussed here are completely
15259 unrelated to the syntax tables described in the Emacs manual.)
15260
15261 @kindex Z S
15262 @pindex calc-edit-user-syntax
15263 The @kbd{Z S} (@code{calc-edit-user-syntax}) command edits the
15264 syntax table for the current language mode. If you want your
15265 syntax to work in any language, define it in the Normal language
15266 mode. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing the syntax table, or
15267 @kbd{C-x k} to cancel the edit. The @kbd{m m} command saves all
15268 the syntax tables along with the other mode settings;
15269 @pxref{General Mode Commands}.
15270
15271 @menu
15272 * Syntax Table Basics::
15273 * Precedence in Syntax Tables::
15274 * Advanced Syntax Patterns::
15275 * Conditional Syntax Rules::
15276 @end menu
15277
15278 @node Syntax Table Basics, Precedence in Syntax Tables, Syntax Tables, Syntax Tables
15279 @subsubsection Syntax Table Basics
15280
15281 @noindent
15282 @dfn{Parsing} is the process of converting a raw string of characters,
15283 such as you would type in during algebraic entry, into a Calc formula.
15284 Calc's parser works in two stages. First, the input is broken down
15285 into @dfn{tokens}, such as words, numbers, and punctuation symbols
15286 like @samp{+}, @samp{:=}, and @samp{+/-}. Space between tokens is
15287 ignored (except when it serves to separate adjacent words). Next,
15288 the parser matches this string of tokens against various built-in
15289 syntactic patterns, such as ``an expression followed by @samp{+}
15290 followed by another expression'' or ``a name followed by @samp{(},
15291 zero or more expressions separated by commas, and @samp{)}.''
15292
15293 A @dfn{syntax table} is a list of user-defined @dfn{syntax rules},
15294 which allow you to specify new patterns to define your own
15295 favorite input notations. Calc's parser always checks the syntax
15296 table for the current language mode, then the table for the Normal
15297 language mode, before it uses its built-in rules to parse an
15298 algebraic formula you have entered. Each syntax rule should go on
15299 its own line; it consists of a @dfn{pattern}, a @samp{:=} symbol,
15300 and a Calc formula with an optional @dfn{condition}. (Syntax rules
15301 resemble algebraic rewrite rules, but the notation for patterns is
15302 completely different.)
15303
15304 A syntax pattern is a list of tokens, separated by spaces.
15305 Except for a few special symbols, tokens in syntax patterns are
15306 matched literally, from left to right. For example, the rule,
15307
15308 @example
15309 foo ( ) := 2+3
15310 @end example
15311
15312 @noindent
15313 would cause Calc to parse the formula @samp{4+foo()*5} as if it
15314 were @samp{4+(2+3)*5}. Notice that the parentheses were written
15315 as two separate tokens in the rule. As a result, the rule works
15316 for both @samp{foo()} and @w{@samp{foo ( )}}. If we had written
15317 the rule as @samp{foo () := 2+3}, then Calc would treat @samp{()}
15318 as a single, indivisible token, so that @w{@samp{foo( )}} would
15319 not be recognized by the rule. (It would be parsed as a regular
15320 zero-argument function call instead.) In fact, this rule would
15321 also make trouble for the rest of Calc's parser: An unrelated
15322 formula like @samp{bar()} would now be tokenized into @samp{bar ()}
15323 instead of @samp{bar ( )}, so that the standard parser for function
15324 calls would no longer recognize it!
15325
15326 While it is possible to make a token with a mixture of letters
15327 and punctuation symbols, this is not recommended. It is better to
15328 break it into several tokens, as we did with @samp{foo()} above.
15329
15330 The symbol @samp{#} in a syntax pattern matches any Calc expression.
15331 On the righthand side, the things that matched the @samp{#}s can
15332 be referred to as @samp{#1}, @samp{#2}, and so on (where @samp{#1}
15333 matches the leftmost @samp{#} in the pattern). For example, these
15334 rules match a user-defined function, prefix operator, infix operator,
15335 and postfix operator, respectively:
15336
15337 @example
15338 foo ( # ) := myfunc(#1)
15339 foo # := myprefix(#1)
15340 # foo # := myinfix(#1,#2)
15341 # foo := mypostfix(#1)
15342 @end example
15343
15344 Thus @samp{foo(3)} will parse as @samp{myfunc(3)}, and @samp{2+3 foo}
15345 will parse as @samp{mypostfix(2+3)}.
15346
15347 It is important to write the first two rules in the order shown,
15348 because Calc tries rules in order from first to last. If the
15349 pattern @samp{foo #} came first, it would match anything that could
15350 match the @samp{foo ( # )} rule, since an expression in parentheses
15351 is itself a valid expression. Thus the @w{@samp{foo ( # )}} rule would
15352 never get to match anything. Likewise, the last two rules must be
15353 written in the order shown or else @samp{3 foo 4} will be parsed as
15354 @samp{mypostfix(3) * 4}. (Of course, the best way to avoid these
15355 ambiguities is not to use the same symbol in more than one way at
15356 the same time! In case you're not convinced, try the following
15357 exercise: How will the above rules parse the input @samp{foo(3,4)},
15358 if at all? Work it out for yourself, then try it in Calc and see.)
15359
15360 Calc is quite flexible about what sorts of patterns are allowed.
15361 The only rule is that every pattern must begin with a literal
15362 token (like @samp{foo} in the first two patterns above), or with
15363 a @samp{#} followed by a literal token (as in the last two
15364 patterns). After that, any mixture is allowed, although putting
15365 two @samp{#}s in a row will not be very useful since two
15366 expressions with nothing between them will be parsed as one
15367 expression that uses implicit multiplication.
15368
15369 As a more practical example, Maple uses the notation
15370 @samp{sum(a(i), i=1..10)} for sums, which Calc's Maple mode doesn't
15371 recognize at present. To handle this syntax, we simply add the
15372 rule,
15373
15374 @example
15375 sum ( # , # = # .. # ) := sum(#1,#2,#3,#4)
15376 @end example
15377
15378 @noindent
15379 to the Maple mode syntax table. As another example, C mode can't
15380 read assignment operators like @samp{++} and @samp{*=}. We can
15381 define these operators quite easily:
15382
15383 @example
15384 # *= # := muleq(#1,#2)
15385 # ++ := postinc(#1)
15386 ++ # := preinc(#1)
15387 @end example
15388
15389 @noindent
15390 To complete the job, we would use corresponding composition functions
15391 and @kbd{Z C} to cause these functions to display in their respective
15392 Maple and C notations. (Note that the C example ignores issues of
15393 operator precedence, which are discussed in the next section.)
15394
15395 You can enclose any token in quotes to prevent its usual
15396 interpretation in syntax patterns:
15397
15398 @example
15399 # ":=" # := becomes(#1,#2)
15400 @end example
15401
15402 Quotes also allow you to include spaces in a token, although once
15403 again it is generally better to use two tokens than one token with
15404 an embedded space. To include an actual quotation mark in a quoted
15405 token, precede it with a backslash. (This also works to include
15406 backslashes in tokens.)
15407
15408 @example
15409 # "bad token" # "/\"\\" # := silly(#1,#2,#3)
15410 @end example
15411
15412 @noindent
15413 This will parse @samp{3 bad token 4 /"\ 5} to @samp{silly(3,4,5)}.
15414
15415 The token @kbd{#} has a predefined meaning in Calc's formula parser;
15416 it is not valid to use @samp{"#"} in a syntax rule. However, longer
15417 tokens that include the @samp{#} character are allowed. Also, while
15418 @samp{"$"} and @samp{"\""} are allowed as tokens, their presence in
15419 the syntax table will prevent those characters from working in their
15420 usual ways (referring to stack entries and quoting strings,
15421 respectively).
15422
15423 Finally, the notation @samp{%%} anywhere in a syntax table causes
15424 the rest of the line to be ignored as a comment.
15425
15426 @node Precedence in Syntax Tables, Advanced Syntax Patterns, Syntax Table Basics, Syntax Tables
15427 @subsubsection Precedence
15428
15429 @noindent
15430 Different operators are generally assigned different @dfn{precedences}.
15431 By default, an operator defined by a rule like
15432
15433 @example
15434 # foo # := foo(#1,#2)
15435 @end example
15436
15437 @noindent
15438 will have an extremely low precedence, so that @samp{2*3+4 foo 5 == 6}
15439 will be parsed as @samp{(2*3+4) foo (5 == 6)}. To change the
15440 precedence of an operator, use the notation @samp{#/@var{p}} in
15441 place of @samp{#}, where @var{p} is an integer precedence level.
15442 For example, 185 lies between the precedences for @samp{+} and
15443 @samp{*}, so if we change this rule to
15444
15445 @example
15446 #/185 foo #/186 := foo(#1,#2)
15447 @end example
15448
15449 @noindent
15450 then @samp{2+3 foo 4*5} will be parsed as @samp{2+(3 foo (4*5))}.
15451 Also, because we've given the righthand expression slightly higher
15452 precedence, our new operator will be left-associative:
15453 @samp{1 foo 2 foo 3} will be parsed as @samp{(1 foo 2) foo 3}.
15454 By raising the precedence of the lefthand expression instead, we
15455 can create a right-associative operator.
15456
15457 @xref{Composition Basics}, for a table of precedences of the
15458 standard Calc operators. For the precedences of operators in other
15459 language modes, look in the Calc source file @file{calc-lang.el}.
15460
15461 @node Advanced Syntax Patterns, Conditional Syntax Rules, Precedence in Syntax Tables, Syntax Tables
15462 @subsubsection Advanced Syntax Patterns
15463
15464 @noindent
15465 To match a function with a variable number of arguments, you could
15466 write
15467
15468 @example
15469 foo ( # ) := myfunc(#1)
15470 foo ( # , # ) := myfunc(#1,#2)
15471 foo ( # , # , # ) := myfunc(#1,#2,#3)
15472 @end example
15473
15474 @noindent
15475 but this isn't very elegant. To match variable numbers of items,
15476 Calc uses some notations inspired regular expressions and the
15477 ``extended BNF'' style used by some language designers.
15478
15479 @example
15480 foo ( @{ # @}*, ) := apply(myfunc,#1)
15481 @end example
15482
15483 The token @samp{@{} introduces a repeated or optional portion.
15484 One of the three tokens @samp{@}*}, @samp{@}+}, or @samp{@}?}
15485 ends the portion. These will match zero or more, one or more,
15486 or zero or one copies of the enclosed pattern, respectively.
15487 In addition, @samp{@}*} and @samp{@}+} can be followed by a
15488 separator token (with no space in between, as shown above).
15489 Thus @samp{@{ # @}*,} matches nothing, or one expression, or
15490 several expressions separated by commas.
15491
15492 A complete @samp{@{ ... @}} item matches as a vector of the
15493 items that matched inside it. For example, the above rule will
15494 match @samp{foo(1,2,3)} to get @samp{apply(myfunc,[1,2,3])}.
15495 The Calc @code{apply} function takes a function name and a vector
15496 of arguments and builds a call to the function with those
15497 arguments, so the net result is the formula @samp{myfunc(1,2,3)}.
15498
15499 If the body of a @samp{@{ ... @}} contains several @samp{#}s
15500 (or nested @samp{@{ ... @}} constructs), then the items will be
15501 strung together into the resulting vector. If the body
15502 does not contain anything but literal tokens, the result will
15503 always be an empty vector.
15504
15505 @example
15506 foo ( @{ # , # @}+, ) := bar(#1)
15507 foo ( @{ @{ # @}*, @}*; ) := matrix(#1)
15508 @end example
15509
15510 @noindent
15511 will parse @samp{foo(1, 2, 3, 4)} as @samp{bar([1, 2, 3, 4])}, and
15512 @samp{foo(1, 2; 3, 4)} as @samp{matrix([[1, 2], [3, 4]])}. Also, after
15513 some thought it's easy to see how this pair of rules will parse
15514 @samp{foo(1, 2, 3)} as @samp{matrix([[1, 2, 3]])}, since the first
15515 rule will only match an even number of arguments. The rule
15516
15517 @example
15518 foo ( # @{ , # , # @}? ) := bar(#1,#2)
15519 @end example
15520
15521 @noindent
15522 will parse @samp{foo(2,3,4)} as @samp{bar(2,[3,4])}, and
15523 @samp{foo(2)} as @samp{bar(2,[])}.
15524
15525 The notation @samp{@{ ... @}?.} (note the trailing period) works
15526 just the same as regular @samp{@{ ... @}?}, except that it does not
15527 count as an argument; the following two rules are equivalent:
15528
15529 @example
15530 foo ( # , @{ also @}? # ) := bar(#1,#3)
15531 foo ( # , @{ also @}?. # ) := bar(#1,#2)
15532 @end example
15533
15534 @noindent
15535 Note that in the first case the optional text counts as @samp{#2},
15536 which will always be an empty vector, but in the second case no
15537 empty vector is produced.
15538
15539 Another variant is @samp{@{ ... @}?$}, which means the body is
15540 optional only at the end of the input formula. All built-in syntax
15541 rules in Calc use this for closing delimiters, so that during
15542 algebraic entry you can type @kbd{[sqrt(2), sqrt(3 @key{RET}}, omitting
15543 the closing parenthesis and bracket. Calc does this automatically
15544 for trailing @samp{)}, @samp{]}, and @samp{>} tokens in syntax
15545 rules, but you can use @samp{@{ ... @}?$} explicitly to get
15546 this effect with any token (such as @samp{"@}"} or @samp{end}).
15547 Like @samp{@{ ... @}?.}, this notation does not count as an
15548 argument. Conversely, you can use quotes, as in @samp{")"}, to
15549 prevent a closing-delimiter token from being automatically treated
15550 as optional.
15551
15552 Calc's parser does not have full backtracking, which means some
15553 patterns will not work as you might expect:
15554
15555 @example
15556 foo ( @{ # , @}? # , # ) := bar(#1,#2,#3)
15557 @end example
15558
15559 @noindent
15560 Here we are trying to make the first argument optional, so that
15561 @samp{foo(2,3)} parses as @samp{bar([],2,3)}. Unfortunately, Calc
15562 first tries to match @samp{2,} against the optional part of the
15563 pattern, finds a match, and so goes ahead to match the rest of the
15564 pattern. Later on it will fail to match the second comma, but it
15565 doesn't know how to go back and try the other alternative at that
15566 point. One way to get around this would be to use two rules:
15567
15568 @example
15569 foo ( # , # , # ) := bar([#1],#2,#3)
15570 foo ( # , # ) := bar([],#1,#2)
15571 @end example
15572
15573 More precisely, when Calc wants to match an optional or repeated
15574 part of a pattern, it scans forward attempting to match that part.
15575 If it reaches the end of the optional part without failing, it
15576 ``finalizes'' its choice and proceeds. If it fails, though, it
15577 backs up and tries the other alternative. Thus Calc has ``partial''
15578 backtracking. A fully backtracking parser would go on to make sure
15579 the rest of the pattern matched before finalizing the choice.
15580
15581 @node Conditional Syntax Rules, , Advanced Syntax Patterns, Syntax Tables
15582 @subsubsection Conditional Syntax Rules
15583
15584 @noindent
15585 It is possible to attach a @dfn{condition} to a syntax rule. For
15586 example, the rules
15587
15588 @example
15589 foo ( # ) := ifoo(#1) :: integer(#1)
15590 foo ( # ) := gfoo(#1)
15591 @end example
15592
15593 @noindent
15594 will parse @samp{foo(3)} as @samp{ifoo(3)}, but will parse
15595 @samp{foo(3.5)} and @samp{foo(x)} as calls to @code{gfoo}. Any
15596 number of conditions may be attached; all must be true for the
15597 rule to succeed. A condition is ``true'' if it evaluates to a
15598 nonzero number. @xref{Logical Operations}, for a list of Calc
15599 functions like @code{integer} that perform logical tests.
15600
15601 The exact sequence of events is as follows: When Calc tries a
15602 rule, it first matches the pattern as usual. It then substitutes
15603 @samp{#1}, @samp{#2}, etc., in the conditions, if any. Next, the
15604 conditions are simplified and evaluated in order from left to right,
15605 as if by the @w{@kbd{a s}} algebra command (@pxref{Simplifying Formulas}).
15606 Each result is true if it is a nonzero number, or an expression
15607 that can be proven to be nonzero (@pxref{Declarations}). If the
15608 results of all conditions are true, the expression (such as
15609 @samp{ifoo(#1)}) has its @samp{#}s substituted, and that is the
15610 result of the parse. If the result of any condition is false, Calc
15611 goes on to try the next rule in the syntax table.
15612
15613 Syntax rules also support @code{let} conditions, which operate in
15614 exactly the same way as they do in algebraic rewrite rules.
15615 @xref{Other Features of Rewrite Rules}, for details. A @code{let}
15616 condition is always true, but as a side effect it defines a
15617 variable which can be used in later conditions, and also in the
15618 expression after the @samp{:=} sign:
15619
15620 @example
15621 foo ( # ) := hifoo(x) :: let(x := #1 + 0.5) :: dnumint(x)
15622 @end example
15623
15624 @noindent
15625 The @code{dnumint} function tests if a value is numerically an
15626 integer, i.e., either a true integer or an integer-valued float.
15627 This rule will parse @code{foo} with a half-integer argument,
15628 like @samp{foo(3.5)}, to a call like @samp{hifoo(4.)}.
15629
15630 The lefthand side of a syntax rule @code{let} must be a simple
15631 variable, not the arbitrary pattern that is allowed in rewrite
15632 rules.
15633
15634 The @code{matches} function is also treated specially in syntax
15635 rule conditions (again, in the same way as in rewrite rules).
15636 @xref{Matching Commands}. If the matching pattern contains
15637 meta-variables, then those meta-variables may be used in later
15638 conditions and in the result expression. The arguments to
15639 @code{matches} are not evaluated in this situation.
15640
15641 @example
15642 sum ( # , # ) := sum(#1,a,b,c) :: matches(#2, a=[b..c])
15643 @end example
15644
15645 @noindent
15646 This is another way to implement the Maple mode @code{sum} notation.
15647 In this approach, we allow @samp{#2} to equal the whole expression
15648 @samp{i=1..10}. Then, we use @code{matches} to break it apart into
15649 its components. If the expression turns out not to match the pattern,
15650 the syntax rule will fail. Note that @kbd{Z S} always uses Calc's
15651 Normal language mode for editing expressions in syntax rules, so we
15652 must use regular Calc notation for the interval @samp{[b..c]} that
15653 will correspond to the Maple mode interval @samp{1..10}.
15654
15655 @node Modes Variable, Calc Mode Line, Language Modes, Mode Settings
15656 @section The @code{Modes} Variable
15657
15658 @noindent
15659 @kindex m g
15660 @pindex calc-get-modes
15661 The @kbd{m g} (@code{calc-get-modes}) command pushes onto the stack
15662 a vector of numbers that describes the various mode settings that
15663 are in effect. With a numeric prefix argument, it pushes only the
15664 @var{n}th mode, i.e., the @var{n}th element of this vector. Keyboard
15665 macros can use the @kbd{m g} command to modify their behavior based
15666 on the current mode settings.
15667
15668 @cindex @code{Modes} variable
15669 @vindex Modes
15670 The modes vector is also available in the special variable
15671 @code{Modes}. In other words, @kbd{m g} is like @kbd{s r Modes @key{RET}}.
15672 It will not work to store into this variable; in fact, if you do,
15673 @code{Modes} will cease to track the current modes. (The @kbd{m g}
15674 command will continue to work, however.)
15675
15676 In general, each number in this vector is suitable as a numeric
15677 prefix argument to the associated mode-setting command. (Recall
15678 that the @kbd{~} key takes a number from the stack and gives it as
15679 a numeric prefix to the next command.)
15680
15681 The elements of the modes vector are as follows:
15682
15683 @enumerate
15684 @item
15685 Current precision. Default is 12; associated command is @kbd{p}.
15686
15687 @item
15688 Binary word size. Default is 32; associated command is @kbd{b w}.
15689
15690 @item
15691 Stack size (not counting the value about to be pushed by @kbd{m g}).
15692 This is zero if @kbd{m g} is executed with an empty stack.
15693
15694 @item
15695 Number radix. Default is 10; command is @kbd{d r}.
15696
15697 @item
15698 Floating-point format. This is the number of digits, plus the
15699 constant 0 for normal notation, 10000 for scientific notation,
15700 20000 for engineering notation, or 30000 for fixed-point notation.
15701 These codes are acceptable as prefix arguments to the @kbd{d n}
15702 command, but note that this may lose information: For example,
15703 @kbd{d s} and @kbd{C-u 12 d s} have similar (but not quite
15704 identical) effects if the current precision is 12, but they both
15705 produce a code of 10012, which will be treated by @kbd{d n} as
15706 @kbd{C-u 12 d s}. If the precision then changes, the float format
15707 will still be frozen at 12 significant figures.
15708
15709 @item
15710 Angular mode. Default is 1 (degrees). Other values are 2 (radians)
15711 and 3 (HMS). The @kbd{m d} command accepts these prefixes.
15712
15713 @item
15714 Symbolic mode. Value is 0 or 1; default is 0. Command is @kbd{m s}.
15715
15716 @item
15717 Fraction mode. Value is 0 or 1; default is 0. Command is @kbd{m f}.
15718
15719 @item
15720 Polar mode. Value is 0 (rectangular) or 1 (polar); default is 0.
15721 Command is @kbd{m p}.
15722
15723 @item
15724 Matrix/Scalar mode. Default value is @mathit{-1}. Value is 0 for Scalar
15725 mode, @mathit{-2} for Matrix mode, @mathit{-3} for square Matrix mode,
15726 or @var{N} for
15727 @texline @math{N\times N}
15728 @infoline @var{N}x@var{N}
15729 Matrix mode. Command is @kbd{m v}.
15730
15731 @item
15732 Simplification mode. Default is 1. Value is @mathit{-1} for off (@kbd{m O}),
15733 0 for @kbd{m N}, 2 for @kbd{m B}, 3 for @kbd{m A}, 4 for @kbd{m E},
15734 or 5 for @w{@kbd{m U}}. The @kbd{m D} command accepts these prefixes.
15735
15736 @item
15737 Infinite mode. Default is @mathit{-1} (off). Value is 1 if the mode is on,
15738 or 0 if the mode is on with positive zeros. Command is @kbd{m i}.
15739 @end enumerate
15740
15741 For example, the sequence @kbd{M-1 m g @key{RET} 2 + ~ p} increases the
15742 precision by two, leaving a copy of the old precision on the stack.
15743 Later, @kbd{~ p} will restore the original precision using that
15744 stack value. (This sequence might be especially useful inside a
15745 keyboard macro.)
15746
15747 As another example, @kbd{M-3 m g 1 - ~ @key{DEL}} deletes all but the
15748 oldest (bottommost) stack entry.
15749
15750 Yet another example: The HP-48 ``round'' command rounds a number
15751 to the current displayed precision. You could roughly emulate this
15752 in Calc with the sequence @kbd{M-5 m g 10000 % ~ c c}. (This
15753 would not work for fixed-point mode, but it wouldn't be hard to
15754 do a full emulation with the help of the @kbd{Z [} and @kbd{Z ]}
15755 programming commands. @xref{Conditionals in Macros}.)
15756
15757 @node Calc Mode Line, , Modes Variable, Mode Settings
15758 @section The Calc Mode Line
15759
15760 @noindent
15761 @cindex Mode line indicators
15762 This section is a summary of all symbols that can appear on the
15763 Calc mode line, the highlighted bar that appears under the Calc
15764 stack window (or under an editing window in Embedded mode).
15765
15766 The basic mode line format is:
15767
15768 @example
15769 --%*-Calc: 12 Deg @var{other modes} (Calculator)
15770 @end example
15771
15772 The @samp{%*} indicates that the buffer is ``read-only''; it shows that
15773 regular Emacs commands are not allowed to edit the stack buffer
15774 as if it were text.
15775
15776 The word @samp{Calc:} changes to @samp{CalcEmbed:} if Embedded mode
15777 is enabled. The words after this describe the various Calc modes
15778 that are in effect.
15779
15780 The first mode is always the current precision, an integer.
15781 The second mode is always the angular mode, either @code{Deg},
15782 @code{Rad}, or @code{Hms}.
15783
15784 Here is a complete list of the remaining symbols that can appear
15785 on the mode line:
15786
15787 @table @code
15788 @item Alg
15789 Algebraic mode (@kbd{m a}; @pxref{Algebraic Entry}).
15790
15791 @item Alg[(
15792 Incomplete algebraic mode (@kbd{C-u m a}).
15793
15794 @item Alg*
15795 Total algebraic mode (@kbd{m t}).
15796
15797 @item Symb
15798 Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s}; @pxref{Symbolic Mode}).
15799
15800 @item Matrix
15801 Matrix mode (@kbd{m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15802
15803 @item Matrix@var{n}
15804 Dimensioned Matrix mode (@kbd{C-u @var{n} m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15805
15806 @item SqMatrix
15807 Square Matrix mode (@kbd{C-u m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15808
15809 @item Scalar
15810 Scalar mode (@kbd{m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15811
15812 @item Polar
15813 Polar complex mode (@kbd{m p}; @pxref{Polar Mode}).
15814
15815 @item Frac
15816 Fraction mode (@kbd{m f}; @pxref{Fraction Mode}).
15817
15818 @item Inf
15819 Infinite mode (@kbd{m i}; @pxref{Infinite Mode}).
15820
15821 @item +Inf
15822 Positive Infinite mode (@kbd{C-u 0 m i}).
15823
15824 @item NoSimp
15825 Default simplifications off (@kbd{m O}; @pxref{Simplification Modes}).
15826
15827 @item NumSimp
15828 Default simplifications for numeric arguments only (@kbd{m N}).
15829
15830 @item BinSimp@var{w}
15831 Binary-integer simplification mode; word size @var{w} (@kbd{m B}, @kbd{b w}).
15832
15833 @item AlgSimp
15834 Algebraic simplification mode (@kbd{m A}).
15835
15836 @item ExtSimp
15837 Extended algebraic simplification mode (@kbd{m E}).
15838
15839 @item UnitSimp
15840 Units simplification mode (@kbd{m U}).
15841
15842 @item Bin
15843 Current radix is 2 (@kbd{d 2}; @pxref{Radix Modes}).
15844
15845 @item Oct
15846 Current radix is 8 (@kbd{d 8}).
15847
15848 @item Hex
15849 Current radix is 16 (@kbd{d 6}).
15850
15851 @item Radix@var{n}
15852 Current radix is @var{n} (@kbd{d r}).
15853
15854 @item Zero
15855 Leading zeros (@kbd{d z}; @pxref{Radix Modes}).
15856
15857 @item Big
15858 Big language mode (@kbd{d B}; @pxref{Normal Language Modes}).
15859
15860 @item Flat
15861 One-line normal language mode (@kbd{d O}).
15862
15863 @item Unform
15864 Unformatted language mode (@kbd{d U}).
15865
15866 @item C
15867 C language mode (@kbd{d C}; @pxref{C FORTRAN Pascal}).
15868
15869 @item Pascal
15870 Pascal language mode (@kbd{d P}).
15871
15872 @item Fortran
15873 FORTRAN language mode (@kbd{d F}).
15874
15875 @item TeX
15876 @TeX{} language mode (@kbd{d T}; @pxref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}).
15877
15878 @item LaTeX
15879 La@TeX{} language mode (@kbd{d L}; @pxref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}).
15880
15881 @item Eqn
15882 @dfn{Eqn} language mode (@kbd{d E}; @pxref{Eqn Language Mode}).
15883
15884 @item Math
15885 Mathematica language mode (@kbd{d M}; @pxref{Mathematica Language Mode}).
15886
15887 @item Maple
15888 Maple language mode (@kbd{d W}; @pxref{Maple Language Mode}).
15889
15890 @item Norm@var{n}
15891 Normal float mode with @var{n} digits (@kbd{d n}; @pxref{Float Formats}).
15892
15893 @item Fix@var{n}
15894 Fixed point mode with @var{n} digits after the point (@kbd{d f}).
15895
15896 @item Sci
15897 Scientific notation mode (@kbd{d s}).
15898
15899 @item Sci@var{n}
15900 Scientific notation with @var{n} digits (@kbd{d s}).
15901
15902 @item Eng
15903 Engineering notation mode (@kbd{d e}).
15904
15905 @item Eng@var{n}
15906 Engineering notation with @var{n} digits (@kbd{d e}).
15907
15908 @item Left@var{n}
15909 Left-justified display indented by @var{n} (@kbd{d <}; @pxref{Justification}).
15910
15911 @item Right
15912 Right-justified display (@kbd{d >}).
15913
15914 @item Right@var{n}
15915 Right-justified display with width @var{n} (@kbd{d >}).
15916
15917 @item Center
15918 Centered display (@kbd{d =}).
15919
15920 @item Center@var{n}
15921 Centered display with center column @var{n} (@kbd{d =}).
15922
15923 @item Wid@var{n}
15924 Line breaking with width @var{n} (@kbd{d b}; @pxref{Normal Language Modes}).
15925
15926 @item Wide
15927 No line breaking (@kbd{d b}).
15928
15929 @item Break
15930 Selections show deep structure (@kbd{j b}; @pxref{Making Selections}).
15931
15932 @item Save
15933 Record modes in @file{~/.calc.el} (@kbd{m R}; @pxref{General Mode Commands}).
15934
15935 @item Local
15936 Record modes in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
15937
15938 @item LocEdit
15939 Record modes as editing-only in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
15940
15941 @item LocPerm
15942 Record modes as permanent-only in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
15943
15944 @item Global
15945 Record modes as global in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
15946
15947 @item Manual
15948 Automatic recomputation turned off (@kbd{m C}; @pxref{Automatic
15949 Recomputation}).
15950
15951 @item Graph
15952 GNUPLOT process is alive in background (@pxref{Graphics}).
15953
15954 @item Sel
15955 Top-of-stack has a selection (Embedded only; @pxref{Making Selections}).
15956
15957 @item Dirty
15958 The stack display may not be up-to-date (@pxref{Display Modes}).
15959
15960 @item Inv
15961 ``Inverse'' prefix was pressed (@kbd{I}; @pxref{Inverse and Hyperbolic}).
15962
15963 @item Hyp
15964 ``Hyperbolic'' prefix was pressed (@kbd{H}).
15965
15966 @item Keep
15967 ``Keep-arguments'' prefix was pressed (@kbd{K}).
15968
15969 @item Narrow
15970 Stack is truncated (@kbd{d t}; @pxref{Truncating the Stack}).
15971 @end table
15972
15973 In addition, the symbols @code{Active} and @code{~Active} can appear
15974 as minor modes on an Embedded buffer's mode line. @xref{Embedded Mode}.
15975
15976 @node Arithmetic, Scientific Functions, Mode Settings, Top
15977 @chapter Arithmetic Functions
15978
15979 @noindent
15980 This chapter describes the Calc commands for doing simple calculations
15981 on numbers, such as addition, absolute value, and square roots. These
15982 commands work by removing the top one or two values from the stack,
15983 performing the desired operation, and pushing the result back onto the
15984 stack. If the operation cannot be performed, the result pushed is a
15985 formula instead of a number, such as @samp{2/0} (because division by zero
15986 is invalid) or @samp{sqrt(x)} (because the argument @samp{x} is a formula).
15987
15988 Most of the commands described here can be invoked by a single keystroke.
15989 Some of the more obscure ones are two-letter sequences beginning with
15990 the @kbd{f} (``functions'') prefix key.
15991
15992 @xref{Prefix Arguments}, for a discussion of the effect of numeric
15993 prefix arguments on commands in this chapter which do not otherwise
15994 interpret a prefix argument.
15995
15996 @menu
15997 * Basic Arithmetic::
15998 * Integer Truncation::
15999 * Complex Number Functions::
16000 * Conversions::
16001 * Date Arithmetic::
16002 * Financial Functions::
16003 * Binary Functions::
16004 @end menu
16005
16006 @node Basic Arithmetic, Integer Truncation, Arithmetic, Arithmetic
16007 @section Basic Arithmetic
16008
16009 @noindent
16010 @kindex +
16011 @pindex calc-plus
16012 @ignore
16013 @mindex @null
16014 @end ignore
16015 @tindex +
16016 The @kbd{+} (@code{calc-plus}) command adds two numbers. The numbers may
16017 be any of the standard Calc data types. The resulting sum is pushed back
16018 onto the stack.
16019
16020 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are vectors or matrices (of matching dimensions),
16021 the result is a vector or matrix sum. If one argument is a vector and the
16022 other a scalar (i.e., a non-vector), the scalar is added to each of the
16023 elements of the vector to form a new vector. If the scalar is not a
16024 number, the operation is left in symbolic form: Suppose you added @samp{x}
16025 to the vector @samp{[1,2]}. You may want the result @samp{[1+x,2+x]}, or
16026 you may plan to substitute a 2-vector for @samp{x} in the future. Since
16027 the Calculator can't tell which interpretation you want, it makes the
16028 safest assumption. @xref{Reducing and Mapping}, for a way to add @samp{x}
16029 to every element of a vector.
16030
16031 If either argument of @kbd{+} is a complex number, the result will in general
16032 be complex. If one argument is in rectangular form and the other polar,
16033 the current Polar mode determines the form of the result. If Symbolic
16034 mode is enabled, the sum may be left as a formula if the necessary
16035 conversions for polar addition are non-trivial.
16036
16037 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are HMS forms, the forms are added according to
16038 the usual conventions of hours-minutes-seconds notation. If one argument
16039 is an HMS form and the other is a number, that number is converted from
16040 degrees or radians (depending on the current Angular mode) to HMS format
16041 and then the two HMS forms are added.
16042
16043 If one argument of @kbd{+} is a date form, the other can be either a
16044 real number, which advances the date by a certain number of days, or
16045 an HMS form, which advances the date by a certain amount of time.
16046 Subtracting two date forms yields the number of days between them.
16047 Adding two date forms is meaningless, but Calc interprets it as the
16048 subtraction of one date form and the negative of the other. (The
16049 negative of a date form can be understood by remembering that dates
16050 are stored as the number of days before or after Jan 1, 1 AD.)
16051
16052 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are error forms, the result is an error form
16053 with an appropriately computed standard deviation. If one argument is an
16054 error form and the other is a number, the number is taken to have zero error.
16055 Error forms may have symbolic formulas as their mean and/or error parts;
16056 adding these will produce a symbolic error form result. However, adding an
16057 error form to a plain symbolic formula (as in @samp{(a +/- b) + c}) will not
16058 work, for the same reasons just mentioned for vectors. Instead you must
16059 write @samp{(a +/- b) + (c +/- 0)}.
16060
16061 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are modulo forms with equal values of @expr{M},
16062 or if one argument is a modulo form and the other a plain number, the
16063 result is a modulo form which represents the sum, modulo @expr{M}, of
16064 the two values.
16065
16066 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are intervals, the result is an interval
16067 which describes all possible sums of the possible input values. If
16068 one argument is a plain number, it is treated as the interval
16069 @w{@samp{[x ..@: x]}}.
16070
16071 If one argument of @kbd{+} is an infinity and the other is not, the
16072 result is that same infinity. If both arguments are infinite and in
16073 the same direction, the result is the same infinity, but if they are
16074 infinite in different directions the result is @code{nan}.
16075
16076 @kindex -
16077 @pindex calc-minus
16078 @ignore
16079 @mindex @null
16080 @end ignore
16081 @tindex -
16082 The @kbd{-} (@code{calc-minus}) command subtracts two values. The top
16083 number on the stack is subtracted from the one behind it, so that the
16084 computation @kbd{5 @key{RET} 2 -} produces 3, not @mathit{-3}. All options
16085 available for @kbd{+} are available for @kbd{-} as well.
16086
16087 @kindex *
16088 @pindex calc-times
16089 @ignore
16090 @mindex @null
16091 @end ignore
16092 @tindex *
16093 The @kbd{*} (@code{calc-times}) command multiplies two numbers. If one
16094 argument is a vector and the other a scalar, the scalar is multiplied by
16095 the elements of the vector to produce a new vector. If both arguments
16096 are vectors, the interpretation depends on the dimensions of the
16097 vectors: If both arguments are matrices, a matrix multiplication is
16098 done. If one argument is a matrix and the other a plain vector, the
16099 vector is interpreted as a row vector or column vector, whichever is
16100 dimensionally correct. If both arguments are plain vectors, the result
16101 is a single scalar number which is the dot product of the two vectors.
16102
16103 If one argument of @kbd{*} is an HMS form and the other a number, the
16104 HMS form is multiplied by that amount. It is an error to multiply two
16105 HMS forms together, or to attempt any multiplication involving date
16106 forms. Error forms, modulo forms, and intervals can be multiplied;
16107 see the comments for addition of those forms. When two error forms
16108 or intervals are multiplied they are considered to be statistically
16109 independent; thus, @samp{[-2 ..@: 3] * [-2 ..@: 3]} is @samp{[-6 ..@: 9]},
16110 whereas @w{@samp{[-2 ..@: 3] ^ 2}} is @samp{[0 ..@: 9]}.
16111
16112 @kindex /
16113 @pindex calc-divide
16114 @ignore
16115 @mindex @null
16116 @end ignore
16117 @tindex /
16118 The @kbd{/} (@code{calc-divide}) command divides two numbers.
16119
16120 When combining multiplication and division in an algebraic formula, it
16121 is good style to use parentheses to distinguish between possible
16122 interpretations; the expression @samp{a/b*c} should be written
16123 @samp{(a/b)*c} or @samp{a/(b*c)}, as appropriate. Without the
16124 parentheses, Calc will interpret @samp{a/b*c} as @samp{a/(b*c)}, since
16125 in algebraic entry Calc gives division a lower precedence than
16126 multiplication. (This is not standard across all computer languages, and
16127 Calc may change the precedence depending on the language mode being used.
16128 @xref{Language Modes}.) This default ordering can be changed by setting
16129 the customizable variable @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} to
16130 @code{nil} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}); this will give multiplication and
16131 division equal precedences. Note that Calc's default choice of
16132 precedence allows @samp{a b / c d} to be used as a shortcut for
16133 @smallexample
16134 @group
16135 a b
16136 ---.
16137 c d
16138 @end group
16139 @end smallexample
16140
16141 When dividing a scalar @expr{B} by a square matrix @expr{A}, the
16142 computation performed is @expr{B} times the inverse of @expr{A}. This
16143 also occurs if @expr{B} is itself a vector or matrix, in which case the
16144 effect is to solve the set of linear equations represented by @expr{B}.
16145 If @expr{B} is a matrix with the same number of rows as @expr{A}, or a
16146 plain vector (which is interpreted here as a column vector), then the
16147 equation @expr{A X = B} is solved for the vector or matrix @expr{X}.
16148 Otherwise, if @expr{B} is a non-square matrix with the same number of
16149 @emph{columns} as @expr{A}, the equation @expr{X A = B} is solved. If
16150 you wish a vector @expr{B} to be interpreted as a row vector to be
16151 solved as @expr{X A = B}, make it into a one-row matrix with @kbd{C-u 1
16152 v p} first. To force a left-handed solution with a square matrix
16153 @expr{B}, transpose @expr{A} and @expr{B} before dividing, then
16154 transpose the result.
16155
16156 HMS forms can be divided by real numbers or by other HMS forms. Error
16157 forms can be divided in any combination of ways. Modulo forms where both
16158 values and the modulo are integers can be divided to get an integer modulo
16159 form result. Intervals can be divided; dividing by an interval that
16160 encompasses zero or has zero as a limit will result in an infinite
16161 interval.
16162
16163 @kindex ^
16164 @pindex calc-power
16165 @ignore
16166 @mindex @null
16167 @end ignore
16168 @tindex ^
16169 The @kbd{^} (@code{calc-power}) command raises a number to a power. If
16170 the power is an integer, an exact result is computed using repeated
16171 multiplications. For non-integer powers, Calc uses Newton's method or
16172 logarithms and exponentials. Square matrices can be raised to integer
16173 powers. If either argument is an error (or interval or modulo) form,
16174 the result is also an error (or interval or modulo) form.
16175
16176 @kindex I ^
16177 @tindex nroot
16178 If you press the @kbd{I} (inverse) key first, the @kbd{I ^} command
16179 computes an Nth root: @kbd{125 @key{RET} 3 I ^} computes the number 5.
16180 (This is entirely equivalent to @kbd{125 @key{RET} 1:3 ^}.)
16181
16182 @kindex \
16183 @pindex calc-idiv
16184 @tindex idiv
16185 @ignore
16186 @mindex @null
16187 @end ignore
16188 @tindex \
16189 The @kbd{\} (@code{calc-idiv}) command divides two numbers on the stack
16190 to produce an integer result. It is equivalent to dividing with
16191 @key{/}, then rounding down with @kbd{F} (@code{calc-floor}), only a bit
16192 more convenient and efficient. Also, since it is an all-integer
16193 operation when the arguments are integers, it avoids problems that
16194 @kbd{/ F} would have with floating-point roundoff.
16195
16196 @kindex %
16197 @pindex calc-mod
16198 @ignore
16199 @mindex @null
16200 @end ignore
16201 @tindex %
16202 The @kbd{%} (@code{calc-mod}) command performs a ``modulo'' (or ``remainder'')
16203 operation. Mathematically, @samp{a%b = a - (a\b)*b}, and is defined
16204 for all real numbers @expr{a} and @expr{b} (except @expr{b=0}). For
16205 positive @expr{b}, the result will always be between 0 (inclusive) and
16206 @expr{b} (exclusive). Modulo does not work for HMS forms and error forms.
16207 If @expr{a} is a modulo form, its modulo is changed to @expr{b}, which
16208 must be positive real number.
16209
16210 @kindex :
16211 @pindex calc-fdiv
16212 @tindex fdiv
16213 The @kbd{:} (@code{calc-fdiv}) [@code{fdiv}] command
16214 divides the two integers on the top of the stack to produce a fractional
16215 result. This is a convenient shorthand for enabling Fraction mode (with
16216 @kbd{m f}) temporarily and using @samp{/}. Note that during numeric entry
16217 the @kbd{:} key is interpreted as a fraction separator, so to divide 8 by 6
16218 you would have to type @kbd{8 @key{RET} 6 @key{RET} :}. (Of course, in
16219 this case, it would be much easier simply to enter the fraction directly
16220 as @kbd{8:6 @key{RET}}!)
16221
16222 @kindex n
16223 @pindex calc-change-sign
16224 The @kbd{n} (@code{calc-change-sign}) command negates the number on the top
16225 of the stack. It works on numbers, vectors and matrices, HMS forms, date
16226 forms, error forms, intervals, and modulo forms.
16227
16228 @kindex A
16229 @pindex calc-abs
16230 @tindex abs
16231 The @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs}) [@code{abs}] command computes the absolute
16232 value of a number. The result of @code{abs} is always a nonnegative
16233 real number: With a complex argument, it computes the complex magnitude.
16234 With a vector or matrix argument, it computes the Frobenius norm, i.e.,
16235 the square root of the sum of the squares of the absolute values of the
16236 elements. The absolute value of an error form is defined by replacing
16237 the mean part with its absolute value and leaving the error part the same.
16238 The absolute value of a modulo form is undefined. The absolute value of
16239 an interval is defined in the obvious way.
16240
16241 @kindex f A
16242 @pindex calc-abssqr
16243 @tindex abssqr
16244 The @kbd{f A} (@code{calc-abssqr}) [@code{abssqr}] command computes the
16245 absolute value squared of a number, vector or matrix, or error form.
16246
16247 @kindex f s
16248 @pindex calc-sign
16249 @tindex sign
16250 The @kbd{f s} (@code{calc-sign}) [@code{sign}] command returns 1 if its
16251 argument is positive, @mathit{-1} if its argument is negative, or 0 if its
16252 argument is zero. In algebraic form, you can also write @samp{sign(a,x)}
16253 which evaluates to @samp{x * sign(a)}, i.e., either @samp{x}, @samp{-x}, or
16254 zero depending on the sign of @samp{a}.
16255
16256 @kindex &
16257 @pindex calc-inv
16258 @tindex inv
16259 @cindex Reciprocal
16260 The @kbd{&} (@code{calc-inv}) [@code{inv}] command computes the
16261 reciprocal of a number, i.e., @expr{1 / x}. Operating on a square
16262 matrix, it computes the inverse of that matrix.
16263
16264 @kindex Q
16265 @pindex calc-sqrt
16266 @tindex sqrt
16267 The @kbd{Q} (@code{calc-sqrt}) [@code{sqrt}] command computes the square
16268 root of a number. For a negative real argument, the result will be a
16269 complex number whose form is determined by the current Polar mode.
16270
16271 @kindex f h
16272 @pindex calc-hypot
16273 @tindex hypot
16274 The @kbd{f h} (@code{calc-hypot}) [@code{hypot}] command computes the square
16275 root of the sum of the squares of two numbers. That is, @samp{hypot(a,b)}
16276 is the length of the hypotenuse of a right triangle with sides @expr{a}
16277 and @expr{b}. If the arguments are complex numbers, their squared
16278 magnitudes are used.
16279
16280 @kindex f Q
16281 @pindex calc-isqrt
16282 @tindex isqrt
16283 The @kbd{f Q} (@code{calc-isqrt}) [@code{isqrt}] command computes the
16284 integer square root of an integer. This is the true square root of the
16285 number, rounded down to an integer. For example, @samp{isqrt(10)}
16286 produces 3. Note that, like @kbd{\} [@code{idiv}], this uses exact
16287 integer arithmetic throughout to avoid roundoff problems. If the input
16288 is a floating-point number or other non-integer value, this is exactly
16289 the same as @samp{floor(sqrt(x))}.
16290
16291 @kindex f n
16292 @kindex f x
16293 @pindex calc-min
16294 @tindex min
16295 @pindex calc-max
16296 @tindex max
16297 The @kbd{f n} (@code{calc-min}) [@code{min}] and @kbd{f x} (@code{calc-max})
16298 [@code{max}] commands take the minimum or maximum of two real numbers,
16299 respectively. These commands also work on HMS forms, date forms,
16300 intervals, and infinities. (In algebraic expressions, these functions
16301 take any number of arguments and return the maximum or minimum among
16302 all the arguments.)
16303
16304 @kindex f M
16305 @kindex f X
16306 @pindex calc-mant-part
16307 @tindex mant
16308 @pindex calc-xpon-part
16309 @tindex xpon
16310 The @kbd{f M} (@code{calc-mant-part}) [@code{mant}] function extracts
16311 the ``mantissa'' part @expr{m} of its floating-point argument; @kbd{f X}
16312 (@code{calc-xpon-part}) [@code{xpon}] extracts the ``exponent'' part
16313 @expr{e}. The original number is equal to
16314 @texline @math{m \times 10^e},
16315 @infoline @expr{m * 10^e},
16316 where @expr{m} is in the interval @samp{[1.0 ..@: 10.0)} except that
16317 @expr{m=e=0} if the original number is zero. For integers
16318 and fractions, @code{mant} returns the number unchanged and @code{xpon}
16319 returns zero. The @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) command can also be
16320 used to ``unpack'' a floating-point number; this produces an integer
16321 mantissa and exponent, with the constraint that the mantissa is not
16322 a multiple of ten (again except for the @expr{m=e=0} case).
16323
16324 @kindex f S
16325 @pindex calc-scale-float
16326 @tindex scf
16327 The @kbd{f S} (@code{calc-scale-float}) [@code{scf}] function scales a number
16328 by a given power of ten. Thus, @samp{scf(mant(x), xpon(x)) = x} for any
16329 real @samp{x}. The second argument must be an integer, but the first
16330 may actually be any numeric value. For example, @samp{scf(5,-2) = 0.05}
16331 or @samp{1:20} depending on the current Fraction mode.
16332
16333 @kindex f [
16334 @kindex f ]
16335 @pindex calc-decrement
16336 @pindex calc-increment
16337 @tindex decr
16338 @tindex incr
16339 The @kbd{f [} (@code{calc-decrement}) [@code{decr}] and @kbd{f ]}
16340 (@code{calc-increment}) [@code{incr}] functions decrease or increase
16341 a number by one unit. For integers, the effect is obvious. For
16342 floating-point numbers, the change is by one unit in the last place.
16343 For example, incrementing @samp{12.3456} when the current precision
16344 is 6 digits yields @samp{12.3457}. If the current precision had been
16345 8 digits, the result would have been @samp{12.345601}. Incrementing
16346 @samp{0.0} produces
16347 @texline @math{10^{-p}},
16348 @infoline @expr{10^-p},
16349 where @expr{p} is the current
16350 precision. These operations are defined only on integers and floats.
16351 With numeric prefix arguments, they change the number by @expr{n} units.
16352
16353 Note that incrementing followed by decrementing, or vice-versa, will
16354 almost but not quite always cancel out. Suppose the precision is
16355 6 digits and the number @samp{9.99999} is on the stack. Incrementing
16356 will produce @samp{10.0000}; decrementing will produce @samp{9.9999}.
16357 One digit has been dropped. This is an unavoidable consequence of the
16358 way floating-point numbers work.
16359
16360 Incrementing a date/time form adjusts it by a certain number of seconds.
16361 Incrementing a pure date form adjusts it by a certain number of days.
16362
16363 @node Integer Truncation, Complex Number Functions, Basic Arithmetic, Arithmetic
16364 @section Integer Truncation
16365
16366 @noindent
16367 There are four commands for truncating a real number to an integer,
16368 differing mainly in their treatment of negative numbers. All of these
16369 commands have the property that if the argument is an integer, the result
16370 is the same integer. An integer-valued floating-point argument is converted
16371 to integer form.
16372
16373 If you press @kbd{H} (@code{calc-hyperbolic}) first, the result will be
16374 expressed as an integer-valued floating-point number.
16375
16376 @cindex Integer part of a number
16377 @kindex F
16378 @pindex calc-floor
16379 @tindex floor
16380 @tindex ffloor
16381 @ignore
16382 @mindex @null
16383 @end ignore
16384 @kindex H F
16385 The @kbd{F} (@code{calc-floor}) [@code{floor} or @code{ffloor}] command
16386 truncates a real number to the next lower integer, i.e., toward minus
16387 infinity. Thus @kbd{3.6 F} produces 3, but @kbd{_3.6 F} produces
16388 @mathit{-4}.
16389
16390 @kindex I F
16391 @pindex calc-ceiling
16392 @tindex ceil
16393 @tindex fceil
16394 @ignore
16395 @mindex @null
16396 @end ignore
16397 @kindex H I F
16398 The @kbd{I F} (@code{calc-ceiling}) [@code{ceil} or @code{fceil}]
16399 command truncates toward positive infinity. Thus @kbd{3.6 I F} produces
16400 4, and @kbd{_3.6 I F} produces @mathit{-3}.
16401
16402 @kindex R
16403 @pindex calc-round
16404 @tindex round
16405 @tindex fround
16406 @ignore
16407 @mindex @null
16408 @end ignore
16409 @kindex H R
16410 The @kbd{R} (@code{calc-round}) [@code{round} or @code{fround}] command
16411 rounds to the nearest integer. When the fractional part is .5 exactly,
16412 this command rounds away from zero. (All other rounding in the
16413 Calculator uses this convention as well.) Thus @kbd{3.5 R} produces 4
16414 but @kbd{3.4 R} produces 3; @kbd{_3.5 R} produces @mathit{-4}.
16415
16416 @kindex I R
16417 @pindex calc-trunc
16418 @tindex trunc
16419 @tindex ftrunc
16420 @ignore
16421 @mindex @null
16422 @end ignore
16423 @kindex H I R
16424 The @kbd{I R} (@code{calc-trunc}) [@code{trunc} or @code{ftrunc}]
16425 command truncates toward zero. In other words, it ``chops off''
16426 everything after the decimal point. Thus @kbd{3.6 I R} produces 3 and
16427 @kbd{_3.6 I R} produces @mathit{-3}.
16428
16429 These functions may not be applied meaningfully to error forms, but they
16430 do work for intervals. As a convenience, applying @code{floor} to a
16431 modulo form floors the value part of the form. Applied to a vector,
16432 these functions operate on all elements of the vector one by one.
16433 Applied to a date form, they operate on the internal numerical
16434 representation of dates, converting a date/time form into a pure date.
16435
16436 @ignore
16437 @starindex
16438 @end ignore
16439 @tindex rounde
16440 @ignore
16441 @starindex
16442 @end ignore
16443 @tindex roundu
16444 @ignore
16445 @starindex
16446 @end ignore
16447 @tindex frounde
16448 @ignore
16449 @starindex
16450 @end ignore
16451 @tindex froundu
16452 There are two more rounding functions which can only be entered in
16453 algebraic notation. The @code{roundu} function is like @code{round}
16454 except that it rounds up, toward plus infinity, when the fractional
16455 part is .5. This distinction matters only for negative arguments.
16456 Also, @code{rounde} rounds to an even number in the case of a tie,
16457 rounding up or down as necessary. For example, @samp{rounde(3.5)} and
16458 @samp{rounde(4.5)} both return 4, but @samp{rounde(5.5)} returns 6.
16459 The advantage of round-to-even is that the net error due to rounding
16460 after a long calculation tends to cancel out to zero. An important
16461 subtle point here is that the number being fed to @code{rounde} will
16462 already have been rounded to the current precision before @code{rounde}
16463 begins. For example, @samp{rounde(2.500001)} with a current precision
16464 of 6 will incorrectly, or at least surprisingly, yield 2 because the
16465 argument will first have been rounded down to @expr{2.5} (which
16466 @code{rounde} sees as an exact tie between 2 and 3).
16467
16468 Each of these functions, when written in algebraic formulas, allows
16469 a second argument which specifies the number of digits after the
16470 decimal point to keep. For example, @samp{round(123.4567, 2)} will
16471 produce the answer 123.46, and @samp{round(123.4567, -1)} will
16472 produce 120 (i.e., the cutoff is one digit to the @emph{left} of
16473 the decimal point). A second argument of zero is equivalent to
16474 no second argument at all.
16475
16476 @cindex Fractional part of a number
16477 To compute the fractional part of a number (i.e., the amount which, when
16478 added to `@tfn{floor(}@var{n}@tfn{)}', will produce @var{n}) just take @var{n}
16479 modulo 1 using the @code{%} command.
16480
16481 Note also the @kbd{\} (integer quotient), @kbd{f I} (integer logarithm),
16482 and @kbd{f Q} (integer square root) commands, which are analogous to
16483 @kbd{/}, @kbd{B}, and @kbd{Q}, respectively, except that they take integer
16484 arguments and return the result rounded down to an integer.
16485
16486 @node Complex Number Functions, Conversions, Integer Truncation, Arithmetic
16487 @section Complex Number Functions
16488
16489 @noindent
16490 @kindex J
16491 @pindex calc-conj
16492 @tindex conj
16493 The @kbd{J} (@code{calc-conj}) [@code{conj}] command computes the
16494 complex conjugate of a number. For complex number @expr{a+bi}, the
16495 complex conjugate is @expr{a-bi}. If the argument is a real number,
16496 this command leaves it the same. If the argument is a vector or matrix,
16497 this command replaces each element by its complex conjugate.
16498
16499 @kindex G
16500 @pindex calc-argument
16501 @tindex arg
16502 The @kbd{G} (@code{calc-argument}) [@code{arg}] command computes the
16503 ``argument'' or polar angle of a complex number. For a number in polar
16504 notation, this is simply the second component of the pair
16505 @texline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@math{\theta}@tfn{)}'.
16506 @infoline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@var{theta}@tfn{)}'.
16507 The result is expressed according to the current angular mode and will
16508 be in the range @mathit{-180} degrees (exclusive) to @mathit{+180} degrees
16509 (inclusive), or the equivalent range in radians.
16510
16511 @pindex calc-imaginary
16512 The @code{calc-imaginary} command multiplies the number on the
16513 top of the stack by the imaginary number @expr{i = (0,1)}. This
16514 command is not normally bound to a key in Calc, but it is available
16515 on the @key{IMAG} button in Keypad mode.
16516
16517 @kindex f r
16518 @pindex calc-re
16519 @tindex re
16520 The @kbd{f r} (@code{calc-re}) [@code{re}] command replaces a complex number
16521 by its real part. This command has no effect on real numbers. (As an
16522 added convenience, @code{re} applied to a modulo form extracts
16523 the value part.)
16524
16525 @kindex f i
16526 @pindex calc-im
16527 @tindex im
16528 The @kbd{f i} (@code{calc-im}) [@code{im}] command replaces a complex number
16529 by its imaginary part; real numbers are converted to zero. With a vector
16530 or matrix argument, these functions operate element-wise.
16531
16532 @ignore
16533 @mindex v p
16534 @end ignore
16535 @kindex v p (complex)
16536 @pindex calc-pack
16537 The @kbd{v p} (@code{calc-pack}) command can pack the top two numbers on
16538 the stack into a composite object such as a complex number. With
16539 a prefix argument of @mathit{-1}, it produces a rectangular complex number;
16540 with an argument of @mathit{-2}, it produces a polar complex number.
16541 (Also, @pxref{Building Vectors}.)
16542
16543 @ignore
16544 @mindex v u
16545 @end ignore
16546 @kindex v u (complex)
16547 @pindex calc-unpack
16548 The @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) command takes the complex number
16549 (or other composite object) on the top of the stack and unpacks it
16550 into its separate components.
16551
16552 @node Conversions, Date Arithmetic, Complex Number Functions, Arithmetic
16553 @section Conversions
16554
16555 @noindent
16556 The commands described in this section convert numbers from one form
16557 to another; they are two-key sequences beginning with the letter @kbd{c}.
16558
16559 @kindex c f
16560 @pindex calc-float
16561 @tindex pfloat
16562 The @kbd{c f} (@code{calc-float}) [@code{pfloat}] command converts the
16563 number on the top of the stack to floating-point form. For example,
16564 @expr{23} is converted to @expr{23.0}, @expr{3:2} is converted to
16565 @expr{1.5}, and @expr{2.3} is left the same. If the value is a composite
16566 object such as a complex number or vector, each of the components is
16567 converted to floating-point. If the value is a formula, all numbers
16568 in the formula are converted to floating-point. Note that depending
16569 on the current floating-point precision, conversion to floating-point
16570 format may lose information.
16571
16572 As a special exception, integers which appear as powers or subscripts
16573 are not floated by @kbd{c f}. If you really want to float a power,
16574 you can use a @kbd{j s} command to select the power followed by @kbd{c f}.
16575 Because @kbd{c f} cannot examine the formula outside of the selection,
16576 it does not notice that the thing being floated is a power.
16577 @xref{Selecting Subformulas}.
16578
16579 The normal @kbd{c f} command is ``pervasive'' in the sense that it
16580 applies to all numbers throughout the formula. The @code{pfloat}
16581 algebraic function never stays around in a formula; @samp{pfloat(a + 1)}
16582 changes to @samp{a + 1.0} as soon as it is evaluated.
16583
16584 @kindex H c f
16585 @tindex float
16586 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H c f} [@code{float}] operates
16587 only on the number or vector of numbers at the top level of its
16588 argument. Thus, @samp{float(1)} is 1.0, but @samp{float(a + 1)}
16589 is left unevaluated because its argument is not a number.
16590
16591 You should use @kbd{H c f} if you wish to guarantee that the final
16592 value, once all the variables have been assigned, is a float; you
16593 would use @kbd{c f} if you wish to do the conversion on the numbers
16594 that appear right now.
16595
16596 @kindex c F
16597 @pindex calc-fraction
16598 @tindex pfrac
16599 The @kbd{c F} (@code{calc-fraction}) [@code{pfrac}] command converts a
16600 floating-point number into a fractional approximation. By default, it
16601 produces a fraction whose decimal representation is the same as the
16602 input number, to within the current precision. You can also give a
16603 numeric prefix argument to specify a tolerance, either directly, or,
16604 if the prefix argument is zero, by using the number on top of the stack
16605 as the tolerance. If the tolerance is a positive integer, the fraction
16606 is correct to within that many significant figures. If the tolerance is
16607 a non-positive integer, it specifies how many digits fewer than the current
16608 precision to use. If the tolerance is a floating-point number, the
16609 fraction is correct to within that absolute amount.
16610
16611 @kindex H c F
16612 @tindex frac
16613 The @code{pfrac} function is pervasive, like @code{pfloat}.
16614 There is also a non-pervasive version, @kbd{H c F} [@code{frac}],
16615 which is analogous to @kbd{H c f} discussed above.
16616
16617 @kindex c d
16618 @pindex calc-to-degrees
16619 @tindex deg
16620 The @kbd{c d} (@code{calc-to-degrees}) [@code{deg}] command converts a
16621 number into degrees form. The value on the top of the stack may be an
16622 HMS form (interpreted as degrees-minutes-seconds), or a real number which
16623 will be interpreted in radians regardless of the current angular mode.
16624
16625 @kindex c r
16626 @pindex calc-to-radians
16627 @tindex rad
16628 The @kbd{c r} (@code{calc-to-radians}) [@code{rad}] command converts an
16629 HMS form or angle in degrees into an angle in radians.
16630
16631 @kindex c h
16632 @pindex calc-to-hms
16633 @tindex hms
16634 The @kbd{c h} (@code{calc-to-hms}) [@code{hms}] command converts a real
16635 number, interpreted according to the current angular mode, to an HMS
16636 form describing the same angle. In algebraic notation, the @code{hms}
16637 function also accepts three arguments: @samp{hms(@var{h}, @var{m}, @var{s})}.
16638 (The three-argument version is independent of the current angular mode.)
16639
16640 @pindex calc-from-hms
16641 The @code{calc-from-hms} command converts the HMS form on the top of the
16642 stack into a real number according to the current angular mode.
16643
16644 @kindex c p
16645 @kindex I c p
16646 @pindex calc-polar
16647 @tindex polar
16648 @tindex rect
16649 The @kbd{c p} (@code{calc-polar}) command converts the complex number on
16650 the top of the stack from polar to rectangular form, or from rectangular
16651 to polar form, whichever is appropriate. Real numbers are left the same.
16652 This command is equivalent to the @code{rect} or @code{polar}
16653 functions in algebraic formulas, depending on the direction of
16654 conversion. (It uses @code{polar}, except that if the argument is
16655 already a polar complex number, it uses @code{rect} instead. The
16656 @kbd{I c p} command always uses @code{rect}.)
16657
16658 @kindex c c
16659 @pindex calc-clean
16660 @tindex pclean
16661 The @kbd{c c} (@code{calc-clean}) [@code{pclean}] command ``cleans'' the
16662 number on the top of the stack. Floating point numbers are re-rounded
16663 according to the current precision. Polar numbers whose angular
16664 components have strayed from the @mathit{-180} to @mathit{+180} degree range
16665 are normalized. (Note that results will be undesirable if the current
16666 angular mode is different from the one under which the number was
16667 produced!) Integers and fractions are generally unaffected by this
16668 operation. Vectors and formulas are cleaned by cleaning each component
16669 number (i.e., pervasively).
16670
16671 If the simplification mode is set below the default level, it is raised
16672 to the default level for the purposes of this command. Thus, @kbd{c c}
16673 applies the default simplifications even if their automatic application
16674 is disabled. @xref{Simplification Modes}.
16675
16676 @cindex Roundoff errors, correcting
16677 A numeric prefix argument to @kbd{c c} sets the floating-point precision
16678 to that value for the duration of the command. A positive prefix (of at
16679 least 3) sets the precision to the specified value; a negative or zero
16680 prefix decreases the precision by the specified amount.
16681
16682 @kindex c 0-9
16683 @pindex calc-clean-num
16684 The keystroke sequences @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9} are equivalent
16685 to @kbd{c c} with the corresponding negative prefix argument. If roundoff
16686 errors have changed 2.0 into 1.999999, typing @kbd{c 1} to clip off one
16687 decimal place often conveniently does the trick.
16688
16689 The @kbd{c c} command with a numeric prefix argument, and the @kbd{c 0}
16690 through @kbd{c 9} commands, also ``clip'' very small floating-point
16691 numbers to zero. If the exponent is less than or equal to the negative
16692 of the specified precision, the number is changed to 0.0. For example,
16693 if the current precision is 12, then @kbd{c 2} changes the vector
16694 @samp{[1e-8, 1e-9, 1e-10, 1e-11]} to @samp{[1e-8, 1e-9, 0, 0]}.
16695 Numbers this small generally arise from roundoff noise.
16696
16697 If the numbers you are using really are legitimately this small,
16698 you should avoid using the @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9} commands.
16699 (The plain @kbd{c c} command rounds to the current precision but
16700 does not clip small numbers.)
16701
16702 One more property of @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9}, and of @kbd{c c} with
16703 a prefix argument, is that integer-valued floats are converted to
16704 plain integers, so that @kbd{c 1} on @samp{[1., 1.5, 2., 2.5, 3.]}
16705 produces @samp{[1, 1.5, 2, 2.5, 3]}. This is not done for huge
16706 numbers (@samp{1e100} is technically an integer-valued float, but
16707 you wouldn't want it automatically converted to a 100-digit integer).
16708
16709 @kindex H c 0-9
16710 @kindex H c c
16711 @tindex clean
16712 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H c c} and @kbd{H c 0} through @kbd{H c 9}
16713 operate non-pervasively [@code{clean}].
16714
16715 @node Date Arithmetic, Financial Functions, Conversions, Arithmetic
16716 @section Date Arithmetic
16717
16718 @noindent
16719 @cindex Date arithmetic, additional functions
16720 The commands described in this section perform various conversions
16721 and calculations involving date forms (@pxref{Date Forms}). They
16722 use the @kbd{t} (for time/date) prefix key followed by shifted
16723 letters.
16724
16725 The simplest date arithmetic is done using the regular @kbd{+} and @kbd{-}
16726 commands. In particular, adding a number to a date form advances the
16727 date form by a certain number of days; adding an HMS form to a date
16728 form advances the date by a certain amount of time; and subtracting two
16729 date forms produces a difference measured in days. The commands
16730 described here provide additional, more specialized operations on dates.
16731
16732 Many of these commands accept a numeric prefix argument; if you give
16733 plain @kbd{C-u} as the prefix, these commands will instead take the
16734 additional argument from the top of the stack.
16735
16736 @menu
16737 * Date Conversions::
16738 * Date Functions::
16739 * Time Zones::
16740 * Business Days::
16741 @end menu
16742
16743 @node Date Conversions, Date Functions, Date Arithmetic, Date Arithmetic
16744 @subsection Date Conversions
16745
16746 @noindent
16747 @kindex t D
16748 @pindex calc-date
16749 @tindex date
16750 The @kbd{t D} (@code{calc-date}) [@code{date}] command converts a
16751 date form into a number, measured in days since Jan 1, 1 AD. The
16752 result will be an integer if @var{date} is a pure date form, or a
16753 fraction or float if @var{date} is a date/time form. Or, if its
16754 argument is a number, it converts this number into a date form.
16755
16756 With a numeric prefix argument, @kbd{t D} takes that many objects
16757 (up to six) from the top of the stack and interprets them in one
16758 of the following ways:
16759
16760 The @samp{date(@var{year}, @var{month}, @var{day})} function
16761 builds a pure date form out of the specified year, month, and
16762 day, which must all be integers. @var{Year} is a year number,
16763 such as 1991 (@emph{not} the same as 91!). @var{Month} must be
16764 an integer in the range 1 to 12; @var{day} must be in the range
16765 1 to 31. If the specified month has fewer than 31 days and
16766 @var{day} is too large, the equivalent day in the following
16767 month will be used.
16768
16769 The @samp{date(@var{month}, @var{day})} function builds a
16770 pure date form using the current year, as determined by the
16771 real-time clock.
16772
16773 The @samp{date(@var{year}, @var{month}, @var{day}, @var{hms})}
16774 function builds a date/time form using an @var{hms} form.
16775
16776 The @samp{date(@var{year}, @var{month}, @var{day}, @var{hour},
16777 @var{minute}, @var{second})} function builds a date/time form.
16778 @var{hour} should be an integer in the range 0 to 23;
16779 @var{minute} should be an integer in the range 0 to 59;
16780 @var{second} should be any real number in the range @samp{[0 .. 60)}.
16781 The last two arguments default to zero if omitted.
16782
16783 @kindex t J
16784 @pindex calc-julian
16785 @tindex julian
16786 @cindex Julian day counts, conversions
16787 The @kbd{t J} (@code{calc-julian}) [@code{julian}] command converts
16788 a date form into a Julian day count, which is the number of days
16789 since noon (GMT) on Jan 1, 4713 BC. A pure date is converted to an
16790 integer Julian count representing noon of that day. A date/time form
16791 is converted to an exact floating-point Julian count, adjusted to
16792 interpret the date form in the current time zone but the Julian
16793 day count in Greenwich Mean Time. A numeric prefix argument allows
16794 you to specify the time zone; @pxref{Time Zones}. Use a prefix of
16795 zero to suppress the time zone adjustment. Note that pure date forms
16796 are never time-zone adjusted.
16797
16798 This command can also do the opposite conversion, from a Julian day
16799 count (either an integer day, or a floating-point day and time in
16800 the GMT zone), into a pure date form or a date/time form in the
16801 current or specified time zone.
16802
16803 @kindex t U
16804 @pindex calc-unix-time
16805 @tindex unixtime
16806 @cindex Unix time format, conversions
16807 The @kbd{t U} (@code{calc-unix-time}) [@code{unixtime}] command
16808 converts a date form into a Unix time value, which is the number of
16809 seconds since midnight on Jan 1, 1970, or vice-versa. The numeric result
16810 will be an integer if the current precision is 12 or less; for higher
16811 precisions, the result may be a float with (@var{precision}@minus{}12)
16812 digits after the decimal. Just as for @kbd{t J}, the numeric time
16813 is interpreted in the GMT time zone and the date form is interpreted
16814 in the current or specified zone. Some systems use Unix-like
16815 numbering but with the local time zone; give a prefix of zero to
16816 suppress the adjustment if so.
16817
16818 @kindex t C
16819 @pindex calc-convert-time-zones
16820 @tindex tzconv
16821 @cindex Time Zones, converting between
16822 The @kbd{t C} (@code{calc-convert-time-zones}) [@code{tzconv}]
16823 command converts a date form from one time zone to another. You
16824 are prompted for each time zone name in turn; you can answer with
16825 any suitable Calc time zone expression (@pxref{Time Zones}).
16826 If you answer either prompt with a blank line, the local time
16827 zone is used for that prompt. You can also answer the first
16828 prompt with @kbd{$} to take the two time zone names from the
16829 stack (and the date to be converted from the third stack level).
16830
16831 @node Date Functions, Business Days, Date Conversions, Date Arithmetic
16832 @subsection Date Functions
16833
16834 @noindent
16835 @kindex t N
16836 @pindex calc-now
16837 @tindex now
16838 The @kbd{t N} (@code{calc-now}) [@code{now}] command pushes the
16839 current date and time on the stack as a date form. The time is
16840 reported in terms of the specified time zone; with no numeric prefix
16841 argument, @kbd{t N} reports for the current time zone.
16842
16843 @kindex t P
16844 @pindex calc-date-part
16845 The @kbd{t P} (@code{calc-date-part}) command extracts one part
16846 of a date form. The prefix argument specifies the part; with no
16847 argument, this command prompts for a part code from 1 to 9.
16848 The various part codes are described in the following paragraphs.
16849
16850 @tindex year
16851 The @kbd{M-1 t P} [@code{year}] function extracts the year number
16852 from a date form as an integer, e.g., 1991. This and the
16853 following functions will also accept a real number for an
16854 argument, which is interpreted as a standard Calc day number.
16855 Note that this function will never return zero, since the year
16856 1 BC immediately precedes the year 1 AD.
16857
16858 @tindex month
16859 The @kbd{M-2 t P} [@code{month}] function extracts the month number
16860 from a date form as an integer in the range 1 to 12.
16861
16862 @tindex day
16863 The @kbd{M-3 t P} [@code{day}] function extracts the day number
16864 from a date form as an integer in the range 1 to 31.
16865
16866 @tindex hour
16867 The @kbd{M-4 t P} [@code{hour}] function extracts the hour from
16868 a date form as an integer in the range 0 (midnight) to 23. Note
16869 that 24-hour time is always used. This returns zero for a pure
16870 date form. This function (and the following two) also accept
16871 HMS forms as input.
16872
16873 @tindex minute
16874 The @kbd{M-5 t P} [@code{minute}] function extracts the minute
16875 from a date form as an integer in the range 0 to 59.
16876
16877 @tindex second
16878 The @kbd{M-6 t P} [@code{second}] function extracts the second
16879 from a date form. If the current precision is 12 or less,
16880 the result is an integer in the range 0 to 59. For higher
16881 precisions, the result may instead be a floating-point number.
16882
16883 @tindex weekday
16884 The @kbd{M-7 t P} [@code{weekday}] function extracts the weekday
16885 number from a date form as an integer in the range 0 (Sunday)
16886 to 6 (Saturday).
16887
16888 @tindex yearday
16889 The @kbd{M-8 t P} [@code{yearday}] function extracts the day-of-year
16890 number from a date form as an integer in the range 1 (January 1)
16891 to 366 (December 31 of a leap year).
16892
16893 @tindex time
16894 The @kbd{M-9 t P} [@code{time}] function extracts the time portion
16895 of a date form as an HMS form. This returns @samp{0@@ 0' 0"}
16896 for a pure date form.
16897
16898 @kindex t M
16899 @pindex calc-new-month
16900 @tindex newmonth
16901 The @kbd{t M} (@code{calc-new-month}) [@code{newmonth}] command
16902 computes a new date form that represents the first day of the month
16903 specified by the input date. The result is always a pure date
16904 form; only the year and month numbers of the input are retained.
16905 With a numeric prefix argument @var{n} in the range from 1 to 31,
16906 @kbd{t M} computes the @var{n}th day of the month. (If @var{n}
16907 is greater than the actual number of days in the month, or if
16908 @var{n} is zero, the last day of the month is used.)
16909
16910 @kindex t Y
16911 @pindex calc-new-year
16912 @tindex newyear
16913 The @kbd{t Y} (@code{calc-new-year}) [@code{newyear}] command
16914 computes a new pure date form that represents the first day of
16915 the year specified by the input. The month, day, and time
16916 of the input date form are lost. With a numeric prefix argument
16917 @var{n} in the range from 1 to 366, @kbd{t Y} computes the
16918 @var{n}th day of the year (366 is treated as 365 in non-leap
16919 years). A prefix argument of 0 computes the last day of the
16920 year (December 31). A negative prefix argument from @mathit{-1} to
16921 @mathit{-12} computes the first day of the @var{n}th month of the year.
16922
16923 @kindex t W
16924 @pindex calc-new-week
16925 @tindex newweek
16926 The @kbd{t W} (@code{calc-new-week}) [@code{newweek}] command
16927 computes a new pure date form that represents the Sunday on or before
16928 the input date. With a numeric prefix argument, it can be made to
16929 use any day of the week as the starting day; the argument must be in
16930 the range from 0 (Sunday) to 6 (Saturday). This function always
16931 subtracts between 0 and 6 days from the input date.
16932
16933 Here's an example use of @code{newweek}: Find the date of the next
16934 Wednesday after a given date. Using @kbd{M-3 t W} or @samp{newweek(d, 3)}
16935 will give you the @emph{preceding} Wednesday, so @samp{newweek(d+7, 3)}
16936 will give you the following Wednesday. A further look at the definition
16937 of @code{newweek} shows that if the input date is itself a Wednesday,
16938 this formula will return the Wednesday one week in the future. An
16939 exercise for the reader is to modify this formula to yield the same day
16940 if the input is already a Wednesday. Another interesting exercise is
16941 to preserve the time-of-day portion of the input (@code{newweek} resets
16942 the time to midnight; hint:@: how can @code{newweek} be defined in terms
16943 of the @code{weekday} function?).
16944
16945 @ignore
16946 @starindex
16947 @end ignore
16948 @tindex pwday
16949 The @samp{pwday(@var{date})} function (not on any key) computes the
16950 day-of-month number of the Sunday on or before @var{date}. With
16951 two arguments, @samp{pwday(@var{date}, @var{day})} computes the day
16952 number of the Sunday on or before day number @var{day} of the month
16953 specified by @var{date}. The @var{day} must be in the range from
16954 7 to 31; if the day number is greater than the actual number of days
16955 in the month, the true number of days is used instead. Thus
16956 @samp{pwday(@var{date}, 7)} finds the first Sunday of the month, and
16957 @samp{pwday(@var{date}, 31)} finds the last Sunday of the month.
16958 With a third @var{weekday} argument, @code{pwday} can be made to look
16959 for any day of the week instead of Sunday.
16960
16961 @kindex t I
16962 @pindex calc-inc-month
16963 @tindex incmonth
16964 The @kbd{t I} (@code{calc-inc-month}) [@code{incmonth}] command
16965 increases a date form by one month, or by an arbitrary number of
16966 months specified by a numeric prefix argument. The time portion,
16967 if any, of the date form stays the same. The day also stays the
16968 same, except that if the new month has fewer days the day
16969 number may be reduced to lie in the valid range. For example,
16970 @samp{incmonth(<Jan 31, 1991>)} produces @samp{<Feb 28, 1991>}.
16971 Because of this, @kbd{t I t I} and @kbd{M-2 t I} do not always give
16972 the same results (@samp{<Mar 28, 1991>} versus @samp{<Mar 31, 1991>}
16973 in this case).
16974
16975 @ignore
16976 @starindex
16977 @end ignore
16978 @tindex incyear
16979 The @samp{incyear(@var{date}, @var{step})} function increases
16980 a date form by the specified number of years, which may be
16981 any positive or negative integer. Note that @samp{incyear(d, n)}
16982 is equivalent to @w{@samp{incmonth(d, 12*n)}}, but these do not have
16983 simple equivalents in terms of day arithmetic because
16984 months and years have varying lengths. If the @var{step}
16985 argument is omitted, 1 year is assumed. There is no keyboard
16986 command for this function; use @kbd{C-u 12 t I} instead.
16987
16988 There is no @code{newday} function at all because @kbd{F} [@code{floor}]
16989 serves this purpose. Similarly, instead of @code{incday} and
16990 @code{incweek} simply use @expr{d + n} or @expr{d + 7 n}.
16991
16992 @xref{Basic Arithmetic}, for the @kbd{f ]} [@code{incr}] command
16993 which can adjust a date/time form by a certain number of seconds.
16994
16995 @node Business Days, Time Zones, Date Functions, Date Arithmetic
16996 @subsection Business Days
16997
16998 @noindent
16999 Often time is measured in ``business days'' or ``working days,''
17000 where weekends and holidays are skipped. Calc's normal date
17001 arithmetic functions use calendar days, so that subtracting two
17002 consecutive Mondays will yield a difference of 7 days. By contrast,
17003 subtracting two consecutive Mondays would yield 5 business days
17004 (assuming two-day weekends and the absence of holidays).
17005
17006 @kindex t +
17007 @kindex t -
17008 @tindex badd
17009 @tindex bsub
17010 @pindex calc-business-days-plus
17011 @pindex calc-business-days-minus
17012 The @kbd{t +} (@code{calc-business-days-plus}) [@code{badd}]
17013 and @kbd{t -} (@code{calc-business-days-minus}) [@code{bsub}]
17014 commands perform arithmetic using business days. For @kbd{t +},
17015 one argument must be a date form and the other must be a real
17016 number (positive or negative). If the number is not an integer,
17017 then a certain amount of time is added as well as a number of
17018 days; for example, adding 0.5 business days to a time in Friday
17019 evening will produce a time in Monday morning. It is also
17020 possible to add an HMS form; adding @samp{12@@ 0' 0"} also adds
17021 half a business day. For @kbd{t -}, the arguments are either a
17022 date form and a number or HMS form, or two date forms, in which
17023 case the result is the number of business days between the two
17024 dates.
17025
17026 @cindex @code{Holidays} variable
17027 @vindex Holidays
17028 By default, Calc considers any day that is not a Saturday or
17029 Sunday to be a business day. You can define any number of
17030 additional holidays by editing the variable @code{Holidays}.
17031 (There is an @w{@kbd{s H}} convenience command for editing this
17032 variable.) Initially, @code{Holidays} contains the vector
17033 @samp{[sat, sun]}. Entries in the @code{Holidays} vector may
17034 be any of the following kinds of objects:
17035
17036 @itemize @bullet
17037 @item
17038 Date forms (pure dates, not date/time forms). These specify
17039 particular days which are to be treated as holidays.
17040
17041 @item
17042 Intervals of date forms. These specify a range of days, all of
17043 which are holidays (e.g., Christmas week). @xref{Interval Forms}.
17044
17045 @item
17046 Nested vectors of date forms. Each date form in the vector is
17047 considered to be a holiday.
17048
17049 @item
17050 Any Calc formula which evaluates to one of the above three things.
17051 If the formula involves the variable @expr{y}, it stands for a
17052 yearly repeating holiday; @expr{y} will take on various year
17053 numbers like 1992. For example, @samp{date(y, 12, 25)} specifies
17054 Christmas day, and @samp{newweek(date(y, 11, 7), 4) + 21} specifies
17055 Thanksgiving (which is held on the fourth Thursday of November).
17056 If the formula involves the variable @expr{m}, that variable
17057 takes on month numbers from 1 to 12: @samp{date(y, m, 15)} is
17058 a holiday that takes place on the 15th of every month.
17059
17060 @item
17061 A weekday name, such as @code{sat} or @code{sun}. This is really
17062 a variable whose name is a three-letter, lower-case day name.
17063
17064 @item
17065 An interval of year numbers (integers). This specifies the span of
17066 years over which this holiday list is to be considered valid. Any
17067 business-day arithmetic that goes outside this range will result
17068 in an error message. Use this if you are including an explicit
17069 list of holidays, rather than a formula to generate them, and you
17070 want to make sure you don't accidentally go beyond the last point
17071 where the holidays you entered are complete. If there is no
17072 limiting interval in the @code{Holidays} vector, the default
17073 @samp{[1 .. 2737]} is used. (This is the absolute range of years
17074 for which Calc's business-day algorithms will operate.)
17075
17076 @item
17077 An interval of HMS forms. This specifies the span of hours that
17078 are to be considered one business day. For example, if this
17079 range is @samp{[9@@ 0' 0" .. 17@@ 0' 0"]} (i.e., 9am to 5pm), then
17080 the business day is only eight hours long, so that @kbd{1.5 t +}
17081 on @samp{<4:00pm Fri Dec 13, 1991>} will add one business day and
17082 four business hours to produce @samp{<12:00pm Tue Dec 17, 1991>}.
17083 Likewise, @kbd{t -} will now express differences in time as
17084 fractions of an eight-hour day. Times before 9am will be treated
17085 as 9am by business date arithmetic, and times at or after 5pm will
17086 be treated as 4:59:59pm. If there is no HMS interval in @code{Holidays},
17087 the full 24-hour day @samp{[0@ 0' 0" .. 24@ 0' 0"]} is assumed.
17088 (Regardless of the type of bounds you specify, the interval is
17089 treated as inclusive on the low end and exclusive on the high end,
17090 so that the work day goes from 9am up to, but not including, 5pm.)
17091 @end itemize
17092
17093 If the @code{Holidays} vector is empty, then @kbd{t +} and
17094 @kbd{t -} will act just like @kbd{+} and @kbd{-} because there will
17095 then be no difference between business days and calendar days.
17096
17097 Calc expands the intervals and formulas you give into a complete
17098 list of holidays for internal use. This is done mainly to make
17099 sure it can detect multiple holidays. (For example,
17100 @samp{<Jan 1, 1989>} is both New Year's Day and a Sunday, but
17101 Calc's algorithms take care to count it only once when figuring
17102 the number of holidays between two dates.)
17103
17104 Since the complete list of holidays for all the years from 1 to
17105 2737 would be huge, Calc actually computes only the part of the
17106 list between the smallest and largest years that have been involved
17107 in business-day calculations so far. Normally, you won't have to
17108 worry about this. Keep in mind, however, that if you do one
17109 calculation for 1992, and another for 1792, even if both involve
17110 only a small range of years, Calc will still work out all the
17111 holidays that fall in that 200-year span.
17112
17113 If you add a (positive) number of days to a date form that falls on a
17114 weekend or holiday, the date form is treated as if it were the most
17115 recent business day. (Thus adding one business day to a Friday,
17116 Saturday, or Sunday will all yield the following Monday.) If you
17117 subtract a number of days from a weekend or holiday, the date is
17118 effectively on the following business day. (So subtracting one business
17119 day from Saturday, Sunday, or Monday yields the preceding Friday.) The
17120 difference between two dates one or both of which fall on holidays
17121 equals the number of actual business days between them. These
17122 conventions are consistent in the sense that, if you add @var{n}
17123 business days to any date, the difference between the result and the
17124 original date will come out to @var{n} business days. (It can't be
17125 completely consistent though; a subtraction followed by an addition
17126 might come out a bit differently, since @kbd{t +} is incapable of
17127 producing a date that falls on a weekend or holiday.)
17128
17129 @ignore
17130 @starindex
17131 @end ignore
17132 @tindex holiday
17133 There is a @code{holiday} function, not on any keys, that takes
17134 any date form and returns 1 if that date falls on a weekend or
17135 holiday, as defined in @code{Holidays}, or 0 if the date is a
17136 business day.
17137
17138 @node Time Zones, , Business Days, Date Arithmetic
17139 @subsection Time Zones
17140
17141 @noindent
17142 @cindex Time zones
17143 @cindex Daylight saving time
17144 Time zones and daylight saving time are a complicated business.
17145 The conversions to and from Julian and Unix-style dates automatically
17146 compute the correct time zone and daylight saving adjustment to use,
17147 provided they can figure out this information. This section describes
17148 Calc's time zone adjustment algorithm in detail, in case you want to
17149 do conversions in different time zones or in case Calc's algorithms
17150 can't determine the right correction to use.
17151
17152 Adjustments for time zones and daylight saving time are done by
17153 @kbd{t U}, @kbd{t J}, @kbd{t N}, and @kbd{t C}, but not by any other
17154 commands. In particular, @samp{<may 1 1991> - <apr 1 1991>} evaluates
17155 to exactly 30 days even though there is a daylight-saving
17156 transition in between. This is also true for Julian pure dates:
17157 @samp{julian(<may 1 1991>) - julian(<apr 1 1991>)}. But Julian
17158 and Unix date/times will adjust for daylight saving time: using Calc's
17159 default daylight saving time rule (see the explanation below),
17160 @samp{julian(<12am may 1 1991>) - julian(<12am apr 1 1991>)}
17161 evaluates to @samp{29.95833} (that's 29 days and 23 hours)
17162 because one hour was lost when daylight saving commenced on
17163 April 7, 1991.
17164
17165 In brief, the idiom @samp{julian(@var{date1}) - julian(@var{date2})}
17166 computes the actual number of 24-hour periods between two dates, whereas
17167 @samp{@var{date1} - @var{date2}} computes the number of calendar
17168 days between two dates without taking daylight saving into account.
17169
17170 @pindex calc-time-zone
17171 @ignore
17172 @starindex
17173 @end ignore
17174 @tindex tzone
17175 The @code{calc-time-zone} [@code{tzone}] command converts the time
17176 zone specified by its numeric prefix argument into a number of
17177 seconds difference from Greenwich mean time (GMT). If the argument
17178 is a number, the result is simply that value multiplied by 3600.
17179 Typical arguments for North America are 5 (Eastern) or 8 (Pacific). If
17180 Daylight Saving time is in effect, one hour should be subtracted from
17181 the normal difference.
17182
17183 If you give a prefix of plain @kbd{C-u}, @code{calc-time-zone} (like other
17184 date arithmetic commands that include a time zone argument) takes the
17185 zone argument from the top of the stack. (In the case of @kbd{t J}
17186 and @kbd{t U}, the normal argument is then taken from the second-to-top
17187 stack position.) This allows you to give a non-integer time zone
17188 adjustment. The time-zone argument can also be an HMS form, or
17189 it can be a variable which is a time zone name in upper- or lower-case.
17190 For example @samp{tzone(PST) = tzone(8)} and @samp{tzone(pdt) = tzone(7)}
17191 (for Pacific standard and daylight saving times, respectively).
17192
17193 North American and European time zone names are defined as follows;
17194 note that for each time zone there is one name for standard time,
17195 another for daylight saving time, and a third for ``generalized'' time
17196 in which the daylight saving adjustment is computed from context.
17197
17198 @smallexample
17199 @group
17200 YST PST MST CST EST AST NST GMT WET MET MEZ
17201 9 8 7 6 5 4 3.5 0 -1 -2 -2
17202
17203 YDT PDT MDT CDT EDT ADT NDT BST WETDST METDST MESZ
17204 8 7 6 5 4 3 2.5 -1 -2 -3 -3
17205
17206 YGT PGT MGT CGT EGT AGT NGT BGT WEGT MEGT MEGZ
17207 9/8 8/7 7/6 6/5 5/4 4/3 3.5/2.5 0/-1 -1/-2 -2/-3 -2/-3
17208 @end group
17209 @end smallexample
17210
17211 @vindex math-tzone-names
17212 To define time zone names that do not appear in the above table,
17213 you must modify the Lisp variable @code{math-tzone-names}. This
17214 is a list of lists describing the different time zone names; its
17215 structure is best explained by an example. The three entries for
17216 Pacific Time look like this:
17217
17218 @smallexample
17219 @group
17220 ( ( "PST" 8 0 ) ; Name as an upper-case string, then standard
17221 ( "PDT" 8 -1 ) ; adjustment, then daylight saving adjustment.
17222 ( "PGT" 8 "PST" "PDT" ) ) ; Generalized time zone.
17223 @end group
17224 @end smallexample
17225
17226 @cindex @code{TimeZone} variable
17227 @vindex TimeZone
17228 With no arguments, @code{calc-time-zone} or @samp{tzone()} will by
17229 default get the time zone and daylight saving information from the
17230 calendar (@pxref{Daylight Saving,Calendar/Diary,The Calendar and the Diary,
17231 emacs,The GNU Emacs Manual}). To use a different time zone, or if the
17232 calendar does not give the desired result, you can set the Calc variable
17233 @code{TimeZone} (which is by default @code{nil}) to an appropriate
17234 time zone name. (The easiest way to do this is to edit the
17235 @code{TimeZone} variable using Calc's @kbd{s T} command, then use the
17236 @kbd{s p} (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) command to save the value of
17237 @code{TimeZone} permanently.)
17238 If the time zone given by @code{TimeZone} is a generalized time zone,
17239 e.g., @code{EGT}, Calc examines the date being converted to tell whether
17240 to use standard or daylight saving time. But if the current time zone
17241 is explicit, e.g., @code{EST} or @code{EDT}, then that adjustment is
17242 used exactly and Calc's daylight saving algorithm is not consulted.
17243 The special time zone name @code{local}
17244 is equivalent to no argument; i.e., it uses the information obtained
17245 from the calendar.
17246
17247 The @kbd{t J} and @code{t U} commands with no numeric prefix
17248 arguments do the same thing as @samp{tzone()}; namely, use the
17249 information from the calendar if @code{TimeZone} is @code{nil},
17250 otherwise use the time zone given by @code{TimeZone}.
17251
17252 @vindex math-daylight-savings-hook
17253 @findex math-std-daylight-savings
17254 When Calc computes the daylight saving information itself (i.e., when
17255 the @code{TimeZone} variable is set), it will by default consider
17256 daylight saving time to begin at 2 a.m.@: on the second Sunday of March
17257 (for years from 2007 on) or on the last Sunday in April (for years
17258 before 2007), and to end at 2 a.m.@: on the first Sunday of
17259 November. (for years from 2007 on) or the last Sunday in October (for
17260 years before 2007). These are the rules that have been in effect in
17261 much of North America since 1966 and take into account the rule change
17262 that began in 2007. If you are in a country that uses different rules
17263 for computing daylight saving time, you have two choices: Write your own
17264 daylight saving hook, or control time zones explicitly by setting the
17265 @code{TimeZone} variable and/or always giving a time-zone argument for
17266 the conversion functions.
17267
17268 The Lisp variable @code{math-daylight-savings-hook} holds the
17269 name of a function that is used to compute the daylight saving
17270 adjustment for a given date. The default is
17271 @code{math-std-daylight-savings}, which computes an adjustment
17272 (either 0 or @mathit{-1}) using the North American rules given above.
17273
17274 The daylight saving hook function is called with four arguments:
17275 The date, as a floating-point number in standard Calc format;
17276 a six-element list of the date decomposed into year, month, day,
17277 hour, minute, and second, respectively; a string which contains
17278 the generalized time zone name in upper-case, e.g., @code{"WEGT"};
17279 and a special adjustment to be applied to the hour value when
17280 converting into a generalized time zone (see below).
17281
17282 @findex math-prev-weekday-in-month
17283 The Lisp function @code{math-prev-weekday-in-month} is useful for
17284 daylight saving computations. This is an internal version of
17285 the user-level @code{pwday} function described in the previous
17286 section. It takes four arguments: The floating-point date value,
17287 the corresponding six-element date list, the day-of-month number,
17288 and the weekday number (0-6).
17289
17290 The default daylight saving hook ignores the time zone name, but a
17291 more sophisticated hook could use different algorithms for different
17292 time zones. It would also be possible to use different algorithms
17293 depending on the year number, but the default hook always uses the
17294 algorithm for 1987 and later. Here is a listing of the default
17295 daylight saving hook:
17296
17297 @smallexample
17298 (defun math-std-daylight-savings (date dt zone bump)
17299 (cond ((< (nth 1 dt) 4) 0)
17300 ((= (nth 1 dt) 4)
17301 (let ((sunday (math-prev-weekday-in-month date dt 7 0)))
17302 (cond ((< (nth 2 dt) sunday) 0)
17303 ((= (nth 2 dt) sunday)
17304 (if (>= (nth 3 dt) (+ 3 bump)) -1 0))
17305 (t -1))))
17306 ((< (nth 1 dt) 10) -1)
17307 ((= (nth 1 dt) 10)
17308 (let ((sunday (math-prev-weekday-in-month date dt 31 0)))
17309 (cond ((< (nth 2 dt) sunday) -1)
17310 ((= (nth 2 dt) sunday)
17311 (if (>= (nth 3 dt) (+ 2 bump)) 0 -1))
17312 (t 0))))
17313 (t 0))
17314 )
17315 @end smallexample
17316
17317 @noindent
17318 The @code{bump} parameter is equal to zero when Calc is converting
17319 from a date form in a generalized time zone into a GMT date value.
17320 It is @mathit{-1} when Calc is converting in the other direction. The
17321 adjustments shown above ensure that the conversion behaves correctly
17322 and reasonably around the 2 a.m.@: transition in each direction.
17323
17324 There is a ``missing'' hour between 2 a.m.@: and 3 a.m.@: at the
17325 beginning of daylight saving time; converting a date/time form that
17326 falls in this hour results in a time value for the following hour,
17327 from 3 a.m.@: to 4 a.m. At the end of daylight saving time, the
17328 hour from 1 a.m.@: to 2 a.m.@: repeats itself; converting a date/time
17329 form that falls in this hour results in a time value for the first
17330 manifestation of that time (@emph{not} the one that occurs one hour
17331 later).
17332
17333 If @code{math-daylight-savings-hook} is @code{nil}, then the
17334 daylight saving adjustment is always taken to be zero.
17335
17336 In algebraic formulas, @samp{tzone(@var{zone}, @var{date})}
17337 computes the time zone adjustment for a given zone name at a
17338 given date. The @var{date} is ignored unless @var{zone} is a
17339 generalized time zone. If @var{date} is a date form, the
17340 daylight saving computation is applied to it as it appears.
17341 If @var{date} is a numeric date value, it is adjusted for the
17342 daylight-saving version of @var{zone} before being given to
17343 the daylight saving hook. This odd-sounding rule ensures
17344 that the daylight-saving computation is always done in
17345 local time, not in the GMT time that a numeric @var{date}
17346 is typically represented in.
17347
17348 @ignore
17349 @starindex
17350 @end ignore
17351 @tindex dsadj
17352 The @samp{dsadj(@var{date}, @var{zone})} function computes the
17353 daylight saving adjustment that is appropriate for @var{date} in
17354 time zone @var{zone}. If @var{zone} is explicitly in or not in
17355 daylight saving time (e.g., @code{PDT} or @code{PST}) the
17356 @var{date} is ignored. If @var{zone} is a generalized time zone,
17357 the algorithms described above are used. If @var{zone} is omitted,
17358 the computation is done for the current time zone.
17359
17360 @node Financial Functions, Binary Functions, Date Arithmetic, Arithmetic
17361 @section Financial Functions
17362
17363 @noindent
17364 Calc's financial or business functions use the @kbd{b} prefix
17365 key followed by a shifted letter. (The @kbd{b} prefix followed by
17366 a lower-case letter is used for operations on binary numbers.)
17367
17368 Note that the rate and the number of intervals given to these
17369 functions must be on the same time scale, e.g., both months or
17370 both years. Mixing an annual interest rate with a time expressed
17371 in months will give you very wrong answers!
17372
17373 It is wise to compute these functions to a higher precision than
17374 you really need, just to make sure your answer is correct to the
17375 last penny; also, you may wish to check the definitions at the end
17376 of this section to make sure the functions have the meaning you expect.
17377
17378 @menu
17379 * Percentages::
17380 * Future Value::
17381 * Present Value::
17382 * Related Financial Functions::
17383 * Depreciation Functions::
17384 * Definitions of Financial Functions::
17385 @end menu
17386
17387 @node Percentages, Future Value, Financial Functions, Financial Functions
17388 @subsection Percentages
17389
17390 @kindex M-%
17391 @pindex calc-percent
17392 @tindex %
17393 @tindex percent
17394 The @kbd{M-%} (@code{calc-percent}) command takes a percentage value,
17395 say 5.4, and converts it to an equivalent actual number. For example,
17396 @kbd{5.4 M-%} enters 0.054 on the stack. (That's the @key{META} or
17397 @key{ESC} key combined with @kbd{%}.)
17398
17399 Actually, @kbd{M-%} creates a formula of the form @samp{5.4%}.
17400 You can enter @samp{5.4%} yourself during algebraic entry. The
17401 @samp{%} operator simply means, ``the preceding value divided by
17402 100.'' The @samp{%} operator has very high precedence, so that
17403 @samp{1+8%} is interpreted as @samp{1+(8%)}, not as @samp{(1+8)%}.
17404 (The @samp{%} operator is just a postfix notation for the
17405 @code{percent} function, just like @samp{20!} is the notation for
17406 @samp{fact(20)}, or twenty-factorial.)
17407
17408 The formula @samp{5.4%} would normally evaluate immediately to
17409 0.054, but the @kbd{M-%} command suppresses evaluation as it puts
17410 the formula onto the stack. However, the next Calc command that
17411 uses the formula @samp{5.4%} will evaluate it as its first step.
17412 The net effect is that you get to look at @samp{5.4%} on the stack,
17413 but Calc commands see it as @samp{0.054}, which is what they expect.
17414
17415 In particular, @samp{5.4%} and @samp{0.054} are suitable values
17416 for the @var{rate} arguments of the various financial functions,
17417 but the number @samp{5.4} is probably @emph{not} suitable---it
17418 represents a rate of 540 percent!
17419
17420 The key sequence @kbd{M-% *} effectively means ``percent-of.''
17421 For example, @kbd{68 @key{RET} 25 M-% *} computes 17, which is 25% of
17422 68 (and also 68% of 25, which comes out to the same thing).
17423
17424 @kindex c %
17425 @pindex calc-convert-percent
17426 The @kbd{c %} (@code{calc-convert-percent}) command converts the
17427 value on the top of the stack from numeric to percentage form.
17428 For example, if 0.08 is on the stack, @kbd{c %} converts it to
17429 @samp{8%}. The quantity is the same, it's just represented
17430 differently. (Contrast this with @kbd{M-%}, which would convert
17431 this number to @samp{0.08%}.) The @kbd{=} key is a convenient way
17432 to convert a formula like @samp{8%} back to numeric form, 0.08.
17433
17434 To compute what percentage one quantity is of another quantity,
17435 use @kbd{/ c %}. For example, @w{@kbd{17 @key{RET} 68 / c %}} displays
17436 @samp{25%}.
17437
17438 @kindex b %
17439 @pindex calc-percent-change
17440 @tindex relch
17441 The @kbd{b %} (@code{calc-percent-change}) [@code{relch}] command
17442 calculates the percentage change from one number to another.
17443 For example, @kbd{40 @key{RET} 50 b %} produces the answer @samp{25%},
17444 since 50 is 25% larger than 40. A negative result represents a
17445 decrease: @kbd{50 @key{RET} 40 b %} produces @samp{-20%}, since 40 is
17446 20% smaller than 50. (The answers are different in magnitude
17447 because, in the first case, we're increasing by 25% of 40, but
17448 in the second case, we're decreasing by 20% of 50.) The effect
17449 of @kbd{40 @key{RET} 50 b %} is to compute @expr{(50-40)/40}, converting
17450 the answer to percentage form as if by @kbd{c %}.
17451
17452 @node Future Value, Present Value, Percentages, Financial Functions
17453 @subsection Future Value
17454
17455 @noindent
17456 @kindex b F
17457 @pindex calc-fin-fv
17458 @tindex fv
17459 The @kbd{b F} (@code{calc-fin-fv}) [@code{fv}] command computes
17460 the future value of an investment. It takes three arguments
17461 from the stack: @samp{fv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment})}.
17462 If you give payments of @var{payment} every year for @var{n}
17463 years, and the money you have paid earns interest at @var{rate} per
17464 year, then this function tells you what your investment would be
17465 worth at the end of the period. (The actual interval doesn't
17466 have to be years, as long as @var{n} and @var{rate} are expressed
17467 in terms of the same intervals.) This function assumes payments
17468 occur at the @emph{end} of each interval.
17469
17470 @kindex I b F
17471 @tindex fvb
17472 The @kbd{I b F} [@code{fvb}] command does the same computation,
17473 but assuming your payments are at the beginning of each interval.
17474 Suppose you plan to deposit $1000 per year in a savings account
17475 earning 5.4% interest, starting right now. How much will be
17476 in the account after five years? @code{fvb(5.4%, 5, 1000) = 5870.73}.
17477 Thus you will have earned $870 worth of interest over the years.
17478 Using the stack, this calculation would have been
17479 @kbd{5.4 M-% 5 @key{RET} 1000 I b F}. Note that the rate is expressed
17480 as a number between 0 and 1, @emph{not} as a percentage.
17481
17482 @kindex H b F
17483 @tindex fvl
17484 The @kbd{H b F} [@code{fvl}] command computes the future value
17485 of an initial lump sum investment. Suppose you could deposit
17486 those five thousand dollars in the bank right now; how much would
17487 they be worth in five years? @code{fvl(5.4%, 5, 5000) = 6503.89}.
17488
17489 The algebraic functions @code{fv} and @code{fvb} accept an optional
17490 fourth argument, which is used as an initial lump sum in the sense
17491 of @code{fvl}. In other words, @code{fv(@var{rate}, @var{n},
17492 @var{payment}, @var{initial}) = fv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment})
17493 + fvl(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{initial})}.
17494
17495 To illustrate the relationships between these functions, we could
17496 do the @code{fvb} calculation ``by hand'' using @code{fvl}. The
17497 final balance will be the sum of the contributions of our five
17498 deposits at various times. The first deposit earns interest for
17499 five years: @code{fvl(5.4%, 5, 1000) = 1300.78}. The second
17500 deposit only earns interest for four years: @code{fvl(5.4%, 4, 1000) =
17501 1234.13}. And so on down to the last deposit, which earns one
17502 year's interest: @code{fvl(5.4%, 1, 1000) = 1054.00}. The sum of
17503 these five values is, sure enough, $5870.73, just as was computed
17504 by @code{fvb} directly.
17505
17506 What does @code{fv(5.4%, 5, 1000) = 5569.96} mean? The payments
17507 are now at the ends of the periods. The end of one year is the same
17508 as the beginning of the next, so what this really means is that we've
17509 lost the payment at year zero (which contributed $1300.78), but we're
17510 now counting the payment at year five (which, since it didn't have
17511 a chance to earn interest, counts as $1000). Indeed, @expr{5569.96 =
17512 5870.73 - 1300.78 + 1000} (give or take a bit of roundoff error).
17513
17514 @node Present Value, Related Financial Functions, Future Value, Financial Functions
17515 @subsection Present Value
17516
17517 @noindent
17518 @kindex b P
17519 @pindex calc-fin-pv
17520 @tindex pv
17521 The @kbd{b P} (@code{calc-fin-pv}) [@code{pv}] command computes
17522 the present value of an investment. Like @code{fv}, it takes
17523 three arguments: @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment})}.
17524 It computes the present value of a series of regular payments.
17525 Suppose you have the chance to make an investment that will
17526 pay $2000 per year over the next four years; as you receive
17527 these payments you can put them in the bank at 9% interest.
17528 You want to know whether it is better to make the investment, or
17529 to keep the money in the bank where it earns 9% interest right
17530 from the start. The calculation @code{pv(9%, 4, 2000)} gives the
17531 result 6479.44. If your initial investment must be less than this,
17532 say, $6000, then the investment is worthwhile. But if you had to
17533 put up $7000, then it would be better just to leave it in the bank.
17534
17535 Here is the interpretation of the result of @code{pv}: You are
17536 trying to compare the return from the investment you are
17537 considering, which is @code{fv(9%, 4, 2000) = 9146.26}, with
17538 the return from leaving the money in the bank, which is
17539 @code{fvl(9%, 4, @var{x})} where @var{x} is the amount of money
17540 you would have to put up in advance. The @code{pv} function
17541 finds the break-even point, @expr{x = 6479.44}, at which
17542 @code{fvl(9%, 4, 6479.44)} is also equal to 9146.26. This is
17543 the largest amount you should be willing to invest.
17544
17545 @kindex I b P
17546 @tindex pvb
17547 The @kbd{I b P} [@code{pvb}] command solves the same problem,
17548 but with payments occurring at the beginning of each interval.
17549 It has the same relationship to @code{fvb} as @code{pv} has
17550 to @code{fv}. For example @code{pvb(9%, 4, 2000) = 7062.59},
17551 a larger number than @code{pv} produced because we get to start
17552 earning interest on the return from our investment sooner.
17553
17554 @kindex H b P
17555 @tindex pvl
17556 The @kbd{H b P} [@code{pvl}] command computes the present value of
17557 an investment that will pay off in one lump sum at the end of the
17558 period. For example, if we get our $8000 all at the end of the
17559 four years, @code{pvl(9%, 4, 8000) = 5667.40}. This is much
17560 less than @code{pv} reported, because we don't earn any interest
17561 on the return from this investment. Note that @code{pvl} and
17562 @code{fvl} are simple inverses: @code{fvl(9%, 4, 5667.40) = 8000}.
17563
17564 You can give an optional fourth lump-sum argument to @code{pv}
17565 and @code{pvb}; this is handled in exactly the same way as the
17566 fourth argument for @code{fv} and @code{fvb}.
17567
17568 @kindex b N
17569 @pindex calc-fin-npv
17570 @tindex npv
17571 The @kbd{b N} (@code{calc-fin-npv}) [@code{npv}] command computes
17572 the net present value of a series of irregular investments.
17573 The first argument is the interest rate. The second argument is
17574 a vector which represents the expected return from the investment
17575 at the end of each interval. For example, if the rate represents
17576 a yearly interest rate, then the vector elements are the return
17577 from the first year, second year, and so on.
17578
17579 Thus, @code{npv(9%, [2000,2000,2000,2000]) = pv(9%, 4, 2000) = 6479.44}.
17580 Obviously this function is more interesting when the payments are
17581 not all the same!
17582
17583 The @code{npv} function can actually have two or more arguments.
17584 Multiple arguments are interpreted in the same way as for the
17585 vector statistical functions like @code{vsum}.
17586 @xref{Single-Variable Statistics}. Basically, if there are several
17587 payment arguments, each either a vector or a plain number, all these
17588 values are collected left-to-right into the complete list of payments.
17589 A numeric prefix argument on the @kbd{b N} command says how many
17590 payment values or vectors to take from the stack.
17591
17592 @kindex I b N
17593 @tindex npvb
17594 The @kbd{I b N} [@code{npvb}] command computes the net present
17595 value where payments occur at the beginning of each interval
17596 rather than at the end.
17597
17598 @node Related Financial Functions, Depreciation Functions, Present Value, Financial Functions
17599 @subsection Related Financial Functions
17600
17601 @noindent
17602 The functions in this section are basically inverses of the
17603 present value functions with respect to the various arguments.
17604
17605 @kindex b M
17606 @pindex calc-fin-pmt
17607 @tindex pmt
17608 The @kbd{b M} (@code{calc-fin-pmt}) [@code{pmt}] command computes
17609 the amount of periodic payment necessary to amortize a loan.
17610 Thus @code{pmt(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{amount})} equals the
17611 value of @var{payment} such that @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n},
17612 @var{payment}) = @var{amount}}.
17613
17614 @kindex I b M
17615 @tindex pmtb
17616 The @kbd{I b M} [@code{pmtb}] command does the same computation
17617 but using @code{pvb} instead of @code{pv}. Like @code{pv} and
17618 @code{pvb}, these functions can also take a fourth argument which
17619 represents an initial lump-sum investment.
17620
17621 @kindex H b M
17622 The @kbd{H b M} key just invokes the @code{fvl} function, which is
17623 the inverse of @code{pvl}. There is no explicit @code{pmtl} function.
17624
17625 @kindex b #
17626 @pindex calc-fin-nper
17627 @tindex nper
17628 The @kbd{b #} (@code{calc-fin-nper}) [@code{nper}] command computes
17629 the number of regular payments necessary to amortize a loan.
17630 Thus @code{nper(@var{rate}, @var{payment}, @var{amount})} equals
17631 the value of @var{n} such that @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n},
17632 @var{payment}) = @var{amount}}. If @var{payment} is too small
17633 ever to amortize a loan for @var{amount} at interest rate @var{rate},
17634 the @code{nper} function is left in symbolic form.
17635
17636 @kindex I b #
17637 @tindex nperb
17638 The @kbd{I b #} [@code{nperb}] command does the same computation
17639 but using @code{pvb} instead of @code{pv}. You can give a fourth
17640 lump-sum argument to these functions, but the computation will be
17641 rather slow in the four-argument case.
17642
17643 @kindex H b #
17644 @tindex nperl
17645 The @kbd{H b #} [@code{nperl}] command does the same computation
17646 using @code{pvl}. By exchanging @var{payment} and @var{amount} you
17647 can also get the solution for @code{fvl}. For example,
17648 @code{nperl(8%, 2000, 1000) = 9.006}, so if you place $1000 in a
17649 bank account earning 8%, it will take nine years to grow to $2000.
17650
17651 @kindex b T
17652 @pindex calc-fin-rate
17653 @tindex rate
17654 The @kbd{b T} (@code{calc-fin-rate}) [@code{rate}] command computes
17655 the rate of return on an investment. This is also an inverse of @code{pv}:
17656 @code{rate(@var{n}, @var{payment}, @var{amount})} computes the value of
17657 @var{rate} such that @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment}) =
17658 @var{amount}}. The result is expressed as a formula like @samp{6.3%}.
17659
17660 @kindex I b T
17661 @kindex H b T
17662 @tindex rateb
17663 @tindex ratel
17664 The @kbd{I b T} [@code{rateb}] and @kbd{H b T} [@code{ratel}]
17665 commands solve the analogous equations with @code{pvb} or @code{pvl}
17666 in place of @code{pv}. Also, @code{rate} and @code{rateb} can
17667 accept an optional fourth argument just like @code{pv} and @code{pvb}.
17668 To redo the above example from a different perspective,
17669 @code{ratel(9, 2000, 1000) = 8.00597%}, which says you will need an
17670 interest rate of 8% in order to double your account in nine years.
17671
17672 @kindex b I
17673 @pindex calc-fin-irr
17674 @tindex irr
17675 The @kbd{b I} (@code{calc-fin-irr}) [@code{irr}] command is the
17676 analogous function to @code{rate} but for net present value.
17677 Its argument is a vector of payments. Thus @code{irr(@var{payments})}
17678 computes the @var{rate} such that @code{npv(@var{rate}, @var{payments}) = 0};
17679 this rate is known as the @dfn{internal rate of return}.
17680
17681 @kindex I b I
17682 @tindex irrb
17683 The @kbd{I b I} [@code{irrb}] command computes the internal rate of
17684 return assuming payments occur at the beginning of each period.
17685
17686 @node Depreciation Functions, Definitions of Financial Functions, Related Financial Functions, Financial Functions
17687 @subsection Depreciation Functions
17688
17689 @noindent
17690 The functions in this section calculate @dfn{depreciation}, which is
17691 the amount of value that a possession loses over time. These functions
17692 are characterized by three parameters: @var{cost}, the original cost
17693 of the asset; @var{salvage}, the value the asset will have at the end
17694 of its expected ``useful life''; and @var{life}, the number of years
17695 (or other periods) of the expected useful life.
17696
17697 There are several methods for calculating depreciation that differ in
17698 the way they spread the depreciation over the lifetime of the asset.
17699
17700 @kindex b S
17701 @pindex calc-fin-sln
17702 @tindex sln
17703 The @kbd{b S} (@code{calc-fin-sln}) [@code{sln}] command computes the
17704 ``straight-line'' depreciation. In this method, the asset depreciates
17705 by the same amount every year (or period). For example,
17706 @samp{sln(12000, 2000, 5)} returns 2000. The asset costs $12000
17707 initially and will be worth $2000 after five years; it loses $2000
17708 per year.
17709
17710 @kindex b Y
17711 @pindex calc-fin-syd
17712 @tindex syd
17713 The @kbd{b Y} (@code{calc-fin-syd}) [@code{syd}] command computes the
17714 accelerated ``sum-of-years'-digits'' depreciation. Here the depreciation
17715 is higher during the early years of the asset's life. Since the
17716 depreciation is different each year, @kbd{b Y} takes a fourth @var{period}
17717 parameter which specifies which year is requested, from 1 to @var{life}.
17718 If @var{period} is outside this range, the @code{syd} function will
17719 return zero.
17720
17721 @kindex b D
17722 @pindex calc-fin-ddb
17723 @tindex ddb
17724 The @kbd{b D} (@code{calc-fin-ddb}) [@code{ddb}] command computes an
17725 accelerated depreciation using the double-declining balance method.
17726 It also takes a fourth @var{period} parameter.
17727
17728 For symmetry, the @code{sln} function will accept a @var{period}
17729 parameter as well, although it will ignore its value except that the
17730 return value will as usual be zero if @var{period} is out of range.
17731
17732 For example, pushing the vector @expr{[1,2,3,4,5]} (perhaps with @kbd{v x 5})
17733 and then mapping @kbd{V M ' [sln(12000,2000,5,$), syd(12000,2000,5,$),
17734 ddb(12000,2000,5,$)] @key{RET}} produces a matrix that allows us to compare
17735 the three depreciation methods:
17736
17737 @example
17738 @group
17739 [ [ 2000, 3333, 4800 ]
17740 [ 2000, 2667, 2880 ]
17741 [ 2000, 2000, 1728 ]
17742 [ 2000, 1333, 592 ]
17743 [ 2000, 667, 0 ] ]
17744 @end group
17745 @end example
17746
17747 @noindent
17748 (Values have been rounded to nearest integers in this figure.)
17749 We see that @code{sln} depreciates by the same amount each year,
17750 @kbd{syd} depreciates more at the beginning and less at the end,
17751 and @kbd{ddb} weights the depreciation even more toward the beginning.
17752
17753 Summing columns with @kbd{V R : +} yields @expr{[10000, 10000, 10000]};
17754 the total depreciation in any method is (by definition) the
17755 difference between the cost and the salvage value.
17756
17757 @node Definitions of Financial Functions, , Depreciation Functions, Financial Functions
17758 @subsection Definitions
17759
17760 @noindent
17761 For your reference, here are the actual formulas used to compute
17762 Calc's financial functions.
17763
17764 Calc will not evaluate a financial function unless the @var{rate} or
17765 @var{n} argument is known. However, @var{payment} or @var{amount} can
17766 be a variable. Calc expands these functions according to the
17767 formulas below for symbolic arguments only when you use the @kbd{a "}
17768 (@code{calc-expand-formula}) command, or when taking derivatives or
17769 integrals or solving equations involving the functions.
17770
17771 @ifnottex
17772 These formulas are shown using the conventions of Big display
17773 mode (@kbd{d B}); for example, the formula for @code{fv} written
17774 linearly is @samp{pmt * ((1 + rate)^n) - 1) / rate}.
17775
17776 @example
17777 n
17778 (1 + rate) - 1
17779 fv(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * ---------------
17780 rate
17781
17782 n
17783 ((1 + rate) - 1) (1 + rate)
17784 fvb(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * ----------------------------
17785 rate
17786
17787 n
17788 fvl(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * (1 + rate)
17789
17790 -n
17791 1 - (1 + rate)
17792 pv(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * ----------------
17793 rate
17794
17795 -n
17796 (1 - (1 + rate) ) (1 + rate)
17797 pvb(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * -----------------------------
17798 rate
17799
17800 -n
17801 pvl(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * (1 + rate)
17802
17803 -1 -2 -3
17804 npv(rate, [a, b, c]) = a*(1 + rate) + b*(1 + rate) + c*(1 + rate)
17805
17806 -1 -2
17807 npvb(rate, [a, b, c]) = a + b*(1 + rate) + c*(1 + rate)
17808
17809 -n
17810 (amt - x * (1 + rate) ) * rate
17811 pmt(rate, n, amt, x) = -------------------------------
17812 -n
17813 1 - (1 + rate)
17814
17815 -n
17816 (amt - x * (1 + rate) ) * rate
17817 pmtb(rate, n, amt, x) = -------------------------------
17818 -n
17819 (1 - (1 + rate) ) (1 + rate)
17820
17821 amt * rate
17822 nper(rate, pmt, amt) = - log(1 - ------------, 1 + rate)
17823 pmt
17824
17825 amt * rate
17826 nperb(rate, pmt, amt) = - log(1 - ---------------, 1 + rate)
17827 pmt * (1 + rate)
17828
17829 amt
17830 nperl(rate, pmt, amt) = - log(---, 1 + rate)
17831 pmt
17832
17833 1/n
17834 pmt
17835 ratel(n, pmt, amt) = ------ - 1
17836 1/n
17837 amt
17838
17839 cost - salv
17840 sln(cost, salv, life) = -----------
17841 life
17842
17843 (cost - salv) * (life - per + 1)
17844 syd(cost, salv, life, per) = --------------------------------
17845 life * (life + 1) / 2
17846
17847 book * 2
17848 ddb(cost, salv, life, per) = --------, book = cost - depreciation so far
17849 life
17850 @end example
17851 @end ifnottex
17852 @tex
17853 \turnoffactive
17854 $$ \code{fv}(r, n, p) = p { (1 + r)^n - 1 \over r } $$
17855 $$ \code{fvb}(r, n, p) = p { ((1 + r)^n - 1) (1 + r) \over r } $$
17856 $$ \code{fvl}(r, n, p) = p (1 + r)^n $$
17857 $$ \code{pv}(r, n, p) = p { 1 - (1 + r)^{-n} \over r } $$
17858 $$ \code{pvb}(r, n, p) = p { (1 - (1 + r)^{-n}) (1 + r) \over r } $$
17859 $$ \code{pvl}(r, n, p) = p (1 + r)^{-n} $$
17860 $$ \code{npv}(r, [a,b,c]) = a (1 + r)^{-1} + b (1 + r)^{-2} + c (1 + r)^{-3} $$
17861 $$ \code{npvb}(r, [a,b,c]) = a + b (1 + r)^{-1} + c (1 + r)^{-2} $$
17862 $$ \code{pmt}(r, n, a, x) = { (a - x (1 + r)^{-n}) r \over 1 - (1 + r)^{-n} }$$
17863 $$ \code{pmtb}(r, n, a, x) = { (a - x (1 + r)^{-n}) r \over
17864 (1 - (1 + r)^{-n}) (1 + r) } $$
17865 $$ \code{nper}(r, p, a) = -\code{log}(1 - { a r \over p }, 1 + r) $$
17866 $$ \code{nperb}(r, p, a) = -\code{log}(1 - { a r \over p (1 + r) }, 1 + r) $$
17867 $$ \code{nperl}(r, p, a) = -\code{log}({a \over p}, 1 + r) $$
17868 $$ \code{ratel}(n, p, a) = { p^{1/n} \over a^{1/n} } - 1 $$
17869 $$ \code{sln}(c, s, l) = { c - s \over l } $$
17870 $$ \code{syd}(c, s, l, p) = { (c - s) (l - p + 1) \over l (l+1) / 2 } $$
17871 $$ \code{ddb}(c, s, l, p) = { 2 (c - \hbox{depreciation so far}) \over l } $$
17872 @end tex
17873
17874 @noindent
17875 In @code{pmt} and @code{pmtb}, @expr{x=0} if omitted.
17876
17877 These functions accept any numeric objects, including error forms,
17878 intervals, and even (though not very usefully) complex numbers. The
17879 above formulas specify exactly the behavior of these functions with
17880 all sorts of inputs.
17881
17882 Note that if the first argument to the @code{log} in @code{nper} is
17883 negative, @code{nper} leaves itself in symbolic form rather than
17884 returning a (financially meaningless) complex number.
17885
17886 @samp{rate(num, pmt, amt)} solves the equation
17887 @samp{pv(rate, num, pmt) = amt} for @samp{rate} using @kbd{H a R}
17888 (@code{calc-find-root}), with the interval @samp{[.01% .. 100%]}
17889 for an initial guess. The @code{rateb} function is the same except
17890 that it uses @code{pvb}. Note that @code{ratel} can be solved
17891 directly; its formula is shown in the above list.
17892
17893 Similarly, @samp{irr(pmts)} solves the equation @samp{npv(rate, pmts) = 0}
17894 for @samp{rate}.
17895
17896 If you give a fourth argument to @code{nper} or @code{nperb}, Calc
17897 will also use @kbd{H a R} to solve the equation using an initial
17898 guess interval of @samp{[0 .. 100]}.
17899
17900 A fourth argument to @code{fv} simply sums the two components
17901 calculated from the above formulas for @code{fv} and @code{fvl}.
17902 The same is true of @code{fvb}, @code{pv}, and @code{pvb}.
17903
17904 The @kbd{ddb} function is computed iteratively; the ``book'' value
17905 starts out equal to @var{cost}, and decreases according to the above
17906 formula for the specified number of periods. If the book value
17907 would decrease below @var{salvage}, it only decreases to @var{salvage}
17908 and the depreciation is zero for all subsequent periods. The @code{ddb}
17909 function returns the amount the book value decreased in the specified
17910 period.
17911
17912 @node Binary Functions, , Financial Functions, Arithmetic
17913 @section Binary Number Functions
17914
17915 @noindent
17916 The commands in this chapter all use two-letter sequences beginning with
17917 the @kbd{b} prefix.
17918
17919 @cindex Binary numbers
17920 The ``binary'' operations actually work regardless of the currently
17921 displayed radix, although their results make the most sense in a radix
17922 like 2, 8, or 16 (as obtained by the @kbd{d 2}, @kbd{d 8}, or @w{@kbd{d 6}}
17923 commands, respectively). You may also wish to enable display of leading
17924 zeros with @kbd{d z}. @xref{Radix Modes}.
17925
17926 @cindex Word size for binary operations
17927 The Calculator maintains a current @dfn{word size} @expr{w}, an
17928 arbitrary positive or negative integer. For a positive word size, all
17929 of the binary operations described here operate modulo @expr{2^w}. In
17930 particular, negative arguments are converted to positive integers modulo
17931 @expr{2^w} by all binary functions.
17932
17933 If the word size is negative, binary operations produce 2's complement
17934 integers from
17935 @texline @math{-2^{-w-1}}
17936 @infoline @expr{-(2^(-w-1))}
17937 to
17938 @texline @math{2^{-w-1}-1}
17939 @infoline @expr{2^(-w-1)-1}
17940 inclusive. Either mode accepts inputs in any range; the sign of
17941 @expr{w} affects only the results produced.
17942
17943 @kindex b c
17944 @pindex calc-clip
17945 @tindex clip
17946 The @kbd{b c} (@code{calc-clip})
17947 [@code{clip}] command can be used to clip a number by reducing it modulo
17948 @expr{2^w}. The commands described in this chapter automatically clip
17949 their results to the current word size. Note that other operations like
17950 addition do not use the current word size, since integer addition
17951 generally is not ``binary.'' (However, @pxref{Simplification Modes},
17952 @code{calc-bin-simplify-mode}.) For example, with a word size of 8
17953 bits @kbd{b c} converts a number to the range 0 to 255; with a word
17954 size of @mathit{-8} @kbd{b c} converts to the range @mathit{-128} to 127.
17955
17956 @kindex b w
17957 @pindex calc-word-size
17958 The default word size is 32 bits. All operations except the shifts and
17959 rotates allow you to specify a different word size for that one
17960 operation by giving a numeric prefix argument: @kbd{C-u 8 b c} clips the
17961 top of stack to the range 0 to 255 regardless of the current word size.
17962 To set the word size permanently, use @kbd{b w} (@code{calc-word-size}).
17963 This command displays a prompt with the current word size; press @key{RET}
17964 immediately to keep this word size, or type a new word size at the prompt.
17965
17966 When the binary operations are written in symbolic form, they take an
17967 optional second (or third) word-size parameter. When a formula like
17968 @samp{and(a,b)} is finally evaluated, the word size current at that time
17969 will be used, but when @samp{and(a,b,-8)} is evaluated, a word size of
17970 @mathit{-8} will always be used. A symbolic binary function will be left
17971 in symbolic form unless the all of its argument(s) are integers or
17972 integer-valued floats.
17973
17974 If either or both arguments are modulo forms for which @expr{M} is a
17975 power of two, that power of two is taken as the word size unless a
17976 numeric prefix argument overrides it. The current word size is never
17977 consulted when modulo-power-of-two forms are involved.
17978
17979 @kindex b a
17980 @pindex calc-and
17981 @tindex and
17982 The @kbd{b a} (@code{calc-and}) [@code{and}] command computes the bitwise
17983 AND of the two numbers on the top of the stack. In other words, for each
17984 of the @expr{w} binary digits of the two numbers (pairwise), the corresponding
17985 bit of the result is 1 if and only if both input bits are 1:
17986 @samp{and(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#1000}.
17987
17988 @kindex b o
17989 @pindex calc-or
17990 @tindex or
17991 The @kbd{b o} (@code{calc-or}) [@code{or}] command computes the bitwise
17992 inclusive OR of two numbers. A bit is 1 if either of the input bits, or
17993 both, are 1: @samp{or(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#1110}.
17994
17995 @kindex b x
17996 @pindex calc-xor
17997 @tindex xor
17998 The @kbd{b x} (@code{calc-xor}) [@code{xor}] command computes the bitwise
17999 exclusive OR of two numbers. A bit is 1 if exactly one of the input bits
18000 is 1: @samp{xor(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#0110}.
18001
18002 @kindex b d
18003 @pindex calc-diff
18004 @tindex diff
18005 The @kbd{b d} (@code{calc-diff}) [@code{diff}] command computes the bitwise
18006 difference of two numbers; this is defined by @samp{diff(a,b) = and(a,not(b))},
18007 so that @samp{diff(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#0100}.
18008
18009 @kindex b n
18010 @pindex calc-not
18011 @tindex not
18012 The @kbd{b n} (@code{calc-not}) [@code{not}] command computes the bitwise
18013 NOT of a number. A bit is 1 if the input bit is 0 and vice-versa.
18014
18015 @kindex b l
18016 @pindex calc-lshift-binary
18017 @tindex lsh
18018 The @kbd{b l} (@code{calc-lshift-binary}) [@code{lsh}] command shifts a
18019 number left by one bit, or by the number of bits specified in the numeric
18020 prefix argument. A negative prefix argument performs a logical right shift,
18021 in which zeros are shifted in on the left. In symbolic form, @samp{lsh(a)}
18022 is short for @samp{lsh(a,1)}, which in turn is short for @samp{lsh(a,n,w)}.
18023 Bits shifted ``off the end,'' according to the current word size, are lost.
18024
18025 @kindex H b l
18026 @kindex H b r
18027 @ignore
18028 @mindex @idots
18029 @end ignore
18030 @kindex H b L
18031 @ignore
18032 @mindex @null
18033 @end ignore
18034 @kindex H b R
18035 @ignore
18036 @mindex @null
18037 @end ignore
18038 @kindex H b t
18039 The @kbd{H b l} command also does a left shift, but it takes two arguments
18040 from the stack (the value to shift, and, at top-of-stack, the number of
18041 bits to shift). This version interprets the prefix argument just like
18042 the regular binary operations, i.e., as a word size. The Hyperbolic flag
18043 has a similar effect on the rest of the binary shift and rotate commands.
18044
18045 @kindex b r
18046 @pindex calc-rshift-binary
18047 @tindex rsh
18048 The @kbd{b r} (@code{calc-rshift-binary}) [@code{rsh}] command shifts a
18049 number right by one bit, or by the number of bits specified in the numeric
18050 prefix argument: @samp{rsh(a,n) = lsh(a,-n)}.
18051
18052 @kindex b L
18053 @pindex calc-lshift-arith
18054 @tindex ash
18055 The @kbd{b L} (@code{calc-lshift-arith}) [@code{ash}] command shifts a
18056 number left. It is analogous to @code{lsh}, except that if the shift
18057 is rightward (the prefix argument is negative), an arithmetic shift
18058 is performed as described below.
18059
18060 @kindex b R
18061 @pindex calc-rshift-arith
18062 @tindex rash
18063 The @kbd{b R} (@code{calc-rshift-arith}) [@code{rash}] command performs
18064 an ``arithmetic'' shift to the right, in which the leftmost bit (according
18065 to the current word size) is duplicated rather than shifting in zeros.
18066 This corresponds to dividing by a power of two where the input is interpreted
18067 as a signed, twos-complement number. (The distinction between the @samp{rsh}
18068 and @samp{rash} operations is totally independent from whether the word
18069 size is positive or negative.) With a negative prefix argument, this
18070 performs a standard left shift.
18071
18072 @kindex b t
18073 @pindex calc-rotate-binary
18074 @tindex rot
18075 The @kbd{b t} (@code{calc-rotate-binary}) [@code{rot}] command rotates a
18076 number one bit to the left. The leftmost bit (according to the current
18077 word size) is dropped off the left and shifted in on the right. With a
18078 numeric prefix argument, the number is rotated that many bits to the left
18079 or right.
18080
18081 @xref{Set Operations}, for the @kbd{b p} and @kbd{b u} commands that
18082 pack and unpack binary integers into sets. (For example, @kbd{b u}
18083 unpacks the number @samp{2#11001} to the set of bit-numbers
18084 @samp{[0, 3, 4]}.) Type @kbd{b u V #} to count the number of ``1''
18085 bits in a binary integer.
18086
18087 Another interesting use of the set representation of binary integers
18088 is to reverse the bits in, say, a 32-bit integer. Type @kbd{b u} to
18089 unpack; type @kbd{31 @key{TAB} -} to replace each bit-number in the set
18090 with 31 minus that bit-number; type @kbd{b p} to pack the set back
18091 into a binary integer.
18092
18093 @node Scientific Functions, Matrix Functions, Arithmetic, Top
18094 @chapter Scientific Functions
18095
18096 @noindent
18097 The functions described here perform trigonometric and other transcendental
18098 calculations. They generally produce floating-point answers correct to the
18099 full current precision. The @kbd{H} (Hyperbolic) and @kbd{I} (Inverse)
18100 flag keys must be used to get some of these functions from the keyboard.
18101
18102 @kindex P
18103 @pindex calc-pi
18104 @cindex @code{pi} variable
18105 @vindex pi
18106 @kindex H P
18107 @cindex @code{e} variable
18108 @vindex e
18109 @kindex I P
18110 @cindex @code{gamma} variable
18111 @vindex gamma
18112 @cindex Gamma constant, Euler's
18113 @cindex Euler's gamma constant
18114 @kindex H I P
18115 @cindex @code{phi} variable
18116 @cindex Phi, golden ratio
18117 @cindex Golden ratio
18118 One miscellaneous command is shift-@kbd{P} (@code{calc-pi}), which pushes
18119 the value of @cpi{} (at the current precision) onto the stack. With the
18120 Hyperbolic flag, it pushes the value @expr{e}, the base of natural logarithms.
18121 With the Inverse flag, it pushes Euler's constant
18122 @texline @math{\gamma}
18123 @infoline @expr{gamma}
18124 (about 0.5772). With both Inverse and Hyperbolic, it
18125 pushes the ``golden ratio''
18126 @texline @math{\phi}
18127 @infoline @expr{phi}
18128 (about 1.618). (At present, Euler's constant is not available
18129 to unlimited precision; Calc knows only the first 100 digits.)
18130 In Symbolic mode, these commands push the
18131 actual variables @samp{pi}, @samp{e}, @samp{gamma}, and @samp{phi},
18132 respectively, instead of their values; @pxref{Symbolic Mode}.
18133
18134 @ignore
18135 @mindex Q
18136 @end ignore
18137 @ignore
18138 @mindex I Q
18139 @end ignore
18140 @kindex I Q
18141 @tindex sqr
18142 The @kbd{Q} (@code{calc-sqrt}) [@code{sqrt}] function is described elsewhere;
18143 @pxref{Basic Arithmetic}. With the Inverse flag [@code{sqr}], this command
18144 computes the square of the argument.
18145
18146 @xref{Prefix Arguments}, for a discussion of the effect of numeric
18147 prefix arguments on commands in this chapter which do not otherwise
18148 interpret a prefix argument.
18149
18150 @menu
18151 * Logarithmic Functions::
18152 * Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions::
18153 * Advanced Math Functions::
18154 * Branch Cuts::
18155 * Random Numbers::
18156 * Combinatorial Functions::
18157 * Probability Distribution Functions::
18158 @end menu
18159
18160 @node Logarithmic Functions, Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions, Scientific Functions, Scientific Functions
18161 @section Logarithmic Functions
18162
18163 @noindent
18164 @kindex L
18165 @pindex calc-ln
18166 @tindex ln
18167 @ignore
18168 @mindex @null
18169 @end ignore
18170 @kindex I E
18171 The shift-@kbd{L} (@code{calc-ln}) [@code{ln}] command computes the natural
18172 logarithm of the real or complex number on the top of the stack. With
18173 the Inverse flag it computes the exponential function instead, although
18174 this is redundant with the @kbd{E} command.
18175
18176 @kindex E
18177 @pindex calc-exp
18178 @tindex exp
18179 @ignore
18180 @mindex @null
18181 @end ignore
18182 @kindex I L
18183 The shift-@kbd{E} (@code{calc-exp}) [@code{exp}] command computes the
18184 exponential, i.e., @expr{e} raised to the power of the number on the stack.
18185 The meanings of the Inverse and Hyperbolic flags follow from those for
18186 the @code{calc-ln} command.
18187
18188 @kindex H L
18189 @kindex H E
18190 @pindex calc-log10
18191 @tindex log10
18192 @tindex exp10
18193 @ignore
18194 @mindex @null
18195 @end ignore
18196 @kindex H I L
18197 @ignore
18198 @mindex @null
18199 @end ignore
18200 @kindex H I E
18201 The @kbd{H L} (@code{calc-log10}) [@code{log10}] command computes the common
18202 (base-10) logarithm of a number. (With the Inverse flag [@code{exp10}],
18203 it raises ten to a given power.) Note that the common logarithm of a
18204 complex number is computed by taking the natural logarithm and dividing
18205 by
18206 @texline @math{\ln10}.
18207 @infoline @expr{ln(10)}.
18208
18209 @kindex B
18210 @kindex I B
18211 @pindex calc-log
18212 @tindex log
18213 @tindex alog
18214 The @kbd{B} (@code{calc-log}) [@code{log}] command computes a logarithm
18215 to any base. For example, @kbd{1024 @key{RET} 2 B} produces 10, since
18216 @texline @math{2^{10} = 1024}.
18217 @infoline @expr{2^10 = 1024}.
18218 In certain cases like @samp{log(3,9)}, the result
18219 will be either @expr{1:2} or @expr{0.5} depending on the current Fraction
18220 mode setting. With the Inverse flag [@code{alog}], this command is
18221 similar to @kbd{^} except that the order of the arguments is reversed.
18222
18223 @kindex f I
18224 @pindex calc-ilog
18225 @tindex ilog
18226 The @kbd{f I} (@code{calc-ilog}) [@code{ilog}] command computes the
18227 integer logarithm of a number to any base. The number and the base must
18228 themselves be positive integers. This is the true logarithm, rounded
18229 down to an integer. Thus @kbd{ilog(x,10)} is 3 for all @expr{x} in the
18230 range from 1000 to 9999. If both arguments are positive integers, exact
18231 integer arithmetic is used; otherwise, this is equivalent to
18232 @samp{floor(log(x,b))}.
18233
18234 @kindex f E
18235 @pindex calc-expm1
18236 @tindex expm1
18237 The @kbd{f E} (@code{calc-expm1}) [@code{expm1}] command computes
18238 @texline @math{e^x - 1},
18239 @infoline @expr{exp(x)-1},
18240 but using an algorithm that produces a more accurate
18241 answer when the result is close to zero, i.e., when
18242 @texline @math{e^x}
18243 @infoline @expr{exp(x)}
18244 is close to one.
18245
18246 @kindex f L
18247 @pindex calc-lnp1
18248 @tindex lnp1
18249 The @kbd{f L} (@code{calc-lnp1}) [@code{lnp1}] command computes
18250 @texline @math{\ln(x+1)},
18251 @infoline @expr{ln(x+1)},
18252 producing a more accurate answer when @expr{x} is close to zero.
18253
18254 @node Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions, Advanced Math Functions, Logarithmic Functions, Scientific Functions
18255 @section Trigonometric/Hyperbolic Functions
18256
18257 @noindent
18258 @kindex S
18259 @pindex calc-sin
18260 @tindex sin
18261 The shift-@kbd{S} (@code{calc-sin}) [@code{sin}] command computes the sine
18262 of an angle or complex number. If the input is an HMS form, it is interpreted
18263 as degrees-minutes-seconds; otherwise, the input is interpreted according
18264 to the current angular mode. It is best to use Radians mode when operating
18265 on complex numbers.
18266
18267 Calc's ``units'' mechanism includes angular units like @code{deg},
18268 @code{rad}, and @code{grad}. While @samp{sin(45 deg)} is not evaluated
18269 all the time, the @kbd{u s} (@code{calc-simplify-units}) command will
18270 simplify @samp{sin(45 deg)} by taking the sine of 45 degrees, regardless
18271 of the current angular mode. @xref{Basic Operations on Units}.
18272
18273 Also, the symbolic variable @code{pi} is not ordinarily recognized in
18274 arguments to trigonometric functions, as in @samp{sin(3 pi / 4)}, but
18275 the @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}) command recognizes many such
18276 formulas when the current angular mode is Radians @emph{and} Symbolic
18277 mode is enabled; this example would be replaced by @samp{sqrt(2) / 2}.
18278 @xref{Symbolic Mode}. Beware, this simplification occurs even if you
18279 have stored a different value in the variable @samp{pi}; this is one
18280 reason why changing built-in variables is a bad idea. Arguments of
18281 the form @expr{x} plus a multiple of @cpiover{2} are also simplified.
18282 Calc includes similar formulas for @code{cos} and @code{tan}.
18283
18284 The @kbd{a s} command knows all angles which are integer multiples of
18285 @cpiover{12}, @cpiover{10}, or @cpiover{8} radians. In Degrees mode,
18286 analogous simplifications occur for integer multiples of 15 or 18
18287 degrees, and for arguments plus multiples of 90 degrees.
18288
18289 @kindex I S
18290 @pindex calc-arcsin
18291 @tindex arcsin
18292 With the Inverse flag, @code{calc-sin} computes an arcsine. This is also
18293 available as the @code{calc-arcsin} command or @code{arcsin} algebraic
18294 function. The returned argument is converted to degrees, radians, or HMS
18295 notation depending on the current angular mode.
18296
18297 @kindex H S
18298 @pindex calc-sinh
18299 @tindex sinh
18300 @kindex H I S
18301 @pindex calc-arcsinh
18302 @tindex arcsinh
18303 With the Hyperbolic flag, @code{calc-sin} computes the hyperbolic
18304 sine, also available as @code{calc-sinh} [@code{sinh}]. With the
18305 Hyperbolic and Inverse flags, it computes the hyperbolic arcsine
18306 (@code{calc-arcsinh}) [@code{arcsinh}].
18307
18308 @kindex C
18309 @pindex calc-cos
18310 @tindex cos
18311 @ignore
18312 @mindex @idots
18313 @end ignore
18314 @kindex I C
18315 @pindex calc-arccos
18316 @ignore
18317 @mindex @null
18318 @end ignore
18319 @tindex arccos
18320 @ignore
18321 @mindex @null
18322 @end ignore
18323 @kindex H C
18324 @pindex calc-cosh
18325 @ignore
18326 @mindex @null
18327 @end ignore
18328 @tindex cosh
18329 @ignore
18330 @mindex @null
18331 @end ignore
18332 @kindex H I C
18333 @pindex calc-arccosh
18334 @ignore
18335 @mindex @null
18336 @end ignore
18337 @tindex arccosh
18338 @ignore
18339 @mindex @null
18340 @end ignore
18341 @kindex T
18342 @pindex calc-tan
18343 @ignore
18344 @mindex @null
18345 @end ignore
18346 @tindex tan
18347 @ignore
18348 @mindex @null
18349 @end ignore
18350 @kindex I T
18351 @pindex calc-arctan
18352 @ignore
18353 @mindex @null
18354 @end ignore
18355 @tindex arctan
18356 @ignore
18357 @mindex @null
18358 @end ignore
18359 @kindex H T
18360 @pindex calc-tanh
18361 @ignore
18362 @mindex @null
18363 @end ignore
18364 @tindex tanh
18365 @ignore
18366 @mindex @null
18367 @end ignore
18368 @kindex H I T
18369 @pindex calc-arctanh
18370 @ignore
18371 @mindex @null
18372 @end ignore
18373 @tindex arctanh
18374 The shift-@kbd{C} (@code{calc-cos}) [@code{cos}] command computes the cosine
18375 of an angle or complex number, and shift-@kbd{T} (@code{calc-tan}) [@code{tan}]
18376 computes the tangent, along with all the various inverse and hyperbolic
18377 variants of these functions.
18378
18379 @kindex f T
18380 @pindex calc-arctan2
18381 @tindex arctan2
18382 The @kbd{f T} (@code{calc-arctan2}) [@code{arctan2}] command takes two
18383 numbers from the stack and computes the arc tangent of their ratio. The
18384 result is in the full range from @mathit{-180} (exclusive) to @mathit{+180}
18385 (inclusive) degrees, or the analogous range in radians. A similar
18386 result would be obtained with @kbd{/} followed by @kbd{I T}, but the
18387 value would only be in the range from @mathit{-90} to @mathit{+90} degrees
18388 since the division loses information about the signs of the two
18389 components, and an error might result from an explicit division by zero
18390 which @code{arctan2} would avoid. By (arbitrary) definition,
18391 @samp{arctan2(0,0)=0}.
18392
18393 @pindex calc-sincos
18394 @ignore
18395 @starindex
18396 @end ignore
18397 @tindex sincos
18398 @ignore
18399 @starindex
18400 @end ignore
18401 @ignore
18402 @mindex arc@idots
18403 @end ignore
18404 @tindex arcsincos
18405 The @code{calc-sincos} [@code{sincos}] command computes the sine and
18406 cosine of a number, returning them as a vector of the form
18407 @samp{[@var{cos}, @var{sin}]}.
18408 With the Inverse flag [@code{arcsincos}], this command takes a two-element
18409 vector as an argument and computes @code{arctan2} of the elements.
18410 (This command does not accept the Hyperbolic flag.)
18411
18412 @pindex calc-sec
18413 @tindex sec
18414 @pindex calc-csc
18415 @tindex csc
18416 @pindex calc-cot
18417 @tindex cot
18418 @pindex calc-sech
18419 @tindex sech
18420 @pindex calc-csch
18421 @tindex csch
18422 @pindex calc-coth
18423 @tindex coth
18424 The remaining trigonometric functions, @code{calc-sec} [@code{sec}],
18425 @code{calc-csc} [@code{csc}] and @code{calc-cot} [@code{cot}], are also
18426 available. With the Hyperbolic flag, these compute their hyperbolic
18427 counterparts, which are also available separately as @code{calc-sech}
18428 [@code{sech}], @code{calc-csch} [@code{csch}] and @code{calc-coth}
18429 [@code{coth}]. (These commands do not accept the Inverse flag.)
18430
18431 @node Advanced Math Functions, Branch Cuts, Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions, Scientific Functions
18432 @section Advanced Mathematical Functions
18433
18434 @noindent
18435 Calc can compute a variety of less common functions that arise in
18436 various branches of mathematics. All of the functions described in
18437 this section allow arbitrary complex arguments and, except as noted,
18438 will work to arbitrarily large precisions. They can not at present
18439 handle error forms or intervals as arguments.
18440
18441 NOTE: These functions are still experimental. In particular, their
18442 accuracy is not guaranteed in all domains. It is advisable to set the
18443 current precision comfortably higher than you actually need when
18444 using these functions. Also, these functions may be impractically
18445 slow for some values of the arguments.
18446
18447 @kindex f g
18448 @pindex calc-gamma
18449 @tindex gamma
18450 The @kbd{f g} (@code{calc-gamma}) [@code{gamma}] command computes the Euler
18451 gamma function. For positive integer arguments, this is related to the
18452 factorial function: @samp{gamma(n+1) = fact(n)}. For general complex
18453 arguments the gamma function can be defined by the following definite
18454 integral:
18455 @texline @math{\Gamma(a) = \int_0^\infty t^{a-1} e^t dt}.
18456 @infoline @expr{gamma(a) = integ(t^(a-1) exp(t), t, 0, inf)}.
18457 (The actual implementation uses far more efficient computational methods.)
18458
18459 @kindex f G
18460 @tindex gammaP
18461 @ignore
18462 @mindex @idots
18463 @end ignore
18464 @kindex I f G
18465 @ignore
18466 @mindex @null
18467 @end ignore
18468 @kindex H f G
18469 @ignore
18470 @mindex @null
18471 @end ignore
18472 @kindex H I f G
18473 @pindex calc-inc-gamma
18474 @ignore
18475 @mindex @null
18476 @end ignore
18477 @tindex gammaQ
18478 @ignore
18479 @mindex @null
18480 @end ignore
18481 @tindex gammag
18482 @ignore
18483 @mindex @null
18484 @end ignore
18485 @tindex gammaG
18486 The @kbd{f G} (@code{calc-inc-gamma}) [@code{gammaP}] command computes
18487 the incomplete gamma function, denoted @samp{P(a,x)}. This is defined by
18488 the integral,
18489 @texline @math{P(a,x) = \left( \int_0^x t^{a-1} e^t dt \right) / \Gamma(a)}.
18490 @infoline @expr{gammaP(a,x) = integ(t^(a-1) exp(t), t, 0, x) / gamma(a)}.
18491 This implies that @samp{gammaP(a,inf) = 1} for any @expr{a} (see the
18492 definition of the normal gamma function).
18493
18494 Several other varieties of incomplete gamma function are defined.
18495 The complement of @expr{P(a,x)}, called @expr{Q(a,x) = 1-P(a,x)} by
18496 some authors, is computed by the @kbd{I f G} [@code{gammaQ}] command.
18497 You can think of this as taking the other half of the integral, from
18498 @expr{x} to infinity.
18499
18500 @ifnottex
18501 The functions corresponding to the integrals that define @expr{P(a,x)}
18502 and @expr{Q(a,x)} but without the normalizing @expr{1/gamma(a)}
18503 factor are called @expr{g(a,x)} and @expr{G(a,x)}, respectively
18504 (where @expr{g} and @expr{G} represent the lower- and upper-case Greek
18505 letter gamma). You can obtain these using the @kbd{H f G} [@code{gammag}]
18506 and @kbd{H I f G} [@code{gammaG}] commands.
18507 @end ifnottex
18508 @tex
18509 \turnoffactive
18510 The functions corresponding to the integrals that define $P(a,x)$
18511 and $Q(a,x)$ but without the normalizing $1/\Gamma(a)$
18512 factor are called $\gamma(a,x)$ and $\Gamma(a,x)$, respectively.
18513 You can obtain these using the \kbd{H f G} [\code{gammag}] and
18514 \kbd{I H f G} [\code{gammaG}] commands.
18515 @end tex
18516
18517 @kindex f b
18518 @pindex calc-beta
18519 @tindex beta
18520 The @kbd{f b} (@code{calc-beta}) [@code{beta}] command computes the
18521 Euler beta function, which is defined in terms of the gamma function as
18522 @texline @math{B(a,b) = \Gamma(a) \Gamma(b) / \Gamma(a+b)},
18523 @infoline @expr{beta(a,b) = gamma(a) gamma(b) / gamma(a+b)},
18524 or by
18525 @texline @math{B(a,b) = \int_0^1 t^{a-1} (1-t)^{b-1} dt}.
18526 @infoline @expr{beta(a,b) = integ(t^(a-1) (1-t)^(b-1), t, 0, 1)}.
18527
18528 @kindex f B
18529 @kindex H f B
18530 @pindex calc-inc-beta
18531 @tindex betaI
18532 @tindex betaB
18533 The @kbd{f B} (@code{calc-inc-beta}) [@code{betaI}] command computes
18534 the incomplete beta function @expr{I(x,a,b)}. It is defined by
18535 @texline @math{I(x,a,b) = \left( \int_0^x t^{a-1} (1-t)^{b-1} dt \right) / B(a,b)}.
18536 @infoline @expr{betaI(x,a,b) = integ(t^(a-1) (1-t)^(b-1), t, 0, x) / beta(a,b)}.
18537 Once again, the @kbd{H} (hyperbolic) prefix gives the corresponding
18538 un-normalized version [@code{betaB}].
18539
18540 @kindex f e
18541 @kindex I f e
18542 @pindex calc-erf
18543 @tindex erf
18544 @tindex erfc
18545 The @kbd{f e} (@code{calc-erf}) [@code{erf}] command computes the
18546 error function
18547 @texline @math{\hbox{erf}(x) = {2 \over \sqrt{\pi}} \int_0^x e^{-t^2} dt}.
18548 @infoline @expr{erf(x) = 2 integ(exp(-(t^2)), t, 0, x) / sqrt(pi)}.
18549 The complementary error function @kbd{I f e} (@code{calc-erfc}) [@code{erfc}]
18550 is the corresponding integral from @samp{x} to infinity; the sum
18551 @texline @math{\hbox{erf}(x) + \hbox{erfc}(x) = 1}.
18552 @infoline @expr{erf(x) + erfc(x) = 1}.
18553
18554 @kindex f j
18555 @kindex f y
18556 @pindex calc-bessel-J
18557 @pindex calc-bessel-Y
18558 @tindex besJ
18559 @tindex besY
18560 The @kbd{f j} (@code{calc-bessel-J}) [@code{besJ}] and @kbd{f y}
18561 (@code{calc-bessel-Y}) [@code{besY}] commands compute the Bessel
18562 functions of the first and second kinds, respectively.
18563 In @samp{besJ(n,x)} and @samp{besY(n,x)} the ``order'' parameter
18564 @expr{n} is often an integer, but is not required to be one.
18565 Calc's implementation of the Bessel functions currently limits the
18566 precision to 8 digits, and may not be exact even to that precision.
18567 Use with care!
18568
18569 @node Branch Cuts, Random Numbers, Advanced Math Functions, Scientific Functions
18570 @section Branch Cuts and Principal Values
18571
18572 @noindent
18573 @cindex Branch cuts
18574 @cindex Principal values
18575 All of the logarithmic, trigonometric, and other scientific functions are
18576 defined for complex numbers as well as for reals.
18577 This section describes the values
18578 returned in cases where the general result is a family of possible values.
18579 Calc follows section 12.5.3 of Steele's @dfn{Common Lisp, the Language},
18580 second edition, in these matters. This section will describe each
18581 function briefly; for a more detailed discussion (including some nifty
18582 diagrams), consult Steele's book.
18583
18584 Note that the branch cuts for @code{arctan} and @code{arctanh} were
18585 changed between the first and second editions of Steele. Recent
18586 versions of Calc follow the second edition.
18587
18588 The new branch cuts exactly match those of the HP-28/48 calculators.
18589 They also match those of Mathematica 1.2, except that Mathematica's
18590 @code{arctan} cut is always in the right half of the complex plane,
18591 and its @code{arctanh} cut is always in the top half of the plane.
18592 Calc's cuts are continuous with quadrants I and III for @code{arctan},
18593 or II and IV for @code{arctanh}.
18594
18595 Note: The current implementations of these functions with complex arguments
18596 are designed with proper behavior around the branch cuts in mind, @emph{not}
18597 efficiency or accuracy. You may need to increase the floating precision
18598 and wait a while to get suitable answers from them.
18599
18600 For @samp{sqrt(a+bi)}: When @expr{a<0} and @expr{b} is small but positive
18601 or zero, the result is close to the @expr{+i} axis. For @expr{b} small and
18602 negative, the result is close to the @expr{-i} axis. The result always lies
18603 in the right half of the complex plane.
18604
18605 For @samp{ln(a+bi)}: The real part is defined as @samp{ln(abs(a+bi))}.
18606 The imaginary part is defined as @samp{arg(a+bi) = arctan2(b,a)}.
18607 Thus the branch cuts for @code{sqrt} and @code{ln} both lie on the
18608 negative real axis.
18609
18610 The following table describes these branch cuts in another way.
18611 If the real and imaginary parts of @expr{z} are as shown, then
18612 the real and imaginary parts of @expr{f(z)} will be as shown.
18613 Here @code{eps} stands for a small positive value; each
18614 occurrence of @code{eps} may stand for a different small value.
18615
18616 @smallexample
18617 z sqrt(z) ln(z)
18618 ----------------------------------------
18619 +, 0 +, 0 any, 0
18620 -, 0 0, + any, pi
18621 -, +eps +eps, + +eps, +
18622 -, -eps +eps, - +eps, -
18623 @end smallexample
18624
18625 For @samp{z1^z2}: This is defined by @samp{exp(ln(z1)*z2)}.
18626 One interesting consequence of this is that @samp{(-8)^1:3} does
18627 not evaluate to @mathit{-2} as you might expect, but to the complex
18628 number @expr{(1., 1.732)}. Both of these are valid cube roots
18629 of @mathit{-8} (as is @expr{(1., -1.732)}); Calc chooses a perhaps
18630 less-obvious root for the sake of mathematical consistency.
18631
18632 For @samp{arcsin(z)}: This is defined by @samp{-i*ln(i*z + sqrt(1-z^2))}.
18633 The branch cuts are on the real axis, less than @mathit{-1} and greater than 1.
18634
18635 For @samp{arccos(z)}: This is defined by @samp{-i*ln(z + i*sqrt(1-z^2))},
18636 or equivalently by @samp{pi/2 - arcsin(z)}. The branch cuts are on
18637 the real axis, less than @mathit{-1} and greater than 1.
18638
18639 For @samp{arctan(z)}: This is defined by
18640 @samp{(ln(1+i*z) - ln(1-i*z)) / (2*i)}. The branch cuts are on the
18641 imaginary axis, below @expr{-i} and above @expr{i}.
18642
18643 For @samp{arcsinh(z)}: This is defined by @samp{ln(z + sqrt(1+z^2))}.
18644 The branch cuts are on the imaginary axis, below @expr{-i} and
18645 above @expr{i}.
18646
18647 For @samp{arccosh(z)}: This is defined by
18648 @samp{ln(z + (z+1)*sqrt((z-1)/(z+1)))}. The branch cut is on the
18649 real axis less than 1.
18650
18651 For @samp{arctanh(z)}: This is defined by @samp{(ln(1+z) - ln(1-z)) / 2}.
18652 The branch cuts are on the real axis, less than @mathit{-1} and greater than 1.
18653
18654 The following tables for @code{arcsin}, @code{arccos}, and
18655 @code{arctan} assume the current angular mode is Radians. The
18656 hyperbolic functions operate independently of the angular mode.
18657
18658 @smallexample
18659 z arcsin(z) arccos(z)
18660 -------------------------------------------------------
18661 (-1..1), 0 (-pi/2..pi/2), 0 (0..pi), 0
18662 (-1..1), +eps (-pi/2..pi/2), +eps (0..pi), -eps
18663 (-1..1), -eps (-pi/2..pi/2), -eps (0..pi), +eps
18664 <-1, 0 -pi/2, + pi, -
18665 <-1, +eps -pi/2 + eps, + pi - eps, -
18666 <-1, -eps -pi/2 + eps, - pi - eps, +
18667 >1, 0 pi/2, - 0, +
18668 >1, +eps pi/2 - eps, + +eps, -
18669 >1, -eps pi/2 - eps, - +eps, +
18670 @end smallexample
18671
18672 @smallexample
18673 z arccosh(z) arctanh(z)
18674 -----------------------------------------------------
18675 (-1..1), 0 0, (0..pi) any, 0
18676 (-1..1), +eps +eps, (0..pi) any, +eps
18677 (-1..1), -eps +eps, (-pi..0) any, -eps
18678 <-1, 0 +, pi -, pi/2
18679 <-1, +eps +, pi - eps -, pi/2 - eps
18680 <-1, -eps +, -pi + eps -, -pi/2 + eps
18681 >1, 0 +, 0 +, -pi/2
18682 >1, +eps +, +eps +, pi/2 - eps
18683 >1, -eps +, -eps +, -pi/2 + eps
18684 @end smallexample
18685
18686 @smallexample
18687 z arcsinh(z) arctan(z)
18688 -----------------------------------------------------
18689 0, (-1..1) 0, (-pi/2..pi/2) 0, any
18690 0, <-1 -, -pi/2 -pi/2, -
18691 +eps, <-1 +, -pi/2 + eps pi/2 - eps, -
18692 -eps, <-1 -, -pi/2 + eps -pi/2 + eps, -
18693 0, >1 +, pi/2 pi/2, +
18694 +eps, >1 +, pi/2 - eps pi/2 - eps, +
18695 -eps, >1 -, pi/2 - eps -pi/2 + eps, +
18696 @end smallexample
18697
18698 Finally, the following identities help to illustrate the relationship
18699 between the complex trigonometric and hyperbolic functions. They
18700 are valid everywhere, including on the branch cuts.
18701
18702 @smallexample
18703 sin(i*z) = i*sinh(z) arcsin(i*z) = i*arcsinh(z)
18704 cos(i*z) = cosh(z) arcsinh(i*z) = i*arcsin(z)
18705 tan(i*z) = i*tanh(z) arctan(i*z) = i*arctanh(z)
18706 sinh(i*z) = i*sin(z) cosh(i*z) = cos(z)
18707 @end smallexample
18708
18709 The ``advanced math'' functions (gamma, Bessel, etc.@:) are also defined
18710 for general complex arguments, but their branch cuts and principal values
18711 are not rigorously specified at present.
18712
18713 @node Random Numbers, Combinatorial Functions, Branch Cuts, Scientific Functions
18714 @section Random Numbers
18715
18716 @noindent
18717 @kindex k r
18718 @pindex calc-random
18719 @tindex random
18720 The @kbd{k r} (@code{calc-random}) [@code{random}] command produces
18721 random numbers of various sorts.
18722
18723 Given a positive numeric prefix argument @expr{M}, it produces a random
18724 integer @expr{N} in the range
18725 @texline @math{0 \le N < M}.
18726 @infoline @expr{0 <= N < M}.
18727 Each possible value @expr{N} appears with equal probability.
18728
18729 With no numeric prefix argument, the @kbd{k r} command takes its argument
18730 from the stack instead. Once again, if this is a positive integer @expr{M}
18731 the result is a random integer less than @expr{M}. However, note that
18732 while numeric prefix arguments are limited to six digits or so, an @expr{M}
18733 taken from the stack can be arbitrarily large. If @expr{M} is negative,
18734 the result is a random integer in the range
18735 @texline @math{M < N \le 0}.
18736 @infoline @expr{M < N <= 0}.
18737
18738 If the value on the stack is a floating-point number @expr{M}, the result
18739 is a random floating-point number @expr{N} in the range
18740 @texline @math{0 \le N < M}
18741 @infoline @expr{0 <= N < M}
18742 or
18743 @texline @math{M < N \le 0},
18744 @infoline @expr{M < N <= 0},
18745 according to the sign of @expr{M}.
18746
18747 If @expr{M} is zero, the result is a Gaussian-distributed random real
18748 number; the distribution has a mean of zero and a standard deviation
18749 of one. The algorithm used generates random numbers in pairs; thus,
18750 every other call to this function will be especially fast.
18751
18752 If @expr{M} is an error form
18753 @texline @math{m} @code{+/-} @math{\sigma}
18754 @infoline @samp{m +/- s}
18755 where @var{m} and
18756 @texline @math{\sigma}
18757 @infoline @var{s}
18758 are both real numbers, the result uses a Gaussian distribution with mean
18759 @var{m} and standard deviation
18760 @texline @math{\sigma}.
18761 @infoline @var{s}.
18762
18763 If @expr{M} is an interval form, the lower and upper bounds specify the
18764 acceptable limits of the random numbers. If both bounds are integers,
18765 the result is a random integer in the specified range. If either bound
18766 is floating-point, the result is a random real number in the specified
18767 range. If the interval is open at either end, the result will be sure
18768 not to equal that end value. (This makes a big difference for integer
18769 intervals, but for floating-point intervals it's relatively minor:
18770 with a precision of 6, @samp{random([1.0..2.0))} will return any of one
18771 million numbers from 1.00000 to 1.99999; @samp{random([1.0..2.0])} may
18772 additionally return 2.00000, but the probability of this happening is
18773 extremely small.)
18774
18775 If @expr{M} is a vector, the result is one element taken at random from
18776 the vector. All elements of the vector are given equal probabilities.
18777
18778 @vindex RandSeed
18779 The sequence of numbers produced by @kbd{k r} is completely random by
18780 default, i.e., the sequence is seeded each time you start Calc using
18781 the current time and other information. You can get a reproducible
18782 sequence by storing a particular ``seed value'' in the Calc variable
18783 @code{RandSeed}. Any integer will do for a seed; integers of from 1
18784 to 12 digits are good. If you later store a different integer into
18785 @code{RandSeed}, Calc will switch to a different pseudo-random
18786 sequence. If you ``unstore'' @code{RandSeed}, Calc will re-seed itself
18787 from the current time. If you store the same integer that you used
18788 before back into @code{RandSeed}, you will get the exact same sequence
18789 of random numbers as before.
18790
18791 @pindex calc-rrandom
18792 The @code{calc-rrandom} command (not on any key) produces a random real
18793 number between zero and one. It is equivalent to @samp{random(1.0)}.
18794
18795 @kindex k a
18796 @pindex calc-random-again
18797 The @kbd{k a} (@code{calc-random-again}) command produces another random
18798 number, re-using the most recent value of @expr{M}. With a numeric
18799 prefix argument @var{n}, it produces @var{n} more random numbers using
18800 that value of @expr{M}.
18801
18802 @kindex k h
18803 @pindex calc-shuffle
18804 @tindex shuffle
18805 The @kbd{k h} (@code{calc-shuffle}) command produces a vector of several
18806 random values with no duplicates. The value on the top of the stack
18807 specifies the set from which the random values are drawn, and may be any
18808 of the @expr{M} formats described above. The numeric prefix argument
18809 gives the length of the desired list. (If you do not provide a numeric
18810 prefix argument, the length of the list is taken from the top of the
18811 stack, and @expr{M} from second-to-top.)
18812
18813 If @expr{M} is a floating-point number, zero, or an error form (so
18814 that the random values are being drawn from the set of real numbers)
18815 there is little practical difference between using @kbd{k h} and using
18816 @kbd{k r} several times. But if the set of possible values consists
18817 of just a few integers, or the elements of a vector, then there is
18818 a very real chance that multiple @kbd{k r}'s will produce the same
18819 number more than once. The @kbd{k h} command produces a vector whose
18820 elements are always distinct. (Actually, there is a slight exception:
18821 If @expr{M} is a vector, no given vector element will be drawn more
18822 than once, but if several elements of @expr{M} are equal, they may
18823 each make it into the result vector.)
18824
18825 One use of @kbd{k h} is to rearrange a list at random. This happens
18826 if the prefix argument is equal to the number of values in the list:
18827 @kbd{[1, 1.5, 2, 2.5, 3] 5 k h} might produce the permuted list
18828 @samp{[2.5, 1, 1.5, 3, 2]}. As a convenient feature, if the argument
18829 @var{n} is negative it is replaced by the size of the set represented
18830 by @expr{M}. Naturally, this is allowed only when @expr{M} specifies
18831 a small discrete set of possibilities.
18832
18833 To do the equivalent of @kbd{k h} but with duplications allowed,
18834 given @expr{M} on the stack and with @var{n} just entered as a numeric
18835 prefix, use @kbd{v b} to build a vector of copies of @expr{M}, then use
18836 @kbd{V M k r} to ``map'' the normal @kbd{k r} function over the
18837 elements of this vector. @xref{Matrix Functions}.
18838
18839 @menu
18840 * Random Number Generator:: (Complete description of Calc's algorithm)
18841 @end menu
18842
18843 @node Random Number Generator, , Random Numbers, Random Numbers
18844 @subsection Random Number Generator
18845
18846 Calc's random number generator uses several methods to ensure that
18847 the numbers it produces are highly random. Knuth's @emph{Art of
18848 Computer Programming}, Volume II, contains a thorough description
18849 of the theory of random number generators and their measurement and
18850 characterization.
18851
18852 If @code{RandSeed} has no stored value, Calc calls Emacs' built-in
18853 @code{random} function to get a stream of random numbers, which it
18854 then treats in various ways to avoid problems inherent in the simple
18855 random number generators that many systems use to implement @code{random}.
18856
18857 When Calc's random number generator is first invoked, it ``seeds''
18858 the low-level random sequence using the time of day, so that the
18859 random number sequence will be different every time you use Calc.
18860
18861 Since Emacs Lisp doesn't specify the range of values that will be
18862 returned by its @code{random} function, Calc exercises the function
18863 several times to estimate the range. When Calc subsequently uses
18864 the @code{random} function, it takes only 10 bits of the result
18865 near the most-significant end. (It avoids at least the bottom
18866 four bits, preferably more, and also tries to avoid the top two
18867 bits.) This strategy works well with the linear congruential
18868 generators that are typically used to implement @code{random}.
18869
18870 If @code{RandSeed} contains an integer, Calc uses this integer to
18871 seed an ``additive congruential'' method (Knuth's algorithm 3.2.2A,
18872 computing
18873 @texline @math{X_{n-55} - X_{n-24}}.
18874 @infoline @expr{X_n-55 - X_n-24}).
18875 This method expands the seed
18876 value into a large table which is maintained internally; the variable
18877 @code{RandSeed} is changed from, e.g., 42 to the vector @expr{[42]}
18878 to indicate that the seed has been absorbed into this table. When
18879 @code{RandSeed} contains a vector, @kbd{k r} and related commands
18880 continue to use the same internal table as last time. There is no
18881 way to extract the complete state of the random number generator
18882 so that you can restart it from any point; you can only restart it
18883 from the same initial seed value. A simple way to restart from the
18884 same seed is to type @kbd{s r RandSeed} to get the seed vector,
18885 @kbd{v u} to unpack it back into a number, then @kbd{s t RandSeed}
18886 to reseed the generator with that number.
18887
18888 Calc uses a ``shuffling'' method as described in algorithm 3.2.2B
18889 of Knuth. It fills a table with 13 random 10-bit numbers. Then,
18890 to generate a new random number, it uses the previous number to
18891 index into the table, picks the value it finds there as the new
18892 random number, then replaces that table entry with a new value
18893 obtained from a call to the base random number generator (either
18894 the additive congruential generator or the @code{random} function
18895 supplied by the system). If there are any flaws in the base
18896 generator, shuffling will tend to even them out. But if the system
18897 provides an excellent @code{random} function, shuffling will not
18898 damage its randomness.
18899
18900 To create a random integer of a certain number of digits, Calc
18901 builds the integer three decimal digits at a time. For each group
18902 of three digits, Calc calls its 10-bit shuffling random number generator
18903 (which returns a value from 0 to 1023); if the random value is 1000
18904 or more, Calc throws it out and tries again until it gets a suitable
18905 value.
18906
18907 To create a random floating-point number with precision @var{p}, Calc
18908 simply creates a random @var{p}-digit integer and multiplies by
18909 @texline @math{10^{-p}}.
18910 @infoline @expr{10^-p}.
18911 The resulting random numbers should be very clean, but note
18912 that relatively small numbers will have few significant random digits.
18913 In other words, with a precision of 12, you will occasionally get
18914 numbers on the order of
18915 @texline @math{10^{-9}}
18916 @infoline @expr{10^-9}
18917 or
18918 @texline @math{10^{-10}},
18919 @infoline @expr{10^-10},
18920 but those numbers will only have two or three random digits since they
18921 correspond to small integers times
18922 @texline @math{10^{-12}}.
18923 @infoline @expr{10^-12}.
18924
18925 To create a random integer in the interval @samp{[0 .. @var{m})}, Calc
18926 counts the digits in @var{m}, creates a random integer with three
18927 additional digits, then reduces modulo @var{m}. Unless @var{m} is a
18928 power of ten the resulting values will be very slightly biased toward
18929 the lower numbers, but this bias will be less than 0.1%. (For example,
18930 if @var{m} is 42, Calc will reduce a random integer less than 100000
18931 modulo 42 to get a result less than 42. It is easy to show that the
18932 numbers 40 and 41 will be only 2380/2381 as likely to result from this
18933 modulo operation as numbers 39 and below.) If @var{m} is a power of
18934 ten, however, the numbers should be completely unbiased.
18935
18936 The Gaussian random numbers generated by @samp{random(0.0)} use the
18937 ``polar'' method described in Knuth section 3.4.1C. This method
18938 generates a pair of Gaussian random numbers at a time, so only every
18939 other call to @samp{random(0.0)} will require significant calculations.
18940
18941 @node Combinatorial Functions, Probability Distribution Functions, Random Numbers, Scientific Functions
18942 @section Combinatorial Functions
18943
18944 @noindent
18945 Commands relating to combinatorics and number theory begin with the
18946 @kbd{k} key prefix.
18947
18948 @kindex k g
18949 @pindex calc-gcd
18950 @tindex gcd
18951 The @kbd{k g} (@code{calc-gcd}) [@code{gcd}] command computes the
18952 Greatest Common Divisor of two integers. It also accepts fractions;
18953 the GCD of two fractions is defined by taking the GCD of the
18954 numerators, and the LCM of the denominators. This definition is
18955 consistent with the idea that @samp{a / gcd(a,x)} should yield an
18956 integer for any @samp{a} and @samp{x}. For other types of arguments,
18957 the operation is left in symbolic form.
18958
18959 @kindex k l
18960 @pindex calc-lcm
18961 @tindex lcm
18962 The @kbd{k l} (@code{calc-lcm}) [@code{lcm}] command computes the
18963 Least Common Multiple of two integers or fractions. The product of
18964 the LCM and GCD of two numbers is equal to the product of the
18965 numbers.
18966
18967 @kindex k E
18968 @pindex calc-extended-gcd
18969 @tindex egcd
18970 The @kbd{k E} (@code{calc-extended-gcd}) [@code{egcd}] command computes
18971 the GCD of two integers @expr{x} and @expr{y} and returns a vector
18972 @expr{[g, a, b]} where
18973 @texline @math{g = \gcd(x,y) = a x + b y}.
18974 @infoline @expr{g = gcd(x,y) = a x + b y}.
18975
18976 @kindex !
18977 @pindex calc-factorial
18978 @tindex fact
18979 @ignore
18980 @mindex @null
18981 @end ignore
18982 @tindex !
18983 The @kbd{!} (@code{calc-factorial}) [@code{fact}] command computes the
18984 factorial of the number at the top of the stack. If the number is an
18985 integer, the result is an exact integer. If the number is an
18986 integer-valued float, the result is a floating-point approximation. If
18987 the number is a non-integral real number, the generalized factorial is used,
18988 as defined by the Euler Gamma function. Please note that computation of
18989 large factorials can be slow; using floating-point format will help
18990 since fewer digits must be maintained. The same is true of many of
18991 the commands in this section.
18992
18993 @kindex k d
18994 @pindex calc-double-factorial
18995 @tindex dfact
18996 @ignore
18997 @mindex @null
18998 @end ignore
18999 @tindex !!
19000 The @kbd{k d} (@code{calc-double-factorial}) [@code{dfact}] command
19001 computes the ``double factorial'' of an integer. For an even integer,
19002 this is the product of even integers from 2 to @expr{N}. For an odd
19003 integer, this is the product of odd integers from 3 to @expr{N}. If
19004 the argument is an integer-valued float, the result is a floating-point
19005 approximation. This function is undefined for negative even integers.
19006 The notation @expr{N!!} is also recognized for double factorials.
19007
19008 @kindex k c
19009 @pindex calc-choose
19010 @tindex choose
19011 The @kbd{k c} (@code{calc-choose}) [@code{choose}] command computes the
19012 binomial coefficient @expr{N}-choose-@expr{M}, where @expr{M} is the number
19013 on the top of the stack and @expr{N} is second-to-top. If both arguments
19014 are integers, the result is an exact integer. Otherwise, the result is a
19015 floating-point approximation. The binomial coefficient is defined for all
19016 real numbers by
19017 @texline @math{N! \over M! (N-M)!\,}.
19018 @infoline @expr{N! / M! (N-M)!}.
19019
19020 @kindex H k c
19021 @pindex calc-perm
19022 @tindex perm
19023 @ifnottex
19024 The @kbd{H k c} (@code{calc-perm}) [@code{perm}] command computes the
19025 number-of-permutations function @expr{N! / (N-M)!}.
19026 @end ifnottex
19027 @tex
19028 The \kbd{H k c} (\code{calc-perm}) [\code{perm}] command computes the
19029 number-of-perm\-utations function $N! \over (N-M)!\,$.
19030 @end tex
19031
19032 @kindex k b
19033 @kindex H k b
19034 @pindex calc-bernoulli-number
19035 @tindex bern
19036 The @kbd{k b} (@code{calc-bernoulli-number}) [@code{bern}] command
19037 computes a given Bernoulli number. The value at the top of the stack
19038 is a nonnegative integer @expr{n} that specifies which Bernoulli number
19039 is desired. The @kbd{H k b} command computes a Bernoulli polynomial,
19040 taking @expr{n} from the second-to-top position and @expr{x} from the
19041 top of the stack. If @expr{x} is a variable or formula the result is
19042 a polynomial in @expr{x}; if @expr{x} is a number the result is a number.
19043
19044 @kindex k e
19045 @kindex H k e
19046 @pindex calc-euler-number
19047 @tindex euler
19048 The @kbd{k e} (@code{calc-euler-number}) [@code{euler}] command similarly
19049 computes an Euler number, and @w{@kbd{H k e}} computes an Euler polynomial.
19050 Bernoulli and Euler numbers occur in the Taylor expansions of several
19051 functions.
19052
19053 @kindex k s
19054 @kindex H k s
19055 @pindex calc-stirling-number
19056 @tindex stir1
19057 @tindex stir2
19058 The @kbd{k s} (@code{calc-stirling-number}) [@code{stir1}] command
19059 computes a Stirling number of the first
19060 @texline kind@tie{}@math{n \brack m},
19061 @infoline kind,
19062 given two integers @expr{n} and @expr{m} on the stack. The @kbd{H k s}
19063 [@code{stir2}] command computes a Stirling number of the second
19064 @texline kind@tie{}@math{n \brace m}.
19065 @infoline kind.
19066 These are the number of @expr{m}-cycle permutations of @expr{n} objects,
19067 and the number of ways to partition @expr{n} objects into @expr{m}
19068 non-empty sets, respectively.
19069
19070 @kindex k p
19071 @pindex calc-prime-test
19072 @cindex Primes
19073 The @kbd{k p} (@code{calc-prime-test}) command checks if the integer on
19074 the top of the stack is prime. For integers less than eight million, the
19075 answer is always exact and reasonably fast. For larger integers, a
19076 probabilistic method is used (see Knuth vol. II, section 4.5.4, algorithm P).
19077 The number is first checked against small prime factors (up to 13). Then,
19078 any number of iterations of the algorithm are performed. Each step either
19079 discovers that the number is non-prime, or substantially increases the
19080 certainty that the number is prime. After a few steps, the chance that
19081 a number was mistakenly described as prime will be less than one percent.
19082 (Indeed, this is a worst-case estimate of the probability; in practice
19083 even a single iteration is quite reliable.) After the @kbd{k p} command,
19084 the number will be reported as definitely prime or non-prime if possible,
19085 or otherwise ``probably'' prime with a certain probability of error.
19086
19087 @ignore
19088 @starindex
19089 @end ignore
19090 @tindex prime
19091 The normal @kbd{k p} command performs one iteration of the primality
19092 test. Pressing @kbd{k p} repeatedly for the same integer will perform
19093 additional iterations. Also, @kbd{k p} with a numeric prefix performs
19094 the specified number of iterations. There is also an algebraic function
19095 @samp{prime(n)} or @samp{prime(n,iters)} which returns 1 if @expr{n}
19096 is (probably) prime and 0 if not.
19097
19098 @kindex k f
19099 @pindex calc-prime-factors
19100 @tindex prfac
19101 The @kbd{k f} (@code{calc-prime-factors}) [@code{prfac}] command
19102 attempts to decompose an integer into its prime factors. For numbers up
19103 to 25 million, the answer is exact although it may take some time. The
19104 result is a vector of the prime factors in increasing order. For larger
19105 inputs, prime factors above 5000 may not be found, in which case the
19106 last number in the vector will be an unfactored integer greater than 25
19107 million (with a warning message). For negative integers, the first
19108 element of the list will be @mathit{-1}. For inputs @mathit{-1}, @mathit{0}, and
19109 @mathit{1}, the result is a list of the same number.
19110
19111 @kindex k n
19112 @pindex calc-next-prime
19113 @ignore
19114 @mindex nextpr@idots
19115 @end ignore
19116 @tindex nextprime
19117 The @kbd{k n} (@code{calc-next-prime}) [@code{nextprime}] command finds
19118 the next prime above a given number. Essentially, it searches by calling
19119 @code{calc-prime-test} on successive integers until it finds one that
19120 passes the test. This is quite fast for integers less than eight million,
19121 but once the probabilistic test comes into play the search may be rather
19122 slow. Ordinarily this command stops for any prime that passes one iteration
19123 of the primality test. With a numeric prefix argument, a number must pass
19124 the specified number of iterations before the search stops. (This only
19125 matters when searching above eight million.) You can always use additional
19126 @kbd{k p} commands to increase your certainty that the number is indeed
19127 prime.
19128
19129 @kindex I k n
19130 @pindex calc-prev-prime
19131 @ignore
19132 @mindex prevpr@idots
19133 @end ignore
19134 @tindex prevprime
19135 The @kbd{I k n} (@code{calc-prev-prime}) [@code{prevprime}] command
19136 analogously finds the next prime less than a given number.
19137
19138 @kindex k t
19139 @pindex calc-totient
19140 @tindex totient
19141 The @kbd{k t} (@code{calc-totient}) [@code{totient}] command computes the
19142 Euler ``totient''
19143 @texline function@tie{}@math{\phi(n)},
19144 @infoline function,
19145 the number of integers less than @expr{n} which
19146 are relatively prime to @expr{n}.
19147
19148 @kindex k m
19149 @pindex calc-moebius
19150 @tindex moebius
19151 The @kbd{k m} (@code{calc-moebius}) [@code{moebius}] command computes the
19152 @texline M@"obius @math{\mu}
19153 @infoline Moebius ``mu''
19154 function. If the input number is a product of @expr{k}
19155 distinct factors, this is @expr{(-1)^k}. If the input number has any
19156 duplicate factors (i.e., can be divided by the same prime more than once),
19157 the result is zero.
19158
19159 @node Probability Distribution Functions, , Combinatorial Functions, Scientific Functions
19160 @section Probability Distribution Functions
19161
19162 @noindent
19163 The functions in this section compute various probability distributions.
19164 For continuous distributions, this is the integral of the probability
19165 density function from @expr{x} to infinity. (These are the ``upper
19166 tail'' distribution functions; there are also corresponding ``lower
19167 tail'' functions which integrate from minus infinity to @expr{x}.)
19168 For discrete distributions, the upper tail function gives the sum
19169 from @expr{x} to infinity; the lower tail function gives the sum
19170 from minus infinity up to, but not including,@w{ }@expr{x}.
19171
19172 To integrate from @expr{x} to @expr{y}, just use the distribution
19173 function twice and subtract. For example, the probability that a
19174 Gaussian random variable with mean 2 and standard deviation 1 will
19175 lie in the range from 2.5 to 2.8 is @samp{utpn(2.5,2,1) - utpn(2.8,2,1)}
19176 (``the probability that it is greater than 2.5, but not greater than 2.8''),
19177 or equivalently @samp{ltpn(2.8,2,1) - ltpn(2.5,2,1)}.
19178
19179 @kindex k B
19180 @kindex I k B
19181 @pindex calc-utpb
19182 @tindex utpb
19183 @tindex ltpb
19184 The @kbd{k B} (@code{calc-utpb}) [@code{utpb}] function uses the
19185 binomial distribution. Push the parameters @var{n}, @var{p}, and
19186 then @var{x} onto the stack; the result (@samp{utpb(x,n,p)}) is the
19187 probability that an event will occur @var{x} or more times out
19188 of @var{n} trials, if its probability of occurring in any given
19189 trial is @var{p}. The @kbd{I k B} [@code{ltpb}] function is
19190 the probability that the event will occur fewer than @var{x} times.
19191
19192 The other probability distribution functions similarly take the
19193 form @kbd{k @var{X}} (@code{calc-utp@var{x}}) [@code{utp@var{x}}]
19194 and @kbd{I k @var{X}} [@code{ltp@var{x}}], for various letters
19195 @var{x}. The arguments to the algebraic functions are the value of
19196 the random variable first, then whatever other parameters define the
19197 distribution. Note these are among the few Calc functions where the
19198 order of the arguments in algebraic form differs from the order of
19199 arguments as found on the stack. (The random variable comes last on
19200 the stack, so that you can type, e.g., @kbd{2 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} 2.5
19201 k N M-@key{RET} @key{DEL} 2.8 k N -}, using @kbd{M-@key{RET} @key{DEL}} to
19202 recover the original arguments but substitute a new value for @expr{x}.)
19203
19204 @kindex k C
19205 @pindex calc-utpc
19206 @tindex utpc
19207 @ignore
19208 @mindex @idots
19209 @end ignore
19210 @kindex I k C
19211 @ignore
19212 @mindex @null
19213 @end ignore
19214 @tindex ltpc
19215 The @samp{utpc(x,v)} function uses the chi-square distribution with
19216 @texline @math{\nu}
19217 @infoline @expr{v}
19218 degrees of freedom. It is the probability that a model is
19219 correct if its chi-square statistic is @expr{x}.
19220
19221 @kindex k F
19222 @pindex calc-utpf
19223 @tindex utpf
19224 @ignore
19225 @mindex @idots
19226 @end ignore
19227 @kindex I k F
19228 @ignore
19229 @mindex @null
19230 @end ignore
19231 @tindex ltpf
19232 The @samp{utpf(F,v1,v2)} function uses the F distribution, used in
19233 various statistical tests. The parameters
19234 @texline @math{\nu_1}
19235 @infoline @expr{v1}
19236 and
19237 @texline @math{\nu_2}
19238 @infoline @expr{v2}
19239 are the degrees of freedom in the numerator and denominator,
19240 respectively, used in computing the statistic @expr{F}.
19241
19242 @kindex k N
19243 @pindex calc-utpn
19244 @tindex utpn
19245 @ignore
19246 @mindex @idots
19247 @end ignore
19248 @kindex I k N
19249 @ignore
19250 @mindex @null
19251 @end ignore
19252 @tindex ltpn
19253 The @samp{utpn(x,m,s)} function uses a normal (Gaussian) distribution
19254 with mean @expr{m} and standard deviation
19255 @texline @math{\sigma}.
19256 @infoline @expr{s}.
19257 It is the probability that such a normal-distributed random variable
19258 would exceed @expr{x}.
19259
19260 @kindex k P
19261 @pindex calc-utpp
19262 @tindex utpp
19263 @ignore
19264 @mindex @idots
19265 @end ignore
19266 @kindex I k P
19267 @ignore
19268 @mindex @null
19269 @end ignore
19270 @tindex ltpp
19271 The @samp{utpp(n,x)} function uses a Poisson distribution with
19272 mean @expr{x}. It is the probability that @expr{n} or more such
19273 Poisson random events will occur.
19274
19275 @kindex k T
19276 @pindex calc-ltpt
19277 @tindex utpt
19278 @ignore
19279 @mindex @idots
19280 @end ignore
19281 @kindex I k T
19282 @ignore
19283 @mindex @null
19284 @end ignore
19285 @tindex ltpt
19286 The @samp{utpt(t,v)} function uses the Student's ``t'' distribution
19287 with
19288 @texline @math{\nu}
19289 @infoline @expr{v}
19290 degrees of freedom. It is the probability that a
19291 t-distributed random variable will be greater than @expr{t}.
19292 (Note: This computes the distribution function
19293 @texline @math{A(t|\nu)}
19294 @infoline @expr{A(t|v)}
19295 where
19296 @texline @math{A(0|\nu) = 1}
19297 @infoline @expr{A(0|v) = 1}
19298 and
19299 @texline @math{A(\infty|\nu) \to 0}.
19300 @infoline @expr{A(inf|v) -> 0}.
19301 The @code{UTPT} operation on the HP-48 uses a different definition which
19302 returns half of Calc's value: @samp{UTPT(t,v) = .5*utpt(t,v)}.)
19303
19304 While Calc does not provide inverses of the probability distribution
19305 functions, the @kbd{a R} command can be used to solve for the inverse.
19306 Since the distribution functions are monotonic, @kbd{a R} is guaranteed
19307 to be able to find a solution given any initial guess.
19308 @xref{Numerical Solutions}.
19309
19310 @node Matrix Functions, Algebra, Scientific Functions, Top
19311 @chapter Vector/Matrix Functions
19312
19313 @noindent
19314 Many of the commands described here begin with the @kbd{v} prefix.
19315 (For convenience, the shift-@kbd{V} prefix is equivalent to @kbd{v}.)
19316 The commands usually apply to both plain vectors and matrices; some
19317 apply only to matrices or only to square matrices. If the argument
19318 has the wrong dimensions the operation is left in symbolic form.
19319
19320 Vectors are entered and displayed using @samp{[a,b,c]} notation.
19321 Matrices are vectors of which all elements are vectors of equal length.
19322 (Though none of the standard Calc commands use this concept, a
19323 three-dimensional matrix or rank-3 tensor could be defined as a
19324 vector of matrices, and so on.)
19325
19326 @menu
19327 * Packing and Unpacking::
19328 * Building Vectors::
19329 * Extracting Elements::
19330 * Manipulating Vectors::
19331 * Vector and Matrix Arithmetic::
19332 * Set Operations::
19333 * Statistical Operations::
19334 * Reducing and Mapping::
19335 * Vector and Matrix Formats::
19336 @end menu
19337
19338 @node Packing and Unpacking, Building Vectors, Matrix Functions, Matrix Functions
19339 @section Packing and Unpacking
19340
19341 @noindent
19342 Calc's ``pack'' and ``unpack'' commands collect stack entries to build
19343 composite objects such as vectors and complex numbers. They are
19344 described in this chapter because they are most often used to build
19345 vectors.
19346
19347 @kindex v p
19348 @pindex calc-pack
19349 The @kbd{v p} (@code{calc-pack}) [@code{pack}] command collects several
19350 elements from the stack into a matrix, complex number, HMS form, error
19351 form, etc. It uses a numeric prefix argument to specify the kind of
19352 object to be built; this argument is referred to as the ``packing mode.''
19353 If the packing mode is a nonnegative integer, a vector of that
19354 length is created. For example, @kbd{C-u 5 v p} will pop the top
19355 five stack elements and push back a single vector of those five
19356 elements. (@kbd{C-u 0 v p} simply creates an empty vector.)
19357
19358 The same effect can be had by pressing @kbd{[} to push an incomplete
19359 vector on the stack, using @key{TAB} (@code{calc-roll-down}) to sneak
19360 the incomplete object up past a certain number of elements, and
19361 then pressing @kbd{]} to complete the vector.
19362
19363 Negative packing modes create other kinds of composite objects:
19364
19365 @table @cite
19366 @item -1
19367 Two values are collected to build a complex number. For example,
19368 @kbd{5 @key{RET} 7 C-u -1 v p} creates the complex number
19369 @expr{(5, 7)}. The result is always a rectangular complex
19370 number. The two input values must both be real numbers,
19371 i.e., integers, fractions, or floats. If they are not, Calc
19372 will instead build a formula like @samp{a + (0, 1) b}. (The
19373 other packing modes also create a symbolic answer if the
19374 components are not suitable.)
19375
19376 @item -2
19377 Two values are collected to build a polar complex number.
19378 The first is the magnitude; the second is the phase expressed
19379 in either degrees or radians according to the current angular
19380 mode.
19381
19382 @item -3
19383 Three values are collected into an HMS form. The first
19384 two values (hours and minutes) must be integers or
19385 integer-valued floats. The third value may be any real
19386 number.
19387
19388 @item -4
19389 Two values are collected into an error form. The inputs
19390 may be real numbers or formulas.
19391
19392 @item -5
19393 Two values are collected into a modulo form. The inputs
19394 must be real numbers.
19395
19396 @item -6
19397 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{[a .. b]}.
19398 The inputs may be real numbers, HMS or date forms, or formulas.
19399
19400 @item -7
19401 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{[a .. b)}.
19402
19403 @item -8
19404 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{(a .. b]}.
19405
19406 @item -9
19407 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{(a .. b)}.
19408
19409 @item -10
19410 Two integer values are collected into a fraction.
19411
19412 @item -11
19413 Two values are collected into a floating-point number.
19414 The first is the mantissa; the second, which must be an
19415 integer, is the exponent. The result is the mantissa
19416 times ten to the power of the exponent.
19417
19418 @item -12
19419 This is treated the same as @mathit{-11} by the @kbd{v p} command.
19420 When unpacking, @mathit{-12} specifies that a floating-point mantissa
19421 is desired.
19422
19423 @item -13
19424 A real number is converted into a date form.
19425
19426 @item -14
19427 Three numbers (year, month, day) are packed into a pure date form.
19428
19429 @item -15
19430 Six numbers are packed into a date/time form.
19431 @end table
19432
19433 With any of the two-input negative packing modes, either or both
19434 of the inputs may be vectors. If both are vectors of the same
19435 length, the result is another vector made by packing corresponding
19436 elements of the input vectors. If one input is a vector and the
19437 other is a plain number, the number is packed along with each vector
19438 element to produce a new vector. For example, @kbd{C-u -4 v p}
19439 could be used to convert a vector of numbers and a vector of errors
19440 into a single vector of error forms; @kbd{C-u -5 v p} could convert
19441 a vector of numbers and a single number @var{M} into a vector of
19442 numbers modulo @var{M}.
19443
19444 If you don't give a prefix argument to @kbd{v p}, it takes
19445 the packing mode from the top of the stack. The elements to
19446 be packed then begin at stack level 2. Thus
19447 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 4 n v p} is another way to
19448 enter the error form @samp{1 +/- 2}.
19449
19450 If the packing mode taken from the stack is a vector, the result is a
19451 matrix with the dimensions specified by the elements of the vector,
19452 which must each be integers. For example, if the packing mode is
19453 @samp{[2, 3]}, then six numbers will be taken from the stack and
19454 returned in the form @samp{[@w{[a, b, c]}, [d, e, f]]}.
19455
19456 If any elements of the vector are negative, other kinds of
19457 packing are done at that level as described above. For
19458 example, @samp{[2, 3, -4]} takes 12 objects and creates a
19459 @texline @math{2\times3}
19460 @infoline 2x3
19461 matrix of error forms: @samp{[[a +/- b, c +/- d ... ]]}.
19462 Also, @samp{[-4, -10]} will convert four integers into an
19463 error form consisting of two fractions: @samp{a:b +/- c:d}.
19464
19465 @ignore
19466 @starindex
19467 @end ignore
19468 @tindex pack
19469 There is an equivalent algebraic function,
19470 @samp{pack(@var{mode}, @var{items})} where @var{mode} is a
19471 packing mode (an integer or a vector of integers) and @var{items}
19472 is a vector of objects to be packed (re-packed, really) according
19473 to that mode. For example, @samp{pack([3, -4], [a,b,c,d,e,f])}
19474 yields @samp{[a +/- b, @w{c +/- d}, e +/- f]}. The function is
19475 left in symbolic form if the packing mode is invalid, or if the
19476 number of data items does not match the number of items required
19477 by the mode.
19478
19479 @kindex v u
19480 @pindex calc-unpack
19481 The @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) command takes the vector, complex
19482 number, HMS form, or other composite object on the top of the stack and
19483 ``unpacks'' it, pushing each of its elements onto the stack as separate
19484 objects. Thus, it is the ``inverse'' of @kbd{v p}. If the value
19485 at the top of the stack is a formula, @kbd{v u} unpacks it by pushing
19486 each of the arguments of the top-level operator onto the stack.
19487
19488 You can optionally give a numeric prefix argument to @kbd{v u}
19489 to specify an explicit (un)packing mode. If the packing mode is
19490 negative and the input is actually a vector or matrix, the result
19491 will be two or more similar vectors or matrices of the elements.
19492 For example, given the vector @samp{[@w{a +/- b}, c^2, d +/- 7]},
19493 the result of @kbd{C-u -4 v u} will be the two vectors
19494 @samp{[a, c^2, d]} and @w{@samp{[b, 0, 7]}}.
19495
19496 Note that the prefix argument can have an effect even when the input is
19497 not a vector. For example, if the input is the number @mathit{-5}, then
19498 @kbd{c-u -1 v u} yields @mathit{-5} and 0 (the components of @mathit{-5}
19499 when viewed as a rectangular complex number); @kbd{C-u -2 v u} yields 5
19500 and 180 (assuming Degrees mode); and @kbd{C-u -10 v u} yields @mathit{-5}
19501 and 1 (the numerator and denominator of @mathit{-5}, viewed as a rational
19502 number). Plain @kbd{v u} with this input would complain that the input
19503 is not a composite object.
19504
19505 Unpacking mode @mathit{-11} converts a float into an integer mantissa and
19506 an integer exponent, where the mantissa is not divisible by 10
19507 (except that 0.0 is represented by a mantissa and exponent of 0).
19508 Unpacking mode @mathit{-12} converts a float into a floating-point mantissa
19509 and integer exponent, where the mantissa (for non-zero numbers)
19510 is guaranteed to lie in the range [1 .. 10). In both cases,
19511 the mantissa is shifted left or right (and the exponent adjusted
19512 to compensate) in order to satisfy these constraints.
19513
19514 Positive unpacking modes are treated differently than for @kbd{v p}.
19515 A mode of 1 is much like plain @kbd{v u} with no prefix argument,
19516 except that in addition to the components of the input object,
19517 a suitable packing mode to re-pack the object is also pushed.
19518 Thus, @kbd{C-u 1 v u} followed by @kbd{v p} will re-build the
19519 original object.
19520
19521 A mode of 2 unpacks two levels of the object; the resulting
19522 re-packing mode will be a vector of length 2. This might be used
19523 to unpack a matrix, say, or a vector of error forms. Higher
19524 unpacking modes unpack the input even more deeply.
19525
19526 @ignore
19527 @starindex
19528 @end ignore
19529 @tindex unpack
19530 There are two algebraic functions analogous to @kbd{v u}.
19531 The @samp{unpack(@var{mode}, @var{item})} function unpacks the
19532 @var{item} using the given @var{mode}, returning the result as
19533 a vector of components. Here the @var{mode} must be an
19534 integer, not a vector. For example, @samp{unpack(-4, a +/- b)}
19535 returns @samp{[a, b]}, as does @samp{unpack(1, a +/- b)}.
19536
19537 @ignore
19538 @starindex
19539 @end ignore
19540 @tindex unpackt
19541 The @code{unpackt} function is like @code{unpack} but instead
19542 of returning a simple vector of items, it returns a vector of
19543 two things: The mode, and the vector of items. For example,
19544 @samp{unpackt(1, 2:3 +/- 1:4)} returns @samp{[-4, [2:3, 1:4]]},
19545 and @samp{unpackt(2, 2:3 +/- 1:4)} returns @samp{[[-4, -10], [2, 3, 1, 4]]}.
19546 The identity for re-building the original object is
19547 @samp{apply(pack, unpackt(@var{n}, @var{x})) = @var{x}}. (The
19548 @code{apply} function builds a function call given the function
19549 name and a vector of arguments.)
19550
19551 @cindex Numerator of a fraction, extracting
19552 Subscript notation is a useful way to extract a particular part
19553 of an object. For example, to get the numerator of a rational
19554 number, you can use @samp{unpack(-10, @var{x})_1}.
19555
19556 @node Building Vectors, Extracting Elements, Packing and Unpacking, Matrix Functions
19557 @section Building Vectors
19558
19559 @noindent
19560 Vectors and matrices can be added,
19561 subtracted, multiplied, and divided; @pxref{Basic Arithmetic}.
19562
19563 @kindex |
19564 @pindex calc-concat
19565 @ignore
19566 @mindex @null
19567 @end ignore
19568 @tindex |
19569 The @kbd{|} (@code{calc-concat}) [@code{vconcat}] command ``concatenates'' two vectors
19570 into one. For example, after @kbd{@w{[ 1 , 2 ]} [ 3 , 4 ] |}, the stack
19571 will contain the single vector @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4]}. If the arguments
19572 are matrices, the rows of the first matrix are concatenated with the
19573 rows of the second. (In other words, two matrices are just two vectors
19574 of row-vectors as far as @kbd{|} is concerned.)
19575
19576 If either argument to @kbd{|} is a scalar (a non-vector), it is treated
19577 like a one-element vector for purposes of concatenation: @kbd{1 [ 2 , 3 ] |}
19578 produces the vector @samp{[1, 2, 3]}. Likewise, if one argument is a
19579 matrix and the other is a plain vector, the vector is treated as a
19580 one-row matrix.
19581
19582 @kindex H |
19583 @tindex append
19584 The @kbd{H |} (@code{calc-append}) [@code{append}] command concatenates
19585 two vectors without any special cases. Both inputs must be vectors.
19586 Whether or not they are matrices is not taken into account. If either
19587 argument is a scalar, the @code{append} function is left in symbolic form.
19588 See also @code{cons} and @code{rcons} below.
19589
19590 @kindex I |
19591 @kindex H I |
19592 The @kbd{I |} and @kbd{H I |} commands are similar, but they use their
19593 two stack arguments in the opposite order. Thus @kbd{I |} is equivalent
19594 to @kbd{@key{TAB} |}, but possibly more convenient and also a bit faster.
19595
19596 @kindex v d
19597 @pindex calc-diag
19598 @tindex diag
19599 The @kbd{v d} (@code{calc-diag}) [@code{diag}] function builds a diagonal
19600 square matrix. The optional numeric prefix gives the number of rows
19601 and columns in the matrix. If the value at the top of the stack is a
19602 vector, the elements of the vector are used as the diagonal elements; the
19603 prefix, if specified, must match the size of the vector. If the value on
19604 the stack is a scalar, it is used for each element on the diagonal, and
19605 the prefix argument is required.
19606
19607 To build a constant square matrix, e.g., a
19608 @texline @math{3\times3}
19609 @infoline 3x3
19610 matrix filled with ones, use @kbd{0 M-3 v d 1 +}, i.e., build a zero
19611 matrix first and then add a constant value to that matrix. (Another
19612 alternative would be to use @kbd{v b} and @kbd{v a}; see below.)
19613
19614 @kindex v i
19615 @pindex calc-ident
19616 @tindex idn
19617 The @kbd{v i} (@code{calc-ident}) [@code{idn}] function builds an identity
19618 matrix of the specified size. It is a convenient form of @kbd{v d}
19619 where the diagonal element is always one. If no prefix argument is given,
19620 this command prompts for one.
19621
19622 In algebraic notation, @samp{idn(a,n)} acts much like @samp{diag(a,n)},
19623 except that @expr{a} is required to be a scalar (non-vector) quantity.
19624 If @expr{n} is omitted, @samp{idn(a)} represents @expr{a} times an
19625 identity matrix of unknown size. Calc can operate algebraically on
19626 such generic identity matrices, and if one is combined with a matrix
19627 whose size is known, it is converted automatically to an identity
19628 matrix of a suitable matching size. The @kbd{v i} command with an
19629 argument of zero creates a generic identity matrix, @samp{idn(1)}.
19630 Note that in dimensioned Matrix mode (@pxref{Matrix Mode}), generic
19631 identity matrices are immediately expanded to the current default
19632 dimensions.
19633
19634 @kindex v x
19635 @pindex calc-index
19636 @tindex index
19637 The @kbd{v x} (@code{calc-index}) [@code{index}] function builds a vector
19638 of consecutive integers from 1 to @var{n}, where @var{n} is the numeric
19639 prefix argument. If you do not provide a prefix argument, you will be
19640 prompted to enter a suitable number. If @var{n} is negative, the result
19641 is a vector of negative integers from @var{n} to @mathit{-1}.
19642
19643 With a prefix argument of just @kbd{C-u}, the @kbd{v x} command takes
19644 three values from the stack: @var{n}, @var{start}, and @var{incr} (with
19645 @var{incr} at top-of-stack). Counting starts at @var{start} and increases
19646 by @var{incr} for successive vector elements. If @var{start} or @var{n}
19647 is in floating-point format, the resulting vector elements will also be
19648 floats. Note that @var{start} and @var{incr} may in fact be any kind
19649 of numbers or formulas.
19650
19651 When @var{start} and @var{incr} are specified, a negative @var{n} has a
19652 different interpretation: It causes a geometric instead of arithmetic
19653 sequence to be generated. For example, @samp{index(-3, a, b)} produces
19654 @samp{[a, a b, a b^2]}. If you omit @var{incr} in the algebraic form,
19655 @samp{index(@var{n}, @var{start})}, the default value for @var{incr}
19656 is one for positive @var{n} or two for negative @var{n}.
19657
19658 @kindex v b
19659 @pindex calc-build-vector
19660 @tindex cvec
19661 The @kbd{v b} (@code{calc-build-vector}) [@code{cvec}] function builds a
19662 vector of @var{n} copies of the value on the top of the stack, where @var{n}
19663 is the numeric prefix argument. In algebraic formulas, @samp{cvec(x,n,m)}
19664 can also be used to build an @var{n}-by-@var{m} matrix of copies of @var{x}.
19665 (Interactively, just use @kbd{v b} twice: once to build a row, then again
19666 to build a matrix of copies of that row.)
19667
19668 @kindex v h
19669 @kindex I v h
19670 @pindex calc-head
19671 @pindex calc-tail
19672 @tindex head
19673 @tindex tail
19674 The @kbd{v h} (@code{calc-head}) [@code{head}] function returns the first
19675 element of a vector. The @kbd{I v h} (@code{calc-tail}) [@code{tail}]
19676 function returns the vector with its first element removed. In both
19677 cases, the argument must be a non-empty vector.
19678
19679 @kindex v k
19680 @pindex calc-cons
19681 @tindex cons
19682 The @kbd{v k} (@code{calc-cons}) [@code{cons}] function takes a value @var{h}
19683 and a vector @var{t} from the stack, and produces the vector whose head is
19684 @var{h} and whose tail is @var{t}. This is similar to @kbd{|}, except
19685 if @var{h} is itself a vector, @kbd{|} will concatenate the two vectors
19686 whereas @code{cons} will insert @var{h} at the front of the vector @var{t}.
19687
19688 @kindex H v h
19689 @tindex rhead
19690 @ignore
19691 @mindex @idots
19692 @end ignore
19693 @kindex H I v h
19694 @ignore
19695 @mindex @null
19696 @end ignore
19697 @kindex H v k
19698 @ignore
19699 @mindex @null
19700 @end ignore
19701 @tindex rtail
19702 @ignore
19703 @mindex @null
19704 @end ignore
19705 @tindex rcons
19706 Each of these three functions also accepts the Hyperbolic flag [@code{rhead},
19707 @code{rtail}, @code{rcons}] in which case @var{t} instead represents
19708 the @emph{last} single element of the vector, with @var{h}
19709 representing the remainder of the vector. Thus the vector
19710 @samp{[a, b, c, d] = cons(a, [b, c, d]) = rcons([a, b, c], d)}.
19711 Also, @samp{head([a, b, c, d]) = a}, @samp{tail([a, b, c, d]) = [b, c, d]},
19712 @samp{rhead([a, b, c, d]) = [a, b, c]}, and @samp{rtail([a, b, c, d]) = d}.
19713
19714 @node Extracting Elements, Manipulating Vectors, Building Vectors, Matrix Functions
19715 @section Extracting Vector Elements
19716
19717 @noindent
19718 @kindex v r
19719 @pindex calc-mrow
19720 @tindex mrow
19721 The @kbd{v r} (@code{calc-mrow}) [@code{mrow}] command extracts one row of
19722 the matrix on the top of the stack, or one element of the plain vector on
19723 the top of the stack. The row or element is specified by the numeric
19724 prefix argument; the default is to prompt for the row or element number.
19725 The matrix or vector is replaced by the specified row or element in the
19726 form of a vector or scalar, respectively.
19727
19728 @cindex Permutations, applying
19729 With a prefix argument of @kbd{C-u} only, @kbd{v r} takes the index of
19730 the element or row from the top of the stack, and the vector or matrix
19731 from the second-to-top position. If the index is itself a vector of
19732 integers, the result is a vector of the corresponding elements of the
19733 input vector, or a matrix of the corresponding rows of the input matrix.
19734 This command can be used to obtain any permutation of a vector.
19735
19736 With @kbd{C-u}, if the index is an interval form with integer components,
19737 it is interpreted as a range of indices and the corresponding subvector or
19738 submatrix is returned.
19739
19740 @cindex Subscript notation
19741 @kindex a _
19742 @pindex calc-subscript
19743 @tindex subscr
19744 @tindex _
19745 Subscript notation in algebraic formulas (@samp{a_b}) stands for the
19746 Calc function @code{subscr}, which is synonymous with @code{mrow}.
19747 Thus, @samp{[x, y, z]_k} produces @expr{x}, @expr{y}, or @expr{z} if
19748 @expr{k} is one, two, or three, respectively. A double subscript
19749 (@samp{M_i_j}, equivalent to @samp{subscr(subscr(M, i), j)}) will
19750 access the element at row @expr{i}, column @expr{j} of a matrix.
19751 The @kbd{a _} (@code{calc-subscript}) command creates a subscript
19752 formula @samp{a_b} out of two stack entries. (It is on the @kbd{a}
19753 ``algebra'' prefix because subscripted variables are often used
19754 purely as an algebraic notation.)
19755
19756 @tindex mrrow
19757 Given a negative prefix argument, @kbd{v r} instead deletes one row or
19758 element from the matrix or vector on the top of the stack. Thus
19759 @kbd{C-u 2 v r} replaces a matrix with its second row, but @kbd{C-u -2 v r}
19760 replaces the matrix with the same matrix with its second row removed.
19761 In algebraic form this function is called @code{mrrow}.
19762
19763 @tindex getdiag
19764 Given a prefix argument of zero, @kbd{v r} extracts the diagonal elements
19765 of a square matrix in the form of a vector. In algebraic form this
19766 function is called @code{getdiag}.
19767
19768 @kindex v c
19769 @pindex calc-mcol
19770 @tindex mcol
19771 @tindex mrcol
19772 The @kbd{v c} (@code{calc-mcol}) [@code{mcol} or @code{mrcol}] command is
19773 the analogous operation on columns of a matrix. Given a plain vector
19774 it extracts (or removes) one element, just like @kbd{v r}. If the
19775 index in @kbd{C-u v c} is an interval or vector and the argument is a
19776 matrix, the result is a submatrix with only the specified columns
19777 retained (and possibly permuted in the case of a vector index).
19778
19779 To extract a matrix element at a given row and column, use @kbd{v r} to
19780 extract the row as a vector, then @kbd{v c} to extract the column element
19781 from that vector. In algebraic formulas, it is often more convenient to
19782 use subscript notation: @samp{m_i_j} gives row @expr{i}, column @expr{j}
19783 of matrix @expr{m}.
19784
19785 @kindex v s
19786 @pindex calc-subvector
19787 @tindex subvec
19788 The @kbd{v s} (@code{calc-subvector}) [@code{subvec}] command extracts
19789 a subvector of a vector. The arguments are the vector, the starting
19790 index, and the ending index, with the ending index in the top-of-stack
19791 position. The starting index indicates the first element of the vector
19792 to take. The ending index indicates the first element @emph{past} the
19793 range to be taken. Thus, @samp{subvec([a, b, c, d, e], 2, 4)} produces
19794 the subvector @samp{[b, c]}. You could get the same result using
19795 @samp{mrow([a, b, c, d, e], @w{[2 .. 4)})}.
19796
19797 If either the start or the end index is zero or negative, it is
19798 interpreted as relative to the end of the vector. Thus
19799 @samp{subvec([a, b, c, d, e], 2, -2)} also produces @samp{[b, c]}. In
19800 the algebraic form, the end index can be omitted in which case it
19801 is taken as zero, i.e., elements from the starting element to the
19802 end of the vector are used. The infinity symbol, @code{inf}, also
19803 has this effect when used as the ending index.
19804
19805 @kindex I v s
19806 @tindex rsubvec
19807 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I v s} [@code{rsubvec}] removes a subvector
19808 from a vector. The arguments are interpreted the same as for the
19809 normal @kbd{v s} command. Thus, @samp{rsubvec([a, b, c, d, e], 2, 4)}
19810 produces @samp{[a, d, e]}. It is always true that @code{subvec} and
19811 @code{rsubvec} return complementary parts of the input vector.
19812
19813 @xref{Selecting Subformulas}, for an alternative way to operate on
19814 vectors one element at a time.
19815
19816 @node Manipulating Vectors, Vector and Matrix Arithmetic, Extracting Elements, Matrix Functions
19817 @section Manipulating Vectors
19818
19819 @noindent
19820 @kindex v l
19821 @pindex calc-vlength
19822 @tindex vlen
19823 The @kbd{v l} (@code{calc-vlength}) [@code{vlen}] command computes the
19824 length of a vector. The length of a non-vector is considered to be zero.
19825 Note that matrices are just vectors of vectors for the purposes of this
19826 command.
19827
19828 @kindex H v l
19829 @tindex mdims
19830 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H v l} [@code{mdims}] computes a vector
19831 of the dimensions of a vector, matrix, or higher-order object. For
19832 example, @samp{mdims([[a,b,c],[d,e,f]])} returns @samp{[2, 3]} since
19833 its argument is a
19834 @texline @math{2\times3}
19835 @infoline 2x3
19836 matrix.
19837
19838 @kindex v f
19839 @pindex calc-vector-find
19840 @tindex find
19841 The @kbd{v f} (@code{calc-vector-find}) [@code{find}] command searches
19842 along a vector for the first element equal to a given target. The target
19843 is on the top of the stack; the vector is in the second-to-top position.
19844 If a match is found, the result is the index of the matching element.
19845 Otherwise, the result is zero. The numeric prefix argument, if given,
19846 allows you to select any starting index for the search.
19847
19848 @kindex v a
19849 @pindex calc-arrange-vector
19850 @tindex arrange
19851 @cindex Arranging a matrix
19852 @cindex Reshaping a matrix
19853 @cindex Flattening a matrix
19854 The @kbd{v a} (@code{calc-arrange-vector}) [@code{arrange}] command
19855 rearranges a vector to have a certain number of columns and rows. The
19856 numeric prefix argument specifies the number of columns; if you do not
19857 provide an argument, you will be prompted for the number of columns.
19858 The vector or matrix on the top of the stack is @dfn{flattened} into a
19859 plain vector. If the number of columns is nonzero, this vector is
19860 then formed into a matrix by taking successive groups of @var{n} elements.
19861 If the number of columns does not evenly divide the number of elements
19862 in the vector, the last row will be short and the result will not be
19863 suitable for use as a matrix. For example, with the matrix
19864 @samp{[[1, 2], @w{[3, 4]}]} on the stack, @kbd{v a 4} produces
19865 @samp{[[1, 2, 3, 4]]} (a
19866 @texline @math{1\times4}
19867 @infoline 1x4
19868 matrix), @kbd{v a 1} produces @samp{[[1], [2], [3], [4]]} (a
19869 @texline @math{4\times1}
19870 @infoline 4x1
19871 matrix), @kbd{v a 2} produces @samp{[[1, 2], [3, 4]]} (the original
19872 @texline @math{2\times2}
19873 @infoline 2x2
19874 matrix), @w{@kbd{v a 3}} produces @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4]]} (not a
19875 matrix), and @kbd{v a 0} produces the flattened list
19876 @samp{[1, 2, @w{3, 4}]}.
19877
19878 @cindex Sorting data
19879 @kindex V S
19880 @kindex I V S
19881 @pindex calc-sort
19882 @tindex sort
19883 @tindex rsort
19884 The @kbd{V S} (@code{calc-sort}) [@code{sort}] command sorts the elements of
19885 a vector into increasing order. Real numbers, real infinities, and
19886 constant interval forms come first in this ordering; next come other
19887 kinds of numbers, then variables (in alphabetical order), then finally
19888 come formulas and other kinds of objects; these are sorted according
19889 to a kind of lexicographic ordering with the useful property that
19890 one vector is less or greater than another if the first corresponding
19891 unequal elements are less or greater, respectively. Since quoted strings
19892 are stored by Calc internally as vectors of ASCII character codes
19893 (@pxref{Strings}), this means vectors of strings are also sorted into
19894 alphabetical order by this command.
19895
19896 The @kbd{I V S} [@code{rsort}] command sorts a vector into decreasing order.
19897
19898 @cindex Permutation, inverse of
19899 @cindex Inverse of permutation
19900 @cindex Index tables
19901 @cindex Rank tables
19902 @kindex V G
19903 @kindex I V G
19904 @pindex calc-grade
19905 @tindex grade
19906 @tindex rgrade
19907 The @kbd{V G} (@code{calc-grade}) [@code{grade}, @code{rgrade}] command
19908 produces an index table or permutation vector which, if applied to the
19909 input vector (as the index of @kbd{C-u v r}, say), would sort the vector.
19910 A permutation vector is just a vector of integers from 1 to @var{n}, where
19911 each integer occurs exactly once. One application of this is to sort a
19912 matrix of data rows using one column as the sort key; extract that column,
19913 grade it with @kbd{V G}, then use the result to reorder the original matrix
19914 with @kbd{C-u v r}. Another interesting property of the @code{V G} command
19915 is that, if the input is itself a permutation vector, the result will
19916 be the inverse of the permutation. The inverse of an index table is
19917 a rank table, whose @var{k}th element says where the @var{k}th original
19918 vector element will rest when the vector is sorted. To get a rank
19919 table, just use @kbd{V G V G}.
19920
19921 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I V G} produces an index table that would
19922 sort the input into decreasing order. Note that @kbd{V S} and @kbd{V G}
19923 use a ``stable'' sorting algorithm, i.e., any two elements which are equal
19924 will not be moved out of their original order. Generally there is no way
19925 to tell with @kbd{V S}, since two elements which are equal look the same,
19926 but with @kbd{V G} this can be an important issue. In the matrix-of-rows
19927 example, suppose you have names and telephone numbers as two columns and
19928 you wish to sort by phone number primarily, and by name when the numbers
19929 are equal. You can sort the data matrix by names first, and then again
19930 by phone numbers. Because the sort is stable, any two rows with equal
19931 phone numbers will remain sorted by name even after the second sort.
19932
19933 @cindex Histograms
19934 @kindex V H
19935 @pindex calc-histogram
19936 @ignore
19937 @mindex histo@idots
19938 @end ignore
19939 @tindex histogram
19940 The @kbd{V H} (@code{calc-histogram}) [@code{histogram}] command builds a
19941 histogram of a vector of numbers. Vector elements are assumed to be
19942 integers or real numbers in the range [0..@var{n}) for some ``number of
19943 bins'' @var{n}, which is the numeric prefix argument given to the
19944 command. The result is a vector of @var{n} counts of how many times
19945 each value appeared in the original vector. Non-integers in the input
19946 are rounded down to integers. Any vector elements outside the specified
19947 range are ignored. (You can tell if elements have been ignored by noting
19948 that the counts in the result vector don't add up to the length of the
19949 input vector.)
19950
19951 @kindex H V H
19952 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H V H} pulls two vectors from the stack.
19953 The second-to-top vector is the list of numbers as before. The top
19954 vector is an equal-sized list of ``weights'' to attach to the elements
19955 of the data vector. For example, if the first data element is 4.2 and
19956 the first weight is 10, then 10 will be added to bin 4 of the result
19957 vector. Without the hyperbolic flag, every element has a weight of one.
19958
19959 @kindex v t
19960 @pindex calc-transpose
19961 @tindex trn
19962 The @kbd{v t} (@code{calc-transpose}) [@code{trn}] command computes
19963 the transpose of the matrix at the top of the stack. If the argument
19964 is a plain vector, it is treated as a row vector and transposed into
19965 a one-column matrix.
19966
19967 @kindex v v
19968 @pindex calc-reverse-vector
19969 @tindex rev
19970 The @kbd{v v} (@code{calc-reverse-vector}) [@code{rev}] command reverses
19971 a vector end-for-end. Given a matrix, it reverses the order of the rows.
19972 (To reverse the columns instead, just use @kbd{v t v v v t}. The same
19973 principle can be used to apply other vector commands to the columns of
19974 a matrix.)
19975
19976 @kindex v m
19977 @pindex calc-mask-vector
19978 @tindex vmask
19979 The @kbd{v m} (@code{calc-mask-vector}) [@code{vmask}] command uses
19980 one vector as a mask to extract elements of another vector. The mask
19981 is in the second-to-top position; the target vector is on the top of
19982 the stack. These vectors must have the same length. The result is
19983 the same as the target vector, but with all elements which correspond
19984 to zeros in the mask vector deleted. Thus, for example,
19985 @samp{vmask([1, 0, 1, 0, 1], [a, b, c, d, e])} produces @samp{[a, c, e]}.
19986 @xref{Logical Operations}.
19987
19988 @kindex v e
19989 @pindex calc-expand-vector
19990 @tindex vexp
19991 The @kbd{v e} (@code{calc-expand-vector}) [@code{vexp}] command
19992 expands a vector according to another mask vector. The result is a
19993 vector the same length as the mask, but with nonzero elements replaced
19994 by successive elements from the target vector. The length of the target
19995 vector is normally the number of nonzero elements in the mask. If the
19996 target vector is longer, its last few elements are lost. If the target
19997 vector is shorter, the last few nonzero mask elements are left
19998 unreplaced in the result. Thus @samp{vexp([2, 0, 3, 0, 7], [a, b])}
19999 produces @samp{[a, 0, b, 0, 7]}.
20000
20001 @kindex H v e
20002 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H v e} takes a filler value from the
20003 top of the stack; the mask and target vectors come from the third and
20004 second elements of the stack. This filler is used where the mask is
20005 zero: @samp{vexp([2, 0, 3, 0, 7], [a, b], z)} produces
20006 @samp{[a, z, c, z, 7]}. If the filler value is itself a vector,
20007 then successive values are taken from it, so that the effect is to
20008 interleave two vectors according to the mask:
20009 @samp{vexp([2, 0, 3, 7, 0, 0], [a, b], [x, y])} produces
20010 @samp{[a, x, b, 7, y, 0]}.
20011
20012 Another variation on the masking idea is to combine @samp{[a, b, c, d, e]}
20013 with the mask @samp{[1, 0, 1, 0, 1]} to produce @samp{[a, 0, c, 0, e]}.
20014 You can accomplish this with @kbd{V M a &}, mapping the logical ``and''
20015 operation across the two vectors. @xref{Logical Operations}. Note that
20016 the @code{? :} operation also discussed there allows other types of
20017 masking using vectors.
20018
20019 @node Vector and Matrix Arithmetic, Set Operations, Manipulating Vectors, Matrix Functions
20020 @section Vector and Matrix Arithmetic
20021
20022 @noindent
20023 Basic arithmetic operations like addition and multiplication are defined
20024 for vectors and matrices as well as for numbers. Division of matrices, in
20025 the sense of multiplying by the inverse, is supported. (Division by a
20026 matrix actually uses LU-decomposition for greater accuracy and speed.)
20027 @xref{Basic Arithmetic}.
20028
20029 The following functions are applied element-wise if their arguments are
20030 vectors or matrices: @code{change-sign}, @code{conj}, @code{arg},
20031 @code{re}, @code{im}, @code{polar}, @code{rect}, @code{clean},
20032 @code{float}, @code{frac}. @xref{Function Index}.
20033
20034 @kindex V J
20035 @pindex calc-conj-transpose
20036 @tindex ctrn
20037 The @kbd{V J} (@code{calc-conj-transpose}) [@code{ctrn}] command computes
20038 the conjugate transpose of its argument, i.e., @samp{conj(trn(x))}.
20039
20040 @ignore
20041 @mindex A
20042 @end ignore
20043 @kindex A (vectors)
20044 @pindex calc-abs (vectors)
20045 @ignore
20046 @mindex abs
20047 @end ignore
20048 @tindex abs (vectors)
20049 The @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs}) [@code{abs}] command computes the
20050 Frobenius norm of a vector or matrix argument. This is the square
20051 root of the sum of the squares of the absolute values of the
20052 elements of the vector or matrix. If the vector is interpreted as
20053 a point in two- or three-dimensional space, this is the distance
20054 from that point to the origin.
20055
20056 @kindex v n
20057 @pindex calc-rnorm
20058 @tindex rnorm
20059 The @kbd{v n} (@code{calc-rnorm}) [@code{rnorm}] command computes the
20060 infinity-norm of a vector, or the row norm of a matrix. For a plain
20061 vector, this is the maximum of the absolute values of the elements. For
20062 a matrix, this is the maximum of the row-absolute-value-sums, i.e., of
20063 the sums of the absolute values of the elements along the various rows.
20064
20065 @kindex V N
20066 @pindex calc-cnorm
20067 @tindex cnorm
20068 The @kbd{V N} (@code{calc-cnorm}) [@code{cnorm}] command computes
20069 the one-norm of a vector, or column norm of a matrix. For a plain
20070 vector, this is the sum of the absolute values of the elements.
20071 For a matrix, this is the maximum of the column-absolute-value-sums.
20072 General @expr{k}-norms for @expr{k} other than one or infinity are
20073 not provided. However, the 2-norm (or Frobenius norm) is provided for
20074 vectors by the @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs}) command.
20075
20076 @kindex V C
20077 @pindex calc-cross
20078 @tindex cross
20079 The @kbd{V C} (@code{calc-cross}) [@code{cross}] command computes the
20080 right-handed cross product of two vectors, each of which must have
20081 exactly three elements.
20082
20083 @ignore
20084 @mindex &
20085 @end ignore
20086 @kindex & (matrices)
20087 @pindex calc-inv (matrices)
20088 @ignore
20089 @mindex inv
20090 @end ignore
20091 @tindex inv (matrices)
20092 The @kbd{&} (@code{calc-inv}) [@code{inv}] command computes the
20093 inverse of a square matrix. If the matrix is singular, the inverse
20094 operation is left in symbolic form. Matrix inverses are recorded so
20095 that once an inverse (or determinant) of a particular matrix has been
20096 computed, the inverse and determinant of the matrix can be recomputed
20097 quickly in the future.
20098
20099 If the argument to @kbd{&} is a plain number @expr{x}, this
20100 command simply computes @expr{1/x}. This is okay, because the
20101 @samp{/} operator also does a matrix inversion when dividing one
20102 by a matrix.
20103
20104 @kindex V D
20105 @pindex calc-mdet
20106 @tindex det
20107 The @kbd{V D} (@code{calc-mdet}) [@code{det}] command computes the
20108 determinant of a square matrix.
20109
20110 @kindex V L
20111 @pindex calc-mlud
20112 @tindex lud
20113 The @kbd{V L} (@code{calc-mlud}) [@code{lud}] command computes the
20114 LU decomposition of a matrix. The result is a list of three matrices
20115 which, when multiplied together left-to-right, form the original matrix.
20116 The first is a permutation matrix that arises from pivoting in the
20117 algorithm, the second is lower-triangular with ones on the diagonal,
20118 and the third is upper-triangular.
20119
20120 @kindex V T
20121 @pindex calc-mtrace
20122 @tindex tr
20123 The @kbd{V T} (@code{calc-mtrace}) [@code{tr}] command computes the
20124 trace of a square matrix. This is defined as the sum of the diagonal
20125 elements of the matrix.
20126
20127 @kindex V K
20128 @pindex calc-kron
20129 @tindex kron
20130 The @kbd{V K} (@code{calc-kron}) [@code{kron}] command computes
20131 the Kronecker product of two matrices.
20132
20133 @node Set Operations, Statistical Operations, Vector and Matrix Arithmetic, Matrix Functions
20134 @section Set Operations using Vectors
20135
20136 @noindent
20137 @cindex Sets, as vectors
20138 Calc includes several commands which interpret vectors as @dfn{sets} of
20139 objects. A set is a collection of objects; any given object can appear
20140 only once in the set. Calc stores sets as vectors of objects in
20141 sorted order. Objects in a Calc set can be any of the usual things,
20142 such as numbers, variables, or formulas. Two set elements are considered
20143 equal if they are identical, except that numerically equal numbers like
20144 the integer 4 and the float 4.0 are considered equal even though they
20145 are not ``identical.'' Variables are treated like plain symbols without
20146 attached values by the set operations; subtracting the set @samp{[b]}
20147 from @samp{[a, b]} always yields the set @samp{[a]} even though if
20148 the variables @samp{a} and @samp{b} both equaled 17, you might
20149 expect the answer @samp{[]}.
20150
20151 If a set contains interval forms, then it is assumed to be a set of
20152 real numbers. In this case, all set operations require the elements
20153 of the set to be only things that are allowed in intervals: Real
20154 numbers, plus and minus infinity, HMS forms, and date forms. If
20155 there are variables or other non-real objects present in a real set,
20156 all set operations on it will be left in unevaluated form.
20157
20158 If the input to a set operation is a plain number or interval form
20159 @var{a}, it is treated like the one-element vector @samp{[@var{a}]}.
20160 The result is always a vector, except that if the set consists of a
20161 single interval, the interval itself is returned instead.
20162
20163 @xref{Logical Operations}, for the @code{in} function which tests if
20164 a certain value is a member of a given set. To test if the set @expr{A}
20165 is a subset of the set @expr{B}, use @samp{vdiff(A, B) = []}.
20166
20167 @kindex V +
20168 @pindex calc-remove-duplicates
20169 @tindex rdup
20170 The @kbd{V +} (@code{calc-remove-duplicates}) [@code{rdup}] command
20171 converts an arbitrary vector into set notation. It works by sorting
20172 the vector as if by @kbd{V S}, then removing duplicates. (For example,
20173 @kbd{[a, 5, 4, a, 4.0]} is sorted to @samp{[4, 4.0, 5, a, a]} and then
20174 reduced to @samp{[4, 5, a]}). Overlapping intervals are merged as
20175 necessary. You rarely need to use @kbd{V +} explicitly, since all the
20176 other set-based commands apply @kbd{V +} to their inputs before using
20177 them.
20178
20179 @kindex V V
20180 @pindex calc-set-union
20181 @tindex vunion
20182 The @kbd{V V} (@code{calc-set-union}) [@code{vunion}] command computes
20183 the union of two sets. An object is in the union of two sets if and
20184 only if it is in either (or both) of the input sets. (You could
20185 accomplish the same thing by concatenating the sets with @kbd{|},
20186 then using @kbd{V +}.)
20187
20188 @kindex V ^
20189 @pindex calc-set-intersect
20190 @tindex vint
20191 The @kbd{V ^} (@code{calc-set-intersect}) [@code{vint}] command computes
20192 the intersection of two sets. An object is in the intersection if
20193 and only if it is in both of the input sets. Thus if the input
20194 sets are disjoint, i.e., if they share no common elements, the result
20195 will be the empty vector @samp{[]}. Note that the characters @kbd{V}
20196 and @kbd{^} were chosen to be close to the conventional mathematical
20197 notation for set
20198 @texline union@tie{}(@math{A \cup B})
20199 @infoline union
20200 and
20201 @texline intersection@tie{}(@math{A \cap B}).
20202 @infoline intersection.
20203
20204 @kindex V -
20205 @pindex calc-set-difference
20206 @tindex vdiff
20207 The @kbd{V -} (@code{calc-set-difference}) [@code{vdiff}] command computes
20208 the difference between two sets. An object is in the difference
20209 @expr{A - B} if and only if it is in @expr{A} but not in @expr{B}.
20210 Thus subtracting @samp{[y,z]} from a set will remove the elements
20211 @samp{y} and @samp{z} if they are present. You can also think of this
20212 as a general @dfn{set complement} operator; if @expr{A} is the set of
20213 all possible values, then @expr{A - B} is the ``complement'' of @expr{B}.
20214 Obviously this is only practical if the set of all possible values in
20215 your problem is small enough to list in a Calc vector (or simple
20216 enough to express in a few intervals).
20217
20218 @kindex V X
20219 @pindex calc-set-xor
20220 @tindex vxor
20221 The @kbd{V X} (@code{calc-set-xor}) [@code{vxor}] command computes
20222 the ``exclusive-or,'' or ``symmetric difference'' of two sets.
20223 An object is in the symmetric difference of two sets if and only
20224 if it is in one, but @emph{not} both, of the sets. Objects that
20225 occur in both sets ``cancel out.''
20226
20227 @kindex V ~
20228 @pindex calc-set-complement
20229 @tindex vcompl
20230 The @kbd{V ~} (@code{calc-set-complement}) [@code{vcompl}] command
20231 computes the complement of a set with respect to the real numbers.
20232 Thus @samp{vcompl(x)} is equivalent to @samp{vdiff([-inf .. inf], x)}.
20233 For example, @samp{vcompl([2, (3 .. 4]])} evaluates to
20234 @samp{[[-inf .. 2), (2 .. 3], (4 .. inf]]}.
20235
20236 @kindex V F
20237 @pindex calc-set-floor
20238 @tindex vfloor
20239 The @kbd{V F} (@code{calc-set-floor}) [@code{vfloor}] command
20240 reinterprets a set as a set of integers. Any non-integer values,
20241 and intervals that do not enclose any integers, are removed. Open
20242 intervals are converted to equivalent closed intervals. Successive
20243 integers are converted into intervals of integers. For example, the
20244 complement of the set @samp{[2, 6, 7, 8]} is messy, but if you wanted
20245 the complement with respect to the set of integers you could type
20246 @kbd{V ~ V F} to get @samp{[[-inf .. 1], [3 .. 5], [9 .. inf]]}.
20247
20248 @kindex V E
20249 @pindex calc-set-enumerate
20250 @tindex venum
20251 The @kbd{V E} (@code{calc-set-enumerate}) [@code{venum}] command
20252 converts a set of integers into an explicit vector. Intervals in
20253 the set are expanded out to lists of all integers encompassed by
20254 the intervals. This only works for finite sets (i.e., sets which
20255 do not involve @samp{-inf} or @samp{inf}).
20256
20257 @kindex V :
20258 @pindex calc-set-span
20259 @tindex vspan
20260 The @kbd{V :} (@code{calc-set-span}) [@code{vspan}] command converts any
20261 set of reals into an interval form that encompasses all its elements.
20262 The lower limit will be the smallest element in the set; the upper
20263 limit will be the largest element. For an empty set, @samp{vspan([])}
20264 returns the empty interval @w{@samp{[0 .. 0)}}.
20265
20266 @kindex V #
20267 @pindex calc-set-cardinality
20268 @tindex vcard
20269 The @kbd{V #} (@code{calc-set-cardinality}) [@code{vcard}] command counts
20270 the number of integers in a set. The result is the length of the vector
20271 that would be produced by @kbd{V E}, although the computation is much
20272 more efficient than actually producing that vector.
20273
20274 @cindex Sets, as binary numbers
20275 Another representation for sets that may be more appropriate in some
20276 cases is binary numbers. If you are dealing with sets of integers
20277 in the range 0 to 49, you can use a 50-bit binary number where a
20278 particular bit is 1 if the corresponding element is in the set.
20279 @xref{Binary Functions}, for a list of commands that operate on
20280 binary numbers. Note that many of the above set operations have
20281 direct equivalents in binary arithmetic: @kbd{b o} (@code{calc-or}),
20282 @kbd{b a} (@code{calc-and}), @kbd{b d} (@code{calc-diff}),
20283 @kbd{b x} (@code{calc-xor}), and @kbd{b n} (@code{calc-not}),
20284 respectively. You can use whatever representation for sets is most
20285 convenient to you.
20286
20287 @kindex b p
20288 @kindex b u
20289 @pindex calc-pack-bits
20290 @pindex calc-unpack-bits
20291 @tindex vpack
20292 @tindex vunpack
20293 The @kbd{b u} (@code{calc-unpack-bits}) [@code{vunpack}] command
20294 converts an integer that represents a set in binary into a set
20295 in vector/interval notation. For example, @samp{vunpack(67)}
20296 returns @samp{[[0 .. 1], 6]}. If the input is negative, the set
20297 it represents is semi-infinite: @samp{vunpack(-4) = [2 .. inf)}.
20298 Use @kbd{V E} afterwards to expand intervals to individual
20299 values if you wish. Note that this command uses the @kbd{b}
20300 (binary) prefix key.
20301
20302 The @kbd{b p} (@code{calc-pack-bits}) [@code{vpack}] command
20303 converts the other way, from a vector or interval representing
20304 a set of nonnegative integers into a binary integer describing
20305 the same set. The set may include positive infinity, but must
20306 not include any negative numbers. The input is interpreted as a
20307 set of integers in the sense of @kbd{V F} (@code{vfloor}). Beware
20308 that a simple input like @samp{[100]} can result in a huge integer
20309 representation
20310 @texline (@math{2^{100}}, a 31-digit integer, in this case).
20311 @infoline (@expr{2^100}, a 31-digit integer, in this case).
20312
20313 @node Statistical Operations, Reducing and Mapping, Set Operations, Matrix Functions
20314 @section Statistical Operations on Vectors
20315
20316 @noindent
20317 @cindex Statistical functions
20318 The commands in this section take vectors as arguments and compute
20319 various statistical measures on the data stored in the vectors. The
20320 references used in the definitions of these functions are Bevington's
20321 @emph{Data Reduction and Error Analysis for the Physical Sciences},
20322 and @emph{Numerical Recipes} by Press, Flannery, Teukolsky and
20323 Vetterling.
20324
20325 The statistical commands use the @kbd{u} prefix key followed by
20326 a shifted letter or other character.
20327
20328 @xref{Manipulating Vectors}, for a description of @kbd{V H}
20329 (@code{calc-histogram}).
20330
20331 @xref{Curve Fitting}, for the @kbd{a F} command for doing
20332 least-squares fits to statistical data.
20333
20334 @xref{Probability Distribution Functions}, for several common
20335 probability distribution functions.
20336
20337 @menu
20338 * Single-Variable Statistics::
20339 * Paired-Sample Statistics::
20340 @end menu
20341
20342 @node Single-Variable Statistics, Paired-Sample Statistics, Statistical Operations, Statistical Operations
20343 @subsection Single-Variable Statistics
20344
20345 @noindent
20346 These functions do various statistical computations on single
20347 vectors. Given a numeric prefix argument, they actually pop
20348 @var{n} objects from the stack and combine them into a data
20349 vector. Each object may be either a number or a vector; if a
20350 vector, any sub-vectors inside it are ``flattened'' as if by
20351 @kbd{v a 0}; @pxref{Manipulating Vectors}. By default one object
20352 is popped, which (in order to be useful) is usually a vector.
20353
20354 If an argument is a variable name, and the value stored in that
20355 variable is a vector, then the stored vector is used. This method
20356 has the advantage that if your data vector is large, you can avoid
20357 the slow process of manipulating it directly on the stack.
20358
20359 These functions are left in symbolic form if any of their arguments
20360 are not numbers or vectors, e.g., if an argument is a formula, or
20361 a non-vector variable. However, formulas embedded within vector
20362 arguments are accepted; the result is a symbolic representation
20363 of the computation, based on the assumption that the formula does
20364 not itself represent a vector. All varieties of numbers such as
20365 error forms and interval forms are acceptable.
20366
20367 Some of the functions in this section also accept a single error form
20368 or interval as an argument. They then describe a property of the
20369 normal or uniform (respectively) statistical distribution described
20370 by the argument. The arguments are interpreted in the same way as
20371 the @var{M} argument of the random number function @kbd{k r}. In
20372 particular, an interval with integer limits is considered an integer
20373 distribution, so that @samp{[2 .. 6)} is the same as @samp{[2 .. 5]}.
20374 An interval with at least one floating-point limit is a continuous
20375 distribution: @samp{[2.0 .. 6.0)} is @emph{not} the same as
20376 @samp{[2.0 .. 5.0]}!
20377
20378 @kindex u #
20379 @pindex calc-vector-count
20380 @tindex vcount
20381 The @kbd{u #} (@code{calc-vector-count}) [@code{vcount}] command
20382 computes the number of data values represented by the inputs.
20383 For example, @samp{vcount(1, [2, 3], [[4, 5], [], x, y])} returns 7.
20384 If the argument is a single vector with no sub-vectors, this
20385 simply computes the length of the vector.
20386
20387 @kindex u +
20388 @kindex u *
20389 @pindex calc-vector-sum
20390 @pindex calc-vector-prod
20391 @tindex vsum
20392 @tindex vprod
20393 @cindex Summations (statistical)
20394 The @kbd{u +} (@code{calc-vector-sum}) [@code{vsum}] command
20395 computes the sum of the data values. The @kbd{u *}
20396 (@code{calc-vector-prod}) [@code{vprod}] command computes the
20397 product of the data values. If the input is a single flat vector,
20398 these are the same as @kbd{V R +} and @kbd{V R *}
20399 (@pxref{Reducing and Mapping}).
20400
20401 @kindex u X
20402 @kindex u N
20403 @pindex calc-vector-max
20404 @pindex calc-vector-min
20405 @tindex vmax
20406 @tindex vmin
20407 The @kbd{u X} (@code{calc-vector-max}) [@code{vmax}] command
20408 computes the maximum of the data values, and the @kbd{u N}
20409 (@code{calc-vector-min}) [@code{vmin}] command computes the minimum.
20410 If the argument is an interval, this finds the minimum or maximum
20411 value in the interval. (Note that @samp{vmax([2..6)) = 5} as
20412 described above.) If the argument is an error form, this returns
20413 plus or minus infinity.
20414
20415 @kindex u M
20416 @pindex calc-vector-mean
20417 @tindex vmean
20418 @cindex Mean of data values
20419 The @kbd{u M} (@code{calc-vector-mean}) [@code{vmean}] command
20420 computes the average (arithmetic mean) of the data values.
20421 If the inputs are error forms
20422 @texline @math{x \pm \sigma},
20423 @infoline @samp{x +/- s},
20424 this is the weighted mean of the @expr{x} values with weights
20425 @texline @math{1 /\sigma^2}.
20426 @infoline @expr{1 / s^2}.
20427 @tex
20428 \turnoffactive
20429 $$ \mu = { \displaystyle \sum { x_i \over \sigma_i^2 } \over
20430 \displaystyle \sum { 1 \over \sigma_i^2 } } $$
20431 @end tex
20432 If the inputs are not error forms, this is simply the sum of the
20433 values divided by the count of the values.
20434
20435 Note that a plain number can be considered an error form with
20436 error
20437 @texline @math{\sigma = 0}.
20438 @infoline @expr{s = 0}.
20439 If the input to @kbd{u M} is a mixture of
20440 plain numbers and error forms, the result is the mean of the
20441 plain numbers, ignoring all values with non-zero errors. (By the
20442 above definitions it's clear that a plain number effectively
20443 has an infinite weight, next to which an error form with a finite
20444 weight is completely negligible.)
20445
20446 This function also works for distributions (error forms or
20447 intervals). The mean of an error form `@var{a} @tfn{+/-} @var{b}' is simply
20448 @expr{a}. The mean of an interval is the mean of the minimum
20449 and maximum values of the interval.
20450
20451 @kindex I u M
20452 @pindex calc-vector-mean-error
20453 @tindex vmeane
20454 The @kbd{I u M} (@code{calc-vector-mean-error}) [@code{vmeane}]
20455 command computes the mean of the data points expressed as an
20456 error form. This includes the estimated error associated with
20457 the mean. If the inputs are error forms, the error is the square
20458 root of the reciprocal of the sum of the reciprocals of the squares
20459 of the input errors. (I.e., the variance is the reciprocal of the
20460 sum of the reciprocals of the variances.)
20461 @tex
20462 \turnoffactive
20463 $$ \sigma_\mu^2 = {1 \over \displaystyle \sum {1 \over \sigma_i^2}} $$
20464 @end tex
20465 If the inputs are plain
20466 numbers, the error is equal to the standard deviation of the values
20467 divided by the square root of the number of values. (This works
20468 out to be equivalent to calculating the standard deviation and
20469 then assuming each value's error is equal to this standard
20470 deviation.)
20471 @tex
20472 \turnoffactive
20473 $$ \sigma_\mu^2 = {\sigma^2 \over N} $$
20474 @end tex
20475
20476 @kindex H u M
20477 @pindex calc-vector-median
20478 @tindex vmedian
20479 @cindex Median of data values
20480 The @kbd{H u M} (@code{calc-vector-median}) [@code{vmedian}]
20481 command computes the median of the data values. The values are
20482 first sorted into numerical order; the median is the middle
20483 value after sorting. (If the number of data values is even,
20484 the median is taken to be the average of the two middle values.)
20485 The median function is different from the other functions in
20486 this section in that the arguments must all be real numbers;
20487 variables are not accepted even when nested inside vectors.
20488 (Otherwise it is not possible to sort the data values.) If
20489 any of the input values are error forms, their error parts are
20490 ignored.
20491
20492 The median function also accepts distributions. For both normal
20493 (error form) and uniform (interval) distributions, the median is
20494 the same as the mean.
20495
20496 @kindex H I u M
20497 @pindex calc-vector-harmonic-mean
20498 @tindex vhmean
20499 @cindex Harmonic mean
20500 The @kbd{H I u M} (@code{calc-vector-harmonic-mean}) [@code{vhmean}]
20501 command computes the harmonic mean of the data values. This is
20502 defined as the reciprocal of the arithmetic mean of the reciprocals
20503 of the values.
20504 @tex
20505 \turnoffactive
20506 $$ { N \over \displaystyle \sum {1 \over x_i} } $$
20507 @end tex
20508
20509 @kindex u G
20510 @pindex calc-vector-geometric-mean
20511 @tindex vgmean
20512 @cindex Geometric mean
20513 The @kbd{u G} (@code{calc-vector-geometric-mean}) [@code{vgmean}]
20514 command computes the geometric mean of the data values. This
20515 is the @var{n}th root of the product of the values. This is also
20516 equal to the @code{exp} of the arithmetic mean of the logarithms
20517 of the data values.
20518 @tex
20519 \turnoffactive
20520 $$ \exp \left ( \sum { \ln x_i } \right ) =
20521 \left ( \prod { x_i } \right)^{1 / N} $$
20522 @end tex
20523
20524 @kindex H u G
20525 @tindex agmean
20526 The @kbd{H u G} [@code{agmean}] command computes the ``arithmetic-geometric
20527 mean'' of two numbers taken from the stack. This is computed by
20528 replacing the two numbers with their arithmetic mean and geometric
20529 mean, then repeating until the two values converge.
20530 @tex
20531 \turnoffactive
20532 $$ a_{i+1} = { a_i + b_i \over 2 } , \qquad b_{i+1} = \sqrt{a_i b_i} $$
20533 @end tex
20534
20535 @cindex Root-mean-square
20536 Another commonly used mean, the RMS (root-mean-square), can be computed
20537 for a vector of numbers simply by using the @kbd{A} command.
20538
20539 @kindex u S
20540 @pindex calc-vector-sdev
20541 @tindex vsdev
20542 @cindex Standard deviation
20543 @cindex Sample statistics
20544 The @kbd{u S} (@code{calc-vector-sdev}) [@code{vsdev}] command
20545 computes the standard
20546 @texline deviation@tie{}@math{\sigma}
20547 @infoline deviation
20548 of the data values. If the values are error forms, the errors are used
20549 as weights just as for @kbd{u M}. This is the @emph{sample} standard
20550 deviation, whose value is the square root of the sum of the squares of
20551 the differences between the values and the mean of the @expr{N} values,
20552 divided by @expr{N-1}.
20553 @tex
20554 \turnoffactive
20555 $$ \sigma^2 = {1 \over N - 1} \sum (x_i - \mu)^2 $$
20556 @end tex
20557
20558 This function also applies to distributions. The standard deviation
20559 of a single error form is simply the error part. The standard deviation
20560 of a continuous interval happens to equal the difference between the
20561 limits, divided by
20562 @texline @math{\sqrt{12}}.
20563 @infoline @expr{sqrt(12)}.
20564 The standard deviation of an integer interval is the same as the
20565 standard deviation of a vector of those integers.
20566
20567 @kindex I u S
20568 @pindex calc-vector-pop-sdev
20569 @tindex vpsdev
20570 @cindex Population statistics
20571 The @kbd{I u S} (@code{calc-vector-pop-sdev}) [@code{vpsdev}]
20572 command computes the @emph{population} standard deviation.
20573 It is defined by the same formula as above but dividing
20574 by @expr{N} instead of by @expr{N-1}. The population standard
20575 deviation is used when the input represents the entire set of
20576 data values in the distribution; the sample standard deviation
20577 is used when the input represents a sample of the set of all
20578 data values, so that the mean computed from the input is itself
20579 only an estimate of the true mean.
20580 @tex
20581 \turnoffactive
20582 $$ \sigma^2 = {1 \over N} \sum (x_i - \mu)^2 $$
20583 @end tex
20584
20585 For error forms and continuous intervals, @code{vpsdev} works
20586 exactly like @code{vsdev}. For integer intervals, it computes the
20587 population standard deviation of the equivalent vector of integers.
20588
20589 @kindex H u S
20590 @kindex H I u S
20591 @pindex calc-vector-variance
20592 @pindex calc-vector-pop-variance
20593 @tindex vvar
20594 @tindex vpvar
20595 @cindex Variance of data values
20596 The @kbd{H u S} (@code{calc-vector-variance}) [@code{vvar}] and
20597 @kbd{H I u S} (@code{calc-vector-pop-variance}) [@code{vpvar}]
20598 commands compute the variance of the data values. The variance
20599 is the
20600 @texline square@tie{}@math{\sigma^2}
20601 @infoline square
20602 of the standard deviation, i.e., the sum of the
20603 squares of the deviations of the data values from the mean.
20604 (This definition also applies when the argument is a distribution.)
20605
20606 @ignore
20607 @starindex
20608 @end ignore
20609 @tindex vflat
20610 The @code{vflat} algebraic function returns a vector of its
20611 arguments, interpreted in the same way as the other functions
20612 in this section. For example, @samp{vflat(1, [2, [3, 4]], 5)}
20613 returns @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4, 5]}.
20614
20615 @node Paired-Sample Statistics, , Single-Variable Statistics, Statistical Operations
20616 @subsection Paired-Sample Statistics
20617
20618 @noindent
20619 The functions in this section take two arguments, which must be
20620 vectors of equal size. The vectors are each flattened in the same
20621 way as by the single-variable statistical functions. Given a numeric
20622 prefix argument of 1, these functions instead take one object from
20623 the stack, which must be an
20624 @texline @math{N\times2}
20625 @infoline Nx2
20626 matrix of data values. Once again, variable names can be used in place
20627 of actual vectors and matrices.
20628
20629 @kindex u C
20630 @pindex calc-vector-covariance
20631 @tindex vcov
20632 @cindex Covariance
20633 The @kbd{u C} (@code{calc-vector-covariance}) [@code{vcov}] command
20634 computes the sample covariance of two vectors. The covariance
20635 of vectors @var{x} and @var{y} is the sum of the products of the
20636 differences between the elements of @var{x} and the mean of @var{x}
20637 times the differences between the corresponding elements of @var{y}
20638 and the mean of @var{y}, all divided by @expr{N-1}. Note that
20639 the variance of a vector is just the covariance of the vector
20640 with itself. Once again, if the inputs are error forms the
20641 errors are used as weight factors. If both @var{x} and @var{y}
20642 are composed of error forms, the error for a given data point
20643 is taken as the square root of the sum of the squares of the two
20644 input errors.
20645 @tex
20646 \turnoffactive
20647 $$ \sigma_{x\!y}^2 = {1 \over N-1} \sum (x_i - \mu_x) (y_i - \mu_y) $$
20648 $$ \sigma_{x\!y}^2 =
20649 {\displaystyle {1 \over N-1}
20650 \sum {(x_i - \mu_x) (y_i - \mu_y) \over \sigma_i^2}
20651 \over \displaystyle {1 \over N} \sum {1 \over \sigma_i^2}}
20652 $$
20653 @end tex
20654
20655 @kindex I u C
20656 @pindex calc-vector-pop-covariance
20657 @tindex vpcov
20658 The @kbd{I u C} (@code{calc-vector-pop-covariance}) [@code{vpcov}]
20659 command computes the population covariance, which is the same as the
20660 sample covariance computed by @kbd{u C} except dividing by @expr{N}
20661 instead of @expr{N-1}.
20662
20663 @kindex H u C
20664 @pindex calc-vector-correlation
20665 @tindex vcorr
20666 @cindex Correlation coefficient
20667 @cindex Linear correlation
20668 The @kbd{H u C} (@code{calc-vector-correlation}) [@code{vcorr}]
20669 command computes the linear correlation coefficient of two vectors.
20670 This is defined by the covariance of the vectors divided by the
20671 product of their standard deviations. (There is no difference
20672 between sample or population statistics here.)
20673 @tex
20674 \turnoffactive
20675 $$ r_{x\!y} = { \sigma_{x\!y}^2 \over \sigma_x^2 \sigma_y^2 } $$
20676 @end tex
20677
20678 @node Reducing and Mapping, Vector and Matrix Formats, Statistical Operations, Matrix Functions
20679 @section Reducing and Mapping Vectors
20680
20681 @noindent
20682 The commands in this section allow for more general operations on the
20683 elements of vectors.
20684
20685 @kindex V A
20686 @pindex calc-apply
20687 @tindex apply
20688 The simplest of these operations is @kbd{V A} (@code{calc-apply})
20689 [@code{apply}], which applies a given operator to the elements of a vector.
20690 For example, applying the hypothetical function @code{f} to the vector
20691 @w{@samp{[1, 2, 3]}} would produce the function call @samp{f(1, 2, 3)}.
20692 Applying the @code{+} function to the vector @samp{[a, b]} gives
20693 @samp{a + b}. Applying @code{+} to the vector @samp{[a, b, c]} is an
20694 error, since the @code{+} function expects exactly two arguments.
20695
20696 While @kbd{V A} is useful in some cases, you will usually find that either
20697 @kbd{V R} or @kbd{V M}, described below, is closer to what you want.
20698
20699 @menu
20700 * Specifying Operators::
20701 * Mapping::
20702 * Reducing::
20703 * Nesting and Fixed Points::
20704 * Generalized Products::
20705 @end menu
20706
20707 @node Specifying Operators, Mapping, Reducing and Mapping, Reducing and Mapping
20708 @subsection Specifying Operators
20709
20710 @noindent
20711 Commands in this section (like @kbd{V A}) prompt you to press the key
20712 corresponding to the desired operator. Press @kbd{?} for a partial
20713 list of the available operators. Generally, an operator is any key or
20714 sequence of keys that would normally take one or more arguments from
20715 the stack and replace them with a result. For example, @kbd{V A H C}
20716 uses the hyperbolic cosine operator, @code{cosh}. (Since @code{cosh}
20717 expects one argument, @kbd{V A H C} requires a vector with a single
20718 element as its argument.)
20719
20720 You can press @kbd{x} at the operator prompt to select any algebraic
20721 function by name to use as the operator. This includes functions you
20722 have defined yourself using the @kbd{Z F} command. (@xref{Algebraic
20723 Definitions}.) If you give a name for which no function has been
20724 defined, the result is left in symbolic form, as in @samp{f(1, 2, 3)}.
20725 Calc will prompt for the number of arguments the function takes if it
20726 can't figure it out on its own (say, because you named a function that
20727 is currently undefined). It is also possible to type a digit key before
20728 the function name to specify the number of arguments, e.g.,
20729 @kbd{V M 3 x f @key{RET}} calls @code{f} with three arguments even if it
20730 looks like it ought to have only two. This technique may be necessary
20731 if the function allows a variable number of arguments. For example,
20732 the @kbd{v e} [@code{vexp}] function accepts two or three arguments;
20733 if you want to map with the three-argument version, you will have to
20734 type @kbd{V M 3 v e}.
20735
20736 It is also possible to apply any formula to a vector by treating that
20737 formula as a function. When prompted for the operator to use, press
20738 @kbd{'} (the apostrophe) and type your formula as an algebraic entry.
20739 You will then be prompted for the argument list, which defaults to a
20740 list of all variables that appear in the formula, sorted into alphabetic
20741 order. For example, suppose you enter the formula @w{@samp{x + 2y^x}}.
20742 The default argument list would be @samp{(x y)}, which means that if
20743 this function is applied to the arguments @samp{[3, 10]} the result will
20744 be @samp{3 + 2*10^3}. (If you plan to use a certain formula in this
20745 way often, you might consider defining it as a function with @kbd{Z F}.)
20746
20747 Another way to specify the arguments to the formula you enter is with
20748 @kbd{$}, @kbd{$$}, and so on. For example, @kbd{V A ' $$ + 2$^$$}
20749 has the same effect as the previous example. The argument list is
20750 automatically taken to be @samp{($$ $)}. (The order of the arguments
20751 may seem backwards, but it is analogous to the way normal algebraic
20752 entry interacts with the stack.)
20753
20754 If you press @kbd{$} at the operator prompt, the effect is similar to
20755 the apostrophe except that the relevant formula is taken from top-of-stack
20756 instead. The actual vector arguments of the @kbd{V A $} or related command
20757 then start at the second-to-top stack position. You will still be
20758 prompted for an argument list.
20759
20760 @cindex Nameless functions
20761 @cindex Generic functions
20762 A function can be written without a name using the notation @samp{<#1 - #2>},
20763 which means ``a function of two arguments that computes the first
20764 argument minus the second argument.'' The symbols @samp{#1} and @samp{#2}
20765 are placeholders for the arguments. You can use any names for these
20766 placeholders if you wish, by including an argument list followed by a
20767 colon: @samp{<x, y : x - y>}. When you type @kbd{V A ' $$ + 2$^$$ @key{RET}},
20768 Calc builds the nameless function @samp{<#1 + 2 #2^#1>} as the function
20769 to map across the vectors. When you type @kbd{V A ' x + 2y^x @key{RET} @key{RET}},
20770 Calc builds the nameless function @w{@samp{<x, y : x + 2 y^x>}}. In both
20771 cases, Calc also writes the nameless function to the Trail so that you
20772 can get it back later if you wish.
20773
20774 If there is only one argument, you can write @samp{#} in place of @samp{#1}.
20775 (Note that @samp{< >} notation is also used for date forms. Calc tells
20776 that @samp{<@var{stuff}>} is a nameless function by the presence of
20777 @samp{#} signs inside @var{stuff}, or by the fact that @var{stuff}
20778 begins with a list of variables followed by a colon.)
20779
20780 You can type a nameless function directly to @kbd{V A '}, or put one on
20781 the stack and use it with @w{@kbd{V A $}}. Calc will not prompt for an
20782 argument list in this case, since the nameless function specifies the
20783 argument list as well as the function itself. In @kbd{V A '}, you can
20784 omit the @samp{< >} marks if you use @samp{#} notation for the arguments,
20785 so that @kbd{V A ' #1+#2 @key{RET}} is the same as @kbd{V A ' <#1+#2> @key{RET}},
20786 which in turn is the same as @kbd{V A ' $$+$ @key{RET}}.
20787
20788 @cindex Lambda expressions
20789 @ignore
20790 @starindex
20791 @end ignore
20792 @tindex lambda
20793 The internal format for @samp{<x, y : x + y>} is @samp{lambda(x, y, x + y)}.
20794 (The word @code{lambda} derives from Lisp notation and the theory of
20795 functions.) The internal format for @samp{<#1 + #2>} is @samp{lambda(ArgA,
20796 ArgB, ArgA + ArgB)}. Note that there is no actual Calc function called
20797 @code{lambda}; the whole point is that the @code{lambda} expression is
20798 used in its symbolic form, not evaluated for an answer until it is applied
20799 to specific arguments by a command like @kbd{V A} or @kbd{V M}.
20800
20801 (Actually, @code{lambda} does have one special property: Its arguments
20802 are never evaluated; for example, putting @samp{<(2/3) #>} on the stack
20803 will not simplify the @samp{2/3} until the nameless function is actually
20804 called.)
20805
20806 @tindex add
20807 @tindex sub
20808 @ignore
20809 @mindex @idots
20810 @end ignore
20811 @tindex mul
20812 @ignore
20813 @mindex @null
20814 @end ignore
20815 @tindex div
20816 @ignore
20817 @mindex @null
20818 @end ignore
20819 @tindex pow
20820 @ignore
20821 @mindex @null
20822 @end ignore
20823 @tindex neg
20824 @ignore
20825 @mindex @null
20826 @end ignore
20827 @tindex mod
20828 @ignore
20829 @mindex @null
20830 @end ignore
20831 @tindex vconcat
20832 As usual, commands like @kbd{V A} have algebraic function name equivalents.
20833 For example, @kbd{V A k g} with an argument of @samp{v} is equivalent to
20834 @samp{apply(gcd, v)}. The first argument specifies the operator name,
20835 and is either a variable whose name is the same as the function name,
20836 or a nameless function like @samp{<#^3+1>}. Operators that are normally
20837 written as algebraic symbols have the names @code{add}, @code{sub},
20838 @code{mul}, @code{div}, @code{pow}, @code{neg}, @code{mod}, and
20839 @code{vconcat}.
20840
20841 @ignore
20842 @starindex
20843 @end ignore
20844 @tindex call
20845 The @code{call} function builds a function call out of several arguments:
20846 @samp{call(gcd, x, y)} is the same as @samp{apply(gcd, [x, y])}, which
20847 in turn is the same as @samp{gcd(x, y)}. The first argument of @code{call},
20848 like the other functions described here, may be either a variable naming a
20849 function, or a nameless function (@samp{call(<#1+2#2>, x, y)} is the same
20850 as @samp{x + 2y}).
20851
20852 (Experts will notice that it's not quite proper to use a variable to name
20853 a function, since the name @code{gcd} corresponds to the Lisp variable
20854 @code{var-gcd} but to the Lisp function @code{calcFunc-gcd}. Calc
20855 automatically makes this translation, so you don't have to worry
20856 about it.)
20857
20858 @node Mapping, Reducing, Specifying Operators, Reducing and Mapping
20859 @subsection Mapping
20860
20861 @noindent
20862 @kindex V M
20863 @pindex calc-map
20864 @tindex map
20865 The @kbd{V M} (@code{calc-map}) [@code{map}] command applies a given
20866 operator elementwise to one or more vectors. For example, mapping
20867 @code{A} [@code{abs}] produces a vector of the absolute values of the
20868 elements in the input vector. Mapping @code{+} pops two vectors from
20869 the stack, which must be of equal length, and produces a vector of the
20870 pairwise sums of the elements. If either argument is a non-vector, it
20871 is duplicated for each element of the other vector. For example,
20872 @kbd{[1,2,3] 2 V M ^} squares the elements of the specified vector.
20873 With the 2 listed first, it would have computed a vector of powers of
20874 two. Mapping a user-defined function pops as many arguments from the
20875 stack as the function requires. If you give an undefined name, you will
20876 be prompted for the number of arguments to use.
20877
20878 If any argument to @kbd{V M} is a matrix, the operator is normally mapped
20879 across all elements of the matrix. For example, given the matrix
20880 @expr{[[1, -2, 3], [-4, 5, -6]]}, @kbd{V M A} takes six absolute values to
20881 produce another
20882 @texline @math{3\times2}
20883 @infoline 3x2
20884 matrix, @expr{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5, 6]]}.
20885
20886 @tindex mapr
20887 The command @kbd{V M _} [@code{mapr}] (i.e., type an underscore at the
20888 operator prompt) maps by rows instead. For example, @kbd{V M _ A} views
20889 the above matrix as a vector of two 3-element row vectors. It produces
20890 a new vector which contains the absolute values of those row vectors,
20891 namely @expr{[3.74, 8.77]}. (Recall, the absolute value of a vector is
20892 defined as the square root of the sum of the squares of the elements.)
20893 Some operators accept vectors and return new vectors; for example,
20894 @kbd{v v} reverses a vector, so @kbd{V M _ v v} would reverse each row
20895 of the matrix to get a new matrix, @expr{[[3, -2, 1], [-6, 5, -4]]}.
20896
20897 Sometimes a vector of vectors (representing, say, strings, sets, or lists)
20898 happens to look like a matrix. If so, remember to use @kbd{V M _} if you
20899 want to map a function across the whole strings or sets rather than across
20900 their individual elements.
20901
20902 @tindex mapc
20903 The command @kbd{V M :} [@code{mapc}] maps by columns. Basically, it
20904 transposes the input matrix, maps by rows, and then, if the result is a
20905 matrix, transposes again. For example, @kbd{V M : A} takes the absolute
20906 values of the three columns of the matrix, treating each as a 2-vector,
20907 and @kbd{V M : v v} reverses the columns to get the matrix
20908 @expr{[[-4, 5, -6], [1, -2, 3]]}.
20909
20910 (The symbols @kbd{_} and @kbd{:} were chosen because they had row-like
20911 and column-like appearances, and were not already taken by useful
20912 operators. Also, they appear shifted on most keyboards so they are easy
20913 to type after @kbd{V M}.)
20914
20915 The @kbd{_} and @kbd{:} modifiers have no effect on arguments that are
20916 not matrices (so if none of the arguments are matrices, they have no
20917 effect at all). If some of the arguments are matrices and others are
20918 plain numbers, the plain numbers are held constant for all rows of the
20919 matrix (so that @kbd{2 V M _ ^} squares every row of a matrix; squaring
20920 a vector takes a dot product of the vector with itself).
20921
20922 If some of the arguments are vectors with the same lengths as the
20923 rows (for @kbd{V M _}) or columns (for @kbd{V M :}) of the matrix
20924 arguments, those vectors are also held constant for every row or
20925 column.
20926
20927 Sometimes it is useful to specify another mapping command as the operator
20928 to use with @kbd{V M}. For example, @kbd{V M _ V A +} applies @kbd{V A +}
20929 to each row of the input matrix, which in turn adds the two values on that
20930 row. If you give another vector-operator command as the operator for
20931 @kbd{V M}, it automatically uses map-by-rows mode if you don't specify
20932 otherwise; thus @kbd{V M V A +} is equivalent to @kbd{V M _ V A +}. (If
20933 you really want to map-by-elements another mapping command, you can use
20934 a triple-nested mapping command: @kbd{V M V M V A +} means to map
20935 @kbd{V M V A +} over the rows of the matrix; in turn, @kbd{V A +} is
20936 mapped over the elements of each row.)
20937
20938 @tindex mapa
20939 @tindex mapd
20940 Previous versions of Calc had ``map across'' and ``map down'' modes
20941 that are now considered obsolete; the old ``map across'' is now simply
20942 @kbd{V M V A}, and ``map down'' is now @kbd{V M : V A}. The algebraic
20943 functions @code{mapa} and @code{mapd} are still supported, though.
20944 Note also that, while the old mapping modes were persistent (once you
20945 set the mode, it would apply to later mapping commands until you reset
20946 it), the new @kbd{:} and @kbd{_} modifiers apply only to the current
20947 mapping command. The default @kbd{V M} always means map-by-elements.
20948
20949 @xref{Algebraic Manipulation}, for the @kbd{a M} command, which is like
20950 @kbd{V M} but for equations and inequalities instead of vectors.
20951 @xref{Storing Variables}, for the @kbd{s m} command which modifies a
20952 variable's stored value using a @kbd{V M}-like operator.
20953
20954 @node Reducing, Nesting and Fixed Points, Mapping, Reducing and Mapping
20955 @subsection Reducing
20956
20957 @noindent
20958 @kindex V R
20959 @pindex calc-reduce
20960 @tindex reduce
20961 The @kbd{V R} (@code{calc-reduce}) [@code{reduce}] command applies a given
20962 binary operator across all the elements of a vector. A binary operator is
20963 a function such as @code{+} or @code{max} which takes two arguments. For
20964 example, reducing @code{+} over a vector computes the sum of the elements
20965 of the vector. Reducing @code{-} computes the first element minus each of
20966 the remaining elements. Reducing @code{max} computes the maximum element
20967 and so on. In general, reducing @code{f} over the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]}
20968 produces @samp{f(f(f(a, b), c), d)}.
20969
20970 @kindex I V R
20971 @tindex rreduce
20972 The @kbd{I V R} [@code{rreduce}] command is similar to @kbd{V R} except
20973 that works from right to left through the vector. For example, plain
20974 @kbd{V R -} on the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]} produces @samp{a - b - c - d}
20975 but @kbd{I V R -} on the same vector produces @samp{a - (b - (c - d))},
20976 or @samp{a - b + c - d}. This ``alternating sum'' occurs frequently
20977 in power series expansions.
20978
20979 @kindex V U
20980 @tindex accum
20981 The @kbd{V U} (@code{calc-accumulate}) [@code{accum}] command does an
20982 accumulation operation. Here Calc does the corresponding reduction
20983 operation, but instead of producing only the final result, it produces
20984 a vector of all the intermediate results. Accumulating @code{+} over
20985 the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]} produces the vector
20986 @samp{[a, a + b, a + b + c, a + b + c + d]}.
20987
20988 @kindex I V U
20989 @tindex raccum
20990 The @kbd{I V U} [@code{raccum}] command does a right-to-left accumulation.
20991 For example, @kbd{I V U -} on the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]} produces the
20992 vector @samp{[a - b + c - d, b - c + d, c - d, d]}.
20993
20994 @tindex reducea
20995 @tindex rreducea
20996 @tindex reduced
20997 @tindex rreduced
20998 As for @kbd{V M}, @kbd{V R} normally reduces a matrix elementwise. For
20999 example, given the matrix @expr{[[a, b, c], [d, e, f]]}, @kbd{V R +} will
21000 compute @expr{a + b + c + d + e + f}. You can type @kbd{V R _} or
21001 @kbd{V R :} to modify this behavior. The @kbd{V R _} [@code{reducea}]
21002 command reduces ``across'' the matrix; it reduces each row of the matrix
21003 as a vector, then collects the results. Thus @kbd{V R _ +} of this
21004 matrix would produce @expr{[a + b + c, d + e + f]}. Similarly, @kbd{V R :}
21005 [@code{reduced}] reduces down; @kbd{V R : +} would produce @expr{[a + d,
21006 b + e, c + f]}.
21007
21008 @tindex reducer
21009 @tindex rreducer
21010 There is a third ``by rows'' mode for reduction that is occasionally
21011 useful; @kbd{V R =} [@code{reducer}] simply reduces the operator over
21012 the rows of the matrix themselves. Thus @kbd{V R = +} on the above
21013 matrix would get the same result as @kbd{V R : +}, since adding two
21014 row vectors is equivalent to adding their elements. But @kbd{V R = *}
21015 would multiply the two rows (to get a single number, their dot product),
21016 while @kbd{V R : *} would produce a vector of the products of the columns.
21017
21018 These three matrix reduction modes work with @kbd{V R} and @kbd{I V R},
21019 but they are not currently supported with @kbd{V U} or @kbd{I V U}.
21020
21021 @tindex reducec
21022 @tindex rreducec
21023 The obsolete reduce-by-columns function, @code{reducec}, is still
21024 supported but there is no way to get it through the @kbd{V R} command.
21025
21026 The commands @kbd{C-x * :} and @kbd{C-x * _} are equivalent to typing
21027 @kbd{C-x * r} to grab a rectangle of data into Calc, and then typing
21028 @kbd{V R : +} or @kbd{V R _ +}, respectively, to sum the columns or
21029 rows of the matrix. @xref{Grabbing From Buffers}.
21030
21031 @node Nesting and Fixed Points, Generalized Products, Reducing, Reducing and Mapping
21032 @subsection Nesting and Fixed Points
21033
21034 @noindent
21035 @kindex H V R
21036 @tindex nest
21037 The @kbd{H V R} [@code{nest}] command applies a function to a given
21038 argument repeatedly. It takes two values, @samp{a} and @samp{n}, from
21039 the stack, where @samp{n} must be an integer. It then applies the
21040 function nested @samp{n} times; if the function is @samp{f} and @samp{n}
21041 is 3, the result is @samp{f(f(f(a)))}. The number @samp{n} may be
21042 negative if Calc knows an inverse for the function @samp{f}; for
21043 example, @samp{nest(sin, a, -2)} returns @samp{arcsin(arcsin(a))}.
21044
21045 @kindex H V U
21046 @tindex anest
21047 The @kbd{H V U} [@code{anest}] command is an accumulating version of
21048 @code{nest}: It returns a vector of @samp{n+1} values, e.g.,
21049 @samp{[a, f(a), f(f(a)), f(f(f(a)))]}. If @samp{n} is negative and
21050 @samp{F} is the inverse of @samp{f}, then the result is of the
21051 form @samp{[a, F(a), F(F(a)), F(F(F(a)))]}.
21052
21053 @kindex H I V R
21054 @tindex fixp
21055 @cindex Fixed points
21056 The @kbd{H I V R} [@code{fixp}] command is like @kbd{H V R}, except
21057 that it takes only an @samp{a} value from the stack; the function is
21058 applied until it reaches a ``fixed point,'' i.e., until the result
21059 no longer changes.
21060
21061 @kindex H I V U
21062 @tindex afixp
21063 The @kbd{H I V U} [@code{afixp}] command is an accumulating @code{fixp}.
21064 The first element of the return vector will be the initial value @samp{a};
21065 the last element will be the final result that would have been returned
21066 by @code{fixp}.
21067
21068 For example, 0.739085 is a fixed point of the cosine function (in radians):
21069 @samp{cos(0.739085) = 0.739085}. You can find this value by putting, say,
21070 1.0 on the stack and typing @kbd{H I V U C}. (We use the accumulating
21071 version so we can see the intermediate results: @samp{[1, 0.540302, 0.857553,
21072 0.65329, ...]}. With a precision of six, this command will take 36 steps
21073 to converge to 0.739085.)
21074
21075 Newton's method for finding roots is a classic example of iteration
21076 to a fixed point. To find the square root of five starting with an
21077 initial guess, Newton's method would look for a fixed point of the
21078 function @samp{(x + 5/x) / 2}. Putting a guess of 1 on the stack
21079 and typing @kbd{H I V R ' ($ + 5/$)/2 @key{RET}} quickly yields the result
21080 2.23607. This is equivalent to using the @kbd{a R} (@code{calc-find-root})
21081 command to find a root of the equation @samp{x^2 = 5}.
21082
21083 These examples used numbers for @samp{a} values. Calc keeps applying
21084 the function until two successive results are equal to within the
21085 current precision. For complex numbers, both the real parts and the
21086 imaginary parts must be equal to within the current precision. If
21087 @samp{a} is a formula (say, a variable name), then the function is
21088 applied until two successive results are exactly the same formula.
21089 It is up to you to ensure that the function will eventually converge;
21090 if it doesn't, you may have to press @kbd{C-g} to stop the Calculator.
21091
21092 The algebraic @code{fixp} function takes two optional arguments, @samp{n}
21093 and @samp{tol}. The first is the maximum number of steps to be allowed,
21094 and must be either an integer or the symbol @samp{inf} (infinity, the
21095 default). The second is a convergence tolerance. If a tolerance is
21096 specified, all results during the calculation must be numbers, not
21097 formulas, and the iteration stops when the magnitude of the difference
21098 between two successive results is less than or equal to the tolerance.
21099 (This implies that a tolerance of zero iterates until the results are
21100 exactly equal.)
21101
21102 Putting it all together, @samp{fixp(<(# + A/#)/2>, B, 20, 1e-10)}
21103 computes the square root of @samp{A} given the initial guess @samp{B},
21104 stopping when the result is correct within the specified tolerance, or
21105 when 20 steps have been taken, whichever is sooner.
21106
21107 @node Generalized Products, , Nesting and Fixed Points, Reducing and Mapping
21108 @subsection Generalized Products
21109
21110 @kindex V O
21111 @pindex calc-outer-product
21112 @tindex outer
21113 The @kbd{V O} (@code{calc-outer-product}) [@code{outer}] command applies
21114 a given binary operator to all possible pairs of elements from two
21115 vectors, to produce a matrix. For example, @kbd{V O *} with @samp{[a, b]}
21116 and @samp{[x, y, z]} on the stack produces a multiplication table:
21117 @samp{[[a x, a y, a z], [b x, b y, b z]]}. Element @var{r},@var{c} of
21118 the result matrix is obtained by applying the operator to element @var{r}
21119 of the lefthand vector and element @var{c} of the righthand vector.
21120
21121 @kindex V I
21122 @pindex calc-inner-product
21123 @tindex inner
21124 The @kbd{V I} (@code{calc-inner-product}) [@code{inner}] command computes
21125 the generalized inner product of two vectors or matrices, given a
21126 ``multiplicative'' operator and an ``additive'' operator. These can each
21127 actually be any binary operators; if they are @samp{*} and @samp{+},
21128 respectively, the result is a standard matrix multiplication. Element
21129 @var{r},@var{c} of the result matrix is obtained by mapping the
21130 multiplicative operator across row @var{r} of the lefthand matrix and
21131 column @var{c} of the righthand matrix, and then reducing with the additive
21132 operator. Just as for the standard @kbd{*} command, this can also do a
21133 vector-matrix or matrix-vector inner product, or a vector-vector
21134 generalized dot product.
21135
21136 Since @kbd{V I} requires two operators, it prompts twice. In each case,
21137 you can use any of the usual methods for entering the operator. If you
21138 use @kbd{$} twice to take both operator formulas from the stack, the
21139 first (multiplicative) operator is taken from the top of the stack
21140 and the second (additive) operator is taken from second-to-top.
21141
21142 @node Vector and Matrix Formats, , Reducing and Mapping, Matrix Functions
21143 @section Vector and Matrix Display Formats
21144
21145 @noindent
21146 Commands for controlling vector and matrix display use the @kbd{v} prefix
21147 instead of the usual @kbd{d} prefix. But they are display modes; in
21148 particular, they are influenced by the @kbd{I} and @kbd{H} prefix keys
21149 in the same way (@pxref{Display Modes}). Matrix display is also
21150 influenced by the @kbd{d O} (@code{calc-flat-language}) mode;
21151 @pxref{Normal Language Modes}.
21152
21153 @kindex V <
21154 @pindex calc-matrix-left-justify
21155 @kindex V =
21156 @pindex calc-matrix-center-justify
21157 @kindex V >
21158 @pindex calc-matrix-right-justify
21159 The commands @kbd{v <} (@code{calc-matrix-left-justify}), @kbd{v >}
21160 (@code{calc-matrix-right-justify}), and @w{@kbd{v =}}
21161 (@code{calc-matrix-center-justify}) control whether matrix elements
21162 are justified to the left, right, or center of their columns.
21163
21164 @kindex V [
21165 @pindex calc-vector-brackets
21166 @kindex V @{
21167 @pindex calc-vector-braces
21168 @kindex V (
21169 @pindex calc-vector-parens
21170 The @kbd{v [} (@code{calc-vector-brackets}) command turns the square
21171 brackets that surround vectors and matrices displayed in the stack on
21172 and off. The @kbd{v @{} (@code{calc-vector-braces}) and @kbd{v (}
21173 (@code{calc-vector-parens}) commands use curly braces or parentheses,
21174 respectively, instead of square brackets. For example, @kbd{v @{} might
21175 be used in preparation for yanking a matrix into a buffer running
21176 Mathematica. (In fact, the Mathematica language mode uses this mode;
21177 @pxref{Mathematica Language Mode}.) Note that, regardless of the
21178 display mode, either brackets or braces may be used to enter vectors,
21179 and parentheses may never be used for this purpose.
21180
21181 @kindex V ]
21182 @pindex calc-matrix-brackets
21183 The @kbd{v ]} (@code{calc-matrix-brackets}) command controls the
21184 ``big'' style display of matrices. It prompts for a string of code
21185 letters; currently implemented letters are @code{R}, which enables
21186 brackets on each row of the matrix; @code{O}, which enables outer
21187 brackets in opposite corners of the matrix; and @code{C}, which
21188 enables commas or semicolons at the ends of all rows but the last.
21189 The default format is @samp{RO}. (Before Calc 2.00, the format
21190 was fixed at @samp{ROC}.) Here are some example matrices:
21191
21192 @example
21193 @group
21194 [ [ 123, 0, 0 ] [ [ 123, 0, 0 ],
21195 [ 0, 123, 0 ] [ 0, 123, 0 ],
21196 [ 0, 0, 123 ] ] [ 0, 0, 123 ] ]
21197
21198 RO ROC
21199
21200 @end group
21201 @end example
21202 @noindent
21203 @example
21204 @group
21205 [ 123, 0, 0 [ 123, 0, 0 ;
21206 0, 123, 0 0, 123, 0 ;
21207 0, 0, 123 ] 0, 0, 123 ]
21208
21209 O OC
21210
21211 @end group
21212 @end example
21213 @noindent
21214 @example
21215 @group
21216 [ 123, 0, 0 ] 123, 0, 0
21217 [ 0, 123, 0 ] 0, 123, 0
21218 [ 0, 0, 123 ] 0, 0, 123
21219
21220 R @r{blank}
21221 @end group
21222 @end example
21223
21224 @noindent
21225 Note that of the formats shown here, @samp{RO}, @samp{ROC}, and
21226 @samp{OC} are all recognized as matrices during reading, while
21227 the others are useful for display only.
21228
21229 @kindex V ,
21230 @pindex calc-vector-commas
21231 The @kbd{v ,} (@code{calc-vector-commas}) command turns commas on and
21232 off in vector and matrix display.
21233
21234 In vectors of length one, and in all vectors when commas have been
21235 turned off, Calc adds extra parentheses around formulas that might
21236 otherwise be ambiguous. For example, @samp{[a b]} could be a vector
21237 of the one formula @samp{a b}, or it could be a vector of two
21238 variables with commas turned off. Calc will display the former
21239 case as @samp{[(a b)]}. You can disable these extra parentheses
21240 (to make the output less cluttered at the expense of allowing some
21241 ambiguity) by adding the letter @code{P} to the control string you
21242 give to @kbd{v ]} (as described above).
21243
21244 @kindex V .
21245 @pindex calc-full-vectors
21246 The @kbd{v .} (@code{calc-full-vectors}) command turns abbreviated
21247 display of long vectors on and off. In this mode, vectors of six
21248 or more elements, or matrices of six or more rows or columns, will
21249 be displayed in an abbreviated form that displays only the first
21250 three elements and the last element: @samp{[a, b, c, ..., z]}.
21251 When very large vectors are involved this will substantially
21252 improve Calc's display speed.
21253
21254 @kindex t .
21255 @pindex calc-full-trail-vectors
21256 The @kbd{t .} (@code{calc-full-trail-vectors}) command controls a
21257 similar mode for recording vectors in the Trail. If you turn on
21258 this mode, vectors of six or more elements and matrices of six or
21259 more rows or columns will be abbreviated when they are put in the
21260 Trail. The @kbd{t y} (@code{calc-trail-yank}) command will be
21261 unable to recover those vectors. If you are working with very
21262 large vectors, this mode will improve the speed of all operations
21263 that involve the trail.
21264
21265 @kindex V /
21266 @pindex calc-break-vectors
21267 The @kbd{v /} (@code{calc-break-vectors}) command turns multi-line
21268 vector display on and off. Normally, matrices are displayed with one
21269 row per line but all other types of vectors are displayed in a single
21270 line. This mode causes all vectors, whether matrices or not, to be
21271 displayed with a single element per line. Sub-vectors within the
21272 vectors will still use the normal linear form.
21273
21274 @node Algebra, Units, Matrix Functions, Top
21275 @chapter Algebra
21276
21277 @noindent
21278 This section covers the Calc features that help you work with
21279 algebraic formulas. First, the general sub-formula selection
21280 mechanism is described; this works in conjunction with any Calc
21281 commands. Then, commands for specific algebraic operations are
21282 described. Finally, the flexible @dfn{rewrite rule} mechanism
21283 is discussed.
21284
21285 The algebraic commands use the @kbd{a} key prefix; selection
21286 commands use the @kbd{j} (for ``just a letter that wasn't used
21287 for anything else'') prefix.
21288
21289 @xref{Editing Stack Entries}, to see how to manipulate formulas
21290 using regular Emacs editing commands.
21291
21292 When doing algebraic work, you may find several of the Calculator's
21293 modes to be helpful, including Algebraic Simplification mode (@kbd{m A})
21294 or No-Simplification mode (@kbd{m O}),
21295 Algebraic entry mode (@kbd{m a}), Fraction mode (@kbd{m f}), and
21296 Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s}). @xref{Mode Settings}, for discussions
21297 of these modes. You may also wish to select Big display mode (@kbd{d B}).
21298 @xref{Normal Language Modes}.
21299
21300 @menu
21301 * Selecting Subformulas::
21302 * Algebraic Manipulation::
21303 * Simplifying Formulas::
21304 * Polynomials::
21305 * Calculus::
21306 * Solving Equations::
21307 * Numerical Solutions::
21308 * Curve Fitting::
21309 * Summations::
21310 * Logical Operations::
21311 * Rewrite Rules::
21312 @end menu
21313
21314 @node Selecting Subformulas, Algebraic Manipulation, Algebra, Algebra
21315 @section Selecting Sub-Formulas
21316
21317 @noindent
21318 @cindex Selections
21319 @cindex Sub-formulas
21320 @cindex Parts of formulas
21321 When working with an algebraic formula it is often necessary to
21322 manipulate a portion of the formula rather than the formula as a
21323 whole. Calc allows you to ``select'' a portion of any formula on
21324 the stack. Commands which would normally operate on that stack
21325 entry will now operate only on the sub-formula, leaving the
21326 surrounding part of the stack entry alone.
21327
21328 One common non-algebraic use for selection involves vectors. To work
21329 on one element of a vector in-place, simply select that element as a
21330 ``sub-formula'' of the vector.
21331
21332 @menu
21333 * Making Selections::
21334 * Changing Selections::
21335 * Displaying Selections::
21336 * Operating on Selections::
21337 * Rearranging with Selections::
21338 @end menu
21339
21340 @node Making Selections, Changing Selections, Selecting Subformulas, Selecting Subformulas
21341 @subsection Making Selections
21342
21343 @noindent
21344 @kindex j s
21345 @pindex calc-select-here
21346 To select a sub-formula, move the Emacs cursor to any character in that
21347 sub-formula, and press @w{@kbd{j s}} (@code{calc-select-here}). Calc will
21348 highlight the smallest portion of the formula that contains that
21349 character. By default the sub-formula is highlighted by blanking out
21350 all of the rest of the formula with dots. Selection works in any
21351 display mode but is perhaps easiest in Big mode (@kbd{d B}).
21352 Suppose you enter the following formula:
21353
21354 @smallexample
21355 @group
21356 3 ___
21357 (a + b) + V c
21358 1: ---------------
21359 2 x + 1
21360 @end group
21361 @end smallexample
21362
21363 @noindent
21364 (by typing @kbd{' ((a+b)^3 + sqrt(c)) / (2x+1)}). If you move the
21365 cursor to the letter @samp{b} and press @w{@kbd{j s}}, the display changes
21366 to
21367
21368 @smallexample
21369 @group
21370 . ...
21371 .. . b. . . .
21372 1* ...............
21373 . . . .
21374 @end group
21375 @end smallexample
21376
21377 @noindent
21378 Every character not part of the sub-formula @samp{b} has been changed
21379 to a dot. The @samp{*} next to the line number is to remind you that
21380 the formula has a portion of it selected. (In this case, it's very
21381 obvious, but it might not always be. If Embedded mode is enabled,
21382 the word @samp{Sel} also appears in the mode line because the stack
21383 may not be visible. @pxref{Embedded Mode}.)
21384
21385 If you had instead placed the cursor on the parenthesis immediately to
21386 the right of the @samp{b}, the selection would have been:
21387
21388 @smallexample
21389 @group
21390 . ...
21391 (a + b) . . .
21392 1* ...............
21393 . . . .
21394 @end group
21395 @end smallexample
21396
21397 @noindent
21398 The portion selected is always large enough to be considered a complete
21399 formula all by itself, so selecting the parenthesis selects the whole
21400 formula that it encloses. Putting the cursor on the @samp{+} sign
21401 would have had the same effect.
21402
21403 (Strictly speaking, the Emacs cursor is really the manifestation of
21404 the Emacs ``point,'' which is a position @emph{between} two characters
21405 in the buffer. So purists would say that Calc selects the smallest
21406 sub-formula which contains the character to the right of ``point.'')
21407
21408 If you supply a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, the selection is
21409 expanded to the @var{n}th enclosing sub-formula. Thus, positioning
21410 the cursor on the @samp{b} and typing @kbd{C-u 1 j s} will select
21411 @samp{a + b}; typing @kbd{C-u 2 j s} will select @samp{(a + b)^3},
21412 and so on.
21413
21414 If the cursor is not on any part of the formula, or if you give a
21415 numeric prefix that is too large, the entire formula is selected.
21416
21417 If the cursor is on the @samp{.} line that marks the top of the stack
21418 (i.e., its normal ``rest position''), this command selects the entire
21419 formula at stack level 1. Most selection commands similarly operate
21420 on the formula at the top of the stack if you haven't positioned the
21421 cursor on any stack entry.
21422
21423 @kindex j a
21424 @pindex calc-select-additional
21425 The @kbd{j a} (@code{calc-select-additional}) command enlarges the
21426 current selection to encompass the cursor. To select the smallest
21427 sub-formula defined by two different points, move to the first and
21428 press @kbd{j s}, then move to the other and press @kbd{j a}. This
21429 is roughly analogous to using @kbd{C-@@} (@code{set-mark-command}) to
21430 select the two ends of a region of text during normal Emacs editing.
21431
21432 @kindex j o
21433 @pindex calc-select-once
21434 The @kbd{j o} (@code{calc-select-once}) command selects a formula in
21435 exactly the same way as @kbd{j s}, except that the selection will
21436 last only as long as the next command that uses it. For example,
21437 @kbd{j o 1 +} is a handy way to add one to the sub-formula indicated
21438 by the cursor.
21439
21440 (A somewhat more precise definition: The @kbd{j o} command sets a flag
21441 such that the next command involving selected stack entries will clear
21442 the selections on those stack entries afterwards. All other selection
21443 commands except @kbd{j a} and @kbd{j O} clear this flag.)
21444
21445 @kindex j S
21446 @kindex j O
21447 @pindex calc-select-here-maybe
21448 @pindex calc-select-once-maybe
21449 The @kbd{j S} (@code{calc-select-here-maybe}) and @kbd{j O}
21450 (@code{calc-select-once-maybe}) commands are equivalent to @kbd{j s}
21451 and @kbd{j o}, respectively, except that if the formula already
21452 has a selection they have no effect. This is analogous to the
21453 behavior of some commands such as @kbd{j r} (@code{calc-rewrite-selection};
21454 @pxref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}) and is mainly intended to be
21455 used in keyboard macros that implement your own selection-oriented
21456 commands.
21457
21458 Selection of sub-formulas normally treats associative terms like
21459 @samp{a + b - c + d} and @samp{x * y * z} as single levels of the formula.
21460 If you place the cursor anywhere inside @samp{a + b - c + d} except
21461 on one of the variable names and use @kbd{j s}, you will select the
21462 entire four-term sum.
21463
21464 @kindex j b
21465 @pindex calc-break-selections
21466 The @kbd{j b} (@code{calc-break-selections}) command controls a mode
21467 in which the ``deep structure'' of these associative formulas shows
21468 through. Calc actually stores the above formulas as
21469 @samp{((a + b) - c) + d} and @samp{x * (y * z)}. (Note that for certain
21470 obscure reasons, by default Calc treats multiplication as
21471 right-associative.) Once you have enabled @kbd{j b} mode, selecting
21472 with the cursor on the @samp{-} sign would only select the @samp{a + b -
21473 c} portion, which makes sense when the deep structure of the sum is
21474 considered. There is no way to select the @samp{b - c + d} portion;
21475 although this might initially look like just as legitimate a sub-formula
21476 as @samp{a + b - c}, the deep structure shows that it isn't. The @kbd{d
21477 U} command can be used to view the deep structure of any formula
21478 (@pxref{Normal Language Modes}).
21479
21480 When @kbd{j b} mode has not been enabled, the deep structure is
21481 generally hidden by the selection commands---what you see is what
21482 you get.
21483
21484 @kindex j u
21485 @pindex calc-unselect
21486 The @kbd{j u} (@code{calc-unselect}) command unselects the formula
21487 that the cursor is on. If there was no selection in the formula,
21488 this command has no effect. With a numeric prefix argument, it
21489 unselects the @var{n}th stack element rather than using the cursor
21490 position.
21491
21492 @kindex j c
21493 @pindex calc-clear-selections
21494 The @kbd{j c} (@code{calc-clear-selections}) command unselects all
21495 stack elements.
21496
21497 @node Changing Selections, Displaying Selections, Making Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21498 @subsection Changing Selections
21499
21500 @noindent
21501 @kindex j m
21502 @pindex calc-select-more
21503 Once you have selected a sub-formula, you can expand it using the
21504 @w{@kbd{j m}} (@code{calc-select-more}) command. If @samp{a + b} is
21505 selected, pressing @w{@kbd{j m}} repeatedly works as follows:
21506
21507 @smallexample
21508 @group
21509 3 ... 3 ___ 3 ___
21510 (a + b) . . . (a + b) + V c (a + b) + V c
21511 1* ............... 1* ............... 1* ---------------
21512 . . . . . . . . 2 x + 1
21513 @end group
21514 @end smallexample
21515
21516 @noindent
21517 In the last example, the entire formula is selected. This is roughly
21518 the same as having no selection at all, but because there are subtle
21519 differences the @samp{*} character is still there on the line number.
21520
21521 With a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, @kbd{j m} expands @var{n}
21522 times (or until the entire formula is selected). Note that @kbd{j s}
21523 with argument @var{n} is equivalent to plain @kbd{j s} followed by
21524 @kbd{j m} with argument @var{n}. If @w{@kbd{j m}} is used when there
21525 is no current selection, it is equivalent to @w{@kbd{j s}}.
21526
21527 Even though @kbd{j m} does not explicitly use the location of the
21528 cursor within the formula, it nevertheless uses the cursor to determine
21529 which stack element to operate on. As usual, @kbd{j m} when the cursor
21530 is not on any stack element operates on the top stack element.
21531
21532 @kindex j l
21533 @pindex calc-select-less
21534 The @kbd{j l} (@code{calc-select-less}) command reduces the current
21535 selection around the cursor position. That is, it selects the
21536 immediate sub-formula of the current selection which contains the
21537 cursor, the opposite of @kbd{j m}. If the cursor is not inside the
21538 current selection, the command de-selects the formula.
21539
21540 @kindex j 1-9
21541 @pindex calc-select-part
21542 The @kbd{j 1} through @kbd{j 9} (@code{calc-select-part}) commands
21543 select the @var{n}th sub-formula of the current selection. They are
21544 like @kbd{j l} (@code{calc-select-less}) except they use counting
21545 rather than the cursor position to decide which sub-formula to select.
21546 For example, if the current selection is @kbd{a + b + c} or
21547 @kbd{f(a, b, c)} or @kbd{[a, b, c]}, then @kbd{j 1} selects @samp{a},
21548 @kbd{j 2} selects @samp{b}, and @kbd{j 3} selects @samp{c}; in each of
21549 these cases, @kbd{j 4} through @kbd{j 9} would be errors.
21550
21551 If there is no current selection, @kbd{j 1} through @kbd{j 9} select
21552 the @var{n}th top-level sub-formula. (In other words, they act as if
21553 the entire stack entry were selected first.) To select the @var{n}th
21554 sub-formula where @var{n} is greater than nine, you must instead invoke
21555 @w{@kbd{j 1}} with @var{n} as a numeric prefix argument.
21556
21557 @kindex j n
21558 @kindex j p
21559 @pindex calc-select-next
21560 @pindex calc-select-previous
21561 The @kbd{j n} (@code{calc-select-next}) and @kbd{j p}
21562 (@code{calc-select-previous}) commands change the current selection
21563 to the next or previous sub-formula at the same level. For example,
21564 if @samp{b} is selected in @w{@samp{2 + a*b*c + x}}, then @kbd{j n}
21565 selects @samp{c}. Further @kbd{j n} commands would be in error because,
21566 even though there is something to the right of @samp{c} (namely, @samp{x}),
21567 it is not at the same level; in this case, it is not a term of the
21568 same product as @samp{b} and @samp{c}. However, @kbd{j m} (to select
21569 the whole product @samp{a*b*c} as a term of the sum) followed by
21570 @w{@kbd{j n}} would successfully select the @samp{x}.
21571
21572 Similarly, @kbd{j p} moves the selection from the @samp{b} in this
21573 sample formula to the @samp{a}. Both commands accept numeric prefix
21574 arguments to move several steps at a time.
21575
21576 It is interesting to compare Calc's selection commands with the
21577 Emacs Info system's commands for navigating through hierarchically
21578 organized documentation. Calc's @kbd{j n} command is completely
21579 analogous to Info's @kbd{n} command. Likewise, @kbd{j p} maps to
21580 @kbd{p}, @kbd{j 2} maps to @kbd{2}, and Info's @kbd{u} is like @kbd{j m}.
21581 (Note that @kbd{j u} stands for @code{calc-unselect}, not ``up''.)
21582 The Info @kbd{m} command is somewhat similar to Calc's @kbd{j s} and
21583 @kbd{j l}; in each case, you can jump directly to a sub-component
21584 of the hierarchy simply by pointing to it with the cursor.
21585
21586 @node Displaying Selections, Operating on Selections, Changing Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21587 @subsection Displaying Selections
21588
21589 @noindent
21590 @kindex j d
21591 @pindex calc-show-selections
21592 The @kbd{j d} (@code{calc-show-selections}) command controls how
21593 selected sub-formulas are displayed. One of the alternatives is
21594 illustrated in the above examples; if we press @kbd{j d} we switch
21595 to the other style in which the selected portion itself is obscured
21596 by @samp{#} signs:
21597
21598 @smallexample
21599 @group
21600 3 ... # ___
21601 (a + b) . . . ## # ## + V c
21602 1* ............... 1* ---------------
21603 . . . . 2 x + 1
21604 @end group
21605 @end smallexample
21606
21607 @node Operating on Selections, Rearranging with Selections, Displaying Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21608 @subsection Operating on Selections
21609
21610 @noindent
21611 Once a selection is made, all Calc commands that manipulate items
21612 on the stack will operate on the selected portions of the items
21613 instead. (Note that several stack elements may have selections
21614 at once, though there can be only one selection at a time in any
21615 given stack element.)
21616
21617 @kindex j e
21618 @pindex calc-enable-selections
21619 The @kbd{j e} (@code{calc-enable-selections}) command disables the
21620 effect that selections have on Calc commands. The current selections
21621 still exist, but Calc commands operate on whole stack elements anyway.
21622 This mode can be identified by the fact that the @samp{*} markers on
21623 the line numbers are gone, even though selections are visible. To
21624 reactivate the selections, press @kbd{j e} again.
21625
21626 To extract a sub-formula as a new formula, simply select the
21627 sub-formula and press @key{RET}. This normally duplicates the top
21628 stack element; here it duplicates only the selected portion of that
21629 element.
21630
21631 To replace a sub-formula with something different, you can enter the
21632 new value onto the stack and press @key{TAB}. This normally exchanges
21633 the top two stack elements; here it swaps the value you entered into
21634 the selected portion of the formula, returning the old selected
21635 portion to the top of the stack.
21636
21637 @smallexample
21638 @group
21639 3 ... ... ___
21640 (a + b) . . . 17 x y . . . 17 x y + V c
21641 2* ............... 2* ............. 2: -------------
21642 . . . . . . . . 2 x + 1
21643
21644 3 3
21645 1: 17 x y 1: (a + b) 1: (a + b)
21646 @end group
21647 @end smallexample
21648
21649 In this example we select a sub-formula of our original example,
21650 enter a new formula, @key{TAB} it into place, then deselect to see
21651 the complete, edited formula.
21652
21653 If you want to swap whole formulas around even though they contain
21654 selections, just use @kbd{j e} before and after.
21655
21656 @kindex j '
21657 @pindex calc-enter-selection
21658 The @kbd{j '} (@code{calc-enter-selection}) command is another way
21659 to replace a selected sub-formula. This command does an algebraic
21660 entry just like the regular @kbd{'} key. When you press @key{RET},
21661 the formula you type replaces the original selection. You can use
21662 the @samp{$} symbol in the formula to refer to the original
21663 selection. If there is no selection in the formula under the cursor,
21664 the cursor is used to make a temporary selection for the purposes of
21665 the command. Thus, to change a term of a formula, all you have to
21666 do is move the Emacs cursor to that term and press @kbd{j '}.
21667
21668 @kindex j `
21669 @pindex calc-edit-selection
21670 The @kbd{j `} (@code{calc-edit-selection}) command is a similar
21671 analogue of the @kbd{`} (@code{calc-edit}) command. It edits the
21672 selected sub-formula in a separate buffer. If there is no
21673 selection, it edits the sub-formula indicated by the cursor.
21674
21675 To delete a sub-formula, press @key{DEL}. This generally replaces
21676 the sub-formula with the constant zero, but in a few suitable contexts
21677 it uses the constant one instead. The @key{DEL} key automatically
21678 deselects and re-simplifies the entire formula afterwards. Thus:
21679
21680 @smallexample
21681 @group
21682 ###
21683 17 x y + # # 17 x y 17 # y 17 y
21684 1* ------------- 1: ------- 1* ------- 1: -------
21685 2 x + 1 2 x + 1 2 x + 1 2 x + 1
21686 @end group
21687 @end smallexample
21688
21689 In this example, we first delete the @samp{sqrt(c)} term; Calc
21690 accomplishes this by replacing @samp{sqrt(c)} with zero and
21691 resimplifying. We then delete the @kbd{x} in the numerator;
21692 since this is part of a product, Calc replaces it with @samp{1}
21693 and resimplifies.
21694
21695 If you select an element of a vector and press @key{DEL}, that
21696 element is deleted from the vector. If you delete one side of
21697 an equation or inequality, only the opposite side remains.
21698
21699 @kindex j @key{DEL}
21700 @pindex calc-del-selection
21701 The @kbd{j @key{DEL}} (@code{calc-del-selection}) command is like
21702 @key{DEL} but with the auto-selecting behavior of @kbd{j '} and
21703 @kbd{j `}. It deletes the selected portion of the formula
21704 indicated by the cursor, or, in the absence of a selection, it
21705 deletes the sub-formula indicated by the cursor position.
21706
21707 @kindex j @key{RET}
21708 @pindex calc-grab-selection
21709 (There is also an auto-selecting @kbd{j @key{RET}} (@code{calc-copy-selection})
21710 command.)
21711
21712 Normal arithmetic operations also apply to sub-formulas. Here we
21713 select the denominator, press @kbd{5 -} to subtract five from the
21714 denominator, press @kbd{n} to negate the denominator, then
21715 press @kbd{Q} to take the square root.
21716
21717 @smallexample
21718 @group
21719 .. . .. . .. . .. .
21720 1* ....... 1* ....... 1* ....... 1* ..........
21721 2 x + 1 2 x - 4 4 - 2 x _________
21722 V 4 - 2 x
21723 @end group
21724 @end smallexample
21725
21726 Certain types of operations on selections are not allowed. For
21727 example, for an arithmetic function like @kbd{-} no more than one of
21728 the arguments may be a selected sub-formula. (As the above example
21729 shows, the result of the subtraction is spliced back into the argument
21730 which had the selection; if there were more than one selection involved,
21731 this would not be well-defined.) If you try to subtract two selections,
21732 the command will abort with an error message.
21733
21734 Operations on sub-formulas sometimes leave the formula as a whole
21735 in an ``un-natural'' state. Consider negating the @samp{2 x} term
21736 of our sample formula by selecting it and pressing @kbd{n}
21737 (@code{calc-change-sign}).
21738
21739 @smallexample
21740 @group
21741 .. . .. .
21742 1* .......... 1* ...........
21743 ......... ..........
21744 . . . 2 x . . . -2 x
21745 @end group
21746 @end smallexample
21747
21748 Unselecting the sub-formula reveals that the minus sign, which would
21749 normally have cancelled out with the subtraction automatically, has
21750 not been able to do so because the subtraction was not part of the
21751 selected portion. Pressing @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}) or doing
21752 any other mathematical operation on the whole formula will cause it
21753 to be simplified.
21754
21755 @smallexample
21756 @group
21757 17 y 17 y
21758 1: ----------- 1: ----------
21759 __________ _________
21760 V 4 - -2 x V 4 + 2 x
21761 @end group
21762 @end smallexample
21763
21764 @node Rearranging with Selections, , Operating on Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21765 @subsection Rearranging Formulas using Selections
21766
21767 @noindent
21768 @kindex j R
21769 @pindex calc-commute-right
21770 The @kbd{j R} (@code{calc-commute-right}) command moves the selected
21771 sub-formula to the right in its surrounding formula. Generally the
21772 selection is one term of a sum or product; the sum or product is
21773 rearranged according to the commutative laws of algebra.
21774
21775 As with @kbd{j '} and @kbd{j @key{DEL}}, the term under the cursor is used
21776 if there is no selection in the current formula. All commands described
21777 in this section share this property. In this example, we place the
21778 cursor on the @samp{a} and type @kbd{j R}, then repeat.
21779
21780 @smallexample
21781 1: a + b - c 1: b + a - c 1: b - c + a
21782 @end smallexample
21783
21784 @noindent
21785 Note that in the final step above, the @samp{a} is switched with
21786 the @samp{c} but the signs are adjusted accordingly. When moving
21787 terms of sums and products, @kbd{j R} will never change the
21788 mathematical meaning of the formula.
21789
21790 The selected term may also be an element of a vector or an argument
21791 of a function. The term is exchanged with the one to its right.
21792 In this case, the ``meaning'' of the vector or function may of
21793 course be drastically changed.
21794
21795 @smallexample
21796 1: [a, b, c] 1: [b, a, c] 1: [b, c, a]
21797
21798 1: f(a, b, c) 1: f(b, a, c) 1: f(b, c, a)
21799 @end smallexample
21800
21801 @kindex j L
21802 @pindex calc-commute-left
21803 The @kbd{j L} (@code{calc-commute-left}) command is like @kbd{j R}
21804 except that it swaps the selected term with the one to its left.
21805
21806 With numeric prefix arguments, these commands move the selected
21807 term several steps at a time. It is an error to try to move a
21808 term left or right past the end of its enclosing formula.
21809 With numeric prefix arguments of zero, these commands move the
21810 selected term as far as possible in the given direction.
21811
21812 @kindex j D
21813 @pindex calc-sel-distribute
21814 The @kbd{j D} (@code{calc-sel-distribute}) command mixes the selected
21815 sum or product into the surrounding formula using the distributive
21816 law. For example, in @samp{a * (b - c)} with the @samp{b - c}
21817 selected, the result is @samp{a b - a c}. This also distributes
21818 products or quotients into surrounding powers, and can also do
21819 transformations like @samp{exp(a + b)} to @samp{exp(a) exp(b)},
21820 where @samp{a + b} is the selected term, and @samp{ln(a ^ b)}
21821 to @samp{ln(a) b}, where @samp{a ^ b} is the selected term.
21822
21823 For multiple-term sums or products, @kbd{j D} takes off one term
21824 at a time: @samp{a * (b + c - d)} goes to @samp{a * (c - d) + a b}
21825 with the @samp{c - d} selected so that you can type @kbd{j D}
21826 repeatedly to expand completely. The @kbd{j D} command allows a
21827 numeric prefix argument which specifies the maximum number of
21828 times to expand at once; the default is one time only.
21829
21830 @vindex DistribRules
21831 The @kbd{j D} command is implemented using rewrite rules.
21832 @xref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}. The rules are stored in
21833 the Calc variable @code{DistribRules}. A convenient way to view
21834 these rules is to use @kbd{s e} (@code{calc-edit-variable}) which
21835 displays and edits the stored value of a variable. Press @kbd{C-c C-c}
21836 to return from editing mode; be careful not to make any actual changes
21837 or else you will affect the behavior of future @kbd{j D} commands!
21838
21839 To extend @kbd{j D} to handle new cases, just edit @code{DistribRules}
21840 as described above. You can then use the @kbd{s p} command to save
21841 this variable's value permanently for future Calc sessions.
21842 @xref{Operations on Variables}.
21843
21844 @kindex j M
21845 @pindex calc-sel-merge
21846 @vindex MergeRules
21847 The @kbd{j M} (@code{calc-sel-merge}) command is the complement
21848 of @kbd{j D}; given @samp{a b - a c} with either @samp{a b} or
21849 @samp{a c} selected, the result is @samp{a * (b - c)}. Once
21850 again, @kbd{j M} can also merge calls to functions like @code{exp}
21851 and @code{ln}; examine the variable @code{MergeRules} to see all
21852 the relevant rules.
21853
21854 @kindex j C
21855 @pindex calc-sel-commute
21856 @vindex CommuteRules
21857 The @kbd{j C} (@code{calc-sel-commute}) command swaps the arguments
21858 of the selected sum, product, or equation. It always behaves as
21859 if @kbd{j b} mode were in effect, i.e., the sum @samp{a + b + c} is
21860 treated as the nested sums @samp{(a + b) + c} by this command.
21861 If you put the cursor on the first @samp{+}, the result is
21862 @samp{(b + a) + c}; if you put the cursor on the second @samp{+}, the
21863 result is @samp{c + (a + b)} (which the default simplifications
21864 will rearrange to @samp{(c + a) + b}). The relevant rules are stored
21865 in the variable @code{CommuteRules}.
21866
21867 You may need to turn default simplifications off (with the @kbd{m O}
21868 command) in order to get the full benefit of @kbd{j C}. For example,
21869 commuting @samp{a - b} produces @samp{-b + a}, but the default
21870 simplifications will ``simplify'' this right back to @samp{a - b} if
21871 you don't turn them off. The same is true of some of the other
21872 manipulations described in this section.
21873
21874 @kindex j N
21875 @pindex calc-sel-negate
21876 @vindex NegateRules
21877 The @kbd{j N} (@code{calc-sel-negate}) command replaces the selected
21878 term with the negative of that term, then adjusts the surrounding
21879 formula in order to preserve the meaning. For example, given
21880 @samp{exp(a - b)} where @samp{a - b} is selected, the result is
21881 @samp{1 / exp(b - a)}. By contrast, selecting a term and using the
21882 regular @kbd{n} (@code{calc-change-sign}) command negates the
21883 term without adjusting the surroundings, thus changing the meaning
21884 of the formula as a whole. The rules variable is @code{NegateRules}.
21885
21886 @kindex j &
21887 @pindex calc-sel-invert
21888 @vindex InvertRules
21889 The @kbd{j &} (@code{calc-sel-invert}) command is similar to @kbd{j N}
21890 except it takes the reciprocal of the selected term. For example,
21891 given @samp{a - ln(b)} with @samp{b} selected, the result is
21892 @samp{a + ln(1/b)}. The rules variable is @code{InvertRules}.
21893
21894 @kindex j E
21895 @pindex calc-sel-jump-equals
21896 @vindex JumpRules
21897 The @kbd{j E} (@code{calc-sel-jump-equals}) command moves the
21898 selected term from one side of an equation to the other. Given
21899 @samp{a + b = c + d} with @samp{c} selected, the result is
21900 @samp{a + b - c = d}. This command also works if the selected
21901 term is part of a @samp{*}, @samp{/}, or @samp{^} formula. The
21902 relevant rules variable is @code{JumpRules}.
21903
21904 @kindex j I
21905 @kindex H j I
21906 @pindex calc-sel-isolate
21907 The @kbd{j I} (@code{calc-sel-isolate}) command isolates the
21908 selected term on its side of an equation. It uses the @kbd{a S}
21909 (@code{calc-solve-for}) command to solve the equation, and the
21910 Hyperbolic flag affects it in the same way. @xref{Solving Equations}.
21911 When it applies, @kbd{j I} is often easier to use than @kbd{j E}.
21912 It understands more rules of algebra, and works for inequalities
21913 as well as equations.
21914
21915 @kindex j *
21916 @kindex j /
21917 @pindex calc-sel-mult-both-sides
21918 @pindex calc-sel-div-both-sides
21919 The @kbd{j *} (@code{calc-sel-mult-both-sides}) command prompts for a
21920 formula using algebraic entry, then multiplies both sides of the
21921 selected quotient or equation by that formula. It simplifies each
21922 side with @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}) before re-forming the
21923 quotient or equation. You can suppress this simplification by
21924 providing a prefix argument: @kbd{C-u j *}. There is also a @kbd{j /}
21925 (@code{calc-sel-div-both-sides}) which is similar to @kbd{j *} but
21926 dividing instead of multiplying by the factor you enter.
21927
21928 If the selection is a quotient with numerator 1, then Calc's default
21929 simplifications would normally cancel the new factors. To prevent
21930 this, when the @kbd{j *} command is used on a selection whose numerator is
21931 1 or -1, the denominator is expanded at the top level using the
21932 distributive law (as if using the @kbd{C-u 1 a x} command). Suppose the
21933 formula on the stack is @samp{1 / (a + 1)} and you wish to multiplying the
21934 top and bottom by @samp{a - 1}. Calc's default simplifications would
21935 normally change the result @samp{(a - 1) /(a + 1) (a - 1)} back
21936 to the original form by cancellation; when @kbd{j *} is used, Calc
21937 expands the denominator to @samp{a (a - 1) + a - 1} to prevent this.
21938
21939 If you wish the @kbd{j *} command to completely expand the denominator
21940 of a quotient you can call it with a zero prefix: @kbd{C-u 0 j *}. For
21941 example, if the formula on the stack is @samp{1 / (sqrt(a) + 1)}, you may
21942 wish to eliminate the square root in the denominator by multiplying
21943 the top and bottom by @samp{sqrt(a) - 1}. If you did this simply by using
21944 a simple @kbd{j *} command, you would get
21945 @samp{(sqrt(a)-1)/ (sqrt(a) (sqrt(a) - 1) + sqrt(a) - 1)}. Instead,
21946 you would probably want to use @kbd{C-u 0 j *}, which would expand the
21947 bottom and give you the desired result @samp{(sqrt(a)-1)/(a-1)}. More
21948 generally, if @kbd{j *} is called with an argument of a positive
21949 integer @var{n}, then the denominator of the expression will be
21950 expanded @var{n} times (as if with the @kbd{C-u @var{n} a x} command).
21951
21952 If the selection is an inequality, @kbd{j *} and @kbd{j /} will
21953 accept any factor, but will warn unless they can prove the factor
21954 is either positive or negative. (In the latter case the direction
21955 of the inequality will be switched appropriately.) @xref{Declarations},
21956 for ways to inform Calc that a given variable is positive or
21957 negative. If Calc can't tell for sure what the sign of the factor
21958 will be, it will assume it is positive and display a warning
21959 message.
21960
21961 For selections that are not quotients, equations, or inequalities,
21962 these commands pull out a multiplicative factor: They divide (or
21963 multiply) by the entered formula, simplify, then multiply (or divide)
21964 back by the formula.
21965
21966 @kindex j +
21967 @kindex j -
21968 @pindex calc-sel-add-both-sides
21969 @pindex calc-sel-sub-both-sides
21970 The @kbd{j +} (@code{calc-sel-add-both-sides}) and @kbd{j -}
21971 (@code{calc-sel-sub-both-sides}) commands analogously add to or
21972 subtract from both sides of an equation or inequality. For other
21973 types of selections, they extract an additive factor. A numeric
21974 prefix argument suppresses simplification of the intermediate
21975 results.
21976
21977 @kindex j U
21978 @pindex calc-sel-unpack
21979 The @kbd{j U} (@code{calc-sel-unpack}) command replaces the
21980 selected function call with its argument. For example, given
21981 @samp{a + sin(x^2)} with @samp{sin(x^2)} selected, the result
21982 is @samp{a + x^2}. (The @samp{x^2} will remain selected; if you
21983 wanted to change the @code{sin} to @code{cos}, just press @kbd{C}
21984 now to take the cosine of the selected part.)
21985
21986 @kindex j v
21987 @pindex calc-sel-evaluate
21988 The @kbd{j v} (@code{calc-sel-evaluate}) command performs the
21989 normal default simplifications on the selected sub-formula.
21990 These are the simplifications that are normally done automatically
21991 on all results, but which may have been partially inhibited by
21992 previous selection-related operations, or turned off altogether
21993 by the @kbd{m O} command. This command is just an auto-selecting
21994 version of the @w{@kbd{a v}} command (@pxref{Algebraic Manipulation}).
21995
21996 With a numeric prefix argument of 2, @kbd{C-u 2 j v} applies
21997 the @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}) command to the selected
21998 sub-formula. With a prefix argument of 3 or more, e.g., @kbd{C-u j v}
21999 applies the @kbd{a e} (@code{calc-simplify-extended}) command.
22000 @xref{Simplifying Formulas}. With a negative prefix argument
22001 it simplifies at the top level only, just as with @kbd{a v}.
22002 Here the ``top'' level refers to the top level of the selected
22003 sub-formula.
22004
22005 @kindex j "
22006 @pindex calc-sel-expand-formula
22007 The @kbd{j "} (@code{calc-sel-expand-formula}) command is to @kbd{a "}
22008 (@pxref{Algebraic Manipulation}) what @kbd{j v} is to @kbd{a v}.
22009
22010 You can use the @kbd{j r} (@code{calc-rewrite-selection}) command
22011 to define other algebraic operations on sub-formulas. @xref{Rewrite Rules}.
22012
22013 @node Algebraic Manipulation, Simplifying Formulas, Selecting Subformulas, Algebra
22014 @section Algebraic Manipulation
22015
22016 @noindent
22017 The commands in this section perform general-purpose algebraic
22018 manipulations. They work on the whole formula at the top of the
22019 stack (unless, of course, you have made a selection in that
22020 formula).
22021
22022 Many algebra commands prompt for a variable name or formula. If you
22023 answer the prompt with a blank line, the variable or formula is taken
22024 from top-of-stack, and the normal argument for the command is taken
22025 from the second-to-top stack level.
22026
22027 @kindex a v
22028 @pindex calc-alg-evaluate
22029 The @kbd{a v} (@code{calc-alg-evaluate}) command performs the normal
22030 default simplifications on a formula; for example, @samp{a - -b} is
22031 changed to @samp{a + b}. These simplifications are normally done
22032 automatically on all Calc results, so this command is useful only if
22033 you have turned default simplifications off with an @kbd{m O}
22034 command. @xref{Simplification Modes}.
22035
22036 It is often more convenient to type @kbd{=}, which is like @kbd{a v}
22037 but which also substitutes stored values for variables in the formula.
22038 Use @kbd{a v} if you want the variables to ignore their stored values.
22039
22040 If you give a numeric prefix argument of 2 to @kbd{a v}, it simplifies
22041 as if in Algebraic Simplification mode. This is equivalent to typing
22042 @kbd{a s}; @pxref{Simplifying Formulas}. If you give a numeric prefix
22043 of 3 or more, it uses Extended Simplification mode (@kbd{a e}).
22044
22045 If you give a negative prefix argument @mathit{-1}, @mathit{-2}, or @mathit{-3},
22046 it simplifies in the corresponding mode but only works on the top-level
22047 function call of the formula. For example, @samp{(2 + 3) * (2 + 3)} will
22048 simplify to @samp{(2 + 3)^2}, without simplifying the sub-formulas
22049 @samp{2 + 3}. As another example, typing @kbd{V R +} to sum the vector
22050 @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4]} produces the formula @samp{reduce(add, [1, 2, 3, 4])}
22051 in No-Simplify mode. Using @kbd{a v} will evaluate this all the way to
22052 10; using @kbd{C-u - a v} will evaluate it only to @samp{1 + 2 + 3 + 4}.
22053 (@xref{Reducing and Mapping}.)
22054
22055 @tindex evalv
22056 @tindex evalvn
22057 The @kbd{=} command corresponds to the @code{evalv} function, and
22058 the related @kbd{N} command, which is like @kbd{=} but temporarily
22059 disables Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s}) during the evaluation, corresponds
22060 to the @code{evalvn} function. (These commands interpret their prefix
22061 arguments differently than @kbd{a v}; @kbd{=} treats the prefix as
22062 the number of stack elements to evaluate at once, and @kbd{N} treats
22063 it as a temporary different working precision.)
22064
22065 The @code{evalvn} function can take an alternate working precision
22066 as an optional second argument. This argument can be either an
22067 integer, to set the precision absolutely, or a vector containing
22068 a single integer, to adjust the precision relative to the current
22069 precision. Note that @code{evalvn} with a larger than current
22070 precision will do the calculation at this higher precision, but the
22071 result will as usual be rounded back down to the current precision
22072 afterward. For example, @samp{evalvn(pi - 3.1415)} at a precision
22073 of 12 will return @samp{9.265359e-5}; @samp{evalvn(pi - 3.1415, 30)}
22074 will return @samp{9.26535897932e-5} (computing a 25-digit result which
22075 is then rounded down to 12); and @samp{evalvn(pi - 3.1415, [-2])}
22076 will return @samp{9.2654e-5}.
22077
22078 @kindex a "
22079 @pindex calc-expand-formula
22080 The @kbd{a "} (@code{calc-expand-formula}) command expands functions
22081 into their defining formulas wherever possible. For example,
22082 @samp{deg(x^2)} is changed to @samp{180 x^2 / pi}. Most functions,
22083 like @code{sin} and @code{gcd}, are not defined by simple formulas
22084 and so are unaffected by this command. One important class of
22085 functions which @emph{can} be expanded is the user-defined functions
22086 created by the @kbd{Z F} command. @xref{Algebraic Definitions}.
22087 Other functions which @kbd{a "} can expand include the probability
22088 distribution functions, most of the financial functions, and the
22089 hyperbolic and inverse hyperbolic functions. A numeric prefix argument
22090 affects @kbd{a "} in the same way as it does @kbd{a v}: A positive
22091 argument expands all functions in the formula and then simplifies in
22092 various ways; a negative argument expands and simplifies only the
22093 top-level function call.
22094
22095 @kindex a M
22096 @pindex calc-map-equation
22097 @tindex mapeq
22098 The @kbd{a M} (@code{calc-map-equation}) [@code{mapeq}] command applies
22099 a given function or operator to one or more equations. It is analogous
22100 to @kbd{V M}, which operates on vectors instead of equations.
22101 @pxref{Reducing and Mapping}. For example, @kbd{a M S} changes
22102 @samp{x = y+1} to @samp{sin(x) = sin(y+1)}, and @kbd{a M +} with
22103 @samp{x = y+1} and @expr{6} on the stack produces @samp{x+6 = y+7}.
22104 With two equations on the stack, @kbd{a M +} would add the lefthand
22105 sides together and the righthand sides together to get the two
22106 respective sides of a new equation.
22107
22108 Mapping also works on inequalities. Mapping two similar inequalities
22109 produces another inequality of the same type. Mapping an inequality
22110 with an equation produces an inequality of the same type. Mapping a
22111 @samp{<=} with a @samp{<} or @samp{!=} (not-equal) produces a @samp{<}.
22112 If inequalities with opposite direction (e.g., @samp{<} and @samp{>})
22113 are mapped, the direction of the second inequality is reversed to
22114 match the first: Using @kbd{a M +} on @samp{a < b} and @samp{a > 2}
22115 reverses the latter to get @samp{2 < a}, which then allows the
22116 combination @samp{a + 2 < b + a}, which the @kbd{a s} command can
22117 then simplify to get @samp{2 < b}.
22118
22119 Using @kbd{a M *}, @kbd{a M /}, @kbd{a M n}, or @kbd{a M &} to negate
22120 or invert an inequality will reverse the direction of the inequality.
22121 Other adjustments to inequalities are @emph{not} done automatically;
22122 @kbd{a M S} will change @w{@samp{x < y}} to @samp{sin(x) < sin(y)} even
22123 though this is not true for all values of the variables.
22124
22125 @kindex H a M
22126 @tindex mapeqp
22127 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H a M} [@code{mapeqp}] does a plain
22128 mapping operation without reversing the direction of any inequalities.
22129 Thus, @kbd{H a M &} would change @kbd{x > 2} to @kbd{1/x > 0.5}.
22130 (This change is mathematically incorrect, but perhaps you were
22131 fixing an inequality which was already incorrect.)
22132
22133 @kindex I a M
22134 @tindex mapeqr
22135 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I a M} [@code{mapeqr}] always reverses
22136 the direction of the inequality. You might use @kbd{I a M C} to
22137 change @samp{x < y} to @samp{cos(x) > cos(y)} if you know you are
22138 working with small positive angles.
22139
22140 @kindex a b
22141 @pindex calc-substitute
22142 @tindex subst
22143 The @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute}) [@code{subst}] command substitutes
22144 all occurrences
22145 of some variable or sub-expression of an expression with a new
22146 sub-expression. For example, substituting @samp{sin(x)} with @samp{cos(y)}
22147 in @samp{2 sin(x)^2 + x sin(x) + sin(2 x)} produces
22148 @samp{2 cos(y)^2 + x cos(y) + @w{sin(2 x)}}.
22149 Note that this is a purely structural substitution; the lone @samp{x} and
22150 the @samp{sin(2 x)} stayed the same because they did not look like
22151 @samp{sin(x)}. @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for a more general method for
22152 doing substitutions.
22153
22154 The @kbd{a b} command normally prompts for two formulas, the old
22155 one and the new one. If you enter a blank line for the first
22156 prompt, all three arguments are taken from the stack (new, then old,
22157 then target expression). If you type an old formula but then enter a
22158 blank line for the new one, the new formula is taken from top-of-stack
22159 and the target from second-to-top. If you answer both prompts, the
22160 target is taken from top-of-stack as usual.
22161
22162 Note that @kbd{a b} has no understanding of commutativity or
22163 associativity. The pattern @samp{x+y} will not match the formula
22164 @samp{y+x}. Also, @samp{y+z} will not match inside the formula @samp{x+y+z}
22165 because the @samp{+} operator is left-associative, so the ``deep
22166 structure'' of that formula is @samp{(x+y) + z}. Use @kbd{d U}
22167 (@code{calc-unformatted-language}) mode to see the true structure of
22168 a formula. The rewrite rule mechanism, discussed later, does not have
22169 these limitations.
22170
22171 As an algebraic function, @code{subst} takes three arguments:
22172 Target expression, old, new. Note that @code{subst} is always
22173 evaluated immediately, even if its arguments are variables, so if
22174 you wish to put a call to @code{subst} onto the stack you must
22175 turn the default simplifications off first (with @kbd{m O}).
22176
22177 @node Simplifying Formulas, Polynomials, Algebraic Manipulation, Algebra
22178 @section Simplifying Formulas
22179
22180 @noindent
22181 @kindex a s
22182 @pindex calc-simplify
22183 @tindex simplify
22184 The @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}) [@code{simplify}] command applies
22185 various algebraic rules to simplify a formula. This includes rules which
22186 are not part of the default simplifications because they may be too slow
22187 to apply all the time, or may not be desirable all of the time. For
22188 example, non-adjacent terms of sums are combined, as in @samp{a + b + 2 a}
22189 to @samp{b + 3 a}, and some formulas like @samp{sin(arcsin(x))} are
22190 simplified to @samp{x}.
22191
22192 The sections below describe all the various kinds of algebraic
22193 simplifications Calc provides in full detail. None of Calc's
22194 simplification commands are designed to pull rabbits out of hats;
22195 they simply apply certain specific rules to put formulas into
22196 less redundant or more pleasing forms. Serious algebra in Calc
22197 must be done manually, usually with a combination of selections
22198 and rewrite rules. @xref{Rearranging with Selections}.
22199 @xref{Rewrite Rules}.
22200
22201 @xref{Simplification Modes}, for commands to control what level of
22202 simplification occurs automatically. Normally only the ``default
22203 simplifications'' occur.
22204
22205 @menu
22206 * Default Simplifications::
22207 * Algebraic Simplifications::
22208 * Unsafe Simplifications::
22209 * Simplification of Units::
22210 @end menu
22211
22212 @node Default Simplifications, Algebraic Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas, Simplifying Formulas
22213 @subsection Default Simplifications
22214
22215 @noindent
22216 @cindex Default simplifications
22217 This section describes the ``default simplifications,'' those which are
22218 normally applied to all results. For example, if you enter the variable
22219 @expr{x} on the stack twice and push @kbd{+}, Calc's default
22220 simplifications automatically change @expr{x + x} to @expr{2 x}.
22221
22222 The @kbd{m O} command turns off the default simplifications, so that
22223 @expr{x + x} will remain in this form unless you give an explicit
22224 ``simplify'' command like @kbd{=} or @kbd{a v}. @xref{Algebraic
22225 Manipulation}. The @kbd{m D} command turns the default simplifications
22226 back on.
22227
22228 The most basic default simplification is the evaluation of functions.
22229 For example, @expr{2 + 3} is evaluated to @expr{5}, and @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(9)}
22230 is evaluated to @expr{3}. Evaluation does not occur if the arguments
22231 to a function are somehow of the wrong type @expr{@tfn{tan}([2,3,4])}),
22232 range (@expr{@tfn{tan}(90)}), or number (@expr{@tfn{tan}(3,5)}),
22233 or if the function name is not recognized (@expr{@tfn{f}(5)}), or if
22234 Symbolic mode (@pxref{Symbolic Mode}) prevents evaluation
22235 (@expr{@tfn{sqrt}(2)}).
22236
22237 Calc simplifies (evaluates) the arguments to a function before it
22238 simplifies the function itself. Thus @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(5+4)} is
22239 simplified to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(9)} before the @code{sqrt} function
22240 itself is applied. There are very few exceptions to this rule:
22241 @code{quote}, @code{lambda}, and @code{condition} (the @code{::}
22242 operator) do not evaluate their arguments, @code{if} (the @code{? :}
22243 operator) does not evaluate all of its arguments, and @code{evalto}
22244 does not evaluate its lefthand argument.
22245
22246 Most commands apply the default simplifications to all arguments they
22247 take from the stack, perform a particular operation, then simplify
22248 the result before pushing it back on the stack. In the common special
22249 case of regular arithmetic commands like @kbd{+} and @kbd{Q} [@code{sqrt}],
22250 the arguments are simply popped from the stack and collected into a
22251 suitable function call, which is then simplified (the arguments being
22252 simplified first as part of the process, as described above).
22253
22254 The default simplifications are too numerous to describe completely
22255 here, but this section will describe the ones that apply to the
22256 major arithmetic operators. This list will be rather technical in
22257 nature, and will probably be interesting to you only if you are
22258 a serious user of Calc's algebra facilities.
22259
22260 @tex
22261 \bigskip
22262 @end tex
22263
22264 As well as the simplifications described here, if you have stored
22265 any rewrite rules in the variable @code{EvalRules} then these rules
22266 will also be applied before any built-in default simplifications.
22267 @xref{Automatic Rewrites}, for details.
22268
22269 @tex
22270 \bigskip
22271 @end tex
22272
22273 And now, on with the default simplifications:
22274
22275 Arithmetic operators like @kbd{+} and @kbd{*} always take two
22276 arguments in Calc's internal form. Sums and products of three or
22277 more terms are arranged by the associative law of algebra into
22278 a left-associative form for sums, @expr{((a + b) + c) + d}, and
22279 (by default) a right-associative form for products,
22280 @expr{a * (b * (c * d))}. Formulas like @expr{(a + b) + (c + d)} are
22281 rearranged to left-associative form, though this rarely matters since
22282 Calc's algebra commands are designed to hide the inner structure of sums
22283 and products as much as possible. Sums and products in their proper
22284 associative form will be written without parentheses in the examples
22285 below.
22286
22287 Sums and products are @emph{not} rearranged according to the
22288 commutative law (@expr{a + b} to @expr{b + a}) except in a few
22289 special cases described below. Some algebra programs always
22290 rearrange terms into a canonical order, which enables them to
22291 see that @expr{a b + b a} can be simplified to @expr{2 a b}.
22292 Calc assumes you have put the terms into the order you want
22293 and generally leaves that order alone, with the consequence
22294 that formulas like the above will only be simplified if you
22295 explicitly give the @kbd{a s} command. @xref{Algebraic
22296 Simplifications}.
22297
22298 Differences @expr{a - b} are treated like sums @expr{a + (-b)}
22299 for purposes of simplification; one of the default simplifications
22300 is to rewrite @expr{a + (-b)} or @expr{(-b) + a}, where @expr{-b}
22301 represents a ``negative-looking'' term, into @expr{a - b} form.
22302 ``Negative-looking'' means negative numbers, negated formulas like
22303 @expr{-x}, and products or quotients in which either term is
22304 negative-looking.
22305
22306 Other simplifications involving negation are @expr{-(-x)} to @expr{x};
22307 @expr{-(a b)} or @expr{-(a/b)} where either @expr{a} or @expr{b} is
22308 negative-looking, simplified by negating that term, or else where
22309 @expr{a} or @expr{b} is any number, by negating that number;
22310 @expr{-(a + b)} to @expr{-a - b}, and @expr{-(b - a)} to @expr{a - b}.
22311 (This, and rewriting @expr{(-b) + a} to @expr{a - b}, are the only
22312 cases where the order of terms in a sum is changed by the default
22313 simplifications.)
22314
22315 The distributive law is used to simplify sums in some cases:
22316 @expr{a x + b x} to @expr{(a + b) x}, where @expr{a} represents
22317 a number or an implicit 1 or @mathit{-1} (as in @expr{x} or @expr{-x})
22318 and similarly for @expr{b}. Use the @kbd{a c}, @w{@kbd{a f}}, or
22319 @kbd{j M} commands to merge sums with non-numeric coefficients
22320 using the distributive law.
22321
22322 The distributive law is only used for sums of two terms, or
22323 for adjacent terms in a larger sum. Thus @expr{a + b + b + c}
22324 is simplified to @expr{a + 2 b + c}, but @expr{a + b + c + b}
22325 is not simplified. The reason is that comparing all terms of a
22326 sum with one another would require time proportional to the
22327 square of the number of terms; Calc relegates potentially slow
22328 operations like this to commands that have to be invoked
22329 explicitly, like @kbd{a s}.
22330
22331 Finally, @expr{a + 0} and @expr{0 + a} are simplified to @expr{a}.
22332 A consequence of the above rules is that @expr{0 - a} is simplified
22333 to @expr{-a}.
22334
22335 @tex
22336 \bigskip
22337 @end tex
22338
22339 The products @expr{1 a} and @expr{a 1} are simplified to @expr{a};
22340 @expr{(-1) a} and @expr{a (-1)} are simplified to @expr{-a};
22341 @expr{0 a} and @expr{a 0} are simplified to @expr{0}, except that
22342 in Matrix mode where @expr{a} is not provably scalar the result
22343 is the generic zero matrix @samp{idn(0)}, and that if @expr{a} is
22344 infinite the result is @samp{nan}.
22345
22346 Also, @expr{(-a) b} and @expr{a (-b)} are simplified to @expr{-(a b)},
22347 where this occurs for negated formulas but not for regular negative
22348 numbers.
22349
22350 Products are commuted only to move numbers to the front:
22351 @expr{a b 2} is commuted to @expr{2 a b}.
22352
22353 The product @expr{a (b + c)} is distributed over the sum only if
22354 @expr{a} and at least one of @expr{b} and @expr{c} are numbers:
22355 @expr{2 (x + 3)} goes to @expr{2 x + 6}. The formula
22356 @expr{(-a) (b - c)}, where @expr{-a} is a negative number, is
22357 rewritten to @expr{a (c - b)}.
22358
22359 The distributive law of products and powers is used for adjacent
22360 terms of the product: @expr{x^a x^b} goes to
22361 @texline @math{x^{a+b}}
22362 @infoline @expr{x^(a+b)}
22363 where @expr{a} is a number, or an implicit 1 (as in @expr{x}),
22364 or the implicit one-half of @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)}, and similarly for
22365 @expr{b}. The result is written using @samp{sqrt} or @samp{1/sqrt}
22366 if the sum of the powers is @expr{1/2} or @expr{-1/2}, respectively.
22367 If the sum of the powers is zero, the product is simplified to
22368 @expr{1} or to @samp{idn(1)} if Matrix mode is enabled.
22369
22370 The product of a negative power times anything but another negative
22371 power is changed to use division:
22372 @texline @math{x^{-2} y}
22373 @infoline @expr{x^(-2) y}
22374 goes to @expr{y / x^2} unless Matrix mode is
22375 in effect and neither @expr{x} nor @expr{y} are scalar (in which
22376 case it is considered unsafe to rearrange the order of the terms).
22377
22378 Finally, @expr{a (b/c)} is rewritten to @expr{(a b)/c}, and also
22379 @expr{(a/b) c} is changed to @expr{(a c)/b} unless in Matrix mode.
22380
22381 @tex
22382 \bigskip
22383 @end tex
22384
22385 Simplifications for quotients are analogous to those for products.
22386 The quotient @expr{0 / x} is simplified to @expr{0}, with the same
22387 exceptions that were noted for @expr{0 x}. Likewise, @expr{x / 1}
22388 and @expr{x / (-1)} are simplified to @expr{x} and @expr{-x},
22389 respectively.
22390
22391 The quotient @expr{x / 0} is left unsimplified or changed to an
22392 infinite quantity, as directed by the current infinite mode.
22393 @xref{Infinite Mode}.
22394
22395 The expression
22396 @texline @math{a / b^{-c}}
22397 @infoline @expr{a / b^(-c)}
22398 is changed to @expr{a b^c}, where @expr{-c} is any negative-looking
22399 power. Also, @expr{1 / b^c} is changed to
22400 @texline @math{b^{-c}}
22401 @infoline @expr{b^(-c)}
22402 for any power @expr{c}.
22403
22404 Also, @expr{(-a) / b} and @expr{a / (-b)} go to @expr{-(a/b)};
22405 @expr{(a/b) / c} goes to @expr{a / (b c)}; and @expr{a / (b/c)}
22406 goes to @expr{(a c) / b} unless Matrix mode prevents this
22407 rearrangement. Similarly, @expr{a / (b:c)} is simplified to
22408 @expr{(c:b) a} for any fraction @expr{b:c}.
22409
22410 The distributive law is applied to @expr{(a + b) / c} only if
22411 @expr{c} and at least one of @expr{a} and @expr{b} are numbers.
22412 Quotients of powers and square roots are distributed just as
22413 described for multiplication.
22414
22415 Quotients of products cancel only in the leading terms of the
22416 numerator and denominator. In other words, @expr{a x b / a y b}
22417 is cancelled to @expr{x b / y b} but not to @expr{x / y}. Once
22418 again this is because full cancellation can be slow; use @kbd{a s}
22419 to cancel all terms of the quotient.
22420
22421 Quotients of negative-looking values are simplified according
22422 to @expr{(-a) / (-b)} to @expr{a / b}, @expr{(-a) / (b - c)}
22423 to @expr{a / (c - b)}, and @expr{(a - b) / (-c)} to @expr{(b - a) / c}.
22424
22425 @tex
22426 \bigskip
22427 @end tex
22428
22429 The formula @expr{x^0} is simplified to @expr{1}, or to @samp{idn(1)}
22430 in Matrix mode. The formula @expr{0^x} is simplified to @expr{0}
22431 unless @expr{x} is a negative number, complex number or zero.
22432 If @expr{x} is negative, complex or @expr{0.0}, @expr{0^x} is an
22433 infinity or an unsimplified formula according to the current infinite
22434 mode. The expression @expr{0^0} is simplified to @expr{1}.
22435
22436 Powers of products or quotients @expr{(a b)^c}, @expr{(a/b)^c}
22437 are distributed to @expr{a^c b^c}, @expr{a^c / b^c} only if @expr{c}
22438 is an integer, or if either @expr{a} or @expr{b} are nonnegative
22439 real numbers. Powers of powers @expr{(a^b)^c} are simplified to
22440 @texline @math{a^{b c}}
22441 @infoline @expr{a^(b c)}
22442 only when @expr{c} is an integer and @expr{b c} also
22443 evaluates to an integer. Without these restrictions these simplifications
22444 would not be safe because of problems with principal values.
22445 (In other words,
22446 @texline @math{((-3)^{1/2})^2}
22447 @infoline @expr{((-3)^1:2)^2}
22448 is safe to simplify, but
22449 @texline @math{((-3)^2)^{1/2}}
22450 @infoline @expr{((-3)^2)^1:2}
22451 is not.) @xref{Declarations}, for ways to inform Calc that your
22452 variables satisfy these requirements.
22453
22454 As a special case of this rule, @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)^n} is simplified to
22455 @texline @math{x^{n/2}}
22456 @infoline @expr{x^(n/2)}
22457 only for even integers @expr{n}.
22458
22459 If @expr{a} is known to be real, @expr{b} is an even integer, and
22460 @expr{c} is a half- or quarter-integer, then @expr{(a^b)^c} is
22461 simplified to @expr{@tfn{abs}(a^(b c))}.
22462
22463 Also, @expr{(-a)^b} is simplified to @expr{a^b} if @expr{b} is an
22464 even integer, or to @expr{-(a^b)} if @expr{b} is an odd integer,
22465 for any negative-looking expression @expr{-a}.
22466
22467 Square roots @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)} generally act like one-half powers
22468 @texline @math{x^{1:2}}
22469 @infoline @expr{x^1:2}
22470 for the purposes of the above-listed simplifications.
22471
22472 Also, note that
22473 @texline @math{1 / x^{1:2}}
22474 @infoline @expr{1 / x^1:2}
22475 is changed to
22476 @texline @math{x^{-1:2}},
22477 @infoline @expr{x^(-1:2)},
22478 but @expr{1 / @tfn{sqrt}(x)} is left alone.
22479
22480 @tex
22481 \bigskip
22482 @end tex
22483
22484 Generic identity matrices (@pxref{Matrix Mode}) are simplified by the
22485 following rules: @expr{@tfn{idn}(a) + b} to @expr{a + b} if @expr{b}
22486 is provably scalar, or expanded out if @expr{b} is a matrix;
22487 @expr{@tfn{idn}(a) + @tfn{idn}(b)} to @expr{@tfn{idn}(a + b)};
22488 @expr{-@tfn{idn}(a)} to @expr{@tfn{idn}(-a)}; @expr{a @tfn{idn}(b)} to
22489 @expr{@tfn{idn}(a b)} if @expr{a} is provably scalar, or to @expr{a b}
22490 if @expr{a} is provably non-scalar; @expr{@tfn{idn}(a) @tfn{idn}(b)} to
22491 @expr{@tfn{idn}(a b)}; analogous simplifications for quotients involving
22492 @code{idn}; and @expr{@tfn{idn}(a)^n} to @expr{@tfn{idn}(a^n)} where
22493 @expr{n} is an integer.
22494
22495 @tex
22496 \bigskip
22497 @end tex
22498
22499 The @code{floor} function and other integer truncation functions
22500 vanish if the argument is provably integer-valued, so that
22501 @expr{@tfn{floor}(@tfn{round}(x))} simplifies to @expr{@tfn{round}(x)}.
22502 Also, combinations of @code{float}, @code{floor} and its friends,
22503 and @code{ffloor} and its friends, are simplified in appropriate
22504 ways. @xref{Integer Truncation}.
22505
22506 The expression @expr{@tfn{abs}(-x)} changes to @expr{@tfn{abs}(x)}.
22507 The expression @expr{@tfn{abs}(@tfn{abs}(x))} changes to
22508 @expr{@tfn{abs}(x)}; in fact, @expr{@tfn{abs}(x)} changes to @expr{x} or
22509 @expr{-x} if @expr{x} is provably nonnegative or nonpositive
22510 (@pxref{Declarations}).
22511
22512 While most functions do not recognize the variable @code{i} as an
22513 imaginary number, the @code{arg} function does handle the two cases
22514 @expr{@tfn{arg}(@tfn{i})} and @expr{@tfn{arg}(-@tfn{i})} just for convenience.
22515
22516 The expression @expr{@tfn{conj}(@tfn{conj}(x))} simplifies to @expr{x}.
22517 Various other expressions involving @code{conj}, @code{re}, and
22518 @code{im} are simplified, especially if some of the arguments are
22519 provably real or involve the constant @code{i}. For example,
22520 @expr{@tfn{conj}(a + b i)} is changed to
22521 @expr{@tfn{conj}(a) - @tfn{conj}(b) i}, or to @expr{a - b i} if @expr{a}
22522 and @expr{b} are known to be real.
22523
22524 Functions like @code{sin} and @code{arctan} generally don't have
22525 any default simplifications beyond simply evaluating the functions
22526 for suitable numeric arguments and infinity. The @kbd{a s} command
22527 described in the next section does provide some simplifications for
22528 these functions, though.
22529
22530 One important simplification that does occur is that
22531 @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{e})} is simplified to 1, and @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{e}^x)} is
22532 simplified to @expr{x} for any @expr{x}. This occurs even if you have
22533 stored a different value in the Calc variable @samp{e}; but this would
22534 be a bad idea in any case if you were also using natural logarithms!
22535
22536 Among the logical functions, @tfn{!(@var{a} <= @var{b})} changes to
22537 @tfn{@var{a} > @var{b}} and so on. Equations and inequalities where both sides
22538 are either negative-looking or zero are simplified by negating both sides
22539 and reversing the inequality. While it might seem reasonable to simplify
22540 @expr{!!x} to @expr{x}, this would not be valid in general because
22541 @expr{!!2} is 1, not 2.
22542
22543 Most other Calc functions have few if any default simplifications
22544 defined, aside of course from evaluation when the arguments are
22545 suitable numbers.
22546
22547 @node Algebraic Simplifications, Unsafe Simplifications, Default Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas
22548 @subsection Algebraic Simplifications
22549
22550 @noindent
22551 @cindex Algebraic simplifications
22552 The @kbd{a s} command makes simplifications that may be too slow to
22553 do all the time, or that may not be desirable all of the time.
22554 If you find these simplifications are worthwhile, you can type
22555 @kbd{m A} to have Calc apply them automatically.
22556
22557 This section describes all simplifications that are performed by
22558 the @kbd{a s} command. Note that these occur in addition to the
22559 default simplifications; even if the default simplifications have
22560 been turned off by an @kbd{m O} command, @kbd{a s} will turn them
22561 back on temporarily while it simplifies the formula.
22562
22563 There is a variable, @code{AlgSimpRules}, in which you can put rewrites
22564 to be applied by @kbd{a s}. Its use is analogous to @code{EvalRules},
22565 but without the special restrictions. Basically, the simplifier does
22566 @samp{@w{a r} AlgSimpRules} with an infinite repeat count on the whole
22567 expression being simplified, then it traverses the expression applying
22568 the built-in rules described below. If the result is different from
22569 the original expression, the process repeats with the default
22570 simplifications (including @code{EvalRules}), then @code{AlgSimpRules},
22571 then the built-in simplifications, and so on.
22572
22573 @tex
22574 \bigskip
22575 @end tex
22576
22577 Sums are simplified in two ways. Constant terms are commuted to the
22578 end of the sum, so that @expr{a + 2 + b} changes to @expr{a + b + 2}.
22579 The only exception is that a constant will not be commuted away
22580 from the first position of a difference, i.e., @expr{2 - x} is not
22581 commuted to @expr{-x + 2}.
22582
22583 Also, terms of sums are combined by the distributive law, as in
22584 @expr{x + y + 2 x} to @expr{y + 3 x}. This always occurs for
22585 adjacent terms, but @kbd{a s} compares all pairs of terms including
22586 non-adjacent ones.
22587
22588 @tex
22589 \bigskip
22590 @end tex
22591
22592 Products are sorted into a canonical order using the commutative
22593 law. For example, @expr{b c a} is commuted to @expr{a b c}.
22594 This allows easier comparison of products; for example, the default
22595 simplifications will not change @expr{x y + y x} to @expr{2 x y},
22596 but @kbd{a s} will; it first rewrites the sum to @expr{x y + x y},
22597 and then the default simplifications are able to recognize a sum
22598 of identical terms.
22599
22600 The canonical ordering used to sort terms of products has the
22601 property that real-valued numbers, interval forms and infinities
22602 come first, and are sorted into increasing order. The @kbd{V S}
22603 command uses the same ordering when sorting a vector.
22604
22605 Sorting of terms of products is inhibited when Matrix mode is
22606 turned on; in this case, Calc will never exchange the order of
22607 two terms unless it knows at least one of the terms is a scalar.
22608
22609 Products of powers are distributed by comparing all pairs of
22610 terms, using the same method that the default simplifications
22611 use for adjacent terms of products.
22612
22613 Even though sums are not sorted, the commutative law is still
22614 taken into account when terms of a product are being compared.
22615 Thus @expr{(x + y) (y + x)} will be simplified to @expr{(x + y)^2}.
22616 A subtle point is that @expr{(x - y) (y - x)} will @emph{not}
22617 be simplified to @expr{-(x - y)^2}; Calc does not notice that
22618 one term can be written as a constant times the other, even if
22619 that constant is @mathit{-1}.
22620
22621 A fraction times any expression, @expr{(a:b) x}, is changed to
22622 a quotient involving integers: @expr{a x / b}. This is not
22623 done for floating-point numbers like @expr{0.5}, however. This
22624 is one reason why you may find it convenient to turn Fraction mode
22625 on while doing algebra; @pxref{Fraction Mode}.
22626
22627 @tex
22628 \bigskip
22629 @end tex
22630
22631 Quotients are simplified by comparing all terms in the numerator
22632 with all terms in the denominator for possible cancellation using
22633 the distributive law. For example, @expr{a x^2 b / c x^3 d} will
22634 cancel @expr{x^2} from the top and bottom to get @expr{a b / c x d}.
22635 (The terms in the denominator will then be rearranged to @expr{c d x}
22636 as described above.) If there is any common integer or fractional
22637 factor in the numerator and denominator, it is cancelled out;
22638 for example, @expr{(4 x + 6) / 8 x} simplifies to @expr{(2 x + 3) / 4 x}.
22639
22640 Non-constant common factors are not found even by @kbd{a s}. To
22641 cancel the factor @expr{a} in @expr{(a x + a) / a^2} you could first
22642 use @kbd{j M} on the product @expr{a x} to Merge the numerator to
22643 @expr{a (1+x)}, which can then be simplified successfully.
22644
22645 @tex
22646 \bigskip
22647 @end tex
22648
22649 Integer powers of the variable @code{i} are simplified according
22650 to the identity @expr{i^2 = -1}. If you store a new value other
22651 than the complex number @expr{(0,1)} in @code{i}, this simplification
22652 will no longer occur. This is done by @kbd{a s} instead of by default
22653 in case someone (unwisely) uses the name @code{i} for a variable
22654 unrelated to complex numbers; it would be unfortunate if Calc
22655 quietly and automatically changed this formula for reasons the
22656 user might not have been thinking of.
22657
22658 Square roots of integer or rational arguments are simplified in
22659 several ways. (Note that these will be left unevaluated only in
22660 Symbolic mode.) First, square integer or rational factors are
22661 pulled out so that @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(8)} is rewritten as
22662 @texline @math{2\,@tfn{sqrt}(2)}.
22663 @infoline @expr{2 sqrt(2)}.
22664 Conceptually speaking this implies factoring the argument into primes
22665 and moving pairs of primes out of the square root, but for reasons of
22666 efficiency Calc only looks for primes up to 29.
22667
22668 Square roots in the denominator of a quotient are moved to the
22669 numerator: @expr{1 / @tfn{sqrt}(3)} changes to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(3) / 3}.
22670 The same effect occurs for the square root of a fraction:
22671 @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(2:3)} changes to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(6) / 3}.
22672
22673 @tex
22674 \bigskip
22675 @end tex
22676
22677 The @code{%} (modulo) operator is simplified in several ways
22678 when the modulus @expr{M} is a positive real number. First, if
22679 the argument is of the form @expr{x + n} for some real number
22680 @expr{n}, then @expr{n} is itself reduced modulo @expr{M}. For
22681 example, @samp{(x - 23) % 10} is simplified to @samp{(x + 7) % 10}.
22682
22683 If the argument is multiplied by a constant, and this constant
22684 has a common integer divisor with the modulus, then this factor is
22685 cancelled out. For example, @samp{12 x % 15} is changed to
22686 @samp{3 (4 x % 5)} by factoring out 3. Also, @samp{(12 x + 1) % 15}
22687 is changed to @samp{3 ((4 x + 1:3) % 5)}. While these forms may
22688 not seem ``simpler,'' they allow Calc to discover useful information
22689 about modulo forms in the presence of declarations.
22690
22691 If the modulus is 1, then Calc can use @code{int} declarations to
22692 evaluate the expression. For example, the idiom @samp{x % 2} is
22693 often used to check whether a number is odd or even. As described
22694 above, @w{@samp{2 n % 2}} and @samp{(2 n + 1) % 2} are simplified to
22695 @samp{2 (n % 1)} and @samp{2 ((n + 1:2) % 1)}, respectively; Calc
22696 can simplify these to 0 and 1 (respectively) if @code{n} has been
22697 declared to be an integer.
22698
22699 @tex
22700 \bigskip
22701 @end tex
22702
22703 Trigonometric functions are simplified in several ways. Whenever a
22704 products of two trigonometric functions can be replaced by a single
22705 function, the replacement is made; for example,
22706 @expr{@tfn{tan}(x) @tfn{cos}(x)} is simplified to @expr{@tfn{sin}(x)}.
22707 Reciprocals of trigonometric functions are replaced by their reciprocal
22708 function; for example, @expr{1/@tfn{sec}(x)} is simplified to
22709 @expr{@tfn{cos}(x)}. The corresponding simplifications for the
22710 hyperbolic functions are also handled.
22711
22712 Trigonometric functions of their inverse functions are
22713 simplified. The expression @expr{@tfn{sin}(@tfn{arcsin}(x))} is
22714 simplified to @expr{x}, and similarly for @code{cos} and @code{tan}.
22715 Trigonometric functions of inverses of different trigonometric
22716 functions can also be simplified, as in @expr{@tfn{sin}(@tfn{arccos}(x))}
22717 to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(1 - x^2)}.
22718
22719 If the argument to @code{sin} is negative-looking, it is simplified to
22720 @expr{-@tfn{sin}(x)}, and similarly for @code{cos} and @code{tan}.
22721 Finally, certain special values of the argument are recognized;
22722 @pxref{Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions}.
22723
22724 Hyperbolic functions of their inverses and of negative-looking
22725 arguments are also handled, as are exponentials of inverse
22726 hyperbolic functions.
22727
22728 No simplifications for inverse trigonometric and hyperbolic
22729 functions are known, except for negative arguments of @code{arcsin},
22730 @code{arctan}, @code{arcsinh}, and @code{arctanh}. Note that
22731 @expr{@tfn{arcsin}(@tfn{sin}(x))} can @emph{not} safely change to
22732 @expr{x}, since this only correct within an integer multiple of
22733 @texline @math{2 \pi}
22734 @infoline @expr{2 pi}
22735 radians or 360 degrees. However, @expr{@tfn{arcsinh}(@tfn{sinh}(x))} is
22736 simplified to @expr{x} if @expr{x} is known to be real.
22737
22738 Several simplifications that apply to logarithms and exponentials
22739 are that @expr{@tfn{exp}(@tfn{ln}(x))},
22740 @texline @tfn{e}@math{^{\ln(x)}},
22741 @infoline @expr{e^@tfn{ln}(x)},
22742 and
22743 @texline @math{10^{{\rm log10}(x)}}
22744 @infoline @expr{10^@tfn{log10}(x)}
22745 all reduce to @expr{x}. Also, @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{exp}(x))}, etc., can
22746 reduce to @expr{x} if @expr{x} is provably real. The form
22747 @expr{@tfn{exp}(x)^y} is simplified to @expr{@tfn{exp}(x y)}. If @expr{x}
22748 is a suitable multiple of
22749 @texline @math{\pi i}
22750 @infoline @expr{pi i}
22751 (as described above for the trigonometric functions), then
22752 @expr{@tfn{exp}(x)} or @expr{e^x} will be expanded. Finally,
22753 @expr{@tfn{ln}(x)} is simplified to a form involving @code{pi} and
22754 @code{i} where @expr{x} is provably negative, positive imaginary, or
22755 negative imaginary.
22756
22757 The error functions @code{erf} and @code{erfc} are simplified when
22758 their arguments are negative-looking or are calls to the @code{conj}
22759 function.
22760
22761 @tex
22762 \bigskip
22763 @end tex
22764
22765 Equations and inequalities are simplified by cancelling factors
22766 of products, quotients, or sums on both sides. Inequalities
22767 change sign if a negative multiplicative factor is cancelled.
22768 Non-constant multiplicative factors as in @expr{a b = a c} are
22769 cancelled from equations only if they are provably nonzero (generally
22770 because they were declared so; @pxref{Declarations}). Factors
22771 are cancelled from inequalities only if they are nonzero and their
22772 sign is known.
22773
22774 Simplification also replaces an equation or inequality with
22775 1 or 0 (``true'' or ``false'') if it can through the use of
22776 declarations. If @expr{x} is declared to be an integer greater
22777 than 5, then @expr{x < 3}, @expr{x = 3}, and @expr{x = 7.5} are
22778 all simplified to 0, but @expr{x > 3} is simplified to 1.
22779 By a similar analysis, @expr{abs(x) >= 0} is simplified to 1,
22780 as is @expr{x^2 >= 0} if @expr{x} is known to be real.
22781
22782 @node Unsafe Simplifications, Simplification of Units, Algebraic Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas
22783 @subsection ``Unsafe'' Simplifications
22784
22785 @noindent
22786 @cindex Unsafe simplifications
22787 @cindex Extended simplification
22788 @kindex a e
22789 @pindex calc-simplify-extended
22790 @ignore
22791 @mindex esimpl@idots
22792 @end ignore
22793 @tindex esimplify
22794 The @kbd{a e} (@code{calc-simplify-extended}) [@code{esimplify}] command
22795 is like @kbd{a s}
22796 except that it applies some additional simplifications which are not
22797 ``safe'' in all cases. Use this only if you know the values in your
22798 formula lie in the restricted ranges for which these simplifications
22799 are valid. The symbolic integrator uses @kbd{a e};
22800 one effect of this is that the integrator's results must be used with
22801 caution. Where an integral table will often attach conditions like
22802 ``for positive @expr{a} only,'' Calc (like most other symbolic
22803 integration programs) will simply produce an unqualified result.
22804
22805 Because @kbd{a e}'s simplifications are unsafe, it is sometimes better
22806 to type @kbd{C-u -3 a v}, which does extended simplification only
22807 on the top level of the formula without affecting the sub-formulas.
22808 In fact, @kbd{C-u -3 j v} allows you to target extended simplification
22809 to any specific part of a formula.
22810
22811 The variable @code{ExtSimpRules} contains rewrites to be applied by
22812 the @kbd{a e} command. These are applied in addition to
22813 @code{EvalRules} and @code{AlgSimpRules}. (The @kbd{a r AlgSimpRules}
22814 step described above is simply followed by an @kbd{a r ExtSimpRules} step.)
22815
22816 Following is a complete list of ``unsafe'' simplifications performed
22817 by @kbd{a e}.
22818
22819 @tex
22820 \bigskip
22821 @end tex
22822
22823 Inverse trigonometric or hyperbolic functions, called with their
22824 corresponding non-inverse functions as arguments, are simplified
22825 by @kbd{a e}. For example, @expr{@tfn{arcsin}(@tfn{sin}(x))} changes
22826 to @expr{x}. Also, @expr{@tfn{arcsin}(@tfn{cos}(x))} and
22827 @expr{@tfn{arccos}(@tfn{sin}(x))} both change to @expr{@tfn{pi}/2 - x}.
22828 These simplifications are unsafe because they are valid only for
22829 values of @expr{x} in a certain range; outside that range, values
22830 are folded down to the 360-degree range that the inverse trigonometric
22831 functions always produce.
22832
22833 Powers of powers @expr{(x^a)^b} are simplified to
22834 @texline @math{x^{a b}}
22835 @infoline @expr{x^(a b)}
22836 for all @expr{a} and @expr{b}. These results will be valid only
22837 in a restricted range of @expr{x}; for example, in
22838 @texline @math{(x^2)^{1:2}}
22839 @infoline @expr{(x^2)^1:2}
22840 the powers cancel to get @expr{x}, which is valid for positive values
22841 of @expr{x} but not for negative or complex values.
22842
22843 Similarly, @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x^a)} and @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)^a} are both
22844 simplified (possibly unsafely) to
22845 @texline @math{x^{a/2}}.
22846 @infoline @expr{x^(a/2)}.
22847
22848 Forms like @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(1 - sin(x)^2)} are simplified to, e.g.,
22849 @expr{@tfn{cos}(x)}. Calc has identities of this sort for @code{sin},
22850 @code{cos}, @code{tan}, @code{sinh}, and @code{cosh}.
22851
22852 Arguments of square roots are partially factored to look for
22853 squared terms that can be extracted. For example,
22854 @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(a^2 b^3 + a^3 b^2)} simplifies to
22855 @expr{a b @tfn{sqrt}(a+b)}.
22856
22857 The simplifications of @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{exp}(x))},
22858 @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{e}^x)}, and @expr{@tfn{log10}(10^x)} to @expr{x} are also
22859 unsafe because of problems with principal values (although these
22860 simplifications are safe if @expr{x} is known to be real).
22861
22862 Common factors are cancelled from products on both sides of an
22863 equation, even if those factors may be zero: @expr{a x / b x}
22864 to @expr{a / b}. Such factors are never cancelled from
22865 inequalities: Even @kbd{a e} is not bold enough to reduce
22866 @expr{a x < b x} to @expr{a < b} (or @expr{a > b}, depending
22867 on whether you believe @expr{x} is positive or negative).
22868 The @kbd{a M /} command can be used to divide a factor out of
22869 both sides of an inequality.
22870
22871 @node Simplification of Units, , Unsafe Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas
22872 @subsection Simplification of Units
22873
22874 @noindent
22875 The simplifications described in this section are applied by the
22876 @kbd{u s} (@code{calc-simplify-units}) command. These are in addition
22877 to the regular @kbd{a s} (but not @kbd{a e}) simplifications described
22878 earlier. @xref{Basic Operations on Units}.
22879
22880 The variable @code{UnitSimpRules} contains rewrites to be applied by
22881 the @kbd{u s} command. These are applied in addition to @code{EvalRules}
22882 and @code{AlgSimpRules}.
22883
22884 Scalar mode is automatically put into effect when simplifying units.
22885 @xref{Matrix Mode}.
22886
22887 Sums @expr{a + b} involving units are simplified by extracting the
22888 units of @expr{a} as if by the @kbd{u x} command (call the result
22889 @expr{u_a}), then simplifying the expression @expr{b / u_a}
22890 using @kbd{u b} and @kbd{u s}. If the result has units then the sum
22891 is inconsistent and is left alone. Otherwise, it is rewritten
22892 in terms of the units @expr{u_a}.
22893
22894 If units auto-ranging mode is enabled, products or quotients in
22895 which the first argument is a number which is out of range for the
22896 leading unit are modified accordingly.
22897
22898 When cancelling and combining units in products and quotients,
22899 Calc accounts for unit names that differ only in the prefix letter.
22900 For example, @samp{2 km m} is simplified to @samp{2000 m^2}.
22901 However, compatible but different units like @code{ft} and @code{in}
22902 are not combined in this way.
22903
22904 Quotients @expr{a / b} are simplified in three additional ways. First,
22905 if @expr{b} is a number or a product beginning with a number, Calc
22906 computes the reciprocal of this number and moves it to the numerator.
22907
22908 Second, for each pair of unit names from the numerator and denominator
22909 of a quotient, if the units are compatible (e.g., they are both
22910 units of area) then they are replaced by the ratio between those
22911 units. For example, in @samp{3 s in N / kg cm} the units
22912 @samp{in / cm} will be replaced by @expr{2.54}.
22913
22914 Third, if the units in the quotient exactly cancel out, so that
22915 a @kbd{u b} command on the quotient would produce a dimensionless
22916 number for an answer, then the quotient simplifies to that number.
22917
22918 For powers and square roots, the ``unsafe'' simplifications
22919 @expr{(a b)^c} to @expr{a^c b^c}, @expr{(a/b)^c} to @expr{a^c / b^c},
22920 and @expr{(a^b)^c} to
22921 @texline @math{a^{b c}}
22922 @infoline @expr{a^(b c)}
22923 are done if the powers are real numbers. (These are safe in the context
22924 of units because all numbers involved can reasonably be assumed to be
22925 real.)
22926
22927 Also, if a unit name is raised to a fractional power, and the
22928 base units in that unit name all occur to powers which are a
22929 multiple of the denominator of the power, then the unit name
22930 is expanded out into its base units, which can then be simplified
22931 according to the previous paragraph. For example, @samp{acre^1.5}
22932 is simplified by noting that @expr{1.5 = 3:2}, that @samp{acre}
22933 is defined in terms of @samp{m^2}, and that the 2 in the power of
22934 @code{m} is a multiple of 2 in @expr{3:2}. Thus, @code{acre^1.5} is
22935 replaced by approximately
22936 @texline @math{(4046 m^2)^{1.5}}
22937 @infoline @expr{(4046 m^2)^1.5},
22938 which is then changed to
22939 @texline @math{4046^{1.5} \, (m^2)^{1.5}},
22940 @infoline @expr{4046^1.5 (m^2)^1.5},
22941 then to @expr{257440 m^3}.
22942
22943 The functions @code{float}, @code{frac}, @code{clean}, @code{abs},
22944 as well as @code{floor} and the other integer truncation functions,
22945 applied to unit names or products or quotients involving units, are
22946 simplified. For example, @samp{round(1.6 in)} is changed to
22947 @samp{round(1.6) round(in)}; the lefthand term evaluates to 2,
22948 and the righthand term simplifies to @code{in}.
22949
22950 The functions @code{sin}, @code{cos}, and @code{tan} with arguments
22951 that have angular units like @code{rad} or @code{arcmin} are
22952 simplified by converting to base units (radians), then evaluating
22953 with the angular mode temporarily set to radians.
22954
22955 @node Polynomials, Calculus, Simplifying Formulas, Algebra
22956 @section Polynomials
22957
22958 A @dfn{polynomial} is a sum of terms which are coefficients times
22959 various powers of a ``base'' variable. For example, @expr{2 x^2 + 3 x - 4}
22960 is a polynomial in @expr{x}. Some formulas can be considered
22961 polynomials in several different variables: @expr{1 + 2 x + 3 y + 4 x y^2}
22962 is a polynomial in both @expr{x} and @expr{y}. Polynomial coefficients
22963 are often numbers, but they may in general be any formulas not
22964 involving the base variable.
22965
22966 @kindex a f
22967 @pindex calc-factor
22968 @tindex factor
22969 The @kbd{a f} (@code{calc-factor}) [@code{factor}] command factors a
22970 polynomial into a product of terms. For example, the polynomial
22971 @expr{x^3 + 2 x^2 + x} is factored into @samp{x*(x+1)^2}. As another
22972 example, @expr{a c + b d + b c + a d} is factored into the product
22973 @expr{(a + b) (c + d)}.
22974
22975 Calc currently has three algorithms for factoring. Formulas which are
22976 linear in several variables, such as the second example above, are
22977 merged according to the distributive law. Formulas which are
22978 polynomials in a single variable, with constant integer or fractional
22979 coefficients, are factored into irreducible linear and/or quadratic
22980 terms. The first example above factors into three linear terms
22981 (@expr{x}, @expr{x+1}, and @expr{x+1} again). Finally, formulas
22982 which do not fit the above criteria are handled by the algebraic
22983 rewrite mechanism.
22984
22985 Calc's polynomial factorization algorithm works by using the general
22986 root-finding command (@w{@kbd{a P}}) to solve for the roots of the
22987 polynomial. It then looks for roots which are rational numbers
22988 or complex-conjugate pairs, and converts these into linear and
22989 quadratic terms, respectively. Because it uses floating-point
22990 arithmetic, it may be unable to find terms that involve large
22991 integers (whose number of digits approaches the current precision).
22992 Also, irreducible factors of degree higher than quadratic are not
22993 found, and polynomials in more than one variable are not treated.
22994 (A more robust factorization algorithm may be included in a future
22995 version of Calc.)
22996
22997 @vindex FactorRules
22998 @ignore
22999 @starindex
23000 @end ignore
23001 @tindex thecoefs
23002 @ignore
23003 @starindex
23004 @end ignore
23005 @ignore
23006 @mindex @idots
23007 @end ignore
23008 @tindex thefactors
23009 The rewrite-based factorization method uses rules stored in the variable
23010 @code{FactorRules}. @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for a discussion of the
23011 operation of rewrite rules. The default @code{FactorRules} are able
23012 to factor quadratic forms symbolically into two linear terms,
23013 @expr{(a x + b) (c x + d)}. You can edit these rules to include other
23014 cases if you wish. To use the rules, Calc builds the formula
23015 @samp{thecoefs(x, [a, b, c, ...])} where @code{x} is the polynomial
23016 base variable and @code{a}, @code{b}, etc., are polynomial coefficients
23017 (which may be numbers or formulas). The constant term is written first,
23018 i.e., in the @code{a} position. When the rules complete, they should have
23019 changed the formula into the form @samp{thefactors(x, [f1, f2, f3, ...])}
23020 where each @code{fi} should be a factored term, e.g., @samp{x - ai}.
23021 Calc then multiplies these terms together to get the complete
23022 factored form of the polynomial. If the rules do not change the
23023 @code{thecoefs} call to a @code{thefactors} call, @kbd{a f} leaves the
23024 polynomial alone on the assumption that it is unfactorable. (Note that
23025 the function names @code{thecoefs} and @code{thefactors} are used only
23026 as placeholders; there are no actual Calc functions by those names.)
23027
23028 @kindex H a f
23029 @tindex factors
23030 The @kbd{H a f} [@code{factors}] command also factors a polynomial,
23031 but it returns a list of factors instead of an expression which is the
23032 product of the factors. Each factor is represented by a sub-vector
23033 of the factor, and the power with which it appears. For example,
23034 @expr{x^5 + x^4 - 33 x^3 + 63 x^2} factors to @expr{(x + 7) x^2 (x - 3)^2}
23035 in @kbd{a f}, or to @expr{[ [x, 2], [x+7, 1], [x-3, 2] ]} in @kbd{H a f}.
23036 If there is an overall numeric factor, it always comes first in the list.
23037 The functions @code{factor} and @code{factors} allow a second argument
23038 when written in algebraic form; @samp{factor(x,v)} factors @expr{x} with
23039 respect to the specific variable @expr{v}. The default is to factor with
23040 respect to all the variables that appear in @expr{x}.
23041
23042 @kindex a c
23043 @pindex calc-collect
23044 @tindex collect
23045 The @kbd{a c} (@code{calc-collect}) [@code{collect}] command rearranges a
23046 formula as a
23047 polynomial in a given variable, ordered in decreasing powers of that
23048 variable. For example, given @expr{1 + 2 x + 3 y + 4 x y^2} on
23049 the stack, @kbd{a c x} would produce @expr{(2 + 4 y^2) x + (1 + 3 y)},
23050 and @kbd{a c y} would produce @expr{(4 x) y^2 + 3 y + (1 + 2 x)}.
23051 The polynomial will be expanded out using the distributive law as
23052 necessary: Collecting @expr{x} in @expr{(x - 1)^3} produces
23053 @expr{x^3 - 3 x^2 + 3 x - 1}. Terms not involving @expr{x} will
23054 not be expanded.
23055
23056 The ``variable'' you specify at the prompt can actually be any
23057 expression: @kbd{a c ln(x+1)} will collect together all terms multiplied
23058 by @samp{ln(x+1)} or integer powers thereof. If @samp{x} also appears
23059 in the formula in a context other than @samp{ln(x+1)}, @kbd{a c} will
23060 treat those occurrences as unrelated to @samp{ln(x+1)}, i.e., as constants.
23061
23062 @kindex a x
23063 @pindex calc-expand
23064 @tindex expand
23065 The @kbd{a x} (@code{calc-expand}) [@code{expand}] command expands an
23066 expression by applying the distributive law everywhere. It applies to
23067 products, quotients, and powers involving sums. By default, it fully
23068 distributes all parts of the expression. With a numeric prefix argument,
23069 the distributive law is applied only the specified number of times, then
23070 the partially expanded expression is left on the stack.
23071
23072 The @kbd{a x} and @kbd{j D} commands are somewhat redundant. Use
23073 @kbd{a x} if you want to expand all products of sums in your formula.
23074 Use @kbd{j D} if you want to expand a particular specified term of
23075 the formula. There is an exactly analogous correspondence between
23076 @kbd{a f} and @kbd{j M}. (The @kbd{j D} and @kbd{j M} commands
23077 also know many other kinds of expansions, such as
23078 @samp{exp(a + b) = exp(a) exp(b)}, which @kbd{a x} and @kbd{a f}
23079 do not do.)
23080
23081 Calc's automatic simplifications will sometimes reverse a partial
23082 expansion. For example, the first step in expanding @expr{(x+1)^3} is
23083 to write @expr{(x+1) (x+1)^2}. If @kbd{a x} stops there and tries
23084 to put this formula onto the stack, though, Calc will automatically
23085 simplify it back to @expr{(x+1)^3} form. The solution is to turn
23086 simplification off first (@pxref{Simplification Modes}), or to run
23087 @kbd{a x} without a numeric prefix argument so that it expands all
23088 the way in one step.
23089
23090 @kindex a a
23091 @pindex calc-apart
23092 @tindex apart
23093 The @kbd{a a} (@code{calc-apart}) [@code{apart}] command expands a
23094 rational function by partial fractions. A rational function is the
23095 quotient of two polynomials; @code{apart} pulls this apart into a
23096 sum of rational functions with simple denominators. In algebraic
23097 notation, the @code{apart} function allows a second argument that
23098 specifies which variable to use as the ``base''; by default, Calc
23099 chooses the base variable automatically.
23100
23101 @kindex a n
23102 @pindex calc-normalize-rat
23103 @tindex nrat
23104 The @kbd{a n} (@code{calc-normalize-rat}) [@code{nrat}] command
23105 attempts to arrange a formula into a quotient of two polynomials.
23106 For example, given @expr{1 + (a + b/c) / d}, the result would be
23107 @expr{(b + a c + c d) / c d}. The quotient is reduced, so that
23108 @kbd{a n} will simplify @expr{(x^2 + 2x + 1) / (x^2 - 1)} by dividing
23109 out the common factor @expr{x + 1}, yielding @expr{(x + 1) / (x - 1)}.
23110
23111 @kindex a \
23112 @pindex calc-poly-div
23113 @tindex pdiv
23114 The @kbd{a \} (@code{calc-poly-div}) [@code{pdiv}] command divides
23115 two polynomials @expr{u} and @expr{v}, yielding a new polynomial
23116 @expr{q}. If several variables occur in the inputs, the inputs are
23117 considered multivariate polynomials. (Calc divides by the variable
23118 with the largest power in @expr{u} first, or, in the case of equal
23119 powers, chooses the variables in alphabetical order.) For example,
23120 dividing @expr{x^2 + 3 x + 2} by @expr{x + 2} yields @expr{x + 1}.
23121 The remainder from the division, if any, is reported at the bottom
23122 of the screen and is also placed in the Trail along with the quotient.
23123
23124 Using @code{pdiv} in algebraic notation, you can specify the particular
23125 variable to be used as the base: @code{pdiv(@var{a},@var{b},@var{x})}.
23126 If @code{pdiv} is given only two arguments (as is always the case with
23127 the @kbd{a \} command), then it does a multivariate division as outlined
23128 above.
23129
23130 @kindex a %
23131 @pindex calc-poly-rem
23132 @tindex prem
23133 The @kbd{a %} (@code{calc-poly-rem}) [@code{prem}] command divides
23134 two polynomials and keeps the remainder @expr{r}. The quotient
23135 @expr{q} is discarded. For any formulas @expr{a} and @expr{b}, the
23136 results of @kbd{a \} and @kbd{a %} satisfy @expr{a = q b + r}.
23137 (This is analogous to plain @kbd{\} and @kbd{%}, which compute the
23138 integer quotient and remainder from dividing two numbers.)
23139
23140 @kindex a /
23141 @kindex H a /
23142 @pindex calc-poly-div-rem
23143 @tindex pdivrem
23144 @tindex pdivide
23145 The @kbd{a /} (@code{calc-poly-div-rem}) [@code{pdivrem}] command
23146 divides two polynomials and reports both the quotient and the
23147 remainder as a vector @expr{[q, r]}. The @kbd{H a /} [@code{pdivide}]
23148 command divides two polynomials and constructs the formula
23149 @expr{q + r/b} on the stack. (Naturally if the remainder is zero,
23150 this will immediately simplify to @expr{q}.)
23151
23152 @kindex a g
23153 @pindex calc-poly-gcd
23154 @tindex pgcd
23155 The @kbd{a g} (@code{calc-poly-gcd}) [@code{pgcd}] command computes
23156 the greatest common divisor of two polynomials. (The GCD actually
23157 is unique only to within a constant multiplier; Calc attempts to
23158 choose a GCD which will be unsurprising.) For example, the @kbd{a n}
23159 command uses @kbd{a g} to take the GCD of the numerator and denominator
23160 of a quotient, then divides each by the result using @kbd{a \}. (The
23161 definition of GCD ensures that this division can take place without
23162 leaving a remainder.)
23163
23164 While the polynomials used in operations like @kbd{a /} and @kbd{a g}
23165 often have integer coefficients, this is not required. Calc can also
23166 deal with polynomials over the rationals or floating-point reals.
23167 Polynomials with modulo-form coefficients are also useful in many
23168 applications; if you enter @samp{(x^2 + 3 x - 1) mod 5}, Calc
23169 automatically transforms this into a polynomial over the field of
23170 integers mod 5: @samp{(1 mod 5) x^2 + (3 mod 5) x + (4 mod 5)}.
23171
23172 Congratulations and thanks go to Ove Ewerlid
23173 (@code{ewerlid@@mizar.DoCS.UU.SE}), who contributed many of the
23174 polynomial routines used in the above commands.
23175
23176 @xref{Decomposing Polynomials}, for several useful functions for
23177 extracting the individual coefficients of a polynomial.
23178
23179 @node Calculus, Solving Equations, Polynomials, Algebra
23180 @section Calculus
23181
23182 @noindent
23183 The following calculus commands do not automatically simplify their
23184 inputs or outputs using @code{calc-simplify}. You may find it helps
23185 to do this by hand by typing @kbd{a s} or @kbd{a e}. It may also help
23186 to use @kbd{a x} and/or @kbd{a c} to arrange a result in the most
23187 readable way.
23188
23189 @menu
23190 * Differentiation::
23191 * Integration::
23192 * Customizing the Integrator::
23193 * Numerical Integration::
23194 * Taylor Series::
23195 @end menu
23196
23197 @node Differentiation, Integration, Calculus, Calculus
23198 @subsection Differentiation
23199
23200 @noindent
23201 @kindex a d
23202 @kindex H a d
23203 @pindex calc-derivative
23204 @tindex deriv
23205 @tindex tderiv
23206 The @kbd{a d} (@code{calc-derivative}) [@code{deriv}] command computes
23207 the derivative of the expression on the top of the stack with respect to
23208 some variable, which it will prompt you to enter. Normally, variables
23209 in the formula other than the specified differentiation variable are
23210 considered constant, i.e., @samp{deriv(y,x)} is reduced to zero. With
23211 the Hyperbolic flag, the @code{tderiv} (total derivative) operation is used
23212 instead, in which derivatives of variables are not reduced to zero
23213 unless those variables are known to be ``constant,'' i.e., independent
23214 of any other variables. (The built-in special variables like @code{pi}
23215 are considered constant, as are variables that have been declared
23216 @code{const}; @pxref{Declarations}.)
23217
23218 With a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, this command computes the
23219 @var{n}th derivative.
23220
23221 When working with trigonometric functions, it is best to switch to
23222 Radians mode first (with @w{@kbd{m r}}). The derivative of @samp{sin(x)}
23223 in degrees is @samp{(pi/180) cos(x)}, probably not the expected
23224 answer!
23225
23226 If you use the @code{deriv} function directly in an algebraic formula,
23227 you can write @samp{deriv(f,x,x0)} which represents the derivative
23228 of @expr{f} with respect to @expr{x}, evaluated at the point
23229 @texline @math{x=x_0}.
23230 @infoline @expr{x=x0}.
23231
23232 If the formula being differentiated contains functions which Calc does
23233 not know, the derivatives of those functions are produced by adding
23234 primes (apostrophe characters). For example, @samp{deriv(f(2x), x)}
23235 produces @samp{2 f'(2 x)}, where the function @code{f'} represents the
23236 derivative of @code{f}.
23237
23238 For functions you have defined with the @kbd{Z F} command, Calc expands
23239 the functions according to their defining formulas unless you have
23240 also defined @code{f'} suitably. For example, suppose we define
23241 @samp{sinc(x) = sin(x)/x} using @kbd{Z F}. If we then differentiate
23242 the formula @samp{sinc(2 x)}, the formula will be expanded to
23243 @samp{sin(2 x) / (2 x)} and differentiated. However, if we also
23244 define @samp{sinc'(x) = dsinc(x)}, say, then Calc will write the
23245 result as @samp{2 dsinc(2 x)}. @xref{Algebraic Definitions}.
23246
23247 For multi-argument functions @samp{f(x,y,z)}, the derivative with respect
23248 to the first argument is written @samp{f'(x,y,z)}; derivatives with
23249 respect to the other arguments are @samp{f'2(x,y,z)} and @samp{f'3(x,y,z)}.
23250 Various higher-order derivatives can be formed in the obvious way, e.g.,
23251 @samp{f'@var{}'(x)} (the second derivative of @code{f}) or
23252 @samp{f'@var{}'2'3(x,y,z)} (@code{f} differentiated with respect to each
23253 argument once).
23254
23255 @node Integration, Customizing the Integrator, Differentiation, Calculus
23256 @subsection Integration
23257
23258 @noindent
23259 @kindex a i
23260 @pindex calc-integral
23261 @tindex integ
23262 The @kbd{a i} (@code{calc-integral}) [@code{integ}] command computes the
23263 indefinite integral of the expression on the top of the stack with
23264 respect to a prompted-for variable. The integrator is not guaranteed to
23265 work for all integrable functions, but it is able to integrate several
23266 large classes of formulas. In particular, any polynomial or rational
23267 function (a polynomial divided by a polynomial) is acceptable.
23268 (Rational functions don't have to be in explicit quotient form, however;
23269 @texline @math{x/(1+x^{-2})}
23270 @infoline @expr{x/(1+x^-2)}
23271 is not strictly a quotient of polynomials, but it is equivalent to
23272 @expr{x^3/(x^2+1)}, which is.) Also, square roots of terms involving
23273 @expr{x} and @expr{x^2} may appear in rational functions being
23274 integrated. Finally, rational functions involving trigonometric or
23275 hyperbolic functions can be integrated.
23276
23277 With an argument (@kbd{C-u a i}), this command will compute the definite
23278 integral of the expression on top of the stack. In this case, the
23279 command will again prompt for an integration variable, then prompt for a
23280 lower limit and an upper limit.
23281
23282 @ifnottex
23283 If you use the @code{integ} function directly in an algebraic formula,
23284 you can also write @samp{integ(f,x,v)} which expresses the resulting
23285 indefinite integral in terms of variable @code{v} instead of @code{x}.
23286 With four arguments, @samp{integ(f(x),x,a,b)} represents a definite
23287 integral from @code{a} to @code{b}.
23288 @end ifnottex
23289 @tex
23290 If you use the @code{integ} function directly in an algebraic formula,
23291 you can also write @samp{integ(f,x,v)} which expresses the resulting
23292 indefinite integral in terms of variable @code{v} instead of @code{x}.
23293 With four arguments, @samp{integ(f(x),x,a,b)} represents a definite
23294 integral $\int_a^b f(x) \, dx$.
23295 @end tex
23296
23297 Please note that the current implementation of Calc's integrator sometimes
23298 produces results that are significantly more complex than they need to
23299 be. For example, the integral Calc finds for
23300 @texline @math{1/(x+\sqrt{x^2+1})}
23301 @infoline @expr{1/(x+sqrt(x^2+1))}
23302 is several times more complicated than the answer Mathematica
23303 returns for the same input, although the two forms are numerically
23304 equivalent. Also, any indefinite integral should be considered to have
23305 an arbitrary constant of integration added to it, although Calc does not
23306 write an explicit constant of integration in its result. For example,
23307 Calc's solution for
23308 @texline @math{1/(1+\tan x)}
23309 @infoline @expr{1/(1+tan(x))}
23310 differs from the solution given in the @emph{CRC Math Tables} by a
23311 constant factor of
23312 @texline @math{\pi i / 2}
23313 @infoline @expr{pi i / 2},
23314 due to a different choice of constant of integration.
23315
23316 The Calculator remembers all the integrals it has done. If conditions
23317 change in a way that would invalidate the old integrals, say, a switch
23318 from Degrees to Radians mode, then they will be thrown out. If you
23319 suspect this is not happening when it should, use the
23320 @code{calc-flush-caches} command; @pxref{Caches}.
23321
23322 @vindex IntegLimit
23323 Calc normally will pursue integration by substitution or integration by
23324 parts up to 3 nested times before abandoning an approach as fruitless.
23325 If the integrator is taking too long, you can lower this limit by storing
23326 a number (like 2) in the variable @code{IntegLimit}. (The @kbd{s I}
23327 command is a convenient way to edit @code{IntegLimit}.) If this variable
23328 has no stored value or does not contain a nonnegative integer, a limit
23329 of 3 is used. The lower this limit is, the greater the chance that Calc
23330 will be unable to integrate a function it could otherwise handle. Raising
23331 this limit allows the Calculator to solve more integrals, though the time
23332 it takes may grow exponentially. You can monitor the integrator's actions
23333 by creating an Emacs buffer called @code{*Trace*}. If such a buffer
23334 exists, the @kbd{a i} command will write a log of its actions there.
23335
23336 If you want to manipulate integrals in a purely symbolic way, you can
23337 set the integration nesting limit to 0 to prevent all but fast
23338 table-lookup solutions of integrals. You might then wish to define
23339 rewrite rules for integration by parts, various kinds of substitutions,
23340 and so on. @xref{Rewrite Rules}.
23341
23342 @node Customizing the Integrator, Numerical Integration, Integration, Calculus
23343 @subsection Customizing the Integrator
23344
23345 @noindent
23346 @vindex IntegRules
23347 Calc has two built-in rewrite rules called @code{IntegRules} and
23348 @code{IntegAfterRules} which you can edit to define new integration
23349 methods. @xref{Rewrite Rules}. At each step of the integration process,
23350 Calc wraps the current integrand in a call to the fictitious function
23351 @samp{integtry(@var{expr},@var{var})}, where @var{expr} is the
23352 integrand and @var{var} is the integration variable. If your rules
23353 rewrite this to be a plain formula (not a call to @code{integtry}), then
23354 Calc will use this formula as the integral of @var{expr}. For example,
23355 the rule @samp{integtry(mysin(x),x) := -mycos(x)} would define a rule to
23356 integrate a function @code{mysin} that acts like the sine function.
23357 Then, putting @samp{4 mysin(2y+1)} on the stack and typing @kbd{a i y}
23358 will produce the integral @samp{-2 mycos(2y+1)}. Note that Calc has
23359 automatically made various transformations on the integral to allow it
23360 to use your rule; integral tables generally give rules for
23361 @samp{mysin(a x + b)}, but you don't need to use this much generality
23362 in your @code{IntegRules}.
23363
23364 @cindex Exponential integral Ei(x)
23365 @ignore
23366 @starindex
23367 @end ignore
23368 @tindex Ei
23369 As a more serious example, the expression @samp{exp(x)/x} cannot be
23370 integrated in terms of the standard functions, so the ``exponential
23371 integral'' function
23372 @texline @math{{\rm Ei}(x)}
23373 @infoline @expr{Ei(x)}
23374 was invented to describe it.
23375 We can get Calc to do this integral in terms of a made-up @code{Ei}
23376 function by adding the rule @samp{[integtry(exp(x)/x, x) := Ei(x)]}
23377 to @code{IntegRules}. Now entering @samp{exp(2x)/x} on the stack
23378 and typing @kbd{a i x} yields @samp{Ei(2 x)}. This new rule will
23379 work with Calc's various built-in integration methods (such as
23380 integration by substitution) to solve a variety of other problems
23381 involving @code{Ei}: For example, now Calc will also be able to
23382 integrate @samp{exp(exp(x))} and @samp{ln(ln(x))} (to get @samp{Ei(exp(x))}
23383 and @samp{x ln(ln(x)) - Ei(ln(x))}, respectively).
23384
23385 Your rule may do further integration by calling @code{integ}. For
23386 example, @samp{integtry(twice(u),x) := twice(integ(u))} allows Calc
23387 to integrate @samp{twice(sin(x))} to get @samp{twice(-cos(x))}.
23388 Note that @code{integ} was called with only one argument. This notation
23389 is allowed only within @code{IntegRules}; it means ``integrate this
23390 with respect to the same integration variable.'' If Calc is unable
23391 to integrate @code{u}, the integration that invoked @code{IntegRules}
23392 also fails. Thus integrating @samp{twice(f(x))} fails, returning the
23393 unevaluated integral @samp{integ(twice(f(x)), x)}. It is still valid
23394 to call @code{integ} with two or more arguments, however; in this case,
23395 if @code{u} is not integrable, @code{twice} itself will still be
23396 integrated: If the above rule is changed to @samp{... := twice(integ(u,x))},
23397 then integrating @samp{twice(f(x))} will yield @samp{twice(integ(f(x),x))}.
23398
23399 If a rule instead produces the formula @samp{integsubst(@var{sexpr},
23400 @var{svar})}, either replacing the top-level @code{integtry} call or
23401 nested anywhere inside the expression, then Calc will apply the
23402 substitution @samp{@var{u} = @var{sexpr}(@var{svar})} to try to
23403 integrate the original @var{expr}. For example, the rule
23404 @samp{sqrt(a) := integsubst(sqrt(x),x)} says that if Calc ever finds
23405 a square root in the integrand, it should attempt the substitution
23406 @samp{u = sqrt(x)}. (This particular rule is unnecessary because
23407 Calc always tries ``obvious'' substitutions where @var{sexpr} actually
23408 appears in the integrand.) The variable @var{svar} may be the same
23409 as the @var{var} that appeared in the call to @code{integtry}, but
23410 it need not be.
23411
23412 When integrating according to an @code{integsubst}, Calc uses the
23413 equation solver to find the inverse of @var{sexpr} (if the integrand
23414 refers to @var{var} anywhere except in subexpressions that exactly
23415 match @var{sexpr}). It uses the differentiator to find the derivative
23416 of @var{sexpr} and/or its inverse (it has two methods that use one
23417 derivative or the other). You can also specify these items by adding
23418 extra arguments to the @code{integsubst} your rules construct; the
23419 general form is @samp{integsubst(@var{sexpr}, @var{svar}, @var{sinv},
23420 @var{sprime})}, where @var{sinv} is the inverse of @var{sexpr} (still
23421 written as a function of @var{svar}), and @var{sprime} is the
23422 derivative of @var{sexpr} with respect to @var{svar}. If you don't
23423 specify these things, and Calc is not able to work them out on its
23424 own with the information it knows, then your substitution rule will
23425 work only in very specific, simple cases.
23426
23427 Calc applies @code{IntegRules} as if by @kbd{C-u 1 a r IntegRules};
23428 in other words, Calc stops rewriting as soon as any rule in your rule
23429 set succeeds. (If it weren't for this, the @samp{integsubst(sqrt(x),x)}
23430 example above would keep on adding layers of @code{integsubst} calls
23431 forever!)
23432
23433 @vindex IntegSimpRules
23434 Another set of rules, stored in @code{IntegSimpRules}, are applied
23435 every time the integrator uses @kbd{a s} to simplify an intermediate
23436 result. For example, putting the rule @samp{twice(x) := 2 x} into
23437 @code{IntegSimpRules} would tell Calc to convert the @code{twice}
23438 function into a form it knows whenever integration is attempted.
23439
23440 One more way to influence the integrator is to define a function with
23441 the @kbd{Z F} command (@pxref{Algebraic Definitions}). Calc's
23442 integrator automatically expands such functions according to their
23443 defining formulas, even if you originally asked for the function to
23444 be left unevaluated for symbolic arguments. (Certain other Calc
23445 systems, such as the differentiator and the equation solver, also
23446 do this.)
23447
23448 @vindex IntegAfterRules
23449 Sometimes Calc is able to find a solution to your integral, but it
23450 expresses the result in a way that is unnecessarily complicated. If
23451 this happens, you can either use @code{integsubst} as described
23452 above to try to hint at a more direct path to the desired result, or
23453 you can use @code{IntegAfterRules}. This is an extra rule set that
23454 runs after the main integrator returns its result; basically, Calc does
23455 an @kbd{a r IntegAfterRules} on the result before showing it to you.
23456 (It also does an @kbd{a s}, without @code{IntegSimpRules}, after that
23457 to further simplify the result.) For example, Calc's integrator
23458 sometimes produces expressions of the form @samp{ln(1+x) - ln(1-x)};
23459 the default @code{IntegAfterRules} rewrite this into the more readable
23460 form @samp{2 arctanh(x)}. Note that, unlike @code{IntegRules},
23461 @code{IntegSimpRules} and @code{IntegAfterRules} are applied any number
23462 of times until no further changes are possible. Rewriting by
23463 @code{IntegAfterRules} occurs only after the main integrator has
23464 finished, not at every step as for @code{IntegRules} and
23465 @code{IntegSimpRules}.
23466
23467 @node Numerical Integration, Taylor Series, Customizing the Integrator, Calculus
23468 @subsection Numerical Integration
23469
23470 @noindent
23471 @kindex a I
23472 @pindex calc-num-integral
23473 @tindex ninteg
23474 If you want a purely numerical answer to an integration problem, you can
23475 use the @kbd{a I} (@code{calc-num-integral}) [@code{ninteg}] command. This
23476 command prompts for an integration variable, a lower limit, and an
23477 upper limit. Except for the integration variable, all other variables
23478 that appear in the integrand formula must have stored values. (A stored
23479 value, if any, for the integration variable itself is ignored.)
23480
23481 Numerical integration works by evaluating your formula at many points in
23482 the specified interval. Calc uses an ``open Romberg'' method; this means
23483 that it does not evaluate the formula actually at the endpoints (so that
23484 it is safe to integrate @samp{sin(x)/x} from zero, for example). Also,
23485 the Romberg method works especially well when the function being
23486 integrated is fairly smooth. If the function is not smooth, Calc will
23487 have to evaluate it at quite a few points before it can accurately
23488 determine the value of the integral.
23489
23490 Integration is much faster when the current precision is small. It is
23491 best to set the precision to the smallest acceptable number of digits
23492 before you use @kbd{a I}. If Calc appears to be taking too long, press
23493 @kbd{C-g} to halt it and try a lower precision. If Calc still appears
23494 to need hundreds of evaluations, check to make sure your function is
23495 well-behaved in the specified interval.
23496
23497 It is possible for the lower integration limit to be @samp{-inf} (minus
23498 infinity). Likewise, the upper limit may be plus infinity. Calc
23499 internally transforms the integral into an equivalent one with finite
23500 limits. However, integration to or across singularities is not supported:
23501 The integral of @samp{1/sqrt(x)} from 0 to 1 exists (it can be found
23502 by Calc's symbolic integrator, for example), but @kbd{a I} will fail
23503 because the integrand goes to infinity at one of the endpoints.
23504
23505 @node Taylor Series, , Numerical Integration, Calculus
23506 @subsection Taylor Series
23507
23508 @noindent
23509 @kindex a t
23510 @pindex calc-taylor
23511 @tindex taylor
23512 The @kbd{a t} (@code{calc-taylor}) [@code{taylor}] command computes a
23513 power series expansion or Taylor series of a function. You specify the
23514 variable and the desired number of terms. You may give an expression of
23515 the form @samp{@var{var} = @var{a}} or @samp{@var{var} - @var{a}} instead
23516 of just a variable to produce a Taylor expansion about the point @var{a}.
23517 You may specify the number of terms with a numeric prefix argument;
23518 otherwise the command will prompt you for the number of terms. Note that
23519 many series expansions have coefficients of zero for some terms, so you
23520 may appear to get fewer terms than you asked for.
23521
23522 If the @kbd{a i} command is unable to find a symbolic integral for a
23523 function, you can get an approximation by integrating the function's
23524 Taylor series.
23525
23526 @node Solving Equations, Numerical Solutions, Calculus, Algebra
23527 @section Solving Equations
23528
23529 @noindent
23530 @kindex a S
23531 @pindex calc-solve-for
23532 @tindex solve
23533 @cindex Equations, solving
23534 @cindex Solving equations
23535 The @kbd{a S} (@code{calc-solve-for}) [@code{solve}] command rearranges
23536 an equation to solve for a specific variable. An equation is an
23537 expression of the form @expr{L = R}. For example, the command @kbd{a S x}
23538 will rearrange @expr{y = 3x + 6} to the form, @expr{x = y/3 - 2}. If the
23539 input is not an equation, it is treated like an equation of the
23540 form @expr{X = 0}.
23541
23542 This command also works for inequalities, as in @expr{y < 3x + 6}.
23543 Some inequalities cannot be solved where the analogous equation could
23544 be; for example, solving
23545 @texline @math{a < b \, c}
23546 @infoline @expr{a < b c}
23547 for @expr{b} is impossible
23548 without knowing the sign of @expr{c}. In this case, @kbd{a S} will
23549 produce the result
23550 @texline @math{b \mathbin{\hbox{\code{!=}}} a/c}
23551 @infoline @expr{b != a/c}
23552 (using the not-equal-to operator) to signify that the direction of the
23553 inequality is now unknown. The inequality
23554 @texline @math{a \le b \, c}
23555 @infoline @expr{a <= b c}
23556 is not even partially solved. @xref{Declarations}, for a way to tell
23557 Calc that the signs of the variables in a formula are in fact known.
23558
23559 Two useful commands for working with the result of @kbd{a S} are
23560 @kbd{a .} (@pxref{Logical Operations}), which converts @expr{x = y/3 - 2}
23561 to @expr{y/3 - 2}, and @kbd{s l} (@pxref{Let Command}) which evaluates
23562 another formula with @expr{x} set equal to @expr{y/3 - 2}.
23563
23564 @menu
23565 * Multiple Solutions::
23566 * Solving Systems of Equations::
23567 * Decomposing Polynomials::
23568 @end menu
23569
23570 @node Multiple Solutions, Solving Systems of Equations, Solving Equations, Solving Equations
23571 @subsection Multiple Solutions
23572
23573 @noindent
23574 @kindex H a S
23575 @tindex fsolve
23576 Some equations have more than one solution. The Hyperbolic flag
23577 (@code{H a S}) [@code{fsolve}] tells the solver to report the fully
23578 general family of solutions. It will invent variables @code{n1},
23579 @code{n2}, @dots{}, which represent independent arbitrary integers, and
23580 @code{s1}, @code{s2}, @dots{}, which represent independent arbitrary
23581 signs (either @mathit{+1} or @mathit{-1}). If you don't use the Hyperbolic
23582 flag, Calc will use zero in place of all arbitrary integers, and plus
23583 one in place of all arbitrary signs. Note that variables like @code{n1}
23584 and @code{s1} are not given any special interpretation in Calc except by
23585 the equation solver itself. As usual, you can use the @w{@kbd{s l}}
23586 (@code{calc-let}) command to obtain solutions for various actual values
23587 of these variables.
23588
23589 For example, @kbd{' x^2 = y @key{RET} H a S x @key{RET}} solves to
23590 get @samp{x = s1 sqrt(y)}, indicating that the two solutions to the
23591 equation are @samp{sqrt(y)} and @samp{-sqrt(y)}. Another way to
23592 think about it is that the square-root operation is really a
23593 two-valued function; since every Calc function must return a
23594 single result, @code{sqrt} chooses to return the positive result.
23595 Then @kbd{H a S} doctors this result using @code{s1} to indicate
23596 the full set of possible values of the mathematical square-root.
23597
23598 There is a similar phenomenon going the other direction: Suppose
23599 we solve @samp{sqrt(y) = x} for @code{y}. Calc squares both sides
23600 to get @samp{y = x^2}. This is correct, except that it introduces
23601 some dubious solutions. Consider solving @samp{sqrt(y) = -3}:
23602 Calc will report @expr{y = 9} as a valid solution, which is true
23603 in the mathematical sense of square-root, but false (there is no
23604 solution) for the actual Calc positive-valued @code{sqrt}. This
23605 happens for both @kbd{a S} and @kbd{H a S}.
23606
23607 @cindex @code{GenCount} variable
23608 @vindex GenCount
23609 @ignore
23610 @starindex
23611 @end ignore
23612 @tindex an
23613 @ignore
23614 @starindex
23615 @end ignore
23616 @tindex as
23617 If you store a positive integer in the Calc variable @code{GenCount},
23618 then Calc will generate formulas of the form @samp{as(@var{n})} for
23619 arbitrary signs, and @samp{an(@var{n})} for arbitrary integers,
23620 where @var{n} represents successive values taken by incrementing
23621 @code{GenCount} by one. While the normal arbitrary sign and
23622 integer symbols start over at @code{s1} and @code{n1} with each
23623 new Calc command, the @code{GenCount} approach will give each
23624 arbitrary value a name that is unique throughout the entire Calc
23625 session. Also, the arbitrary values are function calls instead
23626 of variables, which is advantageous in some cases. For example,
23627 you can make a rewrite rule that recognizes all arbitrary signs
23628 using a pattern like @samp{as(n)}. The @kbd{s l} command only works
23629 on variables, but you can use the @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute})
23630 command to substitute actual values for function calls like @samp{as(3)}.
23631
23632 The @kbd{s G} (@code{calc-edit-GenCount}) command is a convenient
23633 way to create or edit this variable. Press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish.
23634
23635 If you have not stored a value in @code{GenCount}, or if the value
23636 in that variable is not a positive integer, the regular
23637 @code{s1}/@code{n1} notation is used.
23638
23639 @kindex I a S
23640 @kindex H I a S
23641 @tindex finv
23642 @tindex ffinv
23643 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I a S} [@code{finv}] treats the expression
23644 on top of the stack as a function of the specified variable and solves
23645 to find the inverse function, written in terms of the same variable.
23646 For example, @kbd{I a S x} inverts @expr{2x + 6} to @expr{x/2 - 3}.
23647 You can use both Inverse and Hyperbolic [@code{ffinv}] to obtain a
23648 fully general inverse, as described above.
23649
23650 @kindex a P
23651 @pindex calc-poly-roots
23652 @tindex roots
23653 Some equations, specifically polynomials, have a known, finite number
23654 of solutions. The @kbd{a P} (@code{calc-poly-roots}) [@code{roots}]
23655 command uses @kbd{H a S} to solve an equation in general form, then, for
23656 all arbitrary-sign variables like @code{s1}, and all arbitrary-integer
23657 variables like @code{n1} for which @code{n1} only usefully varies over
23658 a finite range, it expands these variables out to all their possible
23659 values. The results are collected into a vector, which is returned.
23660 For example, @samp{roots(x^4 = 1, x)} returns the four solutions
23661 @samp{[1, -1, (0, 1), (0, -1)]}. Generally an @var{n}th degree
23662 polynomial will always have @var{n} roots on the complex plane.
23663 (If you have given a @code{real} declaration for the solution
23664 variable, then only the real-valued solutions, if any, will be
23665 reported; @pxref{Declarations}.)
23666
23667 Note that because @kbd{a P} uses @kbd{H a S}, it is able to deliver
23668 symbolic solutions if the polynomial has symbolic coefficients. Also
23669 note that Calc's solver is not able to get exact symbolic solutions
23670 to all polynomials. Polynomials containing powers up to @expr{x^4}
23671 can always be solved exactly; polynomials of higher degree sometimes
23672 can be: @expr{x^6 + x^3 + 1} is converted to @expr{(x^3)^2 + (x^3) + 1},
23673 which can be solved for @expr{x^3} using the quadratic equation, and then
23674 for @expr{x} by taking cube roots. But in many cases, like
23675 @expr{x^6 + x + 1}, Calc does not know how to rewrite the polynomial
23676 into a form it can solve. The @kbd{a P} command can still deliver a
23677 list of numerical roots, however, provided that Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s})
23678 is not turned on. (If you work with Symbolic mode on, recall that the
23679 @kbd{N} (@code{calc-eval-num}) key is a handy way to reevaluate the
23680 formula on the stack with Symbolic mode temporarily off.) Naturally,
23681 @kbd{a P} can only provide numerical roots if the polynomial coefficients
23682 are all numbers (real or complex).
23683
23684 @node Solving Systems of Equations, Decomposing Polynomials, Multiple Solutions, Solving Equations
23685 @subsection Solving Systems of Equations
23686
23687 @noindent
23688 @cindex Systems of equations, symbolic
23689 You can also use the commands described above to solve systems of
23690 simultaneous equations. Just create a vector of equations, then
23691 specify a vector of variables for which to solve. (You can omit
23692 the surrounding brackets when entering the vector of variables
23693 at the prompt.)
23694
23695 For example, putting @samp{[x + y = a, x - y = b]} on the stack
23696 and typing @kbd{a S x,y @key{RET}} produces the vector of solutions
23697 @samp{[x = a - (a-b)/2, y = (a-b)/2]}. The result vector will
23698 have the same length as the variables vector, and the variables
23699 will be listed in the same order there. Note that the solutions
23700 are not always simplified as far as possible; the solution for
23701 @expr{x} here could be improved by an application of the @kbd{a n}
23702 command.
23703
23704 Calc's algorithm works by trying to eliminate one variable at a
23705 time by solving one of the equations for that variable and then
23706 substituting into the other equations. Calc will try all the
23707 possibilities, but you can speed things up by noting that Calc
23708 first tries to eliminate the first variable with the first
23709 equation, then the second variable with the second equation,
23710 and so on. It also helps to put the simpler (e.g., more linear)
23711 equations toward the front of the list. Calc's algorithm will
23712 solve any system of linear equations, and also many kinds of
23713 nonlinear systems.
23714
23715 @ignore
23716 @starindex
23717 @end ignore
23718 @tindex elim
23719 Normally there will be as many variables as equations. If you
23720 give fewer variables than equations (an ``over-determined'' system
23721 of equations), Calc will find a partial solution. For example,
23722 typing @kbd{a S y @key{RET}} with the above system of equations
23723 would produce @samp{[y = a - x]}. There are now several ways to
23724 express this solution in terms of the original variables; Calc uses
23725 the first one that it finds. You can control the choice by adding
23726 variable specifiers of the form @samp{elim(@var{v})} to the
23727 variables list. This says that @var{v} should be eliminated from
23728 the equations; the variable will not appear at all in the solution.
23729 For example, typing @kbd{a S y,elim(x)} would yield
23730 @samp{[y = a - (b+a)/2]}.
23731
23732 If the variables list contains only @code{elim} specifiers,
23733 Calc simply eliminates those variables from the equations
23734 and then returns the resulting set of equations. For example,
23735 @kbd{a S elim(x)} produces @samp{[a - 2 y = b]}. Every variable
23736 eliminated will reduce the number of equations in the system
23737 by one.
23738
23739 Again, @kbd{a S} gives you one solution to the system of
23740 equations. If there are several solutions, you can use @kbd{H a S}
23741 to get a general family of solutions, or, if there is a finite
23742 number of solutions, you can use @kbd{a P} to get a list. (In
23743 the latter case, the result will take the form of a matrix where
23744 the rows are different solutions and the columns correspond to the
23745 variables you requested.)
23746
23747 Another way to deal with certain kinds of overdetermined systems of
23748 equations is the @kbd{a F} command, which does least-squares fitting
23749 to satisfy the equations. @xref{Curve Fitting}.
23750
23751 @node Decomposing Polynomials, , Solving Systems of Equations, Solving Equations
23752 @subsection Decomposing Polynomials
23753
23754 @noindent
23755 @ignore
23756 @starindex
23757 @end ignore
23758 @tindex poly
23759 The @code{poly} function takes a polynomial and a variable as
23760 arguments, and returns a vector of polynomial coefficients (constant
23761 coefficient first). For example, @samp{poly(x^3 + 2 x, x)} returns
23762 @expr{[0, 2, 0, 1]}. If the input is not a polynomial in @expr{x},
23763 the call to @code{poly} is left in symbolic form. If the input does
23764 not involve the variable @expr{x}, the input is returned in a list
23765 of length one, representing a polynomial with only a constant
23766 coefficient. The call @samp{poly(x, x)} returns the vector @expr{[0, 1]}.
23767 The last element of the returned vector is guaranteed to be nonzero;
23768 note that @samp{poly(0, x)} returns the empty vector @expr{[]}.
23769 Note also that @expr{x} may actually be any formula; for example,
23770 @samp{poly(sin(x)^2 - sin(x) + 3, sin(x))} returns @expr{[3, -1, 1]}.
23771
23772 @cindex Coefficients of polynomial
23773 @cindex Degree of polynomial
23774 To get the @expr{x^k} coefficient of polynomial @expr{p}, use
23775 @samp{poly(p, x)_(k+1)}. To get the degree of polynomial @expr{p},
23776 use @samp{vlen(poly(p, x)) - 1}. For example, @samp{poly((x+1)^4, x)}
23777 returns @samp{[1, 4, 6, 4, 1]}, so @samp{poly((x+1)^4, x)_(2+1)}
23778 gives the @expr{x^2} coefficient of this polynomial, 6.
23779
23780 @ignore
23781 @starindex
23782 @end ignore
23783 @tindex gpoly
23784 One important feature of the solver is its ability to recognize
23785 formulas which are ``essentially'' polynomials. This ability is
23786 made available to the user through the @code{gpoly} function, which
23787 is used just like @code{poly}: @samp{gpoly(@var{expr}, @var{var})}.
23788 If @var{expr} is a polynomial in some term which includes @var{var}, then
23789 this function will return a vector @samp{[@var{x}, @var{c}, @var{a}]}
23790 where @var{x} is the term that depends on @var{var}, @var{c} is a
23791 vector of polynomial coefficients (like the one returned by @code{poly}),
23792 and @var{a} is a multiplier which is usually 1. Basically,
23793 @samp{@var{expr} = @var{a}*(@var{c}_1 + @var{c}_2 @var{x} +
23794 @var{c}_3 @var{x}^2 + ...)}. The last element of @var{c} is
23795 guaranteed to be non-zero, and @var{c} will not equal @samp{[1]}
23796 (i.e., the trivial decomposition @var{expr} = @var{x} is not
23797 considered a polynomial). One side effect is that @samp{gpoly(x, x)}
23798 and @samp{gpoly(6, x)}, both of which might be expected to recognize
23799 their arguments as polynomials, will not because the decomposition
23800 is considered trivial.
23801
23802 For example, @samp{gpoly((x-2)^2, x)} returns @samp{[x, [4, -4, 1], 1]},
23803 since the expanded form of this polynomial is @expr{4 - 4 x + x^2}.
23804
23805 The term @var{x} may itself be a polynomial in @var{var}. This is
23806 done to reduce the size of the @var{c} vector. For example,
23807 @samp{gpoly(x^4 + x^2 - 1, x)} returns @samp{[x^2, [-1, 1, 1], 1]},
23808 since a quadratic polynomial in @expr{x^2} is easier to solve than
23809 a quartic polynomial in @expr{x}.
23810
23811 A few more examples of the kinds of polynomials @code{gpoly} can
23812 discover:
23813
23814 @smallexample
23815 sin(x) - 1 [sin(x), [-1, 1], 1]
23816 x + 1/x - 1 [x, [1, -1, 1], 1/x]
23817 x + 1/x [x^2, [1, 1], 1/x]
23818 x^3 + 2 x [x^2, [2, 1], x]
23819 x + x^2:3 + sqrt(x) [x^1:6, [1, 1, 0, 1], x^1:2]
23820 x^(2a) + 2 x^a + 5 [x^a, [5, 2, 1], 1]
23821 (exp(-x) + exp(x)) / 2 [e^(2 x), [0.5, 0.5], e^-x]
23822 @end smallexample
23823
23824 The @code{poly} and @code{gpoly} functions accept a third integer argument
23825 which specifies the largest degree of polynomial that is acceptable.
23826 If this is @expr{n}, then only @var{c} vectors of length @expr{n+1}
23827 or less will be returned. Otherwise, the @code{poly} or @code{gpoly}
23828 call will remain in symbolic form. For example, the equation solver
23829 can handle quartics and smaller polynomials, so it calls
23830 @samp{gpoly(@var{expr}, @var{var}, 4)} to discover whether @var{expr}
23831 can be treated by its linear, quadratic, cubic, or quartic formulas.
23832
23833 @ignore
23834 @starindex
23835 @end ignore
23836 @tindex pdeg
23837 The @code{pdeg} function computes the degree of a polynomial;
23838 @samp{pdeg(p,x)} is the highest power of @code{x} that appears in
23839 @code{p}. This is the same as @samp{vlen(poly(p,x))-1}, but is
23840 much more efficient. If @code{p} is constant with respect to @code{x},
23841 then @samp{pdeg(p,x) = 0}. If @code{p} is not a polynomial in @code{x}
23842 (e.g., @samp{pdeg(2 cos(x), x)}, the function remains unevaluated.
23843 It is possible to omit the second argument @code{x}, in which case
23844 @samp{pdeg(p)} returns the highest total degree of any term of the
23845 polynomial, counting all variables that appear in @code{p}. Note
23846 that @code{pdeg(c) = pdeg(c,x) = 0} for any nonzero constant @code{c};
23847 the degree of the constant zero is considered to be @code{-inf}
23848 (minus infinity).
23849
23850 @ignore
23851 @starindex
23852 @end ignore
23853 @tindex plead
23854 The @code{plead} function finds the leading term of a polynomial.
23855 Thus @samp{plead(p,x)} is equivalent to @samp{poly(p,x)_vlen(poly(p,x))},
23856 though again more efficient. In particular, @samp{plead((2x+1)^10, x)}
23857 returns 1024 without expanding out the list of coefficients. The
23858 value of @code{plead(p,x)} will be zero only if @expr{p = 0}.
23859
23860 @ignore
23861 @starindex
23862 @end ignore
23863 @tindex pcont
23864 The @code{pcont} function finds the @dfn{content} of a polynomial. This
23865 is the greatest common divisor of all the coefficients of the polynomial.
23866 With two arguments, @code{pcont(p,x)} effectively uses @samp{poly(p,x)}
23867 to get a list of coefficients, then uses @code{pgcd} (the polynomial
23868 GCD function) to combine these into an answer. For example,
23869 @samp{pcont(4 x y^2 + 6 x^2 y, x)} is @samp{2 y}. The content is
23870 basically the ``biggest'' polynomial that can be divided into @code{p}
23871 exactly. The sign of the content is the same as the sign of the leading
23872 coefficient.
23873
23874 With only one argument, @samp{pcont(p)} computes the numerical
23875 content of the polynomial, i.e., the @code{gcd} of the numerical
23876 coefficients of all the terms in the formula. Note that @code{gcd}
23877 is defined on rational numbers as well as integers; it computes
23878 the @code{gcd} of the numerators and the @code{lcm} of the
23879 denominators. Thus @samp{pcont(4:3 x y^2 + 6 x^2 y)} returns 2:3.
23880 Dividing the polynomial by this number will clear all the
23881 denominators, as well as dividing by any common content in the
23882 numerators. The numerical content of a polynomial is negative only
23883 if all the coefficients in the polynomial are negative.
23884
23885 @ignore
23886 @starindex
23887 @end ignore
23888 @tindex pprim
23889 The @code{pprim} function finds the @dfn{primitive part} of a
23890 polynomial, which is simply the polynomial divided (using @code{pdiv}
23891 if necessary) by its content. If the input polynomial has rational
23892 coefficients, the result will have integer coefficients in simplest
23893 terms.
23894
23895 @node Numerical Solutions, Curve Fitting, Solving Equations, Algebra
23896 @section Numerical Solutions
23897
23898 @noindent
23899 Not all equations can be solved symbolically. The commands in this
23900 section use numerical algorithms that can find a solution to a specific
23901 instance of an equation to any desired accuracy. Note that the
23902 numerical commands are slower than their algebraic cousins; it is a
23903 good idea to try @kbd{a S} before resorting to these commands.
23904
23905 (@xref{Curve Fitting}, for some other, more specialized, operations
23906 on numerical data.)
23907
23908 @menu
23909 * Root Finding::
23910 * Minimization::
23911 * Numerical Systems of Equations::
23912 @end menu
23913
23914 @node Root Finding, Minimization, Numerical Solutions, Numerical Solutions
23915 @subsection Root Finding
23916
23917 @noindent
23918 @kindex a R
23919 @pindex calc-find-root
23920 @tindex root
23921 @cindex Newton's method
23922 @cindex Roots of equations
23923 @cindex Numerical root-finding
23924 The @kbd{a R} (@code{calc-find-root}) [@code{root}] command finds a
23925 numerical solution (or @dfn{root}) of an equation. (This command treats
23926 inequalities the same as equations. If the input is any other kind
23927 of formula, it is interpreted as an equation of the form @expr{X = 0}.)
23928
23929 The @kbd{a R} command requires an initial guess on the top of the
23930 stack, and a formula in the second-to-top position. It prompts for a
23931 solution variable, which must appear in the formula. All other variables
23932 that appear in the formula must have assigned values, i.e., when
23933 a value is assigned to the solution variable and the formula is
23934 evaluated with @kbd{=}, it should evaluate to a number. Any assigned
23935 value for the solution variable itself is ignored and unaffected by
23936 this command.
23937
23938 When the command completes, the initial guess is replaced on the stack
23939 by a vector of two numbers: The value of the solution variable that
23940 solves the equation, and the difference between the lefthand and
23941 righthand sides of the equation at that value. Ordinarily, the second
23942 number will be zero or very nearly zero. (Note that Calc uses a
23943 slightly higher precision while finding the root, and thus the second
23944 number may be slightly different from the value you would compute from
23945 the equation yourself.)
23946
23947 The @kbd{v h} (@code{calc-head}) command is a handy way to extract
23948 the first element of the result vector, discarding the error term.
23949
23950 The initial guess can be a real number, in which case Calc searches
23951 for a real solution near that number, or a complex number, in which
23952 case Calc searches the whole complex plane near that number for a
23953 solution, or it can be an interval form which restricts the search
23954 to real numbers inside that interval.
23955
23956 Calc tries to use @kbd{a d} to take the derivative of the equation.
23957 If this succeeds, it uses Newton's method. If the equation is not
23958 differentiable Calc uses a bisection method. (If Newton's method
23959 appears to be going astray, Calc switches over to bisection if it
23960 can, or otherwise gives up. In this case it may help to try again
23961 with a slightly different initial guess.) If the initial guess is a
23962 complex number, the function must be differentiable.
23963
23964 If the formula (or the difference between the sides of an equation)
23965 is negative at one end of the interval you specify and positive at
23966 the other end, the root finder is guaranteed to find a root.
23967 Otherwise, Calc subdivides the interval into small parts looking for
23968 positive and negative values to bracket the root. When your guess is
23969 an interval, Calc will not look outside that interval for a root.
23970
23971 @kindex H a R
23972 @tindex wroot
23973 The @kbd{H a R} [@code{wroot}] command is similar to @kbd{a R}, except
23974 that if the initial guess is an interval for which the function has
23975 the same sign at both ends, then rather than subdividing the interval
23976 Calc attempts to widen it to enclose a root. Use this mode if
23977 you are not sure if the function has a root in your interval.
23978
23979 If the function is not differentiable, and you give a simple number
23980 instead of an interval as your initial guess, Calc uses this widening
23981 process even if you did not type the Hyperbolic flag. (If the function
23982 @emph{is} differentiable, Calc uses Newton's method which does not
23983 require a bounding interval in order to work.)
23984
23985 If Calc leaves the @code{root} or @code{wroot} function in symbolic
23986 form on the stack, it will normally display an explanation for why
23987 no root was found. If you miss this explanation, press @kbd{w}
23988 (@code{calc-why}) to get it back.
23989
23990 @node Minimization, Numerical Systems of Equations, Root Finding, Numerical Solutions
23991 @subsection Minimization
23992
23993 @noindent
23994 @kindex a N
23995 @kindex H a N
23996 @kindex a X
23997 @kindex H a X
23998 @pindex calc-find-minimum
23999 @pindex calc-find-maximum
24000 @tindex minimize
24001 @tindex maximize
24002 @cindex Minimization, numerical
24003 The @kbd{a N} (@code{calc-find-minimum}) [@code{minimize}] command
24004 finds a minimum value for a formula. It is very similar in operation
24005 to @kbd{a R} (@code{calc-find-root}): You give the formula and an initial
24006 guess on the stack, and are prompted for the name of a variable. The guess
24007 may be either a number near the desired minimum, or an interval enclosing
24008 the desired minimum. The function returns a vector containing the
24009 value of the variable which minimizes the formula's value, along
24010 with the minimum value itself.
24011
24012 Note that this command looks for a @emph{local} minimum. Many functions
24013 have more than one minimum; some, like
24014 @texline @math{x \sin x},
24015 @infoline @expr{x sin(x)},
24016 have infinitely many. In fact, there is no easy way to define the
24017 ``global'' minimum of
24018 @texline @math{x \sin x}
24019 @infoline @expr{x sin(x)}
24020 but Calc can still locate any particular local minimum
24021 for you. Calc basically goes downhill from the initial guess until it
24022 finds a point at which the function's value is greater both to the left
24023 and to the right. Calc does not use derivatives when minimizing a function.
24024
24025 If your initial guess is an interval and it looks like the minimum
24026 occurs at one or the other endpoint of the interval, Calc will return
24027 that endpoint only if that endpoint is closed; thus, minimizing @expr{17 x}
24028 over @expr{[2..3]} will return @expr{[2, 38]}, but minimizing over
24029 @expr{(2..3]} would report no minimum found. In general, you should
24030 use closed intervals to find literally the minimum value in that
24031 range of @expr{x}, or open intervals to find the local minimum, if
24032 any, that happens to lie in that range.
24033
24034 Most functions are smooth and flat near their minimum values. Because
24035 of this flatness, if the current precision is, say, 12 digits, the
24036 variable can only be determined meaningfully to about six digits. Thus
24037 you should set the precision to twice as many digits as you need in your
24038 answer.
24039
24040 @ignore
24041 @mindex wmin@idots
24042 @end ignore
24043 @tindex wminimize
24044 @ignore
24045 @mindex wmax@idots
24046 @end ignore
24047 @tindex wmaximize
24048 The @kbd{H a N} [@code{wminimize}] command, analogously to @kbd{H a R},
24049 expands the guess interval to enclose a minimum rather than requiring
24050 that the minimum lie inside the interval you supply.
24051
24052 The @kbd{a X} (@code{calc-find-maximum}) [@code{maximize}] and
24053 @kbd{H a X} [@code{wmaximize}] commands effectively minimize the
24054 negative of the formula you supply.
24055
24056 The formula must evaluate to a real number at all points inside the
24057 interval (or near the initial guess if the guess is a number). If
24058 the initial guess is a complex number the variable will be minimized
24059 over the complex numbers; if it is real or an interval it will
24060 be minimized over the reals.
24061
24062 @node Numerical Systems of Equations, , Minimization, Numerical Solutions
24063 @subsection Systems of Equations
24064
24065 @noindent
24066 @cindex Systems of equations, numerical
24067 The @kbd{a R} command can also solve systems of equations. In this
24068 case, the equation should instead be a vector of equations, the
24069 guess should instead be a vector of numbers (intervals are not
24070 supported), and the variable should be a vector of variables. You
24071 can omit the brackets while entering the list of variables. Each
24072 equation must be differentiable by each variable for this mode to
24073 work. The result will be a vector of two vectors: The variable
24074 values that solved the system of equations, and the differences
24075 between the sides of the equations with those variable values.
24076 There must be the same number of equations as variables. Since
24077 only plain numbers are allowed as guesses, the Hyperbolic flag has
24078 no effect when solving a system of equations.
24079
24080 It is also possible to minimize over many variables with @kbd{a N}
24081 (or maximize with @kbd{a X}). Once again the variable name should
24082 be replaced by a vector of variables, and the initial guess should
24083 be an equal-sized vector of initial guesses. But, unlike the case of
24084 multidimensional @kbd{a R}, the formula being minimized should
24085 still be a single formula, @emph{not} a vector. Beware that
24086 multidimensional minimization is currently @emph{very} slow.
24087
24088 @node Curve Fitting, Summations, Numerical Solutions, Algebra
24089 @section Curve Fitting
24090
24091 @noindent
24092 The @kbd{a F} command fits a set of data to a @dfn{model formula},
24093 such as @expr{y = m x + b} where @expr{m} and @expr{b} are parameters
24094 to be determined. For a typical set of measured data there will be
24095 no single @expr{m} and @expr{b} that exactly fit the data; in this
24096 case, Calc chooses values of the parameters that provide the closest
24097 possible fit. The model formula can be entered in various ways after
24098 the key sequence @kbd{a F} is pressed.
24099
24100 If the letter @kbd{P} is pressed after @kbd{a F} but before the model
24101 description is entered, the data as well as the model formula will be
24102 plotted after the formula is determined. This will be indicated by a
24103 ``P'' in the minibuffer after the help message.
24104
24105 @menu
24106 * Linear Fits::
24107 * Polynomial and Multilinear Fits::
24108 * Error Estimates for Fits::
24109 * Standard Nonlinear Models::
24110 * Curve Fitting Details::
24111 * Interpolation::
24112 @end menu
24113
24114 @node Linear Fits, Polynomial and Multilinear Fits, Curve Fitting, Curve Fitting
24115 @subsection Linear Fits
24116
24117 @noindent
24118 @kindex a F
24119 @pindex calc-curve-fit
24120 @tindex fit
24121 @cindex Linear regression
24122 @cindex Least-squares fits
24123 The @kbd{a F} (@code{calc-curve-fit}) [@code{fit}] command attempts
24124 to fit a set of data (@expr{x} and @expr{y} vectors of numbers) to a
24125 straight line, polynomial, or other function of @expr{x}. For the
24126 moment we will consider only the case of fitting to a line, and we
24127 will ignore the issue of whether or not the model was in fact a good
24128 fit for the data.
24129
24130 In a standard linear least-squares fit, we have a set of @expr{(x,y)}
24131 data points that we wish to fit to the model @expr{y = m x + b}
24132 by adjusting the parameters @expr{m} and @expr{b} to make the @expr{y}
24133 values calculated from the formula be as close as possible to the actual
24134 @expr{y} values in the data set. (In a polynomial fit, the model is
24135 instead, say, @expr{y = a x^3 + b x^2 + c x + d}. In a multilinear fit,
24136 we have data points of the form @expr{(x_1,x_2,x_3,y)} and our model is
24137 @expr{y = a x_1 + b x_2 + c x_3 + d}. These will be discussed later.)
24138
24139 In the model formula, variables like @expr{x} and @expr{x_2} are called
24140 the @dfn{independent variables}, and @expr{y} is the @dfn{dependent
24141 variable}. Variables like @expr{m}, @expr{a}, and @expr{b} are called
24142 the @dfn{parameters} of the model.
24143
24144 The @kbd{a F} command takes the data set to be fitted from the stack.
24145 By default, it expects the data in the form of a matrix. For example,
24146 for a linear or polynomial fit, this would be a
24147 @texline @math{2\times N}
24148 @infoline 2xN
24149 matrix where the first row is a list of @expr{x} values and the second
24150 row has the corresponding @expr{y} values. For the multilinear fit
24151 shown above, the matrix would have four rows (@expr{x_1}, @expr{x_2},
24152 @expr{x_3}, and @expr{y}, respectively).
24153
24154 If you happen to have an
24155 @texline @math{N\times2}
24156 @infoline Nx2
24157 matrix instead of a
24158 @texline @math{2\times N}
24159 @infoline 2xN
24160 matrix, just press @kbd{v t} first to transpose the matrix.
24161
24162 After you type @kbd{a F}, Calc prompts you to select a model. For a
24163 linear fit, press the digit @kbd{1}.
24164
24165 Calc then prompts for you to name the variables. By default it chooses
24166 high letters like @expr{x} and @expr{y} for independent variables and
24167 low letters like @expr{a} and @expr{b} for parameters. (The dependent
24168 variable doesn't need a name.) The two kinds of variables are separated
24169 by a semicolon. Since you generally care more about the names of the
24170 independent variables than of the parameters, Calc also allows you to
24171 name only those and let the parameters use default names.
24172
24173 For example, suppose the data matrix
24174
24175 @ifnottex
24176 @example
24177 @group
24178 [ [ 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 ]
24179 [ 5, 7, 9, 11, 13 ] ]
24180 @end group
24181 @end example
24182 @end ifnottex
24183 @tex
24184 \turnoffactive
24185 \turnoffactive
24186 \beforedisplay
24187 $$ \pmatrix{ 1 & 2 & 3 & 4 & 5 \cr
24188 5 & 7 & 9 & 11 & 13 }
24189 $$
24190 \afterdisplay
24191 @end tex
24192
24193 @noindent
24194 is on the stack and we wish to do a simple linear fit. Type
24195 @kbd{a F}, then @kbd{1} for the model, then @key{RET} to use
24196 the default names. The result will be the formula @expr{3. + 2. x}
24197 on the stack. Calc has created the model expression @kbd{a + b x},
24198 then found the optimal values of @expr{a} and @expr{b} to fit the
24199 data. (In this case, it was able to find an exact fit.) Calc then
24200 substituted those values for @expr{a} and @expr{b} in the model
24201 formula.
24202
24203 The @kbd{a F} command puts two entries in the trail. One is, as
24204 always, a copy of the result that went to the stack; the other is
24205 a vector of the actual parameter values, written as equations:
24206 @expr{[a = 3, b = 2]}, in case you'd rather read them in a list
24207 than pick them out of the formula. (You can type @kbd{t y}
24208 to move this vector to the stack; see @ref{Trail Commands}.
24209
24210 Specifying a different independent variable name will affect the
24211 resulting formula: @kbd{a F 1 k @key{RET}} produces @kbd{3 + 2 k}.
24212 Changing the parameter names (say, @kbd{a F 1 k;b,m @key{RET}}) will affect
24213 the equations that go into the trail.
24214
24215 @tex
24216 \bigskip
24217 @end tex
24218
24219 To see what happens when the fit is not exact, we could change
24220 the number 13 in the data matrix to 14 and try the fit again.
24221 The result is:
24222
24223 @example
24224 2.6 + 2.2 x
24225 @end example
24226
24227 Evaluating this formula, say with @kbd{v x 5 @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET}}, shows
24228 a reasonably close match to the y-values in the data.
24229
24230 @example
24231 [4.8, 7., 9.2, 11.4, 13.6]
24232 @end example
24233
24234 Since there is no line which passes through all the @var{n} data points,
24235 Calc has chosen a line that best approximates the data points using
24236 the method of least squares. The idea is to define the @dfn{chi-square}
24237 error measure
24238
24239 @ifnottex
24240 @example
24241 chi^2 = sum((y_i - (a + b x_i))^2, i, 1, N)
24242 @end example
24243 @end ifnottex
24244 @tex
24245 \turnoffactive
24246 \beforedisplay
24247 $$ \chi^2 = \sum_{i=1}^N (y_i - (a + b x_i))^2 $$
24248 \afterdisplay
24249 @end tex
24250
24251 @noindent
24252 which is clearly zero if @expr{a + b x} exactly fits all data points,
24253 and increases as various @expr{a + b x_i} values fail to match the
24254 corresponding @expr{y_i} values. There are several reasons why the
24255 summand is squared, one of them being to ensure that
24256 @texline @math{\chi^2 \ge 0}.
24257 @infoline @expr{chi^2 >= 0}.
24258 Least-squares fitting simply chooses the values of @expr{a} and @expr{b}
24259 for which the error
24260 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24261 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24262 is as small as possible.
24263
24264 Other kinds of models do the same thing but with a different model
24265 formula in place of @expr{a + b x_i}.
24266
24267 @tex
24268 \bigskip
24269 @end tex
24270
24271 A numeric prefix argument causes the @kbd{a F} command to take the
24272 data in some other form than one big matrix. A positive argument @var{n}
24273 will take @var{N} items from the stack, corresponding to the @var{n} rows
24274 of a data matrix. In the linear case, @var{n} must be 2 since there
24275 is always one independent variable and one dependent variable.
24276
24277 A prefix of zero or plain @kbd{C-u} is a compromise; Calc takes two
24278 items from the stack, an @var{n}-row matrix of @expr{x} values, and a
24279 vector of @expr{y} values. If there is only one independent variable,
24280 the @expr{x} values can be either a one-row matrix or a plain vector,
24281 in which case the @kbd{C-u} prefix is the same as a @w{@kbd{C-u 2}} prefix.
24282
24283 @node Polynomial and Multilinear Fits, Error Estimates for Fits, Linear Fits, Curve Fitting
24284 @subsection Polynomial and Multilinear Fits
24285
24286 @noindent
24287 To fit the data to higher-order polynomials, just type one of the
24288 digits @kbd{2} through @kbd{9} when prompted for a model. For example,
24289 we could fit the original data matrix from the previous section
24290 (with 13, not 14) to a parabola instead of a line by typing
24291 @kbd{a F 2 @key{RET}}.
24292
24293 @example
24294 2.00000000001 x - 1.5e-12 x^2 + 2.99999999999
24295 @end example
24296
24297 Note that since the constant and linear terms are enough to fit the
24298 data exactly, it's no surprise that Calc chose a tiny contribution
24299 for @expr{x^2}. (The fact that it's not exactly zero is due only
24300 to roundoff error. Since our data are exact integers, we could get
24301 an exact answer by typing @kbd{m f} first to get Fraction mode.
24302 Then the @expr{x^2} term would vanish altogether. Usually, though,
24303 the data being fitted will be approximate floats so Fraction mode
24304 won't help.)
24305
24306 Doing the @kbd{a F 2} fit on the data set with 14 instead of 13
24307 gives a much larger @expr{x^2} contribution, as Calc bends the
24308 line slightly to improve the fit.
24309
24310 @example
24311 0.142857142855 x^2 + 1.34285714287 x + 3.59999999998
24312 @end example
24313
24314 An important result from the theory of polynomial fitting is that it
24315 is always possible to fit @var{n} data points exactly using a polynomial
24316 of degree @mathit{@var{n}-1}, sometimes called an @dfn{interpolating polynomial}.
24317 Using the modified (14) data matrix, a model number of 4 gives
24318 a polynomial that exactly matches all five data points:
24319
24320 @example
24321 0.04167 x^4 - 0.4167 x^3 + 1.458 x^2 - 0.08333 x + 4.
24322 @end example
24323
24324 The actual coefficients we get with a precision of 12, like
24325 @expr{0.0416666663588}, clearly suffer from loss of precision.
24326 It is a good idea to increase the working precision to several
24327 digits beyond what you need when you do a fitting operation.
24328 Or, if your data are exact, use Fraction mode to get exact
24329 results.
24330
24331 You can type @kbd{i} instead of a digit at the model prompt to fit
24332 the data exactly to a polynomial. This just counts the number of
24333 columns of the data matrix to choose the degree of the polynomial
24334 automatically.
24335
24336 Fitting data ``exactly'' to high-degree polynomials is not always
24337 a good idea, though. High-degree polynomials have a tendency to
24338 wiggle uncontrollably in between the fitting data points. Also,
24339 if the exact-fit polynomial is going to be used to interpolate or
24340 extrapolate the data, it is numerically better to use the @kbd{a p}
24341 command described below. @xref{Interpolation}.
24342
24343 @tex
24344 \bigskip
24345 @end tex
24346
24347 Another generalization of the linear model is to assume the
24348 @expr{y} values are a sum of linear contributions from several
24349 @expr{x} values. This is a @dfn{multilinear} fit, and it is also
24350 selected by the @kbd{1} digit key. (Calc decides whether the fit
24351 is linear or multilinear by counting the rows in the data matrix.)
24352
24353 Given the data matrix,
24354
24355 @example
24356 @group
24357 [ [ 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 ]
24358 [ 7, 2, 3, 5, 2 ]
24359 [ 14.5, 15, 18.5, 22.5, 24 ] ]
24360 @end group
24361 @end example
24362
24363 @noindent
24364 the command @kbd{a F 1 @key{RET}} will call the first row @expr{x} and the
24365 second row @expr{y}, and will fit the values in the third row to the
24366 model @expr{a + b x + c y}.
24367
24368 @example
24369 8. + 3. x + 0.5 y
24370 @end example
24371
24372 Calc can do multilinear fits with any number of independent variables
24373 (i.e., with any number of data rows).
24374
24375 @tex
24376 \bigskip
24377 @end tex
24378
24379 Yet another variation is @dfn{homogeneous} linear models, in which
24380 the constant term is known to be zero. In the linear case, this
24381 means the model formula is simply @expr{a x}; in the multilinear
24382 case, the model might be @expr{a x + b y + c z}; and in the polynomial
24383 case, the model could be @expr{a x + b x^2 + c x^3}. You can get
24384 a homogeneous linear or multilinear model by pressing the letter
24385 @kbd{h} followed by a regular model key, like @kbd{1} or @kbd{2}.
24386 This will be indicated by an ``h'' in the minibuffer after the help
24387 message.
24388
24389 It is certainly possible to have other constrained linear models,
24390 like @expr{2.3 + a x} or @expr{a - 4 x}. While there is no single
24391 key to select models like these, a later section shows how to enter
24392 any desired model by hand. In the first case, for example, you
24393 would enter @kbd{a F ' 2.3 + a x}.
24394
24395 Another class of models that will work but must be entered by hand
24396 are multinomial fits, e.g., @expr{a + b x + c y + d x^2 + e y^2 + f x y}.
24397
24398 @node Error Estimates for Fits, Standard Nonlinear Models, Polynomial and Multilinear Fits, Curve Fitting
24399 @subsection Error Estimates for Fits
24400
24401 @noindent
24402 @kindex H a F
24403 @tindex efit
24404 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H a F} [@code{efit}] performs the same
24405 fitting operation as @kbd{a F}, but reports the coefficients as error
24406 forms instead of plain numbers. Fitting our two data matrices (first
24407 with 13, then with 14) to a line with @kbd{H a F} gives the results,
24408
24409 @example
24410 3. + 2. x
24411 2.6 +/- 0.382970843103 + 2.2 +/- 0.115470053838 x
24412 @end example
24413
24414 In the first case the estimated errors are zero because the linear
24415 fit is perfect. In the second case, the errors are nonzero but
24416 moderately small, because the data are still very close to linear.
24417
24418 It is also possible for the @emph{input} to a fitting operation to
24419 contain error forms. The data values must either all include errors
24420 or all be plain numbers. Error forms can go anywhere but generally
24421 go on the numbers in the last row of the data matrix. If the last
24422 row contains error forms
24423 @texline `@var{y_i}@w{ @tfn{+/-} }@math{\sigma_i}',
24424 @infoline `@var{y_i}@w{ @tfn{+/-} }@var{sigma_i}',
24425 then the
24426 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24427 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24428 statistic is now,
24429
24430 @ifnottex
24431 @example
24432 chi^2 = sum(((y_i - (a + b x_i)) / sigma_i)^2, i, 1, N)
24433 @end example
24434 @end ifnottex
24435 @tex
24436 \turnoffactive
24437 \beforedisplay
24438 $$ \chi^2 = \sum_{i=1}^N \left(y_i - (a + b x_i) \over \sigma_i\right)^2 $$
24439 \afterdisplay
24440 @end tex
24441
24442 @noindent
24443 so that data points with larger error estimates contribute less to
24444 the fitting operation.
24445
24446 If there are error forms on other rows of the data matrix, all the
24447 errors for a given data point are combined; the square root of the
24448 sum of the squares of the errors forms the
24449 @texline @math{\sigma_i}
24450 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}
24451 used for the data point.
24452
24453 Both @kbd{a F} and @kbd{H a F} can accept error forms in the input
24454 matrix, although if you are concerned about error analysis you will
24455 probably use @kbd{H a F} so that the output also contains error
24456 estimates.
24457
24458 If the input contains error forms but all the
24459 @texline @math{\sigma_i}
24460 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}
24461 values are the same, it is easy to see that the resulting fitted model
24462 will be the same as if the input did not have error forms at all
24463 @texline (@math{\chi^2}
24464 @infoline (@expr{chi^2}
24465 is simply scaled uniformly by
24466 @texline @math{1 / \sigma^2},
24467 @infoline @expr{1 / sigma^2},
24468 which doesn't affect where it has a minimum). But there @emph{will} be
24469 a difference in the estimated errors of the coefficients reported by
24470 @kbd{H a F}.
24471
24472 Consult any text on statistical modeling of data for a discussion
24473 of where these error estimates come from and how they should be
24474 interpreted.
24475
24476 @tex
24477 \bigskip
24478 @end tex
24479
24480 @kindex I a F
24481 @tindex xfit
24482 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I a F} [@code{xfit}] produces even more
24483 information. The result is a vector of six items:
24484
24485 @enumerate
24486 @item
24487 The model formula with error forms for its coefficients or
24488 parameters. This is the result that @kbd{H a F} would have
24489 produced.
24490
24491 @item
24492 A vector of ``raw'' parameter values for the model. These are the
24493 polynomial coefficients or other parameters as plain numbers, in the
24494 same order as the parameters appeared in the final prompt of the
24495 @kbd{I a F} command. For polynomials of degree @expr{d}, this vector
24496 will have length @expr{M = d+1} with the constant term first.
24497
24498 @item
24499 The covariance matrix @expr{C} computed from the fit. This is
24500 an @var{m}x@var{m} symmetric matrix; the diagonal elements
24501 @texline @math{C_{jj}}
24502 @infoline @expr{C_j_j}
24503 are the variances
24504 @texline @math{\sigma_j^2}
24505 @infoline @expr{sigma_j^2}
24506 of the parameters. The other elements are covariances
24507 @texline @math{\sigma_{ij}^2}
24508 @infoline @expr{sigma_i_j^2}
24509 that describe the correlation between pairs of parameters. (A related
24510 set of numbers, the @dfn{linear correlation coefficients}
24511 @texline @math{r_{ij}},
24512 @infoline @expr{r_i_j},
24513 are defined as
24514 @texline @math{\sigma_{ij}^2 / \sigma_i \, \sigma_j}.)
24515 @infoline @expr{sigma_i_j^2 / sigma_i sigma_j}.)
24516
24517 @item
24518 A vector of @expr{M} ``parameter filter'' functions whose
24519 meanings are described below. If no filters are necessary this
24520 will instead be an empty vector; this is always the case for the
24521 polynomial and multilinear fits described so far.
24522
24523 @item
24524 The value of
24525 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24526 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24527 for the fit, calculated by the formulas shown above. This gives a
24528 measure of the quality of the fit; statisticians consider
24529 @texline @math{\chi^2 \approx N - M}
24530 @infoline @expr{chi^2 = N - M}
24531 to indicate a moderately good fit (where again @expr{N} is the number of
24532 data points and @expr{M} is the number of parameters).
24533
24534 @item
24535 A measure of goodness of fit expressed as a probability @expr{Q}.
24536 This is computed from the @code{utpc} probability distribution
24537 function using
24538 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24539 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24540 with @expr{N - M} degrees of freedom. A
24541 value of 0.5 implies a good fit; some texts recommend that often
24542 @expr{Q = 0.1} or even 0.001 can signify an acceptable fit. In
24543 particular,
24544 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24545 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24546 statistics assume the errors in your inputs
24547 follow a normal (Gaussian) distribution; if they don't, you may
24548 have to accept smaller values of @expr{Q}.
24549
24550 The @expr{Q} value is computed only if the input included error
24551 estimates. Otherwise, Calc will report the symbol @code{nan}
24552 for @expr{Q}. The reason is that in this case the
24553 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24554 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24555 value has effectively been used to estimate the original errors
24556 in the input, and thus there is no redundant information left
24557 over to use for a confidence test.
24558 @end enumerate
24559
24560 @node Standard Nonlinear Models, Curve Fitting Details, Error Estimates for Fits, Curve Fitting
24561 @subsection Standard Nonlinear Models
24562
24563 @noindent
24564 The @kbd{a F} command also accepts other kinds of models besides
24565 lines and polynomials. Some common models have quick single-key
24566 abbreviations; others must be entered by hand as algebraic formulas.
24567
24568 Here is a complete list of the standard models recognized by @kbd{a F}:
24569
24570 @table @kbd
24571 @item 1
24572 Linear or multilinear. @mathit{a + b x + c y + d z}.
24573 @item 2-9
24574 Polynomials. @mathit{a + b x + c x^2 + d x^3}.
24575 @item e
24576 Exponential. @mathit{a} @tfn{exp}@mathit{(b x)} @tfn{exp}@mathit{(c y)}.
24577 @item E
24578 Base-10 exponential. @mathit{a} @tfn{10^}@mathit{(b x)} @tfn{10^}@mathit{(c y)}.
24579 @item x
24580 Exponential (alternate notation). @tfn{exp}@mathit{(a + b x + c y)}.
24581 @item X
24582 Base-10 exponential (alternate). @tfn{10^}@mathit{(a + b x + c y)}.
24583 @item l
24584 Logarithmic. @mathit{a + b} @tfn{ln}@mathit{(x) + c} @tfn{ln}@mathit{(y)}.
24585 @item L
24586 Base-10 logarithmic. @mathit{a + b} @tfn{log10}@mathit{(x) + c} @tfn{log10}@mathit{(y)}.
24587 @item ^
24588 General exponential. @mathit{a b^x c^y}.
24589 @item p
24590 Power law. @mathit{a x^b y^c}.
24591 @item q
24592 Quadratic. @mathit{a + b (x-c)^2 + d (x-e)^2}.
24593 @item g
24594 Gaussian.
24595 @texline @math{{a \over b \sqrt{2 \pi}} \exp\left( -{1 \over 2} \left( x - c \over b \right)^2 \right)}.
24596 @infoline @mathit{(a / b sqrt(2 pi)) exp(-0.5*((x-c)/b)^2)}.
24597 @item s
24598 Logistic @emph{s} curve.
24599 @texline @math{a/(1+e^{b(x-c)})}.
24600 @infoline @mathit{a/(1 + exp(b (x - c)))}.
24601 @item b
24602 Logistic bell curve.
24603 @texline @math{ae^{b(x-c)}/(1+e^{b(x-c)})^2}.
24604 @infoline @mathit{a exp(b (x - c))/(1 + exp(b (x - c)))^2}.
24605 @item o
24606 Hubbert linearization.
24607 @texline @math{{y \over x} = a(1-x/b)}.
24608 @infoline @mathit{(y/x) = a (1 - x/b)}.
24609 @end table
24610
24611 All of these models are used in the usual way; just press the appropriate
24612 letter at the model prompt, and choose variable names if you wish. The
24613 result will be a formula as shown in the above table, with the best-fit
24614 values of the parameters substituted. (You may find it easier to read
24615 the parameter values from the vector that is placed in the trail.)
24616
24617 All models except Gaussian, logistics, Hubbert and polynomials can
24618 generalize as shown to any number of independent variables. Also, all
24619 the built-in models except for the logistic and Hubbert curves have an
24620 additive or multiplicative parameter shown as @expr{a} in the above table
24621 which can be replaced by zero or one, as appropriate, by typing @kbd{h}
24622 before the model key.
24623
24624 Note that many of these models are essentially equivalent, but express
24625 the parameters slightly differently. For example, @expr{a b^x} and
24626 the other two exponential models are all algebraic rearrangements of
24627 each other. Also, the ``quadratic'' model is just a degree-2 polynomial
24628 with the parameters expressed differently. Use whichever form best
24629 matches the problem.
24630
24631 The HP-28/48 calculators support four different models for curve
24632 fitting, called @code{LIN}, @code{LOG}, @code{EXP}, and @code{PWR}.
24633 These correspond to Calc models @samp{a + b x}, @samp{a + b ln(x)},
24634 @samp{a exp(b x)}, and @samp{a x^b}, respectively. In each case,
24635 @expr{a} is what the HP-48 identifies as the ``intercept,'' and
24636 @expr{b} is what it calls the ``slope.''
24637
24638 @tex
24639 \bigskip
24640 @end tex
24641
24642 If the model you want doesn't appear on this list, press @kbd{'}
24643 (the apostrophe key) at the model prompt to enter any algebraic
24644 formula, such as @kbd{m x - b}, as the model. (Not all models
24645 will work, though---see the next section for details.)
24646
24647 The model can also be an equation like @expr{y = m x + b}.
24648 In this case, Calc thinks of all the rows of the data matrix on
24649 equal terms; this model effectively has two parameters
24650 (@expr{m} and @expr{b}) and two independent variables (@expr{x}
24651 and @expr{y}), with no ``dependent'' variables. Model equations
24652 do not need to take this @expr{y =} form. For example, the
24653 implicit line equation @expr{a x + b y = 1} works fine as a
24654 model.
24655
24656 When you enter a model, Calc makes an alphabetical list of all
24657 the variables that appear in the model. These are used for the
24658 default parameters, independent variables, and dependent variable
24659 (in that order). If you enter a plain formula (not an equation),
24660 Calc assumes the dependent variable does not appear in the formula
24661 and thus does not need a name.
24662
24663 For example, if the model formula has the variables @expr{a,mu,sigma,t,x},
24664 and the data matrix has three rows (meaning two independent variables),
24665 Calc will use @expr{a,mu,sigma} as the default parameters, and the
24666 data rows will be named @expr{t} and @expr{x}, respectively. If you
24667 enter an equation instead of a plain formula, Calc will use @expr{a,mu}
24668 as the parameters, and @expr{sigma,t,x} as the three independent
24669 variables.
24670
24671 You can, of course, override these choices by entering something
24672 different at the prompt. If you leave some variables out of the list,
24673 those variables must have stored values and those stored values will
24674 be used as constants in the model. (Stored values for the parameters
24675 and independent variables are ignored by the @kbd{a F} command.)
24676 If you list only independent variables, all the remaining variables
24677 in the model formula will become parameters.
24678
24679 If there are @kbd{$} signs in the model you type, they will stand
24680 for parameters and all other variables (in alphabetical order)
24681 will be independent. Use @kbd{$} for one parameter, @kbd{$$} for
24682 another, and so on. Thus @kbd{$ x + $$} is another way to describe
24683 a linear model.
24684
24685 If you type a @kbd{$} instead of @kbd{'} at the model prompt itself,
24686 Calc will take the model formula from the stack. (The data must then
24687 appear at the second stack level.) The same conventions are used to
24688 choose which variables in the formula are independent by default and
24689 which are parameters.
24690
24691 Models taken from the stack can also be expressed as vectors of
24692 two or three elements, @expr{[@var{model}, @var{vars}]} or
24693 @expr{[@var{model}, @var{vars}, @var{params}]}. Each of @var{vars}
24694 and @var{params} may be either a variable or a vector of variables.
24695 (If @var{params} is omitted, all variables in @var{model} except
24696 those listed as @var{vars} are parameters.)
24697
24698 When you enter a model manually with @kbd{'}, Calc puts a 3-vector
24699 describing the model in the trail so you can get it back if you wish.
24700
24701 @tex
24702 \bigskip
24703 @end tex
24704
24705 @vindex Model1
24706 @vindex Model2
24707 Finally, you can store a model in one of the Calc variables
24708 @code{Model1} or @code{Model2}, then use this model by typing
24709 @kbd{a F u} or @kbd{a F U} (respectively). The value stored in
24710 the variable can be any of the formats that @kbd{a F $} would
24711 accept for a model on the stack.
24712
24713 @tex
24714 \bigskip
24715 @end tex
24716
24717 Calc uses the principal values of inverse functions like @code{ln}
24718 and @code{arcsin} when doing fits. For example, when you enter
24719 the model @samp{y = sin(a t + b)} Calc actually uses the easier
24720 form @samp{arcsin(y) = a t + b}. The @code{arcsin} function always
24721 returns results in the range from @mathit{-90} to 90 degrees (or the
24722 equivalent range in radians). Suppose you had data that you
24723 believed to represent roughly three oscillations of a sine wave,
24724 so that the argument of the sine might go from zero to
24725 @texline @math{3\times360}
24726 @infoline @mathit{3*360}
24727 degrees.
24728 The above model would appear to be a good way to determine the
24729 true frequency and phase of the sine wave, but in practice it
24730 would fail utterly. The righthand side of the actual model
24731 @samp{arcsin(y) = a t + b} will grow smoothly with @expr{t}, but
24732 the lefthand side will bounce back and forth between @mathit{-90} and 90.
24733 No values of @expr{a} and @expr{b} can make the two sides match,
24734 even approximately.
24735
24736 There is no good solution to this problem at present. You could
24737 restrict your data to small enough ranges so that the above problem
24738 doesn't occur (i.e., not straddling any peaks in the sine wave).
24739 Or, in this case, you could use a totally different method such as
24740 Fourier analysis, which is beyond the scope of the @kbd{a F} command.
24741 (Unfortunately, Calc does not currently have any facilities for
24742 taking Fourier and related transforms.)
24743
24744 @node Curve Fitting Details, Interpolation, Standard Nonlinear Models, Curve Fitting
24745 @subsection Curve Fitting Details
24746
24747 @noindent
24748 Calc's internal least-squares fitter can only handle multilinear
24749 models. More precisely, it can handle any model of the form
24750 @expr{a f(x,y,z) + b g(x,y,z) + c h(x,y,z)}, where @expr{a,b,c}
24751 are the parameters and @expr{x,y,z} are the independent variables
24752 (of course there can be any number of each, not just three).
24753
24754 In a simple multilinear or polynomial fit, it is easy to see how
24755 to convert the model into this form. For example, if the model
24756 is @expr{a + b x + c x^2}, then @expr{f(x) = 1}, @expr{g(x) = x},
24757 and @expr{h(x) = x^2} are suitable functions.
24758
24759 For most other models, Calc uses a variety of algebraic manipulations
24760 to try to put the problem into the form
24761
24762 @smallexample
24763 Y(x,y,z) = A(a,b,c) F(x,y,z) + B(a,b,c) G(x,y,z) + C(a,b,c) H(x,y,z)
24764 @end smallexample
24765
24766 @noindent
24767 where @expr{Y,A,B,C,F,G,H} are arbitrary functions. It computes
24768 @expr{Y}, @expr{F}, @expr{G}, and @expr{H} for all the data points,
24769 does a standard linear fit to find the values of @expr{A}, @expr{B},
24770 and @expr{C}, then uses the equation solver to solve for @expr{a,b,c}
24771 in terms of @expr{A,B,C}.
24772
24773 A remarkable number of models can be cast into this general form.
24774 We'll look at two examples here to see how it works. The power-law
24775 model @expr{y = a x^b} with two independent variables and two parameters
24776 can be rewritten as follows:
24777
24778 @example
24779 y = a x^b
24780 y = a exp(b ln(x))
24781 y = exp(ln(a) + b ln(x))
24782 ln(y) = ln(a) + b ln(x)
24783 @end example
24784
24785 @noindent
24786 which matches the desired form with
24787 @texline @math{Y = \ln(y)},
24788 @infoline @expr{Y = ln(y)},
24789 @texline @math{A = \ln(a)},
24790 @infoline @expr{A = ln(a)},
24791 @expr{F = 1}, @expr{B = b}, and
24792 @texline @math{G = \ln(x)}.
24793 @infoline @expr{G = ln(x)}.
24794 Calc thus computes the logarithms of your @expr{y} and @expr{x} values,
24795 does a linear fit for @expr{A} and @expr{B}, then solves to get
24796 @texline @math{a = \exp(A)}
24797 @infoline @expr{a = exp(A)}
24798 and @expr{b = B}.
24799
24800 Another interesting example is the ``quadratic'' model, which can
24801 be handled by expanding according to the distributive law.
24802
24803 @example
24804 y = a + b*(x - c)^2
24805 y = a + b c^2 - 2 b c x + b x^2
24806 @end example
24807
24808 @noindent
24809 which matches with @expr{Y = y}, @expr{A = a + b c^2}, @expr{F = 1},
24810 @expr{B = -2 b c}, @expr{G = x} (the @mathit{-2} factor could just as easily
24811 have been put into @expr{G} instead of @expr{B}), @expr{C = b}, and
24812 @expr{H = x^2}.
24813
24814 The Gaussian model looks quite complicated, but a closer examination
24815 shows that it's actually similar to the quadratic model but with an
24816 exponential that can be brought to the top and moved into @expr{Y}.
24817
24818 The logistic models cannot be put into general linear form. For these
24819 models, and the Hubbert linearization, Calc computes a rough
24820 approximation for the parameters, then uses the Levenberg-Marquardt
24821 iterative method to refine the approximations.
24822
24823 Another model that cannot be put into general linear
24824 form is a Gaussian with a constant background added on, i.e.,
24825 @expr{d} + the regular Gaussian formula. If you have a model like
24826 this, your best bet is to replace enough of your parameters with
24827 constants to make the model linearizable, then adjust the constants
24828 manually by doing a series of fits. You can compare the fits by
24829 graphing them, by examining the goodness-of-fit measures returned by
24830 @kbd{I a F}, or by some other method suitable to your application.
24831 Note that some models can be linearized in several ways. The
24832 Gaussian-plus-@var{d} model can be linearized by setting @expr{d}
24833 (the background) to a constant, or by setting @expr{b} (the standard
24834 deviation) and @expr{c} (the mean) to constants.
24835
24836 To fit a model with constants substituted for some parameters, just
24837 store suitable values in those parameter variables, then omit them
24838 from the list of parameters when you answer the variables prompt.
24839
24840 @tex
24841 \bigskip
24842 @end tex
24843
24844 A last desperate step would be to use the general-purpose
24845 @code{minimize} function rather than @code{fit}. After all, both
24846 functions solve the problem of minimizing an expression (the
24847 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24848 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24849 sum) by adjusting certain parameters in the expression. The @kbd{a F}
24850 command is able to use a vastly more efficient algorithm due to its
24851 special knowledge about linear chi-square sums, but the @kbd{a N}
24852 command can do the same thing by brute force.
24853
24854 A compromise would be to pick out a few parameters without which the
24855 fit is linearizable, and use @code{minimize} on a call to @code{fit}
24856 which efficiently takes care of the rest of the parameters. The thing
24857 to be minimized would be the value of
24858 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24859 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24860 returned as the fifth result of the @code{xfit} function:
24861
24862 @smallexample
24863 minimize(xfit(gaus(a,b,c,d,x), x, [a,b,c], data)_5, d, guess)
24864 @end smallexample
24865
24866 @noindent
24867 where @code{gaus} represents the Gaussian model with background,
24868 @code{data} represents the data matrix, and @code{guess} represents
24869 the initial guess for @expr{d} that @code{minimize} requires.
24870 This operation will only be, shall we say, extraordinarily slow
24871 rather than astronomically slow (as would be the case if @code{minimize}
24872 were used by itself to solve the problem).
24873
24874 @tex
24875 \bigskip
24876 @end tex
24877
24878 The @kbd{I a F} [@code{xfit}] command is somewhat trickier when
24879 nonlinear models are used. The second item in the result is the
24880 vector of ``raw'' parameters @expr{A}, @expr{B}, @expr{C}. The
24881 covariance matrix is written in terms of those raw parameters.
24882 The fifth item is a vector of @dfn{filter} expressions. This
24883 is the empty vector @samp{[]} if the raw parameters were the same
24884 as the requested parameters, i.e., if @expr{A = a}, @expr{B = b},
24885 and so on (which is always true if the model is already linear
24886 in the parameters as written, e.g., for polynomial fits). If the
24887 parameters had to be rearranged, the fifth item is instead a vector
24888 of one formula per parameter in the original model. The raw
24889 parameters are expressed in these ``filter'' formulas as
24890 @samp{fitdummy(1)} for @expr{A}, @samp{fitdummy(2)} for @expr{B},
24891 and so on.
24892
24893 When Calc needs to modify the model to return the result, it replaces
24894 @samp{fitdummy(1)} in all the filters with the first item in the raw
24895 parameters list, and so on for the other raw parameters, then
24896 evaluates the resulting filter formulas to get the actual parameter
24897 values to be substituted into the original model. In the case of
24898 @kbd{H a F} and @kbd{I a F} where the parameters must be error forms,
24899 Calc uses the square roots of the diagonal entries of the covariance
24900 matrix as error values for the raw parameters, then lets Calc's
24901 standard error-form arithmetic take it from there.
24902
24903 If you use @kbd{I a F} with a nonlinear model, be sure to remember
24904 that the covariance matrix is in terms of the raw parameters,
24905 @emph{not} the actual requested parameters. It's up to you to
24906 figure out how to interpret the covariances in the presence of
24907 nontrivial filter functions.
24908
24909 Things are also complicated when the input contains error forms.
24910 Suppose there are three independent and dependent variables, @expr{x},
24911 @expr{y}, and @expr{z}, one or more of which are error forms in the
24912 data. Calc combines all the error values by taking the square root
24913 of the sum of the squares of the errors. It then changes @expr{x}
24914 and @expr{y} to be plain numbers, and makes @expr{z} into an error
24915 form with this combined error. The @expr{Y(x,y,z)} part of the
24916 linearized model is evaluated, and the result should be an error
24917 form. The error part of that result is used for
24918 @texline @math{\sigma_i}
24919 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}
24920 for the data point. If for some reason @expr{Y(x,y,z)} does not return
24921 an error form, the combined error from @expr{z} is used directly for
24922 @texline @math{\sigma_i}.
24923 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}.
24924 Finally, @expr{z} is also stripped of its error
24925 for use in computing @expr{F(x,y,z)}, @expr{G(x,y,z)} and so on;
24926 the righthand side of the linearized model is computed in regular
24927 arithmetic with no error forms.
24928
24929 (While these rules may seem complicated, they are designed to do
24930 the most reasonable thing in the typical case that @expr{Y(x,y,z)}
24931 depends only on the dependent variable @expr{z}, and in fact is
24932 often simply equal to @expr{z}. For common cases like polynomials
24933 and multilinear models, the combined error is simply used as the
24934 @texline @math{\sigma}
24935 @infoline @expr{sigma}
24936 for the data point with no further ado.)
24937
24938 @tex
24939 \bigskip
24940 @end tex
24941
24942 @vindex FitRules
24943 It may be the case that the model you wish to use is linearizable,
24944 but Calc's built-in rules are unable to figure it out. Calc uses
24945 its algebraic rewrite mechanism to linearize a model. The rewrite
24946 rules are kept in the variable @code{FitRules}. You can edit this
24947 variable using the @kbd{s e FitRules} command; in fact, there is
24948 a special @kbd{s F} command just for editing @code{FitRules}.
24949 @xref{Operations on Variables}.
24950
24951 @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for a discussion of rewrite rules.
24952
24953 @ignore
24954 @starindex
24955 @end ignore
24956 @tindex fitvar
24957 @ignore
24958 @starindex
24959 @end ignore
24960 @ignore
24961 @mindex @idots
24962 @end ignore
24963 @tindex fitparam
24964 @ignore
24965 @starindex
24966 @end ignore
24967 @ignore
24968 @mindex @null
24969 @end ignore
24970 @tindex fitmodel
24971 @ignore
24972 @starindex
24973 @end ignore
24974 @ignore
24975 @mindex @null
24976 @end ignore
24977 @tindex fitsystem
24978 @ignore
24979 @starindex
24980 @end ignore
24981 @ignore
24982 @mindex @null
24983 @end ignore
24984 @tindex fitdummy
24985 Calc uses @code{FitRules} as follows. First, it converts the model
24986 to an equation if necessary and encloses the model equation in a
24987 call to the function @code{fitmodel} (which is not actually a defined
24988 function in Calc; it is only used as a placeholder by the rewrite rules).
24989 Parameter variables are renamed to function calls @samp{fitparam(1)},
24990 @samp{fitparam(2)}, and so on, and independent variables are renamed
24991 to @samp{fitvar(1)}, @samp{fitvar(2)}, etc. The dependent variable
24992 is the highest-numbered @code{fitvar}. For example, the power law
24993 model @expr{a x^b} is converted to @expr{y = a x^b}, then to
24994
24995 @smallexample
24996 @group
24997 fitmodel(fitvar(2) = fitparam(1) fitvar(1)^fitparam(2))
24998 @end group
24999 @end smallexample
25000
25001 Calc then applies the rewrites as if by @samp{C-u 0 a r FitRules}.
25002 (The zero prefix means that rewriting should continue until no further
25003 changes are possible.)
25004
25005 When rewriting is complete, the @code{fitmodel} call should have
25006 been replaced by a @code{fitsystem} call that looks like this:
25007
25008 @example
25009 fitsystem(@var{Y}, @var{FGH}, @var{abc})
25010 @end example
25011
25012 @noindent
25013 where @var{Y} is a formula that describes the function @expr{Y(x,y,z)},
25014 @var{FGH} is the vector of formulas @expr{[F(x,y,z), G(x,y,z), H(x,y,z)]},
25015 and @var{abc} is the vector of parameter filters which refer to the
25016 raw parameters as @samp{fitdummy(1)} for @expr{A}, @samp{fitdummy(2)}
25017 for @expr{B}, etc. While the number of raw parameters (the length of
25018 the @var{FGH} vector) is usually the same as the number of original
25019 parameters (the length of the @var{abc} vector), this is not required.
25020
25021 The power law model eventually boils down to
25022
25023 @smallexample
25024 @group
25025 fitsystem(ln(fitvar(2)),
25026 [1, ln(fitvar(1))],
25027 [exp(fitdummy(1)), fitdummy(2)])
25028 @end group
25029 @end smallexample
25030
25031 The actual implementation of @code{FitRules} is complicated; it
25032 proceeds in four phases. First, common rearrangements are done
25033 to try to bring linear terms together and to isolate functions like
25034 @code{exp} and @code{ln} either all the way ``out'' (so that they
25035 can be put into @var{Y}) or all the way ``in'' (so that they can
25036 be put into @var{abc} or @var{FGH}). In particular, all
25037 non-constant powers are converted to logs-and-exponentials form,
25038 and the distributive law is used to expand products of sums.
25039 Quotients are rewritten to use the @samp{fitinv} function, where
25040 @samp{fitinv(x)} represents @expr{1/x} while the @code{FitRules}
25041 are operating. (The use of @code{fitinv} makes recognition of
25042 linear-looking forms easier.) If you modify @code{FitRules}, you
25043 will probably only need to modify the rules for this phase.
25044
25045 Phase two, whose rules can actually also apply during phases one
25046 and three, first rewrites @code{fitmodel} to a two-argument
25047 form @samp{fitmodel(@var{Y}, @var{model})}, where @var{Y} is
25048 initially zero and @var{model} has been changed from @expr{a=b}
25049 to @expr{a-b} form. It then tries to peel off invertible functions
25050 from the outside of @var{model} and put them into @var{Y} instead,
25051 calling the equation solver to invert the functions. Finally, when
25052 this is no longer possible, the @code{fitmodel} is changed to a
25053 four-argument @code{fitsystem}, where the fourth argument is
25054 @var{model} and the @var{FGH} and @var{abc} vectors are initially
25055 empty. (The last vector is really @var{ABC}, corresponding to
25056 raw parameters, for now.)
25057
25058 Phase three converts a sum of items in the @var{model} to a sum
25059 of @samp{fitpart(@var{a}, @var{b}, @var{c})} terms which represent
25060 terms @samp{@var{a}*@var{b}*@var{c}} of the sum, where @var{a}
25061 is all factors that do not involve any variables, @var{b} is all
25062 factors that involve only parameters, and @var{c} is the factors
25063 that involve only independent variables. (If this decomposition
25064 is not possible, the rule set will not complete and Calc will
25065 complain that the model is too complex.) Then @code{fitpart}s
25066 with equal @var{b} or @var{c} components are merged back together
25067 using the distributive law in order to minimize the number of
25068 raw parameters needed.
25069
25070 Phase four moves the @code{fitpart} terms into the @var{FGH} and
25071 @var{ABC} vectors. Also, some of the algebraic expansions that
25072 were done in phase 1 are undone now to make the formulas more
25073 computationally efficient. Finally, it calls the solver one more
25074 time to convert the @var{ABC} vector to an @var{abc} vector, and
25075 removes the fourth @var{model} argument (which by now will be zero)
25076 to obtain the three-argument @code{fitsystem} that the linear
25077 least-squares solver wants to see.
25078
25079 @ignore
25080 @starindex
25081 @end ignore
25082 @ignore
25083 @mindex hasfit@idots
25084 @end ignore
25085 @tindex hasfitparams
25086 @ignore
25087 @starindex
25088 @end ignore
25089 @ignore
25090 @mindex @null
25091 @end ignore
25092 @tindex hasfitvars
25093 Two functions which are useful in connection with @code{FitRules}
25094 are @samp{hasfitparams(x)} and @samp{hasfitvars(x)}, which check
25095 whether @expr{x} refers to any parameters or independent variables,
25096 respectively. Specifically, these functions return ``true'' if the
25097 argument contains any @code{fitparam} (or @code{fitvar}) function
25098 calls, and ``false'' otherwise. (Recall that ``true'' means a
25099 nonzero number, and ``false'' means zero. The actual nonzero number
25100 returned is the largest @var{n} from all the @samp{fitparam(@var{n})}s
25101 or @samp{fitvar(@var{n})}s, respectively, that appear in the formula.)
25102
25103 @tex
25104 \bigskip
25105 @end tex
25106
25107 The @code{fit} function in algebraic notation normally takes four
25108 arguments, @samp{fit(@var{model}, @var{vars}, @var{params}, @var{data})},
25109 where @var{model} is the model formula as it would be typed after
25110 @kbd{a F '}, @var{vars} is the independent variable or a vector of
25111 independent variables, @var{params} likewise gives the parameter(s),
25112 and @var{data} is the data matrix. Note that the length of @var{vars}
25113 must be equal to the number of rows in @var{data} if @var{model} is
25114 an equation, or one less than the number of rows if @var{model} is
25115 a plain formula. (Actually, a name for the dependent variable is
25116 allowed but will be ignored in the plain-formula case.)
25117
25118 If @var{params} is omitted, the parameters are all variables in
25119 @var{model} except those that appear in @var{vars}. If @var{vars}
25120 is also omitted, Calc sorts all the variables that appear in
25121 @var{model} alphabetically and uses the higher ones for @var{vars}
25122 and the lower ones for @var{params}.
25123
25124 Alternatively, @samp{fit(@var{modelvec}, @var{data})} is allowed
25125 where @var{modelvec} is a 2- or 3-vector describing the model
25126 and variables, as discussed previously.
25127
25128 If Calc is unable to do the fit, the @code{fit} function is left
25129 in symbolic form, ordinarily with an explanatory message. The
25130 message will be ``Model expression is too complex'' if the
25131 linearizer was unable to put the model into the required form.
25132
25133 The @code{efit} (corresponding to @kbd{H a F}) and @code{xfit}
25134 (for @kbd{I a F}) functions are completely analogous.
25135
25136 @node Interpolation, , Curve Fitting Details, Curve Fitting
25137 @subsection Polynomial Interpolation
25138
25139 @kindex a p
25140 @pindex calc-poly-interp
25141 @tindex polint
25142 The @kbd{a p} (@code{calc-poly-interp}) [@code{polint}] command does
25143 a polynomial interpolation at a particular @expr{x} value. It takes
25144 two arguments from the stack: A data matrix of the sort used by
25145 @kbd{a F}, and a single number which represents the desired @expr{x}
25146 value. Calc effectively does an exact polynomial fit as if by @kbd{a F i},
25147 then substitutes the @expr{x} value into the result in order to get an
25148 approximate @expr{y} value based on the fit. (Calc does not actually
25149 use @kbd{a F i}, however; it uses a direct method which is both more
25150 efficient and more numerically stable.)
25151
25152 The result of @kbd{a p} is actually a vector of two values: The @expr{y}
25153 value approximation, and an error measure @expr{dy} that reflects Calc's
25154 estimation of the probable error of the approximation at that value of
25155 @expr{x}. If the input @expr{x} is equal to any of the @expr{x} values
25156 in the data matrix, the output @expr{y} will be the corresponding @expr{y}
25157 value from the matrix, and the output @expr{dy} will be exactly zero.
25158
25159 A prefix argument of 2 causes @kbd{a p} to take separate x- and
25160 y-vectors from the stack instead of one data matrix.
25161
25162 If @expr{x} is a vector of numbers, @kbd{a p} will return a matrix of
25163 interpolated results for each of those @expr{x} values. (The matrix will
25164 have two columns, the @expr{y} values and the @expr{dy} values.)
25165 If @expr{x} is a formula instead of a number, the @code{polint} function
25166 remains in symbolic form; use the @kbd{a "} command to expand it out to
25167 a formula that describes the fit in symbolic terms.
25168
25169 In all cases, the @kbd{a p} command leaves the data vectors or matrix
25170 on the stack. Only the @expr{x} value is replaced by the result.
25171
25172 @kindex H a p
25173 @tindex ratint
25174 The @kbd{H a p} [@code{ratint}] command does a rational function
25175 interpolation. It is used exactly like @kbd{a p}, except that it
25176 uses as its model the quotient of two polynomials. If there are
25177 @expr{N} data points, the numerator and denominator polynomials will
25178 each have degree @expr{N/2} (if @expr{N} is odd, the denominator will
25179 have degree one higher than the numerator).
25180
25181 Rational approximations have the advantage that they can accurately
25182 describe functions that have poles (points at which the function's value
25183 goes to infinity, so that the denominator polynomial of the approximation
25184 goes to zero). If @expr{x} corresponds to a pole of the fitted rational
25185 function, then the result will be a division by zero. If Infinite mode
25186 is enabled, the result will be @samp{[uinf, uinf]}.
25187
25188 There is no way to get the actual coefficients of the rational function
25189 used by @kbd{H a p}. (The algorithm never generates these coefficients
25190 explicitly, and quotients of polynomials are beyond @w{@kbd{a F}}'s
25191 capabilities to fit.)
25192
25193 @node Summations, Logical Operations, Curve Fitting, Algebra
25194 @section Summations
25195
25196 @noindent
25197 @cindex Summation of a series
25198 @kindex a +
25199 @pindex calc-summation
25200 @tindex sum
25201 The @kbd{a +} (@code{calc-summation}) [@code{sum}] command computes
25202 the sum of a formula over a certain range of index values. The formula
25203 is taken from the top of the stack; the command prompts for the
25204 name of the summation index variable, the lower limit of the
25205 sum (any formula), and the upper limit of the sum. If you
25206 enter a blank line at any of these prompts, that prompt and
25207 any later ones are answered by reading additional elements from
25208 the stack. Thus, @kbd{' k^2 @key{RET} ' k @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} 5 @key{RET} a + @key{RET}}
25209 produces the result 55.
25210 @tex
25211 \turnoffactive
25212 $$ \sum_{k=1}^5 k^2 = 55 $$
25213 @end tex
25214
25215 The choice of index variable is arbitrary, but it's best not to
25216 use a variable with a stored value. In particular, while
25217 @code{i} is often a favorite index variable, it should be avoided
25218 in Calc because @code{i} has the imaginary constant @expr{(0, 1)}
25219 as a value. If you pressed @kbd{=} on a sum over @code{i}, it would
25220 be changed to a nonsensical sum over the ``variable'' @expr{(0, 1)}!
25221 If you really want to use @code{i} as an index variable, use
25222 @w{@kbd{s u i @key{RET}}} first to ``unstore'' this variable.
25223 (@xref{Storing Variables}.)
25224
25225 A numeric prefix argument steps the index by that amount rather
25226 than by one. Thus @kbd{' a_k @key{RET} C-u -2 a + k @key{RET} 10 @key{RET} 0 @key{RET}}
25227 yields @samp{a_10 + a_8 + a_6 + a_4 + a_2 + a_0}. A prefix
25228 argument of plain @kbd{C-u} causes @kbd{a +} to prompt for the
25229 step value, in which case you can enter any formula or enter
25230 a blank line to take the step value from the stack. With the
25231 @kbd{C-u} prefix, @kbd{a +} can take up to five arguments from
25232 the stack: The formula, the variable, the lower limit, the
25233 upper limit, and (at the top of the stack), the step value.
25234
25235 Calc knows how to do certain sums in closed form. For example,
25236 @samp{sum(6 k^2, k, 1, n) = @w{2 n^3} + 3 n^2 + n}. In particular,
25237 this is possible if the formula being summed is polynomial or
25238 exponential in the index variable. Sums of logarithms are
25239 transformed into logarithms of products. Sums of trigonometric
25240 and hyperbolic functions are transformed to sums of exponentials
25241 and then done in closed form. Also, of course, sums in which the
25242 lower and upper limits are both numbers can always be evaluated
25243 just by grinding them out, although Calc will use closed forms
25244 whenever it can for the sake of efficiency.
25245
25246 The notation for sums in algebraic formulas is
25247 @samp{sum(@var{expr}, @var{var}, @var{low}, @var{high}, @var{step})}.
25248 If @var{step} is omitted, it defaults to one. If @var{high} is
25249 omitted, @var{low} is actually the upper limit and the lower limit
25250 is one. If @var{low} is also omitted, the limits are @samp{-inf}
25251 and @samp{inf}, respectively.
25252
25253 Infinite sums can sometimes be evaluated: @samp{sum(.5^k, k, 1, inf)}
25254 returns @expr{1}. This is done by evaluating the sum in closed
25255 form (to @samp{1. - 0.5^n} in this case), then evaluating this
25256 formula with @code{n} set to @code{inf}. Calc's usual rules
25257 for ``infinite'' arithmetic can find the answer from there. If
25258 infinite arithmetic yields a @samp{nan}, or if the sum cannot be
25259 solved in closed form, Calc leaves the @code{sum} function in
25260 symbolic form. @xref{Infinities}.
25261
25262 As a special feature, if the limits are infinite (or omitted, as
25263 described above) but the formula includes vectors subscripted by
25264 expressions that involve the iteration variable, Calc narrows
25265 the limits to include only the range of integers which result in
25266 valid subscripts for the vector. For example, the sum
25267 @samp{sum(k [a,b,c,d,e,f,g]_(2k),k)} evaluates to @samp{b + 2 d + 3 f}.
25268
25269 The limits of a sum do not need to be integers. For example,
25270 @samp{sum(a_k, k, 0, 2 n, n)} produces @samp{a_0 + a_n + a_(2 n)}.
25271 Calc computes the number of iterations using the formula
25272 @samp{1 + (@var{high} - @var{low}) / @var{step}}, which must,
25273 after simplification as if by @kbd{a s}, evaluate to an integer.
25274
25275 If the number of iterations according to the above formula does
25276 not come out to an integer, the sum is invalid and will be left
25277 in symbolic form. However, closed forms are still supplied, and
25278 you are on your honor not to misuse the resulting formulas by
25279 substituting mismatched bounds into them. For example,
25280 @samp{sum(k, k, 1, 10, 2)} is invalid, but Calc will go ahead and
25281 evaluate the closed form solution for the limits 1 and 10 to get
25282 the rather dubious answer, 29.25.
25283
25284 If the lower limit is greater than the upper limit (assuming a
25285 positive step size), the result is generally zero. However,
25286 Calc only guarantees a zero result when the upper limit is
25287 exactly one step less than the lower limit, i.e., if the number
25288 of iterations is @mathit{-1}. Thus @samp{sum(f(k), k, n, n-1)} is zero
25289 but the sum from @samp{n} to @samp{n-2} may report a nonzero value
25290 if Calc used a closed form solution.
25291
25292 Calc's logical predicates like @expr{a < b} return 1 for ``true''
25293 and 0 for ``false.'' @xref{Logical Operations}. This can be
25294 used to advantage for building conditional sums. For example,
25295 @samp{sum(prime(k)*k^2, k, 1, 20)} is the sum of the squares of all
25296 prime numbers from 1 to 20; the @code{prime} predicate returns 1 if
25297 its argument is prime and 0 otherwise. You can read this expression
25298 as ``the sum of @expr{k^2}, where @expr{k} is prime.'' Indeed,
25299 @samp{sum(prime(k)*k^2, k)} would represent the sum of @emph{all} primes
25300 squared, since the limits default to plus and minus infinity, but
25301 there are no such sums that Calc's built-in rules can do in
25302 closed form.
25303
25304 As another example, @samp{sum((k != k_0) * f(k), k, 1, n)} is the
25305 sum of @expr{f(k)} for all @expr{k} from 1 to @expr{n}, excluding
25306 one value @expr{k_0}. Slightly more tricky is the summand
25307 @samp{(k != k_0) / (k - k_0)}, which is an attempt to describe
25308 the sum of all @expr{1/(k-k_0)} except at @expr{k = k_0}, where
25309 this would be a division by zero. But at @expr{k = k_0}, this
25310 formula works out to the indeterminate form @expr{0 / 0}, which
25311 Calc will not assume is zero. Better would be to use
25312 @samp{(k != k_0) ? 1/(k-k_0) : 0}; the @samp{? :} operator does
25313 an ``if-then-else'' test: This expression says, ``if
25314 @texline @math{k \ne k_0},
25315 @infoline @expr{k != k_0},
25316 then @expr{1/(k-k_0)}, else zero.'' Now the formula @expr{1/(k-k_0)}
25317 will not even be evaluated by Calc when @expr{k = k_0}.
25318
25319 @cindex Alternating sums
25320 @kindex a -
25321 @pindex calc-alt-summation
25322 @tindex asum
25323 The @kbd{a -} (@code{calc-alt-summation}) [@code{asum}] command
25324 computes an alternating sum. Successive terms of the sequence
25325 are given alternating signs, with the first term (corresponding
25326 to the lower index value) being positive. Alternating sums
25327 are converted to normal sums with an extra term of the form
25328 @samp{(-1)^(k-@var{low})}. This formula is adjusted appropriately
25329 if the step value is other than one. For example, the Taylor
25330 series for the sine function is @samp{asum(x^k / k!, k, 1, inf, 2)}.
25331 (Calc cannot evaluate this infinite series, but it can approximate
25332 it if you replace @code{inf} with any particular odd number.)
25333 Calc converts this series to a regular sum with a step of one,
25334 namely @samp{sum((-1)^k x^(2k+1) / (2k+1)!, k, 0, inf)}.
25335
25336 @cindex Product of a sequence
25337 @kindex a *
25338 @pindex calc-product
25339 @tindex prod
25340 The @kbd{a *} (@code{calc-product}) [@code{prod}] command is
25341 the analogous way to take a product of many terms. Calc also knows
25342 some closed forms for products, such as @samp{prod(k, k, 1, n) = n!}.
25343 Conditional products can be written @samp{prod(k^prime(k), k, 1, n)}
25344 or @samp{prod(prime(k) ? k : 1, k, 1, n)}.
25345
25346 @kindex a T
25347 @pindex calc-tabulate
25348 @tindex table
25349 The @kbd{a T} (@code{calc-tabulate}) [@code{table}] command
25350 evaluates a formula at a series of iterated index values, just
25351 like @code{sum} and @code{prod}, but its result is simply a
25352 vector of the results. For example, @samp{table(a_i, i, 1, 7, 2)}
25353 produces @samp{[a_1, a_3, a_5, a_7]}.
25354
25355 @node Logical Operations, Rewrite Rules, Summations, Algebra
25356 @section Logical Operations
25357
25358 @noindent
25359 The following commands and algebraic functions return true/false values,
25360 where 1 represents ``true'' and 0 represents ``false.'' In cases where
25361 a truth value is required (such as for the condition part of a rewrite
25362 rule, or as the condition for a @w{@kbd{Z [ Z ]}} control structure), any
25363 nonzero value is accepted to mean ``true.'' (Specifically, anything
25364 for which @code{dnonzero} returns 1 is ``true,'' and anything for
25365 which @code{dnonzero} returns 0 or cannot decide is assumed ``false.''
25366 Note that this means that @w{@kbd{Z [ Z ]}} will execute the ``then''
25367 portion if its condition is provably true, but it will execute the
25368 ``else'' portion for any condition like @expr{a = b} that is not
25369 provably true, even if it might be true. Algebraic functions that
25370 have conditions as arguments, like @code{? :} and @code{&&}, remain
25371 unevaluated if the condition is neither provably true nor provably
25372 false. @xref{Declarations}.)
25373
25374 @kindex a =
25375 @pindex calc-equal-to
25376 @tindex eq
25377 @tindex =
25378 @tindex ==
25379 The @kbd{a =} (@code{calc-equal-to}) command, or @samp{eq(a,b)} function
25380 (which can also be written @samp{a = b} or @samp{a == b} in an algebraic
25381 formula) is true if @expr{a} and @expr{b} are equal, either because they
25382 are identical expressions, or because they are numbers which are
25383 numerically equal. (Thus the integer 1 is considered equal to the float
25384 1.0.) If the equality of @expr{a} and @expr{b} cannot be determined,
25385 the comparison is left in symbolic form. Note that as a command, this
25386 operation pops two values from the stack and pushes back either a 1 or
25387 a 0, or a formula @samp{a = b} if the values' equality cannot be determined.
25388
25389 Many Calc commands use @samp{=} formulas to represent @dfn{equations}.
25390 For example, the @kbd{a S} (@code{calc-solve-for}) command rearranges
25391 an equation to solve for a given variable. The @kbd{a M}
25392 (@code{calc-map-equation}) command can be used to apply any
25393 function to both sides of an equation; for example, @kbd{2 a M *}
25394 multiplies both sides of the equation by two. Note that just
25395 @kbd{2 *} would not do the same thing; it would produce the formula
25396 @samp{2 (a = b)} which represents 2 if the equality is true or
25397 zero if not.
25398
25399 The @code{eq} function with more than two arguments (e.g., @kbd{C-u 3 a =}
25400 or @samp{a = b = c}) tests if all of its arguments are equal. In
25401 algebraic notation, the @samp{=} operator is unusual in that it is
25402 neither left- nor right-associative: @samp{a = b = c} is not the
25403 same as @samp{(a = b) = c} or @samp{a = (b = c)} (which each compare
25404 one variable with the 1 or 0 that results from comparing two other
25405 variables).
25406
25407 @kindex a #
25408 @pindex calc-not-equal-to
25409 @tindex neq
25410 @tindex !=
25411 The @kbd{a #} (@code{calc-not-equal-to}) command, or @samp{neq(a,b)} or
25412 @samp{a != b} function, is true if @expr{a} and @expr{b} are not equal.
25413 This also works with more than two arguments; @samp{a != b != c != d}
25414 tests that all four of @expr{a}, @expr{b}, @expr{c}, and @expr{d} are
25415 distinct numbers.
25416
25417 @kindex a <
25418 @tindex lt
25419 @ignore
25420 @mindex @idots
25421 @end ignore
25422 @kindex a >
25423 @ignore
25424 @mindex @null
25425 @end ignore
25426 @kindex a [
25427 @ignore
25428 @mindex @null
25429 @end ignore
25430 @kindex a ]
25431 @pindex calc-less-than
25432 @pindex calc-greater-than
25433 @pindex calc-less-equal
25434 @pindex calc-greater-equal
25435 @ignore
25436 @mindex @null
25437 @end ignore
25438 @tindex gt
25439 @ignore
25440 @mindex @null
25441 @end ignore
25442 @tindex leq
25443 @ignore
25444 @mindex @null
25445 @end ignore
25446 @tindex geq
25447 @ignore
25448 @mindex @null
25449 @end ignore
25450 @tindex <
25451 @ignore
25452 @mindex @null
25453 @end ignore
25454 @tindex >
25455 @ignore
25456 @mindex @null
25457 @end ignore
25458 @tindex <=
25459 @ignore
25460 @mindex @null
25461 @end ignore
25462 @tindex >=
25463 The @kbd{a <} (@code{calc-less-than}) [@samp{lt(a,b)} or @samp{a < b}]
25464 operation is true if @expr{a} is less than @expr{b}. Similar functions
25465 are @kbd{a >} (@code{calc-greater-than}) [@samp{gt(a,b)} or @samp{a > b}],
25466 @kbd{a [} (@code{calc-less-equal}) [@samp{leq(a,b)} or @samp{a <= b}], and
25467 @kbd{a ]} (@code{calc-greater-equal}) [@samp{geq(a,b)} or @samp{a >= b}].
25468
25469 While the inequality functions like @code{lt} do not accept more
25470 than two arguments, the syntax @w{@samp{a <= b < c}} is translated to an
25471 equivalent expression involving intervals: @samp{b in [a .. c)}.
25472 (See the description of @code{in} below.) All four combinations
25473 of @samp{<} and @samp{<=} are allowed, or any of the four combinations
25474 of @samp{>} and @samp{>=}. Four-argument constructions like
25475 @samp{a < b < c < d}, and mixtures like @w{@samp{a < b = c}} that
25476 involve both equalities and inequalities, are not allowed.
25477
25478 @kindex a .
25479 @pindex calc-remove-equal
25480 @tindex rmeq
25481 The @kbd{a .} (@code{calc-remove-equal}) [@code{rmeq}] command extracts
25482 the righthand side of the equation or inequality on the top of the
25483 stack. It also works elementwise on vectors. For example, if
25484 @samp{[x = 2.34, y = z / 2]} is on the stack, then @kbd{a .} produces
25485 @samp{[2.34, z / 2]}. As a special case, if the righthand side is a
25486 variable and the lefthand side is a number (as in @samp{2.34 = x}), then
25487 Calc keeps the lefthand side instead. Finally, this command works with
25488 assignments @samp{x := 2.34} as well as equations, always taking the
25489 righthand side, and for @samp{=>} (evaluates-to) operators, always
25490 taking the lefthand side.
25491
25492 @kindex a &
25493 @pindex calc-logical-and
25494 @tindex land
25495 @tindex &&
25496 The @kbd{a &} (@code{calc-logical-and}) [@samp{land(a,b)} or @samp{a && b}]
25497 function is true if both of its arguments are true, i.e., are
25498 non-zero numbers. In this case, the result will be either @expr{a} or
25499 @expr{b}, chosen arbitrarily. If either argument is zero, the result is
25500 zero. Otherwise, the formula is left in symbolic form.
25501
25502 @kindex a |
25503 @pindex calc-logical-or
25504 @tindex lor
25505 @tindex ||
25506 The @kbd{a |} (@code{calc-logical-or}) [@samp{lor(a,b)} or @samp{a || b}]
25507 function is true if either or both of its arguments are true (nonzero).
25508 The result is whichever argument was nonzero, choosing arbitrarily if both
25509 are nonzero. If both @expr{a} and @expr{b} are zero, the result is
25510 zero.
25511
25512 @kindex a !
25513 @pindex calc-logical-not
25514 @tindex lnot
25515 @tindex !
25516 The @kbd{a !} (@code{calc-logical-not}) [@samp{lnot(a)} or @samp{!@: a}]
25517 function is true if @expr{a} is false (zero), or false if @expr{a} is
25518 true (nonzero). It is left in symbolic form if @expr{a} is not a
25519 number.
25520
25521 @kindex a :
25522 @pindex calc-logical-if
25523 @tindex if
25524 @ignore
25525 @mindex ? :
25526 @end ignore
25527 @tindex ?
25528 @ignore
25529 @mindex @null
25530 @end ignore
25531 @tindex :
25532 @cindex Arguments, not evaluated
25533 The @kbd{a :} (@code{calc-logical-if}) [@samp{if(a,b,c)} or @samp{a ? b :@: c}]
25534 function is equal to either @expr{b} or @expr{c} if @expr{a} is a nonzero
25535 number or zero, respectively. If @expr{a} is not a number, the test is
25536 left in symbolic form and neither @expr{b} nor @expr{c} is evaluated in
25537 any way. In algebraic formulas, this is one of the few Calc functions
25538 whose arguments are not automatically evaluated when the function itself
25539 is evaluated. The others are @code{lambda}, @code{quote}, and
25540 @code{condition}.
25541
25542 One minor surprise to watch out for is that the formula @samp{a?3:4}
25543 will not work because the @samp{3:4} is parsed as a fraction instead of
25544 as three separate symbols. Type something like @samp{a ? 3 : 4} or
25545 @samp{a?(3):4} instead.
25546
25547 As a special case, if @expr{a} evaluates to a vector, then both @expr{b}
25548 and @expr{c} are evaluated; the result is a vector of the same length
25549 as @expr{a} whose elements are chosen from corresponding elements of
25550 @expr{b} and @expr{c} according to whether each element of @expr{a}
25551 is zero or nonzero. Each of @expr{b} and @expr{c} must be either a
25552 vector of the same length as @expr{a}, or a non-vector which is matched
25553 with all elements of @expr{a}.
25554
25555 @kindex a @{
25556 @pindex calc-in-set
25557 @tindex in
25558 The @kbd{a @{} (@code{calc-in-set}) [@samp{in(a,b)}] function is true if
25559 the number @expr{a} is in the set of numbers represented by @expr{b}.
25560 If @expr{b} is an interval form, @expr{a} must be one of the values
25561 encompassed by the interval. If @expr{b} is a vector, @expr{a} must be
25562 equal to one of the elements of the vector. (If any vector elements are
25563 intervals, @expr{a} must be in any of the intervals.) If @expr{b} is a
25564 plain number, @expr{a} must be numerically equal to @expr{b}.
25565 @xref{Set Operations}, for a group of commands that manipulate sets
25566 of this sort.
25567
25568 @ignore
25569 @starindex
25570 @end ignore
25571 @tindex typeof
25572 The @samp{typeof(a)} function produces an integer or variable which
25573 characterizes @expr{a}. If @expr{a} is a number, vector, or variable,
25574 the result will be one of the following numbers:
25575
25576 @example
25577 1 Integer
25578 2 Fraction
25579 3 Floating-point number
25580 4 HMS form
25581 5 Rectangular complex number
25582 6 Polar complex number
25583 7 Error form
25584 8 Interval form
25585 9 Modulo form
25586 10 Date-only form
25587 11 Date/time form
25588 12 Infinity (inf, uinf, or nan)
25589 100 Variable
25590 101 Vector (but not a matrix)
25591 102 Matrix
25592 @end example
25593
25594 Otherwise, @expr{a} is a formula, and the result is a variable which
25595 represents the name of the top-level function call.
25596
25597 @ignore
25598 @starindex
25599 @end ignore
25600 @tindex integer
25601 @ignore
25602 @starindex
25603 @end ignore
25604 @tindex real
25605 @ignore
25606 @starindex
25607 @end ignore
25608 @tindex constant
25609 The @samp{integer(a)} function returns true if @expr{a} is an integer.
25610 The @samp{real(a)} function
25611 is true if @expr{a} is a real number, either integer, fraction, or
25612 float. The @samp{constant(a)} function returns true if @expr{a} is
25613 any of the objects for which @code{typeof} would produce an integer
25614 code result except for variables, and provided that the components of
25615 an object like a vector or error form are themselves constant.
25616 Note that infinities do not satisfy any of these tests, nor do
25617 special constants like @code{pi} and @code{e}.
25618
25619 @xref{Declarations}, for a set of similar functions that recognize
25620 formulas as well as actual numbers. For example, @samp{dint(floor(x))}
25621 is true because @samp{floor(x)} is provably integer-valued, but
25622 @samp{integer(floor(x))} does not because @samp{floor(x)} is not
25623 literally an integer constant.
25624
25625 @ignore
25626 @starindex
25627 @end ignore
25628 @tindex refers
25629 The @samp{refers(a,b)} function is true if the variable (or sub-expression)
25630 @expr{b} appears in @expr{a}, or false otherwise. Unlike the other
25631 tests described here, this function returns a definite ``no'' answer
25632 even if its arguments are still in symbolic form. The only case where
25633 @code{refers} will be left unevaluated is if @expr{a} is a plain
25634 variable (different from @expr{b}).
25635
25636 @ignore
25637 @starindex
25638 @end ignore
25639 @tindex negative
25640 The @samp{negative(a)} function returns true if @expr{a} ``looks'' negative,
25641 because it is a negative number, because it is of the form @expr{-x},
25642 or because it is a product or quotient with a term that looks negative.
25643 This is most useful in rewrite rules. Beware that @samp{negative(a)}
25644 evaluates to 1 or 0 for @emph{any} argument @expr{a}, so it can only
25645 be stored in a formula if the default simplifications are turned off
25646 first with @kbd{m O} (or if it appears in an unevaluated context such
25647 as a rewrite rule condition).
25648
25649 @ignore
25650 @starindex
25651 @end ignore
25652 @tindex variable
25653 The @samp{variable(a)} function is true if @expr{a} is a variable,
25654 or false if not. If @expr{a} is a function call, this test is left
25655 in symbolic form. Built-in variables like @code{pi} and @code{inf}
25656 are considered variables like any others by this test.
25657
25658 @ignore
25659 @starindex
25660 @end ignore
25661 @tindex nonvar
25662 The @samp{nonvar(a)} function is true if @expr{a} is a non-variable.
25663 If its argument is a variable it is left unsimplified; it never
25664 actually returns zero. However, since Calc's condition-testing
25665 commands consider ``false'' anything not provably true, this is
25666 often good enough.
25667
25668 @ignore
25669 @starindex
25670 @end ignore
25671 @tindex lin
25672 @ignore
25673 @starindex
25674 @end ignore
25675 @tindex linnt
25676 @ignore
25677 @starindex
25678 @end ignore
25679 @tindex islin
25680 @ignore
25681 @starindex
25682 @end ignore
25683 @tindex islinnt
25684 @cindex Linearity testing
25685 The functions @code{lin}, @code{linnt}, @code{islin}, and @code{islinnt}
25686 check if an expression is ``linear,'' i.e., can be written in the form
25687 @expr{a + b x} for some constants @expr{a} and @expr{b}, and some
25688 variable or subformula @expr{x}. The function @samp{islin(f,x)} checks
25689 if formula @expr{f} is linear in @expr{x}, returning 1 if so. For
25690 example, @samp{islin(x,x)}, @samp{islin(-x,x)}, @samp{islin(3,x)}, and
25691 @samp{islin(x y / 3 - 2, x)} all return 1. The @samp{lin(f,x)} function
25692 is similar, except that instead of returning 1 it returns the vector
25693 @expr{[a, b, x]}. For the above examples, this vector would be
25694 @expr{[0, 1, x]}, @expr{[0, -1, x]}, @expr{[3, 0, x]}, and
25695 @expr{[-2, y/3, x]}, respectively. Both @code{lin} and @code{islin}
25696 generally remain unevaluated for expressions which are not linear,
25697 e.g., @samp{lin(2 x^2, x)} and @samp{lin(sin(x), x)}. The second
25698 argument can also be a formula; @samp{islin(2 + 3 sin(x), sin(x))}
25699 returns true.
25700
25701 The @code{linnt} and @code{islinnt} functions perform a similar check,
25702 but require a ``non-trivial'' linear form, which means that the
25703 @expr{b} coefficient must be non-zero. For example, @samp{lin(2,x)}
25704 returns @expr{[2, 0, x]} and @samp{lin(y,x)} returns @expr{[y, 0, x]},
25705 but @samp{linnt(2,x)} and @samp{linnt(y,x)} are left unevaluated
25706 (in other words, these formulas are considered to be only ``trivially''
25707 linear in @expr{x}).
25708
25709 All four linearity-testing functions allow you to omit the second
25710 argument, in which case the input may be linear in any non-constant
25711 formula. Here, the @expr{a=0}, @expr{b=1} case is also considered
25712 trivial, and only constant values for @expr{a} and @expr{b} are
25713 recognized. Thus, @samp{lin(2 x y)} returns @expr{[0, 2, x y]},
25714 @samp{lin(2 - x y)} returns @expr{[2, -1, x y]}, and @samp{lin(x y)}
25715 returns @expr{[0, 1, x y]}. The @code{linnt} function would allow the
25716 first two cases but not the third. Also, neither @code{lin} nor
25717 @code{linnt} accept plain constants as linear in the one-argument
25718 case: @samp{islin(2,x)} is true, but @samp{islin(2)} is false.
25719
25720 @ignore
25721 @starindex
25722 @end ignore
25723 @tindex istrue
25724 The @samp{istrue(a)} function returns 1 if @expr{a} is a nonzero
25725 number or provably nonzero formula, or 0 if @expr{a} is anything else.
25726 Calls to @code{istrue} can only be manipulated if @kbd{m O} mode is
25727 used to make sure they are not evaluated prematurely. (Note that
25728 declarations are used when deciding whether a formula is true;
25729 @code{istrue} returns 1 when @code{dnonzero} would return 1, and
25730 it returns 0 when @code{dnonzero} would return 0 or leave itself
25731 in symbolic form.)
25732
25733 @node Rewrite Rules, , Logical Operations, Algebra
25734 @section Rewrite Rules
25735
25736 @noindent
25737 @cindex Rewrite rules
25738 @cindex Transformations
25739 @cindex Pattern matching
25740 @kindex a r
25741 @pindex calc-rewrite
25742 @tindex rewrite
25743 The @kbd{a r} (@code{calc-rewrite}) [@code{rewrite}] command makes
25744 substitutions in a formula according to a specified pattern or patterns
25745 known as @dfn{rewrite rules}. Whereas @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute})
25746 matches literally, so that substituting @samp{sin(x)} with @samp{cos(x)}
25747 matches only the @code{sin} function applied to the variable @code{x},
25748 rewrite rules match general kinds of formulas; rewriting using the rule
25749 @samp{sin(x) := cos(x)} matches @code{sin} of any argument and replaces
25750 it with @code{cos} of that same argument. The only significance of the
25751 name @code{x} is that the same name is used on both sides of the rule.
25752
25753 Rewrite rules rearrange formulas already in Calc's memory.
25754 @xref{Syntax Tables}, to read about @dfn{syntax rules}, which are
25755 similar to algebraic rewrite rules but operate when new algebraic
25756 entries are being parsed, converting strings of characters into
25757 Calc formulas.
25758
25759 @menu
25760 * Entering Rewrite Rules::
25761 * Basic Rewrite Rules::
25762 * Conditional Rewrite Rules::
25763 * Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules::
25764 * Other Features of Rewrite Rules::
25765 * Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules::
25766 * Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules::
25767 * Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules::
25768 * Selections with Rewrite Rules::
25769 * Matching Commands::
25770 * Automatic Rewrites::
25771 * Debugging Rewrites::
25772 * Examples of Rewrite Rules::
25773 @end menu
25774
25775 @node Entering Rewrite Rules, Basic Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
25776 @subsection Entering Rewrite Rules
25777
25778 @noindent
25779 Rewrite rules normally use the ``assignment'' operator
25780 @samp{@var{old} := @var{new}}.
25781 This operator is equivalent to the function call @samp{assign(old, new)}.
25782 The @code{assign} function is undefined by itself in Calc, so an
25783 assignment formula such as a rewrite rule will be left alone by ordinary
25784 Calc commands. But certain commands, like the rewrite system, interpret
25785 assignments in special ways.
25786
25787 For example, the rule @samp{sin(x)^2 := 1-cos(x)^2} says to replace
25788 every occurrence of the sine of something, squared, with one minus the
25789 square of the cosine of that same thing. All by itself as a formula
25790 on the stack it does nothing, but when given to the @kbd{a r} command
25791 it turns that command into a sine-squared-to-cosine-squared converter.
25792
25793 To specify a set of rules to be applied all at once, make a vector of
25794 rules.
25795
25796 When @kbd{a r} prompts you to enter the rewrite rules, you can answer
25797 in several ways:
25798
25799 @enumerate
25800 @item
25801 With a rule: @kbd{f(x) := g(x) @key{RET}}.
25802 @item
25803 With a vector of rules: @kbd{[f1(x) := g1(x), f2(x) := g2(x)] @key{RET}}.
25804 (You can omit the enclosing square brackets if you wish.)
25805 @item
25806 With the name of a variable that contains the rule or rules vector:
25807 @kbd{myrules @key{RET}}.
25808 @item
25809 With any formula except a rule, a vector, or a variable name; this
25810 will be interpreted as the @var{old} half of a rewrite rule,
25811 and you will be prompted a second time for the @var{new} half:
25812 @kbd{f(x) @key{RET} g(x) @key{RET}}.
25813 @item
25814 With a blank line, in which case the rule, rules vector, or variable
25815 will be taken from the top of the stack (and the formula to be
25816 rewritten will come from the second-to-top position).
25817 @end enumerate
25818
25819 If you enter the rules directly (as opposed to using rules stored
25820 in a variable), those rules will be put into the Trail so that you
25821 can retrieve them later. @xref{Trail Commands}.
25822
25823 It is most convenient to store rules you use often in a variable and
25824 invoke them by giving the variable name. The @kbd{s e}
25825 (@code{calc-edit-variable}) command is an easy way to create or edit a
25826 rule set stored in a variable. You may also wish to use @kbd{s p}
25827 (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) to save your rules permanently;
25828 @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
25829
25830 Rewrite rules are compiled into a special internal form for faster
25831 matching. If you enter a rule set directly it must be recompiled
25832 every time. If you store the rules in a variable and refer to them
25833 through that variable, they will be compiled once and saved away
25834 along with the variable for later reference. This is another good
25835 reason to store your rules in a variable.
25836
25837 Calc also accepts an obsolete notation for rules, as vectors
25838 @samp{[@var{old}, @var{new}]}. But because it is easily confused with a
25839 vector of two rules, the use of this notation is no longer recommended.
25840
25841 @node Basic Rewrite Rules, Conditional Rewrite Rules, Entering Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
25842 @subsection Basic Rewrite Rules
25843
25844 @noindent
25845 To match a particular formula @expr{x} with a particular rewrite rule
25846 @samp{@var{old} := @var{new}}, Calc compares the structure of @expr{x} with
25847 the structure of @var{old}. Variables that appear in @var{old} are
25848 treated as @dfn{meta-variables}; the corresponding positions in @expr{x}
25849 may contain any sub-formulas. For example, the pattern @samp{f(x,y)}
25850 would match the expression @samp{f(12, a+1)} with the meta-variable
25851 @samp{x} corresponding to 12 and with @samp{y} corresponding to
25852 @samp{a+1}. However, this pattern would not match @samp{f(12)} or
25853 @samp{g(12, a+1)}, since there is no assignment of the meta-variables
25854 that will make the pattern match these expressions. Notice that if
25855 the pattern is a single meta-variable, it will match any expression.
25856
25857 If a given meta-variable appears more than once in @var{old}, the
25858 corresponding sub-formulas of @expr{x} must be identical. Thus
25859 the pattern @samp{f(x,x)} would match @samp{f(12, 12)} and
25860 @samp{f(a+1, a+1)} but not @samp{f(12, a+1)} or @samp{f(a+b, b+a)}.
25861 (@xref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}, for a way to match the latter.)
25862
25863 Things other than variables must match exactly between the pattern
25864 and the target formula. To match a particular variable exactly, use
25865 the pseudo-function @samp{quote(v)} in the pattern. For example, the
25866 pattern @samp{x+quote(y)} matches @samp{x+y}, @samp{2+y}, or
25867 @samp{sin(a)+y}.
25868
25869 The special variable names @samp{e}, @samp{pi}, @samp{i}, @samp{phi},
25870 @samp{gamma}, @samp{inf}, @samp{uinf}, and @samp{nan} always match
25871 literally. Thus the pattern @samp{sin(d + e + f)} acts exactly like
25872 @samp{sin(d + quote(e) + f)}.
25873
25874 If the @var{old} pattern is found to match a given formula, that
25875 formula is replaced by @var{new}, where any occurrences in @var{new}
25876 of meta-variables from the pattern are replaced with the sub-formulas
25877 that they matched. Thus, applying the rule @samp{f(x,y) := g(y+x,x)}
25878 to @samp{f(12, a+1)} would produce @samp{g(a+13, 12)}.
25879
25880 The normal @kbd{a r} command applies rewrite rules over and over
25881 throughout the target formula until no further changes are possible
25882 (up to a limit of 100 times). Use @kbd{C-u 1 a r} to make only one
25883 change at a time.
25884
25885 @node Conditional Rewrite Rules, Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules, Basic Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
25886 @subsection Conditional Rewrite Rules
25887
25888 @noindent
25889 A rewrite rule can also be @dfn{conditional}, written in the form
25890 @samp{@var{old} := @var{new} :: @var{cond}}. (There is also the obsolete
25891 form @samp{[@var{old}, @var{new}, @var{cond}]}.) If a @var{cond} part
25892 is present in the
25893 rule, this is an additional condition that must be satisfied before
25894 the rule is accepted. Once @var{old} has been successfully matched
25895 to the target expression, @var{cond} is evaluated (with all the
25896 meta-variables substituted for the values they matched) and simplified
25897 with @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}). If the result is a nonzero
25898 number or any other object known to be nonzero (@pxref{Declarations}),
25899 the rule is accepted. If the result is zero or if it is a symbolic
25900 formula that is not known to be nonzero, the rule is rejected.
25901 @xref{Logical Operations}, for a number of functions that return
25902 1 or 0 according to the results of various tests.
25903
25904 For example, the formula @samp{n > 0} simplifies to 1 or 0 if @expr{n}
25905 is replaced by a positive or nonpositive number, respectively (or if
25906 @expr{n} has been declared to be positive or nonpositive). Thus,
25907 the rule @samp{f(x,y) := g(y+x,x) :: x+y > 0} would apply to
25908 @samp{f(0, 4)} but not to @samp{f(-3, 2)} or @samp{f(12, a+1)}
25909 (assuming no outstanding declarations for @expr{a}). In the case of
25910 @samp{f(-3, 2)}, the condition can be shown not to be satisfied; in
25911 the case of @samp{f(12, a+1)}, the condition merely cannot be shown
25912 to be satisfied, but that is enough to reject the rule.
25913
25914 While Calc will use declarations to reason about variables in the
25915 formula being rewritten, declarations do not apply to meta-variables.
25916 For example, the rule @samp{f(a) := g(a+1)} will match for any values
25917 of @samp{a}, such as complex numbers, vectors, or formulas, even if
25918 @samp{a} has been declared to be real or scalar. If you want the
25919 meta-variable @samp{a} to match only literal real numbers, use
25920 @samp{f(a) := g(a+1) :: real(a)}. If you want @samp{a} to match only
25921 reals and formulas which are provably real, use @samp{dreal(a)} as
25922 the condition.
25923
25924 The @samp{::} operator is a shorthand for the @code{condition}
25925 function; @samp{@var{old} := @var{new} :: @var{cond}} is equivalent to
25926 the formula @samp{condition(assign(@var{old}, @var{new}), @var{cond})}.
25927
25928 If you have several conditions, you can use @samp{... :: c1 :: c2 :: c3}
25929 or @samp{... :: c1 && c2 && c3}. The two are entirely equivalent.
25930
25931 It is also possible to embed conditions inside the pattern:
25932 @samp{f(x :: x>0, y) := g(y+x, x)}. This is purely a notational
25933 convenience, though; where a condition appears in a rule has no
25934 effect on when it is tested. The rewrite-rule compiler automatically
25935 decides when it is best to test each condition while a rule is being
25936 matched.
25937
25938 Certain conditions are handled as special cases by the rewrite rule
25939 system and are tested very efficiently: Where @expr{x} is any
25940 meta-variable, these conditions are @samp{integer(x)}, @samp{real(x)},
25941 @samp{constant(x)}, @samp{negative(x)}, @samp{x >= y} where @expr{y}
25942 is either a constant or another meta-variable and @samp{>=} may be
25943 replaced by any of the six relational operators, and @samp{x % a = b}
25944 where @expr{a} and @expr{b} are constants. Other conditions, like
25945 @samp{x >= y+1} or @samp{dreal(x)}, will be less efficient to check
25946 since Calc must bring the whole evaluator and simplifier into play.
25947
25948 An interesting property of @samp{::} is that neither of its arguments
25949 will be touched by Calc's default simplifications. This is important
25950 because conditions often are expressions that cannot safely be
25951 evaluated early. For example, the @code{typeof} function never
25952 remains in symbolic form; entering @samp{typeof(a)} will put the
25953 number 100 (the type code for variables like @samp{a}) on the stack.
25954 But putting the condition @samp{... :: typeof(a) = 6} on the stack
25955 is safe since @samp{::} prevents the @code{typeof} from being
25956 evaluated until the condition is actually used by the rewrite system.
25957
25958 Since @samp{::} protects its lefthand side, too, you can use a dummy
25959 condition to protect a rule that must itself not evaluate early.
25960 For example, it's not safe to put @samp{a(f,x) := apply(f, [x])} on
25961 the stack because it will immediately evaluate to @samp{a(f,x) := f(x)},
25962 where the meta-variable-ness of @code{f} on the righthand side has been
25963 lost. But @samp{a(f,x) := apply(f, [x]) :: 1} is safe, and of course
25964 the condition @samp{1} is always true (nonzero) so it has no effect on
25965 the functioning of the rule. (The rewrite compiler will ensure that
25966 it doesn't even impact the speed of matching the rule.)
25967
25968 @node Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules, Other Features of Rewrite Rules, Conditional Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
25969 @subsection Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules
25970
25971 @noindent
25972 The rewrite mechanism understands the algebraic properties of functions
25973 like @samp{+} and @samp{*}. In particular, pattern matching takes
25974 the associativity and commutativity of the following functions into
25975 account:
25976
25977 @smallexample
25978 + - * = != && || and or xor vint vunion vxor gcd lcm max min beta
25979 @end smallexample
25980
25981 For example, the rewrite rule:
25982
25983 @example
25984 a x + b x := (a + b) x
25985 @end example
25986
25987 @noindent
25988 will match formulas of the form,
25989
25990 @example
25991 a x + b x, x a + x b, a x + x b, x a + b x
25992 @end example
25993
25994 Rewrites also understand the relationship between the @samp{+} and @samp{-}
25995 operators. The above rewrite rule will also match the formulas,
25996
25997 @example
25998 a x - b x, x a - x b, a x - x b, x a - b x
25999 @end example
26000
26001 @noindent
26002 by matching @samp{b} in the pattern to @samp{-b} from the formula.
26003
26004 Applied to a sum of many terms like @samp{r + a x + s + b x + t}, this
26005 pattern will check all pairs of terms for possible matches. The rewrite
26006 will take whichever suitable pair it discovers first.
26007
26008 In general, a pattern using an associative operator like @samp{a + b}
26009 will try @var{2 n} different ways to match a sum of @var{n} terms
26010 like @samp{x + y + z - w}. First, @samp{a} is matched against each
26011 of @samp{x}, @samp{y}, @samp{z}, and @samp{-w} in turn, with @samp{b}
26012 being matched to the remainders @samp{y + z - w}, @samp{x + z - w}, etc.
26013 If none of these succeed, then @samp{b} is matched against each of the
26014 four terms with @samp{a} matching the remainder. Half-and-half matches,
26015 like @samp{(x + y) + (z - w)}, are not tried.
26016
26017 Note that @samp{*} is not commutative when applied to matrices, but
26018 rewrite rules pretend that it is. If you type @kbd{m v} to enable
26019 Matrix mode (@pxref{Matrix Mode}), rewrite rules will match @samp{*}
26020 literally, ignoring its usual commutativity property. (In the
26021 current implementation, the associativity also vanishes---it is as
26022 if the pattern had been enclosed in a @code{plain} marker; see below.)
26023 If you are applying rewrites to formulas with matrices, it's best to
26024 enable Matrix mode first to prevent algebraically incorrect rewrites
26025 from occurring.
26026
26027 The pattern @samp{-x} will actually match any expression. For example,
26028 the rule
26029
26030 @example
26031 f(-x) := -f(x)
26032 @end example
26033
26034 @noindent
26035 will rewrite @samp{f(a)} to @samp{-f(-a)}. To avoid this, either use
26036 a @code{plain} marker as described below, or add a @samp{negative(x)}
26037 condition. The @code{negative} function is true if its argument
26038 ``looks'' negative, for example, because it is a negative number or
26039 because it is a formula like @samp{-x}. The new rule using this
26040 condition is:
26041
26042 @example
26043 f(x) := -f(-x) :: negative(x) @r{or, equivalently,}
26044 f(-x) := -f(x) :: negative(-x)
26045 @end example
26046
26047 In the same way, the pattern @samp{x - y} will match the sum @samp{a + b}
26048 by matching @samp{y} to @samp{-b}.
26049
26050 The pattern @samp{a b} will also match the formula @samp{x/y} if
26051 @samp{y} is a number. Thus the rule @samp{a x + @w{b x} := (a+b) x}
26052 will also convert @samp{a x + x / 2} to @samp{(a + 0.5) x} (or
26053 @samp{(a + 1:2) x}, depending on the current fraction mode).
26054
26055 Calc will @emph{not} take other liberties with @samp{*}, @samp{/}, and
26056 @samp{^}. For example, the pattern @samp{f(a b)} will not match
26057 @samp{f(x^2)}, and @samp{f(a + b)} will not match @samp{f(2 x)}, even
26058 though conceivably these patterns could match with @samp{a = b = x}.
26059 Nor will @samp{f(a b)} match @samp{f(x / y)} if @samp{y} is not a
26060 constant, even though it could be considered to match with @samp{a = x}
26061 and @samp{b = 1/y}. The reasons are partly for efficiency, and partly
26062 because while few mathematical operations are substantively different
26063 for addition and subtraction, often it is preferable to treat the cases
26064 of multiplication, division, and integer powers separately.
26065
26066 Even more subtle is the rule set
26067
26068 @example
26069 [ f(a) + f(b) := f(a + b), -f(a) := f(-a) ]
26070 @end example
26071
26072 @noindent
26073 attempting to match @samp{f(x) - f(y)}. You might think that Calc
26074 will view this subtraction as @samp{f(x) + (-f(y))} and then apply
26075 the above two rules in turn, but actually this will not work because
26076 Calc only does this when considering rules for @samp{+} (like the
26077 first rule in this set). So it will see first that @samp{f(x) + (-f(y))}
26078 does not match @samp{f(a) + f(b)} for any assignments of the
26079 meta-variables, and then it will see that @samp{f(x) - f(y)} does
26080 not match @samp{-f(a)} for any assignment of @samp{a}. Because Calc
26081 tries only one rule at a time, it will not be able to rewrite
26082 @samp{f(x) - f(y)} with this rule set. An explicit @samp{f(a) - f(b)}
26083 rule will have to be added.
26084
26085 Another thing patterns will @emph{not} do is break up complex numbers.
26086 The pattern @samp{myconj(a + @w{b i)} := a - b i} will work for formulas
26087 involving the special constant @samp{i} (such as @samp{3 - 4 i}), but
26088 it will not match actual complex numbers like @samp{(3, -4)}. A version
26089 of the above rule for complex numbers would be
26090
26091 @example
26092 myconj(a) := re(a) - im(a) (0,1) :: im(a) != 0
26093 @end example
26094
26095 @noindent
26096 (Because the @code{re} and @code{im} functions understand the properties
26097 of the special constant @samp{i}, this rule will also work for
26098 @samp{3 - 4 i}. In fact, this particular rule would probably be better
26099 without the @samp{im(a) != 0} condition, since if @samp{im(a) = 0} the
26100 righthand side of the rule will still give the correct answer for the
26101 conjugate of a real number.)
26102
26103 It is also possible to specify optional arguments in patterns. The rule
26104
26105 @example
26106 opt(a) x + opt(b) (x^opt(c) + opt(d)) := f(a, b, c, d)
26107 @end example
26108
26109 @noindent
26110 will match the formula
26111
26112 @example
26113 5 (x^2 - 4) + 3 x
26114 @end example
26115
26116 @noindent
26117 in a fairly straightforward manner, but it will also match reduced
26118 formulas like
26119
26120 @example
26121 x + x^2, 2(x + 1) - x, x + x
26122 @end example
26123
26124 @noindent
26125 producing, respectively,
26126
26127 @example
26128 f(1, 1, 2, 0), f(-1, 2, 1, 1), f(1, 1, 1, 0)
26129 @end example
26130
26131 (The latter two formulas can be entered only if default simplifications
26132 have been turned off with @kbd{m O}.)
26133
26134 The default value for a term of a sum is zero. The default value
26135 for a part of a product, for a power, or for the denominator of a
26136 quotient, is one. Also, @samp{-x} matches the pattern @samp{opt(a) b}
26137 with @samp{a = -1}.
26138
26139 In particular, the distributive-law rule can be refined to
26140
26141 @example
26142 opt(a) x + opt(b) x := (a + b) x
26143 @end example
26144
26145 @noindent
26146 so that it will convert, e.g., @samp{a x - x}, to @samp{(a - 1) x}.
26147
26148 The pattern @samp{opt(a) + opt(b) x} matches almost any formulas which
26149 are linear in @samp{x}. You can also use the @code{lin} and @code{islin}
26150 functions with rewrite conditions to test for this; @pxref{Logical
26151 Operations}. These functions are not as convenient to use in rewrite
26152 rules, but they recognize more kinds of formulas as linear:
26153 @samp{x/z} is considered linear with @expr{b = 1/z} by @code{lin},
26154 but it will not match the above pattern because that pattern calls
26155 for a multiplication, not a division.
26156
26157 As another example, the obvious rule to replace @samp{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2}
26158 by 1,
26159
26160 @example
26161 sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2 := 1
26162 @end example
26163
26164 @noindent
26165 misses many cases because the sine and cosine may both be multiplied by
26166 an equal factor. Here's a more successful rule:
26167
26168 @example
26169 opt(a) sin(x)^2 + opt(a) cos(x)^2 := a
26170 @end example
26171
26172 Note that this rule will @emph{not} match @samp{sin(x)^2 + 6 cos(x)^2}
26173 because one @expr{a} would have ``matched'' 1 while the other matched 6.
26174
26175 Calc automatically converts a rule like
26176
26177 @example
26178 f(x-1, x) := g(x)
26179 @end example
26180
26181 @noindent
26182 into the form
26183
26184 @example
26185 f(temp, x) := g(x) :: temp = x-1
26186 @end example
26187
26188 @noindent
26189 (where @code{temp} stands for a new, invented meta-variable that
26190 doesn't actually have a name). This modified rule will successfully
26191 match @samp{f(6, 7)}, binding @samp{temp} and @samp{x} to 6 and 7,
26192 respectively, then verifying that they differ by one even though
26193 @samp{6} does not superficially look like @samp{x-1}.
26194
26195 However, Calc does not solve equations to interpret a rule. The
26196 following rule,
26197
26198 @example
26199 f(x-1, x+1) := g(x)
26200 @end example
26201
26202 @noindent
26203 will not work. That is, it will match @samp{f(a - 1 + b, a + 1 + b)}
26204 but not @samp{f(6, 8)}. Calc always interprets at least one occurrence
26205 of a variable by literal matching. If the variable appears ``isolated''
26206 then Calc is smart enough to use it for literal matching. But in this
26207 last example, Calc is forced to rewrite the rule to @samp{f(x-1, temp)
26208 := g(x) :: temp = x+1} where the @samp{x-1} term must correspond to an
26209 actual ``something-minus-one'' in the target formula.
26210
26211 A successful way to write this would be @samp{f(x, x+2) := g(x+1)}.
26212 You could make this resemble the original form more closely by using
26213 @code{let} notation, which is described in the next section:
26214
26215 @example
26216 f(xm1, x+1) := g(x) :: let(x := xm1+1)
26217 @end example
26218
26219 Calc does this rewriting or ``conditionalizing'' for any sub-pattern
26220 which involves only the functions in the following list, operating
26221 only on constants and meta-variables which have already been matched
26222 elsewhere in the pattern. When matching a function call, Calc is
26223 careful to match arguments which are plain variables before arguments
26224 which are calls to any of the functions below, so that a pattern like
26225 @samp{f(x-1, x)} can be conditionalized even though the isolated
26226 @samp{x} comes after the @samp{x-1}.
26227
26228 @smallexample
26229 + - * / \ % ^ abs sign round rounde roundu trunc floor ceil
26230 max min re im conj arg
26231 @end smallexample
26232
26233 You can suppress all of the special treatments described in this
26234 section by surrounding a function call with a @code{plain} marker.
26235 This marker causes the function call which is its argument to be
26236 matched literally, without regard to commutativity, associativity,
26237 negation, or conditionalization. When you use @code{plain}, the
26238 ``deep structure'' of the formula being matched can show through.
26239 For example,
26240
26241 @example
26242 plain(a - a b) := f(a, b)
26243 @end example
26244
26245 @noindent
26246 will match only literal subtractions. However, the @code{plain}
26247 marker does not affect its arguments' arguments. In this case,
26248 commutativity and associativity is still considered while matching
26249 the @w{@samp{a b}} sub-pattern, so the whole pattern will match
26250 @samp{x - y x} as well as @samp{x - x y}. We could go still
26251 further and use
26252
26253 @example
26254 plain(a - plain(a b)) := f(a, b)
26255 @end example
26256
26257 @noindent
26258 which would do a completely strict match for the pattern.
26259
26260 By contrast, the @code{quote} marker means that not only the
26261 function name but also the arguments must be literally the same.
26262 The above pattern will match @samp{x - x y} but
26263
26264 @example
26265 quote(a - a b) := f(a, b)
26266 @end example
26267
26268 @noindent
26269 will match only the single formula @samp{a - a b}. Also,
26270
26271 @example
26272 quote(a - quote(a b)) := f(a, b)
26273 @end example
26274
26275 @noindent
26276 will match only @samp{a - quote(a b)}---probably not the desired
26277 effect!
26278
26279 A certain amount of algebra is also done when substituting the
26280 meta-variables on the righthand side of a rule. For example,
26281 in the rule
26282
26283 @example
26284 a + f(b) := f(a + b)
26285 @end example
26286
26287 @noindent
26288 matching @samp{f(x) - y} would produce @samp{f((-y) + x)} if
26289 taken literally, but the rewrite mechanism will simplify the
26290 righthand side to @samp{f(x - y)} automatically. (Of course,
26291 the default simplifications would do this anyway, so this
26292 special simplification is only noticeable if you have turned the
26293 default simplifications off.) This rewriting is done only when
26294 a meta-variable expands to a ``negative-looking'' expression.
26295 If this simplification is not desirable, you can use a @code{plain}
26296 marker on the righthand side:
26297
26298 @example
26299 a + f(b) := f(plain(a + b))
26300 @end example
26301
26302 @noindent
26303 In this example, we are still allowing the pattern-matcher to
26304 use all the algebra it can muster, but the righthand side will
26305 always simplify to a literal addition like @samp{f((-y) + x)}.
26306
26307 @node Other Features of Rewrite Rules, Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules, Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26308 @subsection Other Features of Rewrite Rules
26309
26310 @noindent
26311 Certain ``function names'' serve as markers in rewrite rules.
26312 Here is a complete list of these markers. First are listed the
26313 markers that work inside a pattern; then come the markers that
26314 work in the righthand side of a rule.
26315
26316 @ignore
26317 @starindex
26318 @end ignore
26319 @tindex import
26320 One kind of marker, @samp{import(x)}, takes the place of a whole
26321 rule. Here @expr{x} is the name of a variable containing another
26322 rule set; those rules are ``spliced into'' the rule set that
26323 imports them. For example, if @samp{[f(a+b) := f(a) + f(b),
26324 f(a b) := a f(b) :: real(a)]} is stored in variable @samp{linearF},
26325 then the rule set @samp{[f(0) := 0, import(linearF)]} will apply
26326 all three rules. It is possible to modify the imported rules
26327 slightly: @samp{import(x, v1, x1, v2, x2, @dots{})} imports
26328 the rule set @expr{x} with all occurrences of
26329 @texline @math{v_1},
26330 @infoline @expr{v1},
26331 as either a variable name or a function name, replaced with
26332 @texline @math{x_1}
26333 @infoline @expr{x1}
26334 and so on. (If
26335 @texline @math{v_1}
26336 @infoline @expr{v1}
26337 is used as a function name, then
26338 @texline @math{x_1}
26339 @infoline @expr{x1}
26340 must be either a function name itself or a @w{@samp{< >}} nameless
26341 function; @pxref{Specifying Operators}.) For example, @samp{[g(0) := 0,
26342 import(linearF, f, g)]} applies the linearity rules to the function
26343 @samp{g} instead of @samp{f}. Imports can be nested, but the
26344 import-with-renaming feature may fail to rename sub-imports properly.
26345
26346 The special functions allowed in patterns are:
26347
26348 @table @samp
26349 @item quote(x)
26350 @ignore
26351 @starindex
26352 @end ignore
26353 @tindex quote
26354 This pattern matches exactly @expr{x}; variable names in @expr{x} are
26355 not interpreted as meta-variables. The only flexibility is that
26356 numbers are compared for numeric equality, so that the pattern
26357 @samp{f(quote(12))} will match both @samp{f(12)} and @samp{f(12.0)}.
26358 (Numbers are always treated this way by the rewrite mechanism:
26359 The rule @samp{f(x,x) := g(x)} will match @samp{f(12, 12.0)}.
26360 The rewrite may produce either @samp{g(12)} or @samp{g(12.0)}
26361 as a result in this case.)
26362
26363 @item plain(x)
26364 @ignore
26365 @starindex
26366 @end ignore
26367 @tindex plain
26368 Here @expr{x} must be a function call @samp{f(x1,x2,@dots{})}. This
26369 pattern matches a call to function @expr{f} with the specified
26370 argument patterns. No special knowledge of the properties of the
26371 function @expr{f} is used in this case; @samp{+} is not commutative or
26372 associative. Unlike @code{quote}, the arguments @samp{x1,x2,@dots{}}
26373 are treated as patterns. If you wish them to be treated ``plainly''
26374 as well, you must enclose them with more @code{plain} markers:
26375 @samp{plain(plain(@w{-a}) + plain(b c))}.
26376
26377 @item opt(x,def)
26378 @ignore
26379 @starindex
26380 @end ignore
26381 @tindex opt
26382 Here @expr{x} must be a variable name. This must appear as an
26383 argument to a function or an element of a vector; it specifies that
26384 the argument or element is optional.
26385 As an argument to @samp{+}, @samp{-}, @samp{*}, @samp{&&}, or @samp{||},
26386 or as the second argument to @samp{/} or @samp{^}, the value @var{def}
26387 may be omitted. The pattern @samp{x + opt(y)} matches a sum by
26388 binding one summand to @expr{x} and the other to @expr{y}, and it
26389 matches anything else by binding the whole expression to @expr{x} and
26390 zero to @expr{y}. The other operators above work similarly.
26391
26392 For general miscellaneous functions, the default value @code{def}
26393 must be specified. Optional arguments are dropped starting with
26394 the rightmost one during matching. For example, the pattern
26395 @samp{f(opt(a,0), b, opt(c,b))} will match @samp{f(b)}, @samp{f(a,b)},
26396 or @samp{f(a,b,c)}. Default values of zero and @expr{b} are
26397 supplied in this example for the omitted arguments. Note that
26398 the literal variable @expr{b} will be the default in the latter
26399 case, @emph{not} the value that matched the meta-variable @expr{b}.
26400 In other words, the default @var{def} is effectively quoted.
26401
26402 @item condition(x,c)
26403 @ignore
26404 @starindex
26405 @end ignore
26406 @tindex condition
26407 @tindex ::
26408 This matches the pattern @expr{x}, with the attached condition
26409 @expr{c}. It is the same as @samp{x :: c}.
26410
26411 @item pand(x,y)
26412 @ignore
26413 @starindex
26414 @end ignore
26415 @tindex pand
26416 @tindex &&&
26417 This matches anything that matches both pattern @expr{x} and
26418 pattern @expr{y}. It is the same as @samp{x &&& y}.
26419 @pxref{Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules}.
26420
26421 @item por(x,y)
26422 @ignore
26423 @starindex
26424 @end ignore
26425 @tindex por
26426 @tindex |||
26427 This matches anything that matches either pattern @expr{x} or
26428 pattern @expr{y}. It is the same as @w{@samp{x ||| y}}.
26429
26430 @item pnot(x)
26431 @ignore
26432 @starindex
26433 @end ignore
26434 @tindex pnot
26435 @tindex !!!
26436 This matches anything that does not match pattern @expr{x}.
26437 It is the same as @samp{!!! x}.
26438
26439 @item cons(h,t)
26440 @ignore
26441 @mindex cons
26442 @end ignore
26443 @tindex cons (rewrites)
26444 This matches any vector of one or more elements. The first
26445 element is matched to @expr{h}; a vector of the remaining
26446 elements is matched to @expr{t}. Note that vectors of fixed
26447 length can also be matched as actual vectors: The rule
26448 @samp{cons(a,cons(b,[])) := cons(a+b,[])} is equivalent
26449 to the rule @samp{[a,b] := [a+b]}.
26450
26451 @item rcons(t,h)
26452 @ignore
26453 @mindex rcons
26454 @end ignore
26455 @tindex rcons (rewrites)
26456 This is like @code{cons}, except that the @emph{last} element
26457 is matched to @expr{h}, with the remaining elements matched
26458 to @expr{t}.
26459
26460 @item apply(f,args)
26461 @ignore
26462 @mindex apply
26463 @end ignore
26464 @tindex apply (rewrites)
26465 This matches any function call. The name of the function, in
26466 the form of a variable, is matched to @expr{f}. The arguments
26467 of the function, as a vector of zero or more objects, are
26468 matched to @samp{args}. Constants, variables, and vectors
26469 do @emph{not} match an @code{apply} pattern. For example,
26470 @samp{apply(f,x)} matches any function call, @samp{apply(quote(f),x)}
26471 matches any call to the function @samp{f}, @samp{apply(f,[a,b])}
26472 matches any function call with exactly two arguments, and
26473 @samp{apply(quote(f), cons(a,cons(b,x)))} matches any call
26474 to the function @samp{f} with two or more arguments. Another
26475 way to implement the latter, if the rest of the rule does not
26476 need to refer to the first two arguments of @samp{f} by name,
26477 would be @samp{apply(quote(f), x :: vlen(x) >= 2)}.
26478 Here's a more interesting sample use of @code{apply}:
26479
26480 @example
26481 apply(f,[x+n]) := n + apply(f,[x])
26482 :: in(f, [floor,ceil,round,trunc]) :: integer(n)
26483 @end example
26484
26485 Note, however, that this will be slower to match than a rule
26486 set with four separate rules. The reason is that Calc sorts
26487 the rules of a rule set according to top-level function name;
26488 if the top-level function is @code{apply}, Calc must try the
26489 rule for every single formula and sub-formula. If the top-level
26490 function in the pattern is, say, @code{floor}, then Calc invokes
26491 the rule only for sub-formulas which are calls to @code{floor}.
26492
26493 Formulas normally written with operators like @code{+} are still
26494 considered function calls: @code{apply(f,x)} matches @samp{a+b}
26495 with @samp{f = add}, @samp{x = [a,b]}.
26496
26497 You must use @code{apply} for meta-variables with function names
26498 on both sides of a rewrite rule: @samp{apply(f, [x]) := f(x+1)}
26499 is @emph{not} correct, because it rewrites @samp{spam(6)} into
26500 @samp{f(7)}. The righthand side should be @samp{apply(f, [x+1])}.
26501 Also note that you will have to use No-Simplify mode (@kbd{m O})
26502 when entering this rule so that the @code{apply} isn't
26503 evaluated immediately to get the new rule @samp{f(x) := f(x+1)}.
26504 Or, use @kbd{s e} to enter the rule without going through the stack,
26505 or enter the rule as @samp{apply(f, [x]) := apply(f, [x+1]) @w{:: 1}}.
26506 @xref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}.
26507
26508 @item select(x)
26509 @ignore
26510 @starindex
26511 @end ignore
26512 @tindex select
26513 This is used for applying rules to formulas with selections;
26514 @pxref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}.
26515 @end table
26516
26517 Special functions for the righthand sides of rules are:
26518
26519 @table @samp
26520 @item quote(x)
26521 The notation @samp{quote(x)} is changed to @samp{x} when the
26522 righthand side is used. As far as the rewrite rule is concerned,
26523 @code{quote} is invisible. However, @code{quote} has the special
26524 property in Calc that its argument is not evaluated. Thus,
26525 while it will not work to put the rule @samp{t(a) := typeof(a)}
26526 on the stack because @samp{typeof(a)} is evaluated immediately
26527 to produce @samp{t(a) := 100}, you can use @code{quote} to
26528 protect the righthand side: @samp{t(a) := quote(typeof(a))}.
26529 (@xref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}, for another trick for
26530 protecting rules from evaluation.)
26531
26532 @item plain(x)
26533 Special properties of and simplifications for the function call
26534 @expr{x} are not used. One interesting case where @code{plain}
26535 is useful is the rule, @samp{q(x) := quote(x)}, trying to expand a
26536 shorthand notation for the @code{quote} function. This rule will
26537 not work as shown; instead of replacing @samp{q(foo)} with
26538 @samp{quote(foo)}, it will replace it with @samp{foo}! The correct
26539 rule would be @samp{q(x) := plain(quote(x))}.
26540
26541 @item cons(h,t)
26542 Where @expr{t} is a vector, this is converted into an expanded
26543 vector during rewrite processing. Note that @code{cons} is a regular
26544 Calc function which normally does this anyway; the only way @code{cons}
26545 is treated specially by rewrites is that @code{cons} on the righthand
26546 side of a rule will be evaluated even if default simplifications
26547 have been turned off.
26548
26549 @item rcons(t,h)
26550 Analogous to @code{cons} except putting @expr{h} at the @emph{end} of
26551 the vector @expr{t}.
26552
26553 @item apply(f,args)
26554 Where @expr{f} is a variable and @var{args} is a vector, this
26555 is converted to a function call. Once again, note that @code{apply}
26556 is also a regular Calc function.
26557
26558 @item eval(x)
26559 @ignore
26560 @starindex
26561 @end ignore
26562 @tindex eval
26563 The formula @expr{x} is handled in the usual way, then the
26564 default simplifications are applied to it even if they have
26565 been turned off normally. This allows you to treat any function
26566 similarly to the way @code{cons} and @code{apply} are always
26567 treated. However, there is a slight difference: @samp{cons(2+3, [])}
26568 with default simplifications off will be converted to @samp{[2+3]},
26569 whereas @samp{eval(cons(2+3, []))} will be converted to @samp{[5]}.
26570
26571 @item evalsimp(x)
26572 @ignore
26573 @starindex
26574 @end ignore
26575 @tindex evalsimp
26576 The formula @expr{x} has meta-variables substituted in the usual
26577 way, then algebraically simplified as if by the @kbd{a s} command.
26578
26579 @item evalextsimp(x)
26580 @ignore
26581 @starindex
26582 @end ignore
26583 @tindex evalextsimp
26584 The formula @expr{x} has meta-variables substituted in the normal
26585 way, then ``extendedly'' simplified as if by the @kbd{a e} command.
26586
26587 @item select(x)
26588 @xref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}.
26589 @end table
26590
26591 There are also some special functions you can use in conditions.
26592
26593 @table @samp
26594 @item let(v := x)
26595 @ignore
26596 @starindex
26597 @end ignore
26598 @tindex let
26599 The expression @expr{x} is evaluated with meta-variables substituted.
26600 The @kbd{a s} command's simplifications are @emph{not} applied by
26601 default, but @expr{x} can include calls to @code{evalsimp} or
26602 @code{evalextsimp} as described above to invoke higher levels
26603 of simplification. The
26604 result of @expr{x} is then bound to the meta-variable @expr{v}. As
26605 usual, if this meta-variable has already been matched to something
26606 else the two values must be equal; if the meta-variable is new then
26607 it is bound to the result of the expression. This variable can then
26608 appear in later conditions, and on the righthand side of the rule.
26609 In fact, @expr{v} may be any pattern in which case the result of
26610 evaluating @expr{x} is matched to that pattern, binding any
26611 meta-variables that appear in that pattern. Note that @code{let}
26612 can only appear by itself as a condition, or as one term of an
26613 @samp{&&} which is a whole condition: It cannot be inside
26614 an @samp{||} term or otherwise buried.
26615
26616 The alternate, equivalent form @samp{let(v, x)} is also recognized.
26617 Note that the use of @samp{:=} by @code{let}, while still being
26618 assignment-like in character, is unrelated to the use of @samp{:=}
26619 in the main part of a rewrite rule.
26620
26621 As an example, @samp{f(a) := g(ia) :: let(ia := 1/a) :: constant(ia)}
26622 replaces @samp{f(a)} with @samp{g} of the inverse of @samp{a}, if
26623 that inverse exists and is constant. For example, if @samp{a} is a
26624 singular matrix the operation @samp{1/a} is left unsimplified and
26625 @samp{constant(ia)} fails, but if @samp{a} is an invertible matrix
26626 then the rule succeeds. Without @code{let} there would be no way
26627 to express this rule that didn't have to invert the matrix twice.
26628 Note that, because the meta-variable @samp{ia} is otherwise unbound
26629 in this rule, the @code{let} condition itself always ``succeeds''
26630 because no matter what @samp{1/a} evaluates to, it can successfully
26631 be bound to @code{ia}.
26632
26633 Here's another example, for integrating cosines of linear
26634 terms: @samp{myint(cos(y),x) := sin(y)/b :: let([a,b,x] := lin(y,x))}.
26635 The @code{lin} function returns a 3-vector if its argument is linear,
26636 or leaves itself unevaluated if not. But an unevaluated @code{lin}
26637 call will not match the 3-vector on the lefthand side of the @code{let},
26638 so this @code{let} both verifies that @code{y} is linear, and binds
26639 the coefficients @code{a} and @code{b} for use elsewhere in the rule.
26640 (It would have been possible to use @samp{sin(a x + b)/b} for the
26641 righthand side instead, but using @samp{sin(y)/b} avoids gratuitous
26642 rearrangement of the argument of the sine.)
26643
26644 @ignore
26645 @starindex
26646 @end ignore
26647 @tindex ierf
26648 Similarly, here is a rule that implements an inverse-@code{erf}
26649 function. It uses @code{root} to search for a solution. If
26650 @code{root} succeeds, it will return a vector of two numbers
26651 where the first number is the desired solution. If no solution
26652 is found, @code{root} remains in symbolic form. So we use
26653 @code{let} to check that the result was indeed a vector.
26654
26655 @example
26656 ierf(x) := y :: let([y,z] := root(erf(a) = x, a, .5))
26657 @end example
26658
26659 @item matches(v,p)
26660 The meta-variable @var{v}, which must already have been matched
26661 to something elsewhere in the rule, is compared against pattern
26662 @var{p}. Since @code{matches} is a standard Calc function, it
26663 can appear anywhere in a condition. But if it appears alone or
26664 as a term of a top-level @samp{&&}, then you get the special
26665 extra feature that meta-variables which are bound to things
26666 inside @var{p} can be used elsewhere in the surrounding rewrite
26667 rule.
26668
26669 The only real difference between @samp{let(p := v)} and
26670 @samp{matches(v, p)} is that the former evaluates @samp{v} using
26671 the default simplifications, while the latter does not.
26672
26673 @item remember
26674 @vindex remember
26675 This is actually a variable, not a function. If @code{remember}
26676 appears as a condition in a rule, then when that rule succeeds
26677 the original expression and rewritten expression are added to the
26678 front of the rule set that contained the rule. If the rule set
26679 was not stored in a variable, @code{remember} is ignored. The
26680 lefthand side is enclosed in @code{quote} in the added rule if it
26681 contains any variables.
26682
26683 For example, the rule @samp{f(n) := n f(n-1) :: remember} applied
26684 to @samp{f(7)} will add the rule @samp{f(7) := 7 f(6)} to the front
26685 of the rule set. The rule set @code{EvalRules} works slightly
26686 differently: There, the evaluation of @samp{f(6)} will complete before
26687 the result is added to the rule set, in this case as @samp{f(7) := 5040}.
26688 Thus @code{remember} is most useful inside @code{EvalRules}.
26689
26690 It is up to you to ensure that the optimization performed by
26691 @code{remember} is safe. For example, the rule @samp{foo(n) := n
26692 :: evalv(eatfoo) > 0 :: remember} is a bad idea (@code{evalv} is
26693 the function equivalent of the @kbd{=} command); if the variable
26694 @code{eatfoo} ever contains 1, rules like @samp{foo(7) := 7} will
26695 be added to the rule set and will continue to operate even if
26696 @code{eatfoo} is later changed to 0.
26697
26698 @item remember(c)
26699 @ignore
26700 @starindex
26701 @end ignore
26702 @tindex remember
26703 Remember the match as described above, but only if condition @expr{c}
26704 is true. For example, @samp{remember(n % 4 = 0)} in the above factorial
26705 rule remembers only every fourth result. Note that @samp{remember(1)}
26706 is equivalent to @samp{remember}, and @samp{remember(0)} has no effect.
26707 @end table
26708
26709 @node Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules, Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules, Other Features of Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26710 @subsection Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules
26711
26712 @noindent
26713 There are three operators, @samp{&&&}, @samp{|||}, and @samp{!!!},
26714 that combine rewrite patterns to make larger patterns. The
26715 combinations are ``and,'' ``or,'' and ``not,'' respectively, and
26716 these operators are the pattern equivalents of @samp{&&}, @samp{||}
26717 and @samp{!} (which operate on zero-or-nonzero logical values).
26718
26719 Note that @samp{&&&}, @samp{|||}, and @samp{!!!} are left in symbolic
26720 form by all regular Calc features; they have special meaning only in
26721 the context of rewrite rule patterns.
26722
26723 The pattern @samp{@var{p1} &&& @var{p2}} matches anything that
26724 matches both @var{p1} and @var{p2}. One especially useful case is
26725 when one of @var{p1} or @var{p2} is a meta-variable. For example,
26726 here is a rule that operates on error forms:
26727
26728 @example
26729 f(x &&& a +/- b, x) := g(x)
26730 @end example
26731
26732 This does the same thing, but is arguably simpler than, the rule
26733
26734 @example
26735 f(a +/- b, a +/- b) := g(a +/- b)
26736 @end example
26737
26738 @ignore
26739 @starindex
26740 @end ignore
26741 @tindex ends
26742 Here's another interesting example:
26743
26744 @example
26745 ends(cons(a, x) &&& rcons(y, b)) := [a, b]
26746 @end example
26747
26748 @noindent
26749 which effectively clips out the middle of a vector leaving just
26750 the first and last elements. This rule will change a one-element
26751 vector @samp{[a]} to @samp{[a, a]}. The similar rule
26752
26753 @example
26754 ends(cons(a, rcons(y, b))) := [a, b]
26755 @end example
26756
26757 @noindent
26758 would do the same thing except that it would fail to match a
26759 one-element vector.
26760
26761 @tex
26762 \bigskip
26763 @end tex
26764
26765 The pattern @samp{@var{p1} ||| @var{p2}} matches anything that
26766 matches either @var{p1} or @var{p2}. Calc first tries matching
26767 against @var{p1}; if that fails, it goes on to try @var{p2}.
26768
26769 @ignore
26770 @starindex
26771 @end ignore
26772 @tindex curve
26773 A simple example of @samp{|||} is
26774
26775 @example
26776 curve(inf ||| -inf) := 0
26777 @end example
26778
26779 @noindent
26780 which converts both @samp{curve(inf)} and @samp{curve(-inf)} to zero.
26781
26782 Here is a larger example:
26783
26784 @example
26785 log(a, b) ||| (ln(a) :: let(b := e)) := mylog(a, b)
26786 @end example
26787
26788 This matches both generalized and natural logarithms in a single rule.
26789 Note that the @samp{::} term must be enclosed in parentheses because
26790 that operator has lower precedence than @samp{|||} or @samp{:=}.
26791
26792 (In practice this rule would probably include a third alternative,
26793 omitted here for brevity, to take care of @code{log10}.)
26794
26795 While Calc generally treats interior conditions exactly the same as
26796 conditions on the outside of a rule, it does guarantee that if all the
26797 variables in the condition are special names like @code{e}, or already
26798 bound in the pattern to which the condition is attached (say, if
26799 @samp{a} had appeared in this condition), then Calc will process this
26800 condition right after matching the pattern to the left of the @samp{::}.
26801 Thus, we know that @samp{b} will be bound to @samp{e} only if the
26802 @code{ln} branch of the @samp{|||} was taken.
26803
26804 Note that this rule was careful to bind the same set of meta-variables
26805 on both sides of the @samp{|||}. Calc does not check this, but if
26806 you bind a certain meta-variable only in one branch and then use that
26807 meta-variable elsewhere in the rule, results are unpredictable:
26808
26809 @example
26810 f(a,b) ||| g(b) := h(a,b)
26811 @end example
26812
26813 Here if the pattern matches @samp{g(17)}, Calc makes no promises about
26814 the value that will be substituted for @samp{a} on the righthand side.
26815
26816 @tex
26817 \bigskip
26818 @end tex
26819
26820 The pattern @samp{!!! @var{pat}} matches anything that does not
26821 match @var{pat}. Any meta-variables that are bound while matching
26822 @var{pat} remain unbound outside of @var{pat}.
26823
26824 For example,
26825
26826 @example
26827 f(x &&& !!! a +/- b, !!![]) := g(x)
26828 @end example
26829
26830 @noindent
26831 converts @code{f} whose first argument is anything @emph{except} an
26832 error form, and whose second argument is not the empty vector, into
26833 a similar call to @code{g} (but without the second argument).
26834
26835 If we know that the second argument will be a vector (empty or not),
26836 then an equivalent rule would be:
26837
26838 @example
26839 f(x, y) := g(x) :: typeof(x) != 7 :: vlen(y) > 0
26840 @end example
26841
26842 @noindent
26843 where of course 7 is the @code{typeof} code for error forms.
26844 Another final condition, that works for any kind of @samp{y},
26845 would be @samp{!istrue(y == [])}. (The @code{istrue} function
26846 returns an explicit 0 if its argument was left in symbolic form;
26847 plain @samp{!(y == [])} or @samp{y != []} would not work to replace
26848 @samp{!!![]} since these would be left unsimplified, and thus cause
26849 the rule to fail, if @samp{y} was something like a variable name.)
26850
26851 It is possible for a @samp{!!!} to refer to meta-variables bound
26852 elsewhere in the pattern. For example,
26853
26854 @example
26855 f(a, !!!a) := g(a)
26856 @end example
26857
26858 @noindent
26859 matches any call to @code{f} with different arguments, changing
26860 this to @code{g} with only the first argument.
26861
26862 If a function call is to be matched and one of the argument patterns
26863 contains a @samp{!!!} somewhere inside it, that argument will be
26864 matched last. Thus
26865
26866 @example
26867 f(!!!a, a) := g(a)
26868 @end example
26869
26870 @noindent
26871 will be careful to bind @samp{a} to the second argument of @code{f}
26872 before testing the first argument. If Calc had tried to match the
26873 first argument of @code{f} first, the results would have been
26874 disastrous: since @code{a} was unbound so far, the pattern @samp{a}
26875 would have matched anything at all, and the pattern @samp{!!!a}
26876 therefore would @emph{not} have matched anything at all!
26877
26878 @node Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules, Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules, Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26879 @subsection Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules
26880
26881 @noindent
26882 When @kbd{a r} (@code{calc-rewrite}) is used, it takes an expression from
26883 the top of the stack and attempts to match any of the specified rules
26884 to any part of the expression, starting with the whole expression
26885 and then, if that fails, trying deeper and deeper sub-expressions.
26886 For each part of the expression, the rules are tried in the order
26887 they appear in the rules vector. The first rule to match the first
26888 sub-expression wins; it replaces the matched sub-expression according
26889 to the @var{new} part of the rule.
26890
26891 Often, the rule set will match and change the formula several times.
26892 The top-level formula is first matched and substituted repeatedly until
26893 it no longer matches the pattern; then, sub-formulas are tried, and
26894 so on. Once every part of the formula has gotten its chance, the
26895 rewrite mechanism starts over again with the top-level formula
26896 (in case a substitution of one of its arguments has caused it again
26897 to match). This continues until no further matches can be made
26898 anywhere in the formula.
26899
26900 It is possible for a rule set to get into an infinite loop. The
26901 most obvious case, replacing a formula with itself, is not a problem
26902 because a rule is not considered to ``succeed'' unless the righthand
26903 side actually comes out to something different than the original
26904 formula or sub-formula that was matched. But if you accidentally
26905 had both @samp{ln(a b) := ln(a) + ln(b)} and the reverse
26906 @samp{ln(a) + ln(b) := ln(a b)} in your rule set, Calc would
26907 run forever switching a formula back and forth between the two
26908 forms.
26909
26910 To avoid disaster, Calc normally stops after 100 changes have been
26911 made to the formula. This will be enough for most multiple rewrites,
26912 but it will keep an endless loop of rewrites from locking up the
26913 computer forever. (On most systems, you can also type @kbd{C-g} to
26914 halt any Emacs command prematurely.)
26915
26916 To change this limit, give a positive numeric prefix argument.
26917 In particular, @kbd{M-1 a r} applies only one rewrite at a time,
26918 useful when you are first testing your rule (or just if repeated
26919 rewriting is not what is called for by your application).
26920
26921 @ignore
26922 @starindex
26923 @end ignore
26924 @ignore
26925 @mindex iter@idots
26926 @end ignore
26927 @tindex iterations
26928 You can also put a ``function call'' @samp{iterations(@var{n})}
26929 in place of a rule anywhere in your rules vector (but usually at
26930 the top). Then, @var{n} will be used instead of 100 as the default
26931 number of iterations for this rule set. You can use
26932 @samp{iterations(inf)} if you want no iteration limit by default.
26933 A prefix argument will override the @code{iterations} limit in the
26934 rule set.
26935
26936 @example
26937 [ iterations(1),
26938 f(x) := f(x+1) ]
26939 @end example
26940
26941 More precisely, the limit controls the number of ``iterations,''
26942 where each iteration is a successful matching of a rule pattern whose
26943 righthand side, after substituting meta-variables and applying the
26944 default simplifications, is different from the original sub-formula
26945 that was matched.
26946
26947 A prefix argument of zero sets the limit to infinity. Use with caution!
26948
26949 Given a negative numeric prefix argument, @kbd{a r} will match and
26950 substitute the top-level expression up to that many times, but
26951 will not attempt to match the rules to any sub-expressions.
26952
26953 In a formula, @code{rewrite(@var{expr}, @var{rules}, @var{n})}
26954 does a rewriting operation. Here @var{expr} is the expression
26955 being rewritten, @var{rules} is the rule, vector of rules, or
26956 variable containing the rules, and @var{n} is the optional
26957 iteration limit, which may be a positive integer, a negative
26958 integer, or @samp{inf} or @samp{-inf}. If @var{n} is omitted
26959 the @code{iterations} value from the rule set is used; if both
26960 are omitted, 100 is used.
26961
26962 @node Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules, Selections with Rewrite Rules, Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26963 @subsection Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules
26964
26965 @noindent
26966 It is possible to separate a rewrite rule set into several @dfn{phases}.
26967 During each phase, certain rules will be enabled while certain others
26968 will be disabled. A @dfn{phase schedule} controls the order in which
26969 phases occur during the rewriting process.
26970
26971 @ignore
26972 @starindex
26973 @end ignore
26974 @tindex phase
26975 @vindex all
26976 If a call to the marker function @code{phase} appears in the rules
26977 vector in place of a rule, all rules following that point will be
26978 members of the phase(s) identified in the arguments to @code{phase}.
26979 Phases are given integer numbers. The markers @samp{phase()} and
26980 @samp{phase(all)} both mean the following rules belong to all phases;
26981 this is the default at the start of the rule set.
26982
26983 If you do not explicitly schedule the phases, Calc sorts all phase
26984 numbers that appear in the rule set and executes the phases in
26985 ascending order. For example, the rule set
26986
26987 @example
26988 @group
26989 [ f0(x) := g0(x),
26990 phase(1),
26991 f1(x) := g1(x),
26992 phase(2),
26993 f2(x) := g2(x),
26994 phase(3),
26995 f3(x) := g3(x),
26996 phase(1,2),
26997 f4(x) := g4(x) ]
26998 @end group
26999 @end example
27000
27001 @noindent
27002 has three phases, 1 through 3. Phase 1 consists of the @code{f0},
27003 @code{f1}, and @code{f4} rules (in that order). Phase 2 consists of
27004 @code{f0}, @code{f2}, and @code{f4}. Phase 3 consists of @code{f0}
27005 and @code{f3}.
27006
27007 When Calc rewrites a formula using this rule set, it first rewrites
27008 the formula using only the phase 1 rules until no further changes are
27009 possible. Then it switches to the phase 2 rule set and continues
27010 until no further changes occur, then finally rewrites with phase 3.
27011 When no more phase 3 rules apply, rewriting finishes. (This is
27012 assuming @kbd{a r} with a large enough prefix argument to allow the
27013 rewriting to run to completion; the sequence just described stops
27014 early if the number of iterations specified in the prefix argument,
27015 100 by default, is reached.)
27016
27017 During each phase, Calc descends through the nested levels of the
27018 formula as described previously. (@xref{Nested Formulas with Rewrite
27019 Rules}.) Rewriting starts at the top of the formula, then works its
27020 way down to the parts, then goes back to the top and works down again.
27021 The phase 2 rules do not begin until no phase 1 rules apply anywhere
27022 in the formula.
27023
27024 @ignore
27025 @starindex
27026 @end ignore
27027 @tindex schedule
27028 A @code{schedule} marker appearing in the rule set (anywhere, but
27029 conventionally at the top) changes the default schedule of phases.
27030 In the simplest case, @code{schedule} has a sequence of phase numbers
27031 for arguments; each phase number is invoked in turn until the
27032 arguments to @code{schedule} are exhausted. Thus adding
27033 @samp{schedule(3,2,1)} at the top of the above rule set would
27034 reverse the order of the phases; @samp{schedule(1,2,3)} would have
27035 no effect since this is the default schedule; and @samp{schedule(1,2,1,3)}
27036 would give phase 1 a second chance after phase 2 has completed, before
27037 moving on to phase 3.
27038
27039 Any argument to @code{schedule} can instead be a vector of phase
27040 numbers (or even of sub-vectors). Then the sub-sequence of phases
27041 described by the vector are tried repeatedly until no change occurs
27042 in any phase in the sequence. For example, @samp{schedule([1, 2], 3)}
27043 tries phase 1, then phase 2, then, if either phase made any changes
27044 to the formula, repeats these two phases until they can make no
27045 further progress. Finally, it goes on to phase 3 for finishing
27046 touches.
27047
27048 Also, items in @code{schedule} can be variable names as well as
27049 numbers. A variable name is interpreted as the name of a function
27050 to call on the whole formula. For example, @samp{schedule(1, simplify)}
27051 says to apply the phase-1 rules (presumably, all of them), then to
27052 call @code{simplify} which is the function name equivalent of @kbd{a s}.
27053 Likewise, @samp{schedule([1, simplify])} says to alternate between
27054 phase 1 and @kbd{a s} until no further changes occur.
27055
27056 Phases can be used purely to improve efficiency; if it is known that
27057 a certain group of rules will apply only at the beginning of rewriting,
27058 and a certain other group will apply only at the end, then rewriting
27059 will be faster if these groups are identified as separate phases.
27060 Once the phase 1 rules are done, Calc can put them aside and no longer
27061 spend any time on them while it works on phase 2.
27062
27063 There are also some problems that can only be solved with several
27064 rewrite phases. For a real-world example of a multi-phase rule set,
27065 examine the set @code{FitRules}, which is used by the curve-fitting
27066 command to convert a model expression to linear form.
27067 @xref{Curve Fitting Details}. This set is divided into four phases.
27068 The first phase rewrites certain kinds of expressions to be more
27069 easily linearizable, but less computationally efficient. After the
27070 linear components have been picked out, the final phase includes the
27071 opposite rewrites to put each component back into an efficient form.
27072 If both sets of rules were included in one big phase, Calc could get
27073 into an infinite loop going back and forth between the two forms.
27074
27075 Elsewhere in @code{FitRules}, the components are first isolated,
27076 then recombined where possible to reduce the complexity of the linear
27077 fit, then finally packaged one component at a time into vectors.
27078 If the packaging rules were allowed to begin before the recombining
27079 rules were finished, some components might be put away into vectors
27080 before they had a chance to recombine. By putting these rules in
27081 two separate phases, this problem is neatly avoided.
27082
27083 @node Selections with Rewrite Rules, Matching Commands, Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
27084 @subsection Selections with Rewrite Rules
27085
27086 @noindent
27087 If a sub-formula of the current formula is selected (as by @kbd{j s};
27088 @pxref{Selecting Subformulas}), the @kbd{a r} (@code{calc-rewrite})
27089 command applies only to that sub-formula. Together with a negative
27090 prefix argument, you can use this fact to apply a rewrite to one
27091 specific part of a formula without affecting any other parts.
27092
27093 @kindex j r
27094 @pindex calc-rewrite-selection
27095 The @kbd{j r} (@code{calc-rewrite-selection}) command allows more
27096 sophisticated operations on selections. This command prompts for
27097 the rules in the same way as @kbd{a r}, but it then applies those
27098 rules to the whole formula in question even though a sub-formula
27099 of it has been selected. However, the selected sub-formula will
27100 first have been surrounded by a @samp{select( )} function call.
27101 (Calc's evaluator does not understand the function name @code{select};
27102 this is only a tag used by the @kbd{j r} command.)
27103
27104 For example, suppose the formula on the stack is @samp{2 (a + b)^2}
27105 and the sub-formula @samp{a + b} is selected. This formula will
27106 be rewritten to @samp{2 select(a + b)^2} and then the rewrite
27107 rules will be applied in the usual way. The rewrite rules can
27108 include references to @code{select} to tell where in the pattern
27109 the selected sub-formula should appear.
27110
27111 If there is still exactly one @samp{select( )} function call in
27112 the formula after rewriting is done, it indicates which part of
27113 the formula should be selected afterwards. Otherwise, the
27114 formula will be unselected.
27115
27116 You can make @kbd{j r} act much like @kbd{a r} by enclosing both parts
27117 of the rewrite rule with @samp{select()}. However, @kbd{j r}
27118 allows you to use the current selection in more flexible ways.
27119 Suppose you wished to make a rule which removed the exponent from
27120 the selected term; the rule @samp{select(a)^x := select(a)} would
27121 work. In the above example, it would rewrite @samp{2 select(a + b)^2}
27122 to @samp{2 select(a + b)}. This would then be returned to the
27123 stack as @samp{2 (a + b)} with the @samp{a + b} selected.
27124
27125 The @kbd{j r} command uses one iteration by default, unlike
27126 @kbd{a r} which defaults to 100 iterations. A numeric prefix
27127 argument affects @kbd{j r} in the same way as @kbd{a r}.
27128 @xref{Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules}.
27129
27130 As with other selection commands, @kbd{j r} operates on the stack
27131 entry that contains the cursor. (If the cursor is on the top-of-stack
27132 @samp{.} marker, it works as if the cursor were on the formula
27133 at stack level 1.)
27134
27135 If you don't specify a set of rules, the rules are taken from the
27136 top of the stack, just as with @kbd{a r}. In this case, the
27137 cursor must indicate stack entry 2 or above as the formula to be
27138 rewritten (otherwise the same formula would be used as both the
27139 target and the rewrite rules).
27140
27141 If the indicated formula has no selection, the cursor position within
27142 the formula temporarily selects a sub-formula for the purposes of this
27143 command. If the cursor is not on any sub-formula (e.g., it is in
27144 the line-number area to the left of the formula), the @samp{select( )}
27145 markers are ignored by the rewrite mechanism and the rules are allowed
27146 to apply anywhere in the formula.
27147
27148 As a special feature, the normal @kbd{a r} command also ignores
27149 @samp{select( )} calls in rewrite rules. For example, if you used the
27150 above rule @samp{select(a)^x := select(a)} with @kbd{a r}, it would apply
27151 the rule as if it were @samp{a^x := a}. Thus, you can write general
27152 purpose rules with @samp{select( )} hints inside them so that they
27153 will ``do the right thing'' in both @kbd{a r} and @kbd{j r},
27154 both with and without selections.
27155
27156 @node Matching Commands, Automatic Rewrites, Selections with Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
27157 @subsection Matching Commands
27158
27159 @noindent
27160 @kindex a m
27161 @pindex calc-match
27162 @tindex match
27163 The @kbd{a m} (@code{calc-match}) [@code{match}] function takes a
27164 vector of formulas and a rewrite-rule-style pattern, and produces
27165 a vector of all formulas which match the pattern. The command
27166 prompts you to enter the pattern; as for @kbd{a r}, you can enter
27167 a single pattern (i.e., a formula with meta-variables), or a
27168 vector of patterns, or a variable which contains patterns, or
27169 you can give a blank response in which case the patterns are taken
27170 from the top of the stack. The pattern set will be compiled once
27171 and saved if it is stored in a variable. If there are several
27172 patterns in the set, vector elements are kept if they match any
27173 of the patterns.
27174
27175 For example, @samp{match(a+b, [x, x+y, x-y, 7, x+y+z])}
27176 will return @samp{[x+y, x-y, x+y+z]}.
27177
27178 The @code{import} mechanism is not available for pattern sets.
27179
27180 The @kbd{a m} command can also be used to extract all vector elements
27181 which satisfy any condition: The pattern @samp{x :: x>0} will select
27182 all the positive vector elements.
27183
27184 @kindex I a m
27185 @tindex matchnot
27186 With the Inverse flag [@code{matchnot}], this command extracts all
27187 vector elements which do @emph{not} match the given pattern.
27188
27189 @ignore
27190 @starindex
27191 @end ignore
27192 @tindex matches
27193 There is also a function @samp{matches(@var{x}, @var{p})} which
27194 evaluates to 1 if expression @var{x} matches pattern @var{p}, or
27195 to 0 otherwise. This is sometimes useful for including into the
27196 conditional clauses of other rewrite rules.
27197
27198 @ignore
27199 @starindex
27200 @end ignore
27201 @tindex vmatches
27202 The function @code{vmatches} is just like @code{matches}, except
27203 that if the match succeeds it returns a vector of assignments to
27204 the meta-variables instead of the number 1. For example,
27205 @samp{vmatches(f(1,2), f(a,b))} returns @samp{[a := 1, b := 2]}.
27206 If the match fails, the function returns the number 0.
27207
27208 @node Automatic Rewrites, Debugging Rewrites, Matching Commands, Rewrite Rules
27209 @subsection Automatic Rewrites
27210
27211 @noindent
27212 @cindex @code{EvalRules} variable
27213 @vindex EvalRules
27214 It is possible to get Calc to apply a set of rewrite rules on all
27215 results, effectively adding to the built-in set of default
27216 simplifications. To do this, simply store your rule set in the
27217 variable @code{EvalRules}. There is a convenient @kbd{s E} command
27218 for editing @code{EvalRules}; @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
27219
27220 For example, suppose you want @samp{sin(a + b)} to be expanded out
27221 to @samp{sin(b) cos(a) + cos(b) sin(a)} wherever it appears, and
27222 similarly for @samp{cos(a + b)}. The corresponding rewrite rule
27223 set would be,
27224
27225 @smallexample
27226 @group
27227 [ sin(a + b) := cos(a) sin(b) + sin(a) cos(b),
27228 cos(a + b) := cos(a) cos(b) - sin(a) sin(b) ]
27229 @end group
27230 @end smallexample
27231
27232 To apply these manually, you could put them in a variable called
27233 @code{trigexp} and then use @kbd{a r trigexp} every time you wanted
27234 to expand trig functions. But if instead you store them in the
27235 variable @code{EvalRules}, they will automatically be applied to all
27236 sines and cosines of sums. Then, with @samp{2 x} and @samp{45} on
27237 the stack, typing @kbd{+ S} will (assuming Degrees mode) result in
27238 @samp{0.7071 sin(2 x) + 0.7071 cos(2 x)} automatically.
27239
27240 As each level of a formula is evaluated, the rules from
27241 @code{EvalRules} are applied before the default simplifications.
27242 Rewriting continues until no further @code{EvalRules} apply.
27243 Note that this is different from the usual order of application of
27244 rewrite rules: @code{EvalRules} works from the bottom up, simplifying
27245 the arguments to a function before the function itself, while @kbd{a r}
27246 applies rules from the top down.
27247
27248 Because the @code{EvalRules} are tried first, you can use them to
27249 override the normal behavior of any built-in Calc function.
27250
27251 It is important not to write a rule that will get into an infinite
27252 loop. For example, the rule set @samp{[f(0) := 1, f(n) := n f(n-1)]}
27253 appears to be a good definition of a factorial function, but it is
27254 unsafe. Imagine what happens if @samp{f(2.5)} is simplified. Calc
27255 will continue to subtract 1 from this argument forever without reaching
27256 zero. A safer second rule would be @samp{f(n) := n f(n-1) :: n>0}.
27257 Another dangerous rule is @samp{g(x, y) := g(y, x)}. Rewriting
27258 @samp{g(2, 4)}, this would bounce back and forth between that and
27259 @samp{g(4, 2)} forever. If an infinite loop in @code{EvalRules}
27260 occurs, Emacs will eventually stop with a ``Computation got stuck
27261 or ran too long'' message.
27262
27263 Another subtle difference between @code{EvalRules} and regular rewrites
27264 concerns rules that rewrite a formula into an identical formula. For
27265 example, @samp{f(n) := f(floor(n))} ``fails to match'' when @expr{n} is
27266 already an integer. But in @code{EvalRules} this case is detected only
27267 if the righthand side literally becomes the original formula before any
27268 further simplification. This means that @samp{f(n) := f(floor(n))} will
27269 get into an infinite loop if it occurs in @code{EvalRules}. Calc will
27270 replace @samp{f(6)} with @samp{f(floor(6))}, which is different from
27271 @samp{f(6)}, so it will consider the rule to have matched and will
27272 continue simplifying that formula; first the argument is simplified
27273 to get @samp{f(6)}, then the rule matches again to get @samp{f(floor(6))}
27274 again, ad infinitum. A much safer rule would check its argument first,
27275 say, with @samp{f(n) := f(floor(n)) :: !dint(n)}.
27276
27277 (What really happens is that the rewrite mechanism substitutes the
27278 meta-variables in the righthand side of a rule, compares to see if the
27279 result is the same as the original formula and fails if so, then uses
27280 the default simplifications to simplify the result and compares again
27281 (and again fails if the formula has simplified back to its original
27282 form). The only special wrinkle for the @code{EvalRules} is that the
27283 same rules will come back into play when the default simplifications
27284 are used. What Calc wants to do is build @samp{f(floor(6))}, see that
27285 this is different from the original formula, simplify to @samp{f(6)},
27286 see that this is the same as the original formula, and thus halt the
27287 rewriting. But while simplifying, @samp{f(6)} will again trigger
27288 the same @code{EvalRules} rule and Calc will get into a loop inside
27289 the rewrite mechanism itself.)
27290
27291 The @code{phase}, @code{schedule}, and @code{iterations} markers do
27292 not work in @code{EvalRules}. If the rule set is divided into phases,
27293 only the phase 1 rules are applied, and the schedule is ignored.
27294 The rules are always repeated as many times as possible.
27295
27296 The @code{EvalRules} are applied to all function calls in a formula,
27297 but not to numbers (and other number-like objects like error forms),
27298 nor to vectors or individual variable names. (Though they will apply
27299 to @emph{components} of vectors and error forms when appropriate.) You
27300 might try to make a variable @code{phihat} which automatically expands
27301 to its definition without the need to press @kbd{=} by writing the
27302 rule @samp{quote(phihat) := (1-sqrt(5))/2}, but unfortunately this rule
27303 will not work as part of @code{EvalRules}.
27304
27305 Finally, another limitation is that Calc sometimes calls its built-in
27306 functions directly rather than going through the default simplifications.
27307 When it does this, @code{EvalRules} will not be able to override those
27308 functions. For example, when you take the absolute value of the complex
27309 number @expr{(2, 3)}, Calc computes @samp{sqrt(2*2 + 3*3)} by calling
27310 the multiplication, addition, and square root functions directly rather
27311 than applying the default simplifications to this formula. So an
27312 @code{EvalRules} rule that (perversely) rewrites @samp{sqrt(13) := 6}
27313 would not apply. (However, if you put Calc into Symbolic mode so that
27314 @samp{sqrt(13)} will be left in symbolic form by the built-in square
27315 root function, your rule will be able to apply. But if the complex
27316 number were @expr{(3,4)}, so that @samp{sqrt(25)} must be calculated,
27317 then Symbolic mode will not help because @samp{sqrt(25)} can be
27318 evaluated exactly to 5.)
27319
27320 One subtle restriction that normally only manifests itself with
27321 @code{EvalRules} is that while a given rewrite rule is in the process
27322 of being checked, that same rule cannot be recursively applied. Calc
27323 effectively removes the rule from its rule set while checking the rule,
27324 then puts it back once the match succeeds or fails. (The technical
27325 reason for this is that compiled pattern programs are not reentrant.)
27326 For example, consider the rule @samp{foo(x) := x :: foo(x/2) > 0}
27327 attempting to match @samp{foo(8)}. This rule will be inactive while
27328 the condition @samp{foo(4) > 0} is checked, even though it might be
27329 an integral part of evaluating that condition. Note that this is not
27330 a problem for the more usual recursive type of rule, such as
27331 @samp{foo(x) := foo(x/2)}, because there the rule has succeeded and
27332 been reactivated by the time the righthand side is evaluated.
27333
27334 If @code{EvalRules} has no stored value (its default state), or if
27335 anything but a vector is stored in it, then it is ignored.
27336
27337 Even though Calc's rewrite mechanism is designed to compare rewrite
27338 rules to formulas as quickly as possible, storing rules in
27339 @code{EvalRules} may make Calc run substantially slower. This is
27340 particularly true of rules where the top-level call is a commonly used
27341 function, or is not fixed. The rule @samp{f(n) := n f(n-1) :: n>0} will
27342 only activate the rewrite mechanism for calls to the function @code{f},
27343 but @samp{lg(n) + lg(m) := lg(n m)} will check every @samp{+} operator.
27344
27345 @smallexample
27346 apply(f, [a*b]) := apply(f, [a]) + apply(f, [b]) :: in(f, [ln, log10])
27347 @end smallexample
27348
27349 @noindent
27350 may seem more ``efficient'' than two separate rules for @code{ln} and
27351 @code{log10}, but actually it is vastly less efficient because rules
27352 with @code{apply} as the top-level pattern must be tested against
27353 @emph{every} function call that is simplified.
27354
27355 @cindex @code{AlgSimpRules} variable
27356 @vindex AlgSimpRules
27357 Suppose you want @samp{sin(a + b)} to be expanded out not all the time,
27358 but only when @kbd{a s} is used to simplify the formula. The variable
27359 @code{AlgSimpRules} holds rules for this purpose. The @kbd{a s} command
27360 will apply @code{EvalRules} and @code{AlgSimpRules} to the formula, as
27361 well as all of its built-in simplifications.
27362
27363 Most of the special limitations for @code{EvalRules} don't apply to
27364 @code{AlgSimpRules}. Calc simply does an @kbd{a r AlgSimpRules}
27365 command with an infinite repeat count as the first step of @kbd{a s}.
27366 It then applies its own built-in simplifications throughout the
27367 formula, and then repeats these two steps (along with applying the
27368 default simplifications) until no further changes are possible.
27369
27370 @cindex @code{ExtSimpRules} variable
27371 @cindex @code{UnitSimpRules} variable
27372 @vindex ExtSimpRules
27373 @vindex UnitSimpRules
27374 There are also @code{ExtSimpRules} and @code{UnitSimpRules} variables
27375 that are used by @kbd{a e} and @kbd{u s}, respectively; these commands
27376 also apply @code{EvalRules} and @code{AlgSimpRules}. The variable
27377 @code{IntegSimpRules} contains simplification rules that are used
27378 only during integration by @kbd{a i}.
27379
27380 @node Debugging Rewrites, Examples of Rewrite Rules, Automatic Rewrites, Rewrite Rules
27381 @subsection Debugging Rewrites
27382
27383 @noindent
27384 If a buffer named @samp{*Trace*} exists, the rewrite mechanism will
27385 record some useful information there as it operates. The original
27386 formula is written there, as is the result of each successful rewrite,
27387 and the final result of the rewriting. All phase changes are also
27388 noted.
27389
27390 Calc always appends to @samp{*Trace*}. You must empty this buffer
27391 yourself periodically if it is in danger of growing unwieldy.
27392
27393 Note that the rewriting mechanism is substantially slower when the
27394 @samp{*Trace*} buffer exists, even if the buffer is not visible on
27395 the screen. Once you are done, you will probably want to kill this
27396 buffer (with @kbd{C-x k *Trace* @key{RET}}). If you leave it in
27397 existence and forget about it, all your future rewrite commands will
27398 be needlessly slow.
27399
27400 @node Examples of Rewrite Rules, , Debugging Rewrites, Rewrite Rules
27401 @subsection Examples of Rewrite Rules
27402
27403 @noindent
27404 Returning to the example of substituting the pattern
27405 @samp{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2} with 1, we saw that the rule
27406 @samp{opt(a) sin(x)^2 + opt(a) cos(x)^2 := a} does a good job of
27407 finding suitable cases. Another solution would be to use the rule
27408 @samp{cos(x)^2 := 1 - sin(x)^2}, followed by algebraic simplification
27409 if necessary. This rule will be the most effective way to do the job,
27410 but at the expense of making some changes that you might not desire.
27411
27412 Another algebraic rewrite rule is @samp{exp(x+y) := exp(x) exp(y)}.
27413 To make this work with the @w{@kbd{j r}} command so that it can be
27414 easily targeted to a particular exponential in a large formula,
27415 you might wish to write the rule as @samp{select(exp(x+y)) :=
27416 select(exp(x) exp(y))}. The @samp{select} markers will be
27417 ignored by the regular @kbd{a r} command
27418 (@pxref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}).
27419
27420 A surprisingly useful rewrite rule is @samp{a/(b-c) := a*(b+c)/(b^2-c^2)}.
27421 This will simplify the formula whenever @expr{b} and/or @expr{c} can
27422 be made simpler by squaring. For example, applying this rule to
27423 @samp{2 / (sqrt(2) + 3)} yields @samp{6:7 - 2:7 sqrt(2)} (assuming
27424 Symbolic mode has been enabled to keep the square root from being
27425 evaluated to a floating-point approximation). This rule is also
27426 useful when working with symbolic complex numbers, e.g.,
27427 @samp{(a + b i) / (c + d i)}.
27428
27429 As another example, we could define our own ``triangular numbers'' function
27430 with the rules @samp{[tri(0) := 0, tri(n) := n + tri(n-1) :: n>0]}. Enter
27431 this vector and store it in a variable: @kbd{@w{s t} trirules}. Now, given
27432 a suitable formula like @samp{tri(5)} on the stack, type @samp{a r trirules}
27433 to apply these rules repeatedly. After six applications, @kbd{a r} will
27434 stop with 15 on the stack. Once these rules are debugged, it would probably
27435 be most useful to add them to @code{EvalRules} so that Calc will evaluate
27436 the new @code{tri} function automatically. We could then use @kbd{Z K} on
27437 the keyboard macro @kbd{' tri($) @key{RET}} to make a command that applies
27438 @code{tri} to the value on the top of the stack. @xref{Programming}.
27439
27440 @cindex Quaternions
27441 The following rule set, contributed by
27442 @texline Fran\c cois
27443 @infoline Francois
27444 Pinard, implements @dfn{quaternions}, a generalization of the concept of
27445 complex numbers. Quaternions have four components, and are here
27446 represented by function calls @samp{quat(@var{w}, [@var{x}, @var{y},
27447 @var{z}])} with ``real part'' @var{w} and the three ``imaginary'' parts
27448 collected into a vector. Various arithmetical operations on quaternions
27449 are supported. To use these rules, either add them to @code{EvalRules},
27450 or create a command based on @kbd{a r} for simplifying quaternion
27451 formulas. A convenient way to enter quaternions would be a command
27452 defined by a keyboard macro containing: @kbd{' quat($$$$, [$$$, $$, $])
27453 @key{RET}}.
27454
27455 @smallexample
27456 [ quat(w, x, y, z) := quat(w, [x, y, z]),
27457 quat(w, [0, 0, 0]) := w,
27458 abs(quat(w, v)) := hypot(w, v),
27459 -quat(w, v) := quat(-w, -v),
27460 r + quat(w, v) := quat(r + w, v) :: real(r),
27461 r - quat(w, v) := quat(r - w, -v) :: real(r),
27462 quat(w1, v1) + quat(w2, v2) := quat(w1 + w2, v1 + v2),
27463 r * quat(w, v) := quat(r * w, r * v) :: real(r),
27464 plain(quat(w1, v1) * quat(w2, v2))
27465 := quat(w1 * w2 - v1 * v2, w1 * v2 + w2 * v1 + cross(v1, v2)),
27466 quat(w1, v1) / r := quat(w1 / r, v1 / r) :: real(r),
27467 z / quat(w, v) := z * quatinv(quat(w, v)),
27468 quatinv(quat(w, v)) := quat(w, -v) / (w^2 + v^2),
27469 quatsqr(quat(w, v)) := quat(w^2 - v^2, 2 * w * v),
27470 quat(w, v)^k := quatsqr(quat(w, v)^(k / 2))
27471 :: integer(k) :: k > 0 :: k % 2 = 0,
27472 quat(w, v)^k := quatsqr(quat(w, v)^((k - 1) / 2)) * quat(w, v)
27473 :: integer(k) :: k > 2,
27474 quat(w, v)^-k := quatinv(quat(w, v)^k) :: integer(k) :: k > 0 ]
27475 @end smallexample
27476
27477 Quaternions, like matrices, have non-commutative multiplication.
27478 In other words, @expr{q1 * q2 = q2 * q1} is not necessarily true if
27479 @expr{q1} and @expr{q2} are @code{quat} forms. The @samp{quat*quat}
27480 rule above uses @code{plain} to prevent Calc from rearranging the
27481 product. It may also be wise to add the line @samp{[quat(), matrix]}
27482 to the @code{Decls} matrix, to ensure that Calc's other algebraic
27483 operations will not rearrange a quaternion product. @xref{Declarations}.
27484
27485 These rules also accept a four-argument @code{quat} form, converting
27486 it to the preferred form in the first rule. If you would rather see
27487 results in the four-argument form, just append the two items
27488 @samp{phase(2), quat(w, [x, y, z]) := quat(w, x, y, z)} to the end
27489 of the rule set. (But remember that multi-phase rule sets don't work
27490 in @code{EvalRules}.)
27491
27492 @node Units, Store and Recall, Algebra, Top
27493 @chapter Operating on Units
27494
27495 @noindent
27496 One special interpretation of algebraic formulas is as numbers with units.
27497 For example, the formula @samp{5 m / s^2} can be read ``five meters
27498 per second squared.'' The commands in this chapter help you
27499 manipulate units expressions in this form. Units-related commands
27500 begin with the @kbd{u} prefix key.
27501
27502 @menu
27503 * Basic Operations on Units::
27504 * The Units Table::
27505 * Predefined Units::
27506 * User-Defined Units::
27507 @end menu
27508
27509 @node Basic Operations on Units, The Units Table, Units, Units
27510 @section Basic Operations on Units
27511
27512 @noindent
27513 A @dfn{units expression} is a formula which is basically a number
27514 multiplied and/or divided by one or more @dfn{unit names}, which may
27515 optionally be raised to integer powers. Actually, the value part need not
27516 be a number; any product or quotient involving unit names is a units
27517 expression. Many of the units commands will also accept any formula,
27518 where the command applies to all units expressions which appear in the
27519 formula.
27520
27521 A unit name is a variable whose name appears in the @dfn{unit table},
27522 or a variable whose name is a prefix character like @samp{k} (for ``kilo'')
27523 or @samp{u} (for ``micro'') followed by a name in the unit table.
27524 A substantial table of built-in units is provided with Calc;
27525 @pxref{Predefined Units}. You can also define your own unit names;
27526 @pxref{User-Defined Units}.
27527
27528 Note that if the value part of a units expression is exactly @samp{1},
27529 it will be removed by the Calculator's automatic algebra routines: The
27530 formula @samp{1 mm} is ``simplified'' to @samp{mm}. This is only a
27531 display anomaly, however; @samp{mm} will work just fine as a
27532 representation of one millimeter.
27533
27534 You may find that Algebraic mode (@pxref{Algebraic Entry}) makes working
27535 with units expressions easier. Otherwise, you will have to remember
27536 to hit the apostrophe key every time you wish to enter units.
27537
27538 @kindex u s
27539 @pindex calc-simplify-units
27540 @ignore
27541 @mindex usimpl@idots
27542 @end ignore
27543 @tindex usimplify
27544 The @kbd{u s} (@code{calc-simplify-units}) [@code{usimplify}] command
27545 simplifies a units
27546 expression. It uses @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}) to simplify the
27547 expression first as a regular algebraic formula; it then looks for
27548 features that can be further simplified by converting one object's units
27549 to be compatible with another's. For example, @samp{5 m + 23 mm} will
27550 simplify to @samp{5.023 m}. When different but compatible units are
27551 added, the righthand term's units are converted to match those of the
27552 lefthand term. @xref{Simplification Modes}, for a way to have this done
27553 automatically at all times.
27554
27555 Units simplification also handles quotients of two units with the same
27556 dimensionality, as in @w{@samp{2 in s/L cm}} to @samp{5.08 s/L}; fractional
27557 powers of unit expressions, as in @samp{sqrt(9 mm^2)} to @samp{3 mm} and
27558 @samp{sqrt(9 acre)} to a quantity in meters; and @code{floor},
27559 @code{ceil}, @code{round}, @code{rounde}, @code{roundu}, @code{trunc},
27560 @code{float}, @code{frac}, @code{abs}, and @code{clean}
27561 applied to units expressions, in which case
27562 the operation in question is applied only to the numeric part of the
27563 expression. Finally, trigonometric functions of quantities with units
27564 of angle are evaluated, regardless of the current angular mode.
27565
27566 @kindex u c
27567 @pindex calc-convert-units
27568 The @kbd{u c} (@code{calc-convert-units}) command converts a units
27569 expression to new, compatible units. For example, given the units
27570 expression @samp{55 mph}, typing @kbd{u c m/s @key{RET}} produces
27571 @samp{24.5872 m/s}. If you have previously converted a units expression
27572 with the same type of units (in this case, distance over time), you will
27573 be offered the previous choice of new units as a default. Continuing
27574 the above example, entering the units expression @samp{100 km/hr} and
27575 typing @kbd{u c @key{RET}} (without specifying new units) produces
27576 @samp{27.7777777778 m/s}.
27577
27578 While many of Calc's conversion factors are exact, some are necessarily
27579 approximate. If Calc is in fraction mode (@pxref{Fraction Mode}), then
27580 unit conversions will try to give exact, rational conversions, but it
27581 isn't always possible. Given @samp{55 mph} in fraction mode, typing
27582 @kbd{u c m/s @key{RET}} produces @samp{15367:625 m/s}, for example,
27583 while typing @kbd{u c au/yr @key{RET}} produces
27584 @samp{5.18665819999e-3 au/yr}.
27585
27586 If the units you request are inconsistent with the original units, the
27587 number will be converted into your units times whatever ``remainder''
27588 units are left over. For example, converting @samp{55 mph} into acres
27589 produces @samp{6.08e-3 acre / m s}. (Recall that multiplication binds
27590 more strongly than division in Calc formulas, so the units here are
27591 acres per meter-second.) Remainder units are expressed in terms of
27592 ``fundamental'' units like @samp{m} and @samp{s}, regardless of the
27593 input units.
27594
27595 One special exception is that if you specify a single unit name, and
27596 a compatible unit appears somewhere in the units expression, then
27597 that compatible unit will be converted to the new unit and the
27598 remaining units in the expression will be left alone. For example,
27599 given the input @samp{980 cm/s^2}, the command @kbd{u c ms} will
27600 change the @samp{s} to @samp{ms} to get @samp{9.8e-4 cm/ms^2}.
27601 The ``remainder unit'' @samp{cm} is left alone rather than being
27602 changed to the base unit @samp{m}.
27603
27604 You can use explicit unit conversion instead of the @kbd{u s} command
27605 to gain more control over the units of the result of an expression.
27606 For example, given @samp{5 m + 23 mm}, you can type @kbd{u c m} or
27607 @kbd{u c mm} to express the result in either meters or millimeters.
27608 (For that matter, you could type @kbd{u c fath} to express the result
27609 in fathoms, if you preferred!)
27610
27611 In place of a specific set of units, you can also enter one of the
27612 units system names @code{si}, @code{mks} (equivalent), or @code{cgs}.
27613 For example, @kbd{u c si @key{RET}} converts the expression into
27614 International System of Units (SI) base units. Also, @kbd{u c base}
27615 converts to Calc's base units, which are the same as @code{si} units
27616 except that @code{base} uses @samp{g} as the fundamental unit of mass
27617 whereas @code{si} uses @samp{kg}.
27618
27619 @cindex Composite units
27620 The @kbd{u c} command also accepts @dfn{composite units}, which
27621 are expressed as the sum of several compatible unit names. For
27622 example, converting @samp{30.5 in} to units @samp{mi+ft+in} (miles,
27623 feet, and inches) produces @samp{2 ft + 6.5 in}. Calc first
27624 sorts the unit names into order of decreasing relative size.
27625 It then accounts for as much of the input quantity as it can
27626 using an integer number times the largest unit, then moves on
27627 to the next smaller unit, and so on. Only the smallest unit
27628 may have a non-integer amount attached in the result. A few
27629 standard unit names exist for common combinations, such as
27630 @code{mfi} for @samp{mi+ft+in}, and @code{tpo} for @samp{ton+lb+oz}.
27631 Composite units are expanded as if by @kbd{a x}, so that
27632 @samp{(ft+in)/hr} is first converted to @samp{ft/hr+in/hr}.
27633
27634 If the value on the stack does not contain any units, @kbd{u c} will
27635 prompt first for the old units which this value should be considered
27636 to have, then for the new units. Assuming the old and new units you
27637 give are consistent with each other, the result also will not contain
27638 any units. For example, @kbd{@w{u c} cm @key{RET} in @key{RET}}
27639 converts the number 2 on the stack to 5.08.
27640
27641 @kindex u b
27642 @pindex calc-base-units
27643 The @kbd{u b} (@code{calc-base-units}) command is shorthand for
27644 @kbd{u c base}; it converts the units expression on the top of the
27645 stack into @code{base} units. If @kbd{u s} does not simplify a
27646 units expression as far as you would like, try @kbd{u b}.
27647
27648 The @kbd{u c} and @kbd{u b} commands treat temperature units (like
27649 @samp{degC} and @samp{K}) as relative temperatures. For example,
27650 @kbd{u c} converts @samp{10 degC} to @samp{18 degF}: A change of 10
27651 degrees Celsius corresponds to a change of 18 degrees Fahrenheit.
27652
27653 @kindex u t
27654 @pindex calc-convert-temperature
27655 @cindex Temperature conversion
27656 The @kbd{u t} (@code{calc-convert-temperature}) command converts
27657 absolute temperatures. The value on the stack must be a simple units
27658 expression with units of temperature only. This command would convert
27659 @samp{10 degC} to @samp{50 degF}, the equivalent temperature on the
27660 Fahrenheit scale.
27661
27662 @kindex u r
27663 @pindex calc-remove-units
27664 @kindex u x
27665 @pindex calc-extract-units
27666 The @kbd{u r} (@code{calc-remove-units}) command removes units from the
27667 formula at the top of the stack. The @kbd{u x}
27668 (@code{calc-extract-units}) command extracts only the units portion of a
27669 formula. These commands essentially replace every term of the formula
27670 that does or doesn't (respectively) look like a unit name by the
27671 constant 1, then resimplify the formula.
27672
27673 @kindex u a
27674 @pindex calc-autorange-units
27675 The @kbd{u a} (@code{calc-autorange-units}) command turns on and off a
27676 mode in which unit prefixes like @code{k} (``kilo'') are automatically
27677 applied to keep the numeric part of a units expression in a reasonable
27678 range. This mode affects @kbd{u s} and all units conversion commands
27679 except @kbd{u b}. For example, with autoranging on, @samp{12345 Hz}
27680 will be simplified to @samp{12.345 kHz}. Autoranging is useful for
27681 some kinds of units (like @code{Hz} and @code{m}), but is probably
27682 undesirable for non-metric units like @code{ft} and @code{tbsp}.
27683 (Composite units are more appropriate for those; see above.)
27684
27685 Autoranging always applies the prefix to the leftmost unit name.
27686 Calc chooses the largest prefix that causes the number to be greater
27687 than or equal to 1.0. Thus an increasing sequence of adjusted times
27688 would be @samp{1 ms, 10 ms, 100 ms, 1 s, 10 s, 100 s, 1 ks}.
27689 Generally the rule of thumb is that the number will be adjusted
27690 to be in the interval @samp{[1 .. 1000)}, although there are several
27691 exceptions to this rule. First, if the unit has a power then this
27692 is not possible; @samp{0.1 s^2} simplifies to @samp{100000 ms^2}.
27693 Second, the ``centi-'' prefix is allowed to form @code{cm} (centimeters),
27694 but will not apply to other units. The ``deci-,'' ``deka-,'' and
27695 ``hecto-'' prefixes are never used. Thus the allowable interval is
27696 @samp{[1 .. 10)} for millimeters and @samp{[1 .. 100)} for centimeters.
27697 Finally, a prefix will not be added to a unit if the resulting name
27698 is also the actual name of another unit; @samp{1e-15 t} would normally
27699 be considered a ``femto-ton,'' but it is written as @samp{1000 at}
27700 (1000 atto-tons) instead because @code{ft} would be confused with feet.
27701
27702 @node The Units Table, Predefined Units, Basic Operations on Units, Units
27703 @section The Units Table
27704
27705 @noindent
27706 @kindex u v
27707 @pindex calc-enter-units-table
27708 The @kbd{u v} (@code{calc-enter-units-table}) command displays the units table
27709 in another buffer called @code{*Units Table*}. Each entry in this table
27710 gives the unit name as it would appear in an expression, the definition
27711 of the unit in terms of simpler units, and a full name or description of
27712 the unit. Fundamental units are defined as themselves; these are the
27713 units produced by the @kbd{u b} command. The fundamental units are
27714 meters, seconds, grams, kelvins, amperes, candelas, moles, radians,
27715 and steradians.
27716
27717 The Units Table buffer also displays the Unit Prefix Table. Note that
27718 two prefixes, ``kilo'' and ``hecto,'' accept either upper- or lower-case
27719 prefix letters. @samp{Meg} is also accepted as a synonym for the @samp{M}
27720 prefix. Whenever a unit name can be interpreted as either a built-in name
27721 or a prefix followed by another built-in name, the former interpretation
27722 wins. For example, @samp{2 pt} means two pints, not two pico-tons.
27723
27724 The Units Table buffer, once created, is not rebuilt unless you define
27725 new units. To force the buffer to be rebuilt, give any numeric prefix
27726 argument to @kbd{u v}.
27727
27728 @kindex u V
27729 @pindex calc-view-units-table
27730 The @kbd{u V} (@code{calc-view-units-table}) command is like @kbd{u v} except
27731 that the cursor is not moved into the Units Table buffer. You can
27732 type @kbd{u V} again to remove the Units Table from the display. To
27733 return from the Units Table buffer after a @kbd{u v}, type @kbd{C-x * c}
27734 again or use the regular Emacs @w{@kbd{C-x o}} (@code{other-window})
27735 command. You can also kill the buffer with @kbd{C-x k} if you wish;
27736 the actual units table is safely stored inside the Calculator.
27737
27738 @kindex u g
27739 @pindex calc-get-unit-definition
27740 The @kbd{u g} (@code{calc-get-unit-definition}) command retrieves a unit's
27741 defining expression and pushes it onto the Calculator stack. For example,
27742 @kbd{u g in} will produce the expression @samp{2.54 cm}. This is the
27743 same definition for the unit that would appear in the Units Table buffer.
27744 Note that this command works only for actual unit names; @kbd{u g km}
27745 will report that no such unit exists, for example, because @code{km} is
27746 really the unit @code{m} with a @code{k} (``kilo'') prefix. To see a
27747 definition of a unit in terms of base units, it is easier to push the
27748 unit name on the stack and then reduce it to base units with @kbd{u b}.
27749
27750 @kindex u e
27751 @pindex calc-explain-units
27752 The @kbd{u e} (@code{calc-explain-units}) command displays an English
27753 description of the units of the expression on the stack. For example,
27754 for the expression @samp{62 km^2 g / s^2 mol K}, the description is
27755 ``Square-Kilometer Gram per (Second-squared Mole Degree-Kelvin).'' This
27756 command uses the English descriptions that appear in the righthand
27757 column of the Units Table.
27758
27759 @node Predefined Units, User-Defined Units, The Units Table, Units
27760 @section Predefined Units
27761
27762 @noindent
27763 The definitions of many units have changed over the years. For example,
27764 the meter was originally defined in 1791 as one ten-millionth of the
27765 distance from the equator to the north pole. In order to be more
27766 precise, the definition was adjusted several times, and now a meter is
27767 defined as the distance that light will travel in a vacuum in
27768 1/299792458 of a second; consequently, the speed of light in a
27769 vacuum is exactly 299792458 m/s. Many other units have been
27770 redefined in terms of fundamental physical processes; a second, for
27771 example, is currently defined as 9192631770 periods of a certain
27772 radiation related to the cesium-133 atom. The only SI unit that is not
27773 based on a fundamental physical process (although there are efforts to
27774 change this) is the kilogram, which was originally defined as the mass
27775 of one liter of water, but is now defined as the mass of the
27776 International Prototype Kilogram (IPK), a cylinder of platinum-iridium
27777 kept at the Bureau International des Poids et Mesures in S@`evres,
27778 France. (There are several copies of the IPK throughout the world.)
27779 The British imperial units, once defined in terms of physical objects,
27780 were redefined in 1963 in terms of SI units. The US customary units,
27781 which were the same as British units until the British imperial system
27782 was created in 1824, were also defined in terms of the SI units in 1893.
27783 Because of these redefinitions, conversions between metric, British
27784 Imperial, and US customary units can often be done precisely.
27785
27786 Since the exact definitions of many kinds of units have evolved over the
27787 years, and since certain countries sometimes have local differences in
27788 their definitions, it is a good idea to examine Calc's definition of a
27789 unit before depending on its exact value. For example, there are three
27790 different units for gallons, corresponding to the US (@code{gal}),
27791 Canadian (@code{galC}), and British (@code{galUK}) definitions. Also,
27792 note that @code{oz} is a standard ounce of mass, @code{ozt} is a Troy
27793 ounce, and @code{ozfl} is a fluid ounce.
27794
27795 The temperature units corresponding to degrees Kelvin and Centigrade
27796 (Celsius) are the same in this table, since most units commands treat
27797 temperatures as being relative. The @code{calc-convert-temperature}
27798 command has special rules for handling the different absolute magnitudes
27799 of the various temperature scales.
27800
27801 The unit of volume ``liters'' can be referred to by either the lower-case
27802 @code{l} or the upper-case @code{L}.
27803
27804 The unit @code{A} stands for Amperes; the name @code{Ang} is used
27805 @tex
27806 for \AA ngstroms.
27807 @end tex
27808 @ifnottex
27809 for Angstroms.
27810 @end ifnottex
27811
27812 The unit @code{pt} stands for pints; the name @code{point} stands for
27813 a typographical point, defined by @samp{72 point = 1 in}. This is
27814 slightly different than the point defined by the American Typefounder's
27815 Association in 1886, but the point used by Calc has become standard
27816 largely due to its use by the PostScript page description language.
27817 There is also @code{texpt}, which stands for a printer's point as
27818 defined by the @TeX{} typesetting system: @samp{72.27 texpt = 1 in}.
27819 Other units used by @TeX{} are available; they are @code{texpc} (a pica),
27820 @code{texbp} (a ``big point'', equal to a standard point which is larger
27821 than the point used by @TeX{}), @code{texdd} (a Didot point),
27822 @code{texcc} (a Cicero) and @code{texsp} (a scaled @TeX{} point,
27823 all dimensions representable in @TeX{} are multiples of this value).
27824
27825 The unit @code{e} stands for the elementary (electron) unit of charge;
27826 because algebra command could mistake this for the special constant
27827 @expr{e}, Calc provides the alternate unit name @code{ech} which is
27828 preferable to @code{e}.
27829
27830 The name @code{g} stands for one gram of mass; there is also @code{gf},
27831 one gram of force. (Likewise for @kbd{lb}, pounds, and @kbd{lbf}.)
27832 Meanwhile, one ``@expr{g}'' of acceleration is denoted @code{ga}.
27833
27834 The unit @code{ton} is a U.S. ton of @samp{2000 lb}, and @code{t} is
27835 a metric ton of @samp{1000 kg}.
27836
27837 The names @code{s} (or @code{sec}) and @code{min} refer to units of
27838 time; @code{arcsec} and @code{arcmin} are units of angle.
27839
27840 Some ``units'' are really physical constants; for example, @code{c}
27841 represents the speed of light, and @code{h} represents Planck's
27842 constant. You can use these just like other units: converting
27843 @samp{.5 c} to @samp{m/s} expresses one-half the speed of light in
27844 meters per second. You can also use this merely as a handy reference;
27845 the @kbd{u g} command gets the definition of one of these constants
27846 in its normal terms, and @kbd{u b} expresses the definition in base
27847 units.
27848
27849 Two units, @code{pi} and @code{alpha} (the fine structure constant,
27850 approximately @mathit{1/137}) are dimensionless. The units simplification
27851 commands simply treat these names as equivalent to their corresponding
27852 values. However you can, for example, use @kbd{u c} to convert a pure
27853 number into multiples of the fine structure constant, or @kbd{u b} to
27854 convert this back into a pure number. (When @kbd{u c} prompts for the
27855 ``old units,'' just enter a blank line to signify that the value
27856 really is unitless.)
27857
27858 @c Describe angular units, luminosity vs. steradians problem.
27859
27860 @node User-Defined Units, , Predefined Units, Units
27861 @section User-Defined Units
27862
27863 @noindent
27864 Calc provides ways to get quick access to your selected ``favorite''
27865 units, as well as ways to define your own new units.
27866
27867 @kindex u 0-9
27868 @pindex calc-quick-units
27869 @vindex Units
27870 @cindex @code{Units} variable
27871 @cindex Quick units
27872 To select your favorite units, store a vector of unit names or
27873 expressions in the Calc variable @code{Units}. The @kbd{u 1}
27874 through @kbd{u 9} commands (@code{calc-quick-units}) provide access
27875 to these units. If the value on the top of the stack is a plain
27876 number (with no units attached), then @kbd{u 1} gives it the
27877 specified units. (Basically, it multiplies the number by the
27878 first item in the @code{Units} vector.) If the number on the
27879 stack @emph{does} have units, then @kbd{u 1} converts that number
27880 to the new units. For example, suppose the vector @samp{[in, ft]}
27881 is stored in @code{Units}. Then @kbd{30 u 1} will create the
27882 expression @samp{30 in}, and @kbd{u 2} will convert that expression
27883 to @samp{2.5 ft}.
27884
27885 The @kbd{u 0} command accesses the tenth element of @code{Units}.
27886 Only ten quick units may be defined at a time. If the @code{Units}
27887 variable has no stored value (the default), or if its value is not
27888 a vector, then the quick-units commands will not function. The
27889 @kbd{s U} command is a convenient way to edit the @code{Units}
27890 variable; @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
27891
27892 @kindex u d
27893 @pindex calc-define-unit
27894 @cindex User-defined units
27895 The @kbd{u d} (@code{calc-define-unit}) command records the units
27896 expression on the top of the stack as the definition for a new,
27897 user-defined unit. For example, putting @samp{16.5 ft} on the stack and
27898 typing @kbd{u d rod} defines the new unit @samp{rod} to be equivalent to
27899 16.5 feet. The unit conversion and simplification commands will now
27900 treat @code{rod} just like any other unit of length. You will also be
27901 prompted for an optional English description of the unit, which will
27902 appear in the Units Table. If you wish the definition of this unit to
27903 be displayed in a special way in the Units Table buffer (such as with an
27904 asterisk to indicate an approximate value), then you can call this
27905 command with an argument, @kbd{C-u u d}; you will then also be prompted
27906 for a string that will be used to display the definition.
27907
27908 @kindex u u
27909 @pindex calc-undefine-unit
27910 The @kbd{u u} (@code{calc-undefine-unit}) command removes a user-defined
27911 unit. It is not possible to remove one of the predefined units,
27912 however.
27913
27914 If you define a unit with an existing unit name, your new definition
27915 will replace the original definition of that unit. If the unit was a
27916 predefined unit, the old definition will not be replaced, only
27917 ``shadowed.'' The built-in definition will reappear if you later use
27918 @kbd{u u} to remove the shadowing definition.
27919
27920 To create a new fundamental unit, use either 1 or the unit name itself
27921 as the defining expression. Otherwise the expression can involve any
27922 other units that you like (except for composite units like @samp{mfi}).
27923 You can create a new composite unit with a sum of other units as the
27924 defining expression. The next unit operation like @kbd{u c} or @kbd{u v}
27925 will rebuild the internal unit table incorporating your modifications.
27926 Note that erroneous definitions (such as two units defined in terms of
27927 each other) will not be detected until the unit table is next rebuilt;
27928 @kbd{u v} is a convenient way to force this to happen.
27929
27930 Temperature units are treated specially inside the Calculator; it is not
27931 possible to create user-defined temperature units.
27932
27933 @kindex u p
27934 @pindex calc-permanent-units
27935 @cindex Calc init file, user-defined units
27936 The @kbd{u p} (@code{calc-permanent-units}) command stores the user-defined
27937 units in your Calc init file (the file given by the variable
27938 @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.calc.el}), so that the
27939 units will still be available in subsequent Emacs sessions. If there
27940 was already a set of user-defined units in your Calc init file, it
27941 is replaced by the new set. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to
27942 tell Calc to use a different file for the Calc init file.)
27943
27944 @node Store and Recall, Graphics, Units, Top
27945 @chapter Storing and Recalling
27946
27947 @noindent
27948 Calculator variables are really just Lisp variables that contain numbers
27949 or formulas in a form that Calc can understand. The commands in this
27950 section allow you to manipulate variables conveniently. Commands related
27951 to variables use the @kbd{s} prefix key.
27952
27953 @menu
27954 * Storing Variables::
27955 * Recalling Variables::
27956 * Operations on Variables::
27957 * Let Command::
27958 * Evaluates-To Operator::
27959 @end menu
27960
27961 @node Storing Variables, Recalling Variables, Store and Recall, Store and Recall
27962 @section Storing Variables
27963
27964 @noindent
27965 @kindex s s
27966 @pindex calc-store
27967 @cindex Storing variables
27968 @cindex Quick variables
27969 @vindex q0
27970 @vindex q9
27971 The @kbd{s s} (@code{calc-store}) command stores the value at the top of
27972 the stack into a specified variable. It prompts you to enter the
27973 name of the variable. If you press a single digit, the value is stored
27974 immediately in one of the ``quick'' variables @code{q0} through
27975 @code{q9}. Or you can enter any variable name.
27976
27977 @kindex s t
27978 @pindex calc-store-into
27979 The @kbd{s s} command leaves the stored value on the stack. There is
27980 also an @kbd{s t} (@code{calc-store-into}) command, which removes a
27981 value from the stack and stores it in a variable.
27982
27983 If the top of stack value is an equation @samp{a = 7} or assignment
27984 @samp{a := 7} with a variable on the lefthand side, then Calc will
27985 assign that variable with that value by default, i.e., if you type
27986 @kbd{s s @key{RET}} or @kbd{s t @key{RET}}. In this example, the
27987 value 7 would be stored in the variable @samp{a}. (If you do type
27988 a variable name at the prompt, the top-of-stack value is stored in
27989 its entirety, even if it is an equation: @samp{s s b @key{RET}}
27990 with @samp{a := 7} on the stack stores @samp{a := 7} in @code{b}.)
27991
27992 In fact, the top of stack value can be a vector of equations or
27993 assignments with different variables on their lefthand sides; the
27994 default will be to store all the variables with their corresponding
27995 righthand sides simultaneously.
27996
27997 It is also possible to type an equation or assignment directly at
27998 the prompt for the @kbd{s s} or @kbd{s t} command: @kbd{s s foo = 7}.
27999 In this case the expression to the right of the @kbd{=} or @kbd{:=}
28000 symbol is evaluated as if by the @kbd{=} command, and that value is
28001 stored in the variable. No value is taken from the stack; @kbd{s s}
28002 and @kbd{s t} are equivalent when used in this way.
28003
28004 @kindex s 0-9
28005 @kindex t 0-9
28006 The prefix keys @kbd{s} and @kbd{t} may be followed immediately by a
28007 digit; @kbd{s 9} is equivalent to @kbd{s s 9}, and @kbd{t 9} is
28008 equivalent to @kbd{s t 9}. (The @kbd{t} prefix is otherwise used
28009 for trail and time/date commands.)
28010
28011 @kindex s +
28012 @kindex s -
28013 @ignore
28014 @mindex @idots
28015 @end ignore
28016 @kindex s *
28017 @ignore
28018 @mindex @null
28019 @end ignore
28020 @kindex s /
28021 @ignore
28022 @mindex @null
28023 @end ignore
28024 @kindex s ^
28025 @ignore
28026 @mindex @null
28027 @end ignore
28028 @kindex s |
28029 @ignore
28030 @mindex @null
28031 @end ignore
28032 @kindex s n
28033 @ignore
28034 @mindex @null
28035 @end ignore
28036 @kindex s &
28037 @ignore
28038 @mindex @null
28039 @end ignore
28040 @kindex s [
28041 @ignore
28042 @mindex @null
28043 @end ignore
28044 @kindex s ]
28045 @pindex calc-store-plus
28046 @pindex calc-store-minus
28047 @pindex calc-store-times
28048 @pindex calc-store-div
28049 @pindex calc-store-power
28050 @pindex calc-store-concat
28051 @pindex calc-store-neg
28052 @pindex calc-store-inv
28053 @pindex calc-store-decr
28054 @pindex calc-store-incr
28055 There are also several ``arithmetic store'' commands. For example,
28056 @kbd{s +} removes a value from the stack and adds it to the specified
28057 variable. The other arithmetic stores are @kbd{s -}, @kbd{s *}, @kbd{s /},
28058 @kbd{s ^}, and @w{@kbd{s |}} (vector concatenation), plus @kbd{s n} and
28059 @kbd{s &} which negate or invert the value in a variable, and @w{@kbd{s [}}
28060 and @kbd{s ]} which decrease or increase a variable by one.
28061
28062 All the arithmetic stores accept the Inverse prefix to reverse the
28063 order of the operands. If @expr{v} represents the contents of the
28064 variable, and @expr{a} is the value drawn from the stack, then regular
28065 @w{@kbd{s -}} assigns
28066 @texline @math{v \coloneq v - a},
28067 @infoline @expr{v := v - a},
28068 but @kbd{I s -} assigns
28069 @texline @math{v \coloneq a - v}.
28070 @infoline @expr{v := a - v}.
28071 While @kbd{I s *} might seem pointless, it is
28072 useful if matrix multiplication is involved. Actually, all the
28073 arithmetic stores use formulas designed to behave usefully both
28074 forwards and backwards:
28075
28076 @example
28077 @group
28078 s + v := v + a v := a + v
28079 s - v := v - a v := a - v
28080 s * v := v * a v := a * v
28081 s / v := v / a v := a / v
28082 s ^ v := v ^ a v := a ^ v
28083 s | v := v | a v := a | v
28084 s n v := v / (-1) v := (-1) / v
28085 s & v := v ^ (-1) v := (-1) ^ v
28086 s [ v := v - 1 v := 1 - v
28087 s ] v := v - (-1) v := (-1) - v
28088 @end group
28089 @end example
28090
28091 In the last four cases, a numeric prefix argument will be used in
28092 place of the number one. (For example, @kbd{M-2 s ]} increases
28093 a variable by 2, and @kbd{M-2 I s ]} replaces a variable by
28094 minus-two minus the variable.
28095
28096 The first six arithmetic stores can also be typed @kbd{s t +}, @kbd{s t -},
28097 etc. The commands @kbd{s s +}, @kbd{s s -}, and so on are analogous
28098 arithmetic stores that don't remove the value @expr{a} from the stack.
28099
28100 All arithmetic stores report the new value of the variable in the
28101 Trail for your information. They signal an error if the variable
28102 previously had no stored value. If default simplifications have been
28103 turned off, the arithmetic stores temporarily turn them on for numeric
28104 arguments only (i.e., they temporarily do an @kbd{m N} command).
28105 @xref{Simplification Modes}. Large vectors put in the trail by
28106 these commands always use abbreviated (@kbd{t .}) mode.
28107
28108 @kindex s m
28109 @pindex calc-store-map
28110 The @kbd{s m} command is a general way to adjust a variable's value
28111 using any Calc function. It is a ``mapping'' command analogous to
28112 @kbd{V M}, @kbd{V R}, etc. @xref{Reducing and Mapping}, to see
28113 how to specify a function for a mapping command. Basically,
28114 all you do is type the Calc command key that would invoke that
28115 function normally. For example, @kbd{s m n} applies the @kbd{n}
28116 key to negate the contents of the variable, so @kbd{s m n} is
28117 equivalent to @kbd{s n}. Also, @kbd{s m Q} takes the square root
28118 of the value stored in a variable, @kbd{s m v v} uses @kbd{v v} to
28119 reverse the vector stored in the variable, and @kbd{s m H I S}
28120 takes the hyperbolic arcsine of the variable contents.
28121
28122 If the mapping function takes two or more arguments, the additional
28123 arguments are taken from the stack; the old value of the variable
28124 is provided as the first argument. Thus @kbd{s m -} with @expr{a}
28125 on the stack computes @expr{v - a}, just like @kbd{s -}. With the
28126 Inverse prefix, the variable's original value becomes the @emph{last}
28127 argument instead of the first. Thus @kbd{I s m -} is also
28128 equivalent to @kbd{I s -}.
28129
28130 @kindex s x
28131 @pindex calc-store-exchange
28132 The @kbd{s x} (@code{calc-store-exchange}) command exchanges the value
28133 of a variable with the value on the top of the stack. Naturally, the
28134 variable must already have a stored value for this to work.
28135
28136 You can type an equation or assignment at the @kbd{s x} prompt. The
28137 command @kbd{s x a=6} takes no values from the stack; instead, it
28138 pushes the old value of @samp{a} on the stack and stores @samp{a = 6}.
28139
28140 @kindex s u
28141 @pindex calc-unstore
28142 @cindex Void variables
28143 @cindex Un-storing variables
28144 Until you store something in them, most variables are ``void,'' that is,
28145 they contain no value at all. If they appear in an algebraic formula
28146 they will be left alone even if you press @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}).
28147 The @kbd{s u} (@code{calc-unstore}) command returns a variable to the
28148 void state.
28149
28150 @kindex s c
28151 @pindex calc-copy-variable
28152 The @kbd{s c} (@code{calc-copy-variable}) command copies the stored
28153 value of one variable to another. One way it differs from a simple
28154 @kbd{s r} followed by an @kbd{s t} (aside from saving keystrokes) is
28155 that the value never goes on the stack and thus is never rounded,
28156 evaluated, or simplified in any way; it is not even rounded down to the
28157 current precision.
28158
28159 The only variables with predefined values are the ``special constants''
28160 @code{pi}, @code{e}, @code{i}, @code{phi}, and @code{gamma}. You are free
28161 to unstore these variables or to store new values into them if you like,
28162 although some of the algebraic-manipulation functions may assume these
28163 variables represent their standard values. Calc displays a warning if
28164 you change the value of one of these variables, or of one of the other
28165 special variables @code{inf}, @code{uinf}, and @code{nan} (which are
28166 normally void).
28167
28168 Note that @code{pi} doesn't actually have 3.14159265359 stored in it,
28169 but rather a special magic value that evaluates to @cpi{} at the current
28170 precision. Likewise @code{e}, @code{i}, and @code{phi} evaluate
28171 according to the current precision or polar mode. If you recall a value
28172 from @code{pi} and store it back, this magic property will be lost. The
28173 magic property is preserved, however, when a variable is copied with
28174 @kbd{s c}.
28175
28176 @kindex s k
28177 @pindex calc-copy-special-constant
28178 If one of the ``special constants'' is redefined (or undefined) so that
28179 it no longer has its magic property, the property can be restored with
28180 @kbd{s k} (@code{calc-copy-special-constant}). This command will prompt
28181 for a special constant and a variable to store it in, and so a special
28182 constant can be stored in any variable. Here, the special constant that
28183 you enter doesn't depend on the value of the corresponding variable;
28184 @code{pi} will represent 3.14159@dots{} regardless of what is currently
28185 stored in the Calc variable @code{pi}. If one of the other special
28186 variables, @code{inf}, @code{uinf} or @code{nan}, is given a value, its
28187 original behavior can be restored by voiding it with @kbd{s u}.
28188
28189 @node Recalling Variables, Operations on Variables, Storing Variables, Store and Recall
28190 @section Recalling Variables
28191
28192 @noindent
28193 @kindex s r
28194 @pindex calc-recall
28195 @cindex Recalling variables
28196 The most straightforward way to extract the stored value from a variable
28197 is to use the @kbd{s r} (@code{calc-recall}) command. This command prompts
28198 for a variable name (similarly to @code{calc-store}), looks up the value
28199 of the specified variable, and pushes that value onto the stack. It is
28200 an error to try to recall a void variable.
28201
28202 It is also possible to recall the value from a variable by evaluating a
28203 formula containing that variable. For example, @kbd{' a @key{RET} =} is
28204 the same as @kbd{s r a @key{RET}} except that if the variable is void, the
28205 former will simply leave the formula @samp{a} on the stack whereas the
28206 latter will produce an error message.
28207
28208 @kindex r 0-9
28209 The @kbd{r} prefix may be followed by a digit, so that @kbd{r 9} is
28210 equivalent to @kbd{s r 9}.
28211
28212 @node Operations on Variables, Let Command, Recalling Variables, Store and Recall
28213 @section Other Operations on Variables
28214
28215 @noindent
28216 @kindex s e
28217 @pindex calc-edit-variable
28218 The @kbd{s e} (@code{calc-edit-variable}) command edits the stored
28219 value of a variable without ever putting that value on the stack
28220 or simplifying or evaluating the value. It prompts for the name of
28221 the variable to edit. If the variable has no stored value, the
28222 editing buffer will start out empty. If the editing buffer is
28223 empty when you press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish, the variable will
28224 be made void. @xref{Editing Stack Entries}, for a general
28225 description of editing.
28226
28227 The @kbd{s e} command is especially useful for creating and editing
28228 rewrite rules which are stored in variables. Sometimes these rules
28229 contain formulas which must not be evaluated until the rules are
28230 actually used. (For example, they may refer to @samp{deriv(x,y)},
28231 where @code{x} will someday become some expression involving @code{y};
28232 if you let Calc evaluate the rule while you are defining it, Calc will
28233 replace @samp{deriv(x,y)} with 0 because the formula @code{x} does
28234 not itself refer to @code{y}.) By contrast, recalling the variable,
28235 editing with @kbd{`}, and storing will evaluate the variable's value
28236 as a side effect of putting the value on the stack.
28237
28238 @kindex s A
28239 @kindex s D
28240 @ignore
28241 @mindex @idots
28242 @end ignore
28243 @kindex s E
28244 @ignore
28245 @mindex @null
28246 @end ignore
28247 @kindex s F
28248 @ignore
28249 @mindex @null
28250 @end ignore
28251 @kindex s G
28252 @ignore
28253 @mindex @null
28254 @end ignore
28255 @kindex s H
28256 @ignore
28257 @mindex @null
28258 @end ignore
28259 @kindex s I
28260 @ignore
28261 @mindex @null
28262 @end ignore
28263 @kindex s L
28264 @ignore
28265 @mindex @null
28266 @end ignore
28267 @kindex s P
28268 @ignore
28269 @mindex @null
28270 @end ignore
28271 @kindex s R
28272 @ignore
28273 @mindex @null
28274 @end ignore
28275 @kindex s T
28276 @ignore
28277 @mindex @null
28278 @end ignore
28279 @kindex s U
28280 @ignore
28281 @mindex @null
28282 @end ignore
28283 @kindex s X
28284 @pindex calc-store-AlgSimpRules
28285 @pindex calc-store-Decls
28286 @pindex calc-store-EvalRules
28287 @pindex calc-store-FitRules
28288 @pindex calc-store-GenCount
28289 @pindex calc-store-Holidays
28290 @pindex calc-store-IntegLimit
28291 @pindex calc-store-LineStyles
28292 @pindex calc-store-PointStyles
28293 @pindex calc-store-PlotRejects
28294 @pindex calc-store-TimeZone
28295 @pindex calc-store-Units
28296 @pindex calc-store-ExtSimpRules
28297 There are several special-purpose variable-editing commands that
28298 use the @kbd{s} prefix followed by a shifted letter:
28299
28300 @table @kbd
28301 @item s A
28302 Edit @code{AlgSimpRules}. @xref{Algebraic Simplifications}.
28303 @item s D
28304 Edit @code{Decls}. @xref{Declarations}.
28305 @item s E
28306 Edit @code{EvalRules}. @xref{Default Simplifications}.
28307 @item s F
28308 Edit @code{FitRules}. @xref{Curve Fitting}.
28309 @item s G
28310 Edit @code{GenCount}. @xref{Solving Equations}.
28311 @item s H
28312 Edit @code{Holidays}. @xref{Business Days}.
28313 @item s I
28314 Edit @code{IntegLimit}. @xref{Calculus}.
28315 @item s L
28316 Edit @code{LineStyles}. @xref{Graphics}.
28317 @item s P
28318 Edit @code{PointStyles}. @xref{Graphics}.
28319 @item s R
28320 Edit @code{PlotRejects}. @xref{Graphics}.
28321 @item s T
28322 Edit @code{TimeZone}. @xref{Time Zones}.
28323 @item s U
28324 Edit @code{Units}. @xref{User-Defined Units}.
28325 @item s X
28326 Edit @code{ExtSimpRules}. @xref{Unsafe Simplifications}.
28327 @end table
28328
28329 These commands are just versions of @kbd{s e} that use fixed variable
28330 names rather than prompting for the variable name.
28331
28332 @kindex s p
28333 @pindex calc-permanent-variable
28334 @cindex Storing variables
28335 @cindex Permanent variables
28336 @cindex Calc init file, variables
28337 The @kbd{s p} (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) command saves a
28338 variable's value permanently in your Calc init file (the file given by
28339 the variable @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.calc.el}), so
28340 that its value will still be available in future Emacs sessions. You
28341 can re-execute @w{@kbd{s p}} later on to update the saved value, but the
28342 only way to remove a saved variable is to edit your calc init file
28343 by hand. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to tell Calc to
28344 use a different file for the Calc init file.)
28345
28346 If you do not specify the name of a variable to save (i.e.,
28347 @kbd{s p @key{RET}}), all Calc variables with defined values
28348 are saved except for the special constants @code{pi}, @code{e},
28349 @code{i}, @code{phi}, and @code{gamma}; the variables @code{TimeZone}
28350 and @code{PlotRejects};
28351 @code{FitRules}, @code{DistribRules}, and other built-in rewrite
28352 rules; and @code{PlotData@var{n}} variables generated
28353 by the graphics commands. (You can still save these variables by
28354 explicitly naming them in an @kbd{s p} command.)
28355
28356 @kindex s i
28357 @pindex calc-insert-variables
28358 The @kbd{s i} (@code{calc-insert-variables}) command writes
28359 the values of all Calc variables into a specified buffer.
28360 The variables are written with the prefix @code{var-} in the form of
28361 Lisp @code{setq} commands
28362 which store the values in string form. You can place these commands
28363 in your Calc init file (or @file{.emacs}) if you wish, though in this case it
28364 would be easier to use @kbd{s p @key{RET}}. (Note that @kbd{s i}
28365 omits the same set of variables as @w{@kbd{s p @key{RET}}}; the difference
28366 is that @kbd{s i} will store the variables in any buffer, and it also
28367 stores in a more human-readable format.)
28368
28369 @node Let Command, Evaluates-To Operator, Operations on Variables, Store and Recall
28370 @section The Let Command
28371
28372 @noindent
28373 @kindex s l
28374 @pindex calc-let
28375 @cindex Variables, temporary assignment
28376 @cindex Temporary assignment to variables
28377 If you have an expression like @samp{a+b^2} on the stack and you wish to
28378 compute its value where @expr{b=3}, you can simply store 3 in @expr{b} and
28379 then press @kbd{=} to reevaluate the formula. This has the side-effect
28380 of leaving the stored value of 3 in @expr{b} for future operations.
28381
28382 The @kbd{s l} (@code{calc-let}) command evaluates a formula under a
28383 @emph{temporary} assignment of a variable. It stores the value on the
28384 top of the stack into the specified variable, then evaluates the
28385 second-to-top stack entry, then restores the original value (or lack of one)
28386 in the variable. Thus after @kbd{'@w{ }a+b^2 @key{RET} 3 s l b @key{RET}},
28387 the stack will contain the formula @samp{a + 9}. The subsequent command
28388 @kbd{@w{5 s l a} @key{RET}} will replace this formula with the number 14.
28389 The variables @samp{a} and @samp{b} are not permanently affected in any way
28390 by these commands.
28391
28392 The value on the top of the stack may be an equation or assignment, or
28393 a vector of equations or assignments, in which case the default will be
28394 analogous to the case of @kbd{s t @key{RET}}. @xref{Storing Variables}.
28395
28396 Also, you can answer the variable-name prompt with an equation or
28397 assignment: @kbd{s l b=3 @key{RET}} is the same as storing 3 on the stack
28398 and typing @kbd{s l b @key{RET}}.
28399
28400 The @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute}) command is another way to substitute
28401 a variable with a value in a formula. It does an actual substitution
28402 rather than temporarily assigning the variable and evaluating. For
28403 example, letting @expr{n=2} in @samp{f(n pi)} with @kbd{a b} will
28404 produce @samp{f(2 pi)}, whereas @kbd{s l} would give @samp{f(6.28)}
28405 since the evaluation step will also evaluate @code{pi}.
28406
28407 @node Evaluates-To Operator, , Let Command, Store and Recall
28408 @section The Evaluates-To Operator
28409
28410 @noindent
28411 @tindex evalto
28412 @tindex =>
28413 @cindex Evaluates-to operator
28414 @cindex @samp{=>} operator
28415 The special algebraic symbol @samp{=>} is known as the @dfn{evaluates-to
28416 operator}. (It will show up as an @code{evalto} function call in
28417 other language modes like Pascal and La@TeX{}.) This is a binary
28418 operator, that is, it has a lefthand and a righthand argument,
28419 although it can be entered with the righthand argument omitted.
28420
28421 A formula like @samp{@var{a} => @var{b}} is evaluated by Calc as
28422 follows: First, @var{a} is not simplified or modified in any
28423 way. The previous value of argument @var{b} is thrown away; the
28424 formula @var{a} is then copied and evaluated as if by the @kbd{=}
28425 command according to all current modes and stored variable values,
28426 and the result is installed as the new value of @var{b}.
28427
28428 For example, suppose you enter the algebraic formula @samp{2 + 3 => 17}.
28429 The number 17 is ignored, and the lefthand argument is left in its
28430 unevaluated form; the result is the formula @samp{2 + 3 => 5}.
28431
28432 @kindex s =
28433 @pindex calc-evalto
28434 You can enter an @samp{=>} formula either directly using algebraic
28435 entry (in which case the righthand side may be omitted since it is
28436 going to be replaced right away anyhow), or by using the @kbd{s =}
28437 (@code{calc-evalto}) command, which takes @var{a} from the stack
28438 and replaces it with @samp{@var{a} => @var{b}}.
28439
28440 Calc keeps track of all @samp{=>} operators on the stack, and
28441 recomputes them whenever anything changes that might affect their
28442 values, i.e., a mode setting or variable value. This occurs only
28443 if the @samp{=>} operator is at the top level of the formula, or
28444 if it is part of a top-level vector. In other words, pushing
28445 @samp{2 + (a => 17)} will change the 17 to the actual value of
28446 @samp{a} when you enter the formula, but the result will not be
28447 dynamically updated when @samp{a} is changed later because the
28448 @samp{=>} operator is buried inside a sum. However, a vector
28449 of @samp{=>} operators will be recomputed, since it is convenient
28450 to push a vector like @samp{[a =>, b =>, c =>]} on the stack to
28451 make a concise display of all the variables in your problem.
28452 (Another way to do this would be to use @samp{[a, b, c] =>},
28453 which provides a slightly different format of display. You
28454 can use whichever you find easiest to read.)
28455
28456 @kindex m C
28457 @pindex calc-auto-recompute
28458 The @kbd{m C} (@code{calc-auto-recompute}) command allows you to
28459 turn this automatic recomputation on or off. If you turn
28460 recomputation off, you must explicitly recompute an @samp{=>}
28461 operator on the stack in one of the usual ways, such as by
28462 pressing @kbd{=}. Turning recomputation off temporarily can save
28463 a lot of time if you will be changing several modes or variables
28464 before you look at the @samp{=>} entries again.
28465
28466 Most commands are not especially useful with @samp{=>} operators
28467 as arguments. For example, given @samp{x + 2 => 17}, it won't
28468 work to type @kbd{1 +} to get @samp{x + 3 => 18}. If you want
28469 to operate on the lefthand side of the @samp{=>} operator on
28470 the top of the stack, type @kbd{j 1} (that's the digit ``one'')
28471 to select the lefthand side, execute your commands, then type
28472 @kbd{j u} to unselect.
28473
28474 All current modes apply when an @samp{=>} operator is computed,
28475 including the current simplification mode. Recall that the
28476 formula @samp{x + y + x} is not handled by Calc's default
28477 simplifications, but the @kbd{a s} command will reduce it to
28478 the simpler form @samp{y + 2 x}. You can also type @kbd{m A}
28479 to enable an Algebraic Simplification mode in which the
28480 equivalent of @kbd{a s} is used on all of Calc's results.
28481 If you enter @samp{x + y + x =>} normally, the result will
28482 be @samp{x + y + x => x + y + x}. If you change to
28483 Algebraic Simplification mode, the result will be
28484 @samp{x + y + x => y + 2 x}. However, just pressing @kbd{a s}
28485 once will have no effect on @samp{x + y + x => x + y + x},
28486 because the righthand side depends only on the lefthand side
28487 and the current mode settings, and the lefthand side is not
28488 affected by commands like @kbd{a s}.
28489
28490 The ``let'' command (@kbd{s l}) has an interesting interaction
28491 with the @samp{=>} operator. The @kbd{s l} command evaluates the
28492 second-to-top stack entry with the top stack entry supplying
28493 a temporary value for a given variable. As you might expect,
28494 if that stack entry is an @samp{=>} operator its righthand
28495 side will temporarily show this value for the variable. In
28496 fact, all @samp{=>}s on the stack will be updated if they refer
28497 to that variable. But this change is temporary in the sense
28498 that the next command that causes Calc to look at those stack
28499 entries will make them revert to the old variable value.
28500
28501 @smallexample
28502 @group
28503 2: a => a 2: a => 17 2: a => a
28504 1: a + 1 => a + 1 1: a + 1 => 18 1: a + 1 => a + 1
28505 . . .
28506
28507 17 s l a @key{RET} p 8 @key{RET}
28508 @end group
28509 @end smallexample
28510
28511 Here the @kbd{p 8} command changes the current precision,
28512 thus causing the @samp{=>} forms to be recomputed after the
28513 influence of the ``let'' is gone. The @kbd{d @key{SPC}} command
28514 (@code{calc-refresh}) is a handy way to force the @samp{=>}
28515 operators on the stack to be recomputed without any other
28516 side effects.
28517
28518 @kindex s :
28519 @pindex calc-assign
28520 @tindex assign
28521 @tindex :=
28522 Embedded mode also uses @samp{=>} operators. In Embedded mode,
28523 the lefthand side of an @samp{=>} operator can refer to variables
28524 assigned elsewhere in the file by @samp{:=} operators. The
28525 assignment operator @samp{a := 17} does not actually do anything
28526 by itself. But Embedded mode recognizes it and marks it as a sort
28527 of file-local definition of the variable. You can enter @samp{:=}
28528 operators in Algebraic mode, or by using the @kbd{s :}
28529 (@code{calc-assign}) [@code{assign}] command which takes a variable
28530 and value from the stack and replaces them with an assignment.
28531
28532 @xref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}, for the way @samp{=>} appears in
28533 @TeX{} language output. The @dfn{eqn} mode gives similar
28534 treatment to @samp{=>}.
28535
28536 @node Graphics, Kill and Yank, Store and Recall, Top
28537 @chapter Graphics
28538
28539 @noindent
28540 The commands for graphing data begin with the @kbd{g} prefix key. Calc
28541 uses GNUPLOT 2.0 or later to do graphics. These commands will only work
28542 if GNUPLOT is available on your system. (While GNUPLOT sounds like
28543 a relative of GNU Emacs, it is actually completely unrelated.
28544 However, it is free software. It can be obtained from
28545 @samp{http://www.gnuplot.info}.)
28546
28547 @vindex calc-gnuplot-name
28548 If you have GNUPLOT installed on your system but Calc is unable to
28549 find it, you may need to set the @code{calc-gnuplot-name} variable
28550 in your Calc init file or @file{.emacs}. You may also need to set some Lisp
28551 variables to show Calc how to run GNUPLOT on your system; these
28552 are described under @kbd{g D} and @kbd{g O} below. If you are
28553 using the X window system, Calc will configure GNUPLOT for you
28554 automatically. If you have GNUPLOT 3.0 or later and you are not using X,
28555 Calc will configure GNUPLOT to display graphs using simple character
28556 graphics that will work on any terminal.
28557
28558 @menu
28559 * Basic Graphics::
28560 * Three Dimensional Graphics::
28561 * Managing Curves::
28562 * Graphics Options::
28563 * Devices::
28564 @end menu
28565
28566 @node Basic Graphics, Three Dimensional Graphics, Graphics, Graphics
28567 @section Basic Graphics
28568
28569 @noindent
28570 @kindex g f
28571 @pindex calc-graph-fast
28572 The easiest graphics command is @kbd{g f} (@code{calc-graph-fast}).
28573 This command takes two vectors of equal length from the stack.
28574 The vector at the top of the stack represents the ``y'' values of
28575 the various data points. The vector in the second-to-top position
28576 represents the corresponding ``x'' values. This command runs
28577 GNUPLOT (if it has not already been started by previous graphing
28578 commands) and displays the set of data points. The points will
28579 be connected by lines, and there will also be some kind of symbol
28580 to indicate the points themselves.
28581
28582 The ``x'' entry may instead be an interval form, in which case suitable
28583 ``x'' values are interpolated between the minimum and maximum values of
28584 the interval (whether the interval is open or closed is ignored).
28585
28586 The ``x'' entry may also be a number, in which case Calc uses the
28587 sequence of ``x'' values @expr{x}, @expr{x+1}, @expr{x+2}, etc.
28588 (Generally the number 0 or 1 would be used for @expr{x} in this case.)
28589
28590 The ``y'' entry may be any formula instead of a vector. Calc effectively
28591 uses @kbd{N} (@code{calc-eval-num}) to evaluate variables in the formula;
28592 the result of this must be a formula in a single (unassigned) variable.
28593 The formula is plotted with this variable taking on the various ``x''
28594 values. Graphs of formulas by default use lines without symbols at the
28595 computed data points. Note that if neither ``x'' nor ``y'' is a vector,
28596 Calc guesses at a reasonable number of data points to use. See the
28597 @kbd{g N} command below. (The ``x'' values must be either a vector
28598 or an interval if ``y'' is a formula.)
28599
28600 @ignore
28601 @starindex
28602 @end ignore
28603 @tindex xy
28604 If ``y'' is (or evaluates to) a formula of the form
28605 @samp{xy(@var{x}, @var{y})} then the result is a
28606 parametric plot. The two arguments of the fictitious @code{xy} function
28607 are used as the ``x'' and ``y'' coordinates of the curve, respectively.
28608 In this case the ``x'' vector or interval you specified is not directly
28609 visible in the graph. For example, if ``x'' is the interval @samp{[0..360]}
28610 and ``y'' is the formula @samp{xy(sin(t), cos(t))}, the resulting graph
28611 will be a circle.
28612
28613 Also, ``x'' and ``y'' may each be variable names, in which case Calc
28614 looks for suitable vectors, intervals, or formulas stored in those
28615 variables.
28616
28617 The ``x'' and ``y'' values for the data points (as pulled from the vectors,
28618 calculated from the formulas, or interpolated from the intervals) should
28619 be real numbers (integers, fractions, or floats). One exception to this
28620 is that the ``y'' entry can consist of a vector of numbers combined with
28621 error forms, in which case the points will be plotted with the
28622 appropriate error bars. Other than this, if either the ``x''
28623 value or the ``y'' value of a given data point is not a real number, that
28624 data point will be omitted from the graph. The points on either side
28625 of the invalid point will @emph{not} be connected by a line.
28626
28627 See the documentation for @kbd{g a} below for a description of the way
28628 numeric prefix arguments affect @kbd{g f}.
28629
28630 @cindex @code{PlotRejects} variable
28631 @vindex PlotRejects
28632 If you store an empty vector in the variable @code{PlotRejects}
28633 (i.e., @kbd{[ ] s t PlotRejects}), Calc will append information to
28634 this vector for every data point which was rejected because its
28635 ``x'' or ``y'' values were not real numbers. The result will be
28636 a matrix where each row holds the curve number, data point number,
28637 ``x'' value, and ``y'' value for a rejected data point.
28638 @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}, for a handy way to keep tabs on the
28639 current value of @code{PlotRejects}. @xref{Operations on Variables},
28640 for the @kbd{s R} command which is another easy way to examine
28641 @code{PlotRejects}.
28642
28643 @kindex g c
28644 @pindex calc-graph-clear
28645 To clear the graphics display, type @kbd{g c} (@code{calc-graph-clear}).
28646 If the GNUPLOT output device is an X window, the window will go away.
28647 Effects on other kinds of output devices will vary. You don't need
28648 to use @kbd{g c} if you don't want to---if you give another @kbd{g f}
28649 or @kbd{g p} command later on, it will reuse the existing graphics
28650 window if there is one.
28651
28652 @node Three Dimensional Graphics, Managing Curves, Basic Graphics, Graphics
28653 @section Three-Dimensional Graphics
28654
28655 @kindex g F
28656 @pindex calc-graph-fast-3d
28657 The @kbd{g F} (@code{calc-graph-fast-3d}) command makes a three-dimensional
28658 graph. It works only if you have GNUPLOT 3.0 or later; with GNUPLOT 2.0,
28659 you will see a GNUPLOT error message if you try this command.
28660
28661 The @kbd{g F} command takes three values from the stack, called ``x'',
28662 ``y'', and ``z'', respectively. As was the case for 2D graphs, there
28663 are several options for these values.
28664
28665 In the first case, ``x'' and ``y'' are each vectors (not necessarily of
28666 the same length); either or both may instead be interval forms. The
28667 ``z'' value must be a matrix with the same number of rows as elements
28668 in ``x'', and the same number of columns as elements in ``y''. The
28669 result is a surface plot where
28670 @texline @math{z_{ij}}
28671 @infoline @expr{z_ij}
28672 is the height of the point
28673 at coordinate @expr{(x_i, y_j)} on the surface. The 3D graph will
28674 be displayed from a certain default viewpoint; you can change this
28675 viewpoint by adding a @samp{set view} to the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}
28676 buffer as described later. See the GNUPLOT documentation for a
28677 description of the @samp{set view} command.
28678
28679 Each point in the matrix will be displayed as a dot in the graph,
28680 and these points will be connected by a grid of lines (@dfn{isolines}).
28681
28682 In the second case, ``x'', ``y'', and ``z'' are all vectors of equal
28683 length. The resulting graph displays a 3D line instead of a surface,
28684 where the coordinates of points along the line are successive triplets
28685 of values from the input vectors.
28686
28687 In the third case, ``x'' and ``y'' are vectors or interval forms, and
28688 ``z'' is any formula involving two variables (not counting variables
28689 with assigned values). These variables are sorted into alphabetical
28690 order; the first takes on values from ``x'' and the second takes on
28691 values from ``y'' to form a matrix of results that are graphed as a
28692 3D surface.
28693
28694 @ignore
28695 @starindex
28696 @end ignore
28697 @tindex xyz
28698 If the ``z'' formula evaluates to a call to the fictitious function
28699 @samp{xyz(@var{x}, @var{y}, @var{z})}, then the result is a
28700 ``parametric surface.'' In this case, the axes of the graph are
28701 taken from the @var{x} and @var{y} values in these calls, and the
28702 ``x'' and ``y'' values from the input vectors or intervals are used only
28703 to specify the range of inputs to the formula. For example, plotting
28704 @samp{[0..360], [0..180], xyz(sin(x)*sin(y), cos(x)*sin(y), cos(y))}
28705 will draw a sphere. (Since the default resolution for 3D plots is
28706 5 steps in each of ``x'' and ``y'', this will draw a very crude
28707 sphere. You could use the @kbd{g N} command, described below, to
28708 increase this resolution, or specify the ``x'' and ``y'' values as
28709 vectors with more than 5 elements.
28710
28711 It is also possible to have a function in a regular @kbd{g f} plot
28712 evaluate to an @code{xyz} call. Since @kbd{g f} plots a line, not
28713 a surface, the result will be a 3D parametric line. For example,
28714 @samp{[[0..720], xyz(sin(x), cos(x), x)]} will plot two turns of a
28715 helix (a three-dimensional spiral).
28716
28717 As for @kbd{g f}, each of ``x'', ``y'', and ``z'' may instead be
28718 variables containing the relevant data.
28719
28720 @node Managing Curves, Graphics Options, Three Dimensional Graphics, Graphics
28721 @section Managing Curves
28722
28723 @noindent
28724 The @kbd{g f} command is really shorthand for the following commands:
28725 @kbd{C-u g d g a g p}. Likewise, @w{@kbd{g F}} is shorthand for
28726 @kbd{C-u g d g A g p}. You can gain more control over your graph
28727 by using these commands directly.
28728
28729 @kindex g a
28730 @pindex calc-graph-add
28731 The @kbd{g a} (@code{calc-graph-add}) command adds the ``curve''
28732 represented by the two values on the top of the stack to the current
28733 graph. You can have any number of curves in the same graph. When
28734 you give the @kbd{g p} command, all the curves will be drawn superimposed
28735 on the same axes.
28736
28737 The @kbd{g a} command (and many others that affect the current graph)
28738 will cause a special buffer, @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}, to be displayed
28739 in another window. This buffer is a template of the commands that will
28740 be sent to GNUPLOT when it is time to draw the graph. The first
28741 @kbd{g a} command adds a @code{plot} command to this buffer. Succeeding
28742 @kbd{g a} commands add extra curves onto that @code{plot} command.
28743 Other graph-related commands put other GNUPLOT commands into this
28744 buffer. In normal usage you never need to work with this buffer
28745 directly, but you can if you wish. The only constraint is that there
28746 must be only one @code{plot} command, and it must be the last command
28747 in the buffer. If you want to save and later restore a complete graph
28748 configuration, you can use regular Emacs commands to save and restore
28749 the contents of the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer.
28750
28751 @vindex PlotData1
28752 @vindex PlotData2
28753 If the values on the stack are not variable names, @kbd{g a} will invent
28754 variable names for them (of the form @samp{PlotData@var{n}}) and store
28755 the values in those variables. The ``x'' and ``y'' variables are what
28756 go into the @code{plot} command in the template. If you add a curve
28757 that uses a certain variable and then later change that variable, you
28758 can replot the graph without having to delete and re-add the curve.
28759 That's because the variable name, not the vector, interval or formula
28760 itself, is what was added by @kbd{g a}.
28761
28762 A numeric prefix argument on @kbd{g a} or @kbd{g f} changes the way
28763 stack entries are interpreted as curves. With a positive prefix
28764 argument @expr{n}, the top @expr{n} stack entries are ``y'' values
28765 for @expr{n} different curves which share a common ``x'' value in
28766 the @expr{n+1}st stack entry. (Thus @kbd{g a} with no prefix
28767 argument is equivalent to @kbd{C-u 1 g a}.)
28768
28769 A prefix of zero or plain @kbd{C-u} means to take two stack entries,
28770 ``x'' and ``y'' as usual, but to interpret ``y'' as a vector of
28771 ``y'' values for several curves that share a common ``x''.
28772
28773 A negative prefix argument tells Calc to read @expr{n} vectors from
28774 the stack; each vector @expr{[x, y]} describes an independent curve.
28775 This is the only form of @kbd{g a} that creates several curves at once
28776 that don't have common ``x'' values. (Of course, the range of ``x''
28777 values covered by all the curves ought to be roughly the same if
28778 they are to look nice on the same graph.)
28779
28780 For example, to plot
28781 @texline @math{\sin n x}
28782 @infoline @expr{sin(n x)}
28783 for integers @expr{n}
28784 from 1 to 5, you could use @kbd{v x} to create a vector of integers
28785 (@expr{n}), then @kbd{V M '} or @kbd{V M $} to map @samp{sin(n x)}
28786 across this vector. The resulting vector of formulas is suitable
28787 for use as the ``y'' argument to a @kbd{C-u g a} or @kbd{C-u g f}
28788 command.
28789
28790 @kindex g A
28791 @pindex calc-graph-add-3d
28792 The @kbd{g A} (@code{calc-graph-add-3d}) command adds a 3D curve
28793 to the graph. It is not valid to intermix 2D and 3D curves in a
28794 single graph. This command takes three arguments, ``x'', ``y'',
28795 and ``z'', from the stack. With a positive prefix @expr{n}, it
28796 takes @expr{n+2} arguments (common ``x'' and ``y'', plus @expr{n}
28797 separate ``z''s). With a zero prefix, it takes three stack entries
28798 but the ``z'' entry is a vector of curve values. With a negative
28799 prefix @expr{-n}, it takes @expr{n} vectors of the form @expr{[x, y, z]}.
28800 The @kbd{g A} command works by adding a @code{splot} (surface-plot)
28801 command to the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer.
28802
28803 (Although @kbd{g a} adds a 2D @code{plot} command to the
28804 @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer, Calc changes this to @code{splot}
28805 before sending it to GNUPLOT if it notices that the data points are
28806 evaluating to @code{xyz} calls. It will not work to mix 2D and 3D
28807 @kbd{g a} curves in a single graph, although Calc does not currently
28808 check for this.)
28809
28810 @kindex g d
28811 @pindex calc-graph-delete
28812 The @kbd{g d} (@code{calc-graph-delete}) command deletes the most
28813 recently added curve from the graph. It has no effect if there are
28814 no curves in the graph. With a numeric prefix argument of any kind,
28815 it deletes all of the curves from the graph.
28816
28817 @kindex g H
28818 @pindex calc-graph-hide
28819 The @kbd{g H} (@code{calc-graph-hide}) command ``hides'' or ``unhides''
28820 the most recently added curve. A hidden curve will not appear in
28821 the actual plot, but information about it such as its name and line and
28822 point styles will be retained.
28823
28824 @kindex g j
28825 @pindex calc-graph-juggle
28826 The @kbd{g j} (@code{calc-graph-juggle}) command moves the curve
28827 at the end of the list (the ``most recently added curve'') to the
28828 front of the list. The next-most-recent curve is thus exposed for
28829 @w{@kbd{g d}} or similar commands to use. With @kbd{g j} you can work
28830 with any curve in the graph even though curve-related commands only
28831 affect the last curve in the list.
28832
28833 @kindex g p
28834 @pindex calc-graph-plot
28835 The @kbd{g p} (@code{calc-graph-plot}) command uses GNUPLOT to draw
28836 the graph described in the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer. Any
28837 GNUPLOT parameters which are not defined by commands in this buffer
28838 are reset to their default values. The variables named in the @code{plot}
28839 command are written to a temporary data file and the variable names
28840 are then replaced by the file name in the template. The resulting
28841 plotting commands are fed to the GNUPLOT program. See the documentation
28842 for the GNUPLOT program for more specific information. All temporary
28843 files are removed when Emacs or GNUPLOT exits.
28844
28845 If you give a formula for ``y'', Calc will remember all the values that
28846 it calculates for the formula so that later plots can reuse these values.
28847 Calc throws out these saved values when you change any circumstances
28848 that may affect the data, such as switching from Degrees to Radians
28849 mode, or changing the value of a parameter in the formula. You can
28850 force Calc to recompute the data from scratch by giving a negative
28851 numeric prefix argument to @kbd{g p}.
28852
28853 Calc uses a fairly rough step size when graphing formulas over intervals.
28854 This is to ensure quick response. You can ``refine'' a plot by giving
28855 a positive numeric prefix argument to @kbd{g p}. Calc goes through
28856 the data points it has computed and saved from previous plots of the
28857 function, and computes and inserts a new data point midway between
28858 each of the existing points. You can refine a plot any number of times,
28859 but beware that the amount of calculation involved doubles each time.
28860
28861 Calc does not remember computed values for 3D graphs. This means the
28862 numerix prefix argument, if any, to @kbd{g p} is effectively ignored if
28863 the current graph is three-dimensional.
28864
28865 @kindex g P
28866 @pindex calc-graph-print
28867 The @kbd{g P} (@code{calc-graph-print}) command is like @kbd{g p},
28868 except that it sends the output to a printer instead of to the
28869 screen. More precisely, @kbd{g p} looks for @samp{set terminal}
28870 or @samp{set output} commands in the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer;
28871 lacking these it uses the default settings. However, @kbd{g P}
28872 ignores @samp{set terminal} and @samp{set output} commands and
28873 uses a different set of default values. All of these values are
28874 controlled by the @kbd{g D} and @kbd{g O} commands discussed below.
28875 Provided everything is set up properly, @kbd{g p} will plot to
28876 the screen unless you have specified otherwise and @kbd{g P} will
28877 always plot to the printer.
28878
28879 @node Graphics Options, Devices, Managing Curves, Graphics
28880 @section Graphics Options
28881
28882 @noindent
28883 @kindex g g
28884 @pindex calc-graph-grid
28885 The @kbd{g g} (@code{calc-graph-grid}) command turns the ``grid''
28886 on and off. It is off by default; tick marks appear only at the
28887 edges of the graph. With the grid turned on, dotted lines appear
28888 across the graph at each tick mark. Note that this command only
28889 changes the setting in @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}; to see the effects
28890 of the change you must give another @kbd{g p} command.
28891
28892 @kindex g b
28893 @pindex calc-graph-border
28894 The @kbd{g b} (@code{calc-graph-border}) command turns the border
28895 (the box that surrounds the graph) on and off. It is on by default.
28896 This command will only work with GNUPLOT 3.0 and later versions.
28897
28898 @kindex g k
28899 @pindex calc-graph-key
28900 The @kbd{g k} (@code{calc-graph-key}) command turns the ``key''
28901 on and off. The key is a chart in the corner of the graph that
28902 shows the correspondence between curves and line styles. It is
28903 off by default, and is only really useful if you have several
28904 curves on the same graph.
28905
28906 @kindex g N
28907 @pindex calc-graph-num-points
28908 The @kbd{g N} (@code{calc-graph-num-points}) command allows you
28909 to select the number of data points in the graph. This only affects
28910 curves where neither ``x'' nor ``y'' is specified as a vector.
28911 Enter a blank line to revert to the default value (initially 15).
28912 With no prefix argument, this command affects only the current graph.
28913 With a positive prefix argument this command changes or, if you enter
28914 a blank line, displays the default number of points used for all
28915 graphs created by @kbd{g a} that don't specify the resolution explicitly.
28916 With a negative prefix argument, this command changes or displays
28917 the default value (initially 5) used for 3D graphs created by @kbd{g A}.
28918 Note that a 3D setting of 5 means that a total of @expr{5^2 = 25} points
28919 will be computed for the surface.
28920
28921 Data values in the graph of a function are normally computed to a
28922 precision of five digits, regardless of the current precision at the
28923 time. This is usually more than adequate, but there are cases where
28924 it will not be. For example, plotting @expr{1 + x} with @expr{x} in the
28925 interval @samp{[0 ..@: 1e-6]} will round all the data points down
28926 to 1.0! Putting the command @samp{set precision @var{n}} in the
28927 @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer will cause the data to be computed
28928 at precision @var{n} instead of 5. Since this is such a rare case,
28929 there is no keystroke-based command to set the precision.
28930
28931 @kindex g h
28932 @pindex calc-graph-header
28933 The @kbd{g h} (@code{calc-graph-header}) command sets the title
28934 for the graph. This will show up centered above the graph.
28935 The default title is blank (no title).
28936
28937 @kindex g n
28938 @pindex calc-graph-name
28939 The @kbd{g n} (@code{calc-graph-name}) command sets the title of an
28940 individual curve. Like the other curve-manipulating commands, it
28941 affects the most recently added curve, i.e., the last curve on the
28942 list in the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer. To set the title of
28943 the other curves you must first juggle them to the end of the list
28944 with @kbd{g j}, or edit the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer by hand.
28945 Curve titles appear in the key; if the key is turned off they are
28946 not used.
28947
28948 @kindex g t
28949 @kindex g T
28950 @pindex calc-graph-title-x
28951 @pindex calc-graph-title-y
28952 The @kbd{g t} (@code{calc-graph-title-x}) and @kbd{g T}
28953 (@code{calc-graph-title-y}) commands set the titles on the ``x''
28954 and ``y'' axes, respectively. These titles appear next to the
28955 tick marks on the left and bottom edges of the graph, respectively.
28956 Calc does not have commands to control the tick marks themselves,
28957 but you can edit them into the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer if
28958 you wish. See the GNUPLOT documentation for details.
28959
28960 @kindex g r
28961 @kindex g R
28962 @pindex calc-graph-range-x
28963 @pindex calc-graph-range-y
28964 The @kbd{g r} (@code{calc-graph-range-x}) and @kbd{g R}
28965 (@code{calc-graph-range-y}) commands set the range of values on the
28966 ``x'' and ``y'' axes, respectively. You are prompted to enter a
28967 suitable range. This should be either a pair of numbers of the
28968 form, @samp{@var{min}:@var{max}}, or a blank line to revert to the
28969 default behavior of setting the range based on the range of values
28970 in the data, or @samp{$} to take the range from the top of the stack.
28971 Ranges on the stack can be represented as either interval forms or
28972 vectors: @samp{[@var{min} ..@: @var{max}]} or @samp{[@var{min}, @var{max}]}.
28973
28974 @kindex g l
28975 @kindex g L
28976 @pindex calc-graph-log-x
28977 @pindex calc-graph-log-y
28978 The @kbd{g l} (@code{calc-graph-log-x}) and @kbd{g L} (@code{calc-graph-log-y})
28979 commands allow you to set either or both of the axes of the graph to
28980 be logarithmic instead of linear.
28981
28982 @kindex g C-l
28983 @kindex g C-r
28984 @kindex g C-t
28985 @pindex calc-graph-log-z
28986 @pindex calc-graph-range-z
28987 @pindex calc-graph-title-z
28988 For 3D plots, @kbd{g C-t}, @kbd{g C-r}, and @kbd{g C-l} (those are
28989 letters with the Control key held down) are the corresponding commands
28990 for the ``z'' axis.
28991
28992 @kindex g z
28993 @kindex g Z
28994 @pindex calc-graph-zero-x
28995 @pindex calc-graph-zero-y
28996 The @kbd{g z} (@code{calc-graph-zero-x}) and @kbd{g Z}
28997 (@code{calc-graph-zero-y}) commands control whether a dotted line is
28998 drawn to indicate the ``x'' and/or ``y'' zero axes. (These are the same
28999 dotted lines that would be drawn there anyway if you used @kbd{g g} to
29000 turn the ``grid'' feature on.) Zero-axis lines are on by default, and
29001 may be turned off only in GNUPLOT 3.0 and later versions. They are
29002 not available for 3D plots.
29003
29004 @kindex g s
29005 @pindex calc-graph-line-style
29006 The @kbd{g s} (@code{calc-graph-line-style}) command turns the connecting
29007 lines on or off for the most recently added curve, and optionally selects
29008 the style of lines to be used for that curve. Plain @kbd{g s} simply
29009 toggles the lines on and off. With a numeric prefix argument, @kbd{g s}
29010 turns lines on and sets a particular line style. Line style numbers
29011 start at one and their meanings vary depending on the output device.
29012 GNUPLOT guarantees that there will be at least six different line styles
29013 available for any device.
29014
29015 @kindex g S
29016 @pindex calc-graph-point-style
29017 The @kbd{g S} (@code{calc-graph-point-style}) command similarly turns
29018 the symbols at the data points on or off, or sets the point style.
29019 If you turn both lines and points off, the data points will show as
29020 tiny dots. If the ``y'' values being plotted contain error forms and
29021 the connecting lines are turned off, then this command will also turn
29022 the error bars on or off.
29023
29024 @cindex @code{LineStyles} variable
29025 @cindex @code{PointStyles} variable
29026 @vindex LineStyles
29027 @vindex PointStyles
29028 Another way to specify curve styles is with the @code{LineStyles} and
29029 @code{PointStyles} variables. These variables initially have no stored
29030 values, but if you store a vector of integers in one of these variables,
29031 the @kbd{g a} and @kbd{g f} commands will use those style numbers
29032 instead of the defaults for new curves that are added to the graph.
29033 An entry should be a positive integer for a specific style, or 0 to let
29034 the style be chosen automatically, or @mathit{-1} to turn off lines or points
29035 altogether. If there are more curves than elements in the vector, the
29036 last few curves will continue to have the default styles. Of course,
29037 you can later use @kbd{g s} and @kbd{g S} to change any of these styles.
29038
29039 For example, @kbd{'[2 -1 3] @key{RET} s t LineStyles} causes the first curve
29040 to have lines in style number 2, the second curve to have no connecting
29041 lines, and the third curve to have lines in style 3. Point styles will
29042 still be assigned automatically, but you could store another vector in
29043 @code{PointStyles} to define them, too.
29044
29045 @node Devices, , Graphics Options, Graphics
29046 @section Graphical Devices
29047
29048 @noindent
29049 @kindex g D
29050 @pindex calc-graph-device
29051 The @kbd{g D} (@code{calc-graph-device}) command sets the device name
29052 (or ``terminal name'' in GNUPLOT lingo) to be used by @kbd{g p} commands
29053 on this graph. It does not affect the permanent default device name.
29054 If you enter a blank name, the device name reverts to the default.
29055 Enter @samp{?} to see a list of supported devices.
29056
29057 With a positive numeric prefix argument, @kbd{g D} instead sets
29058 the default device name, used by all plots in the future which do
29059 not override it with a plain @kbd{g D} command. If you enter a
29060 blank line this command shows you the current default. The special
29061 name @code{default} signifies that Calc should choose @code{x11} if
29062 the X window system is in use (as indicated by the presence of a
29063 @code{DISPLAY} environment variable), or otherwise @code{dumb} under
29064 GNUPLOT 3.0 and later, or @code{postscript} under GNUPLOT 2.0.
29065 This is the initial default value.
29066
29067 The @code{dumb} device is an interface to ``dumb terminals,'' i.e.,
29068 terminals with no special graphics facilities. It writes a crude
29069 picture of the graph composed of characters like @code{-} and @code{|}
29070 to a buffer called @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*}, which Calc then displays.
29071 The graph is made the same size as the Emacs screen, which on most
29072 dumb terminals will be
29073 @texline @math{80\times24}
29074 @infoline 80x24
29075 characters. The graph is displayed in
29076 an Emacs ``recursive edit''; type @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-c C-c} to exit
29077 the recursive edit and return to Calc. Note that the @code{dumb}
29078 device is present only in GNUPLOT 3.0 and later versions.
29079
29080 The word @code{dumb} may be followed by two numbers separated by
29081 spaces. These are the desired width and height of the graph in
29082 characters. Also, the device name @code{big} is like @code{dumb}
29083 but creates a graph four times the width and height of the Emacs
29084 screen. You will then have to scroll around to view the entire
29085 graph. In the @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffer, @key{SPC}, @key{DEL},
29086 @kbd{<}, and @kbd{>} are defined to scroll by one screenful in each
29087 of the four directions.
29088
29089 With a negative numeric prefix argument, @kbd{g D} sets or displays
29090 the device name used by @kbd{g P} (@code{calc-graph-print}). This
29091 is initially @code{postscript}. If you don't have a PostScript
29092 printer, you may decide once again to use @code{dumb} to create a
29093 plot on any text-only printer.
29094
29095 @kindex g O
29096 @pindex calc-graph-output
29097 The @kbd{g O} (@code{calc-graph-output}) command sets the name of
29098 the output file used by GNUPLOT. For some devices, notably @code{x11},
29099 there is no output file and this information is not used. Many other
29100 ``devices'' are really file formats like @code{postscript}; in these
29101 cases the output in the desired format goes into the file you name
29102 with @kbd{g O}. Type @kbd{g O stdout @key{RET}} to set GNUPLOT to write
29103 to its standard output stream, i.e., to @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*}.
29104 This is the default setting.
29105
29106 Another special output name is @code{tty}, which means that GNUPLOT
29107 is going to write graphics commands directly to its standard output,
29108 which you wish Emacs to pass through to your terminal. Tektronix
29109 graphics terminals, among other devices, operate this way. Calc does
29110 this by telling GNUPLOT to write to a temporary file, then running a
29111 sub-shell executing the command @samp{cat tempfile >/dev/tty}. On
29112 typical Unix systems, this will copy the temporary file directly to
29113 the terminal, bypassing Emacs entirely. You will have to type @kbd{C-l}
29114 to Emacs afterwards to refresh the screen.
29115
29116 Once again, @kbd{g O} with a positive or negative prefix argument
29117 sets the default or printer output file names, respectively. In each
29118 case you can specify @code{auto}, which causes Calc to invent a temporary
29119 file name for each @kbd{g p} (or @kbd{g P}) command. This temporary file
29120 will be deleted once it has been displayed or printed. If the output file
29121 name is not @code{auto}, the file is not automatically deleted.
29122
29123 The default and printer devices and output files can be saved
29124 permanently by the @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes}) command. The
29125 default number of data points (see @kbd{g N}) and the X geometry
29126 (see @kbd{g X}) are also saved. Other graph information is @emph{not}
29127 saved; you can save a graph's configuration simply by saving the contents
29128 of the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer.
29129
29130 @vindex calc-gnuplot-plot-command
29131 @vindex calc-gnuplot-default-device
29132 @vindex calc-gnuplot-default-output
29133 @vindex calc-gnuplot-print-command
29134 @vindex calc-gnuplot-print-device
29135 @vindex calc-gnuplot-print-output
29136 You may wish to configure the default and
29137 printer devices and output files for the whole system. The relevant
29138 Lisp variables are @code{calc-gnuplot-default-device} and @code{-output},
29139 and @code{calc-gnuplot-print-device} and @code{-output}. The output
29140 file names must be either strings as described above, or Lisp
29141 expressions which are evaluated on the fly to get the output file names.
29142
29143 Other important Lisp variables are @code{calc-gnuplot-plot-command} and
29144 @code{calc-gnuplot-print-command}, which give the system commands to
29145 display or print the output of GNUPLOT, respectively. These may be
29146 @code{nil} if no command is necessary, or strings which can include
29147 @samp{%s} to signify the name of the file to be displayed or printed.
29148 Or, these variables may contain Lisp expressions which are evaluated
29149 to display or print the output. These variables are customizable
29150 (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
29151
29152 @kindex g x
29153 @pindex calc-graph-display
29154 The @kbd{g x} (@code{calc-graph-display}) command lets you specify
29155 on which X window system display your graphs should be drawn. Enter
29156 a blank line to see the current display name. This command has no
29157 effect unless the current device is @code{x11}.
29158
29159 @kindex g X
29160 @pindex calc-graph-geometry
29161 The @kbd{g X} (@code{calc-graph-geometry}) command is a similar
29162 command for specifying the position and size of the X window.
29163 The normal value is @code{default}, which generally means your
29164 window manager will let you place the window interactively.
29165 Entering @samp{800x500+0+0} would create an 800-by-500 pixel
29166 window in the upper-left corner of the screen.
29167
29168 The buffer called @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} holds a transcript of the
29169 session with GNUPLOT. This shows the commands Calc has ``typed'' to
29170 GNUPLOT and the responses it has received. Calc tries to notice when an
29171 error message has appeared here and display the buffer for you when
29172 this happens. You can check this buffer yourself if you suspect
29173 something has gone wrong.
29174
29175 @kindex g C
29176 @pindex calc-graph-command
29177 The @kbd{g C} (@code{calc-graph-command}) command prompts you to
29178 enter any line of text, then simply sends that line to the current
29179 GNUPLOT process. The @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffer looks deceptively
29180 like a Shell buffer but you can't type commands in it yourself.
29181 Instead, you must use @kbd{g C} for this purpose.
29182
29183 @kindex g v
29184 @kindex g V
29185 @pindex calc-graph-view-commands
29186 @pindex calc-graph-view-trail
29187 The @kbd{g v} (@code{calc-graph-view-commands}) and @kbd{g V}
29188 (@code{calc-graph-view-trail}) commands display the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}
29189 and @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffers, respectively, in another window.
29190 This happens automatically when Calc thinks there is something you
29191 will want to see in either of these buffers. If you type @kbd{g v}
29192 or @kbd{g V} when the relevant buffer is already displayed, the
29193 buffer is hidden again.
29194
29195 One reason to use @kbd{g v} is to add your own commands to the
29196 @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer. Press @kbd{g v}, then use
29197 @kbd{C-x o} to switch into that window. For example, GNUPLOT has
29198 @samp{set label} and @samp{set arrow} commands that allow you to
29199 annotate your plots. Since Calc doesn't understand these commands,
29200 you have to add them to the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer
29201 yourself, then use @w{@kbd{g p}} to replot using these new commands. Note
29202 that your commands must appear @emph{before} the @code{plot} command.
29203 To get help on any GNUPLOT feature, type, e.g., @kbd{g C help set label}.
29204 You may have to type @kbd{g C @key{RET}} a few times to clear the
29205 ``press return for more'' or ``subtopic of @dots{}'' requests.
29206 Note that Calc always sends commands (like @samp{set nolabel}) to
29207 reset all plotting parameters to the defaults before each plot, so
29208 to delete a label all you need to do is delete the @samp{set label}
29209 line you added (or comment it out with @samp{#}) and then replot
29210 with @kbd{g p}.
29211
29212 @kindex g q
29213 @pindex calc-graph-quit
29214 You can use @kbd{g q} (@code{calc-graph-quit}) to kill the GNUPLOT
29215 process that is running. The next graphing command you give will
29216 start a fresh GNUPLOT process. The word @samp{Graph} appears in
29217 the Calc window's mode line whenever a GNUPLOT process is currently
29218 running. The GNUPLOT process is automatically killed when you
29219 exit Emacs if you haven't killed it manually by then.
29220
29221 @kindex g K
29222 @pindex calc-graph-kill
29223 The @kbd{g K} (@code{calc-graph-kill}) command is like @kbd{g q}
29224 except that it also views the @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffer so that
29225 you can see the process being killed. This is better if you are
29226 killing GNUPLOT because you think it has gotten stuck.
29227
29228 @node Kill and Yank, Keypad Mode, Graphics, Top
29229 @chapter Kill and Yank Functions
29230
29231 @noindent
29232 The commands in this chapter move information between the Calculator and
29233 other Emacs editing buffers.
29234
29235 In many cases Embedded mode is an easier and more natural way to
29236 work with Calc from a regular editing buffer. @xref{Embedded Mode}.
29237
29238 @menu
29239 * Killing From Stack::
29240 * Yanking Into Stack::
29241 * Saving Into Registers::
29242 * Inserting From Registers::
29243 * Grabbing From Buffers::
29244 * Yanking Into Buffers::
29245 * X Cut and Paste::
29246 @end menu
29247
29248 @node Killing From Stack, Yanking Into Stack, Kill and Yank, Kill and Yank
29249 @section Killing from the Stack
29250
29251 @noindent
29252 @kindex C-k
29253 @pindex calc-kill
29254 @kindex M-k
29255 @pindex calc-copy-as-kill
29256 @kindex C-w
29257 @pindex calc-kill-region
29258 @kindex M-w
29259 @pindex calc-copy-region-as-kill
29260 @kindex M-C-w
29261 @cindex Kill ring
29262 @dfn{Kill} commands are Emacs commands that insert text into the ``kill
29263 ring,'' from which it can later be ``yanked'' by a @kbd{C-y} command.
29264 Three common kill commands in normal Emacs are @kbd{C-k}, which kills
29265 one line, @kbd{C-w}, which kills the region between mark and point, and
29266 @kbd{M-w}, which puts the region into the kill ring without actually
29267 deleting it. All of these commands work in the Calculator, too,
29268 although in the Calculator they operate on whole stack entries, so they
29269 ``round up'' the specified region to encompass full lines. (To copy
29270 only parts of lines, the @kbd{M-C-w} command in the Calculator will copy
29271 the region to the kill ring without any ``rounding up'', just like the
29272 @kbd{M-w} command in normal Emacs.) Also, @kbd{M-k} has been provided
29273 to complete the set; it puts the current line into the kill ring without
29274 deleting anything.
29275
29276 The kill commands are unusual in that they pay attention to the location
29277 of the cursor in the Calculator buffer. If the cursor is on or below
29278 the bottom line, the kill commands operate on the top of the stack.
29279 Otherwise, they operate on whatever stack element the cursor is on. The
29280 text is copied into the kill ring exactly as it appears on the screen,
29281 including line numbers if they are enabled.
29282
29283 A numeric prefix argument to @kbd{C-k} or @kbd{M-k} affects the number
29284 of lines killed. A positive argument kills the current line and @expr{n-1}
29285 lines below it. A negative argument kills the @expr{-n} lines above the
29286 current line. Again this mirrors the behavior of the standard Emacs
29287 @kbd{C-k} command. Although a whole line is always deleted, @kbd{C-k}
29288 with no argument copies only the number itself into the kill ring, whereas
29289 @kbd{C-k} with a prefix argument of 1 copies the number with its trailing
29290 newline.
29291
29292 @node Yanking Into Stack, Saving Into Registers, Killing From Stack, Kill and Yank
29293 @section Yanking into the Stack
29294
29295 @noindent
29296 @kindex C-y
29297 @pindex calc-yank
29298 The @kbd{C-y} command yanks the most recently killed text back into the
29299 Calculator. It pushes this value onto the top of the stack regardless of
29300 the cursor position. In general it re-parses the killed text as a number
29301 or formula (or a list of these separated by commas or newlines). However if
29302 the thing being yanked is something that was just killed from the Calculator
29303 itself, its full internal structure is yanked. For example, if you have
29304 set the floating-point display mode to show only four significant digits,
29305 then killing and re-yanking 3.14159 (which displays as 3.142) will yank the
29306 full 3.14159, even though yanking it into any other buffer would yank the
29307 number in its displayed form, 3.142. (Since the default display modes
29308 show all objects to their full precision, this feature normally makes no
29309 difference.)
29310
29311 @node Saving Into Registers, Inserting From Registers, Yanking Into Stack, Kill and Yank
29312 @section Saving into Registers
29313
29314 @noindent
29315 @kindex r s
29316 @pindex calc-copy-to-register
29317 @pindex calc-prepend-to-register
29318 @pindex calc-append-to-register
29319 @cindex Registers
29320 An alternative to killing and yanking stack entries is using
29321 registers in Calc. Saving stack entries in registers is like
29322 saving text in normal Emacs registers; although, like Calc's kill
29323 commands, register commands always operate on whole stack
29324 entries.
29325
29326 Registers in Calc are places to store stack entries for later use;
29327 each register is indexed by a single character. To store the current
29328 region (rounded up, of course, to include full stack entries) into a
29329 register, use the command @kbd{r s} (@code{calc-copy-to-register}).
29330 You will then be prompted for a register to use, the next character
29331 you type will be the index for the register. To store the region in
29332 register @var{r}, the full command will be @kbd{r s @var{r}}. With an
29333 argument, @kbd{C-u r s @var{r}}, the region being copied to the
29334 register will be deleted from the Calc buffer.
29335
29336 It is possible to add additional stack entries to a register. The
29337 command @kbd{M-x calc-append-to-register} will prompt for a register,
29338 then add the stack entries in the region to the end of the register
29339 contents. The command @kbd{M-x calc-prepend-to-register} will
29340 similarly prompt for a register and add the stack entries in the
29341 region to the beginning of the register contents. Both commands take
29342 @kbd{C-u} arguments, which will cause the region to be deleted after being
29343 added to the register.
29344
29345 @node Inserting From Registers, Grabbing From Buffers, Saving Into Registers, Kill and Yank
29346 @section Inserting from Registers
29347 @noindent
29348 @kindex r i
29349 @pindex calc-insert-register
29350 The command @kbd{r i} (@code{calc-insert-register}) will prompt for a
29351 register, then insert the contents of that register into the
29352 Calculator. If the contents of the register were placed there from
29353 within Calc, then the full internal structure of the contents will be
29354 inserted into the Calculator, otherwise whatever text is in the
29355 register is reparsed and then inserted into the Calculator.
29356
29357 @node Grabbing From Buffers, Yanking Into Buffers, Inserting From Registers, Kill and Yank
29358 @section Grabbing from Other Buffers
29359
29360 @noindent
29361 @kindex C-x * g
29362 @pindex calc-grab-region
29363 The @kbd{C-x * g} (@code{calc-grab-region}) command takes the text between
29364 point and mark in the current buffer and attempts to parse it as a
29365 vector of values. Basically, it wraps the text in vector brackets
29366 @samp{[ ]} unless the text already is enclosed in vector brackets,
29367 then reads the text as if it were an algebraic entry. The contents
29368 of the vector may be numbers, formulas, or any other Calc objects.
29369 If the @kbd{C-x * g} command works successfully, it does an automatic
29370 @kbd{C-x * c} to enter the Calculator buffer.
29371
29372 A numeric prefix argument grabs the specified number of lines around
29373 point, ignoring the mark. A positive prefix grabs from point to the
29374 @expr{n}th following newline (so that @kbd{M-1 C-x * g} grabs from point
29375 to the end of the current line); a negative prefix grabs from point
29376 back to the @expr{n+1}st preceding newline. In these cases the text
29377 that is grabbed is exactly the same as the text that @kbd{C-k} would
29378 delete given that prefix argument.
29379
29380 A prefix of zero grabs the current line; point may be anywhere on the
29381 line.
29382
29383 A plain @kbd{C-u} prefix interprets the region between point and mark
29384 as a single number or formula rather than a vector. For example,
29385 @kbd{C-x * g} on the text @samp{2 a b} produces the vector of three
29386 values @samp{[2, a, b]}, but @kbd{C-u C-x * g} on the same region
29387 reads a formula which is a product of three things: @samp{2 a b}.
29388 (The text @samp{a + b}, on the other hand, will be grabbed as a
29389 vector of one element by plain @kbd{C-x * g} because the interpretation
29390 @samp{[a, +, b]} would be a syntax error.)
29391
29392 If a different language has been specified (@pxref{Language Modes}),
29393 the grabbed text will be interpreted according to that language.
29394
29395 @kindex C-x * r
29396 @pindex calc-grab-rectangle
29397 The @kbd{C-x * r} (@code{calc-grab-rectangle}) command takes the text between
29398 point and mark and attempts to parse it as a matrix. If point and mark
29399 are both in the leftmost column, the lines in between are parsed in their
29400 entirety. Otherwise, point and mark define the corners of a rectangle
29401 whose contents are parsed.
29402
29403 Each line of the grabbed area becomes a row of the matrix. The result
29404 will actually be a vector of vectors, which Calc will treat as a matrix
29405 only if every row contains the same number of values.
29406
29407 If a line contains a portion surrounded by square brackets (or curly
29408 braces), that portion is interpreted as a vector which becomes a row
29409 of the matrix. Any text surrounding the bracketed portion on the line
29410 is ignored.
29411
29412 Otherwise, the entire line is interpreted as a row vector as if it
29413 were surrounded by square brackets. Leading line numbers (in the
29414 format used in the Calc stack buffer) are ignored. If you wish to
29415 force this interpretation (even if the line contains bracketed
29416 portions), give a negative numeric prefix argument to the
29417 @kbd{C-x * r} command.
29418
29419 If you give a numeric prefix argument of zero or plain @kbd{C-u}, each
29420 line is instead interpreted as a single formula which is converted into
29421 a one-element vector. Thus the result of @kbd{C-u C-x * r} will be a
29422 one-column matrix. For example, suppose one line of the data is the
29423 expression @samp{2 a}. A plain @w{@kbd{C-x * r}} will interpret this as
29424 @samp{[2 a]}, which in turn is read as a two-element vector that forms
29425 one row of the matrix. But a @kbd{C-u C-x * r} will interpret this row
29426 as @samp{[2*a]}.
29427
29428 If you give a positive numeric prefix argument @var{n}, then each line
29429 will be split up into columns of width @var{n}; each column is parsed
29430 separately as a matrix element. If a line contained
29431 @w{@samp{2 +/- 3 4 +/- 5}}, then grabbing with a prefix argument of 8
29432 would correctly split the line into two error forms.
29433
29434 @xref{Matrix Functions}, to see how to pull the matrix apart into its
29435 constituent rows and columns. (If it is a
29436 @texline @math{1\times1}
29437 @infoline 1x1
29438 matrix, just hit @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) twice.)
29439
29440 @kindex C-x * :
29441 @kindex C-x * _
29442 @pindex calc-grab-sum-across
29443 @pindex calc-grab-sum-down
29444 @cindex Summing rows and columns of data
29445 The @kbd{C-x * :} (@code{calc-grab-sum-down}) command is a handy way to
29446 grab a rectangle of data and sum its columns. It is equivalent to
29447 typing @kbd{C-x * r}, followed by @kbd{V R : +} (the vector reduction
29448 command that sums the columns of a matrix; @pxref{Reducing}). The
29449 result of the command will be a vector of numbers, one for each column
29450 in the input data. The @kbd{C-x * _} (@code{calc-grab-sum-across}) command
29451 similarly grabs a rectangle and sums its rows by executing @w{@kbd{V R _ +}}.
29452
29453 As well as being more convenient, @kbd{C-x * :} and @kbd{C-x * _} are also
29454 much faster because they don't actually place the grabbed vector on
29455 the stack. In a @kbd{C-x * r V R : +} sequence, formatting the vector
29456 for display on the stack takes a large fraction of the total time
29457 (unless you have planned ahead and used @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .} modes).
29458
29459 For example, suppose we have a column of numbers in a file which we
29460 wish to sum. Go to one corner of the column and press @kbd{C-@@} to
29461 set the mark; go to the other corner and type @kbd{C-x * :}. Since there
29462 is only one column, the result will be a vector of one number, the sum.
29463 (You can type @kbd{v u} to unpack this vector into a plain number if
29464 you want to do further arithmetic with it.)
29465
29466 To compute the product of the column of numbers, we would have to do
29467 it ``by hand'' since there's no special grab-and-multiply command.
29468 Use @kbd{C-x * r} to grab the column of numbers into the calculator in
29469 the form of a column matrix. The statistics command @kbd{u *} is a
29470 handy way to find the product of a vector or matrix of numbers.
29471 @xref{Statistical Operations}. Another approach would be to use
29472 an explicit column reduction command, @kbd{V R : *}.
29473
29474 @node Yanking Into Buffers, X Cut and Paste, Grabbing From Buffers, Kill and Yank
29475 @section Yanking into Other Buffers
29476
29477 @noindent
29478 @kindex y
29479 @pindex calc-copy-to-buffer
29480 The plain @kbd{y} (@code{calc-copy-to-buffer}) command inserts the number
29481 at the top of the stack into the most recently used normal editing buffer.
29482 (More specifically, this is the most recently used buffer which is displayed
29483 in a window and whose name does not begin with @samp{*}. If there is no
29484 such buffer, this is the most recently used buffer except for Calculator
29485 and Calc Trail buffers.) The number is inserted exactly as it appears and
29486 without a newline. (If line-numbering is enabled, the line number is
29487 normally not included.) The number is @emph{not} removed from the stack.
29488
29489 With a prefix argument, @kbd{y} inserts several numbers, one per line.
29490 A positive argument inserts the specified number of values from the top
29491 of the stack. A negative argument inserts the @expr{n}th value from the
29492 top of the stack. An argument of zero inserts the entire stack. Note
29493 that @kbd{y} with an argument of 1 is slightly different from @kbd{y}
29494 with no argument; the former always copies full lines, whereas the
29495 latter strips off the trailing newline.
29496
29497 With a lone @kbd{C-u} as a prefix argument, @kbd{y} @emph{replaces} the
29498 region in the other buffer with the yanked text, then quits the
29499 Calculator, leaving you in that buffer. A typical use would be to use
29500 @kbd{C-x * g} to read a region of data into the Calculator, operate on the
29501 data to produce a new matrix, then type @kbd{C-u y} to replace the
29502 original data with the new data. One might wish to alter the matrix
29503 display style (@pxref{Vector and Matrix Formats}) or change the current
29504 display language (@pxref{Language Modes}) before doing this. Also, note
29505 that this command replaces a linear region of text (as grabbed by
29506 @kbd{C-x * g}), not a rectangle (as grabbed by @kbd{C-x * r}).
29507
29508 If the editing buffer is in overwrite (as opposed to insert) mode,
29509 and the @kbd{C-u} prefix was not used, then the yanked number will
29510 overwrite the characters following point rather than being inserted
29511 before those characters. The usual conventions of overwrite mode
29512 are observed; for example, characters will be inserted at the end of
29513 a line rather than overflowing onto the next line. Yanking a multi-line
29514 object such as a matrix in overwrite mode overwrites the next @var{n}
29515 lines in the buffer, lengthening or shortening each line as necessary.
29516 Finally, if the thing being yanked is a simple integer or floating-point
29517 number (like @samp{-1.2345e-3}) and the characters following point also
29518 make up such a number, then Calc will replace that number with the new
29519 number, lengthening or shortening as necessary. The concept of
29520 ``overwrite mode'' has thus been generalized from overwriting characters
29521 to overwriting one complete number with another.
29522
29523 @kindex C-x * y
29524 The @kbd{C-x * y} key sequence is equivalent to @kbd{y} except that
29525 it can be typed anywhere, not just in Calc. This provides an easy
29526 way to guarantee that Calc knows which editing buffer you want to use!
29527
29528 @node X Cut and Paste, , Yanking Into Buffers, Kill and Yank
29529 @section X Cut and Paste
29530
29531 @noindent
29532 If you are using Emacs with the X window system, there is an easier
29533 way to move small amounts of data into and out of the calculator:
29534 Use the mouse-oriented cut and paste facilities of X.
29535
29536 The default bindings for a three-button mouse cause the left button
29537 to move the Emacs cursor to the given place, the right button to
29538 select the text between the cursor and the clicked location, and
29539 the middle button to yank the selection into the buffer at the
29540 clicked location. So, if you have a Calc window and an editing
29541 window on your Emacs screen, you can use left-click/right-click
29542 to select a number, vector, or formula from one window, then
29543 middle-click to paste that value into the other window. When you
29544 paste text into the Calc window, Calc interprets it as an algebraic
29545 entry. It doesn't matter where you click in the Calc window; the
29546 new value is always pushed onto the top of the stack.
29547
29548 The @code{xterm} program that is typically used for general-purpose
29549 shell windows in X interprets the mouse buttons in the same way.
29550 So you can use the mouse to move data between Calc and any other
29551 Unix program. One nice feature of @code{xterm} is that a double
29552 left-click selects one word, and a triple left-click selects a
29553 whole line. So you can usually transfer a single number into Calc
29554 just by double-clicking on it in the shell, then middle-clicking
29555 in the Calc window.
29556
29557 @node Keypad Mode, Embedded Mode, Kill and Yank, Top
29558 @chapter Keypad Mode
29559
29560 @noindent
29561 @kindex C-x * k
29562 @pindex calc-keypad
29563 The @kbd{C-x * k} (@code{calc-keypad}) command starts the Calculator
29564 and displays a picture of a calculator-style keypad. If you are using
29565 the X window system, you can click on any of the ``keys'' in the
29566 keypad using the left mouse button to operate the calculator.
29567 The original window remains the selected window; in Keypad mode
29568 you can type in your file while simultaneously performing
29569 calculations with the mouse.
29570
29571 @pindex full-calc-keypad
29572 If you have used @kbd{C-x * b} first, @kbd{C-x * k} instead invokes
29573 the @code{full-calc-keypad} command, which takes over the whole
29574 Emacs screen and displays the keypad, the Calc stack, and the Calc
29575 trail all at once. This mode would normally be used when running
29576 Calc standalone (@pxref{Standalone Operation}).
29577
29578 If you aren't using the X window system, you must switch into
29579 the @samp{*Calc Keypad*} window, place the cursor on the desired
29580 ``key,'' and type @key{SPC} or @key{RET}. If you think this
29581 is easier than using Calc normally, go right ahead.
29582
29583 Calc commands are more or less the same in Keypad mode. Certain
29584 keypad keys differ slightly from the corresponding normal Calc
29585 keystrokes; all such deviations are described below.
29586
29587 Keypad mode includes many more commands than will fit on the keypad
29588 at once. Click the right mouse button [@code{calc-keypad-menu}]
29589 to switch to the next menu. The bottom five rows of the keypad
29590 stay the same; the top three rows change to a new set of commands.
29591 To return to earlier menus, click the middle mouse button
29592 [@code{calc-keypad-menu-back}] or simply advance through the menus
29593 until you wrap around. Typing @key{TAB} inside the keypad window
29594 is equivalent to clicking the right mouse button there.
29595
29596 You can always click the @key{EXEC} button and type any normal
29597 Calc key sequence. This is equivalent to switching into the
29598 Calc buffer, typing the keys, then switching back to your
29599 original buffer.
29600
29601 @menu
29602 * Keypad Main Menu::
29603 * Keypad Functions Menu::
29604 * Keypad Binary Menu::
29605 * Keypad Vectors Menu::
29606 * Keypad Modes Menu::
29607 @end menu
29608
29609 @node Keypad Main Menu, Keypad Functions Menu, Keypad Mode, Keypad Mode
29610 @section Main Menu
29611
29612 @smallexample
29613 @group
29614 |----+----+--Calc---+----+----1
29615 |FLR |CEIL|RND |TRNC|CLN2|FLT |
29616 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29617 | LN |EXP | |ABS |IDIV|MOD |
29618 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29619 |SIN |COS |TAN |SQRT|y^x |1/x |
29620 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29621 | ENTER |+/- |EEX |UNDO| <- |
29622 |-----+---+-+--+--+-+---++----|
29623 | INV | 7 | 8 | 9 | / |
29624 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
29625 | HYP | 4 | 5 | 6 | * |
29626 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
29627 |EXEC | 1 | 2 | 3 | - |
29628 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
29629 | OFF | 0 | . | PI | + |
29630 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+
29631 @end group
29632 @end smallexample
29633
29634 @noindent
29635 This is the menu that appears the first time you start Keypad mode.
29636 It will show up in a vertical window on the right side of your screen.
29637 Above this menu is the traditional Calc stack display. On a 24-line
29638 screen you will be able to see the top three stack entries.
29639
29640 The ten digit keys, decimal point, and @key{EEX} key are used for
29641 entering numbers in the obvious way. @key{EEX} begins entry of an
29642 exponent in scientific notation. Just as with regular Calc, the
29643 number is pushed onto the stack as soon as you press @key{ENTER}
29644 or any other function key.
29645
29646 The @key{+/-} key corresponds to normal Calc's @kbd{n} key. During
29647 numeric entry it changes the sign of the number or of the exponent.
29648 At other times it changes the sign of the number on the top of the
29649 stack.
29650
29651 The @key{INV} and @key{HYP} keys modify other keys. As well as
29652 having the effects described elsewhere in this manual, Keypad mode
29653 defines several other ``inverse'' operations. These are described
29654 below and in the following sections.
29655
29656 The @key{ENTER} key finishes the current numeric entry, or otherwise
29657 duplicates the top entry on the stack.
29658
29659 The @key{UNDO} key undoes the most recent Calc operation.
29660 @kbd{INV UNDO} is the ``redo'' command, and @kbd{HYP UNDO} is
29661 ``last arguments'' (@kbd{M-@key{RET}}).
29662
29663 The @key{<-} key acts as a ``backspace'' during numeric entry.
29664 At other times it removes the top stack entry. @kbd{INV <-}
29665 clears the entire stack. @kbd{HYP <-} takes an integer from
29666 the stack, then removes that many additional stack elements.
29667
29668 The @key{EXEC} key prompts you to enter any keystroke sequence
29669 that would normally work in Calc mode. This can include a
29670 numeric prefix if you wish. It is also possible simply to
29671 switch into the Calc window and type commands in it; there is
29672 nothing ``magic'' about this window when Keypad mode is active.
29673
29674 The other keys in this display perform their obvious calculator
29675 functions. @key{CLN2} rounds the top-of-stack by temporarily
29676 reducing the precision by 2 digits. @key{FLT} converts an
29677 integer or fraction on the top of the stack to floating-point.
29678
29679 The @key{INV} and @key{HYP} keys combined with several of these keys
29680 give you access to some common functions even if the appropriate menu
29681 is not displayed. Obviously you don't need to learn these keys
29682 unless you find yourself wasting time switching among the menus.
29683
29684 @table @kbd
29685 @item INV +/-
29686 is the same as @key{1/x}.
29687 @item INV +
29688 is the same as @key{SQRT}.
29689 @item INV -
29690 is the same as @key{CONJ}.
29691 @item INV *
29692 is the same as @key{y^x}.
29693 @item INV /
29694 is the same as @key{INV y^x} (the @expr{x}th root of @expr{y}).
29695 @item HYP/INV 1
29696 are the same as @key{SIN} / @kbd{INV SIN}.
29697 @item HYP/INV 2
29698 are the same as @key{COS} / @kbd{INV COS}.
29699 @item HYP/INV 3
29700 are the same as @key{TAN} / @kbd{INV TAN}.
29701 @item INV/HYP 4
29702 are the same as @key{LN} / @kbd{HYP LN}.
29703 @item INV/HYP 5
29704 are the same as @key{EXP} / @kbd{HYP EXP}.
29705 @item INV 6
29706 is the same as @key{ABS}.
29707 @item INV 7
29708 is the same as @key{RND} (@code{calc-round}).
29709 @item INV 8
29710 is the same as @key{CLN2}.
29711 @item INV 9
29712 is the same as @key{FLT} (@code{calc-float}).
29713 @item INV 0
29714 is the same as @key{IMAG}.
29715 @item INV .
29716 is the same as @key{PREC}.
29717 @item INV ENTER
29718 is the same as @key{SWAP}.
29719 @item HYP ENTER
29720 is the same as @key{RLL3}.
29721 @item INV HYP ENTER
29722 is the same as @key{OVER}.
29723 @item HYP +/-
29724 packs the top two stack entries as an error form.
29725 @item HYP EEX
29726 packs the top two stack entries as a modulo form.
29727 @item INV EEX
29728 creates an interval form; this removes an integer which is one
29729 of 0 @samp{[]}, 1 @samp{[)}, 2 @samp{(]} or 3 @samp{()}, followed
29730 by the two limits of the interval.
29731 @end table
29732
29733 The @kbd{OFF} key turns Calc off; typing @kbd{C-x * k} or @kbd{C-x * *}
29734 again has the same effect. This is analogous to typing @kbd{q} or
29735 hitting @kbd{C-x * c} again in the normal calculator. If Calc is
29736 running standalone (the @code{full-calc-keypad} command appeared in the
29737 command line that started Emacs), then @kbd{OFF} is replaced with
29738 @kbd{EXIT}; clicking on this actually exits Emacs itself.
29739
29740 @node Keypad Functions Menu, Keypad Binary Menu, Keypad Main Menu, Keypad Mode
29741 @section Functions Menu
29742
29743 @smallexample
29744 @group
29745 |----+----+----+----+----+----2
29746 |IGAM|BETA|IBET|ERF |BESJ|BESY|
29747 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29748 |IMAG|CONJ| RE |ATN2|RAND|RAGN|
29749 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29750 |GCD |FACT|DFCT|BNOM|PERM|NXTP|
29751 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29752 @end group
29753 @end smallexample
29754
29755 @noindent
29756 This menu provides various operations from the @kbd{f} and @kbd{k}
29757 prefix keys.
29758
29759 @key{IMAG} multiplies the number on the stack by the imaginary
29760 number @expr{i = (0, 1)}.
29761
29762 @key{RE} extracts the real part a complex number. @kbd{INV RE}
29763 extracts the imaginary part.
29764
29765 @key{RAND} takes a number from the top of the stack and computes
29766 a random number greater than or equal to zero but less than that
29767 number. (@xref{Random Numbers}.) @key{RAGN} is the ``random
29768 again'' command; it computes another random number using the
29769 same limit as last time.
29770
29771 @key{INV GCD} computes the LCM (least common multiple) function.
29772
29773 @key{INV FACT} is the gamma function.
29774 @texline @math{\Gamma(x) = (x-1)!}.
29775 @infoline @expr{gamma(x) = (x-1)!}.
29776
29777 @key{PERM} is the number-of-permutations function, which is on the
29778 @kbd{H k c} key in normal Calc.
29779
29780 @key{NXTP} finds the next prime after a number. @kbd{INV NXTP}
29781 finds the previous prime.
29782
29783 @node Keypad Binary Menu, Keypad Vectors Menu, Keypad Functions Menu, Keypad Mode
29784 @section Binary Menu
29785
29786 @smallexample
29787 @group
29788 |----+----+----+----+----+----3
29789 |AND | OR |XOR |NOT |LSH |RSH |
29790 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29791 |DEC |HEX |OCT |BIN |WSIZ|ARSH|
29792 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29793 | A | B | C | D | E | F |
29794 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29795 @end group
29796 @end smallexample
29797
29798 @noindent
29799 The keys in this menu perform operations on binary integers.
29800 Note that both logical and arithmetic right-shifts are provided.
29801 @key{INV LSH} rotates one bit to the left.
29802
29803 The ``difference'' function (normally on @kbd{b d}) is on @key{INV AND}.
29804 The ``clip'' function (normally on @w{@kbd{b c}}) is on @key{INV NOT}.
29805
29806 The @key{DEC}, @key{HEX}, @key{OCT}, and @key{BIN} keys select the
29807 current radix for display and entry of numbers: Decimal, hexadecimal,
29808 octal, or binary. The six letter keys @key{A} through @key{F} are used
29809 for entering hexadecimal numbers.
29810
29811 The @key{WSIZ} key displays the current word size for binary operations
29812 and allows you to enter a new word size. You can respond to the prompt
29813 using either the keyboard or the digits and @key{ENTER} from the keypad.
29814 The initial word size is 32 bits.
29815
29816 @node Keypad Vectors Menu, Keypad Modes Menu, Keypad Binary Menu, Keypad Mode
29817 @section Vectors Menu
29818
29819 @smallexample
29820 @group
29821 |----+----+----+----+----+----4
29822 |SUM |PROD|MAX |MAP*|MAP^|MAP$|
29823 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29824 |MINV|MDET|MTRN|IDNT|CRSS|"x" |
29825 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29826 |PACK|UNPK|INDX|BLD |LEN |... |
29827 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29828 @end group
29829 @end smallexample
29830
29831 @noindent
29832 The keys in this menu operate on vectors and matrices.
29833
29834 @key{PACK} removes an integer @var{n} from the top of the stack;
29835 the next @var{n} stack elements are removed and packed into a vector,
29836 which is replaced onto the stack. Thus the sequence
29837 @kbd{1 ENTER 3 ENTER 5 ENTER 3 PACK} enters the vector
29838 @samp{[1, 3, 5]} onto the stack. To enter a matrix, build each row
29839 on the stack as a vector, then use a final @key{PACK} to collect the
29840 rows into a matrix.
29841
29842 @key{UNPK} unpacks the vector on the stack, pushing each of its
29843 components separately.
29844
29845 @key{INDX} removes an integer @var{n}, then builds a vector of
29846 integers from 1 to @var{n}. @kbd{INV INDX} takes three numbers
29847 from the stack: The vector size @var{n}, the starting number,
29848 and the increment. @kbd{BLD} takes an integer @var{n} and any
29849 value @var{x} and builds a vector of @var{n} copies of @var{x}.
29850
29851 @key{IDNT} removes an integer @var{n}, then builds an @var{n}-by-@var{n}
29852 identity matrix.
29853
29854 @key{LEN} replaces a vector by its length, an integer.
29855
29856 @key{...} turns on or off ``abbreviated'' display mode for large vectors.
29857
29858 @key{MINV}, @key{MDET}, @key{MTRN}, and @key{CROSS} are the matrix
29859 inverse, determinant, and transpose, and vector cross product.
29860
29861 @key{SUM} replaces a vector by the sum of its elements. It is
29862 equivalent to @kbd{u +} in normal Calc (@pxref{Statistical Operations}).
29863 @key{PROD} computes the product of the elements of a vector, and
29864 @key{MAX} computes the maximum of all the elements of a vector.
29865
29866 @key{INV SUM} computes the alternating sum of the first element
29867 minus the second, plus the third, minus the fourth, and so on.
29868 @key{INV MAX} computes the minimum of the vector elements.
29869
29870 @key{HYP SUM} computes the mean of the vector elements.
29871 @key{HYP PROD} computes the sample standard deviation.
29872 @key{HYP MAX} computes the median.
29873
29874 @key{MAP*} multiplies two vectors elementwise. It is equivalent
29875 to the @kbd{V M *} command. @key{MAP^} computes powers elementwise.
29876 The arguments must be vectors of equal length, or one must be a vector
29877 and the other must be a plain number. For example, @kbd{2 MAP^} squares
29878 all the elements of a vector.
29879
29880 @key{MAP$} maps the formula on the top of the stack across the
29881 vector in the second-to-top position. If the formula contains
29882 several variables, Calc takes that many vectors starting at the
29883 second-to-top position and matches them to the variables in
29884 alphabetical order. The result is a vector of the same size as
29885 the input vectors, whose elements are the formula evaluated with
29886 the variables set to the various sets of numbers in those vectors.
29887 For example, you could simulate @key{MAP^} using @key{MAP$} with
29888 the formula @samp{x^y}.
29889
29890 The @kbd{"x"} key pushes the variable name @expr{x} onto the
29891 stack. To build the formula @expr{x^2 + 6}, you would use the
29892 key sequence @kbd{"x" 2 y^x 6 +}. This formula would then be
29893 suitable for use with the @key{MAP$} key described above.
29894 With @key{INV}, @key{HYP}, or @key{INV} and @key{HYP}, the
29895 @kbd{"x"} key pushes the variable names @expr{y}, @expr{z}, and
29896 @expr{t}, respectively.
29897
29898 @node Keypad Modes Menu, , Keypad Vectors Menu, Keypad Mode
29899 @section Modes Menu
29900
29901 @smallexample
29902 @group
29903 |----+----+----+----+----+----5
29904 |FLT |FIX |SCI |ENG |GRP | |
29905 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29906 |RAD |DEG |FRAC|POLR|SYMB|PREC|
29907 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29908 |SWAP|RLL3|RLL4|OVER|STO |RCL |
29909 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29910 @end group
29911 @end smallexample
29912
29913 @noindent
29914 The keys in this menu manipulate modes, variables, and the stack.
29915
29916 The @key{FLT}, @key{FIX}, @key{SCI}, and @key{ENG} keys select
29917 floating-point, fixed-point, scientific, or engineering notation.
29918 @key{FIX} displays two digits after the decimal by default; the
29919 others display full precision. With the @key{INV} prefix, these
29920 keys pop a number-of-digits argument from the stack.
29921
29922 The @key{GRP} key turns grouping of digits with commas on or off.
29923 @kbd{INV GRP} enables grouping to the right of the decimal point as
29924 well as to the left.
29925
29926 The @key{RAD} and @key{DEG} keys switch between radians and degrees
29927 for trigonometric functions.
29928
29929 The @key{FRAC} key turns Fraction mode on or off. This affects
29930 whether commands like @kbd{/} with integer arguments produce
29931 fractional or floating-point results.
29932
29933 The @key{POLR} key turns Polar mode on or off, determining whether
29934 polar or rectangular complex numbers are used by default.
29935
29936 The @key{SYMB} key turns Symbolic mode on or off, in which
29937 operations that would produce inexact floating-point results
29938 are left unevaluated as algebraic formulas.
29939
29940 The @key{PREC} key selects the current precision. Answer with
29941 the keyboard or with the keypad digit and @key{ENTER} keys.
29942
29943 The @key{SWAP} key exchanges the top two stack elements.
29944 The @key{RLL3} key rotates the top three stack elements upwards.
29945 The @key{RLL4} key rotates the top four stack elements upwards.
29946 The @key{OVER} key duplicates the second-to-top stack element.
29947
29948 The @key{STO} and @key{RCL} keys are analogous to @kbd{s t} and
29949 @kbd{s r} in regular Calc. @xref{Store and Recall}. Click the
29950 @key{STO} or @key{RCL} key, then one of the ten digits. (Named
29951 variables are not available in Keypad mode.) You can also use,
29952 for example, @kbd{STO + 3} to add to register 3.
29953
29954 @node Embedded Mode, Programming, Keypad Mode, Top
29955 @chapter Embedded Mode
29956
29957 @noindent
29958 Embedded mode in Calc provides an alternative to copying numbers
29959 and formulas back and forth between editing buffers and the Calc
29960 stack. In Embedded mode, your editing buffer becomes temporarily
29961 linked to the stack and this copying is taken care of automatically.
29962
29963 @menu
29964 * Basic Embedded Mode::
29965 * More About Embedded Mode::
29966 * Assignments in Embedded Mode::
29967 * Mode Settings in Embedded Mode::
29968 * Customizing Embedded Mode::
29969 @end menu
29970
29971 @node Basic Embedded Mode, More About Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
29972 @section Basic Embedded Mode
29973
29974 @noindent
29975 @kindex C-x * e
29976 @pindex calc-embedded
29977 To enter Embedded mode, position the Emacs point (cursor) on a
29978 formula in any buffer and press @kbd{C-x * e} (@code{calc-embedded}).
29979 Note that @kbd{C-x * e} is not to be used in the Calc stack buffer
29980 like most Calc commands, but rather in regular editing buffers that
29981 are visiting your own files.
29982
29983 Calc will try to guess an appropriate language based on the major mode
29984 of the editing buffer. (@xref{Language Modes}.) If the current buffer is
29985 in @code{latex-mode}, for example, Calc will set its language to La@TeX{}.
29986 Similarly, Calc will use @TeX{} language for @code{tex-mode},
29987 @code{plain-tex-mode} and @code{context-mode}, C language for
29988 @code{c-mode} and @code{c++-mode}, FORTRAN language for
29989 @code{fortran-mode} and @code{f90-mode}, Pascal for @code{pascal-mode},
29990 and eqn for @code{nroff-mode} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
29991 These can be overridden with Calc's mode
29992 changing commands (@pxref{Mode Settings in Embedded Mode}). If no
29993 suitable language is available, Calc will continue with its current language.
29994
29995 Calc normally scans backward and forward in the buffer for the
29996 nearest opening and closing @dfn{formula delimiters}. The simplest
29997 delimiters are blank lines. Other delimiters that Embedded mode
29998 understands are:
29999
30000 @enumerate
30001 @item
30002 The @TeX{} and La@TeX{} math delimiters @samp{$ $}, @samp{$$ $$},
30003 @samp{\[ \]}, and @samp{\( \)};
30004 @item
30005 Lines beginning with @samp{\begin} and @samp{\end} (except matrix delimiters);
30006 @item
30007 Lines beginning with @samp{@@} (Texinfo delimiters).
30008 @item
30009 Lines beginning with @samp{.EQ} and @samp{.EN} (@dfn{eqn} delimiters);
30010 @item
30011 Lines containing a single @samp{%} or @samp{.\"} symbol and nothing else.
30012 @end enumerate
30013
30014 @xref{Customizing Embedded Mode}, to see how to make Calc recognize
30015 your own favorite delimiters. Delimiters like @samp{$ $} can appear
30016 on their own separate lines or in-line with the formula.
30017
30018 If you give a positive or negative numeric prefix argument, Calc
30019 instead uses the current point as one end of the formula, and includes
30020 that many lines forward or backward (respectively, including the current
30021 line). Explicit delimiters are not necessary in this case.
30022
30023 With a prefix argument of zero, Calc uses the current region (delimited
30024 by point and mark) instead of formula delimiters. With a prefix
30025 argument of @kbd{C-u} only, Calc uses the current line as the formula.
30026
30027 @kindex C-x * w
30028 @pindex calc-embedded-word
30029 The @kbd{C-x * w} (@code{calc-embedded-word}) command will start Embedded
30030 mode on the current ``word''; in this case Calc will scan for the first
30031 non-numeric character (i.e., the first character that is not a digit,
30032 sign, decimal point, or upper- or lower-case @samp{e}) forward and
30033 backward to delimit the formula.
30034
30035 When you enable Embedded mode for a formula, Calc reads the text
30036 between the delimiters and tries to interpret it as a Calc formula.
30037 Calc can generally identify @TeX{} formulas and
30038 Big-style formulas even if the language mode is wrong. If Calc
30039 can't make sense of the formula, it beeps and refuses to enter
30040 Embedded mode. But if the current language is wrong, Calc can
30041 sometimes parse the formula successfully (but incorrectly);
30042 for example, the C expression @samp{atan(a[1])} can be parsed
30043 in Normal language mode, but the @code{atan} won't correspond to
30044 the built-in @code{arctan} function, and the @samp{a[1]} will be
30045 interpreted as @samp{a} times the vector @samp{[1]}!
30046
30047 If you press @kbd{C-x * e} or @kbd{C-x * w} to activate an embedded
30048 formula which is blank, say with the cursor on the space between
30049 the two delimiters @samp{$ $}, Calc will immediately prompt for
30050 an algebraic entry.
30051
30052 Only one formula in one buffer can be enabled at a time. If you
30053 move to another area of the current buffer and give Calc commands,
30054 Calc turns Embedded mode off for the old formula and then tries
30055 to restart Embedded mode at the new position. Other buffers are
30056 not affected by Embedded mode.
30057
30058 When Embedded mode begins, Calc pushes the current formula onto
30059 the stack. No Calc stack window is created; however, Calc copies
30060 the top-of-stack position into the original buffer at all times.
30061 You can create a Calc window by hand with @kbd{C-x * o} if you
30062 find you need to see the entire stack.
30063
30064 For example, typing @kbd{C-x * e} while somewhere in the formula
30065 @samp{n>2} in the following line enables Embedded mode on that
30066 inequality:
30067
30068 @example
30069 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $n>2$.
30070 @end example
30071
30072 @noindent
30073 The formula @expr{n>2} will be pushed onto the Calc stack, and
30074 the top of stack will be copied back into the editing buffer.
30075 This means that spaces will appear around the @samp{>} symbol
30076 to match Calc's usual display style:
30077
30078 @example
30079 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $n > 2$.
30080 @end example
30081
30082 @noindent
30083 No spaces have appeared around the @samp{+} sign because it's
30084 in a different formula, one which we have not yet touched with
30085 Embedded mode.
30086
30087 Now that Embedded mode is enabled, keys you type in this buffer
30088 are interpreted as Calc commands. At this point we might use
30089 the ``commute'' command @kbd{j C} to reverse the inequality.
30090 This is a selection-based command for which we first need to
30091 move the cursor onto the operator (@samp{>} in this case) that
30092 needs to be commuted.
30093
30094 @example
30095 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $2 < n$.
30096 @end example
30097
30098 The @kbd{C-x * o} command is a useful way to open a Calc window
30099 without actually selecting that window. Giving this command
30100 verifies that @samp{2 < n} is also on the Calc stack. Typing
30101 @kbd{17 @key{RET}} would produce:
30102
30103 @example
30104 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $17$.
30105 @end example
30106
30107 @noindent
30108 with @samp{2 < n} and @samp{17} on the stack; typing @key{TAB}
30109 at this point will exchange the two stack values and restore
30110 @samp{2 < n} to the embedded formula. Even though you can't
30111 normally see the stack in Embedded mode, it is still there and
30112 it still operates in the same way. But, as with old-fashioned
30113 RPN calculators, you can only see the value at the top of the
30114 stack at any given time (unless you use @kbd{C-x * o}).
30115
30116 Typing @kbd{C-x * e} again turns Embedded mode off. The Calc
30117 window reveals that the formula @w{@samp{2 < n}} is automatically
30118 removed from the stack, but the @samp{17} is not. Entering
30119 Embedded mode always pushes one thing onto the stack, and
30120 leaving Embedded mode always removes one thing. Anything else
30121 that happens on the stack is entirely your business as far as
30122 Embedded mode is concerned.
30123
30124 If you press @kbd{C-x * e} in the wrong place by accident, it is
30125 possible that Calc will be able to parse the nearby text as a
30126 formula and will mangle that text in an attempt to redisplay it
30127 ``properly'' in the current language mode. If this happens,
30128 press @kbd{C-x * e} again to exit Embedded mode, then give the
30129 regular Emacs ``undo'' command (@kbd{C-_} or @kbd{C-x u}) to put
30130 the text back the way it was before Calc edited it. Note that Calc's
30131 own Undo command (typed before you turn Embedded mode back off)
30132 will not do you any good, because as far as Calc is concerned
30133 you haven't done anything with this formula yet.
30134
30135 @node More About Embedded Mode, Assignments in Embedded Mode, Basic Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30136 @section More About Embedded Mode
30137
30138 @noindent
30139 When Embedded mode ``activates'' a formula, i.e., when it examines
30140 the formula for the first time since the buffer was created or
30141 loaded, Calc tries to sense the language in which the formula was
30142 written. If the formula contains any La@TeX{}-like @samp{\} sequences,
30143 it is parsed (i.e., read) in La@TeX{} mode. If the formula appears to
30144 be written in multi-line Big mode, it is parsed in Big mode. Otherwise,
30145 it is parsed according to the current language mode.
30146
30147 Note that Calc does not change the current language mode according
30148 the formula it reads in. Even though it can read a La@TeX{} formula when
30149 not in La@TeX{} mode, it will immediately rewrite this formula using
30150 whatever language mode is in effect.
30151
30152 @tex
30153 \bigskip
30154 @end tex
30155
30156 @kindex d p
30157 @pindex calc-show-plain
30158 Calc's parser is unable to read certain kinds of formulas. For
30159 example, with @kbd{v ]} (@code{calc-matrix-brackets}) you can
30160 specify matrix display styles which the parser is unable to
30161 recognize as matrices. The @kbd{d p} (@code{calc-show-plain})
30162 command turns on a mode in which a ``plain'' version of a
30163 formula is placed in front of the fully-formatted version.
30164 When Calc reads a formula that has such a plain version in
30165 front, it reads the plain version and ignores the formatted
30166 version.
30167
30168 Plain formulas are preceded and followed by @samp{%%%} signs
30169 by default. This notation has the advantage that the @samp{%}
30170 character begins a comment in @TeX{} and La@TeX{}, so if your formula is
30171 embedded in a @TeX{} or La@TeX{} document its plain version will be
30172 invisible in the final printed copy. Certain major modes have different
30173 delimiters to ensure that the ``plain'' version will be
30174 in a comment for those modes, also.
30175 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode} to see how to change the ``plain''
30176 formula delimiters.
30177
30178 There are several notations which Calc's parser for ``big''
30179 formatted formulas can't yet recognize. In particular, it can't
30180 read the large symbols for @code{sum}, @code{prod}, and @code{integ},
30181 and it can't handle @samp{=>} with the righthand argument omitted.
30182 Also, Calc won't recognize special formats you have defined with
30183 the @kbd{Z C} command (@pxref{User-Defined Compositions}). In
30184 these cases it is important to use ``plain'' mode to make sure
30185 Calc will be able to read your formula later.
30186
30187 Another example where ``plain'' mode is important is if you have
30188 specified a float mode with few digits of precision. Normally
30189 any digits that are computed but not displayed will simply be
30190 lost when you save and re-load your embedded buffer, but ``plain''
30191 mode allows you to make sure that the complete number is present
30192 in the file as well as the rounded-down number.
30193
30194 @tex
30195 \bigskip
30196 @end tex
30197
30198 Embedded buffers remember active formulas for as long as they
30199 exist in Emacs memory. Suppose you have an embedded formula
30200 which is @cpi{} to the normal 12 decimal places, and then
30201 type @w{@kbd{C-u 5 d n}} to display only five decimal places.
30202 If you then type @kbd{d n}, all 12 places reappear because the
30203 full number is still there on the Calc stack. More surprisingly,
30204 even if you exit Embedded mode and later re-enter it for that
30205 formula, typing @kbd{d n} will restore all 12 places because
30206 each buffer remembers all its active formulas. However, if you
30207 save the buffer in a file and reload it in a new Emacs session,
30208 all non-displayed digits will have been lost unless you used
30209 ``plain'' mode.
30210
30211 @tex
30212 \bigskip
30213 @end tex
30214
30215 In some applications of Embedded mode, you will want to have a
30216 sequence of copies of a formula that show its evolution as you
30217 work on it. For example, you might want to have a sequence
30218 like this in your file (elaborating here on the example from
30219 the ``Getting Started'' chapter):
30220
30221 @smallexample
30222 The derivative of
30223
30224 ln(ln(x))
30225
30226 is
30227
30228 @r{(the derivative of }ln(ln(x))@r{)}
30229
30230 whose value at x = 2 is
30231
30232 @r{(the value)}
30233
30234 and at x = 3 is
30235
30236 @r{(the value)}
30237 @end smallexample
30238
30239 @kindex C-x * d
30240 @pindex calc-embedded-duplicate
30241 The @kbd{C-x * d} (@code{calc-embedded-duplicate}) command is a
30242 handy way to make sequences like this. If you type @kbd{C-x * d},
30243 the formula under the cursor (which may or may not have Embedded
30244 mode enabled for it at the time) is copied immediately below and
30245 Embedded mode is then enabled for that copy.
30246
30247 For this example, you would start with just
30248
30249 @smallexample
30250 The derivative of
30251
30252 ln(ln(x))
30253 @end smallexample
30254
30255 @noindent
30256 and press @kbd{C-x * d} with the cursor on this formula. The result
30257 is
30258
30259 @smallexample
30260 The derivative of
30261
30262 ln(ln(x))
30263
30264
30265 ln(ln(x))
30266 @end smallexample
30267
30268 @noindent
30269 with the second copy of the formula enabled in Embedded mode.
30270 You can now press @kbd{a d x @key{RET}} to take the derivative, and
30271 @kbd{C-x * d C-x * d} to make two more copies of the derivative.
30272 To complete the computations, type @kbd{3 s l x @key{RET}} to evaluate
30273 the last formula, then move up to the second-to-last formula
30274 and type @kbd{2 s l x @key{RET}}.
30275
30276 Finally, you would want to press @kbd{C-x * e} to exit Embedded
30277 mode, then go up and insert the necessary text in between the
30278 various formulas and numbers.
30279
30280 @tex
30281 \bigskip
30282 @end tex
30283
30284 @kindex C-x * f
30285 @kindex C-x * '
30286 @pindex calc-embedded-new-formula
30287 The @kbd{C-x * f} (@code{calc-embedded-new-formula}) command
30288 creates a new embedded formula at the current point. It inserts
30289 some default delimiters, which are usually just blank lines,
30290 and then does an algebraic entry to get the formula (which is
30291 then enabled for Embedded mode). This is just shorthand for
30292 typing the delimiters yourself, positioning the cursor between
30293 the new delimiters, and pressing @kbd{C-x * e}. The key sequence
30294 @kbd{C-x * '} is equivalent to @kbd{C-x * f}.
30295
30296 @kindex C-x * n
30297 @kindex C-x * p
30298 @pindex calc-embedded-next
30299 @pindex calc-embedded-previous
30300 The @kbd{C-x * n} (@code{calc-embedded-next}) and @kbd{C-x * p}
30301 (@code{calc-embedded-previous}) commands move the cursor to the
30302 next or previous active embedded formula in the buffer. They
30303 can take positive or negative prefix arguments to move by several
30304 formulas. Note that these commands do not actually examine the
30305 text of the buffer looking for formulas; they only see formulas
30306 which have previously been activated in Embedded mode. In fact,
30307 @kbd{C-x * n} and @kbd{C-x * p} are a useful way to tell which
30308 embedded formulas are currently active. Also, note that these
30309 commands do not enable Embedded mode on the next or previous
30310 formula, they just move the cursor.
30311
30312 @kindex C-x * `
30313 @pindex calc-embedded-edit
30314 The @kbd{C-x * `} (@code{calc-embedded-edit}) command edits the
30315 embedded formula at the current point as if by @kbd{`} (@code{calc-edit}).
30316 Embedded mode does not have to be enabled for this to work. Press
30317 @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish the edit, or @kbd{C-x k} to cancel.
30318
30319 @node Assignments in Embedded Mode, Mode Settings in Embedded Mode, More About Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30320 @section Assignments in Embedded Mode
30321
30322 @noindent
30323 The @samp{:=} (assignment) and @samp{=>} (``evaluates-to'') operators
30324 are especially useful in Embedded mode. They allow you to make
30325 a definition in one formula, then refer to that definition in
30326 other formulas embedded in the same buffer.
30327
30328 An embedded formula which is an assignment to a variable, as in
30329
30330 @example
30331 foo := 5
30332 @end example
30333
30334 @noindent
30335 records @expr{5} as the stored value of @code{foo} for the
30336 purposes of Embedded mode operations in the current buffer. It
30337 does @emph{not} actually store @expr{5} as the ``global'' value
30338 of @code{foo}, however. Regular Calc operations, and Embedded
30339 formulas in other buffers, will not see this assignment.
30340
30341 One way to use this assigned value is simply to create an
30342 Embedded formula elsewhere that refers to @code{foo}, and to press
30343 @kbd{=} in that formula. However, this permanently replaces the
30344 @code{foo} in the formula with its current value. More interesting
30345 is to use @samp{=>} elsewhere:
30346
30347 @example
30348 foo + 7 => 12
30349 @end example
30350
30351 @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}, for a general discussion of @samp{=>}.
30352
30353 If you move back and change the assignment to @code{foo}, any
30354 @samp{=>} formulas which refer to it are automatically updated.
30355
30356 @example
30357 foo := 17
30358
30359 foo + 7 => 24
30360 @end example
30361
30362 The obvious question then is, @emph{how} can one easily change the
30363 assignment to @code{foo}? If you simply select the formula in
30364 Embedded mode and type 17, the assignment itself will be replaced
30365 by the 17. The effect on the other formula will be that the
30366 variable @code{foo} becomes unassigned:
30367
30368 @example
30369 17
30370
30371 foo + 7 => foo + 7
30372 @end example
30373
30374 The right thing to do is first to use a selection command (@kbd{j 2}
30375 will do the trick) to select the righthand side of the assignment.
30376 Then, @kbd{17 @key{TAB} @key{DEL}} will swap the 17 into place (@pxref{Selecting
30377 Subformulas}, to see how this works).
30378
30379 @kindex C-x * j
30380 @pindex calc-embedded-select
30381 The @kbd{C-x * j} (@code{calc-embedded-select}) command provides an
30382 easy way to operate on assignments. It is just like @kbd{C-x * e},
30383 except that if the enabled formula is an assignment, it uses
30384 @kbd{j 2} to select the righthand side. If the enabled formula
30385 is an evaluates-to, it uses @kbd{j 1} to select the lefthand side.
30386 A formula can also be a combination of both:
30387
30388 @example
30389 bar := foo + 3 => 20
30390 @end example
30391
30392 @noindent
30393 in which case @kbd{C-x * j} will select the middle part (@samp{foo + 3}).
30394
30395 The formula is automatically deselected when you leave Embedded
30396 mode.
30397
30398 @kindex C-x * u
30399 @pindex calc-embedded-update-formula
30400 Another way to change the assignment to @code{foo} would simply be
30401 to edit the number using regular Emacs editing rather than Embedded
30402 mode. Then, we have to find a way to get Embedded mode to notice
30403 the change. The @kbd{C-x * u} (@code{calc-embedded-update-formula})
30404 command is a convenient way to do this.
30405
30406 @example
30407 foo := 6
30408
30409 foo + 7 => 13
30410 @end example
30411
30412 Pressing @kbd{C-x * u} is much like pressing @kbd{C-x * e = C-x * e}, that
30413 is, temporarily enabling Embedded mode for the formula under the
30414 cursor and then evaluating it with @kbd{=}. But @kbd{C-x * u} does
30415 not actually use @kbd{C-x * e}, and in fact another formula somewhere
30416 else can be enabled in Embedded mode while you use @kbd{C-x * u} and
30417 that formula will not be disturbed.
30418
30419 With a numeric prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * u} updates all active
30420 @samp{=>} formulas in the buffer. Formulas which have not yet
30421 been activated in Embedded mode, and formulas which do not have
30422 @samp{=>} as their top-level operator, are not affected by this.
30423 (This is useful only if you have used @kbd{m C}; see below.)
30424
30425 With a plain @kbd{C-u} prefix, @kbd{C-u C-x * u} updates only in the
30426 region between mark and point rather than in the whole buffer.
30427
30428 @kbd{C-x * u} is also a handy way to activate a formula, such as an
30429 @samp{=>} formula that has freshly been typed in or loaded from a
30430 file.
30431
30432 @kindex C-x * a
30433 @pindex calc-embedded-activate
30434 The @kbd{C-x * a} (@code{calc-embedded-activate}) command scans
30435 through the current buffer and activates all embedded formulas
30436 that contain @samp{:=} or @samp{=>} symbols. This does not mean
30437 that Embedded mode is actually turned on, but only that the
30438 formulas' positions are registered with Embedded mode so that
30439 the @samp{=>} values can be properly updated as assignments are
30440 changed.
30441
30442 It is a good idea to type @kbd{C-x * a} right after loading a file
30443 that uses embedded @samp{=>} operators. Emacs includes a nifty
30444 ``buffer-local variables'' feature that you can use to do this
30445 automatically. The idea is to place near the end of your file
30446 a few lines that look like this:
30447
30448 @example
30449 --- Local Variables: ---
30450 --- eval:(calc-embedded-activate) ---
30451 --- End: ---
30452 @end example
30453
30454 @noindent
30455 where the leading and trailing @samp{---} can be replaced by
30456 any suitable strings (which must be the same on all three lines)
30457 or omitted altogether; in a @TeX{} or La@TeX{} file, @samp{%} would be a good
30458 leading string and no trailing string would be necessary. In a
30459 C program, @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} would be good leading and
30460 trailing strings.
30461
30462 When Emacs loads a file into memory, it checks for a Local Variables
30463 section like this one at the end of the file. If it finds this
30464 section, it does the specified things (in this case, running
30465 @kbd{C-x * a} automatically) before editing of the file begins.
30466 The Local Variables section must be within 3000 characters of the
30467 end of the file for Emacs to find it, and it must be in the last
30468 page of the file if the file has any page separators.
30469 @xref{File Variables, , Local Variables in Files, emacs, the
30470 Emacs manual}.
30471
30472 Note that @kbd{C-x * a} does not update the formulas it finds.
30473 To do this, type, say, @kbd{M-1 C-x * u} after @w{@kbd{C-x * a}}.
30474 Generally this should not be a problem, though, because the
30475 formulas will have been up-to-date already when the file was
30476 saved.
30477
30478 Normally, @kbd{C-x * a} activates all the formulas it finds, but
30479 any previous active formulas remain active as well. With a
30480 positive numeric prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * a} first deactivates
30481 all current active formulas, then actives the ones it finds in
30482 its scan of the buffer. With a negative prefix argument,
30483 @kbd{C-x * a} simply deactivates all formulas.
30484
30485 Embedded mode has two symbols, @samp{Active} and @samp{~Active},
30486 which it puts next to the major mode name in a buffer's mode line.
30487 It puts @samp{Active} if it has reason to believe that all
30488 formulas in the buffer are active, because you have typed @kbd{C-x * a}
30489 and Calc has not since had to deactivate any formulas (which can
30490 happen if Calc goes to update an @samp{=>} formula somewhere because
30491 a variable changed, and finds that the formula is no longer there
30492 due to some kind of editing outside of Embedded mode). Calc puts
30493 @samp{~Active} in the mode line if some, but probably not all,
30494 formulas in the buffer are active. This happens if you activate
30495 a few formulas one at a time but never use @kbd{C-x * a}, or if you
30496 used @kbd{C-x * a} but then Calc had to deactivate a formula
30497 because it lost track of it. If neither of these symbols appears
30498 in the mode line, no embedded formulas are active in the buffer
30499 (e.g., before Embedded mode has been used, or after a @kbd{M-- C-x * a}).
30500
30501 Embedded formulas can refer to assignments both before and after them
30502 in the buffer. If there are several assignments to a variable, the
30503 nearest preceding assignment is used if there is one, otherwise the
30504 following assignment is used.
30505
30506 @example
30507 x => 1
30508
30509 x := 1
30510
30511 x => 1
30512
30513 x := 2
30514
30515 x => 2
30516 @end example
30517
30518 As well as simple variables, you can also assign to subscript
30519 expressions of the form @samp{@var{var}_@var{number}} (as in
30520 @code{x_0}), or @samp{@var{var}_@var{var}} (as in @code{x_max}).
30521 Assignments to other kinds of objects can be represented by Calc,
30522 but the automatic linkage between assignments and references works
30523 only for plain variables and these two kinds of subscript expressions.
30524
30525 If there are no assignments to a given variable, the global
30526 stored value for the variable is used (@pxref{Storing Variables}),
30527 or, if no value is stored, the variable is left in symbolic form.
30528 Note that global stored values will be lost when the file is saved
30529 and loaded in a later Emacs session, unless you have used the
30530 @kbd{s p} (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) command to save them;
30531 @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
30532
30533 The @kbd{m C} (@code{calc-auto-recompute}) command turns automatic
30534 recomputation of @samp{=>} forms on and off. If you turn automatic
30535 recomputation off, you will have to use @kbd{C-x * u} to update these
30536 formulas manually after an assignment has been changed. If you
30537 plan to change several assignments at once, it may be more efficient
30538 to type @kbd{m C}, change all the assignments, then use @kbd{M-1 C-x * u}
30539 to update the entire buffer afterwards. The @kbd{m C} command also
30540 controls @samp{=>} formulas on the stack; @pxref{Evaluates-To
30541 Operator}. When you turn automatic recomputation back on, the
30542 stack will be updated but the Embedded buffer will not; you must
30543 use @kbd{C-x * u} to update the buffer by hand.
30544
30545 @node Mode Settings in Embedded Mode, Customizing Embedded Mode, Assignments in Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30546 @section Mode Settings in Embedded Mode
30547
30548 @kindex m e
30549 @pindex calc-embedded-preserve-modes
30550 @noindent
30551 The mode settings can be changed while Calc is in embedded mode, but
30552 by default they will revert to their original values when embedded mode
30553 is ended. However, the modes saved when the mode-recording mode is
30554 @code{Save} (see below) and the modes in effect when the @kbd{m e}
30555 (@code{calc-embedded-preserve-modes}) command is given
30556 will be preserved when embedded mode is ended.
30557
30558 Embedded mode has a rather complicated mechanism for handling mode
30559 settings in Embedded formulas. It is possible to put annotations
30560 in the file that specify mode settings either global to the entire
30561 file or local to a particular formula or formulas. In the latter
30562 case, different modes can be specified for use when a formula
30563 is the enabled Embedded mode formula.
30564
30565 When you give any mode-setting command, like @kbd{m f} (for Fraction
30566 mode) or @kbd{d s} (for scientific notation), Embedded mode adds
30567 a line like the following one to the file just before the opening
30568 delimiter of the formula.
30569
30570 @example
30571 % [calc-mode: fractions: t]
30572 % [calc-mode: float-format: (sci 0)]
30573 @end example
30574
30575 When Calc interprets an embedded formula, it scans the text before
30576 the formula for mode-setting annotations like these and sets the
30577 Calc buffer to match these modes. Modes not explicitly described
30578 in the file are not changed. Calc scans all the way to the top of
30579 the file, or up to a line of the form
30580
30581 @example
30582 % [calc-defaults]
30583 @end example
30584
30585 @noindent
30586 which you can insert at strategic places in the file if this backward
30587 scan is getting too slow, or just to provide a barrier between one
30588 ``zone'' of mode settings and another.
30589
30590 If the file contains several annotations for the same mode, the
30591 closest one before the formula is used. Annotations after the
30592 formula are never used (except for global annotations, described
30593 below).
30594
30595 The scan does not look for the leading @samp{% }, only for the
30596 square brackets and the text they enclose. In fact, the leading
30597 characters are different for different major modes. You can edit the
30598 mode annotations to a style that works better in context if you wish.
30599 @xref{Customizing Embedded Mode}, to see how to change the style
30600 that Calc uses when it generates the annotations. You can write
30601 mode annotations into the file yourself if you know the syntax;
30602 the easiest way to find the syntax for a given mode is to let
30603 Calc write the annotation for it once and see what it does.
30604
30605 If you give a mode-changing command for a mode that already has
30606 a suitable annotation just above the current formula, Calc will
30607 modify that annotation rather than generating a new, conflicting
30608 one.
30609
30610 Mode annotations have three parts, separated by colons. (Spaces
30611 after the colons are optional.) The first identifies the kind
30612 of mode setting, the second is a name for the mode itself, and
30613 the third is the value in the form of a Lisp symbol, number,
30614 or list. Annotations with unrecognizable text in the first or
30615 second parts are ignored. The third part is not checked to make
30616 sure the value is of a valid type or range; if you write an
30617 annotation by hand, be sure to give a proper value or results
30618 will be unpredictable. Mode-setting annotations are case-sensitive.
30619
30620 While Embedded mode is enabled, the word @code{Local} appears in
30621 the mode line. This is to show that mode setting commands generate
30622 annotations that are ``local'' to the current formula or set of
30623 formulas. The @kbd{m R} (@code{calc-mode-record-mode}) command
30624 causes Calc to generate different kinds of annotations. Pressing
30625 @kbd{m R} repeatedly cycles through the possible modes.
30626
30627 @code{LocEdit} and @code{LocPerm} modes generate annotations
30628 that look like this, respectively:
30629
30630 @example
30631 % [calc-edit-mode: float-format: (sci 0)]
30632 % [calc-perm-mode: float-format: (sci 5)]
30633 @end example
30634
30635 The first kind of annotation will be used only while a formula
30636 is enabled in Embedded mode. The second kind will be used only
30637 when the formula is @emph{not} enabled. (Whether the formula
30638 is ``active'' or not, i.e., whether Calc has seen this formula
30639 yet, is not relevant here.)
30640
30641 @code{Global} mode generates an annotation like this at the end
30642 of the file:
30643
30644 @example
30645 % [calc-global-mode: fractions t]
30646 @end example
30647
30648 Global mode annotations affect all formulas throughout the file,
30649 and may appear anywhere in the file. This allows you to tuck your
30650 mode annotations somewhere out of the way, say, on a new page of
30651 the file, as long as those mode settings are suitable for all
30652 formulas in the file.
30653
30654 Enabling a formula with @kbd{C-x * e} causes a fresh scan for local
30655 mode annotations; you will have to use this after adding annotations
30656 above a formula by hand to get the formula to notice them. Updating
30657 a formula with @kbd{C-x * u} will also re-scan the local modes, but
30658 global modes are only re-scanned by @kbd{C-x * a}.
30659
30660 Another way that modes can get out of date is if you add a local
30661 mode annotation to a formula that has another formula after it.
30662 In this example, we have used the @kbd{d s} command while the
30663 first of the two embedded formulas is active. But the second
30664 formula has not changed its style to match, even though by the
30665 rules of reading annotations the @samp{(sci 0)} applies to it, too.
30666
30667 @example
30668 % [calc-mode: float-format: (sci 0)]
30669 1.23e2
30670
30671 456.
30672 @end example
30673
30674 We would have to go down to the other formula and press @kbd{C-x * u}
30675 on it in order to get it to notice the new annotation.
30676
30677 Two more mode-recording modes selectable by @kbd{m R} are available
30678 which are also available outside of Embedded mode.
30679 (@pxref{General Mode Commands}.) They are @code{Save}, in which mode
30680 settings are recorded permanently in your Calc init file (the file given
30681 by the variable @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.calc.el})
30682 rather than by annotating the current document, and no-recording
30683 mode (where there is no symbol like @code{Save} or @code{Local} in
30684 the mode line), in which mode-changing commands do not leave any
30685 annotations at all.
30686
30687 When Embedded mode is not enabled, mode-recording modes except
30688 for @code{Save} have no effect.
30689
30690 @node Customizing Embedded Mode, , Mode Settings in Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30691 @section Customizing Embedded Mode
30692
30693 @noindent
30694 You can modify Embedded mode's behavior by setting various Lisp
30695 variables described here. These variables are customizable
30696 (@pxref{Customizing Calc}), or you can use @kbd{M-x set-variable}
30697 or @kbd{M-x edit-options} to adjust a variable on the fly.
30698 (Another possibility would be to use a file-local variable annotation at
30699 the end of the file;
30700 @pxref{File Variables, , Local Variables in Files, emacs, the Emacs manual}.)
30701 Many of the variables given mentioned here can be set to depend on the
30702 major mode of the editing buffer (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
30703
30704 @vindex calc-embedded-open-formula
30705 The @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} variable holds a regular
30706 expression for the opening delimiter of a formula. @xref{Regexp Search,
30707 , Regular Expression Search, emacs, the Emacs manual}, to see
30708 how regular expressions work. Basically, a regular expression is a
30709 pattern that Calc can search for. A regular expression that considers
30710 blank lines, @samp{$}, and @samp{$$} to be opening delimiters is
30711 @code{"\\`\\|^\n\\|\\$\\$?"}. Just in case the meaning of this
30712 regular expression is not completely plain, let's go through it
30713 in detail.
30714
30715 The surrounding @samp{" "} marks quote the text between them as a
30716 Lisp string. If you left them off, @code{set-variable} or
30717 @code{edit-options} would try to read the regular expression as a
30718 Lisp program.
30719
30720 The most obvious property of this regular expression is that it
30721 contains indecently many backslashes. There are actually two levels
30722 of backslash usage going on here. First, when Lisp reads a quoted
30723 string, all pairs of characters beginning with a backslash are
30724 interpreted as special characters. Here, @code{\n} changes to a
30725 new-line character, and @code{\\} changes to a single backslash.
30726 So the actual regular expression seen by Calc is
30727 @samp{\`\|^ @r{(newline)} \|\$\$?}.
30728
30729 Regular expressions also consider pairs beginning with backslash
30730 to have special meanings. Sometimes the backslash is used to quote
30731 a character that otherwise would have a special meaning in a regular
30732 expression, like @samp{$}, which normally means ``end-of-line,''
30733 or @samp{?}, which means that the preceding item is optional. So
30734 @samp{\$\$?} matches either one or two dollar signs.
30735
30736 The other codes in this regular expression are @samp{^}, which matches
30737 ``beginning-of-line,'' @samp{\|}, which means ``or,'' and @samp{\`},
30738 which matches ``beginning-of-buffer.'' So the whole pattern means
30739 that a formula begins at the beginning of the buffer, or on a newline
30740 that occurs at the beginning of a line (i.e., a blank line), or at
30741 one or two dollar signs.
30742
30743 The default value of @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} looks just
30744 like this example, with several more alternatives added on to
30745 recognize various other common kinds of delimiters.
30746
30747 By the way, the reason to use @samp{^\n} rather than @samp{^$}
30748 or @samp{\n\n}, which also would appear to match blank lines,
30749 is that the former expression actually ``consumes'' only one
30750 newline character as @emph{part of} the delimiter, whereas the
30751 latter expressions consume zero or two newlines, respectively.
30752 The former choice gives the most natural behavior when Calc
30753 must operate on a whole formula including its delimiters.
30754
30755 See the Emacs manual for complete details on regular expressions.
30756 But just for your convenience, here is a list of all characters
30757 which must be quoted with backslash (like @samp{\$}) to avoid
30758 some special interpretation: @samp{. * + ? [ ] ^ $ \}. (Note
30759 the backslash in this list; for example, to match @samp{\[} you
30760 must use @code{"\\\\\\["}. An exercise for the reader is to
30761 account for each of these six backslashes!)
30762
30763 @vindex calc-embedded-close-formula
30764 The @code{calc-embedded-close-formula} variable holds a regular
30765 expression for the closing delimiter of a formula. A closing
30766 regular expression to match the above example would be
30767 @code{"\\'\\|\n$\\|\\$\\$?"}. This is almost the same as the
30768 other one, except it now uses @samp{\'} (``end-of-buffer'') and
30769 @samp{\n$} (newline occurring at end of line, yet another way
30770 of describing a blank line that is more appropriate for this
30771 case).
30772
30773 @vindex calc-embedded-word-regexp
30774 The @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp} variable holds a regular expression
30775 used to define an expression to look for (a ``word'') when you type
30776 @kbd{C-x * w} to enable Embedded mode.
30777
30778 @vindex calc-embedded-open-plain
30779 The @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} variable is a string which
30780 begins a ``plain'' formula written in front of the formatted
30781 formula when @kbd{d p} mode is turned on. Note that this is an
30782 actual string, not a regular expression, because Calc must be able
30783 to write this string into a buffer as well as to recognize it.
30784 The default string is @code{"%%% "} (note the trailing space), but may
30785 be different for certain major modes.
30786
30787 @vindex calc-embedded-close-plain
30788 The @code{calc-embedded-close-plain} variable is a string which
30789 ends a ``plain'' formula. The default is @code{" %%%\n"}, but may be
30790 different for different major modes. Without
30791 the trailing newline here, the first line of a Big mode formula
30792 that followed might be shifted over with respect to the other lines.
30793
30794 @vindex calc-embedded-open-new-formula
30795 The @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} variable is a string
30796 which is inserted at the front of a new formula when you type
30797 @kbd{C-x * f}. Its default value is @code{"\n\n"}. If this
30798 string begins with a newline character and the @kbd{C-x * f} is
30799 typed at the beginning of a line, @kbd{C-x * f} will skip this
30800 first newline to avoid introducing unnecessary blank lines in
30801 the file.
30802
30803 @vindex calc-embedded-close-new-formula
30804 The @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} variable is the corresponding
30805 string which is inserted at the end of a new formula. Its default
30806 value is also @code{"\n\n"}. The final newline is omitted by
30807 @w{@kbd{C-x * f}} if typed at the end of a line. (It follows that if
30808 @kbd{C-x * f} is typed on a blank line, both a leading opening
30809 newline and a trailing closing newline are omitted.)
30810
30811 @vindex calc-embedded-announce-formula
30812 The @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula} variable is a regular
30813 expression which is sure to be followed by an embedded formula.
30814 The @kbd{C-x * a} command searches for this pattern as well as for
30815 @samp{=>} and @samp{:=} operators. Note that @kbd{C-x * a} will
30816 not activate just anything surrounded by formula delimiters; after
30817 all, blank lines are considered formula delimiters by default!
30818 But if your language includes a delimiter which can only occur
30819 actually in front of a formula, you can take advantage of it here.
30820 The default pattern is @code{"%Embed\n\\(% .*\n\\)*"}, but may be
30821 different for different major modes.
30822 This pattern will check for @samp{%Embed} followed by any number of
30823 lines beginning with @samp{%} and a space. This last is important to
30824 make Calc consider mode annotations part of the pattern, so that the
30825 formula's opening delimiter really is sure to follow the pattern.
30826
30827 @vindex calc-embedded-open-mode
30828 The @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} variable is a string (not a
30829 regular expression) which should precede a mode annotation.
30830 Calc never scans for this string; Calc always looks for the
30831 annotation itself. But this is the string that is inserted before
30832 the opening bracket when Calc adds an annotation on its own.
30833 The default is @code{"% "}, but may be different for different major
30834 modes.
30835
30836 @vindex calc-embedded-close-mode
30837 The @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} variable is a string which
30838 follows a mode annotation written by Calc. Its default value
30839 is simply a newline, @code{"\n"}, but may be different for different
30840 major modes. If you change this, it is a good idea still to end with a
30841 newline so that mode annotations will appear on lines by themselves.
30842
30843 @node Programming, Copying, Embedded Mode, Top
30844 @chapter Programming
30845
30846 @noindent
30847 There are several ways to ``program'' the Emacs Calculator, depending
30848 on the nature of the problem you need to solve.
30849
30850 @enumerate
30851 @item
30852 @dfn{Keyboard macros} allow you to record a sequence of keystrokes
30853 and play them back at a later time. This is just the standard Emacs
30854 keyboard macro mechanism, dressed up with a few more features such
30855 as loops and conditionals.
30856
30857 @item
30858 @dfn{Algebraic definitions} allow you to use any formula to define a
30859 new function. This function can then be used in algebraic formulas or
30860 as an interactive command.
30861
30862 @item
30863 @dfn{Rewrite rules} are discussed in the section on algebra commands.
30864 @xref{Rewrite Rules}. If you put your rewrite rules in the variable
30865 @code{EvalRules}, they will be applied automatically to all Calc
30866 results in just the same way as an internal ``rule'' is applied to
30867 evaluate @samp{sqrt(9)} to 3 and so on. @xref{Automatic Rewrites}.
30868
30869 @item
30870 @dfn{Lisp} is the programming language that Calc (and most of Emacs)
30871 is written in. If the above techniques aren't powerful enough, you
30872 can write Lisp functions to do anything that built-in Calc commands
30873 can do. Lisp code is also somewhat faster than keyboard macros or
30874 rewrite rules.
30875 @end enumerate
30876
30877 @kindex z
30878 Programming features are available through the @kbd{z} and @kbd{Z}
30879 prefix keys. New commands that you define are two-key sequences
30880 beginning with @kbd{z}. Commands for managing these definitions
30881 use the shift-@kbd{Z} prefix. (The @kbd{Z T} (@code{calc-timing})
30882 command is described elsewhere; @pxref{Troubleshooting Commands}.
30883 The @kbd{Z C} (@code{calc-user-define-composition}) command is also
30884 described elsewhere; @pxref{User-Defined Compositions}.)
30885
30886 @menu
30887 * Creating User Keys::
30888 * Keyboard Macros::
30889 * Invocation Macros::
30890 * Algebraic Definitions::
30891 * Lisp Definitions::
30892 @end menu
30893
30894 @node Creating User Keys, Keyboard Macros, Programming, Programming
30895 @section Creating User Keys
30896
30897 @noindent
30898 @kindex Z D
30899 @pindex calc-user-define
30900 Any Calculator command may be bound to a key using the @kbd{Z D}
30901 (@code{calc-user-define}) command. Actually, it is bound to a two-key
30902 sequence beginning with the lower-case @kbd{z} prefix.
30903
30904 The @kbd{Z D} command first prompts for the key to define. For example,
30905 press @kbd{Z D a} to define the new key sequence @kbd{z a}. You are then
30906 prompted for the name of the Calculator command that this key should
30907 run. For example, the @code{calc-sincos} command is not normally
30908 available on a key. Typing @kbd{Z D s sincos @key{RET}} programs the
30909 @kbd{z s} key sequence to run @code{calc-sincos}. This definition will remain
30910 in effect for the rest of this Emacs session, or until you redefine
30911 @kbd{z s} to be something else.
30912
30913 You can actually bind any Emacs command to a @kbd{z} key sequence by
30914 backspacing over the @samp{calc-} when you are prompted for the command name.
30915
30916 As with any other prefix key, you can type @kbd{z ?} to see a list of
30917 all the two-key sequences you have defined that start with @kbd{z}.
30918 Initially, no @kbd{z} sequences (except @kbd{z ?} itself) are defined.
30919
30920 User keys are typically letters, but may in fact be any key.
30921 (@key{META}-keys are not permitted, nor are a terminal's special
30922 function keys which generate multi-character sequences when pressed.)
30923 You can define different commands on the shifted and unshifted versions
30924 of a letter if you wish.
30925
30926 @kindex Z U
30927 @pindex calc-user-undefine
30928 The @kbd{Z U} (@code{calc-user-undefine}) command unbinds a user key.
30929 For example, the key sequence @kbd{Z U s} will undefine the @code{sincos}
30930 key we defined above.
30931
30932 @kindex Z P
30933 @pindex calc-user-define-permanent
30934 @cindex Storing user definitions
30935 @cindex Permanent user definitions
30936 @cindex Calc init file, user-defined commands
30937 The @kbd{Z P} (@code{calc-user-define-permanent}) command makes a key
30938 binding permanent so that it will remain in effect even in future Emacs
30939 sessions. (It does this by adding a suitable bit of Lisp code into
30940 your Calc init file; that is, the file given by the variable
30941 @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.calc.el}.) For example,
30942 @kbd{Z P s} would register our @code{sincos} command permanently. If
30943 you later wish to unregister this command you must edit your Calc init
30944 file by hand. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to tell Calc to
30945 use a different file for the Calc init file.)
30946
30947 The @kbd{Z P} command also saves the user definition, if any, for the
30948 command bound to the key. After @kbd{Z F} and @kbd{Z C}, a given user
30949 key could invoke a command, which in turn calls an algebraic function,
30950 which might have one or more special display formats. A single @kbd{Z P}
30951 command will save all of these definitions.
30952 To save an algebraic function, type @kbd{'} (the apostrophe)
30953 when prompted for a key, and type the function name. To save a command
30954 without its key binding, type @kbd{M-x} and enter a function name. (The
30955 @samp{calc-} prefix will automatically be inserted for you.)
30956 (If the command you give implies a function, the function will be saved,
30957 and if the function has any display formats, those will be saved, but
30958 not the other way around: Saving a function will not save any commands
30959 or key bindings associated with the function.)
30960
30961 @kindex Z E
30962 @pindex calc-user-define-edit
30963 @cindex Editing user definitions
30964 The @kbd{Z E} (@code{calc-user-define-edit}) command edits the definition
30965 of a user key. This works for keys that have been defined by either
30966 keyboard macros or formulas; further details are contained in the relevant
30967 following sections.
30968
30969 @node Keyboard Macros, Invocation Macros, Creating User Keys, Programming
30970 @section Programming with Keyboard Macros
30971
30972 @noindent
30973 @kindex X
30974 @cindex Programming with keyboard macros
30975 @cindex Keyboard macros
30976 The easiest way to ``program'' the Emacs Calculator is to use standard
30977 keyboard macros. Press @w{@kbd{C-x (}} to begin recording a macro. From
30978 this point on, keystrokes you type will be saved away as well as
30979 performing their usual functions. Press @kbd{C-x )} to end recording.
30980 Press shift-@kbd{X} (or the standard Emacs key sequence @kbd{C-x e}) to
30981 execute your keyboard macro by replaying the recorded keystrokes.
30982 @xref{Keyboard Macros, , , emacs, the Emacs Manual}, for further
30983 information.
30984
30985 When you use @kbd{X} to invoke a keyboard macro, the entire macro is
30986 treated as a single command by the undo and trail features. The stack
30987 display buffer is not updated during macro execution, but is instead
30988 fixed up once the macro completes. Thus, commands defined with keyboard
30989 macros are convenient and efficient. The @kbd{C-x e} command, on the
30990 other hand, invokes the keyboard macro with no special treatment: Each
30991 command in the macro will record its own undo information and trail entry,
30992 and update the stack buffer accordingly. If your macro uses features
30993 outside of Calc's control to operate on the contents of the Calc stack
30994 buffer, or if it includes Undo, Redo, or last-arguments commands, you
30995 must use @kbd{C-x e} to make sure the buffer and undo list are up-to-date
30996 at all times. You could also consider using @kbd{K} (@code{calc-keep-args})
30997 instead of @kbd{M-@key{RET}} (@code{calc-last-args}).
30998
30999 Calc extends the standard Emacs keyboard macros in several ways.
31000 Keyboard macros can be used to create user-defined commands. Keyboard
31001 macros can include conditional and iteration structures, somewhat
31002 analogous to those provided by a traditional programmable calculator.
31003
31004 @menu
31005 * Naming Keyboard Macros::
31006 * Conditionals in Macros::
31007 * Loops in Macros::
31008 * Local Values in Macros::
31009 * Queries in Macros::
31010 @end menu
31011
31012 @node Naming Keyboard Macros, Conditionals in Macros, Keyboard Macros, Keyboard Macros
31013 @subsection Naming Keyboard Macros
31014
31015 @noindent
31016 @kindex Z K
31017 @pindex calc-user-define-kbd-macro
31018 Once you have defined a keyboard macro, you can bind it to a @kbd{z}
31019 key sequence with the @kbd{Z K} (@code{calc-user-define-kbd-macro}) command.
31020 This command prompts first for a key, then for a command name. For
31021 example, if you type @kbd{C-x ( n @key{TAB} n @key{TAB} C-x )} you will
31022 define a keyboard macro which negates the top two numbers on the stack
31023 (@key{TAB} swaps the top two stack elements). Now you can type
31024 @kbd{Z K n @key{RET}} to define this keyboard macro onto the @kbd{z n} key
31025 sequence. The default command name (if you answer the second prompt with
31026 just the @key{RET} key as in this example) will be something like
31027 @samp{calc-User-n}. The keyboard macro will now be available as both
31028 @kbd{z n} and @kbd{M-x calc-User-n}. You can backspace and enter a more
31029 descriptive command name if you wish.
31030
31031 Macros defined by @kbd{Z K} act like single commands; they are executed
31032 in the same way as by the @kbd{X} key. If you wish to define the macro
31033 as a standard no-frills Emacs macro (to be executed as if by @kbd{C-x e}),
31034 give a negative prefix argument to @kbd{Z K}.
31035
31036 Once you have bound your keyboard macro to a key, you can use
31037 @kbd{Z P} to register it permanently with Emacs. @xref{Creating User Keys}.
31038
31039 @cindex Keyboard macros, editing
31040 The @kbd{Z E} (@code{calc-user-define-edit}) command on a key that has
31041 been defined by a keyboard macro tries to use the @code{edmacro} package
31042 edit the macro. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing and update
31043 the definition stored on the key, or, to cancel the edit, kill the
31044 buffer with @kbd{C-x k}.
31045 The special characters @code{RET}, @code{LFD}, @code{TAB}, @code{SPC},
31046 @code{DEL}, and @code{NUL} must be entered as these three character
31047 sequences, written in all uppercase, as must the prefixes @code{C-} and
31048 @code{M-}. Spaces and line breaks are ignored. Other characters are
31049 copied verbatim into the keyboard macro. Basically, the notation is the
31050 same as is used in all of this manual's examples, except that the manual
31051 takes some liberties with spaces: When we say @kbd{' [1 2 3] @key{RET}},
31052 we take it for granted that it is clear we really mean
31053 @kbd{' [1 @key{SPC} 2 @key{SPC} 3] @key{RET}}.
31054
31055 @kindex C-x * m
31056 @pindex read-kbd-macro
31057 The @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro}) command reads an Emacs ``region''
31058 of spelled-out keystrokes and defines it as the current keyboard macro.
31059 It is a convenient way to define a keyboard macro that has been stored
31060 in a file, or to define a macro without executing it at the same time.
31061
31062 @node Conditionals in Macros, Loops in Macros, Naming Keyboard Macros, Keyboard Macros
31063 @subsection Conditionals in Keyboard Macros
31064
31065 @noindent
31066 @kindex Z [
31067 @kindex Z ]
31068 @pindex calc-kbd-if
31069 @pindex calc-kbd-else
31070 @pindex calc-kbd-else-if
31071 @pindex calc-kbd-end-if
31072 @cindex Conditional structures
31073 The @kbd{Z [} (@code{calc-kbd-if}) and @kbd{Z ]} (@code{calc-kbd-end-if})
31074 commands allow you to put simple tests in a keyboard macro. When Calc
31075 sees the @kbd{Z [}, it pops an object from the stack and, if the object is
31076 a non-zero value, continues executing keystrokes. But if the object is
31077 zero, or if it is not provably nonzero, Calc skips ahead to the matching
31078 @kbd{Z ]} keystroke. @xref{Logical Operations}, for a set of commands for
31079 performing tests which conveniently produce 1 for true and 0 for false.
31080
31081 For example, @kbd{@key{RET} 0 a < Z [ n Z ]} implements an absolute-value
31082 function in the form of a keyboard macro. This macro duplicates the
31083 number on the top of the stack, pushes zero and compares using @kbd{a <}
31084 (@code{calc-less-than}), then, if the number was less than zero,
31085 executes @kbd{n} (@code{calc-change-sign}). Otherwise, the change-sign
31086 command is skipped.
31087
31088 To program this macro, type @kbd{C-x (}, type the above sequence of
31089 keystrokes, then type @kbd{C-x )}. Note that the keystrokes will be
31090 executed while you are making the definition as well as when you later
31091 re-execute the macro by typing @kbd{X}. Thus you should make sure a
31092 suitable number is on the stack before defining the macro so that you
31093 don't get a stack-underflow error during the definition process.
31094
31095 Conditionals can be nested arbitrarily. However, there should be exactly
31096 one @kbd{Z ]} for each @kbd{Z [} in a keyboard macro.
31097
31098 @kindex Z :
31099 The @kbd{Z :} (@code{calc-kbd-else}) command allows you to choose between
31100 two keystroke sequences. The general format is @kbd{@var{cond} Z [
31101 @var{then-part} Z : @var{else-part} Z ]}. If @var{cond} is true
31102 (i.e., if the top of stack contains a non-zero number after @var{cond}
31103 has been executed), the @var{then-part} will be executed and the
31104 @var{else-part} will be skipped. Otherwise, the @var{then-part} will
31105 be skipped and the @var{else-part} will be executed.
31106
31107 @kindex Z |
31108 The @kbd{Z |} (@code{calc-kbd-else-if}) command allows you to choose
31109 between any number of alternatives. For example,
31110 @kbd{@var{cond1} Z [ @var{part1} Z : @var{cond2} Z | @var{part2} Z :
31111 @var{part3} Z ]} will execute @var{part1} if @var{cond1} is true,
31112 otherwise it will execute @var{part2} if @var{cond2} is true, otherwise
31113 it will execute @var{part3}.
31114
31115 More precisely, @kbd{Z [} pops a number and conditionally skips to the
31116 next matching @kbd{Z :} or @kbd{Z ]} key. @w{@kbd{Z ]}} has no effect when
31117 actually executed. @kbd{Z :} skips to the next matching @kbd{Z ]}.
31118 @kbd{Z |} pops a number and conditionally skips to the next matching
31119 @kbd{Z :} or @kbd{Z ]}; thus, @kbd{Z [} and @kbd{Z |} are functionally
31120 equivalent except that @kbd{Z [} participates in nesting but @kbd{Z |}
31121 does not.
31122
31123 Calc's conditional and looping constructs work by scanning the
31124 keyboard macro for occurrences of character sequences like @samp{Z:}
31125 and @samp{Z]}. One side-effect of this is that if you use these
31126 constructs you must be careful that these character pairs do not
31127 occur by accident in other parts of the macros. Since Calc rarely
31128 uses shift-@kbd{Z} for any purpose except as a prefix character, this
31129 is not likely to be a problem. Another side-effect is that it will
31130 not work to define your own custom key bindings for these commands.
31131 Only the standard shift-@kbd{Z} bindings will work correctly.
31132
31133 @kindex Z C-g
31134 If Calc gets stuck while skipping characters during the definition of a
31135 macro, type @kbd{Z C-g} to cancel the definition. (Typing plain @kbd{C-g}
31136 actually adds a @kbd{C-g} keystroke to the macro.)
31137
31138 @node Loops in Macros, Local Values in Macros, Conditionals in Macros, Keyboard Macros
31139 @subsection Loops in Keyboard Macros
31140
31141 @noindent
31142 @kindex Z <
31143 @kindex Z >
31144 @pindex calc-kbd-repeat
31145 @pindex calc-kbd-end-repeat
31146 @cindex Looping structures
31147 @cindex Iterative structures
31148 The @kbd{Z <} (@code{calc-kbd-repeat}) and @kbd{Z >}
31149 (@code{calc-kbd-end-repeat}) commands pop a number from the stack,
31150 which must be an integer, then repeat the keystrokes between the brackets
31151 the specified number of times. If the integer is zero or negative, the
31152 body is skipped altogether. For example, @kbd{1 @key{TAB} Z < 2 * Z >}
31153 computes two to a nonnegative integer power. First, we push 1 on the
31154 stack and then swap the integer argument back to the top. The @kbd{Z <}
31155 pops that argument leaving the 1 back on top of the stack. Then, we
31156 repeat a multiply-by-two step however many times.
31157
31158 Once again, the keyboard macro is executed as it is being entered.
31159 In this case it is especially important to set up reasonable initial
31160 conditions before making the definition: Suppose the integer 1000 just
31161 happened to be sitting on the stack before we typed the above definition!
31162 Another approach is to enter a harmless dummy definition for the macro,
31163 then go back and edit in the real one with a @kbd{Z E} command. Yet
31164 another approach is to type the macro as written-out keystroke names
31165 in a buffer, then use @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro}) to read the
31166 macro.
31167
31168 @kindex Z /
31169 @pindex calc-break
31170 The @kbd{Z /} (@code{calc-kbd-break}) command allows you to break out
31171 of a keyboard macro loop prematurely. It pops an object from the stack;
31172 if that object is true (a non-zero number), control jumps out of the
31173 innermost enclosing @kbd{Z <} @dots{} @kbd{Z >} loop and continues
31174 after the @kbd{Z >}. If the object is false, the @kbd{Z /} has no
31175 effect. Thus @kbd{@var{cond} Z /} is similar to @samp{if (@var{cond}) break;}
31176 in the C language.
31177
31178 @kindex Z (
31179 @kindex Z )
31180 @pindex calc-kbd-for
31181 @pindex calc-kbd-end-for
31182 The @kbd{Z (} (@code{calc-kbd-for}) and @kbd{Z )} (@code{calc-kbd-end-for})
31183 commands are similar to @kbd{Z <} and @kbd{Z >}, except that they make the
31184 value of the counter available inside the loop. The general layout is
31185 @kbd{@var{init} @var{final} Z ( @var{body} @var{step} Z )}. The @kbd{Z (}
31186 command pops initial and final values from the stack. It then creates
31187 a temporary internal counter and initializes it with the value @var{init}.
31188 The @kbd{Z (} command then repeatedly pushes the counter value onto the
31189 stack and executes @var{body} and @var{step}, adding @var{step} to the
31190 counter each time until the loop finishes.
31191
31192 @cindex Summations (by keyboard macros)
31193 By default, the loop finishes when the counter becomes greater than (or
31194 less than) @var{final}, assuming @var{initial} is less than (greater
31195 than) @var{final}. If @var{initial} is equal to @var{final}, the body
31196 executes exactly once. The body of the loop always executes at least
31197 once. For example, @kbd{0 1 10 Z ( 2 ^ + 1 Z )} computes the sum of the
31198 squares of the integers from 1 to 10, in steps of 1.
31199
31200 If you give a numeric prefix argument of 1 to @kbd{Z (}, the loop is
31201 forced to use upward-counting conventions. In this case, if @var{initial}
31202 is greater than @var{final} the body will not be executed at all.
31203 Note that @var{step} may still be negative in this loop; the prefix
31204 argument merely constrains the loop-finished test. Likewise, a prefix
31205 argument of @mathit{-1} forces downward-counting conventions.
31206
31207 @kindex Z @{
31208 @kindex Z @}
31209 @pindex calc-kbd-loop
31210 @pindex calc-kbd-end-loop
31211 The @kbd{Z @{} (@code{calc-kbd-loop}) and @kbd{Z @}}
31212 (@code{calc-kbd-end-loop}) commands are similar to @kbd{Z <} and
31213 @kbd{Z >}, except that they do not pop a count from the stack---they
31214 effectively create an infinite loop. Every @kbd{Z @{} @dots{} @kbd{Z @}}
31215 loop ought to include at least one @kbd{Z /} to make sure the loop
31216 doesn't run forever. (If any error message occurs which causes Emacs
31217 to beep, the keyboard macro will also be halted; this is a standard
31218 feature of Emacs. You can also generally press @kbd{C-g} to halt a
31219 running keyboard macro, although not all versions of Unix support
31220 this feature.)
31221
31222 The conditional and looping constructs are not actually tied to
31223 keyboard macros, but they are most often used in that context.
31224 For example, the keystrokes @kbd{10 Z < 23 @key{RET} Z >} push
31225 ten copies of 23 onto the stack. This can be typed ``live'' just
31226 as easily as in a macro definition.
31227
31228 @xref{Conditionals in Macros}, for some additional notes about
31229 conditional and looping commands.
31230
31231 @node Local Values in Macros, Queries in Macros, Loops in Macros, Keyboard Macros
31232 @subsection Local Values in Macros
31233
31234 @noindent
31235 @cindex Local variables
31236 @cindex Restoring saved modes
31237 Keyboard macros sometimes want to operate under known conditions
31238 without affecting surrounding conditions. For example, a keyboard
31239 macro may wish to turn on Fraction mode, or set a particular
31240 precision, independent of the user's normal setting for those
31241 modes.
31242
31243 @kindex Z `
31244 @kindex Z '
31245 @pindex calc-kbd-push
31246 @pindex calc-kbd-pop
31247 Macros also sometimes need to use local variables. Assignments to
31248 local variables inside the macro should not affect any variables
31249 outside the macro. The @kbd{Z `} (@code{calc-kbd-push}) and @kbd{Z '}
31250 (@code{calc-kbd-pop}) commands give you both of these capabilities.
31251
31252 When you type @kbd{Z `} (with a backquote or accent grave character),
31253 the values of various mode settings are saved away. The ten ``quick''
31254 variables @code{q0} through @code{q9} are also saved. When
31255 you type @w{@kbd{Z '}} (with an apostrophe), these values are restored.
31256 Pairs of @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '} commands may be nested.
31257
31258 If a keyboard macro halts due to an error in between a @kbd{Z `} and
31259 a @kbd{Z '}, the saved values will be restored correctly even though
31260 the macro never reaches the @kbd{Z '} command. Thus you can use
31261 @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '} without having to worry about what happens
31262 in exceptional conditions.
31263
31264 If you type @kbd{Z `} ``live'' (not in a keyboard macro), Calc puts
31265 you into a ``recursive edit.'' You can tell you are in a recursive
31266 edit because there will be extra square brackets in the mode line,
31267 as in @samp{[(Calculator)]}. These brackets will go away when you
31268 type the matching @kbd{Z '} command. The modes and quick variables
31269 will be saved and restored in just the same way as if actual keyboard
31270 macros were involved.
31271
31272 The modes saved by @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '} are the current precision
31273 and binary word size, the angular mode (Deg, Rad, or HMS), the
31274 simplification mode, Algebraic mode, Symbolic mode, Infinite mode,
31275 Matrix or Scalar mode, Fraction mode, and the current complex mode
31276 (Polar or Rectangular). The ten ``quick'' variables' values (or lack
31277 thereof) are also saved.
31278
31279 Most mode-setting commands act as toggles, but with a numeric prefix
31280 they force the mode either on (positive prefix) or off (negative
31281 or zero prefix). Since you don't know what the environment might
31282 be when you invoke your macro, it's best to use prefix arguments
31283 for all mode-setting commands inside the macro.
31284
31285 In fact, @kbd{C-u Z `} is like @kbd{Z `} except that it sets the modes
31286 listed above to their default values. As usual, the matching @kbd{Z '}
31287 will restore the modes to their settings from before the @kbd{C-u Z `}.
31288 Also, @w{@kbd{Z `}} with a negative prefix argument resets the algebraic mode
31289 to its default (off) but leaves the other modes the same as they were
31290 outside the construct.
31291
31292 The contents of the stack and trail, values of non-quick variables, and
31293 other settings such as the language mode and the various display modes,
31294 are @emph{not} affected by @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '}.
31295
31296 @node Queries in Macros, , Local Values in Macros, Keyboard Macros
31297 @subsection Queries in Keyboard Macros
31298
31299 @c @noindent
31300 @c @kindex Z =
31301 @c @pindex calc-kbd-report
31302 @c The @kbd{Z =} (@code{calc-kbd-report}) command displays an informative
31303 @c message including the value on the top of the stack. You are prompted
31304 @c to enter a string. That string, along with the top-of-stack value,
31305 @c is displayed unless @kbd{m w} (@code{calc-working}) has been used
31306 @c to turn such messages off.
31307
31308 @noindent
31309 @kindex Z #
31310 @pindex calc-kbd-query
31311 The @kbd{Z #} (@code{calc-kbd-query}) command prompts for an algebraic
31312 entry which takes its input from the keyboard, even during macro
31313 execution. All the normal conventions of algebraic input, including the
31314 use of @kbd{$} characters, are supported. The prompt message itself is
31315 taken from the top of the stack, and so must be entered (as a string)
31316 before the @kbd{Z #} command. (Recall, as a string it can be entered by
31317 pressing the @kbd{"} key and will appear as a vector when it is put on
31318 the stack. The prompt message is only put on the stack to provide a
31319 prompt for the @kbd{Z #} command; it will not play any role in any
31320 subsequent calculations.) This command allows your keyboard macros to
31321 accept numbers or formulas as interactive input.
31322
31323 As an example,
31324 @kbd{2 @key{RET} "Power: " @key{RET} Z # 3 @key{RET} ^} will prompt for
31325 input with ``Power: '' in the minibuffer, then return 2 to the provided
31326 power. (The response to the prompt that's given, 3 in this example,
31327 will not be part of the macro.)
31328
31329 @xref{Keyboard Macro Query, , , emacs, the Emacs Manual}, for a description of
31330 @kbd{C-x q} (@code{kbd-macro-query}), the standard Emacs way to accept
31331 keyboard input during a keyboard macro. In particular, you can use
31332 @kbd{C-x q} to enter a recursive edit, which allows the user to perform
31333 any Calculator operations interactively before pressing @kbd{C-M-c} to
31334 return control to the keyboard macro.
31335
31336 @node Invocation Macros, Algebraic Definitions, Keyboard Macros, Programming
31337 @section Invocation Macros
31338
31339 @kindex C-x * z
31340 @kindex Z I
31341 @pindex calc-user-invocation
31342 @pindex calc-user-define-invocation
31343 Calc provides one special keyboard macro, called up by @kbd{C-x * z}
31344 (@code{calc-user-invocation}), that is intended to allow you to define
31345 your own special way of starting Calc. To define this ``invocation
31346 macro,'' create the macro in the usual way with @kbd{C-x (} and
31347 @kbd{C-x )}, then type @kbd{Z I} (@code{calc-user-define-invocation}).
31348 There is only one invocation macro, so you don't need to type any
31349 additional letters after @kbd{Z I}. From now on, you can type
31350 @kbd{C-x * z} at any time to execute your invocation macro.
31351
31352 For example, suppose you find yourself often grabbing rectangles of
31353 numbers into Calc and multiplying their columns. You can do this
31354 by typing @kbd{C-x * r} to grab, and @kbd{V R : *} to multiply columns.
31355 To make this into an invocation macro, just type @kbd{C-x ( C-x * r
31356 V R : * C-x )}, then @kbd{Z I}. Then, to multiply a rectangle of data,
31357 just mark the data in its buffer in the usual way and type @kbd{C-x * z}.
31358
31359 Invocation macros are treated like regular Emacs keyboard macros;
31360 all the special features described above for @kbd{Z K}-style macros
31361 do not apply. @kbd{C-x * z} is just like @kbd{C-x e}, except that it
31362 uses the macro that was last stored by @kbd{Z I}. (In fact, the
31363 macro does not even have to have anything to do with Calc!)
31364
31365 The @kbd{m m} command saves the last invocation macro defined by
31366 @kbd{Z I} along with all the other Calc mode settings.
31367 @xref{General Mode Commands}.
31368
31369 @node Algebraic Definitions, Lisp Definitions, Invocation Macros, Programming
31370 @section Programming with Formulas
31371
31372 @noindent
31373 @kindex Z F
31374 @pindex calc-user-define-formula
31375 @cindex Programming with algebraic formulas
31376 Another way to create a new Calculator command uses algebraic formulas.
31377 The @kbd{Z F} (@code{calc-user-define-formula}) command stores the
31378 formula at the top of the stack as the definition for a key. This
31379 command prompts for five things: The key, the command name, the function
31380 name, the argument list, and the behavior of the command when given
31381 non-numeric arguments.
31382
31383 For example, suppose we type @kbd{' a+2b @key{RET}} to push the formula
31384 @samp{a + 2*b} onto the stack. We now type @kbd{Z F m} to define this
31385 formula on the @kbd{z m} key sequence. The next prompt is for a command
31386 name, beginning with @samp{calc-}, which should be the long (@kbd{M-x}) form
31387 for the new command. If you simply press @key{RET}, a default name like
31388 @code{calc-User-m} will be constructed. In our example, suppose we enter
31389 @kbd{spam @key{RET}} to define the new command as @code{calc-spam}.
31390
31391 If you want to give the formula a long-style name only, you can press
31392 @key{SPC} or @key{RET} when asked which single key to use. For example
31393 @kbd{Z F @key{RET} spam @key{RET}} defines the new command as
31394 @kbd{M-x calc-spam}, with no keyboard equivalent.
31395
31396 The third prompt is for an algebraic function name. The default is to
31397 use the same name as the command name but without the @samp{calc-}
31398 prefix. (If this is of the form @samp{User-m}, the hyphen is removed so
31399 it won't be taken for a minus sign in algebraic formulas.)
31400 This is the name you will use if you want to enter your
31401 new function in an algebraic formula. Suppose we enter @kbd{yow @key{RET}}.
31402 Then the new function can be invoked by pushing two numbers on the
31403 stack and typing @kbd{z m} or @kbd{x spam}, or by entering the algebraic
31404 formula @samp{yow(x,y)}.
31405
31406 The fourth prompt is for the function's argument list. This is used to
31407 associate values on the stack with the variables that appear in the formula.
31408 The default is a list of all variables which appear in the formula, sorted
31409 into alphabetical order. In our case, the default would be @samp{(a b)}.
31410 This means that, when the user types @kbd{z m}, the Calculator will remove
31411 two numbers from the stack, substitute these numbers for @samp{a} and
31412 @samp{b} (respectively) in the formula, then simplify the formula and
31413 push the result on the stack. In other words, @kbd{10 @key{RET} 100 z m}
31414 would replace the 10 and 100 on the stack with the number 210, which is
31415 @expr{a + 2 b} with @expr{a=10} and @expr{b=100}. Likewise, the formula
31416 @samp{yow(10, 100)} will be evaluated by substituting @expr{a=10} and
31417 @expr{b=100} in the definition.
31418
31419 You can rearrange the order of the names before pressing @key{RET} to
31420 control which stack positions go to which variables in the formula. If
31421 you remove a variable from the argument list, that variable will be left
31422 in symbolic form by the command. Thus using an argument list of @samp{(b)}
31423 for our function would cause @kbd{10 z m} to replace the 10 on the stack
31424 with the formula @samp{a + 20}. If we had used an argument list of
31425 @samp{(b a)}, the result with inputs 10 and 100 would have been 120.
31426
31427 You can also put a nameless function on the stack instead of just a
31428 formula, as in @samp{<a, b : a + 2 b>}. @xref{Specifying Operators}.
31429 In this example, the command will be defined by the formula @samp{a + 2 b}
31430 using the argument list @samp{(a b)}.
31431
31432 The final prompt is a y-or-n question concerning what to do if symbolic
31433 arguments are given to your function. If you answer @kbd{y}, then
31434 executing @kbd{z m} (using the original argument list @samp{(a b)}) with
31435 arguments @expr{10} and @expr{x} will leave the function in symbolic
31436 form, i.e., @samp{yow(10,x)}. On the other hand, if you answer @kbd{n},
31437 then the formula will always be expanded, even for non-constant
31438 arguments: @samp{10 + 2 x}. If you never plan to feed algebraic
31439 formulas to your new function, it doesn't matter how you answer this
31440 question.
31441
31442 If you answered @kbd{y} to this question you can still cause a function
31443 call to be expanded by typing @kbd{a "} (@code{calc-expand-formula}).
31444 Also, Calc will expand the function if necessary when you take a
31445 derivative or integral or solve an equation involving the function.
31446
31447 @kindex Z G
31448 @pindex calc-get-user-defn
31449 Once you have defined a formula on a key, you can retrieve this formula
31450 with the @kbd{Z G} (@code{calc-user-define-get-defn}) command. Press a
31451 key, and this command pushes the formula that was used to define that
31452 key onto the stack. Actually, it pushes a nameless function that
31453 specifies both the argument list and the defining formula. You will get
31454 an error message if the key is undefined, or if the key was not defined
31455 by a @kbd{Z F} command.
31456
31457 The @kbd{Z E} (@code{calc-user-define-edit}) command on a key that has
31458 been defined by a formula uses a variant of the @code{calc-edit} command
31459 to edit the defining formula. Press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing and
31460 store the new formula back in the definition, or kill the buffer with
31461 @kbd{C-x k} to
31462 cancel the edit. (The argument list and other properties of the
31463 definition are unchanged; to adjust the argument list, you can use
31464 @kbd{Z G} to grab the function onto the stack, edit with @kbd{`}, and
31465 then re-execute the @kbd{Z F} command.)
31466
31467 As usual, the @kbd{Z P} command records your definition permanently.
31468 In this case it will permanently record all three of the relevant
31469 definitions: the key, the command, and the function.
31470
31471 You may find it useful to turn off the default simplifications with
31472 @kbd{m O} (@code{calc-no-simplify-mode}) when entering a formula to be
31473 used as a function definition. For example, the formula @samp{deriv(a^2,v)}
31474 which might be used to define a new function @samp{dsqr(a,v)} will be
31475 ``simplified'' to 0 immediately upon entry since @code{deriv} considers
31476 @expr{a} to be constant with respect to @expr{v}. Turning off
31477 default simplifications cures this problem: The definition will be stored
31478 in symbolic form without ever activating the @code{deriv} function. Press
31479 @kbd{m D} to turn the default simplifications back on afterwards.
31480
31481 @node Lisp Definitions, , Algebraic Definitions, Programming
31482 @section Programming with Lisp
31483
31484 @noindent
31485 The Calculator can be programmed quite extensively in Lisp. All you
31486 do is write a normal Lisp function definition, but with @code{defmath}
31487 in place of @code{defun}. This has the same form as @code{defun}, but it
31488 automagically replaces calls to standard Lisp functions like @code{+} and
31489 @code{zerop} with calls to the corresponding functions in Calc's own library.
31490 Thus you can write natural-looking Lisp code which operates on all of the
31491 standard Calculator data types. You can then use @kbd{Z D} if you wish to
31492 bind your new command to a @kbd{z}-prefix key sequence. The @kbd{Z E} command
31493 will not edit a Lisp-based definition.
31494
31495 Emacs Lisp is described in the GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual. This section
31496 assumes a familiarity with Lisp programming concepts; if you do not know
31497 Lisp, you may find keyboard macros or rewrite rules to be an easier way
31498 to program the Calculator.
31499
31500 This section first discusses ways to write commands, functions, or
31501 small programs to be executed inside of Calc. Then it discusses how
31502 your own separate programs are able to call Calc from the outside.
31503 Finally, there is a list of internal Calc functions and data structures
31504 for the true Lisp enthusiast.
31505
31506 @menu
31507 * Defining Functions::
31508 * Defining Simple Commands::
31509 * Defining Stack Commands::
31510 * Argument Qualifiers::
31511 * Example Definitions::
31512
31513 * Calling Calc from Your Programs::
31514 * Internals::
31515 @end menu
31516
31517 @node Defining Functions, Defining Simple Commands, Lisp Definitions, Lisp Definitions
31518 @subsection Defining New Functions
31519
31520 @noindent
31521 @findex defmath
31522 The @code{defmath} function (actually a Lisp macro) is like @code{defun}
31523 except that code in the body of the definition can make use of the full
31524 range of Calculator data types. The prefix @samp{calcFunc-} is added
31525 to the specified name to get the actual Lisp function name. As a simple
31526 example,
31527
31528 @example
31529 (defmath myfact (n)
31530 (if (> n 0)
31531 (* n (myfact (1- n)))
31532 1))
31533 @end example
31534
31535 @noindent
31536 This actually expands to the code,
31537
31538 @example
31539 (defun calcFunc-myfact (n)
31540 (if (math-posp n)
31541 (math-mul n (calcFunc-myfact (math-add n -1)))
31542 1))
31543 @end example
31544
31545 @noindent
31546 This function can be used in algebraic expressions, e.g., @samp{myfact(5)}.
31547
31548 The @samp{myfact} function as it is defined above has the bug that an
31549 expression @samp{myfact(a+b)} will be simplified to 1 because the
31550 formula @samp{a+b} is not considered to be @code{posp}. A robust
31551 factorial function would be written along the following lines:
31552
31553 @smallexample
31554 (defmath myfact (n)
31555 (if (> n 0)
31556 (* n (myfact (1- n)))
31557 (if (= n 0)
31558 1
31559 nil))) ; this could be simplified as: (and (= n 0) 1)
31560 @end smallexample
31561
31562 If a function returns @code{nil}, it is left unsimplified by the Calculator
31563 (except that its arguments will be simplified). Thus, @samp{myfact(a+1+2)}
31564 will be simplified to @samp{myfact(a+3)} but no further. Beware that every
31565 time the Calculator reexamines this formula it will attempt to resimplify
31566 it, so your function ought to detect the returning-@code{nil} case as
31567 efficiently as possible.
31568
31569 The following standard Lisp functions are treated by @code{defmath}:
31570 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}, @code{^} or
31571 @code{expt}, @code{=}, @code{<}, @code{>}, @code{<=}, @code{>=},
31572 @code{/=}, @code{1+}, @code{1-}, @code{logand}, @code{logior}, @code{logxor},
31573 @code{logandc2}, @code{lognot}. Also, @code{~=} is an abbreviation for
31574 @code{math-nearly-equal}, which is useful in implementing Taylor series.
31575
31576 For other functions @var{func}, if a function by the name
31577 @samp{calcFunc-@var{func}} exists it is used, otherwise if a function by the
31578 name @samp{math-@var{func}} exists it is used, otherwise if @var{func} itself
31579 is defined as a function it is used, otherwise @samp{calcFunc-@var{func}} is
31580 used on the assumption that this is a to-be-defined math function. Also, if
31581 the function name is quoted as in @samp{('integerp a)} the function name is
31582 always used exactly as written (but not quoted).
31583
31584 Variable names have @samp{var-} prepended to them unless they appear in
31585 the function's argument list or in an enclosing @code{let}, @code{let*},
31586 @code{for}, or @code{foreach} form,
31587 or their names already contain a @samp{-} character. Thus a reference to
31588 @samp{foo} is the same as a reference to @samp{var-foo}.
31589
31590 A few other Lisp extensions are available in @code{defmath} definitions:
31591
31592 @itemize @bullet
31593 @item
31594 The @code{elt} function accepts any number of index variables.
31595 Note that Calc vectors are stored as Lisp lists whose first
31596 element is the symbol @code{vec}; thus, @samp{(elt v 2)} yields
31597 the second element of vector @code{v}, and @samp{(elt m i j)}
31598 yields one element of a Calc matrix.
31599
31600 @item
31601 The @code{setq} function has been extended to act like the Common
31602 Lisp @code{setf} function. (The name @code{setf} is recognized as
31603 a synonym of @code{setq}.) Specifically, the first argument of
31604 @code{setq} can be an @code{nth}, @code{elt}, @code{car}, or @code{cdr} form,
31605 in which case the effect is to store into the specified
31606 element of a list. Thus, @samp{(setq (elt m i j) x)} stores @expr{x}
31607 into one element of a matrix.
31608
31609 @item
31610 A @code{for} looping construct is available. For example,
31611 @samp{(for ((i 0 10)) body)} executes @code{body} once for each
31612 binding of @expr{i} from zero to 10. This is like a @code{let}
31613 form in that @expr{i} is temporarily bound to the loop count
31614 without disturbing its value outside the @code{for} construct.
31615 Nested loops, as in @samp{(for ((i 0 10) (j 0 (1- i) 2)) body)},
31616 are also available. For each value of @expr{i} from zero to 10,
31617 @expr{j} counts from 0 to @expr{i-1} in steps of two. Note that
31618 @code{for} has the same general outline as @code{let*}, except
31619 that each element of the header is a list of three or four
31620 things, not just two.
31621
31622 @item
31623 The @code{foreach} construct loops over elements of a list.
31624 For example, @samp{(foreach ((x (cdr v))) body)} executes
31625 @code{body} with @expr{x} bound to each element of Calc vector
31626 @expr{v} in turn. The purpose of @code{cdr} here is to skip over
31627 the initial @code{vec} symbol in the vector.
31628
31629 @item
31630 The @code{break} function breaks out of the innermost enclosing
31631 @code{while}, @code{for}, or @code{foreach} loop. If given a
31632 value, as in @samp{(break x)}, this value is returned by the
31633 loop. (Lisp loops otherwise always return @code{nil}.)
31634
31635 @item
31636 The @code{return} function prematurely returns from the enclosing
31637 function. For example, @samp{(return (+ x y))} returns @expr{x+y}
31638 as the value of a function. You can use @code{return} anywhere
31639 inside the body of the function.
31640 @end itemize
31641
31642 Non-integer numbers (and extremely large integers) cannot be included
31643 directly into a @code{defmath} definition. This is because the Lisp
31644 reader will fail to parse them long before @code{defmath} ever gets control.
31645 Instead, use the notation, @samp{:"3.1415"}. In fact, any algebraic
31646 formula can go between the quotes. For example,
31647
31648 @smallexample
31649 (defmath sqexp (x) ; sqexp(x) == sqrt(exp(x)) == exp(x*0.5)
31650 (and (numberp x)
31651 (exp :"x * 0.5")))
31652 @end smallexample
31653
31654 expands to
31655
31656 @smallexample
31657 (defun calcFunc-sqexp (x)
31658 (and (math-numberp x)
31659 (calcFunc-exp (math-mul x '(float 5 -1)))))
31660 @end smallexample
31661
31662 Note the use of @code{numberp} as a guard to ensure that the argument is
31663 a number first, returning @code{nil} if not. The exponential function
31664 could itself have been included in the expression, if we had preferred:
31665 @samp{:"exp(x * 0.5)"}. As another example, the multiplication-and-recursion
31666 step of @code{myfact} could have been written
31667
31668 @example
31669 :"n * myfact(n-1)"
31670 @end example
31671
31672 A good place to put your @code{defmath} commands is your Calc init file
31673 (the file given by @code{calc-settings-file}, typically
31674 @file{~/.calc.el}), which will not be loaded until Calc starts.
31675 If a file named @file{.emacs} exists in your home directory, Emacs reads
31676 and executes the Lisp forms in this file as it starts up. While it may
31677 seem reasonable to put your favorite @code{defmath} commands there,
31678 this has the unfortunate side-effect that parts of the Calculator must be
31679 loaded in to process the @code{defmath} commands whether or not you will
31680 actually use the Calculator! If you want to put the @code{defmath}
31681 commands there (for example, if you redefine @code{calc-settings-file}
31682 to be @file{.emacs}), a better effect can be had by writing
31683
31684 @example
31685 (put 'calc-define 'thing '(progn
31686 (defmath ... )
31687 (defmath ... )
31688 ))
31689 @end example
31690
31691 @noindent
31692 @vindex calc-define
31693 The @code{put} function adds a @dfn{property} to a symbol. Each Lisp
31694 symbol has a list of properties associated with it. Here we add a
31695 property with a name of @code{thing} and a @samp{(progn ...)} form as
31696 its value. When Calc starts up, and at the start of every Calc command,
31697 the property list for the symbol @code{calc-define} is checked and the
31698 values of any properties found are evaluated as Lisp forms. The
31699 properties are removed as they are evaluated. The property names
31700 (like @code{thing}) are not used; you should choose something like the
31701 name of your project so as not to conflict with other properties.
31702
31703 The net effect is that you can put the above code in your @file{.emacs}
31704 file and it will not be executed until Calc is loaded. Or, you can put
31705 that same code in another file which you load by hand either before or
31706 after Calc itself is loaded.
31707
31708 The properties of @code{calc-define} are evaluated in the same order
31709 that they were added. They can assume that the Calc modules @file{calc.el},
31710 @file{calc-ext.el}, and @file{calc-macs.el} have been fully loaded, and
31711 that the @samp{*Calculator*} buffer will be the current buffer.
31712
31713 If your @code{calc-define} property only defines algebraic functions,
31714 you can be sure that it will have been evaluated before Calc tries to
31715 call your function, even if the file defining the property is loaded
31716 after Calc is loaded. But if the property defines commands or key
31717 sequences, it may not be evaluated soon enough. (Suppose it defines the
31718 new command @code{tweak-calc}; the user can load your file, then type
31719 @kbd{M-x tweak-calc} before Calc has had chance to do anything.) To
31720 protect against this situation, you can put
31721
31722 @example
31723 (run-hooks 'calc-check-defines)
31724 @end example
31725
31726 @findex calc-check-defines
31727 @noindent
31728 at the end of your file. The @code{calc-check-defines} function is what
31729 looks for and evaluates properties on @code{calc-define}; @code{run-hooks}
31730 has the advantage that it is quietly ignored if @code{calc-check-defines}
31731 is not yet defined because Calc has not yet been loaded.
31732
31733 Examples of things that ought to be enclosed in a @code{calc-define}
31734 property are @code{defmath} calls, @code{define-key} calls that modify
31735 the Calc key map, and any calls that redefine things defined inside Calc.
31736 Ordinary @code{defun}s need not be enclosed with @code{calc-define}.
31737
31738 @node Defining Simple Commands, Defining Stack Commands, Defining Functions, Lisp Definitions
31739 @subsection Defining New Simple Commands
31740
31741 @noindent
31742 @findex interactive
31743 If a @code{defmath} form contains an @code{interactive} clause, it defines
31744 a Calculator command. Actually such a @code{defmath} results in @emph{two}
31745 function definitions: One, a @samp{calcFunc-} function as was just described,
31746 with the @code{interactive} clause removed. Two, a @samp{calc-} function
31747 with a suitable @code{interactive} clause and some sort of wrapper to make
31748 the command work in the Calc environment.
31749
31750 In the simple case, the @code{interactive} clause has the same form as
31751 for normal Emacs Lisp commands:
31752
31753 @smallexample
31754 (defmath increase-precision (delta)
31755 "Increase precision by DELTA." ; This is the "documentation string"
31756 (interactive "p") ; Register this as a M-x-able command
31757 (setq calc-internal-prec (+ calc-internal-prec delta)))
31758 @end smallexample
31759
31760 This expands to the pair of definitions,
31761
31762 @smallexample
31763 (defun calc-increase-precision (delta)
31764 "Increase precision by DELTA."
31765 (interactive "p")
31766 (calc-wrapper
31767 (setq calc-internal-prec (math-add calc-internal-prec delta))))
31768
31769 (defun calcFunc-increase-precision (delta)
31770 "Increase precision by DELTA."
31771 (setq calc-internal-prec (math-add calc-internal-prec delta)))
31772 @end smallexample
31773
31774 @noindent
31775 where in this case the latter function would never really be used! Note
31776 that since the Calculator stores small integers as plain Lisp integers,
31777 the @code{math-add} function will work just as well as the native
31778 @code{+} even when the intent is to operate on native Lisp integers.
31779
31780 @findex calc-wrapper
31781 The @samp{calc-wrapper} call invokes a macro which surrounds the body of
31782 the function with code that looks roughly like this:
31783
31784 @smallexample
31785 (let ((calc-command-flags nil))
31786 (unwind-protect
31787 (save-excursion
31788 (calc-select-buffer)
31789 @emph{body of function}
31790 @emph{renumber stack}
31791 @emph{clear} Working @emph{message})
31792 @emph{realign cursor and window}
31793 @emph{clear Inverse, Hyperbolic, and Keep Args flags}
31794 @emph{update Emacs mode line}))
31795 @end smallexample
31796
31797 @findex calc-select-buffer
31798 The @code{calc-select-buffer} function selects the @samp{*Calculator*}
31799 buffer if necessary, say, because the command was invoked from inside
31800 the @samp{*Calc Trail*} window.
31801
31802 @findex calc-set-command-flag
31803 You can call, for example, @code{(calc-set-command-flag 'no-align)} to
31804 set the above-mentioned command flags. Calc routines recognize the
31805 following command flags:
31806
31807 @table @code
31808 @item renum-stack
31809 Stack line numbers @samp{1:}, @samp{2:}, and so on must be renumbered
31810 after this command completes. This is set by routines like
31811 @code{calc-push}.
31812
31813 @item clear-message
31814 Calc should call @samp{(message "")} if this command completes normally
31815 (to clear a ``Working@dots{}'' message out of the echo area).
31816
31817 @item no-align
31818 Do not move the cursor back to the @samp{.} top-of-stack marker.
31819
31820 @item position-point
31821 Use the variables @code{calc-position-point-line} and
31822 @code{calc-position-point-column} to position the cursor after
31823 this command finishes.
31824
31825 @item keep-flags
31826 Do not clear @code{calc-inverse-flag}, @code{calc-hyperbolic-flag},
31827 and @code{calc-keep-args-flag} at the end of this command.
31828
31829 @item do-edit
31830 Switch to buffer @samp{*Calc Edit*} after this command.
31831
31832 @item hold-trail
31833 Do not move trail pointer to end of trail when something is recorded
31834 there.
31835 @end table
31836
31837 @kindex Y
31838 @kindex Y ?
31839 @vindex calc-Y-help-msgs
31840 Calc reserves a special prefix key, shift-@kbd{Y}, for user-written
31841 extensions to Calc. There are no built-in commands that work with
31842 this prefix key; you must call @code{define-key} from Lisp (probably
31843 from inside a @code{calc-define} property) to add to it. Initially only
31844 @kbd{Y ?} is defined; it takes help messages from a list of strings
31845 (initially @code{nil}) in the variable @code{calc-Y-help-msgs}. All
31846 other undefined keys except for @kbd{Y} are reserved for use by
31847 future versions of Calc.
31848
31849 If you are writing a Calc enhancement which you expect to give to
31850 others, it is best to minimize the number of @kbd{Y}-key sequences
31851 you use. In fact, if you have more than one key sequence you should
31852 consider defining three-key sequences with a @kbd{Y}, then a key that
31853 stands for your package, then a third key for the particular command
31854 within your package.
31855
31856 Users may wish to install several Calc enhancements, and it is possible
31857 that several enhancements will choose to use the same key. In the
31858 example below, a variable @code{inc-prec-base-key} has been defined
31859 to contain the key that identifies the @code{inc-prec} package. Its
31860 value is initially @code{"P"}, but a user can change this variable
31861 if necessary without having to modify the file.
31862
31863 Here is a complete file, @file{inc-prec.el}, which makes a @kbd{Y P I}
31864 command that increases the precision, and a @kbd{Y P D} command that
31865 decreases the precision.
31866
31867 @smallexample
31868 ;;; Increase and decrease Calc precision. Dave Gillespie, 5/31/91.
31869 ;; (Include copyright or copyleft stuff here.)
31870
31871 (defvar inc-prec-base-key "P"
31872 "Base key for inc-prec.el commands.")
31873
31874 (put 'calc-define 'inc-prec '(progn
31875
31876 (define-key calc-mode-map (format "Y%sI" inc-prec-base-key)
31877 'increase-precision)
31878 (define-key calc-mode-map (format "Y%sD" inc-prec-base-key)
31879 'decrease-precision)
31880
31881 (setq calc-Y-help-msgs
31882 (cons (format "%s + Inc-prec, Dec-prec" inc-prec-base-key)
31883 calc-Y-help-msgs))
31884
31885 (defmath increase-precision (delta)
31886 "Increase precision by DELTA."
31887 (interactive "p")
31888 (setq calc-internal-prec (+ calc-internal-prec delta)))
31889
31890 (defmath decrease-precision (delta)
31891 "Decrease precision by DELTA."
31892 (interactive "p")
31893 (setq calc-internal-prec (- calc-internal-prec delta)))
31894
31895 )) ; end of calc-define property
31896
31897 (run-hooks 'calc-check-defines)
31898 @end smallexample
31899
31900 @node Defining Stack Commands, Argument Qualifiers, Defining Simple Commands, Lisp Definitions
31901 @subsection Defining New Stack-Based Commands
31902
31903 @noindent
31904 To define a new computational command which takes and/or leaves arguments
31905 on the stack, a special form of @code{interactive} clause is used.
31906
31907 @example
31908 (interactive @var{num} @var{tag})
31909 @end example
31910
31911 @noindent
31912 where @var{num} is an integer, and @var{tag} is a string. The effect is
31913 to pop @var{num} values off the stack, resimplify them by calling
31914 @code{calc-normalize}, and hand them to your function according to the
31915 function's argument list. Your function may include @code{&optional} and
31916 @code{&rest} parameters, so long as calling the function with @var{num}
31917 parameters is valid.
31918
31919 Your function must return either a number or a formula in a form
31920 acceptable to Calc, or a list of such numbers or formulas. These value(s)
31921 are pushed onto the stack when the function completes. They are also
31922 recorded in the Calc Trail buffer on a line beginning with @var{tag},
31923 a string of (normally) four characters or less. If you omit @var{tag}
31924 or use @code{nil} as a tag, the result is not recorded in the trail.
31925
31926 As an example, the definition
31927
31928 @smallexample
31929 (defmath myfact (n)
31930 "Compute the factorial of the integer at the top of the stack."
31931 (interactive 1 "fact")
31932 (if (> n 0)
31933 (* n (myfact (1- n)))
31934 (and (= n 0) 1)))
31935 @end smallexample
31936
31937 @noindent
31938 is a version of the factorial function shown previously which can be used
31939 as a command as well as an algebraic function. It expands to
31940
31941 @smallexample
31942 (defun calc-myfact ()
31943 "Compute the factorial of the integer at the top of the stack."
31944 (interactive)
31945 (calc-slow-wrapper
31946 (calc-enter-result 1 "fact"
31947 (cons 'calcFunc-myfact (calc-top-list-n 1)))))
31948
31949 (defun calcFunc-myfact (n)
31950 "Compute the factorial of the integer at the top of the stack."
31951 (if (math-posp n)
31952 (math-mul n (calcFunc-myfact (math-add n -1)))
31953 (and (math-zerop n) 1)))
31954 @end smallexample
31955
31956 @findex calc-slow-wrapper
31957 The @code{calc-slow-wrapper} function is a version of @code{calc-wrapper}
31958 that automatically puts up a @samp{Working...} message before the
31959 computation begins. (This message can be turned off by the user
31960 with an @kbd{m w} (@code{calc-working}) command.)
31961
31962 @findex calc-top-list-n
31963 The @code{calc-top-list-n} function returns a list of the specified number
31964 of values from the top of the stack. It resimplifies each value by
31965 calling @code{calc-normalize}. If its argument is zero it returns an
31966 empty list. It does not actually remove these values from the stack.
31967
31968 @findex calc-enter-result
31969 The @code{calc-enter-result} function takes an integer @var{num} and string
31970 @var{tag} as described above, plus a third argument which is either a
31971 Calculator data object or a list of such objects. These objects are
31972 resimplified and pushed onto the stack after popping the specified number
31973 of values from the stack. If @var{tag} is non-@code{nil}, the values
31974 being pushed are also recorded in the trail.
31975
31976 Note that if @code{calcFunc-myfact} returns @code{nil} this represents
31977 ``leave the function in symbolic form.'' To return an actual empty list,
31978 in the sense that @code{calc-enter-result} will push zero elements back
31979 onto the stack, you should return the special value @samp{'(nil)}, a list
31980 containing the single symbol @code{nil}.
31981
31982 The @code{interactive} declaration can actually contain a limited
31983 Emacs-style code string as well which comes just before @var{num} and
31984 @var{tag}. Currently the only Emacs code supported is @samp{"p"}, as in
31985
31986 @example
31987 (defmath foo (a b &optional c)
31988 (interactive "p" 2 "foo")
31989 @var{body})
31990 @end example
31991
31992 In this example, the command @code{calc-foo} will evaluate the expression
31993 @samp{foo(a,b)} if executed with no argument, or @samp{foo(a,b,n)} if
31994 executed with a numeric prefix argument of @expr{n}.
31995
31996 The other code string allowed is @samp{"m"} (unrelated to the usual @samp{"m"}
31997 code as used with @code{defun}). It uses the numeric prefix argument as the
31998 number of objects to remove from the stack and pass to the function.
31999 In this case, the integer @var{num} serves as a default number of
32000 arguments to be used when no prefix is supplied.
32001
32002 @node Argument Qualifiers, Example Definitions, Defining Stack Commands, Lisp Definitions
32003 @subsection Argument Qualifiers
32004
32005 @noindent
32006 Anywhere a parameter name can appear in the parameter list you can also use
32007 an @dfn{argument qualifier}. Thus the general form of a definition is:
32008
32009 @example
32010 (defmath @var{name} (@var{param} @var{param...}
32011 &optional @var{param} @var{param...}
32012 &rest @var{param})
32013 @var{body})
32014 @end example
32015
32016 @noindent
32017 where each @var{param} is either a symbol or a list of the form
32018
32019 @example
32020 (@var{qual} @var{param})
32021 @end example
32022
32023 The following qualifiers are recognized:
32024
32025 @table @samp
32026 @item complete
32027 @findex complete
32028 The argument must not be an incomplete vector, interval, or complex number.
32029 (This is rarely needed since the Calculator itself will never call your
32030 function with an incomplete argument. But there is nothing stopping your
32031 own Lisp code from calling your function with an incomplete argument.)
32032
32033 @item integer
32034 @findex integer
32035 The argument must be an integer. If it is an integer-valued float
32036 it will be accepted but converted to integer form. Non-integers and
32037 formulas are rejected.
32038
32039 @item natnum
32040 @findex natnum
32041 Like @samp{integer}, but the argument must be non-negative.
32042
32043 @item fixnum
32044 @findex fixnum
32045 Like @samp{integer}, but the argument must fit into a native Lisp integer,
32046 which on most systems means less than 2^23 in absolute value. The
32047 argument is converted into Lisp-integer form if necessary.
32048
32049 @item float
32050 @findex float
32051 The argument is converted to floating-point format if it is a number or
32052 vector. If it is a formula it is left alone. (The argument is never
32053 actually rejected by this qualifier.)
32054
32055 @item @var{pred}
32056 The argument must satisfy predicate @var{pred}, which is one of the
32057 standard Calculator predicates. @xref{Predicates}.
32058
32059 @item not-@var{pred}
32060 The argument must @emph{not} satisfy predicate @var{pred}.
32061 @end table
32062
32063 For example,
32064
32065 @example
32066 (defmath foo (a (constp (not-matrixp b)) &optional (float c)
32067 &rest (integer d))
32068 @var{body})
32069 @end example
32070
32071 @noindent
32072 expands to
32073
32074 @example
32075 (defun calcFunc-foo (a b &optional c &rest d)
32076 (and (math-matrixp b)
32077 (math-reject-arg b 'not-matrixp))
32078 (or (math-constp b)
32079 (math-reject-arg b 'constp))
32080 (and c (setq c (math-check-float c)))
32081 (setq d (mapcar 'math-check-integer d))
32082 @var{body})
32083 @end example
32084
32085 @noindent
32086 which performs the necessary checks and conversions before executing the
32087 body of the function.
32088
32089 @node Example Definitions, Calling Calc from Your Programs, Argument Qualifiers, Lisp Definitions
32090 @subsection Example Definitions
32091
32092 @noindent
32093 This section includes some Lisp programming examples on a larger scale.
32094 These programs make use of some of the Calculator's internal functions;
32095 @pxref{Internals}.
32096
32097 @menu
32098 * Bit Counting Example::
32099 * Sine Example::
32100 @end menu
32101
32102 @node Bit Counting Example, Sine Example, Example Definitions, Example Definitions
32103 @subsubsection Bit-Counting
32104
32105 @noindent
32106 @ignore
32107 @starindex
32108 @end ignore
32109 @tindex bcount
32110 Calc does not include a built-in function for counting the number of
32111 ``one'' bits in a binary integer. It's easy to invent one using @kbd{b u}
32112 to convert the integer to a set, and @kbd{V #} to count the elements of
32113 that set; let's write a function that counts the bits without having to
32114 create an intermediate set.
32115
32116 @smallexample
32117 (defmath bcount ((natnum n))
32118 (interactive 1 "bcnt")
32119 (let ((count 0))
32120 (while (> n 0)
32121 (if (oddp n)
32122 (setq count (1+ count)))
32123 (setq n (lsh n -1)))
32124 count))
32125 @end smallexample
32126
32127 @noindent
32128 When this is expanded by @code{defmath}, it will become the following
32129 Emacs Lisp function:
32130
32131 @smallexample
32132 (defun calcFunc-bcount (n)
32133 (setq n (math-check-natnum n))
32134 (let ((count 0))
32135 (while (math-posp n)
32136 (if (math-oddp n)
32137 (setq count (math-add count 1)))
32138 (setq n (calcFunc-lsh n -1)))
32139 count))
32140 @end smallexample
32141
32142 If the input numbers are large, this function involves a fair amount
32143 of arithmetic. A binary right shift is essentially a division by two;
32144 recall that Calc stores integers in decimal form so bit shifts must
32145 involve actual division.
32146
32147 To gain a bit more efficiency, we could divide the integer into
32148 @var{n}-bit chunks, each of which can be handled quickly because
32149 they fit into Lisp integers. It turns out that Calc's arithmetic
32150 routines are especially fast when dividing by an integer less than
32151 1000, so we can set @var{n = 9} bits and use repeated division by 512:
32152
32153 @smallexample
32154 (defmath bcount ((natnum n))
32155 (interactive 1 "bcnt")
32156 (let ((count 0))
32157 (while (not (fixnump n))
32158 (let ((qr (idivmod n 512)))
32159 (setq count (+ count (bcount-fixnum (cdr qr)))
32160 n (car qr))))
32161 (+ count (bcount-fixnum n))))
32162
32163 (defun bcount-fixnum (n)
32164 (let ((count 0))
32165 (while (> n 0)
32166 (setq count (+ count (logand n 1))
32167 n (lsh n -1)))
32168 count))
32169 @end smallexample
32170
32171 @noindent
32172 Note that the second function uses @code{defun}, not @code{defmath}.
32173 Because this function deals only with native Lisp integers (``fixnums''),
32174 it can use the actual Emacs @code{+} and related functions rather
32175 than the slower but more general Calc equivalents which @code{defmath}
32176 uses.
32177
32178 The @code{idivmod} function does an integer division, returning both
32179 the quotient and the remainder at once. Again, note that while it
32180 might seem that @samp{(logand n 511)} and @samp{(lsh n -9)} are
32181 more efficient ways to split off the bottom nine bits of @code{n},
32182 actually they are less efficient because each operation is really
32183 a division by 512 in disguise; @code{idivmod} allows us to do the
32184 same thing with a single division by 512.
32185
32186 @node Sine Example, , Bit Counting Example, Example Definitions
32187 @subsubsection The Sine Function
32188
32189 @noindent
32190 @ignore
32191 @starindex
32192 @end ignore
32193 @tindex mysin
32194 A somewhat limited sine function could be defined as follows, using the
32195 well-known Taylor series expansion for
32196 @texline @math{\sin x}:
32197 @infoline @samp{sin(x)}:
32198
32199 @smallexample
32200 (defmath mysin ((float (anglep x)))
32201 (interactive 1 "mysn")
32202 (setq x (to-radians x)) ; Convert from current angular mode.
32203 (let ((sum x) ; Initial term of Taylor expansion of sin.
32204 newsum
32205 (nfact 1) ; "nfact" equals "n" factorial at all times.
32206 (xnegsqr :"-(x^2)")) ; "xnegsqr" equals -x^2.
32207 (for ((n 3 100 2)) ; Upper limit of 100 is a good precaution.
32208 (working "mysin" sum) ; Display "Working" message, if enabled.
32209 (setq nfact (* nfact (1- n) n)
32210 x (* x xnegsqr)
32211 newsum (+ sum (/ x nfact)))
32212 (if (~= newsum sum) ; If newsum is "nearly equal to" sum,
32213 (break)) ; then we are done.
32214 (setq sum newsum))
32215 sum))
32216 @end smallexample
32217
32218 The actual @code{sin} function in Calc works by first reducing the problem
32219 to a sine or cosine of a nonnegative number less than @cpiover{4}. This
32220 ensures that the Taylor series will converge quickly. Also, the calculation
32221 is carried out with two extra digits of precision to guard against cumulative
32222 round-off in @samp{sum}. Finally, complex arguments are allowed and handled
32223 by a separate algorithm.
32224
32225 @smallexample
32226 (defmath mysin ((float (scalarp x)))
32227 (interactive 1 "mysn")
32228 (setq x (to-radians x)) ; Convert from current angular mode.
32229 (with-extra-prec 2 ; Evaluate with extra precision.
32230 (cond ((complexp x)
32231 (mysin-complex x))
32232 ((< x 0)
32233 (- (mysin-raw (- x))) ; Always call mysin-raw with x >= 0.
32234 (t (mysin-raw x))))))
32235
32236 (defmath mysin-raw (x)
32237 (cond ((>= x 7)
32238 (mysin-raw (% x (two-pi)))) ; Now x < 7.
32239 ((> x (pi-over-2))
32240 (- (mysin-raw (- x (pi))))) ; Now -pi/2 <= x <= pi/2.
32241 ((> x (pi-over-4))
32242 (mycos-raw (- x (pi-over-2)))) ; Now -pi/2 <= x <= pi/4.
32243 ((< x (- (pi-over-4)))
32244 (- (mycos-raw (+ x (pi-over-2))))) ; Now -pi/4 <= x <= pi/4,
32245 (t (mysin-series x)))) ; so the series will be efficient.
32246 @end smallexample
32247
32248 @noindent
32249 where @code{mysin-complex} is an appropriate function to handle complex
32250 numbers, @code{mysin-series} is the routine to compute the sine Taylor
32251 series as before, and @code{mycos-raw} is a function analogous to
32252 @code{mysin-raw} for cosines.
32253
32254 The strategy is to ensure that @expr{x} is nonnegative before calling
32255 @code{mysin-raw}. This function then recursively reduces its argument
32256 to a suitable range, namely, plus-or-minus @cpiover{4}. Note that each
32257 test, and particularly the first comparison against 7, is designed so
32258 that small roundoff errors cannot produce an infinite loop. (Suppose
32259 we compared with @samp{(two-pi)} instead; if due to roundoff problems
32260 the modulo operator ever returned @samp{(two-pi)} exactly, an infinite
32261 recursion could result!) We use modulo only for arguments that will
32262 clearly get reduced, knowing that the next rule will catch any reductions
32263 that this rule misses.
32264
32265 If a program is being written for general use, it is important to code
32266 it carefully as shown in this second example. For quick-and-dirty programs,
32267 when you know that your own use of the sine function will never encounter
32268 a large argument, a simpler program like the first one shown is fine.
32269
32270 @node Calling Calc from Your Programs, Internals, Example Definitions, Lisp Definitions
32271 @subsection Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs
32272
32273 @noindent
32274 A later section (@pxref{Internals}) gives a full description of
32275 Calc's internal Lisp functions. It's not hard to call Calc from
32276 inside your programs, but the number of these functions can be daunting.
32277 So Calc provides one special ``programmer-friendly'' function called
32278 @code{calc-eval} that can be made to do just about everything you
32279 need. It's not as fast as the low-level Calc functions, but it's
32280 much simpler to use!
32281
32282 It may seem that @code{calc-eval} itself has a daunting number of
32283 options, but they all stem from one simple operation.
32284
32285 In its simplest manifestation, @samp{(calc-eval "1+2")} parses the
32286 string @code{"1+2"} as if it were a Calc algebraic entry and returns
32287 the result formatted as a string: @code{"3"}.
32288
32289 Since @code{calc-eval} is on the list of recommended @code{autoload}
32290 functions, you don't need to make any special preparations to load
32291 Calc before calling @code{calc-eval} the first time. Calc will be
32292 loaded and initialized for you.
32293
32294 All the Calc modes that are currently in effect will be used when
32295 evaluating the expression and formatting the result.
32296
32297 @ifinfo
32298 @example
32299
32300 @end example
32301 @end ifinfo
32302 @subsubsection Additional Arguments to @code{calc-eval}
32303
32304 @noindent
32305 If the input string parses to a list of expressions, Calc returns
32306 the results separated by @code{", "}. You can specify a different
32307 separator by giving a second string argument to @code{calc-eval}:
32308 @samp{(calc-eval "1+2,3+4" ";")} returns @code{"3;7"}.
32309
32310 The ``separator'' can also be any of several Lisp symbols which
32311 request other behaviors from @code{calc-eval}. These are discussed
32312 one by one below.
32313
32314 You can give additional arguments to be substituted for
32315 @samp{$}, @samp{$$}, and so on in the main expression. For
32316 example, @samp{(calc-eval "$/$$" nil "7" "1+1")} evaluates the
32317 expression @code{"7/(1+1)"} to yield the result @code{"3.5"}
32318 (assuming Fraction mode is not in effect). Note the @code{nil}
32319 used as a placeholder for the item-separator argument.
32320
32321 @ifinfo
32322 @example
32323
32324 @end example
32325 @end ifinfo
32326 @subsubsection Error Handling
32327
32328 @noindent
32329 If @code{calc-eval} encounters an error, it returns a list containing
32330 the character position of the error, plus a suitable message as a
32331 string. Note that @samp{1 / 0} is @emph{not} an error by Calc's
32332 standards; it simply returns the string @code{"1 / 0"} which is the
32333 division left in symbolic form. But @samp{(calc-eval "1/")} will
32334 return the list @samp{(2 "Expected a number")}.
32335
32336 If you bind the variable @code{calc-eval-error} to @code{t}
32337 using a @code{let} form surrounding the call to @code{calc-eval},
32338 errors instead call the Emacs @code{error} function which aborts
32339 to the Emacs command loop with a beep and an error message.
32340
32341 If you bind this variable to the symbol @code{string}, error messages
32342 are returned as strings instead of lists. The character position is
32343 ignored.
32344
32345 As a courtesy to other Lisp code which may be using Calc, be sure
32346 to bind @code{calc-eval-error} using @code{let} rather than changing
32347 it permanently with @code{setq}.
32348
32349 @ifinfo
32350 @example
32351
32352 @end example
32353 @end ifinfo
32354 @subsubsection Numbers Only
32355
32356 @noindent
32357 Sometimes it is preferable to treat @samp{1 / 0} as an error
32358 rather than returning a symbolic result. If you pass the symbol
32359 @code{num} as the second argument to @code{calc-eval}, results
32360 that are not constants are treated as errors. The error message
32361 reported is the first @code{calc-why} message if there is one,
32362 or otherwise ``Number expected.''
32363
32364 A result is ``constant'' if it is a number, vector, or other
32365 object that does not include variables or function calls. If it
32366 is a vector, the components must themselves be constants.
32367
32368 @ifinfo
32369 @example
32370
32371 @end example
32372 @end ifinfo
32373 @subsubsection Default Modes
32374
32375 @noindent
32376 If the first argument to @code{calc-eval} is a list whose first
32377 element is a formula string, then @code{calc-eval} sets all the
32378 various Calc modes to their default values while the formula is
32379 evaluated and formatted. For example, the precision is set to 12
32380 digits, digit grouping is turned off, and the Normal language
32381 mode is used.
32382
32383 This same principle applies to the other options discussed below.
32384 If the first argument would normally be @var{x}, then it can also
32385 be the list @samp{(@var{x})} to use the default mode settings.
32386
32387 If there are other elements in the list, they are taken as
32388 variable-name/value pairs which override the default mode
32389 settings. Look at the documentation at the front of the
32390 @file{calc.el} file to find the names of the Lisp variables for
32391 the various modes. The mode settings are restored to their
32392 original values when @code{calc-eval} is done.
32393
32394 For example, @samp{(calc-eval '("$+$$" calc-internal-prec 8) 'num a b)}
32395 computes the sum of two numbers, requiring a numeric result, and
32396 using default mode settings except that the precision is 8 instead
32397 of the default of 12.
32398
32399 It's usually best to use this form of @code{calc-eval} unless your
32400 program actually considers the interaction with Calc's mode settings
32401 to be a feature. This will avoid all sorts of potential ``gotchas'';
32402 consider what happens with @samp{(calc-eval "sqrt(2)" 'num)}
32403 when the user has left Calc in Symbolic mode or No-Simplify mode.
32404
32405 As another example, @samp{(equal (calc-eval '("$<$$") nil a b) "1")}
32406 checks if the number in string @expr{a} is less than the one in
32407 string @expr{b}. Without using a list, the integer 1 might
32408 come out in a variety of formats which would be hard to test for
32409 conveniently: @code{"1"}, @code{"8#1"}, @code{"00001"}. (But
32410 see ``Predicates'' mode, below.)
32411
32412 @ifinfo
32413 @example
32414
32415 @end example
32416 @end ifinfo
32417 @subsubsection Raw Numbers
32418
32419 @noindent
32420 Normally all input and output for @code{calc-eval} is done with strings.
32421 You can do arithmetic with, say, @samp{(calc-eval "$+$$" nil a b)}
32422 in place of @samp{(+ a b)}, but this is very inefficient since the
32423 numbers must be converted to and from string format as they are passed
32424 from one @code{calc-eval} to the next.
32425
32426 If the separator is the symbol @code{raw}, the result will be returned
32427 as a raw Calc data structure rather than a string. You can read about
32428 how these objects look in the following sections, but usually you can
32429 treat them as ``black box'' objects with no important internal
32430 structure.
32431
32432 There is also a @code{rawnum} symbol, which is a combination of
32433 @code{raw} (returning a raw Calc object) and @code{num} (signaling
32434 an error if that object is not a constant).
32435
32436 You can pass a raw Calc object to @code{calc-eval} in place of a
32437 string, either as the formula itself or as one of the @samp{$}
32438 arguments. Thus @samp{(calc-eval "$+$$" 'raw a b)} is an
32439 addition function that operates on raw Calc objects. Of course
32440 in this case it would be easier to call the low-level @code{math-add}
32441 function in Calc, if you can remember its name.
32442
32443 In particular, note that a plain Lisp integer is acceptable to Calc
32444 as a raw object. (All Lisp integers are accepted on input, but
32445 integers of more than six decimal digits are converted to ``big-integer''
32446 form for output. @xref{Data Type Formats}.)
32447
32448 When it comes time to display the object, just use @samp{(calc-eval a)}
32449 to format it as a string.
32450
32451 It is an error if the input expression evaluates to a list of
32452 values. The separator symbol @code{list} is like @code{raw}
32453 except that it returns a list of one or more raw Calc objects.
32454
32455 Note that a Lisp string is not a valid Calc object, nor is a list
32456 containing a string. Thus you can still safely distinguish all the
32457 various kinds of error returns discussed above.
32458
32459 @ifinfo
32460 @example
32461
32462 @end example
32463 @end ifinfo
32464 @subsubsection Predicates
32465
32466 @noindent
32467 If the separator symbol is @code{pred}, the result of the formula is
32468 treated as a true/false value; @code{calc-eval} returns @code{t} or
32469 @code{nil}, respectively. A value is considered ``true'' if it is a
32470 non-zero number, or false if it is zero or if it is not a number.
32471
32472 For example, @samp{(calc-eval "$<$$" 'pred a b)} tests whether
32473 one value is less than another.
32474
32475 As usual, it is also possible for @code{calc-eval} to return one of
32476 the error indicators described above. Lisp will interpret such an
32477 indicator as ``true'' if you don't check for it explicitly. If you
32478 wish to have an error register as ``false'', use something like
32479 @samp{(eq (calc-eval ...) t)}.
32480
32481 @ifinfo
32482 @example
32483
32484 @end example
32485 @end ifinfo
32486 @subsubsection Variable Values
32487
32488 @noindent
32489 Variables in the formula passed to @code{calc-eval} are not normally
32490 replaced by their values. If you wish this, you can use the
32491 @code{evalv} function (@pxref{Algebraic Manipulation}). For example,
32492 if 4 is stored in Calc variable @code{a} (i.e., in Lisp variable
32493 @code{var-a}), then @samp{(calc-eval "a+pi")} will return the
32494 formula @code{"a + pi"}, but @samp{(calc-eval "evalv(a+pi)")}
32495 will return @code{"7.14159265359"}.
32496
32497 To store in a Calc variable, just use @code{setq} to store in the
32498 corresponding Lisp variable. (This is obtained by prepending
32499 @samp{var-} to the Calc variable name.) Calc routines will
32500 understand either string or raw form values stored in variables,
32501 although raw data objects are much more efficient. For example,
32502 to increment the Calc variable @code{a}:
32503
32504 @example
32505 (setq var-a (calc-eval "evalv(a+1)" 'raw))
32506 @end example
32507
32508 @ifinfo
32509 @example
32510
32511 @end example
32512 @end ifinfo
32513 @subsubsection Stack Access
32514
32515 @noindent
32516 If the separator symbol is @code{push}, the formula argument is
32517 evaluated (with possible @samp{$} expansions, as usual). The
32518 result is pushed onto the Calc stack. The return value is @code{nil}
32519 (unless there is an error from evaluating the formula, in which
32520 case the return value depends on @code{calc-eval-error} in the
32521 usual way).
32522
32523 If the separator symbol is @code{pop}, the first argument to
32524 @code{calc-eval} must be an integer instead of a string. That
32525 many values are popped from the stack and thrown away. A negative
32526 argument deletes the entry at that stack level. The return value
32527 is the number of elements remaining in the stack after popping;
32528 @samp{(calc-eval 0 'pop)} is a good way to measure the size of
32529 the stack.
32530
32531 If the separator symbol is @code{top}, the first argument to
32532 @code{calc-eval} must again be an integer. The value at that
32533 stack level is formatted as a string and returned. Thus
32534 @samp{(calc-eval 1 'top)} returns the top-of-stack value. If the
32535 integer is out of range, @code{nil} is returned.
32536
32537 The separator symbol @code{rawtop} is just like @code{top} except
32538 that the stack entry is returned as a raw Calc object instead of
32539 as a string.
32540
32541 In all of these cases the first argument can be made a list in
32542 order to force the default mode settings, as described above.
32543 Thus @samp{(calc-eval '(2 calc-number-radix 16) 'top)} returns the
32544 second-to-top stack entry, formatted as a string using the default
32545 instead of current display modes, except that the radix is
32546 hexadecimal instead of decimal.
32547
32548 It is, of course, polite to put the Calc stack back the way you
32549 found it when you are done, unless the user of your program is
32550 actually expecting it to affect the stack.
32551
32552 Note that you do not actually have to switch into the @samp{*Calculator*}
32553 buffer in order to use @code{calc-eval}; it temporarily switches into
32554 the stack buffer if necessary.
32555
32556 @ifinfo
32557 @example
32558
32559 @end example
32560 @end ifinfo
32561 @subsubsection Keyboard Macros
32562
32563 @noindent
32564 If the separator symbol is @code{macro}, the first argument must be a
32565 string of characters which Calc can execute as a sequence of keystrokes.
32566 This switches into the Calc buffer for the duration of the macro.
32567 For example, @samp{(calc-eval "vx5\rVR+" 'macro)} pushes the
32568 vector @samp{[1,2,3,4,5]} on the stack and then replaces it
32569 with the sum of those numbers. Note that @samp{\r} is the Lisp
32570 notation for the carriage-return, @key{RET}, character.
32571
32572 If your keyboard macro wishes to pop the stack, @samp{\C-d} is
32573 safer than @samp{\177} (the @key{DEL} character) because some
32574 installations may have switched the meanings of @key{DEL} and
32575 @kbd{C-h}. Calc always interprets @kbd{C-d} as a synonym for
32576 ``pop-stack'' regardless of key mapping.
32577
32578 If you provide a third argument to @code{calc-eval}, evaluation
32579 of the keyboard macro will leave a record in the Trail using
32580 that argument as a tag string. Normally the Trail is unaffected.
32581
32582 The return value in this case is always @code{nil}.
32583
32584 @ifinfo
32585 @example
32586
32587 @end example
32588 @end ifinfo
32589 @subsubsection Lisp Evaluation
32590
32591 @noindent
32592 Finally, if the separator symbol is @code{eval}, then the Lisp
32593 @code{eval} function is called on the first argument, which must
32594 be a Lisp expression rather than a Calc formula. Remember to
32595 quote the expression so that it is not evaluated until inside
32596 @code{calc-eval}.
32597
32598 The difference from plain @code{eval} is that @code{calc-eval}
32599 switches to the Calc buffer before evaluating the expression.
32600 For example, @samp{(calc-eval '(setq calc-internal-prec 17) 'eval)}
32601 will correctly affect the buffer-local Calc precision variable.
32602
32603 An alternative would be @samp{(calc-eval '(calc-precision 17) 'eval)}.
32604 This is evaluating a call to the function that is normally invoked
32605 by the @kbd{p} key, giving it 17 as its ``numeric prefix argument.''
32606 Note that this function will leave a message in the echo area as
32607 a side effect. Also, all Calc functions switch to the Calc buffer
32608 automatically if not invoked from there, so the above call is
32609 also equivalent to @samp{(calc-precision 17)} by itself.
32610 In all cases, Calc uses @code{save-excursion} to switch back to
32611 your original buffer when it is done.
32612
32613 As usual the first argument can be a list that begins with a Lisp
32614 expression to use default instead of current mode settings.
32615
32616 The result of @code{calc-eval} in this usage is just the result
32617 returned by the evaluated Lisp expression.
32618
32619 @ifinfo
32620 @example
32621
32622 @end example
32623 @end ifinfo
32624 @subsubsection Example
32625
32626 @noindent
32627 @findex convert-temp
32628 Here is a sample Emacs command that uses @code{calc-eval}. Suppose
32629 you have a document with lots of references to temperatures on the
32630 Fahrenheit scale, say ``98.6 F'', and you wish to convert these
32631 references to Centigrade. The following command does this conversion.
32632 Place the Emacs cursor right after the letter ``F'' and invoke the
32633 command to change ``98.6 F'' to ``37 C''. Or, if the temperature is
32634 already in Centigrade form, the command changes it back to Fahrenheit.
32635
32636 @example
32637 (defun convert-temp ()
32638 (interactive)
32639 (save-excursion
32640 (re-search-backward "[^-.0-9]\\([-.0-9]+\\) *\\([FC]\\)")
32641 (let* ((top1 (match-beginning 1))
32642 (bot1 (match-end 1))
32643 (number (buffer-substring top1 bot1))
32644 (top2 (match-beginning 2))
32645 (bot2 (match-end 2))
32646 (type (buffer-substring top2 bot2)))
32647 (if (equal type "F")
32648 (setq type "C"
32649 number (calc-eval "($ - 32)*5/9" nil number))
32650 (setq type "F"
32651 number (calc-eval "$*9/5 + 32" nil number)))
32652 (goto-char top2)
32653 (delete-region top2 bot2)
32654 (insert-before-markers type)
32655 (goto-char top1)
32656 (delete-region top1 bot1)
32657 (if (string-match "\\.$" number) ; change "37." to "37"
32658 (setq number (substring number 0 -1)))
32659 (insert number))))
32660 @end example
32661
32662 Note the use of @code{insert-before-markers} when changing between
32663 ``F'' and ``C'', so that the character winds up before the cursor
32664 instead of after it.
32665
32666 @node Internals, , Calling Calc from Your Programs, Lisp Definitions
32667 @subsection Calculator Internals
32668
32669 @noindent
32670 This section describes the Lisp functions defined by the Calculator that
32671 may be of use to user-written Calculator programs (as described in the
32672 rest of this chapter). These functions are shown by their names as they
32673 conventionally appear in @code{defmath}. Their full Lisp names are
32674 generally gotten by prepending @samp{calcFunc-} or @samp{math-} to their
32675 apparent names. (Names that begin with @samp{calc-} are already in
32676 their full Lisp form.) You can use the actual full names instead if you
32677 prefer them, or if you are calling these functions from regular Lisp.
32678
32679 The functions described here are scattered throughout the various
32680 Calc component files. Note that @file{calc.el} includes @code{autoload}s
32681 for only a few component files; when Calc wants to call an advanced
32682 function it calls @samp{(calc-extensions)} first; this function
32683 autoloads @file{calc-ext.el}, which in turn autoloads all the functions
32684 in the remaining component files.
32685
32686 Because @code{defmath} itself uses the extensions, user-written code
32687 generally always executes with the extensions already loaded, so
32688 normally you can use any Calc function and be confident that it will
32689 be autoloaded for you when necessary. If you are doing something
32690 special, check carefully to make sure each function you are using is
32691 from @file{calc.el} or its components, and call @samp{(calc-extensions)}
32692 before using any function based in @file{calc-ext.el} if you can't
32693 prove this file will already be loaded.
32694
32695 @menu
32696 * Data Type Formats::
32697 * Interactive Lisp Functions::
32698 * Stack Lisp Functions::
32699 * Predicates::
32700 * Computational Lisp Functions::
32701 * Vector Lisp Functions::
32702 * Symbolic Lisp Functions::
32703 * Formatting Lisp Functions::
32704 * Hooks::
32705 @end menu
32706
32707 @node Data Type Formats, Interactive Lisp Functions, Internals, Internals
32708 @subsubsection Data Type Formats
32709
32710 @noindent
32711 Integers are stored in either of two ways, depending on their magnitude.
32712 Integers less than one million in absolute value are stored as standard
32713 Lisp integers. This is the only storage format for Calc data objects
32714 which is not a Lisp list.
32715
32716 Large integers are stored as lists of the form @samp{(bigpos @var{d0}
32717 @var{d1} @var{d2} @dots{})} for positive integers 1000000 or more, or
32718 @samp{(bigneg @var{d0} @var{d1} @var{d2} @dots{})} for negative integers
32719 @mathit{-1000000} or less. Each @var{d} is a base-1000 ``digit,'' a Lisp integer
32720 from 0 to 999. The least significant digit is @var{d0}; the last digit,
32721 @var{dn}, which is always nonzero, is the most significant digit. For
32722 example, the integer @mathit{-12345678} is stored as @samp{(bigneg 678 345 12)}.
32723
32724 The distinction between small and large integers is entirely hidden from
32725 the user. In @code{defmath} definitions, the Lisp predicate @code{integerp}
32726 returns true for either kind of integer, and in general both big and small
32727 integers are accepted anywhere the word ``integer'' is used in this manual.
32728 If the distinction must be made, native Lisp integers are called @dfn{fixnums}
32729 and large integers are called @dfn{bignums}.
32730
32731 Fractions are stored as a list of the form, @samp{(frac @var{n} @var{d})}
32732 where @var{n} is an integer (big or small) numerator, @var{d} is an
32733 integer denominator greater than one, and @var{n} and @var{d} are relatively
32734 prime. Note that fractions where @var{d} is one are automatically converted
32735 to plain integers by all math routines; fractions where @var{d} is negative
32736 are normalized by negating the numerator and denominator.
32737
32738 Floating-point numbers are stored in the form, @samp{(float @var{mant}
32739 @var{exp})}, where @var{mant} (the ``mantissa'') is an integer less than
32740 @samp{10^@var{p}} in absolute value (@var{p} represents the current
32741 precision), and @var{exp} (the ``exponent'') is a fixnum. The value of
32742 the float is @samp{@var{mant} * 10^@var{exp}}. For example, the number
32743 @mathit{-3.14} is stored as @samp{(float -314 -2) = -314*10^-2}. Other constraints
32744 are that the number 0.0 is always stored as @samp{(float 0 0)}, and,
32745 except for the 0.0 case, the rightmost base-10 digit of @var{mant} is
32746 always nonzero. (If the rightmost digit is zero, the number is
32747 rearranged by dividing @var{mant} by ten and incrementing @var{exp}.)
32748
32749 Rectangular complex numbers are stored in the form @samp{(cplx @var{re}
32750 @var{im})}, where @var{re} and @var{im} are each real numbers, either
32751 integers, fractions, or floats. The value is @samp{@var{re} + @var{im}i}.
32752 The @var{im} part is nonzero; complex numbers with zero imaginary
32753 components are converted to real numbers automatically.
32754
32755 Polar complex numbers are stored in the form @samp{(polar @var{r}
32756 @var{theta})}, where @var{r} is a positive real value and @var{theta}
32757 is a real value or HMS form representing an angle. This angle is
32758 usually normalized to lie in the interval @samp{(-180 ..@: 180)} degrees,
32759 or @samp{(-pi ..@: pi)} radians, according to the current angular mode.
32760 If the angle is 0 the value is converted to a real number automatically.
32761 (If the angle is 180 degrees, the value is usually also converted to a
32762 negative real number.)
32763
32764 Hours-minutes-seconds forms are stored as @samp{(hms @var{h} @var{m}
32765 @var{s})}, where @var{h} is an integer or an integer-valued float (i.e.,
32766 a float with @samp{@var{exp} >= 0}), @var{m} is an integer or integer-valued
32767 float in the range @w{@samp{[0 ..@: 60)}}, and @var{s} is any real number
32768 in the range @samp{[0 ..@: 60)}.
32769
32770 Date forms are stored as @samp{(date @var{n})}, where @var{n} is
32771 a real number that counts days since midnight on the morning of
32772 January 1, 1 AD. If @var{n} is an integer, this is a pure date
32773 form. If @var{n} is a fraction or float, this is a date/time form.
32774
32775 Modulo forms are stored as @samp{(mod @var{n} @var{m})}, where @var{m} is a
32776 positive real number or HMS form, and @var{n} is a real number or HMS
32777 form in the range @samp{[0 ..@: @var{m})}.
32778
32779 Error forms are stored as @samp{(sdev @var{x} @var{sigma})}, where @var{x}
32780 is the mean value and @var{sigma} is the standard deviation. Each
32781 component is either a number, an HMS form, or a symbolic object
32782 (a variable or function call). If @var{sigma} is zero, the value is
32783 converted to a plain real number. If @var{sigma} is negative or
32784 complex, it is automatically normalized to be a positive real.
32785
32786 Interval forms are stored as @samp{(intv @var{mask} @var{lo} @var{hi})},
32787 where @var{mask} is one of the integers 0, 1, 2, or 3, and @var{lo} and
32788 @var{hi} are real numbers, HMS forms, or symbolic objects. The @var{mask}
32789 is a binary integer where 1 represents the fact that the interval is
32790 closed on the high end, and 2 represents the fact that it is closed on
32791 the low end. (Thus 3 represents a fully closed interval.) The interval
32792 @w{@samp{(intv 3 @var{x} @var{x})}} is converted to the plain number @var{x};
32793 intervals @samp{(intv @var{mask} @var{x} @var{x})} for any other @var{mask}
32794 represent empty intervals. If @var{hi} is less than @var{lo}, the interval
32795 is converted to a standard empty interval by replacing @var{hi} with @var{lo}.
32796
32797 Vectors are stored as @samp{(vec @var{v1} @var{v2} @dots{})}, where @var{v1}
32798 is the first element of the vector, @var{v2} is the second, and so on.
32799 An empty vector is stored as @samp{(vec)}. A matrix is simply a vector
32800 where all @var{v}'s are themselves vectors of equal lengths. Note that
32801 Calc vectors are unrelated to the Emacs Lisp ``vector'' type, which is
32802 generally unused by Calc data structures.
32803
32804 Variables are stored as @samp{(var @var{name} @var{sym})}, where
32805 @var{name} is a Lisp symbol whose print name is used as the visible name
32806 of the variable, and @var{sym} is a Lisp symbol in which the variable's
32807 value is actually stored. Thus, @samp{(var pi var-pi)} represents the
32808 special constant @samp{pi}. Almost always, the form is @samp{(var
32809 @var{v} var-@var{v})}. If the variable name was entered with @code{#}
32810 signs (which are converted to hyphens internally), the form is
32811 @samp{(var @var{u} @var{v})}, where @var{u} is a symbol whose name
32812 contains @code{#} characters, and @var{v} is a symbol that contains
32813 @code{-} characters instead. The value of a variable is the Calc
32814 object stored in its @var{sym} symbol's value cell. If the symbol's
32815 value cell is void or if it contains @code{nil}, the variable has no
32816 value. Special constants have the form @samp{(special-const
32817 @var{value})} stored in their value cell, where @var{value} is a formula
32818 which is evaluated when the constant's value is requested. Variables
32819 which represent units are not stored in any special way; they are units
32820 only because their names appear in the units table. If the value
32821 cell contains a string, it is parsed to get the variable's value when
32822 the variable is used.
32823
32824 A Lisp list with any other symbol as the first element is a function call.
32825 The symbols @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}, @code{^},
32826 and @code{|} represent special binary operators; these lists are always
32827 of the form @samp{(@var{op} @var{lhs} @var{rhs})} where @var{lhs} is the
32828 sub-formula on the lefthand side and @var{rhs} is the sub-formula on the
32829 right. The symbol @code{neg} represents unary negation; this list is always
32830 of the form @samp{(neg @var{arg})}. Any other symbol @var{func} represents a
32831 function that would be displayed in function-call notation; the symbol
32832 @var{func} is in general always of the form @samp{calcFunc-@var{name}}.
32833 The function cell of the symbol @var{func} should contain a Lisp function
32834 for evaluating a call to @var{func}. This function is passed the remaining
32835 elements of the list (themselves already evaluated) as arguments; such
32836 functions should return @code{nil} or call @code{reject-arg} to signify
32837 that they should be left in symbolic form, or they should return a Calc
32838 object which represents their value, or a list of such objects if they
32839 wish to return multiple values. (The latter case is allowed only for
32840 functions which are the outer-level call in an expression whose value is
32841 about to be pushed on the stack; this feature is considered obsolete
32842 and is not used by any built-in Calc functions.)
32843
32844 @node Interactive Lisp Functions, Stack Lisp Functions, Data Type Formats, Internals
32845 @subsubsection Interactive Functions
32846
32847 @noindent
32848 The functions described here are used in implementing interactive Calc
32849 commands. Note that this list is not exhaustive! If there is an
32850 existing command that behaves similarly to the one you want to define,
32851 you may find helpful tricks by checking the source code for that command.
32852
32853 @defun calc-set-command-flag flag
32854 Set the command flag @var{flag}. This is generally a Lisp symbol, but
32855 may in fact be anything. The effect is to add @var{flag} to the list
32856 stored in the variable @code{calc-command-flags}, unless it is already
32857 there. @xref{Defining Simple Commands}.
32858 @end defun
32859
32860 @defun calc-clear-command-flag flag
32861 If @var{flag} appears among the list of currently-set command flags,
32862 remove it from that list.
32863 @end defun
32864
32865 @defun calc-record-undo rec
32866 Add the ``undo record'' @var{rec} to the list of steps to take if the
32867 current operation should need to be undone. Stack push and pop functions
32868 automatically call @code{calc-record-undo}, so the kinds of undo records
32869 you might need to create take the form @samp{(set @var{sym} @var{value})},
32870 which says that the Lisp variable @var{sym} was changed and had previously
32871 contained @var{value}; @samp{(store @var{var} @var{value})} which says that
32872 the Calc variable @var{var} (a string which is the name of the symbol that
32873 contains the variable's value) was stored and its previous value was
32874 @var{value} (either a Calc data object, or @code{nil} if the variable was
32875 previously void); or @samp{(eval @var{undo} @var{redo} @var{args} @dots{})},
32876 which means that to undo requires calling the function @samp{(@var{undo}
32877 @var{args} @dots{})} and, if the undo is later redone, calling
32878 @samp{(@var{redo} @var{args} @dots{})}.
32879 @end defun
32880
32881 @defun calc-record-why msg args
32882 Record the error or warning message @var{msg}, which is normally a string.
32883 This message will be replayed if the user types @kbd{w} (@code{calc-why});
32884 if the message string begins with a @samp{*}, it is considered important
32885 enough to display even if the user doesn't type @kbd{w}. If one or more
32886 @var{args} are present, the displayed message will be of the form,
32887 @samp{@var{msg}: @var{arg1}, @var{arg2}, @dots{}}, where the arguments are
32888 formatted on the assumption that they are either strings or Calc objects of
32889 some sort. If @var{msg} is a symbol, it is the name of a Calc predicate
32890 (such as @code{integerp} or @code{numvecp}) which the arguments did not
32891 satisfy; it is expanded to a suitable string such as ``Expected an
32892 integer.'' The @code{reject-arg} function calls @code{calc-record-why}
32893 automatically; @pxref{Predicates}.
32894 @end defun
32895
32896 @defun calc-is-inverse
32897 This predicate returns true if the current command is inverse,
32898 i.e., if the Inverse (@kbd{I} key) flag was set.
32899 @end defun
32900
32901 @defun calc-is-hyperbolic
32902 This predicate is the analogous function for the @kbd{H} key.
32903 @end defun
32904
32905 @node Stack Lisp Functions, Predicates, Interactive Lisp Functions, Internals
32906 @subsubsection Stack-Oriented Functions
32907
32908 @noindent
32909 The functions described here perform various operations on the Calc
32910 stack and trail. They are to be used in interactive Calc commands.
32911
32912 @defun calc-push-list vals n
32913 Push the Calc objects in list @var{vals} onto the stack at stack level
32914 @var{n}. If @var{n} is omitted it defaults to 1, so that the elements
32915 are pushed at the top of the stack. If @var{n} is greater than 1, the
32916 elements will be inserted into the stack so that the last element will
32917 end up at level @var{n}, the next-to-last at level @var{n}+1, etc.
32918 The elements of @var{vals} are assumed to be valid Calc objects, and
32919 are not evaluated, rounded, or renormalized in any way. If @var{vals}
32920 is an empty list, nothing happens.
32921
32922 The stack elements are pushed without any sub-formula selections.
32923 You can give an optional third argument to this function, which must
32924 be a list the same size as @var{vals} of selections. Each selection
32925 must be @code{eq} to some sub-formula of the corresponding formula
32926 in @var{vals}, or @code{nil} if that formula should have no selection.
32927 @end defun
32928
32929 @defun calc-top-list n m
32930 Return a list of the @var{n} objects starting at level @var{m} of the
32931 stack. If @var{m} is omitted it defaults to 1, so that the elements are
32932 taken from the top of the stack. If @var{n} is omitted, it also
32933 defaults to 1, so that the top stack element (in the form of a
32934 one-element list) is returned. If @var{m} is greater than 1, the
32935 @var{m}th stack element will be at the end of the list, the @var{m}+1st
32936 element will be next-to-last, etc. If @var{n} or @var{m} are out of
32937 range, the command is aborted with a suitable error message. If @var{n}
32938 is zero, the function returns an empty list. The stack elements are not
32939 evaluated, rounded, or renormalized.
32940
32941 If any stack elements contain selections, and selections have not
32942 been disabled by the @kbd{j e} (@code{calc-enable-selections}) command,
32943 this function returns the selected portions rather than the entire
32944 stack elements. It can be given a third ``selection-mode'' argument
32945 which selects other behaviors. If it is the symbol @code{t}, then
32946 a selection in any of the requested stack elements produces an
32947 ``invalid operation on selections'' error. If it is the symbol @code{full},
32948 the whole stack entry is always returned regardless of selections.
32949 If it is the symbol @code{sel}, the selected portion is always returned,
32950 or @code{nil} if there is no selection. (This mode ignores the @kbd{j e}
32951 command.) If the symbol is @code{entry}, the complete stack entry in
32952 list form is returned; the first element of this list will be the whole
32953 formula, and the third element will be the selection (or @code{nil}).
32954 @end defun
32955
32956 @defun calc-pop-stack n m
32957 Remove the specified elements from the stack. The parameters @var{n}
32958 and @var{m} are defined the same as for @code{calc-top-list}. The return
32959 value of @code{calc-pop-stack} is uninteresting.
32960
32961 If there are any selected sub-formulas among the popped elements, and
32962 @kbd{j e} has not been used to disable selections, this produces an
32963 error without changing the stack. If you supply an optional third
32964 argument of @code{t}, the stack elements are popped even if they
32965 contain selections.
32966 @end defun
32967
32968 @defun calc-record-list vals tag
32969 This function records one or more results in the trail. The @var{vals}
32970 are a list of strings or Calc objects. The @var{tag} is the four-character
32971 tag string to identify the values. If @var{tag} is omitted, a blank tag
32972 will be used.
32973 @end defun
32974
32975 @defun calc-normalize n
32976 This function takes a Calc object and ``normalizes'' it. At the very
32977 least this involves re-rounding floating-point values according to the
32978 current precision and other similar jobs. Also, unless the user has
32979 selected No-Simplify mode (@pxref{Simplification Modes}), this involves
32980 actually evaluating a formula object by executing the function calls
32981 it contains, and possibly also doing algebraic simplification, etc.
32982 @end defun
32983
32984 @defun calc-top-list-n n m
32985 This function is identical to @code{calc-top-list}, except that it calls
32986 @code{calc-normalize} on the values that it takes from the stack. They
32987 are also passed through @code{check-complete}, so that incomplete
32988 objects will be rejected with an error message. All computational
32989 commands should use this in preference to @code{calc-top-list}; the only
32990 standard Calc commands that operate on the stack without normalizing
32991 are stack management commands like @code{calc-enter} and @code{calc-roll-up}.
32992 This function accepts the same optional selection-mode argument as
32993 @code{calc-top-list}.
32994 @end defun
32995
32996 @defun calc-top-n m
32997 This function is a convenient form of @code{calc-top-list-n} in which only
32998 a single element of the stack is taken and returned, rather than a list
32999 of elements. This also accepts an optional selection-mode argument.
33000 @end defun
33001
33002 @defun calc-enter-result n tag vals
33003 This function is a convenient interface to most of the above functions.
33004 The @var{vals} argument should be either a single Calc object, or a list
33005 of Calc objects; the object or objects are normalized, and the top @var{n}
33006 stack entries are replaced by the normalized objects. If @var{tag} is
33007 non-@code{nil}, the normalized objects are also recorded in the trail.
33008 A typical stack-based computational command would take the form,
33009
33010 @smallexample
33011 (calc-enter-result @var{n} @var{tag} (cons 'calcFunc-@var{func}
33012 (calc-top-list-n @var{n})))
33013 @end smallexample
33014
33015 If any of the @var{n} stack elements replaced contain sub-formula
33016 selections, and selections have not been disabled by @kbd{j e},
33017 this function takes one of two courses of action. If @var{n} is
33018 equal to the number of elements in @var{vals}, then each element of
33019 @var{vals} is spliced into the corresponding selection; this is what
33020 happens when you use the @key{TAB} key, or when you use a unary
33021 arithmetic operation like @code{sqrt}. If @var{vals} has only one
33022 element but @var{n} is greater than one, there must be only one
33023 selection among the top @var{n} stack elements; the element from
33024 @var{vals} is spliced into that selection. This is what happens when
33025 you use a binary arithmetic operation like @kbd{+}. Any other
33026 combination of @var{n} and @var{vals} is an error when selections
33027 are present.
33028 @end defun
33029
33030 @defun calc-unary-op tag func arg
33031 This function implements a unary operator that allows a numeric prefix
33032 argument to apply the operator over many stack entries. If the prefix
33033 argument @var{arg} is @code{nil}, this uses @code{calc-enter-result}
33034 as outlined above. Otherwise, it maps the function over several stack
33035 elements; @pxref{Prefix Arguments}. For example,
33036
33037 @smallexample
33038 (defun calc-zeta (arg)
33039 (interactive "P")
33040 (calc-unary-op "zeta" 'calcFunc-zeta arg))
33041 @end smallexample
33042 @end defun
33043
33044 @defun calc-binary-op tag func arg ident unary
33045 This function implements a binary operator, analogously to
33046 @code{calc-unary-op}. The optional @var{ident} and @var{unary}
33047 arguments specify the behavior when the prefix argument is zero or
33048 one, respectively. If the prefix is zero, the value @var{ident}
33049 is pushed onto the stack, if specified, otherwise an error message
33050 is displayed. If the prefix is one, the unary function @var{unary}
33051 is applied to the top stack element, or, if @var{unary} is not
33052 specified, nothing happens. When the argument is two or more,
33053 the binary function @var{func} is reduced across the top @var{arg}
33054 stack elements; when the argument is negative, the function is
33055 mapped between the next-to-top @mathit{-@var{arg}} stack elements and the
33056 top element.
33057 @end defun
33058
33059 @defun calc-stack-size
33060 Return the number of elements on the stack as an integer. This count
33061 does not include elements that have been temporarily hidden by stack
33062 truncation; @pxref{Truncating the Stack}.
33063 @end defun
33064
33065 @defun calc-cursor-stack-index n
33066 Move the point to the @var{n}th stack entry. If @var{n} is zero, this
33067 will be the @samp{.} line. If @var{n} is from 1 to the current stack size,
33068 this will be the beginning of the first line of that stack entry's display.
33069 If line numbers are enabled, this will move to the first character of the
33070 line number, not the stack entry itself.
33071 @end defun
33072
33073 @defun calc-substack-height n
33074 Return the number of lines between the beginning of the @var{n}th stack
33075 entry and the bottom of the buffer. If @var{n} is zero, this
33076 will be one (assuming no stack truncation). If all stack entries are
33077 one line long (i.e., no matrices are displayed), the return value will
33078 be equal @var{n}+1 as long as @var{n} is in range. (Note that in Big
33079 mode, the return value includes the blank lines that separate stack
33080 entries.)
33081 @end defun
33082
33083 @defun calc-refresh
33084 Erase the @code{*Calculator*} buffer and reformat its contents from memory.
33085 This must be called after changing any parameter, such as the current
33086 display radix, which might change the appearance of existing stack
33087 entries. (During a keyboard macro invoked by the @kbd{X} key, refreshing
33088 is suppressed, but a flag is set so that the entire stack will be refreshed
33089 rather than just the top few elements when the macro finishes.)
33090 @end defun
33091
33092 @node Predicates, Computational Lisp Functions, Stack Lisp Functions, Internals
33093 @subsubsection Predicates
33094
33095 @noindent
33096 The functions described here are predicates, that is, they return a
33097 true/false value where @code{nil} means false and anything else means
33098 true. These predicates are expanded by @code{defmath}, for example,
33099 from @code{zerop} to @code{math-zerop}. In many cases they correspond
33100 to native Lisp functions by the same name, but are extended to cover
33101 the full range of Calc data types.
33102
33103 @defun zerop x
33104 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically zero, in any of the Calc data
33105 types. (Note that for some types, such as error forms and intervals,
33106 it never makes sense to return true.) In @code{defmath}, the expression
33107 @samp{(= x 0)} will automatically be converted to @samp{(math-zerop x)},
33108 and @samp{(/= x 0)} will be converted to @samp{(not (math-zerop x))}.
33109 @end defun
33110
33111 @defun negp x
33112 Returns true if @var{x} is negative. This accepts negative real numbers
33113 of various types, negative HMS and date forms, and intervals in which
33114 all included values are negative. In @code{defmath}, the expression
33115 @samp{(< x 0)} will automatically be converted to @samp{(math-negp x)},
33116 and @samp{(>= x 0)} will be converted to @samp{(not (math-negp x))}.
33117 @end defun
33118
33119 @defun posp x
33120 Returns true if @var{x} is positive (and non-zero). For complex
33121 numbers, none of these three predicates will return true.
33122 @end defun
33123
33124 @defun looks-negp x
33125 Returns true if @var{x} is ``negative-looking.'' This returns true if
33126 @var{x} is a negative number, or a formula with a leading minus sign
33127 such as @samp{-a/b}. In other words, this is an object which can be
33128 made simpler by calling @code{(- @var{x})}.
33129 @end defun
33130
33131 @defun integerp x
33132 Returns true if @var{x} is an integer of any size.
33133 @end defun
33134
33135 @defun fixnump x
33136 Returns true if @var{x} is a native Lisp integer.
33137 @end defun
33138
33139 @defun natnump x
33140 Returns true if @var{x} is a nonnegative integer of any size.
33141 @end defun
33142
33143 @defun fixnatnump x
33144 Returns true if @var{x} is a nonnegative Lisp integer.
33145 @end defun
33146
33147 @defun num-integerp x
33148 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically an integer, i.e., either a
33149 true integer or a float with no significant digits to the right of
33150 the decimal point.
33151 @end defun
33152
33153 @defun messy-integerp x
33154 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically, but not literally, an integer.
33155 A value is @code{num-integerp} if it is @code{integerp} or
33156 @code{messy-integerp} (but it is never both at once).
33157 @end defun
33158
33159 @defun num-natnump x
33160 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically a nonnegative integer.
33161 @end defun
33162
33163 @defun evenp x
33164 Returns true if @var{x} is an even integer.
33165 @end defun
33166
33167 @defun looks-evenp x
33168 Returns true if @var{x} is an even integer, or a formula with a leading
33169 multiplicative coefficient which is an even integer.
33170 @end defun
33171
33172 @defun oddp x
33173 Returns true if @var{x} is an odd integer.
33174 @end defun
33175
33176 @defun ratp x
33177 Returns true if @var{x} is a rational number, i.e., an integer or a
33178 fraction.
33179 @end defun
33180
33181 @defun realp x
33182 Returns true if @var{x} is a real number, i.e., an integer, fraction,
33183 or floating-point number.
33184 @end defun
33185
33186 @defun anglep x
33187 Returns true if @var{x} is a real number or HMS form.
33188 @end defun
33189
33190 @defun floatp x
33191 Returns true if @var{x} is a float, or a complex number, error form,
33192 interval, date form, or modulo form in which at least one component
33193 is a float.
33194 @end defun
33195
33196 @defun complexp x
33197 Returns true if @var{x} is a rectangular or polar complex number
33198 (but not a real number).
33199 @end defun
33200
33201 @defun rect-complexp x
33202 Returns true if @var{x} is a rectangular complex number.
33203 @end defun
33204
33205 @defun polar-complexp x
33206 Returns true if @var{x} is a polar complex number.
33207 @end defun
33208
33209 @defun numberp x
33210 Returns true if @var{x} is a real number or a complex number.
33211 @end defun
33212
33213 @defun scalarp x
33214 Returns true if @var{x} is a real or complex number or an HMS form.
33215 @end defun
33216
33217 @defun vectorp x
33218 Returns true if @var{x} is a vector (this simply checks if its argument
33219 is a list whose first element is the symbol @code{vec}).
33220 @end defun
33221
33222 @defun numvecp x
33223 Returns true if @var{x} is a number or vector.
33224 @end defun
33225
33226 @defun matrixp x
33227 Returns true if @var{x} is a matrix, i.e., a vector of one or more vectors,
33228 all of the same size.
33229 @end defun
33230
33231 @defun square-matrixp x
33232 Returns true if @var{x} is a square matrix.
33233 @end defun
33234
33235 @defun objectp x
33236 Returns true if @var{x} is any numeric Calc object, including real and
33237 complex numbers, HMS forms, date forms, error forms, intervals, and
33238 modulo forms. (Note that error forms and intervals may include formulas
33239 as their components; see @code{constp} below.)
33240 @end defun
33241
33242 @defun objvecp x
33243 Returns true if @var{x} is an object or a vector. This also accepts
33244 incomplete objects, but it rejects variables and formulas (except as
33245 mentioned above for @code{objectp}).
33246 @end defun
33247
33248 @defun primp x
33249 Returns true if @var{x} is a ``primitive'' or ``atomic'' Calc object,
33250 i.e., one whose components cannot be regarded as sub-formulas. This
33251 includes variables, and all @code{objectp} types except error forms
33252 and intervals.
33253 @end defun
33254
33255 @defun constp x
33256 Returns true if @var{x} is constant, i.e., a real or complex number,
33257 HMS form, date form, or error form, interval, or vector all of whose
33258 components are @code{constp}.
33259 @end defun
33260
33261 @defun lessp x y
33262 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically less than @var{y}. Returns false
33263 if @var{x} is greater than or equal to @var{y}, or if the order is
33264 undefined or cannot be determined. Generally speaking, this works
33265 by checking whether @samp{@var{x} - @var{y}} is @code{negp}. In
33266 @code{defmath}, the expression @samp{(< x y)} will automatically be
33267 converted to @samp{(lessp x y)}; expressions involving @code{>}, @code{<=},
33268 and @code{>=} are similarly converted in terms of @code{lessp}.
33269 @end defun
33270
33271 @defun beforep x y
33272 Returns true if @var{x} comes before @var{y} in a canonical ordering
33273 of Calc objects. If @var{x} and @var{y} are both real numbers, this
33274 will be the same as @code{lessp}. But whereas @code{lessp} considers
33275 other types of objects to be unordered, @code{beforep} puts any two
33276 objects into a definite, consistent order. The @code{beforep}
33277 function is used by the @kbd{V S} vector-sorting command, and also
33278 by @kbd{a s} to put the terms of a product into canonical order:
33279 This allows @samp{x y + y x} to be simplified easily to @samp{2 x y}.
33280 @end defun
33281
33282 @defun equal x y
33283 This is the standard Lisp @code{equal} predicate; it returns true if
33284 @var{x} and @var{y} are structurally identical. This is the usual way
33285 to compare numbers for equality, but note that @code{equal} will treat
33286 0 and 0.0 as different.
33287 @end defun
33288
33289 @defun math-equal x y
33290 Returns true if @var{x} and @var{y} are numerically equal, either because
33291 they are @code{equal}, or because their difference is @code{zerop}. In
33292 @code{defmath}, the expression @samp{(= x y)} will automatically be
33293 converted to @samp{(math-equal x y)}.
33294 @end defun
33295
33296 @defun equal-int x n
33297 Returns true if @var{x} and @var{n} are numerically equal, where @var{n}
33298 is a fixnum which is not a multiple of 10. This will automatically be
33299 used by @code{defmath} in place of the more general @code{math-equal}
33300 whenever possible.
33301 @end defun
33302
33303 @defun nearly-equal x y
33304 Returns true if @var{x} and @var{y}, as floating-point numbers, are
33305 equal except possibly in the last decimal place. For example,
33306 314.159 and 314.166 are considered nearly equal if the current
33307 precision is 6 (since they differ by 7 units), but not if the current
33308 precision is 7 (since they differ by 70 units). Most functions which
33309 use series expansions use @code{with-extra-prec} to evaluate the
33310 series with 2 extra digits of precision, then use @code{nearly-equal}
33311 to decide when the series has converged; this guards against cumulative
33312 error in the series evaluation without doing extra work which would be
33313 lost when the result is rounded back down to the current precision.
33314 In @code{defmath}, this can be written @samp{(~= @var{x} @var{y})}.
33315 The @var{x} and @var{y} can be numbers of any kind, including complex.
33316 @end defun
33317
33318 @defun nearly-zerop x y
33319 Returns true if @var{x} is nearly zero, compared to @var{y}. This
33320 checks whether @var{x} plus @var{y} would by be @code{nearly-equal}
33321 to @var{y} itself, to within the current precision, in other words,
33322 if adding @var{x} to @var{y} would have a negligible effect on @var{y}
33323 due to roundoff error. @var{X} may be a real or complex number, but
33324 @var{y} must be real.
33325 @end defun
33326
33327 @defun is-true x
33328 Return true if the formula @var{x} represents a true value in
33329 Calc, not Lisp, terms. It tests if @var{x} is a non-zero number
33330 or a provably non-zero formula.
33331 @end defun
33332
33333 @defun reject-arg val pred
33334 Abort the current function evaluation due to unacceptable argument values.
33335 This calls @samp{(calc-record-why @var{pred} @var{val})}, then signals a
33336 Lisp error which @code{normalize} will trap. The net effect is that the
33337 function call which led here will be left in symbolic form.
33338 @end defun
33339
33340 @defun inexact-value
33341 If Symbolic mode is enabled, this will signal an error that causes
33342 @code{normalize} to leave the formula in symbolic form, with the message
33343 ``Inexact result.'' (This function has no effect when not in Symbolic mode.)
33344 Note that if your function calls @samp{(sin 5)} in Symbolic mode, the
33345 @code{sin} function will call @code{inexact-value}, which will cause your
33346 function to be left unsimplified. You may instead wish to call
33347 @samp{(normalize (list 'calcFunc-sin 5))}, which in Symbolic mode will
33348 return the formula @samp{sin(5)} to your function.
33349 @end defun
33350
33351 @defun overflow
33352 This signals an error that will be reported as a floating-point overflow.
33353 @end defun
33354
33355 @defun underflow
33356 This signals a floating-point underflow.
33357 @end defun
33358
33359 @node Computational Lisp Functions, Vector Lisp Functions, Predicates, Internals
33360 @subsubsection Computational Functions
33361
33362 @noindent
33363 The functions described here do the actual computational work of the
33364 Calculator. In addition to these, note that any function described in
33365 the main body of this manual may be called from Lisp; for example, if
33366 the documentation refers to the @code{calc-sqrt} [@code{sqrt}] command,
33367 this means @code{calc-sqrt} is an interactive stack-based square-root
33368 command and @code{sqrt} (which @code{defmath} expands to @code{calcFunc-sqrt})
33369 is the actual Lisp function for taking square roots.
33370
33371 The functions @code{math-add}, @code{math-sub}, @code{math-mul},
33372 @code{math-div}, @code{math-mod}, and @code{math-neg} are not included
33373 in this list, since @code{defmath} allows you to write native Lisp
33374 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}, and unary @code{-},
33375 respectively, instead.
33376
33377 @defun normalize val
33378 (Full form: @code{math-normalize}.)
33379 Reduce the value @var{val} to standard form. For example, if @var{val}
33380 is a fixnum, it will be converted to a bignum if it is too large, and
33381 if @var{val} is a bignum it will be normalized by clipping off trailing
33382 (i.e., most-significant) zero digits and converting to a fixnum if it is
33383 small. All the various data types are similarly converted to their standard
33384 forms. Variables are left alone, but function calls are actually evaluated
33385 in formulas. For example, normalizing @samp{(+ 2 (calcFunc-abs -4))} will
33386 return 6.
33387
33388 If a function call fails, because the function is void or has the wrong
33389 number of parameters, or because it returns @code{nil} or calls
33390 @code{reject-arg} or @code{inexact-result}, @code{normalize} returns
33391 the formula still in symbolic form.
33392
33393 If the current simplification mode is ``none'' or ``numeric arguments
33394 only,'' @code{normalize} will act appropriately. However, the more
33395 powerful simplification modes (like Algebraic Simplification) are
33396 not handled by @code{normalize}. They are handled by @code{calc-normalize},
33397 which calls @code{normalize} and possibly some other routines, such
33398 as @code{simplify} or @code{simplify-units}. Programs generally will
33399 never call @code{calc-normalize} except when popping or pushing values
33400 on the stack.
33401 @end defun
33402
33403 @defun evaluate-expr expr
33404 Replace all variables in @var{expr} that have values with their values,
33405 then use @code{normalize} to simplify the result. This is what happens
33406 when you press the @kbd{=} key interactively.
33407 @end defun
33408
33409 @defmac with-extra-prec n body
33410 Evaluate the Lisp forms in @var{body} with precision increased by @var{n}
33411 digits. This is a macro which expands to
33412
33413 @smallexample
33414 (math-normalize
33415 (let ((calc-internal-prec (+ calc-internal-prec @var{n})))
33416 @var{body}))
33417 @end smallexample
33418
33419 The surrounding call to @code{math-normalize} causes a floating-point
33420 result to be rounded down to the original precision afterwards. This
33421 is important because some arithmetic operations assume a number's
33422 mantissa contains no more digits than the current precision allows.
33423 @end defmac
33424
33425 @defun make-frac n d
33426 Build a fraction @samp{@var{n}:@var{d}}. This is equivalent to calling
33427 @samp{(normalize (list 'frac @var{n} @var{d}))}, but more efficient.
33428 @end defun
33429
33430 @defun make-float mant exp
33431 Build a floating-point value out of @var{mant} and @var{exp}, both
33432 of which are arbitrary integers. This function will return a
33433 properly normalized float value, or signal an overflow or underflow
33434 if @var{exp} is out of range.
33435 @end defun
33436
33437 @defun make-sdev x sigma
33438 Build an error form out of @var{x} and the absolute value of @var{sigma}.
33439 If @var{sigma} is zero, the result is the number @var{x} directly.
33440 If @var{sigma} is negative or complex, its absolute value is used.
33441 If @var{x} or @var{sigma} is not a valid type of object for use in
33442 error forms, this calls @code{reject-arg}.
33443 @end defun
33444
33445 @defun make-intv mask lo hi
33446 Build an interval form out of @var{mask} (which is assumed to be an
33447 integer from 0 to 3), and the limits @var{lo} and @var{hi}. If
33448 @var{lo} is greater than @var{hi}, an empty interval form is returned.
33449 This calls @code{reject-arg} if @var{lo} or @var{hi} is unsuitable.
33450 @end defun
33451
33452 @defun sort-intv mask lo hi
33453 Build an interval form, similar to @code{make-intv}, except that if
33454 @var{lo} is less than @var{hi} they are simply exchanged, and the
33455 bits of @var{mask} are swapped accordingly.
33456 @end defun
33457
33458 @defun make-mod n m
33459 Build a modulo form out of @var{n} and the modulus @var{m}. Since modulo
33460 forms do not allow formulas as their components, if @var{n} or @var{m}
33461 is not a real number or HMS form the result will be a formula which
33462 is a call to @code{makemod}, the algebraic version of this function.
33463 @end defun
33464
33465 @defun float x
33466 Convert @var{x} to floating-point form. Integers and fractions are
33467 converted to numerically equivalent floats; components of complex
33468 numbers, vectors, HMS forms, date forms, error forms, intervals, and
33469 modulo forms are recursively floated. If the argument is a variable
33470 or formula, this calls @code{reject-arg}.
33471 @end defun
33472
33473 @defun compare x y
33474 Compare the numbers @var{x} and @var{y}, and return @mathit{-1} if
33475 @samp{(lessp @var{x} @var{y})}, 1 if @samp{(lessp @var{y} @var{x})},
33476 0 if @samp{(math-equal @var{x} @var{y})}, or 2 if the order is
33477 undefined or cannot be determined.
33478 @end defun
33479
33480 @defun numdigs n
33481 Return the number of digits of integer @var{n}, effectively
33482 @samp{ceil(log10(@var{n}))}, but much more efficient. Zero is
33483 considered to have zero digits.
33484 @end defun
33485
33486 @defun scale-int x n
33487 Shift integer @var{x} left @var{n} decimal digits, or right @mathit{-@var{n}}
33488 digits with truncation toward zero.
33489 @end defun
33490
33491 @defun scale-rounding x n
33492 Like @code{scale-int}, except that a right shift rounds to the nearest
33493 integer rather than truncating.
33494 @end defun
33495
33496 @defun fixnum n
33497 Return the integer @var{n} as a fixnum, i.e., a native Lisp integer.
33498 If @var{n} is outside the permissible range for Lisp integers (usually
33499 24 binary bits) the result is undefined.
33500 @end defun
33501
33502 @defun sqr x
33503 Compute the square of @var{x}; short for @samp{(* @var{x} @var{x})}.
33504 @end defun
33505
33506 @defun quotient x y
33507 Divide integer @var{x} by integer @var{y}; return an integer quotient
33508 and discard the remainder. If @var{x} or @var{y} is negative, the
33509 direction of rounding is undefined.
33510 @end defun
33511
33512 @defun idiv x y
33513 Perform an integer division; if @var{x} and @var{y} are both nonnegative
33514 integers, this uses the @code{quotient} function, otherwise it computes
33515 @samp{floor(@var{x}/@var{y})}. Thus the result is well-defined but
33516 slower than for @code{quotient}.
33517 @end defun
33518
33519 @defun imod x y
33520 Divide integer @var{x} by integer @var{y}; return the integer remainder
33521 and discard the quotient. Like @code{quotient}, this works only for
33522 integer arguments and is not well-defined for negative arguments.
33523 For a more well-defined result, use @samp{(% @var{x} @var{y})}.
33524 @end defun
33525
33526 @defun idivmod x y
33527 Divide integer @var{x} by integer @var{y}; return a cons cell whose
33528 @code{car} is @samp{(quotient @var{x} @var{y})} and whose @code{cdr}
33529 is @samp{(imod @var{x} @var{y})}.
33530 @end defun
33531
33532 @defun pow x y
33533 Compute @var{x} to the power @var{y}. In @code{defmath} code, this can
33534 also be written @samp{(^ @var{x} @var{y})} or
33535 @w{@samp{(expt @var{x} @var{y})}}.
33536 @end defun
33537
33538 @defun abs-approx x
33539 Compute a fast approximation to the absolute value of @var{x}. For
33540 example, for a rectangular complex number the result is the sum of
33541 the absolute values of the components.
33542 @end defun
33543
33544 @findex e
33545 @findex gamma-const
33546 @findex ln-2
33547 @findex ln-10
33548 @findex phi
33549 @findex pi-over-2
33550 @findex pi-over-4
33551 @findex pi-over-180
33552 @findex sqrt-two-pi
33553 @findex sqrt-e
33554 @findex two-pi
33555 @defun pi
33556 The function @samp{(pi)} computes @samp{pi} to the current precision.
33557 Other related constant-generating functions are @code{two-pi},
33558 @code{pi-over-2}, @code{pi-over-4}, @code{pi-over-180}, @code{sqrt-two-pi},
33559 @code{e}, @code{sqrt-e}, @code{ln-2}, @code{ln-10}, @code{phi} and
33560 @code{gamma-const}. Each function returns a floating-point value in the
33561 current precision, and each uses caching so that all calls after the
33562 first are essentially free.
33563 @end defun
33564
33565 @defmac math-defcache @var{func} @var{initial} @var{form}
33566 This macro, usually used as a top-level call like @code{defun} or
33567 @code{defvar}, defines a new cached constant analogous to @code{pi}, etc.
33568 It defines a function @code{func} which returns the requested value;
33569 if @var{initial} is non-@code{nil} it must be a @samp{(float @dots{})}
33570 form which serves as an initial value for the cache. If @var{func}
33571 is called when the cache is empty or does not have enough digits to
33572 satisfy the current precision, the Lisp expression @var{form} is evaluated
33573 with the current precision increased by four, and the result minus its
33574 two least significant digits is stored in the cache. For example,
33575 calling @samp{(pi)} with a precision of 30 computes @samp{pi} to 34
33576 digits, rounds it down to 32 digits for future use, then rounds it
33577 again to 30 digits for use in the present request.
33578 @end defmac
33579
33580 @findex half-circle
33581 @findex quarter-circle
33582 @defun full-circle symb
33583 If the current angular mode is Degrees or HMS, this function returns the
33584 integer 360. In Radians mode, this function returns either the
33585 corresponding value in radians to the current precision, or the formula
33586 @samp{2*pi}, depending on the Symbolic mode. There are also similar
33587 function @code{half-circle} and @code{quarter-circle}.
33588 @end defun
33589
33590 @defun power-of-2 n
33591 Compute two to the integer power @var{n}, as a (potentially very large)
33592 integer. Powers of two are cached, so only the first call for a
33593 particular @var{n} is expensive.
33594 @end defun
33595
33596 @defun integer-log2 n
33597 Compute the base-2 logarithm of @var{n}, which must be an integer which
33598 is a power of two. If @var{n} is not a power of two, this function will
33599 return @code{nil}.
33600 @end defun
33601
33602 @defun div-mod a b m
33603 Divide @var{a} by @var{b}, modulo @var{m}. This returns @code{nil} if
33604 there is no solution, or if any of the arguments are not integers.
33605 @end defun
33606
33607 @defun pow-mod a b m
33608 Compute @var{a} to the power @var{b}, modulo @var{m}. If @var{a},
33609 @var{b}, and @var{m} are integers, this uses an especially efficient
33610 algorithm. Otherwise, it simply computes @samp{(% (^ a b) m)}.
33611 @end defun
33612
33613 @defun isqrt n
33614 Compute the integer square root of @var{n}. This is the square root
33615 of @var{n} rounded down toward zero, i.e., @samp{floor(sqrt(@var{n}))}.
33616 If @var{n} is itself an integer, the computation is especially efficient.
33617 @end defun
33618
33619 @defun to-hms a ang
33620 Convert the argument @var{a} into an HMS form. If @var{ang} is specified,
33621 it is the angular mode in which to interpret @var{a}, either @code{deg}
33622 or @code{rad}. Otherwise, the current angular mode is used. If @var{a}
33623 is already an HMS form it is returned as-is.
33624 @end defun
33625
33626 @defun from-hms a ang
33627 Convert the HMS form @var{a} into a real number. If @var{ang} is specified,
33628 it is the angular mode in which to express the result, otherwise the
33629 current angular mode is used. If @var{a} is already a real number, it
33630 is returned as-is.
33631 @end defun
33632
33633 @defun to-radians a
33634 Convert the number or HMS form @var{a} to radians from the current
33635 angular mode.
33636 @end defun
33637
33638 @defun from-radians a
33639 Convert the number @var{a} from radians to the current angular mode.
33640 If @var{a} is a formula, this returns the formula @samp{deg(@var{a})}.
33641 @end defun
33642
33643 @defun to-radians-2 a
33644 Like @code{to-radians}, except that in Symbolic mode a degrees to
33645 radians conversion yields a formula like @samp{@var{a}*pi/180}.
33646 @end defun
33647
33648 @defun from-radians-2 a
33649 Like @code{from-radians}, except that in Symbolic mode a radians to
33650 degrees conversion yields a formula like @samp{@var{a}*180/pi}.
33651 @end defun
33652
33653 @defun random-digit
33654 Produce a random base-1000 digit in the range 0 to 999.
33655 @end defun
33656
33657 @defun random-digits n
33658 Produce a random @var{n}-digit integer; this will be an integer
33659 in the interval @samp{[0, 10^@var{n})}.
33660 @end defun
33661
33662 @defun random-float
33663 Produce a random float in the interval @samp{[0, 1)}.
33664 @end defun
33665
33666 @defun prime-test n iters
33667 Determine whether the integer @var{n} is prime. Return a list which has
33668 one of these forms: @samp{(nil @var{f})} means the number is non-prime
33669 because it was found to be divisible by @var{f}; @samp{(nil)} means it
33670 was found to be non-prime by table look-up (so no factors are known);
33671 @samp{(nil unknown)} means it is definitely non-prime but no factors
33672 are known because @var{n} was large enough that Fermat's probabilistic
33673 test had to be used; @samp{(t)} means the number is definitely prime;
33674 and @samp{(maybe @var{i} @var{p})} means that Fermat's test, after @var{i}
33675 iterations, is @var{p} percent sure that the number is prime. The
33676 @var{iters} parameter is the number of Fermat iterations to use, in the
33677 case that this is necessary. If @code{prime-test} returns ``maybe,''
33678 you can call it again with the same @var{n} to get a greater certainty;
33679 @code{prime-test} remembers where it left off.
33680 @end defun
33681
33682 @defun to-simple-fraction f
33683 If @var{f} is a floating-point number which can be represented exactly
33684 as a small rational number. return that number, else return @var{f}.
33685 For example, 0.75 would be converted to 3:4. This function is very
33686 fast.
33687 @end defun
33688
33689 @defun to-fraction f tol
33690 Find a rational approximation to floating-point number @var{f} to within
33691 a specified tolerance @var{tol}; this corresponds to the algebraic
33692 function @code{frac}, and can be rather slow.
33693 @end defun
33694
33695 @defun quarter-integer n
33696 If @var{n} is an integer or integer-valued float, this function
33697 returns zero. If @var{n} is a half-integer (i.e., an integer plus
33698 @mathit{1:2} or 0.5), it returns 2. If @var{n} is a quarter-integer,
33699 it returns 1 or 3. If @var{n} is anything else, this function
33700 returns @code{nil}.
33701 @end defun
33702
33703 @node Vector Lisp Functions, Symbolic Lisp Functions, Computational Lisp Functions, Internals
33704 @subsubsection Vector Functions
33705
33706 @noindent
33707 The functions described here perform various operations on vectors and
33708 matrices.
33709
33710 @defun math-concat x y
33711 Do a vector concatenation; this operation is written @samp{@var{x} | @var{y}}
33712 in a symbolic formula. @xref{Building Vectors}.
33713 @end defun
33714
33715 @defun vec-length v
33716 Return the length of vector @var{v}. If @var{v} is not a vector, the
33717 result is zero. If @var{v} is a matrix, this returns the number of
33718 rows in the matrix.
33719 @end defun
33720
33721 @defun mat-dimens m
33722 Determine the dimensions of vector or matrix @var{m}. If @var{m} is not
33723 a vector, the result is an empty list. If @var{m} is a plain vector
33724 but not a matrix, the result is a one-element list containing the length
33725 of the vector. If @var{m} is a matrix with @var{r} rows and @var{c} columns,
33726 the result is the list @samp{(@var{r} @var{c})}. Higher-order tensors
33727 produce lists of more than two dimensions. Note that the object
33728 @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5]]} is a vector of vectors not all the same size,
33729 and is treated by this and other Calc routines as a plain vector of two
33730 elements.
33731 @end defun
33732
33733 @defun dimension-error
33734 Abort the current function with a message of ``Dimension error.''
33735 The Calculator will leave the function being evaluated in symbolic
33736 form; this is really just a special case of @code{reject-arg}.
33737 @end defun
33738
33739 @defun build-vector args
33740 Return a Calc vector with @var{args} as elements.
33741 For example, @samp{(build-vector 1 2 3)} returns the Calc vector
33742 @samp{[1, 2, 3]}, stored internally as the list @samp{(vec 1 2 3)}.
33743 @end defun
33744
33745 @defun make-vec obj dims
33746 Return a Calc vector or matrix all of whose elements are equal to
33747 @var{obj}. For example, @samp{(make-vec 27 3 4)} returns a 3x4 matrix
33748 filled with 27's.
33749 @end defun
33750
33751 @defun row-matrix v
33752 If @var{v} is a plain vector, convert it into a row matrix, i.e.,
33753 a matrix whose single row is @var{v}. If @var{v} is already a matrix,
33754 leave it alone.
33755 @end defun
33756
33757 @defun col-matrix v
33758 If @var{v} is a plain vector, convert it into a column matrix, i.e., a
33759 matrix with each element of @var{v} as a separate row. If @var{v} is
33760 already a matrix, leave it alone.
33761 @end defun
33762
33763 @defun map-vec f v
33764 Map the Lisp function @var{f} over the Calc vector @var{v}. For example,
33765 @samp{(map-vec 'math-floor v)} returns a vector of the floored components
33766 of vector @var{v}.
33767 @end defun
33768
33769 @defun map-vec-2 f a b
33770 Map the Lisp function @var{f} over the two vectors @var{a} and @var{b}.
33771 If @var{a} and @var{b} are vectors of equal length, the result is a
33772 vector of the results of calling @samp{(@var{f} @var{ai} @var{bi})}
33773 for each pair of elements @var{ai} and @var{bi}. If either @var{a} or
33774 @var{b} is a scalar, it is matched with each value of the other vector.
33775 For example, @samp{(map-vec-2 'math-add v 1)} returns the vector @var{v}
33776 with each element increased by one. Note that using @samp{'+} would not
33777 work here, since @code{defmath} does not expand function names everywhere,
33778 just where they are in the function position of a Lisp expression.
33779 @end defun
33780
33781 @defun reduce-vec f v
33782 Reduce the function @var{f} over the vector @var{v}. For example, if
33783 @var{v} is @samp{[10, 20, 30, 40]}, this calls @samp{(f (f (f 10 20) 30) 40)}.
33784 If @var{v} is a matrix, this reduces over the rows of @var{v}.
33785 @end defun
33786
33787 @defun reduce-cols f m
33788 Reduce the function @var{f} over the columns of matrix @var{m}. For
33789 example, if @var{m} is @samp{[[1, 2], [3, 4], [5, 6]]}, the result
33790 is a vector of the two elements @samp{(f (f 1 3) 5)} and @samp{(f (f 2 4) 6)}.
33791 @end defun
33792
33793 @defun mat-row m n
33794 Return the @var{n}th row of matrix @var{m}. This is equivalent to
33795 @samp{(elt m n)}. For a slower but safer version, use @code{mrow}.
33796 (@xref{Extracting Elements}.)
33797 @end defun
33798
33799 @defun mat-col m n
33800 Return the @var{n}th column of matrix @var{m}, in the form of a vector.
33801 The arguments are not checked for correctness.
33802 @end defun
33803
33804 @defun mat-less-row m n
33805 Return a copy of matrix @var{m} with its @var{n}th row deleted. The
33806 number @var{n} must be in range from 1 to the number of rows in @var{m}.
33807 @end defun
33808
33809 @defun mat-less-col m n
33810 Return a copy of matrix @var{m} with its @var{n}th column deleted.
33811 @end defun
33812
33813 @defun transpose m
33814 Return the transpose of matrix @var{m}.
33815 @end defun
33816
33817 @defun flatten-vector v
33818 Flatten nested vector @var{v} into a vector of scalars. For example,
33819 if @var{v} is @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5]]} the result is @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4, 5]}.
33820 @end defun
33821
33822 @defun copy-matrix m
33823 If @var{m} is a matrix, return a copy of @var{m}. This maps
33824 @code{copy-sequence} over the rows of @var{m}; in Lisp terms, each
33825 element of the result matrix will be @code{eq} to the corresponding
33826 element of @var{m}, but none of the @code{cons} cells that make up
33827 the structure of the matrix will be @code{eq}. If @var{m} is a plain
33828 vector, this is the same as @code{copy-sequence}.
33829 @end defun
33830
33831 @defun swap-rows m r1 r2
33832 Exchange rows @var{r1} and @var{r2} of matrix @var{m} in-place. In
33833 other words, unlike most of the other functions described here, this
33834 function changes @var{m} itself rather than building up a new result
33835 matrix. The return value is @var{m}, i.e., @samp{(eq (swap-rows m 1 2) m)}
33836 is true, with the side effect of exchanging the first two rows of
33837 @var{m}.
33838 @end defun
33839
33840 @node Symbolic Lisp Functions, Formatting Lisp Functions, Vector Lisp Functions, Internals
33841 @subsubsection Symbolic Functions
33842
33843 @noindent
33844 The functions described here operate on symbolic formulas in the
33845 Calculator.
33846
33847 @defun calc-prepare-selection num
33848 Prepare a stack entry for selection operations. If @var{num} is
33849 omitted, the stack entry containing the cursor is used; otherwise,
33850 it is the number of the stack entry to use. This function stores
33851 useful information about the current stack entry into a set of
33852 variables. @code{calc-selection-cache-num} contains the number of
33853 the stack entry involved (equal to @var{num} if you specified it);
33854 @code{calc-selection-cache-entry} contains the stack entry as a
33855 list (such as @code{calc-top-list} would return with @code{entry}
33856 as the selection mode); and @code{calc-selection-cache-comp} contains
33857 a special ``tagged'' composition (@pxref{Formatting Lisp Functions})
33858 which allows Calc to relate cursor positions in the buffer with
33859 their corresponding sub-formulas.
33860
33861 A slight complication arises in the selection mechanism because
33862 formulas may contain small integers. For example, in the vector
33863 @samp{[1, 2, 1]} the first and last elements are @code{eq} to each
33864 other; selections are recorded as the actual Lisp object that
33865 appears somewhere in the tree of the whole formula, but storing
33866 @code{1} would falsely select both @code{1}'s in the vector. So
33867 @code{calc-prepare-selection} also checks the stack entry and
33868 replaces any plain integers with ``complex number'' lists of the form
33869 @samp{(cplx @var{n} 0)}. This list will be displayed the same as a
33870 plain @var{n} and the change will be completely invisible to the
33871 user, but it will guarantee that no two sub-formulas of the stack
33872 entry will be @code{eq} to each other. Next time the stack entry
33873 is involved in a computation, @code{calc-normalize} will replace
33874 these lists with plain numbers again, again invisibly to the user.
33875 @end defun
33876
33877 @defun calc-encase-atoms x
33878 This modifies the formula @var{x} to ensure that each part of the
33879 formula is a unique atom, using the @samp{(cplx @var{n} 0)} trick
33880 described above. This function may use @code{setcar} to modify
33881 the formula in-place.
33882 @end defun
33883
33884 @defun calc-find-selected-part
33885 Find the smallest sub-formula of the current formula that contains
33886 the cursor. This assumes @code{calc-prepare-selection} has been
33887 called already. If the cursor is not actually on any part of the
33888 formula, this returns @code{nil}.
33889 @end defun
33890
33891 @defun calc-change-current-selection selection
33892 Change the currently prepared stack element's selection to
33893 @var{selection}, which should be @code{eq} to some sub-formula
33894 of the stack element, or @code{nil} to unselect the formula.
33895 The stack element's appearance in the Calc buffer is adjusted
33896 to reflect the new selection.
33897 @end defun
33898
33899 @defun calc-find-nth-part expr n
33900 Return the @var{n}th sub-formula of @var{expr}. This function is used
33901 by the selection commands, and (unless @kbd{j b} has been used) treats
33902 sums and products as flat many-element formulas. Thus if @var{expr}
33903 is @samp{((a + b) - c) + d}, calling @code{calc-find-nth-part} with
33904 @var{n} equal to four will return @samp{d}.
33905 @end defun
33906
33907 @defun calc-find-parent-formula expr part
33908 Return the sub-formula of @var{expr} which immediately contains
33909 @var{part}. If @var{expr} is @samp{a*b + (c+1)*d} and @var{part}
33910 is @code{eq} to the @samp{c+1} term of @var{expr}, then this function
33911 will return @samp{(c+1)*d}. If @var{part} turns out not to be a
33912 sub-formula of @var{expr}, the function returns @code{nil}. If
33913 @var{part} is @code{eq} to @var{expr}, the function returns @code{t}.
33914 This function does not take associativity into account.
33915 @end defun
33916
33917 @defun calc-find-assoc-parent-formula expr part
33918 This is the same as @code{calc-find-parent-formula}, except that
33919 (unless @kbd{j b} has been used) it continues widening the selection
33920 to contain a complete level of the formula. Given @samp{a} from
33921 @samp{((a + b) - c) + d}, @code{calc-find-parent-formula} will
33922 return @samp{a + b} but @code{calc-find-assoc-parent-formula} will
33923 return the whole expression.
33924 @end defun
33925
33926 @defun calc-grow-assoc-formula expr part
33927 This expands sub-formula @var{part} of @var{expr} to encompass a
33928 complete level of the formula. If @var{part} and its immediate
33929 parent are not compatible associative operators, or if @kbd{j b}
33930 has been used, this simply returns @var{part}.
33931 @end defun
33932
33933 @defun calc-find-sub-formula expr part
33934 This finds the immediate sub-formula of @var{expr} which contains
33935 @var{part}. It returns an index @var{n} such that
33936 @samp{(calc-find-nth-part @var{expr} @var{n})} would return @var{part}.
33937 If @var{part} is not a sub-formula of @var{expr}, it returns @code{nil}.
33938 If @var{part} is @code{eq} to @var{expr}, it returns @code{t}. This
33939 function does not take associativity into account.
33940 @end defun
33941
33942 @defun calc-replace-sub-formula expr old new
33943 This function returns a copy of formula @var{expr}, with the
33944 sub-formula that is @code{eq} to @var{old} replaced by @var{new}.
33945 @end defun
33946
33947 @defun simplify expr
33948 Simplify the expression @var{expr} by applying various algebraic rules.
33949 This is what the @w{@kbd{a s}} (@code{calc-simplify}) command uses. This
33950 always returns a copy of the expression; the structure @var{expr} points
33951 to remains unchanged in memory.
33952
33953 More precisely, here is what @code{simplify} does: The expression is
33954 first normalized and evaluated by calling @code{normalize}. If any
33955 @code{AlgSimpRules} have been defined, they are then applied. Then
33956 the expression is traversed in a depth-first, bottom-up fashion; at
33957 each level, any simplifications that can be made are made until no
33958 further changes are possible. Once the entire formula has been
33959 traversed in this way, it is compared with the original formula (from
33960 before the call to @code{normalize}) and, if it has changed,
33961 the entire procedure is repeated (starting with @code{normalize})
33962 until no further changes occur. Usually only two iterations are
33963 needed:@: one to simplify the formula, and another to verify that no
33964 further simplifications were possible.
33965 @end defun
33966
33967 @defun simplify-extended expr
33968 Simplify the expression @var{expr}, with additional rules enabled that
33969 help do a more thorough job, while not being entirely ``safe'' in all
33970 circumstances. (For example, this mode will simplify @samp{sqrt(x^2)}
33971 to @samp{x}, which is only valid when @var{x} is positive.) This is
33972 implemented by temporarily binding the variable @code{math-living-dangerously}
33973 to @code{t} (using a @code{let} form) and calling @code{simplify}.
33974 Dangerous simplification rules are written to check this variable
33975 before taking any action.
33976 @end defun
33977
33978 @defun simplify-units expr
33979 Simplify the expression @var{expr}, treating variable names as units
33980 whenever possible. This works by binding the variable
33981 @code{math-simplifying-units} to @code{t} while calling @code{simplify}.
33982 @end defun
33983
33984 @defmac math-defsimplify funcs body
33985 Register a new simplification rule; this is normally called as a top-level
33986 form, like @code{defun} or @code{defmath}. If @var{funcs} is a symbol
33987 (like @code{+} or @code{calcFunc-sqrt}), this simplification rule is
33988 applied to the formulas which are calls to the specified function. Or,
33989 @var{funcs} can be a list of such symbols; the rule applies to all
33990 functions on the list. The @var{body} is written like the body of a
33991 function with a single argument called @code{expr}. The body will be
33992 executed with @code{expr} bound to a formula which is a call to one of
33993 the functions @var{funcs}. If the function body returns @code{nil}, or
33994 if it returns a result @code{equal} to the original @code{expr}, it is
33995 ignored and Calc goes on to try the next simplification rule that applies.
33996 If the function body returns something different, that new formula is
33997 substituted for @var{expr} in the original formula.
33998
33999 At each point in the formula, rules are tried in the order of the
34000 original calls to @code{math-defsimplify}; the search stops after the
34001 first rule that makes a change. Thus later rules for that same
34002 function will not have a chance to trigger until the next iteration
34003 of the main @code{simplify} loop.
34004
34005 Note that, since @code{defmath} is not being used here, @var{body} must
34006 be written in true Lisp code without the conveniences that @code{defmath}
34007 provides. If you prefer, you can have @var{body} simply call another
34008 function (defined with @code{defmath}) which does the real work.
34009
34010 The arguments of a function call will already have been simplified
34011 before any rules for the call itself are invoked. Since a new argument
34012 list is consed up when this happens, this means that the rule's body is
34013 allowed to rearrange the function's arguments destructively if that is
34014 convenient. Here is a typical example of a simplification rule:
34015
34016 @smallexample
34017 (math-defsimplify calcFunc-arcsinh
34018 (or (and (math-looks-negp (nth 1 expr))
34019 (math-neg (list 'calcFunc-arcsinh
34020 (math-neg (nth 1 expr)))))
34021 (and (eq (car-safe (nth 1 expr)) 'calcFunc-sinh)
34022 (or math-living-dangerously
34023 (math-known-realp (nth 1 (nth 1 expr))))
34024 (nth 1 (nth 1 expr)))))
34025 @end smallexample
34026
34027 This is really a pair of rules written with one @code{math-defsimplify}
34028 for convenience; the first replaces @samp{arcsinh(-x)} with
34029 @samp{-arcsinh(x)}, and the second, which is safe only for real @samp{x},
34030 replaces @samp{arcsinh(sinh(x))} with @samp{x}.
34031 @end defmac
34032
34033 @defun common-constant-factor expr
34034 Check @var{expr} to see if it is a sum of terms all multiplied by the
34035 same rational value. If so, return this value. If not, return @code{nil}.
34036 For example, if called on @samp{6x + 9y + 12z}, it would return 3, since
34037 3 is a common factor of all the terms.
34038 @end defun
34039
34040 @defun cancel-common-factor expr factor
34041 Assuming @var{expr} is a sum with @var{factor} as a common factor,
34042 divide each term of the sum by @var{factor}. This is done by
34043 destructively modifying parts of @var{expr}, on the assumption that
34044 it is being used by a simplification rule (where such things are
34045 allowed; see above). For example, consider this built-in rule for
34046 square roots:
34047
34048 @smallexample
34049 (math-defsimplify calcFunc-sqrt
34050 (let ((fac (math-common-constant-factor (nth 1 expr))))
34051 (and fac (not (eq fac 1))
34052 (math-mul (math-normalize (list 'calcFunc-sqrt fac))
34053 (math-normalize
34054 (list 'calcFunc-sqrt
34055 (math-cancel-common-factor
34056 (nth 1 expr) fac)))))))
34057 @end smallexample
34058 @end defun
34059
34060 @defun frac-gcd a b
34061 Compute a ``rational GCD'' of @var{a} and @var{b}, which must both be
34062 rational numbers. This is the fraction composed of the GCD of the
34063 numerators of @var{a} and @var{b}, over the GCD of the denominators.
34064 It is used by @code{common-constant-factor}. Note that the standard
34065 @code{gcd} function uses the LCM to combine the denominators.
34066 @end defun
34067
34068 @defun map-tree func expr many
34069 Try applying Lisp function @var{func} to various sub-expressions of
34070 @var{expr}. Initially, call @var{func} with @var{expr} itself as an
34071 argument. If this returns an expression which is not @code{equal} to
34072 @var{expr}, apply @var{func} again until eventually it does return
34073 @var{expr} with no changes. Then, if @var{expr} is a function call,
34074 recursively apply @var{func} to each of the arguments. This keeps going
34075 until no changes occur anywhere in the expression; this final expression
34076 is returned by @code{map-tree}. Note that, unlike simplification rules,
34077 @var{func} functions may @emph{not} make destructive changes to
34078 @var{expr}. If a third argument @var{many} is provided, it is an
34079 integer which says how many times @var{func} may be applied; the
34080 default, as described above, is infinitely many times.
34081 @end defun
34082
34083 @defun compile-rewrites rules
34084 Compile the rewrite rule set specified by @var{rules}, which should
34085 be a formula that is either a vector or a variable name. If the latter,
34086 the compiled rules are saved so that later @code{compile-rules} calls
34087 for that same variable can return immediately. If there are problems
34088 with the rules, this function calls @code{error} with a suitable
34089 message.
34090 @end defun
34091
34092 @defun apply-rewrites expr crules heads
34093 Apply the compiled rewrite rule set @var{crules} to the expression
34094 @var{expr}. This will make only one rewrite and only checks at the
34095 top level of the expression. The result @code{nil} if no rules
34096 matched, or if the only rules that matched did not actually change
34097 the expression. The @var{heads} argument is optional; if is given,
34098 it should be a list of all function names that (may) appear in
34099 @var{expr}. The rewrite compiler tags each rule with the
34100 rarest-looking function name in the rule; if you specify @var{heads},
34101 @code{apply-rewrites} can use this information to narrow its search
34102 down to just a few rules in the rule set.
34103 @end defun
34104
34105 @defun rewrite-heads expr
34106 Compute a @var{heads} list for @var{expr} suitable for use with
34107 @code{apply-rewrites}, as discussed above.
34108 @end defun
34109
34110 @defun rewrite expr rules many
34111 This is an all-in-one rewrite function. It compiles the rule set
34112 specified by @var{rules}, then uses @code{map-tree} to apply the
34113 rules throughout @var{expr} up to @var{many} (default infinity)
34114 times.
34115 @end defun
34116
34117 @defun match-patterns pat vec not-flag
34118 Given a Calc vector @var{vec} and an uncompiled pattern set or
34119 pattern set variable @var{pat}, this function returns a new vector
34120 of all elements of @var{vec} which do (or don't, if @var{not-flag} is
34121 non-@code{nil}) match any of the patterns in @var{pat}.
34122 @end defun
34123
34124 @defun deriv expr var value symb
34125 Compute the derivative of @var{expr} with respect to variable @var{var}
34126 (which may actually be any sub-expression). If @var{value} is specified,
34127 the derivative is evaluated at the value of @var{var}; otherwise, the
34128 derivative is left in terms of @var{var}. If the expression contains
34129 functions for which no derivative formula is known, new derivative
34130 functions are invented by adding primes to the names; @pxref{Calculus}.
34131 However, if @var{symb} is non-@code{nil}, the presence of undifferentiable
34132 functions in @var{expr} instead cancels the whole differentiation, and
34133 @code{deriv} returns @code{nil} instead.
34134
34135 Derivatives of an @var{n}-argument function can be defined by
34136 adding a @code{math-derivative-@var{n}} property to the property list
34137 of the symbol for the function's derivative, which will be the
34138 function name followed by an apostrophe. The value of the property
34139 should be a Lisp function; it is called with the same arguments as the
34140 original function call that is being differentiated. It should return
34141 a formula for the derivative. For example, the derivative of @code{ln}
34142 is defined by
34143
34144 @smallexample
34145 (put 'calcFunc-ln\' 'math-derivative-1
34146 (function (lambda (u) (math-div 1 u))))
34147 @end smallexample
34148
34149 The two-argument @code{log} function has two derivatives,
34150 @smallexample
34151 (put 'calcFunc-log\' 'math-derivative-2 ; d(log(x,b)) / dx
34152 (function (lambda (x b) ... )))
34153 (put 'calcFunc-log\'2 'math-derivative-2 ; d(log(x,b)) / db
34154 (function (lambda (x b) ... )))
34155 @end smallexample
34156 @end defun
34157
34158 @defun tderiv expr var value symb
34159 Compute the total derivative of @var{expr}. This is the same as
34160 @code{deriv}, except that variables other than @var{var} are not
34161 assumed to be constant with respect to @var{var}.
34162 @end defun
34163
34164 @defun integ expr var low high
34165 Compute the integral of @var{expr} with respect to @var{var}.
34166 @xref{Calculus}, for further details.
34167 @end defun
34168
34169 @defmac math-defintegral funcs body
34170 Define a rule for integrating a function or functions of one argument;
34171 this macro is very similar in format to @code{math-defsimplify}.
34172 The main difference is that here @var{body} is the body of a function
34173 with a single argument @code{u} which is bound to the argument to the
34174 function being integrated, not the function call itself. Also, the
34175 variable of integration is available as @code{math-integ-var}. If
34176 evaluation of the integral requires doing further integrals, the body
34177 should call @samp{(math-integral @var{x})} to find the integral of
34178 @var{x} with respect to @code{math-integ-var}; this function returns
34179 @code{nil} if the integral could not be done. Some examples:
34180
34181 @smallexample
34182 (math-defintegral calcFunc-conj
34183 (let ((int (math-integral u)))
34184 (and int
34185 (list 'calcFunc-conj int))))
34186
34187 (math-defintegral calcFunc-cos
34188 (and (equal u math-integ-var)
34189 (math-from-radians-2 (list 'calcFunc-sin u))))
34190 @end smallexample
34191
34192 In the @code{cos} example, we define only the integral of @samp{cos(x) dx},
34193 relying on the general integration-by-substitution facility to handle
34194 cosines of more complicated arguments. An integration rule should return
34195 @code{nil} if it can't do the integral; if several rules are defined for
34196 the same function, they are tried in order until one returns a non-@code{nil}
34197 result.
34198 @end defmac
34199
34200 @defmac math-defintegral-2 funcs body
34201 Define a rule for integrating a function or functions of two arguments.
34202 This is exactly analogous to @code{math-defintegral}, except that @var{body}
34203 is written as the body of a function with two arguments, @var{u} and
34204 @var{v}.
34205 @end defmac
34206
34207 @defun solve-for lhs rhs var full
34208 Attempt to solve the equation @samp{@var{lhs} = @var{rhs}} by isolating
34209 the variable @var{var} on the lefthand side; return the resulting righthand
34210 side, or @code{nil} if the equation cannot be solved. The variable
34211 @var{var} must appear at least once in @var{lhs} or @var{rhs}. Note that
34212 the return value is a formula which does not contain @var{var}; this is
34213 different from the user-level @code{solve} and @code{finv} functions,
34214 which return a rearranged equation or a functional inverse, respectively.
34215 If @var{full} is non-@code{nil}, a full solution including dummy signs
34216 and dummy integers will be produced. User-defined inverses are provided
34217 as properties in a manner similar to derivatives:
34218
34219 @smallexample
34220 (put 'calcFunc-ln 'math-inverse
34221 (function (lambda (x) (list 'calcFunc-exp x))))
34222 @end smallexample
34223
34224 This function can call @samp{(math-solve-get-sign @var{x})} to create
34225 a new arbitrary sign variable, returning @var{x} times that sign, and
34226 @samp{(math-solve-get-int @var{x})} to create a new arbitrary integer
34227 variable multiplied by @var{x}. These functions simply return @var{x}
34228 if the caller requested a non-``full'' solution.
34229 @end defun
34230
34231 @defun solve-eqn expr var full
34232 This version of @code{solve-for} takes an expression which will
34233 typically be an equation or inequality. (If it is not, it will be
34234 interpreted as the equation @samp{@var{expr} = 0}.) It returns an
34235 equation or inequality, or @code{nil} if no solution could be found.
34236 @end defun
34237
34238 @defun solve-system exprs vars full
34239 This function solves a system of equations. Generally, @var{exprs}
34240 and @var{vars} will be vectors of equal length.
34241 @xref{Solving Systems of Equations}, for other options.
34242 @end defun
34243
34244 @defun expr-contains expr var
34245 Returns a non-@code{nil} value if @var{var} occurs as a subexpression
34246 of @var{expr}.
34247
34248 This function might seem at first to be identical to
34249 @code{calc-find-sub-formula}. The key difference is that
34250 @code{expr-contains} uses @code{equal} to test for matches, whereas
34251 @code{calc-find-sub-formula} uses @code{eq}. In the formula
34252 @samp{f(a, a)}, the two @samp{a}s will be @code{equal} but not
34253 @code{eq} to each other.
34254 @end defun
34255
34256 @defun expr-contains-count expr var
34257 Returns the number of occurrences of @var{var} as a subexpression
34258 of @var{expr}, or @code{nil} if there are no occurrences.
34259 @end defun
34260
34261 @defun expr-depends expr var
34262 Returns true if @var{expr} refers to any variable the occurs in @var{var}.
34263 In other words, it checks if @var{expr} and @var{var} have any variables
34264 in common.
34265 @end defun
34266
34267 @defun expr-contains-vars expr
34268 Return true if @var{expr} contains any variables, or @code{nil} if @var{expr}
34269 contains only constants and functions with constant arguments.
34270 @end defun
34271
34272 @defun expr-subst expr old new
34273 Returns a copy of @var{expr}, with all occurrences of @var{old} replaced
34274 by @var{new}. This treats @code{lambda} forms specially with respect
34275 to the dummy argument variables, so that the effect is always to return
34276 @var{expr} evaluated at @var{old} = @var{new}.
34277 @end defun
34278
34279 @defun multi-subst expr old new
34280 This is like @code{expr-subst}, except that @var{old} and @var{new}
34281 are lists of expressions to be substituted simultaneously. If one
34282 list is shorter than the other, trailing elements of the longer list
34283 are ignored.
34284 @end defun
34285
34286 @defun expr-weight expr
34287 Returns the ``weight'' of @var{expr}, basically a count of the total
34288 number of objects and function calls that appear in @var{expr}. For
34289 ``primitive'' objects, this will be one.
34290 @end defun
34291
34292 @defun expr-height expr
34293 Returns the ``height'' of @var{expr}, which is the deepest level to
34294 which function calls are nested. (Note that @samp{@var{a} + @var{b}}
34295 counts as a function call.) For primitive objects, this returns zero.
34296 @end defun
34297
34298 @defun polynomial-p expr var
34299 Check if @var{expr} is a polynomial in variable (or sub-expression)
34300 @var{var}. If so, return the degree of the polynomial, that is, the
34301 highest power of @var{var} that appears in @var{expr}. For example,
34302 for @samp{(x^2 + 3)^3 + 4} this would return 6. This function returns
34303 @code{nil} unless @var{expr}, when expanded out by @kbd{a x}
34304 (@code{calc-expand}), would consist of a sum of terms in which @var{var}
34305 appears only raised to nonnegative integer powers. Note that if
34306 @var{var} does not occur in @var{expr}, then @var{expr} is considered
34307 a polynomial of degree 0.
34308 @end defun
34309
34310 @defun is-polynomial expr var degree loose
34311 Check if @var{expr} is a polynomial in variable or sub-expression
34312 @var{var}, and, if so, return a list representation of the polynomial
34313 where the elements of the list are coefficients of successive powers of
34314 @var{var}: @samp{@var{a} + @var{b} x + @var{c} x^3} would produce the
34315 list @samp{(@var{a} @var{b} 0 @var{c})}, and @samp{(x + 1)^2} would
34316 produce the list @samp{(1 2 1)}. The highest element of the list will
34317 be non-zero, with the special exception that if @var{expr} is the
34318 constant zero, the returned value will be @samp{(0)}. Return @code{nil}
34319 if @var{expr} is not a polynomial in @var{var}. If @var{degree} is
34320 specified, this will not consider polynomials of degree higher than that
34321 value. This is a good precaution because otherwise an input of
34322 @samp{(x+1)^1000} will cause a huge coefficient list to be built. If
34323 @var{loose} is non-@code{nil}, then a looser definition of a polynomial
34324 is used in which coefficients are no longer required not to depend on
34325 @var{var}, but are only required not to take the form of polynomials
34326 themselves. For example, @samp{sin(x) x^2 + cos(x)} is a loose
34327 polynomial with coefficients @samp{((calcFunc-cos x) 0 (calcFunc-sin
34328 x))}. The result will never be @code{nil} in loose mode, since any
34329 expression can be interpreted as a ``constant'' loose polynomial.
34330 @end defun
34331
34332 @defun polynomial-base expr pred
34333 Check if @var{expr} is a polynomial in any variable that occurs in it;
34334 if so, return that variable. (If @var{expr} is a multivariate polynomial,
34335 this chooses one variable arbitrarily.) If @var{pred} is specified, it should
34336 be a Lisp function which is called as @samp{(@var{pred} @var{subexpr})},
34337 and which should return true if @code{mpb-top-expr} (a global name for
34338 the original @var{expr}) is a suitable polynomial in @var{subexpr}.
34339 The default predicate uses @samp{(polynomial-p mpb-top-expr @var{subexpr})};
34340 you can use @var{pred} to specify additional conditions. Or, you could
34341 have @var{pred} build up a list of every suitable @var{subexpr} that
34342 is found.
34343 @end defun
34344
34345 @defun poly-simplify poly
34346 Simplify polynomial coefficient list @var{poly} by (destructively)
34347 clipping off trailing zeros.
34348 @end defun
34349
34350 @defun poly-mix a ac b bc
34351 Mix two polynomial lists @var{a} and @var{b} (in the form returned by
34352 @code{is-polynomial}) in a linear combination with coefficient expressions
34353 @var{ac} and @var{bc}. The result is a (not necessarily simplified)
34354 polynomial list representing @samp{@var{ac} @var{a} + @var{bc} @var{b}}.
34355 @end defun
34356
34357 @defun poly-mul a b
34358 Multiply two polynomial coefficient lists @var{a} and @var{b}. The
34359 result will be in simplified form if the inputs were simplified.
34360 @end defun
34361
34362 @defun build-polynomial-expr poly var
34363 Construct a Calc formula which represents the polynomial coefficient
34364 list @var{poly} applied to variable @var{var}. The @kbd{a c}
34365 (@code{calc-collect}) command uses @code{is-polynomial} to turn an
34366 expression into a coefficient list, then @code{build-polynomial-expr}
34367 to turn the list back into an expression in regular form.
34368 @end defun
34369
34370 @defun check-unit-name var
34371 Check if @var{var} is a variable which can be interpreted as a unit
34372 name. If so, return the units table entry for that unit. This
34373 will be a list whose first element is the unit name (not counting
34374 prefix characters) as a symbol and whose second element is the
34375 Calc expression which defines the unit. (Refer to the Calc sources
34376 for details on the remaining elements of this list.) If @var{var}
34377 is not a variable or is not a unit name, return @code{nil}.
34378 @end defun
34379
34380 @defun units-in-expr-p expr sub-exprs
34381 Return true if @var{expr} contains any variables which can be
34382 interpreted as units. If @var{sub-exprs} is @code{t}, the entire
34383 expression is searched. If @var{sub-exprs} is @code{nil}, this
34384 checks whether @var{expr} is directly a units expression.
34385 @end defun
34386
34387 @defun single-units-in-expr-p expr
34388 Check whether @var{expr} contains exactly one units variable. If so,
34389 return the units table entry for the variable. If @var{expr} does
34390 not contain any units, return @code{nil}. If @var{expr} contains
34391 two or more units, return the symbol @code{wrong}.
34392 @end defun
34393
34394 @defun to-standard-units expr which
34395 Convert units expression @var{expr} to base units. If @var{which}
34396 is @code{nil}, use Calc's native base units. Otherwise, @var{which}
34397 can specify a units system, which is a list of two-element lists,
34398 where the first element is a Calc base symbol name and the second
34399 is an expression to substitute for it.
34400 @end defun
34401
34402 @defun remove-units expr
34403 Return a copy of @var{expr} with all units variables replaced by ones.
34404 This expression is generally normalized before use.
34405 @end defun
34406
34407 @defun extract-units expr
34408 Return a copy of @var{expr} with everything but units variables replaced
34409 by ones.
34410 @end defun
34411
34412 @node Formatting Lisp Functions, Hooks, Symbolic Lisp Functions, Internals
34413 @subsubsection I/O and Formatting Functions
34414
34415 @noindent
34416 The functions described here are responsible for parsing and formatting
34417 Calc numbers and formulas.
34418
34419 @defun calc-eval str sep arg1 arg2 @dots{}
34420 This is the simplest interface to the Calculator from another Lisp program.
34421 @xref{Calling Calc from Your Programs}.
34422 @end defun
34423
34424 @defun read-number str
34425 If string @var{str} contains a valid Calc number, either integer,
34426 fraction, float, or HMS form, this function parses and returns that
34427 number. Otherwise, it returns @code{nil}.
34428 @end defun
34429
34430 @defun read-expr str
34431 Read an algebraic expression from string @var{str}. If @var{str} does
34432 not have the form of a valid expression, return a list of the form
34433 @samp{(error @var{pos} @var{msg})} where @var{pos} is an integer index
34434 into @var{str} of the general location of the error, and @var{msg} is
34435 a string describing the problem.
34436 @end defun
34437
34438 @defun read-exprs str
34439 Read a list of expressions separated by commas, and return it as a
34440 Lisp list. If an error occurs in any expressions, an error list as
34441 shown above is returned instead.
34442 @end defun
34443
34444 @defun calc-do-alg-entry initial prompt no-norm
34445 Read an algebraic formula or formulas using the minibuffer. All
34446 conventions of regular algebraic entry are observed. The return value
34447 is a list of Calc formulas; there will be more than one if the user
34448 entered a list of values separated by commas. The result is @code{nil}
34449 if the user presses Return with a blank line. If @var{initial} is
34450 given, it is a string which the minibuffer will initially contain.
34451 If @var{prompt} is given, it is the prompt string to use; the default
34452 is ``Algebraic:''. If @var{no-norm} is @code{t}, the formulas will
34453 be returned exactly as parsed; otherwise, they will be passed through
34454 @code{calc-normalize} first.
34455
34456 To support the use of @kbd{$} characters in the algebraic entry, use
34457 @code{let} to bind @code{calc-dollar-values} to a list of the values
34458 to be substituted for @kbd{$}, @kbd{$$}, and so on, and bind
34459 @code{calc-dollar-used} to 0. Upon return, @code{calc-dollar-used}
34460 will have been changed to the highest number of consecutive @kbd{$}s
34461 that actually appeared in the input.
34462 @end defun
34463
34464 @defun format-number a
34465 Convert the real or complex number or HMS form @var{a} to string form.
34466 @end defun
34467
34468 @defun format-flat-expr a prec
34469 Convert the arbitrary Calc number or formula @var{a} to string form,
34470 in the style used by the trail buffer and the @code{calc-edit} command.
34471 This is a simple format designed
34472 mostly to guarantee the string is of a form that can be re-parsed by
34473 @code{read-expr}. Most formatting modes, such as digit grouping,
34474 complex number format, and point character, are ignored to ensure the
34475 result will be re-readable. The @var{prec} parameter is normally 0; if
34476 you pass a large integer like 1000 instead, the expression will be
34477 surrounded by parentheses unless it is a plain number or variable name.
34478 @end defun
34479
34480 @defun format-nice-expr a width
34481 This is like @code{format-flat-expr} (with @var{prec} equal to 0),
34482 except that newlines will be inserted to keep lines down to the
34483 specified @var{width}, and vectors that look like matrices or rewrite
34484 rules are written in a pseudo-matrix format. The @code{calc-edit}
34485 command uses this when only one stack entry is being edited.
34486 @end defun
34487
34488 @defun format-value a width
34489 Convert the Calc number or formula @var{a} to string form, using the
34490 format seen in the stack buffer. Beware the string returned may
34491 not be re-readable by @code{read-expr}, for example, because of digit
34492 grouping. Multi-line objects like matrices produce strings that
34493 contain newline characters to separate the lines. The @var{w}
34494 parameter, if given, is the target window size for which to format
34495 the expressions. If @var{w} is omitted, the width of the Calculator
34496 window is used.
34497 @end defun
34498
34499 @defun compose-expr a prec
34500 Format the Calc number or formula @var{a} according to the current
34501 language mode, returning a ``composition.'' To learn about the
34502 structure of compositions, see the comments in the Calc source code.
34503 You can specify the format of a given type of function call by putting
34504 a @code{math-compose-@var{lang}} property on the function's symbol,
34505 whose value is a Lisp function that takes @var{a} and @var{prec} as
34506 arguments and returns a composition. Here @var{lang} is a language
34507 mode name, one of @code{normal}, @code{big}, @code{c}, @code{pascal},
34508 @code{fortran}, @code{tex}, @code{eqn}, @code{math}, or @code{maple}.
34509 In Big mode, Calc actually tries @code{math-compose-big} first, then
34510 tries @code{math-compose-normal}. If this property does not exist,
34511 or if the function returns @code{nil}, the function is written in the
34512 normal function-call notation for that language.
34513 @end defun
34514
34515 @defun composition-to-string c w
34516 Convert a composition structure returned by @code{compose-expr} into
34517 a string. Multi-line compositions convert to strings containing
34518 newline characters. The target window size is given by @var{w}.
34519 The @code{format-value} function basically calls @code{compose-expr}
34520 followed by @code{composition-to-string}.
34521 @end defun
34522
34523 @defun comp-width c
34524 Compute the width in characters of composition @var{c}.
34525 @end defun
34526
34527 @defun comp-height c
34528 Compute the height in lines of composition @var{c}.
34529 @end defun
34530
34531 @defun comp-ascent c
34532 Compute the portion of the height of composition @var{c} which is on or
34533 above the baseline. For a one-line composition, this will be one.
34534 @end defun
34535
34536 @defun comp-descent c
34537 Compute the portion of the height of composition @var{c} which is below
34538 the baseline. For a one-line composition, this will be zero.
34539 @end defun
34540
34541 @defun comp-first-char c
34542 If composition @var{c} is a ``flat'' composition, return the first
34543 (leftmost) character of the composition as an integer. Otherwise,
34544 return @code{nil}.
34545 @end defun
34546
34547 @defun comp-last-char c
34548 If composition @var{c} is a ``flat'' composition, return the last
34549 (rightmost) character, otherwise return @code{nil}.
34550 @end defun
34551
34552 @comment @node Lisp Variables, Hooks, Formatting Lisp Functions, Internals
34553 @comment @subsubsection Lisp Variables
34554 @comment
34555 @comment @noindent
34556 @comment (This section is currently unfinished.)
34557
34558 @node Hooks, , Formatting Lisp Functions, Internals
34559 @subsubsection Hooks
34560
34561 @noindent
34562 Hooks are variables which contain Lisp functions (or lists of functions)
34563 which are called at various times. Calc defines a number of hooks
34564 that help you to customize it in various ways. Calc uses the Lisp
34565 function @code{run-hooks} to invoke the hooks shown below. Several
34566 other customization-related variables are also described here.
34567
34568 @defvar calc-load-hook
34569 This hook is called at the end of @file{calc.el}, after the file has
34570 been loaded, before any functions in it have been called, but after
34571 @code{calc-mode-map} and similar variables have been set up.
34572 @end defvar
34573
34574 @defvar calc-ext-load-hook
34575 This hook is called at the end of @file{calc-ext.el}.
34576 @end defvar
34577
34578 @defvar calc-start-hook
34579 This hook is called as the last step in a @kbd{M-x calc} command.
34580 At this point, the Calc buffer has been created and initialized if
34581 necessary, the Calc window and trail window have been created,
34582 and the ``Welcome to Calc'' message has been displayed.
34583 @end defvar
34584
34585 @defvar calc-mode-hook
34586 This hook is called when the Calc buffer is being created. Usually
34587 this will only happen once per Emacs session. The hook is called
34588 after Emacs has switched to the new buffer, the mode-settings file
34589 has been read if necessary, and all other buffer-local variables
34590 have been set up. After this hook returns, Calc will perform a
34591 @code{calc-refresh} operation, set up the mode line display, then
34592 evaluate any deferred @code{calc-define} properties that have not
34593 been evaluated yet.
34594 @end defvar
34595
34596 @defvar calc-trail-mode-hook
34597 This hook is called when the Calc Trail buffer is being created.
34598 It is called as the very last step of setting up the Trail buffer.
34599 Like @code{calc-mode-hook}, this will normally happen only once
34600 per Emacs session.
34601 @end defvar
34602
34603 @defvar calc-end-hook
34604 This hook is called by @code{calc-quit}, generally because the user
34605 presses @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x * c} while in Calc. The Calc buffer will
34606 be the current buffer. The hook is called as the very first
34607 step, before the Calc window is destroyed.
34608 @end defvar
34609
34610 @defvar calc-window-hook
34611 If this hook is non-@code{nil}, it is called to create the Calc window.
34612 Upon return, this new Calc window should be the current window.
34613 (The Calc buffer will already be the current buffer when the
34614 hook is called.) If the hook is not defined, Calc will
34615 generally use @code{split-window}, @code{set-window-buffer},
34616 and @code{select-window} to create the Calc window.
34617 @end defvar
34618
34619 @defvar calc-trail-window-hook
34620 If this hook is non-@code{nil}, it is called to create the Calc Trail
34621 window. The variable @code{calc-trail-buffer} will contain the buffer
34622 which the window should use. Unlike @code{calc-window-hook}, this hook
34623 must @emph{not} switch into the new window.
34624 @end defvar
34625
34626 @defvar calc-embedded-mode-hook
34627 This hook is called the first time that Embedded mode is entered.
34628 @end defvar
34629
34630 @defvar calc-embedded-new-buffer-hook
34631 This hook is called each time that Embedded mode is entered in a
34632 new buffer.
34633 @end defvar
34634
34635 @defvar calc-embedded-new-formula-hook
34636 This hook is called each time that Embedded mode is enabled for a
34637 new formula.
34638 @end defvar
34639
34640 @defvar calc-edit-mode-hook
34641 This hook is called by @code{calc-edit} (and the other ``edit''
34642 commands) when the temporary editing buffer is being created.
34643 The buffer will have been selected and set up to be in
34644 @code{calc-edit-mode}, but will not yet have been filled with
34645 text. (In fact it may still have leftover text from a previous
34646 @code{calc-edit} command.)
34647 @end defvar
34648
34649 @defvar calc-mode-save-hook
34650 This hook is called by the @code{calc-save-modes} command,
34651 after Calc's own mode features have been inserted into the
34652 Calc init file and just before the ``End of mode settings''
34653 message is inserted.
34654 @end defvar
34655
34656 @defvar calc-reset-hook
34657 This hook is called after @kbd{C-x * 0} (@code{calc-reset}) has
34658 reset all modes. The Calc buffer will be the current buffer.
34659 @end defvar
34660
34661 @defvar calc-other-modes
34662 This variable contains a list of strings. The strings are
34663 concatenated at the end of the modes portion of the Calc
34664 mode line (after standard modes such as ``Deg'', ``Inv'' and
34665 ``Hyp''). Each string should be a short, single word followed
34666 by a space. The variable is @code{nil} by default.
34667 @end defvar
34668
34669 @defvar calc-mode-map
34670 This is the keymap that is used by Calc mode. The best time
34671 to adjust it is probably in a @code{calc-mode-hook}. If the
34672 Calc extensions package (@file{calc-ext.el}) has not yet been
34673 loaded, many of these keys will be bound to @code{calc-missing-key},
34674 which is a command that loads the extensions package and
34675 ``retypes'' the key. If your @code{calc-mode-hook} rebinds
34676 one of these keys, it will probably be overridden when the
34677 extensions are loaded.
34678 @end defvar
34679
34680 @defvar calc-digit-map
34681 This is the keymap that is used during numeric entry. Numeric
34682 entry uses the minibuffer, but this map binds every non-numeric
34683 key to @code{calcDigit-nondigit} which generally calls
34684 @code{exit-minibuffer} and ``retypes'' the key.
34685 @end defvar
34686
34687 @defvar calc-alg-ent-map
34688 This is the keymap that is used during algebraic entry. This is
34689 mostly a copy of @code{minibuffer-local-map}.
34690 @end defvar
34691
34692 @defvar calc-store-var-map
34693 This is the keymap that is used during entry of variable names for
34694 commands like @code{calc-store} and @code{calc-recall}. This is
34695 mostly a copy of @code{minibuffer-local-completion-map}.
34696 @end defvar
34697
34698 @defvar calc-edit-mode-map
34699 This is the (sparse) keymap used by @code{calc-edit} and other
34700 temporary editing commands. It binds @key{RET}, @key{LFD},
34701 and @kbd{C-c C-c} to @code{calc-edit-finish}.
34702 @end defvar
34703
34704 @defvar calc-mode-var-list
34705 This is a list of variables which are saved by @code{calc-save-modes}.
34706 Each entry is a list of two items, the variable (as a Lisp symbol)
34707 and its default value. When modes are being saved, each variable
34708 is compared with its default value (using @code{equal}) and any
34709 non-default variables are written out.
34710 @end defvar
34711
34712 @defvar calc-local-var-list
34713 This is a list of variables which should be buffer-local to the
34714 Calc buffer. Each entry is a variable name (as a Lisp symbol).
34715 These variables also have their default values manipulated by
34716 the @code{calc} and @code{calc-quit} commands; @pxref{Multiple Calculators}.
34717 Since @code{calc-mode-hook} is called after this list has been
34718 used the first time, your hook should add a variable to the
34719 list and also call @code{make-local-variable} itself.
34720 @end defvar
34721
34722 @node Copying, GNU Free Documentation License, Programming, Top
34723 @appendix GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
34724 @include gpl.texi
34725
34726 @node GNU Free Documentation License, Customizing Calc, Copying, Top
34727 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
34728 @include doclicense.texi
34729
34730 @node Customizing Calc, Reporting Bugs, GNU Free Documentation License, Top
34731 @appendix Customizing Calc
34732
34733 The usual prefix for Calc is the key sequence @kbd{C-x *}. If you wish
34734 to use a different prefix, you can put
34735
34736 @example
34737 (global-set-key "NEWPREFIX" 'calc-dispatch)
34738 @end example
34739
34740 @noindent
34741 in your .emacs file.
34742 (@xref{Key Bindings,,Customizing Key Bindings,emacs,
34743 The GNU Emacs Manual}, for more information on binding keys.)
34744 A convenient way to start Calc is with @kbd{C-x * *}; to make it equally
34745 convenient for users who use a different prefix, the prefix can be
34746 followed by @kbd{=}, @kbd{&}, @kbd{#}, @kbd{\}, @kbd{/}, @kbd{+} or
34747 @kbd{-} as well as @kbd{*} to start Calc, and so in many cases the last
34748 character of the prefix can simply be typed twice.
34749
34750 Calc is controlled by many variables, most of which can be reset
34751 from within Calc. Some variables are less involved with actual
34752 calculation, and can be set outside of Calc using Emacs's
34753 customization facilities. These variables are listed below.
34754 Typing @kbd{M-x customize-variable RET @var{variable-name} RET}
34755 will bring up a buffer in which the variable's value can be redefined.
34756 Typing @kbd{M-x customize-group RET calc RET} will bring up a buffer which
34757 contains all of Calc's customizable variables. (These variables can
34758 also be reset by putting the appropriate lines in your .emacs file;
34759 @xref{Init File, ,Init File, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}.)
34760
34761 Some of the customizable variables are regular expressions. A regular
34762 expression is basically a pattern that Calc can search for.
34763 See @ref{Regexp Search,, Regular Expression Search, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}
34764 to see how regular expressions work.
34765
34766 @defvar calc-settings-file
34767 The variable @code{calc-settings-file} holds the file name in
34768 which commands like @kbd{m m} and @kbd{Z P} store ``permanent''
34769 definitions.
34770 If @code{calc-settings-file} is not your user init file (typically
34771 @file{~/.emacs}) and if the variable @code{calc-loaded-settings-file} is
34772 @code{nil}, then Calc will automatically load your settings file (if it
34773 exists) the first time Calc is invoked.
34774
34775 The default value for this variable is @code{"~/.calc.el"}.
34776 @end defvar
34777
34778 @defvar calc-gnuplot-name
34779 See @ref{Graphics}.@*
34780 The variable @code{calc-gnuplot-name} should be the name of the
34781 GNUPLOT program (a string). If you have GNUPLOT installed on your
34782 system but Calc is unable to find it, you may need to set this
34783 variable. You may also need to set some Lisp variables to show Calc how
34784 to run GNUPLOT on your system, see @ref{Devices, ,Graphical Devices} .
34785 The default value of @code{calc-gnuplot-name} is @code{"gnuplot"}.
34786 @end defvar
34787
34788 @defvar calc-gnuplot-plot-command
34789 @defvarx calc-gnuplot-print-command
34790 See @ref{Devices, ,Graphical Devices}.@*
34791 The variables @code{calc-gnuplot-plot-command} and
34792 @code{calc-gnuplot-print-command} represent system commands to
34793 display and print the output of GNUPLOT, respectively. These may be
34794 @code{nil} if no command is necessary, or strings which can include
34795 @samp{%s} to signify the name of the file to be displayed or printed.
34796 Or, these variables may contain Lisp expressions which are evaluated
34797 to display or print the output.
34798
34799 The default value of @code{calc-gnuplot-plot-command} is @code{nil},
34800 and the default value of @code{calc-gnuplot-print-command} is
34801 @code{"lp %s"}.
34802 @end defvar
34803
34804 @defvar calc-language-alist
34805 See @ref{Basic Embedded Mode}.@*
34806 The variable @code{calc-language-alist} controls the languages that
34807 Calc will associate with major modes. When Calc embedded mode is
34808 enabled, it will try to use the current major mode to
34809 determine what language should be used. (This can be overridden using
34810 Calc's mode changing commands, @xref{Mode Settings in Embedded Mode}.)
34811 The variable @code{calc-language-alist} consists of a list of pairs of
34812 the form @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} . @var{LANGUAGE})}; for example,
34813 @code{(latex-mode . latex)} is one such pair. If Calc embedded is
34814 activated in a buffer whose major mode is @var{MAJOR-MODE}, it will set itself
34815 to use the language @var{LANGUAGE}.
34816
34817 The default value of @code{calc-language-alist} is
34818 @example
34819 ((latex-mode . latex)
34820 (tex-mode . tex)
34821 (plain-tex-mode . tex)
34822 (context-mode . tex)
34823 (nroff-mode . eqn)
34824 (pascal-mode . pascal)
34825 (c-mode . c)
34826 (c++-mode . c)
34827 (fortran-mode . fortran)
34828 (f90-mode . fortran))
34829 @end example
34830 @end defvar
34831
34832 @defvar calc-embedded-announce-formula
34833 @defvarx calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist
34834 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
34835 The variable @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula} helps determine
34836 what formulas @kbd{C-x * a} will activate in a buffer. It is a
34837 regular expression, and when activating embedded formulas with
34838 @kbd{C-x * a}, it will tell Calc that what follows is a formula to be
34839 activated. (Calc also uses other patterns to find formulas, such as
34840 @samp{=>} and @samp{:=}.)
34841
34842 The default pattern is @code{"%Embed\n\\(% .*\n\\)*"}, which checks
34843 for @samp{%Embed} followed by any number of lines beginning with
34844 @samp{%} and a space.
34845
34846 The variable @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist} is used to
34847 set @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula} to different regular
34848 expressions depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
34849 It consists of a list of pairs of the form @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} .
34850 @var{REGEXP})}, and its default value is
34851 @example
34852 ((c++-mode . "//Embed\n\\(// .*\n\\)*")
34853 (c-mode . "/\\*Embed\\*/\n\\(/\\* .*\\*/\n\\)*")
34854 (f90-mode . "!Embed\n\\(! .*\n\\)*")
34855 (fortran-mode . "C Embed\n\\(C .*\n\\)*")
34856 (html-helper-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
34857 (html-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
34858 (nroff-mode . "\\\\\"Embed\n\\(\\\\\" .*\n\\)*")
34859 (pascal-mode . "@{Embed@}\n\\(@{.*@}\n\\)*")
34860 (sgml-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
34861 (xml-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
34862 (texinfo-mode . "@@c Embed\n\\(@@c .*\n\\)*"))
34863 @end example
34864 Any major modes added to @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist}
34865 should also be added to @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist}
34866 and @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist}.
34867 @end defvar
34868
34869 @defvar calc-embedded-open-formula
34870 @defvarx calc-embedded-close-formula
34871 @defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-formula-alist
34872 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
34873 The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} and
34874 @code{calc-embedded-close-formula} control the region that Calc will
34875 activate as a formula when Embedded mode is entered with @kbd{C-x * e}.
34876 They are regular expressions;
34877 Calc normally scans backward and forward in the buffer for the
34878 nearest text matching these regular expressions to be the ``formula
34879 delimiters''.
34880
34881 The simplest delimiters are blank lines. Other delimiters that
34882 Embedded mode understands by default are:
34883 @enumerate
34884 @item
34885 The @TeX{} and La@TeX{} math delimiters @samp{$ $}, @samp{$$ $$},
34886 @samp{\[ \]}, and @samp{\( \)};
34887 @item
34888 Lines beginning with @samp{\begin} and @samp{\end} (except matrix delimiters);
34889 @item
34890 Lines beginning with @samp{@@} (Texinfo delimiters).
34891 @item
34892 Lines beginning with @samp{.EQ} and @samp{.EN} (@dfn{eqn} delimiters);
34893 @item
34894 Lines containing a single @samp{%} or @samp{.\"} symbol and nothing else.
34895 @end enumerate
34896
34897 The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-formula-alist} is used to
34898 set @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} and
34899 @code{calc-embedded-close-formula} to different regular
34900 expressions depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
34901 It consists of a list of lists of the form
34902 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-FORMULA-REGEXP}
34903 @var{CLOSE-FORMULA-REGEXP})}, and its default value is
34904 @code{nil}.
34905 @end defvar
34906
34907 @defvar calc-embedded-word-regexp
34908 @defvarx calc-embedded-word-regexp-alist
34909 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
34910 The variable @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp} determines the expression
34911 that Calc will activate when Embedded mode is entered with @kbd{C-x *
34912 w}. It is a regular expressions.
34913
34914 The default value of @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp} is
34915 @code{"[-+]?[0-9]+\\(\\.[0-9]+\\)?\\([eE][-+]?[0-9]+\\)?"}.
34916
34917 The variable @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp-alist} is used to
34918 set @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp} to a different regular
34919 expression depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
34920 It consists of a list of lists of the form
34921 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{WORD-REGEXP})}, and its default value is
34922 @code{nil}.
34923 @end defvar
34924
34925 @defvar calc-embedded-open-plain
34926 @defvarx calc-embedded-close-plain
34927 @defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist
34928 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
34929 The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} and
34930 @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} are used to delimit ``plain''
34931 formulas. Note that these are actual strings, not regular
34932 expressions, because Calc must be able to write these string into a
34933 buffer as well as to recognize them.
34934
34935 The default string for @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} is
34936 @code{"%%% "}, note the trailing space. The default string for
34937 @code{calc-embedded-close-plain} is @code{" %%%\n"}, without
34938 the trailing newline here, the first line of a Big mode formula
34939 that followed might be shifted over with respect to the other lines.
34940
34941 The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist} is used to
34942 set @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} and
34943 @code{calc-embedded-close-plain} to different strings
34944 depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
34945 It consists of a list of lists of the form
34946 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-PLAIN-STRING}
34947 @var{CLOSE-PLAIN-STRING})}, and its default value is
34948 @example
34949 ((c++-mode "// %% " " %%\n")
34950 (c-mode "/* %% " " %% */\n")
34951 (f90-mode "! %% " " %%\n")
34952 (fortran-mode "C %% " " %%\n")
34953 (html-helper-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
34954 (html-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
34955 (nroff-mode "\\\" %% " " %%\n")
34956 (pascal-mode "@{%% " " %%@}\n")
34957 (sgml-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
34958 (xml-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
34959 (texinfo-mode "@@c %% " " %%\n"))
34960 @end example
34961 Any major modes added to @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist}
34962 should also be added to @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist}
34963 and @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist}.
34964 @end defvar
34965
34966 @defvar calc-embedded-open-new-formula
34967 @defvarx calc-embedded-close-new-formula
34968 @defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-new-formula-alist
34969 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
34970 The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} and
34971 @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} are strings which are
34972 inserted before and after a new formula when you type @kbd{C-x * f}.
34973
34974 The default value of @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} is
34975 @code{"\n\n"}. If this string begins with a newline character and the
34976 @kbd{C-x * f} is typed at the beginning of a line, @kbd{C-x * f} will skip
34977 this first newline to avoid introducing unnecessary blank lines in the
34978 file. The default value of @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} is
34979 also @code{"\n\n"}. The final newline is omitted by @w{@kbd{C-x * f}}
34980 if typed at the end of a line. (It follows that if @kbd{C-x * f} is
34981 typed on a blank line, both a leading opening newline and a trailing
34982 closing newline are omitted.)
34983
34984 The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-new-formula-alist} is used to
34985 set @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} and
34986 @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} to different strings
34987 depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
34988 It consists of a list of lists of the form
34989 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-NEW-FORMULA-STRING}
34990 @var{CLOSE-NEW-FORMULA-STRING})}, and its default value is
34991 @code{nil}.
34992 @end defvar
34993
34994 @defvar calc-embedded-open-mode
34995 @defvarx calc-embedded-close-mode
34996 @defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist
34997 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
34998 The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} and
34999 @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} are strings which Calc will place before
35000 and after any mode annotations that it inserts. Calc never scans for
35001 these strings; Calc always looks for the annotation itself, so it is not
35002 necessary to add them to user-written annotations.
35003
35004 The default value of @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} is @code{"% "}
35005 and the default value of @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} is
35006 @code{"\n"}.
35007 If you change the value of @code{calc-embedded-close-mode}, it is a good
35008 idea still to end with a newline so that mode annotations will appear on
35009 lines by themselves.
35010
35011 The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist} is used to
35012 set @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} and
35013 @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} to different strings
35014 expressions depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35015 It consists of a list of lists of the form
35016 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-MODE-STRING}
35017 @var{CLOSE-MODE-STRING})}, and its default value is
35018 @example
35019 ((c++-mode "// " "\n")
35020 (c-mode "/* " " */\n")
35021 (f90-mode "! " "\n")
35022 (fortran-mode "C " "\n")
35023 (html-helper-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
35024 (html-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
35025 (nroff-mode "\\\" " "\n")
35026 (pascal-mode "@{ " " @}\n")
35027 (sgml-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
35028 (xml-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
35029 (texinfo-mode "@@c " "\n"))
35030 @end example
35031 Any major modes added to @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist}
35032 should also be added to @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist}
35033 and @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist}.
35034 @end defvar
35035
35036 @defvar calc-multiplication-has-precedence
35037 The variable @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} determines
35038 whether multiplication has precedence over division in algebraic
35039 formulas in normal language modes. If
35040 @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} is non-@code{nil}, then
35041 multiplication has precedence (and, for certain obscure reasons, is
35042 right associative), and so for example @samp{a/b*c} will be interpreted
35043 as @samp{a/(b*c)}. If @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} is
35044 @code{nil}, then multiplication has the same precedence as division
35045 (and, like division, is left associative), and so for example
35046 @samp{a/b*c} will be interpreted as @samp{(a/b)*c}. The default value
35047 of @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} is @code{t}.
35048 @end defvar
35049
35050 @node Reporting Bugs, Summary, Customizing Calc, Top
35051 @appendix Reporting Bugs
35052
35053 @noindent
35054 If you find a bug in Calc, send e-mail to Jay Belanger,
35055
35056 @example
35057 jay.p.belanger@@gmail.com
35058 @end example
35059
35060 @noindent
35061 There is an automatic command @kbd{M-x report-calc-bug} which helps
35062 you to report bugs. This command prompts you for a brief subject
35063 line, then leaves you in a mail editing buffer. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to
35064 send your mail. Make sure your subject line indicates that you are
35065 reporting a Calc bug; this command sends mail to the maintainer's
35066 regular mailbox.
35067
35068 If you have suggestions for additional features for Calc, please send
35069 them. Some have dared to suggest that Calc is already top-heavy with
35070 features; this obviously cannot be the case, so if you have ideas, send
35071 them right in.
35072
35073 At the front of the source file, @file{calc.el}, is a list of ideas for
35074 future work. If any enthusiastic souls wish to take it upon themselves
35075 to work on these, please send a message (using @kbd{M-x report-calc-bug})
35076 so any efforts can be coordinated.
35077
35078 The latest version of Calc is available from Savannah, in the Emacs
35079 CVS tree. See @uref{http://savannah.gnu.org/projects/emacs}.
35080
35081 @c [summary]
35082 @node Summary, Key Index, Reporting Bugs, Top
35083 @appendix Calc Summary
35084
35085 @noindent
35086 This section includes a complete list of Calc keystroke commands.
35087 Each line lists the stack entries used by the command (top-of-stack
35088 last), the keystrokes themselves, the prompts asked by the command,
35089 and the result of the command (also with top-of-stack last).
35090 The result is expressed using the equivalent algebraic function.
35091 Commands which put no results on the stack show the full @kbd{M-x}
35092 command name in that position. Numbers preceding the result or
35093 command name refer to notes at the end.
35094
35095 Algebraic functions and @kbd{M-x} commands that don't have corresponding
35096 keystrokes are not listed in this summary.
35097 @xref{Command Index}. @xref{Function Index}.
35098
35099 @iftex
35100 @begingroup
35101 @tex
35102 \vskip-2\baselineskip \null
35103 \gdef\sumrow#1{\sumrowx#1\relax}%
35104 \gdef\sumrowx#1\:#2\:#3\:#4\:#5\:#6\relax{%
35105 \leavevmode%
35106 {\smallfonts
35107 \hbox to5em{\sl\hss#1}%
35108 \hbox to5em{\tt#2\hss}%
35109 \hbox to4em{\sl#3\hss}%
35110 \hbox to5em{\rm\hss#4}%
35111 \thinspace%
35112 {\tt#5}%
35113 {\sl#6}%
35114 }}%
35115 \gdef\sumlpar{{\rm(}}%
35116 \gdef\sumrpar{{\rm)}}%
35117 \gdef\sumcomma{{\rm,\thinspace}}%
35118 \gdef\sumexcl{{\rm!}}%
35119 \gdef\sumbreak{\vskip-2.5\baselineskip\goodbreak}%
35120 \gdef\minus#1{{\tt-}}%
35121 @end tex
35122 @let@:=@sumsep
35123 @let@r=@sumrow
35124 @catcode`@(=@active @let(=@sumlpar
35125 @catcode`@)=@active @let)=@sumrpar
35126 @catcode`@,=@active @let,=@sumcomma
35127 @catcode`@!=@active @let!=@sumexcl
35128 @end iftex
35129 @format
35130 @iftex
35131 @advance@baselineskip-2.5pt
35132 @let@c@sumbreak
35133 @end iftex
35134 @r{ @: C-x * a @: @: 33 @:calc-embedded-activate@:}
35135 @r{ @: C-x * b @: @: @:calc-big-or-small@:}
35136 @r{ @: C-x * c @: @: @:calc@:}
35137 @r{ @: C-x * d @: @: @:calc-embedded-duplicate@:}
35138 @r{ @: C-x * e @: @: 34 @:calc-embedded@:}
35139 @r{ @: C-x * f @:formula @: @:calc-embedded-new-formula@:}
35140 @r{ @: C-x * g @: @: 35 @:calc-grab-region@:}
35141 @r{ @: C-x * i @: @: @:calc-info@:}
35142 @r{ @: C-x * j @: @: @:calc-embedded-select@:}
35143 @r{ @: C-x * k @: @: @:calc-keypad@:}
35144 @r{ @: C-x * l @: @: @:calc-load-everything@:}
35145 @r{ @: C-x * m @: @: @:read-kbd-macro@:}
35146 @r{ @: C-x * n @: @: 4 @:calc-embedded-next@:}
35147 @r{ @: C-x * o @: @: @:calc-other-window@:}
35148 @r{ @: C-x * p @: @: 4 @:calc-embedded-previous@:}
35149 @r{ @: C-x * q @:formula @: @:quick-calc@:}
35150 @r{ @: C-x * r @: @: 36 @:calc-grab-rectangle@:}
35151 @r{ @: C-x * s @: @: @:calc-info-summary@:}
35152 @r{ @: C-x * t @: @: @:calc-tutorial@:}
35153 @r{ @: C-x * u @: @: @:calc-embedded-update-formula@:}
35154 @r{ @: C-x * w @: @: @:calc-embedded-word@:}
35155 @r{ @: C-x * x @: @: @:calc-quit@:}
35156 @r{ @: C-x * y @: @:1,28,49 @:calc-copy-to-buffer@:}
35157 @r{ @: C-x * z @: @: @:calc-user-invocation@:}
35158 @r{ @: C-x * : @: @: 36 @:calc-grab-sum-down@:}
35159 @r{ @: C-x * _ @: @: 36 @:calc-grab-sum-across@:}
35160 @r{ @: C-x * ` @:editing @: 30 @:calc-embedded-edit@:}
35161 @r{ @: C-x * 0 @:(zero) @: @:calc-reset@:}
35162
35163 @c
35164 @r{ @: 0-9 @:number @: @:@:number}
35165 @r{ @: . @:number @: @:@:0.number}
35166 @r{ @: _ @:number @: @:-@:number}
35167 @r{ @: e @:number @: @:@:1e number}
35168 @r{ @: # @:number @: @:@:current-radix@tfn{#}number}
35169 @r{ @: P @:(in number) @: @:+/-@:}
35170 @r{ @: M @:(in number) @: @:mod@:}
35171 @r{ @: @@ ' " @: (in number)@: @:@:HMS form}
35172 @r{ @: h m s @: (in number)@: @:@:HMS form}
35173
35174 @c
35175 @r{ @: ' @:formula @: 37,46 @:@:formula}
35176 @r{ @: $ @:formula @: 37,46 @:$@:formula}
35177 @r{ @: " @:string @: 37,46 @:@:string}
35178
35179 @c
35180 @r{ a b@: + @: @: 2 @:add@:(a,b) a+b}
35181 @r{ a b@: - @: @: 2 @:sub@:(a,b) a@minus{}b}
35182 @r{ a b@: * @: @: 2 @:mul@:(a,b) a b, a*b}
35183 @r{ a b@: / @: @: 2 @:div@:(a,b) a/b}
35184 @r{ a b@: ^ @: @: 2 @:pow@:(a,b) a^b}
35185 @r{ a b@: I ^ @: @: 2 @:nroot@:(a,b) a^(1/b)}
35186 @r{ a b@: % @: @: 2 @:mod@:(a,b) a%b}
35187 @r{ a b@: \ @: @: 2 @:idiv@:(a,b) a\b}
35188 @r{ a b@: : @: @: 2 @:fdiv@:(a,b)}
35189 @r{ a b@: | @: @: 2 @:vconcat@:(a,b) a|b}
35190 @r{ a b@: I | @: @: @:vconcat@:(b,a) b|a}
35191 @r{ a b@: H | @: @: 2 @:append@:(a,b)}
35192 @r{ a b@: I H | @: @: @:append@:(b,a)}
35193 @r{ a@: & @: @: 1 @:inv@:(a) 1/a}
35194 @r{ a@: ! @: @: 1 @:fact@:(a) a!}
35195 @r{ a@: = @: @: 1 @:evalv@:(a)}
35196 @r{ a@: M-% @: @: @:percent@:(a) a%}
35197
35198 @c
35199 @r{ ... a@: @summarykey{RET} @: @: 1 @:@:... a a}
35200 @r{ ... a@: @summarykey{SPC} @: @: 1 @:@:... a a}
35201 @r{... a b@: @summarykey{TAB} @: @: 3 @:@:... b a}
35202 @r{. a b c@: M-@summarykey{TAB} @: @: 3 @:@:... b c a}
35203 @r{... a b@: @summarykey{LFD} @: @: 1 @:@:... a b a}
35204 @r{ ... a@: @summarykey{DEL} @: @: 1 @:@:...}
35205 @r{... a b@: M-@summarykey{DEL} @: @: 1 @:@:... b}
35206 @r{ @: M-@summarykey{RET} @: @: 4 @:calc-last-args@:}
35207 @r{ a@: ` @:editing @: 1,30 @:calc-edit@:}
35208
35209 @c
35210 @r{ ... a@: C-d @: @: 1 @:@:...}
35211 @r{ @: C-k @: @: 27 @:calc-kill@:}
35212 @r{ @: C-w @: @: 27 @:calc-kill-region@:}
35213 @r{ @: C-y @: @: @:calc-yank@:}
35214 @r{ @: C-_ @: @: 4 @:calc-undo@:}
35215 @r{ @: M-k @: @: 27 @:calc-copy-as-kill@:}
35216 @r{ @: M-w @: @: 27 @:calc-copy-region-as-kill@:}
35217
35218 @c
35219 @r{ @: [ @: @: @:@:[...}
35220 @r{[.. a b@: ] @: @: @:@:[a,b]}
35221 @r{ @: ( @: @: @:@:(...}
35222 @r{(.. a b@: ) @: @: @:@:(a,b)}
35223 @r{ @: , @: @: @:@:vector or rect complex}
35224 @r{ @: ; @: @: @:@:matrix or polar complex}
35225 @r{ @: .. @: @: @:@:interval}
35226
35227 @c
35228 @r{ @: ~ @: @: @:calc-num-prefix@:}
35229 @r{ @: < @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-left@:}
35230 @r{ @: > @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-right@:}
35231 @r{ @: @{ @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-down@:}
35232 @r{ @: @} @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-up@:}
35233 @r{ @: ? @: @: @:calc-help@:}
35234
35235 @c
35236 @r{ a@: n @: @: 1 @:neg@:(a) @minus{}a}
35237 @r{ @: o @: @: 4 @:calc-realign@:}
35238 @r{ @: p @:precision @: 31 @:calc-precision@:}
35239 @r{ @: q @: @: @:calc-quit@:}
35240 @r{ @: w @: @: @:calc-why@:}
35241 @r{ @: x @:command @: @:M-x calc-@:command}
35242 @r{ a@: y @: @:1,28,49 @:calc-copy-to-buffer@:}
35243
35244 @c
35245 @r{ a@: A @: @: 1 @:abs@:(a)}
35246 @r{ a b@: B @: @: 2 @:log@:(a,b)}
35247 @r{ a b@: I B @: @: 2 @:alog@:(a,b) b^a}
35248 @r{ a@: C @: @: 1 @:cos@:(a)}
35249 @r{ a@: I C @: @: 1 @:arccos@:(a)}
35250 @r{ a@: H C @: @: 1 @:cosh@:(a)}
35251 @r{ a@: I H C @: @: 1 @:arccosh@:(a)}
35252 @r{ @: D @: @: 4 @:calc-redo@:}
35253 @r{ a@: E @: @: 1 @:exp@:(a)}
35254 @r{ a@: H E @: @: 1 @:exp10@:(a) 10.^a}
35255 @r{ a@: F @: @: 1,11 @:floor@:(a,d)}
35256 @r{ a@: I F @: @: 1,11 @:ceil@:(a,d)}
35257 @r{ a@: H F @: @: 1,11 @:ffloor@:(a,d)}
35258 @r{ a@: I H F @: @: 1,11 @:fceil@:(a,d)}
35259 @r{ a@: G @: @: 1 @:arg@:(a)}
35260 @r{ @: H @:command @: 32 @:@:Hyperbolic}
35261 @r{ @: I @:command @: 32 @:@:Inverse}
35262 @r{ a@: J @: @: 1 @:conj@:(a)}
35263 @r{ @: K @:command @: 32 @:@:Keep-args}
35264 @r{ a@: L @: @: 1 @:ln@:(a)}
35265 @r{ a@: H L @: @: 1 @:log10@:(a)}
35266 @r{ @: M @: @: @:calc-more-recursion-depth@:}
35267 @r{ @: I M @: @: @:calc-less-recursion-depth@:}
35268 @r{ a@: N @: @: 5 @:evalvn@:(a)}
35269 @r{ @: P @: @: @:@:pi}
35270 @r{ @: I P @: @: @:@:gamma}
35271 @r{ @: H P @: @: @:@:e}
35272 @r{ @: I H P @: @: @:@:phi}
35273 @r{ a@: Q @: @: 1 @:sqrt@:(a)}
35274 @r{ a@: I Q @: @: 1 @:sqr@:(a) a^2}
35275 @r{ a@: R @: @: 1,11 @:round@:(a,d)}
35276 @r{ a@: I R @: @: 1,11 @:trunc@:(a,d)}
35277 @r{ a@: H R @: @: 1,11 @:fround@:(a,d)}
35278 @r{ a@: I H R @: @: 1,11 @:ftrunc@:(a,d)}
35279 @r{ a@: S @: @: 1 @:sin@:(a)}
35280 @r{ a@: I S @: @: 1 @:arcsin@:(a)}
35281 @r{ a@: H S @: @: 1 @:sinh@:(a)}
35282 @r{ a@: I H S @: @: 1 @:arcsinh@:(a)}
35283 @r{ a@: T @: @: 1 @:tan@:(a)}
35284 @r{ a@: I T @: @: 1 @:arctan@:(a)}
35285 @r{ a@: H T @: @: 1 @:tanh@:(a)}
35286 @r{ a@: I H T @: @: 1 @:arctanh@:(a)}
35287 @r{ @: U @: @: 4 @:calc-undo@:}
35288 @r{ @: X @: @: 4 @:calc-call-last-kbd-macro@:}
35289
35290 @c
35291 @r{ a b@: a = @: @: 2 @:eq@:(a,b) a=b}
35292 @r{ a b@: a # @: @: 2 @:neq@:(a,b) a!=b}
35293 @r{ a b@: a < @: @: 2 @:lt@:(a,b) a<b}
35294 @r{ a b@: a > @: @: 2 @:gt@:(a,b) a>b}
35295 @r{ a b@: a [ @: @: 2 @:leq@:(a,b) a<=b}
35296 @r{ a b@: a ] @: @: 2 @:geq@:(a,b) a>=b}
35297 @r{ a b@: a @{ @: @: 2 @:in@:(a,b)}
35298 @r{ a b@: a & @: @: 2,45 @:land@:(a,b) a&&b}
35299 @r{ a b@: a | @: @: 2,45 @:lor@:(a,b) a||b}
35300 @r{ a@: a ! @: @: 1,45 @:lnot@:(a) !a}
35301 @r{ a b c@: a : @: @: 45 @:if@:(a,b,c) a?b:c}
35302 @r{ a@: a . @: @: 1 @:rmeq@:(a)}
35303 @r{ a@: a " @: @: 7,8 @:calc-expand-formula@:}
35304
35305 @c
35306 @r{ a@: a + @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:sum@:(a,i,l,h)}
35307 @r{ a@: a - @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:asum@:(a,i,l,h)}
35308 @r{ a@: a * @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:prod@:(a,i,l,h)}
35309 @r{ a b@: a _ @: @: 2 @:subscr@:(a,b) a_b}
35310
35311 @c
35312 @r{ a b@: a \ @: @: 2 @:pdiv@:(a,b)}
35313 @r{ a b@: a % @: @: 2 @:prem@:(a,b)}
35314 @r{ a b@: a / @: @: 2 @:pdivrem@:(a,b) [q,r]}
35315 @r{ a b@: H a / @: @: 2 @:pdivide@:(a,b) q+r/b}
35316
35317 @c
35318 @r{ a@: a a @: @: 1 @:apart@:(a)}
35319 @r{ a@: a b @:old, new @: 38 @:subst@:(a,old,new)}
35320 @r{ a@: a c @:v @: 38 @:collect@:(a,v)}
35321 @r{ a@: a d @:v @: 4,38 @:deriv@:(a,v)}
35322 @r{ a@: H a d @:v @: 4,38 @:tderiv@:(a,v)}
35323 @r{ a@: a e @: @: @:esimplify@:(a)}
35324 @r{ a@: a f @: @: 1 @:factor@:(a)}
35325 @r{ a@: H a f @: @: 1 @:factors@:(a)}
35326 @r{ a b@: a g @: @: 2 @:pgcd@:(a,b)}
35327 @r{ a@: a i @:v @: 38 @:integ@:(a,v)}
35328 @r{ a@: a m @:pats @: 38 @:match@:(a,pats)}
35329 @r{ a@: I a m @:pats @: 38 @:matchnot@:(a,pats)}
35330 @r{ data x@: a p @: @: 28 @:polint@:(data,x)}
35331 @r{ data x@: H a p @: @: 28 @:ratint@:(data,x)}
35332 @r{ a@: a n @: @: 1 @:nrat@:(a)}
35333 @r{ a@: a r @:rules @:4,8,38 @:rewrite@:(a,rules,n)}
35334 @r{ a@: a s @: @: @:simplify@:(a)}
35335 @r{ a@: a t @:v, n @: 31,39 @:taylor@:(a,v,n)}
35336 @r{ a@: a v @: @: 7,8 @:calc-alg-evaluate@:}
35337 @r{ a@: a x @: @: 4,8 @:expand@:(a)}
35338
35339 @c
35340 @r{ data@: a F @:model, vars @: 48 @:fit@:(m,iv,pv,data)}
35341 @r{ data@: I a F @:model, vars @: 48 @:xfit@:(m,iv,pv,data)}
35342 @r{ data@: H a F @:model, vars @: 48 @:efit@:(m,iv,pv,data)}
35343 @r{ a@: a I @:v, l, h @: 38 @:ninteg@:(a,v,l,h)}
35344 @r{ a b@: a M @:op @: 22 @:mapeq@:(op,a,b)}
35345 @r{ a b@: I a M @:op @: 22 @:mapeqr@:(op,a,b)}
35346 @r{ a b@: H a M @:op @: 22 @:mapeqp@:(op,a,b)}
35347 @r{ a g@: a N @:v @: 38 @:minimize@:(a,v,g)}
35348 @r{ a g@: H a N @:v @: 38 @:wminimize@:(a,v,g)}
35349 @r{ a@: a P @:v @: 38 @:roots@:(a,v)}
35350 @r{ a g@: a R @:v @: 38 @:root@:(a,v,g)}
35351 @r{ a g@: H a R @:v @: 38 @:wroot@:(a,v,g)}
35352 @r{ a@: a S @:v @: 38 @:solve@:(a,v)}
35353 @r{ a@: I a S @:v @: 38 @:finv@:(a,v)}
35354 @r{ a@: H a S @:v @: 38 @:fsolve@:(a,v)}
35355 @r{ a@: I H a S @:v @: 38 @:ffinv@:(a,v)}
35356 @r{ a@: a T @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:table@:(a,i,l,h)}
35357 @r{ a g@: a X @:v @: 38 @:maximize@:(a,v,g)}
35358 @r{ a g@: H a X @:v @: 38 @:wmaximize@:(a,v,g)}
35359
35360 @c
35361 @r{ a b@: b a @: @: 9 @:and@:(a,b,w)}
35362 @r{ a@: b c @: @: 9 @:clip@:(a,w)}
35363 @r{ a b@: b d @: @: 9 @:diff@:(a,b,w)}
35364 @r{ a@: b l @: @: 10 @:lsh@:(a,n,w)}
35365 @r{ a n@: H b l @: @: 9 @:lsh@:(a,n,w)}
35366 @r{ a@: b n @: @: 9 @:not@:(a,w)}
35367 @r{ a b@: b o @: @: 9 @:or@:(a,b,w)}
35368 @r{ v@: b p @: @: 1 @:vpack@:(v)}
35369 @r{ a@: b r @: @: 10 @:rsh@:(a,n,w)}
35370 @r{ a n@: H b r @: @: 9 @:rsh@:(a,n,w)}
35371 @r{ a@: b t @: @: 10 @:rot@:(a,n,w)}
35372 @r{ a n@: H b t @: @: 9 @:rot@:(a,n,w)}
35373 @r{ a@: b u @: @: 1 @:vunpack@:(a)}
35374 @r{ @: b w @:w @: 9,50 @:calc-word-size@:}
35375 @r{ a b@: b x @: @: 9 @:xor@:(a,b,w)}
35376
35377 @c
35378 @r{c s l p@: b D @: @: @:ddb@:(c,s,l,p)}
35379 @r{ r n p@: b F @: @: @:fv@:(r,n,p)}
35380 @r{ r n p@: I b F @: @: @:fvb@:(r,n,p)}
35381 @r{ r n p@: H b F @: @: @:fvl@:(r,n,p)}
35382 @r{ v@: b I @: @: 19 @:irr@:(v)}
35383 @r{ v@: I b I @: @: 19 @:irrb@:(v)}
35384 @r{ a@: b L @: @: 10 @:ash@:(a,n,w)}
35385 @r{ a n@: H b L @: @: 9 @:ash@:(a,n,w)}
35386 @r{ r n a@: b M @: @: @:pmt@:(r,n,a)}
35387 @r{ r n a@: I b M @: @: @:pmtb@:(r,n,a)}
35388 @r{ r n a@: H b M @: @: @:pmtl@:(r,n,a)}
35389 @r{ r v@: b N @: @: 19 @:npv@:(r,v)}
35390 @r{ r v@: I b N @: @: 19 @:npvb@:(r,v)}
35391 @r{ r n p@: b P @: @: @:pv@:(r,n,p)}
35392 @r{ r n p@: I b P @: @: @:pvb@:(r,n,p)}
35393 @r{ r n p@: H b P @: @: @:pvl@:(r,n,p)}
35394 @r{ a@: b R @: @: 10 @:rash@:(a,n,w)}
35395 @r{ a n@: H b R @: @: 9 @:rash@:(a,n,w)}
35396 @r{ c s l@: b S @: @: @:sln@:(c,s,l)}
35397 @r{ n p a@: b T @: @: @:rate@:(n,p,a)}
35398 @r{ n p a@: I b T @: @: @:rateb@:(n,p,a)}
35399 @r{ n p a@: H b T @: @: @:ratel@:(n,p,a)}
35400 @r{c s l p@: b Y @: @: @:syd@:(c,s,l,p)}
35401
35402 @r{ r p a@: b # @: @: @:nper@:(r,p,a)}
35403 @r{ r p a@: I b # @: @: @:nperb@:(r,p,a)}
35404 @r{ r p a@: H b # @: @: @:nperl@:(r,p,a)}
35405 @r{ a b@: b % @: @: @:relch@:(a,b)}
35406
35407 @c
35408 @r{ a@: c c @: @: 5 @:pclean@:(a,p)}
35409 @r{ a@: c 0-9 @: @: @:pclean@:(a,p)}
35410 @r{ a@: H c c @: @: 5 @:clean@:(a,p)}
35411 @r{ a@: H c 0-9 @: @: @:clean@:(a,p)}
35412 @r{ a@: c d @: @: 1 @:deg@:(a)}
35413 @r{ a@: c f @: @: 1 @:pfloat@:(a)}
35414 @r{ a@: H c f @: @: 1 @:float@:(a)}
35415 @r{ a@: c h @: @: 1 @:hms@:(a)}
35416 @r{ a@: c p @: @: @:polar@:(a)}
35417 @r{ a@: I c p @: @: @:rect@:(a)}
35418 @r{ a@: c r @: @: 1 @:rad@:(a)}
35419
35420 @c
35421 @r{ a@: c F @: @: 5 @:pfrac@:(a,p)}
35422 @r{ a@: H c F @: @: 5 @:frac@:(a,p)}
35423
35424 @c
35425 @r{ a@: c % @: @: @:percent@:(a*100)}
35426
35427 @c
35428 @r{ @: d . @:char @: 50 @:calc-point-char@:}
35429 @r{ @: d , @:char @: 50 @:calc-group-char@:}
35430 @r{ @: d < @: @: 13,50 @:calc-left-justify@:}
35431 @r{ @: d = @: @: 13,50 @:calc-center-justify@:}
35432 @r{ @: d > @: @: 13,50 @:calc-right-justify@:}
35433 @r{ @: d @{ @:label @: 50 @:calc-left-label@:}
35434 @r{ @: d @} @:label @: 50 @:calc-right-label@:}
35435 @r{ @: d [ @: @: 4 @:calc-truncate-up@:}
35436 @r{ @: d ] @: @: 4 @:calc-truncate-down@:}
35437 @r{ @: d " @: @: 12,50 @:calc-display-strings@:}
35438 @r{ @: d @summarykey{SPC} @: @: @:calc-refresh@:}
35439 @r{ @: d @summarykey{RET} @: @: 1 @:calc-refresh-top@:}
35440
35441 @c
35442 @r{ @: d 0 @: @: 50 @:calc-decimal-radix@:}
35443 @r{ @: d 2 @: @: 50 @:calc-binary-radix@:}
35444 @r{ @: d 6 @: @: 50 @:calc-hex-radix@:}
35445 @r{ @: d 8 @: @: 50 @:calc-octal-radix@:}
35446
35447 @c
35448 @r{ @: d b @: @:12,13,50 @:calc-line-breaking@:}
35449 @r{ @: d c @: @: 50 @:calc-complex-notation@:}
35450 @r{ @: d d @:format @: 50 @:calc-date-notation@:}
35451 @r{ @: d e @: @: 5,50 @:calc-eng-notation@:}
35452 @r{ @: d f @:num @: 31,50 @:calc-fix-notation@:}
35453 @r{ @: d g @: @:12,13,50 @:calc-group-digits@:}
35454 @r{ @: d h @:format @: 50 @:calc-hms-notation@:}
35455 @r{ @: d i @: @: 50 @:calc-i-notation@:}
35456 @r{ @: d j @: @: 50 @:calc-j-notation@:}
35457 @r{ @: d l @: @: 12,50 @:calc-line-numbering@:}
35458 @r{ @: d n @: @: 5,50 @:calc-normal-notation@:}
35459 @r{ @: d o @:format @: 50 @:calc-over-notation@:}
35460 @r{ @: d p @: @: 12,50 @:calc-show-plain@:}
35461 @r{ @: d r @:radix @: 31,50 @:calc-radix@:}
35462 @r{ @: d s @: @: 5,50 @:calc-sci-notation@:}
35463 @r{ @: d t @: @: 27 @:calc-truncate-stack@:}
35464 @r{ @: d w @: @: 12,13 @:calc-auto-why@:}
35465 @r{ @: d z @: @: 12,50 @:calc-leading-zeros@:}
35466
35467 @c
35468 @r{ @: d B @: @: 50 @:calc-big-language@:}
35469 @r{ @: d C @: @: 50 @:calc-c-language@:}
35470 @r{ @: d E @: @: 50 @:calc-eqn-language@:}
35471 @r{ @: d F @: @: 50 @:calc-fortran-language@:}
35472 @r{ @: d M @: @: 50 @:calc-mathematica-language@:}
35473 @r{ @: d N @: @: 50 @:calc-normal-language@:}
35474 @r{ @: d O @: @: 50 @:calc-flat-language@:}
35475 @r{ @: d P @: @: 50 @:calc-pascal-language@:}
35476 @r{ @: d T @: @: 50 @:calc-tex-language@:}
35477 @r{ @: d L @: @: 50 @:calc-latex-language@:}
35478 @r{ @: d U @: @: 50 @:calc-unformatted-language@:}
35479 @r{ @: d W @: @: 50 @:calc-maple-language@:}
35480
35481 @c
35482 @r{ a@: f [ @: @: 4 @:decr@:(a,n)}
35483 @r{ a@: f ] @: @: 4 @:incr@:(a,n)}
35484
35485 @c
35486 @r{ a b@: f b @: @: 2 @:beta@:(a,b)}
35487 @r{ a@: f e @: @: 1 @:erf@:(a)}
35488 @r{ a@: I f e @: @: 1 @:erfc@:(a)}
35489 @r{ a@: f g @: @: 1 @:gamma@:(a)}
35490 @r{ a b@: f h @: @: 2 @:hypot@:(a,b)}
35491 @r{ a@: f i @: @: 1 @:im@:(a)}
35492 @r{ n a@: f j @: @: 2 @:besJ@:(n,a)}
35493 @r{ a b@: f n @: @: 2 @:min@:(a,b)}
35494 @r{ a@: f r @: @: 1 @:re@:(a)}
35495 @r{ a@: f s @: @: 1 @:sign@:(a)}
35496 @r{ a b@: f x @: @: 2 @:max@:(a,b)}
35497 @r{ n a@: f y @: @: 2 @:besY@:(n,a)}
35498
35499 @c
35500 @r{ a@: f A @: @: 1 @:abssqr@:(a)}
35501 @r{ x a b@: f B @: @: @:betaI@:(x,a,b)}
35502 @r{ x a b@: H f B @: @: @:betaB@:(x,a,b)}
35503 @r{ a@: f E @: @: 1 @:expm1@:(a)}
35504 @r{ a x@: f G @: @: 2 @:gammaP@:(a,x)}
35505 @r{ a x@: I f G @: @: 2 @:gammaQ@:(a,x)}
35506 @r{ a x@: H f G @: @: 2 @:gammag@:(a,x)}
35507 @r{ a x@: I H f G @: @: 2 @:gammaG@:(a,x)}
35508 @r{ a b@: f I @: @: 2 @:ilog@:(a,b)}
35509 @r{ a b@: I f I @: @: 2 @:alog@:(a,b) b^a}
35510 @r{ a@: f L @: @: 1 @:lnp1@:(a)}
35511 @r{ a@: f M @: @: 1 @:mant@:(a)}
35512 @r{ a@: f Q @: @: 1 @:isqrt@:(a)}
35513 @r{ a@: I f Q @: @: 1 @:sqr@:(a) a^2}
35514 @r{ a n@: f S @: @: 2 @:scf@:(a,n)}
35515 @r{ y x@: f T @: @: @:arctan2@:(y,x)}
35516 @r{ a@: f X @: @: 1 @:xpon@:(a)}
35517
35518 @c
35519 @r{ x y@: g a @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-add@:}
35520 @r{ @: g b @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-border@:}
35521 @r{ @: g c @: @: @:calc-graph-clear@:}
35522 @r{ @: g d @: @: 41 @:calc-graph-delete@:}
35523 @r{ x y@: g f @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-fast@:}
35524 @r{ @: g g @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-grid@:}
35525 @r{ @: g h @:title @: @:calc-graph-header@:}
35526 @r{ @: g j @: @: 4 @:calc-graph-juggle@:}
35527 @r{ @: g k @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-key@:}
35528 @r{ @: g l @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-log-x@:}
35529 @r{ @: g n @:name @: @:calc-graph-name@:}
35530 @r{ @: g p @: @: 42 @:calc-graph-plot@:}
35531 @r{ @: g q @: @: @:calc-graph-quit@:}
35532 @r{ @: g r @:range @: @:calc-graph-range-x@:}
35533 @r{ @: g s @: @: 12,13 @:calc-graph-line-style@:}
35534 @r{ @: g t @:title @: @:calc-graph-title-x@:}
35535 @r{ @: g v @: @: @:calc-graph-view-commands@:}
35536 @r{ @: g x @:display @: @:calc-graph-display@:}
35537 @r{ @: g z @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-zero-x@:}
35538
35539 @c
35540 @r{ x y z@: g A @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-add-3d@:}
35541 @r{ @: g C @:command @: @:calc-graph-command@:}
35542 @r{ @: g D @:device @: 43,44 @:calc-graph-device@:}
35543 @r{ x y z@: g F @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-fast-3d@:}
35544 @r{ @: g H @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-hide@:}
35545 @r{ @: g K @: @: @:calc-graph-kill@:}
35546 @r{ @: g L @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-log-y@:}
35547 @r{ @: g N @:number @: 43,51 @:calc-graph-num-points@:}
35548 @r{ @: g O @:filename @: 43,44 @:calc-graph-output@:}
35549 @r{ @: g P @: @: 42 @:calc-graph-print@:}
35550 @r{ @: g R @:range @: @:calc-graph-range-y@:}
35551 @r{ @: g S @: @: 12,13 @:calc-graph-point-style@:}
35552 @r{ @: g T @:title @: @:calc-graph-title-y@:}
35553 @r{ @: g V @: @: @:calc-graph-view-trail@:}
35554 @r{ @: g X @:format @: @:calc-graph-geometry@:}
35555 @r{ @: g Z @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-zero-y@:}
35556
35557 @c
35558 @r{ @: g C-l @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-log-z@:}
35559 @r{ @: g C-r @:range @: @:calc-graph-range-z@:}
35560 @r{ @: g C-t @:title @: @:calc-graph-title-z@:}
35561
35562 @c
35563 @r{ @: h b @: @: @:calc-describe-bindings@:}
35564 @r{ @: h c @:key @: @:calc-describe-key-briefly@:}
35565 @r{ @: h f @:function @: @:calc-describe-function@:}
35566 @r{ @: h h @: @: @:calc-full-help@:}
35567 @r{ @: h i @: @: @:calc-info@:}
35568 @r{ @: h k @:key @: @:calc-describe-key@:}
35569 @r{ @: h n @: @: @:calc-view-news@:}
35570 @r{ @: h s @: @: @:calc-info-summary@:}
35571 @r{ @: h t @: @: @:calc-tutorial@:}
35572 @r{ @: h v @:var @: @:calc-describe-variable@:}
35573
35574 @c
35575 @r{ @: j 1-9 @: @: @:calc-select-part@:}
35576 @r{ @: j @summarykey{RET} @: @: 27 @:calc-copy-selection@:}
35577 @r{ @: j @summarykey{DEL} @: @: 27 @:calc-del-selection@:}
35578 @r{ @: j ' @:formula @: 27 @:calc-enter-selection@:}
35579 @r{ @: j ` @:editing @: 27,30 @:calc-edit-selection@:}
35580 @r{ @: j " @: @: 7,27 @:calc-sel-expand-formula@:}
35581
35582 @c
35583 @r{ @: j + @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-add-both-sides@:}
35584 @r{ @: j - @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-sub-both-sides@:}
35585 @r{ @: j * @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-mul-both-sides@:}
35586 @r{ @: j / @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-div-both-sides@:}
35587 @r{ @: j & @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-invert@:}
35588
35589 @c
35590 @r{ @: j a @: @: 27 @:calc-select-additional@:}
35591 @r{ @: j b @: @: 12 @:calc-break-selections@:}
35592 @r{ @: j c @: @: @:calc-clear-selections@:}
35593 @r{ @: j d @: @: 12,50 @:calc-show-selections@:}
35594 @r{ @: j e @: @: 12 @:calc-enable-selections@:}
35595 @r{ @: j l @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-less@:}
35596 @r{ @: j m @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-more@:}
35597 @r{ @: j n @: @: 4 @:calc-select-next@:}
35598 @r{ @: j o @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-once@:}
35599 @r{ @: j p @: @: 4 @:calc-select-previous@:}
35600 @r{ @: j r @:rules @:4,8,27 @:calc-rewrite-selection@:}
35601 @r{ @: j s @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-here@:}
35602 @r{ @: j u @: @: 27 @:calc-unselect@:}
35603 @r{ @: j v @: @: 7,27 @:calc-sel-evaluate@:}
35604
35605 @c
35606 @r{ @: j C @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-commute@:}
35607 @r{ @: j D @: @: 4,27 @:calc-sel-distribute@:}
35608 @r{ @: j E @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-jump-equals@:}
35609 @r{ @: j I @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-isolate@:}
35610 @r{ @: H j I @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-isolate@: (full)}
35611 @r{ @: j L @: @: 4,27 @:calc-commute-left@:}
35612 @r{ @: j M @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-merge@:}
35613 @r{ @: j N @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-negate@:}
35614 @r{ @: j O @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-once-maybe@:}
35615 @r{ @: j R @: @: 4,27 @:calc-commute-right@:}
35616 @r{ @: j S @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-here-maybe@:}
35617 @r{ @: j U @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-unpack@:}
35618
35619 @c
35620 @r{ @: k a @: @: @:calc-random-again@:}
35621 @r{ n@: k b @: @: 1 @:bern@:(n)}
35622 @r{ n x@: H k b @: @: 2 @:bern@:(n,x)}
35623 @r{ n m@: k c @: @: 2 @:choose@:(n,m)}
35624 @r{ n m@: H k c @: @: 2 @:perm@:(n,m)}
35625 @r{ n@: k d @: @: 1 @:dfact@:(n) n!!}
35626 @r{ n@: k e @: @: 1 @:euler@:(n)}
35627 @r{ n x@: H k e @: @: 2 @:euler@:(n,x)}
35628 @r{ n@: k f @: @: 4 @:prfac@:(n)}
35629 @r{ n m@: k g @: @: 2 @:gcd@:(n,m)}
35630 @r{ m n@: k h @: @: 14 @:shuffle@:(n,m)}
35631 @r{ n m@: k l @: @: 2 @:lcm@:(n,m)}
35632 @r{ n@: k m @: @: 1 @:moebius@:(n)}
35633 @r{ n@: k n @: @: 4 @:nextprime@:(n)}
35634 @r{ n@: I k n @: @: 4 @:prevprime@:(n)}
35635 @r{ n@: k p @: @: 4,28 @:calc-prime-test@:}
35636 @r{ m@: k r @: @: 14 @:random@:(m)}
35637 @r{ n m@: k s @: @: 2 @:stir1@:(n,m)}
35638 @r{ n m@: H k s @: @: 2 @:stir2@:(n,m)}
35639 @r{ n@: k t @: @: 1 @:totient@:(n)}
35640
35641 @c
35642 @r{ n p x@: k B @: @: @:utpb@:(x,n,p)}
35643 @r{ n p x@: I k B @: @: @:ltpb@:(x,n,p)}
35644 @r{ v x@: k C @: @: @:utpc@:(x,v)}
35645 @r{ v x@: I k C @: @: @:ltpc@:(x,v)}
35646 @r{ n m@: k E @: @: @:egcd@:(n,m)}
35647 @r{v1 v2 x@: k F @: @: @:utpf@:(x,v1,v2)}
35648 @r{v1 v2 x@: I k F @: @: @:ltpf@:(x,v1,v2)}
35649 @r{ m s x@: k N @: @: @:utpn@:(x,m,s)}
35650 @r{ m s x@: I k N @: @: @:ltpn@:(x,m,s)}
35651 @r{ m x@: k P @: @: @:utpp@:(x,m)}
35652 @r{ m x@: I k P @: @: @:ltpp@:(x,m)}
35653 @r{ v x@: k T @: @: @:utpt@:(x,v)}
35654 @r{ v x@: I k T @: @: @:ltpt@:(x,v)}
35655
35656 @c
35657 @r{ @: m a @: @: 12,13 @:calc-algebraic-mode@:}
35658 @r{ @: m d @: @: @:calc-degrees-mode@:}
35659 @r{ @: m e @: @: @:calc-embedded-preserve-modes@:}
35660 @r{ @: m f @: @: 12 @:calc-frac-mode@:}
35661 @r{ @: m g @: @: 52 @:calc-get-modes@:}
35662 @r{ @: m h @: @: @:calc-hms-mode@:}
35663 @r{ @: m i @: @: 12,13 @:calc-infinite-mode@:}
35664 @r{ @: m m @: @: @:calc-save-modes@:}
35665 @r{ @: m p @: @: 12 @:calc-polar-mode@:}
35666 @r{ @: m r @: @: @:calc-radians-mode@:}
35667 @r{ @: m s @: @: 12 @:calc-symbolic-mode@:}
35668 @r{ @: m t @: @: 12 @:calc-total-algebraic-mode@:}
35669 @r{ @: m v @: @: 12,13 @:calc-matrix-mode@:}
35670 @r{ @: m w @: @: 13 @:calc-working@:}
35671 @r{ @: m x @: @: @:calc-always-load-extensions@:}
35672
35673 @c
35674 @r{ @: m A @: @: 12 @:calc-alg-simplify-mode@:}
35675 @r{ @: m B @: @: 12 @:calc-bin-simplify-mode@:}
35676 @r{ @: m C @: @: 12 @:calc-auto-recompute@:}
35677 @r{ @: m D @: @: @:calc-default-simplify-mode@:}
35678 @r{ @: m E @: @: 12 @:calc-ext-simplify-mode@:}
35679 @r{ @: m F @:filename @: 13 @:calc-settings-file-name@:}
35680 @r{ @: m N @: @: 12 @:calc-num-simplify-mode@:}
35681 @r{ @: m O @: @: 12 @:calc-no-simplify-mode@:}
35682 @r{ @: m R @: @: 12,13 @:calc-mode-record-mode@:}
35683 @r{ @: m S @: @: 12 @:calc-shift-prefix@:}
35684 @r{ @: m U @: @: 12 @:calc-units-simplify-mode@:}
35685
35686 @c
35687 @r{ @: r s @:register @: 27 @:calc-copy-to-register@:}
35688 @r{ @: r i @:register @: @:calc-insert-register@:}
35689
35690 @c
35691 @r{ @: s c @:var1, var2 @: 29 @:calc-copy-variable@:}
35692 @r{ @: s d @:var, decl @: @:calc-declare-variable@:}
35693 @r{ @: s e @:var, editing @: 29,30 @:calc-edit-variable@:}
35694 @r{ @: s i @:buffer @: @:calc-insert-variables@:}
35695 @r{ @: s k @:const, var @: 29 @:calc-copy-special-constant@:}
35696 @r{ a b@: s l @:var @: 29 @:@:a (letting var=b)}
35697 @r{ a ...@: s m @:op, var @: 22,29 @:calc-store-map@:}
35698 @r{ @: s n @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-neg@: (v/-1)}
35699 @r{ @: s p @:var @: 29 @:calc-permanent-variable@:}
35700 @r{ @: s r @:var @: 29 @:@:v (recalled value)}
35701 @r{ @: r 0-9 @: @: @:calc-recall-quick@:}
35702 @r{ a@: s s @:var @: 28,29 @:calc-store@:}
35703 @r{ a@: s 0-9 @: @: @:calc-store-quick@:}
35704 @r{ a@: s t @:var @: 29 @:calc-store-into@:}
35705 @r{ a@: t 0-9 @: @: @:calc-store-into-quick@:}
35706 @r{ @: s u @:var @: 29 @:calc-unstore@:}
35707 @r{ a@: s x @:var @: 29 @:calc-store-exchange@:}
35708
35709 @c
35710 @r{ @: s A @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-AlgSimpRules@:}
35711 @r{ @: s D @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-Decls@:}
35712 @r{ @: s E @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-EvalRules@:}
35713 @r{ @: s F @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-FitRules@:}
35714 @r{ @: s G @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-GenCount@:}
35715 @r{ @: s H @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-Holidays@:}
35716 @r{ @: s I @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-IntegLimit@:}
35717 @r{ @: s L @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-LineStyles@:}
35718 @r{ @: s P @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-PointStyles@:}
35719 @r{ @: s R @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-PlotRejects@:}
35720 @r{ @: s T @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-TimeZone@:}
35721 @r{ @: s U @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-Units@:}
35722 @r{ @: s X @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-ExtSimpRules@:}
35723
35724 @c
35725 @r{ a@: s + @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-plus@: (v+a)}
35726 @r{ a@: s - @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-minus@: (v-a)}
35727 @r{ a@: s * @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-times@: (v*a)}
35728 @r{ a@: s / @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-div@: (v/a)}
35729 @r{ a@: s ^ @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-power@: (v^a)}
35730 @r{ a@: s | @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-concat@: (v|a)}
35731 @r{ @: s & @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-inv@: (v^-1)}
35732 @r{ @: s [ @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-decr@: (v-1)}
35733 @r{ @: s ] @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-incr@: (v-(-1))}
35734 @r{ a b@: s : @: @: 2 @:assign@:(a,b) a @tfn{:=} b}
35735 @r{ a@: s = @: @: 1 @:evalto@:(a,b) a @tfn{=>}}
35736
35737 @c
35738 @r{ @: t [ @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-first@:}
35739 @r{ @: t ] @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-last@:}
35740 @r{ @: t < @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-scroll-left@:}
35741 @r{ @: t > @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-scroll-right@:}
35742 @r{ @: t . @: @: 12 @:calc-full-trail-vectors@:}
35743
35744 @c
35745 @r{ @: t b @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-backward@:}
35746 @r{ @: t d @: @: 12,50 @:calc-trail-display@:}
35747 @r{ @: t f @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-forward@:}
35748 @r{ @: t h @: @: @:calc-trail-here@:}
35749 @r{ @: t i @: @: @:calc-trail-in@:}
35750 @r{ @: t k @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-kill@:}
35751 @r{ @: t m @:string @: @:calc-trail-marker@:}
35752 @r{ @: t n @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-next@:}
35753 @r{ @: t o @: @: @:calc-trail-out@:}
35754 @r{ @: t p @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-previous@:}
35755 @r{ @: t r @:string @: @:calc-trail-isearch-backward@:}
35756 @r{ @: t s @:string @: @:calc-trail-isearch-forward@:}
35757 @r{ @: t y @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-yank@:}
35758
35759 @c
35760 @r{ d@: t C @:oz, nz @: @:tzconv@:(d,oz,nz)}
35761 @r{d oz nz@: t C @:$ @: @:tzconv@:(d,oz,nz)}
35762 @r{ d@: t D @: @: 15 @:date@:(d)}
35763 @r{ d@: t I @: @: 4 @:incmonth@:(d,n)}
35764 @r{ d@: t J @: @: 16 @:julian@:(d,z)}
35765 @r{ d@: t M @: @: 17 @:newmonth@:(d,n)}
35766 @r{ @: t N @: @: 16 @:now@:(z)}
35767 @r{ d@: t P @:1 @: 31 @:year@:(d)}
35768 @r{ d@: t P @:2 @: 31 @:month@:(d)}
35769 @r{ d@: t P @:3 @: 31 @:day@:(d)}
35770 @r{ d@: t P @:4 @: 31 @:hour@:(d)}
35771 @r{ d@: t P @:5 @: 31 @:minute@:(d)}
35772 @r{ d@: t P @:6 @: 31 @:second@:(d)}
35773 @r{ d@: t P @:7 @: 31 @:weekday@:(d)}
35774 @r{ d@: t P @:8 @: 31 @:yearday@:(d)}
35775 @r{ d@: t P @:9 @: 31 @:time@:(d)}
35776 @r{ d@: t U @: @: 16 @:unixtime@:(d,z)}
35777 @r{ d@: t W @: @: 17 @:newweek@:(d,w)}
35778 @r{ d@: t Y @: @: 17 @:newyear@:(d,n)}
35779
35780 @c
35781 @r{ a b@: t + @: @: 2 @:badd@:(a,b)}
35782 @r{ a b@: t - @: @: 2 @:bsub@:(a,b)}
35783
35784 @c
35785 @r{ @: u a @: @: 12 @:calc-autorange-units@:}
35786 @r{ a@: u b @: @: @:calc-base-units@:}
35787 @r{ a@: u c @:units @: 18 @:calc-convert-units@:}
35788 @r{ defn@: u d @:unit, descr @: @:calc-define-unit@:}
35789 @r{ @: u e @: @: @:calc-explain-units@:}
35790 @r{ @: u g @:unit @: @:calc-get-unit-definition@:}
35791 @r{ @: u p @: @: @:calc-permanent-units@:}
35792 @r{ a@: u r @: @: @:calc-remove-units@:}
35793 @r{ a@: u s @: @: @:usimplify@:(a)}
35794 @r{ a@: u t @:units @: 18 @:calc-convert-temperature@:}
35795 @r{ @: u u @:unit @: @:calc-undefine-unit@:}
35796 @r{ @: u v @: @: @:calc-enter-units-table@:}
35797 @r{ a@: u x @: @: @:calc-extract-units@:}
35798 @r{ a@: u 0-9 @: @: @:calc-quick-units@:}
35799
35800 @c
35801 @r{ v1 v2@: u C @: @: 20 @:vcov@:(v1,v2)}
35802 @r{ v1 v2@: I u C @: @: 20 @:vpcov@:(v1,v2)}
35803 @r{ v1 v2@: H u C @: @: 20 @:vcorr@:(v1,v2)}
35804 @r{ v@: u G @: @: 19 @:vgmean@:(v)}
35805 @r{ a b@: H u G @: @: 2 @:agmean@:(a,b)}
35806 @r{ v@: u M @: @: 19 @:vmean@:(v)}
35807 @r{ v@: I u M @: @: 19 @:vmeane@:(v)}
35808 @r{ v@: H u M @: @: 19 @:vmedian@:(v)}
35809 @r{ v@: I H u M @: @: 19 @:vhmean@:(v)}
35810 @r{ v@: u N @: @: 19 @:vmin@:(v)}
35811 @r{ v@: u S @: @: 19 @:vsdev@:(v)}
35812 @r{ v@: I u S @: @: 19 @:vpsdev@:(v)}
35813 @r{ v@: H u S @: @: 19 @:vvar@:(v)}
35814 @r{ v@: I H u S @: @: 19 @:vpvar@:(v)}
35815 @r{ @: u V @: @: @:calc-view-units-table@:}
35816 @r{ v@: u X @: @: 19 @:vmax@:(v)}
35817
35818 @c
35819 @r{ v@: u + @: @: 19 @:vsum@:(v)}
35820 @r{ v@: u * @: @: 19 @:vprod@:(v)}
35821 @r{ v@: u # @: @: 19 @:vcount@:(v)}
35822
35823 @c
35824 @r{ @: V ( @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-parens@:}
35825 @r{ @: V @{ @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-braces@:}
35826 @r{ @: V [ @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-brackets@:}
35827 @r{ @: V ] @:ROCP @: 50 @:calc-matrix-brackets@:}
35828 @r{ @: V , @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-commas@:}
35829 @r{ @: V < @: @: 50 @:calc-matrix-left-justify@:}
35830 @r{ @: V = @: @: 50 @:calc-matrix-center-justify@:}
35831 @r{ @: V > @: @: 50 @:calc-matrix-right-justify@:}
35832 @r{ @: V / @: @: 12,50 @:calc-break-vectors@:}
35833 @r{ @: V . @: @: 12,50 @:calc-full-vectors@:}
35834
35835 @c
35836 @r{ s t@: V ^ @: @: 2 @:vint@:(s,t)}
35837 @r{ s t@: V - @: @: 2 @:vdiff@:(s,t)}
35838 @r{ s@: V ~ @: @: 1 @:vcompl@:(s)}
35839 @r{ s@: V # @: @: 1 @:vcard@:(s)}
35840 @r{ s@: V : @: @: 1 @:vspan@:(s)}
35841 @r{ s@: V + @: @: 1 @:rdup@:(s)}
35842
35843 @c
35844 @r{ m@: V & @: @: 1 @:inv@:(m) 1/m}
35845
35846 @c
35847 @r{ v@: v a @:n @: @:arrange@:(v,n)}
35848 @r{ a@: v b @:n @: @:cvec@:(a,n)}
35849 @r{ v@: v c @:n >0 @: 21,31 @:mcol@:(v,n)}
35850 @r{ v@: v c @:n <0 @: 31 @:mrcol@:(v,-n)}
35851 @r{ m@: v c @:0 @: 31 @:getdiag@:(m)}
35852 @r{ v@: v d @: @: 25 @:diag@:(v,n)}
35853 @r{ v m@: v e @: @: 2 @:vexp@:(v,m)}
35854 @r{ v m f@: H v e @: @: 2 @:vexp@:(v,m,f)}
35855 @r{ v a@: v f @: @: 26 @:find@:(v,a,n)}
35856 @r{ v@: v h @: @: 1 @:head@:(v)}
35857 @r{ v@: I v h @: @: 1 @:tail@:(v)}
35858 @r{ v@: H v h @: @: 1 @:rhead@:(v)}
35859 @r{ v@: I H v h @: @: 1 @:rtail@:(v)}
35860 @r{ @: v i @:n @: 31 @:idn@:(1,n)}
35861 @r{ @: v i @:0 @: 31 @:idn@:(1)}
35862 @r{ h t@: v k @: @: 2 @:cons@:(h,t)}
35863 @r{ h t@: H v k @: @: 2 @:rcons@:(h,t)}
35864 @r{ v@: v l @: @: 1 @:vlen@:(v)}
35865 @r{ v@: H v l @: @: 1 @:mdims@:(v)}
35866 @r{ v m@: v m @: @: 2 @:vmask@:(v,m)}
35867 @r{ v@: v n @: @: 1 @:rnorm@:(v)}
35868 @r{ a b c@: v p @: @: 24 @:calc-pack@:}
35869 @r{ v@: v r @:n >0 @: 21,31 @:mrow@:(v,n)}
35870 @r{ v@: v r @:n <0 @: 31 @:mrrow@:(v,-n)}
35871 @r{ m@: v r @:0 @: 31 @:getdiag@:(m)}
35872 @r{ v i j@: v s @: @: @:subvec@:(v,i,j)}
35873 @r{ v i j@: I v s @: @: @:rsubvec@:(v,i,j)}
35874 @r{ m@: v t @: @: 1 @:trn@:(m)}
35875 @r{ v@: v u @: @: 24 @:calc-unpack@:}
35876 @r{ v@: v v @: @: 1 @:rev@:(v)}
35877 @r{ @: v x @:n @: 31 @:index@:(n)}
35878 @r{ n s i@: C-u v x @: @: @:index@:(n,s,i)}
35879
35880 @c
35881 @r{ v@: V A @:op @: 22 @:apply@:(op,v)}
35882 @r{ v1 v2@: V C @: @: 2 @:cross@:(v1,v2)}
35883 @r{ m@: V D @: @: 1 @:det@:(m)}
35884 @r{ s@: V E @: @: 1 @:venum@:(s)}
35885 @r{ s@: V F @: @: 1 @:vfloor@:(s)}
35886 @r{ v@: V G @: @: @:grade@:(v)}
35887 @r{ v@: I V G @: @: @:rgrade@:(v)}
35888 @r{ v@: V H @:n @: 31 @:histogram@:(v,n)}
35889 @r{ v w@: H V H @:n @: 31 @:histogram@:(v,w,n)}
35890 @r{ v1 v2@: V I @:mop aop @: 22 @:inner@:(mop,aop,v1,v2)}
35891 @r{ m@: V J @: @: 1 @:ctrn@:(m)}
35892 @r{ m1 m2@: V K @: @: @:kron@:(m1,m2)}
35893 @r{ m@: V L @: @: 1 @:lud@:(m)}
35894 @r{ v@: V M @:op @: 22,23 @:map@:(op,v)}
35895 @r{ v@: V N @: @: 1 @:cnorm@:(v)}
35896 @r{ v1 v2@: V O @:op @: 22 @:outer@:(op,v1,v2)}
35897 @r{ v@: V R @:op @: 22,23 @:reduce@:(op,v)}
35898 @r{ v@: I V R @:op @: 22,23 @:rreduce@:(op,v)}
35899 @r{ a n@: H V R @:op @: 22 @:nest@:(op,a,n)}
35900 @r{ a@: I H V R @:op @: 22 @:fixp@:(op,a)}
35901 @r{ v@: V S @: @: @:sort@:(v)}
35902 @r{ v@: I V S @: @: @:rsort@:(v)}
35903 @r{ m@: V T @: @: 1 @:tr@:(m)}
35904 @r{ v@: V U @:op @: 22 @:accum@:(op,v)}
35905 @r{ v@: I V U @:op @: 22 @:raccum@:(op,v)}
35906 @r{ a n@: H V U @:op @: 22 @:anest@:(op,a,n)}
35907 @r{ a@: I H V U @:op @: 22 @:afixp@:(op,a)}
35908 @r{ s t@: V V @: @: 2 @:vunion@:(s,t)}
35909 @r{ s t@: V X @: @: 2 @:vxor@:(s,t)}
35910
35911 @c
35912 @r{ @: Y @: @: @:@:user commands}
35913
35914 @c
35915 @r{ @: z @: @: @:@:user commands}
35916
35917 @c
35918 @r{ c@: Z [ @: @: 45 @:calc-kbd-if@:}
35919 @r{ c@: Z | @: @: 45 @:calc-kbd-else-if@:}
35920 @r{ @: Z : @: @: @:calc-kbd-else@:}
35921 @r{ @: Z ] @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-if@:}
35922
35923 @c
35924 @r{ @: Z @{ @: @: 4 @:calc-kbd-loop@:}
35925 @r{ c@: Z / @: @: 45 @:calc-kbd-break@:}
35926 @r{ @: Z @} @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-loop@:}
35927 @r{ n@: Z < @: @: @:calc-kbd-repeat@:}
35928 @r{ @: Z > @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-repeat@:}
35929 @r{ n m@: Z ( @: @: @:calc-kbd-for@:}
35930 @r{ s@: Z ) @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-for@:}
35931
35932 @c
35933 @r{ @: Z C-g @: @: @:@:cancel if/loop command}
35934
35935 @c
35936 @r{ @: Z ` @: @: @:calc-kbd-push@:}
35937 @r{ @: Z ' @: @: @:calc-kbd-pop@:}
35938 @r{ @: Z # @: @: @:calc-kbd-query@:}
35939
35940 @c
35941 @r{ comp@: Z C @:func, args @: 50 @:calc-user-define-composition@:}
35942 @r{ @: Z D @:key, command @: @:calc-user-define@:}
35943 @r{ @: Z E @:key, editing @: 30 @:calc-user-define-edit@:}
35944 @r{ defn@: Z F @:k, c, f, a, n@: 28 @:calc-user-define-formula@:}
35945 @r{ @: Z G @:key @: @:calc-get-user-defn@:}
35946 @r{ @: Z I @: @: @:calc-user-define-invocation@:}
35947 @r{ @: Z K @:key, command @: @:calc-user-define-kbd-macro@:}
35948 @r{ @: Z P @:key @: @:calc-user-define-permanent@:}
35949 @r{ @: Z S @: @: 30 @:calc-edit-user-syntax@:}
35950 @r{ @: Z T @: @: 12 @:calc-timing@:}
35951 @r{ @: Z U @:key @: @:calc-user-undefine@:}
35952
35953 @end format
35954
35955 @noindent
35956 NOTES
35957
35958 @enumerate
35959 @c 1
35960 @item
35961 Positive prefix arguments apply to @expr{n} stack entries.
35962 Negative prefix arguments apply to the @expr{-n}th stack entry.
35963 A prefix of zero applies to the entire stack. (For @key{LFD} and
35964 @kbd{M-@key{DEL}}, the meaning of the sign is reversed.)
35965
35966 @c 2
35967 @item
35968 Positive prefix arguments apply to @expr{n} stack entries.
35969 Negative prefix arguments apply to the top stack entry
35970 and the next @expr{-n} stack entries.
35971
35972 @c 3
35973 @item
35974 Positive prefix arguments rotate top @expr{n} stack entries by one.
35975 Negative prefix arguments rotate the entire stack by @expr{-n}.
35976 A prefix of zero reverses the entire stack.
35977
35978 @c 4
35979 @item
35980 Prefix argument specifies a repeat count or distance.
35981
35982 @c 5
35983 @item
35984 Positive prefix arguments specify a precision @expr{p}.
35985 Negative prefix arguments reduce the current precision by @expr{-p}.
35986
35987 @c 6
35988 @item
35989 A prefix argument is interpreted as an additional step-size parameter.
35990 A plain @kbd{C-u} prefix means to prompt for the step size.
35991
35992 @c 7
35993 @item
35994 A prefix argument specifies simplification level and depth.
35995 1=Default, 2=like @kbd{a s}, 3=like @kbd{a e}.
35996
35997 @c 8
35998 @item
35999 A negative prefix operates only on the top level of the input formula.
36000
36001 @c 9
36002 @item
36003 Positive prefix arguments specify a word size of @expr{w} bits, unsigned.
36004 Negative prefix arguments specify a word size of @expr{w} bits, signed.
36005
36006 @c 10
36007 @item
36008 Prefix arguments specify the shift amount @expr{n}. The @expr{w} argument
36009 cannot be specified in the keyboard version of this command.
36010
36011 @c 11
36012 @item
36013 From the keyboard, @expr{d} is omitted and defaults to zero.
36014
36015 @c 12
36016 @item
36017 Mode is toggled; a positive prefix always sets the mode, and a negative
36018 prefix always clears the mode.
36019
36020 @c 13
36021 @item
36022 Some prefix argument values provide special variations of the mode.
36023
36024 @c 14
36025 @item
36026 A prefix argument, if any, is used for @expr{m} instead of taking
36027 @expr{m} from the stack. @expr{M} may take any of these values:
36028 @iftex
36029 {@advance@tableindent10pt
36030 @end iftex
36031 @table @asis
36032 @item Integer
36033 Random integer in the interval @expr{[0 .. m)}.
36034 @item Float
36035 Random floating-point number in the interval @expr{[0 .. m)}.
36036 @item 0.0
36037 Gaussian with mean 1 and standard deviation 0.
36038 @item Error form
36039 Gaussian with specified mean and standard deviation.
36040 @item Interval
36041 Random integer or floating-point number in that interval.
36042 @item Vector
36043 Random element from the vector.
36044 @end table
36045 @iftex
36046 }
36047 @end iftex
36048
36049 @c 15
36050 @item
36051 A prefix argument from 1 to 6 specifies number of date components
36052 to remove from the stack. @xref{Date Conversions}.
36053
36054 @c 16
36055 @item
36056 A prefix argument specifies a time zone; @kbd{C-u} says to take the
36057 time zone number or name from the top of the stack. @xref{Time Zones}.
36058
36059 @c 17
36060 @item
36061 A prefix argument specifies a day number (0-6, 0-31, or 0-366).
36062
36063 @c 18
36064 @item
36065 If the input has no units, you will be prompted for both the old and
36066 the new units.
36067
36068 @c 19
36069 @item
36070 With a prefix argument, collect that many stack entries to form the
36071 input data set. Each entry may be a single value or a vector of values.
36072
36073 @c 20
36074 @item
36075 With a prefix argument of 1, take a single
36076 @texline @var{n}@math{\times2}
36077 @infoline @mathit{@var{N}x2}
36078 matrix from the stack instead of two separate data vectors.
36079
36080 @c 21
36081 @item
36082 The row or column number @expr{n} may be given as a numeric prefix
36083 argument instead. A plain @kbd{C-u} prefix says to take @expr{n}
36084 from the top of the stack. If @expr{n} is a vector or interval,
36085 a subvector/submatrix of the input is created.
36086
36087 @c 22
36088 @item
36089 The @expr{op} prompt can be answered with the key sequence for the
36090 desired function, or with @kbd{x} or @kbd{z} followed by a function name,
36091 or with @kbd{$} to take a formula from the top of the stack, or with
36092 @kbd{'} and a typed formula. In the last two cases, the formula may
36093 be a nameless function like @samp{<#1+#2>} or @samp{<x, y : x+y>}, or it
36094 may include @kbd{$}, @kbd{$$}, etc. (where @kbd{$} will correspond to the
36095 last argument of the created function), or otherwise you will be
36096 prompted for an argument list. The number of vectors popped from the
36097 stack by @kbd{V M} depends on the number of arguments of the function.
36098
36099 @c 23
36100 @item
36101 One of the mapping direction keys @kbd{_} (horizontal, i.e., map
36102 by rows or reduce across), @kbd{:} (vertical, i.e., map by columns or
36103 reduce down), or @kbd{=} (map or reduce by rows) may be used before
36104 entering @expr{op}; these modify the function name by adding the letter
36105 @code{r} for ``rows,'' @code{c} for ``columns,'' @code{a} for ``across,''
36106 or @code{d} for ``down.''
36107
36108 @c 24
36109 @item
36110 The prefix argument specifies a packing mode. A nonnegative mode
36111 is the number of items (for @kbd{v p}) or the number of levels
36112 (for @kbd{v u}). A negative mode is as described below. With no
36113 prefix argument, the mode is taken from the top of the stack and
36114 may be an integer or a vector of integers.
36115 @iftex
36116 {@advance@tableindent-20pt
36117 @end iftex
36118 @table @cite
36119 @item -1
36120 (@var{2}) Rectangular complex number.
36121 @item -2
36122 (@var{2}) Polar complex number.
36123 @item -3
36124 (@var{3}) HMS form.
36125 @item -4
36126 (@var{2}) Error form.
36127 @item -5
36128 (@var{2}) Modulo form.
36129 @item -6
36130 (@var{2}) Closed interval.
36131 @item -7
36132 (@var{2}) Closed .. open interval.
36133 @item -8
36134 (@var{2}) Open .. closed interval.
36135 @item -9
36136 (@var{2}) Open interval.
36137 @item -10
36138 (@var{2}) Fraction.
36139 @item -11
36140 (@var{2}) Float with integer mantissa.
36141 @item -12
36142 (@var{2}) Float with mantissa in @expr{[1 .. 10)}.
36143 @item -13
36144 (@var{1}) Date form (using date numbers).
36145 @item -14
36146 (@var{3}) Date form (using year, month, day).
36147 @item -15
36148 (@var{6}) Date form (using year, month, day, hour, minute, second).
36149 @end table
36150 @iftex
36151 }
36152 @end iftex
36153
36154 @c 25
36155 @item
36156 A prefix argument specifies the size @expr{n} of the matrix. With no
36157 prefix argument, @expr{n} is omitted and the size is inferred from
36158 the input vector.
36159
36160 @c 26
36161 @item
36162 The prefix argument specifies the starting position @expr{n} (default 1).
36163
36164 @c 27
36165 @item
36166 Cursor position within stack buffer affects this command.
36167
36168 @c 28
36169 @item
36170 Arguments are not actually removed from the stack by this command.
36171
36172 @c 29
36173 @item
36174 Variable name may be a single digit or a full name.
36175
36176 @c 30
36177 @item
36178 Editing occurs in a separate buffer. Press @kbd{C-c C-c} (or
36179 @key{LFD}, or in some cases @key{RET}) to finish the edit, or kill the
36180 buffer with @kbd{C-x k} to cancel the edit. The @key{LFD} key prevents evaluation
36181 of the result of the edit.
36182
36183 @c 31
36184 @item
36185 The number prompted for can also be provided as a prefix argument.
36186
36187 @c 32
36188 @item
36189 Press this key a second time to cancel the prefix.
36190
36191 @c 33
36192 @item
36193 With a negative prefix, deactivate all formulas. With a positive
36194 prefix, deactivate and then reactivate from scratch.
36195
36196 @c 34
36197 @item
36198 Default is to scan for nearest formula delimiter symbols. With a
36199 prefix of zero, formula is delimited by mark and point. With a
36200 non-zero prefix, formula is delimited by scanning forward or
36201 backward by that many lines.
36202
36203 @c 35
36204 @item
36205 Parse the region between point and mark as a vector. A nonzero prefix
36206 parses @var{n} lines before or after point as a vector. A zero prefix
36207 parses the current line as a vector. A @kbd{C-u} prefix parses the
36208 region between point and mark as a single formula.
36209
36210 @c 36
36211 @item
36212 Parse the rectangle defined by point and mark as a matrix. A positive
36213 prefix @var{n} divides the rectangle into columns of width @var{n}.
36214 A zero or @kbd{C-u} prefix parses each line as one formula. A negative
36215 prefix suppresses special treatment of bracketed portions of a line.
36216
36217 @c 37
36218 @item
36219 A numeric prefix causes the current language mode to be ignored.
36220
36221 @c 38
36222 @item
36223 Responding to a prompt with a blank line answers that and all
36224 later prompts by popping additional stack entries.
36225
36226 @c 39
36227 @item
36228 Answer for @expr{v} may also be of the form @expr{v = v_0} or
36229 @expr{v - v_0}.
36230
36231 @c 40
36232 @item
36233 With a positive prefix argument, stack contains many @expr{y}'s and one
36234 common @expr{x}. With a zero prefix, stack contains a vector of
36235 @expr{y}s and a common @expr{x}. With a negative prefix, stack
36236 contains many @expr{[x,y]} vectors. (For 3D plots, substitute
36237 @expr{z} for @expr{y} and @expr{x,y} for @expr{x}.)
36238
36239 @c 41
36240 @item
36241 With any prefix argument, all curves in the graph are deleted.
36242
36243 @c 42
36244 @item
36245 With a positive prefix, refines an existing plot with more data points.
36246 With a negative prefix, forces recomputation of the plot data.
36247
36248 @c 43
36249 @item
36250 With any prefix argument, set the default value instead of the
36251 value for this graph.
36252
36253 @c 44
36254 @item
36255 With a negative prefix argument, set the value for the printer.
36256
36257 @c 45
36258 @item
36259 Condition is considered ``true'' if it is a nonzero real or complex
36260 number, or a formula whose value is known to be nonzero; it is ``false''
36261 otherwise.
36262
36263 @c 46
36264 @item
36265 Several formulas separated by commas are pushed as multiple stack
36266 entries. Trailing @kbd{)}, @kbd{]}, @kbd{@}}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{"}
36267 delimiters may be omitted. The notation @kbd{$$$} refers to the value
36268 in stack level three, and causes the formula to replace the top three
36269 stack levels. The notation @kbd{$3} refers to stack level three without
36270 causing that value to be removed from the stack. Use @key{LFD} in place
36271 of @key{RET} to prevent evaluation; use @kbd{M-=} in place of @key{RET}
36272 to evaluate variables.
36273
36274 @c 47
36275 @item
36276 The variable is replaced by the formula shown on the right. The
36277 Inverse flag reverses the order of the operands, e.g., @kbd{I s - x}
36278 assigns
36279 @texline @math{x \coloneq a-x}.
36280 @infoline @expr{x := a-x}.
36281
36282 @c 48
36283 @item
36284 Press @kbd{?} repeatedly to see how to choose a model. Answer the
36285 variables prompt with @expr{iv} or @expr{iv;pv} to specify
36286 independent and parameter variables. A positive prefix argument
36287 takes @mathit{@var{n}+1} vectors from the stack; a zero prefix takes a matrix
36288 and a vector from the stack.
36289
36290 @c 49
36291 @item
36292 With a plain @kbd{C-u} prefix, replace the current region of the
36293 destination buffer with the yanked text instead of inserting.
36294
36295 @c 50
36296 @item
36297 All stack entries are reformatted; the @kbd{H} prefix inhibits this.
36298 The @kbd{I} prefix sets the mode temporarily, redraws the top stack
36299 entry, then restores the original setting of the mode.
36300
36301 @c 51
36302 @item
36303 A negative prefix sets the default 3D resolution instead of the
36304 default 2D resolution.
36305
36306 @c 52
36307 @item
36308 This grabs a vector of the form [@var{prec}, @var{wsize}, @var{ssize},
36309 @var{radix}, @var{flfmt}, @var{ang}, @var{frac}, @var{symb}, @var{polar},
36310 @var{matrix}, @var{simp}, @var{inf}]. A prefix argument from 1 to 12
36311 grabs the @var{n}th mode value only.
36312 @end enumerate
36313
36314 @iftex
36315 (Space is provided below for you to keep your own written notes.)
36316 @page
36317 @endgroup
36318 @end iftex
36319
36320
36321 @c [end-summary]
36322
36323 @node Key Index, Command Index, Summary, Top
36324 @unnumbered Index of Key Sequences
36325
36326 @printindex ky
36327
36328 @node Command Index, Function Index, Key Index, Top
36329 @unnumbered Index of Calculator Commands
36330
36331 Since all Calculator commands begin with the prefix @samp{calc-}, the
36332 @kbd{x} key has been provided as a variant of @kbd{M-x} which automatically
36333 types @samp{calc-} for you. Thus, @kbd{x last-args} is short for
36334 @kbd{M-x calc-last-args}.
36335
36336 @printindex pg
36337
36338 @node Function Index, Concept Index, Command Index, Top
36339 @unnumbered Index of Algebraic Functions
36340
36341 This is a list of built-in functions and operators usable in algebraic
36342 expressions. Their full Lisp names are derived by adding the prefix
36343 @samp{calcFunc-}, as in @code{calcFunc-sqrt}.
36344 @iftex
36345 All functions except those noted with ``*'' have corresponding
36346 Calc keystrokes and can also be found in the Calc Summary.
36347 @end iftex
36348
36349 @printindex tp
36350
36351 @node Concept Index, Variable Index, Function Index, Top
36352 @unnumbered Concept Index
36353
36354 @printindex cp
36355
36356 @node Variable Index, Lisp Function Index, Concept Index, Top
36357 @unnumbered Index of Variables
36358
36359 The variables in this list that do not contain dashes are accessible
36360 as Calc variables. Add a @samp{var-} prefix to get the name of the
36361 corresponding Lisp variable.
36362
36363 The remaining variables are Lisp variables suitable for @code{setq}ing
36364 in your Calc init file or @file{.emacs} file.
36365
36366 @printindex vr
36367
36368 @node Lisp Function Index, , Variable Index, Top
36369 @unnumbered Index of Lisp Math Functions
36370
36371 The following functions are meant to be used with @code{defmath}, not
36372 @code{defun} definitions. For names that do not start with @samp{calc-},
36373 the corresponding full Lisp name is derived by adding a prefix of
36374 @samp{math-}.
36375
36376 @printindex fn
36377
36378 @bye
36379
36380
36381 @ignore
36382 arch-tag: 77a71809-fa4d-40be-b2cc-da3e8fb137c0
36383 @end ignore